Мануал для ниссан ноут е12

Инструкции по эксплуатации и ремонту

Аватара пользователя

Aleksey1

Сообщения: 23
Стаж: 5 лет 10 месяцев
Откуда: Хабаровск
Авто: Note е12 dig-s 2017
Благодарил (а): 11 раз
Поблагодарили: 9 раз

Инструкции по эксплуатации и ремонту

Сообщение

Aleksey1 » 22 июн 2017, 19:55

Если есть у кого то японская сервисная книга то сфотайте обложку на закрытой книге заключительную,а я на японском сайте постараюсь найти. Я так на форя нашёл когдато.

Аватара пользователя

Revizor007

Сообщения: 140
Стаж: 5 лет 7 месяцев
Откуда: Владивосток
Авто: Note NE12 X/FOUR 2014
Благодарил (а): 37 раз
Поблагодарили: 47 раз

Инструкции по эксплуатации и ремонту

Сообщение

Revizor007 » 22 апр 2018, 21:28

А есть у кого-нибудь сервис-мануал, либо ссылка на двигатель HR12DE хоть на каком-нибудь языке? Либо ссылка на сервис-мануал Note E12, но чтобы там присутствовал данный двигатель? Ну либо ссылка на проверенных продавцов, где можно купить такой?

Аватара пользователя

Maksimus

Сообщения: 17
Стаж: 4 года 10 месяцев
Откуда: Находка
Авто: E12 / 2014
Поблагодарили: 1 раз

Инструкции по эксплуатации и ремонту

Сообщение

Maksimus » 03 июн 2018, 21:09

Приветствую. подскажите можно переключать с режима D в режим L в движении?
:?

Отправлено спустя 1 минуту 41 секунду:
На каких скоростях это можно делать? И какую продолжительность времени его использовать? Например на D в сопочку крутую вообще не едет, а вот на L очень даже хорошо. Но у нас есть подъемы по несколько км очень крутых…

Аватара пользователя

Vladimir

Сообщения: 1124
Стаж: 6 лет 7 месяцев
Откуда: Хабаровск
Авто: Note e-power HE12 2017
Благодарил (а): 1112 раз
Поблагодарили: 611 раз

Инструкции по эксплуатации и ремонту

Сообщение

Vladimir » 03 июн 2018, 22:55

Maksimus, Положение селектора L блокируют переключение передачи выше указанной. То есть если вы ехали 90 км/ч, на четвёртой передаче и перевели селектор на «L», то так и будете ехать на четвёртой. Но при торможении АКПП вначале переведёт на 3-ю передачу, потом на 2-ю, потом на 1-ю по мере надобности, но не будет переключать на 3-ю и 4-ю. Так что переключаться можно. А использовать можно столько, сколько нужно, ведь при движении в горочку вы не перетруждаете двигатель и вариатор ненужными переключениями скоростей

Аватара пользователя

gil-081

Сообщения: 26
Стаж: 4 года 10 месяцев
Откуда: Хабаровск
Авто: Note e12 2014
Благодарил (а): 58 раз
Поблагодарили: 7 раз

Инструкции по эксплуатации и ремонту

Сообщение

gil-081 » 23 июн 2019, 21:01

Товарищи, всем доброго времени. Наткнулся сегодня на некую деталь, которая у меня просто болталась на двух проводках под передним бампером. Кто подскажет, что это за штука?) пытался методом «на ощупь» найти место, где она раньше висела или крепилась к чему-то, но так и не понял, где именно все крепилось, нужно решётку радиатора снимать…

_20190623_205910.JPG
_20190623_210007.JPG

Аватара пользователя

Денис12121991

Сообщения: 2
Стаж: 3 года 4 месяца
Откуда: уссурийск
Авто: Note e12 2012

Инструкции по эксплуатации и ремонту

Сообщение

Денис12121991 » 02 фев 2020, 21:42

Добрый вечер, подскажите куда два провода подключать которые на поводке с противотуманки шла, просто не могу понять есть и рэле и предохранитель на ней, а штатной проводки на машине нету чтобы туманки подключить

Руководство на английском языке по техническому обслуживанию и ремонту автомобиля Nissan Note серии E12.

Рекомендуем перед началом ремонта или обслуживания изучить руководство, это позволит избежать проблем при эксплуатации и узнать о всех функциях и особенностях автомобиля.

  • Автор:
  • Издательство: Nissan
  • Год издания: 2013
  • Страниц:
  • Формат: PDF
  • Размер: 60,0 Mb
  • ◀Скачать Service Manual Nissan GT-R 2007-2014 г

    Скачать Учебный курс Nissan Patrol Y62▶

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    ACC

    ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    ACC

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 3
    ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM …………… 3

    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 3
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….. 3

    F

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………. 5

    G

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………………… 5

    H

    Accelerator Control …………………………………………… 5

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 3

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    ACC-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009452281

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    ACC-2

    2014 Note

    ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015312

    ACC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JSBIA1087GB

    1.

    Accelerator pedal

    2. Brake pedal bracket

    A.

    H

    Locating hook

    B. Locating pin

    I

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009443948

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    J

    Disconnect harness connector (A) from the accelerator pedal.
    Remove bolts (B) and accelerator pedal (1).
    CAUTION:
    • Do not disassemble accelerator pedal.
    • Do not drop or impact accelerator pedal.
    • Do not expose accelerator pedal to water.

    K

    L

    M
    ALBIA1149ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    N

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    • Insert locating pin into brake pedal bracket to position accelerator pedal.
    • Perform accelerator pedal inspection. Refer to ACC-3, «Inspection».

    Inspection

    O
    INFOID:0000000009443949

    P

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    Revision: April 2013

    ACC-3

    2014 Note

    ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check that the accelerator pedal moves smoothly within the specified range.
    Accelerator pedal stroke (A) : Refer to ACC-5, «Accelerator Control».

    ALBIA1151ZZ

    • Check the accelerator pedal height.
    Accelerator pedal height

    : Refer to ACC-5, «Accelerator Control».

    CAUTION:
    • Whenever the harness connector of the accelerator pedal position sensor has been disconnected,
    perform “ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING”. Refer to EC-113, «Work Procedure».
    • The accelerator pedal should return smoothly to the fully released position.

    Revision: April 2013

    ACC-4

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Accelerator Control

    INFOID:0000000009443950

    ACC

    Unit: mm (in)

    C

    D

    E

    ALBIA1151ZZ

    Accelerator pedal stroke (A)

    49.8 — 52.6 (1.96 — 2.07)

    Accelerator pedal height

    113.0 — 123.0 (4.45 — 4.84)

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    ACC-5

    2014 Note

    DRIVER INFORMATION & MULTIMEDIA

    SECTION

    AV

    AUDIO, VISUAL & NAVIGATION SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    BASE AUDIO

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …….. 23

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 5
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 5

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….23

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 25

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 5
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 5

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT …. 25

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 6

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER ………………………….. 26

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 6
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 6
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 6

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 7
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 7
    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 7
    Audio unit ………………………………………………………… 7
    Speaker …………………………………………………………… 7
    Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder
    …… 8

    AUDIO UNIT ………………………………………………………25
    AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure …………………..25
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..26
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..28

    AUDIO SYSTEM ……………………………………….. 30

    I

    J

    K

    Symptom Table ……………………………………………….30

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION …………… 32
    Description ………………………………………………………32

    L

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 33

    System Description …………………………………………. 10

    Exploded View …………………………………………………33
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..33

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT) …………….11
    Diagnosis Description ……………………………………… 11
    On Board Diagnosis Function …………………………… 11

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER ………………………….. 34

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 14

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER ……………………………. 35

    M

    AV

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..34
    O

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..35

    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 14

    ROD ANTENNA ………………………………………… 36

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 16

    Exploded View …………………………………………………36
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..36

    BASE AUDIO ……………………………………………..16

    ANTENNA FEEDER …………………………………… 37

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 23
    Revision: April 2013

    H

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 30

    AUDIO UNIT ……………………………………………… 33

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 16

    G

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER ……………………………. 28

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….10

    AUDIO UNIT ……………………………………………….14

    F

    AV-1

    Feeder Layout …………………………………………………37

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    2014 Note

    P

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………… 38

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ….. 72

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………. 38

    AUDIO UNIT …………………………………………………….. 72
    AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ………………….. 72

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» ……………………………………………………….. 38
    Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis ……………………… 38
    Precaution for Harness Repair …………………………. 38
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………… 39

    PREPARATION ……………………………………. 40
    PREPARATION …………………………………………. 40
    Special Service Tools ……………………………………… 40
    Commercial Service Tools ……………………………….. 40

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………. 41
    COMPONENT PARTS ………………………………… 41
    Component Parts Location ………………………………. 41
    Audio Unit ……………………………………………………… 42
    Speaker ………………………………………………………… 42
    USB Interface ………………………………………………… 42
    Bluetooth Control Unit …………………………………….. 43
    Bluetooth Antenna ………………………………………….. 43
    Steering Switch ………………………………………………. 43
    Microphone ……………………………………………………. 43
    Rear View Camera …………………………………………. 44
    Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder
    … 44

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT ………………………… 72
    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure …………………………………………………………… 72

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER …………………………… 74
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 74

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER …………………………….. 76
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 76

    BLUETOOTH® VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT …….. 78
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 78

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT… 80
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 80

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT …………………………………………………………. 81
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 81

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ……………….. 83
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 83

    STEERING SWITCH …………………………………… 85
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 85

    USB CONNECTOR ……………………………………. 87

    SYSTEM ……………………………………………………. 46

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 87

    System Description …………………………………………. 46

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 88

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT) …………… 48
    Description …………………………………………………….. 48
    On Board Diagnosis Function …………………………… 48

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT) ………………………………………………. 53

    AUDIO SYSTEM ………………………………………… 88
    Symptom Table ………………………………………………. 88

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION ……………. 91
    Description …………………………………………………….. 91

    Diagnosis Description ……………………………………… 53
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………… 53

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ………….. 93

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 54

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 93
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 93

    AUDIO UNIT ……………………………………………… 54
    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 54

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT …………………. 57
    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 57

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………. 59
    DISPLAY AUDIO ……………………………………….. 59
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 59

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 70
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ……… 70
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………… 70

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 72
    Revision: April 2013

    AUDIO UNIT ……………………………………………… 93

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER …………………………… 94
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 94

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER …………………………….. 95
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 95

    USB INTERFACE ………………………………………. 96
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 96

    REAR VIEW CAMERA ……………………………….. 97
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 97

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT …………………. 98
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 98

    BLUETOOTH® ANTENNA ………………………….. 99

    AV-2

    2014 Note

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 99

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM ……………………………. 121
    Wiring Diagram ……………………………………………… 121

    STEERING SWITCH …………………………………. 100
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 100

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………… 132

    MICROPHONE …………………………………………. 101

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …… 132

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 101

    ROD ANTENNA ……………………………………….. 102
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 102
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 102

    ANTENNA FEEDER ………………………………….. 103
    Feeder Layout ………………………………………………. 103

    NAVIGATION
    PRECAUTION …………………………………….. 104
    PRECAUTIONS ………………………………………… 104
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» ……………………………………………………… 104
    Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis …………………….. 104
    Precaution for Harness Repair ………………………… 104
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………. 105

    PREPARATION ………………………………….. 106
    PREPARATION ………………………………………… 106
    Special Service Tools …………………………………….. 106
    Commercial Service Tools ……………………………… 106

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………… 107

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT ……………. 134
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
    CONTROL UNIT ……………………………………………… 134
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
    CONTROL UNIT : Description …………………………. 134
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
    CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure ………………….. 134
    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) …………… 134
    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description ……………………………………………………….. 135
    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work
    Procedure …………………………………………………….. 135
    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List ………………………………………………… 136

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ………………….. 137
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 137
    Diagnosis Procedure …………………………………….. 137
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 138
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 139

    U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………. 140

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 140

    U122F AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………. 141
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 141

    U1244 GPS ANTENNA …………………………….. 142
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 142
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 142

    L

    M

    U1263 USB ……………………………………………… 143 AV

    System Description ……………………………………….. 111

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 143
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 143

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT).. 115

    U1264 ANTENNA AMP. ……………………………. 144

    O

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 144
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 144

    U12AA CONFIGURATION ERROR ……………. 145
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 145
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 145

    AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………………….. 117
    Reference Value …………………………………………… 117
    DTC Index ……………………………………………………. 120

    U12AC AV CONTROL UNIT ……………………… 146

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………… 121

    U12AD AV CONTROL UNIT ……………………… 147

    Revision: April 2013

    D

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ………………….. 138

    Component Parts Location ……………………………… 107
    AV Control Unit …………………………………………….. 107
    Speaker ……………………………………………………….. 108
    USB Interface and AUX In Jack ………………………. 108
    Steering Switch …………………………………………….. 109
    Microphone ………………………………………………….. 109
    Rear View Camera ………………………………………… 109
    Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder
    .. 109
    GPS Antenna ……………………………………………….. 110
    SD Card ………………………………………………………. 110

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………… 117

    C

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ……………………. 137

    U1217 AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………. 139

    Description …………………………………………………… 115
    On Board Diagnosis Function …………………………. 115
    CONSULT Function ………………………………………. 116

    B

    Work Flow …………………………………………………….. 132

    COMPONENT PARTS ………………………………. 107

    SYSTEM ………………………………………………….. 111

    A

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 146

    AV-3

    2014 Note

    P

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..147

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………… 166

    U12AE AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………. 148

    MULTI AV SYSTEM ………………………………….. 166

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..148

    U12AF AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………. 149
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..149

    U12B0 POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE ………….. 150
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..150
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………150

    U12B1 POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE ………….. 151

    Symptom Table …………………………………………….. 166

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION …………… 169
    Description …………………………………………………… 169

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………. 178
    AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………………….. 178
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 178

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..151
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………151

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER ………………………….. 179

    U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT ……………………….. 152

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER ……………………………. 180

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..152

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 180

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT … 153

    USB INTERFACE ……………………………………… 181

    AV CONTROL UNIT ………………………………………….153
    AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ……….153

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER …………………………. 154
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………154

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER …………………………… 156
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………156

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 179

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 181

    AUXILIARY INPUT JACK ………………………….. 182
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 182

    STEERING SWITCH ………………………………….. 183
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 183

    MICROPHONE …………………………………………. 184
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 184

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ……………………………………………………….. 158

    REAR VIEW CAMERA ………………………………. 185

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………158

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 185

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ……………… 160

    GPS ANTENNA ………………………………………… 186

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………160

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 186

    STEERING SWITCH …………………………………. 162

    ROD ANTENNA ………………………………………… 187

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………162

    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 187
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 187

    USB CONNECTOR …………………………………… 164
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………164

    AUXILIARY INPUT JACK …………………………. 165

    ANTENNA FEEDER ………………………………….. 188
    Feeder Layout ………………………………………………. 188

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………165

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-4

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009640319

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009640320

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component K
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    L
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    M
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    AV
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    O
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.
    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-5

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009640321

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009640322

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009509282

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3058ZZ

    No.

    Component

    1.

    Rod antenna

    2.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    3.

    Rear door speaker RH

    4.

    Front door speaker RH

    5.

    Front door speaker LH

    6.

    Rear door speaker LH

    7.

    Audio unit

    G

    Function
    Refer to AV-8, «Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder».

    H

    Refer to AV-7, «Speaker».

    I

    Refer to AV-7, «Audio unit».

    J

    Audio unit

    INFOID:0000000009509278

    K

    DESCRIPTION
    • AM/FM electronic tuner radio, CD player, and auxiliary input jack
    are integrated into the audio unit.
    • The audio unit supports CD-R/CD-RW and provides the playback
    of MP3/WMA music files.

    L

    M

    AV
    JSNIA5416ZZ

    Speaker

    INFOID:0000000009509279

    O

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    • 16.5 cm (6.5 in) speakers are installed in the bottom of the front doors.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-7

    P

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Sound signals are input from the audio unit to output high, mid and
    low range sounds.

    [BASE AUDIO]

    JPNIA1454ZZ

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    • 16.5 cm (6.5 in) speakers are installed in the bottom of the rear doors.
    • Sound signals are input from the audio unit to output high, mid and
    low range sounds.

    JPNIA1454ZZ

    Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder

    INFOID:0000000009509280

    RADIO ANTENNA
    AM/FM radio rod antenna and antenna base is located on the rear of the roof. The antenna amp. is built into
    the antenna base.

    AWNIA3059GB

    ANTENNA FEEDER LAYOUT

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-8

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    AWNIA3114ZZ

    1.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    2.

    Rod Antenna

    4.

    M67, M350

    5.

    M106

    3.

    M351

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-9

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009460105

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    ALNIA1522GB

    AUDIO SYSTEM
    The audio system consists of the following components
    • Audio unit
    • Front door speakers
    • Rear door speakers
    • Antenna amp.
    • Rod antenna
    When the audio system is on, AM/FM signals received by the rod antenna are amplified by the antenna amp.
    and sent to the audio unit. The audio unit then sends audio signals to the front door speakers and rear door
    speakers.
    Refer to Owner’s Manual for audio system operating instructions.

    SPEED SENSITIVE VOLUME SYSTEM
    Volume level of this system goes up and down automatically in proportion to the vehicle speed. The control
    level can be selected by the customer. Refer to Owner’s Manual for operating instructions.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-10

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)

    A

    Diagnosis Description

    INFOID:0000000009460106

    The audio unit on board diagnosis performs the functions listed in the table below:
    Mode

    B

    Description

    Hardware/Software Versions

    The following information is available for the audio unit:
    • hardware version.
    • software version.
    • EQ pin info.

    Speaker Channel Check

    The connection of the speakers to the audio unit can be confirmed.

    Communication Diagnosis

    The AV communication (M-CAN) message history can be monitored.

    On Board Diagnosis Function

    C

    D

    INFOID:0000000009460107

    E

    METHOD OF STARTING
    F

    Hardware/Software Versions and Speaker Channel Check
    1. Turn the ignition ON.
    2. Turn the audio system OFF.
    3. While pressing the preset 1 button, turn the volume control dial
    clockwise or counterclockwise 30 clicks or more.

    G

    H

    I

    AWNIA3042ZZ

    4.

    Initially, all display segments will be illuminated.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    ALNIA1382GB

    5.

    AV

    To exit hardware/software versions and speaker channel check, turn the ignition OFF.

    Communication Diagnosis
    1. Turn the ignition ON.
    2. Turn the audio system OFF.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-11

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    3. While pressing the preset 6 button, turn the volume control dial
    clockwise or counterclockwise 30 clicks or more.

    [BASE AUDIO]

    ALNIA1516ZZ

    4.

    Initially, the communication diagnosis mode is displayed.

    ALNIA1387GB

    5.

    To exit communication diagnosis, turn the ignition OFF.

    SELF DIAGNOSIS MODE
    Hardware/Software Versions
    1. Press the DISP button to enter versions display, and the audio
    head unit software version is displayed.

    ALNIA1383GB

    2. With each additional press of the DISP button, the following information is available:
    HARD V###### (hardware version)
    EEP V###### (EEPROM version)
    @@@@ EQ1-4 # (EQ pin info)
    If an EQ error is present, INVALID EQ is displayed
    3. Hold the DISP button down to return to all display segments screen.
    Speaker Channel Check

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-12

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    1. Press the RPT/DRM button to enter speaker channel check, and
    the front left tweeter (front tweeter LH) is displayed.

    [BASE AUDIO]
    A

    B

    C
    ALNIA1384GB

    D

    2.
    3.

    With each additional press of the RPT/DRM button, the following information is available:
    FR RIGHT TWEETER (front tweeter RH)
    FR RIGHT (front door speaker RH)
    RR RIGHT (rear speaker RH)
    RR LEFT (rear speaker LH)
    FR LEFT (front door speaker LH)
    Hold the RPT/DRM button down to return to all display segments screen.

    E

    F

    Communication Diagnosis
    1. Press the DISP button, and the M-CAN message transmission
    error history screen is displayed.

    G

    H

    I

    ALNIA1386GB

    2.
    3.
    4.

    5.

    J

    Press the DISP button again, and the TEL $$ nn (CMF message reception error history from M-CAN TEL)
    screen is displayed.
    K
    Press the DISP button again, and the TROUBLE DEL. (deletion of M-CAN message communication history) screen is displayed. To retain the M-CAN message communication history and return to the communication diagnosis mode screen, press the DISP button.
    L
    To proceed to the M-CAN message communication history deletion screen, press the SEEK/TRACK
    button. The REC DEL-NO? (selection of M-CAN message communication history deletion) screen is displayed. To cancel M-CAN message communication history deletion, wait 6 seconds and you will be
    returned to the TROUBLE DEL. (deletion of M-CAN message communication history) screen. To proceed M
    with M-CAN message communication history deletion, press the SEEK/TRACK
    button again.
    The REC [email protected] (selection of M-CAN message communication history deletion) screen is displayed. To cancel M-CAN message communication history deletion, press the SEEK/TRACK
    button AV
    and you will be returned to the REC DEL-NO? (selection of M-CAN message communication history deletion) screen. To proceed with M-CAN message communication history deletion, wait 6 seconds and the
    communication history deletion will be executed. After the communication history deletion has been executed, you will be returned to the TROUBLE DEL. (deletion of M-CAN message communication history) O
    screen. To return to the communication diagnosis mode screen, press the DISP button.
    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-13

    2014 Note

    AUDIO UNIT
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    AUDIO UNIT
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009460110

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    AWNIA3055ZZ

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    Terminal
    (Wire color)

    Description

    Condition

    +

    Signal name

    Input/
    Output

    2
    (GR)

    3
    (P)

    Sound signal front speaker
    LH

    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    ON

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    Sound output.

    SKIA0177E

    4
    (W)

    5
    (R)

    Sound signal rear speaker
    LH

    Output

    ON

    Sound output.

    SKIA0177E

    7
    (W)

    Ground

    ACC power supply

    Input

    ACC

    9
    (LG/R)

    Ground

    Illumination control signal

    Input

    ON

    Headlamps ON.

    11
    (O)

    12
    (V)

    Output

    ON

    Sound output.

    Sound signal front speaker
    RH

    Battery voltage
    Battery voltage

    SKIA0177E

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-14

    2014 Note

    AUDIO UNIT
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description

    Signal name

    Condition
    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    A

    B

    13
    (L)

    14
    (Y)

    Sound signal rear speaker
    RH

    Output

    ON

    C

    Sound output.

    SKIA0177E

    D

    E
    18
    (LG)

    Ground

    Vehicle speed signal

    Input

    ON

    When vehicle speed is approx. 40 km/h (25 MPH).

    F
    JSNIA0012GB

    19
    (Y)

    Ground

    Battery power supply

    21
    (B/W)

    Ground

    23
    (B)

    Input

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    EQ1 Ground

    ON

    0V

    Ground

    EQ3 Ground

    ON

    0V

    37
    (B)

    Ground

    Antenna amp. ON signal

    Output

    ON

    Audio unit ON, AM or FM
    selected.

    Battery voltage

    38
    (B)

    Ground

    AM/FM antenna signal

    Input

    ON

    Audio unit ON, AM or FM
    selected.

    5.0 V

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-15

    2014 Note

    BASE AUDIO
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    BASE AUDIO
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009460112

    AANWA0858GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-16

    2014 Note

    BASE AUDIO
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1704GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-17

    2014 Note

    BASE AUDIO
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1705GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-18

    2014 Note

    BASE AUDIO
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1706GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-19

    2014 Note

    BASE AUDIO
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1707GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-20

    2014 Note

    BASE AUDIO
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1708GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-21

    2014 Note

    BASE AUDIO
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1709GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-22

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009460113

    B

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    AWNIA2404GB

    M

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM

    AV

    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when the
    incident/malfunction occurred).
    O

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer. Verify relation between the symptom and the condition
    when the symptom is detected. Refer to AV-30, «Symptom Table».
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
    Inspect according to Diagnostic Procedure of the system.
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-23

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    4.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnostic Procedure.
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.FINAL CHECK

    Refer to confirmed symptom in step 2, and make sure that the symptom is not detected.
    Was the repair confirmed?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-24

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    AUDIO UNIT

    B

    AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460114

    C

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-16, «Wiring Diagram».
    D

    1.CHECK FUSE
    Check that the following fuses are not blown.

    E
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    7

    ACC power supply

    18 (10A)

    19

    Battery power supply

    29 (15A)

    F

    Are the fuses blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    G

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M43.
    Check voltage between audio unit connector M43 and ground.

    I

    Audio unit
    Connector

    Ground

    Terminal
    7

    M43

    19

    Condition
    Ignition switch: ON
    Ignition switch: OFF

    Voltage
    (Approx.)
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    J

    K

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    L

    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M101.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M101 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector
    M101

    Ground

    Terminal

    Continuity

    AV

    21

    23

    Yes

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-25

    P

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460116

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-16, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR CHECK
    Check the audio unit and speaker connectors for the following:
    • Proper connection
    • Damage
    • Disconnected or loose terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminals or connectors.

    2.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect audio unit connector M43 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M43 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Front door speaker
    Terminal

    Connector

    2

    11

    3.

    2
    1

    D112 (RH)

    12

    Continuity

    1

    D12 (LH)

    3

    M43

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M43 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    2
    3

    M43

    11
    12

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect audio unit connector M43 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Turn ignition switch to ACC.
    Push audio unit POWER switch.
    Check signal between the terminals of audio unit connector M43.
    Audio unit connector M43
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    AV-26

    Reference value

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2

    3

    11

    12

    A
    Audio signal output

    B
    SKIB3609E

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front door speaker. Refer to AV-34, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-33, «Removal and Installation».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-27

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460118

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-16, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR CHECK
    Check the audio unit and speaker connectors for the following:
    • Proper connection
    • Damage
    • Disconnected or loose terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminals or connectors.

    2.CHECK REAR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect audio unit connector M43 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M43 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Rear door speaker
    Terminal

    Connector

    4

    13

    3.

    2
    1

    D307 (RH)

    14

    Continuity

    1

    D207 (LH)

    5

    M43

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M43 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    4
    5

    M43

    13
    14

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK REAR SPEAKER SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect audio unit connector M43 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Turn ignition switch to ACC.
    Push audio unit POWER switch.
    Check signal between the terminals of audio unit connector M43.
    Audio unit connector M43
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    AV-28

    Reference value

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4

    5

    13

    14

    A
    Audio signal output

    B
    SKIB3609E

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear door speaker. Refer to AV-35, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-33, «Removal and Installation».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-29

    2014 Note

    AUDIO SYSTEM
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    AUDIO SYSTEM
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009460123

    RELATED TO AUDIO
    Symptoms
    The disk cannot be removed.

    Check items
    Audio unit

    No sound from all speakers.

    • Speaker circuit shorted to ground.
    Refer to AV-16, «Wiring Diagram».
    • Audio unit power supply and ground circuits malfunction.
    Refer to AV-25, «AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure».

    Only a certain speaker (front door speaker
    LH, front door speaker RH, rear door
    speaker LH, rear door speaker RH) does
    not output sound.

    • Poor connector connection of speaker.
    • Sound signal circuit malfunction between
    audio unit and speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-26, «Diagnosis Procedure» (front door
    speaker).
    — AV-28, «Diagnosis Procedure» (rear door
    speaker).
    • Malfunction in speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-34, «Removal and Installation» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-35, «Removal and Installation» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-11, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Noise comes out from all speakers.

    Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-11, «On Board Diagnosis Function».

    Noise comes out only from a certain speaker (front door speaker LH, front door speaker RH, rear door speaker LH, rear door
    speaker RH).

    • Poor connector connection of speaker.
    • Sound signal circuit malfunction between
    audio unit and speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-26, «Diagnosis Procedure» (front door
    speaker).
    — AV-28, «Diagnosis Procedure» (rear door
    speaker).
    • Malfunction in speaker.
    • Poor Installation of speaker (e.g. backlash and looseness).
    Refer to:
    — AV-34, «Removal and Installation» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-35, «Removal and Installation» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-11, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Noise is mixed with radio only (when the vehicle hits a bump or while driving over bad
    roads)

    Poor connector connection of antenna or
    antenna feeder.
    Refer to AV-37, «Feeder Layout».

    No sound comes out or the level of the
    sound is low.

    Noise is mixed with audio.

    Revision: April 2013

    Probable malfunction location
    Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-11, «On Board Diagnosis Function».

    AV-30

    2014 Note

    AUDIO SYSTEM
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptoms

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    No radio reception or poor reception.

    • Other audio sounds are normal.
    • Antenna amp. ON signal circuit malfunc• Any radio station cannot be received or
    tion.
    poor reception is caused even after movRefer to AV-14, «Reference Value».
    ing to a service area with good reception • Poor connector connection of antenna or
    antenna feeder.
    (e.g. a place with clear view and no obRefer to AV-37, «Feeder Layout».
    stacles generating external noises).

    Buzz/rattle sound from speaker

    The majority of buzz/rattle sounds are not
    indicative of an issue with the speaker, usually something nearby the speaker is causing the buzz/rattle.

    Refer to «SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS» in the appropriate interior trim section.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-31

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009460124

    RELATED TO NOISE
    The majority of the audio concerns are the result of outside causes (bad CD, electromagnetic interference,
    etc.).
    The following noise results from variations in field strength, such as fading noise and multi-path noise, or
    external noise from trains and other sources. It is not a malfunction.
    • Fading noise: This noise occurs because of variations in the field strength in a narrow range due to mountains or buildings blocking the signal.
    • Multi-path noise: This noise results from the waves sent directly from the broadcast station arriving at the
    antenna at a different time from the waves which reflect off mountains or buildings.
    The vehicle itself can be a source of noise if noise prevention parts or electrical equipment is malfunctioning.
    Check if noise is caused and/or changed by engine speed, ignition switch turned to each position, and operation of each piece of electrical equipment, and determine the cause.
    NOTE:
    The source of the noise can be found easily by listening to the noise while removing the fuses of electrical
    components, one by one.
    Type of Noise and Possible Cause
    Occurrence condition
    Occurs only when engine is ON.

    Possible cause

    A continuous growling noise occurs. The speed of
    the noise varies with changes in the engine speed.

    The occurrence of the noise is linked with the operation of the fuel pump.
    Noise only occurs when various
    electrical components are operating.

    • Ignition components
    • Fuel pump condenser

    A cracking or snapping sound occurs with the operation of various switches.

    • Relay malfunction, audio unit malfunction

    The noise occurs when various motors are operating.

    • Motor case ground
    • Motor

    The noise occurs constantly, not just under certain conditions.

    • Rear defogger coil malfunction
    • Open circuit in printed heater
    • Poor ground of antenna feeder line

    A cracking or snapping sound occurs while the vehicle is being driven, especially when
    it is vibrating excessively.

    • Ground wire of body parts
    • Ground due to improper part installation
    • Wiring connections or a short circuit

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-32

    2014 Note

    AUDIO UNIT
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    AUDIO UNIT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009640309

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AWNIA3121ZZ

    1. Audio unit bracket (LH)

    2.

    Audio unit

    3.

    Audio unit bracket (RH)

    L

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640310

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    K

    M

    Remove the negative battery cable. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the audio unit screws.
    Partially remove the audio unit to gain access to the harness connectors.
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the audio unit and remove.
    Remove the audio unit bracket screws from each side of the audio unit (if necessary).

    AV

    O

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    P

    AV-33

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640311

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from front door speaker.
    Remove the front door speaker screws (A).
    Remove the front door speaker (1).

    AWNIA3062ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-34

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640312

    REMOVAL

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    C

    Remove the rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the rear door speaker.
    Remove the rear door speaker screws (A).
    Remove the rear door speaker (1).

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3089ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-35

    2014 Note

    ROD ANTENNA
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ROD ANTENNA
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009667865

    AWNIA3124ZZ

    1. Antenna rod

    2. Antenna base

    A. Antenna nut

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009667866

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Lower the rear portion of the headlining. Refer to INT-29, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the antenna (satellite radio model shown).
    Remove the antenna nut (A) and remove the antenna.

    AWNIA3115ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    If the antenna nut is tightened looser than the specified torque this will lower the sensitivity of the
    antenna. If the antenna nut is tightened tighter than the specified torque this will deform the roof
    panel.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-36

    2014 Note

    ANTENNA FEEDER
    [BASE AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ANTENNA FEEDER

    A

    Feeder Layout

    INFOID:0000000009460134

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWNIA3114ZZ

    1.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    2.

    Rod Antenna

    4.

    M67, M350

    5.

    M106

    3.

    M351

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-37

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009640323

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009640324

    AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
    • Do not apply voltage of 7.0 V or higher to the measurement terminals.
    • Use the tester with its open terminal voltage being 7.0 V or less.
    • Be sure to turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal before
    checking the circuit.

    Precaution for Harness Repair

    INFOID:0000000009640325

    AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
    • Solder the repaired parts, and wrap with tape. [Frays of twisted line
    must be within 110 mm (4.33 in).]

    PKIA0306E

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-38

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Do not perform bypass wire connections for the repair parts. (The
    spliced wire will become separated and the characteristics of
    twisted line will be lost.)

    [DISPLAY AUDIO]
    A

    B

    C
    PKIA0307E

    D

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009640326

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-39

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009640327

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009640328

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-40

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009509283

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AWNIA3091ZZ

    A. Luggage side lower finisher (RH) removed
    No.

    B. Front of headliner

    Rod antenna

    2.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    C. Center of back door

    L

    Component

    1.

    Function
    Refer to AV-44, «Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder».

    3.

    Rear door speaker RH

    4.

    Front door speaker RH

    5.

    Front door speaker LH

    6.

    Rear door speaker LH

    7.

    Audio unit

    Refer to AV-42, «Audio Unit».

    8.

    Steering wheel audio control switches

    Refer to AV-43, «Steering Switch».

    9.

    USB interface

    Refer to AV-42, «USB Interface».

    10.

    Bluetooth® control unit

    Refer to AV-43, «Bluetooth Control Unit».

    11.

    Bluetooth® antenna

    Refer to AV-43, «Bluetooth Antenna».

    12.

    Microphone

    Refer to AV-43, «Microphone».

    13.

    Rear view camera

    Refer to AV-44, «Rear View Camera».

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    M

    AV
    Refer to AV-42, «Speaker».

    O

    AV-41

    P

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Audio Unit

    INFOID:0000000009509284

    Description
    • AM/FM electronic tuner radio, CD drive, auxiliary input jack, and
    camera controller are integrated into the audio unit.
    • The display can show audio status and rear view monitor images.
    • Music files stored in iPod®*/USB memory can be played using the
    separate USB connector.

    JSNIA4722ZZ

    Speaker

    INFOID:0000000009509285

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    • 16.5 cm (6.5 in) speakers are installed in the bottom of the front doors.
    • Sound signals are input from the audio unit to output high, mid and
    low range sounds.

    JPNIA1454ZZ

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    • 16.5 cm (6.5 in) speakers are installed in the bottom of the rear doors.
    • Sound signals are input from the audio unit to output high, mid and
    low range sounds.

    JPNIA1454ZZ

    USB Interface

    INFOID:0000000009509289

    • USB Interface is installed in the console.
    • iPod® and USB memory can be connected to the audio unit.

    JPNIA1447ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-42

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Bluetooth Control Unit

    INFOID:0000000009509286

    A

    • Inputs the TEL voice signal from Bluetooth® antenna and outputs it
    to the audio unit
    • Connected to the audio unit via AV communication.

    B

    C

    D
    JSNIA4236ZZ

    Bluetooth Antenna

    INFOID:0000000009509287

    Receives the TEL voice signal from cellular phone and outputs it to
    the Bluetooth® control unit.

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JSNIA4237ZZ

    Steering Switch

    INFOID:0000000009509290

    • Operations for audio and hands-free phone are possible.
    • Switch is connected to the Bluetooth® control unit.

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSNIA4329ZZ

    Microphone

    INFOID:0000000009509288

    • The microphone is installed in the roof in front of the map lamp
    assembly.
    • Power is supplied from the Bluetooth® control unit.

    M

    AV

    O

    P
    JPNIA1448ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-43

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Rear View Camera

    INFOID:0000000009509293

    • The rear view camera is installed to the back door finisher.
    • Power is supplied from the audio unit.

    JPNIA1452ZZ

    Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder

    INFOID:0000000009509291

    RADIO ANTENNA
    AM/FM radio rod antenna and antenna base is located on the rear of the roof. The antenna amp. is built into
    the antenna base.

    AWNIA3059GB

    ANTENNA FEEDER LAYOUT

    AWNIA3114ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-44

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    1.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    2.

    Rod Antenna

    4.

    M67, M350

    5.

    M108

    3.

    M351

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-45

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009460150

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    AWNIA3105GB

    AUDIO SYSTEM
    The audio system consists of the following components
    • Audio unit
    • Front door speakers
    • Rear door speakers
    • Steering switches
    • USB interface
    • Antenna amp.
    • Rod antenna
    When the audio system is on, AM/FM signals received by the rod antenna are amplified by the antenna amp.
    and sent to the audio unit. The audio unit then sends audio signals to the front door speakers and rear door
    speakers.
    Refer to Owner’s Manual for audio system operating instructions.

    HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM
    System Operation
    NOTE:
    Cellular telephones must have their wireless connection set up (paired) before using the Bluetooth® telephone
    system.
    The Bluetooth® telephone system allows users who have a Bluetooth® cellular telephone to make a wireless
    connection between their cellular telephone and the Bluetooth® control unit. Hands-free cellular telephone
    calls can be sent and received. Some Bluetooth® cellular telephones may not be recognized by the Bluetooth®
    control unit. When a cellular telephone or the Bluetooth® control unit is replaced, the telephone must be paired
    with the Bluetooth® control unit. Different cellular telephones may have different pairing procedures, refer to
    the cellular telephone operating manual.
    Refer to the Owner’s Manual for Bluetooth® telephone system operating instructions.
    Bluetooth® Control Unit

    When the ignition switch is turned to ACC or ON, the Bluetooth® control unit will power up. During power up,
    the Bluetooth® control unit is initialized and performs various self-checks. Initialization may take up to 20 seconds. If a phone is present in the vehicle and paired with the Bluetooth® control unit, Nissan Voice Recognition
    will then become active. Bluetooth® telephone functions can be turned off using the Nissan Voice Recognition
    system.
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-46

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Steering Switches
    When buttons on the steering switches are pushed, the resistance in steering wheel audio control switch circuit changes, depending on which button is pushed. The Bluetooth® control unit uses this signal to perform
    various functions while navigating through the voice recognition system.
    The following functions can be performed using the steering switches:
    • Initiate self-diagnosis of the Bluetooth® telephone system
    • Start a voice recognition session
    • Answer and end telephone calls
    • Adjust the volume of calls

    A

    B

    C

    Microphone

    The microphone is located in the roof console assembly. The microphone sends a signal to the Bluetooth®
    control unit. The microphone can be actively tested during self-diagnosis.

    D

    Audio Unit

    The audio unit receives signals from the Bluetooth® control unit and sends audio signals to the speakers.

    E

    SPEED SENSITIVE VOLUME SYSTEM
    Volume level of this system goes up and down automatically in proportion to the vehicle speed. The control
    level can be selected by the customer. Refer to Owner’s Manual for operating instructions.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-47

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009460151

    The audio unit on board diagnosis performs the functions listed in the table below:
    Mode
    Self Diagnosis

    Confirmation/
    Adjustment

    Description
    • Audio unit diagnosis.
    • Diagnoses the connections across system components.

    Display Diagnosis

    The following check functions are available: color tone check by color bar
    display and white display, light and shade check by gray scale display.

    Vehicle Signals

    Diagnosis of signals can be performed for vehicle speed, lights, reverse,
    EQ pin, destination and camera type.

    Speaker Test

    The connection of a speaker can be confirmed by test tone.

    Error History

    The system malfunction and the frequency when occurring in the past are
    displayed. When the malfunctioning item is selected, the time and place
    that the selected malfunction last occurred are displayed.

    Camera System

    Displayed but not used.

    AV COMM Diagnosis

    The communication condition of each unit of display audio system can be
    monitored.

    Delete Unit Connection Log

    Erase the connection history of unit and error history.

    Initialize Setting

    Initializes the audio unit memory.

    On Board Diagnosis Function

    INFOID:0000000009460152

    METHOD OF STARTING
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition ON.
    Turn the audio system OFF.
    While pressing the preset 1 button, turn the volume control dial
    clockwise or counterclockwise for 40 clicks or more. Shifting
    from current screen to previous screen is performed by pressing
    BACK button.

    AWNIA3086ZZ

    4.

    The trouble diagnosis initial screen is displayed, and Self Diagnosis or Confirmation/Adjustment can be selected.

    JSNIA0138GB

    SELF DIAGNOSIS MODE
    Audio Unit Self Diagnosis
    1. Select Self Diagnosis.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-48

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    2. Self diagnosis screen is displayed. The bar graph visible in center of screen indicates progress of self
    diagnosis.
    3. Diagnosis results are displayed after the self diagnosis is completed. The unit names and the connection lines are color coded
    according to the diagnostic results.

    A

    B

    C

    D
    AWNIA2832GB

    E
    Diagnosis results

    Unit

    Normal

    Connection line

    Green

    Green

    Connection malfunction

    Gray

    Yellow

    Unit malfunction 1

    Red

    Green

    F

    1: Control unit (audio unit) is displayed in red.
    • Replace audio unit if Self Diagnosis did not run because control unit malfunction is indicated. The symptom is audio unit internal
    error. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».
    • If multiple errors occur at the same time for a single unit, the screen switch colors are determined according to the following order
    of priority: red > gray.

    4.

    G

    H

    Comments of self diagnosis results can be viewed in the diagnosis result screen.
    I

    J

    K
    JSNIA1870ZZ

    Audio Unit Self Diagnosis Results

    L
    Only Unit Part Is Displayed In Red

    Screen switch

    Control unit

    Description

    Possible cause

    Malfunction is detected in audio unit power
    supply and ground circuits.

    • Audio unit power supply or ground circuits.
    Refer to AV-72, «AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure».
    • If no malfunction is detected in audio unit
    power supply and ground circuits, replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-49

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    A Connecting Cable Between Units Is Displayed In Yellow
    Area with yellow connection lines

    Description
    When one of the following is detected:

    Control unit ⇔ BT HF Unit

    • malfunction is detected in Bluetooth®
    control unit power supply and ground circuits.
    • malfunction is detected in AV communication circuits between audio unit and
    Bluetooth® control unit.

    Possible cause
    • Bluetooth® control unit power supply or
    ground circuits.
    Refer to AV-72, «BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure».
    • AV communication circuits between audio unit and Bluetooth® control unit.

    Audio Unit Confirmation/Adjustment
    1. Select Confirmation/Adjustment.
    2. Select each switch on the Confirmation/Adjustment screen to
    display the relevant trouble diagnosis screen. Press the BACK
    switch to return to the initial Confirmation/Adjustment screen.

    AWNIA2631GB

    Display Diagnosis

    AWNIA2632GB

    Vehicle Signals

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-50

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    A comparison check can be made of each actual vehicle signal and
    the signals recognized by the system.

    [DISPLAY AUDIO]
    A

    B

    C
    AWNIA2633GB

    D

    Speaker Test
    Select Speaker Test to display the Speaker Diagnosis screen. Press
    Start to generate a test tone in a speaker. Press Start again to generate a test tone in the next speaker. Press End to stop the test tones.

    E

    F

    G
    AWNIA2634GB

    Error History
    The self diagnosis results are judged depending on whether any error occurs from when Self Diagnosis is
    selected until the self diagnosis results are displayed.
    However, the diagnosis results are judged normal if an error has occurred before the ignition switch is turned
    ON and then no error has occurred until the self diagnosis start. Check the Error Record to detect any error
    that may have occurred before the self diagnosis start because of this situation.
    The frequency of occurrence is displayed in a count up manner. The actual count up method differs depending
    on the error item.

    H

    I

    J

    Count up method A

    • The counter is set to 40 if an error occurs. 1 is subtracted from the counter if the condition is normal at a next
    ignition ON cycle.
    • The counter lower limit is 1. The counter can be reset (no error record display) with the Delete log switch.
    Count up method B

    • The counter increases by 1 if an error occurs when ignition switch is ON. The counter will not decrease even
    if the condition is normal at the next ignition ON cycle.
    • The counter upper limit is 50. Any counts exceeding 50 are ignored. The counter can be reset (no error
    record display) with the Delete log switch.
    Display type of occurrence
    frequency

    K

    L

    M

    Error history display item

    Count up method A

    AV communication line, control unit (AV)

    Count up method B

    Other than the above

    AV

    O

    Error item
    Some error items may be displayed simultaneously according to the cause. If some error items are displayed
    simultaneously, the detection of the cause can be performed by the combination of display items

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-51

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AUDIO UNIT)
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Error item
    CONTROL UNIT (AV)

    Description
    AV communication circuit initial diagnosis
    malfunction is detected.
    When one of the following is detected:

    AV COMM CIRCUIT

    • malfunction is detected in Bluetooth®
    control unit power supply and ground circuits.
    • malfunction is detected in AV communication circuits between audio unit and
    Bluetooth® control unit.

    Possible cause
    Replace the audio unit if the malfunction
    occurs constantly.
    Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation»
    • Bluetooth® control unit power supply or
    ground circuits.
    Refer to AV-72, «BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure».
    • AV communication circuits between audio unit and Bluetooth® control unit.

    AV COMM Diagnosis
    • Displays the communication status between audio unit (master
    unit) and Bluetooth® control unit.
    • The error counter displays OK if any malfunction was not detected
    in the past and displays 0 if a malfunction is detected. It increases
    by 1 if the condition is normal at the next ignition switch ON cycle.
    The upper limit of the counter is 39.
    • The error counter is erased if Reset is pressed.
    Status
    (Current)

    Counter
    (Past)

    BUS OFF

    OK / ???

    OK / 0 – 39

    C Rx(BTHF-H/U)

    OK / ???

    OK / 0 – 39

    Items

    AWNIA2833GB

    NOTE:
    “???” indicates UNKWN.
    Delete Unit Connection Log
    Deletes any unit connection records and error records from the
    audio unit memory (clears the records of the unit that has been
    removed).

    AWNIA2637GB

    Initialize Settings
    Deletes data stored from the audio unit.

    JSNIA0155GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-52

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT)
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT)
    Diagnosis Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009460153

    The Bluetooth® control unit has two diagnostic checks. The first diagnostic check is performed automatically
    every ignition cycle during control unit initialization. The second diagnostic check is performed by the technician using the steering wheel audio control switches prior to trouble diagnosis.

    B

    Bluetooth® CONTROL UNIT INITIALIZATION CHECKS

    C

    • Internal control unit failure
    • Bluetooth® antenna connection open or shorted



    Steering wheel audio control switches [
    (PHONE/SEND),
    Vehicle speed pulse count
    Microphone connection test (with playback to operator)
    Bluetooth® inquiry check

    D

    (PHONE/END)] stuck closed

    E

    OPERATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
    Wait for the Bluetooth® system to complete initialization. This may take up to 20 seconds.

    F

    3.

    Press and hold the steering wheel audio control switch
    (PHONE/SEND) button for at least 5 seconds. The Bluetooth®
    system will begin to play a verbal prompt.

    G

    H

    I
    AWNIA3082ZZ

    4.

    5.

    6.
    7.

    J

    While the prompt is playing, press and hold the steering wheel
    audio control switch
    (PHONE/END) button until you hear the
    “Diagnostics mode” prompt. The Bluetooth® system will sound a
    5-second beep.
    While the beep is sounding, press and hold the steering wheel
    audio control switch
    (PHONE/END) button again until you
    hear prompts.
    The Bluetooth® system has now entered into the diagnostic
    mode. Results of the diagnostic checks will be verbalized to the
    technician. Refer to AV-53, «Work Flow».
    After the failure records are reported, an interactive microphone
    test will be performed. Follow the voice prompt. If the microphone test fails, refer to AV-53, «Work Flow».

    K

    L

    M
    AWNIA3083ZZ

    AV

    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009460154

    O
    Failure Message

    Action

    “Internal failure”

    Replace Bluetooth® control unit. Refer to AV-98, «Removal and Installation».

    “Bluetooth® antenna open”

    1.

    Inspect harness connection.

    “Bluetooth® antenna shorted”

    2.

    Replace Bluetooth® antenna. Refer to AV-99, «Removal and Installation».

    “Phone/Send for Hands Free System is stuck”

    Check steering wheel audio control switches. Refer to AV-85, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    “Phone/End for the Hands Free System is stuck”
    “Microphone test” (failed interactive test)

    Revision: April 2013

    1.
    2.

    Inspect harness between Bluetooth® control unit and microphone.
    Replace microphone. Refer to AV-101, «Removal and Installation» .

    AV-53

    2014 Note

    P

    AUDIO UNIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    AUDIO UNIT
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009460155

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    AWNIA3056ZZ

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    Terminal
    (Wire color)
    +

    2
    (GR)

    3
    (P)

    Description
    Signal name

    Sound signal front door
    speaker LH

    Condition
    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Output

    ON

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    Sound output

    SKIB3609E

    4
    (W)

    5
    (R)

    Sound signal rear door
    speaker LH

    Output

    ON

    Sound output

    SKIB3609E

    Press SOURCE switch
    6
    (BR)

    15
    (GR)

    Steering switch signal A

    Input

    ON

    Press

    switch

    1.0V

    Press

    switch

    2.0V

    Press

    switch

    Except above
    7
    (W)

    Ground

    ACC power supply

    Input

    ACC

    9
    (LG/R)

    Ground

    Illumination control signal

    Input

    ON

    Revision: April 2013

    0V

    3.0V
    5.0V

    Battery voltage

    Headlamps ON

    Battery voltage

    AV-54

    2014 Note

    AUDIO UNIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description

    Signal name

    Condition
    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    A

    B

    11
    (O)

    12
    (V)

    Sound signal front door
    speaker RH

    Output

    ON

    C

    Sound output

    SKIB3609E

    D

    E
    13
    (L)

    14
    (Y)

    Sound signal rear door
    speaker RH

    Output

    ON

    Sound output

    F
    SKIB3609E

    16
    (V)

    15
    (GR)

    Steering switch signal B

    Input

    ON

    Press

    switch

    0V

    Press

    switch

    1.0V

    Press

    switch

    Except above

    G

    2.0V

    H

    5.0V

    I
    18
    (LG)

    Ground

    Vehicle speed signal

    Input

    ON

    When vehicle speed is approx. 40 km/h (25 MPH)

    J
    JSNIA0012GB

    19
    (Y)

    Ground

    Battery power supply

    20
    (B/W)

    Ground

    Ground

    25
    (G)

    24
    (R)

    TEL voice signal

    Input

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    ON

    0V

    Input

    ON

    L

    M

    During voice guide output
    with

    K

    switch pressed.

    AV
    SKIB3609E

    26
    (Shield)

    TEL voice signal shield

    31
    (SB)

    AV communication (H)

    Input/
    Output

    32
    (LG)

    AV communication (L)

    Input/
    Output

    33
    (B)

    Ground

    Camera ground

    ON

    0V

    34
    (L)

    Ground

    Camera power supply

    Output

    ON

    Revision: April 2013

    Camera image displayed
    Except for above

    AV-55

    O

    P

    6.0 V
    0V

    2014 Note

    AUDIO UNIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    (Wire color)
    +

    35
    (Y)

    36
    (Shield)

    Description
    Signal name

    Camera image signal

    Condition
    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Input

    ON

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    Camera image displayed

    SKIB2251J

    44
    (B)

    Ground

    Camera detection

    ON

    0V

    46
    (B)

    Ground

    EQ02 Ground

    ON

    0V

    48
    (B/W)

    Ground

    EQ04 Ground

    ON

    0V

    50
    (Y)

    Ground

    53
    (W)

    V BUS signal

    54
    (G)

    USB ground

    55
    (L)

    56
    (R)

    Reverse signal

    Input

    ON

    Selector lever in R (reverse)

    Battery voltage

    Selector lever in any position other than R (reverse)

    0V

    USB D+ signal

    USB D− signal

    57
    (Shield)

    USB shield

    58
    (B)

    Ground

    Antenna amp. ON signal

    Output

    ON

    Audio unit ON, FM-AM selected.

    Battery voltage

    59
    (B)

    Ground

    AM/FM antenna signal

    Input

    ON

    Audio unit ON, FM-AM selected.

    5.0 V

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-56

    2014 Note

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT

    A

    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009460156

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    B

    C

    D

    AWNIA3057ZZ

    E

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    Terminal
    (wire color)

    Description

    Condition

    F
    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    Input/
    output

    Ignition
    switch

    Operation

    Battery power

    Input

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    Ground

    ACC power

    Input

    ACC

    Battery voltage

    3
    (O)

    Ground

    IGN power

    Input

    ON

    Battery voltage

    4
    (B)

    Ground

    Ground

    ON

    0V

    7
    (P)

    8
    (Shield)

    MIC in signal

    Input

    +

    1
    (Y/G)

    Ground

    2
    (L/Y)

    Signal name

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    9
    (W)

    10
    (B)

    Audio out

    Output

    ACC
    or
    ON

    Bluetooth® control unit
    sends audio signal

    L
    SKIB3609E

    Press SOURCE switch
    12
    (R)

    14
    (G)

    LAD IN 1

    Input

    ON

    Press

    switch

    1.0V

    Press

    switch

    2.0V

    Press

    switch

    Except above

    13
    (P)

    14
    (G)

    LAD IN 2

    Input

    ON

    0V

    Press

    switch

    1.0V

    Except above

    Revision: April 2013

    5.0V

    switch

    switch

    AV-57

    AV

    3.0V

    Press

    Press

    M

    0V

    O

    P

    2.0V
    5.0V

    2014 Note

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    (wire color)
    +

    Description

    Signal name

    Condition
    Input/
    output

    Ignition
    switch

    Operation
    Press SOURCE switch

    17
    (BR)

    19
    (GR)

    LAD OUT 1

    Output

    ON

    switch

    1.0V

    Press

    switch

    2.0V

    switch

    Except above

    19
    (GR)

    LAD OUT 2

    Output

    ON

    0V

    Press

    Press

    18
    (V)

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    3.0V
    5.0V

    Press

    switch

    0V

    Press

    switch

    1.0V

    Press

    switch

    Except above

    2.0V
    5.0V

    20
    (B)

    Ground

    CONT1 Ground

    ON

    0V

    22
    (B)

    Ground

    CONT3 Ground

    ON

    0V

    23
    (B)

    Ground

    CONT4 Ground

    ON

    0V

    24
    (B)

    Ground

    CONT5 Ground

    ON

    0V

    27
    (B)

    Ground

    CONT6 Ground

    ON

    0V

    28
    (Y)

    Ground

    Vehicle speed signal (2pulse)

    Input

    ON

    When vehicle speed is approx. 40 km/h (25 MPH)

    PKIA1935E

    29
    (L)

    Ground

    33
    (SB)

    34
    (LG)

    Microphone power

    Output

    ON

    5V

    AV communication (H)

    AV communication (L)

    37
    (LG)

    AV communication jumper
    (H)

    38
    (LG)

    AV communication jumper
    (H)

    39
    (SB)

    AV communication jumper
    (L)

    40
    (SB)

    AV communication jumper
    (L)

    41
    (B)

    Bluetooth® antenna

    42
    (Shield)

    Shield

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-58

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009460157

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    AANWA0859GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-59

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANWA0860GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-60

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1710GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-61

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1711GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-62

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1712GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-63

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1713GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-64

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1714GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-65

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1715GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-66

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1716GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-67

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1717GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-68

    2014 Note

    DISPLAY AUDIO
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1718GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-69

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009460158

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    AWNIA2404GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when the
    incident/malfunction occurred).
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer. Verify relation between the symptom and the condition
    when the symptom is detected. Refer to AV-88, «Symptom Table».
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
    Inspect according to Diagnostic Procedure of the system.
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-70

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    A

    4.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.

    B

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnostic Procedure.

    C

    >> GO TO 5.

    5.FINAL CHECK

    D

    Refer to confirmed symptom in step 2, and make sure that the symptom is not detected.
    Was the repair confirmed?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-71

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    AUDIO UNIT
    AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460159

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSE
    Check that the following fuses are not blown.
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    7

    ACC power supply

    18 (10A)

    19

    Battery power supply

    29 (15A)

    Are the fuses blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M45.
    Check voltage between audio unit connector M45 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Ground

    Terminal
    7

    M45

    19

    Condition
    Ignition switch: ON
    Ignition switch: OFF

    Voltage
    (Approx.)
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M40.
    Check continuity between audio unit connectors and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M45

    20
    44

    M40

    46

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    48

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-72

    INFOID:0000000009460160

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».

    A

    1.CHECK FUSE
    B

    Check that the following fuses are not blown.
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    1

    Battery power supply

    29 (15A)

    2

    ACC power supply

    17 (10A)

    3

    Ignition signal

    5 (10A)

    C

    D

    Are the fuses blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    E

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect Bluetooth® control unit connector B33.
    Check voltage between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and ground.
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    Ground

    Terminal
    1

    B33

    Condition

    F

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ignition switch: OFF

    2

    3

    Ignition switch: ACC

    H
    Battery voltage

    Ignition switch: ON

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    J

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and ground.
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    G

    Ground

    Terminal

    K
    Continuity

    L

    4
    20
    B33

    M

    22

    23

    Yes

    AV

    24
    27

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-73

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460161

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR CHECK
    Check the audio unit and speaker connectors for the following:
    • Proper connection
    • Damage
    • Disconnected or loose terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminals or connectors.

    2.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect audio unit connector M45 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M45 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Front door speaker
    Terminal

    Connector

    2

    11

    3.

    2
    1

    D112 (RH)

    12

    Continuity

    1

    D12 (LH)

    3

    M45

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M45 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    2
    3

    M45

    11
    12

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect audio unit connector M45 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Turn ignition switch to ACC.
    Push audio unit POWER switch.
    Check signal between the terminals of audio unit connector M45.
    Audio unit connector M45
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    AV-74

    Reference value

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2

    3

    11

    12

    A
    Audio signal output

    B
    SKIB3609E

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front door speaker. Refer to AV-94, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-75

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460163

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR CHECK
    Check the audio unit and speaker connectors for the following:
    • Proper connection
    • Damage
    • Disconnected or loose terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminals or connectors.

    2.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect audio unit connector M45 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M45 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Rear speaker
    Terminal

    Connector

    4

    13

    3.

    2
    1

    D307 (RH)

    14

    Continuity

    1

    D207 (LH)

    5

    M45

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M45 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    4
    5

    M45

    13
    14

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect audio unit connector M45 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Turn ignition switch to ACC.
    Push audio unit POWER switch.
    Check signal between the terminals of audio unit connector M45.
    Audio unit connector M45
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    AV-76

    Reference value

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4

    5

    13

    14

    A
    Audio signal output

    B
    SKIB3609E

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear door speaker. Refer to AV-95, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-77

    2014 Note

    BLUETOOTH® VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BLUETOOTH® VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460164

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK BLUETOOTH® VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M40 and Bluetooth® control unit connector B33.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and Bluetooth® control unit connector B33.
    Bluetooth® control unit

    Audio unit

    4.

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    25

    B33

    9

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    25

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    2.CHECK BLUETOOTH® VOICE SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and Bluetooth® control unit connector B33.
    Bluetooth® control unit

    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    24

    B33

    10

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK BLUETOOTH® VOICE SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect audio unit connector M40 and Bluetooth® control unit connector B33.
    Turn ignition switch to ACC.
    Press
    switch.
    Check signal between the terminals of audio unit connector M40.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-78

    2014 Note

    BLUETOOTH® VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    Audio unit connector M40
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    25

    24

    Condition

    Reference value

    B

    C

    During voice guide output with
    switch pressed.

    D
    SKIB3609E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace Bluetooth® control unit. Refer to AV-98, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-79

    2014 Note

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460165

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect Bluetooth® control unit connector B33.
    Check continuity between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and ground.
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    Terminals

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    20
    22
    B33

    23
    24
    27

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace Bluetooth® control unit. Refer to AV-98, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-80

    2014 Note

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009592936

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1.CHECK REVERSE INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Shift the selector lever to R (reverse).
    Check voltage between audio unit connector M40 and ground.
    Audio unit

    D

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    50

    Condition

    (−)

    Selector lever in R (reverse)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    E

    F
    Battery Voltage

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    G

    2.CHECK CAMERA POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    H

    1.
    2.
    3.

    I

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M40 and rear view camera connector.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and rear view camera connector D501.
    Audio unit

    4.

    Rear view camera

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    34

    D501

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and ground.

    K

    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    34

    Continuity

    Ground

    M

    3.CHECK CAMERA POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE

    AV

    Connect audio unit connector M40 and rear view camera connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Shift the selector lever to R (reverse).
    Check voltage between audio unit connector M40 and ground.
    Audio unit

    O

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    34

    (−)

    Condition

    Selector lever is in “R”.

    Voltage
    (Approx.)
    6.0 V

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    L

    No

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    J

    AV-81

    2014 Note

    P

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    4.CHECK CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M40 and rear view camera connector.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and rear view camera connector D501.
    Audio unit

    4.

    Rear view camera

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    35

    D501

    4

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    35

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK CAMERA GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M40 and rear view camera connector D501.
    Audio unit

    Rear view camera

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    33

    D501

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect audio unit connector M40 and rear view camera connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Shift the selector lever to R (reverse).
    Check signal between audio unit connector M40 and ground.
    Audio unit

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M40

    35

    (−)

    Condition

    Reference value

    Camera image displayed.

    SKIB2251J

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace rear view camera. Refer to AV-97, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-82

    2014 Note

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460166

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT AND MICROPHONE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and microphone connector R15.
    Check continuity between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and microphone connector R15.
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    E

    Microphone

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    7
    B33

    R15

    F

    2

    29

    4.

    Continuity

    1

    8

    Yes

    4

    G

    Check continuity between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and ground.
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    Terminal
    7

    B33

    D

    29

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    H

    I

    Are continuity results as specified?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connectors.

    J

    2.CHECK MICROPHONE POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    K

    Connect Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and microphone connector R15.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between microphone connector R15 and ground.
    Microphone

    L

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    R15

    4

    (-)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    5V

    M

    AV

    Is the voltage reading as specified?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace Bluetooth® control unit. Refer to AV-98, «Removal and Installation».

    3.CHECK MICROPHONE SIGNAL

    O

    Check signal between terminals of Bluetooth® control unit connector B33.
    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-83

    2014 Note

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Bluetooth® control unit connector B33
    (+)

    (-)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    7

    8

    Condition

    Reference value

    Speak into microphone.

    PKIB5037J

    Were voltage readings as specified?
    YES >> Replace Bluetooth® control unit. Refer to AV-98, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace microphone. Refer to AV-101, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-84

    2014 Note

    STEERING SWITCH
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    STEERING SWITCH

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460167

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1.CHECK STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROL SWITCH RESISTANCE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    D

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination switch connector M88.
    Check resistance between the terminals of combination switch connector M88.
    Combination switch connector M88
    Terminal

    Resistance Ω
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal

    Depress SOURCE switch.
    14
    17

    15

    E

    1

    Depress

    switch.

    121

    Depress

    switch.

    321

    Depress

    switch.

    723

    Depress

    switch.

    1

    Depress

    switch.

    121

    Depress

    G

    H

    I

    321

    switch.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace steering switches. Refer to AV-100, «Removal and Installation».

    J

    2.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT AND COMBINATION SWITCH
    1.
    2.

    F

    Disconnect Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and combination switch connector M30.
    Check continuity between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and combination switch connector M30.

    K

    L
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    Combination switch

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    12
    B33

    M

    24

    13

    M30

    31

    14

    3.

    Continuity

    Yes

    33

    AV

    Check continuity between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and ground.
    O

    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    12
    B33

    P

    13
    14

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-85

    2014 Note

    STEERING SWITCH
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK COMBINATION SWITCH
    Check continuity between combination switch connectors M88 and M30.
    Combination switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    14
    M88

    Continuity

    24

    15

    M30

    31

    17

    Yes

    33

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace spiral cable. Refer to SR-15, «Removal and Installation».

    4.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT AND AUDIO UNIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect audio unit connector M45.
    Check continuity between Bluetooth® control unit connector B33 and audio unit connector M45.
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    Audio unit

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    17
    B33

    6

    18

    M45

    16

    19

    3.

    Continuity

    Yes

    15
    ®

    Check continuity between Bluetooth control unit connector B33 and ground.
    Bluetooth® control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    17
    B33

    18
    19

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-86

    2014 Note

    USB CONNECTOR
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    USB CONNECTOR

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460168

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect audio unit connector M44 and USB interface connector M72.
    Check continuity between audio unit connector M44 and USB interface connector M72.
    Audio unit
    Connector

    USB interface
    Terminal

    M44

    4.

    Connector

    Terminal

    53

    4

    54

    1

    55

    M72

    2

    56

    3

    57

    5

    D

    Continuity

    F
    Yes

    G

    Check continuity between audio unit connector M44 and ground.
    Audio unit
    Connector
    M44

    Terminal

    E

    H
    Continuity

    I

    53

    Ground

    55

    No

    J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the USB interface. Refer to AV-96, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-87

    2014 Note

    AUDIO SYSTEM
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    AUDIO SYSTEM
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009460169

    RELATED TO AUDIO
    Symptoms
    The disk cannot be removed.

    Check items
    Audio unit

    No sound from all speakers.

    • Speaker circuit shorted to ground.
    Refer to AV-59, «Wiring Diagram».
    • Audio unit power supply and ground circuits malfunction.
    Refer to AV-72, «AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure».

    Only a certain speaker (front door speaker
    LH, front door speaker RH, rear door
    speaker LH, rear door speaker RH) does
    not output sound.

    • Poor connector connection of speaker.
    • Sound signal circuit malfunction between
    audio unit and speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-74, «Diagnosis Procedure» (front door
    speaker).
    — AV-76, «Diagnosis Procedure» (rear door
    speaker).
    • Malfunction in speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-94, «Removal and Installation» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-95, «Removal and Installation» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-48, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Noise comes out from all speakers.

    Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-48, «On Board Diagnosis Function».

    Noise comes out only from a certain speaker (front door speaker LH, front door speaker RH, rear door speaker LH, rear door
    speaker RH).

    • Poor connector connection of speaker.
    • Sound signal circuit malfunction between
    audio unit and speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-74, «Diagnosis Procedure» (front door
    speaker).
    — AV-76, «Diagnosis Procedure» (rear door
    speaker).
    • Malfunction in speaker.
    • Poor Installation of speaker (e.g. backlash and looseness).
    Refer to:
    — AV-94, «Removal and Installation» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-95, «Removal and Installation» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-48, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Noise is mixed with radio only (when the vehicle hits a bump or while driving over bad
    roads)

    Poor connector connection of antenna or
    antenna feeder.
    Refer to AV-103, «Feeder Layout».

    No sound comes out or the level of the
    sound is low.

    Noise is mixed with audio.

    Revision: April 2013

    Probable malfunction location
    Malfunction in audio unit.
    Refer to AV-48, «On Board Diagnosis Function».

    AV-88

    2014 Note

    AUDIO SYSTEM
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptoms

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    No radio reception or poor reception.

    • Other audio sounds are normal.
    • Antenna amp. ON signal circuit malfunc• Any radio station cannot be received or
    tion.
    poor reception is caused even after movRefer to AV-54, «Reference Value».
    ing to a service area with good reception • Poor connector connection of antenna or
    antenna feeder.
    (e.g. a place with clear view and no obRefer to AV-103, «Feeder Layout».
    stacles generating external noises).

    Buzz/rattle sound from speaker

    The majority of buzz/rattle sounds are not
    indicative of an issue with the speaker, usually something nearby the speaker is causing the buzz/rattle.

    Refer to «SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS» in the appropriate interior trim section.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE
    • Before performing diagnosis, confirm that the cellular phone being used by the customer is compatible with
    the vehicle.
    • It is possible that a malfunction is occurring due to a version change of the phone even though the phone is
    a compatible type. This can be confirmed by changing the cellular phone to another compatible type, and
    check that it operates normally. It is important to determine whether the cause of the malfunction is the vehicle or the cellular phone.

    E

    F

    Check Compatibility

    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.
    a.
    b.

    c.
    d.

    Make sure the customer’s Bluetooth® related concern is understood.
    Verify the customer’s concern.
    NOTE:
    The customer’s phone may be required, depending upon their concern.
    Write down the customer’s phone brand, model and service provider.
    NOTE:
    It is necessary to know the service provider. On occasion, a given phone may be on the approved list with
    one provider, but may not be on the approved list with other providers.
    Go to “www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth/”.
    Using the website’s search engine, find out if the customer’s phone is on the approved list.
    If the customer’s phone is NOT on the approved list:
    Stop diagnosis here. The customer needs to obtain a Bluetooth® phone that is on the approved list before
    any further action.
    If the feature related to the customer’s concern shows as “N” (not compatible):
    Stop diagnosis here. If the customer still wants the feature to function, they will need to get an approved
    phone showing the feature as “Y” (compatible) in the “Basic Features”.
    If the feature related to the customer’s concern shows as “Y” (compatible):
    Perform diagnosis as per the following table.
    Symptoms

    Check items

    Does not recognize cellular phone connection (no connection is displayed on the display at the guide).

    Repeat the registration of cellular phone.

    Hands-free phone cannot be established.

    • Hands-free phone operation can be
    made, but the communication cannot be
    established.
    • Hands-free phone operation can be performed, however, voice between each
    other cannot be heard during the conversation.

    The other party’s voice cannot be heard by
    hands-free phone.

    Check the “microphone speaker” in Inspection & Adjustment Mode if sound is heard.

    Originating sound is not heard by the other
    party with hands-free phone communication.

    Sound operation function is normal.

    Revision: April 2013

    Probable malfunction location

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    Sound operation function does not work.

    AV-89

    Malfunction in audio unit.
    Replace audio unit. Refer to AV-93, «Removal and Installation».

    O

    P

    Microphone signal circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-83, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2014 Note

    AUDIO SYSTEM
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptoms

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    • The voice recognition can be controlled.
    • Steering switch’s

    ,

    switch works, but
    The system cannot be operated.

    Steering switch’s

    , and

    does not work.
    ,

    ,

    , and

    switches do not work.
    All steering switches do not work.

    Steering switch malfunction.
    Replace steering switch. Refer to AV-100,
    «Removal and Installation».
    Steering switch signal circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-85, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Steering switch ground circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-85, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    RELATED TO REAR VIEW CAMERA
    Symptoms

    Rear view camera is inoperative.

    Revision: April 2013

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    Reverse signal circuit malfunction.

    Reverse signal circuit malfunction between
    BCM and audio unit.
    Refer to AV-81, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Camera image signal circuit malfunction.

    Camera image signal circuit malfunction
    between rear view camera and audio unit.
    Refer to AV-81, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Rear view camera malfunction.

    Replace rear view camera.
    Refer to AV-97, «Removal and Installation».

    AV-90

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009460170

    RELATED TO NOISE

    B

    The majority of the audio concerns are the result of outside causes (bad CD, electromagnetic interference,
    etc.).
    The following noise results from variations in field strength, such as fading noise and multi-path noise, or
    external noise from trains and other sources. It is not a malfunction.
    • Fading noise: This noise occurs because of variations in the field strength in a narrow range due to mountains or buildings blocking the signal.
    • Multi-path noise: This noise results from the waves sent directly from the broadcast station arriving at the
    antenna at a different time from the waves which reflect off mountains or buildings.
    The vehicle itself can be a source of noise if noise prevention parts or electrical equipment is malfunctioning.
    Check if noise is caused and/or changed by engine speed, ignition switch turned to each position, and operation of each piece of electrical equipment, and determine the cause.
    NOTE:
    The source of the noise can be found easily by listening to the noise while removing the fuses of electrical
    components, one by one.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    Type of Noise and Possible Cause
    Occurrence condition
    Occurs only when engine is ON.

    A continuous growling noise occurs. The speed of
    the noise varies with changes in the engine speed.

    The occurrence of the noise is linked with the operation of the fuel pump.
    Noise only occurs when various
    electrical components are operating.

    G

    Possible cause
    • Ignition components

    H

    • Fuel pump condenser

    A cracking or snapping sound occurs with the operation of various switches.

    • Relay malfunction, audio unit malfunction

    The noise occurs when various motors are operating.

    • Motor case ground
    • Motor

    I

    The noise occurs constantly, not just under certain conditions.

    • Rear defogger coil malfunction
    • Open circuit in printed heater
    • Poor ground of antenna feeder line

    A cracking or snapping sound occurs while the vehicle is being driven, especially when
    it is vibrating excessively.

    • Ground wire of body parts
    • Ground due to improper part installation
    • Wiring connections or a short circuit

    RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE
    Cause and Counter measure

    Does not recognize cellular phone connection (No connection is
    displayed on the display at the guide).

    Some Bluetooth® enabled cellular phones may not be recognized
    by the in-vehicle phone module.
    Refer to “RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE (Check Compatibility)” in AV-88, «Symptom Table».
    Customer will not be able to use a hands-free phone under the following conditions:
    • The vehicle is outside of the telephone service area.
    • The vehicle is in an area where it is difficult to receive radio
    waves; such as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage,
    near a tall building or in a mountainous area.
    • The cellular phone is locked to prevent it from being dialed.
    NOTE:
    While a cellular phone is connected through the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may discharge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
    System cannot charge cellular phones.

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    L

    Symptom

    Cannot use hands-free phone.

    J

    AV-91

    2014 Note

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom

    Cause and Counter measure

    The other party’s voice cannot be heard by hands-free phone.

    When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too
    loud, it may be difficult to hear the other person’s voice during a
    call.

    Poor sound quality.

    Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or
    far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality
    degradation and wireless connection disruption.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-92

    2014 Note

    AUDIO UNIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    AUDIO UNIT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009640329

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AWNIA3125ZZ

    1.

    Audio unit bracket (LH)

    2.

    Audio unit

    3.

    Audio unit bracket (RH)

    L

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640330

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    K

    M

    Remove the battery negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the audio unit screws.
    Partially remove the audio unit to gain access to the harness connectors.
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the audio unit and remove.
    Remove the audio unit bracket screws from each side of the audio unit (if necessary).

    AV

    O

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    P

    AV-93

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640331

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from front door speaker.
    Remove the front door speaker screws (A).
    Remove the front door speaker (1).

    AWNIA3062ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-94

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640332

    REMOVAL

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    C

    Remove the rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the rear door speaker.
    Remove the rear door speaker screws (A).
    Remove the rear door speaker (1).

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3089ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-95

    2014 Note

    USB INTERFACE
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    USB INTERFACE
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640333

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Release the pawls (A) from the back of the center console
    assembly (2) using a suitable tool and remove the USB interface
    (1).

    AWNIA3069ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-96

    2014 Note

    REAR VIEW CAMERA
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR VIEW CAMERA

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640334

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove the back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-34, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from rear view camera.
    Remove the nuts (A) from the rear view camera and remove.

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3070ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-97

    2014 Note

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BLUETOOTH® CONTROL UNIT
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640335

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove the luggage side lower finisher (RH). Refer to INT-32, «LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the Bluetooth® control unit.
    Remove the Bluetooth® antenna screws (A) and the Bluetooth®
    antenna (1).

    AWNIA3095ZZ

    4.

    Remove the Bluetooth® control unit bracket screws (A) and the
    Bluetooth® control unit (1).

    AWNIA3122ZZ

    5.

    Remove the Bluetooth® control unit screws (A) and separate
    the Bluetooth® control unit (1) from the bracket (2).

    AWNIA3097ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-98

    2014 Note

    BLUETOOTH® ANTENNA
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BLUETOOTH® ANTENNA

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640336

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove the luggage side lower finisher (RH). Refer to INT-32, «LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the Bluetooth® antenna harness connector from the Bluetooth® control unit.
    Remove the Bluetooth® antenna screws (A) and the Bluetooth®
    antenna (1).

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3095ZZ

    G

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-99

    2014 Note

    STEERING SWITCH
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    STEERING SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640337

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the steering wheel. Refer to ST-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the steering wheel rear finisher (1) by releasing pawls
    (A).

    AWNIA3063ZZ

    3.

    Remove the steering wheel audio control switch screws (A) from
    the back of the steering wheel.

    AWNIA3064ZZ

    4.

    Remove the steering wheel audio control switches from the steering wheel.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-100

    2014 Note

    MICROPHONE
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    MICROPHONE

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640338

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    B

    Remove the microphone from the headlining by releasing pawls using a suitable tool.
    Disconnect the harness connector from microphone and remove.

    C

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-101

    2014 Note

    ROD ANTENNA
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ROD ANTENNA
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009667930

    AWNIA3124ZZ

    1. Antenna rod

    2. Antenna base

    A. Antenna nut

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009667931

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Lower the rear portion of the headlining. Refer to INT-29, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the antenna (satellite radio model shown).
    Remove the antenna nut (A) and remove the antenna.

    AWNIA3115ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    If the antenna nut is tightened looser than the specified torque this will lower the sensitivity of the
    antenna. If the antenna nut is tightened tighter than the specified torque this will deform the roof
    panel.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-102

    2014 Note

    ANTENNA FEEDER
    [DISPLAY AUDIO]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ANTENNA FEEDER

    A

    Feeder Layout

    INFOID:0000000009460183

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWNIA3114ZZ

    1.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    2.

    Rod Antenna

    4.

    M67, M350

    5.

    M108

    3.

    M351

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-103

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [NAVIGATION]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009640342

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009640343

    AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
    • Do not apply voltage of 7.0 V or higher to the measurement terminals.
    • Use the tester with its open terminal voltage being 7.0 V or less.
    • Be sure to turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal before
    checking the circuit.

    Precaution for Harness Repair

    INFOID:0000000009640344

    AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
    • Solder the repaired parts, and wrap with tape. [Frays of twisted line
    must be within 110 mm (4.33 in).]

    PKIA0306E

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-104

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Do not perform bypass wire connections for the repair parts. (The
    spliced wire will become separated and the characteristics of
    twisted line will be lost.)

    [NAVIGATION]
    A

    B

    C
    PKIA0307E

    D

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009640345

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-105

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009640346

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009640347

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-106

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009509296

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AWNIA3092ZZ

    A. Front of headliner

    K

    B. Center of back door

    L
    No.

    Component

    Function

    1.

    Rod antenna

    2.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    3.

    Rear door speaker RH

    4.

    Front door speaker RH

    5.

    Front door speaker LH

    6.

    Rear door speaker LH

    7.

    AV control unit

    Refer to AV-107, «AV Control Unit».

    8.

    GPS antenna

    Refer to AV-110, «GPS Antenna».

    9.

    Steering wheel audio control switches

    Refer to AV-109, «Steering Switch».

    10.

    USB interface and AUX in jack

    Refer to AV-108, «USB Interface and AUX In Jack».

    11.

    Microphone

    Refer to AV-109, «Microphone».

    12.

    Rear view camera

    Refer to AV-109, «Rear View Camera».

    Refer to AV-109, «Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder».

    AV

    Refer to AV-108, «Speaker».

    AV Control Unit

    O

    P

    INFOID:0000000009606268

    Description
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-107

    M

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • A 5.8-inch QVGA display, an AM/FM electronic tuner radio, CD
    drive, audio amplifier, Bluetooth® module, USB interface, camera
    controller and navigation unit are integrated into the AV control
    unit.
    • The 5.8-inch display is a high resolution monitor that includes
    touch panel functions.
    • Music files stored in iPod®*/USB memory can be played using the
    separate USB interface.

    [NAVIGATION]

    ALNIA1524ZZ

    Speaker

    INFOID:0000000009606269

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    • 16.5 cm (6.5 in) speakers are installed in the bottom of the front doors.
    • Sound signals are input from the AV control unit to output high, mid
    and low range sounds.

    JPNIA1454ZZ

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    • 16.5 cm (6.5 in) speakers are installed in the bottom of the rear doors.
    • Sound signals are input from the AV control unit to output high, mid
    and low range sounds.

    JPNIA1454ZZ

    USB Interface and AUX In Jack

    INFOID:0000000009606270

    • USB Interface and AUX in jack is installed in the console.
    • iPod® and USB memory can be connected to the AV control unit
    through the USB interface.
    • An external audio device can be connected to the AV control unit
    through the AUX in jack.

    ALNIA1523ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-108

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Steering Switch

    INFOID:0000000009606271

    A

    • Operations for audio and hands-free phone are possible.
    • Switch is connected to the AV control unit.
    B

    C

    D
    JSNIA4329ZZ

    Microphone

    INFOID:0000000009606272

    • The microphone is installed in the roof in front of the map lamp
    assembly.
    • Power is supplied from the AV control unit.

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JPNIA1448ZZ

    Rear View Camera

    INFOID:0000000009606273

    • The rear view camera is installed to the back door finisher.
    • Power is supplied from the AV control unit.

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JPNIA1452ZZ

    Rod Antenna, Antenna Amp. and Antenna Feeder

    INFOID:0000000009606274

    M

    RADIO ANTENNA
    AM/FM radio rod antenna and antenna base is located on the rear of the roof. The antenna amp. is built into AV
    the antenna base.
    O

    P

    AWNIA3059GB

    ANTENNA FEEDER LAYOUT

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-109

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    AWNIA3114ZZ

    1.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    2.

    Rod Antenna

    4.

    M67, M350

    5.

    M73

    GPS Antenna

    3.

    M351

    INFOID:0000000009509301

    • GPS antenna is installed in the instrument panel.
    • Power is supplied from the AV control unit.

    JSNIA3303ZZ

    SD Card

    INFOID:0000000009509305

    • Map data is memorized in the SD card.
    • Map data is sent to the AV control unit from the SD slot.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-110

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009460258

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWNIA3101GB

    AUDIO SYSTEM

    H

    Refer to Owner’s Manual for navigation and audio system operating instructions.
    Audio function and display are built into AV control unit.
    This navigation has the following functions.
    • Map data on SD-card
    • Full support for playback of music from iPod® and USB device
    • High resolution color 5.8-inch display with touch panel function
    • FM/AM twin digital tuner
    • USB mass storage connection
    • Hands-free phone system
    iPod® is a trademark of Apple inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.

    I

    J

    K

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    Description
    • The navigation system can be operated by control panel of the AV control unit and display (touch panel) of
    the AV control unit.
    • Guide sound during the operation of the navigation system is output from AV control unit to front tweeters.
    • AV control unit calculates the vehicle location based on the signals from GYRO (angle speed sensor), vehicle sensor, and GPS satellite, as well as the map data from map SD-card. The vehicle location is displayed
    on the AV control unit.

    L

    M

    POSITION DETECTION PRINCIPLE
    AV
    The navigation system periodically calculates the vehicle’s current position according to the following three
    signals:
    • Travel distance of the vehicle as determined by the vehicle speed sensor
    O
    • Turning angle of the vehicle as determined by the gyroscope (angular velocity sensor)
    • Direction of vehicle travel as determined by the GPS antenna (GPS information)
    The current position of the vehicle is then identified by comparing the calculated vehicle position with map data
    read from the map SD-card (map-matching), and indicated on the screen as a vehicle mark. More accurate P
    data is judged and used by comparing vehicle position detection results found by the GPS with the result by
    map-matching.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-111

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    The current vehicle position will be calculated by detecting the distance the vehicle moved from the previous calculation point and its
    direction.
    • Travel distance
    Travel distance calculations are based on the vehicle speed sensor input signal. Therefore, the calculation may become incorrect
    as the tires wear down. To prevent this, an automatic distance correction function has been adopted.
    • Travel direction
    Change in the travel direction of the vehicle is calculated by a gyroscope (angular velocity sensor) and a GPS antenna (GPS information). They have both advantages and disadvantages.
    Type

    Advantage

    [NAVIGATION]

    SEL684V

    Disadvantage

    Gyroscope
    (angular velocity sensor)

    Can detect the vehicle’s turning angle quite
    accurately.

    Direction errors may accumulate when vehicle is
    driven for long distances without stopping.

    GPS antenna
    (GPS information)

    Can detect the vehicle’s travel direction
    (North/South/East/West).

    Correct direction cannot be detected when vehicle
    speed is low.

    More accurate traveling direction is detected because priorities are set for the signals from these two
    devices according to the situation.
    MAP-MATCHING
    Map-matching compares a current location detected by the method
    in the “Location Detection Principle” with a road map data from map
    SD-card.
    NOTE:
    The road map data is based on data stored in the map SD-card.

    SEL685V

    The vehicle position may not be corrected under the following circumstances and after driving for a certain
    time when GPS information is difficult to receive. In this case, the vehicle mark on the display must be corrected manually.
    • In map-matching, alternative routes to reach the destination will be
    shown and prioritized, after the road on which the vehicle is currently driven has been judged and the vehicle mark has been repositioned.
    Alternative routes will be shown in different order of priority, and
    the incorrect road can be avoided if there is an error in distance
    and/or direction.
    Routes are of the same priority if two roads are running in parallel.
    Therefore, the vehicle mark may appear on either of them alternately, depending on maneuvering of the steering wheel and configuration of the road.
    SEL686V

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-112

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Map-matching does not function correctly when a road on which
    the vehicle is driving is new and not recorded in the map SD-card,
    or when road pattern stored in the map data and the actual road
    pattern are different due to repair.
    The map-matching function may find another road and position the
    vehicle mark on it when driving on a road not present in the map.
    Then, the vehicle mark may change to it when the correct road is
    detected.
    • Effective range for comparing the vehicle position and travel direction calculated by the distance and direction with the road data
    read from the map SD-card is limited. Therefore, correction by
    map-matching is not possible when there is an excessive gap
    between current vehicle position and the position on the map.

    [NAVIGATION]

    GPS (Global Positioning System)
    GPS (Global Positioning System) is developed for and is controlled
    by the US Department of Defense. The system utilizes GPS satellites (NAVSTAR), transmitting out radio waves while flying on an orbit
    around the earth at an altitude of approximately 21,000 km (13,049
    mile).
    The receiver calculates the travel position in three dimensions (latitude/longitude/altitude) according to the time lag of the radio waves
    that four or more GPS satellites transmit (three-dimensional positioning). The GPS receiver calculates the travel position in two dimensions (latitude/longitude) with the previous altitude data if the GPS
    receiver receives only three radio waves (two-dimensional positioning). GPS position correction is not performed while stopping the
    vehicle.

    A

    B

    C
    SKIA0613E

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SEL526V

    Accuracy of the GPS will deteriorate under the following conditions:
    • In two-dimensional positioning, GPS accuracy will deteriorate when altitude of the vehicle position changes.
    • The position of GPS satellite affects GPS detection precision. The position detection may not be precisely
    performed.
    • The position detection is not performed if GPS receiver does not receive radio waves from GPS satellites.
    (Inside a tunnel, parking in a building, under an elevated highway etc.) GPS receiver may not receive radio
    waves from GPS satellites if any object is placed on the GPS antenna.
    NOTE:
    • The detection result has an error of approximately 10 m (32.81 ft) even with a high-precision three dimensional positioning.
    • There may be cases when the accuracy is lowered and radio waves are stopped intentionally because the
    GPS satellite signal is controlled by the US trace control center.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    REAR VIEW MONITOR

    M
    Camera Image Operation Principle
    • The AV control unit supplies power to the rear view camera when receiving a reverse signal.
    • The rear view camera transmits camera images to the AV control unit.
    • The AV control unit combines a warning message and fixed guide lines with an image received from the rear AV
    view camera.

    USB INTERFACE
    • iPod® or music files in USB memory can be played.
    • Sound signals are transmitted from USB interface to the AV control unit and output to each speaker.
    • iPod® is recharged when connected to USB interface.

    AUX IN JACK
    • Sound can be output from an external device by connecting a device to the AUX in jack.
    • AUX sound signals are transmitted to each speaker via AV control unit.

    SPEED SENSITIVE VOLUME SYSTEM
    • Volume level of this system goes up and down automatically in proportion to the vehicle speed.
    • The control level can be selected by the customer.
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-113

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM
    • Bluetooth® control is built into AV control unit.
    • The connection between cellular phone and AV control unit is performed with Bluetooth® communication.
    • The voice guidance signal is input from the AV control unit and output to the front speakers when operating
    the cellular phone.
    When A Call Is Originated
    • Spoken voice sound output from the microphone (microphone signal) is input to AV control unit.
    • AV control unit outputs to cellular phone with Bluetooth® communication as a TEL voice signal.
    • Voice sound is then heard at the other party.
    When Receiving A Call
    • Voice sound is input to own cellular phone from the other party.
    • TEL voice signal is input to AV control unit by establishing Bluetooth® communication from cellular phone,
    and the signal is output to front speakers.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-114

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009460259

    The AV control unit on board diagnosis performs the functions listed in the table below:
    Mode

    Item

    Content

    Version data of the AV control unit is displayed.

    Touch Display Calibration

    Allows correction of the position detection accuracy of the touch panel.

    FM monitor

    AM monitor

    Monitors the dynamic values of the current tuner

    XM monitor

    Version data is displayed.

    E

    Current status is displayed.

    F

    Version
    User Configuration

    B

    Radio

    XM functions

    Running System Status





    Clear XM Chipset NVM
    Reset All XM Settings
    Clear IGS
    XM CBM Debug Mode
    External Diag Mode













    SD card slot Access
    Power Supply
    Speed Signal
    Direction Signal
    Illumination Signal
    GPS Antenna
    GPS Tracking
    Satellites Visible
    Satellites Tracked
    Microphone Current
    Steering wheel key
    Radio Antenna
    USB Device

    C

    D

    G

    H
    The current system status is displayed.

    I

    J

    • iPod® firmware version

    System State
    Speaker Test 4kHz

    This activates a sequence of test tone
    outputs to the audio circuits one after the
    other for 1 second.

    This provides a test sequence where
    test displays (plain colored display: e.g.
    white, black, red, blue, green) are shown
    one after the other.
    The respective color is shown for an indicated period of time (parameter). After
    the display test, the design of the display
    previously available is stored. While the
    screen shows a plain colored display, a
    pixel malfunction may be detected.

    AV

    A system self test is executed and the
    results are stored into the error memory.

    O

    Perform CONSULT diagnosis if the AV control unit on board diagnosis does not start or the screen does not
    display anything.

    P

    Speaker Test 100Hz

    Display-Test

    Self Test





    SD Card Access
    BT Module Access
    Radio Antenna
    GPS Antenna
    XM Antenna

    On Board Diagnosis Function

    INFOID:0000000009460260

    METHOD OF STARTING
    1.
    2.

    Turn the ignition ON.
    Turn the audio system OFF.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-115

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    3. While pressing the SETUP button, turn the TUNE-SCROLL dial
    counterclockwise 3 or more clicks, then clockwise 3 or more
    clicks, then counterclockwise 3 or more clicks. Shifting from current screen to previous screen is performed by pressing
    button.

    ALNIA1473ZZ

    4.

    The trouble diagnosis initial screen is displayed, and Version,
    User Config, Radio, System State or Self Test can be selected.

    ALNIA1378ZZ

    CONSULT Function

    INFOID:0000000009460261

    CONSULT FUNCTIONS
    CONSULT performs the following functions via communication with the AV control unit.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    Ecu Identification

    The AV control unit part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The AV control unit self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The AV control unit input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing AV control unit.

    CAN Diag Support Mntr

    • The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of AV communication is displayed.
    • The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    ECU IDENTIFICATION
    The part number of AV control unit is displayed.

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Refer to AV-120, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    VHCL SPD SIG [On/Off]

    Indicates vehicle speed signal received from combination meter on CAN communication
    line.

    ILLUM SIG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of illumination signal for the AV control unit.

    IGN SIG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of ignition signal.

    REV SIG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of reverse signal received from BCM.

    CONFIGURATION
    Refer to AV-135, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description».

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR
    Refer to LAN-12, «CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor».
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-116

    2014 Note

    AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION

    A

    AV CONTROL UNIT
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009460262

    B

    TERMINAL LAYOUT
    C

    D

    E
    AWNIA3087ZZ

    PHYSICAL VALUES

    F

    Terminal
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description

    Signal name

    Condition
    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    G

    H
    2
    (GR)

    3
    (P)

    Sound signal front speaker
    LH

    Output

    ON

    I

    Sound output

    SKIB3609E

    4
    (W)

    5
    (R)

    Sound signal rear speaker
    LH

    J

    K
    Output

    ON

    Sound output

    L
    SKIB3609E

    Press SOURCE switch
    6
    (SB)

    15
    (G)

    Steering switch signal A

    Input

    ON

    Press

    switch

    1.0V

    Press

    switch

    2.0V

    Press

    switch

    Except above
    7
    (W)

    Ground

    8
    (L)

    CAN (H)

    9
    (LG/R)

    44
    (B)

    Illumination control signal

    ACC power supply

    Revision: April 2013

    0V

    M

    AV

    3.0V
    5.0V

    Input

    ACC

    Battery voltage

    Input/
    Output

    Input

    ON

    Headlamps ON

    O

    P

    AV-117

    Battery voltage

    2014 Note

    AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    (Wire color)

    Description

    Condition

    +

    Signal name

    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    11
    (O)

    12
    (V)

    Sound signal front speaker
    RH

    Output

    ON

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    Sound output

    SKIB3609E

    13
    (L)

    14
    (Y)

    Sound signal rear speaker
    RH

    Output

    ON

    Sound output

    SKIB3609E

    16
    (V)

    15
    (G)

    Steering switch signal B

    Input

    ON

    Press

    switch

    0V

    Press

    switch

    1.0V

    Press

    switch

    Except above
    17
    (P)

    18
    (LG)

    Ground

    CAN (L)

    Vehicle speed signal

    Input/
    Output

    Input

    ON

    When vehicle speed is approx. 40 km/h (25 MPH)

    2.0V
    5.0V

    JSNIA0012GB

    19
    (Y)

    Ground

    Battery power supply

    20
    (B/W)

    Ground

    Ground

    23
    (R)

    28
    (Y)

    Ground

    30
    (Y)

    Ground

    MR output

    Reverse signal

    AUX jack audio signal LH

    Input

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    ON

    0V

    Output

    Input

    Input

    ON

    ON

    Selector lever in R (reverse)
    Selector lever in any position other than R (reverse)

    Battery voltage
    0V

    Recieved audio signal
    (AUX input)

    SKIB3609E

    31
    (G)

    Ground

    AUX ground

    Revision: April 2013

    ON

    AV-118

    0V

    2014 Note

    AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description

    Signal name

    Condition
    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Operation

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    A

    B

    32
    (L)

    Ground

    AUX jack audio signal RH

    Input

    ON

    Recieved audio signal
    (AUX input)

    C

    SKIB3609E

    33
    (B)

    Ground

    Camera ground

    ON

    D

    0V

    E

    34
    (L)

    Ground

    Camera image signal

    Input

    ON

    When camera image is displayed

    F

    SKIB2251J

    35
    (Shield)

    36
    (Y)

    Ground

    37
    (O)

    Ground

    42
    (L)

    43
    (P)

    41
    (Shield)

    Camera image signal
    shield
    Camera power supply

    Output

    ON

    When camera image is displayed

    6.0 V

    Except for above

    G

    H
    0V

    I

    Ignition power supply

    Input

    ON

    Battery voltage

    MIC VCC

    Input

    ON

    ON

    While speaking into microphone.

    J

    K
    Microphone signal

    Input

    L
    SKIB3609E

    53
    (W)

    V BUS signal

    54
    (G)

    USB ground

    55
    (L)

    USB D+ signal

    56
    (R)

    USB D− signal

    57
    (Shield)

    USB shield

    58
    (B)

    Ground

    Antenna amp. ON signal

    Output

    ON

    Battery voltage

    59
    (B)

    Ground

    AM-FM main antenna

    Input

    ON

    5.0 V

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-119

    2014 Note

    AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    (Wire color)
    +

    61
    (B)

    Ground

    62
    (Shield)

    Description

    Condition

    Reference value
    (Approx.)

    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Operation

    GPS antenna signal

    Input

    ON

    5.0 V

    GPS antenna shield

    Signal name

    DTC Index

    INFOID:0000000009460263

    CONSULT Display

    Reference Page

    U1000: CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    AV-137, «DTC Logic»

    U1010: CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    AV-138, «DTC Logic»

    U1217: BLUETOOTH MODULE

    AV-139, «DTC Logic»

    U1229: iPod CERTIFICATION

    AV-140, «DTC Logic»

    U122F: Digital broadcasting connection error

    AV-141, «DTC Logic»

    U1244: GPS ANTENNA CONN

    AV-142, «DTC Logic»

    U1263: USB OVERCURRENT

    AV-143, «DTC Logic»

    U1264: ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL

    AV-144, «DTC Logic»

    U12AA: Configuration Error

    AV-145, «DTC Logic»

    U12AC: Display Temperature too High

    AV-146, «DTC Logic»

    U12AD: ECU Temperature too High

    AV-147, «DTC Logic»

    U12AE: Internal Amplifier temperature Warning

    AV-148, «DTC Logic»

    U12AF: CD Mechanism Temperature Warning

    AV-149, «DTC Logic»

    U12B0: Supply Voltage Goes below 9V > 20s

    AV-150, «DTC Logic»

    U12B1: Supply Voltage Goes High > 16V for 20s

    AV-151, «DTC Logic»

    U1310: CONTROL UNIT (AV)

    AV-152, «DTC Logic»

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-120

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009460264

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    AANWA0861GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-121

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANWA0862GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-122

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1720GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-123

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1721GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-124

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1722GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-125

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1723GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-126

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1724GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-127

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1725GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-128

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1726GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-129

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1727GB

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-130

    2014 Note

    NAVIGATION SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O
    AANIA1728GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-131

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [NAVIGATION]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009460265

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    AWNIA2982GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when the
    incident/malfunction occurred).
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer. Verify relation between the symptom and the condition
    when the symptom is detected.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    1.

    Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 seconds or more.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-132

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [NAVIGATION]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
    Are any DTCs displayed?
    YES >> Refer to AV-120, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    A

    4.PERFORM SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    B

    Refer to AV-166, «Symptom Table».
    C

    >> GO TO 5

    5.FINAL CHECK

    D

    Refer to symptom described by the customer in step 1.
    Is the symptom still present?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-133

    2014 Note

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Description
    INFOID:0000000009460266

    BEFORE REPLACEMENT
    When replacing AV control unit, save or print current vehicle specification with CONSULT configuration before
    replacement.
    NOTE:
    If “Before Replace ECU” cannot be used, use the “After Replace ECU” or “Manual Configuration” after replacing AV control unit.

    AFTER REPLACEMENT
    CAUTION:
    When replacing AV control unit, you must perform “After Replace ECU” with CONSULT.
    • Complete the procedure of “After Replace ECU” in order.
    • If you set incorrect “After Replace ECU”, incidents might occur.
    • Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure
    INFOID:0000000009460267

    1.SAVING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
    -CONSULT
    Enter “Re/Programming, Configuration” and perform “Before Replace ECU” to save or print current vehicle
    specification.
    NOTE:
    If “Before Replace ECU” cannot be used, use the “After Replace ECU” or “Manual Configuration” after replacing AV control unit.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE AV CONTROL UNIT
    Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.WRITING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
    CONSULT
    Enter «Re/Programming, Configuration».
    If “Before Replace ECU” operation was performed, automatically an «Operation Log Selection» screen will
    be displayed. Select the applicable file from the «Saved Data List» and press “Confirm” to write vehicle
    specification. Refer to AV-135, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure».
    3. If “Before Replace ECU” operation was not performed, select «After Replace ECU» or «Manual Configuration» to write vehicle specification. Refer to AV-135, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure».
    1.
    2.

    >> GO TO 4.

    4.OPERATION CHECK
    Check that the operation of the AV control unit and camera images (fixed guide lines) are normal.
    >> Work End.

    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT)

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-134

    2014 Note

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description

    INFOID:0000000009460268

    A

    Vehicle specification needs to be written with CONSULT because it is not written after replacing AV control
    unit.
    Configuration has three functions as follows:
    Function

    B

    Description

    «Before Replace ECU»

    • Reads the vehicle configuration of current AV control unit.
    • Saves the read vehicle configuration.

    «After Replace ECU»

    Writes the vehicle configuration with manual selection.

    «Select Saved Data List»

    Writes the vehicle configuration with saved data.

    C

    D

    CAUTION:
    • When replacing AV control unit, you must perform “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU»
    with CONSULT.
    • Complete the procedure of “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU» in order.
    • If you set incorrect “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU», incidents might occur.
    • Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
    • Never perform “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU» except for new AV control unit.

    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure

    E

    F

    INFOID:0000000009460269

    G

    1.WRITING MODE SELECTION
    CONSULT
    Select “Reprogramming, Configuration” of AV control unit.

    H

    When writing saved data>>GO TO 2.
    When writing manually>>GO TO 3.

    I

    2.PERFORM “SAVED DATA LIST”

    CONSULT
    Automatically “Operation Log Selection” window will display if “Before Replace ECU” was performed. Select
    applicable file from the “Save Data List” and press “Confirm”.

    J

    K

    >> Work End.

    3.PERFORM “AFTER REPLACE ECU” OR “MANUAL CONFIGURATION”

    L

    CONSULT
    Select “After Replace ECU” or “Manual Configuration”.
    Identify the correct model and configuration list. Refer to AV-136, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL M
    UNIT) : Configuration List».
    3. Confirm and/or change setting value for each item.
    CAUTION:
    AV
    Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. ECU control may not operate normally
    if the setting is not correct.
    4. Select “Next”.
    O
    CAUTION:
    Make sure to select “Next”, confirm each setting value and press “OK” even if the indicated configuration of brand new AV control unit is same as the desirable configuration. If not, configuration
    which is set automatically by selecting vehicle model can not be memorized.
    P
    5. When «Completed», select «End».

    1.
    2.

    >> GO TO 4.

    4.OPERATION CHECK
    Confirm that each function controlled by AV control unit operates normally.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-135

    2014 Note

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> Work End.

    CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List

    INFOID:0000000009460270

    CAUTION:
    Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. Incorrect settings may result in abnormal
    control of ECU.
    MANUAL SETTING ITEM
    Items

    Setting value

    SOUND SYSTEM

    BASE ⇔ BOSE

    CAMERA SYSTEM

    NONE/AVM ⇔ REAR CAMERA

    ⇔: Items which confirm vehicle specifications

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-136

    2014 Note

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460271

    B

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [U1000]

    DTC Detection Condition
    AV control unit is not transmitting or receiving
    CAN communication signal for 2 seconds or
    more.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    Possible Cause
    CAN communication system.

    D
    INFOID:0000000009460272

    E

    1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    F

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 seconds or more.
    2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
    Is CAN COMM CIRCUIT displayed?
    YES >> Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-137

    2014 Note

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460273

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [U1010]

    Revision: April 2013

    DTC Detection Condition
    Error during CAN controller hardware initialization (VCAN).

    AV-138

    Possible Cause
    Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction occurs constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    2014 Note

    U1217 AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1217 AV CONTROL UNIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460274

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    BLUETOOTH MODULE
    [U1217]

    B
    DTC Detection Condition
    Connection failure to the internal Blueooth® sub
    unit is detected.

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-139

    2014 Note

    U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460275

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    iPod CERTIFICATION
    [U1229]

    Revision: April 2013

    DTC Detection Condition
    iPod authentication chip error.

    AV-140

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    2014 Note

    U122F AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U122F AV CONTROL UNIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460276

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    Digital broadcasting connection
    error
    [U122F]

    Communication error with digital audio broadcast
    module internal to AV control unit.

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-141

    2014 Note

    U1244 GPS ANTENNA
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1244 GPS ANTENNA
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460277

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    GPS ANTENNA CONN
    [U1244]

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    Open or short to ground is detected in GPS antenna connection.

    • GPS antenna disconnection.
    • Open or short to ground in GPS antenna signal
    circuit.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460278

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.GPS ANTENNA INSPECTION
    Visually inspect the GPS antenna and antenna feeder. Refer to AV-186, «Removal and Installation».
    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect AV control unit connector M80.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between AV control unit connector M80 and ground.
    AV control unit

    Ground

    Connector

    Terminal

    M80

    61

    Voltage
    5.0 V

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace GPS antenna. Refer to AV-186, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-142

    2014 Note

    U1263 USB
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1263 USB

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460281

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    USB OVERCURRENT
    [U1263]

    B
    DTC Detection Condition
    Overcurrent in USB harness is detected.

    Possible Cause
    • Device connected to USB interface.
    • Harness between the AV control unit and USB
    interface.

    C

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1. If there is a device connected to the USB interface, disconnect it.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 seconds or more.
    3. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
    Is DTC U1263 displayed?
    YES >> Refer to AV-143, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    E

    1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    INFOID:0000000009460282

    G

    1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS
    Visually inspect USB interface harness. Refer to AV-181, «Removal and Installation».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-181, «Removal and Installation».

    H

    Check USB interface harness. Refer to AV-164, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-181, «Removal and Installation».

    J

    I

    2.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-143

    2014 Note

    U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460283

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL
    [U1264]

    Possible Cause
    • Antenna amp. disconnection.
    • Open or short to ground in antenna amp. ON
    signal circuit.

    Open or short to ground is detected in Antenna
    amp. connection.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460284

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.ANTENNA AMP. INSPECTION
    Visually inspect the antenna base (antenna amp.) and antenna feeder. Refer to AV-188, «Feeder Layout».
    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    2.CHECK CONTINUITY BETWEEN AV CONTROL UNIT AND ANTENNA BASE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect AV control unit connector M73 and antenna base connector M351.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M73 and antenna base connector M351.
    AV control unit

    4.

    Antenna base

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M73

    58

    M351

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M73 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M73

    58

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Connect AV control unit connector M73.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between AV control unit connector M73 and ground.
    AV control unit

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M73

    58

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace antenna base. Refer to AV-187, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-144

    2014 Note

    U12AA CONFIGURATION ERROR
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U12AA CONFIGURATION ERROR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460285

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display
    Configuration Error
    [U12AA]

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    AV control unit is not properly configured or configuration is corrupt.

    Configuration data needs to be written.
    Refer to AV-135, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460286

    1.PERFORM CONFIGURATION

    C

    D

    E

    When U12AA is detected, configuration data must be written.
    >> Write configuration data with CONSULT. Refer to AV-135, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
    UNIT) : Work Procedure».

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-145

    2014 Note

    U12AC AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U12AC AV CONTROL UNIT
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460287

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    Display Temperature too High
    [U12AC]

    Revision: April 2013

    DTC Detection Condition
    Display temperature has exceeded maximum
    temperature. Display is switched OFF to avoid irreversible damage.

    AV-146

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    2014 Note

    U12AD AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U12AD AV CONTROL UNIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460288

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    ECU Temperature too High
    [U12AD]

    B
    DTC Detection Condition
    AV control unit temperature has exceeded maximum temperature.

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-147

    2014 Note

    U12AE AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U12AE AV CONTROL UNIT
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460289

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    Internal Amplifier temperature
    Warning
    [U12AE]

    Revision: April 2013

    DTC Detection Condition
    Internal amplifier temperature has exceeded
    maximum temperature.

    AV-148

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    2014 Note

    U12AF AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U12AF AV CONTROL UNIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460290

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    CD Mechanism Temperature
    Warning
    [U12AF]

    B
    DTC Detection Condition
    CD drive temperature has exceeded maximum
    temperature. CD drive is switched OFF to avoid
    irreversible damage.

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-149

    2014 Note

    U12B0 POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U12B0 POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460291

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    Supply Voltage Goes below 9V
    > 20s
    [U12B0]

    AV control unit supply voltage exceeds lower limits.

    • Charging system malfunction.
    • AV control unit power supply or ground circuits.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460292

    1.CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM
    Check the vehicle charging system. Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)» or
    CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning components.

    2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUITS

    Perform the AV control unit power supply and ground circuit diagnosis procedure. Refer to AV-153, «AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-150

    2014 Note

    U12B1 POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U12B1 POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460293

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display
    Supply Voltage Goes High >
    16V for 20s
    [U12B1]

    DTC Detection Condition
    AV control unit supply voltage exceeds upper limits.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    Possible Cause

    C
    Charging system malfunction.

    INFOID:0000000009460294

    D

    E

    1.CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM
    Check the vehicle charging system. Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)» or
    CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning components.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-151

    2014 Note

    U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460295

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    CONTROL UNIT (AV)
    [U1310]

    Revision: April 2013

    DTC Detection Condition
    Error during CAN controller hardware initialization (MCAN).

    AV-152

    Possible Cause
    Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs
    constantly.
    Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    A

    AV CONTROL UNIT
    AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460296

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    B

    C

    1.CHECK FUSE
    D

    Check that the following fuses are not blown.
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    7

    ACC power supply

    18 (10A)

    19

    Battery power supply

    29 (15A)

    37

    Ignition power supply

    5 (10A)

    E

    F

    Are the fuses blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    G

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect AV control unit connectors M70 and M71.
    Check voltage between AV control unit connectors M70 and M71 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Ground

    Terminal
    19

    M70

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ignition switch: OFF

    7

    M71

    Condition

    H

    37

    Ignition switch: ON

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    J

    K

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    I

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M70 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M70

    20

    M

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    AV

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-153

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460297

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR CHECK
    Check the AV control unit and speaker connectors for the following:
    • Proper connection
    • Damage
    • Disconnected or loose terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminals or connectors.

    2.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect AV control unit connector M70 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M70 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Front door speaker
    Terminal

    Connector

    2

    11

    3.

    2
    1

    D112 (RH)

    12

    Continuity

    1

    D12 (LH)

    3

    M70

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M70 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    2
    3

    M70

    11
    12

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect AV control unit connector M70 and suspect front door speaker connector.
    Turn ignition switch to ACC.
    Push AV control unit POWER switch.
    Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M70.
    AV control unit connector M70
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    AV-154

    Reference value

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2

    3

    11

    12

    A
    Audio signal output

    B
    SKIB3609E

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front door speaker. Refer to AV-179, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-155

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460299

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR CHECK
    Check the AV control unit and speaker connectors for the following:
    • Proper connection
    • Damage
    • Disconnected or loose terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminals or connectors.

    2.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect AV control unit connector M70 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M70 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Rear door speaker
    Terminal

    Connector

    4

    13

    3.

    2
    1

    D307 (RH)

    14

    Continuity

    1

    D207 (LH)

    5

    M70

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M70 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    4
    5

    M70

    13
    14

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect AV control unit connector M70 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
    Turn ignition switch to ACC.
    Push AV control unit POWER switch.
    Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M70.
    AV control unit connector M70
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    AV-156

    Reference value

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4

    5

    13

    14

    A
    Audio signal output

    B
    SKIB3609E

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear door speaker. Refer to AV-180, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-157

    2014 Note

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460300

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK REVERSE INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Shift the selector lever to R (reverse).
    Check voltage between AV control unit connector M71 and ground.
    AV control unit

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M71

    34

    Condition

    (−)

    Selector lever in R (reverse)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery Voltage

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    2.CHECK CAMERA POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect AV control unit connector M71 and rear view camera connector.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and rear view camera connector D501.
    AV control unit

    4.

    Rear view camera

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M71

    34

    D501

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M71

    34

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK CAMERA POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect AV control unit connector M71 and rear view camera connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Shift the selector lever to R (reverse).
    Check voltage between AV control unit connector M71 and ground.
    AV control unit

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M71

    36

    (−)

    Condition

    Selector lever is in “R”.

    Voltage
    (Approx.)
    6.0 V

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    AV-158

    2014 Note

    REAR VIEW CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    4.CHECK CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect AV control unit connector M71 and rear view camera connector.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and rear view camera connector D501.
    AV control unit

    4.

    Rear view camera

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M71

    36

    D501

    4

    Continuity

    M71

    36

    C

    D

    AV control unit
    Terminal

    B

    Yes

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and ground.

    Connector

    A

    Continuity

    Ground

    E
    No

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    F

    5.CHECK CAMERA GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    G

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and rear view camera connector D501.
    AV control unit

    Rear view camera

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M71

    33

    D501

    1

    Continuity

    H

    Yes

    I

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL

    J

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    K

    Connect AV control unit connector M71 and rear view camera connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Shift the selector lever to R (reverse).
    Check signal between AV control unit connector M71 and ground.
    AV control unit

    L

    Ground

    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M71

    33

    (−)

    Condition

    Reference value

    M

    AV

    Camera image displayed.

    O
    SKIB2251J

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace rear view camera. Refer to AV-185, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-159

    P

    2014 Note

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460301

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect AV control unit connector M71 and microphone connector R15.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and microphone connector R15.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Microphone
    Terminal

    Connector

    41
    M71

    2

    42

    R15

    4

    43

    4.

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    1

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    Terminal
    42

    M71

    43

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    2.CHECK MICROPHONE VCC VOLTAGE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Connect AV control unit connector M71.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between terminals of AV control unit connector M71.
    AV control unit connector M71
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    42

    41

    Voltage
    (Approx.)
    5.0 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».

    3.CHECK MICROPHONE SIGNAL

    1.
    2.

    Connect microphone connector.
    Check signal between terminals of AV control unit connector M71.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-160

    2014 Note

    MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    AV control unit connector M71
    (+)

    (−)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    43

    41

    Condition

    Reference value

    B

    C

    Speak into microphone.

    D
    PKIB5037J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace microphone. Refer to AV-184, «Removal and Installation».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-161

    2014 Note

    STEERING SWITCH
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    STEERING SWITCH
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460302

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROL SWITCH RESISTANCE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination switch connector M88.
    Check resistance between the terminals of combination switch connector M88.
    Combination switch connector M88
    Terminal

    Resistance Ω
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal

    Depress SOURCE switch.
    14
    17

    15

    1

    Depress

    switch.

    121

    Depress

    switch.

    321

    Depress

    switch.

    723

    Depress

    switch.

    1

    Depress

    switch.

    121

    Depress

    321

    switch.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace steering switches. Refer to AV-183, «Removal and Installation».

    2.CHECK COMBINATION SWITCH

    Check continuity between combination switch connectors M88 and M30.
    Combination switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    14
    M88

    15

    Continuity

    24
    M30

    31

    17

    Yes

    33

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace spiral cable. Refer to SR-15, «Removal and Installation».

    3.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN COMBINATION SWITCH AND AV CONTROL UNIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect AV control unit connector M70.
    Check continuity between combination switch connector M30 and AV control unit connector M70.
    Combination switch

    AV control unit

    Connector

    Terminal

    M30

    31

    Connector

    Terminal

    M70

    16

    24

    6

    33

    Revision: April 2013

    Continuity

    Yes

    15

    AV-162

    2014 Note

    STEERING SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check continuity between combination switch connector M30 and ground.

    [NAVIGATION]
    A

    Combination switch
    Connector

    Ground

    Terminal

    Continuity

    B

    24
    M30

    31

    No

    33

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-163

    2014 Note

    USB CONNECTOR
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    USB CONNECTOR
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460303

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect AV control unit connector M76 and USB interface connector M72.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M76 and USB interface connector M72.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    USB interface
    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    53

    4

    54
    M76

    4.

    Continuity

    1

    55

    M72

    2

    56

    3

    57

    5

    Yes

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M76 and ground.
    AV control unit
    Connector
    M76

    Terminal
    53
    55

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the USB interface. Refer to AV-181, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-164

    2014 Note

    AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
    [NAVIGATION]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    AUXILIARY INPUT JACK

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460304

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1.CHECK AUX JACK HARNESS CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect AV control unit connector M71 and AUX jack connector M23.
    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and AUX jack connector M23.
    AV control unit
    Connector

    AUX jack
    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    30
    M71

    Continuity

    1

    31

    M23

    3

    32

    4.

    D

    Yes

    AV control unit

    M71

    F

    4

    Check continuity between AV control unit connector M71 and ground.

    Connector

    E

    Terminal
    30
    32

    G

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    H

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the AUX jack. Refer to AV-182, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-165

    2014 Note

    MULTI AV SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    MULTI AV SYSTEM
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009460305

    RELATED TO AUDIO
    Symptoms
    The disk cannot be removed.

    Check items
    AV control unit

    No sound from all speakers.

    • Speaker circuit shorted to ground.
    Refer to AV-121, «Wiring Diagram».
    • AV control unit power supply and ground
    circuits malfunction.
    Refer to AV-153, «AV CONTROL UNIT :
    Diagnosis Procedure».

    Only a certain speaker (front door speaker
    LH, front door speaker RH, rear door
    speaker LH, rear door speaker RH) does
    not output sound.

    • Poor connector connection of speaker.
    • Sound signal circuit malfunction between
    AV control unit and speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-154, «Diagnosis Procedure» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-156, «Diagnosis Procedure» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-179, «Removal and Installation» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-180, «Removal and Installation» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in AV control unit.
    Refer to AV-115, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Noise comes out from all speakers.

    Malfunction in AV control unit.
    Refer to AV-115, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Noise comes out only from a certain speaker (front door speaker LH, front door speaker RH, rear door speaker LH, rear door
    speaker RH).

    • Poor connector connection of speaker.
    • Sound signal circuit malfunction between
    AV control unit and speaker.
    Refer to:
    — AV-154, «Diagnosis Procedure» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-156, «Diagnosis Procedure» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in speaker.
    • Poor Installation of speaker (e.g. backlash and looseness).
    Refer to:
    — AV-179, «Removal and Installation» (front
    door speaker).
    — AV-180, «Removal and Installation» (rear
    door speaker).
    • Malfunction in AV control unit.
    Refer to AV-115, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Noise is mixed with radio only (when the vehicle hits a bump or while driving over bad
    roads)

    Poor connector connection of antenna or
    antenna feeder.
    Refer to AV-188, «Feeder Layout».

    No sound comes out or the level of the
    sound is low.

    Noise is mixed with audio.

    Revision: April 2013

    Probable malfunction location
    Malfunction in AV control unit.
    Refer to AV-115, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    AV-166

    2014 Note

    MULTI AV SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptoms

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    No radio reception or poor reception.

    • Other audio sounds are normal.
    • Antenna amp. ON signal circuit malfunc• Any radio station cannot be received or
    tion.
    poor reception is caused even after movRefer to AV-144, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    ing to a service area with good reception • Poor connector connection of antenna or
    antenna feeder.
    (e.g. a place with clear view and no obRefer to AV-188, «Feeder Layout».
    stacles generating external noises).

    Buzz/rattle sound from speaker

    The majority of buzz/rattle sounds are not
    indicative of an issue with the speaker, usually something nearby the speaker is causing the buzz/rattle.

    Refer to «SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS» in the appropriate interior trim section.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE
    • Before performing diagnosis, confirm that the cellular phone being used by the customer is compatible with
    the vehicle.
    • It is possible that a malfunction is occurring due to a version change of the phone even though the phone is
    a compatible type. This can be confirmed by changing the cellular phone to another compatible type, and
    check that it operates normally. It is important to determine whether the cause of the malfunction is the vehicle or the cellular phone.

    E

    F

    Check Compatibility

    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.
    a.
    b.

    c.
    d.

    Make sure the customer’s Bluetooth® related concern is understood.
    Verify the customer’s concern.
    NOTE:
    The customer’s phone may be required, depending upon their concern.
    Write down the customer’s phone brand, model and service provider.
    NOTE:
    It is necessary to know the service provider. On occasion, a given phone may be on the approved list with
    one provider, but may not be on the approved list with other providers.
    Go to “www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth/”.
    Using the website’s search engine, find out if the customer’s phone is on the approved list.
    If the customer’s phone is NOT on the approved list:
    Stop diagnosis here. The customer needs to obtain a Bluetooth® phone that is on the approved list before
    any further action.
    If the feature related to the customer’s concern shows as “N” (not compatible):
    Stop diagnosis here. If the customer still wants the feature to function, they will need to get an approved
    phone showing the feature as “Y” (compatible) in the “Basic Features”.
    If the feature related to the customer’s concern shows as “Y” (compatible):
    Perform diagnosis as per the following table.
    Symptoms

    Check items

    Does not recognize cellular phone connection (no connection is displayed on the display at the guide).

    Repeat the registration of cellular phone.

    Hands-free phone cannot be established.

    • Hands-free phone operation can be
    made, but the communication cannot be
    established.
    • Hands-free phone operation can be performed, however, voice between each
    other cannot be heard during the conversation.

    The other party’s voice cannot be heard by
    hands-free phone.

    Check the “microphone speaker” in Inspection & Adjustment Mode if sound is heard.

    Originating sound is not heard by the other
    party with hands-free phone communication.

    Sound operation function is normal.

    Revision: April 2013

    Probable malfunction location

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    Sound operation function does not work.

    AV-167

    Malfunction in AV control unit.
    Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-178,
    «Removal and Installation».

    O

    P

    Microphone signal circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-160, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2014 Note

    MULTI AV SYSTEM
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptoms

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    • The voice recognition can be controlled.
    • Steering switch’s

    ,

    switch works, but
    The system cannot be operated.

    Steering switch’s

    , and

    does not work.
    ,

    ,

    , and

    switches do not work.
    All steering switches do not work.

    Steering switch malfunction.
    Replace steering switch. Refer to AV-183,
    «Removal and Installation».
    Steering switch signal circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-162, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Steering switch ground circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-162, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    RELATED TO NAVIGATION
    Symptoms

    Navigation system is inoperative.

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    Navigation malfunction.

    • Malfunction in SD card.
    • Malfunction in AV control unit.
    Refer to AV-115, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function».

    Steering switches malfunction.

    Steering switch signal circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-162, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Voice activated control malfunction.

    Microphone signal circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-160, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Steering switch signal circuit malfunction.
    Refer to AV-162, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    RELATED TO REAR VIEW CAMERA
    Symptoms

    Rear view camera is inoperative.

    Revision: April 2013

    Check items

    Probable malfunction location

    Reverse signal circuit malfunction.

    Reverse signal circuit malfunction between
    BCM and AV control unit.
    Refer to AV-158, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Camera image signal circuit malfunction.

    Camera image signal circuit malfunction
    between rear view camera and AV control
    unit.
    Refer to AV-158, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Rear view camera malfunction.

    Replace rear view camera.
    Refer to AV-185, «Removal and Installation».

    AV-168

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009460306

    RELATED TO NOISE

    B

    The majority of the audio concerns are the result of outside causes (bad CD, electromagnetic interference,
    etc.).
    The following noise results from variations in field strength, such as fading noise and multi-path noise, or
    external noise from trains and other sources. It is not a malfunction.
    • Fading noise: This noise occurs because of variations in the field strength in a narrow range due to mountains or buildings blocking the signal.
    • Multi-path noise: This noise results from the waves sent directly from the broadcast station arriving at the
    antenna at a different time from the waves which reflect off mountains or buildings.
    The vehicle itself can be a source of noise if noise prevention parts or electrical equipment is malfunctioning.
    Check if noise is caused and/or changed by engine speed, ignition switch turned to each position, and operation of each piece of electrical equipment, and determine the cause.
    NOTE:
    The source of the noise can be found easily by listening to the noise while removing the fuses of electrical
    components, one by one.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    Type of Noise and Possible Cause
    Occurrence condition
    Occurs only when engine is ON.

    A continuous growling noise occurs. The speed of
    the noise varies with changes in the engine speed.

    The occurrence of the noise is linked with the operation of the fuel pump.
    Noise only occurs when various
    electrical components are operating.

    G

    Possible cause
    • Ignition components

    H

    • Fuel pump condenser

    A cracking or snapping sound occurs with the operation of various switches.

    • Relay malfunction, AV control unit malfunction

    The noise occurs when various motors are operating.

    • Motor case ground
    • Motor

    The noise occurs constantly, not just under certain conditions.

    • Rear defogger coil malfunction
    • Open circuit in printed heater
    • Poor ground of antenna feeder line

    A cracking or snapping sound occurs while the vehicle is being driven, especially when
    it is vibrating excessively.

    • Ground wire of body parts
    • Ground due to improper part installation
    • Wiring connections or a short circuit

    RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE

    K

    Cause and Counter measure

    Does not recognize cellular phone connection (No connection is
    displayed on the display at the guide).

    Some Bluetooth® enabled cellular phones may not be recognized
    by the in-vehicle phone module.
    Refer to “RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE (Check Compatibility)” in AV-166, «Symptom Table».
    Customer will not be able to use a hands-free phone under the following conditions:
    • The vehicle is outside of the telephone service area.
    • The vehicle is in an area where it is difficult to receive radio
    waves; such as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage,
    near a tall building or in a mountainous area.
    • The cellular phone is locked to prevent it from being dialed.
    NOTE:
    While a cellular phone is connected through the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may discharge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
    System cannot charge cellular phones.

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    L

    Symptom

    Cannot use hands-free phone.

    I

    AV-169

    2014 Note

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom

    Cause and Counter measure

    The other party’s voice cannot be heard by hands-free phone.

    When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too
    loud, it may be difficult to hear the other person’s voice during a
    call.

    Poor sound quality.

    Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or
    far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality
    degradation and wireless connection disruption.

    RELATED TO NAVIGATION
    Basic Operation
    Symptom

    Cause

    Remedy

    No image is shown.

    Display brightness adjustment is set fully to DARK
    side.

    Adjust the display brightness.

    No guide sound is heard.
    Audio guide volume is too low or
    too high.

    Volume control is set to OFF, MIN or MAX.

    Adjust the audio guide volume.

    Audio guidance is not available while the vehicle is
    driving on a dark pink route.

    System is not malfunctioning.

    Screen is too dark.
    Motion of the image is too slow.

    Temperature inside the vehicle is low.

    Wait until the temperature inside the vehicle
    reaches the proper temperature.

    Small black or bright spots appear
    on the screen.

    Symptom peculiar to a liquid crystal display (display unit).

    System is not malfunction.

    Vehicle Mark
    Symptom

    Cause

    Remedy

    Map screen and BIRDVIEW™
    Name of the place vary with the
    screen.

    Some thinning of the character data is done to prevent the display becoming to complex. In some
    cases and in some locations, the display contents
    may differ.
    The same place name, street name, etc. may not
    be displayed every time on account of the data
    processing.

    System is not malfunctioning.

    Vehicle mark is not positioned correctly.

    Vehicle is transferred by ferry or by towing after its
    ignition switch is turned to OFF.

    Drive the vehicle for a while in the GPS satellite signal receiving condition.

    Screen will not switch to nighttime
    mode after the lighting switch is
    turned ON.

    The daytime screen is selected by the “SWITCH
    SCREENS” when the last time the screen dimming setting is done.
    Switching between daytime/nighttime screen may
    be inhibited by the automatic illumination adjustment function.

    Perform screen dimming and select the
    nighttime screen by “SWITCH SCREENS”.

    Map screen will not scroll in accordance with the vehicle travel.

    Current location is not displayed.

    Press “MAP” button to display the current location.

    Vehicle mark will not be shown.

    Current location is not displayed.

    Press “MAP” button to display the current location.

    Accuracy indicator (GPS satellite
    mark) on the map screen stays
    gray.

    GPS satellite signal is intercepted because the vehicle is in or behind a building.

    Move the vehicle out to an open space.

    GPS satellite signal cannot be received because
    an obstacle is placed on top of the instrument panel.

    Do not place anything on top of the meter display (instrument panel).

    GPS satellites are not visible from current location.

    Wait until GPS satellites are visible by moving the vehicle.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-170

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom
    Vehicle location accuracy is low.

    Cause

    Remedy

    Accuracy indicator (GPS satellite mark) on the
    map screen stays gray.

    Current location is not determined.

    Vehicle speed setting by the vehicle speed pulse
    has been deviated (advanced or retarded) from
    the actual vehicle speed because tire chain is fitted or the system has been used on another vehicle.

    Drive the vehicle for a while [for approx. 30
    minutes at approx. 30 km/h (19 MPH)] and
    the deviation will be automatically adjusted. If
    advancement or retard still occur, perform
    the distance adjustment by CONFIRMATION/ADJUSTMENT mode of diagnosis
    function.

    Map data has error or omission. (Vehicle mark is
    always deviated to the same position.)

    As a rule, an updated map DVD–ROM will be
    released once a year.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    Destination, Passing Points and Menu Items Cannot be Selected/Set
    Symptom

    Cause

    E

    Remedy

    Destination cannot be set.

    Destination to be set is on an expressway.

    Set the destination on an ordinary road.

    Passing point is not searched
    when re-searching the route.

    The vehicle has already passed the passing point,
    or the system judged so.

    To include the passing points that have been
    passed into the route again, set the route
    again.

    Route information will not be displayed.

    Route searching has not been done.

    Set the destination and perform route
    searching.

    Vehicle mark is not on the recommended route.

    Drive on the recommended route.

    Route guide is turned OFF.

    Turn route guide ON.

    Route information is not available on the dark pink
    route.

    System is not malfunctioning.

    After the route searching, no guide
    sign will appear as the vehicle
    goes near the entrance/exit to the
    toll road.

    Vehicle mark is not on the recommended route.
    (On the display, only guide signs related to the recommended route will be shown.)

    Drive on the recommended route.

    Automatic route searching is not
    possible.

    Vehicle is driving on a highway (gray route), or no
    recommended route is available.

    Drive on a road to be searched. Or re–search
    the route manually. In this case, however, the
    whole route will be searched.

    Performed automatic detour
    search (or detour search). However, the result is the same as that of
    the previous search.

    Performed search with every conditions considered. However, the result is the same as that of the
    previous search.

    System is not malfunctioning.

    Passing points cannot be set.

    More than five passing points were set.

    Passing points can be set up to five. To stop
    at more than five points, perform sharing in
    several steps.

    When setting the route, the starting
    point cannot be selected.

    The current vehicle location is always set as the
    starting point of a route.

    System is not malfunctioning.

    Some menu items cannot be selected.

    The vehicle is being driven.

    Stop the vehicle at a safe place and then operate the system.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    Voice Guide
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-171

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom
    Voice guide will not operate.

    Voice guide does not match the actual road pattern.

    Cause

    Remedy

    Note: Voice guide is only available at intersections
    that satisfy certain conditions (indicated by z on
    the map). Therefore, guidance may not be given
    even when the route on the map changes direction.

    System is not malfunctioning.

    The vehicle is not on the recommended route.

    Return to the recommended route or research the route.

    Voice guide is turned OFF.

    Turn voice guide ON.

    Route guide is turned OFF.

    Turn route guide ON.

    Voice guide may vary with the direction to which
    the vehicle is turn and the connection of the road to
    other roads.

    Drive in conformity to the actual traffic rules.

    Cause

    Remedy

    No road to be searched is found around the destination.

    Find wider road (orange road or wider) nearby and reset the destination and passing
    points onto it. Take care of the traveling direction when there are separate up and down
    roads.

    Starting point and the destination are too close.

    Set the destination at more distant point.

    Conditional traffic regulation (day of the week/
    time of the day) is set at the area around the current location or the destination.

    Turn the time-regulating search conditions
    OFF. Turn “Avoid regulation time” in the
    search conditions OFF.

    In some areas, highways (gray routes) are not

    System is not malfunctioning.

    Route Search
    Symptom
    No route is shown.

    Indicated route is intermittent.

    used for the search(Note)Therefore, the route to
    the current location or the passing points may be
    intermittent.
    When the vehicle has passed the
    recommended route, it is deleted
    from the screen.

    A recommended route is controlled by each section. When the vehicle has passed the passing
    point 1, then the map data from the starting point
    up to the passing point 1 will be deleted. (The data
    may remain undeleted in some area.)

    System is not malfunctioning.

    Detouring route is recommended.

    In some areas, highways (gray routes) are not
    used for the search. (Note). Therefore, detour
    route may be recommended.

    Set the route closer to the basic route (gray
    route).

    A detour route may be shown when some traffic
    regulation (one-way traffic, etc.) is set at the area
    around the starting point or the destination.

    Slightly move the starting point or the destination, or set the passing point on the route of
    your choice.

    In the area where highways (gray routes) are
    used for the search, left turn has priority around
    the current location and the destination (passing
    points). For this reason, the recommended route
    may be detouring.

    System is not malfunctioning.

    Landmarks on the map do not
    match the actual ones.

    This can be happen due to omission or error in
    the map data.

    As a rule, an updated map DVD-ROM will be
    released once a year. Wait until the latest
    map has become available.

    Recommended route is far from
    the starting point, passing points,
    and destination.

    Starting point, passing points, and destination of
    the route guide were set far from the desired
    points because route searching data around
    these area were not stored.

    Reset the destination onto the road nearby. If
    this road is one of the highways (gray routes),
    an ordinary road nearby may be displayed as
    the recommended route.

    NOTE:
    Except for the ordinance-designated cities. (Malfunctioning areas may be changed in the updated map disc.)

    Examples of Current-Location Mark Displacement

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-172

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Vehicle’s travel amount is calculated by reading its travel distance and turning angle. Therefore, if the vehicle
    is driven in the following manner, an error will occur in the vehicle’s current location display. If correct location
    has not been restored after driving the vehicle for a while, perform location correction.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    SEL698V

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-173

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Cause (condition)

    –: While driving ooo: Display

    Driving condition

    Remarks (correction, etc.)

    Y–intersections
    At a Y intersection or similar gradual division of roads, an error in the direction of
    travel deduced by the sensor may result in
    the current-location mark appearing on the
    wrong road.
    ELK0192D

    Spiral roads
    When driving on a large, continuous spiral
    road (such as loop bridge), turning angle
    error is accumulated and the vehicle mark
    may deviate from the correct location.
    ELK0193D

    Straight roads

    Road configuration

    When driving on a long, straight road and
    slow curve without stopping, map-matching
    does not work effectively enough and distance errors may accumulate. As a result,
    the vehicle mark may deviate from the correct location when the vehicle is turned at a
    corner.
    ELK0194D

    Zigzag roads
    When driving on a zigzag road, the map
    may be matched to other roads in the similar direction nearby at every turn, and the
    vehicle mark may deviate from the correct
    location.

    If after travelling about 10 km (6
    miles) the correct location has
    not been restored, perform location correction and, if necessary, direction correction.

    ELK0195D

    Roads laid out in a grid pattern
    When driving where roads are laid out in a
    grid pattern, or where many roads are running in the similar direction nearby, the map
    may be matched to them by mistake and
    the vehicle mark may deviate from the correct location.
    ELK0196D

    Parallel roads
    When two roads are running in parallel
    (such as highway and sideway), the map
    may be matched to the other road by mistake and the vehicle mark may deviate from
    the correct location.
    ELK0197D

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-174

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Cause (condition)

    –: While driving ooo: Display

    In a parking lot

    SEL709V

    Turntable

    Driving condition

    Remarks (correction, etc.)

    When driving in a parking lot, or other location where there are no roads on the map,
    matching may place the vehicle mark on a
    nearby road. When the vehicle returns to
    the road, the vehicle mark may have deviated from the correct location.
    When driving in circle or turning the steering wheel repeatedly, direction errors accumulate, and the vehicle mark may deviate
    from the correct location.

    B

    C

    D

    When the ignition switch is OFF, the navigation system cannot get the signal from
    the gyroscope (angular speed sensor).
    Therefore, the displayed direction may be
    wrong and the correct road may not be easily returned to after rotating the vehicle on a
    turntable with the ignition OFF.

    Place

    E

    F

    SEL710V

    Slippery roads

    On snow, wet roads, gravel, or other roads
    where tires may slip easily, accumulated
    mileage errors may cause the vehicle mark
    to deviate from the correct road.

    Slopes

    When parking in sloped garages, when
    travelling on banked roads, or in other cases where the vehicle turns when tilted, an
    error in the turning angle will occur, and the
    vehicle mark may deviate from the road.

    Road not displayed on the map screen

    If after travelling about 10 km (6
    miles) the correct location has
    not been restored, perform location correction and, if necessary, direction correction.

    Different road pattern
    (Changed due to repair)

    G

    H

    I

    When driving on new roads or other roads
    not displayed on the map screen, map
    matching does not function correctly and
    matches the location to a nearby road.
    When the vehicle returns to a road which is
    on the map, the vehicle mark may deviate
    from the correct road.

    J

    K

    SEL699V

    Map data

    A

    If the road pattern stored in the map data
    and the actual road pattern are different,
    map matching does not function correctly
    and matches the location to a nearby road.
    The vehicle mark may deviate from the correct road.

    L

    M

    ELK0201D

    Vehicle

    Use of tire chains

    When tire chains are used, the mileage is
    not correctly detected, and the vehicle mark
    may deviate from the correct road.

    Drive the vehicle for a while. If
    the distance still deviates, adjust it by using the distance adjustment function. (If the tire
    chain is removed, recover the
    original value.)

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-175

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Cause (condition)

    –: While driving ooo: Display

    Just after the engine is started

    Continuous driving without stopping
    Precautions
    for driving
    Abusive driving

    Driving condition

    Remarks (correction, etc.)

    If the vehicle is driven just after the engine
    is started when the gyroscope (angular
    speed sensor) correction is not completed,
    the vehicle can lose its direction and may
    have deviated from the correct location.

    Wait for a short while before
    driving after starting the engine.

    When driving long distances without stopping, direction errors may accumulate, and
    the current-location mark may deviate from
    the correct road.

    Stop and adjust the orientation.

    Spinning the wheels or engaging in other
    kinds of abusive driving may result in the
    system being unable perform correct detection, and may cause the vehicle mark to deviate from the correct road.

    If after travelling about 10 km (6
    miles) the correct location has
    not been restored, perform location correction and, if necessary, direction correction.

    If the accuracy of location settings is poor,
    accuracy may be reduced when the correct
    road cannot be found, particularly in places
    where there are many roads.

    Enter in the road displayed on
    the screen with an accuracy of
    approx. 1mm.
    Caution: Whenever possible,
    use detailed map for the correction.

    If the accuracy of location settings during
    correction is poor, accuracy may be reduced afterwards.

    Perform direction correction.

    Position correction accuracy

    How to correct location

    SEL701V

    Direction when location is corrected

    SEL702V

    Location Correction by Map-Matching is Slow
    • The map-matching function needs to refer to the data of the surrounding area. It is necessary to drive some
    distance for the function to work.
    • Because map-matching operates on this principle, when there are many roads running in similar directions
    in the surrounding area, no matching determination may be made. The location may not be corrected until
    some special feature is found.
    Name of Road is Not Displayed
    The current road name may not be displayed if there are no road names displayed on the map screen.
    Contents of Display Differ for Birdview™ and the (Flat) Map Screen
    Difference of the BIRDVIEW™ screen from the flat map screen are as follows.
    • The current place name displays names which are primarily in the direction of vehicle travel.
    • The amount of time before the vehicle travel or turn angle is updated on the screen is longer than for the
    (flat) map display.
    • The conditions for display of place names, roads, and other data are different for nearby areas and for more
    distant areas.
    • Some thinning of the character data is done to prevent the display becoming too complex. In some cases
    and in some locations, the display contents may differ.
    • The same place name, street name, etc. may be displayed multiple times.
    Vehicle Mark Shows a Position Which is Completely Wrong
    In the following cases, the vehicle mark may appear on completely different position in the map depending on
    the GPS satellite signal receiving conditions. In this case, perform location correction and direction correction.
    • When location correction has not been done
    — If the receiving conditions of the GPS satellite signal is poor, if the vehicle mark becomes out of place, it may
    move to a completely different location and not come back if location correction is not done. The position will
    be corrected if the GPS signal can be received.
    • When the vehicle has traveled by ferry, or when the vehicle has been being towed

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-176

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [NAVIGATION]
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    — Because calculation of the current location cannot be done when traveling with the ignition off, for example
    when traveling by ferry or when being towed, the location before travel is displayed. If the precise location
    can be detected with GPS, the location will be corrected.
    Vehicle Mark Jumps
    In the following cases, the vehicle mark may appear to jump as a result of automatic correction of the current
    location.
    • When map matching has been done
    — If the current location and the vehicle mark are different when map matching is done, the vehicle mark may
    seem to jump. At this time, the location may be “corrected” to the wrong road or to a location which is not on
    a road.
    • When GPS location correction has been done
    — If the current location and the vehicle mark are different when the location is corrected using GPS measurements, the vehicle mark may seem to jump. At this time, the location may be “corrected” to a location which
    is not on a road.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    Vehicle Mark is in a River or Sea
    The navigation system moves the vehicle mark with no distinction between land and rivers or sea. If the vehicle mark is somehow out of place, it may appear that the vehicle is driving in a river or the sea.

    E

    Vehicle Mark Automatically Rotates
    The system wrongly memorizes the rotating status as stopping when the ignition switch is turned ON with the
    turntable rotating. That causes the vehicle mark to rotate when the vehicle is stopped.

    F

    When Driving on Same Road, Sometimes Vehicle Mark is in Right Place and Sometimes it is in Wrong Place
    The conditions of the GPS antenna (GPS data) and gyroscope (angular speed sensor) change gradually.
    Depending on the road traveled and the operation of the steering wheel, the location detection results will be
    different. Therefore, even on a road on which the location has never been wrong, conditions may cause the
    vehicle mark to deviate.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-177

    2014 Note

    AV CONTROL UNIT
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    AV CONTROL UNIT
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640348

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Perform read configuration using CONSULT. Refer to AV-135, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) :
    Description».
    Remove the battery negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the AV control unit screws (A) and partially remove the
    AV control unit (1).

    AWNIA3071ZZ

    AWNIA3072ZZ

    5.
    6.

    Disconnect the harness connectors from the AV control unit and remove.
    Remove the AV control unit bracket screws (A) and the AV control unit bracket (1) from each side of the AV control unit (if necessary).

    AWNIA3073ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    Perform AV control unit configuration after replacement. Refer to AV-135, «CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
    UNIT) : Work Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-178

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DOOR SPEAKER

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640349

    REMOVAL

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    C

    Remove the front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from front door speaker.
    Remove the front door speaker screws (A).
    Remove the front door speaker (1).

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3062ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-179

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DOOR SPEAKER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640350

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the rear door speaker.
    Remove the rear door speaker screws (A).
    Remove the rear door speaker (1).

    AWNIA3089ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-180

    2014 Note

    USB INTERFACE
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    USB INTERFACE

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640351

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    B

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Release the pawls (A) from the back of the center console
    assembly (2) using a suitable tool and remove the USB interface
    (1).

    C

    D

    E

    AWNIA3069ZZ

    F

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-181

    2014 Note

    AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009647057

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Release the pawls (A) from the back of the center console
    assembly (2) using a suitable tool and remove the auxiliary input
    jack (1).

    AWNIA3069ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-182

    2014 Note

    STEERING SWITCH
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    STEERING SWITCH

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640352

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    B

    Remove the steering wheel. Refer to ST-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the steering wheel rear finisher (1) by releasing pawls
    (A).

    C

    D

    E

    AWNIA3063ZZ

    3.

    Remove the steering wheel audio control switch screws (A) from
    the back of the steering wheel.

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWNIA3064ZZ

    4.

    J

    Remove the steering wheel audio control switches from the steering wheel.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-183

    2014 Note

    MICROPHONE
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    MICROPHONE
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640353

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the microphone from the headlining by releasing pawls using a suitable tool.
    Disconnect the harness connector from microphone and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-184

    2014 Note

    REAR VIEW CAMERA
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR VIEW CAMERA

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640356

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove the back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-34, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from rear view camera.
    Remove the nuts (A) from the rear view camera and remove.

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3070ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    AV

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-185

    2014 Note

    GPS ANTENNA
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    GPS ANTENNA
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009640358

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the AV control unit in order to disconnect the GPS antenna harness connector. Refer to AV-178,
    «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the GPS antenna screw (A) from the GPS antenna.
    Disconnect the harness clip (B) and remove the GPS antenna.

    AWNIA3076ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-186

    2014 Note

    ROD ANTENNA
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ROD ANTENNA

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009667932

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWNIA3124ZZ

    1. Antenna rod

    2. Antenna base

    G

    A. Antenna nut

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009667933

    H

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Lower the rear portion of the headlining. Refer to INT-29, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the antenna (satellite radio model shown).
    Remove the antenna nut (A) and remove the antenna.

    I

    J

    K

    L
    AWNIA3115ZZ

    M

    INSTALLATION

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    AV
    If the antenna nut is tightened looser than the specified torque this will lower the sensitivity of the
    antenna. If the antenna nut is tightened tighter than the specified torque this will deform the roof
    panel.
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-187

    2014 Note

    ANTENNA FEEDER
    [NAVIGATION]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ANTENNA FEEDER
    Feeder Layout

    INFOID:0000000009460322

    AWNIA3114ZZ

    1.

    Antenna base (antenna amp.)

    2.

    Rod Antenna

    4.

    M67, M350

    5.

    M73

    Revision: April 2013

    AV-188

    3.

    M351

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL & POWER CONTROL

    SECTION

    BCS

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    DOOR LOCK : CONSULT Function (BCM DOOR LOCK) ………………………………………………….17

    F

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3

    REAR DEFOGGER …………………………………………….17
    REAR DEFOGGER : CONSULT Function (BCM REAR DEFOGGER) …………………………………………17

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4

    BUZZER ……………………………………………………………18
    BUZZER : CONSULT Function (BCM — BUZZER)….18

    H

    INT LAMP ………………………………………………………….18
    INT LAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — INT
    LAMP) …………………………………………………………….18

    I

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM …………………………………. 4
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts
    Location …………………………………………………………… 4
    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM ……… 4
    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM :
    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 4

    HEADLAMP ………………………………………………………19
    HEADLAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — HEAD
    LAMP) …………………………………………………………….19

    G

    J

    K

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 5

    WIPER ………………………………………………………………20
    WIPER : CONSULT Function (BCM — WIPER) …….20

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM …………………………………. 5
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description…… 5
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail-safe ………………… 6

    FLASHER ………………………………………………………….20
    FLASHER : CONSULT Function (BCM — FLASHER) ………………………………………………………………..21

    L

    COMBINATION SWITCH READING SYSTEM ……….. 7
    COMBINATION SWITCH READING SYSTEM :
    System Description …………………………………………… 7

    AIR CONDITIONER ……………………………………………21
    AIR CONDITIONER : CONSULT Function (BCM AIR CONDITIONER) ………………………………………..21

    BCS

    SIGNAL BUFFER SYSTEM ……………………………….. 12
    SIGNAL BUFFER SYSTEM : System Description…. 13

    INTELLIGENT KEY …………………………………………….21
    INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM INTELLIGENT KEY) …………………………………………21

    N

    COMB SW …………………………………………………………23
    COMB SW : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMB
    SW) ………………………………………………………………..23

    O

    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM ……. 13
    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM :
    System Description …………………………………………. 13

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….16
    COMMON ITEM ………………………………………………… 16
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) …………………………………………….. 16
    DOOR LOCK ……………………………………………………. 16

    Revision: April 2013

    BCM …………………………………………………………………24
    BCM : CONSULT Function (BCM — BCM) ……………24
    IMMU ………………………………………………………………..24
    IMMU : CONSULT Function (BCM — IMMU) …………24
    BATTERY SAVER ……………………………………………..25

    BCS-1

    2014 Note

    P

    BATTERY SAVER : CONSULT Function (BCM BATTERY SAVER) …………………………………………. 25

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS …………………… 57

    THEFT ALM …………………………………………………….. 26
    THEFT ALM : CONSULT Function (BCM THEFT) …………………………………………………………. 26

    Description …………………………………………………….. 57
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 57
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 57

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ………………………. 57

    RETAINED PWR ………………………………………………. 26
    RETAINED PWR : CONSULT Function (BCM RETAINED PWR) …………………………………………… 26

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ……………………. 58

    SIGNAL BUFFER ……………………………………………… 27
    SIGNAL BUFFER : CONSULT Function (BCM SIGNAL BUFFER) ………………………………………….. 27

    U0415 VEHICLE SPEED …………………………….. 59

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 58
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 58
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 59
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 59

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 28

    B2562 LOW VOLTAGE ………………………………. 60

    BCM …………………………………………………………. 28

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 60
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 60

    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 28
    Fail-safe ………………………………………………………… 44
    DTC Inspection Priority Chart ………………………… 46
    DTC Index …………………………………………………….. 46

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………. 48
    BCM …………………………………………………………. 48
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 48

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ….. 61
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 61

    COMBINATION SWITCH INPUT CIRCUIT ……. 62
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 62

    COMBINATION SWITCH OUTPUT CIRCUIT … 64
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 64

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 54

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 66

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT ………………. 54

    COMBINATION SWITCH SYSTEM SYMPTOMS ……………………………………………………….. 66

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
    CONTROL UNIT (BCM) …………………………………….. 54
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
    CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Description ……………….. 54
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
    CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Work Procedure ………… 54
    CONFIGURATION (BCM) ………………………………….. 55
    CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Description …………….. 55
    CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Work Procedure ……… 55
    CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Configuration list …….. 56

    Revision: April 2013

    Symptom Table ………………………………………………. 66

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ………….. 67
    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE) ……………… 67
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 67

    COMBINATION SWITCH ……………………………. 68
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 68

    BCS-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009447002

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-3

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009567507

    AWMIA1424ZZ

    1.

    BCM

    A.

    View with instrument panel removed

    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM
    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location
    INFOID:0000000009567509

    AWMIA1437ZZ

    1

    Combination meter
    2
    Refer to MWI-5, «METER SYSTEM :
    Component Parts Location».

    Revision: April 2013

    IPDM E/R
    Refer to PCS-4, «Component Parts
    Location».

    BCS-4

    3

    BCM
    Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL
    SYSTEM : Component Parts Location».

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009567510

    B

    OUTLINE
    • BCM (Body Control Module) controls the various electrical components. It inputs the information required to
    the control from CAN communication and the signal received from each switch and sensor.
    • BCM has combination switch reading function for reading the operation status of combination switches (light,
    turn signal, wiper and washer) in addition to a function for controlling the operation of various electrical components. It also has the signal transmission function as the passed point of signal and the power saving control function that reduces the power consumption with the ignition switch OFF.
    • BCM is equipped with the diagnosis function that performs the diagnosis with CONSULT and various settings.

    BCM CONTROL FUNCTION LIST
    System

    Reference

    Combination switch reading system
    Signal buffer system

    BCS-13, «SIGNAL BUFFER SYSTEM : System Description»

    Power consumption control system

    BCS-13, «POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM :
    System Description»

    Headlamp system

    EXL-8, «HEADLAMP SYSTEM : System Description»

    Daytime light system

    EXL-9, «DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : System Description»

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamp system

    EXL-10, «TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMP
    SYSTEM : System Description»

    Parking, license plate and tail lamps system

    EXL-10, «PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND
    TAIL LAMP SYSTEM : System Description»

    Front fog lamp system

    EXL-12, «FRONT FOG LAMP SYSTEM : System Description»

    Exterior lamp battery saver system

    EXL-13, «EXTERIOR LAMP BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM :
    System Description»

    Interior room lamp control system

    INL-7, «INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description»

    Interior room lamp battery saver system

    INL-7, «INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description»

    Front wiper and washer system

    WW-8, «FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System
    Description»

    Rear wiper and washer system

    WW-11, «REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System
    Description»

    Rear window defogger system

    DEF-5, «System Description»

    Manual air conditioning system

    HAC-13, «System Description»

    Warning chime system

    WCS-5, «WARNING CHIME SYSTEM : System Description»

    Power door lock system

    DLK-17, «System Description»

    Nissan vehicle immobilizer system (NVIS)

    SEC-13, «NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM : System Description»

    Vehicle security system

    SEC-15, «VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM : System Description»

    BCS-5

    D

    E

    F

    BCS-7, «COMBINATION SWITCH READING SYSTEM :
    System Description»

    Revision: April 2013

    C

    2014 Note

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    System

    Intelligent Key system/engine start system

    Reference
    Door lock function

    DLK-20, «DOOR LOCK FUNCTION : System Description»

    Warning function

    DLK-24, «WARNING FUNCTION : System Description»

    Key reminder function

    DLK-24, «KEY REMINDER FUNCTION : System Description»

    Engine start function

    SEC-10, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START
    FUNCTION : System Description»

    Power window system

    PWC-7, «System Description»

    RAP (retained accessory power) system

    BCS-26, «RETAINED PWR : CONSULT Function (BCM — RETAINED PWR)»

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009654074

    BCM performs fail-safe control when the following DTCs are detected.
    CONSULT Display

    Fail-safe

    Cancellation

    B2192: ID DISCORD BCM-ECM

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Erase DTC

    B2193: CHAIN OF BCM-ECM

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Erase DTC

    B2195: ANTI SCANNING

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Ignition switch ON → OFF

    B2198: NATS ANTENNA AMP

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Erase DTC

    B2557: VEHICLE SPEED

    When the following CAN signal status (vehicle speed signal) becomes
    consistent
    • Vehicle speed signal (ABS)
    • Vehicle speed signal (Meter)

    B2601: SHIFT P SIGNAL

    500 ms after the following signal reception status becomes consistent
    • Park position switch signal
    • P range signal (CAN)

    5 seconds after the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch is in the ON position
    • Park position switch signal: P position (push selector button) or except P position (9 – 16 V)
    • Vehicle speed: 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or more

    500 ms after any of the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Status 1
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — Park position switch signal: P position (push selector button) or except P position (9 – 16 V)
    — P/N position signal: Except P and N positions (0 – 1.5 V)
    • Status 2
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — Park position switch signal: P position (release selector button) (0 –
    1.5 V)
    — P/N position signal: P or N positions (9 – 16 V)

    500 ms after any of the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Status 1
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: P or N position (9 – 16 V)
    — Shift position signal (CAN): P or N position
    • Status 2
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: Except P and N positions (0 – 1.5 V)
    — Shift position signal (CAN): Except P and N position

    B2602: SHIFT P DIAG

    B2603: SHIFT POSITION

    B2604: SHIFT PN DIAG CAN

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-6

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    CONSULT Display

    B2605: SHIFT PN DIAG IPDM

    Fail-safe

    Cancellation

    500 ms after any of the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Status 1
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: Except P and N positions (0 – 1.5 V)
    • Status 2
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: P or N position (9 – 16 V)

    A

    B

    C

    Inhibit engine cranking

    500 ms after the following signal communication status becomes consistent
    • Starter motor relay control signal
    • Starter relay status signal (CAN)

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When any of the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch changes to ACC
    • Receives engine status signal (CAN)

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): ON
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): ON

    B26F2: IGN RELAY ON

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): OFF
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): OFF

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): OFF
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): OFF

    G

    B26F3: START CONT RLY ON

    B26F4: START CONT RLY OFF

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): ON
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): ON

    H

    B26F7: BCM

    Inhibit engine cranking
    by Intelligent Key system

    When room antenna and luggage room antenna functions normally

    B2608: STARTER RELAY

    B260F: ECM CAN COMM

    B26F1: IGN RELAY OFF

    U0415: VDC CAN CIR2

    When vehicle speed signal (Meter) (CAN) is received normally

    COMBINATION SWITCH READING SYSTEM
    COMBINATION SWITCH READING SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009567512

    D

    E

    F

    I

    J

    K

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    Combination Switch Circuit (With Variable Intermittent Wipers)

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    AWMIA1427GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-7

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Combination Switch Circuit (Without Variable Intermittent Wipers)

    AWMIA1428GB

    OUTLINE
    • BCM reads the status of the combination switch (light, turn signal, wiper and washer) and recognizes the
    status of each switch.
    • BCM has a combination of 5 output terminals (OUTPUT 1 — 5) and 5 input terminals (INPUT 1 — 5). It reads a
    maximum of 20 switch states.

    COMBINATION SWITCH MATRIX (WITH VARIABLE INTERMITTENT WIPERS)
    Combination switch circuit (With Variable Intermittent Wipers)

    AWMIA1429GB

    Combination switch INPUT-OUTPUT system list

    System

    INPUT 1

    INPUT 2

    INPUT 3

    INPUT 4

    INPUT 5

    OUTPUT 1

    FR WASHER

    FR WIPER LOW

    TURN LH

    TURN RH

    OUTPUT 2

    FR WIPER HI

    FR WIPER INT

    PASSING

    HEADLAMP 1

    OUTPUT 3

    INT VOLUME 1

    RR WASHER

    HEADLAMP 2

    HI BEAM

    OUTPUT 4

    RR WIPER INT

    INT VOLUME 3

    TAIL LAMP

    OUTPUT 5

    INT VOLUME 2

    RR WIPER ON

    FR FOG

    COMBINATION SWITCH MATRIX (WITHOUT VARIABLE INTERMITTENT WIPERS)

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-8

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Combination Switch Circuit (Without Variable Intermittent Wipers)
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    AWMIA1430GB

    F

    Combination switch INPUT-OUTPUT system list

    System

    INPUT 1

    INPUT 2

    INPUT 3

    INPUT 4

    INPUT 5

    OUTPUT 1

    FR WASHER

    FR WIPER LOW

    TURN LH

    TURN RH

    OUTPUT 2

    FR WIPER HI

    FR WIPER INT

    PASSING

    HEADLAMP 1

    OUTPUT 3

    HEADLAMP 2

    HI BEAM

    OUTPUT 4

    TAIL LAMP

    OUTPUT 5

    G

    H

    I

    COMBINATION SWITCH READING FUNCTION
    Description
    • BCM reads the status of the combination switch at 10 ms intervals normally.

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    JPMIA0609GB

    NOTE:
    BCM reads the status of the combination switch at 60 ms intervals when BCM is controlled at low power
    consumption control mode.
    • BCM operates as follows and judges the status of the combination switch.
    — It operates the transistor on OUTPUT side in the following order: OUTPUT 1 → 2 → 3 → 4 → 5, and outputs
    voltage waveform.
    — The voltage waveform of OUTPUT corresponding to the formed circuit is input into the interface on INPUT
    side if any (1 or more) switches are ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-9

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    — It reads this change of the voltage as the status signal of the combination switch.

    JMMIA0326GB

    Operation Example
    In the following operation example, the combination of the status signals of the combination switch is replaced
    as follows: INPUT 1 — 5 to “1 — 5” and OUTPUT 1 — 5 to “A — E”.
    Example 1: When a switch (TAIL LAMP) is turned ON

    • The circuit between OUTPUT 4 and INPUT 5 is formed when the TAIL LAMP switch is turned ON.

    Combination switch circuit (With Variable Intermittent Wipers)

    AWMIA1431GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-10

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Combination switch circuit (Without Variable Intermittent Wipers)
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    AWMIA1432GB

    • BCM detects the combination switch status signal “5D” when the signal of OUTPUT 4 is input to INPUT 5.
    • BCM judges that the TAIL LAMP switch is ON when the signal “5D” is detected.

    F

    G

    Example 2: When some switches (TURN RH, TAIL LAMP) are turned ON

    • The circuits between OUTPUT 1 and INPUT 5 and between OUTPUT 4 and INPUT 5 are formed when the
    TURN RH switch and TAIL LAMP switch are turned ON.
    H

    Combination switch circuit (With Variable Intermittent Wipers)

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS
    AWMIA1433GB

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-11

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Combination switch circuit (Without Variable Intermittent Wipers)

    AWMIA1434GB

    • BCM detects the combination switch status signal “5AD” when the signals of OUTPUT 1 and OUTPUT 4 are
    input to INPUT 5.
    • BCM judges that the TURN RH switch and TAIL LAMP switch are ON when the signal “5AD” is detected.

    WIPER INTERMITTENT DIAL POSITION (WITH VARIABLE INTERMITTENT WIPERS)
    BCM judges the wiper intermittent dial 1 — 7 by the status of INT VOLUME 1, 2 and 3 switches.
    Switch status

    Wiper intermittent
    dial position

    INT VOLUME 1

    INT VOLUME 2

    INT VOLUME 3

    1

    ON

    ON

    ON

    2

    ON

    ON

    OFF

    3

    ON

    OFF

    OFF

    4

    OFF

    OFF

    OFF

    5

    OFF

    OFF

    ON

    6

    OFF

    ON

    ON

    7

    OFF

    ON

    OFF

    NOTE:
    For details of wiper intermittent dial position, refer to WW-8, «FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Description».

    SIGNAL BUFFER SYSTEM

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-12

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SIGNAL BUFFER SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009567514

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    B

    C

    D

    E

    AWMIA1275GB

    F

    OUTLINE
    BCM has the signal transmission function that outputs/transmits each input/received signal to each unit.

    Signal transmission function list
    Signal name

    Input

    Output

    Description

    • Ignition switch ON signal
    • Ignition switch signal

    Engine switch (push switch)

    IPDM E/R (CAN)

    Inputs the push-button ignition
    switch (push switch) signal and
    transmits the ignition switch status judged with BCM via CAN
    communication.

    Door switch signal

    Any door switch

    • Combination meter (CAN)
    • IPDM E/R (CAN)

    Inputs the door switch signal
    and transmits it via CAN communication.

    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM
    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009567516

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P
    ALCIA0030GB

    OUTLINE
    • BCM incorporates a power saving control function that reduces the power consumption according to the
    vehicle status.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-13

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • BCM switches the status (control mode) by itself with the power saving control function. It performs the sleep
    request to each unit (IPDM E/R and combination meter) that operates with the ignition switch OFF.
    Normal mode (wake-up)

    — CAN communication is normally performed with other units
    — Each control with BCM is operating properly
    CAN communication sleep mode (CAN sleep)

    — CAN transmission is stopped
    — Control with BCM only is operating

    Low power consumption mode (BCM sleep)

    — Low power consumption control is active
    — CAN transmission is stopped

    LOW POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL WITH BCM
    BCM reduces the power consumption with the following operation in the low power consumption mode.
    • The reading interval of each switch changes from 10 ms interval to 60 ms interval.

    Sleep mode activation
    • BCM receives the sleep-ready signal (ready) from IPDM E/R and combination meter via CAN communication.
    • BCM transmits the sleep wake up signal (sleep) to each unit when all of the CAN sleep conditions are fulfilled.
    • Each unit stops the transmission of CAN communication with the sleep wakeup signal. BCM is in CAN communication sleep mode.
    • BCM is in the low power consumption mode and performs the low power consumption control when all of the
    BCM sleep conditions are fulfilled with CAN sleep condition.
    Sleep condition

    CAN sleep condition












    Receiving the sleep-ready signal (ready) from all units
    Ignition switch: OFF
    Vehicle security system alarm: No operation
    Warning lamp: Not operation
    Intelligent Key system buzzer: No operation
    Brake switch: OFF
    Turn signal indicator lamp: No operation
    Exterior lamp: OFF
    Door lock status: No change
    CONSULT communication status: No communication
    Meter display signal: Non-transmission
    Door switch status: No change
    Rear window defogger: OFF

    BCM sleep condition





    Interior room lamp battery saver: Time out
    RAP system: OFF
    Push-button ignition switch (push switch) illumination: OFF
    NATS: No operation
    Remote keyless entry receiver communication status: No communication

    Wake-up operation
    • BCM changes from the low power consumption mode to the CAN communication sleep mode when the any
    of the BCM wake-up conditions are fulfilled. Only the control with BCM is activated.
    • BCM transmits the sleep wake up signal (wake up) to each unit when any of the CAN wake-up conditions
    are fulfilled. It changes from the low power consumption mode or the CAN communication sleep mode to the
    normal mode.
    • Each unit starts the transmission of CAN communication with the sleep wake up signal. In addition, the combination meter transmits the wake up signal to BCM via CAN communication to report the CAN communication start.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-14

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    BCM wake-up condition




    CAN wake-up condition

    Door lock assembly LH (key cylinder switch): Lock or unlock
    Door lock switch: OFF→ON
    Door unlock switch: OFF→ON
    Remote keyless entry receiver: Receiving valid keyfob











    Receiving the sleep-ready signal (Not-ready) from any units
    Push-button ignition switch (push switch): OFF→ON
    Hazard switch: OFF→ON
    PASSING switch: OFF→ON, ON→OFF
    TAIL LAMP switch: OFF→ON
    Driver door switch: OFF→ON, ON→OFF
    Passenger door switch: OFF → ON, ON → OFF
    Driver door request switch: OFF→ON
    Passenger door request switch: OFF→ON
    Stop lamp switch 2 signal: ON
    Remote keyless entry receiver: Receiving valid keyfob

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-15

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009567517

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    DOOR LOCK

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-16

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DOOR LOCK : CONSULT Function (BCM — DOOR LOCK)

    INFOID:0000000009567518

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]
    REQ SW-DR [On/Off]

    B

    Description
    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    REQ SW -BD/TR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door request switch.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    C

    D

    E

    CDL UNLOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    KEY CYL LK-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    KEY CYL UN-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    F

    G

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    DOOR LOCK

    Description

    H

    This test is able to check door lock operation [OTR ULK/AS UNLK/DR UNLK/ALL UNLK/ALL
    LOCK].

    WORK SUPPORT

    I

    Support Item
    DOOR LOCK-UNLOCK SET

    AUTOMATIC LOCK/UNLOCK
    SELECT

    AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK SELECT

    AUTOMATIC DOOR UNLOCK
    SELECT

    Setting

    Description

    J

    On*

    Automatic door locks function ON.

    Off

    Automatic door locks function OFF.

    Lock/Unlock*

    Automatic door locks function operates in lock and unlock.

    Lock Only

    Automatic door locks function operates in lock only.

    Unlock Only

    Automatic door locks function operates in unlock only.

    Off

    Automatic door locks function OFF.

    P RANGE

    Doors lock automatically when shifted out of Park (P).

    VH SPD*

    Doors lock automatically when vehicle speed reaches 24 km/h (15 mph).

    MODE6*

    Drivers door unlocks automatically when key is removed.

    MODE5

    Drivers door unlocks automatically when shifted into Park (P).

    MODE4

    Drivers door unlocks automatically when ignition is switched from ON to OFF.

    MODE3

    Doors unlock automatically when key is removed.

    K

    L

    MODE2

    Doors unlock automatically when shifted into Park (P).

    MODE1

    Doors unlock automatically when ignition is switched from ON to OFF.

    BCS

    N

    O

    *: Initial setting

    REAR DEFOGGER

    P

    REAR DEFOGGER : CONSULT Function (BCM — REAR DEFOGGER)

    INFOID:0000000009567519

    DATA MONITOR

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-17

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    REAR DEF SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear window defogger switch.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    REAR DEFOGGER

    Description
    This test is able to check rear window defogger operation [Off/On].

    BUZZER
    BUZZER : CONSULT Function (BCM — BUZZER)

    INFOID:0000000009567520

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    PUSH -SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    VEH SPEED 1 [km/h]

    Indicates vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    TAIL LAMP SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of combination switch.

    FR FOG SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front fog lamp switch.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    LIGHT WARN ALM

    Description
    This test is able to check light warning chime operation [On/Off].

    INT LAMP
    INT LAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — INT LAMP)

    INFOID:0000000009567521

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    PUSH -SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    CDL UNLOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    KEY CYL LK-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    KEY CYL UN-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-18

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    ACTIVE TEST
    A
    Test Item
    INT LAMP

    Description
    This test is able to check interior room lamp operation [On/Off].

    B

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    R LAMP TIMER LOGIC SET

    SET I/L D-UNLCK INTCON

    ROOM LAMP TIMER SET

    Setting

    Description

    C

    MODE 2

    Interior room lamp timer activates with all doors.

    MODE 1*

    Interior room lamp timer activates with the driver door only.

    On*

    Interior room lamp timer function ON.

    Off

    D

    Interior room lamp timer function OFF.

    MODE 4

    30 sec.

    MODE 3*

    15 sec.

    MODE 2

    7.5 sec.

    Sets the interior room lamp ON time. (Timer operating time).

    E

    F

    *: Initial setting

    HEADLAMP
    HEADLAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — HEAD LAMP)

    INFOID:0000000009567522

    G

    DATA MONITOR
    H
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    ENGINE STATE [Stop/Stall/Crank/Run]

    Indicates engine status received from ECM on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 1 [km/h]

    Indicates vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    I

    TURN SIGNAL R [On/Off]

    J

    TURN SIGNAL L [On/Off]
    TAIL LAMP SW [On/Off]
    HI BEAM SW [On/Off]
    HEAD LAMP SW 1 [On/Off]

    K

    Indicates condition of combination switch.

    HEAD LAMP SW 2 [On/Off]

    L

    PASSING SW [On/Off]
    FR FOG SW [On/Off]
    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    BCS

    N

    ACTIVE TEST

    O

    Test Item

    Description

    P

    FR FOG LAMP

    This test is able to check front fog lamp operation [On/Off].

    HEAD LAMP

    This test is able to check head lamp operation [Hi/Low/Off].

    ILL DIM SIGNAL

    This test is able to check head lamp illumination dimming operation [On/Off].

    TAIL LAMP

    This test is able to check tail lamp operation [On/Off].

    WORK SUPPORT

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-19

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Support Item
    BATTERY SAVER SET

    ILL DELAY SET

    Setting

    Description

    On*

    Exterior lamp battery saver function ON.

    Off

    Exterior lamp battery saver function OFF.

    MODE 8

    180 sec.

    MODE 7

    150 sec.

    MODE 6

    120 sec.

    MODE 4

    60 sec.

    MODE 5

    90 sec.

    MODE 3

    30 sec.

    MODE 2

    OFF

    MODE 1*

    45 sec.

    Sets delay timer function operation time
    (All doors closed).

    *: Initial setting

    WIPER
    WIPER : CONSULT Function (BCM — WIPER)

    INFOID:0000000009567523

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    VEH SPEED 1 [km/h]

    Indicates vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    FR WIPER HI [On/Off]
    FR WIPER LOW [On/Off]
    FR WASHER SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of wiper operation of combination switch.

    FR WIPER INT [On/Off]
    FR WIPER STOP [On/Off]

    Indicates front wiper auto stop signal received from IPDM E/R on CAN communication
    line.

    INT VOLUME [1 − 7]

    Indicates condition of intermittent wiper operation of combination switch.

    RR WIPER ON [On/Off]
    RR WIPER INT [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear wiper operation of combination switch.

    RR WASHER SW [On/Off]
    RR WIPER STOP [On/Off]

    Indicates rear wiper motor auto stop input from rear wiper motor.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item

    Description

    FR WIPER

    This test is able to check front wiper operation [INT/Lo/Hi/Off].

    RR WIPER

    This test is able to check rear wiper operation [On/Off].

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    WIPER SPEED SETTING

    Setting

    Description

    On

    Front wiper intermittent time linked with vehicle speed and wiper dial position.

    Off*

    Front wiper intermittent time linked with wiper dial position.

    * : Initial setting

    FLASHER

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-20

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    FLASHER : CONSULT Function (BCM — FLASHER)

    INFOID:0000000009567524

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]
    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    TURN SIGNAL R [On/Off]
    TURN SIGNAL L [On/Off]

    B

    Description

    C

    D

    Indicates condition of turn signal function of combination switch.

    HAZARD SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of hazard switch.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    E

    ACTIVE TEST

    F

    Test Item
    FLASHER

    Description
    This test is able to check turn signal lamp operation [Off/LH/RH].

    G

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item

    H

    Setting

    Description

    Lock/Unlock*

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked or unlocked with
    Intelligent Key.

    Unlock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are unlocked with Intelligent
    Key.

    Lock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked with Intelligent
    Key.

    Off

    No hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked or unlocked
    with Intelligent Key.

    HAZARD ANSWER BACK

    I

    J

    K

    * : Initial setting

    AIR CONDITIONER
    AIR CONDITIONER : CONSULT Function (BCM — AIR CONDITIONER)

    INFOID:0000000009567525

    L

    DATA MONITOR
    BCS
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    FAN ON SIG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of fan switch.

    AIR COND SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of A/C switch.

    N

    INTELLIGENT KEY
    INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)

    O
    INFOID:0000000009567526

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    P

    Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Main

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-21

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item [Unit]
    REQ SW -BD/TR [On/Off]

    Main
    ×

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Description
    Indicates condition of back door request switch.
    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    BRAKE SW 1 [On/Off]

    ×

    CLUTCH SW [On/Off]

    ×

    BRAKE SW 2 [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of brake switch.
    Indicates condition of clutch interlock switch.
    Indicates condition of brake switch.

    DETE/CANCL SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of P (park) position.

    SFT PN/N SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of P (park) or N (neutral) position.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    PUSH SW -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch received from IPDM E/R on
    CAN communication line.

    IGN RLY1 -F/B [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of ignition relay 1 received from IPDM E/R on CAN communication line.

    DETE SW -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of detent switch received from TCM on CAN communication
    line.

    SFT PN -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of P (park) or N (neutral) position from TCM on CAN communication line.

    SFT P -MET [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of P (park) position from TCM on CAN communication line.

    SFT N -MET [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of N (neutral) position from IPDM E/R on CAN communication line.

    ENGINE STATE [Stop/Start/Crank/Run]

    ×

    Indicates condition of engine state from ECM on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 1 [mph/km/h]

    ×

    Indicates condition of vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 2 [mph/km/h]

    ×

    Indicates condition of vehicle speed signal received from combination meter on
    CAN communication line.

    DOOR STAT -DR [LOCK/READY/UNLK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of driver side door status.

    DOOR STAT -AS [LOCK/READY/UNLK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of passenger side door status.

    ID OK FLAG [Set/Reset]

    Indicates condition of Intelligent Key ID.

    PRMT ENG STRT [Set/Reset]

    Indicates condition of engine start possibility.

    RKE OPE COUN1 [0-19]

    ×

    When remote keyless entry receiver receives the signal transmitted while operating on Intelligent Key, the numerical value start changing.

    RKE OPE COUN2 [0-19]

    ×

    When remote keyless entry receiver receives the signal transmitted while operating on Intelligent Key, the numerical value start changing.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-MODE CHG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of mode change signal from Intelligent Key.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item

    Description

    INSIDE BUZZER

    This test is able to check combination meter warning chime operation [Take Out/Knob/Key/
    Off].

    LCD

    This test is able to check combination meter display information [Off/LK WN/OUTKEY/NO
    KY/BATT/INSRT/SFT P/ROTAT/ID NG/B&P I/B&P N].

    BATTERY SAVER

    This test is able to check battery saver operation [On/Off].

    ENGINE SW ILLUMI

    This test is able to check push-button ignition switch START indicator operation [On/Off].

    PUSH SWITCH INDICATOR

    This test is able to check back door lock actuator operation [On/Off].

    INT LAMP

    This test is able to check interior room lamp operation [On/Off].

    INDICATOR

    This test is able to check combination meter warning lamp operation [KEY ON/KEY IND/Off].

    FLASHER

    This test is able to check hazard lamp operation [LH/RH/Off].

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-22

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Test Item

    Description

    OUTSIDE BUZZER

    This test is able to check Intelligent Key warning buzzer operation [On/Off].

    HORN

    This test is able to check horn operation [On].

    P RANGE

    This test is able to check CVT shift selector illumination operation [On/Off].

    A

    B

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY

    ANTI KEY LOCK IN FUNCTI

    ANS BACK I-KEY UNLOCK

    ANS BACK I-KEY LOCK

    HORN WITH KEYLESS LOCK

    Setting

    C

    Description

    On*

    Door lock/unlock function from Intelligent Key ON.

    Off

    Door lock/unlock function from Intelligent Key OFF.

    On*

    Anti lock out setting ON.

    Off

    Anti lock out setting OFF.

    Off

    No buzzer reminder when doors are unlocked with request switch.

    On*

    Buzzer reminder when doors are unlocked with request switch.

    Horn Chirp

    Horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Buzzer*

    Buzzer reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Off

    No reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Off

    Horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with Intelligent Key.

    On*

    No horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with Intelligent Key.

    Lock/Unlock*

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked/unlocked
    with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Unlock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are unlocked with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Lock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Off

    No hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked/unlocked
    with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    HAZARD ANSWER BACK

    D

    INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS

    This function allows inside key antenna self-diagnosis.

    CONFIRM KEY FOB ID

    Intelligent Key ID code can be checked.

    Start

    100 msec

    AUTO LOCK SET

    200 msec

    H

    I

    J

    L

    On*

    Intelligent Key low battery warning ON.

    Off

    Intelligent Key low battery warning OFF.

    MODE7

    5 min

    MODE6

    4 min

    MODE5

    3 min

    MODE4

    2 min

    MODE3*

    1 min

    MODE2

    30 sec

    MODE1

    Off

    BCS

    N
    Auto door lock time setting.

    O

    P

    *: Initial Setting

    COMB SW
    COMB SW : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMB SW)

    INFOID:0000000009567527

    DATA MONITOR
    Revision: April 2013

    G

    Starter motor operation duration time setting.

    End
    LO- BATT OF KEY FOB WARN

    F

    K

    70 msec
    SHORT CRANKING OUTPUT

    E

    BCS-23

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    FR WIPER HI [On/Off]
    FR WIPER LOW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of wiper operation of combination switch.

    FR WASHER SW [On/Off]
    FR WIPER INT [On/Off]
    INT VOLUME [1 — 7]

    Indicates condition of intermittent wiper operation of combination switch.

    RR WIPER ON [On/Off]
    RR WIPER INT [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear wiper operation of combination switch.

    RR WASHER SW [On/Off]
    TURN SIGNAL R [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of right turn signal operation of combination switch.

    TURN SIGNAL L [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of left turn signal operation of combination switch.

    TAIL LAMP SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of tail lamp switch operation of combination switch.

    HI BEAM SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of Hi beam switch operation of combination switch.

    HEAD LAMP SW 1 [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of head lamp switch 1 operation of combination switch.

    HEAD LAMP SW 2 [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of head lamp switch 2 operation of combination switch.

    PASSING SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of passing switch operation of combination switch.

    FR FOG SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front fog lamp switch operation of combination switch.

    BCM
    BCM : CONSULT Function (BCM — BCM)

    INFOID:0000000009567528

    ECU IDENTIFICATION
    The BCM part number is displayed.

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    RESET SETTING VALUE

    Setting

    Description

    Reset

    Returns BCM to initial value in factory shipment.

    Cancel

    Cancels the reset function.

    CONFIGURATION
    Refer to BCS-55, «CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Description».

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR
    Refer to LAN-11, «CAN Diagnosis with CONSULT».

    IMMU

    IMMU : CONSULT Function (BCM — IMMU)

    INFOID:0000000009567529

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-24

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    A

    CONFIRM ID ALL [Yet/DONE]
    CONFIRM ID4 [Yet/DONE]
    CONFIRM ID3 [Yet/DONE]

    B

    Switches to DONE when an Intelligent Key is registered.

    CONFIRM ID2 [Yet/DONE]
    CONFIRM ID1 [Yet/DONE]

    C

    TP 4 [Yet/DONE]
    TP 3 [Yet/DONE]
    TP 2 [Yet/DONE]

    DONE indicates the number of Intelligent Key ID which has been registered.

    D

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    E

    TP 1 [Yet/DONE]
    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    THEFT IND

    F

    Description
    This test is able to check security indicator operation [On/Off].

    BATTERY SAVER

    G

    BATTERY SAVER : CONSULT Function (BCM — BATTERY SAVER)

    INFOID:0000000009567530

    H

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    I

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    CDL UNLOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    KEY CYL LK-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    J

    K

    L

    KEY CYL UN-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    BCS

    N

    O

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test item
    BATTERY SAVER

    Description

    P

    This test is able to check battery saver operation [On/Off].

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    BATTERY SAVER SET

    Revision: April 2013

    Setting

    Description

    ON*

    Exterior lamp battery saver function ON.

    OFF

    Exterior lamp battery saver function OFF.

    BCS-25

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Support Item

    Setting

    ROOM LAMP TIMER SET

    Description

    MODE 3*

    10 min.

    MODE 2

    60 min.

    MODE 1

    15 min.

    Sets interior room lamp battery saver timer operating time.

    *: Initial setting

    THEFT ALM
    THEFT ALM : CONSULT Function (BCM — THEFT)

    INFOID:0000000009567532

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitored Item

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    REQ SW -BD/TR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door request switch.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    CDL UNLOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    KEY CYL LK-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    KEY CYL UN-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item

    Description

    VEHICLE SECURITY HORN

    This test is able to check vehicle security horn operation [On].

    FLASHER

    This test is able to check turn signal lamp operation [LH/RH/Off].

    THEFT IND

    This test is able to check security indicator lamp operation [On/Off].

    HEADLAMP(HI)

    This test is able to check vehicle security lamp operation [On].

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item

    Setting

    THEFT ALM TRG
    SECURITY ALARM SET

    Description
    Displays status of components that can trigger the theft alarm.

    On

    Security alarm ON.

    Off

    Security alarm OFF.

    RETAINED PWR
    RETAINED PWR : CONSULT Function (BCM — RETAINED PWR)

    INFOID:0000000009567533

    DATA MONITOR

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-26

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    A

    B

    SIGNAL BUFFER
    SIGNAL BUFFER : CONSULT Function (BCM — SIGNAL BUFFER)

    INFOID:0000000009567534

    C

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]
    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    D

    Description
    Indicates condition of the push-button ignition switch.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-27

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    BCM
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009567536

    VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL
    Monitor Item
    AIR COND SW

    BRAKE SW 1

    BRAKE SW2

    CDL LOCK SW

    CDL UNLOCK SW

    CONFRM ID ALL

    CONFIRM ID4

    CONFIRM ID3

    CONFIRM ID2

    CONFIRM ID1

    DETE SW -IPDM

    DETE/CANCL SW

    DOOR STAT-AS

    DOOR STAT-DR

    DOOR SW-AS

    DOOR SW-BK

    DOOR SW-DR

    DOOR SW-RL

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    Value/Status

    A/C switch OFF

    Off

    A/C switch ON

    On

    When the brake pedal is released

    On

    When the brake pedal is depressed

    Off

    Brake pedal released

    Off

    Brake pedal depressed

    On

    Door lock/unlock switch does not operate

    Off

    Press door lock/unlock switch to the LOCK side

    On

    Door lock/unlock switch does not operate

    Off

    Press door lock/unlock switch to the UNLOCK side

    On

    The key ID does not match any key ID registered to BCM.

    Yet

    The key ID matches any key ID registered to BCM.

    DONE

    The key ID does not match the fourth key ID registered to BCM.

    Yet

    The key ID matches the fourth key ID registered to BCM.

    DONE

    The key ID does not match the third key ID registered to BCM.

    Yet

    The key ID matches the third key ID registered to BCM.

    DONE

    The key ID does not match the second key ID registered to BCM.

    Yet

    The key ID matches the second key ID registered to BCM.

    DONE

    The key ID does not match the first key ID registered to BCM.

    Yet

    The key ID matches the first key ID registered to BCM.

    DONE

    When selector lever is in P position

    Off

    When selector lever is in any position other than P

    On

    When selector lever is in P position

    Off

    When selector lever is in any position other than P

    On

    Passenger door LOCK status

    LOCK

    Passenger door UNLOCK status

    UNLK

    Wait with selective UNLOCK operation (5 seconds)

    READY

    Driver door LOCK status

    LOCK

    Driver door UNLOCK status

    UNLK

    Wait with selective UNLOCK operation (5 seconds)

    READY

    Front door RH closed

    Off

    Front door RH opened

    On

    Back door closed

    Off

    Back door opened

    On

    Front door LH closed

    Off

    Front door LH opened

    On

    Rear door LH closed

    Off

    Rear door LH opened

    On

    BCS-28

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item
    DOOR SW-RR

    ENGINE STATE

    FAN ON SIG

    FR FOG SW

    FR WASHER SW

    FR WIPER LOW

    FR WIPER HI

    FR WIPER INT

    FR WIPER STOP

    HAZARD SW

    HEAD LAMP SW 1

    HEAD LAMP SW 2

    HI BEAM SW

    ID OK FLAG

    IGN RLY1 F/B
    INT VOLUME
    KEY CYL LK-SW

    KEY CYL UN-SW

    PASSING SW

    PRMT ENG STRT

    PUSH SW

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    Value/Status

    Rear door RH closed

    Off

    Rear door RH opened

    On

    Engine stopped

    Stop

    While the engine stalls

    Stall

    At engine cranking

    Crank

    Engine running

    Run

    Blower motor fan switch OFF

    Off

    Blower motor fan switch ON

    On

    Front fog lamp switch OFF

    Off

    Front fog lamp switch ON

    On

    Front washer switch OFF

    Off

    Front washer switch ON

    On

    Front wiper switch OFF

    Off

    Front wiper switch LO

    On

    Front wiper switch OFF

    Off

    Front wiper switch HI

    On

    Front wiper switch OFF

    Off

    Front wiper switch INT

    On

    Any position other than front wiper stop position

    Off

    Front wiper stop position

    On

    When hazard switch is not pressed

    Off

    When hazard switch is pressed

    On

    Headlamp switch OFF

    Off

    Headlamp switch 1st

    On

    Headlamp switch OFF

    Off

    Headlamp switch 1st

    On

    High beam switch OFF

    Off

    High beam switch HI

    On

    Ignition switch ACC or ON

    Reset

    Ignition switch OFF

    Set

    Ignition switch OFF or ACC

    Off

    Ignition switch ON

    On

    Wiper intermittent dial is in a dial position 1 — 7

    1-7

    Door key cylinder LOCK position

    Off

    Door key cylinder other than LOCK position

    On

    Door key cylinder UNLOCK position

    Off

    Door key cylinder other than UNLOCK position

    On

    Other than lighting switch PASS

    Off

    Lighting switch PASS

    On

    When the engine start is prohibited

    Reset

    When the engine start is permitted

    Set

    Return ignition switch to LOCK position

    Off

    Press ignition switch

    On

    BCS-29

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item
    PUSH SW-IPDM

    REAR DEF SW

    Condition

    Value/Status

    When engine switch (push switch) is not pressed

    Off

    When engine switch (push switch) is pressed

    On

    Rear window defogger switch OFF

    Off

    Rear window defogger switch ON

    On

    When passenger door request switch is not pressed

    Off

    When passenger door request switch is pressed

    On

    When back door request switch is not pressed

    Off

    When back door request switch is pressed

    On

    When driver door request switch is not pressed

    Off

    When driver door request switch is pressed

    On

    When LOCK button of Intelligent Key is not pressed

    Off

    When LOCK button of Intelligent Key is pressed

    On

    When LOCK/UNLOCK button of Intelligent Key is not pressed and
    held simultaneously

    Off

    When LOCK/UNLOCK button of Intelligent Key is pressed and held
    simultaneously

    On

    RKE OPE COUN1

    Operation frequency of Intelligent Key

    0-19

    RKE OPE COUN2

    Operation frequency of Intelligent Key

    0-19

    When UNLOCK button of Intelligent Key is not pressed

    Off

    When UNLOCK button of Intelligent Key is pressed

    On

    Rear washer switch OFF

    Off

    Rear washer switch ON

    On

    REQ SW-AS

    REQ SW-BD/TR

    REQ SW-DR

    RKE-LOCK

    RKE-MODE CHG

    RKE-UNLOCK

    RR WASHER SW

    RR WIPER INT

    RR WIPER ON

    RR WIPER STOP

    SFT N-MET

    SFT P-MET

    SFT PN -IPDM

    SFT PN/N SW

    TAIL LAMP SW

    TP 4

    TP 3

    TP 2

    Revision: April 2013

    Rear wiper switch OFF

    Off

    Rear wiper switch INT

    On

    Rear wiper switch OFF

    Off

    Rear wiper switch ON

    On

    Any position other than rear wiper stop position

    Off

    Rear wiper stop position

    On

    When selector lever is in any position other than N

    Off

    When selector lever is in N position

    On

    When selector lever is in any position other than P

    Off

    When selector lever is in P position

    On

    When selector lever is in any position other than P or N

    Off

    When selector lever is in P or N position

    On

    When selector lever is in any position other than P or N

    Off

    When selector lever is in P or N position

    On

    Other than lighting switch 1ST and 2ND

    Off

    Lighting switch 1ST or 2ND

    On

    The ID of fourth key is not registered to BCM

    Yet

    The ID of fourth key is registered to BCM

    DONE

    The ID of third key is not registered to BCM

    Yet

    The ID of third key is registered to BCM

    DONE

    The ID of second key is not registered to BCM

    Yet

    The ID of second key is registered to BCM

    DONE

    BCS-30

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item

    Condition

    Value/Status

    The ID of first key is not registered to BCM

    Yet

    The ID of first key is registered to BCM

    DONE

    Turn signal switch OFF

    Off

    Turn signal switch LH

    On

    Turn signal switch OFF

    Off

    Turn signal switch RH

    On

    Driver door UNLOCK status

    Off

    Driver door LOCK status

    On

    VEH SPEED 1

    While driving, equivalent to speedometer reading

    mph, km/h

    VEH SPEED 2

    While driving, equivalent to speedometer reading

    mph, km/h

    TP 1

    TURN SIGNAL L

    TURN SIGNAL R

    UNLK SEN-DR

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    JMMIA1063ZZ

    PHYSICAL VALUES

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-31

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    1
    (GR)

    Ground

    Description
    Signal name
    Rear window
    defogger relay
    control

    Condition

    Input/
    Output
    Input

    Rear window
    defogger switch

    Value
    (Approx.)

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    ON

    0 – 0.5 V

    OFF

    0V

    TURN RH
    HEADLAMP 1
    2
    (BR)

    Ground

    INPUT 5 signal

    Input

    Combination
    switch

    HI BEAM

    TAIL LAMP
    PKIB4958J

    1.0 V
    OFF

    0V

    TURN LH
    PASSING
    3
    (Y)

    Ground

    INPUT 4 signal

    Input

    Combination
    switch

    HEADLAMP 2

    FR FOG
    PKIB4958J

    1.0 V
    OFF

    0V

    FR WIPER LO

    4
    (L)

    Ground

    INPUT 3 signal

    Input

    Combination
    switch

    FR WIPER INT
    (any intermittent position)
    PKIB4958J

    1.0 V
    OFF

    0V

    FR WASHER
    Wiper intermittent dial 1
    5
    (G)

    Ground

    INPUT 2 signal

    Input

    Combination
    switch

    Wiper intermittent dial 5

    Wiper intermittent dial 6
    PKIB4958J

    1.0 V
    OFF

    0V

    FR WIPER HI
    Wiper intermittent dial 1
    6
    (R)

    Ground

    INPUT 1 signal

    Input

    Combination
    switch

    Wiper intermittent dial 2
    Wiper intermittent dial 3
    Wiper intermittent dial 6
    Wiper intermittent dial 7

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-32

    PKIB4958J

    1.0 V

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Value
    (Approx.)

    A

    B

    7
    (W)

    Ground

    Key cylinder unlock
    sw signal

    Input

    Key cylinder
    switch

    N position

    C

    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    UNLOCK position

    D

    0V

    E

    8
    (GR)

    Ground

    Key cylinder lock sw
    signal

    Input

    Key cylinder
    switch

    N position

    F

    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V

    9
    (LG)

    Ground

    Stop lamp switch 1

    Input

    Stop lamp
    switch

    LOCK position

    0V

    OFF (Brake pedal
    released)

    0V

    ON (Brake pedal
    depressed)

    Battery voltage

    G

    H

    I

    J
    12
    (GR)

    Ground

    Central door lock sw
    signal

    Input

    Door lock and
    unlock switch

    NEUTRAL position

    K
    JPMIA0012GB

    1.0 — 1.5 V
    LOCK position

    0V

    L

    BCS
    13
    (BR)

    Ground

    Central door unlock
    sw signal

    Input

    Door lock and
    unlock switch

    NEUTRAL position

    N
    JPMIA0012GB

    1.0 — 1.5 V
    UNLOCK position

    0V

    O

    P
    15
    (G)

    Ground

    Rear defogger
    switch signal

    Input

    Rear window
    defogger switch

    Not pressed

    JPMIA0012GB

    1.0 — 1.5 V
    Pressed

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-33

    0V

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)

    Description
    Signal name

    +

    18
    (V)

    Ground

    Keyless tuner
    ground

    19
    (LG)

    Ground

    Keyless tuner power
    supply

    Condition

    Input/
    Output
    Input

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Value
    (Approx.)
    0V

    Push-button ignition switch OFF

    JMKIA3838GB

    Push-button ignition switch ACC or ON

    5V

    Waiting

    20
    (G)

    Ground

    Keyless tuner signal

    Input

    Push-button ignition switch
    OFF

    JMKIA3838GB

    When operating either
    button on Intelligent Key

    JMKIA3841GB

    21
    (P)

    Ground

    Immobilizer one way
    communication
    (CLOCK) signal

    Input/
    Output

    Intelligent Key
    battery is removed

    Brake pedal depressed
    NOTE:
    Waveform varies each
    time when brake pedal is
    depressed
    JMKIA6232JP

    Brake pedal released

    Battery voltage

    Waiting

    22
    (W)

    Ground

    Keyless tuner RSSI
    signal

    Input

    Push-button ignition switch
    OFF

    JMKIA5952GB

    When pressing and holding either button on Intelligent Key

    JMKIA5953GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-34

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    ON

    23
    (R/Y)

    Ground

    Security indicator
    output

    Output

    Security indicator lamp

    Value
    (Approx.)

    A

    0 – 0.5 V

    B

    C

    Blinking (push-button ignition switch OFF)

    D
    JPMIA0590GB

    12.0 V
    OFF

    25
    (LG)

    Ground

    Immobilizer two way
    communication signal

    Input/
    Output

    During waiting

    Battery voltage

    Brake pedal depressed
    NOTE:
    Waveform varies each
    time when brake pedal is
    depressed

    E

    F

    G
    JMKIA6233JP

    27
    (W)

    Ground

    Air con sw signal

    Input

    Push-button ignition switch ON
    and blower fan
    switch ON

    Brake pedal released

    Battery voltage

    A/C switch OFF

    Battery voltage

    A/C switch ON

    0V

    OFF

    0V

    H

    I

    J
    28
    (SB)

    Ground

    Blower fan sw signal

    Input

    Fan switch

    ON

    K
    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    29
    (O)

    Ground

    Hazard sw signal

    Input

    Hazard switch

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    ON

    0 – 1.5 V

    L

    BCS

    31
    (Y)

    Ground

    Driver door lock status

    Input

    Front door LH

    N

    LOCK status

    JPMIA0011GB

    O

    11.8V
    UNLOCK status

    0V

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-35

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Value
    (Approx.)

    OFF

    PKIB4960J

    32
    (P)

    Ground

    OUTPUT 5

    Output

    Combination
    switch

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    FR FOG
    Wiper intermittent dial 1
    Wiper intermittent dial 2
    Wiper intermittent dial 6
    Wiper intermittent dial 7

    PKIB4956J

    1.0 V

    OFF

    PKIB4960J

    33
    (V)

    Ground

    OUTPUT 4

    Output

    Combination
    switch

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    TAIL LAMP
    Wiper intermittent dial 1
    Wiper intermittent dial 5

    Wiper intermittent dial 6
    PKIB4958J

    1.2 V

    OFF

    PKIB4960J

    34
    (W)

    Ground

    OUTPUT 3

    Output

    Combination
    switch

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    HEADLAMP 2
    HI BEAM
    Wiper intermittent dial 1
    Wiper intermittent dial 2
    Wiper intermittent dial 3

    PKIB4958J

    1.2 V

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-36

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Value
    (Approx.)

    A

    B

    OFF

    C

    PKIB4960J

    35
    (GR)

    Ground

    OUTPUT 2

    Output

    Combination
    switch

    7.0 — 8.0 V

    D

    HEADLAMP 1
    PASSING

    E

    FR WIPER HI

    F

    FR WIPER INT
    (any intermittent position)
    PKIB4958J

    1.2 V

    G

    H

    OFF

    PKIB4960J

    36
    (LG)

    Ground

    OUTPUT 1

    Output

    Combination
    switch

    I

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    TURN RH

    J

    TURN LH
    FR WIPER LO

    K
    FR WASHER
    PKIB4958J

    1.2 V
    P (Park) position

    0 – 1.5 V

    37
    (R)

    Ground

    Park position switch
    signal

    39
    (L)

    Ground

    CAN-H

    Input/
    Output

    40
    (P)

    Ground

    CAN-L

    Input/
    Output

    Input

    Selector lever

    Any position other than P
    (Park)

    L

    Battery voltage

    BCS

    N

    O

    43
    (P)

    Ground

    Door switch (Back)
    signal

    Input

    Back door
    switch

    OFF (back door closed)

    P
    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    ON (back door open)

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-37

    0V

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +
    44
    (LG)

    45
    (O)

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Ground

    Rear wiper autostop
    switch

    Input

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Ground

    Door switch (AS)
    signal

    Input

    Front door
    switch RH

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Rear wiper stop position

    Battery voltage

    Any position other than
    rear wiper stop position

    0V

    OFF (front RH door
    closed)

    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    ON (front RH door open)

    46
    (BR)

    Ground

    Door switch (RR)
    signal

    Input

    Rear door
    switch RH

    0V

    OFF (rear RH door
    closed)

    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    ON (rear RH door open)

    47
    (SB)

    Ground

    Door switch (DR)
    signal

    Input

    Front door
    switch LH

    0V

    OFF (front LH door
    closed)

    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    ON (front LH door open)

    48
    (W)

    Ground

    Door switch (RL)
    signal

    Input

    Rear door
    switch LH

    0V

    OFF (rear LH door closed)

    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V
    ON (rear LH door open)
    49
    (L)

    Ground

    Cargo lamp control

    50
    (G)

    Ground

    Door unlock output
    (back)

    Output

    51
    (W)

    Ground

    Request sw (back
    door) signal

    Input

    54
    (R)

    Ground

    Rear wiper output

    Revision: April 2013

    Output

    Back door is closed (cargo lamp turns OFF)

    Battery voltage

    Back door is opened (cargo lamp turns ON)

    0–1V

    Back door

    UNLOCK (Actuator is activated)
    Actuator is not activated

    Output

    0V

    Back door request switch
    Rear wiper

    ON (Pressed)
    OFF (Not pressed)

    Battery voltage
    0V
    0 – 1.5 V
    Battery voltage

    OFF (stopped)

    0V

    ON (activated)

    Battery voltage

    BCS-38

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    55
    (G)

    Ground

    56
    (W)

    Door unlock output
    (RR, RL)

    Output

    Ground

    Battery saver output

    Output

    57
    (Y)

    Ground

    Battery power supply

    Input

    58
    (O)

    Air bag deployment
    information

    Input

    59
    (G)

    Ground

    Door unlock output
    (AS)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Output

    Rear doors

    UNLOCK (Actuator is activated)

    Value
    (Approx.)

    A

    Battery voltage

    B

    Actuator is not activated

    0V

    Interior room lamp battery saver timed out

    0V

    C

    Except when interior room lamp battery saver timed out

    Battery voltage

    Push-button ignition switch OFF

    Battery voltage

    Front RH door

    UNLOCK (Actuator is activated)

    Battery voltage

    D

    E

    Actuator is not activated

    0V

    Turn signal switch OFF

    0V

    F

    G
    60
    (V)

    Ground

    Flasher output
    (LEFT)

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Turn signal switch LH

    H
    PKIC6370E

    6.5 V
    Turn signal switch OFF

    I

    0V

    J
    61
    (W)

    Ground

    Flasher output
    (RIGHT)

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Turn signal switch RH

    K
    PKIC6370E

    6.5 V
    63
    (R)
    65
    (SB)

    Ground

    Ground

    Room lamp control

    Door lock output

    Output

    Output

    Interior room
    lamp

    All doors

    Battery voltage

    ON

    0 – 1.0 V

    LOCK (Actuator is activated)
    Actuator is not activated

    66
    (G)

    Ground

    67
    (B)

    L

    OFF

    UNLOCK (Actuator is activated)

    Battery voltage
    0V

    N

    Battery voltage

    Door unlock output
    (DR)

    Output

    Ground

    Ground

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    0V

    68
    (L)

    Ground

    Power window power supply (IGN)

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Battery voltage

    70
    (G)

    Ground

    Battery power supply

    Input

    Push-button ignition switch OFF

    Battery voltage

    75
    (GR)

    Ground

    Request sw (DR)
    signal

    Input

    Driver door request switch

    Revision: April 2013

    Front LH door

    Actuator is not activated

    ON (Pressed)
    OFF (Not pressed)

    BCS-39

    BCS

    0V

    O

    0 – 1.5 V
    Battery voltage

    2014 Note

    P

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    76
    (L)

    Ground

    Description
    Signal name
    Engine start sw

    Condition

    Input/
    Output
    Input

    Push-button ignition switch

    START pressed
    Not pressed

    Value
    (Approx.)
    0 – 1.5 V
    Battery voltage

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    78
    (P)

    Ground

    Door antenna (DR) +

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON
    Driver door request switch
    pressed

    JMKIA5954GB

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)
    JMKIA5955GB

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    79
    (V)

    Ground

    Door antenna (DR) —

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON
    Driver door request switch
    pressed

    JMKIA5954GB

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)
    JMKIA5955GB

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    80
    (LG)

    Ground

    Door antenna (AS) +

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON
    Passenger door
    request switch
    pressed

    JMKIA5954GB

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)
    JMKIA5955GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-40

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Value
    (Approx.)

    A

    B
    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    81
    (Y)

    Ground

    Door antenna (AS) —

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON
    Passenger door
    request switch
    pressed

    C

    JMKIA5954GB

    D

    E
    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)

    F
    JMKIA5955GB

    G

    H

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    82
    (W)

    Ground

    Outside key antenna
    (rear bumper) +

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON
    Back door request switch
    pressed

    JMKIA5954GB

    I

    J
    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)

    K
    JMKIA5955GB

    L

    BCS
    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    83
    (B)

    Ground

    Outside key antenna
    (rear bumper) —

    Output

    When the back
    door request
    switch is operated with pushbutton ignition
    switch ON

    N
    JMKIA5954GB

    O

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)

    P

    JMKIA5955GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-41

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)
    JMKIA5951GB

    84
    (P)

    Ground

    Inside key antenna
    (instrument center) +

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)
    JMKIA3839GB

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)
    JMKIA5951GB

    85
    (L)

    Ground

    Inside key antenna
    (instrument center) —

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)
    JMKIA3839GB

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)
    JMKIA5951GB

    86
    (G)

    Ground

    Inside key antenna
    (console) +

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)
    JMKIA3839GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-42

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Value
    (Approx.)

    A

    B
    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    C

    JMKIA5951GB

    87
    (R)

    Ground

    Inside key antenna
    (console) —

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    D

    E
    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)

    F
    JMKIA3839GB

    G

    H

    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)
    JMKIA5951GB

    88
    (V)

    Ground

    Inside key antenna
    (trunk room) +

    Output

    I

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    J
    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)

    K
    JMKIA3839GB

    L

    BCS
    Intelligent Key not in antenna detection area
    (Approx. 2 m)

    N
    JMKIA5951GB

    89
    (LG)

    Ground

    Inside key antenna
    (trunk room) —

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    O

    Intelligent Key in antenna
    detection area
    (80 cm or less)

    P

    JMKIA3839GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-43

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)

    Description
    Signal name

    Input/
    Output

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    +

    90
    (W)

    Push-button ignition
    switch illumination
    power supply

    Battery voltage

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch illumination

    ON

    Ground

    OFF

    0 – 1.5 V

    91
    (V)

    Ground

    ACC/ON indicator
    lamp

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    ACC or ON

    0 – 1.5 V

    93
    (R)

    Ground

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    Output

    Intelligent Key
    warning buzzer

    Sounding

    0 – 1.5 V

    96
    (SB)

    Ground

    Accessory relay
    control

    Output

    Ignition Pushbutton switch

    OFF

    Battery voltage
    0 – 0.5 V

    ACC or ON

    Battery voltage

    Selector lever in P (Park)
    or N (Neutral) position

    Battery voltage

    Selector lever not in P
    (Park) or N (Neutral) position

    0 – 0.5 V

    97
    (R/Y)

    Ground

    98
    (O)

    Ground

    Ignition relay (IPDM
    E/R) control

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch

    OFF or ACC
    ON

    0 – 0.5 V

    99
    (GR)

    Ground

    Ignition relay (F/B)
    control

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch

    OFF or ACC

    0 – 0.5 V

    100
    (L)

    Ground

    Request sw (AS)
    signal

    Input

    Passenger door
    request switch

    ON (Pressed)

    Ground

    Clutch interlock
    switch

    Input

    Clutch interlock
    switch

    101
    (V)

    102
    (BR)

    Ground

    Starter relay control

    P/N position

    Output

    Input

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    Not sounding

    Selector lever

    Battery voltage

    ON

    Battery voltage
    0 – 1.5 V

    OFF (Not pressed)

    Battery voltage

    OFF (clutch pedal is not
    depressed)

    0V

    ON (clutch pedal is depressed)

    Battery voltage

    Selector lever in P (Park)
    or N (Neutral) position

    Battery voltage

    Selector lever not in P
    (Park) or N (Neutral) position

    0 – 1.5 V

    Ground

    CVT shift selector
    (park position
    switch) power supply

    Output

    Push-button ignition switch ON

    9 – 16 V

    105
    (SB)

    Ground

    Stop lamp switch 2

    Input

    Push-button ignition switch OFF

    Battery voltage

    106
    (Y)

    Ground

    Blower relay control

    Output

    104
    (V)

    Push-button ignition switch

    OFF or ACC

    0 – 0.5 V

    ON

    Battery voltage

    Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009567537

    BCM performs fail-safe control when the following DTCs are detected.
    CONSULT Display

    Fail-safe

    Cancellation

    B2192: ID DISCORD BCM-ECM

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Erase DTC

    B2193: CHAIN OF BCM-ECM

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Erase DTC

    B2195: ANTI SCANNING

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Ignition switch ON → OFF

    B2198: NATS ANTENNA AMP

    Inhibit engine cranking

    Erase DTC

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-44

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    CONSULT Display

    B2557: VEHICLE SPEED

    B2601: SHIFT P SIGNAL

    B2602: SHIFT P DIAG

    B2603: SHIFT POSITION

    B2604: SHIFT PN DIAG CAN

    B2605: SHIFT PN DIAG IPDM

    Fail-safe

    Cancellation

    When the following CAN signal status (vehicle speed signal) becomes
    consistent
    • Vehicle speed signal (ABS)
    • Vehicle speed signal (Meter)

    500 ms after the following signal reception status becomes consistent
    • Park position switch signal
    • P range signal (CAN)

    5 seconds after the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch is in the ON position
    • Park position switch signal: P position (push selector button) or except P position (9 – 16 V)
    • Vehicle speed: 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or more

    500 ms after any of the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Status 1
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — Park position switch signal: P position (push selector button) or except P position (9 – 16 V)
    — P/N position signal: Except P and N positions (0 – 1.5 V)
    • Status 2
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — Park position switch signal: P position (release selector button) (0 –
    1.5 V)
    — P/N position signal: P or N positions (9 – 16 V)

    500 ms after any of the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Status 1
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: P or N position (9 – 16 V)
    — Shift position signal (CAN): P or N position
    • Status 2
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: Except P and N positions (0 – 1.5 V)
    — Shift position signal (CAN): Except P and N position

    500 ms after any of the following BCM recognition conditions are fulfilled
    • Status 1
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: Except P and N positions (0 – 1.5 V)
    • Status 2
    — Ignition switch is in the ON position
    — P/N position signal: P or N position (9 – 16 V)

    Inhibit engine cranking

    500 ms after the following signal communication status becomes consistent
    • Starter motor relay control signal
    • Starter relay status signal (CAN)

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When any of the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch changes to ACC
    • Receives engine status signal (CAN)

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): ON
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): ON

    B26F2: IGN RELAY ON

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): OFF
    • Ignition switch ON signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): OFF

    B26F3: START CONT RLY ON

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): OFF
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): OFF

    B26F4: START CONT RLY OFF

    Inhibit engine cranking

    When the following conditions are fulfilled
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from BCM): ON
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN: Transmitted from IPDM E/R): ON

    B2608: STARTER RELAY

    B260F: ECM CAN COMM

    B26F1: IGN RELAY OFF

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-45

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    CONSULT Display

    Fail-safe
    Inhibit engine cranking
    by Intelligent Key system

    B26F7: BCM
    U0415: VDC CAN CIR2

    Cancellation
    When room antenna and luggage room antenna functions normally
    When vehicle speed signal (Meter) (CAN) is received normally

    DTC Inspection Priority Chart

    INFOID:0000000009567538

    If more than one DTC is displayed at the same time, perform inspections based on the following priority chart.
    Priority

    DTC

    1

    B2562: LOW VOLTAGE

    2

    • U1000: CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    • U1010: CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    3




    B2192: ID DISCORD BCM-ECM
    B2193: CHAIN OF BCM-ECM
    B2195: ANTI SCANNING
    B2198: NATS ANTENNA AMP

    4




























    B2555: STOP LAMP CIRCUIT
    B2556: ENG START SW
    B2557: VEHICLE SPEED
    B2562: LOW VOLTAGE
    B2601: SHIFT P SIGNAL
    B2602: SHIFT P DIAG
    B2603: SHIFT POSITION
    B2604: SHIFT PN DIAG CAN
    B2605: SHIFT PN DIAG IPDM
    B2608: STARTER RELAY
    B260F: ECM CAN COMM
    B2614: ACC RELAY REQ FB
    B2615: IGN RELAY3 REQ FB
    B2616: IGN RELAY2 REQ FB
    B2618: IGN RELAY1 REQ FB
    B261A: ENGINE SW
    B261F: ASCD CANCEL SW
    B2620: NEUTRAL SW
    B26E8: CLUTCH SW
    B26F1: IGN RELAY OFF
    B26F2: IGN RELAY ON
    B26F3: START CONT RLY ON
    B26F4: START CONT RLY OFF
    B26F6: BCM
    B26F7: BCM
    B26FB: CLUTCH SWITCH
    B26FC: KEY REGISTRATION
    U0415: VDC CAN CIR2

    5

    • B2621: INSIDE ANTENNA 1
    • B2622: INSIDE ANTENNA 2
    • B2623: INSIDE ANTENNA 3

    6

    • B2626: OUTSIDE 1 ANTENNA
    • B2627: OUTSIDE 2 ANTENNA
    • B2628: OUTSIDE 3 ANTENNA

    DTC Index

    INFOID:0000000009567539

    NOTE:
    The details of time display are as follows.
    • CRNT: A malfunction is detected now.
    • PAST: A malfunction was detected in the past.
    IGN counter is displayed on Freeze Frame Data.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-46

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Fail-safe

    Freeze Frame Data
    •Vehicle Speed
    •Odo/Trip Meter
    •Vehicle Condition

    Intelligent Key
    warning lamp ON

    Reference page

    No DTC is detected.
    further testing
    may be required.

    U1000: CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    BCS-57

    U1010: CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    BCS-58

    U0415: VDC CAN CIR2

    ×

    ×

    BCS-59

    B2192: ID DISCORD BCM-ECM

    ×

    SEC-65

    B2193: CHAIN OF BCM-ECM

    ×

    SEC-66

    B2195: ANTI SCANNING

    ×

    SEC-67

    B2198: NATS ANTENNA AMP

    ×

    SEC-68

    B2555: STOP LAMP CIRCUIT

    ×

    ×

    SEC-71

    B2556: ENG START SW

    ×

    ×

    SEC-74

    B2557: VEHICLE SPEED

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-76

    B2562: LOW VOLTAGE

    ×

    BCS-60

    B2601: SHIFT P SIGNAL

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-77

    B2602: SHIFT P DIAG

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-79

    B2603: SHIFT POSITION

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-82

    B2604: SHIFT PN DIAG CAN

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-86

    B2605: SHIFT PN DIAG IPDM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-89

    B2608: STARTER RELAY

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-91

    B260F: ECM CAN COMM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-93

    B2614: ACC RELAY REQ FB

    ×

    ×

    PCS-53

    B2615: IGN RELAY3 REQ FB

    ×

    ×

    PCS-55

    B2616: IGN RELAY2 REQ FB

    ×

    ×

    PCS-57

    B2618: IGN RELAY1 REQ FB

    ×

    ×

    PCS-59

    B261A: ENGINE SW

    ×

    ×

    PCS-61

    B261F: ASCD CANCEL SW

    ×

    ×

    SEC-94

    B2620: NEUTRAL SW

    ×

    ×

    SEC-97

    B2621: INSIDE ANTENNA 1

    ×

    DLK-54

    B2622: INSIDE ANTENNA 2

    ×

    DLK-56

    B2623: INSIDE ANTENNA 3

    ×

    DLK-58

    B2626: OUTSIDE 1 ANTENNA

    ×

    DLK-60

    B2627: OUTSIDE 2 ANTENNA

    ×

    DLK-62

    B2628: OUTSIDE 3 ANTENNA

    ×

    DLK-64

    B26E8: CLUTCH SW

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-100

    B26F1: IGN RELAY OFF

    ×

    ×

    ×

    PCS-63

    B26F2: IGN RELAY ON

    ×

    ×

    ×

    PCS-65

    B26F3: START CONT RLY ON

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-103

    B26F4: START CONT RLY OFF

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-104

    B26F6: BCM

    ×

    ×

    PCS-67

    B26F7: BCM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    SEC-105

    B26FB: CLUTCH SWITCH

    ×

    ×

    SEC-106

    B26FC: KEY REGISTRATION

    ×

    ×

    SEC-107

    CONSULT display

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-47

    2014 Note

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    BCM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    BCM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009567540

    AAMWA0775GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-48

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O
    AAMWA0776GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-49

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMWA0777GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-50

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O
    AAMIA1688GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-51

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1689GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-52

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O
    AAMIA1690GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-53

    2014 Note

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM)
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Description
    INFOID:0000000009567541

    BEFORE REPLACEMENT
    When replacing BCM, save or print current vehicle specification with CONSULT configuration before replacement.
    NOTE:
    If “Before Replace ECU” cannot be used, use the “After Replace ECU” or “Manual Configuration” after replacing BCM.

    AFTER REPLACEMENT
    CAUTION:
    • When replacing BCM, you must perform “After Replace ECU” with CONSULT.
    — Complete the procedure of “After Replace ECU” in order.
    — If you set incorrect “After Replace ECU”, incidents might occur.
    — Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
    • When replacing BCM, perform the system initialization (NATS).

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567542

    1.SAVING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
    CONSULT
    Enter «Re/Programming, Configuration» and perform “Before Replace ECU” to save or print current vehicle
    specification.
    NOTE:
    If “Before Replace ECU” cannot be used, use the «After Replace ECU» or «Manual Configuration» after replacing BCM.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE BCM

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.WRITING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
    CONSULT
    Enter «Re/Programming, Configuration».
    If “Before Replace ECU” operation was performed, automatically an «Operation Log Selection» screen will
    be displayed. Select the applicable file from the «Saved Data List» and press “Confirm” to write vehicle
    specification. Refer to BCS-54, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM) :
    Work Procedure».
    3. If “Before Replace ECU” operation was not performed, select «After Replace ECU» or «Manual Configuration» to write vehicle specification. Refer to BCS-54, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Work Procedure».
    1.
    2.

    >> GO TO 4.

    4.INITIALIZE BCM (NATS)
    Perform BCM initialization. (NATS)

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-54

    2014 Note

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> Work End.

    CONFIGURATION (BCM)

    A

    CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Description

    INFOID:0000000009567543

    Vehicle specification needs to be written with CONSULT because it is not written after replacing BCM.
    Configuration has three functions as follows:
    Function

    C

    Description

    «Before Replace ECU»

    • Reads the vehicle configuration of current BCM.
    • Saves the read vehicle configuration.

    «After Replace ECU»

    Writes the vehicle configuration with manual selection.

    «Select Saved Data List»

    Writes the vehicle configuration with saved data.

    B

    D

    CAUTION:
    • When replacing BCM, you must perform “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU» with CONSULT.
    • Complete the procedure of “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU» in order.
    • If you set incorrect “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU», incidents might occur.
    • Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
    • Never perform “Select Saved Data List” or «After Replace ECU» except for new BCM.

    E

    CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Work Procedure

    G

    INFOID:0000000009567544

    1.WRITING MODE SELECTION

    F

    H

    CONSULT
    Select “Reprogramming, Configuration” of BCM.

    I

    When writing saved data>>GO TO 2.
    When writing manually>>GO TO 3.

    2.PERFORM “SAVED DATA LIST”

    J

    CONSULT
    Automatically “Operation Log Selection” window will display if “Before Replace ECU” was performed. Select
    applicable file from the “Save Data List” and press “Confirm”.

    K

    L

    >> Work End.

    3.PERFORM “AFTER REPLACE ECU” OR “MANUAL CONFIGURATION”
    CONSULT
    BCS
    Select “After Replace ECU” or “Manual Configuration”.
    Identify the correct model and configuration list. Refer to BCS-56, «CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Configuration list».
    N
    3. Confirm and/or change setting value for each item.
    CAUTION:
    Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. ECU control may not operate normally
    O
    if the setting is not correct.
    4. Select “Next”.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure to select “Next”, confirm each setting value and press “OK” even if the indicated con- P
    figuration of brand new BCM is same as the desirable configuration. If not, configuration which is
    set automatically by selecting vehicle model cannot be memorized.
    5. When «Completed», select «End».
    1.
    2.

    >> GO TO 4.

    4.OPERATION CHECK
    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-55

    2014 Note

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Confirm that each function controlled by BCM operates normally.
    >> Work End.

    CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Configuration list

    INFOID:0000000009567545

    CAUTION:
    Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. Incorrect settings may result in abnormal
    control of ECU.
    SETTING ITEM
    Items

    Setting value

    TRANSMISSION

    AT with ABS ⇔ MT with ABS

    BLOWE FAN SIG

    MODE1 ⇔ MODE2

    ⇔: Items which confirm vehicle specifications

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-56

    2014 Note

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009567546

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567547

    C

    Refer to LAN-6, «CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description».

    DTC Logic
    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    NOTE:
    U1000 can be set if a module harness was disconnected and reconnected, perhaps during a repair. Confirm
    that there are actual CAN diagnostic symptoms and a present DTC by performing the Self Diagnostic Result
    procedure.
    CONSULT Display

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [U1000]

    DTC Detection Condition

    When any listed module cannot communicate
    with CAN communication signal continuously for
    2 seconds or more with ignition switch ON

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    E

    Possible Cause
    In CAN communication system, any item (or
    items) of the following listed below is malfunctioning.
    • Transmission
    • Receiving (ECM)
    • Receiving (ABS)
    • Receiving (METER/M&A)
    • Receiving (TCM)
    • Receiving (IPDM E/R)

    F

    G

    H

    INFOID:0000000009567548

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    I

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 second or more.
    2. Check “SELF- DIAG RESULTS”.
    Is “CAN COMM CIRCUIT” displayed?
    YES >> Perform CAN Diagnosis as described in DIAGNOSIS section of CONSULT Operation Manual.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-57

    2014 Note

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567549

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [U1010]

    DTC Detection Condition
    BCM detected internal CAN communication circuit malfunction.

    Possible Cause
    BCM

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567550

    1.REPLACE BCM
    When DTC “U1010” is detected, replace BCM.
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-58

    2014 Note

    U0415 VEHICLE SPEED
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U0415 VEHICLE SPEED

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567551

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC U0415 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC U0415 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».

    C

    CONSULT Display
    VDC CAN CIR2
    [U0415]

    DTC Detection Condition
    When the vehicle speed signal received from the
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) remains abnormal for 2 seconds or more.

    D

    Probable Cause
    • ABS system
    • Combination meter system
    • CAN bus harness

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1. DTC CONFIRMATION

    F

    1.
    2.
    3.

    G

    Erase the DTC.
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of BCM with CONSULT, after the ignition switch has been turned ON for 2
    seconds or more.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567552

    1. ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of ABS with CONSULT. Refer to BRC-19, «CONSULT Function (ABS)».
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2. CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND

    H

    I

    J

    K

    CIRCUIT
    Check ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) power and ground. Refer to BRC-42, «Diagnosis Proce- L
    dure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    BCS
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3. COMBINATION METER SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of METER M&A with CONSULT. Refer to MWI-15, «CONSULT Function».
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-59

    2014 Note

    B2562 LOW VOLTAGE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2562 LOW VOLTAGE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567553

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    LOW VOLTAGE
    [B2562]

    DTC Detection Condition
    When the power supply voltage to BCM remains
    less than 8.8 V for 120 seconds or more

    Possible Cause
    • Harness or connector (power supply circuit)
    • Vehicle battery

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1. DTC CONFIRMATION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Erase DTC.
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Perform the Self Diagnostic Result of BCM with CONSULT, after the ignition switch has been turned ON
    for 120 seconds or more.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to BCS-60, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567554

    1. CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
    Check battery voltage.
    Is battery voltage less than 8.8V?
    YES >> Charge battery and retest. Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)» or
    CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2. CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check BCM power supply and ground circuit. Refer to BCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3. BCM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of BCM with CONSULT. Refer to BCS-24, «BCM : CONSULT Function (BCM BCM)».
    Is DTC B2562 CRNT?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-60

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567555

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1.CHECK FUSES AND FUSIBLE LINK
    Check that the following fuses and fusible link are not blown.

    D
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    57

    Fuses and fusible link No.
    12 (10A)

    Battery power supply

    70

    E

    G (40A)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    G

    Disconnect BCM connector M99.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M99 and ground.

    H

    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal
    57

    M99

    70

    Ground

    Voltage

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    J

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    K

    Check continuity between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    67

    I

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    L

    BCS

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-61

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION SWITCH INPUT CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    COMBINATION SWITCH INPUT CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567556

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK INPUT 1 — 5 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM and combination switch connectors.
    Check continuity between BCM connector and combination switch connector.
    Combination switch
    signal

    BCM

    Combination switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    INPUT 1

    Terminal

    36

    INPUT 2
    INPUT 3

    Connector

    11

    35
    M18

    Continuity

    9

    34

    M28

    7

    INPUT 4

    33

    10

    INPUT 5

    32

    13

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connectors.

    2.CHECK INPUT 1 — 5 CIRCUIT FOR SHORT

    Check for continuity between BCM connector and ground.
    Combination switch
    signal

    BCM
    Connector

    INPUT 1

    36

    INPUT 2

    35

    INPUT 3

    M18

    Continuity

    Terminal

    34

    INPUT 4

    33

    INPUT 5

    32

    Ground
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Repair harness or connectors.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK BCM OUTPUT VOLTAGE

    1.
    2.

    Connect BCM connector.
    Check voltage between BCM connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-62

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION SWITCH INPUT CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    Terminals
    (+)

    BCM signal

    (−)

    BCM
    Connector

    OUTPUT 1

    36
    35
    M18

    B

    Terminal

    OUTPUT 2
    OUTPUT 3

    Voltage

    34

    OUTPUT 4

    33

    OUTPUT 5

    32

    C

    Ground
    Refer to BCS-28, «Reference Value».

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination switch. Refer to BCS-68, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-63

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION SWITCH OUTPUT CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    COMBINATION SWITCH OUTPUT CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567557

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK OUTPUT 1 — 5 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM and combination switch connectors.
    Check continuity between BCM connector and combination switch connector.
    Combination switch
    signal

    BCM

    Combination switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    OUTPUT 1

    Terminal

    6

    OUTPUT 2
    OUTPUT 3

    Connector

    12

    5
    M18

    Continuity

    14

    4

    M28

    5

    OUTPUT 4

    3

    2

    OUTPUT 5

    2

    8

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connectors.

    2.CHECK OUTPUT 1 — 5 CIRCUIT FOR SHORT

    Check for continuity between BCM connector and ground.
    Combination switch
    signal

    BCM
    Connector

    OUTPUT 1

    6

    OUTPUT 2

    5

    OUTPUT 3

    M18

    Continuity

    Terminal

    4

    OUTPUT 4

    3

    OUTPUT 5

    2

    Ground
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Repair harness or connectors.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Connect BCM and combination switch connectors.
    Turn ON any switch in the system that is malfunctioning.
    Check voltage between BCM connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-64

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION SWITCH OUTPUT CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    Terminals
    (+)

    BCM signal

    (−)

    BCM
    Connector

    6

    INPUT 2

    5
    M18

    B

    Terminal

    INPUT 1

    INPUT 3

    Voltage

    4

    INPUT 4

    3

    INPUT 5

    2

    C

    Ground
    Refer to BCS-28, «Reference Value».

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Yes
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    No
    >> Replace combination switch. Refer to BCS-68, «Removal and Installation».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-65

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION SWITCH SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    COMBINATION SWITCH SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    Symptom Table
    1.
    2.

    INFOID:0000000009567558

    Perform the data monitor of CONSULT to check for any malfunctioning item.
    Check the malfunction combinations.
    Malfunction item: ×

    ×

    B

    ×
    ×

    E

    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    FR FOG SW

    PASSING SW

    HEAD LAMP SW 2

    HEAD LAMP SW 1

    HI BEAM SW

    TURN SIGNAL L

    ×
    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    G

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    I
    ×

    J

    3.

    TAIL LAMP SW

    TURN SIGNAL R

    RR WASHER SW

    RR WIPER INT

    ×
    ×

    D

    H

    ×
    ×

    C

    F

    RR WIPER ON

    ×

    INT VOLUME

    ×

    FR WIPER INT

    FR WASHER SW

    A

    FR WIPER LOW

    Malfunction combination

    FR WIPER HI

    Data monitor item

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    K

    All Items

    L

    If only one item is detected or the item is not applicable to the combinations A to K

    Identify the malfunctioning part from the agreed combination and repair or replace the part.
    Malfunction
    combination

    Malfunctioning part

    Repair or replace

    A

    Combination switch INPUT 1 circuit

    B

    Combination switch INPUT 2 circuit

    C

    Combination switch INPUT 3 circuit

    D

    Combination switch INPUT 4 circuit

    E

    Combination switch INPUT 5 circuit

    F

    Combination switch OUTPUT 1 circuit

    G

    Combination switch OUTPUT 2 circuit

    H

    Combination switch OUTPUT 3 circuit

    I

    Combination switch OUTPUT 4 circuit

    J

    Combination switch OUTPUT 5 circuit

    K

    BCM

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    L

    Combination switch

    Replace the combination switch.

    Revision: April 2013

    Inspect the combination switch input circuit applicable to the malfunctioning
    part. Refer to BCS-62, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Inspect the combination switch output circuit applicable to the malfunctioning part. Refer to BCS-64, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    BCS-66

    2014 Note

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE)
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE)
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009447118

    B

    REMOVAL
    CAUTION:
    Before replacing BCM, perform “READ CONFIGURATION” to save or print current vehicle specification. Refer to BCS-55, «CONFIGURATION (BCM) : Description».
    1. Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    2. Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    3. Remove screws (A) and remove the BCM (1) from the steering
    member and position aside.
    : Front
    4. Disconnect the harness connectors from the BCM.
    5. Remove relays from relay bracket.
    6. Remove relay bracket from BCM to transfer to new BCM.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    ALMIA0656ZZ

    H

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Perform “CONFIGURATION (BCM)” when replacing BCM. Refer to BCS-54, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE
    WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Description».
    • Make sure to perform the system initialization (NATS) when replacing BCM. Refer to BCS-54, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Work Procedure».
    • When replacing BCM, if new BCM does not come with keyfobs attached, all existing keyfobs must be
    re-registered.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    BCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-67

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    COMBINATION SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009447322

    CAUTION:
    • Before servicing, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery terminals and wait at least
    three minutes.
    • Do not use air or electric tools when removing or installing the combination switch.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove the steering column covers. Refer to IP-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate steering wheel clockwise to access first combination
    switch screw (A) and remove.

    ALMIA0648ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Rotate steering wheel counter-clockwise to access second combination switch screw (A) and remove.
    Disconnect the harness connector (B) from the combination
    switch (1) and remove.

    ALMIA0649ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After the work is completed, make sure no system malfunction is detected by air bag warning lamp.
    • In case a malfunction is detected by the air bag warning lamp, reset with the self-diagnosis function
    and delete the memory with CONSULT.
    • If a malfunction is still detected after the above operation, perform self-diagnosis to repair malfunctions. Refer to BCS-54, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT (BCM) : Work
    Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    BCS-68

    2014 Note

    BRAKES

    SECTION

    BR

    BRAKE SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover…… 3
    Precaution for Brake System ……………………………… 3

    DISC ROTOR …………………………………………………….15
    DISC ROTOR : Inspection …………………………………15

    REAR DRUM BRAKE ………………………………… 17
    BRAKE LINING ………………………………………………….17
    BRAKE LINING : Inspection ………………………………17
    BRAKE LINING : Brake Burnishing …………………….17

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 5

    BRAKE DRUM …………………………………………………..17
    BRAKE DRUM : Inspection ……………………………….17

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 5

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 19

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 5
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 5

    BRAKE PEDAL …………………………………………. 19
    Exploded View …………………………………………………19
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..19
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………..20

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 7
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….. 7
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………….. 7

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 8
    BRAKE PEDAL …………………………………………… 8
    Inspection and Adjustment …………………………………. 8

    BRAKE FLUID …………………………………………….11

    BRAKE PIPING …………………………………………. 21
    FRONT ……………………………………………………………..21
    FRONT : Exploded View …………………………………..21
    FRONT : Hydraulic Piping …………………………………22
    FRONT : Removal and Installation ……………………..22
    FRONT : Inspection ………………………………………….23

    Inspection ………………………………………………………. 11
    Draining …………………………………………………………. 11
    Refilling …………………………………………………………. 11
    Bleeding Brake System ……………………………………. 12

    REAR ……………………………………………………………….23
    REAR : Exploded View ……………………………………..24
    REAR : Hydraulic Piping ……………………………………24
    REAR : Removal and Installation ……………………….25
    REAR : Inspection ……………………………………………25

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER ……………………….13

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER …………………….. 27

    Inspection ………………………………………………………. 13

    Exploded View …………………………………………………27
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..27
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….28
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….28

    BRAKE BOOSTER ……………………………………..14
    Inspection ………………………………………………………. 14

    FRONT DISC BRAKE ………………………………….15

    BRAKE BOOSTER AND CHECK VALVE …….. 30

    BRAKE PAD …………………………………………………….. 15
    BRAKE PAD : Inspection …………………………………. 15
    BRAKE PAD : Brake Burnishing ……………………….. 15

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-1

    Exploded View …………………………………………………30
    Removal and installation …………………………………..30
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………..31

    2014 Note

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    VACUUM LINES ………………………………………… 32

    REAR DRUM BRAKE ………………………………… 40

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 32
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 32
    Inspection ……………………………………………………… 32

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 40
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 40
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………… 42
    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………….. 42

    FRONT DISC BRAKE …………………………………. 34
    BRAKE PAD ……………………………………………………. 34
    BRAKE PAD : Exploded View ………………………….. 34
    BRAKE PAD : Removal and Installation …………….. 34
    BRAKE PAD : Inspection …………………………………. 35
    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY ………………………….. 35
    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View … 35
    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………….. 36
    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Disassembly and
    Assembly ………………………………………………………. 37

    Revision: April 2013

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………. 44
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 44
    General Specifications …………………………………….. 44
    Brake Pedal …………………………………………………… 44
    Check Valve …………………………………………………… 44
    Brake Booster ………………………………………………… 44
    Front Disc Brake …………………………………………….. 44
    Rear Drum Brake ……………………………………………. 45

    BR-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009578746

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along C
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    D
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    E
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    BR
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.
    G

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS

    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009364984

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc. to prevent damage to
    windshield.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M
    PIIB3706J

    Precaution for Brake System

    INFOID:0000000009364985

    WARNING:
    Clean any dust from the front brake and rear brake with a vacuum dust collector. Do not blow with
    compressed air.
    • Brake fluid use refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe it off
    immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Always confirm the specified tightening torque when installing the brake pipes.
    • After pressing the brake pedal more deeply or harder than normal driving, such as air bleeding, inspect the
    brake pedal height and play. Adjust brake pedal if it is outside the standard value.
    • Always clean with new brake fluid when cleaning the brake caliper and other components.
    • Do not use mineral oils such as gasoline or light oil to clean. They may damage rubber parts and cause
    improper operation.
    Revision: April 2013

    BR-3

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Always loosen the brake tube flare nut with a flare nut wrench.
    • Tighten the brake tube flare nut to the specified torque with a crowfoot (A) and torque wrench (B).
    • Brake system is an important safety part. If a brake fluid leak is
    detected, always disassemble the affected part. If a malfunction is
    detected, replace part with a new one.
    • Always connect the battery terminals when moving the vehicle.
    • Check that no brake fluid leakage is present after replacing the
    parts.
    • Burnish the brake contact surfaces after refinishing or replacing
    disc brake rotors, after replacing brake pads, or if a soft pedal
    occurs at very low mileage.
    — Front brake pad: Refer to BR-15, «BRAKE PAD : Inspection».
    — Front disc brake rotor: Refer to BR-15, «DISC ROTOR : Inspection».
    — Rear brake lining: refer to BR-17, «BRAKE LINING : Inspection».
    — Rear brake drum: BR-17, «BRAKE DRUM : Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-4

    JPFIA0001ZZ

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009364986

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46532)
    Brake height tool

    Measuring brake pedal height

    C

    D

    E
    LFIA0227E

    38-PFM92-GYX/5
    ( — )
    On-car brake lathe

    BR

    Turning disc brake rotors

    G

    H
    ALFIA0092ZZ

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009364987

    I
    Tool name

    Description

    1. Flare nut crowfoot
    2. Torque wrench

    Removing and installing brake pipe and
    hose flare nuts
    a:10 mm (0.39 in) / 12 mm (0.47 in)

    J

    K

    L

    NT360

    Vacuum pump

    • Air tight
    • Inspection of check valve

    M

    N
    ZZC1313D

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-5

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    Tool name

    Description

    Brake caliper wrench (front)

    Return the piston

    NNFIA0040ZZ

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-6

    2014 Note

    Symptom
    BRAKE

    Revision: April 2013
    Noise
    ×
    ×
    ×

    Shake
    ×

    Shimmy, Shudder
    ×
    ×

    BR-7
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×
    ×
    ×

    STEERING

    ×

    DRIVE SHAFT

    ×
    ×

    ST-7 (steering system)

    FAX-6 (front axle)

    WT-4 (wheel and tire)

    WT-5 (wheel and tire)

    FAX-6 (front axle)
    RAX-4 (rear axle)
    FSU-5 (front suspension)
    RSU-4 (rear suspension)

    BR-17

    BR-15

    BR-15, BR-17

    BR-15, BR-17

    BR-15

    BR-15

    BR-15, BR-17

    BR-15

    BR-15

    BR-15, BR-17

    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    ×

    ×

    ROAD WHEEL

    ×

    TIRE

    ×

    AXLE AND SUSPENSION

    Drum out of round

    Rotor thickness variation

    Rotor or drum rust

    Rotor or drum deflection

    Rotor deformation

    Rotor runout

    Rotor or drum damage

    Rotor imbalance

    Shims damaged

    Possible cause and
    SUSPECTED PARTS
    Pads or lining uneven wear

    BR-15, BR-17

    Reference page

    Pads or lining damaged

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    A

    INFOID:0000000009364988

    ×

    ×

    2014 Note

    B

    Use the chart below to find the cause of the symptom. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    ×: Applicable

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    BRAKE PEDAL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    BRAKE PEDAL
    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009364989

    INSPECTION
    Brake Pedal Height
    Check the height (H1) between the dash lower panel (1) and the
    brake pedal upper surface.

    Brake pedal height

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Pedal».

    CAUTION:
    Remove the floor trim.

    JPFIA0065ZZ

    Stop Lamp Switch
    Check the clearance (C) between the brake pedal (1) and the stop
    lamp switch (2) threaded end.

    Clearance

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Pedal».

    CAUTION:
    The stop lamp must turn off when the brake pedal is released.

    JPFIA0866ZZ

    ASCD Cancel Switch (if equipped)
    Check the clearance (C) between the brake pedal (1) and the ASCD
    cancel switch (2) threaded end.

    Clearance

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Pedal».

    CAUTION:
    The stop lamp must turn off when the brake pedal is released.

    JPFIA0866ZZ

    Brake Pedal Play
    Press the brake pedal. Check that brake pedal play does not exist.
    Depressed Brake Pedal Height

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-8

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PEDAL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Check the height between the dash lower panel (1) and the brake
    pedal upper surface (H2) when depressing the brake pedal at 490 N
    (50.0 kg-f, 110.2 lb-f) while turning engine ON.
    Depressed brake
    pedal height

    A

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Pedal».

    B

    CAUTION:
    Remove the floor trim.

    C
    JPFIA0068ZZ

    D

    ADJUSTMENT
    Brake Pedal Height

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    a.

    E

    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from stop lamp switch.
    Loosen the stop lamp switch 45° counterclockwise.
    Adjust the brake pedal height with the following procedure.
    Loosen the input rod lock nut (1).
    CAUTION:
    The threaded end of the input rod (2) must project to the
    inner side (L) of the clevis (3).

    BR

    G

    H

    I
    JPFIA0003ZZ

    b.

    Brake pedal
    height
    c.
    5.

    J

    Rotate the input rod, adjust the brake pedal to the specified
    height (H1).

    K

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Pedal».

    Tighten the lock nut. Refer to BR-30, «Exploded View».
    Check the brake pedal play.

    L

    JPFIA0279ZZ

    M

    Stop Lamp Switch

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from stop lamp switch.
    Loosen the stop lamp switch 45° counterclockwise.
    Press-fit the stop lamp switch (2) until the stop lamp switch hits
    the brake pedal (1) then tighten 45° clockwise while pulling the
    brake pedal pad slightly.
    CAUTION:
    • The clearance (C) between the brake pedal and stop lamp
    switch threaded and must be the specified value.
    Clearance

    N

    O

    P

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Pedal».

    • The stop lamp must turn off when the brake pedal is
    released.
    JPFIA0866ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-9

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PEDAL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    ASCD Cancel Switch (if equipped)

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from ASCD cancel switch.
    Loosen the ASCD cancel switch 45° counterclockwise.
    Press-fit the ASCD cancel switch (2) until the ASCD cancel
    switch hits the brake pedal (1) then tighten 45° clockwise while
    pulling the brake pedal pad slightly.
    CAUTION:
    • The clearance (C) between the brake pedal and ASCD cancel switch threaded and must be the specified value.
    Clearance

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Pedal».

    • The stop lamp must turn off when the brake pedal is
    released.
    JPFIA0866ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-10

    2014 Note

    BRAKE FLUID
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    BRAKE FLUID

    A

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009364990

    BRAKE FLUID LEVEL

    B

    • Check that the fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the specified
    range between the MAX – MIN lines as shown.
    • Visually check for any brake fluid leaks around the reservoir tank.
    • Check the brake system for any leaks if the fluid level is extremely
    low (lower than MIN).
    • Check the brake system for fluid leaks if the warning lamp remains
    illuminated even after the parking brake is released.
    • Check the reservoir tank for the mixing of foreign matter (e.g. dust)
    and oils other than brake fluid.

    C

    D

    E
    JPFIA0007ZZ

    BRAKE LINE
    1.
    2.

    BR

    Check brake tubes and hoses for cracks, deterioration or other
    damage. Replace any damaged parts.
    Check for brake fluid leaks by fully depressing brake pedal while
    engine is running.
    CAUTION:
    Retighten the applicable connection to the specified torque
    and repair any abnormal (damaged, worn or deformed) part
    if any brake fluid leaks are present.

    G

    H

    I
    SBR389C

    Draining

    INFOID:0000000009364991

    CAUTION:
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) or battery
    negative terminal before performing work.
    1. Connect a vinyl tube to the bleeder valve.
    2. Depress the brake pedal and loosen the bleeder valve to gradually discharge brake fluid.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    BRA0007D

    Refilling

    CAUTION:
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) or battery
    negative terminal before performing work.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Monitor the brake fluid level in the reservoir while performing the air bleeding procedure.
    • Always use new brake fluid for refilling. Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    Revision: April 2013

    O

    INFOID:0000000009364992

    BR-11

    2014 Note

    P

    BRAKE FLUID
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    1. Check that there is no foreign material in the reservoir tank, and
    refill with new brake fluid. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    2. Loosen the bleeder valve, slowly depress the brake pedal to the
    full stroke, and then release the pedal. Repeat this operation at
    intervals of 2 or 3 seconds until new brake fluid is discharged.
    Then close the bleeder valve with the brake pedal depressed.
    Repeat the same work on each wheel.
    3. Perform the air bleeding procedure. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding
    Brake System».
    PFIA0403J

    Bleeding Brake System

    INFOID:0000000009364993

    CAUTION:
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) or battery
    negative terminal before performing the work.
    • Monitor the fluid level in the reservoir tank while performing the air bleeding.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Always use new brake fluid for refilling. Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    1. Connect a vinyl tube to the bleeder valve.
    2. Fully depress the brake pedal 4 to 5 times.
    3. Loosen the bleeder valve and bleed air with the brake pedal depressed, and then quickly tighten the
    bleeder valve.
    4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 until all of the air is out of the brake line.
    5. Tighten the bleeder valve to the specified torque.
    • Front disc brake: Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View».
    • Rear drum brake: Refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».
    6. Perform steps 1 to 5 in the following order: Front (RH) brake → front (LH) brake → rear (RH) brake → rear
    (LH) brake.
    7. Check that the fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the specified range after air bleeding. Refer to BR11, «Inspection».
    8. Add brake fluid as necessary to keep the brake fluid level within the specified range. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    9. Inspect the brake pedal height and play. Adjust it if the measurement value is not the standard. Refer to
    BR-8, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-12

    2014 Note

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER

    A

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009364994

    FLUID LEAKS

    B

    Check for brake fluid leaks from the master cylinder, reservoir tank, and brake tube connections.
    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-13

    2014 Note

    BRAKE BOOSTER
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    BRAKE BOOSTER
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009364995

    OPERATION
    Depress the brake pedal several times at 5-second intervals with the engine stopped. Start the engine with the
    brake pedal fully depressed. Check that the clearance between brake pedal and dash lower panel decreases.
    NOTE:
    A slight impact with a small click may be felt on the pedal when the brake pedal is fully depressed. This is a
    normal phenomenon due to the brake system operation.

    AIR TIGHT
    1.

    2.

    Run the engine at idle for 1 minute to apply vacuum to the brake booster, and stop the engine. Then
    depress the brake pedal several times at 5-second intervals until the accumulated vacuum is released to
    atmospheric pressure. Check that the clearance between brake pedal and dash lower panel gradually
    increases each time the brake pedal is depressed when performing this operation.
    Depress the brake pedal with the engine running. Then stop the engine while holding down the brake
    pedal. Check that the brake pedal stroke does not change after holding down the brake pedal for 30 seconds or more.

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-14

    2014 Note

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    FRONT DISC BRAKE

    A

    BRAKE PAD
    BRAKE PAD : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009364996

    B

    INSPECTION
    Check brake pad wear thickness from an inspection hole on cylinder
    body. Check using a scale if necessary.
    Wear thickness

    C

    : Refer to BR-15, «BRAKE PAD : Inspection».

    D

    E

    BRA0010D

    BRAKE PAD : Brake Burnishing

    BR

    INFOID:0000000009671178

    BRAKE BURNISHING
    Burnish contact surfaces between disc brake rotor and brake pads according to the following procedure after
    refinishing disc brake rotors, replacing disc brake rotors, replacing brake pads, or if a soft pedal occurs at very
    low mileage:
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful of vehicle speed because the brake pedal does not operate firmly/securely until pads and
    disc brake rotor are securely seated.
    • Only perform this procedure under safe road and traffic conditions. Use extreme caution.
    1. Drive vehicle on straight, flat road.
    2. Depress brake pedal with the power to stop vehicle within 3 to 5 seconds until the vehicle stops.
    3. Drive without depressing brake pedal for a few minutes to cool the brakes.
    4. Repeat steps 1 to 3 until pad and disc brake rotor are securely seated.

    DISC ROTOR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DISC ROTOR : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009364997

    L

    INSPECTION
    Appearance
    Check surface of disc brake rotor for uneven wear, cracks, and serious damage. Replace it if necessary. Refer
    to BR-15, «DISC ROTOR : Inspection».

    M

    Runout

    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    Secure the disc brake rotor to the wheel hub with wheel nuts (2
    points at least).
    Check the wheel bearing axial end play before the inspection.
    Refer to FAX-7, «Inspection».
    Inspect the runout with a dial indicator to measure at 10 mm
    (0.39 in) inside the disc edge.

    O

    P

    Runout
    4.
    5.

    : Refer to BR-44, «Front Disc Brake».

    Find the installation position that has a minimum runout by shifting the disc brake rotor-to-wheel hub installation position by one
    BRA0013D
    hole at a time if the runout exceeds the limit value.
    Refinish or replace the disc brake rotor if the runout is outside the limit even after performing the above
    operation.

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-15

    2014 Note

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    CAUTION:
    If the thickness is less than wear thickness + 0.3 mm (0.012 in), replace the disc brake rotor. Refer
    to BR-36, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Wear thickness

    : Refer to BR-44, «Front Disc Brake».

    Thickness
    Check the thickness of the disc brake rotor using a micrometer.
    Replace the disc brake rotor if the thickness is below the wear limit.
    Refer to BR-44, «Front Disc Brake».

    Wear thickness

    : Refer to BR-44, «Front
    Disc Brake».
    Thickness variation (mea- : Refer to BR-44, «Front
    sured at 8 positions)
    Disc Brake».

    SBR020B

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-16

    2014 Note

    REAR DRUM BRAKE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    REAR DRUM BRAKE

    A

    BRAKE LINING
    BRAKE LINING : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009364998

    B

    INSPECTION
    Brake Lining

    1.
    2.

    C

    Remove plug from back plate. Refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».
    Check brake lining wear thickness (A) from an inspection hole
    on back plate. Check using a scale if necessary.
    Wear thickness

    D

    : Refer to BR-45, «Rear Drum Brake».
    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J
    JSFIA1039ZZ

    BRAKE LINING : Brake Burnishing

    INFOID:0000000009671191

    K

    BRAKE BURNISHING
    Burnish contact surfaces between brake lining and brake drum according to the following procedure after
    refinishing brake drum, replacing brake drum, replacing brake lining, or if a soft pedal occurs at very low mileage:
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful of vehicle speed because the brake pedal does not operate firmly/securely until brake lining and brake drum are securely seated.
    • Only perform this procedure under safe road and traffic conditions. Use extreme caution.
    1. Drive vehicle on straight, flat road.
    2. Depress brake pedal with the power to stop vehicle within 3 to 5 seconds until the vehicle stops.
    3. Drive without depressing brake pedal for a few minutes to cool the brake.
    4. Repeat steps 1 to 3 until brake lining and brake drum are securely seated.

    BRAKE DRUM
    BRAKE DRUM : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009364999

    INSPECTION
    Appearance
    Check surface of brake drum for uneven wear, cracks and serious damage. Replace it if necessary. Refer to
    BR-40, «Removal and Installation».
    NOTE:
    • Make sure the parking brake control is fully released prior to removal of the brake drum.

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-17

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    REAR DRUM BRAKE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    • The rear wheel hub is part of the brake drum.
    Brake Drum Inner Diameter
    Check inner diameter (B) of the brake drum.

    Inner diameter : Refer to BR-45, «Rear Drum Brake».

    JPFIA0113ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-18

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PEDAL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    BRAKE PEDAL
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365000

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    AWFIA0875GB

    1.

    Snap pin

    2.

    Brake pedal

    3.

    Brake pedal pad

    4.

    Stop lamp switch

    5.

    Clip

    6.

    Clevis pin

    7.

    ASCD cancel switch (if equipped)

    K

    NOTE:
    The CVT brake pedal is shown. The M/T brake pedal is similar.

    Removal and Installation

    L
    INFOID:0000000009365001

    M

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove knee bolster. Refer to IP-14, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the stop lamp switch.
    Disconnect the harness connector from the ASCD cancel switch (if equipped).
    Disconnect the harness connector from the accelerator pedal. Remove the accelerator pedal. Refer to
    ACC-3, «Removal and Installation».
    6. Separate the harness from brake pedal.
    7. Rotate the stop lamp switch counter clockwise to remove.
    8. Rotate the ASCD cancel switch (if equipped) counter clockwise to remove.
    9. Remove snap pin and clevis pin from clevis.
    10. Disconnect the power steering harness connector and position it aside.
    11. Remove the brake pedal.
    CAUTION:
    Support the brake booster and master cylinder to prevent contact with other components.
    Revision: April 2013

    J

    BR-19

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    BRAKE PEDAL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    12. Perform the inspection after removal. Refer to BR-20, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Replace the brake pedal if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    • Apply the multi-purpose grease to the clevis pin and the mating faces. (Not necessary if grease has been
    already applied)
    NOTE:
    The clevis pin may be inserted in either direction.
    • Perform the adjustment after installation. Refer to BR-20, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009365002

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    • Check the brake pedal for damage and cracks on the welded parts, and replace the brake pedal if necessary.

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Inspect the brake pedal height and play. Adjust it if the measurement value is not the standard. Refer to BR8, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    • Perform the accelerator pedal released position learning procedure. Refer to EC-113, «Work Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-20

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BRAKE PIPING

    A

    FRONT
    FRONT : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365003

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ALFIA0217GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-21

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1.

    Master cylinder brake tube (second- 2.
    ary)

    Master cylinder brake tube (primary) 3.

    ABS actuator to brake tube connector (LH)

    4.

    ABS actuator to brake tube connec- 5.
    tor (RH)

    Brake tube connector

    6.

    Front brake tube (RH)

    7.

    Front brake tube (LH)

    Brake master cylinder

    9.

    Brake booster

    8.

    10. ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    11. Lock plate

    12. Front brake hose

    13. Copper sealing washer

    A.

    B.

    To front brake hose

    To rear brake tube

    Front

    FRONT : Hydraulic Piping

    INFOID:0000000009365004

    AWFIA0818GB

    1.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    2.

    Front disc brake

    3.

    Brake master cylinder

    4.

    Brake booster

    5.

    Brake tube connector

    6.

    Rear drum brake

    A.

    Brake tube

    B.

    Brake hose

    Flare nut

    Union bolt

    CAUTION:
    • All hoses and tubes must be free from excessive bending, twisting and pulling.
    • Make sure there is no interference with other parts when turning steering clockwise and counterclockwise.
    • The brake system is an important safety system. If a brake fluid leak is detected, always disassemble
    the parts. Replace applicable part with a new one, if necessary.
    • Do not bend or twist brake hose sharply, or strongly pull it.
    • When removing components, cover connections so that no dirt, dust, or other foreign matter gets in.
    • Do not reuse drained brake fluid.

    FRONT : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009365005

    CAUTION:
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the sub tank.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    Revision: April 2013

    BR-22

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Remove the wheel and tire using power tool.
    2. Loosen the flare nut using a flare nut wrench and separate the brake tube from the hose, and remove the
    brake tube.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not scratch the flare nut and the brake tube.
    • Do not bend sharply, twist or strongly pull out the brake hoses and tubes.
    3. Remove the union bolt, the copper sealing washers, and the brake hose from the brake caliper.
    4. Remove the lock plate and brake hose.

    A

    B

    C

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Assemble the union bolt (A) and the copper sealing washers (1)
    to the brake hose and install it to the caliper. Align the brake
    hose L-pin with the brake caliper hole, and tighten the union bolt
    (A) to the specified torque. Refer to BR-21, «FRONT : Exploded
    View».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse copper sealing washers.

    D

    E

    BR

    AWFIA0795ZZ

    2.

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Install the brake tube to the brake hose, temporarily tighten the flare nut by hand until it does not rotate
    further, and secure the brake hose to the bracket with the lock plate.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that all brake hoses and brake tubes are not excessively bent, kinked or twisted.
    • Make sure that interference does not exist between the brake hoses and other parts when turning the steering wheel clockwise and counterclockwise.
    Tighten the flare nut to the specified torque using a crowfoot and torque wrench.
    CAUTION:
    Do not scratch the flare nut and the brake tube.
    Refill with new brake fluid and perform the air bleeding. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    Install the wheel and tire. Refer to WT-8, «Exploded View».
    Perform inspection after installation. Refer to BR-23, «FRONT : Inspection».

    FRONT : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009365006

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.

    2.

    Check the brake hoses and tubes for the following: no scratches; no twist and deformation; no interference with other components when steering the steering wheel; no looseness at connections.
    CAUTION:
    Clearance with brake hose and each parts being secured more than 10 mm (0.39 in) in unladen
    condition*.
    *: Fuel, engine coolant and lubricant are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools and mats are in designated positions.
    Depress the brake pedal with a force of 785 N (80.1 kg-f, 176.5 lb-f) and hold down the brake pedal for
    approximately 5 seconds with the engine running. Check for any fluid leaks.
    CAUTION:
    Retighten the applicable connection to the specified torque and repair any abnormal (damaged,
    worn or deformed) part if any brake fluid leaks are present.

    REAR

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-23

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    BRAKE PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365007

    AWFIA0820GB

    1.

    Rear brake tube (RH)

    2.

    Rear brake tube (LH)

    3.

    Lock plate

    4.

    Rear brake hose

    5.

    Wheel cylinder brake tube

    A.

    To rear brake hose

    B.

    To brake tube connector

    Front

    REAR : Hydraulic Piping

    INFOID:0000000009365008

    AWFIA0818GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-24

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    2.

    Front disc brake

    3.

    Brake master cylinder

    4.

    Brake booster

    5.

    Brake tube connector

    6.

    Rear drum brake

    A.

    Brake tube

    B.

    Brake hose

    : Flare nut

    A

    B

    Union bolt

    CAUTION:
    • All hoses and tubes must be free from excessive bending, twisting and pulling.
    • Make sure there is no interference with other parts when turning steering clockwise and counterclockwise.
    • The brake system is an important safety system. If a brake fluid leak is detected, always disassemble
    the parts. Replace applicable part with a new one, if necessary.
    • Do not bend or twist brake hose sharply, or strongly pull it.
    • When removing components, cover connections so that no dirt, dust, or other foreign matter gets in.
    • Do not reuse drained brake fluid.

    REAR : Removal and Installation

    C

    D

    E

    INFOID:0000000009365009

    CAUTION:
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    BR

    G

    H

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    3.
    4.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool.
    Loosen the flare nut using a flare nut wrench and separate the brake tube from the brake hose.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not scratch the flare nut or the brake tube.
    • Do not bend sharply, twist or strongly pull out the brake hoses and brake tubes.
    Remove the lock plate and remove the brake hose from the vehicle.
    Loosen the flare nut using a flare nut wrench and separate the brake tube from the wheel cylinder.
    Remove the brake tube.

    I

    J

    K

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    3.

    4.
    5.
    6.

    Connect the brake tube to the wheel cylinder. Temporarily tighten the flare nut by hand until it does not
    rotate further.
    Connect the brake hose to the brake tube. Temporarily tighten the flare nut by hand until it does not rotate
    further. Secure the brake hose to the bracket with the lock plate.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that all brake hoses and brake tubes are not excessively bent, kinked or twisted.
    • Make sure that interference does not exist between the brake hoses and other parts when the
    suspension moves.
    Tighten the flare nut to the specified torque using a crowfoot and torque wrench. Refer to BR-24, «REAR :
    Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Do not scratch the flare nut or the brake tube.
    Refill with new brake fluid and perform the air bleeding. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    Install the wheel and tire. Refer to WT-8, «Exploded View».
    Perform inspection after installation. Refer to BR-25, «REAR : Inspection».

    REAR : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009365010

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    BR-25

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    BRAKE PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Check the brake hoses and tubes for the following: no scratches; no twist and deformation; no looseness
    at connections.
    CAUTION:
    Clearance with brake hose and each parts being secured more than 10 mm (0.39 in) in unladen
    condition*.
    *: Fuel, engine coolant and lubricant are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools and mats are in designated positions.
    2. Depress the brake pedal with a force of 785 N (80.1 kg-f, 176.5 lb-f) and hold down the pedal for approximately 5 seconds with the engine running. Check for any fluid leaks.
    CAUTION:
    Retighten the applicable connection to the specified torque and repair any abnormal (damaged,
    worn or deformed) part if any brake fluid leaks are present.

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-26

    2014 Note

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365011

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I
    AWFIA1021ZZ

    1.

    Reservoir cap

    2.

    Brake fluid strainer

    3.

    Reservoir tank

    4.

    Grommet

    5.

    Brake master cylinder

    6.

    Brake fluid level switch

    7.

    O-ring

    Apply brake fluid

    Removal and Installation

    J

    PBC (Poly Butyl Cuprysil) grease or
    silicone-based grease
    INFOID:0000000009365012

    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to splash brake fluid on painted areas; it may cause paint damage. If brake fluid is
    splashed on painted areas, wash it away with water immediately.
    • Do not scratch the piston of brake master cylinder when installing/removing because the piston is
    exposed. Check for any dust on the piston, and wash with brake fluid if needed.
    • Hold the brake master cylinder when handing the brake master cylinder. Do not hold the piston
    because the piston might become detached if pulled strongly.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove battery tray. Refer to PG-70, «Removal and Installation (Battery Tray)».
    Remove air cleaner and air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    Position the IPDM E/R aside to obtain access to the brake master cylinder. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal
    and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the brake fluid level switch.
    Disconnect the brake tubes from the brake master cylinder using a flare nut wrench.
    CAUTION:
    Do not scratch the flare nut or the brake tubes.
    Remove nuts and brake master cylinder.

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    M

    N

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    K

    BR-27

    2014 Note

    P

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    CAUTION:
    • Do not bend sharply, twist, or strongly pull out the brake tubes.
    • Do not depress the brake pedal after the brake master cylinder is removed.
    • The piston of the brake master cylinder is exposed. Do not damage it when removing the brake
    master cylinder.
    7. Remove and discard the O-ring.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse the seal.
    • Do not reuse the O-ring.
    • Check that no dirt and dust are present on the piston before installation. Clean it with new brake fluid
    if necessary.
    • Check that all brake tubes are not excessively bent, kinked or twisted.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the sub tank and reservoir tank.
    • Apply silicone grease to the brake booster (A) as shown when
    installing the brake master cylinder to the brake booster.

    JPFIA0013ZZ

    • Temporarily tighten the brake tube flare nut to the brake master cylinder by hand. Then tighten it to the specified torque using a crowfoot and torque wrench. Refer to BR-21, «FRONT : Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Do not scratch the flare nut or the brake tubes.
    • After installation, perform the air bleeding. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Perform the inspection after installation. Refer to BR-28, «Inspection».

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009365013

    DISASSEMBLY
    CAUTION:
    • Do not disassemble the brake master cylinder.
    • Remove the reservoir tank only when necessary.
    Remove the reservoir tank and grommets from the brake master cylinder.

    ASSEMBLY
    CAUTION:
    • Do not use mineral oils such as kerosene or gasoline and rubber grease during the cleaning and
    assembly process.
    • Do not drop the parts. The parts must not be reused if they are dropped.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    1. Apply new brake fluid to the grommets and install on brake master cylinder.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the grommets.
    2. Install the reservoir tank to the brake master cylinder.

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009365014

    INSPECTION BEFORE REMOVAL
    Revision: April 2013

    BR-28

    2014 Note

    BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check the brake fluid level switch. Refer to BR-13, «Inspection».
    A

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check the following items and replace if necessary.
    • Check the brake master cylinder for deformation, twist, contact with other parts or looseness of connection.
    • Check for fluid leaks from connections. Refer to BR-23, «FRONT : Inspection».
    CAUTION:
    If fluid leaks are present, retighten connections to the specified torque. Refer to BR-21, «FRONT :
    Exploded View». Replace components if necessary.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-29

    2014 Note

    BRAKE BOOSTER AND CHECK VALVE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BRAKE BOOSTER AND CHECK VALVE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365015

    AWFIA1022ZZ

    1.

    Brake master cylinder

    2.

    Check valve

    3.

    Brake booster

    4.

    Lock nut

    5.

    Clevis

    6.

    Gasket

    Removal and installation

    INFOID:0000000009365016

    CAUTION:
    Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe it
    off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Remove brake master cylinder. Refer to BR-27, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove battery tray. Refer to PG-70, «Removal and Installation (Battery Tray)».
    Remove ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove TCM (if equipped). Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove vacuum hose from check valve. Refer to BR-32, «Exploded View».
    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove knee bolster. Refer to IP-14, «Exploded View».
    Remove the snap pin (1) and clevis pin (2). Refer to BR-19,
    «Exploded View».
    9. Remove nuts on brake booster and brake pedal. Refer to BR19, «Exploded View».
    10. Remove brake booster from dash panel on engine room side.
    CAUTION:
    Do not deform or bend the brake tubes.
    NOTE:
    If removing brake booster is difficult, remove clevis from brake
    booster.
    11. Remove check valve from brake booster.
    12. Perform inspection after removal. Refer to BR-31, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    JPFIA0019ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Do not reuse the gasket.
    Revision: April 2013

    BR-30

    2014 Note

    BRAKE BOOSTER AND CHECK VALVE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Be careful not to damage brake booster stud bolt threads. If brake booster is tilted during installation, the dash panel may damage the threads.
    • Check that all brake tubes are not excessively bent, kinked or twisted.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Set check valve angle (A) as shown.
    Check valve angle

    : 45°

    A

    B

    C

    • After installation, perform the air bleeding. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Perform the inspection after installation. Adjust the brake pedal
    height and play if necessary. Refer to BR-8, «Inspection and
    Adjustment».

    D

    E
    JPFIA0871ZZ

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009365017

    BR

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check Valve Vacuum Inspection

    1.

    G

    Check the vacuum using a suitable tool.
    When connected to the booster side
    When connected to the vacuum hose side

    2.

    : Refer to BR-44, «Check Valve».
    : Refer to BR-44, «Check Valve».

    H

    If the vacuum still cannot be maintained, replace the check valve.
    I

    Input Rod Length Inspection

    1.

    Loosen the lock nut (1) and adjust the input rod (2) to the specified length (A).
    Input rod
    length

    2.

    J

    : Refer to BR-44, «Brake Booster».
    K

    Tighten the lock nut to the specified torque. Refer to BR-30,
    «Exploded View».

    L
    JPFIA0238ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    M

    Inspect the brake booster operation. Refer to BR-14, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Inspect the brake pedal height and play. Adjust it if the measurement is not the standard. Refer to BR-8,
    «Inspection and Adjustment».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-31

    2014 Note

    VACUUM LINES
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    VACUUM LINES
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365018

    JSFIA0997ZZ

    1.

    Clamp

    2.

    Vacuum hose

    3.

    Vacuum piping

    A.

    To brake booster

    B.

    Paint mark

    C.

    To intake manifold

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009365019

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the air cleaner and air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the vacuum hose and vacuum piping.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • When installing vacuum hose, insert until tip reaches the back-end
    of length (A) or further as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use lubricating oil during assembly.
    Length

    : 24 mm (0.94 in) or more

    — Face the paint mark of vacuum hose (intake manifold side) upward
    to assemble.
    — Face the other paint marks of vacuum hose to the vehicle front
    side to assemble.
    JPFIA0023ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009365020

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Appearance

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-32

    2014 Note

    VACUUM LINES
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check for correct assembly, damage and deterioration.
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-33

    2014 Note

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    BRAKE PAD
    BRAKE PAD : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365021

    AWFIA1020ZZ

    1.

    Cylinder body

    2.

    Inner shim

    3.

    Inner pad (with pad wear sensor)

    4.

    Pad return spring

    5.

    Pad retainer

    6.

    Torque member

    7.

    Outer pad

    8.

    Outer shim

    Apply MOLYKOTE® 7439 or equivalent.

    BRAKE PAD : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009365022

    WARNING:
    Clean any dust from the front brake and rear brake with a vacuum dust collector. Do not blow with
    compressed air.
    CAUTION:
    • While removing caliper, do not depress the brake pedal because the piston will pop out.
    • It is not necessary to remove bolts on torque member and brake hose except for disassembly or
    replacement of front disc brake caliper. In this case, hang front disc brake caliper with a wire so as
    not to stretch brake hose.
    • Do not damage piston boot.
    • Keep disc brake rotor and brake pads free from brake fluid and grease.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    Remove the front wheel and tire using power tool.
    Remove sliding pin bolts.
    Suspend the cylinder body with suitable wire in a position so that the brake hose will not stretch. Then
    remove the pad return springs, brake pads, shims and pad retainers from the torque member.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not deform the pad return springs or pad retainers when servicing the brake pads.
    • Note the position of the brake pads during removal to aid installation.
    Perform inspection after removal. Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE PAD : Inspection».

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Install the pad retainers to the torque member.
    CAUTION:
    • Install the pad retainers so that they will not be lifted up from the torque member.
    • Do not deform the pad retainers.

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-34

    2014 Note

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2.
    3.

    4.

    5.

    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    Apply MOLYKOTE® 7439 or equivalent to the to the mating surfaces between the shims and the brake
    A
    pads.
    Install the brake pads and shims to the torque member.
    CAUTION:
    • Replace the brake pads and shims if they have been dropped or sustained and impact.
    B
    • If any shim is damaged by corrosion, replace it.
    • Always replace shims and brake pads as a set.
    Install the pad return springs to the brake pads.
    C
    CAUTION:
    • Do not deform the pad return springs.
    • Correctly insert the pad return spring into the pad return spring hole on the brake pad.
    D
    Install cylinder body to torque member.
    CAUTION:
    When installing new brake pads, check the brake fluid level in the reservoir tank because brake
    E
    fluid returns to the reservoir tank when pressing piston in.
    NOTE:
    Use a disc brake piston tool to press piston into the cylinder body.
    Install the sliding pin bolts and tighten to the specified torque. Refer to BR-34, «BRAKE PAD : Exploded BR
    View».
    Depress the brake pedal several times to verify that brake drag does not exist for the front disc brake.
    Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE PAD : Inspection».
    G
    Install the front wheel and tire. Refer to WT-8, «Exploded View».
    Perform the inspection after installation. Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE PAD : Inspection».
    H

    BRAKE PAD : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009365023

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL

    I

    If any shim is subject to serious corrosion, replace it with a new one.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.
    a.
    b.
    c.
    d.
    e.
    2.

    Check drag of front disc brake. If any drag is found, follow the procedure described below:
    Remove brake pads. Refer to BR-34, «BRAKE PAD : Removal and Installation».
    Press the piston.
    Install brake pads. Refer to BR-34, «BRAKE PAD : Removal and Installation».
    Securely depress the brake pedal several times.
    Check drag of front disc brake again. If any drag is found, disassemble the cylinder body and replace if
    necessary. Refer to BR-37, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Disassembly and Assembly».
    Burnish the brake pads and disc brake rotor mutually contacting surfaces, after refinishing or replacing
    disc brake rotors, after replacing brake pads, or if a soft pedal occurs at very low mileage. Refer to BR-15,
    «BRAKE PAD : Brake Burnishing».

    J

    K

    L

    M

    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365024

    N

    REMOVAL
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-35

    2014 Note

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    JPFIA0510GB

    1. Brake caliper

    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009365025

    WARNING:
    Clean any dust from the brake caliper and brake pads with a vacuum dust collector. Do not blow with
    compressed air.
    CAUTION:
    • While removing caliper, do not depress the brake pedal because the piston will pop out.
    • Do not damage piston boot.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    off immediately and wash with water if brake fluid spills on painted surfaces.
    • Keep disc brake rotor free from brake fluid.
    • Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the front wheel and tire using power tool.
    Remove union bolt and disconnect brake hose from brake caliper. Discard the copper sealing washers.
    Remove bolts and torque member including brake caliper.
    Remove disc brake rotor. If reusing the disc brake rotor, apply matching marks on the wheel hub and disc
    brake rotor to aid installation.
    CAUTION:
    Put matching marks on the wheel hub and disc brake rotor, if it is necessary to remove disc brake
    rotor.

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    2.

    Install disc brake rotor, align the matching marks if installing the original disc brake rotor.
    CAUTION:
    • Replace the disc brake rotor if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    • Align the marks on disc brake rotor and wheel hub at the time of installation when reusing disc
    brake rotor.
    Install the torque member including brake caliper to the steering knuckle and tighten the torque member
    bolts to the specified torque. Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    • Replace the torque member if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-36

    2014 Note

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Do not allow oil or any moisture on all contact surfaces between steering knuckle and torque
    member, and bolts.
    3. Install brake hose to brake caliper with new copper sealing
    washers (1). Tighten union bolt (A) to the specified torque. Refer
    to BR-21, «FRONT : Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse copper sealing washers.

    A

    B

    C

    D
    AWFIA0795ZZ

    4.
    5.
    6.

    Refill reservoir tank with new brake fluid and bleed air from the brake hydraulic system. Refer to BR-12, E
    «Bleeding Brake System».
    Install the front wheel and tire. Refer to WT-8, «Exploded View».
    Perform the inspection after installation. Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE PAD : Inspection».
    BR

    BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009365026

    G

    DISASSEMBLY

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    AWFIA1018ZZ

    M
    1.

    Cap

    4.

    Piston seal

    5.

    Piston

    6.

    Piston boot

    7.

    Sliding pin

    8.

    Sliding pin boot

    9.

    Bushing

    10. Torque member

    2.

    Bleeder valve

    Apply Syntheso® GLK 1 grease or
    equivalent.

    3.

    Cylinder body

    N

    Apply clean brake fluid

    WARNING:
    Clean dust on brake caliper and brake pad with a vacuum dust collector to minimize the hazard of airborne particles or other materials.
    CAUTION:
    • While removing brake caliper, do not depress brake pedal because piston will pop out.
    • Do not damage the piston boot.
    NOTE:
    • The front brake caliper (LH) is shown. The front brake caliper (RH) is similar.
    • Do not remove the pad return springs, brake pads, and pad retainers from the torque member when disassembling and assembling the brake caliper.

    DISASSEMBLY
    Revision: April 2013

    BR-37

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Remove the sliding pin bolts and the cylinder body from the torque member.
    2. Remove the sliding pins and the sliding pin boots.
    3. Remove the bushing from the sliding pin.
    4. Place a wooden block as shown, and blow air from union bolt
    mounting hole to remove piston and piston boot.
    WARNING:
    Do not get fingers caught between the piston and wooden
    block.

    MAA0272D

    5.
    6.
    7.

    Remove piston seal from cylinder body using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage cylinder inner wall.
    Remove bleeder valve and cap.
    Perform inspection after disassembly.

    JPFIA0738ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Brake Caliper
    Check the inner wall of brake caliper for corrosion, wear, and damage. Replace as necessary.
    CAUTION:
    Clean the brake caliper using new brake fluid. Do not use mineral oils such as gasoline or kerosene.
    Torque Member
    Check torque member for wear, cracks, and damage. Replace as necessary.
    Piston
    Check the piston surface for corrosion, wear, and damage. Replace as necessary.
    CAUTION:
    The piston sliding surface is plated. Do not polish with sandpaper.
    Sliding Pins, Sliding Pin Bolts, Sliding Pin Boot
    Check the sliding pins, sliding pin bolts, and sliding pin boots for wear, damage, and cracks. Replace as necessary.

    ASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.

    Install bleeder valve and cap.
    Apply clean brake fluid to new piston seal (1), and install to
    groove in cylinder body.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse piston seal.

    JPFIA0039ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-38

    2014 Note

    FRONT DISC BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Apply Syntheso® GLK 1 grease or equivalent to piston boot (1).
    Cover the piston (2) end with new piston boot, and then install
    cylinder side lip on piston boot securely into a groove on cylinder
    body.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse piston boot.

    A

    B

    C
    JPFIA0739ZZ

    4.

    D

    Push piston (1) into cylinder body by hand and push piston boot
    (2) piston-side lip into the piston groove.
    CAUTION:
    Press the piston evenly and vary the pressing point to prevent cylinder inner wall from being rubbed.

    E

    BR

    G
    JPFIA0034ZZ

    5.
    6.

    Apply rubber grease to the mating surfaces (A) of the sliding pin
    (1) and the bushing (2).
    Install the bushing to the sliding pin.

    H

    I

    J

    JPFIA0836ZZ

    7.
    8.

    Apply rubber grease to the mating surfaces of the sliding pins
    (1) and the sliding pin boots (2).
    Install the sliding pins and sliding pin boots to the torque member (3).

    K

    L

    M

    N
    JPFIA0837ZZ

    9.

    Install the cylinder body to the torque member with the sliding pin bolts. Refer to BR-34, «BRAKE PAD :
    Exploded View».

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-39

    2014 Note

    REAR DRUM BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DRUM BRAKE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365027

    AWFIA1019ZZ

    1.

    Shoe hold pin

    2.

    Back plate

    3.

    Plug

    4.

    Brake shoe

    5.

    Retainer

    6.

    Upper spring

    7.

    Adjuster

    8.

    Return spring

    9.

    Brake drum

    10. Boot

    11. Piston

    12.

    Piston cup

    13. Spring

    14. Wheel cylinder

    15.

    Bleeder valve

    16. Cap
    1: Apply Syntheso® GLEP1 grease or equivalent.
    2: Apply Molyguard GS 2039 grease or equivalent.
    : Apply clean brake fluid

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009365028

    WARNING:
    Clean any dust from the front brake and rear brake with a vacuum dust collector. Do not blow with
    compressed air.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not depress the brake pedal while removing the brake drum because the pistons may pop out.
    Revision: April 2013

    BR-40

    2014 Note

    REAR DRUM BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Do not drop the removed parts.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on the brake drum.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    3.

    4.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Exploded View».
    Remove the brake drum. Refer to RAX-6, «Removal and Installation».
    NOTE:
    • Make sure the parking brake is fully released prior to removal of the brake drum.
    • The rear wheel hub is part of the brake drum.
    Remove the retainers (1) by pushing them inward toward the
    vehicle and rotating. This will release the shoe hold pins, brake
    shoes, each retainer, and adjuster.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the wheel cylinder boots.
    Disconnect the parking brake cable from operating lever.
    CAUTION:
    Do not bend the operating lever.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G
    JSFIA0636ZZ

    5.
    6.
    a.
    b.
    7.

    H

    Disassemble the brake shoes, each spring, and adjuster.
    Remove the wheel cylinder using the following procedure:
    Disconnect the brake tube from the wheel cylinder.
    Remove the two bolts and wheel cylinder from back plate.
    Perform inspection after removal. Refer to BR-42, «Inspection
    and Adjustment».

    I

    J

    JSFIA1056ZZ

    K

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    • Replace the parts if they have been dropped or sustained an impact.
    • Do not damage the wheel cylinder.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    Installation is in the reverse of removal.
    • Check the difference between left and right adjuster.
    : Front

    L

    M

    N
    Adjuster

    Direction

    Left side

    Left screw

    Right side

    Right screw

    O

    • Shorten the length of the adjuster by rotating it.
    • For grease type and placement, refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».

    P
    JPFIA0904ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-41

    2014 Note

    REAR DRUM BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check drum brake components for proper installation.
    • Check the brake shoe linings and brake drum inner surface for
    grease. Make sure that grease does not contact the lining material
    or drum inner surface.
    • Perform the air bleeding after installing a new or rebuilt wheel cylinder. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    • Step on the brake pedal several times after installing the brake
    drum.
    • Perform the inspection after installation. Refer to BR-42, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    JSFIA0637ZZ

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009365029

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.

    3.
    4.

    Remove boots from wheel cylinder. Refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».
    Remove pistons, piston cups and spring from wheel cylinder.
    CAUTION:
    Pull the pistons out from the wheel cylinder to prevent the wheel cylinder inner wall from being
    damaged.
    Remove piston cups from pistons.
    Perform inspection after disassembly. Refer to BR-42, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    ASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    5.
    6.

    Apply clean brake fluid to the new piston cups (1) and pistons
    (3).
    Apply Syntheso® GLEP1 grease or equivalent to boots (2).
    Install piston cups and new boots to pistons (3).
    CAUTION:
    • Do not mistake the direction of pistons.
    • Do not reuse piston cups and boots.
    Apply clean brake fluid to wheel cylinder inner wall, and install
    spring and pistons into wheel cylinder.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the wheel cylinder inner wall.
    Install boots to wheel cylinder. Refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».
    Perform inspection after assembly. Refer to BR-42, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    Inspection and Adjustment

    JPFIA0915ZZ

    INFOID:0000000009365030

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check the following items and replace if necessary.
    • Check the brake shoe lining for excessive wear, damage, and peeling.
    • Check each spring for settling, excessive wear, damage, and rust.
    • Check the adjuster for smoothness, and check it for excessive wear, damage, and rust.
    • Check the back plate for damage, cracks, and deformation.
    • Check the wheel cylinder for cracks, damage, and leaks.
    • Visually check the brake drum for excessive wear, cracks, and damage.

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Check the following items and replace if necessary.
    • Check the wheel cylinder inner wall for excessive wear, cracks, and damage.
    • Check the pistons for excessive wear and damage.

    INSPECTION AFTER ASSEMBLY
    Check that the pistons move smoothly.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.

    Check that the drum brake component parts are installed properly.

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-42

    2014 Note

    REAR DRUM BRAKE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Rotate the brake drum and check that there is no drag. Perform the following procedure if necessary:
    a. Remove the brake shoes. Refer to BR-40, «Removal and Installation».
    b. Push the pistons.
    CAUTION:
    Push both side of the piston simultaneously.
    c. Install the brake shoes. Refer to BR-40, «Removal and Installation».
    3. Inspect and adjust the parking brake. Refer to PB-4, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    4. Check drag of rear drum brake again. If any drag is found, disassemble the wheel cylinder and replace if
    necessary. Refer to BR-42, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    5. Perform brake burnishing. Refer to BR-17, «BRAKE LINING : Brake Burnishing».

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-43

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    General Specifications

    INFOID:0000000009365031

    Unit: mm (in)

    Cylinder bore diameter
    Front brake

    54.025 (2.13)

    Pad length × width × thickness

    115.0 × 42.0 × 9.0 (4.53 × 1.654 × 0.354)

    Rotor outer diameter × thickness

    260 × 22.0 (10.24 × 0.87)

    Cylinder bore diameter
    Rear brake

    19.05 (3/4)
    Trailing: 172 × 37 × 4.8 (6.77 × 1.46 × 0.19)
    Leading: 155 × 37 × 4.8 (6.10 ×1.46 × 0.19)

    Lining length × width × thickness
    Drum inner diameter — new

    203.2 (8.00)

    Master cylinder

    Cylinder bore diameter

    22.23 (0.875)

    Control valve

    Valve type

    Brake booster

    Diaphragm diameter

    Electric brake force distribution
    255 (10)

    Recommended brake fluid

    Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    Brake Pedal

    INFOID:0000000009365032

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item

    Standard
    158 ±5 (6.22 ±0.20)

    Brake pedal height
    Clearance between brake pedal lever and the stop lamp switch threaded end

    0.2 – 1.96 (0.008 – 0.077)

    Brake pedal full stroke

    128 (5.04)

    Check Valve

    INFOID:0000000009641742

    Vacuum applied at intake manifold side.

    0 kPa (0 mmHg, 0 inHg)

    Vacuum leakage
    [at vacuum of -66.7 kPa (-500 mmHg, -19.69 inHg) applied at
    booster side.]

    Within 1.3 kPa (10 mmHg, 0.39 inHg) of vacuum for 15 seconds.

    Brake Booster

    INFOID:0000000009365033

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item

    Standard

    Input rod length

    125 (4.92)

    Front Disc Brake

    INFOID:0000000009365034

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item
    Brake pad

    Disc rotor

    Revision: April 2013

    Limit

    Wear thickness

    2.0 (0.08)

    Wear thickness

    20.0 (0.787)

    Thickness variation (measured at 8 positions)

    0.013 (0.001)

    Runout (with it attached to the vehicle)

    0.055 (0.002)

    BR-44

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Rear Drum Brake

    INFOID:0000000009365035

    A
    Unit: mm (in)

    Item
    Brake lining

    Wear thickness

    Brake drum

    Wear inner diameter- maximum

    Limit

    B

    1.0 (0.04)
    204.2 (8.04)

    C

    D

    E

    BR

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BR-45

    2014 Note

    BRAKES

    SECTION

    BRC

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 22 BRC

    ABS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Brake System ……………………………… 3
    Precaution for Brake Control System …………………… 4
    Precaution for Harness Repair ……………………………. 4

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 5

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT
    (CONTROL UNIT) ……………………………………… 22
    Reference Value ………………………………………………22
    Fail-safe ………………………………………………………….24
    DTC Inspection Priority Chart …………………………….25
    DTC Index ………………………………………………………26

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM ……………………… 27

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 34
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW ……. 34

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 6

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….34
    Diagnostic Work Sheet ……………………………………..35

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 6

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 36

    ABS …………………………………………………………………… 9
    ABS : System Diagram ……………………………………… 9
    ABS : System Description ………………………………….. 9
    ABS : ABS Function ………………………………………… 14
    ABS : EBD Function ………………………………………… 15
    ABS : Fail-safe ……………………………………………….. 16

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM [ABS ACTUATOR
    AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)] ……..19
    CONSULT Function (ABS) ……………………………….. 19

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..27

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 5
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 5

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 9

    H

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 27

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 5

    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 6
    Component Description ……………………………………… 7
    ABS Actuator and Electric Unit (Control Unit) ……….. 7
    Wheel Sensor and Sensor Rotor ………………………… 7
    Stop Lamp Switch …………………………………………….. 8
    Brake Fluid Level Switch ……………………………………. 8
    Parking Brake Switch ………………………………………… 8

    G

    J

    K

    L

    C1101, C1102, C1103, C1104 WHEEL SENSOR …………………………………………………………. 36
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….36
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..36

    M

    C1105, C1106, C1107, C1108 WHEEL SENSOR …………………………………………………………. 40

    N

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….40
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..40

    C1109 POWER AND GROUND SYSTEM …….. 42
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….42
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..42

    C1110 CONTROL FAILURE ……………………….. 44
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….44
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..44

    C1111 PUMP MOTOR ……………………………….. 45
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….45

    BRC-1

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 45

    C1115 ABS SENSOR [ABNORMAL SIGNAL]… 47
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 47
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 47

    C1120, C1122, C1124, C1126 ABS IN VALVE
    SYSTEM ……………………………………………………. 49
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 49
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 49

    C1121, C1123, C1125, C1127 ABS OUT
    VALVE SYSTEM ………………………………………… 51
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 51
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 51

    C1130 ENGINE SIGNAL …………………………….. 53

    EXCESSIVE ABS FUNCTION OPERATION
    FREQUENCY …………………………………………….. 63
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 63

    UNEXPECTED PEDAL REACTION ……………… 64
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 64

    THE BRAKING DISTANCE IS LONG …………… 65
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 65

    ABS FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE ………. 66
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 66

    PEDAL VIBRATION OR ABS OPERATION
    SOUND OCCURS ………………………………………. 67
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 67

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 53
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 53

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION ……………. 68

    C1140 ACTUATOR RELAY SYSTEM …………… 54

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ………….. 69

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 54
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 54

    WHEEL SENSOR ………………………………………. 69

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ………………………. 56
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 56
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 56

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ……………………. 57
    Description …………………………………………………….. 57
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 57
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 57

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ………………………… 58
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 58
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 58
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 59

    ABS WARNING LAMP ……………………………….. 60
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 60
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 60

    BRAKE WARNING LAMP …………………………… 61

    Description …………………………………………………….. 68

    FRONT WHEEL SENSOR …………………………………. 69
    FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Exploded View ……….. 69
    FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………….. 69
    REAR WHEEL SENSOR ……………………………………. 70
    REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Exploded View …………. 70
    REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………………….. 70

    SENSOR ROTOR ………………………………………. 72
    FRONT SENSOR ROTOR …………………………………. 72
    FRONT SENSOR ROTOR : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………….. 72
    REAR SENSOR ROTOR ……………………………………. 72
    REAR SENSOR ROTOR : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………………….. 72

    Component Function Check …………………………….. 61
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 61

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT
    (CONTROL UNIT) ………………………………………. 73

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………….. 62

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 73
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 73

    ABS ………………………………………………………….. 62
    Symptom Table ……………………………………………… 62

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [ABS]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009619483

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along C
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    D
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    E
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    BRC
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.
    G

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS

    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Brake System

    INFOID:0000000009619484

    WARNING:
    Clean any dust from the front brake and rear brake using a vacuum dust collector. Do not blow by
    compressed air.
    • Brake fluid use refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe it off
    immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Always confirm the specified tightening torque when installing the brake pipes.
    • After pressing the brake pedal more deeply or harder than normal driving, such as air bleeding, check each
    item of brake pedal. Adjust brake pedal if it is outside the standard value.
    • Do not use mineral oils such as gasoline or light oil to clean. They may damage rubber parts and cause
    improper operation.
    • Always loosen the brake tube flare nut with a flare nut wrench.
    • Tighten the brake tube flare nut to the specified torque with a crowfoot (A) and torque wrench (B).
    • Always connect the battery terminal when moving the vehicle.
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the ABS actuator and
    electric unit (control unit) harness connector or the battery negative
    terminal before performing the work.
    • Check that no brake fluid leakage is present after replacing the
    parts.

    JPFIA0001ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-3

    2014 Note

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    [ABS]

    < PRECAUTION >

    Precaution for Brake Control System

    INFOID:0000000009619485

    • Just after starting vehicle after ignition switch is ON, brake pedal may vibrate or motor operating noise may
    be heard from engine compartment. This is a normal condition.
    • When an error is indicated by ABS or another warning lamp, collect all necessary information from customer
    (what symptoms are present under what conditions) and check for simple causes before starting diagnostic
    servicing. Besides electrical system inspection, check brake booster operation, brake fluid level and oil
    leaks.
    • If tire size and type are used in an improper combination or brake pads are not Genuine NISSAN parts, stopping distance or steering stability may deteriorate.
    • ABS might be out of order or malfunctions by putting a radio (wiring inclusive), an antenna and a lead-in wire
    near the control unit.
    • If aftermarket parts (car stereo, CD player, etc.) have been installed, check for incidents such as harness
    pinches, open circuits, and improper wiring.
    — When replacing the following parts with parts other than genuine parts or making modifications: Suspensionrelated parts (shock absorber, spring, bushing, etc.), tires, wheels (other than specified sizes), brake-related
    parts (pad, rotor, caliper, etc.), engine-related parts (muffler, ECM, etc.) and body reinforcement-related parts
    (roll bar, tower bar, etc.).
    — When driving with worn or deteriorated suspension, tires and brake-related parts.

    Precaution for Harness Repair

    INFOID:0000000009619486

    • Solder the repair part, and wrap it with tape. [Twisted wire fray
    must be 110 mm (4.33 in) or less.]

    SKIB8766E

    • Do not bypass the repair point with wire. (If it is bypassed, the turnout point cannot be separated and the twisted wire characteristics
    are lost.)

    SKIB8767E

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-4

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [ABS]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009619487

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV991J0080
    (J-45741)
    ABS active wheel sensor tester

    Checking operation of ABS active wheel sensors

    C

    D

    E
    WFIA0101E

    BRC

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009619488

    G

    Tool name

    Description

    1. Flare nut crowfoot
    2. Torque wrench

    Removing and installing brake piping
    a: 10mm (0.39 in)/12mm (0.47 in)

    H

    I
    S-NT360

    Power Tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    J

    K

    L

    PIIB1407E

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-5

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009365049

    ALFIA0360ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    A

    Parking brake switch
    (view with console removed)

    B

    Combination meter

    C

    IPDM E/R

    D

    Brake fluid level switch
    (view with IPDM E/R removed)

    E

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    F

    Front wheel sensor

    G

    Stop lamp switch

    H

    Rear wheel sensor

    Component Description

    A

    B
    INFOID:0000000009365050

    C
    No.

    Component

    Reference/Function

    1

    Parking brake switch

    BRC-8, «Parking Brake Switch»

    2

    Combination meter

    MWI-6, «METER SYSTEM : Combination Meter»

    3

    IPDM E/R

    PCS-4, «Component Parts Location»

    4

    Brake fluid level switch

    BRC-8, «Brake Fluid Level Switch»

    5

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    BRC-7, «ABS Actuator and Electric Unit (Control Unit)»

    6

    Front wheel speed sensor

    BRC-7, «Wheel Sensor and Sensor Rotor»

    7

    Stop lamp switch

    BRC-8, «Stop Lamp Switch»

    8

    Rear wheel speed sensor

    BRC-7, «Wheel Sensor and Sensor Rotor»

    ABS Actuator and Electric Unit (Control Unit)

    D

    E

    BRC

    G
    INFOID:0000000009365051

    Electric unit (control unit) is integrated with actuator and comprehensively controls ABS function and EBD
    function.

    ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)

    H

    I

    • Brake fluid pressure is controlled according to signals from each sensor.
    • If malfunction is detected, the system enters fail-safe mode.

    ACTUATOR

    J

    The following components are integrated with ABS actuator.
    Pump
    Returns the brake fluid reserved in reservoir to master cylinder by reducing pressure.

    K

    Motor
    Activates the pump according to signals from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    Motor Relay
    Operates the motor ON/OFF according to signals from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    Actuator Relay (Main Relay)
    Operates each valve ON/OFF according to signals from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    ABS IN Valve
    Switches the fluid pressure line to increase or hold according to signals from control unit.

    L

    M

    N

    ABS OUT Valve
    Switches the fluid pressure line to increase, hold or decrease according to signals from control unit.
    Return Check Valve
    Returns the brake fluid from brake caliper and wheel cylinder to master cylinder by bypassing orifice of each
    valve when brake is released.
    Reservoir
    Temporarily reserves the brake fluid drained from brake caliper, so that pressure efficiently decreases when
    decreasing pressure of brake caliper and wheel cylinder.

    Wheel Sensor and Sensor Rotor

    INFOID:0000000009365052

    NOTE:
    • Wheel sensor of front wheel is installed on steering knuckle.
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-7

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Sensor rotor of front wheel is integrated in wheel hub assembly.
    • Wheel sensor of rear wheel is installed on back plate of rear brake.
    • Sensor rotor of rear wheel is installed on rear brake drum.
    • Never measure resistance and voltage value using a tester because sensor is active sensor.
    • Downsize and weight reduction is aimed. IC for detection portion
    and magnet for sensor rotor are adopted.
    • Power supply is supplied to detection portion so that magnetic field
    line is read. Magnetic field that is detected is converted to current
    signal.
    • When sensor rotor rotates, magnetic field changes. Magnetic field
    change is converted to current signals (rectangular wave) and is
    transmitted to ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Change
    of magnetic field is proportional to wheel speed.

    [ABS]

    JPFIC0131GB

    Stop Lamp Switch

    INFOID:0000000009365053

    Detects the operation status of brake pedal and transmits converted electric signal to ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).

    Brake Fluid Level Switch

    INFOID:0000000009365056

    Detects the brake fluid level in reservoir tank and transmits converted electric signal from combination meter to
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN communication.

    Parking Brake Switch

    INFOID:0000000009365057

    Detects the operation status of parking brake switch and transmits converted electric signal from combination
    meter to ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN communication.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-8

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    ABS
    ABS : System Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009365058

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I
    ALFIA0392GB

    ABS : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009365059

    • The system switches fluid pressure of each brake caliper and each wheel cylinder to increase, to hold, or to
    decrease according to signals from control unit in ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). This control
    system is applied to ABS and EBD functions.
    • Fail-safe function is available for each function and is activated by each function when system malfunction
    occurs.

    INPUT SIGNAL AND OUTPUT SIGNAL

    J

    K

    L

    Major signal transmission between each unit via communication lines is shown in the following table.
    Component

    Combination meter

    M

    Signal description
    Transmits the following signals to ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN communication.
    • Brake fluid level switch signal
    • Parking brake switch signal
    Receives the following signals from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN communication.
    • ABS warning lamp signal
    • Brake warning lamp signal

    VALVE OPERATION (ABS AND EBD FUNCTIONS)
    The control unit built into the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) controls fluid pressure of the brake
    calipers by operating each valve.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-9

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Brake Pedal Applied or ABS Function Operating (Pressure Increases)

    JSFIA0679GB

    Name

    Not activated

    During pressure increases

    Cut valve 1

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Cut valve 2

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Suction valve 1

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Suction valve 2

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    ABS IN valve

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    ABS OUT valve

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Pressure increases

    Each brake caliper and each wheel cylinder
    (fluid pressure)

    Front RH brake caliper

    • When the cut valve 1 and the ABS IN valve opens, brake fluid is supplied to the front RH brake caliper from
    the master cylinder through the ABS IN valve. Brake fluid does not flow into the reservoir because the ABS
    OUT valve is closed.
    Front LH brake caliper

    • When the cut valve 2 and the ABS IN valve opens, brake fluid is supplied to the front LH brake caliper from
    the master cylinder through the ABS IN valve. Brake fluid does not flow into the reservoir because the ABS
    OUT valve is closed.
    Rear RH wheel cylinder

    • When the cut valve 2 and the ABS IN valve opens, brake fluid is supplied to the rear RH wheel cylinder from
    the master cylinder through the ABS IN valve. Brake fluid does not flow into the reservoir because the ABS
    OUT valve is closed.
    Rear LH wheel cylinder

    • When the cut valve 1 and the ABS IN valve opens, brake fluid is supplied to the rear LH wheel cylinder from
    the master cylinder through the ABS IN valve. Brake fluid does not flow into the reservoir because the ABS
    OUT valve is closed.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-10

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    ABS Function Starts Operating (Pressure Holds)

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H
    JSFIA0680GB

    Name

    Not activated

    During pressure holds

    Cut valve 1

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Cut valve 2

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Suction valve 1

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Suction valve 2

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    ABS IN valve

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is supplied (close)

    ABS OUT valve

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Pressure holds

    Each brake caliper and each wheel cylinder
    (fluid pressure)

    I

    J

    K

    L
    Front RH brake caliper

    • Since the ABS IN valve and the ABS OUT valve are closed, the front RH brake caliper, master cylinder, and
    reservoir are blocked. This maintains fluid pressure applied on the front RH brake caliper.

    M

    Front LH brake caliper

    • Since the ABS IN valve and the ABS OUT valve are closed, the front LH brake caliper, master cylinder, and
    reservoir are blocked. This maintains fluid pressure applied on the front LH brake caliper.
    Rear RH wheel cylinder

    • Since the ABS IN valve and the ABS OUT valve are closed, the rear RH wheel cylinder, master cylinder, and
    reservoir are blocked. This maintains fluid pressure applied on the rear RH wheel cylinder.
    Rear LH wheel cylinder

    • Since the ABS IN valve and the ABS OUT valve are closed, the rear LH wheel cylinder, master cylinder, and
    reservoir are blocked. This maintains fluid pressure applied on the rear LH wheel cylinder.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-11

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    ABS Function Operating (Pressure Decreases)

    JSFIA0681GB

    Name

    Not activated

    During pressure decreases

    Cut valve 1

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Cut valve 2

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Suction valve 1

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Suction valve 2

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    ABS IN valve

    Power supply is not supplied (open)

    Power supply is supplied (close)

    ABS OUT valve

    Power supply is not supplied (close)

    Power supply is supplied (open)

    Pressure decreases

    Each brake caliper and each wheel cylinder
    (fluid pressure)

    Front RH brake caliper

    • Since the ABS IN valve is closed and the ABS OUT valve is opened, fluid pressure applied on the front RH
    brake caliper is supplied to the reservoir through the ABS OUT valve. This fluid pressure decreases when
    sent to the master cylinder by the pump.
    Front LH brake caliper

    • Since the ABS IN valve is closed and the ABS OUT valve is opened, fluid pressure applied on the front LH
    brake caliper is supplied to the reservoir through the ABS OUT valve. This fluid pressure decreases when
    sent to the master cylinder by the pump.
    Rear RH wheel cylinder

    • Since the ABS IN valve is closed and the ABS OUT valve is opened, fluid pressure applied on the rear RH
    wheel cylinder is supplied to the reservoir through the ABS OUT valve. This fluid pressure decreases when
    sent to the master cylinder by the pump.
    Rear LH wheel cylinder

    • Since the ABS IN valve is closed and the ABS OUT valve is opened, fluid pressure applied on the rear LH
    wheel cylinder is supplied to the reservoir through the ABS OUT valve. This fluid pressure decreases when
    sent to the master cylinder by the pump.
    Component Parts and Function

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-12

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Component

    Function

    A

    Pump

    Returns the brake fluid reserved in reservoir to master cylinder by reducing pressure.

    Motor

    Activates the pump according to signals from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).

    ABS IN valve

    Switches the fluid pressure line to increase or hold according to signals from control unit.

    ABS OUT valve

    Switches the fluid pressure line to increase, hold or decrease according to signals from control unit.

    Return check valve

    Returns the brake fluid from brake caliper and wheel cylinder to master cylinder by bypassing orifice
    of each valve when brake is released.

    Reservoir

    Temporarily reserves the brake fluid drained from brake caliper, so that pressure efficiently decreases when decreasing pressure of brake caliper and wheel cylinder.

    B

    C

    D

    CONDITIONS FOR WARNING LAMP ILLUMINATION
    Turns ON when ignition switch turns ON and turns OFF when the system is normal, for bulb check purposes.
    E
    Condition (status)

    ABS warning lamp

    Brake warning lamp

    Ignition switch OFF

    OFF

    OFF

    For approx. 1 second after the ignition switch
    is turned ON

    ON

    ON

    Approx. 1 second after ignition switch is
    turned ON (when the system is in normal operation)

    OFF

    OFF

    After engine starts

    OFF

    OFF

    When parking brake operates (parking brake
    switch ON)

    OFF

    ON

    When brake fluid is less than the specified
    level (brake fluid level switch ON)

    OFF

    ON

    ABS function is malfunctioning

    ON

    OFF

    EBD function is malfunctioning

    ON

    ON

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-13

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    ABS : ABS Function

    INFOID:0000000009365062

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    AWFIA0808GB

    • By preventing wheel lock through brake force (brake fluid pressure) control that is electronically controlled by
    detecting wheel speed during braking, stability during emergency braking is improved so that obstacles can
    be easily bypassed by steering operation.
    • During braking, control units calculate wheel speed and pseudo-vehicle speed, and transmit pressure
    increase, hold or decrease signals to actuator portion according to wheel slip status.
    • The following effects are obtained by preventing wheel lock during
    braking.
    — Vehicle tail slip is prevented during braking when driving straight.
    — Understeer and oversteer tendencies are moderated during braking while cornering.
    — Obstacles may be easily bypassed by steering operation during
    braking.
    • CONSULT can be used to diagnose the system.
    • Fail-safe function is adopted. When a malfunction occurs in ABS
    function, the control is suspended for ABS function. However, EBD
    function operates normally. Refer to BRC-16, «ABS : Fail-safe».

    JPFIC0140GB

    INPUT SIGNAL AND OUTPUT SIGNAL
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-14

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Major signal transmission between each unit via communication lines is shown in the following table.
    A
    Component
    Combination meter

    Signal description
    Receives the following signals from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN communication.
    • ABS warning lamp signal

    ABS : EBD Function

    INFOID:0000000009667732

    B

    C

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AWFIA0808GB

    • By preventing rear wheel slip increase through rear wheel brake force (brake fluid pressure) control that is
    electronically controlled when slight skip on front and rear wheels are detected during braking, stability during braking is improved.
    • EBD function is expanded and developed from conventional ABS function and corrects rear wheel brake
    force to appropriate level by electronic control according to load weight (number of passengers).

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JPFIC0142GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-15

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • During braking, control unit portion compares slight slip on front
    and rear wheels by wheel speed sensor signal, transmits drive signal to actuator portion when rear wheel slip exceeds front wheel
    slip for the specified value or more, and controls rear wheel brake
    force (brake fluid pressure) so that increase of rear wheel slip is
    prevented and slips on front wheel and rear wheel are nearly
    equalized. ABS control is applied when slip on each wheel
    increases and wheel speed is the threshold value of ABS control or
    less.
    • CONSULT can be used to diagnose the system.
    • Fail-safe function is adopted. When a malfunction occurs in EBD
    function, the control is suspended for ABS function and EBD function. Refer to BRC-24, «Fail-safe».

    JPFIC0143GB

    INPUT SIGNAL AND OUTPUT SIGNAL
    Major signal transmission between each unit via communication lines is shown in the following table.
    Component
    Combination meter

    Signal description
    Mainly receives the following signals from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN
    communication.
    • Brake warning lamp signal

    ABS : Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009365064

    ABS FUNCTION
    ABS warning lamp in combination meter turns ON when a malfunction occurs in system [ABS actuator and
    electric unit (control unit)]. The control is suspended for ABS functions. However, EBD functions operate normally.

    EBD FUNCTION
    ABS warning lamp and brake warning lamp in combination meter turn ON when a malfunction occurs in system [ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)]. The control is suspended for ABS and EBD functions.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-16

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    DTC

    Malfunction detected condition

    C1101

    When an open circuit is detected in rear RH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1102

    When an open circuit is detected in rear LH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1103

    When an open circuit is detected in front RH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1104

    When an open circuit is detected in front LH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1105

    • When a short circuit is detected in rear RH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of rear RH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Rear RH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Rear RH wheel sensor power supply voltage
    • When distance between rear RH wheel sensor and rear RH wheel sensor rotor is
    large.
    • When installation of rear RH wheel sensor or rear RH wheel sensor rotor is not
    normal.

    C1106

    • When a short circuit is detected in rear LH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of rear LH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Rear LH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Rear LH wheel sensor power
    supply voltage
    • When distance between rear LH wheel sensor and rear LH wheel sensor rotor is
    large.
    • When installation of rear LH wheel sensor or rear LH wheel sensor rotor is not normal.

    C1107

    C1108

    Fail-safe condition

    B

    C

    D

    E

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD (only when both rear wheels
    are malfunctioning)

    • When a short circuit is detected in front RH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of front RH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Front RH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Front RH wheel sensor
    power supply voltage
    • When distance between front RH wheel sensor and front RH wheel sensor rotor
    is large.
    • When installation of front RH wheel sensor or front RH wheel sensor rotor is not
    normal.

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    • When a short circuit is detected in front LH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of front LH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Front LH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Front LH wheel sensor power supply voltage
    • When distance between front LH wheel sensor and front LH wheel sensor rotor is
    large.
    • When installation of front LH wheel sensor or front LH wheel sensor rotor is not
    normal.

    J

    K

    C1109

    • When ignition power supply voltage is in following state.
    — Ignition power supply voltage: 10 V ≥ Ignition power supply voltage.
    — Ignition power supply voltage: 16 V ≤ Ignition power supply voltage.

    C1110

    When there is an internal malfunction in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control
    unit).

    C1111

    When a malfunction is detected in motor or motor relay.

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS

    When difference in wheel speed between any wheel and others is detected when
    the vehicle is driven, because of installation of tires other than specified.

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD

    C1115

    A

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-17

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    DTC

    Malfunction detected condition

    C1120

    When a malfunction is detected in front LH ABS IN valve.

    C1121

    When a malfunction is detected in front LH ABS OUT valve.

    C1122

    When a malfunction is detected in front RH ABS IN valve.

    C1123

    When a malfunction is detected in front RH ABS OUT valve.

    C1124

    When a malfunction is detected in rear LH ABS IN valve.

    C1125

    When a malfunction is detected in rear LH ABS OUT valve.

    C1126

    When a malfunction is detected in rear RH ABS IN valve.

    C1127

    When a malfunction is detected in rear RH ABS OUT valve.

    C1130

    When a CAN signal malfunction is detected.

    C1140

    When a malfunction is detected in actuator relay.

    U1000

    When CAN communication signal is not continuously transmitted or received for 2
    seconds or more.

    U1010

    When detecting error during the initial diagnosis of CAN controller of ABS actuator
    and electric unit (control unit).

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-18

    Fail-safe condition

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM [ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL
    UNIT)]
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM [ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL
    UNIT)]
    CONSULT Function (ABS)

    INFOID:0000000009365065

    A

    B

    APPLICATION ITEMS
    CONSULT can display each diagnostic item using the following direct diagnostic modes.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    C

    Description

    ECU identification

    The ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) activates outputs to test components.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    ECU IDENTIFICATION

    D

    E

    BRC

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) part number is displayed.

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    G

    Operation Procedure

    1.

    Before performing the self-diagnosis, start engine and drive vehicle at 30 km/h (19 MPH) or more for
    approximately 1 minute.

    How To Erase Self Diagnostic Result

    1.

    After erasing DTC memory, start engine and drive vehicle at 30 km/h (19 MPH) or more for approximately
    1 minute as the final inspection, and make sure that the ABS warning lamp and brake warning lamp turn
    OFF.
    CAUTION:
    If memory cannot be erased, perform applicable diagnosis.
    NOTE:
    • When the wheel sensor malfunctions, after inspecting the wheel sensor system, the ABS warning lamp
    and brake warning lamp will not turn OFF even when the system is normal, unless the vehicle is driven
    at approximately 30 km/h (19 MPH) or more for approximately 1 minute.
    • Brake warning lamp will turn ON in case of parking brake operation (when switch is ON) or of brake fluid
    level switch operation (when brake fluid is insufficient).

    Display Item List
    Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    DATA MONITOR
    M

    Item
    (Unit)

    Data monitor item selection

    N

    Remarks

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    SELECTION
    FROM MENU

    FR LH SENSOR
    (km/h, mph)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wheel speed (km/h, mph) calculated by front wheel
    sensor LH signal is displayed.

    FR RH SENSOR
    (km/h, mph)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wheel speed (km/h, mph) calculated by front wheel
    sensor RH signal is displayed.

    RR LH SENSOR
    (km/h, mph)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wheel speed (km/h, mph) calculated by rear wheel
    sensor LH signal is displayed.

    RR RH SENSOR
    (km/h, mph)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wheel speed (km/h, mph) calculated by rear wheel
    sensor RH signal is displayed.

    FR RH IN SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Front RH IN ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-19

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM [ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL
    UNIT)]
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Item
    (Unit)

    Data monitor item selection
    Remarks

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    SELECTION
    FROM MENU

    FR RH OUT SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Front RH OUT ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    FR LH IN SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Front LH IN ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    FR LH OUT SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Front LH OUT ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    RR RH IN SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Rear RH IN ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    RR RH OUT SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Rear RH OUT ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    RR LH IN SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Rear LH IN ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    RR LH OUT SOL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Rear LH OUT ABS solenoid (On/Off) status is displayed.

    EBD WARN LAMP
    (On/Off)

    ×

    Brake warning lamp (On/Off) status is displayed.

    STOP LAMP SW
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Stop lamp switch (On/Off) status is displayed.

    MOTOR RELAY
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    ABS motor relay signal (On/Off) status is displayed.

    ACTUATOR RLY
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    ABS actuator relay signal (On/Off) status is displayed.

    ABS WARN LAMP
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    ABS warning lamp (On/Off) status is displayed.

    BATTERY VOLT
    (V)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Voltage (V) supplied to ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit) is displayed.

    ENGINE SPEED

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Engine speed status is displayed.

    EBD SIGNAL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    EBD operation (On/Off) status is displayed.

    ABS SIGNAL
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ABS operation (On/Off) status is displayed.

    EBD FAIL SIG
    (On/Off)

    ×

    EBD fail signal (On/Off) status is displayed.

    ABS FAIL SIG
    (On/Off)

    ×

    ABS fail signal (On/Off) status is displayed.

    CRANKING SIG
    (On/Off)

    ×

    The input state of the key SW START position signal
    is displayed.

    ×: Applicable
    –: Not applicable

    ACTIVE TEST MODE
    CAUTION:
    • Do not perform active test while driving vehicle.
    • Make sure to completely bleed air from brake system.
    • The active test cannot be performed with the ABS warning lamp or brake warning lamp on.
    • ABS warning lamp and brake warning lamp turn on during active test.
    NOTE:
    • When active test is performed while depressing the pedal, the pedal depression amount will change. This is
    normal.
    • “TEST IS STOPPED” is displayed 10 seconds after operation start.
    • After “TEST IS STOPPED” is displayed, to perform test again, touch BACK.
    Test Item

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-20

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM [ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL
    UNIT)]
    [ABS]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    ABS SOLENOID VALVE

    • Select “Up”, “Keep” and “Down”. Then use screen monitor to check that solenoid valve operates as shown in
    the table below.
    Test item

    Display (Note)

    Display item

    FR RH SOL

    FR LH SOL

    RR RH SOL

    RR LH SOL

    Up

    Keep

    Down

    FR RH IN SOL

    Off

    On

    On

    FR RH OUT SOL

    Off

    Off

    On*

    FR LH IN SOL

    Off

    On

    On

    FR LH OUT SOL

    Off

    Off

    On*

    RR RH IN SOL

    Off

    On

    On

    RR RH OUT SOL

    Off

    Off

    On*

    RR LH IN SOL

    Off

    On

    On

    RR LH OUT SOL

    Off

    Off

    On*

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    *: On for 1 to 2 seconds after the select, and then Off.

    BRC

    NOTE:
    A brief moment of On/Off condition occurs every 20 seconds after ignition switch turned ON. This is not malfunction because it is an
    operation for checking.

    G

    ABS MOTOR

    • Select “On” and “Off”. Make sure motor relay and actuator relay operates as shown in table below.
    Test item

    ABS MOTOR

    Display item

    H

    Display
    On

    Off

    MOTOR RELAY

    On

    Off

    ACTUATOR RLY (Note)

    On

    On

    I

    NOTE:
    A brief moment of On/Off condition occurs every 20 seconds after ignition switch turned ON. This is not malfunction because it is an
    operation for checking.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-21

    2014 Note

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    [ABS]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009365066

    VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL
    CAUTION:
    The display shows the control unit calculation data, so a normal value might be displayed even in the
    event the output circuit (harness) is open or short-circuited.
    Data monitor
    Monitor item

    Display content

    FR LH SENSOR

    Wheel speed

    FR RH SENSOR

    Wheel speed

    RR LH SENSOR

    Wheel speed

    RR RH SENSOR

    Wheel speed

    FR RH IN SOL

    FR RH OUT SOL

    FR LH IN SOL

    FR LH OUT SOL

    RR RH IN SOL

    Condition

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    Revision: April 2013

    Reference value in
    normal operation

    0 [km/h, mph]

    Vehicle stopped

    Nearly matches the speed meter display
    (± 10% or less)

    Vehicle running
    (Note 1)

    0 [km/h, mph]

    Vehicle stopped

    Nearly matches the speed meter display
    (± 10% or less)

    Vehicle running
    (Note 1)

    0 [km/h, mph]

    Vehicle stopped

    Nearly matches the speed meter display
    (± 10% or less)

    Vehicle running
    (Note 1)

    0 [km/h, mph]

    Vehicle stopped

    Nearly matches the speed meter display
    (± 10% or less)

    Vehicle running
    (Note 1)

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    BRC-22

    2014 Note

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    [ABS]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Data monitor
    Monitor item

    RR RH OUT SOL

    RR LH IN SOL

    RR LH OUT SOL

    Display content

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    Operation status of all solenoid valves

    EBD WARN LAMP

    EBD warning lamp
    (Note 2)

    STOP LAMP SW

    Brake pedal operation

    MOTOR RELAY

    Motor and motor relay operation

    ACTUATOR RLY

    Actuator relay operation

    ABS WARN LAMP

    ABS warning lamp
    (Note 2)

    BATTERY VOLT

    Battery voltage supplied to the ABS actuator
    and electric unit (control unit)

    ENGINE SPEED

    Engine speed status

    Reference value in
    normal operation

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    B

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    C

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    D

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    Actuator (solenoid valve) is active (“ACTIVE TEST” with CONSULT) or actuator
    relay is inactive (in fail-safe mode)

    On

    When the actuator (solenoid valve) is not
    active and actuator relay is active (ignition switch ON)

    Off

    When EBD warning lamp is ON

    On

    When EBD warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    When brake pedal is depressed

    On

    When brake pedal is not depressed

    Off

    When the motor relay and motor are operating

    On

    When the motor relay and motor are not
    operating

    Off

    When the actuator relay is operating

    On

    When the actuator relay is not operating

    Off

    When ABS warning lamp is ON

    On

    When ABS warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    Ignition switch ON
    Engine stopped
    Engine running

    EBD SIGNAL

    ABS SIGNAL

    EBD operation

    ABS operation

    EBD FAIL SIG

    EBD fail-safe signal

    ABS FAIL SIG

    ABS fail-safe signal

    CRANKING SIG

    Crank operation

    10 – 16 V

    BRC

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    0 RPM
    Almost same reading as tachometer

    EBD is active

    On

    EBD is inactive

    Off

    ABS is active

    On

    ABS is inactive

    Off

    In EBD fail-safe

    On

    EBD is normal

    Off

    In ABS fail-safe

    On

    ABS is normal

    Off

    Crank is active

    On

    Crank is inactive

    Off

    Note 2: On and off timing for warning lamps and indicator lamps.
    • Refer to BRC-14, «ABS : ABS Function».

    BRC-23

    E

    G

    Note 1: Confirm tire pressure is normal.

    Revision: April 2013

    A

    Condition

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    [ABS]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    • Refer to BRC-15, «ABS : EBD Function».

    Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009365067

    ABS FUNCTION
    ABS warning lamp in combination meter turns ON when a malfunction occurs in system [ABS actuator and
    electric unit (control unit)]. The control is suspended for ABS functions. However, EBD functions operate normally.

    EBD FUNCTION
    ABS warning lamp, brake warning lamp in combination meter turn ON when a malfunction occurs in system
    [ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)]. The control is suspended for ABS and EBD functions.
    DTC

    Malfunction detected condition

    C1101

    When an open circuit is detected in rear RH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1102

    When an open circuit is detected in rear LH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1103

    When an open circuit is detected in front RH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1104

    When an open circuit is detected in front LH wheel sensor circuit.

    C1105

    • When a short circuit is detected in rear RH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of rear RH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Rear RH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Rear RH wheel sensor power supply voltage
    • When distance between rear RH wheel sensor and rear RH wheel sensor rotor is
    large.
    • When installation of rear RH wheel sensor or rear RH wheel sensor rotor is not
    normal.

    C1106

    • When a short circuit is detected in rear LH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of rear LH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Rear LH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Rear LH wheel sensor power
    supply voltage
    • When distance between rear LH wheel sensor and rear LH wheel sensor rotor is
    large.
    • When installation of rear LH wheel sensor or rear LH wheel sensor rotor is not normal.

    C1107

    • When a short circuit is detected in front RH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of front RH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Front RH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Front RH wheel sensor
    power supply voltage
    • When distance between front RH wheel sensor and front RH wheel sensor rotor
    is large.
    • When installation of front RH wheel sensor or front RH wheel sensor rotor is not
    normal.

    C1108

    • When a short circuit is detected in front LH wheel sensor circuit.
    • When power supply voltage of front LH wheel sensor is in following state.
    — Front LH wheel sensor power supply voltage: 7.2 V ≥ Front LH wheel sensor power supply voltage
    • When distance between front LH wheel sensor and front LH wheel sensor rotor is
    large.
    • When installation of front LH wheel sensor or front LH wheel sensor rotor is not
    normal.

    C1109

    • When ignition power supply voltage is in following state.
    — Ignition power supply voltage: 10 V ≥ Ignition power supply voltage.
    — Ignition power supply voltage: 16 V ≤ Ignition power supply voltage.

    C1110

    When there is an internal malfunction in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control
    unit).

    C1111

    When there is a failure on the pump motor

    C1115

    When difference in wheel speed between any wheel and others is detected when
    the vehicle is driven, because of installation of tires other than specified.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-24

    Fail-safe condition

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD (only when both rear wheels
    are malfunctioning)

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD
    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD

    2014 Note

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    [ABS]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    DTC

    Malfunction detected condition

    C1120

    When a malfunction is detected in front LH ABS IN valve.

    C1121

    When a malfunction is detected in front LH ABS OUT valve.

    C1122

    When a malfunction is detected in front RH ABS IN valve.

    C1123

    When a malfunction is detected in front RH ABS OUT valve.

    C1124

    When a malfunction is detected in rear LH ABS IN valve.

    C1125

    When a malfunction is detected in rear LH ABS OUT valve.

    C1126

    When a malfunction is detected in rear RH ABS IN valve.

    C1127

    When a malfunction is detected in rear RH ABS OUT valve.

    C1130

    When a CAN signal malfunction is detected..

    Fail-safe condition

    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD

    When a malfunction is detected in actuator relay.

    U1000

    When CAN communication signal is not continuously transmitted or received for 2
    seconds or more.

    U1010

    When detecting error during the initial diagnosis of CAN controller of ABS actuator
    and electrical unit (control unit).

    DTC Inspection Priority Chart

    B

    C

    D
    The following functions are suspended:
    • ABS
    • EBD

    C1140

    A

    E

    BRC

    G
    INFOID:0000000009365068

    When multiple DTCs are displayed simultaneously, check each one using the following priority list.
    Priority

    H

    Detected item (DTC)

    1

    • U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    • U1010 CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    2

    • C1110 CONTROLLER FAILURE

    3

    • C1130 ENGINE SIGNAL 1
    • C1144 ST ANG SEN SIGNAL

    4

    • C1109 BATTERY VOLTAGE [ABNORMAL]
    • C1111 PUMP MOTOR
    • C1140 ACTUATOR RLY

    5

















    I

    J

    K

    C1101 RR RH SENSOR-1
    C1102 RR LH SENSOR-1
    C1103 FR RH SENSOR-1
    C1104 FR LH SENSOR-1
    C1105 RR RH SENSOR-2
    C1106 RR LH SENSOR-2
    C1107 FR RH SENSOR-2
    C1108 FR LH SENSOR-2
    C1115 ABS SENSOR [ABNORMAL SIGNAL]
    C1120 FR LH IN ABS SOL
    C1121 FR LH OUT ABS SOL
    C1122 FR RH IN ABS SOL
    C1123 FR RH OUT ABS SOL
    C1124 RR LH IN ABS SOL
    C1125 RR LH OUT ABS SOL
    C1126 RR RH IN ABS SOL
    C1127 RR RH OUT ABS SOL

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-25

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    [ABS]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    DTC Index

    INFOID:0000000009365069

    DTC

    Items (CONSULT screen terms)

    Reference

    C1101

    RR RH SENSOR-1

    C1102

    RR LH SENSOR-1

    C1103

    FR RH SENSOR-1

    C1104

    FR LH SENSOR-1

    C1105

    RR RH SENSOR-2

    C1106

    RR LH SENSOR-2

    C1107

    FR RH SENSOR-2

    C1108

    FR LH SENSOR-2

    C1109

    BATTERY VOLTAGE [ABNORMAL]

    BRC-42, «DTC Logic»

    C1110

    CONTROLLER FAILURE

    BRC-44, «DTC Logic»

    C1111

    PUMP MOTOR

    BRC-45, «DTC Logic»

    C1115

    ABS SENSOR [ABNORMAL SIGNAL]

    BRC-47, «DTC Logic»

    C1120

    FR LH IN ABS SOL

    BRC-49, «DTC Logic»

    C1121

    FR LH OUT ABS SOL

    BRC-51, «DTC Logic»

    C1122

    FR RH IN ABS SOL

    BRC-49, «DTC Logic»

    C1123

    FR RH OUT ABS SOL

    BRC-51, «DTC Logic»

    C1124

    RR LH IN ABS SOL

    BRC-49, «DTC Logic»

    C1125

    RR LH OUT ABS SOL

    BRC-51, «DTC Logic»

    C1126

    RR RH IN ABS SOL

    BRC-49, «DTC Logic»

    C1127

    RR RH OUT ABS SOL

    BRC-51, «DTC Logic»

    C1130

    ENGINE SIGNAL 1

    BRC-53, «DTC Logic»

    C1140

    ACTUATOR RLY

    BRC-54, «DTC Logic»

    U1000

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    BRC-56, «DTC Logic»

    U1010

    CONTROL UNIT [CAN]

    BRC-57, «DTC Logic»

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-26

    BRC-36, «DTC Logic»

    BRC-40, «DTC Logic»

    2014 Note

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009365070

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AAFWA0103GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-27

    2014 Note

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAFWA0104GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-28

    2014 Note

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAFIA0166GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-29

    2014 Note

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAFIA0167GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-30

    2014 Note

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAFIA0168GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-31

    2014 Note

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAFIA0169GB

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-32

    2014 Note

    BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAFIA0170GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-33

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [ABS]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009365071

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    AWFIA0208GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.COLLECT INFORMATION FROM THE CUSTOMER
    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when the
    incident/malfunction occurred) using the diagnostic worksheet. Refer to BRC-35, «Diagnostic Work Sheet».
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Perform self diagnostic result. Refer to BRC-19, «CONSULT Function (ABS)».
    Are any DTCs displayed?
    YES >> Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK SYMPTOM OPERATING CONDITION

    Check that the symptom is a normal operating condition. Refer to BRC-68, «Description».
    Is the symptom a normal operating condition?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK WARNING AND INDICATOR LAMPS OPERATION

    Check ABS and brake warning lamps. Refer to MWI-7, «METER SYSTEM : System Description».
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-34

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [ABS]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Is ON/OFF timing normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Perform warning lamp diagnosis. Refer to BRC-60, «Component Function Check» (ABS warning
    lamp), BRC-61, «Component Function Check» (brake warning lamp).

    5.PERFORM DIAGNOSIS APPLICABLE TO THE SYMPTOM

    A

    B

    Perform diagnosis applicable to the symptom. Refer to BRC-62, «Symptom Table».
    C

    >> GO TO 6.

    6.FINAL CHECK

    Perform self diagnostic result again, and check that the malfunction is repaired. After checking, erase the self
    diagnosis memory. Refer to BRC-19, «CONSULT Function (ABS)».

    D

    E

    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnostic Work Sheet

    INFOID:0000000009365072

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    SFIA3265E

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-35

    2014 Note

    C1101, C1102, C1103, C1104 WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    C1101, C1102, C1103, C1104 WHEEL SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009549271

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1101

    C1102

    C1103

    C1104

    Display Item

    Malfunction detected condition

    RR RH SENSOR-1

    • When power supply voltage of rear wheel sensor
    RH is low.
    • When an open or shorted circuit is detected in rear
    wheel sensor RH circuit.

    RR LH SENSOR-1

    • When power supply voltage of rear wheel sensor
    LH is low.
    • When an open or shorted circuit is detected in rear
    wheel sensor LH circuit.

    FR RH SENSOR-1

    • When power supply voltage of front wheel sensor
    RH is low.
    • When an open or shorted circuit is detected in front
    wheel sensor RH circuit.

    FR LH SENSOR-1

    • When power supply voltage of front wheel sensor
    LH is low.
    • When an open or shorted circuit is detected in front
    wheel sensor LH circuit.

    Possible causes

    • Harness or connector
    • Wheel sensor
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    With CONSULT.
    1. Start engine and drive vehicle at approximately 21 km/h (13 MPH) or more for approximately 5 minutes.
    2. Perform self-diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1101, C1102, C1103 or C1104 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-36, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549272

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONFIRM DTC
    With CONSULT
    1. Perform self-diagnostic result of ABS and record all active DTCs.
    2. Clear all DTCs.
    3. Perform DTC confirmation procedure. Refer to BRC-36, «DTC Logic».
    Does DTC C1101, C1102, C1103 or C1104 reset?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    2.INSPECT WHEEL SENSOR

    Inspect the suspect wheel sensor for damage or deformation.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    3.HARNESS AND CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-36

    2014 Note

    C1101, C1102, C1103, C1104 WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 and wheel sensor connector of
    suspect wheel.
    2. Check harness, connectors and terminals for corrosion, deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    4.CHECK WHEEL SENSOR OUTPUT SIGNAL

    A

    B

    C

    1.
    2.

    Connect ABS active wheel sensor tester (J-45741) to wheel sensor using appropriate adapter.
    Turn on the ABS active wheel sensor tester power switch.
    D
    NOTE:
    The green POWER indicator should illuminate. If the POWER indicator does not illuminate, replace the
    battery in the ABS active wheel sensor tester before proceeding.
    3. Spin the wheel of the vehicle by hand and observe the red SENSOR indicator on the ABS active wheel E
    sensor tester. The red SENSOR indicator should flash ON and OFF to indicate an output signal.
    NOTE:
    If the red SENSOR indicator illuminates but does not flash, reverse the polarity of the tester leads and
    BRC
    retest.
    Does the ABS active wheel sensor tester detect a signal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace the wheel sensor. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installa- G
    tion» or BRC-70, «REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation».

    5.CHECK WIRING HARNESS FOR SHORT TO VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between wheel sensor harness connector terminals of suspect wheel and ground.

    I

    Wheel Sensor
    Wheel

    Connector

    Front LH

    E51

    Front RH

    E52

    Rear LH

    B22

    Rear RH

    B35

    Terminal

    Ground

    Voltage

    J

    1
    2
    1
    2
    1

    K

    0V

    2

    L

    1
    2

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair the circuit.

    N

    6.CHECK WIRING HARNESS FOR SHORT TO GROUND
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between wheel sensor harness connector terminals of suspect wheel and ground.
    Wheel Sensor
    Wheel

    Revision: April 2013

    Connector

    H

    Terminal

    BRC-37

    Ground

    Continuity

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    C1101, C1102, C1103, C1104 WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Front LH

    E51

    Front RH

    E52

    Rear LH

    B22

    Rear RH

    B35

    1
    2
    1
    2

    1

    No

    2
    1
    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair the circuit.

    7.CHECK WIRING HARNESS FOR SHORT BETWEEN CIRCUITS
    Check continuity between wheel sensor harness connector terminals of suspect wheel.
    Wheel Sensor
    Wheel

    Connector

    Front LH

    E51

    Front RH

    E52

    Rear LH

    B22

    Rear RH

    B35

    (+)

    (-)

    Terminal

    Terminal

    1

    2

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair the circuit.

    8.CHECK WIRING HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector E33 and harness
    connector of suspect wheel sensor.
    Wheel sensor

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    37

    Front LH

    E51

    36
    26

    Front RH
    E33
    Rear LH

    Rear RH

    Wheel sensor

    E52

    27
    30

    B22

    29
    33

    B35

    34

    Continuity
    Terminal
    1
    2
    1
    2

    Yes

    1
    2
    1
    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair the circuit.

    9.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector E33 terminal and
    ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-38

    2014 Note

    C1101, C1102, C1103, C1104 WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    E33

    6

    Ground

    Condition

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ignition switch ON

    Battery voltage

    Ignition switch OFF

    0V

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Check the following:
    • 10A fuse No. 50 located in the IPDM E/R
    • Harness between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) and IPDM E/R

    C

    1.
    2.

    E

    D

    10.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) GROUND CIRCUIT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminals and
    ground.

    BRC
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    G

    13

    E33

    38

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    H

    11.CHECK WHEEL SENSOR INPUT VOLTAGE

    I

    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    Connect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between suspect wheel sensor harness connector terminals.
    Wheel Sensor
    Wheel

    Connector

    Front LH

    E51

    Front RH

    E52

    Rear LH

    B22

    Rear RH

    B35

    (+)

    (-)

    Terminal

    1

    Terminal

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    K

    2

    Battery voltage

    L

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace wheel sensor. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation»
    or BRC-70, «REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation». Then, GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».

    12.CONFIRM REPAIR

    With CONSULT
    1. Clear all DTCs.
    2. Perform DTC confirmation procedure. Refer to BRC-36, «DTC Logic».
    Does DTC C1105, C1106, C1107 or C1108 reset?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-39

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    C1105, C1106, C1107, C1108 WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1105, C1106, C1107, C1108 WHEEL SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009549273

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1105

    C1106

    C1107

    C1108

    Display Item

    Malfunction detected condition

    RR RH SENSOR-2

    • When distance between rear wheel sensor RH and
    rear wheel sensor RH rotor is large.
    • When installation of rear wheel sensor RH or rear
    wheel sensor RH rotor is not normal.

    RR LH SENSOR-2

    • When distance between rear wheel sensor LH and
    rear wheel sensor LH rotor is large.
    • When installation of rear wheel sensor LH or rear
    wheel sensor LH rotor is not normal.

    FR RH SENSOR-2

    • When distance between front wheel sensor RH
    and front wheel sensor RH rotor is large.
    • When installation of front wheel sensor RH or front
    wheel sensor RH rotor is not normal.

    FR LH SENSOR-2

    • When distance between front wheel sensor LH and
    front wheel sensor LH rotor is large.
    • When installation of front wheel sensor LH or front
    wheel sensor LH rotor is not normal.

    Possible causes

    • Wheel sensor
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    • Sensor rotor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    With CONSULT.
    1. Start engine and drive vehicle at approximately 21 km/h (13 MPH) or more for approximately 5 minutes.
    2. Perform self-diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1105, C1106, C1107 or C1108 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-40, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549274

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONFIRM DTC
    With CONSULT
    1. Perform self-diagnostic result of ABS and record all active DTCs.
    2. Clear all DTCs.
    3. Perform DTC confirmation procedure. Refer to BRC-36, «DTC Logic».
    Does DTC C1105, C1106, C1107 or C1108 reset?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    2.CHECK TIRE PRESSURE AND TIRE WEAR

    Check tires for excessive wear and proper inflation. Refer to WT-4, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    3.CHECK WHEEL SENSOR

    Check wheel sensor for the following:
    • Proper installation
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-40

    2014 Note

    C1105, C1106, C1107, C1108 WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    • Physical damage
    • Contamination
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    A

    B

    4.CHECK SENSOR ROTOR

    Check sensor rotor for the following:
    • Contamination
    • Physical damage (missing teeth, cracks, etc.)
    • Foreign material
    • Looseness
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the wheel sensor. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation» or BRC-70, «REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation». Then, GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    5.CONFIRM REPAIR

    With CONSULT
    1. Clear all DTCs.
    2. Perform DTC confirmation procedure. Refer to BRC-36, «DTC Logic».
    Does DTC C1105, C1106, C1107 or C1108 reset?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-41

    2014 Note

    C1109 POWER AND GROUND SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1109 POWER AND GROUND SYSTEM
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365081

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1109

    Display Item

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    [ABNORMAL]

    Malfunction detected condition

    • When ignition voltage is 10 V or less.
    • When ignition voltage is 16 V or more.

    Possible causes
    • Harness or connector
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    • Fuse
    • Ignition power supply system
    • Battery

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn the ignition switch ON.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1109 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365082

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connectors.
    3. Check connectors and terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    2.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) IGNITION POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    Check voltage between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminal 28 and ground.
    ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    E33

    6

    Ground

    Condition

    Voltage

    Ignition switch ON

    Battery voltage

    Ignition switch OFF

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    3.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminals 13, 38 and
    ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-42

    2014 Note

    C1109 POWER AND GROUND SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector
    E33

    Terminal
    13
    38

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-43

    2014 Note

    C1110 CONTROL FAILURE
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1110 CONTROL FAILURE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365083

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    C1110

    Display item
    CONTROLLER FAILURE

    Malfunction detected condition

    Possible cause

    When there is an internal malfunction in the ABS actuator
    and electric unit (control unit).

    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS
    Check the self-diagnosis results.
    Self-diagnosis results
    CONTROLLER FAILURE
    EMERGENCY BRAKE
    VARIANT CODING

    Is above displayed on the self-diagnosis display?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-44, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365084

    1.REPLACE ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    CAUTION:
    Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) when self diagnostic result shows items other
    than those applicable.
    >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-44

    2014 Note

    C1111 PUMP MOTOR
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1111 PUMP MOTOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365085

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1111

    B

    Display Item

    PUMP MOTOR

    Malfunction detected condition

    Possible causes

    • When a malfunction is detected in motor or motor
    relay.
    • When a low pressure malfunction is detected in accumulator.

    • Harness or connector
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    • Fusible link
    • Battery power supply system
    • Motor/accumulator assembly

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    C

    D

    E

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Depress brake pedal 20 times or more.
    3. Start the engine and wait for 3 minutes or more.
    4. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1111 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-45, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    BRC

    G

    H

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365086

    I

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».
    J

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connectors.
    3. Check connectors and terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    K

    L

    2.CHECK ABS MOTOR AND MOTOR RELAY BATTERY POWER SUPPLY

    Check voltage between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminal 1 and ground.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    E33

    1

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminals 13, 38 and
    ground.

    BRC-45

    N

    O

    P

    3.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) GROUND CIRCUIT

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    2014 Note

    C1111 PUMP MOTOR
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector
    E33

    Terminal
    13
    38

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-46

    2014 Note

    C1115 ABS SENSOR [ABNORMAL SIGNAL]
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1115 ABS SENSOR [ABNORMAL SIGNAL]

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365087

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1115

    B

    Display Item

    ABS SENSOR
    [ABNORMAL SIGNAL]

    Malfunction detected condition
    When difference in wheel speed between any wheel
    and others is detected while the vehicle is driven, because of installation of tires other than specified.

    Possible causes



    Harness or connector
    Wheel sensor
    Sensor rotor
    ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)

    C

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    E

    With CONSULT.
    1. Start engine and drive vehicle at approximately 30 km/h (19 MPH) or more for approximately 1 minute.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1115 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-47, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    BRC

    G

    INFOID:0000000009365088

    H

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».
    I

    CAUTION:
    Do not check between wheel sensor terminals.

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION

    J

    1.

    Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 and wheel sensor connector of
    wheel with DTC.
    2. Check terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    K

    L

    2.CHECK WHEEL SENSOR OUTPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Connect ABS active wheel sensor tester (J-45741) to wheel sensor using appropriate adapter.
    Turn on the ABS active wheel sensor tester power switch.
    NOTE:
    The green POWER indicator should illuminate. If the POWER indicator does not illuminate, replace the
    battery in the ABS active wheel sensor tester before proceeding.
    3. Spin the wheel of the vehicle by hand and observe the red SENSOR indicator on the ABS active wheel
    sensor tester. The red SENSOR indicator should flash on and off to indicate an output signal.
    NOTE:
    If the red SENSOR indicator illuminates but does not flash, reverse the polarity of the tester leads and
    retest.
    Does the ABS active wheel sensor tester detect a signal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the wheel sensor. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation» (front) or BRC-70, «REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation» (rear).

    3.CHECK TIRES

    Check the inflation pressure, wear and size of each tire.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-47

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    C1115 ABS SENSOR [ABNORMAL SIGNAL]
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Adjust tire pressure, or replace tire(s).

    4.CHECK WIRING HARNESS FOR SHORT CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between wheel sensor connector terminals and ground of wheel with DTC.
    Wheel Sensor
    Wheel

    Connector

    Front LH

    E51

    Front RH

    E52

    Rear LH

    B22

    Rear RH

    B35

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    1
    2
    1
    2
    1
    2
    1
    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair the circuit.

    5.CHECK WIRING HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 and wheel sensor connector of wheel with DTC.
    Wheel sensor

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector

    E51

    36
    26

    Front RH
    E33

    Rear RH

    Connector

    37

    Front LH

    Rear LH

    Terminal

    Wheel sensor

    E52

    27
    30

    B22

    29
    33

    B35

    34

    Continuity
    Terminal
    1
    2
    1
    2

    Yes

    1
    2
    1
    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair the circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-48

    2014 Note

    C1120, C1122, C1124, C1126 ABS IN VALVE SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1120, C1122, C1124, C1126 ABS IN VALVE SYSTEM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365091

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Display Item

    Malfunction detected condition

    C1120

    FR LH IN ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in front LH ABS IN
    valve.

    C1122

    FR RH IN ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in front RH ABS IN
    valve.

    C1124

    RR LH IN ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in rear LH ABS IN
    valve.

    C1126

    RR RH IN ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in rear RH ABS IN
    valve.

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    • Fusible link
    • Battery power supply system

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    BRC

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1120, C1122, C1124 or C1126 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-49, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    G

    H

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365092

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».

    I

    J

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION

    K

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector.
    3. Check connector and terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    L

    2.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) BATTERY POWER SUPPLY

    M

    Check voltage between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminal 25 and ground.
    N
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    E33

    25

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    P

    3.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminals 13, 38 and
    ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-49

    O

    2014 Note

    C1120, C1122, C1124, C1126 ABS IN VALVE SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector
    E33

    Terminal
    13
    38

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-50

    2014 Note

    C1121, C1123, C1125, C1127 ABS OUT VALVE SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1121, C1123, C1125, C1127 ABS OUT VALVE SYSTEM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365093

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Display Item

    Malfunction detected condition

    C1121

    FR LH OUT ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in front LH ABS OUT
    valve.

    C1123

    FR RH OUT ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in front RH ABS OUT
    valve.

    C1125

    RR LH OUT ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in rear LH ABS OUT
    valve.

    C1127

    RR RH OUT ABS SOL

    When a malfunction is detected in rear RH ABS OUT
    valve.

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    • Fusible link
    • Battery power supply system

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    BRC

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1121, C1123, C1125 or C1127 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-51, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    G

    H

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365094

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».

    I

    J

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION

    K

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector.
    3. Check connector and terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    L

    2.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) BATTERY POWER SUPPLY

    M

    Check voltage between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminal 25 and ground.
    N
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    E33

    25

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    P

    3.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminals 13, 38 and
    ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-51

    O

    2014 Note

    C1121, C1123, C1125, C1127 ABS OUT VALVE SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector
    E33

    Terminal
    13
    38

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-52

    2014 Note

    C1130 ENGINE SIGNAL
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1130 ENGINE SIGNAL

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365095

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1130

    B

    Display Item

    ENGINE SIGNAL 1

    Malfunction detected condition

    Possible causes

    When a CAN signal malfunction is detected in ECM
    system.

    • ECM
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    • CAN communication line

    C

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    E

    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1130 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-53, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    BRC

    G
    INFOID:0000000009365096

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT FOR ENGINE SYSTEM

    H

    With CONSULT.
    Perform self diagnostic result. Refer to EC-53, «CONSULT Function».
    Are any ECM DTCs detected?
    YES >> Refer to EC-76, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    I

    2.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT FOR ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    With CONSULT.
    1. Perform self diagnostic result and erase DTCs.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    3. Start engine and drive vehicle for a short period of time.
    4. Check that malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) turns OFF.
    5. Stop vehicle and perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1130 detected?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Check pin terminals and connection of connectors for abnormal conditions. Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-53

    2014 Note

    C1140 ACTUATOR RELAY SYSTEM
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1140 ACTUATOR RELAY SYSTEM
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365097

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1140

    Display Item

    ACTUATOR RLY

    Malfunction detected condition

    When a malfunction is detected in actuator relay.

    Possible causes
    • Harness or connector
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)
    • Fusible link
    • Battery power supply system

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC C1140 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-54, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365098

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector.
    3. Check connector and terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    2.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) BATTERY POWER SUPPLY

    Check voltage between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminal 25 and ground.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector

    Terminal

    E33

    25

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    3.CHECK ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector E33 terminals 13, 38 and
    ground.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    Connector
    E33

    Revision: April 2013

    Terminal
    13
    38

    BRC-54

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    2014 Note

    C1140 ACTUATOR RELAY SYSTEM
    [ABS]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-55

    2014 Note

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009365112

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    U1000

    Display Item
    CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    Malfunction detected condition

    Possible causes

    When CAN communication signal is not continuously
    received for 2 seconds or more

    CAN communication system malfunction

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365113

    1.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC U1000 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-56

    2014 Note

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009452284

    Initial diagnosis of ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    B

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009452285

    C

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    Items
    (CONSULT screen terms)

    DTC

    U1010

    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    DTC detection condition

    Possible cause

    When detecting error during the initial diagnosis of CAN controller of ABS actuator and
    electric unit (control unit).

    ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    BRC

    With CONSULT.
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Perform self diagnostic result.
    Is DTC U1010 detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-57, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    G

    H
    INFOID:0000000009452286

    1.REPLACE ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)

    I

    Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    J

    >> Inspection End.
    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-57

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009365116

    1.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH OPERATION
    Check that brake warning lamp in combination meter turns ON/OFF when parking brake is actuated.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365117

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BRC-27, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect combination meter and parking brake switch connectors.
    3. Check connectors and terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    2.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH

    Check parking brake switch. Refer to BRC-59, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace parking brake switch. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».

    3.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT.
    Connect combination meter connector and parking brake switch connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    In “DATA MONITOR” select “PARK BRAKE SW” and check parking brake switch signal.
    Condition

    DATA MONITOR

    Actuate parking brake

    On

    Release parking brake

    Off

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to BRC-34, «Work Flow».
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination meter and parking brake switch connectors.
    Check continuity between combination meter connector and parking brake switch connector M17 terminal
    1.
    Combination meter

    4.

    Parking brake switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    10

    M17

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between combination meter connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-58

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    Combination meter
    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    10

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    Component Inspection

    C
    INFOID:0000000009365118

    1.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH

    D

    1.
    2.
    3.

    E

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect parking brake switch connector.
    Check continuity between parking brake switch terminal 1 and ground.

    Parking brake switch terminal

    1

    Ground

    Condition

    Continuity

    Parking brake actuated

    Yes

    Parking brake released

    No

    BRC

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace parking brake switch. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-59

    2014 Note

    ABS WARNING LAMP
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ABS WARNING LAMP
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009365122

    1.CHECK ABS WARNING LAMP FUNCTION
    Check that ABS warning lamp in combination meter turns ON for approximately 2 seconds after ignition switch
    is turned ON.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-60, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365123

    1.PERFORM THE SELF-DIAGNOSIS
    With CONSULT.
    Perform self diagnostic result.
    Are any DTCs detected?
    YES >> Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK COMBINATION METER

    Check if indication and operation of combination meter are normal. Refer to MWI-7, «METER SYSTEM : System Description».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-60

    2014 Note

    BRAKE WARNING LAMP
    [ABS]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BRAKE WARNING LAMP

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009365124

    1.CHECK BRAKE WARNING LAMP FUNCTION (1)

    B

    Check that brake warning lamp in combination meter turns ON for approximately 2 seconds after ignition
    switch is turned ON.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to BRC-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    2.CHECK BRAKE WARNING LAMP FUNCTION (2)

    D

    Check that brake warning lamp in combination meter turns ON/OFF when parking brake is operated.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check parking brake switch system. Refer to BRC-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365125

    1.PERFORM THE SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    BRC

    G

    With CONSULT.
    Perform self diagnostic result.
    Are any DTCs detected?
    YES >> Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    H

    2.CHECK COMBINATION METER

    I

    Check if indication and operation of combination meter are normal. Refer to MWI-7, «METER SYSTEM : System Description».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-61

    2014 Note

    ABS
    [ABS]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    ABS
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009365130

    If ABS warning lamp turns ON, perform self-diagnosis.
    Symptom

    Check item

    Reference

    Brake force distribution
    Excessive ABS function operation frequency

    Looseness of front and rear axle

    BRC-63, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Wheel sensor and rotor system
    Unexpected pedal reaction

    Brake pedal stroke
    Make sure the braking force is sufficient when the ABS is not operating.

    BRC-64, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    The braking distance is long

    Check stopping distance when the ABS is not operating.

    BRC-65, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    ABS function does not operate (Note 1)

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    BRC-66, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Pedal vibration or ABS operation sound
    occurs (Note 2)

    Brake pedal
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    BRC-67, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    NOTE:
    • 1: The ABS does not operate when the speed is 10 km/h (6 MPH) or less.
    • 2: Under the following conditions, ABS is activated and vibration is felt when brake pedal is lightly depressed (just place a foot on it).
    However, this is normal.
    — When shifting gears
    — When driving on slippery road
    — During cornering at high speed
    — When passing over bumps or grooves [approximately 50 mm (1.97 in) or more]
    — When pulling away just after starting engine [at approximately 10 km/h (6 MPH) or higher]

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-62

    2014 Note

    EXCESSIVE ABS FUNCTION OPERATION FREQUENCY
    [ABS]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    EXCESSIVE ABS FUNCTION OPERATION FREQUENCY
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009365131

    1.CHECK START

    B

    Check front and rear brake force distribution using a brake tester.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Check brake system.

    C

    2.CHECK FRONT AND REAR AXLE

    D

    Make sure that there is no excessive play in the front and rear axles. Refer to front: FSU-6, «Inspection», rear:
    RSU-5, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    3.CHECK WHEEL SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR

    E

    BRC

    Check the following:
    • Wheel sensor installation for damage
    • Sensor rotor installation for damage
    • Wheel sensor connector
    • Wheel sensor harness
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> • Replace wheel sensor BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation» (front)
    or BRC-70, «REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation» (rear).
    • Replace sensor rotor BRC-72, «FRONT SENSOR ROTOR : Removal and Installation» (front) or
    BRC-72, «REAR SENSOR ROTOR : Removal and Installation» (rear).
    • Repair harness.

    4.CHECK ABS WARNING LAMP DISPLAY

    Make sure that the ABS warning lamp is turned off after the ignition switch is turned ON or when driving.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Perform self diagnostic result. Refer to BRC-19, «CONSULT Function (ABS)».

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-63

    2014 Note

    UNEXPECTED PEDAL REACTION
    [ABS]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    UNEXPECTED PEDAL REACTION
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365132

    1.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL STROKE
    Check brake pedal stroke. Refer to BR-8, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    Is the stroke too big?
    YES >> • Bleed air from brake line and hose. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    • Check brake pedal, brake booster, and master cylinder for mount play, looseness, brake system
    fluid leakage, etc. Refer to brake pedal: BR-8, «Inspection and Adjustment» or brake booster
    assembly BR-14, «Inspection».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK ABS FUNCTION

    1. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector to deactivate ABS.
    2. Check if braking force is normal in this condition.
    3. Reconnect connector after inspection.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check brake system.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-64

    2014 Note

    THE BRAKING DISTANCE IS LONG
    [ABS]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    THE BRAKING DISTANCE IS LONG
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009365133

    CAUTION:
    The stopping distance on slippery road surfaces might be longer with the ABS operating than when
    the ABS is not operating.

    1.CHECK ABS FUNCTION

    B

    C

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) connector to deactivate ABS.
    3. Check stopping distance.
    4. After inspection, reconnect connector.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check brake system.

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-65

    2014 Note

    ABS FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE
    [ABS]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    ABS FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009365134

    CAUTION:
    ABS does not operate when speed is 10 km/h (6 MPH) or lower.

    1.CHECK ABS WARNING LAMP DISPLAY

    Make sure that the ABS warning lamp turns OFF after ignition switch is turned ON or when driving.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Perform self diagnostic result. Refer to BRC-19, «CONSULT Function (ABS)».

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-66

    2014 Note

    PEDAL VIBRATION OR ABS OPERATION SOUND OCCURS
    [ABS]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    PEDAL VIBRATION OR ABS OPERATION SOUND OCCURS
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009365135

    CAUTION:
    Under the following conditions, ABS is activated and vibration is felt when brake pedal is lightly
    depressed (just place a foot on it). However, this is normal.
    • When shifting gears
    • When driving on slippery road
    • During cornering at high speed
    • When passing over bumps or grooves [approximately 50 mm (1.97 in) or more]
    • When pulling away just after starting engine [at approximately 10 km/h (6 MPH) or higher]

    1.SYMPTOM CHECK 1

    Check that there are pedal vibrations when the engine is started.
    Do symptoms occur?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspect the brake pedal.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    2.SYMPTOM CHECK 2

    Check that there are ABS operation noises when the engine is started.
    Do symptoms occur?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform self diagnostic result. Refer to BRC-19, «CONSULT Function (ABS)».

    G

    3.SYMPTOM CHECK 3

    H

    Check symptoms when electrical component (headlamps, etc.) switches are operated.
    Do symptoms occur?
    YES >> Check if there is a radio, antenna, antenna lead wire, or wiring close to the control unit. If there is,
    move it farther away.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-67

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [ABS]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009365137

    Symptom

    Result

    Slight vibrations are felt on the brake pedal and operation noises occur when ABS is activated.
    Stopping distance is longer than that of vehicles without ABS when the vehicle drives on rough, gravel, or
    snow-covered (fresh, deep snow) roads.
    The brake pedal vibrates and motor operation noises occur from the engine room after the engine starts and
    just after the vehicle starts.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-68

    This is a normal condition due to the ABS activation.
    This is normal, and it is
    caused by the ABS operation check.

    2014 Note

    WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    WHEEL SENSOR
    FRONT WHEEL SENSOR

    B

    FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009619489

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I

    J
    AWFIA0865GB

    1.

    Front wheel sensor

    2.

    Harness connector

    Front

    FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation

    K
    INFOID:0000000009619490

    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage front wheel sensor edge and sensor rotor teeth.
    • When removing the front wheel hub, first remove the front wheel sensor from the steering knuckle.
    Failure to do so may result in damage to the front wheel sensor, making the front wheel sensor inoperative.
    • Pull out the front wheel sensor, being careful to turn it as little as possible. Do not pull on the front
    wheel sensor harness.
    • Before installation, check if foreign objects, such as iron fragments, are adhered to the pick-up part
    of the front wheel sensor or to the inside of the hole in the steering knuckle for the front wheel sensor, or if a foreign object is caught in the surface of the sensor rotor. Fix as necessary and then
    install the front wheel sensor.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove fender protector. Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the front wheel sensor.
    Remove bolt and front wheel sensor from steering knuckle.
    Release front wheel sensor harness clips from the vehicle.

    P

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of the removal.
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-69

    2014 Note

    WHEEL SENSOR
    [ABS]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    CAUTION:
    Do not twist front wheel sensor harness when installing front
    wheel sensor. Check that grommet (2) is fully inserted to
    bracket (1). Check that front wheel sensor harness is not
    twisted after installation.

    JPFIC0209ZZ

    REAR WHEEL SENSOR
    REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009619491

    AWFIA0866GB

    1.

    Rear wheel sensor

    2.

    Harness connector

    REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation

    Front
    INFOID:0000000009619492

    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage rear wheel sensor edge and sensor rotor teeth.
    • When removing the rear wheel hub, first remove the rear wheel sensor from the back plate. Failure to
    do so may result in damage to the rear wheel sensor, making the rear wheel sensor inoperative.
    • Pull out the rear wheel sensor, being careful to turn it as little as possible. Do not pull on the rear
    wheel sensor harness.
    • Before installation, check if foreign objects, such as iron fragments, are adhered to the pick-up part
    of the rear wheel sensor or to the inside of the hole in the back plate for the rear wheel sensor, or if a
    foreign object is caught in the surface of the sensor rotor. Fix as necessary and then install the rear
    wheel sensor.

    REMOVAL
    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-70

    2014 Note

    WHEEL SENSOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Remove bolts (A) and support bracket (1) (LH side only).

    [ABS]
    A

    B

    C
    ALFIA0391ZZ

    2.
    3.
    4.

    D

    Disconnect the harness connector from the rear wheel sensor.
    Release rear wheel sensor harness clips from the vehicle.
    Remove bolts and rear wheel sensor from back plate.

    E

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not twist rear wheel sensor harness when installing rear
    wheel sensor. Check that grommet (2) is fully inserted to
    bracket (1). Check that rear wheel sensor harness is not twisted
    after installation.

    BRC

    G

    H

    I
    JPFIC0209ZZ

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-71

    2014 Note

    SENSOR ROTOR
    [ABS]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    SENSOR ROTOR
    FRONT SENSOR ROTOR
    FRONT SENSOR ROTOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009619493

    REMOVAL
    Remove sensor rotor from steering knuckle. Refer to FAX-9, «Exploded View».

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    REAR SENSOR ROTOR

    REAR SENSOR ROTOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009619494

    REMOVAL
    Remove sensor rotor from brake drum. Refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse rear sensor rotor.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-72

    2014 Note

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    [ABS]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    Exploded View

    A
    INFOID:0000000009619495

    B

    C

    D

    E

    BRC

    G

    H

    I
    AWFIA1025ZZ

    1.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    2.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector

    3.

    Bracket

    4.

    Bushing

    5.

    Insulating clip

    6.

    Bolt

    J

    A.

    To master cylinder secondary side

    B.

    To rear brake tube (RH)

    C.

    To front brake tube (LH)

    D.

    To front brake tube (RH)

    E.

    To rear brake tube (LH)

    F.

    To master cylinder primary side

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009619496

    K

    L

    REMOVAL
    CAUTION:
    • Before servicing, disconnect the battery cable from negative terminal.
    • Do not remove acuator by holding harness.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    1. Disconnect negative battery cable. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    2. Disconnect vacuum hose from intake manifold. Refer to BR-32, «Exploded View».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-73

    2014 Note

    ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Remove ground harness bolt (A) and ground harness from radiator core support.

    [ABS]

    ALKIA3174ZZ

    4.

    Disconnect high-pressure pipe from expansion valve. Refer to HA-27, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C piping and expansion valve with suitable material such as vinyl
    tape to avoid the entry of air.
    5. Remove low-pressure flexible hose. Refer to HA-27, «LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal and
    Installation».
    6. Loosen flare nut from brake tubes using a flare nut wrench, then remove brake tubes from ABS actuator
    and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BR-21, «FRONT : Exploded View».
    7. Disconnect the harness connector from the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    8. Remove ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) bracket bolts.
    9. Remove the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) and bracket as an assembly.
    10. Remove bracket and bushing from ABS actuator and electric unit (if necessary).

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Bleed the brake system. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    CAUTION:
    • Replace the ABS actuator and electric until (control unit) if it has been dropped or sustained an
    impact.
    • Do not install actuator by holding harness.
    • After installing harness connector in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit), make sure harness connector is securely locked.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRC-74

    2014 Note

    BODY EXTERIOR, DOORS, ROOF & VEHICLE SECURITY

    SECTION

    BRM

    BODY REPAIR

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    VEHICLE INFORMATION ……………………….. 2
    BODY EXTERIOR PAINT COLOR ………………… 2
    Body Exterior Paint Color ………………………………… 2

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………. 4

    F

    BODY ALIGNMENT ……………………………………. 4

    G

    Body Center Marks …………………………………………. 4
    Description ………………………………………………………. 5
    Engine Compartment ……………………………………….. 5
    Underbody ………………………………………………………. 7
    Passenger Compartment ………………………………….10
    Rear End Panel ……………………………………………….11

    H

    I

    J

    BRM

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-1

    2014 Note

    BODY EXTERIOR PAINT COLOR
    < VEHICLE INFORMATION >

    VEHICLE INFORMATION
    BODY EXTERIOR PAINT COLOR
    Body Exterior Paint Color

    INFOID:0000000009654082

    AWKIA2519ZZ

    Component

    Color code

    B17

    FAK

    QAC

    KH3

    K23

    K36

    NAC

    RBE

    Description

    Blue

    Green

    White

    Black

    Silver

    Gray

    Red

    Blue

    Paint type

    M

    M

    3P

    2S

    M

    M

    M

    M

    t

    t

    t

    t

    t

    t

    t

    t

    1

    Door outside handles

    Body color

    Hard clear coat

    B17

    FAK

    QAC

    KH3

    K23

    K36

    NAC

    RBE

    2

    Fuel filler lid

    Body color

    B17

    FAK

    QAC

    KH3

    K23

    K36

    NAC

    RBE

    3

    Back door outer finisher

    Body color

    B17

    FAK

    QAC

    KH3

    K23

    K36

    NAC

    RBE

    4

    Rear bumper fascia

    Body color

    B17

    FAK

    QAC

    KH3

    K23

    K36

    NAC

    RBE

    5

    Door mirror

    Body color

    B17

    FAK

    QAC

    KH3

    K23

    K36

    NAC

    RBE

    Black

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    6

    Front bumper fascia

    Body color

    B17

    FAK

    QAC

    KH3

    K23

    K36

    NAC

    RBE

    7

    Front grille

    Black

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    KH3

    M = Metallic, 2S = Solid and Clear, 3P = 3-Stage pearl, t = Primerless Diamond Clear coat.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009654083

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    BRM

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-3

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    BODY ALIGNMENT
    Body Center Marks

    INFOID:0000000009654084

    A mark has been placed on each part of the body to indicate the vehicle center. When repairing parts damaged by an accident which might affect the vehicle frame (members, pillars, etc.), more accurate and effective
    repair will be possible by using these marks together with body alignment specifications.

    AWKIA2546ZZ

    Front

    Point

    Portion

    Mark

    A

    Cowl top extension

    Hole

    B

    Front roof position mark for alignment

    Raised dimple

    C

    Rear roof position mark for alignment

    Raised dimple

    D

    Rear panel upper

    Cut out

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-4

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009654085

    A

    • All dimensions indicated in the figures are actual.
    • When using a tracking gauge, adjust both pointers to equal length. Then check the pointers and gauge itself
    to make sure there is no free play.
    • When a measuring tape is used, check to be sure there is no elongation, twisting or bending.
    • Measurements should be taken at the center of the mounting holes.
    • An asterisk (*) following the value at the measuring point indicates that the measuring point on the other side
    is symmetrically the same value.
    • The coordinates of the measurement points are the distances measured from the standard line of ″X″, ″Y″
    and ″Z″.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    PIIA0104E

    Engine Compartment

    INFOID:0000000009654086

    I

    MEASUREMENTS
    J

    BRM

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-5

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    ALKIA3123ZZ

    Unit: mm (in)

    Position

    Description

    Measurement

    A.

    Center of rear hood hinge hole to center of rear hood hinge hole 12 (0.47)

    1407.0 (55.39)

    B.

    Center shock hole to the center of the shock hole 52 (2.05)

    1132.0 (44.57)

    C.

    Center of front shock tower hole to the center of the front shock tower hole 12 (0.47)

    1228.0 (48.35)

    D.

    Hole for hood locator to the hole for hood locator 12 (0.47)

    1346.0 (53.99)

    E.

    Rear hole for radiator support to rear hole for radiator support 7 (0.28)

    893.0 (35.16)

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-6

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    F.

    Upper hole for front bumper reinforcement to upper hole front bumper reinforcement 8.2 (0.32)

    948.0 (37.32)

    G.

    Lower hole front radiator support to lower hole front lower radiator support 11 (0.43)

    987.0 (38.86)

    H.

    Rear hinge hole 12 (0.47) to front hole upper radiator support 12 (0.47)

    1312.0 (51.65)

    J.

    Rear hinge hole 12 (0.47) to hood locator hole 7 (0.28)

    345.0 (13.58)

    Underbody

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009654087

    MEASUREMENT

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    BRM

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ALKIA3128ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-7

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Unit:mm (in)

    Front

    LH side

    Points

    Measurement

    Points

    Measurement

    A-a

    904.0 (35.59)

    B-b

    820.0 (32.28)

    C-c

    797.0 (31.38).

    D-d

    1134.0 (44.65)

    E-e

    797.0 (31.38)

    F-f

    1220.0 (48.03)

    G-g

    746.0 (29.37)

    H-h

    951.0 (37.44)

    J-j

    952.0 (37.48)

    A-b*

    1835.5 (72.26)

    A-c*

    1192.2 (46.94)

    A-d*

    1619.6 (63.76)

    A-e*

    1665.0 (65.55)

    E-f*

    1362.1 (53.63)

    F-g*

    1038.5 (40.89)

    F-h*

    1214.5 (47.81)

    F-j*

    1379.2 (54.30)

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-8

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    MEASURMENT POINTS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    BRM

    L

    M

    N
    AWKIA2547ZZ

    O

    Front
    Unit: mm (in)

    Coordinates

    Points

    X

    Y

    Z

    A, a

    ± 299.0 (±11.77)

    ±±452.0 (17.80)

    293.6 (11.56)

    B, b

    1305.0 (51.38)

    ± 410.0 (16.14)

    63.0 (2.48)

    Remarks

    P

    Hole 16.0 (0.63)
    Hole 14.0X12.0 (0.55X0.47)

    C, c

    507.0 (19.96)

    ± 398.5 (15.69)

    73.5 (2.89)

    Hole 14.0X12.0 (0.55X0.47)

    D, d

    950.0 (37.40)

    ± 567.0 (22.32)

    136.0 (5.35)

    Hole 12.0 (0.47)

    E, e

    1107.0 (43.58)

    ± 398.5 (15.69)

    25.0 (0.98)

    Hole 12.0 (0.47)

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-9

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Coordinates

    Points

    Remarks

    X

    Y

    Z

    F, f

    2022.5 (79.63)

    ± 610.0 (24.02)

    32.8 (1.29)

    Hole 16.0 (0.63)

    G, g

    2305.0 (90.75)

    ± 373.0 (14.69)

    213.0 (8.39)

    Hole 16.0 (0.63)

    H, h

    2535.0 (99.80)

    ± 475.5 (18.72)

    217.5 (8.56)

    Hole 18.0×16.0 (0.71×0.63)

    J, j

    2850.0 (112.20)

    ± 476.0 (18.74)

    227.5 (8.96)

    Hole 18.0×16.0 (0.71×0.63)

    Passenger Compartment

    INFOID:0000000009654088

    MEASURMENTS

    ALKIA3130ZZ

    Unit: mm (in)

    Position

    Description

    Measurement

    A.

    Front door upper hinge forward bolt hole to rear door upper hinge upper bolt hole.

    1166.4 (45.92)

    B.

    Front door upper hinge forward bolt hole to rear door lower hinge rear bolt hole.

    1189.9 (46.85)

    C.

    Front door lower hinge forward bolt hole to rear door upper hinge upper bolt hole.

    1219.7 (48.02)

    D.

    Front door lower hinge forward bolt hole to rear door lower hinge rear bolt hole.

    1142.0 (44.96)

    E.

    Rear door upper hinge upper bolt hole to rear door body side upper notch.

    755.7 (29.75)

    F.

    Rear door upper hinge upper bolt to rear door body side lower notch.

    681.5 (26.83)

    G.

    Rear door lower hinge rear hole to rear door upper body side notch.

    844.3 (33.24)

    H.

    Rear door rear hinge hole to rear door lower body side notch.

    620.5 (24.43)

    The vehicle is symmetrically identical dimensions on both LH and RH sides of the vehicle.

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-10

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Rear End Panel

    INFOID:0000000009654089

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    ALKIA3132ZZ

    Unit: mm (in)

    Point

    Measurement

    Point

    A-D

    853.7 (33.61)

    A — C*

    871.0 (34.29)

    C* — b*

    1121.7 (44.16)

    C-c

    1055.0 (41.5)

    I

    Measurement

    J

    * The vehicle is symmetrically identical dimensions on both RH and LH sides of the vehicle.

    BRM

    MEASUREMENT POINTS

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-11

    2014 Note

    BODY ALIGNMENT
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    ALKIA3133ZZ

    Front

    Point

    Description

    Point

    Description

    A.

    Roof flange end of center positioning mark

    B.

    Back pillar main joggle

    C.

    Upper rear panel joggle

    D.

    Edge of rear panel between back door striker installing
    holes

    Revision: April 2013

    BRM-12

    2014 Note

    CRUISE CONTROL & DRIVER ASSISTANCE

    SECTION

    CCS

    CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    ASCD

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 3

    F

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE
    (ASCD) ……………………………………………………… 3

    G

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    Information ………………………………………………………. 3

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    CCS

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CCS-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [ASCD]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009474426

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    CCS-2

    2014 Note

    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)
    [ASCD]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)
    Information

    INFOID:0000000009472909

    Automatic Speed Control Device (ASCD) system is controlled by ECM.
    Regarding the information for ASCD system, refer to EC-34, «AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE
    (ASCD) : System Description».

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    CCS

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CCS-3

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL & POWER CONTROL

    SECTION

    CHG

    CHARGING SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 17

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    B TERMINAL CIRCUIT ………………………………. 17

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    Description ………………………………………………………17
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..17

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 3

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4

    L TERMINAL CIRCUIT (OPEN) …………………… 18
    Description ………………………………………………………18
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..18

    L TERMINAL CIRCUIT (SHORT) ………………… 20
    Description ………………………………………………………20
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..20

    S TERMINAL CIRCUIT ………………………………. 21

    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 4

    Description ………………………………………………………21
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..21

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 5

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 22

    System Description …………………………………………… 5

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………… 6
    CHARGING SYSTEM …………………………………… 6
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………… 6

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 10
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ………10

    Symptom Table ……………………………………………….22

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 23
    GENERATOR ……………………………………………. 23 CHG
    Exploded View …………………………………………………23
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..23

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 25

    CHARGING SYSTEM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION ………………………………………………….16

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 25

    Revision: April 2013

    G

    CHARGING SYSTEM ………………………………… 22

    Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI) …… 10
    Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)…. 13

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 16

    F

    Generator ……………………………………………………….25

    CHG-1

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009385608

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009385609

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (—) Model GR8-1200 NI
    Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station

    Tests batteries, starting and charging systems and charges batteries.
    Operating instructions, refer to diagnostic station instruction manual.

    C

    D

    E
    AWIIA1239ZZ


    (—) Model EXP-800 NI
    Battery and electrical diagnostic analyzer

    Tests batteries and charging systems.
    Operating instructions, refer to diagnostic analyzer instruction manual.

    F

    G

    H
    JSMIA0806ZZ

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009385610

    I
    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    J

    K

    L

    PIIB1407E

    CHG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-3

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009014841

    ALMIA0653GB

    A. Inside motor room (right)
    No.

    1.

    2.

    B. Combination meter

    Component part

    Generator

    ”B” terminal

    Refer to: CHG-17, «Description».

    ”S” terminal

    Refer to: CHG-21, «Description».

    ”L” terminal

    Refer to: CHG-18, «Description».

    Combination meter (Charge warning lamp)

    Revision: April 2013

    Description

    The IC voltage regulator warning function activates to illuminate
    the charge warning lamp, if any of the following symptoms occur
    while generator is operating:
    • Excessive voltage is produced.
    • No voltage is produced.

    CHG-4

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009446803

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    ALMIA0652GB

    The generator provides DC voltage to operate the vehicle’s electrical system and to keep the battery charged.
    The voltage output is controlled by the IC regulator.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-5

    2014 Note

    CHARGING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    CHARGING SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009014843

    AAMWA0758GB

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-6

    2014 Note

    CHARGING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1655GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-7

    2014 Note

    CHARGING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1656GB

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-8

    2014 Note

    CHARGING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1657GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-9

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)

    INFOID:0000000009446782

    CHARGING SYSTEM DIAGNOSIS WITH EXP-800 NI OR GR8-1200 NI
    To test the charging system, use the following special service tools:
    • EXP-800 NI Battery and electrical diagnostic analyzer
    • GR8-1200 NI Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station
    NOTE:
    Refer to the applicable Instruction Manual for proper charging system diagnosis procedures.

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-10

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O
    AWMIA1202GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    NOTE:
    To ensure a complete and thorough diagnosis, the battery, stater and generator test segments must be done
    as a set from start to finish.

    1.PRELIMINARY INSPECTION

    Perform the preliminary inspection. Refer to CHG-16, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-11

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DIAGNOSIS WITH EXP-800 NI OR GR8-1200 NI
    Perform the charging system test using Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station GR8-1200 NI or
    Battery and electrical diagnostic analyzer EXP-800 NI. Refer to the applicable Instruction Manual for proper
    testing procedures.
    Test result
    NO PROBLEMS>>Charging system is normal and will also show “DIODE RIPPLE” test result.
    NO VOLTAGE>>GO TO 3.
    LOW VOLTAGE>>GO TO 11.
    HIGH VOLTAGE>>GO TO 13.
    EXCESSIVE RIPPLE, OPEN PHASE, OPEN DIODE or SHORTED DIODE>>Replace the generator. Refer
    to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation». Perform “DIODE RIPPLE” test again using Multitasking
    battery and electrical diagnostic station GR8-1200 NI or Battery and electrical diagnostic analyzer
    EXP-800 NI to confirm repair.

    3.INSPECTION WITH CHARGE WARNING LAMP (IGNITION SWITCH IS ON)

    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Does the charge warning lamp illuminate?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.“L” TERMINAL CIRCUIT (OPEN) INSPECTION

    Check “L” terminal circuit (open). Refer to CHG-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the “L” terminal circuit normal?
    YES >> Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    5.INSPECTION WITH CHARGE WARNING LAMP (IDLING)

    Start the engine and run it at idle.
    Does the charge warning lamp turn OFF?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.“L” TERMINAL CIRCUIT (SHORT) INSPECTION

    Check “L” terminal circuit (short). Refer to CHG-20, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the “L” terminal circuit normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    7.“S” TERMINAL CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    Check “S” terminal circuit. Refer to CHG-21, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the “S” terminal circuit normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    8.INSPECTION WITH CHARGE WARNING LAMP (ENGINE AT 3,000 RPM)

    Increase and maintain the engine speed at 3,000 rpm.
    Does the charge warning lamp remain off?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.INSPECTION OF GENERATOR PULLEY

    Check generator pulley. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Is generator pulley normal?
    YES >> Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-12

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    10.“B” TERMINAL CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    A

    Check “B” terminal circuit. Refer to CHG-17, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is “B” terminal circuit normal?
    YES >> Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    B

    11.“B” TERMINAL CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    C

    Check “B” terminal circuit. Refer to CHG-17, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is “B” terminal circuit normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    D

    12.INSPECTION OF GENERATOR PULLEY

    E

    Check generator pulley. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Is generator pulley normal?
    YES >> Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    F

    13.“S” TERMINAL CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    G

    Check “S” terminal circuit. Refer to CHG-21, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the “S” terminal circuit normal?
    YES >> Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)

    H
    INFOID:0000000009446783

    I

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    Before performing a generator test, make sure that the battery is fully charged. A 30-volt voltmeter and suitable test probes are necessary for the test.
    • Before starting, inspect the fusible link.

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-13

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Use fully charged battery.

    ALMIA0657GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.PRELIMINARY INSPECTION
    Perform the preliminary inspection. Refer to CHG-16, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.INSPECTION WITH CHARGE WARNING LAMP (IGNITION SWITCH IS TURNED ON)
    When ignition switch is turned ON.
    Does the charge warning lamp illuminate?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    3.INSPECTION WITH CHARGE WARNING LAMP (IDLING)

    Start the engine and run it at idle
    Does the charge warning lamp turn OFF?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.INSPECTION WITH CHARGE WARNING LAMP (ENGINE AT 2,500 RPM)

    Increase and maintain the engine speed at 2,500 rpm.
    Does the charge warning lamp illuminate?
    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    A

    5.“L” TERMINAL CIRCUIT (SHORT) INSPECTION
    Check terminal “L” circuit for (short). Refer to CHG-20, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    B

    C

    6.“S” TERMINAL CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    Check terminal “S” circuit. Refer to CHG-21, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    D

    7.MEASURE “B” TERMINAL VOLTAGE

    E

    Start engine. With engine running at 2,500 rpm, measure “B” terminal voltage.
    What voltage does the measurement result show?
    Less than 13.0 V>>GO TO 8.
    More than 16.0 V>>Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».

    F

    8.“B” TERMINAL CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    G

    Check “B” terminal circuit. Refer to CHG-17, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    H

    9.INSPECTION WITH CHARGE WARNING LAMP (IGNITION SWITCH IS ON)

    I

    1. Disconnect generator connector and apply ground to “L” terminal.
    2. Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Does the charge warning lamp illuminate?
    YES >> Replace generator. Refer to CHG-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 10.

    J

    10.CHECK “L” TERMINAL CIRCUIT (OPEN)

    K

    Check “L” terminal circuit (OPEN). Refer to CHG-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    L

    >> Repair as needed.
    CHG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-15

    2014 Note

    CHARGING SYSTEM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    CHARGING SYSTEM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009446787

    1.CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS CONNECTION
    Check if battery terminals are clean and tight.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair battery terminal connection. Confirm repair by performing complete Charging system test
    using EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI (if available). Refer to the applicable Instruction Manual for
    proper testing procedures.

    2.CHECK FUSE

    Check for blown fuse and fusible link.
    Unit

    Power source (Power supply terminals)

    Fuse or Fusible Link

    Battery (terminal 3)

    Fuse 24

    Battery (terminal 1)

    Fusible Link A

    Ignition switch ON (terminal 2)

    Fuse 3

    Generator
    Combination meter

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.

    3.CHECK GENERATOR GROUND TERMINAL CONNECTION

    Check if connector F4 terminal 5 is clean.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair connection.

    4.CHECK DRIVE BELT TENSION

    Check drive belt tension. Refer to EM-115, «Drive Belt».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-16

    2014 Note

    B TERMINAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    B TERMINAL CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009446807

    B

    “B” terminal circuit supplies power to charge the battery and to operate the vehicles electrical system.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009446808

    C

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information. Refer to CHG-6, «Wiring Diagram».

    D

    1.CHECK “B” TERMINAL CONNECTION

    E

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check if “B” terminal is clean and tight.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair terminal “B” connection. Confirm repair by performing complete Charging system test
    using the EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI (if available). Refer to applicable Instruction Manual for
    proper testing procedures.

    F

    G

    2.CHECK “B” TERMINAL CIRCUIT

    H

    Check voltage between generator “B” terminal and ground.
    (+)
    Generator
    Connector

    Terminal

    F2

    1

    (-)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    I

    J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check harness for open between generator and fusible link.

    K

    1.
    2.

    L

    3.CHECK “B” TERMINAL CONNECTION (VOLTAGE DROP TEST)

    Start engine, then engine running at idle and warm.
    Check voltage between battery positive terminal and generator connector “B” terminal.
    (+)
    (-)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    CHG

    Battery positive terminal

    Less than 0.2V

    N

    Generator
    Connector

    Terminal

    F2

    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> “B” terminal circuit is normal. Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)»
    or CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».
    NO
    >> Check harness between battery and generator for continuity.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-17

    2014 Note

    L TERMINAL CIRCUIT (OPEN)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    L TERMINAL CIRCUIT (OPEN)
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009446809

    The “L” terminal circuit controls the charge warning lamp. The charge warning lamp turns ON when the ignition switch is set to ON or START. When the generator is providing sufficient voltage with the engine running,
    the charge warning lamp turns OFF. If the charge warning lamp illuminates with the engine running, a malfunction is indicated.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009446810

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information. Refer to CHG-6, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK “L” TERMINAL CONNECTION
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check if “L” terminal is clean and tight.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair “L” terminal connection. Confirm repair by performing complete Charging system test
    using EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI (if available). Refer to applicable Instruction Manual for proper
    testing procedures.

    2.CHECK “L” TERMINAL CIRCUIT (OPEN)

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the generator connector.
    Apply ground to generator harness connector terminal.
    Check condition of the charge warning lamp with the ignition switch in the ON position.
    Generator

    Condition

    Connector

    Terminal

    F1

    2

    Ground

    Ignition switch position

    Charge warning lamp

    ON

    Illuminate

    Does it illuminate?
    YES >> “L” terminal circuit is normal. Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)» or
    CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Disconnect the combination meter connector.
    Check continuity between generator harness connector and combination meter harness connector.
    Generator

    Combination meter

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F1

    2

    M24

    38

    Continuity
    Yes

    is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Connect the battery cable to the negative terminal.
    Check voltage between combination meter harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-18

    2014 Note

    L TERMINAL CIRCUIT (OPEN)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    (+)
    Combination meter
    Connector
    M24

    (-)

    Condition

    Ground

    When the ignition
    switch is in ON position

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Terminal
    28

    B
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connectors.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-19

    2014 Note

    L TERMINAL CIRCUIT (SHORT)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    L TERMINAL CIRCUIT (SHORT)
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009446811

    The terminal “L” circuit controls the charge warning lamp. The charge warning lamp turns ON when the ignition switch is set to ON or START. When the generator is providing sufficient voltage with the engine running,
    the charge warning lamp turns off. If the charge warning lamp illuminates with the engine running, a malfunction is indicated.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009446812

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to CHG-6, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK “L” TERMINAL CIRCUIT (SHORT)
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect generator connector.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    Does charge warning lamp illuminate?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)» or CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Disconnect generator connector.
    Check continuity between the generator harness connector and ground.
    Generator
    Connector

    Terminal

    F1

    2

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-20

    2014 Note

    S TERMINAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    S TERMINAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009446813

    The output voltage of the generator is controlled by the IC regulator at terminal “S” detecting the input voltage
    from battery.
    The “S” terminal circuit detects the battery voltage to adjust the generator output voltage with the IC voltage
    regulator.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    B

    C

    INFOID:0000000009446814

    D

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information. Refer to CHG-6, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK “S” TERMINAL CONNECTION

    E

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check if “S” terminal is clean and tight.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair “S” terminal connection. Confirm repair by performing complete Charging system test
    using EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI (if available). Refer to the applicable Instruction Manual for
    proper testing procedures.

    2.CHECK “S” TERMINAL CIRCUIT

    F

    G

    H

    Check voltage between generator harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Generator
    Connector

    Terminal

    F1

    3

    (-)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)» or CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».
    NO
    >> Check harness for open between generator and fuse.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-21

    2014 Note

    CHARGING SYSTEM
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    CHARGING SYSTEM
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009014847

    Symptom

    Reference

    Battery discharged
    The charge warning lamp does not illuminate when the ignition
    switch is set to ON.
    The charge warning lamp does not turn OFF after the engine
    starts.

    Refer to CHG-10, «Work Flow (With EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)»
    or CHG-13, «Work Flow (Without EXP-800 NI or GR8-1200 NI)».

    The charging warning lamp turns ON when increasing the engine
    speed.

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-22

    2014 Note

    GENERATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    GENERATOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009385611

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    AWGIA0293ZZ

    1.

    Generator bracket

    2.

    Tensioner Idler pulley

    4.

    “B” terminal harness

    5.

    Generator harness connector

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Generator

    I
    INFOID:0000000009385612

    J

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    Remove the radiator core support upper. DLK-122, «RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER : Removal K
    and Installation».
    Remove drive belt. Refer to EM-24, «Exploded View».
    L
    Disconnect generator harness connector.
    Remove “B” terminal nut and disconnect “B” terminal harness.
    Remove the generator bolts.
    CHG
    Remove the generator.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage surrounding parts when removing generator from the vehicle.
    N
    Remove bolts and remove generator bracket if necessary.

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    Install the generator bracket (if removed), using the following
    procedure.
    Temporarily tighten bolt (1).
    Temporarily tighten bolt (2).
    Tighten bolts to specification in numerical order as shown.

    O

    P

    JMMIA0463ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-23

    2014 Note

    GENERATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    Install the generator using the following procedure.
    Temporarily tighten the generator bolts in order from the lower to the upper.
    Tighten the generator bolts to the specification starting with the top bolt.
    Install “B” terminal harness and «B» terminal nut.
    CAUTION:
    Be sure to tighten «B» terminal nut carefully.
    Installation of the remaining components is the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-24

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Generator

    INFOID:0000000009385613

    Model*

    A002TJ1791ZC

    Manufacturer

    Mitsubishi

    Nominal rating

    13.5V — 110A

    Ground polarity

    Negative

    Minimum revolution under no-load

    1,000 rpm

    C

    D

    More than 27A/1,300 rpm
    More than 95A/2,500 rpm
    More than 116A/5,000 rpm

    Hot output current (When 13.5 V is applied)

    B

    E

    * : Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    CHG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CHG-25

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION & DRIVELINE

    SECTION

    CL

    CLUTCH

    A

    B

    C

    CL

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………..11

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER …………………… 12

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    General Precautions …………………………………………. 2

    Exploded View …………………………………………………12
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..12
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………..13

    CLUTCH PIPING ……………………………………….. 14

    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 3

    Exploded View …………………………………………………14
    Hydraulic Layout ………………………………………………14
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..14
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………..15

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 4

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …… 16

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….. 4

    CSC (CONCENTRIC SLAVE CYLINDER) ……. 16

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3

    Exploded View …………………………………………………16
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..16
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………..17

    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………….. 4

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 5
    CLUTCH PEDAL …………………………………………. 5

    CLUTCH DISC AND CLUTCH COVER ………… 18
    Exploded View …………………………………………………18
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..18
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….19

    Inspection and Adjustment …………………………………. 5

    CLUTCH FLUID …………………………………………… 6
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 6
    Draining …………………………………………………………… 6
    Refilling …………………………………………………………… 7
    Air Bleeding ……………………………………………………… 8

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 10

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 21
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 21

    CLUTCH PEDAL …………………………………………10
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 10
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 10

    General Specifications ………………………………………21
    Clutch Pedal ……………………………………………………21
    Clutch Disc ……………………………………………………..21
    Clutch Cover ……………………………………………………21

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009578850

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    General Precautions

    INFOID:0000000009417548

    WARNING:
    After cleaning clutch disc, wipe it with a dust collector. Do not use compressed air.
    CAUTION:
    • Always use recommended clutch fluid. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Do not reuse drained clutch fluid.
    • Keep painted surface on the body and other parts free of clutch fluid. If fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash the affected area with water.
    • Do not use mineral oils, such as gasoline or kerosene. It will ruin the rubber parts of the hydraulic
    system.
    • Do not reuse CSC (Concentric Slave Cylinder). CSC slides back to the original position every time
    when removing transaxle assembly. At this time, dust on the sliding parts may damage the seal of
    CSC and may cause clutch fluid leakage. Refer to CL-16, «Removal and Installation».
    • Do not disassemble clutch master cylinder and CSC.

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009417550

    Tool name

    Description

    Clutch aligner

    Installing clutch disc

    B

    C

    CL

    E
    MCIB0404E

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    F

    G
    PIIB1407E

    ST20050240
    ( — )
    Diaphragm adjusting wrench

    Adjusting unevenness of diaphragm spring lever

    H

    I

    J

    ZZA0508D

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-3

    2014 Note

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009417551

    CL-18
    FLYWHEEL (Distortion)

    2

    PRESSURE PLATE (Distortion)

    2

    DIAPHRAGM SPRING (Out of tip alignment)

    2

    DIAPHRAGM SPRING (Damaged)

    2

    CLUTCH DISC (Lack of spline grease)

    CL-19
    CLUTCH DISC (Dirty or burned)

    2

    4

    5

    2

    2
    1

    Clutch slips

    1

    Clutch does not disengage

    1

    Revision: April 2013

    CLUTCH DISC (Hardened)

    Clutch noisy

    CLUTCH DISC (Worn out)

    Symptom

    1

    2

    CLUTCH DISC (Oily)

    Clutch pedal spongy

    CLUTCH DISC (Lining broken)

    CL-17
    CSC (Concentric Slave Cylinder) (Worn, dirty or damaged)

    1

    CLUTCH DISC (Runout is excessive)

    EM-85
    ENGINE MOUNTING (Loose)

    Clutch grabs/chatters

    CLUTCH DISC (Out of true)

    CL-8
    CLUTCH LINE (Air in line)

    SUSPECTED PARTS (Possible cause)

    CL-5

    Reference page

    CLUTCH PEDAL (Inspection and adjustment)

    Use the chart below to find the cause of the symptom. The numbers indicate the order of the inspection. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    2

    3

    CL-4

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3
    3

    4

    4

    5

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH PEDAL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    CLUTCH PEDAL
    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009417552

    1.

    Check to see if the master cylinder rod end (
    should not be bound by the clutch pedal.

    a.

    If the master cylinder rod end ( ) does not move freely, remove
    the master cylinder rod end ( ) and check for deformation or
    damage on the master cylinder rod end ( ). Leave the master
    cylinder rod end ( ) removed.

    B

    ) moves freely. It
    C

    CL

    E
    PCIB1491E

    2.
    a.
    b.
    3.

    Check the clutch pedal stroke for free range of movement.
    With the master cylinder rod end removed, manually move the pedal up and down to determine if it moves
    freely.
    If any sticking is noted, replace the clutch pedal assembly. Re-verify that the master cylinder rod end
    moves freely.

    G

    H

    Adjust clutch interlock switch (1) position so that clearance
    between clutch pedal (2) and thread end of clutch interlock
    switch (1), with clutch pedal fully depressed, is within specification (C).
    Clearance (C)

    F

    I

    : Refer to CL-21, «Clutch Pedal».
    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    PCIB1493E

    4.
    a.
    b.

    Check the clutch hydraulic system components (clutch master cylinder, clutch pedal and CSC (Concentric
    Slave Cylinder) for sticking or binding.
    If any sticking or binding is noted, repair or replace the related parts as necessary.
    If any hydraulic system repair was necessary, bleed the clutch hydraulic system. Refer to CL-8, «Air
    Bleeding».

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-5

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    CLUTCH FLUID
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    CLUTCH FLUID
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417553

    CLUTCH FLUID LEAKS
    • Check clutch line for cracks, deterioration or other damage. Replace any damaged parts.
    • Check for clutch fluid leaks by fully depressing clutch pedal while engine is running.
    CAUTION:
    If leaks occur around connections, reinstall the lines or replace damaged parts, if necessary.

    CLUTCH FLUID LEVEL
    • Check that the clutch fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the
    specified range, between the MAX and MIN lines as shown.
    • Visually check for any clutch fluid leaks around the reservoir tank.
    • Check the clutch system for any leaks if the clutch fluid level is
    extremely low (lower than MIN).

    JPFIA0007ZZ

    Draining

    INFOID:0000000009417554

    CAUTION:
    Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash the
    affected area with water.
    1. Connect a transparent vinyl hose to air bleeder of bleeding connector (1).

    JPDIB0144ZZ

    2.

    Press the lock pin (1) into the bleeding connector (2), and maintain the position.

    PCIB1495E

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-6

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH FLUID
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    3. Slide clutch tube (1) for the specified distance (A) in the direction
    of the arrow ( ) as shown.
    (2)

    A

    : Bleeding connector

    B

    Dimension (A)

    : 5 mm (0.20 in)

    CAUTION:
    Do not allow the clutch tube to disconnect from the bleeding connector.

    C
    JPDIB0147ZZ

    4.

    Depress clutch pedal to gradually discharge clutch fluid.
    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the clutch tube to disconnect from the
    bleeding connector.

    Refilling

    CL

    E

    INFOID:0000000009417555

    CAUTION:
    Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash the
    affected area with water.
    1. Check that there is no foreign material in reservoir tank and then fill with new clutch fluid.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained clutch fluid.
    2. Connect a transparent vinyl hose to air bleeder of bleeding connector (1).

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JPDIB0144ZZ

    3.

    Press the lock pin (1) into the bleeding connector (2), and maintain the position.

    K

    L

    M

    N
    PCIB1495E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-7

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH FLUID
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    4. Slide clutch tube (1) for the specified distance (A) in the direction
    of the arrow ( ) as shown.
    (2)

    : Bleeding connector

    Dimension (A)

    : 5 mm (0.20 in)

    JPDIB0147ZZ

    5.

    6.
    7.
    8.

    Slowly depress clutch pedal to the full stroke position and then release the pedal.
    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the clutch tube to disconnect from the
    bleeding connector.
    Repeat step 5 at intervals of 2 or 3 seconds until new clutch fluid is discharged.
    CAUTION:
    Monitor clutch fluid level in reservoir tank so as not to empty the tank.
    Return clutch tube and lock pin in their original positions while clutch pedal is depressed.
    Perform the air bleeding. Refer to CL-8, «Air Bleeding».

    Air Bleeding

    INFOID:0000000009417556

    CAUTION:
    • Monitor clutch fluid level in reservoir tank so as not to empty the tank.
    • Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash
    the affected area with water.
    1. Fill reservoir tank with new clutch fluid.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained clutch fluid.
    2. Connect a transparent vinyl hose to air bleeder of bleeding connector (1).
    3. Depress and release the clutch pedal slowly and fully 15 times
    at an interval of 2 to 3 seconds and release the clutch pedal.

    JPDIB0144ZZ

    4.

    Press the lock pin (1) into the bleeding connector (2), and maintain the position.
    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the
    clutch tube to disconnect from the bleeding connector.

    PCIB1495E

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-8

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH FLUID
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    5. Slide clutch tube (1) for the specified distance (A) in the direction
    of the arrow ( ) as shown and immediately depress the clutch
    pedal and hold it, to bleed the air from the system.
    (2)

    : Bleeding connector

    Dimension (A)

    B

    : 5 mm (0.20 in)

    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the
    clutch tube to disconnect from the bleeding connector.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    A

    C
    JPDIB0147ZZ

    Return clutch tube and lock pin in their original positions.
    Release clutch pedal and wait for 5 seconds.
    Repeat steps 3 to 7 until no bubbles are observed in the clutch fluid.
    Check that the clutch fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the specified range after air bleeding. Refer
    to CL-6, «Inspection».

    CL

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-9

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH PEDAL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    CLUTCH PEDAL
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417557

    AWDIA0944GB

    1.

    Clutch pedal

    2.

    Pedal stopper rubber

    3.

    Pedal pad

    4.

    Clutch interlock switch

    5.

    Clip

    6.

    ASCD cancel switch

    7.

    Clip

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417558

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove the instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».

    2.

    Disconnect master cylinder rod end (

    ) from clutch pedal.

    PCIB1491E

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Disconnect ASCD cancel switch and clutch interlock switch harness connector
    Remove harness clip from clutch pedal.
    Remove clutch pedal nuts and remove clutch pedal.
    Remove pedal pad from clutch pedal.
    Remove clutch interlock switch and clip from clutch pedal.
    Remove pedal stopper rubber from clutch pedal using a suitable tool.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Press master cylinder rod end into clutch pedal until it stops.
    Revision: April 2013

    CL-10

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH PEDAL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009417559

    A

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    • Check clutch pedal for bend, damage, or a cracked weld. If bend, damage, or a cracked weld is found,
    replace clutch pedal.
    • Check pedal stopper rubber. If damage or deformation is found, replace pedal stopper rubber.
    • Check pedal pad. If wear or damage is found, replace pedal pad.

    B

    C

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Inspect the clutch interlock switch position and adjust as necessary. Refer to CL-5, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    CL

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-11

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417560

    JPDIB0222ZZ

    1.

    Reservoir hose

    2.

    Master cylinder

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417561

    CAUTION:
    • Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash
    the affected area with water.
    • Do not disassemble clutch master cylinder.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove battery. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove air cleaner and air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove ECM bracket nuts (A).
    : Front

    JPDIB0233ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-12

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    5.
    6.

    Remove master cylinder rod end ( ) from clutch pedal.
    Use one of the following methods to remove reservoir hose from
    master cylinder.
    • Drain clutch fluid from reservoir tank and remove reservoir
    hose. Refer to CL-6, «Draining».
    • Remove hose from master cylinder.

    A

    B

    C
    PCIB1491E

    7.
    8.

    CL

    Pull up the lock pin (1) from connector of master cylinder (2) and
    separate clutch tube (3).
    Rotate master cylinder clockwise by 45 degrees and then
    remove master cylinder from the vehicle.

    E

    F

    G
    JPDIB0169ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash the
    affected area with water.
    1. With the nipple (1) rotated clockwise by 45 degrees, insert clutch
    master cylinder into the mounting hole. Rotate the clutch master
    cylinder counterclockwise by 45 degrees (A) as shown to secure
    it. At this time, nipple is in the upward (B).
    2. Install master cylinder rod end to clutch pedal.
    CAUTION:
    Press master cylinder rod end into clutch pedal until it
    stops.
    3. Install reservoir hose to master cylinder.
    4. Press down the lock pin into connector of master cylinder until it
    JPDIB0114ZZ
    stops.
    5. Install clutch tube into connector of master cylinder until it stops.
    6. Fill with clutch fluid and bleed clutch hydraulic system. Refer to CL-7, «Refilling».
    7. Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    Inspection and Adjustment

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    INFOID:0000000009417562

    N

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for clutch fluid leaks and check the fluid level. Refer to CL-6, «Inspection».
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-13

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CLUTCH PIPING
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417563

    JPDIB0181ZZ

    1.

    CSC (Concentric Slave Cylinder)

    2.

    Clip

    3.

    Clutch tube

    4.

    Clutch damper

    5.

    Bracket

    6.

    Master cylinder

    Hydraulic Layout

    INFOID:0000000009417564

    PCIB1499E

    1.

    Clutch tube

    2.

    Lock pin

    3.

    CSC (concentric slave cylinder)

    4.

    Clutch damper

    5.

    Master cylinder

    6.

    Clutch pedal

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417565

    CAUTION:
    Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash the
    affected area with water.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    Revision: April 2013

    CL-14

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH PIPING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    REMOVAL
    1. Remove the battery. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    2. Use one of the following methods to remove hose from clutch master cylinder.
    • Drain clutch fluid from reservoir tank and remove hose. Refer to CL-6, «Draining».
    • Remove hose from clutch master cylinder.
    3. Remove clutch tube lock pin from clutch master cylinder.
    4. Remove clutch tube lock pin at clutch housing.
    5. Remove clutch tube lock pins (2) from clutch damper (3).
    6. Remove clutch tube (1) from clutch damper (3).
    7. Remove clutch damper (3) from bracket (4).

    A

    B

    C

    CL

    E

    F
    WCIA0597E

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage clutch tube.
    • Insert each clutch tube into the CSC bleeding connector, the clutch damper connector, and the clutch master
    cylinder connector until it contacts the end of each connector.
    • Install each lock pin into the clutch damper connector and the clutch master cylinder connector until it contacts the end of each connector.
    • After installation, bleed the air from the clutch hydraulic system. Refer to CL-8, «Air Bleeding».

    Inspection and Adjustment

    G

    H

    I

    INFOID:0000000009417566

    J

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    • Check the clutch tube for cracks and damage. If the clutch tube has cracks or damage, replace it with a new
    one.
    • Check the O-ring of the clutch tube for cracks and damage. If the O-ring of the clutch tube has cracks or
    damage, replace clutch tube with a new one.
    • Check the clutch damper for cracks and damage. If the clutch damper has cracks or damage, replace it with
    a new one.

    K

    L

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for clutch fluid leaks and check the clutch fluid level. Refer to CL-6, «Inspection».
    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-15

    2014 Note

    CSC (CONCENTRIC SLAVE CYLINDER)
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    CSC (CONCENTRIC SLAVE CYLINDER)
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417567

    JPDIB0146GB

    1.

    Transaxle assembly

    2.

    CSC (concentric slave cylinder)

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417568

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse CSC (concentric slave cylinder). CSC slides back to the original position every time
    when removing transaxle assembly. At this time, dust on the sliding parts may damage the seal of
    CSC and may cause clutch fluid leaks.
    • Do not disassemble CSC.
    • Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash
    the affected area with water.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove engine transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove CSC bolts and the CSC from clutch housing.

    PCIB1498E

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Install CSC to clutch housing and then tighten CSC bolts to the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse CSC.

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-16

    2014 Note

    CSC (CONCENTRIC SLAVE CYLINDER)
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Do not insert and operate CSC when transaxle is removed. Piston and stopper of CSC components may fall off.
    2. Install engine and transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-23, «Removal and Installation».

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009417569

    A

    B

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for clutch fluid leaks and clutch fluid level. Refer to CL-6, «Inspection».

    C

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Perform the air bleeding. Refer to CL-8, «Air Bleeding».

    CL

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-17

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH DISC AND CLUTCH COVER
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CLUTCH DISC AND CLUTCH COVER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417570

    AWDIA0948GB

    1.

    Flywheel

    2.

    Clutch disc

    3.

    Clutch cover

    4.

    Input shaft

    A.

    First step

    B.

    Final step

    : Apply lithium-based grease including molybdenum disulphide.

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417571

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse CSC (concentric slave cylinder). CSC slides back to the original position every time
    when removing transaxle assembly. At this time, dust on the sliding parts may damage the seal of
    CSC and may cause clutch fluid leaks.
    • Do not allow any grease to contact the clutch disc facing, pressure plate surface and flywheel surface.
    • Do not clean clutch disc using solvent.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove engine and transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Loosen clutch cover bolts evenly. Then remove clutch cover and clutch disc.

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Clean clutch disc and input shaft splines to remove grease and dust caused by abrasion.
    Apply recommended grease to clutch disc and input shaft splines.
    CAUTION:
    Be sure to apply grease to the points specified. Otherwise, noise, poor disengagement, or damage
    to the clutch may result. Excessive grease may cause slip or shudder. If grease adheres to seal of
    CSC, it may cause clutch fluid leaks. Wipe off excess grease. Wipe off any grease oozing from the
    parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-18

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH DISC AND CLUTCH COVER
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Install clutch disc, using suitable tool (A).
    4. Install clutch cover and then temporarily tighten clutch cover
    bolts.
    5. Tighten clutch cover bolts to the specified torque evenly in two
    steps in the numerical order as shown.
    6. Install engine and transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-23,
    «Removal and Installation».

    A

    B

    C
    PCIB1503E

    CL

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417572

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL

    E

    Clutch Disc
    • Measure clutch facing runout. If it is outside the specification,
    replace clutch disc.

    F

    Runout limit/diameter of the area
    to be measured

    : Refer to CL-21,
    «Clutch Disc».

    G

    • Measure spline backlash at outer edge of clutch disc. If it is outside
    the specification, replace clutch disc.
    Maximum allowable spline backlash (at outer edge of disc)

    H

    : Refer to CL-21,
    «Clutch Disc».
    SCL221

    I

    • Measure the depth (A) to clutch disc facing rivet heads, using suitable tool. If it exceeds the allowable wear limit, replace clutch disc.
    Facing wear limit (depth to the
    rivet head) (A)

    J

    : Refer to CL-21,
    «Clutch Disc».

    K

    L
    JPDIB0026ZZ

    Clutch Cover
    • Check clutch cover thrust ring for wear or damage. If wear or damage is found, replace clutch cover.
    NOTE:
    • Worn thrust ring will generate a beating noise when tapped at the rivet using suitable tool.
    • Broken thrust ring will make a clinking sound when cover is shaken up and down.
    • If a trace of burn or discoloration is found on the clutch cover pressure plate to clutch disc contact surface,
    repair the surface with sandpaper. If surface is damaged or distorted, replace clutch cover.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    M

    N

    O

    Clutch Cover
    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-19

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH DISC AND CLUTCH COVER
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check diaphragm spring levers for unevenness with the clutch cover
    installed on the engine. If they exceed the tolerance, adjust diaphragm spring lever height, using suitable tool (A).
    Tolerance for diaphragm spring
    lever unevenness

    : Refer to CL-21,
    «Clutch Cover».

    JPDIB0160ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-20

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    General Specifications

    INFOID:0000000009417573

    B

    Unit: mm (in)

    Engine type

    HR16DE

    Type of clutch control

    Hydraulic

    Clutch disc

    Facing size (Outer dia. × Inner dia. × Thickness)

    Recommended clutch fluid

    C

    200 × 140 × 3.1 (7.87 × 5.51 × 0.122)
    Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    Clutch Pedal

    CL

    INFOID:0000000009417574

    Unit: mm (in)

    Engine type

    E

    HR16DE

    Clearance between clutch pedal and clutch interlock switch
    threaded end while clutch pedal is fully depressed.

    F

    0.2 – 1.96 (0.01 – 0.08)

    Clutch Disc

    INFOID:0000000009417575

    G

    Unit: mm (in)

    Engine type

    HR16DE

    Clutch facing runout limit / diameter of the area to be measured

    H

    1.0 (0.039) / 190 (7.48) dia.

    Maximum allowable spline backlash (at outer edge of disc)

    0.8 (0.031)

    Clutch facing wear limit (depth to the rivet head)

    0.3 (0.012)

    Clutch Cover

    I
    INFOID:0000000009417576

    Unit: mm (in)

    Engine type

    J

    HR16DE

    Tolerance for diaphragm spring lever unevenness

    0.7 (0.028) or less

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CL-21

    2014 Note

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    CO

    ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM

    A

    CO

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    HR16DE
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    RADIATOR CAP ………………………………………………..12
    RADIATOR CAP : Inspection …………………………….12
    RADIATOR ………………………………………………………..12
    RADIATOR : Inspection …………………………………….12

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 14

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    Exploded View …………………………………………………14
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..14

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 3

    RADIATOR ……………………………………………….. 14

    F

    G

    H

    I

    COOLING FAN ………………………………………….. 17

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4

    Exploded View …………………………………………………17
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..17
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….18

    DESCRIPTION ……………………………………………. 4

    WATER PUMP ………………………………………….. 19

    J

    Engine Cooling System ……………………………………… 4
    Engine Cooling System Schematic ……………………… 5

    Exploded View …………………………………………………19
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..19

    K

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 6

    THERMOSTAT ………………………………………….. 21

    L

    Exploded View …………………………………………………21
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..21

    OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS ……………… 6
    Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………………….. 6

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 8
    ENGINE COOLANT …………………………………….. 8

    WATER OUTLET ………………………………………. 24

    M

    Exploded View …………………………………………………24
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..25

    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 8
    Draining Engine Coolant ……………………………………. 8
    Refilling …………………………………………………………… 9
    Flushing Cooling System …………………………………. 11

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 26

    RADIATOR …………………………………………………12

    Standard and Limit …………………………………………..26

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 26

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [HR16DE]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009515764

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009444910

    CO

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV991J0070
    (J-45695)
    Coolant refill tool

    Refilling engine cooling system

    C

    D

    E
    LMA053

    EG17650301
    (J-33984-A)
    Radiator cap tester adapter

    Adapting radiator cap tester to radiator cap
    and radiator filler neck
    a: 28 (1.10) dia.
    b: 31.4 (1.236) dia.
    c: 41.3 (1.626) dia.
    Unit: mm (in)

    F

    G

    H
    S-NT564

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009444911

    I
    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    J

    K

    L

    PIIB1407E

    Radiator cap tester

    Checking radiator and radiator cap

    M

    N
    PBIC1982E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-3

    2014 Note

    DESCRIPTION
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    DESCRIPTION
    Engine Cooling System

    INFOID:0000000009444912

    M/T models

    JSBIA1096GB

    CVT models

    JSBIA1297GB

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-4

    2014 Note

    DESCRIPTION
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Engine Cooling System Schematic

    INFOID:0000000009444913

    A

    M/T models
    CO

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    AWBIA1141GB

    CVT models

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AWBIA1142GB

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-5

    2014 Note

    OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS
    Troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009444914

    Symptom

    Poor heat transfer

    Check items

    Water pump malfunction

    Worn or loose drive belt

    Thermostat stuck closed

    Thermostat

    Damaged fins

    Dust contamination or paper clogging

    Physical damage
    Clogged radiator cooling
    tube

    Excess foreign material
    (rust, dirt, sand, etc.)

    Cooling fan does not operate
    Reduced air flow

    High resistance to fan rotation

    Fan assembly

    Damaged fan blades

    Cooling system parts
    malfunction

    Damaged radiator shroud

    Radiator shroud

    Improper engine coolant
    mixture ratio

    Engine coolant viscosity

    Poor engine coolant quality

    Periodic maintenance

    Cooling hose
    Water pump
    Radiator cap
    Engine coolant leaks

    Loose clamp
    Cracked hose
    Poor sealing
    Loose
    Poor sealing
    O-ring for damage, deterioration or improper fitting

    Insufficient engine coolant
    Radiator

    Cracked radiator tank
    Cracked radiator core

    Reservoir tank
    Overflowing reservoir tank

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-6

    Exhaust gas leaking into
    cooling system

    Cracked reservoir tank
    Cylinder head deterioration
    Cylinder head gasket deterioration

    2014 Note

    OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom

    Check items
    High engine rpm under no
    load
    Abusive driving

    Driving in low gear for extended time

    A

    CO

    Driving at extremely high
    speed

    Overload on engine

    Installed improper size
    wheels and tires

    Except cooling system
    parts malfunction

    C

    Power train system malfunction

    D

    Dragging brakes
    Improper ignition timing

    Blocked or restricted air
    flow

    Blocked bumper

    Installed front bumper fascia cover

    Blocked radiator grille

    Mud contamination or paper
    clogging

    E

    F

    Blocked radiator
    Blocked condenser

    Blocked air flow

    G

    Installed large fog lamp

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-7

    2014 Note

    ENGINE COOLANT
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    ENGINE COOLANT
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009444915

    CHECKING COOLING SYSTEM HOSES
    Check hoses for the following:
    • Improper attachment
    • Leaks
    • Cracks
    • Damage
    • Loose connections
    • Chafing
    • Deterioration

    CHECKING RESERVOIR LEVEL
    • Check that the reservoir tank engine coolant level is within the
    MAX (A) to MIN (B) range when the engine is cool.
    • Adjust the engine coolant level if necessary.
    CAUTION:
    Refill the engine cooling system with the specified coolant or
    equivalent. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    JPBIA0102ZZ

    CHECKING COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly push down and
    turn it a quarter turn to allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by pushing it down
    and turning it all the way.
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when the engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belt.
    To check for leaks, apply pressure to the cooling system using suitable tool (A) and Tool (B).
    Tool number (B)

    : EG17650301 (J-33984-A)

    Testing pressure

    : Refer to CO-8, «Inspection».

    PBIC5121J

    Draining Engine Coolant

    INFOID:0000000009515750

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly push down and
    turn it a quarter turn to allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by pushing it down
    and turning it all the way.
    1. Remove front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    CO-8

    2014 Note

    ENGINE COOLANT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    2. Connect a suitable hose to the radiator drain plug.
    • Use a suitable hose with the dimensions as shown.
    Diameter (A)
    Length (B)

    [HR16DE]
    A

    : 0.8 mm (0.31 in)
    : 300 mm (11.81 in)

    CO

    C
    JPBIA4770ZZ

    3.

    D

    Open radiator drain plug (A) at the bottom of radiator, and then
    remove radiator cap.
    (A): Suitable hose
    : Front
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on the drive belt.

    E

    F

    G
    ALBIA1140ZZ

    4.
    5.
    6.

    It is necessary to drain the cylinder block when draining all of engine coolant in the system. To drain the
    cylinder block, open the water drain plugs on cylinder block. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    Remove reservoir tank if necessary, and drain engine coolant and clean reservoir tank before installing.
    Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».
    Check drained engine coolant for contaminants such as rust, corrosion or discoloration. If contaminated,
    flush the engine cooling system. Refer to CO-11, «Flushing Cooling System».

    Refilling
    1.

    INFOID:0000000009509400

    Install the radiator drain plug. Install the reservoir tank and cylinder block drain plug, if removed for a total
    system drain or for engine removal or repair.
    • The radiator must be completely empty of engine coolant and water.
    • Apply sealant to the threads of the cylinder block drain plug. Use Genuine High Performance
    Thread Sealant or equivalent. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    Radiator drain plug
    2.
    3.

    : Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».

    If disconnected, reattach the upper radiator hose at the engine side.
    Set the vehicle heater controls to the full HOT and heater ON position. Turn the vehicle ignition ON with
    the engine OFF as necessary to activate the heater mode.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-9

    2014 Note

    ENGINE COOLANT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    4. Install the Tool by installing the radiator cap adapter onto the
    radiator neck opening. Then attach the gauge body assembly
    with the refill tube and the venturi assembly to the radiator cap
    adapter.
    Tool number
    5.

    : KV991J0070 (J-45695)

    Insert the refill hose into the engine coolant mixture container
    that is placed at floor level. Make sure the ball valve is in the
    closed position.
    • Use recommended engine coolant or equivalent.
    Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    Engine coolant capacity
    (with reservoir tank)

    6.

    8.

    : 549 — 824 kPa (5.6 — 8.4 kg/cm2,
    80 — 119 psi)

    10.

    11.
    12.
    13.

    LLIA0058E

    CAUTION:
    The compressed air supply must be equipped with an air dryer.
    The vacuum gauge will begin to rise and there will be an audible hissing noise. During this process open
    the ball valve on the refill hose slightly. Engine coolant will be visible rising in the refill hose. Once the refill
    hose is full of engine coolant, close the ball valve. This will purge any air trapped in the refill hose.
    Continue to draw the vacuum until the gauge reaches 28 inches
    of vacuum. The gauge may not reach 28 inches in high altitude
    locations, use the vacuum specifications based on the altitude
    above sea level.
    Altitude above sea level
    0 — 100 m (328 ft)
    300 m (984 ft)
    500 m (1,641 ft)
    1,000 m (3,281 ft)

    9.

    : Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and
    Lubricants».

    CAUTION:
    Do not use any cooling system additives such as radiator
    sealer. Additives may clog the cooling system and cause
    damage to the engine, transmission and/or cooling system.
    Install an air hose to the venturi assembly, the air pressure must
    be within specification.
    Compressed air
    supply pressure

    7.

    [HR16DE]

    Vacuum gauge reading
    : 28 inches of vacuum
    : 27 inches of vacuum
    : 26 inches of vacuum
    : 24 — 25 inches of vacuum

    LLIA0057E

    When the vacuum gauge has reached the specified amount, disconnect the air hose and wait 20 seconds
    to see if the system loses any vacuum. If the vacuum level drops, perform any necessary repairs to the
    system and repeat steps 6 — 8 to bring the vacuum to the specified amount. Recheck for any leaks.
    Place the engine coolant container (with the refill hose inserted) at the same level as the top of the radiator. Then open the ball valve on the refill hose so the engine coolant will be drawn up to fill the cooling system. The cooling system is full when the vacuum gauge reads zero.
    CAUTION:
    Do not allow the engine coolant container to get too low when filling, to avoid air from being drawn
    into the cooling system.
    Remove the Tool from the radiator neck opening.
    Fill the cooling system reservoir tank to the specified level and install the radiator cap. Run the engine to
    warm up the cooling system and top up the system as necessary.
    Install the front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-10

    2014 Note

    ENGINE COOLANT
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    Flushing Cooling System
    1.

    3.
    4.

    A

    Install radiator drain plug and reservoir tank, if removed.
    Radiator drain plug

    2.

    INFOID:0000000009509391

    : Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».

    CO

    CAUTION:
    Be sure to clean drain plug and install with new O-ring.
    If water drain plugs on cylinder block were removed, close and tighten them. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded
    View».
    Remove air duct from between air cleaner case and electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-26,
    «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect heater hose (1) at location ( ) as shown.
    • Position heater hose as high as possible.
    : Front

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JSBIA0616ZZ

    5.

    Fill radiator until engine coolant flows out of the disconnected heater hose and then reconnect the heater
    hose.
    6. Finish filling the engine and reservoir tank with water and reinstall the radiator cap.
    7. Install air duct in between air cleaner case and electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-26, «Removal
    and Installation».
    8. Run the engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    9. Rev the engine two or three times under no-load.
    10. Stop the engine and wait until it cools down.
    11. Drain water from the system. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    12. Repeat steps 1 through 11 until clear water begins to drain from radiator.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-11

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    RADIATOR
    RADIATOR CAP
    RADIATOR CAP : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009444919

    • Check valve seat (A) of radiator cap.
    (B)

    : Metal plunger

    — Replace the cap if the metal plunger cannot be seen around the
    edge of the black rubber gasket.
    — Replace the cap if deposits of waxy residue or other foreign material are on the black rubber gasket or the metal retainer.
    NOTE:
    Thoroughly wipe out the radiator filler neck to remove any waxy
    residue or foreign material.
    JPBIA0108ZZ

    • Pull negative-pressure valve to open it, and check that it closes
    completely when released.
    — Check that there is no dirt or damage on the valve seat of radiator
    cap negative-pressure valve.
    — Check that there are no abnormalities in the opening and closing
    conditions of negative-pressure valve.

    SMA967B

    • Check radiator cap relief pressure using suitable tool (A) and Tool
    (B).
    Tool number

    : EG17650301 (J-33984-A)

    Standard and Limit

    : Refer to CO-26, «Standard and
    Limit».

    — When connecting the radiator cap to Tool (B), apply water or
    engine coolant to the cap seal surface.
    — Replace the radiator cap if there is an abnormality in the negativepressure valve, or if the open-valve pressure is outside of the standard values.

    PBIC5122J

    RADIATOR

    RADIATOR : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009509402

    Check radiator for mud or clogging. If necessary, clean radiator as follows.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to bend or damage radiator fins.
    • When radiator is cleaned without removal, remove all surrounding parts in order to access the radiator core. Then tape harness and harness connectors to prevent water from entering.
    1. Spray water to the back side of the radiator core using a side to side motion from the top down.
    2. Stop spraying when debris no longer flows from radiator.
    3. Blow air into the back side of radiator core using side to side motion from the top down.
    • Use compressed air lower than 490 kPa (5 kg/cm2, 71 psi) and keep distance more than 30 cm (11.81
    in).
    4. Continue to blow air until no water sprays out.
    Revision: April 2013

    CO-12

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    5. Check for engine coolant leaks. Repair if necessary.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    CO

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-13

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    RADIATOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444921

    AWBIA1144GB

    1.

    Reservoir tank hose

    2.

    Reservoir tank cap

    3.

    Reservoir tank

    4.

    Mounting rubber (lower)

    5.

    O-ring

    6.

    Drain plug

    7.

    Radiator

    8.

    Cooling fan assembly

    9.

    Clamp

    10. Radiator hose (lower)

    11. Clamp

    13. Radiator hose to water outlet (upper) 14. Radiator cap adapter

    12. Oil cooler hose
    15. Radiator cap

    16. Radiator cap adapter bracket

    17. Clamp

    18. Radiator hose (upper) to radiator

    19. Mounting rubber (upper)

    20. CVT cooler hose

    21. Clamp

    21. Clamp

    22. Clamp

    23. CVT cooler hose

    24. Clamp

    A.

    B.

    C.

    To water inlet

    To water outlet

    To oil cooler

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444922

    REMOVAL
    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the radiator cap. Slowly turn it a
    quarter of a turn to release built-up pressure. Carefully remove radiator cap by turning it all the way.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    Revision: April 2013

    CO-14

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Drain engine coolant. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    CAUTION:
    A
    • Perform this step when the engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belt.
    2. Remove air duct (inlet). Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    CO
    3. Disconnect battery negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    4. Remove radiator hose (lower).
    C
    5. Remove radiator hose (upper) from water outlet.
    6. Remove the front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    7. Remove the front grille. Refer toEXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    D
    8. Disconnect reservoir tank hose, and remove reservoir tank.
    9. Disconnect harness connector from fan motor, and move harness aside.
    10. Remove radiator core support (upper). Refer to DLK-122, «RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER :
    E
    Removal and Installation».
    11. Remove the condenser bolts and place aside. Refer to HA-29, «Exploded View».
    12. Remove radiator hose (upper) from radiator.
    F
    13. Remove cooling fan assembly. Refer to CO-17, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage or scratch the radiator.
    G
    14. Disconnect CVT cooler lines.
    15. Remove the radiator from bottom of the vehicle.
    CAUTION:
    H
    When removing, do not damage or scratch radiator core or A/C condenser.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-ring.
    • Insert the radiator hose (1) all the way to the stopper (2) or by 33 mm (1.30 in) (hose without a stopper) as
    shown.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M
    JPBIA4294GB

    1.

    Radiator hose

    2.

    Stopper

    A.

    Radiator side

    B.

    Engine side

    N

    • The correct orientation of the hose clamps are as shown.
    O
    Radiator hose
    Radiator hose (upper)

    Radiator hose (lower)

    Hose end

    Paint mark

    Position of hose clamp*

    Radiator side

    Upper

    A

    Engine side

    Upper

    B

    Radiator side

    Lower

    C

    Engine side

    Upper

    D

    P

    *: Refer to the illustrations for the specific position for each hose clamp tab.

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-15

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    JSBIA1299ZZ

    A.

    View A

    B.

    View B

    C.

    View C

    D

    View D

    E.

    View E

    f.

    45°

    : Vehicle upper

    • The angle (b) created by the hose clamp pawl and the specified
    line (A) must be within ±30° as shown.

    JPBIA4295ZZ

    • To install hose clamps (1), check that the dimension (A) from the
    end of the hose clamp on the radiator hose to the hose clamp is
    within the reference value.
    Dimension (A)

    : 3 – 7 mm (0.12 – 0.28 in)

    CAUTION:
    • When installing do not damage or scratch radiator core or A/C
    condenser.
    • Replace water hose clamp if it is removed.
    • Use only Genuine NISSAN bolts for the cooling fan assembly
    and strictly follow the tightening torque. Over tightening may
    damage the radiator.

    JPBIA3527ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Check for engine coolant leaks. Refer to CO-8, «Inspection».
    • Start and warm up the engine. Visually inspect for engine coolant leaks. Repair as necessary.

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-16

    2014 Note

    COOLING FAN
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    COOLING FAN

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444923

    CO

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWBIA1140GB

    1.

    Fan shroud

    2.

    Fan motor

    A.

    Cooling fan nut

    L.

    Genuine NISSAN high strength locking sealant

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Cooling fan

    H

    INFOID:0000000009444924

    I

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the radiator cap. Slowly turn it a
    quarter of a turn to release built-up pressure. Carefully remove radiator cap by turning it all the way.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    1. Drain engine coolant. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when the engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belt.
    2. Disconnect battery negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    3. Remove the front grille. Refer toEXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    4. Remove reservoir tank. Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».
    5. Disconnect harness connector from fan motor, and move harness aside.
    6. Remove radiator core support (upper). Refer to DLK-122, «RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER :
    Removal and Installation».
    7. Remove cooling fan assembly. Refer to CO-17, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage or scratch the radiator.

    J

    REMOVAL

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Only use Genuine NISSAN parts for the fan shroud bolt.
    NOTE:
    Cooling fan assembly is controlled by ECM. For details, refer to EC-35, «COOLING FAN CONTROL : System
    Description».
    Revision: April 2013

    CO-17

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    COOLING FAN
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009444925

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.

    Remove cooling fan nut, and then remove the cooling fan.
    Remove fan motor.

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Cooling fan and shroud
    Inspect cooling fan and shroud for nicks, cracks, breaks and warping. Replace if necessary.

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    CAUTION:
    Apply Genuine NISSAN high strength thread locking sealant on fan motor shaft.

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-18

    2014 Note

    WATER PUMP
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    WATER PUMP

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444926

    CO

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JPBIA4104GB

    1.

    Gasket

    2.

    Water pump

    3.

    Water pump pulley

    Removal and Installation

    H
    INFOID:0000000009444927

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the radiator cap. Slowly turn it a
    quarter of a turn to release built-up pressure. Carefully remove radiator cap by turning it all the way.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Drain engine coolant from radiator. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when the engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belt.
    Remove front wheel and tire (RH) using power tool. Refer to WT-5, «Adjustment».
    Remove front fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Loosen water pump pulley bolts before loosening belt tension of drive belt.
    Remove drive belt. Refer to EM-16, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove water pump pulley.
    Remove water pump.
    • Loosen water pump bolts in reverse order as shown.
    • Engine coolant will leak from cylinder block, so have a receptacle ready below.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not allow water pump vane to contact any other parts.
    • Water pump cannot be disassembled and must be
    replaced as an assembly.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL

    CO-19

    J

    K

    KBIA3393J

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    2014 Note

    WATER PUMP
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Visually check for significant dirt or rust on the water pump body
    and vane (A) and replace as necessary.
    • Check that the vane shaft turns smoothly by hand and is not
    excessively loose.
    • Replace the water pump assembly if the water pump does not perform properly.

    PBIC3808E

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Tighten water pump bolts in order as shown.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not allow the water pump vane to contact any other parts.
    • Water pump cannot be disassembled and must be replaced as
    an assembly.
    • Do not reuse gasket.
    • Sealing surface must be clean and free of dents or flaws.

    KBIA3393J

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids, including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels, including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item
    Engine coolant
    Engine oil

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-20

    2014 Note

    THERMOSTAT
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    THERMOSTAT

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444928

    CO

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    PBIC3810E

    1.

    Radiator hose (lower)

    2.

    Water inlet

    4.

    Thermostat

    A.

    To radiator

    3.

    Rubber ring

    Removal and Installation

    H
    INFOID:0000000009444929

    I

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the radiator cap. Slowly turn it a
    quarter of a turn to release built-up pressure. Carefully remove radiator cap by turning it all the way.

    J

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.
    4.

    K

    Drain engine coolant from radiator. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belt.
    Remove air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect radiator hose (lower) from water inlet. Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».
    Remove water inlet, thermostat, and rubber ring.
    NOTE:
    Engine coolant will leak from cylinder block, so have a receptacle ready below.

    L

    M

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL

    N

    Thermostat
    • Place a thread (A) so that it is caught in the valves of thermostat
    (1). Immerse fully in a container (B) filled with water. Heat while
    stirring.
    • The valve opening temperature is the temperature at which the
    valve opens and falls from the thread.
    • Continue heating. Check the full open valve lift amount.
    • After checking the maximum valve lift amount, lower the water
    temperature and check the valve closing temperature.

    Standard: Refer to CO-26, «Standard and
    Limit».

    O

    P

    PBIC3314J

    • If out of the standard specification range, replace the thermostat.
    Revision: April 2013

    CO-21

    2014 Note

    THERMOSTAT
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Thermostat
    • Install thermostat making sure rubber ring (1) groove fits securely
    to thermostat flange (A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse rubber ring.

    JPBIA4229ZZ

    • Install thermostat (2) into the cylinder block (1) with jiggle valve (A)
    facing upward.

    PBIC3812E

    Water Inlet
    After installation, attach the water inlet clip (A) on the oil level gauge
    guide (1) positioned at location (B) as shown.

    PBIC3755E

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids, including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels, including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-22

    2014 Note

    THERMOSTAT
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Exhaust gas

    A

    CO

    C

    D

    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-23

    2014 Note

    WATER OUTLET
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    WATER OUTLET
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444930

    M/T model

    AWBIA1582ZZ

    1.

    Engine coolant temperature sensor

    2.

    Clamp

    3.

    Gasket

    4.

    Clamp

    5.

    Bracket

    6.

    Clamp

    7.

    Water outlet

    8.

    Clamp

    9.

    Clamp

    A.

    From electric throttle control actuator B.

    To radiator

    C.

    From heater core

    To heater core

    To electric throttle control actuator

    D.

    To heater core

    D.

    E.

    Front

    CVT model

    AWBIA1583ZZ

    1.

    Engine coolant temperature sensor

    2.

    Clamp

    3.

    4.

    Clamp

    5.

    Bracket

    6.

    Gasket
    Clamp

    7.

    Water outlet

    8.

    Clamp

    9.

    Clamp

    10. Clamp

    A.

    From electric throttle control actuator B.

    To radiator

    C.

    To heater core / CVT oil warmer

    D.

    To CVT oil warmer

    To heater core

    F.

    To electric throttle control actuator

    Revision: April 2013

    E.

    Front

    CO-24

    2014 Note

    WATER OUTLET
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444931

    A
    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the radiator cap. Slowly turn it a CO
    quarter of a turn to release built-up pressure. Carefully remove radiator cap by turning it all the way.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spillC
    ing.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Drain engine coolant. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belt.
    Remove air ducts and air cleaner assembly. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect radiator hose (upper). Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect harness connector from engine coolant temperature sensor.
    Disconnect water hoses and heater hoses from water outlet.
    Remove water outlet.
    Remove engine coolant temperature sensor from water outlet, if necessary.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    H

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids, including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels, including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    CO-25

    2014 Note

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Standard and Limit

    INFOID:0000000009444932

    Engine coolant capacity (approximate)
    Unit:

    Engine coolant capacity (With reservoir tank at “MAX” level)*
    Reservoir tank engine coolant capacity (At “MAX” level)

    (US qt, Imp qt)

    CVT models

    7.3 (7-3/4, 6-3/8)

    M/T models

    6.7 (7-1/8, 5-7/8)
    0.7 (3/4, 5/8)

    *: Includes reservoir amount.

    Radiator
    Unit: kPa (kg/cm2, psi)

    Cap relief pressure

    Standard

    88 (0.90, 12.8)

    Radiator leak test pressure

    156 (1.59, 22.6)

    Thermostat
    Standard

    Valve opening temperature

    80.5 — 83.5°C (177 — 182°F)

    Maximum valve lift

    8.0 mm/95°C (0.315 in/203°F)

    Valve closing temperature

    Revision: April 2013

    77°C (171°F)

    CO-26

    2014 Note

    DRIVER CONTROLS

    SECTION

    DEF

    DEFOGGER

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 16

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH ……….. 16

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    Description ………………………………………………………16
    Component Function Check ………………………………16
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..16
    Component Inspection ………………………………………17

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 3
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 3
    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 3
    Rear window defogger ………………………………………. 4

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 5
    System Description …………………………………………… 5

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….. 6
    COMMON ITEM ………………………………………………….. 6
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) ………………………………………………. 6

    Description ………………………………………………………18
    Component Function Check ………………………………18
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..18
    Component Inspection ………………………………………19

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT …………………….. 20
    Description ………………………………………………………20
    Component Function Check ………………………………20
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..20
    Component Inspection ………………………………………21

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 22

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION …………… 8

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..22

    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………. 8

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………… 9
    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM …………. 9
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………… 9

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 13
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW ……..13
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………… 13

    Revision: April 2013

    G

    H

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY …………. 18

    REAR DEFOGGER …………………………………………….. 6
    REAR DEFOGGER : CONSULT Function (BCM REAR DEFOGGER) …………………………………………. 7

    BCM …………………………………………………………… 8

    F

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER DOES NOT
    OPERATE ………………………………………………… 22
    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH DOES
    NOT LIGHT, BUT REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER OPERATES ………………………………………. 23
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..23

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 24
    FILAMENT ………………………………………………… 24
    Inspection and Repair ……………………………………….24

    CONDENSER ……………………………………………. 26
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..26

    DEF-1

    2014 Note

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009500279

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-2

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009477885

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M
    ALLIA1294ZZ

    A.

    Center of instrument panel

    No.

    B.

    Left side of instrument panel

    Component

    C.

    Back door lower finisher inside

    Function

    1.

    BCM

    • Operates the rear window defogger with the operation of rear window defogger switch.
    • Performs the timer control of rear window defogger.
    Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location» for detailed installation location.

    2.

    Rear window defogger

    Refer to DEF-4, «Rear window defogger».

    3.

    Front air control (rear window
    defogger switch)

    • The rear window defogger switch is turned ON.
    • Turns the indicator lamp ON when detecting the operation of rear window defogger.

    4.

    Rear window defogger relay

    Operates the rear window defogger with the control signal from BCM.

    5.

    Condenser

    Removes the noise that is generated when the rear window defogger turns ON/OFF.

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    DEF-3

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Rear window defogger

    INFOID:0000000009499782

    Heats the heating wire with the power supply from the rear window
    defogger relay to prevent the rear window from fogging up.

    JMLIA2595GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-4

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009477888

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    ALLIA1291GB

    Operation Description
    • When rear window defogger switch is turned ON while ignition switch is ON, the front air control (rear window defogger switch) transmits rear window defogger switch signal to BCM.
    • BCM turns rear window defogger relay ON when rear window defogger switch signal is received.
    • Rear window defogger are supplied with power and operate when rear window defogger relay turns ON.
    • Rear window defogger ON is displayed when front air control receives signals.

    Timer function
    • BCM turns rear window defogger relay ON for approximately 15 minutes when rear window defogger switch
    is turned ON while ignition switch is ON. It makes rear window defogger operate.
    • Timer is canceled after pressing rear window defogger switch again during timer operation. Then BCM turns
    rear window defogger relay OFF. The same reaction also occurs during timer operation, if the ignition switch
    is turned OFF.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
    Switch

    Input signal to BCM

    Rear window defogger switch

    Defogger switch signal

    Ignition switch

    Ignition signal

    BCM function

    Actuator

    Rear window defogger control

    Rear window defogger

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-5

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009567628

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-6

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    REAR DEFOGGER : CONSULT Function (BCM — REAR DEFOGGER)

    INFOID:0000000009567629

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    B

    Description

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    REAR DEF SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear window defogger switch.

    C

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    REAR DEFOGGER

    Description

    D

    This test is able to check rear window defogger operation [Off/On].

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-7

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    BCM
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009477893

    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-8

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009477894

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AALWA0623GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-9

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1366GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-10

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1367GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-11

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1368GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-12

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009477895

    B

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JMKIA0101GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-13

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    1. GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    Get the detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when
    the incident/malfunction occurred).
    >> GO TO 2

    2. CHECK DTC

    1. Check DTC.
    2. Perform the following procedure if DTC is displayed.
    Record DTC and freeze frame data (Print them out with CONSULT.)
    Erase DTC.
    Study the relationship between the cause detected by DTC and the symptom described by the customer.
    3. Check related service bulletins for information.
    Is any symptom described and any DTC detected?
    Symptom is described, DTC is displayed>>GO TO 3
    Symptom is described, DTC is not displayed>>GO TO 4
    Symptom is not described, DTC is displayed>>GO TO 5

    3. CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    Confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Connect CONSULT to the vehicle in “DATA MONITOR” mode and check real time diagnosis results.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.
    >> GO TO 5

    4. CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
    Confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Connect CONSULT to the vehicle in “DATA MONITOR” mode and check real time diagnosis results.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.
    >> GO TO 6

    5. PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure for the displayed DTC, and then check that DTC is detected again.
    At this time, always connect CONSULT to the vehicle, and check diagnostic results in real time.
    If two or more DTCs are detected, refer to BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart» and determine trouble
    diagnosis order.
    NOTE:
    • Freeze frame data is useful if the DTC is not detected.
    • Perform Component Function Check if DTC Confirmation Procedure is not included in Service Manual. This
    simplified check procedure is an effective alternative though DTC cannot be detected during this check.
    If the result of Component Function Check is NG, it is the same as the detection of DTC by DTC Confirmation Procedure.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 8
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    6. PERFORM BASIC INSPECTION

    Perform DEF-13, «Work Flow».
    >> GO TO 7

    7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM BY SYMPTOM TABLE
    Detect malfunctioning system according to DEF-5, «System Description» based on the confirmed symptom in
    step 4, and determine the trouble diagnosis order based on possible causes and symptom.
    >> GO TO 8
    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
    Inspect according to Diagnostic Procedure of the system.
    NOTE:
    The Diagnostic Procedure described based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit inspection is also
    required for the circuit check in the Diagnostic Procedure.
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 9
    NO
    >> Check voltage of related BCM terminals using CONSULT.

    A

    B

    C

    9. REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnostic Procedure again after repair and replacement.
    Check DTC. If DTC is displayed, erase it.

    D

    E

    >> GO TO 10

    10. FINAL CHECK

    F

    When DTC was detected in step 2, perform DTC Confirmation Procedure or Component Function Check
    again, and then check that the malfunction have been repaired securely.
    When symptom was described from the customer, refer to confirmed symptom in step 3 or 4, and check that
    the symptom is not detected.
    Does the symptom reappear?
    YES (DTC is detected)>>GO TO 8
    YES (Symptom remains)>>GO TO 6
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-15

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477896

    • The rear window defogger is operated by pressing the rear window defogger switch ON.
    • The indicator lamp in the rear window defogger switch illuminates while the rear window defogger is ON.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009477897

    1. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH FUNCTION
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check that the indicator lamp of rear window defogger illuminates with rear window defogger switch ON.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to DEF-16, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK REAR DEFOGGER ON STATUS

    1.
    2.

    Using CONSULT, select “BCM (REAR DEFOGGER)”, then “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Select “REAR DEF SW” and monitor while pressing the rear DEF switch ON and OFF.
    Monitored Item
    REAR DEF SW

    Condition

    Status

    Rear DEF switch ON (LED ON)

    On

    Rear DEF switch OFF (LED OFF)

    Off

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to DEF-16, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477898

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DEF-9, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK BCM OUTPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front air control connector.
    Check voltage between front air control harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Front air control
    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    10

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and front air control harness connector.
    BCM

    Front air control

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M18

    15

    M33

    10

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-16

    Continuity
    Yes

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    A
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M18

    15

    Continuity

    Ground

    B

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    C

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    D

    Check continuity between front air control harness connector and ground.
    Front air control
    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    8

    Continuity

    Ground

    E

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    4.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH

    G

    Refer to DEF-17, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection

    H

    INFOID:0000000009477899

    I

    1.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front air control connector.
    Check continuity between front air control terminals.

    K

    Front air control

    Condition

    Terminal
    10

    J

    8

    Rear window defogger switch

    Continuity
    Pressed

    Yes

    Released

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-17

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477900

    Power is supplied to the rear window defogger with BCM control.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009477901

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check that an operation noise of rear window defogger relay can be heard when turning the rear window
    defogger switch ON.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Rear window defogger relay function is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DEF-18, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477902

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DEF-9, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect rear window defogger relay connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between rear window defogger relay harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Rear window defogger relay
    Connector

    Terminal

    M14

    1

    (−)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FUSE

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check 10A fuse (No. 5).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check ignition power supply circuit. Refer to PG-22, «Wiring Diagram — Ignition Power Supply —
    «.
    NO
    >> If fuse is blown, be sure to eliminate cause of malfunction before installing new fuse.

    3.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and rear window defogger relay harness connector.
    BCM

    4.

    Rear window defogger relay

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M18

    1

    M14

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-18

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M18

    1

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    A

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    C

    4.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY
    Refer to DEF-19, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace rear window defogger relay.

    D

    E

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009477903

    F

    Check continuity between terminal 3 and 5.
    Terminal

    Condition

    Continuity

    3 and 5

    12 V direct current supply between terminal 1
    and 2

    Yes

    No current supply

    No

    G

    H

    I
    SEF497Y

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-19

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477904

    Heats the heating wire with the power supply from the rear window defogger relay to prevent the rear window
    from fogging up.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009477905

    1. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER
    Check that the heating wire of rear window defogger is heated when turning the rear window defogger switch
    ON.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Rear window defogger is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DEF-20, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477906

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DEF-9, «Wiring Diagram».

    1. CHECK FUSES
    Check if any of the following fuses in fuse block (J/B) are blown.
    COMPONENT PARTS

    AMPERE

    FUSE NO.

    Fuse block (J/B)

    20A

    11

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> If fuse is blown, be sure to eliminate cause of malfunction before installing new fuse.

    2. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between rear window defogger relay connector and ground.
    Terminals
    (+)
    Rear window
    defogger relay
    connector

    Terminal

    M14

    5

    (–)

    Condition of rear
    window defogger
    switch

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    ON

    Battery voltage

    OFF

    0

    Ground

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3
    NO
    >> Check the following:
    • Rear window defogger relay.
    • Battery power supply circuit.

    3. CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between rear window defogger connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-20

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    Terminals
    (+)
    Rear window
    defogger
    connector

    Terminal

    B50

    1

    (–)

    Condition of rear
    window
    defogger switch

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    ON

    Battery voltage

    OFF

    0

    Ground

    B

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4
    NO
    >> GO TO 5

    D

    4. CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    E

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear window defogger.
    Check continuity between rear window defogger connector and ground.

    F
    Rear window defogger connector

    Terminal

    B51

    2

    Ground

    Continuity
    Yes

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    H

    5. CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear window defogger relay connector and condenser connector.
    Check continuity between rear window defogger relay connector and condenser connector.

    I

    J

    Rear window
    defogger relay
    connector

    Terminal

    Condenser connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    M14

    5

    B42

    1

    Yes

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace condenser. Refer to DEF-26, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace or repair harness.

    DEF

    6. CHECK FILAMENT

    Check filament.
    Refer to DEF-21, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair filament. Refer to DEF-24, «Inspection and Repair».

    Component Inspection

    M

    N
    INFOID:0000000009477907

    O

    1. CHECK FILAMENT
    Check the filament for damage or open circuits.
    Refer to DEF-24, «Inspection and Repair».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair filament. Refer to DEF-24, «Inspection and Repair».

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-21

    P

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477916

    1. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH
    Check rear window defogger switch.
    Refer to DEF-16, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER RELAY

    Check rear window defogger relay.
    Refer to DEF-18, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check rear window defogger power supply and ground circuit.
    Refer to DEF-20, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-22

    2014 Note

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH DOES NOT LIGHT, BUT REAR WINDOW
    DEFOGGER OPERATES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH DOES NOT LIGHT, BUT REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER OPERATES
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477921

    1. CHECK FRONT AIR CONTROL (REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH)
    Check that the front air control (rear window defogger switch) is operating normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Refer to DEF-16, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DEF

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-23

    2014 Note

    FILAMENT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    FILAMENT
    Inspection and Repair

    INFOID:0000000009500277

    INSPECTION
    1.

    When measuring voltage, wrap tin foil around the top of the negative probe. Then press the foil against the wire with your finger.

    SEL122R

    2.

    Attach probe circuit tester (in Volt range) to middle portion of
    each filament.

    SEL263

    3.
    4.

    If a filament is burned out, circuit tester registers 0 or battery
    voltage.
    To locate burned out point, move probe to left and right along filament. Test needle will swing abruptly when probe passes the
    point.

    SEL265

    REPAIR
    REPAIR EQUIPMENT
    • Conductive silver composition (Dupont No. 4817 or equivalent)

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-24

    2014 Note

    FILAMENT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Ruler 30 cm (11.8 in) long
    • Drawing pen
    • Heat gun
    • Alcohol
    • Cloth

    A

    B

    REPAIRING PROCEDURE

    1.
    2.

    3.

    Wipe broken heat wire and its surrounding area clean with a
    cloth dampened in alcohol.
    Apply a small amount of conductive silver composition to tip of
    drawing pen.
    NOTE:
    Shake silver composition container before use.
    Place ruler on glass along broken line. Deposit conductive silver
    composition on break with drawing pen. Slightly overlap existing
    heat wire on both sides [preferably 5 mm (0.20 in)] of the break.

    C

    D

    E
    PIIA0215E

    F

    4.

    After repair has been completed, check repaired wire for continuity. This check should be conducted 10 minutes after silver
    composition is deposited.
    CAUTION:
    Do not touch repaired area while test is being conducted.

    G

    H

    I
    SEL012D

    5.

    J

    Apply a constant stream of hot air directly to the repaired area
    for approximately 20 minutes with a heat gun. A minimum distance of 3 cm (1.2 in) should be kept between repaired area and
    hot air outlet.
    NOTE:
    If a heat gun is not available, let the repaired area dry for 24
    hours.

    K

    DEF

    SEL013D

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-25

    2014 Note

    CONDENSER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CONDENSER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009500278

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove back door inner finisher. Refer to INT-34, «BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors (B), from the condenser (1).
    : Front
    Remove the condenser bolt (A) and the condenser (1).

    ALLIA1295ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DEF-26

    2014 Note

    BODY EXTERIOR, DOORS, ROOF & VEHICLE SECURITY

    SECTION

    DLK

    DOOR & LOCK

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 6
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 6
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 6
    Procedure without Cowl Top Cover ………………….. 6
    Precaution for Servicing Doors and Locks ……………. 6

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 8
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 8
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 8
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 8

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………….. 10
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………10
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM ……………………………………… 10
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Component Parts Location ……………………………………………………………….. 10
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside Key Antenna (Instrument Center) …………………………………………….. 12
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside Key Antenna
    (Console) ……………………………………………………….. 13
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside Key Antenna
    (Trunk Room) …………………………………………………. 13
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside Key Antenna
    (Rear Bumper) ……………………………………………….. 13
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside Key Antenna
    (Driver Side) …………………………………………………… 13
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside Key Antenna
    (Passenger Side) ……………………………………………. 14
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Front Door Lock Assembly (Driver Side) ……………………………………………… 14
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Remote Keyless Entry
    Receiver ………………………………………………………… 14
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Intelligent Key Warning
    Buzzer …………………………………………………………… 14
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Back Door Lock Assembly …………………………………………………………………. 15

    Revision: April 2013

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Door Lock and Unlock
    Switch …………………………………………………………….15
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Front Door Request
    Switch (Driver Side) ………………………………………….15
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Front Door Request
    Switch (Passenger Side) …………………………………..15
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Door Switch …………………16
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Back Door Request
    Switch …………………………………………………………….16

    SYSTEM (POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM) …. 17
    System Diagram ………………………………………………17
    System Description …………………………………………..17

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM) ……… 19

    J

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM ………………………………19
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : System Description …………………………………………………………………19

    DLK

    DOOR LOCK FUNCTION ……………………………………20
    DOOR LOCK FUNCTION : System Description ….20

    L

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION ………………22
    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION : System Description ………………………………………………..22

    M

    KEY REMINDER FUNCTION ………………………………23
    KEY REMINDER FUNCTION : System Description …………………………………………………………………24

    N

    WARNING FUNCTION ……………………………………….24
    WARNING FUNCTION : System Description ……….24

    O

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 27
    BCM …………………………………………………………. 27
    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………27

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 28
    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM …………………………… 28
    POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM ………………………….28

    DLK-1

    2014 Note

    P

    POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram
    … 28
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM …………………………….. 36
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram ….. 37

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 51
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW …….. 51
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………… 51

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 54
    B2621 INSIDE ANTENNA …………………………… 54
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 54
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 54

    BACK DOOR : Description ………………………………. 72
    BACK DOOR : Component Function Check ……… 72
    BACK DOOR : Diagnosis Procedure …………………. 73

    BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY ……. 75
    Description …………………………………………………….. 75
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 75
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 75
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 76

    DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH …………. 78
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 78
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 78
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 79

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH …………………………. 80

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 56
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 56

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 80
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 80
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 81

    B2623 INSIDE ANTENNA …………………………… 58

    BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH ………………. 82

    B2622 INSIDE ANTENNA …………………………… 56

    B2626 OUTSIDE ANTENNA ……………………….. 60

    Description …………………………………………………….. 82
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 82
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 82
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 83

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 60
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 60

    DOOR SWITCH …………………………………………. 84

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 58
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 58

    B2627 OUTSIDE ANTENNA ……………………….. 62
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 62
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 62

    B2628 OUTSIDE ANTENNA ……………………….. 64
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 64
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 64

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ….. 66

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 84
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 84
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 85

    HAZARD FUNCTION …………………………………. 87
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 87
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 87

    INTELLIGENT KEY ……………………………………. 88

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 66

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 88
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 88

    COMBINATION METER BUZZER ……………….. 67

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER ……… 89

    Component Function Check …………………………… 67
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 67

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 89
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 89

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR ………………………….. 68

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 93

    DRIVER SIDE …………………………………………………… 68
    DRIVER SIDE : Component Function Check …….. 68
    DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure ……………….. 68

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH
    DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH …………. 93

    PASSENGER SIDE …………………………………………… 69
    PASSENGER SIDE :
    Component Function Check …………………………… 69
    PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure ……….. 69
    REAR LH …………………………………………………………. 70
    REAR LH : Component Function Check …………… 70
    REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure ………………………. 70
    REAR RH ………………………………………………………… 71
    REAR RH : Component Function Check ………….. 71
    REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………… 71
    BACK DOOR ……………………………………………………. 72

    Revision: April 2013

    ALL DOOR ………………………………………………………. 93
    ALL DOOR : Description ………………………………….. 93
    ALL DOOR : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………. 93
    DRIVER SIDE …………………………………………………… 93
    DRIVER SIDE : Description ……………………………… 93
    DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure ………………… 93
    PASSENGER SIDE …………………………………………… 93
    PASSENGER SIDE : Description ……………………… 94
    PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure ………… 94
    REAR LH …………………………………………………………. 94
    REAR LH : Description ……………………………………. 94

    DLK-2

    2014 Note

    REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure ………………………. 94
    REAR RH …………………………………………………………. 94
    REAR RH : Description ……………………………………. 94
    REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure ………………………. 94

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH
    DRIVER SIDE DOOR LOCK KNOB OR DOOR
    KEY CYLINDER ………………………………………….96
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 96

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH
    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH …………………………..97
    ALL DOOR REQUEST SWITCHES …………………….. 97
    ALL DOOR REQUEST SWITCHES : Description…. 97
    ALL DOOR REQUEST SWITCHES : Diagnosis
    Procedure ………………………………………………………. 97
    DRIVER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH …………… 97
    DRIVER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH : Description …………………………………………………………. 98
    DRIVER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………………… 98
    PASSENGER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH …… 98
    PASSENGER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH :
    Description …………………………………………………….. 98
    PASSENGER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH :
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 98

    ACC WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE …….. 107
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 107

    TAKE AWAY WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE ………………………………………………………… 108
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 108

    INTELLIGENT KEY LOW BATTERY WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE ………………………. 109

    A

    B

    C

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 109

    DOOR LOCK OPERATION WARNING DOES
    NOT OPERATE ……………………………………….. 110

    D

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 110

    KEY ID WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE …. 111

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 111

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES …………………………………………………… 112
    Work Flow …………………………………………………….. 112
    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting ……… 113
    Diagnostic Worksheet …………………………………….. 116

    F

    G

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………. 118
    HOOD …………………………………………………….. 118

    H

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 118
    HOOD ASSEMBLY ………………………………………….. 118
    HOOD ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation ….. 118
    HOOD ASSEMBLY : Adjustment …………………….. 119

    I

    HOOD HINGE …………………………………………………. 120
    HOOD HINGE : Removal and Installation …………. 120

    J

    DLK

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 100

    HOOD SUPPORT ROD ……………………………………. 121
    HOOD SUPPORT ROD : Removal and Installation ………………………………………………………………. 121

    AUTO DOOR LOCK OPERATION DOES NOT
    OPERATE ………………………………………………… 101

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT …………………… 122

    L

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH INTELLIGENT KEY …………………………………………99
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 99

    IGNITION POSITION WARNING FUNCTION
    DOES NOT OPERATE ………………………………. 100

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 101

    VEHICLE SPEED SENSING AUTO LOCK
    OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE ………….. 102
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 102

    HAZARD AND BUZZER REMINDER DOES
    NOT OPERATE ………………………………………… 103
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 103

    KEY REMINDER FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE …………………………………………………….. 104
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 104

    OFF POSITION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE …………………………………………………….. 105
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 105

    P POSITION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE …………………………………………………………. 106
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 106

    Revision: April 2013

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 122
    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER ………………. 122
    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER : Removal
    and Installation ……………………………………………… 122

    M

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT LOWER ……………… 123
    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT LOWER : Removal
    and Installation ……………………………………………… 123

    N

    FRONT FENDER ……………………………………… 125

    O

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 125
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 125

    FRONT DOOR …………………………………………. 127
    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 127
    DOOR ASSEMBLY ………………………………………….. 127
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation ….. 127
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment …………………….. 128
    DOOR STRIKER ……………………………………………… 129

    DLK-3

    2014 Note

    P

    DOOR STRIKER : Removal and Installation ………129
    DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment …………………………129

    FRONT DOOR LOCK ………………………………… 145

    DOOR HINGE …………………………………………………..130
    DOOR HINGE : Removal and Installation ………….130

    DOOR LOCK ………………………………………………….. 145
    DOOR LOCK : Removal and Installation ………….. 145

    DOOR CHECK LINK …………………………………………130
    DOOR CHECK LINK : Removal and Installation ..130

    INSIDE HANDLE …………………………………………….. 146
    INSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation …….. 146

    REAR DOOR …………………………………………… 131

    OUTSIDE HANDLE …………………………………………. 147
    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation …. 147

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….131
    DOOR ASSEMBLY …………………………………………..131
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation …..131
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment ……………………..133
    DOOR STRIKER ………………………………………………134
    DOOR STRIKER : Removal and Installation ………134
    DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment …………………………134
    DOOR HINGE …………………………………………………..134
    DOOR HINGE : Removal and Installation ………….134
    DOOR CHECK LINK …………………………………………135
    DOOR CHECK LINK : Removal and Installation ..135

    BACK DOOR …………………………………………… 136
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….136
    BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY …………………………………136
    BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………………….136
    BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment …………….138
    BACK DOOR STRIKER …………………………………….139
    BACK DOOR STRIKER : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………………….139
    BACK DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment ……………….139
    BACK DOOR HINGE ………………………………………..140
    BACK DOOR HINGE : Removal and Installation ..140
    BACK DOOR STAY ………………………………………….140
    BACK DOOR STAY : Removal and Installation ….140
    BACK DOOR STAY : Disposal …………………………140
    BACK DOOR WEATHER-STRIP ………………………..141
    BACK DOOR WEATHER-STRIP : Removal and
    Installation …………………………………………………….141

    HOOD LOCK …………………………………………… 142
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….142
    HOOD LOCK ……………………………………………………142
    HOOD LOCK : Removal and Installation ……………142
    HOOD LOCK : Inspection ………………………………..143
    HOOD LOCK RELEASE CABLE ……………………….143
    HOOD LOCK RELEASE CABLE : Removal and
    Installation …………………………………………………….143
    HOOD LOCK RELEASE HANDLE ……………………..144
    HOOD LOCK RELEASE HANDLE : Removal and
    Installation …………………………………………………….144

    Revision: April 2013

    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 145

    REAR DOOR LOCK ………………………………….. 149
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 149
    DOOR LOCK ………………………………………………….. 149
    DOOR LOCK : Removal and Installation ………….. 149
    INSIDE HANDLE …………………………………………….. 150
    INSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation …….. 150
    OUTSIDE HANDLE …………………………………………. 151
    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation …. 151

    BACK DOOR LOCK ………………………………….. 153
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 153
    BACK DOOR LOCK ………………………………………… 153
    BACK DOOR LOCK : Removal and Installation … 153
    OUTSIDE HANDLE …………………………………………. 153
    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation …. 153
    EMERGENCY LEVER ……………………………………… 154
    EMERGENCY LEVER : Removal and Installation. 154

    FUEL FILLER LID OPENER ………………………. 155
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 155
    FUEL FILLER LID …………………………………………… 155
    FUEL FILLER LID : Removal and Installation ……. 155
    FUEL FILLER OPENER CABLE ………………………. 156
    FUEL FILLER OPENER CABLE : Removal and
    Installation ……………………………………………………. 156
    FUEL FILLER LID LOCK …………………………………. 156
    FUEL FILLER LID LOCK : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………………… 157

    DOOR SWITCH ………………………………………… 158
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 158

    INSIDE KEY ANTENNA …………………………….. 159
    INSTRUMENT CENTER …………………………………… 159
    INSTRUMENT CENTER : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………………… 159
    CONSOLE ……………………………………………………… 159
    CONSOLE : Removal and Installation ……………… 159
    LUGGAGE ROOM …………………………………………… 159
    LUGGAGE ROOM : Removal and Installation …… 159

    DLK-4

    2014 Note

    OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA …………………………. 161

    PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation …. 162

    OUTSIDE HANDLE …………………………………………. 161
    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation …. 161

    BACK DOOR ………………………………………………….. 162
    BACK DOOR : Removal and Installation …………… 162

    REAR BUMPER ……………………………………………… 161
    REAR BUMPER : Removal and Installation ……… 161

    INTELLIGENT KEY WARNING BUZZER ……. 163

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH ………………………… 162

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER ……. 164

    DRIVER SIDE …………………………………………………. 162
    DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation …………. 162
    PASSENGER SIDE …………………………………………. 162

    A

    B

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 163
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 164

    C

    INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY ………………….. 165
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 165

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-5

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009499759

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009486703

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc. to prevent damage to
    the windshield.

    PIIB3706J

    Precaution for Servicing Doors and Locks

    INFOID:0000000009486704

    WARNING:
    Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a pacemaker should
    contact the electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before use,
    • After removing and installing the opening/closing parts, be sure to carry out fitting adjustments to check their
    operation.
    • Check the lubrication level, damage, and wear of each part. If necessary, grease or replace it.
    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-6

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-7

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009486705

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-39570)
    Chassis Ear

    Locating the noise

    SIIA0993E


    (J-50397)
    NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit

    Repairing the cause of noise

    ALJIA1232ZZ


    (J-43241)
    Remote Keyless Entry
    Tester

    Used to test keyfobs

    LEL946A


    (J-50190)
    Signal Tech II

    • Check Intelligent Key relative signal
    strength
    • Confirm vehicle Intelligent Key antenna
    signal strength

    ALEIA0131ZZ


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    Revision: April 2013

    INFOID:0000000009486706

    DLK-8

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39565)
    Engine Ear

    Locating the noise

    A

    B

    C
    SIIA0995E

    ( — )
    Power Tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    D

    E

    PIIB1407E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-9

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM
    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009015758

    ALKIA3191ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-10

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    A.

    View with instrument panel assembly B.
    removed

    View with glove box door removed

    C.

    View with front grill removed

    D.

    View of LH door. (RH similar)

    E.

    View of LH door switch (RH similar)

    F.

    View with rear bumper cover removed

    G.

    View from rear of vehicle

    H.

    View with rear seat cushion removed I.

    No.

    1.

    2.

    3.

    Component

    View with center console removed
    Function

    Push-button ignition switch

    Push-button ignition switch has push switch inside
    which detects that push-button ignition switch is
    pressed, and then transmits ON/OFF signal to
    BCM. BCM changes the ignition switch position with
    the operation of push-button ignition switch. BCM
    maintains the ignition switch position status while
    push-button ignition switch is not operated.

    BCM

    BCM controls INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM (ENGINE START FUNCTION), NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM-NATS [NVIS (NATS)] and
    VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM.
    BCM performs the ID verification between BCM and
    Intelligent Key when the Intelligent Key is carried
    into the detection area of inside key antenna, and
    push-button ignition switch is pressed. If the ID verification result is OK, ignition switch operation is
    available.
    Then, when the ignition switch is turned ON, BCM
    performs ID verification between BCM and ECM. If
    the ID verification result is OK, ECM can start engine.
    Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM :
    Component Parts Location» for detailed installation
    location.

    Main power window and door lock/unlock switch

    Door lock and unlock switch is integrated into the
    power window main switch.
    Door lock and unlock switch transmits door lock/unlock operation signal to BCM.
    Refer to PWC-6, «Power Window Main Switch».

    5.

    Front door lock assembly LH

    Door key cylinder switch is integrated into front door
    lock assembly (driver side).
    Door key cylinder switch detects door LOCK/UNLOCK operation using mechanical key, and then
    transmits the operation signal to BCM.
    Refer to DLK-14, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Front
    Door Lock Assembly (Driver Side)».

    6.

    Rear door lock actuator LH

    Rear door lock actuator locks/unlocks the rear door
    latch assembly.

    7.

    Back door lock actuator

    Back door lock actuator locks/unlocks the back door
    latch assembly.

    4.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-11

    B

    C

    Combination meter transmits the vehicle speed signal to BCM via CAN communication.
    BCM also receives the vehicle speed signal from
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN
    communication. BCM compares both signals to detect the vehicle speed.
    Security indicator lamp is located on combination
    meter.
    Security indicator lamp blinks when ignition switch
    is in any position other than ON to warn that NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM-NATS
    [NVIS (NATS)] is on board.
    Refer to MWI-6, «METER SYSTEM : Combination
    Meter».

    Combination meter

    A

    2014 Note

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component

    Function

    Inside key antenna (instrument center)

    Inside key antenna (instrument center) detects
    whether Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or not,
    and then transmits the signal to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-12, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside
    Key Antenna (Instrument Center)».

    Remote keyless entry receiver

    Remote keyless entry receiver receives button operation signal and key ID signal of Intelligent Key,
    and them transmits them to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-14, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Remote
    Keyless Entry Receiver».

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer warns the user, who
    is outside the vehicle, of operation confirmation according to Intelligent Key operation and door request switch operation, or of an inappropriate
    operation.
    Refer to DLK-14, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Intelligent Key Warning Buzzer».

    11.

    Outside key antenna LH

    Outside key antenna (LH) detects whether Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle or not, and then
    transmits the signal to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-13, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside
    Key Antenna (Driver Side)».

    12.

    Door request switch

    Door request switch transmits door lock/unlock request signal to the BCM.

    13.

    Door switch

    Door switch detects door open/close condition and
    then transmits ON/OFF signal to BCM.

    14.

    Outside key antenna (rear bumper)

    Outside key antenna (Rear bumper) detects whether Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle or not, and
    then transmits the signal to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-13, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside
    Key Antenna (Rear Bumper)».

    15.

    Back door request switch

    Back door request switch transmits door lock/unlock
    request signal to the BCM.

    Inside key antenna (trunk room)

    Inside key antenna (trunk room) detects whether Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or not, and then
    transmits the signal to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-13, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside
    Key Antenna (Trunk Room)».

    Inside key antenna (console)

    Inside key antenna (console) detects whether Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or not, and then
    transmits the signal to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-13, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside
    Key Antenna (Console)».

    8.

    9.

    10.

    16.

    17.

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside Key Antenna (Instrument Center)

    INFOID:0000000009516557

    • Inside key antenna (instrument center) detects that Intelligent Key
    is within the inside detection area, and then transmits detection
    status to BCM.
    • Inside key antenna (instrument center) is installed in the rear of
    cluster lid C of instrument center.

    JMKIA8646ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-12

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside Key Antenna (Console)

    INFOID:0000000009516558

    A

    • Inside key antenna (console) detects that Intelligent Key is within
    the inside detection area, and then transmits detection status to
    BCM.
    • Inside key antenna (console) is installed underneath the center
    console.

    B

    C

    D
    JMKIA8646ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Inside Key Antenna (Trunk Room)

    INFOID:0000000009516559

    • Inside key antenna (trunk room) detects that Intelligent Key is
    within the inside detection area, and then transmits detection status to BCM.
    • Inside key antenna (trunk room) is installed under the rear seat
    cushion.

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JMKIA8646ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside Key Antenna (Rear Bumper)

    INFOID:0000000009516560

    • Outside key antenna (rear bumper) detects that Intelligent Key is
    within the outside detection area, and then transmits detection status to BCM. Request signal is transmitted simultaneously to Intelligent Key.
    • Outside key antenna (rear bumper) is installed in the rear of rear
    bumper.

    I

    J

    DLK

    L
    JMKIA8646ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside Key Antenna (Driver Side)

    INFOID:0000000009516561

    • Outside key antenna (driver side) detects that Intelligent Key is
    within the outside detection area, and then transmits detection status to BCM. Request signal is transmitted simultaneously to Intelligent Key.
    • Outside key antenna (driver side) is installed in driver side outside
    handle.

    M

    N

    O

    P
    JMKIA8648ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-13

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Outside Key Antenna (Passenger Side)

    INFOID:0000000009516562

    • Outside key antenna (passenger side) detects that Intelligent Key
    is within the outside detection area, and then transmits detection
    status to BCM. Request signal is transmitted simultaneously to
    Intelligent Key.
    • Outside key antenna (passenger side) is installed in driver side
    outside handle.

    JMKIA8648ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Front Door Lock Assembly (Driver Side)

    INFOID:0000000009516563

    • Door lock actuator and unlock sensor are Integrated in driver door
    lock assembly.
    • Door lock actuator receives lock/unlock signal from BCM, and then
    locks/unlocks driver door.
    • Only front door lock assembly (driver side) integrates unlock sensor. Unlock sensor transmits lock/unlock status of driver seat to
    BCM.

    JMKIA8649ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Remote Keyless Entry Receiver

    INFOID:0000000009516564

    • Remote keyless entry receiver receives button operation signal
    and key ID signal of Intelligent Key, and then transmits them to
    BCM.
    • Remote keyless entry receiver is installed in the rear of glove box
    lid.

    JMKIA8647ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Intelligent Key Warning Buzzer

    INFOID:0000000009516565

    • Intelligent Key warning buzzer warns the user, who is outside vehicle, of operation confirmation according to Intelligent Key operation
    and door request switch operation, or of an inappropriate operation.
    • Intelligent Key warning buzzer is installed in the rear of front
    bumper and underneath headlight RH.

    JMKIA8650ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-14

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Back Door Lock Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009516566

    A

    • Back door lock assembly lock assembly integrates door lock actuator and back door latch.
    • Door lock actuator locks/unlocks the back door according to the
    door lock/unlock signal from BCM.

    B

    C

    D
    JMKIA8651ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Door Lock and Unlock Switch

    INFOID:0000000009516567

    • Door lock and unlock switch transmits door lock/unlock signal
    operation to BCM.
    • Door lock and unlock switch (1) is integrated in the power window
    main switch and front power window switch (passenger side).

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JMKIA9352ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Front Door Request Switch (Driver Side)

    INFOID:0000000009516568

    • Front door request switch (driver side) transmits door request
    switch signal to BCM.
    • Front door request switch (driver side) (1) is integrated in driver
    side outside handle.

    I

    J

    DLK

    L
    JMKIA9353ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Front Door Request Switch (Passenger Side)

    INFOID:0000000009516569

    • Front door request switch (passenger side) transmits door request
    switch signal to BCM.
    • Front door request switch (passenger side) (1) is integrated in passenger side outside handle.

    M

    N

    O

    P
    JMKIA9353ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-15

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Door Switch

    INFOID:0000000009516570

    Door switch detects open/close status of door and transmits door
    switch signal to BCM.

    JMKIA6526ZZ

    DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Back Door Request Switch

    INFOID:0000000009516571

    • Back door request switch transmits back door request switch signal to BCM.
    • Back door request switch (1) is integrated in outside handle (back
    door).

    ALKIA3192ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-16

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM (POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM (POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM)

    A

    System Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009516451

    B

    C

    D

    E

    ALKIA3193GB

    System Description
    Input
    Door lock/unlock switch
    Door key cylinder switch
    Each door switch

    INFOID:0000000009516452

    G
    Single

    Function

    Door lock/unlock signal

    Actuator

    H

    Door lock function

    Door open/close signal

    Key reminder function

    Warning buzzer signal
    Combination meter.

    F

    • Each door lock actuator

    Automatic door lock/unlock
    function

    Vehicle speed signal

    I

    J

    DOOR LOCK FUNCTION
    • The door lock and unlock switch (driver side) is built into power window main switch.
    • The door lock and unlock switch (passenger side) is on door trim.
    DLK
    • Interlocked with the locking operation of door lock and unlock switch, door lock actuators of all doors are
    locked.
    • Interlocked with the unlocking operation of door lock and unlock switch, door lock actuators of all doors are
    L
    unlocked.
    Door Key Cylinder
    • With the door key inserted in the door key cylinder on driver side, turning it to “LOCK”, will lock door lock
    actuator of all doors.
    • With the door key inserted in the door key cylinder on driver side, turning it to “UNLOCK” once unlocks the
    driver side door lock actuator; turning it to “UNLOCK” again within 60 seconds after the first unlock operation
    unlocks all of the other doors. — (SELECTIVE UNLOCK OPERATION)
    Selective unlock operation mode can be changed using “AUTO LOCK SET” mode in “WORK SUPPORT”.
    Refer to BCS-17, «DOOR LOCK : CONSULT Function (BCM — DOOR LOCK)».

    AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS (LOCK OPERATION)

    M

    N

    O

    The automatic door locks function is the function that locks all doors linked with the vehicle speed or shift position.
    Vehicle Speed Sensing Auto Door Lock*1
    All doors are locked when the vehicle speed reaches 24 km/h (15 MPH) or more.
    BCM outputs the lock signal to all door lock actuators when it detects that the ignition switch is turned ON, all
    doors are closed and the vehicle speed received from the combination meter via CAN communication
    becomes 24 km/h (15 MPH) or more.
    If a door is opened and closed at any time during one ignition cycle (OFF → ON), even after initial auto door
    lock operation has taken place, the BCM will re-lock all doors when the vehicle speed reaches 24 km/h (15
    MPH) or more again.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-17

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM (POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Setting change of Automatic Door Locks (LOCK) Function
    The LOCK operation setting of the automatic door locks function can be changed.
    With CONSULT
    The ON/OFF switching of the automatic door locks (LOCK) function and the type selection of the automatic
    door locks (LOCK) function can be performed at the WORK SUPPORT setting of CONSULT. Refer to BCS-17,
    «DOOR LOCK : CONSULT Function (BCM — DOOR LOCK)».
    Without CONSULT
    The automatic door locks (LOCK) function can be switched ON/OFF by performing the following operation.
    1. Close all doors (door switch OFF)
    2. Push the ignition switch to the ON position
    3. Press and hold the door lock and unlock switch for 5 seconds or more in the lock direction within 20 seconds after turning the ignition switch ON.
    4. The switching is completed when the hazard lamp blinks.

    5.

    OFF → ON

    : 2 blinks

    ON → OFF

    : 1 blink

    The ignition switch must be turned OFF and ON again between each setting change.

    AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS (UNLOCK OPERATION)
    The automatic door locks (UNLOCK) function is the function that unlocks all doors linked with the key position
    or shift position.
    IGN OFF Interlock Door Unlock*1
    All doors are unlocked when the power supply position is changed from ON to OFF.
    BCM outputs the unlock signal to all door lock actuators when it detects that the power supply position is
    changed from ignition switch ON to OFF.
    Setting change of Automatic Door Locks (UNLOCK) Function
    The UNLOCK operation setting of the automatic door locks function can be changed.
    With CONSULT
    The ON/OFF switching of the automatic door locks (UNLOCK) function and the type selection of the automatic
    door locks (UNLOCK) function can be performed at the WORK SUPPORT setting of CONSULT. Refer to BCS17, «DOOR LOCK : CONSULT Function (BCM — DOOR LOCK)».
    Without CONSULT
    The automatic door locks (UNLOCK) function can be switched ON/OFF by performing the following operation.
    1. Close all doors (door switch OFF)
    2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position
    3. Press and hold the door lock and unlock switch for 5 seconds or more in the unlock direction within 20
    seconds after turning the power supply position ON.
    4. The switching is completed when the hazard lamp blinks.

    5.
    *1

    OFF → ON

    : 2 blinks

    ON → OFF

    : 1 blink

    The ignition switch must be turned OFF and ON again between each setting change.

    : This function is set to ON before delivery.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-18

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)

    A

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009516518

    B

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    ALKIA3194GB

    M

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    • The Intelligent Key system is a system that makes it possible to lock and unlock the door locks (door lock/
    unlock function) by carrying the Intelligent Key, which operates based on the results of electronic ID verification using two-way communication between the Intelligent Key and the vehicle (BCM).
    NOTE:
    The driver should always carry the Intelligent Key
    • The settings for each function can be changed with CONSULT.
    • If an Intelligent Key is lost, a new Intelligent Key can be registered. A maximum of 4 Intelligent Keys can be
    registered.
    • It is possible to perform a diagnosis on the system and register an Intelligent Key with CONSULT.
    Function

    Description

    Refer

    Door lock

    Lock/unlock can be performed by pressing the request switch

    DLK-20

    Remote keyless entry

    Lock/unlock can be performed by pressing the remote controller button of the
    Intelligent Key

    DLK-22

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-19

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Function

    Description

    Refer

    Key reminder

    The key reminder buzzer sounds a warning if the door is locked with the key left
    inside the vehicle

    DLK-24

    Warning

    If an action that does not meet the operating condition of the Intelligent Key system is taken, the buzzer sounds to inform the driver

    DLK-24

    Engine start

    The engine can be turned on while carrying the Intelligent Key

    DLK-19

    Interior room lamp control

    Interior room lamp is controlled according to door lock/unlock state

    INL-7

    DOOR LOCK FUNCTION
    DOOR LOCK FUNCTION : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009516519

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JMKIA6137GB

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH OPERATION
    When pressing the request switch, it is possible to lock and unlock the door by carrying the Intelligent Key.

    OPERATION DESCRIPTION
    • When the BCM detects that each door request switch is pressed, it starts the outside key antenna and inside
    key antenna corresponding to the pressed door request switch and transmits the request signal to the Intelligent Key. And then, check that the Intelligent Key is near the door.
    • If the Intelligent Key is within the outside key antenna detection area, it receives the request signal and
    transmits the key ID signal to the BCM via remote keyless entry receiver.
    • BCM receives the key ID signal and compares it with the registered key ID.
    • BCM transmits door lock/unlock signal and operates each door lock actuator. At the same time, BCM blinks
    hazard warning lamp (lock: 1 time, unlock: 2 times) and sounds Intelligent Key buzzer (lock: 1 time, unlock:
    2 times) as a reminder.

    OPERATION CONDITION
    If the following conditions are satisfied, door lock/unlock operation is performed if the door request switch is
    operated.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-20

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Each request switch operation

    Operation condition

    Lock





    All doors are closed
    Ignition switch is in the LOCK or OFF position
    Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle
    Intelligent Key is within outside key antenna detection area
    P position warning is not activated

    Unlock




    All doors are closed
    Ignition switch is in the LOCK or OFF position
    Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle
    Intelligent Key is within outside key antenna detection area *

    A

    B

    C

    *: Even with a registered Intelligent Key remaining inside the vehicle, door locks can be unlocked from outside of the vehicle with a spare
    Intelligent Key as long as key IDs are different.

    Door lock function can be changed using “LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY” mode in “WORK SUPPORT”. Refer to
    BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».

    D

    E

    OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA DETECTION AREA
    The outside key antenna detection area of door lock/unlock function
    is in the range of approximately 80 cm (31.50 in) surrounding the
    driver, passenger door handles (1). However, this operating range
    depends on the ambient conditions.

    F

    G

    H
    JMKIA4881ZZ

    HAZARD AND BUZZER REMINDER FUNCTION

    I

    For the operation check, BCM blinks hazard warning lamps (lock: 1 time, unlock: 2 times) and sounds Intelligent Key warning buzzer (lock: 1 time, unlock: 2 times) when door lock or unlock operates by operation of
    each door request switch.

    J

    How to Change Hazard and Buzzer Reminder Mode
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».

    DLK

    AUTO DOOR LOCK FUNCTION
    After door is unlocked by door request switch operation and if 30 seconds or more passes without performing
    the following operation, all doors are automatically locked. However, operation check function does not activate.
    Operating condition

    • Door switch is ON (door is open)
    • BCM receives lock signal
    • Push switch is pressed

    L

    M

    Auto door lock mode can be changed by the “AUTO LOCK SET” mode in “WORK SUPPORT”. Refer to BCS21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».

    N

    LIST OF OPERATION RELATED PARTS

    Parts marked with × are the parts related to operation.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-21

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)

    ×

    ×

    Auto door lock function

    ×
    ×

    Hazard and buzzer reminder function
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Combination meter

    ×

    Push-button ignition switch

    Outside key antenna

    ×

    Hazard warning lamp

    Inside key antenna

    ×

    BCM

    Door lock actuator

    ×

    CAN communication system

    Door request switch

    ×

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    Door switch

    Door lock/unlock function

    Remote keyless entry receiver

    Door lock function

    Intelligent Key

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION
    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009516520

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    ALKIA3195GB

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY OPERATION
    The Intelligent Key has the same functions as the remote control entry system. Therefore, it can be used in the
    same manner as the remote controller by operating the door lock/unlock button.
    Remote keyless entry system controls operation of the following items.
    • Auto door lock
    • Door lock/unlock
    • Hazard and buzzer reminder

    OPERATION AREA
    To check that the Intelligent Key works normally, use within 1 m (3 ft) range of each door, however the operable range may differ according to surroundings.

    DOOR LOCK/UNLOCK FUNCTION
    • When door lock/unlock button of the Intelligent Key is pressed, lock signal or unlock signal is transmitted
    from Intelligent Key to BCM via remote keyless entry receiver.
    • BCM receives the signal and compares it with the registered key ID to the vehicle.
    • BCM transmits door lock/unlock signal to each door lock actuator and operates each door lock actuator,
    when key ID matches. At the same time, BCM blinks hazard warning lamps (lock: 1 time, unlock: 2 times)
    and sounds Intelligent Key buzzer (lock: 1 time, unlock: 2 times) as a reminder.

    OPERATION CONDITION

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-22

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Remote controller operation

    Operation condition

    Lock

    • All door are closed
    • Ignition switch is in the LOCK or OFF position
    • P position warning is not activated

    Unlock

    • Ignition switch is in the LOCK or OFF position
    • Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle
    • P position warning is not activated

    A

    B

    C

    HAZARD AND BUZZER REMINDER FUNCTION
    For the operation check, BCM blinks hazard warning lamps (lock: 1 time, unlock: 2 times) and sounds Intelligent Key warning buzzer (lock: 1 time, unlock: 2 times) when door lock or unlock operates by each remote
    controller button operation of Intelligent Key.
    How to Change Hazard and Buzzer Reminder Mode
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».

    D

    E

    AUTO DOOR LOCK FUNCTION
    After door is unlocked by Intelligent Key button operation and if 30 seconds or more passes without performing
    the following operation, all doors are automatically locked. However, operation check function does not activate.
    Operating condition

    • Door switch is ON (door is open)
    • BCM receives lock signal
    • Push switch is pressed

    F

    G

    Auto door lock mode can be changed by the “AUTO LOCK SET” mode in “WORK SUPPORT”. Refer to BCS21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».

    H

    LIST OF OPERATION RELATED PARTS

    Parts marked with × are the parts related to operation.

    Hazard and buzzer reminder function

    ×

    ×

    Auto door lock function

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    L

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    Horn

    ×

    DLK
    IPDM E/R

    ×

    Hazard warning lamp

    Push-button ignition switch

    ×

    Combination meter

    Door lock actuator

    ×

    J

    BCM

    Door switch

    ×

    CAN communication system

    Remote keyless entry receiver

    Door lock/unlock function by remote control button

    Remote keyless entry functions

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    Intelligent Key

    I

    ×

    ×

    M

    ×

    KEY REMINDER FUNCTION

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-23

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    KEY REMINDER FUNCTION : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009516521

    System Diagram

    ALKIA3196GB

    BASIC OPERATION
    Key reminder is the function that prevents the key from being left in the vehicle.
    Key reminder has the following 3 functions.
    Key reminder function

    Operation condition

    Operation

    Driver side door closed*

    Right after driver side door is closed under the following conditions
    • Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle
    • Driver side door is opened
    • Driver side door is in unlock state

    All doors unlock

    Door is open or closed

    Right after all doors are closed under the following conditions
    • Door lock/unlock switch or driver side door lock knob are operated
    • Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle
    • Any door is opened
    • All doors are locked.

    • All doors unlock
    • Honk Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    Back door is closed

    Right after Back door is closed under the following conditions
    • Intelligent Key is inside luggage room
    • All doors are closed
    • All doors are locked

    • Back door open
    • Honk Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    *:When closing the door if something comes into contact with the door lock switch it might activate the door locks accidentally, but the
    unlock operation will override this.

    NOTE:
    The above function operates when the Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle. However, there may be times when
    the Intelligent Key cannot be detected, and this function does not operate when the Intelligent Key is on the
    instrument panel, rear parcel shelf, or in the glove box. Also, this system sometimes does not operate if the
    Intelligent Key is in the door pocket for the open door.

    WARNING FUNCTION

    WARNING FUNCTION : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009516522

    OPERATION DESCRIPTION
    The warning function are as per the following items and are given to the user as warning information and
    warnings using combinations of Intelligent Key warning buzzer, combination meter buzzer, KEY warning lamp,
    shift P warning lamp and engine start operation indicator lamp.
    • Intelligent Key system malfunction
    • OFF position warning
    • P position warning
    • ACC warning
    • Take away warning
    • Door lock operation warning
    • Engine start information
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-24

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Intelligent Key low battery warning
    • Key ID warning

    A

    OPERATION CONDITION
    Operation condition of warning and information is as per the following table.
    Warning/Information functions

    B

    Operation procedure

    Intelligent Key system malfunction

    A malfunction is detected on BCM and key warning lamp turns ON

    OFF position warning

    When condition A, B or condition C is satisfied
    • Condition A
    — Ignition switch: ACC position
    — Door switch (driver side): ON (Door is open)
    • Condition B
    — Turn ignition switch from ON to OFF while door is open
    • Condition C
    — Intelligent Key backside is contacted to push-button ignition switch while
    brake pedal is depressed and ignition switch is LOCK or OFF (When the
    Intelligent Key battery is discharged)
    — Door switch (driver side): ON (Door is open)

    E

    F

    • Shift position: Other than P
    • Engine is stopped (Ignition switch is turned from ON to OFF)

    For external

    • P position warning (For internal) operates
    • Door switch: ON to OFF (Door is open to close)
    • Intelligent Key cannot be detected inside the vehicle

    G

    • After P position warning operates, or when ignition switch is turned ON
    immediately after P position warning operates
    • Ignition switch: ACC

    H

    Door status changes
    from open to close

    • Ignition switch: Other than LOCK and OFF
    • Door switch: ON to OFF (Door status changes from open to close)
    • Registered Intelligent Key is not detected inside the vehicle

    I

    Door status is open

    • Ignition switch: Other than LOCK and OFF
    • Door switch: ON (Door is open)
    • Registered Intelligent Key is not detected inside the vehicle during Key
    ID verification for 5 seconds

    J

    Push button-ignition
    switch operation

    • Ignition switch: Other than LOCK position
    • Push-button ignition switch is pressed
    • Registered Intelligent Key is not detected inside the vehicle

    ACC warning

    Door lock operation warning

    DLK

    Door lock operation is requested while door lock operation condition of
    door request switch is not satisfied

    Ignition switch is ON position

    • Ignition switch: ON position
    • Shift position: P
    • Engine is stopped

    Ignition switch is other
    than ON position

    • Ignition switch: Other than ON
    • Shift position: P
    • Intelligent Key is in the passenger room after driver door is opened and
    closed

    Ignition switch is ON position to OFF position

    • Ignition switch: ON position to OFF position
    • Shift position: P position
    NOTE:
    Engine start information turns ON for several seconds and then turns OFF,
    when ignition switch is turned to the ON position from the OFF position. Engine start information does not turn ON until opening and closing of driver
    door is detected again.

    Engine start information

    Intelligent Key low battery warning
    Key ID warning

    • Push-button ignition switch is pressed
    • Registered Intelligent Key is not detected inside the vehicle

    WARNING METHOD
    The following table shows the alarm or warning methods with chime.

    DLK-25

    L

    M

    BCM detects that Intelligent Key is low battery, after ignition switch is turned
    ON

    Revision: April 2013

    D

    For internal
    P position warning

    Take away warning

    C

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM (INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Shift P
    warning
    lamp

    Combination
    meter buzzer

    Intelligent
    Key warning buzzer

    Indicate

    For internal

    Activate

    For external

    Activate

    Indicate

    Activate

    Active

    Activate

    Activate

    Activate

    Activate

    Warning/Information functions

    Intelligent Key system malfunction
    OFF position warning

    P position warning

    For internal
    For external

    ACC warning

    Blink (yellow)

    Door is open to close
    Take away warning

    Warning chime

    “KEY” warning
    lamp

    Door is open

    Blink (yellow)

    Push-ignition switch operation

    Engine start
    operation indicator lamp

    Door lock operation warning

    Activate

    Engine start information

    Indicate

    Intelligent Key low battery warning

    Blink (green)

    Key ID warning

    Blink (yellow)

    LIST OF OPERATION RELATED PARTS

    OFF position warning

    For internal

    ×

    For external

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    “KEY” warning lamp

    ×

    Engine start operation indicator lamp

    ×

    Shift P warning lamp

    BCM

    Intelligent Key system malfunction

    CAN communication system

    Combination meter buzzer

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    Outside key antenna

    Inside key antenna

    Door request switch

    Door switch

    Intelligent Key

    Function

    Push-button ignition switch

    Parts marked with × are the parts related to operation.

    ×

    ×

    P position warning

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ACC warning

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Take away warning

    Door is open or close

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Door is open

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Push-button ignition
    switch operation

    ×

    Door lock operation warning

    ×

    Key ID warning
    Engine start information

    ×

    Intelligent Key low battery warning

    ×

    Revision: April 2013

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    DLK-26

    ×

    ×
    ×
    ×

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION

    A

    BCM
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009015761

    ECU

    Reference

    C

    BCS-28, «Reference Value»
    BCM

    B

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»

    D

    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-27

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM
    POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009567506

    AAKWA0643GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-28

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKWA0644GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-29

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1294GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-30

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1295GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-31

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1296GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-32

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1297GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-33

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1298GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-34

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1299GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-35

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1300GB

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-36

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009567505

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    AAKWA0636GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-37

    2014 Note

    P

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKWA0637GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-38

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKWA0638GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-39

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKWA0639GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-40

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1277GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-41

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1278GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-42

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1279GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-43

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1280GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-44

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1281GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-45

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1282GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-46

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1283GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-47

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1284GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-48

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1285GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-49

    2014 Note

    DOOR & LOCK SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABKIA4627GB

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-50

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009015763

    B

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JMKIA8652GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-51

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    1.
    2.

    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when
    the incident/malfunction occurs).
    Check operation condition of the function that is malfunctioning.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC

    1. Check DTC.
    2. Perform the following procedure if DTC is detected.
    Record DTC and freeze frame data (Print them out using CONSULT.)
    Erase DTC.
    Study the relationship between the cause detected by DTC and the symptom described by the customer.
    3. Check related service bulletins for information.
    Are any symptoms described and any DTC detected?
    Symptom is described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 3.
    Symptom is described, DTC is not detected>>GO TO 4.
    Symptom is not described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 5.

    3.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Also study the normal operation and fail-safe related to the symptom.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.
    >> GO TO 6.

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for the detected DTC, and then check that DTC is detected
    again. At this time, always connect CONSULT to the vehicle, and check self diagnostic results in real time.
    If two or more DTCs are detected, refer to BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart» and determine trouble
    diagnosis order.
    NOTE:
    • Freeze frame data is useful if the DTC is not detected.
    • Perform Component Function Check if DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE is not included on Service
    Manual. This simplified check procedure is an effective alternative though DTC cannot be detected during
    this check.
    If the result of Component Function Check is NG, it is the same as the detection of DTC by DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident.

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM BY SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    Detect malfunctioning system according to SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS based on the confirmed symptom in step
    4, and determine the trouble diagnosis order based on possible causes and symptom.
    Is the symptom described?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Monitor input data from related sensors or check voltage of related module terminals using CONSULT.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSIS PROCEDURE
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-52

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Inspect according to Diagnosis Procedure of the system.
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident.

    A

    8.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnosis Procedure again after repair and replacement.
    Check DTC. If DTC is detected, erase it.

    C

    D

    >> GO TO 9.

    9.FINAL CHECK

    When DTC is detected in step 2, perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE again, and then check that the
    malfunction is repaired securely.
    When symptom is described by the customer, refer to confirmed symptom in step 3 or 4, and check that the
    symptom is not detected.
    Is DTC detected and does symptom remain?
    YES-1 >> DTC is detected: GO TO 7.
    YES-2 >> Symptom remains: GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Before returning the vehicle to the customer, always erase DTC.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-53

    2014 Note

    B2621 INSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    B2621 INSIDE ANTENNA
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009515834

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B2621

    CONSULT display
    description

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    INSIDE ANTENNA 1

    An excessive high or low voltage from inside antenna (instrument center) is sent to BCM

    • Inside key antenna (instrument
    center)
    • Between BCM Inside key antenna
    (instrument center)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    3. Perform inside key antenna (INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS) on WORK SUPPORT of INTELLIGENT KEY.
    4. Check BCM for DTC.
    Is inside key antenna DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to DLK-54, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inside key antenna (instrument center) is OK.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515835

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 1
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    When Intelligent Key is in the antenna detection area

    M98

    84
    85

    JMKIA3839GB

    Ground

    When Intelligent Key is not in the
    antenna detection area

    JMKIA5951GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-54

    2014 Note

    B2621 INSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector and inside key antenna (instrument center) connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and inside key antenna (instrument center) harness
    connector.
    BCM
    Connector

    Inside key antenna (instrument center)
    Terminal
    84

    M98

    4.

    Connector

    1

    M95

    85

    Continuity

    Terminal

    B

    C

    Yes

    2

    D

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    No

    85

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    G

    3.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 2

    H

    Replace inside key antenna (instrument center). (New antenna or other antenna)
    Connect BCM connector and inside key antenna (instrument center) connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.

    I

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    E

    Ground

    84

    M98

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    A

    Condition

    J

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    DLK

    When Intelligent Key is in the antenna detection area

    M98

    84
    85

    L

    JMKIA3839GB

    Ground

    M

    N
    When Intelligent Key is not in the
    antenna detection area

    O
    JMKIA5951GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace inside key antenna (instrument center). Refer to DLK-159, «INSTRUMENT CENTER :
    Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-55

    2014 Note

    P

    B2622 INSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2622 INSIDE ANTENNA
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009515836

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    CONSULT display
    description

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    B2622

    INSIDE ANTENNA 2

    An excessive high or low voltage from inside antenna (console) is sent to BCM

    • Inside key antenna (console)
    • Between BCM Inside key antenna
    (console)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    3. Perform inside key antenna (INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS) on WORK SUPPORT of INTELLIGENT KEY.
    4. Check BCM for DTC.
    Is inside key antenna DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to DLK-56, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inside key antenna (console) is OK.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515837

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 1
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    When Intelligent Key is in the antenna detection area

    M98

    86
    87

    JMKIA3839GB

    Ground

    When Intelligent Key is not in the antenna detection area

    JMKIA5951GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector and inside key antenna (console) connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-56

    2014 Note

    B2622 INSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check continuity between BCM harness connector and inside key antenna (console) harness connector.
    A
    BCM
    Connector

    Inside key antenna (console)
    Terminal
    86

    M98

    4.

    Connector

    B

    1

    M89

    87

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    C

    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    M98

    D

    Ground

    86

    No

    87

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    3.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 2
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Replace inside key antenna (console). (New antenna or other antenna)
    Connect BCM connector and inside key antenna (console) connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.

    G

    H

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    I

    Terminal

    J
    When Intelligent Key is in the antenna detection area

    M98

    86
    87

    DLK
    JMKIA3839GB

    Ground

    L

    When Intelligent Key is not in the antenna detection area

    M

    JMKIA5951GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace inside key antenna (console). Refer to DLK-159, «CONSOLE : Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-57

    2014 Note

    B2623 INSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2623 INSIDE ANTENNA
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009515838

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    CONSULT display
    description

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    B2623

    INSIDE ANTENNA 3

    An excessive high or low voltage from inside antenna (trunk room) is sent to BCM

    • Inside key antenna (trunk room)
    • Between BCM Inside key antenna
    (trunk room)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    3. Perform inside key antenna (INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS) on WORK SUPPORT of INTELLIGENT KEY.
    4. Check BCM for DTC.
    Is inside key antenna DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to DLK-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inside key antenna (trunk room) is OK.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515839

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 1
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    When Intelligent Key is in the antenna detection area

    M98

    88
    89

    JMKIA3839GB

    Ground

    When Intelligent Key is not in the antenna detection area

    JMKIA5951GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector and inside key antenna (trunk room) connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-58

    2014 Note

    B2623 INSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check continuity between BCM harness connector and inside key antenna (trunk room) harness connector.
    BCM
    Connector

    Inside key antenna (trunk room)
    Terminal
    88

    M98

    4.

    Connector

    1

    B48

    89

    Continuity

    Terminal

    C

    BCM

    Continuity

    Terminal

    No

    89

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    3.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 2
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    G

    Replace inside key antenna (trunk room). (New antenna or other antenna)
    Connect BCM connector and inside key antenna (trunk room) connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.

    H

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    D

    Ground

    88

    M98

    B

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Connector

    A

    Condition

    I

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    J
    When Intelligent Key is in the antenna detection area

    M98

    88
    89

    DLK

    JMKIA3839GB

    Ground

    L

    M

    When Intelligent Key is not in the antenna detection area

    N
    JMKIA5951GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace inside key antenna (trunk room). Refer to DLK-159, «LUGGAGE ROOM : Removal and
    Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-59

    2014 Note

    B2626 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2626 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009515840

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    CONSULT display
    description

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    B2626

    OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    1

    An excessive high or low voltage from outside key
    antenna (LH) is sent to BCM

    • Outside key antenna (LH)
    • Between BCM Outside key antenna (LH)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to DLK-60, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Outside key antenna (LH) is OK.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515841

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 1
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    M98

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    78
    79

    Ground

    When the driver door
    request switch is operated with ignition
    switch OFF

    When Intelligent
    Key is in the antenna detection
    area (The distance between
    Intelligent Key
    and antenna: 80
    cm or less)
    When Intelligent
    Key is not in the
    antenna detection area (The
    distance between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: Approx. 2 m)

    JMKIA5955GB

    JMKIA5954GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector and outside key antenna (LH) connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and outside key antenna (LH) harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-60

    2014 Note

    B2626 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM

    Outside key antenna (LH)

    Connector

    Terminal
    78

    M98

    4.

    Connector

    1

    D6

    79

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    B

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    C

    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    78

    M98

    D

    No

    79

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    E

    3.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 2
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    A

    F

    Replace outside key antenna (LH). (New antenna or other antenna)
    Connect BCM connector and outside key antenna (LH) connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.

    G

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    M98

    (–)

    Condition

    H

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    78
    79

    Ground

    When the driver
    door request switch
    is operated with ignition switch OFF

    When Intelligent
    Key is in the antenna detection
    area (The distance between
    Intelligent Key
    and antenna: 80
    cm or less)
    When Intelligent
    Key is not in the
    antenna detection area (The
    distance between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: Approx. 2 m)

    I

    J

    JMKIA5955GB

    DLK

    L

    M
    JMKIA5954GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace outside key antenna (LH). Refer to DLK-161, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-61

    2014 Note

    B2627 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2627 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009515842

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    CONSULT display
    description

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    B2627

    OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    2

    An excessive high or low voltage from outside key
    antenna (RH) is sent to BCM

    • Outside key antenna (RH)
    • Between BCM Outside key antenna (RH)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is outside key antenna DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to DLK-62, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Outside key antenna (RH) is OK.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515843

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 1
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    M98

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    80
    81

    Ground

    When the passenger
    side door request
    switch is operated
    with ignition switch
    OFF

    When Intelligent Key is in
    the antenna detection area
    (The distance
    between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: 80 cm
    or less)
    When Intelligent Key is not
    in the antenna
    detection area
    (The distance
    between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: Approx. 2 m)

    JMKIA5955GB

    JMKIA5954GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector and outside key antenna (RH) connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and outside key antenna (RH) harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-62

    2014 Note

    B2627 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM

    Outside key antenna (RH)

    Connector

    Terminal
    80

    M98

    4.

    Connector

    1

    D106

    81

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    2

    B

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    C

    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    80

    M98

    D

    No

    81

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    E

    3.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 2
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    A

    F

    Replace outside key antenna (RH). (New antenna or other antenna)
    Connect BCM connector and outside key antenna (RH) connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.

    G

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    M98

    (–)

    Condition

    H

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    80
    81

    Ground

    When the passenger
    side door request
    switch is operated with
    ignition switch OFF

    When Intelligent Key is in
    the antenna detection area
    (The distance
    between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: 80 cm
    or less)
    When Intelligent Key is not
    in the antenna
    detection area
    (The distance
    between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: Approx. 2 m)

    I

    J

    JMKIA5955GB

    DLK

    L

    M
    JMKIA5954GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace outside key antenna (RH). Refer to DLK-161, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-63

    2014 Note

    B2628 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2628 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009515844

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    CONSULT display
    description

    DTC detecting condition

    B2628

    OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    3

    An excessive high or low voltage from outside key
    antenna (rear bumper) is sent to BCM

    Possible cause
    • Outside key antenna (rear
    bumper)
    • Between BCM – Outside key antenna (rear bumper)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is outside key antenna DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to DLK-64, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Outside key antenna (rear bumper) is OK.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515845

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 1
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    M98

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    82,83

    Ground

    When the back
    door request
    switch is operated with ignition
    switch OFF

    When Intelligent
    Key is in the antenna detection
    area (The distance between
    Intelligent Key
    and antenna: 80
    cm or less)
    When Intelligent
    Key is not in the
    antenna detection area (The
    distance between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: Approx. 2 m)

    JMKIA5955GB

    JMKIA5954GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector and outside key antenna (rear bumper) connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-64

    2014 Note

    B2628 OUTSIDE ANTENNA
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check continuity between BCM harness connector and outside key antenna (rear bumper) harness connector.
    BCM
    Connector

    Outside key antenna (rear bumper)
    Terminal
    82

    M98

    4.

    Connector

    1

    B49

    83

    Continuity

    Terminal

    C

    BCM
    Continuity

    Terminal

    No

    83

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    3.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA INPUT SIGNAL 2
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    D

    Ground

    82

    M98

    B

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Connector

    A

    Replace outside key antenna (rear bumper). (New antenna or other antenna)
    Connect BCM and outside key antenna (rear bumper) connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check signal between BCM harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.

    G

    H

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    M98

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    I

    Terminal

    82,83

    Ground

    When the back
    door request
    switch is operated with ignition
    switch OFF

    When Intelligent
    Key is in the antenna detection
    area (The distance between
    Intelligent Key
    and antenna: 80
    cm or less)
    When Intelligent
    Key is not in the
    antenna detection area (The
    distance between Intelligent Key and
    antenna: Approx. 2 m)

    J

    DLK
    JMKIA5955GB

    L

    M

    JMKIA5954GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace outside key antenna (rear bumper). Refer to DLK-161, «REAR BUMPER : Removal and
    Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-65

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567651

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSES AND FUSIBLE LINK
    Check that the following fuses and fusible link are not blown.
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    57

    Fuses and fusible link No.
    12 (10A)

    Battery power supply

    70

    G (40A)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector M99.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal
    57

    M99

    70

    Ground

    Voltage

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    67

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-66

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER BUZZER
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    COMBINATION METER BUZZER

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515847

    1.CHECK FUNCTION

    B

    1. Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select INSIDE BUZZER in ACTIVE TEST mode.
    3. Touch Key, Knob or Take Out to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Yes
    >> Combination meter buzzer is OK.
    No
    >> Refer to DLK-67, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    D
    INFOID:0000000009515848

    1.CHECK METER BUZZER CIRCUIT

    E

    Refer to WCS-28, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Yes
    >> GO TO 2.
    No
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    2.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    G

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    H

    >> Inspection End.

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-67

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    DRIVER SIDE
    DRIVER SIDE : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515849

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1. Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select DOOR LOCK in ACTIVE TEST mode.
    3. Touch ALL LOCK or ALL UNLK to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Door lock actuator is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-68, «DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure».

    DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515850

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-28, «POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front door lock actuator LH connector.
    Check voltage between front door lock actuator LH harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Front door lock actuator
    LH
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal
    1

    D14

    Ground

    2

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Lock

    12 V

    Unlock

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front door lock actuator LH.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector and all door lock actuator connectors.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and front door lock actuator LH harness connector.
    BCM
    Connector

    Front door lock actuator LH
    Terminal
    66

    M99

    3.

    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    D14

    65

    2

    Continuity

    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    M99

    Ground

    65

    No

    66

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK BCM OUTPUT SIGNAL

    1.
    2.

    Connect BCM connector.
    Check voltage between front door lock actuator LH harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-68

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal
    65

    M99

    Ground

    66

    Door lock and unlock switch

    A

    B

    Lock

    12 V

    Unlock

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check for internal short of each door lock actuator.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    C

    PASSENGER SIDE

    D

    PASSENGER SIDE : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515851

    1.CHECK FUNCTION

    E

    1. Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select DOOR LOCK in ACTIVE TEST mode.
    3. Touch ALL LOCK or ALL UNLK to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Door lock actuator is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-69, «PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure».

    F

    G

    PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515852

    H

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-28, «POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR INPUT SIGNAL

    I

    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front door lock actuator RH connector.
    Check voltage between front door lock actuator RH harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Front door lock actuator
    RH
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal
    2

    D114

    Ground

    1

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Lock
    Unlock

    L
    12 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front door lock actuator (RH).
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    M

    2.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Connector
    M99

    3.

    N

    Disconnect BCM connector and all door lock actuators.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and front door lock actuator RH harness connector.
    BCM

    Front door lock actuator RH
    Terminal
    65
    59

    Connector
    D114

    Terminal
    2
    1

    DLK-69

    O

    Continuity

    P
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    65

    M99

    No

    59

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK BCM OUTPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Connect BCM connector.
    Check voltage between front door lock actuator RH harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal
    65

    M99

    59

    Ground

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Lock
    Unlock

    12 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check for internal short of each door lock actuator.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    REAR LH

    REAR LH : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515853

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1. Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select DOOR LOCK in ACTIVE TEST mode.
    3. Touch ALL LOCK or ALL UNLK to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Door lock actuator is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-71, «REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure».

    REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515854

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-28, «POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear door lock actuator LH connector.
    Check voltage between rear door lock actuator LH harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Rear door lock actuator LH
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal

    D205

    1
    2

    Ground

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Lock
    Unlock

    12 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear door lock actuator LH.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR CIRCUIT

    1.

    Disconnect BCM connector and all door lock actuator connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-70

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Check continuity between BCM harness connector and rear door lock actuator LH harness connector.
    A
    BCM
    Connector

    Rear door lock actuator LH
    Terminal
    65

    M99

    3.

    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    D205

    55

    2

    Continuity

    B
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    C

    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    M99

    D

    Ground

    65

    No

    55

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK BCM OUTPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    F

    Connect BCM connector.
    Check voltage between rear door lock actuator LH harness connector and ground.

    G

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    H

    Terminal

    M99

    65
    55

    Ground

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Lock
    Unlock

    12 V

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check for internal short of each door lock actuator.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    J

    REAR RH

    REAR RH : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515855

    1.CHECK FUNCTION

    L

    1. Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select DOOR LOCK in ACTIVE TEST mode.
    3. Touch ALL LOCK or ALL UNLK to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Door lock actuator is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-71, «REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure».

    REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure

    DLK

    M

    N
    INFOID:0000000009515856

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-28, «POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    O

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    P

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear door lock actuator RH connector.
    Check voltage between rear door lock actuator RH harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-71

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    Rear door lock actuator RH
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal
    2

    D305

    Ground

    1

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Lock

    12 V

    Unlock

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear door lock actuator RH.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector and all door lock actuator connectors.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and rear door lock actuator RH harness connector.
    BCM
    Connector

    Rear door lock actuator RH
    Terminal
    65

    M99

    3.

    Connector

    Terminal
    2

    D305

    55

    1

    Continuity

    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    65

    M99

    No

    55

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK BCM OUTPUT SIGNAL

    1.
    2.

    Connect BCM connector.
    Check voltage between rear door lock actuator RH harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal

    M99

    65
    55

    Ground

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Lock
    Unlock

    12 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check for internal short of each door lock actuator.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    BACK DOOR

    BACK DOOR : Description

    INFOID:0000000009519658

    Locks/unlocks the door with the signal from BCM.

    BACK DOOR : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009519659

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1. Use CONSULT to perform Active Test (“DOOR LOCK”).
    2. Touch “ALL LOCK” or “ALL UNLK” to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-72

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Back door lock actuator is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-73, «BACK DOOR : Diagnosis Procedure».

    A

    BACK DOOR : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009519660

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-28, «POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR INPUT SIGNAL

    C

    1.
    2.
    3.

    D

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect back door lock actuator connector.
    Check voltage between back door lock actuator harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Back door lock actuator
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    1

    D505

    Ground

    2

    Door lock and unlock switch

    Unlock

    0 → Battery voltage → 0

    Lock

    0 → Battery voltage → 0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace back door lock actuator. Refer to DLK-153, «Exploded View».
    NO-1 >> GO TO 2 (lock signal).
    NO-2 >> GO TO 3 (unlock signal).

    H

    Disconnect BCM connector and all door lock actuator connectors.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and back door lock actuator harness connector.
    BCM

    3.

    I

    Back door lock actuator

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    65

    D505

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    65

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    M

    3.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR UNLOCK CIRCUIT

    Disconnect back door lock actuator relay connector.
    Check continuity between back door lock actuator relay harness connector and back door lock actuator
    harness connector.
    Back door lock actuator relay

    Back door lock actuator

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M41

    3

    D505

    1

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    M41

    3

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    DLK-73

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    N

    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    Back door lock actuator relay

    DLK

    L

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.

    J

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM

    1.
    2.

    F

    G

    2.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR LOCK CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Terminal

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    4.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Check intermittent incident.
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident»
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-74

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009519998

    Controls back door lock actuator lock/unlock operation.

    B

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009519999

    1.CHECK FUNCTION

    C

    1. Use CONSULT to perform Active Test (“DOOR LOCK”).
    2. Touch “ALL LOCK” or “ALL UNLK” to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Back door lock actuator relay is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-75, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    D

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009520000

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-28, «POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    F

    1.CHECK FUSE

    G

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check 10 A fuse, [No. 8, located in fuse block (J/B)].
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit if a fuse is blown.

    H

    2.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY POWER CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    I

    Remove back door lock actuator relay.
    Check voltage between back door lock actuator relay harness connector and ground.

    J

    (+)
    Back door lock actuator relay
    Connector

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    (–)

    DLK

    Terminal
    1

    M41

    Ground

    5

    Battery voltage

    L

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    M

    3.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY CIRCUIT 1
    1.
    2.

    Install the back door lock actuator relay.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    N

    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    50

    Ground

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Door lock and unlock switch

    LOCK

    Battery voltage

    UNLOCK

    0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO-1 (when voltage is fixed at 12V)>>Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO-2 (when voltage is fixed at 0V)>>GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY CIRCUIT 1
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-75

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Disconnect BCM connector.
    2. Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    50

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY CIRCUIT 2
    1.
    2.

    Remove back door lock actuator relay.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and back door lock actuator relay harness connector.
    Back door lock actuator relay

    3.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M41

    2

    M100

    50

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    Back door lock actuator relay
    Connector

    Terminal

    M41

    2

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace back door lock actuator relay.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    6.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between back door lock actuator relay harness connector and ground.
    Back door lock actuator relay
    Connector

    Terminal

    M41

    4

    Ground

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    7.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY

    Check back door lock actuator relay.Refer to DLK-76, «Component Inspection»
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace back door lock actuator relay.

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Check intermittent incident.
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident»
    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009520001

    1.CHECK BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove back door lock actuator relay.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-76

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check continuity between back door lock actuator relay terminals.
    A
    Back door lock actuator relay

    Condition

    Continuity

    B

    Terminal
    4
    3
    5

    12 V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2

    No

    No current supply

    Yes

    12 V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2

    Yes

    No current supply

    No

    C

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Replace back door lock actuator relay.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-77

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515857

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select CDL LOCK SW, CDL UNLOCK SW in DATA MONITOR mode.
    Check that the function operates normally according to the following conditions.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    CDL LOCK SW
    Main power window and door
    lock/unlock switch
    CDL UNLOCK SW

    Status

    LOCK

    ON

    UNLOCK

    OFF

    LOCK

    OFF

    UNLOCK

    ON

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Main power window and door lock/unlock switch is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-78, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515858

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-28, «POWER DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect main power window and door lock/unlock switch connector.
    Check signal between main power window and door lock/unlock switch harness connector and ground
    using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    Main power window and door lock/unlock switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    D7

    6

    D8

    18

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    (–)

    Ground

    JPMIA0012GB

    1.0 — 1.5 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and main power window and door lock/unlock switch
    harness connector.
    BCM
    Connector
    M18

    3.

    Main power window and door lock/unlock switch
    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    12

    D8

    18

    13

    D7

    6

    Continuity

    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-78

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    12

    M18

    A

    No

    13

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    C

    3.CHECK DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH GROUND

    Check continuity between main power window and door lock/unlock switch harness connector and ground.
    Main power window and door lock/unlock switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    D8

    17

    Ground

    Continuity

    D

    E

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    4.CHECK DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH

    G

    Refer to DLK-79, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace main power window and door lock/unlock switch. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    H

    I

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    J

    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009515859

    1.CHECK MAIN POWER WINDOW AND DOOR LOCK/UNLOCK SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect main power window and door lock/unlock switch connector.
    Check continuity between main power window and door lock/unlock switch terminals.
    Condition

    Terminal

    17
    18

    L

    M

    Main power window and door lock/unlock switch

    6

    Main power window
    and door lock/ unlock
    switch

    Continuity

    LOCK

    No

    UNLOCK

    Yes

    LOCK

    Yes

    UNLOCK

    No

    DLK-79

    N

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Replace main power window and door lock/unlock switch. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK

    2014 Note

    P

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515860

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of CM using CONSULT.
    Select REQ SW-DR, REQ SW-AS in DATA MONITOR mode.
    Check that the function operates normally according to the following conditions.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    REQ SW -DR

    Door request switch LH

    REQ SW -AS

    Door request switch RH

    Status
    Pressed

    ON

    Released

    OFF

    Pressed

    ON

    Released

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Front door request switch is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-80, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515861

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect malfunctioning front door request switch connector.
    Check voltage between malfunctioning front door request switch harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Front door request switch
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    12 V

    Terminal

    Left side

    D17

    Right side

    D113

    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between malfunctioning front door request switch harness connector and BCM harness
    connector.
    Front door request switch
    Connector

    3.

    Left side

    D17

    Right side

    D113

    BCM
    Terminal

    Connector

    1

    M98

    Terminal

    Continuity

    75

    Yes

    100

    Check continuity between malfunctioning front door request switch harness connector and ground.
    Front door request switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    Left side

    D17

    Right side

    D113

    1

    Continuity
    Ground
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-80

    2014 Note

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    A

    3.CHECK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between malfunctioning front door request switch harness connector and ground.
    Front door request switch
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Left side

    D17

    Right side

    D113

    B

    C

    Ground

    2

    Yes

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    4.CHECK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH

    E

    Refer to DLK-81, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning front door request switch.

    F

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    G

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    H

    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009515862

    I

    1.CHECK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect malfunctioning front door request switch connector.
    Check continuity between malfunctioning front door request switch terminals.
    Front door request switch

    Condition

    Terminal
    1

    2

    Door request switch

    J

    Continuity

    Pressed

    Yes

    Released

    No

    DLK

    L

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning front door request switch. Refer to DLK-147, «OUTSIDE HANDLE :
    Removal and Installation».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-81

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009519952

    Transmits lock/unlock operation to BCM.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009519953

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    Check (“REQSW-BD/TR”) in “Data Monitor” mode using CONSULT.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    REQSW-BD/TR

    Back door request switch

    Status

    Pressed

    ON

    Released

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Back door request switch is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-82, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009519954

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect back door request switch connector.
    Check voltage between back door request switch harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Back door request switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    D506

    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and back door request switch harness connector.
    BCM

    3.

    Back door request switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    51

    D506

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    51

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    3.CHECK BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between back door request switch harness connector and ground.
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-82

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Back door request switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    D506

    2

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    A

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    C

    4.CHECK BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    Refer to DLK-83, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace back door request switch. Refer to DLK-153, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    D

    E

    F

    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009519955

    1.CHECK BACK DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    G

    H

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect back door request switch connector.
    Check continuity between back door request switch terminals.

    I
    Back door request switch

    Condition

    Terminal
    1

    2

    Back door request switch

    Continuity
    Pressed

    Yes

    Released

    No

    J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    DLK
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace back door request switch. Refer to DLK-153, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-83

    2014 Note

    DOOR SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR SWITCH
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515863

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select DOOR SW-DR, DOOR SW-AS, DOOR SW-RL and DOOR SW-RR in DATA MONITOR mode.
    Check that the function operates normally according to the following conditions.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    DOOR SW-DR

    Front door LH

    DOOR SW-AS

    Front door RH

    DOOR SW-RL

    Rear door LH

    DOOR SW-RR

    Rear door RH

    Status

    Open

    ON

    Closed

    OFF

    Open

    ON

    Closed

    OFF

    Open

    ON

    Closed

    OFF

    Open

    ON

    Closed

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Door switch is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-84, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515864

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DOOR SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect malfunctioning door switch connector.
    Check signal between malfunctioning door switch harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.
    (+)
    Door switch
    Connector

    (–)

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    Front door switch
    LH

    B8

    3

    Front door switch
    RH

    B16

    3

    Rear door switch
    LH

    B6

    3

    Rear door switch
    RH

    B17

    3

    Ground

    PKIB4960J

    7.0 — 8.0 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DOOR SWITCH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between door switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-84

    2014 Note

    DOOR SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Door switch

    BCM

    Connector

    3.

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    Front door switch
    LH

    B8

    Front door switch
    RH

    B16

    Rear door switch
    LH

    B6

    48

    Rear door switch
    RH

    B17

    46

    Continuity

    47

    A

    B

    45
    3

    M100

    Yes

    C

    D

    Check continuity between door switch harness connector and ground.
    Door switch
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Front door switch LH

    B8

    Front door switch RH

    B16

    Rear door switch LH

    B6

    Rear door switch RH

    B17

    Ground

    E

    F

    3

    No

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    H

    3.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    Refer to DLK-85, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning door switch. Refer to DLK-158, «Removal and Installation».

    I

    J

    4.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    DLK

    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009515865

    L

    1.CHECK DOOR SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect malfunctioning door switch connector.
    Check continuity between door switch terminals.

    N
    Door switch

    Condition

    Terminal

    Continuity

    Front door switch
    LH

    Pressed

    No

    Released

    Yes

    Front door switch
    RH

    Pressed

    No

    Released

    Yes

    Pressed

    No

    Released

    Yes

    Pressed

    No

    Released

    Yes

    3
    Rear door switch
    LH

    Ground part of door
    switch

    Door switch

    Rear door switch
    RH

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-85

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    DOOR SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunction door switch. Refer to DLK-158, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-86

    2014 Note

    HAZARD FUNCTION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    HAZARD FUNCTION

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515866

    1.CHECK FUNCTION

    B

    1. Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Select FLASHER in ACTIVE TEST mode.
    3. Touch LH or RH to check that it works normally.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Hazard warning lamp circuit is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-87, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    D
    INFOID:0000000009515867

    1.CHECK HAZARD SWITCH CIRCUIT

    E

    Refer to DLK-87, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    2.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    G

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    H

    >> Inspection End.

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-87

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    INTELLIGENT KEY
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515868

    NOTE:
    The Signal Tech II Tool (J-50190) can be used to perform the following functions. Refer to the Signal Tech II
    User Guide for additional information.
    • Check Intelligent Key relative signal strength.
    • Confirm vehicle Intelligent Key antenna signal strength.

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select “INTELLIGENT KEY” of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Select “RKE OPE COUN1” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Check that the function operates normally according to the following conditions.
    Monitor item
    RKE OPE COUN1

    Condition
    Check that the numerical value is changing while operating on the Intelligent Key.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Intelligent Key is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-88, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515869

    NOTE:
    The Signal Tech II Tool (J-50190) can be used to perform the following functions. Refer to the Signal Tech II
    User Guide for additional information.
    • Check Intelligent Key relative signal strength.
    • Confirm vehicle Intelligent Key antenna signal strength.

    1.CHECK INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY

    Check by connecting a resistance (approximately 300Ω) so that the
    current value becomes about 10 mA. Refer to DLK-165, «Removal
    and Installation».
    Standard

    : Approx. 2.5 — 3.0V

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> Replace Intelligent Key.
    NO
    >> Replace Intelligent Key battery.
    OCC0607D

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-88

    2014 Note

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009515872

    1.CHECK FUNCTION

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Select “INTELLIGENT KEY” of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Select “RKE OPE COUN1” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Check that the function operates normally according to the following conditions.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    RKE OPE COUN1

    D

    Checks whether value changes when operating Intelligent Key

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Remote keyless entry receiver is OK.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-89, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009515874

    F

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to DLK-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM : Wiring Diagram».

    G

    1.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER OUTPUT SIGNAL

    H

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check signal between remote keyless entry receiver connector and ground with oscilloscope.
    I
    Terminals
    (+)
    Remote keyless entry
    receiver connector

    Terminal

    (–)

    Condition

    J

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    DLK

    L

    Waiting
    (All doors closed)

    M90

    2

    M

    JMKIA0064GB

    Ground

    N
    When signal is received
    (All doors closed)

    O
    JMKIA0065GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7
    NO
    >> GO TO 2

    P

    2.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect remote keyless entry receiver connector.
    Check signal between remote keyless entry receiver connector and ground with oscilloscope.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-89

    2014 Note

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Terminals
    (+)
    Remote keyless
    entry receiver
    connector

    Terminal

    M90

    4

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    (–)

    Ground

    JMKIA0064GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4
    NO
    >> GO TO 3

    3.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER CIRCUIT 1
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM connector and remote keyless entry receiver connector.

    BCM connector

    Terminal

    Remote keyless entry
    receiver
    connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    M18

    19

    M90

    4

    Yes

    3.

    Check continuity between BCM connector and ground.
    BCM connector

    Terminal

    M18

    19

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Reconnect BCM, GO TO 4
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness between BCM and remote keyless entry receiver.

    4.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between remote keyless entry receiver connector and ground.
    Remote keyless entry
    receiver
    connector

    Terminal

    M90

    1

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6
    NO
    >> GO TO 5

    5.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER CIRCUIT 2

    Check continuity between BCM connector and remote keyless entry receiver connector.
    BCM
    connector

    Terminal

    Remote keyless entry
    receiver
    connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    M18

    18

    M90

    1

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-90

    2014 Note

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness between BCM and remote keyless entry receiver.

    6.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER CIRCUIT 3
    1.

    A

    Check continuity between BCM connector and remote keyless entry receiver connector.
    B

    2.

    BCM
    connector

    Terminal

    Remote keyless entry
    receiver
    connector

    M18

    20

    M90

    Terminal

    Continuity

    2

    Yes

    C

    Check continuity between BCM connector and ground.
    D
    BCM connector

    Terminal

    M18

    20

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness between BCM and remote keyless entry.

    7.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER RSSI SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and remote keyless entry receiver harness connector.
    BCM

    3.

    F

    Remote keyless entry receiver

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M18

    22

    M90

    3

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    M18

    22

    Ground

    H

    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM

    G

    I
    Continuity

    J

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness between BCM and remote keyless entry.

    DLK

    8.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER RSSI SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Reconnect remote keyless entry receiver connector.
    Check signal between remote keyless entry receiver harness connector and ground using oscilloscope.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-91

    2014 Note

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    Remote keyless entry receiver
    Connector

    (–)

    Condition

    Signal
    (Reference value)

    Terminal

    During waiting

    M90

    3

    JMKIA5952GB

    Ground

    When pressing
    and holding either
    button on Intelligent Key
    JMKIA5953GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Replace remote keyless entry receiver. Refer to DLK-164, «Removal and Installation».

    9.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-92

    2014 Note

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK
    SWITCH
    ALL DOOR
    ALL DOOR : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516182

    A

    B

    C

    All doors do not lock/unlock using door lock and unlock switch.

    ALL DOOR : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516183

    D

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
    Check door lock and unlock switch.
    Refer to DLK-78, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    E

    Check front door lock assembly (driver side).
    Refer to DLK-145, «DOOR LOCK : Removal and Installation».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    G

    F

    2.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR

    H

    3.REPLACE BCM

    I

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    J

    DRIVER SIDE

    DLK

    DRIVER SIDE : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516184

    L

    Driver side door does not lock/unlock using door lock and unlock switch.

    DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516185

    M

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    Check front door lock assembly (driver side).
    Refer to DLK-68, «DRIVER SIDE : Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    N

    O

    2.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    P

    PASSENGER SIDE

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-93

    2014 Note

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    PASSENGER SIDE : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516186

    Passenger side door does not lock/unlock using door lock and unlock switch.

    PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516187

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    Check front door lock assembly (passenger side).
    Refer to DLK-69, «PASSENGER SIDE : Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    REAR LH

    REAR LH : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516188

    Rear LH side door does not lock/unlock using door lock and unlock switch.

    REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516189

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    Check rear door lock assembly LH.
    Refer to DLK-70, «REAR LH : Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    REAR RH

    REAR RH : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516190

    Rear RH side door does not lock/unlock using door lock and unlock switch.

    REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516191

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
    Check rear door lock assembly RH.
    Refer to DLK-71, «REAR RH : Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.REPLACE BCM

    1.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-94

    2014 Note

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-95

    2014 Note

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DRIVER SIDE DOOR LOCK KNOB OR
    DOOR KEY CYLINDER
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DRIVER SIDE DOOR LOCK
    KNOB OR DOOR KEY CYLINDER
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516192

    1.CHECK POWER DOOR LOCK OPERATION
    Check power door lock operation.
    Does door lock/unlock with door lock and unlock switch?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-78, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK UNLOCK SENSOR

    Check unlock sensor.
    Refer to DLK-78, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-96

    2014 Note

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    ALL DOOR REQUEST SWITCHES
    ALL DOOR REQUEST SWITCHES : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516193

    A

    B

    All doors do not lock/unlock using all door request switches.

    ALL DOOR REQUEST SWITCHES : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516194

    1.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION
    Check remote keyless entry function.
    Does door lock/unlock with Intelligent Key button?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-17, «System Description».

    D

    E

    2.CHECK LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Set “ON” in “LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY”.

    F

    G

    3.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    H

    Check door switch.
    Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    I

    J

    4.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    Check inside key antenna.
    • Instrument center: Refer to DLK-54, «DTC Logic».
    • Console: Refer to DLK-56, «DTC Logic».
    • Luggage room: Refer to DLK-58, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    DLK

    L

    5.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    M

    Check outside key antenna.
    • Driver side: Refer to DLK-60, «DTC Logic».
    • Passenger side: Refer to DLK-62, «DTC Logic».
    • Rear bumper: Refer to DLK-64, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    N

    O

    6.REPLACE BCM

    P

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    DRIVER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    Revision: April 2013

    C

    DLK-97

    2014 Note

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    DRIVER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516195

    All doors do not lock/unlock using driver side door request switch.

    DRIVER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516196

    1.CHECK DRIVER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    Check driver side door request switch.
    Refer to DLK-80, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    Check outside key antenna (driver side).
    Refer to DLK-60, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    PASSENGER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH

    PASSENGER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH : Description

    INFOID:0000000009516197

    All doors do not lock/unlock using passenger side door request switch.

    PASSENGER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516198

    1.CHECK PASSENGER SIDE DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    Check passenger side door request switch.
    Refer to DLK-80, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    Check outside key antenna (passenger side).
    Refer to DLK-62, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-98

    2014 Note

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH INTELLIGENT KEY
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR DOES NOT LOCK/UNLOCK WITH INTELLIGENT KEY
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009516199

    1.CHECK POWER DOOR LOCK OPERATION

    B

    Check power door lock operation.
    Does door lock/unlock with door lock and unlock switch?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-78, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    2.CHECK REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER

    D

    Check remote keyless entry receiver.
    Refer to DLK-89, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    E

    3.CHECK INTELLIGENT KEY

    F

    Check Intelligent Key.
    Refer to DLK-88, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    G

    H

    4.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    Check door switch.
    Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    I

    J

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-99

    2014 Note

    IGNITION POSITION WARNING FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    IGNITION POSITION WARNING FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516204

    1.CHECK POWER DOOR LOCK OPERATION
    Check power door lock operation.
    Does door lock/unlock with driver side door lock knob and door key cylinder?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-78, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    Check door switch.
    Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-100

    2014 Note

    AUTO DOOR LOCK OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    AUTO DOOR LOCK OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009516205

    1.CHECK AUTO LOCK SET SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select AUTO LOCK SET in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check AUTO LOCK SET setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Set MODE 2, MODE 3, MODE 4, MODE 5, MODE 6 or MODE 7 in AUTO LOCK SET.

    D

    2.REPLACE BCM

    E

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-101

    2014 Note

    VEHICLE SPEED SENSING AUTO LOCK OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    VEHICLE SPEED SENSING AUTO LOCK OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516206

    1.CHECK AUTOMATIC LOCK/UNLOCK SELECT SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select AUTOMATIC LOCK/UNLOCK SELECT in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check AUTOMATIC LOCK/UNLOCK SELECT setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-17, «DOOR LOCK : CONSULT Function (BCM — DOOR LOCK)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Set Lock Only or Lock/Unlock in WORK SUPPORT.

    2.CHECK AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK SELECT SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select DOOR LOCK of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK SELECT in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK SELECT setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-17, «DOOR LOCK : CONSULT Function (BCM — DOOR LOCK)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Set VH SPD in AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK SELECT.

    3.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-102

    2014 Note

    HAZARD AND BUZZER REMINDER DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    HAZARD AND BUZZER REMINDER DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009516208

    1.CHECK HAZARD ANSWER BACK SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select HAZARD ANSWER BACK in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check the HAZARD ANSWER BACK setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Set the Lock Only, Unlock Only or Lock/Unlock in HAZARD ANSWER BACK.

    D

    2.CHECK ANS BACK I-KEY LOCK SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT

    E

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select ANS BACK I-KEY LOCK in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check the ANS BACK I-KEY LOCK setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Set the Horn Chirp or Buzzer in ANS BACK I-KEY LOCK.

    F

    G

    3.CHECK ANS BACK I-KEY UNLOCK SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select ANS BACK I-KEY UNLOCK in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check the ANS BACK I-KEY UNLOCK setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Set the On in ANS BACK I-KEY UNLOCK.

    H

    I

    J

    4.CHECK HAZARD FUNCTION

    Check hazard function.
    Refer to DLK-87, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    DLK

    L

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-103

    2014 Note

    KEY REMINDER FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    KEY REMINDER FUNCTION DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516209

    1.CHECK ANTI KEY LOCK IN FUNCTI SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM using CONSULT.
    Select ANTI KEY LOCK IN FUNCTI in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check ANTI KEY LOCK IN FUNCTI setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Set On in ANTI KEY LOCK IN FUNCTI.

    2.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    Check door switch.
    Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    Check inside key antenna.
    • Instrument center: Refer to DLK-54, «DTC Logic».
    • Console: Refer to DLK-56, «DTC Logic».
    • Luggage room: Refer to DLK-58, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    4.CHECK UNLOCK SENSOR

    Check unlock sensor.
    Refer to DLK-78, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-104

    2014 Note

    OFF POSITION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    OFF POSITION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009516210

    1.CHECK DTC WITH BCM

    B

    Check that DTC is not detected with BCM
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    C

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    D

    Check that DTC is not detected with combination meter
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    E

    3.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    F

    Check front door switch (driver side).
    Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    G

    4.CHECK COMBINATION METER BUZZER

    H

    Check combination meter buzzer.
    Refer to DLK-67, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    I

    5.REPLACE BCM

    J

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-105

    2014 Note

    P POSITION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    P POSITION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516211

    1.CHECK DTC WITH BCM
    Check that DTC is not detected with BCM
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    Check that DTC is not detected with combination meter
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    3.CHECK COMBINATION METER BUZZER

    Check combination meter buzzer.
    Refer to DLK-67, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    4.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    Check front door switch (driver side).
    Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-106

    2014 Note

    ACC WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    ACC WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009516212

    1.CHECK DTC WITH BCM

    B

    Check that DTC is not detected with BCM
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    C

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    D

    Check that DTC is not detected with combination meter
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    E

    3.CHECK COMBINATION METER BUZZER

    F

    Check combination meter buzzer.
    Refer to DLK-67, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    G

    4.REPLACE BCM

    H

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-107

    2014 Note

    TAKE AWAY WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    TAKE AWAY WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516213

    1.CHECK DTC WITH BCM
    Check that DTC is not detected with BCM
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    Check that DTC is not detected with combination meter
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    3.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    Check inside key antenna.
    • Instrument center: Refer to DLK-54, «DTC Logic».
    • Console: Refer to DLK-56, «DTC Logic».
    • Trunk room: Refer to DLK-58, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    4.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    Check door switch.
    Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    5.CHECK COMBINATION METER BUZZER

    Check combination meter buzzer.
    Refer to DLK-67, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    6.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-108

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY LOW BATTERY WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    INTELLIGENT KEY LOW BATTERY WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A

    INFOID:0000000009516214

    1.CHECK DTC WITH BCM

    B

    Check that DTC is not detected with BCM
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    C

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    D

    Check that DTC is not detected with combination meter
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    E

    3.CHECK LO- BATT OF KEY FOB WARN SETTING IN WORK SUPPORT

    F

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select INTELLIGENT KEY of BCM.
    Select LO- BATT OF KEY FOB WARN in WORK SUPPORT mode.
    Check LO- BATT OF KEY FOB WARN setting in WORK SUPPORT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Set ON in LO- BATT OF KEY FOB WARN.

    G

    H

    4.CHECK INTELLIGENT KEY

    Check Intelligent key.
    Refer to DLK-88, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    I

    J

    5.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    DLK

    Check inside key antenna.
    • Instrument center: Refer to DLK-54, «DTC Logic».
    • Console: Refer to DLK-56, «DTC Logic».
    • Luggage room: Refer to DLK-58, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    L

    M

    6.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-109

    2014 Note

    DOOR LOCK OPERATION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    DOOR LOCK OPERATION WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009516215

    1.CHECK DOOR LOCK FUNCTION
    Check door lock function.
    Does door lock/unlock using door request switch?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to DLK-80, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK INTELLIGENT KEY WARNING BUZZER

    Check Intelligent Key warning buzzer.
    Refer to DLK-67, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE BCM

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-110

    2014 Note

    KEY ID WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    KEY ID WARNING DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009516216

    1.CHECK DTC WITH BCM

    B

    Check that DTC is not detected with BCM
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    C

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    D

    Check that DTC is not detected with combination meter
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis relevant to DTC indicated.

    E

    3.CHECK INTELLIGENT KEY

    F

    Check Intelligent Key.
    Refer to DLK-88, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    G

    4.CHECK INSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    H

    Check inside key antenna.
    • Instrument center: Refer to DLK-54, «DTC Logic».
    • Console: Refer to DLK-56, «DTC Logic».
    • Luggage room: Refer to DLK-58, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    I

    J

    5.REPLACE BCM

    DLK

    1. Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-111

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671276

    SBT842

    CUSTOMER INTERVIEW
    Interview the customer if possible, to determine the conditions that exist when the noise occurs. Use the Diagnostic Worksheet during the interview to document the facts and conditions when the noise occurs and any
    customer’s comments; refer to DLK-116, «Diagnostic Worksheet». This information is necessary to duplicate
    the conditions that exist when the noise occurs.
    • The customer may not be able to provide a detailed description or the location of the noise. Attempt to obtain
    all the facts and conditions that exist when the noise occurs (or does not occur).
    • If there is more than one noise in the vehicle, be sure to diagnose and repair the noise that the customer is
    concerned about. This can be accomplished by test driving the vehicle with the customer.
    • After identifying the type of noise, isolate the noise in terms of its characteristics. The noise characteristics
    are provided so the customer, service adviser and technician are all speaking the same language when
    defining the noise.
    • Squeak —(Like tennis shoes on a clean floor)
    Squeak characteristics include the light contact/fast movement/brought on by road conditions/hard surfaces
    = higher pitch noise/softer surfaces = lower pitch noises/edge to surface = chirping.
    • Creak—(Like walking on an old wooden floor)
    Creak characteristics include firm contact/slow movement/twisting with a rotational movement/pitch dependent on materials/often brought on by activity.
    • Rattle—(Like shaking a baby rattle)
    Rattle characteristics include the fast repeated contact/vibration or similar movement/loose parts/missing
    clip or fastener/incorrect clearance.
    • Knock —(Like a knock on a door)
    Knock characteristics include hollow sounding/sometimes repeating/often brought on by driver action.
    • Tick—(Like a clock second hand)
    Tick characteristics include gentle contacting of light materials/loose components/can be caused by driver
    action or road conditions.
    • Thump—(Heavy, muffled knock noise)
    Thump characteristics include softer knock/dead sound often brought on by activity.
    • Buzz—(Like a bumble bee)
    Buzz characteristics include high frequency rattle/firm contact.
    • Often the degree of acceptable noise level will vary depending upon the person. A noise that you may judge
    as acceptable may be very irritating to the customer.
    • Weather conditions, especially humidity and temperature, may have a great effect on noise level.

    DUPLICATE THE NOISE AND TEST DRIVE
    If possible, drive the vehicle with the customer until the noise is duplicated. Note any additional information on
    the Diagnostic Worksheet regarding the conditions or location of the noise. This information can be used to
    duplicate the same conditions when you confirm the repair.
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-112

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    If the noise can be duplicated easily during the test drive, to help identify the source of the noise, try to duplicate the noise with the vehicle stopped by doing one or all of the following:
    1) Close a door.
    2) Tap or push/pull around the area where the noise appears to be coming from.
    3) Rev the engine.
    4) Use a floor jack to recreate vehicle “twist”.
    5) At idle, apply engine load (electrical load, half-clutch on M/T model, drive position on CVT and A/T models).
    6) Raise the vehicle on a hoist and hit a tire with a rubber hammer.
    • Drive the vehicle and attempt to duplicate the conditions the customer states exist when the noise occurs.
    • If it is difficult to duplicate the noise, drive the vehicle slowly on an undulating or rough road to stress the
    vehicle body.

    A

    B

    C

    CHECK RELATED SERVICE BULLETINS

    D

    After verifying the customer concern or symptom, check ASIST for Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) related
    to that concern or symptom.
    If a TSB relates to the symptom, follow the procedure to repair the noise.

    E

    LOCATE THE NOISE AND IDENTIFY THE ROOT CAUSE
    1.
    2.

    Narrow down the noise to a general area. To help pinpoint the source of the noise, use a listening tool
    (Chassis Ear: J-39570, Engine Ear: J-39565 and mechanic’s stethoscope).
    Narrow down the noise to a more specific area and identify the cause of the noise by:
    • removing the components in the area that you suspect the noise is coming from.
    Do not use too much force when removing clips and fasteners, otherwise clips and fasteners can be
    broken or lost during the repair, resulting in the creation of new noise.
    • tapping or pushing/pulling the component that you suspect is causing the noise.
    Do not tap or push/pull the component with excessive force, otherwise the noise will be eliminated only
    temporarily.
    • feeling for a vibration with your hand by touching the component(s) that you suspect is (are) causing the
    noise.
    • placing a piece of paper between components that you suspect are causing the noise.
    • looking for loose components and contact marks.
    Refer to DLK-113, «Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting».

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    REPAIR THE CAUSE


    If the cause is a loose component, tighten the component securely.
    If the cause is insufficient clearance between components:
    DLK
    separate components by repositioning or loosening and retightening the component, if possible.
    insulate components with a suitable insulator such as urethane pads, foam blocks, felt cloth tape or urethane
    tape. A NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) is available through your authorized NISSAN Parts Department.
    L
    CAUTION:
    Do not use excessive force as many components are constructed of plastic and may be damaged.
    NOTE:
    M
    • Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    • The materials contained in the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) are listed on the inside cover of the
    kit; and can each be ordered separately as needed.
    • The following materials not found in the kit can also be used to repair squeaks and rattles.
    N
    — SILICONE GREASE: Use instead of UHMW tape that will be visible or does not fit. The silicone grease will
    only last a few months.
    — SILICONE SPRAY: Use when grease cannot be applied.
    O
    — DUCT TAPE: Use to eliminate movement.

    CONFIRM THE REPAIR
    Confirm that the cause of a noise is repaired by test driving the vehicle. Operate the vehicle under the same
    conditions as when the noise originally occurred. Refer to the notes on the Diagnostic Worksheet.

    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting

    INFOID:0000000009671277

    Refer to Table of Contents for specific component removal and installation information.

    INSTRUMENT PANEL
    Most incidents are caused by contact and movement between:
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-113

    2014 Note

    P

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Cluster lid A and the instrument panel
    2. Acrylic lens and combination meter housing
    3. Instrument panel to front pillar finisher
    4. Instrument panel to windshield
    5. Instrument panel pins
    6. Wiring harnesses behind the combination meter
    7. A/C defroster duct and duct joint
    These incidents can usually be located by tapping or moving the components to duplicate the noise or by
    pressing on the components while driving to stop the noise. Most of these incidents can be repaired by applying felt cloth tape or silicone spray (in hard to reach areas). Urethane pads can be used to insulate wiring harness.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use silicone spray to isolate a squeak or rattle. If you saturate the area with silicone, you will
    not be able to recheck the repair.

    CENTER CONSOLE
    Components to pay attention to include:
    1. Shift selector assembly cover to finisher
    2. A/C control unit and cluster lid C
    3. Wiring harnesses behind audio and A/C control unit
    The instrument panel repair and isolation procedures also apply to the center console.

    DOORS
    Pay attention to the:
    1. Finisher and inner panel making a slapping noise
    2. Inside handle escutcheon to door finisher
    3. Wiring harnesses tapping
    4. Door striker out of alignment causing a popping noise on starts and stops
    Tapping or moving the components or pressing on them while driving to duplicate the conditions can isolate
    many of these incidents. You can usually insulate the areas with felt cloth tape or insulator foam blocks from
    the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) to repair the noise.

    TRUNK
    Trunk noises are often caused by a loose jack or loose items put into the trunk by the owner.
    In addition look for:
    1. Trunk lid bumpers out of adjustment
    2. Trunk lid striker out of adjustment
    3. The trunk lid torsion bars knocking together
    4. A loose license plate or bracket
    Most of these incidents can be repaired by adjusting, securing or insulating the item(s) or component(s) causing the noise.

    SUNROOF/HEADLINING
    Noises in the sunroof/headlining area can often be traced to one of the following:
    1. Sunroof lid, rail, linkage or seals making a rattle or light knocking noise
    2. Sun visor shaft shaking in the holder
    3. Front or rear windshield touching headlining and squeaking
    Again, pressing on the components to stop the noise while duplicating the conditions can isolate most of these
    incidents. Repairs usually consist of insulating with felt cloth tape.

    OVERHEAD CONSOLE (FRONT AND REAR)
    Overhead console noises are often caused by the console panel clips not being engaged correctly. Most of
    these incidents are repaired by pushing up on the console at the clip locations until the clips engage.
    In addition look for:
    1. Loose harness or harness connectors.
    2. Front console map/reading lamp lens loose.
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-114

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Loose screws at console attachment points.
    A

    SEATS
    When isolating seat noise it’s important to note the position the seat is in and the load placed on the seat when
    the noise is present. These conditions should be duplicated when verifying and isolating the cause of the
    noise.
    Cause of seat noise include:
    1. Headrest rods and holder
    2. A squeak between the seat pad cushion and frame
    3. The rear seatback lock and bracket
    These noises can be isolated by moving or pressing on the suspected components while duplicating the conditions under which the noise occurs. Most of these incidents can be repaired by repositioning the component
    or applying urethane tape to the contact area.

    UNDERHOOD
    Some interior noise may be caused by components under the hood or on the engine wall. The noise is then
    transmitted into the passenger compartment.
    Causes of transmitted underhood noise include:
    1. Any component installed to the engine wall
    2. Components that pass through the engine wall
    3. Engine wall mounts and connectors
    4. Loose radiator installation pins
    5. Hood bumpers out of adjustment
    6. Hood striker out of adjustment
    These noises can be difficult to isolate since they cannot be reached from the interior of the vehicle. The best
    method is to secure, move or insulate one component at a time and test drive the vehicle. Also, engine rpm or
    load can be changed to isolate the noise. Repairs can usually be made by moving, adjusting, securing, or
    insulating the component causing the noise.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-115

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnostic Worksheet

    INFOID:0000000009671278

    LAIA0072E

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-116

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O
    LAIA0071E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-117

    2014 Note

    HOOD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    HOOD
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567329

    AWKIA2564ZZ

    1.

    Hood

    2.

    Bumper rubber (hood side)

    3.

    Hood insulator (if equipped)

    4.

    Hood rod clamp

    5.

    Bumper rubber (body side)

    6.

    Hood rod grommet

    7.

    Hood hinge (LH)

    8.

    Hood support rod

    9.

    Hood hinge (RH)

    A.

    Hood insulator clip

    HOOD ASSEMBLY
    HOOD ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567330

    CAUTION:
    • Use two people when removing or installing hood assembly due to its heavy weight.
    • Use protective tape or shop cloths to protect surrounding components from damage during removal
    and installation of hood assembly.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.

    Support hood assembly using a suitable tool.
    WARNING:
    Bodily injury may occur if hood assembly is not supported properly when removing hood assembly.
    Remove hood hinge nuts and hood assembly.
    Remove clips and hood insulator (if necessary) (if equipped).

    INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-118

    2014 Note

    HOOD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Before installing hood assembly, apply anticorrosive agent to the surface of hood hinge.
    • After installation, perform the hood assembly adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-119, «HOOD
    ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».
    • After installation, apply touch-up paint (body color) to the head of hood hinge nuts.

    HOOD ASSEMBLY : Adjustment

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567331

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M
    AWKIA2565ZZ

    1.

    N

    Hood assembly

    2.

    Bumper rubber (body side)

    3.

    Hood hinge (LH)

    4.

    Hood lock

    5.

    Front grille finisher

    6.

    Front combination lamp

    7.

    Front fender

    O

    Check the clearance and the surface height between hood and each part by visual inspection and tactile feel.
    If the clearance and the surface height are out of specification, adjust them according to the adjustment procedure.
    Unit: mm (in)

    Section

    Item

    A–A

    B–B

    Revision: April 2013

    Measurement

    Standard

    Parallelism

    Equality

    D

    Clearance

    4.4 ± 2.0 (0.17 ± 0.08)

    2.0 (0.08)

    E

    Surface height

    -0.5 +2.0, -1.5 (0.02 +0.08, -0.06)

    2.0 (0.08)

    F

    Clearance

    4.0 ± 2.0 (0.16 ± 0.08)

    2.0 (0.08)

    3.0 (0.12)

    G

    Surface height

    DLK-119

    2014 Note

    P

    HOOD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Section

    Item

    Measurement

    Standard

    Parallelism

    Equality

    H

    Clearance

    3.5 ± 1.0 (0.14 ± 0.04)

    1.5 (0.06)

    1.5 (0.06)

    J

    Surface height

    0.0 ± 1.5 (0.0 ± 0.06)

    1.5 (0.06)

    1.5 (0.06)

    C–C

    CLEARANCE ADJUSTMENT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Loosen hood hinge nuts and bolts.
    Loosen hood lock assembly bolts.
    Adjust the hood lock assembly so the clearance measurements are within the specifications provided.
    Tighten hood hinge nuts and bolts to specified torque.
    Tighten hood lock assembly bolts to specified torque.

    HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Loosen hood lock assembly bolts.
    Adjust the surface height of hood assembly to front upper grille, front fender and front combination lamp to
    the specified values by rotating hood bumper rubber.
    Temporarily tighten hood lock assembly bolts.
    Adjust (A) as shown to the following value with hood’s own weight by dropping it from approximately 200
    mm (7.87 in) height or by pressing hood lightly [approximately 29 N (3.0 kg, 6.5 lb)].

    ALKIA3162ZZ

    5.

    1.

    Hood striker

    A.

    20.0 mm (0.79 in)

    2.

    Secondary latch

    3.

    Primary latch

    After adjustment, tighten hood lock assembly bolts to specified torque.

    HOOD HINGE
    HOOD HINGE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567332

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove hood assembly. Refer to DLK-118, «HOOD ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Remove front fender. Refer to DLK-125, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove cowl top side cover. Refer to EXT-22, «Exploded View».
    Remove hood hinge bolts and hood hinge.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Before installing the hood hinge, apply anticorrosive agent onto the surface of the vehicle.
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-120

    2014 Note

    HOOD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check hood hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    A

    B

    C
    JMKIA7995ZZ

    HOOD SUPPORT ROD

    D

    HOOD SUPPORT ROD : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567333

    E

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.

    Support hood assembly using a suitable tool.
    WARNING:
    Bodily injury may occur if hood assembly is not supported properly when removing hood support
    rod.
    Rotate and remove hood support rod from grommet.
    Release tab and remove grommet from hood hinge (if necessary).

    INSTALLATION

    F

    G

    H

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-121

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567334

    ALKIA3172ZZ

    1.

    Upper air guide

    2.

    Air guide (RH)

    3.

    Front bumper reinforcement

    4.

    Lower air guide

    5.

    Air guide (LH)

    6.

    Radiator core lower support

    7.

    Lower grommet

    8.

    Upper grommet

    9.

    Radiator core upper support

    Clip

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER
    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567335

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove ground harness bolt (A).

    ALKIA3174ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-122

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Remove washer tube inlet clip (A).
    A

    B

    C
    AWKIA2567ZZ

    4.

    D

    Remove radiator cap adapter bracket bolt (A) and radiator reservoir tank bolt (B).

    E

    F

    G
    JMKIA8027ZZ

    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.
    10.
    11.
    12.

    Remove horn. Refer to HRN-6, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove crash zone sensor. Refer to SR-19, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove hood lock assembly. Refer to DLK-142, «HOOD LOCK : Removal and Installation».
    Release hood lock release cable clips from radiator core support upper using a suitable tool.
    Remove upper air guide. Refer to DLK-122, «Exploded View».
    Remove air guide (LH/RH). Refer to DLK-122, «Exploded View».
    Release all harness connector clips from radiator core support upper using a suitable tool.
    Remove bolts (A) and radiator core support upper.

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M
    AWKIA2568ZZ

    N

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installation, perform hood assembly adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-119, «HOOD ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».

    O

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT LOWER

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT LOWER : Removal and Installation

    P
    INFOID:0000000009567336

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove radiator core support upper. Refer to DLK-122, «RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Reposition the radiator and condenser.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-123

    2014 Note

    RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Using a suitable tool (A), suspend radiator and condenser to
    prevent them from falling.
    CAUTION:
    Use care to avoid damaging radiator and condenser.

    JMKIA8030ZZ

    4.

    Remove bolts (A) and radiator core support lower (1).

    ALKIA3181ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-124

    2014 Note

    FRONT FENDER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT FENDER

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567337

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L
    AWKIA2569ZZ

    1.

    Front fender

    4.

    Front fender stiffener

    2.

    Cowl top side cover
    Pawl

    3.

    Front fender insulator

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567338

    CAUTION:
    Use a shop cloths to protect the body from being damaged during removal and installation.
    Remove the front combination lamp. Refer to EXL-108, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove cowl top side cover. Refer to DLK-125, «Exploded View».
    Remove front fender bolts.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-125

    N

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    Clip

    P

    2014 Note

    FRONT FENDER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4. Remove front fender stiffener (2) by carefully pulling upper portion of front fender (1) away from body.
    : Front
    CAUTION:
    Use care when removing the front fender. The front fender
    stiffener foam adheres the front fender to the body. Carefully release the stiffener foam or damage to front fender
    may occur.

    JMKIA5633ZZ

    5.

    Remove front fender.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, apply touch-up paint (body color) to the head of front fender bolts.
    • After installation, adjust the following components as necessary:
    — Hood assembly: Refer to DLK-119, «HOOD ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».
    — Front door assembly: Refer to DLK-128, «DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-126

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DOOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567339

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J
    AWKIA2492ZZ

    1.

    Inside seal

    2.

    Door sash front tape

    3.

    Grommet (driver side only)

    4.

    Door upper hinge

    5.

    Door lower hinge

    6.

    Door check link

    7.

    Front door panel

    8.

    Lower grommet

    9.

    Upper grommet

    10. Door striker

    11. Body panel plug

    DLK

    L

    12. Door sash rear tape

    DOOR ASSEMBLY
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567340

    CAUTION:
    • Use two people when removing or installing front door due to its heavy weight
    • When removing and installing front door assembly, support the door using a suitable tool.
    • Do not use air tools or electric tools for servicing.
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch off, disconnect both battery terminals and wait at least three
    minutes.

    M

    N

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the battery positive and negative terminals and wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove dash side finisher. Refer to INT-22, «DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the front door.
    Remove door check link bolt (body side).
    Remove door hinge nuts (door side) and front door assembly.

    INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-127

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, perform the front door adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-128, «DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».
    • Apply anticorrosive agent to the door hinge mating surface.
    • Check door hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    JMKIA8072ZZ

    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009567341

    AWKIA2493ZZ

    1.

    Front fender

    4.

    Body side outer

    5.

    Door striker

    6.

    Striker bolt

    7.

    Front door hinge

    8.

    Rear door upper hinge

    9.

    Rear door lower hinge

    Revision: April 2013

    2.

    Front door

    DLK-128

    3.

    Rear door

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check the clearance and surface height between front door and each part by visual inspection and tactile feel.
    If the clearance and the surface height are out of specification, adjust them according to the adjustment procedure.

    A

    Unit: mm (in)

    Section
    A–A

    B–B

    C–C

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    8.

    B

    Measurement

    Standard

    Clearance

    4.6 ± 1.0 (0.18 ± 0.04)

    Surface height

    0.0 ± 1.0 (0.0 ± 0.04)

    Clearance

    4.6 ± 2.0 (0.18 ± 0.08)

    Surface height

    0.0 ± 1.5 (0.0 ± 0.06)

    Clearance

    4.6 ± 1.0 (0.18 ± 0.04)

    Surface height

    0.0 ± 1.0 (0.0 ± 0.04)

    Remove front fender. Refer to DLK-125, «Removal and Installation».
    Loosen front door hinge nuts (door side).
    Adjust the surface height of front door according to the specifications provided.
    Temporarily tighten front door hinge nuts (door side).
    Loosen front door hinge bolts (body side).
    Raise or lower the front door at rear end to adjust clearance of the front door according to the specifications provided.
    After adjustment tighten bolts and nuts to the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    Check door hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose
    grease.
    Install front fender. Refer to refer to DLK-125, «Removal and Installation».

    DOOR STRIKER
    DOOR STRIKER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567342

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    REMOVAL
    Remove bolts and door striker.

    DLK

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse door striker bolts.
    • Tighten bolts to specification. Refer to DLK-127, «Exploded View».
    • After installation, check front door open/close operation. If necessary, perform the door striker
    adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-129, «DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment».

    DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment

    M

    INFOID:0000000009567343

    N

    DOOR STRIKER ADJUSTMENT
    1.
    2.

    L

    Loosen door striker bolts
    Adjust door striker so that it becomes parallel with front door lock
    insertion direction.

    O

    P

    PIIB2804J

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-129

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3.

    Tighten door striker bolts to specification. Refer to DLK-127, «Exploded View».

    DOOR HINGE
    DOOR HINGE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567344

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove front fender. Refer to DLK-125, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove front door assembly. Refer to DLK-127, «DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Remove front door hinge bolts (body side) and front door hinge.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Apply anticorrosive agent to the hinge mating surface.
    • After installation, perform the front door adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-128, «DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».
    • Check door hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    JMKIA8072ZZ

    DOOR CHECK LINK
    DOOR CHECK LINK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567345

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove front door speaker. Refer to AV-34, «Removal and Installation» (BASE AUDIO), AV-94, «Removal
    and Installation» (DISPLAY AUDIO) or AV-179, «Removal and Installation» (NAVIGATION).
    Remove door check link bolt (body side).
    Remove door check link bolts (door side) and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, check rear door open/close, lock/unlock operation.
    • Check door check link rotating point for poor lubrication. If
    necessary, apply a multi-purpose grease.

    JMKIA8074ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-130

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DOOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567346

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J
    AWKIA2570ZZ

    1.

    Door sash rear tape

    2.

    Inside seal

    3.

    4.

    Door upper hinge

    5.

    Door lower hinge

    6.

    Door check link

    7.

    Rear door panel

    8.

    Door striker

    9.

    Grommet

    DLK

    Door sash front tape

    L

    10. Body panel plug

    DOOR ASSEMBLY
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567347

    CAUTION:
    • Use two people when removing or installing rear door due to its heavy weight.
    • When removing and installing rear door assembly, support door using a suitable tool.

    N

    REMOVAL
    1.

    M

    O

    Remove rear door harness grommet (1) from body side outer
    (2), then pull out rear door harness.

    P

    JMKIA8083ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-131

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2.

    Disconnect the harness connector (A) from rear door.

    JMKIA8084ZZ

    3.
    4.

    Remove door check link bolt (body side).
    Remove door hinge nuts (door side) and rear door assembly.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Apply anticorrosive agent to the hinge mating surface.
    • After installation, perform the rear door adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-133, «DOOR ASSEMBLY
    : Adjustment».
    • After adjusting, apply touch-up paint (body color) to the head of door hinge nuts.
    • Check door hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    JMKIA8072ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-132

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009567348

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK
    AWKIA2493ZZ

    L
    1.

    Front fender

    2.

    Front door

    3.

    Rear door

    4.

    Body side outer

    5.

    Door striker

    6.

    Striker bolt

    7.

    Front door hinge

    8.

    Rear door upper hinge

    9.

    Rear door lower hinge

    M

    Check the clearance and surface height between rear door and each part by visual inspection and tactile feel.
    If the clearance and the surface height are out of specification, adjust them according to the adjustment procedure.

    N

    Unit: mm (in)

    Section
    A–A

    B–B

    C–C

    1.

    Measurement

    Standard

    Clearance

    4.6 ± 1.0 (0.18 ± 0.04)

    Surface height

    0.0 ± 1.0 (0.0 ± 0.04)

    Clearance

    4.6 ± 2.0 (0.18 ± 0.08)

    Surface height

    0.0 ± 1.5 (0.0 ± 0.06)

    Clearance

    4.6 ± 1.0 (0.18 ± 0.04)

    Surface height

    0.0 ± 1.0 (0.0 ± 0.04)

    Remove center pillar lower finisher. Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-133

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    REAR DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Loosen door hinge nuts (door side).
    3. Adjust the surface height of rear door according to the specifications provided.
    4. Temporarily tighten door hinge nuts (door side).
    5. Loosen door hinge nuts and bolts (body side).
    6. Raise rear door at rear end to adjust clearance of rear door according to the specifications provided.
    7. After adjustment tighten bolts and nuts to the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    • Apply touch-up paint (body color) to the head of hinge bolts and nuts.
    • Check door hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose
    grease.
    8. Install center pillar lower finisher. Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal and
    Installation».

    DOOR STRIKER
    DOOR STRIKER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567349

    REMOVAL
    Remove bolts and rear door striker.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse door striker bolts.
    • Tighten door striker bolts to specification. Refer to DLK-131, «Exploded View».
    • After installation, check front door open/close operation. If necessary, adjust the door striker. Refer
    to DLK-134, «DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment».

    DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009567350

    DOOR STRIKER ADJUSTMENT
    1.
    2.

    Loosen door striker bolts.
    Adjust door striker so that it becomes parallel with rear door lock
    insertion direction.

    PIIB2804J

    3.

    Tighten door striker bolts to specification. Refer to DLK-131, «Exploded View».

    DOOR HINGE
    DOOR HINGE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567351

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove rear door assembly. Refer to DLK-131, «DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Remove center pillar lower finisher. Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation».
    Remove rear door hinge bolts and nuts (body side) and rear door hinge.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-134

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Apply anticorrosive agent to the door hinge mating surface.
    • After installation, perform the rear door adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-133, «DOOR ASSEMBLY
    : Adjustment».
    • After adjusting, apply touch-up paint (body color) to the head of door hinge bolts and nuts.
    • Check door hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    JMKIA8072ZZ

    DOOR CHECK LINK
    DOOR CHECK LINK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567352

    E

    F

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove rear door speaker. Refer to AV-35, «Removal and Installation» (BASE AUDIO), AV-95, «Removal
    and Installation» (DISPLAY AUDIO) or AV-180, «Removal and Installation» (NAVIGATION).
    Remove door check link bolt (body side).
    Remove door check link bolts (door side) and remove.

    G

    H

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, check rear door open/close operation.
    • Check door check link rotating point for poor lubrication. If
    necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    I

    J

    DLK

    L
    JMKIA8074ZZ

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-135

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BACK DOOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567353

    AWKIA2571ZZ

    1.

    Back door hinge (RH)

    4.

    Back door stay stud ball (RH)

    5.

    Back door stay (LH)

    6.

    Back door stay stud ball (LH)

    7.

    Bumper rubber seal

    8.

    Bumper rubber

    9.

    Spacer

    10. Back door outer finisher

    2.

    Back door hinge (LH)

    3.

    Back door stay (RH)

    11. Back door assembly

    BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY
    BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567354

    CAUTION:
    • Use two people when removing or installing the back door due to its heavy weight.
    • Use shop cloths to protect surrounding components from damage during removal and installation of
    back door.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove back door inner finisher. Refer to INT-34, «BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove back door stay (LH/RH). Refer to DLK-140, «BACK DOOR STAY : Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-136

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Remove back door harness grommet (1), then pull harness from
    the back door.

    A

    B

    C
    ALKIA3187ZZ

    4.
    5.

    D

    Disconnect washer tube from rear wiper.
    Remove washer tube grommet (1), then pull washer tube from
    the back door.

    E

    F

    G
    ALKIA3188ZZ

    6.

    7.

    Support the back door assembly using a suitable tool.
    WARNING:
    Bodily injury may occur if back door assembly is not supported properly when removing the back
    door spindle unit.
    Remove back door hinge nuts (door side) and remove.

    H

    I

    J

    INSTALLATION

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    DLK
    • Apply anticorrosive agent onto the surface between hinge and door side.
    • When reusing stud ball, always apply locking sealant before installing stud ball to back door.
    • After installation, perform the back door assembly adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-138, «BACK
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».
    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-137

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009567355

    AWKIA2495ZZ

    1.

    Back door panel

    2.

    Roof panel

    3.

    Rear combination lamp

    4.

    Rear bumper fascia

    5.

    Back door hinge

    6.

    Bumper rubber

    7.

    Bolt

    8.

    Back door striker

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-138

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check the clearance and the surface height between back door and each part by visual inspection and tactile
    feel. If the clearance and the surface height are out of specification, adjust them according to the adjustment
    procedure.

    A

    Unit: mm (in)

    Portion

    Section

    Back door panel – Roof panel

    A–A

    Rear combination lamp – Back door panel

    Rear bumper fascia – Back-door panel

    B–B

    C–C
    D–D

    B

    Item

    Measurement

    Standard

    H

    Clearance

    6.0 ± 1.0 (0.24 ± 0.04)

    I

    Surface height

    0.0 +0.5, -1.5 (0.00 +0.02, -0.06)

    J

    Clearance

    5.0 ± 2.0 (0.20 ± 0.08)

    K

    Surface height

    -2.0 ± 2.0 (-0.08 ± 0.08)

    L

    Clearance

    5.0 ± 2.0 (0.20 ± 0.08)

    M

    Surface height

    0.0 +0.5, -2.0 (0.0 +0.02, -0.08)

    M

    Clearance

    7.0 ± 2.0 (0.28 ± 0.08)

    1.
    2.

    Loosen back door hinge nuts (door side).
    Lift up back door approximately 100 – 150 mm (3.94 – 5.91 in) height then close it lightly and check that it
    is engaged firmly with back door closed.
    3. Check the clearance and surface height and adjust back door as necessary.
    4. Tighten back door hinge nuts to specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, check back door open/close, lock/unlock operation.
    • Check back door hinge rotating point for poor lubrication. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.
    • After adjusting, apply touch-up paint (body color) to the head of rear door hinge bolts and nuts.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    BACK DOOR STRIKER

    BACK DOOR STRIKER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567356

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    J

    Remove back door kicking plate using a suitable tool.
    Remove bolts and back door striker.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse back door striker bolts.
    • After installation, check back door open/close, lock/unlock operation.
    • After installation, perform the back door assembly adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-138, «BACK
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».

    BACK DOOR STRIKER : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009567357

    DOOR STRIKER ADJUSTMENT
    1.
    2.

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    Loosen door striker bolts.
    Adjust door striker so that it becomes parallel with back door
    lock insertion direction.

    O

    P

    PIIB2804J

    3.

    Tighten door striker bolts to specification. Refer to DLK-136, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-139

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BACK DOOR HINGE
    BACK DOOR HINGE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567358

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove back door assembly. Refer to DLK-136, «BACK DOOR ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Partially remove back door weatherstrip. Refer to DLK-141, «BACK DOOR WEATHER-STRIP : Removal
    and Installation».
    Remove back door hinge nuts and bolts (body side) and then remove back door hinge.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Apply anticorrosive agent onto the surface between hinge and body side.
    • After installation, perform the back door assembly adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-138, «BACK
    DOOR ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».

    BACK DOOR STAY

    BACK DOOR STAY : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567359

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.

    Support the back door with a suitable tool too prevent it from falling.
    WARNING:
    Body injury may occur if no supporting rod is holding the back door open when removing the
    back door stay.
    Remove the metal clip (3) located on the connection between
    the back door stay (1) and the stud ball (2) (back door side) by
    using a flat blade screwdriver (A).
    Remove the back door stay (back door side).

    JMKIA2255ZZ

    4.

    In the same way, remove the back door stay from the body side.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Check the back door open/close operation after installation.

    BACK DOOR STAY : Disposal

    INFOID:0000000009567360

    BACK DOOR STAY DISPOSAL
    WARNING:
    When performing disposal procedure, wear protective gloves and glasses.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-140

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Secure back door stay (1) using a vice (C).
    CAUTION:
    When cutting back door stay, always cover suitable tool (A)
    using a shop cloth (B) to avoid scattering metal fragments
    or oil.

    A

    B

    C
    JMKIA3336ZZ

    2.

    D

    Slowly cut a hole in back door stay and drain the gas using a
    hacksaw at position (B) as shown.
    A: 20 mm (0.79 in)

    E

    F

    G
    JMKIA5421ZZ

    BACK DOOR WEATHER-STRIP

    H

    BACK DOOR WEATHER-STRIP : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567361

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Support back door using a suitable tool.
    Carefully remove back door weather-strip from opening door joint.

    J

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Beginning with upper section, align weather-strip mark with vehicle center position mark and install
    DLK
    weather strip to the vehicle.
    2. For the lower section, align weather-strip seam with center of back door striker.
    NOTE:
    L
    Pull weather-strip gently to make sure that there are no loose sections.
    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-141

    2014 Note

    HOOD LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    HOOD LOCK
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567362

    AWKIA2572ZZ

    1.

    Hood lock/fuel filler lid release handle

    A.

    Clip

    2.

    Hood lock assembly

    3.

    Hood lock release cable assembly

    HOOD LOCK
    HOOD LOCK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567363

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove hood lock bolts (A).

    ALKIA3190ZZ

    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the harness connector from the hood lock assembly (if equipped).
    Disconnect hood lock release cable (2) from hood lock (1) and
    remove.

    AWKIA2497ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-142

    2014 Note

    HOOD LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, perform hood assembly adjustment procedure. Refer to DLK-119, «HOOD ASSEMBLY : Adjustment».
    • After adjustment, perform hood lock control inspection. Refer to DLK-143, «HOOD LOCK : Inspection».

    HOOD LOCK : Inspection

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567364

    HOOD LOCK INSPECTION

    C

    NOTE:
    If hood lock cable is bent or deformed, replace it. Refer to DLK-142, «HOOD LOCK : Removal and Installation».
    1. Check that secondary latch is properly engage with secondary striker with hoods own weight.
    2. While operating hood lock release lever, carefully check that the front end of hood assembly is raised by
    approximately 20.0 mm (0.79 in). Also check that hood lock release lever returns to original position.
    3. Check that hood lock release lever operates at 49 N (5.0 kg-m, 11.0 ft-lb) or below.
    4. Install so that static closing force of hood is 315-490 N (32.1-50.0 kg-m, 70.8-110.2 ft-lb).
    5. Check hood lock assembly lubrication condition. If necessary, apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    D

    E

    F

    HOOD LOCK RELEASE CABLE
    HOOD LOCK RELEASE CABLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567365

    G

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    H

    Disconnect hood lock release cable from hood lock. Refer to DLK-142, «Exploded View».
    Remove radiator cap adapter bracket bolt (A) and radiator reservoir tank bolt (B).

    I

    J

    DLK
    JMKIA8027ZZ

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Remove fender protector (LH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Release hood lock control cable clips using a suitable tool.
    Remove hood lock/fuel filler door release handle. Refer to DLK-144, «HOOD LOCK RELEASE HANDLE :
    Removal and Installation».
    Remove dash side finisher (LH). Refer to INT-22, «DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation»
    Remove grommet on the lower dash and pull the hood lock release cable into the passenger compartment.
    CAUTION:
    While pulling, be careful not to damage (peel) the outside of the hood lock release cable.

    M

    N

    O

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to bend cable too much, keep the radius 100 mm (3.94 in) or more.
    • Check that hood lock release cable is properly engaged with hood lock.

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    DLK-143

    P

    2014 Note

    HOOD LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check that cable is not offset from the positioning grommet,
    and apply the sealant to the grommet (at * mark).

    PIIB5801E

    HOOD LOCK RELEASE HANDLE
    HOOD LOCK RELEASE HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567366

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove hood lock/fuel filler door release handle bolts (A).

    AWKIA2498ZZ

    2.

    Disconnect hood lock release cable from hood lock/fuel filler door release handle and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-144

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DOOR LOCK

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567367

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2573ZZ

    1.

    Key cylinder (driver side)

    2.

    Outside handle bracket

    3.

    Outside handle escutcheon
    (passenger side)

    4.

    Front gasket

    5.

    Outside handle

    6.

    Inside handle

    7.

    Door lock

    8.

    Key cylinder rod (driver side)

    9.

    Rear gasket

    A.

    Clip

    B.

    Bolt

    J

    DLK

    Pawl

    DOOR LOCK

    L

    DOOR LOCK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567368

    M

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove inside handle. Refer to DLK-146, «INSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove outside handle. Refer to DLK-147, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the door lock actuator.
    Remove front door glass rear run. Refer to GW-21, «Exploded View».
    Remove bolts and door lock.

    N

    O

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse door lock bolts.
    • After installation, check door open/close, lock/unlock operation.
    • Check door lock cables are properly engaged to inside handle and outside handle bracket.
    • When installing key cylinder on front door, be sure to rotate key cylinder rod holder until a click is
    felt.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-145

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check door lock for poor lubrication. Apply a suitable multipurpose grease to door lock if necessary.

    JMKIA8077ZZ

    INSIDE HANDLE
    INSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567369

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Partially remove vapor barrier. Refer to GW-21, «Exploded View».
    Release lock knob (2) and inside handle cable (3) from clip (1)
    using a suitable tool.

    JMKIA8078ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Remove inside handle bolt.
    Release inside handle (1) from door panel using a suitable tool
    and remove.
    : Pawl

    AWKIA2500ZZ

    6.

    Release inside handle cable (3) and lock cable (2) from inside
    handle (1) and remove.

    JMKIA5885ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-146

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check that door lock cables are properly engaged to inside handle.
    • After installation, check door open/close, lock/unlock operation.

    A

    OUTSIDE HANDLE

    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567370

    B

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Partially remove vapor barrier. Refer to GW-21, «Exploded View».
    Open rod holder (1) by pulling downward and separate key rod
    (3) from door lock assembly (2) (driver side only).

    C

    D

    E

    F
    JMKIA8080ZZ

    4.

    G

    Release outside handle cable (1) from cable clip (A).

    H

    I

    J
    AWKIA2574ZZ

    5.

    Remove door grommet (1) and bolt from grommet hole (2).

    DLK

    L

    M

    JMKIA5888ZZ

    6.

    While pulling outside handle, remove outside handle escutcheon.

    N

    O

    P

    JMKIA0560ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-147

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    7. While pulling outside handle (1), slide toward rear of vehicle.

    JMKIA0524ZZ

    8. Disconnect the harness connectors from the outside handle and remove.
    9. Remove front gasket and rear gasket.
    10. Slide outside handle bracket toward rear of vehicle to remove.
    : Front

    JMKIA5890ZZ

    11. Disconnect outside handle cable (1) from outside handle bracket
    (2) as shown.

    JMKIA5891ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that door lock cables are properly engaged with outside handle bracket.
    • After installation, check door open/close, and lock/unlock operation.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-148

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DOOR LOCK

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567371

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2575ZZ

    1.

    Outside handle bracket

    2.

    Outside handle escutcheon

    3.

    Front gasket

    4.

    Outside handle

    5.

    Inside handle

    6.

    Door lock

    7.

    Door lock

    A.

    Clip

    B.

    Bolt

    J

    DLK

    Pawl

    DOOR LOCK
    DOOR LOCK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567372

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    M

    Remove inside handle. Refer to DLK-150, «INSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove outside handle. Refer to DLK-151, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove bolts (A) from rear door glass rear run (1).

    N

    O

    P

    JMKIA8086ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the harness connector from door lock actuator.
    Remove bolts and door lock.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-149

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse door lock assembly bolts.
    • After installation, check door open/close, lock/unlock operation.
    • Check door lock cable is properly engaged with inside handle and outside handle bracket.
    • Check door lock assembly for poor lubrication. If necessary,
    apply a suitable multi-purpose grease.

    JMKIA8087ZZ

    INSIDE HANDLE
    INSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567373

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove upper portion of vapor barrier. Refer to GW-25, «Exploded View».
    Release lock knob (2) and inside handle cable (3) from clip (1)
    using a suitable tool.

    JMKIA5704ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Remove inside handle bolt.
    Release inside handle (1) from door panel using a suitable tool
    and remove.
    : Pawl

    AWKIA2500ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-150

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Release inside handle cable (3) and lock cable (2) from inside
    handle (1) and remove.

    A

    B

    C
    JMKIA5885ZZ

    D

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that door lock cables are properly engaged to inside handle.
    • After installation, check door open/close, lock/unlock operation.

    E

    OUTSIDE HANDLE

    F

    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567374

    G

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove inside handle. Refer to DLK-150, «INSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation»
    Remove door grommet and bolt from grommet hole.

    H

    I

    J

    JMKIA1467ZZ

    3.

    While pulling outside handle, remove outside handle escutcheon.

    DLK

    L

    M

    N
    JMKIA5342ZZ

    4.

    O

    While pulling outside handle (1), slide towards rear of vehicle to
    remove.

    P

    JMKIA0524ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-151

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    5.
    6.

    Remove front gasket and rear gasket.
    Slide outside handle bracket toward rear of vehicle to remove.
    : Front

    JMKIA5890ZZ

    7.

    Disconnect outside handle cable (1) from outside handle bracket
    (2) as shown.

    JMKIA5891ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, check door open/close, lock/unlock operation.
    • Check door lock cable is properly engaged with outside handle bracket.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-152

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BACK DOOR LOCK

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009671215

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWKIA2578ZZ

    1.

    Outside handle

    2.

    Back door lock cable

    4.

    Back door lock

    5.

    Door striker

    3.

    Back door lock actuator

    H

    BACK DOOR LOCK
    BACK DOOR LOCK : Removal and Installation

    I
    INFOID:0000000009567376

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    J
    Remove back door inner finisher. Refer to INT-34, «BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-34, «Removal and Installation».
    DLK
    Disconnect lock rod from key cylinder (if equipped).
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the back door lock.
    L
    Disconnect door lock cable from handle.
    Remove back door lock bolts and back door lock.

    INSTALLATION

    M

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Tighten back door bolts to specification.
    • After installation, check back door open/close and lock/unlock operation.

    N

    OUTSIDE HANDLE

    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567377

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-34, «Removal and Installation».
    Release the back door lock cable from the outside handle.
    Remove outside handle bolts and outside handle.

    P

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Tighten outside handle bolts to specification. Refer to DLK-153, «Exploded View».
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-153

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR LOCK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • After installation, check back door open/close and lock/unlock operation.

    EMERGENCY LEVER

    EMERGENCY LEVER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567378

    UNLOCK PROCEDURE
    NOTE:
    If back door lock cannot be unlocked due to a malfunction or battery discharge, perform the following procedure to unlock back door assembly.
    From inside the vehicle, using a suitable tool, rotate the emergency
    lever (1) in a clockwise direction to unlock the back door assembly.

    AWKIA2577ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-154

    2014 Note

    FUEL FILLER LID OPENER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FUEL FILLER LID OPENER

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567379

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2582ZZ

    1.

    Fuel filler lid lock release cable

    2.

    Fuel filler lid lock

    3.

    Fuel filler lid bumper

    4.

    Fuel filler lid spring

    5.

    Fuel filler lid

    A.

    Clip

    B.

    Cable protector

    J

    Pawl

    DLK

    FUEL FILLER LID
    FUEL FILLER LID : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567380

    L

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove fuel cap pin (1).

    M

    N

    O

    ALKIA3198ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-155

    2014 Note

    P

    FUEL FILLER LID OPENER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Remove fuel filler lid screws (A) and fuel filler lid (1).

    ALKIA3199ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installation, check fuel filler lid assembly open/close and lock/unlock operation.

    FUEL FILLER OPENER CABLE

    FUEL FILLER OPENER CABLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567381

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove hood lock/fuel filler lid lock release handle. Refer to DLK-144, «HOOD LOCK RELEASE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect fuel filler lid opener cable (2) from hood lock/fuel
    filler lid lock release handle (1).

    JMKIA7999ZZ

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove dash side finisher (LH). Refer to INT-22, «DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove center pillar lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Remove luggage side lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-32, «LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect fuel filler lid opener cable (1) by pulling downward
    and then sliding cable end to the side to remove from fuel filler
    lid lock assembly (2).

    JMKIA8139ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installation, check fuel filler lid assembly open/close, lock/unlock operation.

    FUEL FILLER LID LOCK
    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-156

    2014 Note

    FUEL FILLER LID OPENER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FUEL FILLER LID LOCK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567382

    A

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Fully open fuel filler lid.
    Remove luggage side lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-32, «LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the fuel filler lid lock assemby.
    Release pawls (A) and remove fuel filler lid lock assembly (1).
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage gasket (2) when removing.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    JMKIA8138ZZ

    5.

    Disconnect fuel filler lid opener cable (1) by pulling downward
    and then sliding cable end to the side to remove from fuel filler
    lid lock assembly (2).

    G

    H

    I

    JMKIA8139ZZ

    J

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installation, check fuel filler lid assembly open/close, lock/unlock operation.

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-157

    2014 Note

    DOOR SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567383

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the door switch bolt (A).
    Disconnect the harness connector and remove door switch (1).

    JMKIA2173ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-158

    2014 Note

    INSIDE KEY ANTENNA
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    INSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    A

    INSTRUMENT CENTER
    INSTRUMENT CENTER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567384

    B

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove center console lower. Refer to IP-20, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the inside key antenna (instrument center).
    Remove screws (A) and the inside key antenna (instrument center) (1).

    C

    D

    E

    F
    JMKIA7948ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    G

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    CONSOLE

    H

    CONSOLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567385

    REMOVAL

    I

    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    Remove center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the inside key antenna (console).
    Release clips (A) and remove inside key antenna (console) (1).

    DLK

    L

    JMKIA7950ZZ

    M

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    N

    LUGGAGE ROOM

    LUGGAGE ROOM : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567386

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove rear seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the inside key antenna (luggage room).

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-159

    P

    2014 Note

    INSIDE KEY ANTENNA
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Release clips (A) and remove inside key antenna (luggage
    room) (1).

    ALKIA3208ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-160

    2014 Note

    OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    OUTSIDE KEY ANTENNA

    A

    OUTSIDE HANDLE
    OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567387

    B

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove outside handle. Refer to DLK-147, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove screw (1) and outside handle finisher (1) from outside
    handle (2).

    C

    D

    E

    F
    ALKIA3209ZZ

    3.

    Remove outside key antenna (outside handle) (1) from outside
    handle (2).

    G

    H

    I

    ALKIA3210ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    J

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    REAR BUMPER

    DLK

    REAR BUMPER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567388

    L

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove the rear bumper fascia. Refer to EXT-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the outside key antenna (rear bumper)
    Release clips (A) and remove outside key antenna (rear
    bumper) (1).

    M

    N

    O

    P
    JMKIA7952ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-161

    2014 Note

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR REQUEST SWITCH
    DRIVER SIDE
    DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009671358

    The door request switch (driver side) is serviced as an assembly with the outside handle. Refer to DLK-147,
    «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».

    PASSENGER SIDE

    PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009671359

    The door request switch (passenger side) is serviced as an assembly with the outside handle. Refer to DLK147, «OUTSIDE HANDLE : Removal and Installation».

    BACK DOOR

    BACK DOOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009671360

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-34, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove screws (A) and back door request switch (1) from back
    door outer finisher (2).

    AWKIA2584ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-162

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY WARNING BUZZER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    INTELLIGENT KEY WARNING BUZZER
    Removal and Installation

    A
    INFOID:0000000009567389

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    B

    Remove front combination lamp (LH). Refer to EXL-108, «Removal and Installation»
    Remove bolt (A) and Intelligent Key warning buzzer (1).

    C

    D

    E

    JMKIA7949ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    F

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    G

    H

    I

    J

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-163

    2014 Note

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567390

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove glove box assembly. Refer to IP-25, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove remote keyless entry receiver bolt (A).
    Disconnect the harness connector and remove remote keyless
    entry receiver (1)

    JMKIA7947ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-164

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY

    A

    Removal and Installation
    1.
    2.

    INFOID:0000000009567391

    Release the lock knob at the back of the Intelligent Key and remove the mechanical key.
    Insert a suitable tool (A) wrapped with a cloth into the slit of the
    corner and rotate it to separate the upper part from the lower
    part.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the circuit board or battery terminal.
    • The key fob is water-resistant. However, if it does get wet,
    immediately wipe it dry.

    B

    C

    D

    E
    PIIB6221E

    3.

    Replace the battery with new one.
    Battery replacement

    4.

    F

    :Coin-type lithium battery
    (CR2025)

    G

    Align the tips of the upper and lower parts, and then push them
    together until it is securely closed.
    CAUTION:
    • When replacing battery, keep dirt, grease, and other foreign materials off the electrode contact area.
    • After replacing the battery, check that all Intelligent Key
    functions work normally.

    H

    I

    J
    PIIB6222E

    DLK

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    DLK-165

    2014 Note

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    EC

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    HR16DE

    Fuel Pump ………………………………………………………19
    Heated Oxygen Sensor 2 ………………………………….20
    Heated Oxygen Sensor 2 Heater ……………………….20
    Ignition Coil With Power Transistor …………………….20
    Intake Air Temperature Sensor ………………………….21
    Intake Valve Timing Control Solenoid Valve ………..21
    Knock Sensor ………………………………………………….21
    Mass Air Flow Sensor ……………………………………….22
    Refrigerant Pressure Sensor ……………………………..22
    Stop Lamp Switch & Brake Pedal Position Switch….22
    Throttle Control Motor ……………………………………….22
    Throttle Control Motor Relay ……………………………..22
    Throttle Position Sensor ……………………………………23

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 6
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 6
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 6
    On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine
    and CVT ………………………………………………………….. 6
    General Precautions …………………………………………. 7

    PREPARATION ……………………………………. 10
    PREPARATION …………………………………………..10
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………. 10

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………….. 11
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………11
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM …………………………….. 11
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM :
    Component Parts Location ……………………………… 11
    ECM ……………………………………………………………… 15
    Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor …………………….. 15
    Air Fuel Ratio Sensor 1 ……………………………………. 15
    Air Fuel Ratio Sensor 1 Heater …………………………. 15
    ASCD Steering Switch …………………………………….. 16
    Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) ………………….. 16
    Clutch Pedal Position Switch ……………………………. 16
    Cooling Fan ……………………………………………………. 16
    Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) …………………….. 17
    Electric Throttle Control Actuator ………………………. 17
    Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor …………………. 17
    Engine Oil Pressure Sensor ……………………………… 18
    Engine Oil Temperature Sensor ………………………… 18
    EVAP Canister Purge Volume Control Solenoid
    Valve …………………………………………………………….. 18
    Exhaust Valve Timing Control Position Sensor ……. 19
    Exhaust Valve Timing Control Solenoid Valve …….. 19
    Fuel Injector …………………………………………………… 19

    Revision: April 2013

    WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS ………………23
    WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS : Engine
    Oil Pressure Warning Lamp ………………………………23
    WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) …………………………….24

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION ………………… 26
    Positive Crankcase Ventilation …………………………..26

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………… 27
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM ……………………………..27
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description …………………………………………………………………27
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail Safe …………..28

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM …………….29
    MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM : System Description ………………………………………………..30

    O

    ELECTRIC IGNITION SYSTEM ……………………………32
    ELECTRIC IGNITION SYSTEM : System Description ………………………………………………………….32

    P

    AIR CONDITIONING CUT CONTROL …………………..33
    AIR CONDITIONING CUT CONTROL : System
    Description ………………………………………………………33
    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)….33

    EC-1

    2014 Note

    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD) : System Description ………………………………… 34
    CAN COMMUNICATION ……………………………………. 34
    CAN COMMUNICATION : System Description …… 34
    COOLING FAN CONTROL ………………………………… 34
    COOLING FAN CONTROL : System Description… 35

    Test Value and Test Limit ………………………………… 78

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………… 86
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM ……………………… 86
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 86

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………… 107

    EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM ………………….. 35
    EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM : System
    Description …………………………………………………….. 36

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …….. 107

    INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL …………………… 36
    INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL : System Description ………………………………………………………… 37

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
    ECM ………………………………………………………… 111

    EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL ……………….. 37
    EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL : System
    Description …………………………………………………….. 38
    ENGINE PROTECTION CONTROL AT LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE ………………………………………. 38
    ENGINE PROTECTION CONTROL AT LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE : System Description ……… 38
    WARNING/INDICATOR/CHIME LIST ………………….. 39
    WARNING/INDICATOR/CHIME LIST : Warning
    lamps/Indicator lamps ……………………………………… 39

    OPERATION ……………………………………………… 40
    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)… 40
    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD) : Switch Name and Function ……………………… 40

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ….. 42
    Diagnosis Description ……………………………………… 42
    GST (Generic Scan Tool) ………………………………… 42

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM) ………………………. 43
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION ………………………………. 43
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : 1st Trip Detection
    Logic and Two Trip Detection Logic ………………….. 43
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : DTC and Freeze
    Frame Data ……………………………………………………. 43
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Counter System ….. 44
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Driving Pattern ……. 47
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : System Readiness
    Test (SRT) Code ……………………………………………. 48
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ……………………………………………….. 49
    On Board Diagnosis Function …………………………… 49
    CONSULT Function ………………………………………… 53

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 62
    ECM …………………………………………………………. 62
    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 62
    Fail Safe ……………………………………………………….. 73
    DTC Inspection Priority Chart ………………………… 74
    DTC Index …………………………………………………….. 76

    Revision: April 2013

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………. 107
    Diagnostic Work Sheet ………………………………….. 109

    Description …………………………………………………… 111
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 111

    ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING ………………………………………. 113
    Description …………………………………………………… 113
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 113

    THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION
    LEARNING ………………………………………………. 114
    Description …………………………………………………… 114
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 114

    IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING ………………….. 115
    Description …………………………………………………… 115
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 115

    MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE
    CLEAR …………………………………………………….. 117
    Description …………………………………………………… 117
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 117

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………………. 118
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 118

    FUEL PRESSURE CHECK ………………………… 122
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 122

    HOW TO SET SRT CODE ………………………….. 124
    Description …………………………………………………… 124
    SRT Set Driving Pattern …………………………………. 125
    Work Procedure ……………………………………………. 127

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ………………….. 129
    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION
    VALUE …………………………………………………….. 129
    Description …………………………………………………… 129
    Component Function Check …………………………… 129
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 130

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT …. 137
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 137

    U0101 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ……………………… 140
    DTC Description ……………………………………………. 140
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 140

    EC-2

    2014 Note

    U1001 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ……………………… 141

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 174

    Description …………………………………………………… 141
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 141
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 141

    P0132 A/F SENSOR 1 ……………………………… 176

    P0011 IVT CONTROL ……………………………….. 142
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 142
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 143
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 144

    P0014 EVT CONTROL ………………………………. 146

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 176
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 177

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 149
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 149
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 150

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 179
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 180
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 183
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 184
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 185
    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 186

    P0138 HO2S2 ………………………………………….. 188

    P0078 EVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE …. 155
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 155
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 155
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 156

    P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR …………………….. 158
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 158
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 158
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 160

    P0139 HO2S2 ………………………………………….. 196

    G

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 196
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 197
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 198
    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 199

    P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION ………………………………………………………. 201

    P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION ………………………………………………………. 205
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 205
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 206

    P0130 A/F SENSOR 1 ……………………………….. 170
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 170
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 171
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 171

    J

    K

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 209
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 210
    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 210

    L

    P0197, P0198 EOT SENSOR ……………………. 211

    M

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 211
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 211
    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 212

    N

    P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR ………………………. 213
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 213
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 213
    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 214

    O

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE ……………………………………………………….. 216

    P

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 216
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 217

    P0327, P0328 KS …………………………………….. 222

    P0131 A/F SENSOR 1 ……………………………….. 173
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 173

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    P0196 EOT SENSOR ……………………………….. 209

    P0122, P0123 TP SENSOR ……………………….. 167
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 167
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 167
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 168

    H

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 201
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 202

    P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR ……………………… 165
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 165
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 165
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 166

    E

    F

    P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR ………………………. 163
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 163
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 163
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 164

    D

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 188
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 190
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 191
    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 193

    P0075 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE ….. 153
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 153
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 153
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 154

    C

    P0137 HO2S2 ………………………………………….. 183

    P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER ………………….. 151
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 151
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 151
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 152

    EC

    P0133 A/F SENSOR 1 ……………………………… 179

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 146
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 147
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 148

    P0031, P0032 A/F SENSOR 1 HEATER ……… 149

    A

    EC-3

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 222
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 222

    2014 Note

    Component Inspection …………………………………….223

    P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) ……………………… 224
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..224
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………224
    Component Inspection …………………………………….226

    P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) …………………. 228
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..228
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………228
    Component Inspection …………………………………….230

    P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION . 232
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..232
    Component Function Check …………………………….233
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………234

    P0444 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME
    CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE ………………….. 237
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..237
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………237
    Component Inspection …………………………………….238

    P0500 VSS ………………………………………………. 240
    Description …………………………………………………….240
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..240
    Component Function Check …………………………….241
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………241

    P0520 EOP SENSOR ……………………………….. 242
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..242
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………242
    Component Inspection …………………………………….243

    P0524 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE ……………….. 244
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..244
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………245
    Component Inspection …………………………………….246

    P0603 ECM POWER SUPPLY …………………… 247
    Description …………………………………………………….247
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..247
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………247

    P0605 ECM ……………………………………………… 249
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..249
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………249

    P0607 ECM ……………………………………………… 251
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..251
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………251

    P0643 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY …………….. 252
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..252
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………252

    P0850 PNP SWITCH ………………………………… 254
    Description …………………………………………………….254
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..254
    Component Function Check …………………………….255
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………255

    Revision: April 2013

    P1078 EVT CONTROL POSITION SENSOR .. 257
    DTC Description ……………………………………………. 257
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 257
    Component Inspection (Exhaust Valve Timing
    Control Position Sensor) ………………………………… 259

    P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE ……… 260
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 260
    Component Function Check …………………………… 260
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 261

    P1225 TP SENSOR …………………………………… 263
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 263
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 263

    P1226 TP SENSOR …………………………………… 264
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 264
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 264

    P1564 ASCD STEERING SWITCH ……………… 265
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 265
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 265
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 267

    P1572 ASCD BRAKE SWITCH …………………… 268
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 268
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 269
    Component Inspection (Brake Pedal Position
    Switch) ………………………………………………………… 271
    Component Inspection (Stop Lamp Switch) ………. 272

    P1574 ASCD VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ……. 273
    Description …………………………………………………… 273
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 273
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 273

    P1715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR ………………….. 275
    Description …………………………………………………… 275
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 275
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 275

    P1720 VSS ……………………………………………….. 276
    Description …………………………………………………… 276
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 276
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 276

    P1805 BRAKE SWITCH …………………………….. 278
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 278
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 278
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 279

    P2100, P2103 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY …………………………………………….. 280
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 280
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 280

    P2101 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
    FUNCTION ……………………………………………….. 283
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 283
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 283
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 286

    EC-4

    2014 Note

    P2118 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR ………. 287

    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 315

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 287
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 287
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 288

    FUEL PUMP ……………………………………………. 316

    P2119 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
    ACTUATOR ……………………………………………… 289
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 289
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 289

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 316
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 316
    Component Inspection ……………………………………. 318
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 319
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 319
    Component Inspection (Ignition Coil with Power
    Transistor) ……………………………………………………. 322
    Component Inspection (Condenser) …………………. 323
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 324
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 324

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR ………. 325

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 327

    G

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS … 327
    Symptom Table …………………………………………….. 327

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 300
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 300
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 302

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION …………. 333

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 304
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 304
    Component Inspection (Brake Pedal Position
    Switch) ………………………………………………………… 305

    ASCD INDICATOR ……………………………………. 306

    E

    F

    P2138 APP SENSOR ………………………………… 300

    BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH …………… 304

    D

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 325
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 325

    P2135 TP SENSOR …………………………………… 297
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 297
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 297
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 298

    C

    MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP ………….. 324

    P2127, P2128 APP SENSOR ……………………… 294
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 294
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 294
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 296

    EC

    IGNITION SIGNAL …………………………………… 319

    P2122, P2123 APP SENSOR ……………………… 291
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 291
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 291
    Component Inspection …………………………………… 292

    A

    H

    Description ……………………………………………………. 333

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………. 334
    IDLE SPEED …………………………………………… 334
    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 334

    I

    J

    IGNITION TIMING ……………………………………. 335
    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 335

    K

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 306
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 306

    EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM …………. 336

    CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH …………. 307

    POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION ……. 337

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 307
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 307
    Component Inspection (Clutch Pedal Position
    Switch) ………………………………………………………… 308

    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 337

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………. 338

    COOLING FAN …………………………………………. 309

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 338
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 338

    N

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………. 339

    O

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………… 339

    P

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 309
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 309
    Component Inspection (Cooling Fan Motor) ……… 310
    Component Inspection (Cooling Fan Relay) ……… 311

    ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL ……………………. 312
    Description …………………………………………………… 312
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 312
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 312

    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 336

    M

    ECM ……………………………………………………….. 338

    FUEL INJECTOR ……………………………………… 314
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 314
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 314

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    EC-5

    Idle Speed ……………………………………………………. 339
    Ignition Timing ………………………………………………. 339
    Calculated Load Value …………………………………… 339
    Mass Air Flow Sensor …………………………………….. 339

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [HR16DE]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009582464

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine and CVT

    INFOID:0000000009022412

    The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) to warn the
    driver of a malfunction causing emission deterioration.
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the negative battery cable before any repair
    or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid valves, etc. will
    cause the MI to light up.
    • Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
    cause the MI to light up due to the open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease,
    dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
    • Certain systems and components, especially those related to OBD, may use a new style slide-locking type harness connector. For description and how to disconnect, refer to GI-3, «Contents».
    • Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. The interference of the harness with
    a bracket, etc. may cause the MI to light up due to the short circuit.
    • Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
    may cause the MI to light up due to the malfunction of the fuel injection system, etc.
    • Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the ECM and
    TCM (Transmission control module) before returning the vehicle to the customer.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-6

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [HR16DE]

    < PRECAUTION >

    General Precautions

    INFOID:0000000009022413

    A

    • Always use a 12 volt battery as power source.
    • Do not attempt to disconnect battery cables while engine is
    running.
    • Before connecting or disconnecting the ECM harness connector, turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect negative battery cable. Failure to do so may damage the ECM because
    battery voltage is applied to ECM even if ignition switch is
    turned OFF.
    • Before removing parts, turn ignition switch OFF and then disconnect battery ground cable.

    EC

    C

    D
    SEF289H

    • Do not disassemble ECM.
    • If a battery cable is disconnected, the memory will return to
    the ECM value.
    The ECM will now start to self-control at its initial value. So,
    engine operation can vary slightly in this case. However, this
    is not an indication of a malfunction. Do not replace parts
    because of a slight variation.
    • If the battery is disconnected, the following emission-related
    diagnostic information will be lost within 24 hours.
    — Diagnostic trouble codes
    — 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
    — Freeze frame data
    — 1st trip freeze frame data
    — System readiness test (SRT) codes
    — Test values
    • When connecting or disconnecting pin connectors into or
    from ECM, take care not to damage pin terminals (bend or
    break).
    Make sure that there are not any bends or breaks on ECM pin
    terminal, when connecting pin connectors.
    • Securely connect ECM harness connectors.
    A poor connection can cause an extremely high (surge) voltage to develop in coil and condenser, thus resulting in damage to ICs.
    • Keep engine control system harness at least 10 cm (4 in) away
    from adjacent harness, to prevent engine control system malfunctions due to receiving external noise, degraded operation
    of ICs, etc.
    • Keep engine control system parts and harness dry.
    • Before replacing ECM, perform ECM Terminals and Reference
    Value inspection and make sure ECM functions properly.
    Refer to EC-62, «Reference Value».
    • Handle mass air flow sensor carefully to avoid damage.
    • Do not clean mass air flow sensor with any type of detergent.
    • Do not disassemble electric throttle control actuator.
    • Even a slight leak in the air intake system can cause serious
    incidents.
    • Do not shock or jar the camshaft position sensor (PHASE),
    crankshaft position sensor (POS).

    E

    F

    G

    PBIA9222J

    I

    J

    K

    L
    PBIB0090E

    M

    N

    O

    P
    MEF040D

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-7

    H

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • After performing each TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS, perform DTC
    CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE or Component Function
    Check. The DTC should not be displayed in the DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE if the repair is completed. The Component
    Function Check should be a good result if the repair is completed.

    [HR16DE]

    JSBIA1315ZZ

    • When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, never allow
    the two tester probes to contact.
    Accidental contact of probes will cause a short circuit and
    damage the ECM power transistor.

    SEF348N

    • Do not operate fuel pump when there is no fuel in lines.
    • Tighten fuel hose clamps to the specified torque.
    • Do not depress accelerator pedal when starting.
    • Immediately after starting, do not rev up engine unnecessarily.
    • Do not rev up engine just prior to shutdown.

    SEF709Y

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-8

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • When installing C.B. ham radio or a mobile phone, be sure to
    observe the following as it may adversely affect electronic
    control systems depending on installation location.
    — Keep the antenna as far as possible from the electronic control units.
    — Keep the antenna feeder line more than 20 cm (8 in) away
    from the harness of electronic controls.
    Do not let them run parallel for a long distance.
    — Adjust the antenna and feeder line so that the standing-wave
    ratio can be kept smaller.
    — Be sure to ground the radio to vehicle body.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    C
    SEF708Y

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-9

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009022414

    Tool number
    Tool name

    Description

    KV10118400
    Fuel tube adapter

    Measuring fuel pressure

    PBIB3043E

    KV10120000
    Fuel tube adapter

    JSBIA0410ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-10

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM

    EC

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009022415

    ENGINE ROOM COMPARTMENT

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    ALBIA1138ZZ

    No.

    Component

    L

    Function

    ECM

    EC-15, «ECM»

    IPDM E/R

    IPDM E/R control the internal relays and the actuators.
    When CAN communication with ECM is impossible, IPDM E/R
    performs fail-safe control.
    PCS-4, «Component Parts Location».

    Mass air flow sensor
    (with intake air temperature sensor)

    EC-21, «Knock Sensor»

    Electric throttle control actuator
    EC-17, «Electric Throttle Control Actuator»
    (with built in throttle position sensor and throttle control motor)
    EC-18, «EVAP Canister Purge Volume Control Solenoid Valve»

    Cooling fan motor

    EC-16, «Cooling Fan»

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    HA-11, «Component Parts Location»

    P

    ENGINE COMPARTMENT

    EC-11

    N

    O

    EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    JSBIA0592ZZ

    Engine front right side

    No.

    Left view of the engine

    Engine rear right side

    Component

    Function

    Ignition coil No.4
    (with power transistor)

    EC-20, «Ignition Coil With Power Transistor»

    Ignition coil No.3
    (with power transistor)

    EC-20, «Ignition Coil With Power Transistor»

    Ignition coil No.2
    (with power transistor)

    EC-20, «Ignition Coil With Power Transistor»

    Ignition coil No.1
    (with power transistor)

    EC-20, «Ignition Coil With Power Transistor»

    PCV valve

    The positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve is provided to
    conduct crankcase blow-by gas to the intake manifold.

    Intake valve timing control solenoid valve

    EC-21, «Intake Valve Timing Control Solenoid Valve»

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    EC-18, «Engine Oil Pressure Sensor»

    Engine oil temperature sensor

    EC-18, «Engine Oil Temperature Sensor»

    Knock sensor

    EC-21, «Knock Sensor»

    Engine coolant temperature sensor

    EC-17, «Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor»

    Camshaft position sensor

    EC-16, «Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE)»

    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor

    EC-19, «Exhaust Valve Timing Control Position Sensor»

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve

    EC-19, «Exhaust Valve Timing Control Solenoid Valve»

    Fuel injector No.1 (Front)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-12

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component

    Function

    A

    Fuel injector No.1 (Rear)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Fuel injector No.2 (Front)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Fuel injector No.2 (Rear)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Fuel injector No.3 (Front)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Fuel injector No.3 (Rear)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Fuel injector No.4 (Front)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Fuel injector No.4 (Rear)

    EC-19, «Fuel Injector»

    Crankshaft position sensor

    EC-17, «Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS)»

    EC

    C

    D

    EXHAUST COMPARTMENT

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSBIA0593ZZ

    No.

    Component

    M

    Function

    A/F sensor 1

    EC-15, «Air Fuel Ratio Sensor 1»

    Heated oxygen sensor 2

    EC-20, «Heated Oxygen Sensor 2»

    N

    BODY COMPARTMENT
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-13

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    ALBIA1139ZZ

    Left center side of undercarriage (fuel tank)
    No.

    IPDM E/R area

    Component

    Brake pedal area

    Function

    ASCD steering switch

    EC-16, «ASCD Steering Switch»

    Fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump

    EC-19, «Fuel Pump»

    EVAP canister

    EC-36, «EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM : System Description»

    Brake pedal position switch

    EC-22, «Stop Lamp Switch & Brake Pedal Position Switch»

    Stop lamp switch

    EC-22, «Stop Lamp Switch & Brake Pedal Position Switch»

    Clutch pedal position switch (M/T models)

    EC-16, «Clutch Pedal Position Switch»

    Accelerator pedal position switch

    EC-15, «Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor»

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-14

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    ECM

    INFOID:0000000009022416

    A

    The ECM consists of a microcomputer and connectors for signal
    input and output and for power supply. The ECM controls the engine.
    EC

    C

    D
    PBIA9222J

    Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022417

    The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
    of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelerator position and sends a signal to the ECM.
    Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
    are a kind of potentiometer which transform the accelerator pedal
    position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signals to the ECM.
    The ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal
    from these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on
    these signals.
    Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
    receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The
    ECM uses this signal for the engine operation such as fuel cut.

    Air Fuel Ratio Sensor 1

    E

    F

    G

    H
    PBIB1741E

    INFOID:0000000009022418

    The air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1 is a planar one-cell limit current sensor. The sensor element of the A/F sensor 1 is composed an electrode layer, which transports ions. It has a heater in the element.
    The sensor is capable of precise measurement = 1, but also in the
    lean and rich range. Together with its control electronics, the sensor
    outputs a clear, continuous signal throughout a wide range.
    The exhaust gas components diffuse through the diffusion layer at
    the sensor cell. An electrode layer is applied voltage, and this current
    relative oxygen density in lean. Also this current relative hydrocarbon density in rich.

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JMBIA0112GB

    M

    Therefore, the A/F sensor 1 is able to indicate air fuel ratio by this
    electrode layer of current. In addition, a heater is integrated in the
    sensor to ensure the required operating temperature of about 800°C
    (1,472°F).

    N

    O

    P
    PBIB3354E

    Air Fuel Ratio Sensor 1 Heater

    INFOID:0000000009022419

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-15

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Sensor

    Input Signal to ECM

    Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    Engine speed

    Mass air flow sensor

    Amount of intake air

    ECM function

    Actuator

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    heater control

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    heater

    The ECM performs ON/OFF duty control of the A/F sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine operating
    condition to keep the temperature of A/F sensor 1 element within the specified range.

    ASCD Steering Switch

    INFOID:0000000009509471

    ASCD steering switch has variant values of electrical resistance for each button. ECM reads voltage variation
    of switch, and determines which button is operated.
    Refer to EC-34, «AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD) : System Description» for the ASCD function.

    Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE)

    INFOID:0000000009022421

    The camshaft position sensor (PHASE) senses the protrusion of
    intake camshaft to identify a particular cylinder. The camshaft position sensor (PHASE) senses the piston position.
    When the crankshaft position sensor (POS) system becomes inoperative, the camshaft position sensor (PHASE) provides various controls of engine parts instead, utilizing timing of cylinder identification
    signals.
    The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
    When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause
    the gap with the sensor to change.
    The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
    change.
    Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor changes.
    ECM receives the signals as shown in the figure.

    PBIA9209J

    JPBIA5503GB

    Clutch Pedal Position Switch

    INFOID:0000000009509475

    When the clutch pedal is depressed, the clutch pedal position switch turns OFF and the clutch pedal position
    switch signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM judges the clutch pedal conditions via the signal (ON or OFF).

    Cooling Fan

    INFOID:0000000009022422

    Cooling fan operates at low and high speed when the current flows in the cooling fan motor.
    Refer to EC-35, «COOLING FAN CONTROL : System Description» for cooling fan operation.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-16

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS)

    INFOID:0000000009022423

    A

    The crankshaft position sensor (POS) is located on the cylinder
    block rear housing facing the gear teeth (cogs) of the signal plate at
    end of the crankshaft. It detects the fluctuation of the engine revolution.
    The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
    When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth
    cause the gap with the sensor to change.
    The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
    change.
    Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor
    changes.
    The ECM receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation of
    the engine revolution.
    ECM receives the signals as shown in the figure.

    EC

    C

    D
    PBIA9209J

    E

    F

    G

    H

    JPBIA5503GB

    Electric Throttle Control Actuator

    INFOID:0000000009022424

    Electric throttle control actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
    The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
    The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feedback to the ECM to control the throttle valve in response to driving conditions via the throttle control motor.

    Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor

    I

    J

    INFOID:0000000009022425

    K

    The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
    coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
    ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant
    temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
    the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as temperature increases.

    L

    M

    SEF594K

    O

    Engine coolant temperature [°C (°F)]

    Voltage* (V)

    Resistance (kΩ)

    –10 (14)

    4.4

    7.0 — 11.4

    20 (68)

    3.5

    2.10 — 2.90

    50 (122)

    2.2

    0.68 — 1.00

    90 (194)

    0.9

    0.236 — 0.260

    P

    SEF012P

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    EC-17

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Engine Oil Pressure Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022426

    The engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor is detects engine oil pressure
    and transmits a voltage signal to the ECM.

    JSBIA0292ZZ

    Engine Oil Temperature Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022427

    The engine oil temperature sensor is used to detect the engine oil
    temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the ECM.
    The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine oil temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to the
    change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor
    decreases as temperature increases.

    SEF594K

    Engine oil temperature [°C (°F)]

    Voltage* (V)

    Resistance (kΩ)

    –10 (14)

    4.4

    7.0 — 11.4

    20 (68)

    3.5

    2.10 — 2.90

    50 (122)

    2.2

    0.68 — 1.00

    90 (194)

    0.9

    0.236 — 0.260

    110 (230)

    0.6

    0.143 — 0.153

    *: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminals.

    EVAP Canister Purge Volume Control Solenoid Valve

    SEF012P

    INFOID:0000000009022428

    The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
    OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
    moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
    the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.

    JSBIA0651ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-18

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Exhaust Valve Timing Control Position Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022429

    A

    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor detects the protrusion of
    the signal plate installed to the exhaust camshaft front end.
    This sensor signal is used for sensing a position of the exhaust camshaft.
    The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
    When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause
    the gap with the sensor to change.
    The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
    change.
    Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor
    changes.

    EC

    C

    D
    PBIA9209J

    Exhaust Valve Timing Control Solenoid Valve

    INFOID:0000000009022430

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve is activated by ON/OFF
    pulse duty (ratio) signals from the ECM.
    The exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve changes the oil
    amount and direction of flow through exhaust valve timing control
    unit or stops oil flow.
    The longer pulse width retards valve angle.
    The shorter pulse width advances valve angle.
    When ON and OFF pulse widths become equal, the solenoid valve
    stops oil pressure flow to fix the exhaust valve angle at the control
    position.

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JSBIA0652ZZ

    Fuel Injector

    INFOID:0000000009022431

    The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When the ECM
    supplies a ground to the fuel injector circuit, the coil in the fuel injector is energized. The energized coil pulls the ball valve back and
    allows fuel to flow through the fuel injector into the intake manifold.
    The amount of fuel injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse duration is the length of time the fuel injector remains
    open. The ECM controls the injection pulse duration based on
    engine fuel needs.

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSBIA0742ZZ

    Fuel Pump

    INFOID:0000000009022432

    Sensor

    Input signal to ECM

    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
    Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)

    Engine speed*

    Battery

    Battery voltage*

    ECM function
    Fuel pump control

    Actuator
    Fuel pump relay

    Fuel pump

    M

    N

    O

    *: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.

    The ECM activates the fuel pump for a few seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON to improve engine
    start ability. If the ECM receives a engine speed signal from the crankshaft position sensor (POS) and camshaft position sensor (PHASE), it knows that the engine is rotating, and causes the pump to operate. If the
    engine speed signal is not received when the ignition switch is ON, the engine stalls. The ECM stops pump
    operation and prevents battery discharging, thereby improving safety. The ECM does not directly drive the fuel
    pump. It controls the ON/OFF fuel pump relay, which in turn controls the fuel pump.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-19

    2014 Note

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Condition

    Fuel pump operation

    Ignition switch is turned to ON.

    Operates for 1 second.

    Engine running and cranking

    Operates.

    When engine is stopped

    Stops in 1.5 seconds.

    Except as shown above

    Stops.

    Heated Oxygen Sensor 2

    INFOID:0000000009022433

    The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst (manifold),
    monitors the oxygen level in the exhaust gas.
    Even if switching characteristics of the air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    are shifted, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
    This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from approximately 1 V in richer conditions to 0 V in leaner conditions.
    Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
    engine control operation.
    SEF327R

    Heated Oxygen Sensor 2 Heater

    INFOID:0000000009022434

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    Sensor

    Input signal to ECM

    Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    Engine speed

    Engine coolant temperature sensor

    Engine coolant temperature

    Mass air flow sensor

    Amount of intake air

    ECM function

    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    heater control

    Actuator

    Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater

    The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed,
    amount of intake air and engine coolant temperature.

    OPERATION
    Engine speed

    Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater

    Above 3,600 rpm

    OFF

    Below 3,600 rpm after the following conditions are met.
    • Engine: After warming up
    • Keeping the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle for 1 minute
    under no load

    ON

    Ignition Coil With Power Transistor

    INFOID:0000000009022435

    The ignition signal from the ECM is sent to and amplified by the power transistor. The power transistor turns
    ON and OFF the ignition coil primary circuit. This ON/OFF operation induces the proper high voltage in the coil
    secondary circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-20

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Intake Air Temperature Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022436

    A

    The intake air temperature sensor is built-into mass air flow sensor
    . The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal
    to the ECM.
    The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
    the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
    decreases in response to the temperature rise.

    EC

    C

    D
    PBIA9559J

    E

    Intake air temperature [°C (°F)]

    Voltage* (V)

    Resistance (kΩ)

    25 (77)

    3.3

    1.800 — 2.200

    80 (176)

    1.2

    0.283 — 0.359

    F

    G

    SEF012P

    Intake Valve Timing Control Solenoid Valve

    H

    INFOID:0000000009022437

    I

    Intake valve timing control solenoid valve is activated by ON/OFF
    pulse duty (ratio) signals from the ECM.
    The intake valve timing control solenoid valve changes the oil
    amount and direction of flow through intake valve timing control unit
    or stops oil flow.
    The longer pulse width advances valve angle.
    The shorter pulse width retards valve angle.
    When ON and OFF pulse widths become equal, the solenoid valve
    stops oil pressure flow to fix the intake valve angle at the control
    position.

    J

    K

    L
    PBIB1842E

    Knock Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022438

    M

    The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. It senses engine
    knocking using a piezoelectric element. A knocking vibration from
    the cylinder block is sensed as vibrational pressure. This pressure is
    converted into a voltage signal and sent to the ECM.

    N

    O

    P
    JSBIA0284ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-21

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Mass Air Flow Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022440

    The mass air flow sensor
    is placed in the stream of intake air. It
    measures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire
    intake flow. The mass air flow sensor controls the temperature of the
    hot wire to a certain amount. The heat generated by the hot wire is
    reduced as the intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater
    the heat loss.
    Therefore, the electric current supplied to hot wire is changed to
    maintain the temperature of the hot wire as air flow increases. The
    ECM detects the air flow by means of this current change.
    PBIA9559J

    Refrigerant Pressure Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022442

    The refrigerant pressure sensor is installed at the condenser of the air conditioner system. The sensor uses an
    electrostatic volume pressure transducer to convert refrigerant pressure to voltage. The voltage signal is sent
    to ECM, and ECM controls cooling fan system.

    PBIB2657E

    Stop Lamp Switch & Brake Pedal Position Switch

    INFOID:0000000009022443

    Stop lamp switch and brake pedal position switch are installed to brake pedal bracket.
    ECM detects the state of the brake pedal by those two types of input (ON/OFF signal).
    Brake pedal

    Brake pedal position switch

    Stop lamp switch

    Released

    ON

    OFF

    Depressed

    OFF

    ON

    Throttle Control Motor

    INFOID:0000000009022444

    The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
    The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feedback to the ECM to control the throttle valve in response to driving conditions via the throttle control motor.

    Throttle Control Motor Relay

    INFOID:0000000009022445

    Power supply for the throttle control motor is provided to the ECM via throttle control motor relay. The throttle
    control motor relay is ON/OFF controlled by the ECM. When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM sends
    an ON signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is provided to the ECM. When the ignition
    switch is turned OFF, the ECM sends an OFF signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is not
    provided to the ECM.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-22

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Throttle Position Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022446

    A

    Electric throttle control actuator consists of throttle control motor,
    throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
    the throttle valve movement.
    The throttle position sensor has two sensors. These sensors are a
    kind of potentiometer which transform the throttle valve position into
    output voltage, and emit the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
    judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these signals and controls the throttle valve in response to driving conditions
    via the throttle control motor.

    EC

    C

    D
    PBIB0145E

    WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS

    E

    WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS : Engine Oil Pressure Warning Lamp
    INFOID:0000000009022441

    F

    DESIGN/PURPOSE
    When engine oil pressure is low, the engine oil pressure warning
    lamp informs the driver of low oil pressure to prevent damage to the
    engine.

    G

    H

    I
    JPNIA1881ZZ

    BULB CHECK

    J

    Not applicable

    OPERATION AT COMBINATION METER CAN COMMUNICATION CUT-OFF OR UNUSUAL SIGNAL

    K

    For the operation for CAN communications blackout or abnormal signal reception, refer to MWI-19, «Fail-safe».

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    L

    M

    N

    JSBIA2846GB

    SIGNAL PATH
    ECM calculates an engine oil pressure according to a signal transmitted from the engine oil pressure sensor.
    When the engine oil pressure is low, ECM transmits the engine oil pressure warning lamp signal to combination meter via CAN communication. Then the engine oil pressure warning lamp illuminates.

    SHUTOFF CONDITION
    When any of the following conditions is satisfied:
    • Ignition switch: OFF
    • Engine oil pressure is the specified value or more.

    LIGHTING CONDITION
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-23

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    When any of the following conditions is satisfied:
    • Ignition switch: ON
    • Engine oil pressure is less than specified value.

    TIMING CHART

    JPBIA6026GB

    WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
    INFOID:0000000009022439

    DESIGN/PURPOSE
    When a malfunction which increases exhaust gases is detected, ECM turns ON MIL and informs the driver of
    the necessity of inspection and repair.
    When a malfunction which causes damage to the catalyst is
    detected, ECM immediately blinks MIL to alert the driver.

    JSBIA1315ZZ

    BULB CHECK
    The bulb turns ON after turning ON the ignition switch (engine stop) and turns OFF after restarting the engine.

    OPERATION AT COMBINATION METER CAN COMMUNICATION CUT-OFF OR UNUSUAL SIGNAL
    For the operation for CAN communication blackout in the combination meter, refer to MWI-19, «Fail-safe».

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JPBIA6021GB

    SIGNAL PATH
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-24

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • When the lighting conditions of the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) are satisfied, ECM transmits a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) signal to the combination meter via CAN communication.
    • The combination meter turns ON or blinks the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL), according to a signal
    received from ECM.

    LIGHTING CONDITION

    A

    EC

    When all of the following conditions are satisfied:
    • Ignition switch: ON
    • DTC which influences on exhaust gasses is judged.
    For DTCs that the malfunction indicator lamp turns ON and the number of DTC diagnosis trips, refer to EC-76,
    «DTC Index».

    C

    SHUTOFF CONDITION

    D

    When any of the following conditions is satisfied:
    • Ignition switch: OFF
    • Erase DTC
    NOTE:
    For the conditions of erasing DTC, refer to EC-43, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : DTC and Freeze Frame
    Data».

    E

    F

    TIMING CHART

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JPBIA6022GB

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-25

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    Positive Crankcase Ventilation

    INFOID:0000000009022447

    PBIB2962E

    This system returns blow-by gas to the intake manifold.
    The positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve is provided to conduct crankcase blow-by gas to the intake
    manifold.
    During partial throttle operation of the engine, the intake manifold sucks the blow-by gas through the PCV
    valve.
    Normally, the capacity of the valve is sufficient to handle any blow-by and a small amount of ventilating air.
    The ventilating air is then drawn from the air inlet tubes into the crankcase. In this process the air passes
    through the hose connecting air inlet tubes to rocker cover.
    Under full-throttle condition, the manifold vacuum is insufficient to draw the blow-by flow through the valve.
    The flow goes through the hose connection in the reverse direction.
    On vehicles with an excessively high blow-by, the valve does not
    meet the requirement. This is because some of the flow will go
    through the hose connection to the air inlet tubes under all conditions.

    PBIB1588E

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-26

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022448

    EC

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JPBIA5483GB

    NOTE:
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-27

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Buttery current sensor is not apply.

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    ECM controls the engine by various functions.
    Function

    Reference

    Fuel injection control

    EC-30, «MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM : System Description»

    Electric ignition control

    EC-32, «ELECTRIC IGNITION SYSTEM : System Description»

    Intake valve timing control

    EC-37, «INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL : System Description»

    Exhaust valve timing control

    EC-38, «EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL : System Description»

    Engine protection control (Low engine oil pressure)

    EC-38, «ENGINE PROTECTION CONTROL AT LOW ENGINE
    OIL PRESSURE : System Description»

    Air conditioning cut control

    EC-33, «AIR CONDITIONING CUT CONTROL : System Description»

    Cooling fan control

    EC-35, «COOLING FAN CONTROL : System Description»

    Evaporative emission

    EC-36, «EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM : System Description»

    Warning/Indicator/Chime control

    EC-39, «WARNING/INDICATOR/CHIME LIST : Warning lamps/Indicator lamps»

    CAN communication

    EC-34, «CAN COMMUNICATION : System Description»

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail Safe

    INFOID:0000000009582428

    NON DTC RELATED ITEM
    Detected
    items

    Engine operating condition
    in fail-safe mode

    Malfunction
    indicator
    lamp circuit

    Engine speed will not rise
    more than 2,500 rpm due
    to the fuel cut

    Remarks

    Reference page

    When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the
    driver by lighting up MIL when there is malfunction on engine control
    system.
    Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related
    diagnoses are continuously detected as NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the
    driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open
    by means of operating fail safe function.
    The fail safe function also operates when above diagnoses except MIL
    circuit are detected and demands the driver to repair the malfunction.

    EC-324, «Component Function
    Check»

    DTC RELATED ITEM
    DTC No.

    Detected items

    Engine operating condition in fail safe mode

    P0011

    Intake valve timing control

    The signal is not energized to the intake valve timing control solenoid valve and the valve
    control does not function.

    P0014

    Exhaust valve timing control

    The signal is not energized to the exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve and the valve
    control does not function.

    P0102
    P0103

    Mass air flow sensor circuit

    Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-28

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    DTC No.
    P0117
    P0118

    Detected items
    Engine coolant temperature
    sensor circuit

    Engine operating condition in fail safe mode
    Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the following conditions.
    CONSULT displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
    Condition

    Engine coolant temperature decided
    (CONSULT display)

    Just as ignition switch is turned ON or START

    40°C (104°F)

    Approx. 4 minutes or more after engine starting

    80°C (176°F)
    40 — 80°C (104 — 176°F)
    (Depends on the time)

    Except as shown above

    A

    EC

    C

    When the fail safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling
    fan operates while engine is running.

    D

    The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in
    order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
    The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal
    condition.
    So, the acceleration will be poor.

    E

    Exhaust valve timing control does not function.

    F

    P0122
    P0123
    P0222
    P0223
    P2135

    Throttle position sensor

    P0197
    P0198

    Engine oil temperature sensor

    P0500

    Vehicle speed sensor

    The cooling fan operates (Highest) while engine is running.

    P0605

    ECM

    (When ECM calculation function is malfunctioning:)
    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    G

    P0643

    Sensor power supply

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    H

    P1805

    Brake switch

    ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to a
    small range.
    Therefore, acceleration will be poor.
    Vehicle condition

    I

    Driving condition

    When engine is idling

    Normal

    When accelerating

    Poor acceleration

    J

    P2100
    P2103

    Throttle control motor relay

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P2101

    Electric throttle control function

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P2118

    Throttle control motor

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P2119

    Electric throttle control actuator

    (When electric throttle control actuator does not function properly due to the return spring
    malfunction:)
    ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the
    idle position. The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.

    M

    (When throttle valve opening angle in fail safe mode is not in specified range:)
    ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20
    degrees or less.

    N

    (When ECM detects the throttle valve is stuck open:)
    While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the
    engine stalls.
    The engine can restart in the Neutral position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm
    or more.
    P2122
    P2123
    P2127
    P2128
    P2138

    Accelerator pedal position sensor

    The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in
    order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
    The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal
    condition.
    So, the acceleration will be poor.

    MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-29

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022451

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSBIA3075GB

    *1: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
    *2: This sensor is not used to control the engine system under normal conditions.

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    The amount of fuel injected from the fuel injector is determined by the ECM. The ECM controls the length of
    time the valve remains open (injection pulse duration). The amount of fuel injected is a program value in the
    ECM memory. The program value is preset by engine operating conditions. These conditions are determined
    by input signals (for engine speed and intake air) from the crankshaft position sensor, camshaft position sensor and the mass air flow sensor.

    VARIOUS FUEL INJECTION INCREASE/DECREASE COMPENSATION
    In addition, the amount of fuel injected is compensated to improve engine performance under various operating conditions as listed below.






    During warm-up
    When starting the engine
    During acceleration
    Hot-engine operation
    When selector lever position is changed from N to D (CVT models)
    High-load, high-speed operation

    • During deceleration
    • During high engine speed operation

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-30

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    MIXTURE RATIO FEEDBACK CONTROL (CLOSED LOOP CONTROL)

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    C
    PBIB2793E

    The mixture ratio feedback system provides the best air-fuel mixture ratio for drive ability and emission control.
    The three way catalyst (manifold) can better reduce CO, HC and NOx emissions. This system uses A/F sensor 1 in the exhaust manifold to monitor whether the engine operation is rich or lean. The ECM adjusts the
    injection pulse width according to the sensor voltage signal. For more information about A/F sensor 1, refer to
    EC-15, «Air Fuel Ratio Sensor 1». This maintains the mixture ratio within the range of stoichiometric (ideal airfuel mixture).
    This stage is referred to as the closed loop control condition.
    Heated oxygen sensor 2 is located downstream of the three way catalyst (manifold). Even if the switching
    characteristics of A/F sensor 1 shift, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric by the signal from heated
    oxygen sensor 2.
    • Open Loop Control
    The open loop system condition refers to when the ECM detects any of the following conditions. Feedback
    control stops in order to maintain stabilized fuel combustion.
    — Deceleration and acceleration
    — High-load, high-speed operation
    — Malfunction of A/F sensor 1 or its circuit
    — Insufficient activation of heated sensor 1 at low engine coolant temperature
    — High engine coolant temperature
    — During warm-up
    — After shifting from N to D (CVT models)
    — When starting the engine

    MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
    The mixture ratio feedback control system monitors the mixture ratio signal transmitted from A/F sensor 1.
    This feedback signal is then sent to the ECM. The ECM controls the basic mixture ratio as close to the theoretical mixture ratio as possible. However, the basic mixture ratio is not necessarily controlled as originally
    designed. Both manufacturing differences (i.e., mass air flow sensor hot wire) and characteristic changes during operation (i.e., fuel injector clogging) directly affect mixture ratio.
    Accordingly, the difference between the basic and theoretical mixture ratios is monitored in this system. This is
    then computed in terms of “injection pulse duration” to automatically compensate for the difference between
    the two ratios.
    “Fuel trim” refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection duration. Fuel trim
    includes “short-term fuel trim” and “long-term fuel trim”.
    “Short-term fuel trim” is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the mixture ratio at its theoretical
    value. The signal from A/F sensor 1 indicates whether the mixture ratio is RICH or LEAN compared to the theoretical value. The signal then triggers a reduction in fuel volume if the mixture ratio is rich, and an increase in
    fuel volume if it is lean.
    “Long-term fuel trim” is overall fuel compensation carried out long-term to compensate for continual deviation
    of the “short-term fuel trim” from the central value. Such deviation will occur due to individual engine differences, wear over time and changes in the usage environment.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-31

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    FUEL INJECTION TIMING

    SEF337W

    Two types of systems are used.
    • Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection System
    Fuel is injected into each cylinder during each engine cycle according to the firing order. This system is used
    when the engine is running.
    • Simultaneous Multiport Fuel Injection System
    Fuel is injected simultaneously into all four cylinders twice each engine cycle. In other words, pulse signals
    of the same width are simultaneously transmitted from the ECM.
    The four injectors will then receive the signals two times for each engine cycle.
    This system is used when the engine is being started and/or if the fail safe system (CPU) is operating.

    FUEL SHUT-OFF
    Fuel to each cylinder is cut off during deceleration, operation of the engine at excessively high speeds or operation of the vehicle at excessively high speeds.

    ELECTRIC IGNITION SYSTEM

    ELECTRIC IGNITION SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022452

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSBIA3076GB

    *: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    Firing order: 1 — 3 — 4 — 2
    The ignition timing is controlled by the ECM to maintain the best air-fuel ratio for every running condition of the
    engine. The ignition timing data is stored in the ECM.
    The ECM receives information such as the injection pulse width and camshaft position sensor signal. Computing this information, ignition signals are transmitted to the power transistor.
    During the following conditions, the ignition timing is revised by the ECM according to the other data stored in
    the ECM.
    • At starting
    • During warm-up
    • At idle
    • At low battery voltage
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-32

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • During acceleration
    The knock sensor retard system is designed only for emergencies. The basic ignition timing is programmed
    within the anti-knocking zone, if recommended fuel is used under dry conditions. The retard system does not
    operate under normal driving conditions. If engine knocking occurs, the knock sensor monitors the condition.
    The signal is transmitted to the ECM. The ECM retards the ignition timing to eliminate the knocking condition.

    AIR CONDITIONING CUT CONTROL

    AIR CONDITIONING CUT CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022453

    A

    EC

    C

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JSBIA3077GB

    *: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.

    K

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    This system improves engine operation when the air conditioner is used.
    Under the following conditions, the air conditioner is turned off.
    • When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed.
    • When cranking the engine.
    • At high engine speeds.
    • When the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high.
    • When operating power steering during low engine speed or low vehicle speed.
    • When engine speed is excessively low.
    • When refrigerant pressure is excessively low or high.

    L

    M

    N

    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-33

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD) : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009509477

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSBIA3607GB

    *1: M/T models
    *2: CVT models

    BASIC ASCD SYSTEM
    • Automatic Speed Control Device (ASCD) allows a driver to keep vehicle at predetermined constant speed
    without depressing accelerator pedal. Driver can be set the vehicle speed in the set speed range.
    • ECM controls throttle angle of electric throttle control actuator to regulate engine speed.
    • Operation status of ASCD is indicated in combination meter.
    • If any malfunction occurs in the ASCD system, it automatically deactivates the ASCD control.
    Refer to EC-40, «AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD) : Switch Name and Function» for ASCD
    operating instructions.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle in a safe manner according to traffic conditions and obey all traffic laws.

    CAN COMMUNICATION

    CAN COMMUNICATION : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022454

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
    control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
    communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
    Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
    Refer to LAN-29, «CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN Communication Signal Chart», about CAN communication for detail.

    COOLING FAN CONTROL

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-34

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    COOLING FAN CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022455

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F
    JSBIA3078GB

    *: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.

    G

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    ECM controls cooling fan speed corresponding to vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, refrigerant pressure, air conditioner ON signal. Then control system has 3-step control [HIGH/LOW/OFF].

    H

    Cooling Fan Operation
    I

    J

    K

    L

    M
    PBIB2483E

    N

    Cooling Fan Relay Operation
    The ECM controls cooling fan relays through CAN communication line.
    Cooling fan speed

    O

    Cooling fan relay
    1

    2

    3

    Stop (OFF)

    OFF

    OFF

    OFF

    Low (LOW)

    ON

    OFF

    OFF

    High (HI)

    ON

    ON

    ON

    P

    EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-35

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022456

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSBIA0114GB

    *: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    PBIB3039E

    The evaporative emission system is used to reduce hydrocarbons emitted into the atmosphere from the fuel
    system. This reduction of hydrocarbons is accomplished by activated charcoals in the EVAP canister.
    The fuel vapor in the sealed fuel tank is led into the EVAP canister which contains activated carbon and the
    vapor is stored there when the engine is not operating or when refueling to the fuel tank.
    The vapor in the EVAP canister is purged by the air through the purge line to the intake manifold when the
    engine is operating. EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is controlled by ECM. When the
    engine operates, the flow rate of vapor controlled by EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
    proportionally regulated as the air flow increases.
    EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve also shuts off the vapor purge line during decelerating and
    idling.

    INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-36

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022457

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    EC

    C

    D

    E

    JSBIA3079GB

    F

    *: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    JPBIA4884GB

    This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
    valve.
    The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, engine oil temperature and engine coolant temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve
    timing (IVT) control solenoid valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open
    timing of the intake valve to increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range.

    EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-37

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009022458

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSBIA3080GB

    *: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    JPBIA4886GB

    This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the exhaust
    valve.
    The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed and engine oil temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the exhaust valve timing (EVT) control solenoid
    valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the exhaust valve
    to increase engine torque and output in a range of high engine speed.

    ENGINE PROTECTION CONTROL AT LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE

    ENGINE PROTECTION CONTROL AT LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE : System De-

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-38

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    scription

    INFOID:0000000009022460

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    EC

    C

    D
    JSBIA0704GB

    INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
    Sensor

    E

    Input signal to ECM

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    Engine pressure

    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    Engine speed

    ECM function
    Engine protection control
    • Oil pressure warning lamp signal

    Actuator
    Combination meter
    • Oil pressure warning lamp

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    • The engine protection control at low engine oil pressure warns the driver of a decrease in engine oil pressure by the oil pressure warning lamp a before the engine becomes damaged.
    • When detecting a decrease in engine oil pressure at an engine speed less than 1,000 rpm, ECM transmits
    an oil pressure warning lamp signal to the combination meter. The combination meter turns ON the oil pressure warning lamp, according to the signal.
    Decrease in engine
    oil pressure
    Detection

    Combination meter

    Engine speed

    F

    G

    H

    I

    Oil pressure warning lamp

    Less than 1,000 rpm

    ON*

    1,000 rpm or more

    ON

    J

    *: When detecting a normal engine oil pressure, ECM turns OFF the oil pressure warning lamp.

    WARNING/INDICATOR/CHIME LIST

    K

    WARNING/INDICATOR/CHIME LIST : Warning lamps/Indicator lamps

    INFOID:0000000009022461

    L

    Regarding the arrangement. Refer to MWI-6, «METER SYSTEM : Combination Meter».

    Name

    Design

    Arrangement/Function

    Engine oil pressure warning
    lamp

    Regarding the function. Refer to EC-23, «WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR
    LAMPS : Engine Oil Pressure Warning Lamp».

    M

    Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL)

    Regarding the function. Refer to EC-24, «WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR
    LAMPS : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-39

    2014 Note

    OPERATION
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    OPERATION
    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)
    AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD) : Switch Name and Function
    INFOID:0000000009582728

    SWITCHES AND INDICATORS

    JPBIA5485ZZ

    CRUISE indicator

    SET indicator

    CANCEL switch

    ACCEL/RES switch

    COAST/SET switch

    ASCD MAIN switch

    On the combination meter
    (Information display)

    On the steering wheel

    SET SPEED RANGE
    ASCD system can be set the following vehicle speed.
    Minimum speed (Approx.)
    30 km/h (19 MPH)

    Maximum speed (Approx.)
    170 km/h (105 MPH)

    SWITCH OPERATION
    Item

    Function

    CANCEL switch

    Cancels the cruise control driving.

    ACCEL/RES switch
    (ACCELERATE/RESUME)

    • Resumes the set speed.
    • Increases speed incrementally during cruise control driving.

    COAST/SET switch

    • Sets desired cruise speed.
    • Decreases speed incrementally during cruise control driving.

    ASCD MAIN switch

    Master switch to activate the ASCD system.

    SET OPERATION
    Press ASCD MAIN switch. (The CRUISE indicator in combination meter illuminates.)
    When vehicle speed reaches a desired speed between approximately 30 km/h (19 MPH) and 170 km/h (105
    MPH), press COAST/SET switch. (Then SET indicator in combination meter illuminates.)

    ACCELERATE OPERATION
    If the ACCEL/RES switch is pressed during cruise control driving, increase the vehicle speed until the switch is
    released or vehicle speed reaches maximum speed controlled by the system.
    And then ASCD will keep the new set speed.

    CANCEL OPERATION
    When any of following conditions exist, cruise operation will be canceled.
    • CANCEL switch is pressed
    • More than 2 switches at ASCD steering switch are pressed at the same time (Set speed will be cleared)
    • Brake pedal is depressed
    • Clutch pedal is depressed or gear position is changed to neutral position. (M/T models)
    • Selector lever is changed to N, P or R position (CVT models)
    • Vehicle speed decreased to 13 km/h (8 MPH) lower than the set speed
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-40

    2014 Note

    OPERATION
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • TCS system is operated
    When the ECM detects any of the following conditions, the ECM will cancel the cruise operation and inform A
    the driver by blinking indicator lamp.
    • Engine coolant temperature is slightly higher than the normal operating temperature, CRUISE indicator may
    blink slowly.
    EC
    When the engine coolant temperature decreases to the normal operating temperature, CRUISE indicator will
    stop blinking and the cruise operation will be able to work by pressing SET/− switch or RES/+ switch.
    • Malfunction for some self-diagnoses regarding ASCD control: SET indicator will blink quickly.
    • Speed limiter MAIN switch is pressed.(Set speed is cleared.)
    C
    • ASCD MAIN switch is pressed.(Set speed is cleared.)

    COAST OPERATION
    When the COAST/SET switch is pressed during cruise control driving, decrease vehicle set speed until the
    switch is released. And then ASCD will keep the new set speed.

    RESUME OPERATION
    When the ACCEL/RES switch is pressed after cancel operation other than pressing MAIN switch is performed,
    vehicle speed will return to last set speed. To resume vehicle set speed, vehicle condition must meet following
    conditions.
    • Brake pedal is released
    • Clutch pedal is released (M/T models)
    • Selector lever is in other than P and N positions (CVT models)
    • Vehicle speed is greater than 30 km/h (19 MPH) and less than 170 km/h (105 MPH)

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-41

    2014 Note

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
    Diagnosis Description

    INFOID:0000000009022462

    This system is an on board diagnostic system that records exhaust emission-related diagnostic information
    and detects a sensors/actuator-related malfunction. A malfunction is indicated by the malfunction indicator
    lamp (MIL) and stored in ECU memory as a DTC. The diagnostic information can be obtained with the diagnostic tool (GST: Generic Scan Tool).

    GST (Generic Scan Tool)

    INFOID:0000000009022463

    When GST is connected with a data link connector equipped on the vehicle side, it will communicate with the
    control unit equipped in the vehicle and then enable various kinds of diagnostic tests. Refer to EC-42, «Diagnosis Description».
    NOTE:
    Service $0A is not applied for regions where it is not mandated.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-42

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)

    A

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : 1st Trip Detection Logic and Two Trip Detection Logic
    INFOID:0000000009022464

    When a malfunction is detected for the first time, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip Freeze Frame data are stored in the
    ECM memory. The MIL will not illuminate at this stage. <1st trip>
    If the same malfunction is detected again during the next drive, the DTC and Freeze Frame data are stored in
    the ECM memory, and the MIL illuminates. The MIL illuminates at the same time when the DTC is stored.
    <2nd trip> The “trip” in the “Two Trip Detection Logic” means a driving mode in which self-diagnosis is performed during vehicle operation. Specific on board diagnostic items will cause the ECM to illuminate or blink
    the MIL, and store DTC and Freeze Frame data, even in the 1st trip, as shown below.

    EC

    C

    D

    ×: Applicable —: Not applicable

    MIL
    Items

    DTC

    1st trip

    2nd trip

    1st trip DTC

    Blinking

    Illuminated

    Blinking

    Illuminated

    1st trip
    displaying

    2nd trip
    displaying

    1st trip
    displaying

    Misfire (Possible three way catalyst
    damage) — DTC: P0300 – P0308 is
    being detected

    ×

    ×

    Misfire (Possible three way catalyst
    damage) — DTC: P0300 – P0308 is
    being detected

    ×

    ×

    One trip detection diagnoses (Refer
    to EC-76, «DTC Index».)

    ×

    ×

    Except above

    ×

    ×

    ×

    E

    2nd trip
    displaying

    F

    G

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : DTC and Freeze Frame Data

    INFOID:0000000009022465

    DTC AND 1ST TRIP DTC

    H

    I

    J

    The 1st trip DTC (whose number is the same as the DTC number) is displayed for the latest self-diagnostic
    result obtained. If the ECM memory was cleared previously, and the 1st trip DTC did not recur, the 1st trip DTC
    will not be displayed.
    If a malfunction is detected during the 1st trip, the 1st trip DTC is saved in the ECM memory. The MIL will not
    light up (two trip detection logic). If the same malfunction is not detected in the 2nd trip (meeting the required
    driving pattern), the 1st trip DTC is cleared from the ECM memory. If the same malfunction is detected in the
    2nd trip, both the 1st trip DTC and DTC are saved in the ECM memory and the MIL lights up. In other words,
    the DTC is stored in the ECM memory and the MIL lights up when the same malfunction occurs in two consecutive trips. If a 1st trip DTC is stored and a non-diagnostic operation is performed between the 1st and 2nd
    trips, only the 1st trip DTC will continue to be stored. For malfunctions that blink or light up the MIL during the
    1st trip, the DTC and 1st trip DTC are stored in the ECM memory.
    For malfunctions in which 1st trip DTCs are displayed, refer to EC-76, «DTC Index». These items are required
    by legal regulations to continuously monitor the system/component. In addition, the items monitored non-continuously are also displayed on CONSULT.
    1st trip DTC is specified in Service $07 of SAE J1979/ISO 15031-5. 1st trip DTC detection occurs without illuminating the MIL and therefore does not warn the driver of a malfunction.
    When a 1st trip DTC is detected, check, print out or write down and erase (1st trip) DTC and Freeze Frame
    data as specified in Work Flow procedure Step 2, refer to EC-107, «Work Flow». Then perform DTC Confirmation Procedure or Component Function Check to try to duplicate the malfunction. If the malfunction is duplicated, the item requires repair.

    M

    FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP FREEZE FRAME DATA

    P

    The ECM records the driving conditions such as fuel system status, calculated load value, engine coolant temperature, short term fuel trim, long term fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, absolute throttle position, base
    fuel schedule and intake air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected.
    Data which are stored in the ECM memory, along with the 1st trip DTC, are called 1st trip freeze frame data.
    The data, stored together with the DTC data, are called freeze frame data and displayed on CONSULT or
    GST. The 1st trip freeze frame data can only be displayed on the CONSULT screen.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-43

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    N

    O

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Only one set of freeze frame data (either 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data) can be stored in the
    ECM. 1st trip freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory along with the 1st trip DTC. There is no priority
    for 1st trip freeze frame data and it is updated each time a different 1st trip DTC is detected. However, once
    freeze frame data (2nd trip detection/MIL on) is stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze frame data is no
    longer stored. Remember, only one set of freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM. The ECM has the following priorities to update the data.
    Priority
    1

    Items
    Freeze frame data

    2
    3

    Misfire — DTC: P0300 – P0308
    Fuel Injection System Function — DTC: P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175
    Except the above items

    1st trip freeze frame data

    For example, the EGR malfunction (Priority: 2) was detected and the freeze frame data was saved in the 2nd
    trip. After that when the misfire (Priority: 1) is detected in another trip, the freeze frame data will be updated
    from the EGR malfunction to the misfire. The 1st trip freeze frame data is updated each time a different malfunction is detected. There is no priority for 1st trip freeze frame data. However, once freeze frame data is
    stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze data is no longer stored (because only one freeze frame data or 1st
    trip freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM). If freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory and freeze
    frame data with the same priority occurs later, the first (original) freeze frame data remains unchanged in the
    ECM memory.
    Both 1st trip freeze frame data and freeze frame data (along with the DTCs) are cleared when the ECM memory is erased.

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Counter System

    INFOID:0000000009022466

    RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MIL, 1ST TRIP DTC, DTC, AND DETECTABLE ITEMS
    • When a malfunction is detected for the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip freeze frame data are
    stored in the ECM memory.
    • When the same malfunction is detected in two consecutive trips, the DTC and the freeze frame data are
    stored in the ECM memory, and the MIL will come on.
    • The MIL will turn OFF after the vehicle is driven 3 times (driving pattern B) with no malfunction. The drive is
    counted only when the recorded driving pattern is met (as stored in the ECM). If another malfunction occurs
    while counting, the counter will reset.
    • The DTC and the freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 40 times (driving pattern A) without the same malfunction recurring (except for Misfire and Fuel Injection System). For Misfire and Fuel Injection System, the DTC and freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 80 times (driving pattern
    C) without the same malfunction recurring. The “TIME” in “SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS” mode of CONSULT will count the number of times the vehicle is driven.
    • The 1st trip DTC is not displayed when the self-diagnosis results in OK for the 2nd trip.

    COUNTER SYSTEM CHART
    Items
    MIL (turns OFF)
    DTC, Freeze Frame Data (no display)
    1st Trip DTC (clear)
    1st Trip Freeze Frame Data (clear)

    Fuel Injection System

    Misfire

    Other

    3 (pattern B)

    3 (pattern B)

    3 (pattern B)

    80 (pattern C)

    80 (pattern C)

    40 (pattern A)

    1 (pattern C), *1

    1 (pattern C), *1

    1 (pattern B)

    *1, *2

    *1, *2

    1 (pattern B)

    For details about patterns B and C under “Fuel Injection System” and “Misfire”, see “EXPLANATION FOR
    DRIVING PATTERNS FOR “MISFIRE ”, “FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM”.
    For details about patterns A and B under Other, see “EXPLANATION FOR DRIVING PATTERNS FOR “MISFIRE ”, “FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM”.
    • *1: Clear timing is at the moment OK is detected.
    • *2: Clear timing is when the same malfunction is detected in the 2nd trip.

    Relationship Between MIL, DTC, 1st Trip DTC and Driving Patterns for “Misfire ”, “Fuel Injection System”
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-44

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JMBIA1417GB

    *1: When the same malfunction is detected in two consecutive trips, MIL
    will light up.

    *2: MIL will turn OFF after vehicle is driv- *3: When the same malfunction is deen 3 times (pattern B) without any
    tected in two consecutive trips, the
    malfunctions.
    DTC and the freeze frame data will be
    stored in ECM.

    *4: The DTC and the freeze frame data *5: When a malfunction is detected for
    *6: The 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip
    will not be displayed any longer after
    the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the
    freeze frame data will be cleared at
    vehicle is driven 80 times (pattern C)
    1st trip freeze frame data will be
    the moment OK is detected.
    without the same malfunction. (The
    stored in ECM.
    DTC and the freeze frame data still
    remain in ECM.)
    *7: When the same malfunction is detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
    freeze frame data will be cleared.

    *8: 1st trip DTC will be cleared when vehicle is driven once (pattern C) without the same malfunction after DTC
    is stored in ECM.

    Driving Pattern B
    Refer to EC-47, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Driving Pattern».
    Driving Pattern C

    EC-45

    N

    O

    P

    Explanation for Driving Patterns for “Misfire ”, “Fuel Injection System”

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Refer to EC-47, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Driving Pattern».
    Example:
    If the stored freeze frame data is as per the following:
    Engine speed: 850 rpm, Calculated load value: 30%, Engine coolant temperature: 80°C (176°F)
    To be satisfied with driving pattern C, the vehicle should run under the following conditions:
    Engine speed: 475 – 1,225 rpm, Calculated load value: 27 – 33%, Engine coolant temperature: more than
    70°C (158°F)

    Relationship Between MIL, DTC, 1st Trip DTC and Driving Patterns Except For “Misfire ”, “Fuel Injection System”

    JMBIA1418GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-46

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    *1: When the same malfunction is detected in two consecutive trips, MIL
    will light up.

    *2: MIL will turn OFF after vehicle is driv- *3: When the same malfunction is deen 3 times (pattern B) without any
    tected in two consecutive trips, the
    malfunctions.
    DTC and the freeze frame data will be
    stored in ECM.

    A

    *4: The DTC and the freeze frame data
    will not be displayed any longer after
    vehicle is driven 40 times (pattern A)
    without the same malfunction.
    (The DTC and the freeze frame data
    still remain in ECM.)

    *5: When a malfunction is detected for
    *6: 1st trip DTC will be cleared after vehithe first time, the 1st trip DTC and the
    cle is driven once (pattern B) without
    1st trip freeze frame data will be
    the same malfunction.
    stored in ECM.

    EC

    *7: When the same malfunction is detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
    freeze frame data will be cleared.

    C

    D

    Explanation for Driving Patterns Except for “Misfire ”, “Fuel Injection
    System”
    Driving Pattern A
    Refer to EC-47, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Driving Pattern».
    Driving Pattern B
    Refer to EC-47, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Driving Pattern».

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Driving Pattern

    E

    F
    INFOID:0000000009022467

    G

    DRIVING PATTERN A
    Driving pattern A means a trip satisfying the following conditions.
    • Engine speed reaches 400 rpm or more.
    • Engine coolant temperature rises by 20°C (36°F) or more after starting the engine.
    • Engine coolant temperature reaches 70°C (158°F) or more.
    • The ignition switch is turned from ON to OFF.
    NOTE:
    • When the same malfunction is detected regardless of driving conditions, reset the counter of driving pattern
    A.
    • When the above conditions are satisfied without detecting the same malfunction, reset the counter of driving
    pattern A.

    DRIVING PATTERN B
    Driving pattern B means a trip satisfying the following conditions.
    • Engine speed reaches 400 rpm or more.
    • Engine coolant temperature reaches 70°C (158°F) or more.
    • Vehicle speed of 70 – 120 km/h (44 – 75 MPH) is maintained for 60 seconds or more under the control of
    closed loop.
    • Vehicle speed of 30 – 60 km/h (19 – 37 MPH) is maintained for 10 seconds or more under the control of
    closed loop.
    • Under the closed loop control condition, the following state reaches 12 seconds or more in total: Vehicle
    speed of 4 km/h (2 MPH) or less with idling condition.
    • The state of driving at 10 km/h (7 MPH) or more reaches 10 minutes or more in total.
    • A lapse of 22 minutes or more after engine start.
    NOTE:
    • Drive the vehicle at a constant velocity.
    • When the same malfunction is detected regardless of driving conditions, reset the counter of driving pattern
    B.
    • When the above conditions are satisfied without detecting the same malfunction, reset the counter of driving
    pattern B.

    DRIVING PATTERN C
    Driving pattern C means operating vehicle as per the following:
    The following conditions should be satisfied at the same time:
    Engine speed: (Engine speed in the freeze frame data) ±375 rpm
    Calculated load value: (Calculated load value in the freeze frame data) x (1±0.1) [%]
    Engine coolant temperature condition:

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-47

    2014 Note

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • When the freeze frame data shows lower than 70°C (158°F), engine coolant temperature should be lower
    than 70°C (158°F).
    • When the freeze frame data shows higher than or equal to 70°C (158°F), engine coolant temperature should
    be higher than or equal to 70°C (158°F).
    NOTE:
    • When the same malfunction is detected regardless of the above vehicle conditions, reset the counter of driving pattern C.
    • When the above conditions are satisfied without detecting the same malfunction, reset the counter of driving
    pattern C.
    • The 1st trip DTC will be cleared when C counter is counted once without the same malfunction after DTC is
    stored in ECM.

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : System Readiness Test (SRT) Code

    INFOID:0000000009022468

    System Readiness Test (SRT) code is specified in Service $01 of SAE J1979/ISO 15031-5.
    As part of an enhanced emissions test for Inspection & Maintenance (I/M), certain states require the status of
    SRT be used to indicate whether the ECM has completed self-diagnosis of major emission systems and components. Completion must be verified in order for the emissions inspection to proceed.
    If a vehicle is rejected for a State emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating “INCMP”, use
    the information in this Service Manual to set the SRT to “CMPLT”.
    In most cases the ECM will automatically complete its self-diagnosis cycle during normal usage, and the SRT
    status will indicate “CMPLT” for each application system. Once set as “CMPLT”, the SRT status remains
    “CMPLT” until the self-diagnosis memory is erased.
    Occasionally, certain portions of the self-diagnostic test may not be completed as a result of the customer’s
    normal driving pattern; the SRT will indicate “INCMP” for these items.
    NOTE:
    The SRT will also indicate “INCMP” if the self-diagnosis memory is erased for any reason or if the ECM memory power supply is interrupted for several hours.
    If, during the state emissions inspection, the SRT indicates “CMPLT” for all test items, the inspector will continue with the emissions test. However, if the SRT indicates “INCMP” for one or more of the SRT items the
    vehicle is returned to the customer untested.
    NOTE:
    If MIL is ON during the state emissions inspection, the vehicle is also returned to the customer untested even
    though the SRT indicates “CMPLT” for all test items. Therefore, it is important to check SRT (“CMPLT”) and
    DTC (No DTCs) before the inspection.

    SRT SET TIMING
    SRT is set as “CMPLT” after self-diagnosis has been performed one or more times. Completion of SRT is
    done regardless of whether the result is OK or NG. The set timing is different between OK and NG results and
    is shown in the table below.
    Example
    Self-diagnosis result
    All OK

    Case 1

    Case 2

    Revision: April 2013

    Diagnosis

    ← ON →

    OFF

    Ignition cycle
    ← ON → OFF ← ON → OFF

    ← ON →

    P0400

    OK (1)

    — (1)

    OK (2)

    — (2)

    P0402

    OK (1)

    — (1)

    — (1)

    OK (2)

    P1402

    OK (1)

    OK (2)

    — (2)

    — (2)

    SRT of EGR

    “CMPLT”

    “CMPLT”

    “CMPLT”

    “CMPLT”

    P0400

    OK (1)

    — (1)

    — (1)

    — (1)

    P0402

    — (0)

    — (0)

    OK (1)

    — (1)

    P1402

    OK (1)

    OK (2)

    — (2)

    — (2)

    SRT of EGR

    “INCMP”

    “INCMP”

    “CMPLT”

    “CMPLT”

    EC-48

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Example
    Self-diagnosis result
    NG exists

    Diagnosis

    Case 3

    Ignition cycle
    ← ON → OFF ← ON → OFF ← ON →

    A
    OFF ← ON →

    P0400

    OK

    OK

    P0402

    P1402

    NG

    NG

    NG
    (Consecutive NG)

    (1st trip)
    DTC

    1st trip DTC

    1st trip DTC

    DTC
    (= MIL ON)

    SRT of EGR

    “INCMP”

    “INCMP”

    “INCMP”

    “CMPLT”

    EC

    C

    D

    OK: Self-diagnosis is carried out and the result is OK.
    NG: Self-diagnosis is carried out and the result is NG.
    —: Self-diagnosis is not carried out.

    When all SRT related self-diagnoses show OK results in a single cycle (Ignition OFF-ON-OFF), the SRT will
    indicate “CMPLT”. → Case 1 above
    When all SRT related self-diagnoses show OK results through several different cycles, the SRT will indicate
    “CMPLT” at the time the respective self-diagnoses have at least one OK result. → Case 2 above
    If one or more SRT related self-diagnoses show NG results in 2 consecutive cycles, the SRT will also indicate
    “CMPLT”. → Case 3 above
    The table above shows that the minimum number of cycles for setting SRT as “INCMP” is the number one (1)
    for each self-diagnosis (Case 1 & 2) or the number two (2) for one of self-diagnoses (Case 3). However, in
    preparation for the state emissions inspection, it is unnecessary for each self-diagnosis to be executed twice
    (Case 3) for the following reasons:
    • The SRT will indicate “CMPLT” at the time the respective self-diagnoses have one (1) OK result.
    • The emissions inspection requires “CMPLT” of the SRT only with OK self-diagnosis results.
    • During SRT driving pattern, the 1st trip DTC (NG) is detected prior to “CMPLT” of SRT and the self-diagnosis
    memory must be erased from the ECM after repair.
    • If the 1st trip DTC is erased, all the SRT will indicate “INCMP”.
    NOTE:
    SRT can be set as “CMPLT” together with the DTC(s). Therefore, DTC check must always be carried out
    prior to the state emission inspection even though the SRT indicates “CMPLT”.

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)

    INFOID:0000000009022470

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSIS ITEM
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-49

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    INFOID:0000000009022469

    • When detecting a DTC that affects exhaust gas, the exhaust emission-related control module transmits a malfunction indicator lamp
    signal to ECM via CAN communication line.
    ECM prioritizes (MIL: ON/blink) the signal received from the
    exhaust emission-related control module and the ECM-stored DTC
    that affects exhaust gas and transmits a malfunction indicator lamp
    signal to the combination meter via CAN communication line.
    The combination meter turns ON or blinks the MIL, according to
    the signal transmitted from ECM, and alerts the driver of malfunction detection.
    • Control modules that a DTC of MIL ON/Blink is stored (Control
    JSBIA1315ZZ
    module varies among DTCs.):
    — ECM
    — TCM
    1. The MIL illuminates when ignition switch is turned ON (engine is not running).
    NOTE:
    Check the MIL circuit if MIL does not illuminate. Refer to EC-324, «Component Function Check».
    2. When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
    NOTE:
    If MIL remains ON or continues blinking, a DTC(s) that affects exhaust gas is detected. In this case, Self
    diagnosis is required for performing inspection and repair.

    On Board Diagnosis Function

    E

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    The on board diagnostic system has the following functions.
    Diagnostic test mode

    Function

    Bulb check

    MIL can be checked.

    SRT status

    ECM can read if SRT codes are set.

    Malfunction warning

    If ECM detects a malfunction, it illuminates or blinks MIL to inform the driver that a malfunction has been detected.

    Self-diagnostic results

    DTCs or 1st trip DTCs stored in ECM can be read.

    Accelerator pedal released position learning

    ECM can learn the accelerator pedal released position. Refer to EC-113, «Description».

    Throttle valve closed position learning

    ECM can learn the throttle valve closed position. Refer to EC-114, «Description».

    Idle air volume learning

    ECM can learn the idle air volume. Refer to EC-115, «Description».

    Mixture ratio self-learning value clear

    Mixture ratio self-learning value can be erased. Refer to EC-117, «Description».

    BULB CHECK MODE
    Description
    This function allows damage inspection in the MIL bulb (blown, open circuit, etc.).
    Operation Procedure

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    The MIL on the instrument panel should stay ON.
    If it remains OFF, check MIL circuit. Refer to EC-324, «Component Function Check».

    SRT STATUS MODE
    Description
    This function allows to read if ECM has completed the self-diagnoses of major emission control systems and
    components. For SRT, refer to EC-48, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : System Readiness Test (SRT) Code».
    Operation Procedure

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON and wait 20 seconds.
    SRT status is indicated as shown blow.
    • ECM continues to illuminate MIL if all SRT codes are set.
    • ECM blinks MIL for about 10 seconds if all SRT codes are not set.

    JMBIA1515GB

    MALFUNCTION WARNING MODE
    Description
    In this function ECM turns on or blinks MIL when it detects a malfunction in the emission control system components and/or the powertrain control components (which affect vehicle emissions) to inform the driver that a
    malfunction has been detected.
    Operation Procedure

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-50

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    A
    2. Check that MIL illuminates.
    If it remains OFF, check MIL circuit. Refer to EC-324, «Component Function Check».
    3. Start engine and let it idle.
    • For two trip detection logic diagnoses, ECM turns on MIL when it detects the same malfunction twice in EC
    the two consecutive driving cycles.
    • For 1st trip detection logic diagnoses, ECM turns on MIL when it detects a malfunction in one driving
    cycle.
    C
    • ECM blinks MIL when it detects a malfunction that may damage the three way catalyst (misfire).

    SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS MODE
    Description
    This function allows to indicate DTCs or 1st trip DTCs stored in ECM according to the number of times MIL is
    blinking.

    D

    How to Set Self-diagnostic Results Mode
    NOTE:
    • It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
    • It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit has a malfunction.
    • After ignition switch is turned off, ECM is always released from the “self-diagnostic results” mode.
    1. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
    2. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
    • Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
    • Fully release the accelerator pedal.
    3. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it depressed for approx. 10 seconds until the
    MIL starts blinking.
    NOTE:
    Do not release the accelerator pedal for 10 seconds if MIL starts blinking during this period. This blinking
    is displaying SRT status and is continued for another 10 seconds.
    4. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
    ECM has entered to “Self-diagnostic results” mode.
    NOTE:
    Wait until the same DTC (or 1st trip DTC) appears to completely confirm all DTCs.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M
    PBIB0092E

    How to Read Self-diagnostic Results
    The DTC and 1st trip DTC are indicated by the number of blinks of the MIL as shown below.
    The DTC and 1st trip DTC are displayed at the same time. If the MIL does not illuminate in diagnostic test
    mode I (Malfunction warning), all displayed items are 1st trip DTCs. If only one code is displayed when the MIL
    illuminates in “malfunction warning” mode, it is a DTC; if two or more codes are displayed, they may be either

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-51

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    DTCs or 1st trip DTCs. DTC No. is same as that of 1st trip DTC. These unidentified codes can be identified by
    using the CONSULT or GST. A DTC will be used as an example for how to read a code.

    PBIB3005E

    A particular trouble code can be identified by the number of four-digit numeral flashes per the following.
    Number

    0

    1

    2

    3

    4

    5

    6

    7

    8

    9

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    Flashes

    10

    1

    2

    3

    4

    5

    6

    7

    8

    9

    11

    12

    13

    14

    15

    16

    The length of time the 1,000th-digit numeral flashes on and off is 1.2 seconds consisting of an ON (0.6-seconds) — OFF (0.6-seconds) cycle.
    The 100th-digit numeral and lower digit numerals consist of a 0.3-seconds ON and 0.3-seconds OFF cycle.
    A change from one digit numeral to another occurs at an interval of 1.0-second OFF. In other words, the later
    numeral appears on the display 1.3 seconds after the former numeral has disappeared.
    A change from one trouble code to another occurs at an interval of 1.8-seconds OFF.
    In this way, all the detected malfunctions are classified by their DTC numbers. The DTC 0000 refers to no malfunction. Refer to EC-76, «DTC Index».
    How to Erase Self-diagnostic Results
    By performing this procedure, ECM memory is erased and the following diagnostic information is erased as
    well.
    • Diagnostic trouble codes
    • 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
    • Freeze frame data
    • 1st trip freeze frame data
    • System readiness test (SRT) codes
    • Test values
    NOTE:
    Also, if a battery terminal is disconnected, ECM memory is erased and the diagnostic information as listed
    above is erased. (The amount of time required for erasing may vary from a few seconds to several hours.)
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-52

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    4. Turn ignition switch ON.
    5. Set ECM in “self-diagnostic results” mode.
    6. The diagnostic information has been erased from the backup memory in the ECM.
    Fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it depressed for more than 10 seconds.
    7. Fully release the accelerator pedal, and confirm the DTC 0000 is displayed.

    CONSULT Function

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC
    INFOID:0000000009022471

    C

    FUNCTION
    Diagnostic test mode

    Function

    D

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Self-diagnostic results such as 1st trip DTC, DTCs and 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data
    can be read and erased quickly.*

    Data Monitor

    Input/Output data in the ECM can be read.

    Work support

    This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately by following the
    indications on the CONSULT unit.

    Active Test

    Diagnostic Test Mode in which CONSULT drives some actuators apart from the ECMs and also shifts
    some parameters in a specified range.

    ECU Identification

    ECM part number can be read.

    DTC Work Support

    The status of system monitoring tests and the self-diagnosis status/result can be confirmed.

    E

    *: The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
    • Diagnostic trouble codes
    • 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
    • Freeze frame data
    • 1st trip freeze frame data
    • System readiness test (SRT) codes
    • Test values

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT MODE
    J

    Self Diagnostic Item
    Regarding items of DTC and 1st trip DTC, refer to EC-76, «DTC Index».
    How to Read DTC and 1st Trip DTC
    DTCs and 1st trip DTCs related to the malfunction are displayed in “self-diag results”.
    • When ECM detects a 1st trip DTC, “1t” is displayed for “TIME”.
    • When ECM has detected a current DTC, “0” is displayed for “TIME”.
    • If “TIME” is neither “0” nor “1t”, the DTC occurred in the past and ECM shows the number of times the vehicle has been driven since the last detection of the DTC.
    How to Erase DTC and 1st Trip DTC
    NOTE:
    If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least 10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
    1. Select “ENGINE” with CONSULT.
    2. Select “SELF-DIAG RESULTS”.
    3. Touch “ERASE”. (DTC in ECM will be erased.)

    Freeze frame data item*

    FUEL SYS-B2

    DTC RESULTS

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    M

    N

    O

    Freeze Frame Data and 1st Trip Freeze Frame Data

    FUEL SYS-B1

    K

    Description
    • “Fuel injection system status” at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
    • One mode in the following is displayed.
    Mode2: Open loop due to detected system malfunction
    Mode3: Open loop due to driving conditions (power enrichment, deceleration enleanment)
    Mode4: Closed loop — using oxygen sensor(s) as feedback for fuel control
    Mode5: Open loop — has not yet satisfied condition to go to closed loop
    The engine control component part/control system has a trouble code, it is displayed as PXXXX.
    (Refer to EC-76, «DTC Index».)

    EC-53

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Freeze frame data item*

    Description

    CAL/LD VALUE [%]

    The calculated load value at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.

    COOLANT TEMP [°C] or [°F]

    The engine coolant temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.

    L-FUEL TRM-B1 [%]

    • “Long-term fuel trim” at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
    • The long-term fuel trim indicates much more gradual feedback compensation to the base fuel
    schedule than short-term fuel trim.

    L-FUEL TRM-B2 [%]
    S-FUEL TRM-B1 [%]
    S-FUEL TRM-B2 [%]

    • “Short-term fuel trim” at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
    • The short-term fuel trim indicates dynamic or instantaneous feedback compensation to the base
    fuel schedule.

    ENGINE SPEED [rpm]

    The engine speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.

    VEHICL SPEED [km/h] or [mph]

    The vehicle speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.

    INT MANI PRES [kPa]

    These items are displayed but are not applicable to this model.

    COMBUST CONDITION
    ABSOL TH·P/S [%]

    The throttle valve opening angle at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.

    B/FUEL SCHDL [msec]

    The base fuel schedule at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.

    INT/A TEMP SE [°C] or [°F]

    The intake air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.

    *: The items are the same as those of 1st trip freeze frame data.

    DATA MONITOR MODE
    NOTE:
    • The following table includes information (items) inapplicable to this vehicle. For information (items) applicable to this vehicle, refer to CONSULT display items.
    • For reference values of the following items, refer to EC-62, «Reference Value».
    Monitored Item
    ×: Applicable

    Monitor Item Selection
    Monitored item

    ENG SPEED

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    A/F ALPHA-B1

    Revision: April 2013

    Unit

    rpm

    V

    ms

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    Remarks
    Description

    Indicates the engine speed
    computed from the signal of
    the crankshaft position sensor
    (POS) and camshaft position
    sensor (PHASE).

    • Accuracy becomes poor if
    engine speed drops below
    the idle rpm.
    • If the signal is interrupted
    while the engine is running,
    an abnormal value may be
    indicated.

    ×

    The signal voltage of the mass
    air flow sensor is displayed.

    • When the engine is
    stopped, a certain value is
    indicated.
    • When engine is running,
    specification range is indicated in “SPEC”.

    ×

    “Base fuel schedule” indicates
    the fuel injection pulse width
    programmed into ECM, prior
    to any learned on board correction.

    When engine is running,
    specification range is indicated in “SPEC”.

    The mean value of the air-fuel
    ratio feedback correction factor per cycle is indicated.

    • When the engine is
    stopped, a certain value is
    indicated.
    • When engine is running,
    specification range is indicated in “SPEC”.
    • This data also includes the
    data for the air-fuel ratio
    learning control.

    ×

    %

    EC-54

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item Selection
    Monitored item

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    Unit

    °C or °F

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    ×

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    ×

    Remarks
    Description

    The engine coolant temperature (determined by the signal
    voltage of the engine coolant
    temperature sensor) is displayed.

    A/F SEN1 (B1)

    V

    ×

    ×

    The A/F signal computed from
    the input signal of the air fuel
    ratio (A/F) sensor 1 is displayed.

    HO2S2 (B1)

    V

    ×

    ×

    The signal voltage of the heated oxygen sensor 2 is displayed.

    HO2S2 MNTR(B1)

    VHCL SPEED SE

    BATTERY VOLT

    RICH/LEAN

    km/h or mph

    ×

    Display of heated oxygen sensor 2 signal:
    RICH: means the amount of
    oxygen after three way catalyst is relatively small.
    LEAN: means the amount of
    oxygen after three way catalyst is relatively large.

    ×

    The vehicle speed computed
    from the vehicle speed signal
    sent from combination meter
    is displayed.

    ×

    TP SEN 2-B1

    START SIGNAL

    CLSD THL POS

    AIR COND SIG

    PW/ST SIGNAL

    Revision: April 2013

    F
    When the engine is stopped, a
    certain value is indicated.

    I

    V

    ACCEL SEN 2 signal is converted by ECM internally.
    Thus, it differs from ECM terminal voltage signal.

    The throttle position sensor
    signal voltage is displayed.

    TP SEN 2-B1 signal is converted by ECM internally.
    Thus, it differs from ECM terminal voltage signal.

    V

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ON/OFF

    Indicates start signal status
    [ON/OFF] computed by the
    ECM according to the signals
    of engine speed and battery
    voltage.

    ON/OFF

    ×

    Indicates idle position [ON/
    OFF] computed by ECM according to the accelerator
    pedal position sensor signal.

    ×

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    of the air conditioner switch as
    determined by the air conditioner signal.

    ×

    [ON/OFF] condition of the
    power steering system (determined by the signal sent from
    EPS control unit) is indicated.

    ON/OFF

    ON/OFF

    ×

    ×

    ×

    EC-55

    G

    H

    The accelerator pedal position
    sensor signal voltage is displayed.
    ×

    C

    E

    V

    TP SEN 1-B1

    EC

    D

    The power supply voltage of
    ECM is displayed.

    ACCEL SEN 1
    ACCEL SEN 2

    When the engine coolant temperature sensor is open or
    short-circuited, ECM enters
    fail-safe mode. The engine
    coolant temperature determined by the ECM is displayed.

    A

    After starting the engine,
    [OFF] is displayed regardless
    of the starter signal.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item Selection
    Monitored item

    Unit

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    Remarks
    Description

    LOAD SIGNAL

    ON/OFF

    ×

    ×

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    of the electrical lode signal.
    ON: Rear window defogger
    switch is ON and/or lighting
    switch is 2nd position.
    OFF: Both rear window defogger switch and lighting switch
    are OFF.

    IGNITION SW

    ON/OFF

    ×

    ×

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from ignition switch signal.

    HEATER FAN SW

    ON/OFF

    ×

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from the heater fan switch signal.

    BRAKE SW

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from the stop lamp switch signal.

    INJ PULSE-B1

    msec

    Indicates the actual fuel injection pulse width compensated
    by ECM according to the input
    signals.

    When the engine is stopped, a
    certain computed value is indicated.

    IGN TIMING

    BTDC

    Indicates the ignition timing
    computed by ECM according
    to the input signals.

    When the engine is stopped, a
    certain value is indicated.

    %

    “Calculated load value” indicates the value of the current
    air flow divided by peak air
    flow.

    g/s

    Indicates the mass air flow
    computed by ECM according
    to the signal voltage of the
    mass air flow sensor.

    %

    • Indicates the EVAP canister
    purge volume control solenoid valve control value
    computed by the ECM according to the input signals.
    • The opening becomes larger as the value increases.

    INT/V TIM(B1)

    °CA

    Indicates [°CA] of intake camshaft advance angle.

    EXH/V TIM B1

    °CA

    Indicates [°CA] of exhaust
    camshaft retard angle.

    CAL/LD VALUE

    MASS AIRFLOW

    PURG VOL C/V

    INT/V SOL(B1)

    AIR COND RLY

    Revision: April 2013

    • The control value of the intake valve timing control solenoid valve (determined by
    ECM according to the input
    signals) is indicated.
    • The advance angle becomes larger as the value
    increases.

    %

    The air conditioner relay control condition (determined by
    ECM according to the input
    signals) is indicated.

    ON/OFF

    EC-56

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item Selection
    Monitored item

    FUEL PUMP RLY

    THRTL RELAY

    COOLING FAN

    HO2S2 HTR (B1)

    ALT DUTY SIG

    VEHICLE SPEED

    IDL A/V LEARN

    TRVL AFTER MIL

    ENG OIL TEMP

    A/F S1 HTR(B1)

    ALT DUTY

    Revision: April 2013

    Unit

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    Remarks
    Description

    ON/OFF

    Indicates the fuel pump relay
    control condition determined
    by ECM according to the input
    signals.

    ON/OFF

    Indicates the throttle control
    motor relay control condition
    determined by the ECM according to the input signals.

    HI/LOW/OFF

    Indicates the condition of the
    cooling fan (determined by
    ECM according to the input
    signals).
    HI: High speed operation
    LOW: Low speed operation
    OFF: Stop

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    of heated oxygen sensor 2
    heater determined by ECM
    according to the input signals.

    ON/OFF

    The control condition of the
    power generation voltage
    variable control (determined
    by ECM according to the input
    signals) is indicated.
    ON: Power generation voltage
    variable control is active.
    OFF: Power generation voltage variable control is inactive.

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    km/h or mph

    The vehicle speed computed
    from the vehicle speed signal
    sent from TCM is displayed.

    K

    YET/CMPLT

    Displays the condition of Idle
    Air Volume Learning
    YET: Idle air volume learning
    has not been performed yet.
    CMPLT: Idle air volume learning has already been performed successfully.

    km or mile

    Distance traveled while MIL is
    activated.

    M

    °C or °F

    The engine oil temperature
    (determined by the signal voltage of the engine oil temperature sensor) is indicated.

    %

    • Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    heater control value computed by ECM according to
    the input signals.
    • The current flow to the heater becomes larger as the
    value increases.

    L

    N

    O

    P

    Indicates the duty ratio of the
    power generation command
    value. The ratio is calculated
    by ECM based on the battery
    current sensor signal.

    %

    EC-57

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item Selection
    Monitored item

    BAT CUR SEN

    VHCL SPEED SE

    A/F ADJ-B1

    P/N POSI SW

    Unit

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    Remarks
    Description

    mV

    The signal voltage of battery
    current sensor is displayed.

    km/h or mph

    The vehicle speed computed
    from the vehicle speed signal
    sent from combination meter
    is displayed.

    ×

    ×

    Indicates the correction of a
    factor stored in ECM.
    The factor is calculated from
    the difference between the
    target air-fuel ratio stored in
    ECM and the air-fuel ratio calculated from A/F sensor 1 signal.

    ON/OFF

    INT/A TEMP SE

    °C or °F

    AC PRESS SEN

    V

    SET VHCL SPD

    km/h or mph

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from the park/neutral position
    (PNP) signal.

    ×

    The intake air temperature
    (determined by the signal voltage of the intake air temperature sensor) is indicated.
    The signal voltage from the refrigerant pressure sensor is
    displayed.
    The preset vehicle speed is
    displayed.

    MAIN SW

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from MAIN switch signal.

    CANCEL SW

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from CANCEL switch signal.

    RESUME/ACC SW

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from RESUME/ACCELERATE switch signal.

    SET SW

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from SET/COAST switch signal.

    BRAKE SW1

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    from brake pedal position
    switch signal.

    BRAKE SW2

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    of stop lamp switch signal.

    NON/CUT

    Indicates the vehicle cruise
    condition.
    NON: Vehicle speed is maintained at the ASCD set speed.
    CUT: Vehicle speed decreased to excessively low
    compared with the ASCD set
    speed, and ASCD operation is
    cut off.

    VHCL SPD CUT

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-58

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item Selection
    Monitored item

    LO SPEED CUT

    Unit

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT
    SIGNALS

    Remarks
    Description
    Indicates the vehicle cruise
    condition.
    NON: Vehicle speed is maintained at the ASCD set speed.
    CUT: Vehicle speed decreased to excessively low,
    and ASCD operation is cut off.

    NON/CUT

    A

    EC

    C

    AT OD MONITOR

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [On/Off] condition of
    CVT O/D according to the input signal from the TCM.

    D

    AT OD CANCEL

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [On/Off] condition of
    CVT O/D cancel request signal.

    E

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    of CRUISE lamp determined
    by the ECM according to the
    input signals.

    F

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    of SET lamp determined by
    the ECM according to the input signals.

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    of kickdown determined by
    the ECM according to the input signals.

    ON/OFF

    Indicates [ON/OFF] condition
    clutch pedal position switch
    signals.

    VTC DTY EX B1

    %

    • The control value of the exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve (determined
    by ECM according to the input signals) is indicated.
    • The advance angle becomes larger as the value
    increases.

    THRTL STK CNT B1

    Not used.

    EOP SENSOR

    mV

    The signal voltage of EOP
    sensor is displayed.

    CRUISE LAMP

    SET LAMP

    KICKDOWN POS

    CLUTCH P/P SW

    HO2 S2 DIAG2(B1)

    A/F SEN1 DIAG2(B1)

    INCMP/CMPLT

    NOTE:
    The item is indicated, but not
    used.

    INCMP/CMPLT

    NOTE:
    The item is indicated, but not
    used.

    G

    H

    I
    Models other than M/T models always display OFF.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    NOTE:
    Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.

    WORK SUPPORT MODE

    P

    Work Item

    Revision: April 2013

    O

    EC-59

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    WORK ITEM

    CONDITION

    USAGE

    FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE

    Fuel pump will stop by touching “START” during idling.
    Crank a few times after engine stalls.

    When releasing fuel pressure from fuel line

    IDLE AIR VOL LEARN

    The idle air volume that keeps the engine within the
    specified range is memorized in ECM.

    When learning the idle air volume

    SELF-LEARNING CONT

    The coefficient of self-learning control mixture ratio returns to the original coefficient.

    When clearing mixture ratio self-learning
    value

    TARGET IDLE RPM ADJ*

    Idle condition

    When setting target idle speed

    TARGET IGN TIM ADJ*

    Idle condition

    When adjusting target ignition timing

    CLSD THL POS LEARN

    Ignition on and engine stopped.

    When learning throttle valve closed position

    *: This function is not necessary in the usual service procedure.

    ACTIVE TEST MODE
    Test Item
    TEST ITEM

    CONDITION

    JUDGMENT

    CHECK ITEM (REMEDY)

    ENG COOLANT
    TEMP

    • Engine: Return to the original trouble condition
    • Change the engine coolant temperature
    using CONSULT.

    If trouble symptom disappears, see CHECK ITEM.

    • Harness and connectors
    • Engine coolant temperature
    sensor
    • Fuel injector

    FUEL INJECTION

    • Engine: Return to the original trouble condition
    • Change the amount of fuel injection using
    CONSULT.

    If trouble symptom disappears, see CHECK ITEM.

    • Harness and connectors
    • Fuel injector
    • Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1

    PURG VOL CONT/V

    • Engine: After warming up, run engine at
    1,500 rpm.
    • Change the EVAP canister purge volume
    control solenoid valve opening percent using CONSULT.

    Engine speed changes according to the opening percent.

    • Harness and connectors
    • Solenoid valve

    FUEL PUMP RELAY

    • Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped)
    • Turn the fuel pump relay “ON” and “OFF”
    using CONSULT and listen to operating
    sound.

    Fuel pump relay makes the
    operating sound.

    • Harness and connectors
    • Fuel pump relay

    COOLING FAN*

    • Ignition switch: ON
    • Turn the cooling fan “LOW”, “HI” and “OFF”
    CONSULT.

    Cooling fan moves and stops.

    • Harness and connectors
    • IPDM E/R (Cooling fan relay)
    • Cooling fan motor

    IGNITION TIMING

    • Engine: Return to the original trouble condition
    • Timing light: Set
    • Retard the ignition timing using CONSULT.

    If trouble symptom disappears, see CHECK ITEM.

    Perform Idle Air Volume Learning.

    Engine runs rough or dies.






    POWER BALANCE




    Engine: After warming up, idle the engine.
    A/C switch OFF
    Shift lever: Neutral
    Cut off each fuel injector signal one at a
    time using CONSULT.

    Harness and connectors
    Compression
    Fuel injector
    Power transistor
    Spark plug
    Ignition coil

    INT V/T ASSIGN
    ANGLE

    • Engine: Return to the original non-standard condition
    • Change intake valve timing using CONSULT.

    If malfunctioning symptom
    disappears, see CHECK
    ITEM.

    • Harness and connectors
    • Intake valve timing control solenoid valve

    EXH V/T ASSIGN
    ANGLE

    • Engine: Return to the original non-standard condition
    • Change exhaust valve timing using CONSULT.

    If malfunctioning symptom
    disappears, see CHECK
    ITEM.

    • Harness and connectors
    • Exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve

    *: Leaving cooling fan OFF with CONSULT while engine is running may cause the engine to overheat.

    DTC WORK SUPPORT MODE
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-60

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (ECM)
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Test Item

    A
    Test mode

    HO2S2

    A/F SEN1

    Test item

    Corresponding DTC No.

    Reference page

    HO2S2 (B1) P1146

    P0138

    EC-188, «DTC Logic»

    HO2S2 (B1) P1147

    P0137

    EC-183, «DTC Logic»

    HO2S2 (B1) P0139

    P0139

    EC-196, «DTC Logic»

    A/F SEN1 (B1) P1278/P1279

    P0133

    EC-179, «DTC Logic»

    A/F SEN1 (B1) P1276

    P0130

    EC-170, «DTC Logic»

    SRT & P-DTC MODE
    SRT STATUS Mode
    For items whose SRT codes are set, “CMPLT” is displayed on the CONSULT screen; for items whose SRT
    codes are not set, “INCMP” is displayed.
    SRT WORK SUPPORT Mode
    This mode enables a technician to drive a vehicle to set the SRT while monitoring the SRT status.

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-61

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    ECM
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009022472

    VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL
    NOTE:
    • The following table includes information (items) inapplicable to this vehicle. For information (items) applicable to this vehicle, refer to CONSULT display items.
    • Numerical values in the following table are reference values.
    • These values are input/output values that ECM receives/transmits and may differ from actual operations.
    Example: The ignition timing shown by the timing light may differ from the ignition timing displayed on the
    data monitor.
    This occurs because the timing light shows a value calculated by ECM according to signals received from
    the camshaft position sensor and other sensors related to ignition timing.
    • For outlines of following items, refer to EC-53, «CONSULT Function».
    Monitor Item

    Condition

    ENG SPEED

    • Run engine and compare CONSULT value with the tachometer indication.

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    See EC-129, «Description».

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    See EC-129, «Description».

    A/F ALPHA-B1

    See EC-129, «Description».

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    • Engine: After warming up

    A/F SEN1 (B1)

    • Engine: After warming up

    Values/Status
    Almost the same speed as
    the tachometer indication.

    More than 70°C (158F)
    Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm

    Fluctuates around 2.2 V

    • Revving engine from idle up to 3,000 rpm quickly after the following conditions
    are met.
    — Engine: After warming up
    — After keeping engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at
    idle for 1 minute under no load

    0 — 0.3 V ←→ Approx. 0.6 1.0 V

    VHCL SPEED SE

    • Turn drive wheels and compare CONSULT value with the speedometer indication.

    Almost the same speed as
    speedometer indication

    BATTERY VOLT

    • Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped)

    11 — 14 V

    ACCEL SEN 1

    • Ignition switch: ON
    (Engine stopped)

    Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    0.6 — 0.9 V

    Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    4.0 — 4.8 V

    ACCEL SEN 2

    • Ignition switch: ON
    (Engine stopped)

    Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    0.6 — 0.9 V

    Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    3.9 — 4.8 V

    • Ignition switch: ON
    (Engine stopped)
    • Shift lever: 1st

    Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    More than 0.36 V

    TP SEN 1-B1

    Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    Less than 4.75 V

    • Ignition switch: ON
    (Engine stopped)
    • Shift lever:1st

    Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    More than 0.36 V

    TP SEN 2-B1

    Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    Less than 4.75 V

    START SIGNAL

    • Ignition switch: ON → START → ON

    CLSD THL POS

    • Ignition switch: ON
    (Engine stopped)

    AIR COND SIG

    • Engine: After warming up, idle
    the engine

    PW/ST SIGNAL

    • Engine: After warming up, idle
    the engine

    HO2S2 (B1)
    HO2S2 MNTR (B1)

    Revision: April 2013

    LEAN ←→ RICH

    OFF → ON → OFF

    Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    ON

    Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed

    OFF

    Air conditioner switch: OFF

    OFF

    Air conditioner switch: ON
    (Compressor operates.)

    ON

    Steering wheel: Not being turned

    OFF

    Steering wheel: Being turned

    ON

    EC-62

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item

    LOAD SIGNAL

    IGNITION SW

    Condition

    • Ignition switch: ON

    Rear window defogger switch: ON
    and/or
    Lighting switch: 2nd position

    ON

    Rear window defogger switch and lighting
    switch: OFF

    OFF

    • Ignition switch: ON → OFF → ON

    HEATER FAN SW

    • Engine: After warming up, idle
    the engine

    BRAKE SW

    • Ignition switch: ON

    INJ PULSE-B1

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    IGN TIMING

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    Values/Status

    EC

    ON → OFF → ON
    Heater fan switch: ON

    ON

    Heater fan switch: OFF

    OFF

    Brake pedal: Fully released

    OFF

    Brake pedal: Slightly depressed

    ON

    Idle

    2.0 — 3.0 msec

    C

    D

    E
    2,000 rpm

    1.9 — 2.9 msec

    Idle

    11°BTDC (CVT)
    10°BTDC (M/T)

    2,000 rpm

    25° — 45°BTDC

    Idle

    10% — 35%

    CAL/LD VALUE

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    2,500 rpm

    10% — 35%

    Idle

    0.8 — 4.0 g/s

    MASS AIRFLOW

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    2,500 rpm

    2.0 — 10.0 g/s

    Idle

    0%

    PURG VOL C/V

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    2,000 rpm

    0% — 50%

    Idle

    −5° — 5°CA

    INT/V TIM(B1)

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    When revving engine up to 2,000rpm
    Quickly

    Approx. 0° — 40°CA

    Idle

    −5° — 5°CA

    EXH/V TIM B1

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    When revving engine up to 2,000rpm
    Quickly

    Approx. 0° — 40°CA

    Idle

    0% — 2%

    INT/V SOL(B1)

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    When revving engine up to 2,000rpm
    Quickly

    Approx. 0% — 90%

    Air conditioner switch: OFF

    OFF

    Air conditioner switch: ON
    (Compressor operates.)

    ON

    AIR COND RLY

    FUEL PUMP RLY

    • Engine: After warming up, idle
    the engine

    F

    G

    H

    ON

    • Except above

    OFF

    EC-63

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    • For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch: ON
    • Engine running or cranking

    Revision: April 2013

    A

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item
    THRTL RELAY

    COOLING FAN

    HO2S2 HTR (B1)

    ALT DUTY SIG
    VEHICLE SPEED

    IDL A/V LEARN

    Condition
    • Ignition switch: ON

    • Engine: After warning up, idle the
    engine
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF

    Values/Status
    ON

    Engine coolant temperature is 98°C
    (208°F) or less

    OFF

    Engine coolant temperature is between
    98°C (208°F) and 99°C (210°F)

    LOW

    Engine coolant temperature is 100°C
    (212°F) or more

    HIGH

    • Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm after the following conditions are met.
    — Engine: After warming up
    — Keeping the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at
    idle for 1 minute under no load

    ON

    • Power generation voltage variable control: Operating

    ON

    • Power generation voltage variable control: Not operating

    OFF

    • Turn drive wheels and compare CONSULT value with the speedometer indication.

    Almost the same speed as
    speedometer indication

    • Engine: running

    Idle air volume learning has not been performed yet.

    YET

    Idle air volume learning has already been
    performed successfully.

    CMPLT

    Vehicle has traveled after MIL has turned
    ON.

    0 — 65,535 km
    (0 — 40,723 miles)

    TRVL AFTER MIL

    • Ignition switch: ON

    ENG OIL TEMP

    • Engine: After warming up

    More than 70°C (158F)

    A/F S1 HTR (B1)

    • Engine: After warming up, idle the engine
    (More than 140 seconds after starting engine)

    4 — 100%

    ALT DUTY

    • Engine: Idle

    0 — 80%

    • Engine speed: Idle
    BAT CUR SEN




    Battery: Fully charged*
    Selector lever position: P or N (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    Air conditioner switch: OFF
    No load

    Approx 2,500 — 3,500 mV

    VHCL SPEED SE

    • Turn drive wheels and compare CONSULT value with the speedometer indication.

    Almost the same speed as
    speedometer indication

    A/F ADJ-B1

    • Engine running

    −0.330 — 0.330

    P/N POSI SW

    • Ignition switch: ON

    Selector lever position: P or N (CVT) or
    Neutral (M/T)

    ON

    Shift lever: Except above

    OFF

    INT/A TEMP SE

    • Ignition switch: ON

    Indicates intake air temperature

    AC PRESS SEN

    • Engine: Idle
    • Both A/C switch and blower fan switch: ON (Compressor operates.)

    1.0 — 4.0 V

    SET VHCL SPD

    • Engine: Running

    ASCD: Operating

    The preset vehicle speed is
    displayed

    MAIN SW

    • Ignition switch: ON

    MAIN switch: Pressed

    ON

    MAIN switch: Released

    OFF

    CANCEL SW

    • Ignition switch: ON

    CANCEL switch: Pressed

    ON

    CANCEL switch: Released

    OFF

    RESUME/ACC SW

    • Ignition switch: ON

    SET SW

    • Ignition switch: ON

    Revision: April 2013

    ACCEL/RES switch: Pressed

    ON

    ACCEL/RES switch: Released

    OFF

    COAST/SET switch: Pressed

    ON

    COAST/SET switch: Released

    OFF

    EC-64

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item

    Condition

    Values/Status

    BRAKE SW1
    (Brake pedal position switch)

    • Brake pedal: Fully released

    ON

    • Ignition switch: ON

    • Brake pedal: Slightly depressed

    OFF

    BRAKE SW2
    (Stop lamp switch)

    • Ignition switch: ON

    Brake pedal: Fully released

    OFF

    Brake pedal: Slightly depressed

    ON

    VHCL SPD CUT

    • Ignition switch: ON

    NON

    LO SPEED CUT

    • Ignition switch: ON

    NON

    AT OD MONITOR

    • Ignition switch: ON

    OFF

    AT OD CANCEL

    • Ignition switch: ON

    OFF

    CRUISE LAMP

    • Ignition switch: ON

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    MAIN switch: Pressed at the 1st time → at
    the 2nd time

    ON → OFF

    ASCD: Operating

    ON

    SET LAMP

    • MAIN switch: ON
    • When vehicle speed: Between
    30 km/h (19 MPH) and 170 km/h
    (105 MPH)

    ASCD: Not operating

    OFF

    Idle

    0 — 2%

    VTC DTY EX B1

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever: P or N (CVT) or
    Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    2,000 rpm

    Approx 0- 90%

    KICKDOWN POS

    • Ignition switch: ON

    Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    OFF

    Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    ON

    CLUTCH P/P SW

    • Ignition switch: ON

    Clutch pedal: Fully released

    OFF

    Clutch pedal: Fully depressed

    ON

    THRTL STK CNT B1

    Not used.

    HO2 S2 DIAG2(B1)

    NOTE:
    The item is indicated, but not used.

    EOP SENSOR

    • Engine: After warming up
    • Selector lever position: P or N
    (CVT) or Neutral (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    A/F SEN1
    DIAG2(B1)

    NOTE:
    The item is indicated, but not used.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    Idle

    Approx 1,000 — 2,000 mV

    2,000 rpm

    Approx 1,500 — 3,500 mV

    K

    L

    *: Accelerator pedal position sensor 2 signal and throttle position sensor 2 signal are converted by ECM internally. Thus, they differ from ECM terminals voltage signal.
    M

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    N

    O

    P

    PBIA9221J

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    NOTE:
    • ECM is located in the engine room left side near battery.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-65

    2014 Note

    ECM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    • When disconnecting ECM harness connector , loosen
    levers as far as they will go as shown in the figure.

    [HR16DE]
    it with

    : ECM
    : Fasten

    • Connect a break-out box and harness adapter between the ECM
    and ECM harness connector.
    — Use extreme care not to touch 2 pins at one time.
    — Data is for comparison and may not be exact.
    • Specification data are reference values and are measured
    between each terminals.
    • Pulse signal is measured by CONSULT.

    Terminal No.
    +

    JMBIA0029ZZ

    Description

    Signal name

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    2.6 V

    1
    (L)

    108
    (B)

    Throttle control motor
    (Open)

    Output

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Shift lever: D (CVT), 1st (M/T)
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed
    JMBIA0213GB

    2
    (L/W)

    108
    (B)

    Throttle control motor power
    supply

    Input

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)
    2.9 — 8.8 V

    3
    (G/W)

    108
    (B)

    A/F sensor 1 heater

    Output

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed
    (More than 140 seconds after starting engine)
    JSBIA0714GB

    1.8 V

    4
    (P)

    108
    (B)

    Throttle control motor
    (Close)

    Output

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Shift lever: D (CVT), 1st (M/T)
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully released
    JMBIA0215GB

    5
    (BR/
    W)

    59
    (L/Y)

    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    heater

    Output

    [Engine is running]
    • Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm after the following conditions are met
    — Engine: after warming up
    — Keeping the engine speed between
    3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute
    and at idle for 1 minute under no
    load
    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    [Engine is running]
    • Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-66

    10 V

    JMBIA0214GB

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    +

    Description

    Signal name

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    A

    BATTERY VOLTAGE

    EC

    (11 — 14 V)
    [Engine is running]
    • Idle speed

    9
    (SB)

    108
    (B)

    EVAP canister purge volume
    control solenoid valve

    C

    JMBIA0039GB

    Output

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    E

    [Engine is running]
    • Engine speed: About 2,000 rpm
    (More than 100 seconds after starting engine.)

    F

    JMBIA0216GB

    10
    (B)

    ECM ground

    11
    (B/Y)

    ECM ground

    12
    (L/W)

    Fuel injector No. 3 (Rear)

    20
    (O/W)

    Fuel injector No. 2 (Rear)

    24
    (R)
    25
    (R)

    H

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed
    NOTE:
    The pulse cycle changes depending
    on rpm at idle

    (11 — 14 V)

    I

    J

    Fuel injector No. 4 (Rear)
    108
    (B)

    JMBIA0221GB

    Output

    Fuel injector No. 3 (Front)

    30
    (O)

    Fuel injector No. 2 (Front)

    31
    (L)

    Fuel injector No. 1 (Front)

    K

    BATTERY VOLTAGE

    Fuel injector No. 4 (Front)

    29
    (G)

    15
    (G/W)

    G

    BATTERY VOLTAGE

    Fuel injector No. 1 (Rear)

    16
    (G)

    D

    (11 — 14 V)

    L

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Engine speed: 2,000 rpm

    M
    JMBIA0222GB

    108
    (B)

    Throttle control motor relay

    Output

    [Ignition switch: OFF]

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    0 — 1.0 V

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-67

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    +

    Description

    Signal name

    17
    (V)

    Ignition signal No. 1

    18
    (Y/B)

    Ignition signal No. 2

    21
    (W)

    108
    (B)

    22
    (BR)

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    0 — 0.3 V
    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed
    NOTE:
    The pulse cycle changes depending
    on rpm at idle
    JMBIA0219GB

    Output
    0.2 — 0.5 V

    Ignition signal No. 4
    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Engine speed: 2,500 rpm

    Ignition signal No. 3

    JMBIA0220GB

    23
    (GR)

    32
    (P)

    33
    (W)

    34
    (B)

    108
    (B)

    108
    (B)

    36
    (R)

    36
    (R)

    Fuel pump relay

    ECM relay
    (Self shut-off)

    Throttle position sensor 1

    Throttle position sensor 2

    Output

    Output

    Input

    Input

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • For 1 second after turning ignition
    switch ON
    [Engine is running]

    0 — 1.0 V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • More than 1 second after turning ignition switch ON

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    [Engine is running]
    [Ignition switch: OFF]
    • A few seconds after turning ignition
    switch OFF

    0 — 1.0 V

    [Ignition switch: OFF]
    • More than a few seconds after turning ignition switch OFF

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Shift lever: D (CVT), 1st (M/T)
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    More than 0.36 V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Shift lever: D (CVT), 1st (M/T)
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    Less than 4.75 V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Shift lever: D (CVT), 1st (M/T)
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    Less than 4.75 V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Shift lever: D (CVT), 1st (M/T)
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    More than 0.36 V

    36
    (R)

    Sensor ground
    (Throttle position sensor)

    37
    (W)

    40
    (L)

    Knock sensor

    Input

    [Engine is running]
    • Idle speed

    2.5 V

    38
    (LG/B)

    44
    (P)

    Engine coolant temperature
    sensor

    Input

    [Engine is running]

    0 — 4.8 V
    Output voltage varies with battery
    temperature.

    40
    (L)

    Sensor ground
    (Knock sensor shield circuit)

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-68

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.

    Description

    +

    Signal name

    Input/
    Output

    44
    (P)

    Sensor ground
    (Engine coolant temperature
    sensor)

    45
    (G/B)

    46
    (V)

    47
    (Y)

    52
    (L/G)

    52
    (LG)

    60
    (L)

    Mass air flow sensor

    Intake air temperature sensor

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    Input

    Input

    Input

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    A

    EC

    [Ignition switch ON]
    • Engine stopped

    0.4V

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed

    0.8 — 1.3 V

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Engine is revving from idle to about
    4,000 rpm

    0.8 — 1.3 to 2.4 V
    (Check for linear voltage rise in
    response to engine being increased to about 4,000 rpm.)

    E

    [Engine is running]

    0 — 4.8 V
    Output voltage varies with intake
    air temperature.

    F

    C

    D

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed

    1.0 — 2.0 V

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Engine speed: 2,000 rpm

    1.5 — 3.5 V

    G

    H
    4.3 V

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed
    NOTE:
    The pulse cycle changes depending
    on rpm at idle
    48
    (W/R)

    63
    (W)

    Exhaust valve timing control
    position sensor

    I

    J
    JSBIA0716GB

    Input
    4.3 V

    K

    [Engine is running]
    • Engine speed: 2,000 rpm

    L
    JSBIA0717GB

    49
    (G)

    50
    (L/R)

    108
    (B)

    59
    (L/Y)

    52
    (LG)

    53
    (L)

    108
    (B)

    A/F sensor 1

    Heated oxygen sensor 2

    Sensor ground
    (Mass air flow sensor/Intake
    air temperature sensor)
    A/F sensor 1

    Revision: April 2013

    Input

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    Input

    [Engine is running]
    • Revving engine from idle to 3,000
    rpm quickly after the following conditions are met
    — Engine: after warming up
    — Keeping the engine speed between
    3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute
    and at idle for 1 minute under no
    load

    0 — 1.0 V

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Engine speed: 2,500 rpm

    1.8 V
    Output voltage varies with air fuel
    ratio.

    Input

    EC-69

    M

    2.2 V

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.

    Description

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    +

    Signal name

    Input/
    Output

    54
    (BR)

    Sensor ground
    (Engine oil temperature sensor)

    55
    (G/L)

    Sensor ground
    (Intake air l temperature
    sensor)

    57
    (P)

    54
    (BR)

    [Engine is running]

    0 — 4.8 V
    Output voltage varies with engine
    oil temperature.

    59
    (L/Y)

    Sensor ground
    (Heated oxygen sensor 2)

    60
    (L)

    Sensor ground
    (Engine oil pressure sensor)

    Engine oil temperature sensor

    Input

    4.0 V
    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed
    NOTE:
    The pulse cycle changes depending
    on rpm at idle
    61
    (L/O)

    62
    (G)

    Crankshaft position sensor
    (POS)

    JMBIA2185GB

    Input
    4.0 V

    [Engine is running]
    • Engine speed: 2,000 rpm

    JMBIA2186GB

    62
    (G)

    63
    (W)

    Sensor ground
    [Crankshaft position sensor
    (POS)]

    Sensor ground
    [Camshaft position sensor
    (PHASE), exhaust valve timing control position sensor]

    4.3 V
    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed
    NOTE:
    The pulse cycle changes depending
    on rpm at idle
    65
    (R/W)

    63
    (W)

    Camshaft position sensor
    (PHASE)

    JSBIA0718GB

    Input
    4.3 V

    [Engine is running]
    • Engine speed is 2,000 rpm

    JSBIA0719GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-70

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    +

    69
    (BR)

    72
    (G)

    Description

    108
    (B)

    36
    (R)

    Signal name

    PNP signal

    Sensor power supply
    (Throttle position sensor)

    Value
    (Approx.)

    A

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Shift lever: P or N (CVT), Neutral (M/
    T)

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    EC

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Shift lever: Except above position

    0V

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    5V

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Input

    C

    D

    E

    7 — 10 V
    73
    (P)

    108
    (B)

    Intake valve timing control
    solenoid valve

    Output

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • When revving engine up to
    2,000rpm quickly

    F

    JSBIA0720GB

    74
    (O)

    60
    (W)

    Sensor power supply
    (Engine oil pressure sensor)

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    5V

    75
    (O)

    62
    (G)

    Sensor power supply
    [Crankshaft position sensor
    (POS)]

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    5V

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Idle speed

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    H

    I

    J

    7 — 10 V
    77
    (P/W)

    108
    (B)

    Exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve

    Output

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • When revving engine up to
    2,000rpm quickly

    K

    JSBIA0720GB

    78
    (BR)

    63
    (W)

    Sensor power supply
    [Camshaft position sensor
    (PHASE), exhaust valve timing control position sensor]

    81
    (V)

    108
    (B)

    Power supply for ECM
    (Back-up)

    83
    (P)

    CAN-L

    84
    (L)

    CAN-H

    85
    (V)

    98
    (LG)

    88
    (GR)

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    Data link connector

    Revision: April 2013

    G

    L

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    5V

    Input

    [Ignition switch: OFF]

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    Input/
    Output

    Input/
    Output

    O

    [Engine is running]
    • Warm-up condition
    • Both A/C switch and blower fan
    switch: ON (Compressor operates)

    1.0 — 4.0 V

    P

    Input

    Input/
    Output

    EC-71

    M

    2014 Note

    N

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    +

    92
    (R)

    108
    (B)

    93
    (L)

    108
    (B)

    94
    (Y)

    Description

    95
    (B)

    Signal name

    Clutch pedal position switch

    Ignition switch

    ASCD steering switch

    Input

    Input

    Input

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Clutch pedal: Slightly depressed

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Clutch pedal: Fully released

    0V

    [Ignition switch: OFF]

    0V

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • ASCD steering switch: OFF

    4V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • MAIN switch: Pressed

    0V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • CANCEL switch: Pressed

    1V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • COAST/SET switch: Pressed

    2V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • ACCEL/RES switch: Pressed

    3V

    95
    (B)

    Sensor ground
    (ASCD steering switch)

    98
    (LG)

    Sensor ground
    (Refrigerant pressure sensor)

    99
    (LG)

    108
    (B)

    [Ignition switch: OFF]
    • Brake pedal: Fully released

    0V

    [Ignition switch: OFF]
    • Brake pedal: Slightly depressed

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    100
    (G)

    108
    (B)

    0V

    Brake pedal position switch

    Input

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Brake pedal: Slightly depressed
    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Brake pedal: Fully released

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    101
    (W)

    98
    (LG)

    Sensor power supply
    (Refrigerant pressure sensor)

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    5V

    102
    (BR)

    104
    (Y)

    Sensor power supply
    (Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 2)

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    5V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    0.3 — 0.6 V

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    1.95 — 2.4 V

    Input

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    BATTERY VOLTAGE
    (11 — 14 V)

    103
    (GR)

    104
    (Y)

    Stop lamp switch

    Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 2

    Sensor ground
    (Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 2)

    Input

    Input

    104
    (Y)

    105
    (G)

    108
    (B)

    Power supply for ECM

    106
    (V)

    111
    (GR)

    Sensor power supply
    (Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 1)

    [Ignition switch: ON]

    5V

    108
    (B)

    ECM ground

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-72

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    +

    110
    (SB)

    Description

    111
    (P)

    111
    (P)

    Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 1

    Input

    Sensor ground
    (Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 1)

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Signal name

    A

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully released

    0.6 — 0.9 V

    EC

    [Ignition switch: ON]
    • Engine stopped
    • Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed

    3.9 — 4.7 V

    C

    D

    : Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)

    Fail Safe

    INFOID:0000000009022473

    NON DTC RELATED ITEM
    Detected
    items

    Engine operating condition
    in fail-safe mode

    Malfunction
    indicator
    lamp circuit

    Engine speed will not rise
    more than 2,500 rpm due
    to the fuel cut

    E

    F
    Remarks

    Reference page

    When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the
    driver by lighting up MIL when there is malfunction on engine control
    system.
    Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related
    diagnoses are continuously detected as NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the
    driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open
    by means of operating fail safe function.
    The fail safe function also operates when above diagnoses except MIL
    circuit are detected and demands the driver to repair the malfunction.

    G
    EC-324, «Component Function
    Check»

    H

    I

    DTC RELATED ITEM
    J
    DTC No.

    Detected items

    Engine operating condition in fail safe mode

    P0011

    Intake valve timing control

    The signal is not energized to the intake valve timing control solenoid valve and the valve
    control does not function.

    P0014

    Exhaust valve timing control

    The signal is not energized to the exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve and the valve
    control does not function.

    P0102
    P0103

    Mass air flow sensor circuit

    Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.

    L

    P0117
    P0118

    Engine coolant temperature
    sensor circuit

    Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the following conditions.
    CONSULT displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.

    M

    Condition

    Engine coolant temperature decided
    (CONSULT display)

    Just as ignition switch is turned ON or START

    40°C (104°F)

    Approx. 4 minutes or more after engine starting

    80°C (176°F)

    Except as shown above

    40 — 80°C (104 — 176°F)
    (Depends on the time)

    K

    N

    O

    When the fail safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling
    fan operates while engine is running.
    P0122
    P0123
    P0222
    P0223
    P2135

    Throttle position sensor

    The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in
    order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
    The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal
    condition.
    So, the acceleration will be poor.

    P0197
    P0198

    Engine oil temperature sensor

    Exhaust valve timing control does not function.

    P0500

    Vehicle speed sensor

    The cooling fan operates (Highest) while engine is running.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-73

    2014 Note

    P

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    DTC No.

    Detected items

    Engine operating condition in fail safe mode

    P0605

    ECM

    (When ECM calculation function is malfunctioning:)
    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P0643

    Sensor power supply

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P1805

    Brake switch

    ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to a
    small range.
    Therefore, acceleration will be poor.
    Vehicle condition

    Driving condition

    When engine is idling

    Normal

    When accelerating

    Poor acceleration

    P2100
    P2103

    Throttle control motor relay

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P2101

    Electric throttle control function

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P2118

    Throttle control motor

    ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
    fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.

    P2119

    Electric throttle control actuator

    (When electric throttle control actuator does not function properly due to the return spring
    malfunction:)
    ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the
    idle position. The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
    (When throttle valve opening angle in fail safe mode is not in specified range:)
    ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20
    degrees or less.
    (When ECM detects the throttle valve is stuck open:)
    While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the
    engine stalls.
    The engine can restart in the Neutral position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm
    or more.

    P2122
    P2123
    P2127
    P2128
    P2138

    Accelerator pedal position sensor

    The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in
    order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
    The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal
    condition.
    So, the acceleration will be poor.

    DTC Inspection Priority Chart

    INFOID:0000000009022474

    If some DTCs are displayed at the same time, perform inspections one by one based on the following priority
    chart.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-74

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Priority

    1

    2

    3

    DTC

    Detected items

    U0101, U1001

    CAN communication line

    P0102, P0103

    Mass air flow sensor

    P0112, P0113

    Intake air temperature sensor

    P0117, P0118

    Engine coolant temperature sensor

    P0122, P0123, P0222, P0223, P1225, P1226, P2135

    Throttle position sensor

    P0197, P0198

    Engine oil temperature sensor

    P0327, P0328

    Knock sensor

    P0335

    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    P0340

    Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)

    P0500

    Vehicle speed sensor

    P0520

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    P0605, P0607

    ECM

    P0643

    Sensor power supply

    P0850

    Park/neutral position (PNP) switch

    P1610 — P1615

    NATS

    P2122, P2123, P2127, P2128, P2138

    Accelerator pedal position sensor

    P0031, P0032

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1 heater

    P0037, P0038

    Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    P0075

    Intake valve timing control solenoid valve

    P0078

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve

    P0130, P0131, P0132, P0133

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1

    P0137, P0138, P0139

    Heated oxygen sensor 2

    P0444

    EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve

    P0603

    ECM

    P0710, P0715, P0720, P0740, P0744, P0745, P0746,
    P0776, P0778, P0840, P1740, P1777, P1778

    CVT related sensors, solenoid valves and switches

    P1078

    Exhaust camshaft position sensor

    P1217

    Engine over temperature (OVERHEAT)

    P1805

    Brake switch

    P2100, P2103

    Throttle control motor relay

    P2101

    Electric throttle control function

    P2118

    Throttle control motor

    P0011

    Intake valve timing control

    P0014

    Exhaust valve timing control

    P0171, P0172

    Fuel injection system function

    P0300 — P0304

    Misfire

    P0420

    Three way catalyst function

    P0524

    Engine oil pressure

    P1564

    ASCD steering switch

    P1572

    ASCD brake switch

    P1574

    ASCD vehicle speed sensor

    P1715

    Input speed sensor

    P1720

    Vehicle speed sensor

    P2119

    Electric throttle control actuator

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-75

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    DTC Index

    INFOID:0000000009022475

    ×:Applicable —: Not applicable

    DTC*1
    CONSULT
    GST*2

    ECM*3

    Items
    (CONSULT screen terms)

    SRT code

    Trip

    MIL

    Reference page

    LOST COMM (TCM)

    1

    ×

    EC-140

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    2

    EC-141

    U0101

    0101

    U1001

    1001*4

    P0000

    0000

    NO DTC IS DETECTED.
    FURTHER TESTING MAY BE REQUIRED.

    P0011

    0011

    INT/V TIM CONT-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-142

    P0014

    0014

    EXT/V TIM CONT-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-146

    P0031

    0031

    A/F SEN1 HTR (B1)

    2

    ×

    EC-149

    P0032

    0032

    A/F SEN1 HTR (B1)

    2

    ×

    EC-149

    P0037

    0037

    HO2S2 HTR (B1)

    2

    ×

    EC-151

    P0038

    0038

    HO2S2 HTR (B1)

    2

    ×

    EC-151

    P0075

    0075

    INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-153

    P0078

    0078

    EX V/T ACT/CIRC-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-155

    P0102

    0102

    MAF SEN/CIRCUIT-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-158

    P0103

    0103

    MAF SEN/CIRCUIT-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-158

    P0112

    0112

    IAT SEN/CIRCUIT-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-163

    P0113

    0113

    IAT SEN/CIRCUIT-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-163

    P0117

    0117

    ECT SEN/CIRC

    1

    ×

    EC-165

    P0118

    0118

    ECT SEN/CIRC

    1

    ×

    EC-165

    P0122

    0122

    TP SEN 2/CIRC-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-167

    P0123

    0123

    TP SEN 2/CIRC-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-167

    P0130

    0130

    A/F SENSOR1 (B1)

    ×

    2

    ×

    EC-170

    P0131

    0131

    A/F SENSOR1 (B1)

    2

    ×

    EC-173

    P0132

    0132

    A/F SENSOR1 (B1)

    2

    ×

    EC-176

    P0133

    0133

    A/F SENSOR1 (B1)

    ×

    2

    ×

    EC-179

    P0137

    0137

    HO2S2 (B1)

    ×

    2

    ×

    EC-183

    P0138

    0138

    HO2S2 (B1)

    ×

    2

    ×

    EC-188

    P0139

    0139

    HO2S2 (B1)

    ×

    2

    ×

    EC-196

    P0171

    0171

    FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-201

    P0172

    0172

    FUEL SYS-RICH-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-205

    P0196

    0196

    EOP SEN/CIR

    2

    ×

    EC-209

    P0197

    0197

    EOP SEN/CIRC

    2

    ×

    EC-211

    P0198

    0198

    EOP SEN/CIRC

    2

    ×

    EC-211

    P0222

    0222

    TP SEN 1/CIRC-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-213

    P0223

    0223

    TP SEN 1/CIRC-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-213

    P0300

    0300

    MULTI CYL MISFIRE

    1 or 2

    × or —

    EC-216

    P0301

    0301

    CYL 1 MISFIRE

    1 or 2

    × or —

    EC-216

    P0302

    0302

    CYL 2 MISFIRE

    1 or 2

    × or —

    EC-216

    P0303

    0303

    CYL 3 MISFIRE

    1 or 2

    × or —

    EC-216

    P0304

    0304

    CYL 4 MISFIRE

    1 or 2

    × or —

    EC-216

    P0327

    0327

    KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1

    2

    EC-222

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-76

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    DTC*1
    CONSULT
    GST*2

    Items
    (CONSULT screen terms)

    ECM*3

    SRT code

    Trip

    MIL

    Reference page

    P0328

    0328

    KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1

    2

    EC-222

    P0335

    0335

    CKP SEN/CIRCUIT

    2

    ×

    EC-224

    P0340

    0340

    CMP SEN/CIRC-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-228

    P0420

    0420

    TW CATALYST SYS-B1

    ×

    2

    ×

    EC-232

    P0444

    0444

    PURG VOLUME CONT/V

    2

    ×

    EC-237

    P0500

    0500

    VEHICLE SPEED SEN A*5

    2

    ×

    EC-240

    P0520

    0520

    EOP SENSOR/SWITCH

    2

    EC-242

    P0524

    0524

    ENGINE OIL PRESSURE

    1

    EC-244

    P0603

    0603

    ECM BACK UP/CIRCUIT*6

    2

    ×

    EC-247

    P0605

    0605

    ECM

    1 or 2

    × or —

    EC-249

    P0607

    0607

    ECM

    P0643

    0643

    SENSOR POWER/CIRC

    P0850

    0850

    P1078

    1*

    7

    ×*

    7

    EC-251

    2*8

    —*8

    1

    ×

    EC-252

    P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT

    2

    ×

    EC-254

    1078

    EXH TIM SEN/CIRC-B1

    2

    ×

    EC-257

    P1217

    1217

    ENG OVER TEMP

    1

    ×

    EC-260

    P1225

    1225

    CTP LEARNING-B1

    2

    EC-263

    P1226

    1226

    CTP LEARNING-B1

    2

    EC-264

    P1564

    1564

    ASCD SW

    1

    EC-265

    P1572

    1572

    ASCD BRAKE SW

    1

    EC-268

    P1574

    1574

    ASCD VHL SPD SEN

    1

    EC-273

    P1610

    1610

    LOCK MODE

    2

    SEC-62

    P1611

    1611

    ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM

    2

    SEC-63

    P1612

    1612

    CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU

    2

    SEC-64

    P1715

    1715

    IN PULY SPEED

    2

    EC-275

    P1720

    1720

    V/SP SEN (A/T OUT)

    2

    EC-276

    P1805

    1805

    BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT

    2

    EC-278

    P2100

    2100

    ETC MOT PWR-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-280

    P2101

    2101

    ETC FNCTN/CIRC-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-283

    P2103

    2103

    ETC MOT PWR

    1

    ×

    EC-280

    P2118

    2118

    ETC MOT-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-287

    P2119

    2119

    ETC ACTR-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-289

    P2122

    2122

    APP SEN 1/CIRC

    1

    ×

    EC-291

    P2123

    2123

    APP SEN 1/CIRC

    1

    ×

    EC-291

    P2127

    2127

    APP SEN 2/CIRC

    1

    ×

    EC-294

    P2128

    2128

    APP SEN 2/CIRC

    1

    ×

    EC-294

    P2135

    2135

    TP SENSOR-B1

    1

    ×

    EC-297

    P2138

    2138

    APP SENSOR

    1

    ×

    EC-300

    *1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
    *2: This number is prescribed by SAE J1979/ ISO 15031-5.
    *3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), this number is controlled by NISSAN.
    *4: The troubleshooting for this DTC needs CONSULT.
    *5: When the fail-safe operations for both self-diagnoses occur, the MIL illuminates.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-77

    2014 Note

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    *6: This self-diagnosis is not for ECM power supply circuit, even though “ECM BACK UP/CIRCUIT” is displayed on CONSULT screen.
    *7: CVT models.
    *8: M/T models.

    Test Value and Test Limit

    INFOID:0000000009421403

    The following is the information specified in Service $06 of SAE J1979/ISO 15031-5.
    The test value is a parameter used to determine whether a system/circuit diagnostic test is OK or NG while
    being monitored by the ECM during self-diagnosis. The test limit is a reference value which is specified as the
    maximum or minimum value and is compared with the test value being monitored.
    These data (test value and test limit) are specified by On Board Monitor ID (OBDMID), Test ID (TID), Unit and
    Scaling ID and can be displayed on the GST screen.
    The items of the test value and test limit will be displayed with GST screen which items are provided by the
    ECM. (e.g., if bank 2 is not applied on this vehicle, only the items of bank 1 are displayed)

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-78

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Item

    HO2S

    OBDMID

    01H

    Self-diagnostic test item

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    (Bank 1)

    DTC

    Test value and Test
    limit
    (GST display)

    A
    Description

    TID

    Unit and
    Scaling
    ID

    P0131

    83H

    0BH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0131

    84H

    0BH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0130

    85H

    0BH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0130

    86H

    0BH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0133

    87H

    04H

    Response rate: Response ratio (lean
    to rich)

    P0133

    88H

    04H

    Response rate: Response ratio (rich to
    lean)

    P2A00 or P2096

    89H

    84H

    The amount of shift in air fuel ratio (too
    lean)

    P2A00 or P2097

    8AH

    84H

    The amount of shift in air fuel ratio (too
    rich)

    P0130

    8BH

    0BH

    Difference in sensor output voltage

    P0133

    8CH

    83H

    Response gain at the limited frequency

    P014C

    8DH

    04H

    O2 sensor slow response — Rich to
    lean bank 1 sensor 1

    P014C

    8EH

    04H

    O2 sensor slow response — Rich to
    lean bank 1 sensor 1

    P014D

    8FH

    84H

    O2 sensor slow response — Lean to rich
    bank 1 sensor 1

    P014D

    90H

    84H

    O2 sensor slow response — Lean to rich
    bank 1 sensor 1

    P015A

    91H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Rich to
    lean bank 1 sensor 1

    P015A

    92H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Rich to
    lean bank 1 sensor 1

    P015B

    93H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Lean to
    rich bank 1 sensor 1

    EC

    P015B

    94H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Lean to
    rich bank 1 sensor 1

    P0133

    95H

    04H

    Response rate: Response ratio (lean
    to rich)

    P0133

    96H

    84H

    Response rate: Response ratio (rich to
    lean)

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-79

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Item

    OBDMID

    02H

    03H

    Self-diagnostic test item

    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    (Bank 1)

    Heated oxygen sensor 3
    (Bank 1)

    HO2S

    05H

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    (Bank 2)

    Revision: April 2013

    DTC

    Test value and Test
    limit
    (GST display)

    Description

    TID

    Unit and
    Scaling
    ID

    P0138

    07H

    0CH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0137

    08H

    0CH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0138

    80H

    0CH

    Sensor output voltage

    P0139

    81H

    0CH

    Difference in sensor output voltage

    P0139

    82H

    11H

    Rear O2 sensor delay response diagnosis

    P0143

    07H

    0CH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0144

    08H

    0CH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0146

    80H

    0CH

    Sensor output voltage

    P0145

    81H

    0CH

    Difference in sensor output voltage

    P0151

    83H

    0BH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0151

    84H

    0BH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0150

    85H

    0BH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0150

    86H

    0BH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0153

    87H

    04H

    Response rate: Response ratio (lean
    to rich)

    P0153

    88H

    04H

    Response rate: Response ratio (rich to
    lean)

    P2A03 or P2098

    89H

    84H

    The amount of shift in air fuel ratio (too
    lean)

    P2A03 or P2099

    8AH

    84H

    The amount of shift in air fuel ratio (too
    rich)

    P0150

    8BH

    0BH

    Difference in sensor output voltage

    P0153

    8CH

    83H

    Response gain at the limited frequency

    P014E

    8DH

    04H

    O2 sensor slow response — Rich to
    lean bank 2 sensor 1

    P014E

    8EH

    04H

    O2 sensor slow response — Rich to
    lean bank 2 sensor 1

    P014F

    8FH

    84H

    O2 sensor slow response — Lean to rich
    bank 2 sensor 1

    P014F

    90H

    84H

    O2 sensor slow response — Lean to rich
    bank 2 sensor 1

    P015C

    91H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Rich to
    lean bank 2 sensor 1

    P015C

    92H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Rich to
    lean bank 2 sensor 1

    P015D

    93H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Lean to
    rich bank 2 sensor 1

    EC-80

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Item

    OBDMID

    Self-diagnostic test item

    DTC

    P015D
    05H

    HO2S

    06H

    07H

    21H

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    (Bank 2)

    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    (Bank 2)

    Heated oxygen sensor 3
    (Bank2)

    Three way catalyst function
    (Bank1)

    CATALYST

    22H

    EGR
    SYSTEM

    31H

    Three way catalyst function
    (Bank2)

    EGR function

    Revision: April 2013

    Test value and Test
    limit
    (GST display)

    A
    Description

    TID

    Unit and
    Scaling
    ID

    94H

    01H

    O2 sensor delayed response — Lean to
    rich bank 2 sensor 1

    EC

    P0153

    95H

    04H

    Response rate: Response ratio (lean
    to rich)

    P0153

    96H

    84H

    Response rate: Response ratio (rich to
    lean)

    P0158

    07H

    0CH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0157

    08H

    0CH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0158

    80H

    0CH

    Sensor output voltage

    P0159

    81H

    0CH

    Difference in sensor output voltage

    P0159

    82H

    11H

    Rear O2 sensor delay response diagnosis

    P0163

    07H

    0CH

    Minimum sensor output voltage for test
    cycle

    P0164

    08H

    0CH

    Maximum sensor output voltage for
    test cycle

    P0166

    80H

    0CH

    Sensor output voltage

    P0165

    81H

    0CH

    Difference in sensor output voltage

    P0420

    80H

    01H

    O2 storage index

    P0420

    82H

    01H

    Switching time lag engine exhaust index value

    P2423

    83H

    0CH

    Difference in 3rd O2 sensor output
    voltage

    P2423

    84H

    84H

    O2 storage index in HC trap catalyst

    P0430

    80H

    01H

    O2 storage index

    P0430

    82H

    01H

    Switching time lag engine exhaust index value

    P2424

    83H

    0CH

    Difference in 3rd O2 sensor output
    voltage

    P2424

    84H

    84H

    O2 storage index in HC trap catalyst

    P0400

    80H

    96H

    Low flow faults: EGR temp change rate
    (short term)

    P0400

    81H

    96H

    Low flow faults: EGR temp change rate
    (long term)

    P0400

    82H

    96H

    Low flow faults: Difference between
    max EGR temp and EGR temp under
    idling condition

    P0400

    83H

    96H

    Low flow faults: Max EGR temp

    P1402

    84H

    96H

    High Flow Faults: EGR temp increase
    rate

    EC-81

    2014 Note

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Item

    OBDMID

    35H

    Self-diagnostic test item

    VVT Monitor (Bank1)

    VVT
    SYSTEM

    36H

    EVAP
    SYSTEM

    VVT Monitor (Bank2)

    DTC

    Test value and Test
    limit
    (GST display)

    Description

    TID

    Unit and
    Scaling
    ID

    P0011

    80H

    9DH

    VTC intake function diagnosis (VTC
    alignment check diagnosis)

    P0014

    81H

    9DH

    VTC exhaust function diagnosis (VTC
    alignment check diagnosis)

    P0011

    82H

    9DH

    VTC intake function diagnosis (VTC
    drive failure diagnosis)

    P0014

    83H

    9DH

    VTC exhaust function diagnosis (VTC
    drive failure diagnosis)

    P100A

    84H

    10H

    VEL slow response diagnosis

    P1090

    85H

    10H

    VEL servo system diagnosis

    P0011

    86H

    9DH

    VTC intake intermediate lock function
    diagnosis (VTC intermediate position
    alignment check diagnosis)

    Advanced: P052A
    Retarded: P052B

    87H

    9DH

    VTC intake intermediate lock system
    diagnosis (VTC intermediate lock position check diagnosis)

    P0021

    80H

    9DH

    VTC intake function diagnosis (VTC
    alignment check diagnosis)

    P0024

    81H

    9DH

    VTC exhaust function diagnosis (VTC
    alignment check diagnosis)

    P0021

    82H

    9DH

    VTC intake function diagnosis (VTC
    drive failure diagnosis)

    P0024

    83H

    9DH

    VTC exhaust function diagnosis (VTC
    drive failure diagnosis)

    P100B

    84H

    10H

    VEL slow response diagnosis

    P1093

    85H

    10H

    VEL servo system diagnosis

    P0021

    86H

    9DH

    VTC intake intermediate lock function
    diagnosis (VTC intermediate position
    alignment check diagnosis)

    Advanced: P052C
    Retarded: P052D

    87H

    9DH

    VTC intake intermediate lock system
    diagnosis (VTC intermediate lock position check diagnosis)

    39H

    EVAP control system leak
    (Cap Off)

    P0455

    80H

    0CH

    Difference in pressure sensor output
    voltage before and after pull down

    3BH

    EVAP control system leak
    (Small leak)

    P0442

    80H

    05H

    Leak area index (for more than 0.04
    inch)

    P0456

    80H

    05H

    Leak area index (for more than 0.02
    inch)

    P0456

    81H

    FDH

    Maximum internal pressure of EVAP
    system during monitoring

    P0456

    82H

    FDH

    Internal pressure of EVAP system at
    the end of monitoring

    P0441

    83H

    0CH

    Difference in pressure sensor output
    voltage before and after vent control
    valve close

    3CH

    3DH

    EVAP control system leak
    (Very small leak)

    Purge flow system

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-82

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Item

    O2 SENSOR
    HEATER

    SECONDARY AIR

    OBDMID

    Self-diagnostic test item

    DTC

    Test value and Test
    limit
    (GST display)

    A
    Description

    TID

    Unit and
    Scaling
    ID

    81H

    0BH

    Converted value of heater electric current to voltage

    EC

    41H

    A/F sensor 1 heater (Bank 1)

    Low Input: P0031
    High Input: P0032

    42H

    Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater (Bank 1)

    Low Input: P0037
    High Input: P0038

    80H

    0CH

    Converted value of heater electric current to voltage

    43H

    Heated oxygen sensor 3 heater (Bank 1)

    P0043

    80H

    0CH

    Converted value of heater electric current to voltage

    45H

    A/F sensor 1 heater (Bank 2)

    Low Input: P0051
    High Input: P0052

    81H

    0BH

    Converted value of heater electric current to voltage

    46H

    Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater (Bank 2)

    Low Input: P0057
    High Input: P0058

    80H

    0CH

    Converted value of heater electric current to voltage

    47H

    Heated oxygen sensor 3 heater (Bank 2)

    P0063

    80H

    0CH

    Converted value of heater electric current to voltage

    P0411

    80H

    01H

    Secondary air injection system incorrect flow detected

    Bank1: P0491
    Bank2: P0492

    81H

    01H

    Secondary air injection system insufficient flow

    P2445

    82H

    01H

    Secondary air injection system pump
    stuck off

    P2448

    83H

    01H

    Secondary air injection system high
    airflow

    Bank1: P2440
    Bank2: P2442

    84H

    01H

    Secondary air injection system switching valve stuck open

    P2440

    85H

    01H

    Secondary air injection system switching valve stuck open

    P2444

    86H

    01H

    Secondary air injection system pump
    stuck on

    P0171 or P0172

    80H

    2FH

    Long term fuel trim

    P0171 or P0172

    81H

    24H

    The number of lambda control
    clamped

    P117A

    82H

    03H

    Cylinder A/F imbalance monitoring

    P0174 or P0175

    80H

    2FH

    Long term fuel trim

    P0174 or P0175

    81H

    24H

    The number of lambda control
    clamped

    P117B

    82H

    03H

    Cylinder A/F imbalance monitoring

    71H

    81H

    Secondary air system

    Fuel injection system function
    (Bank 1)

    FUEL
    SYSTEM
    82H

    Fuel injection system function
    (Bank 2)

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-83

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Item

    MISFIRE

    OBDMID

    A1H

    Self-diagnostic test item

    DTC

    Test value and Test
    limit
    (GST display)
    TID

    P0301

    80H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the first cylinder

    P0302

    81H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the second cylinder

    P0303

    82H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the third cylinder

    P0304

    83H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the fourth cylinder

    P0305

    84H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the fifth cylinder

    P0306

    85H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the sixth cylinder

    P0307

    86H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the seventh cylinder

    P0308

    87H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the eighth cylinder

    P0300

    88H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the multiple cylinders

    P0301

    89H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the first cylinder

    P0302

    8AH

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the second cylinder

    P0303

    8BH

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the third cylinder

    P0304

    8CH

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the fourth cylinder

    P0305

    8DH

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the fifth cylinder

    P0306

    8EH

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the sixth cylinder

    P0307

    8FH

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the seventh cylinder

    P0308

    90H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the eighth cylinder

    P0300

    91H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 1000 revolution of
    the single cylinder

    P0300

    92H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the single cylinder

    P0300

    93H

    24H

    Misfiring counter at 200 revolution of
    the multiple cylinders

    Multiple cylinder misfires

    Revision: April 2013

    Description

    Unit and
    Scaling
    ID

    EC-84

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Item

    OBDMID

    A2H

    A3H

    A4H

    Self-diagnostic test item

    DTC

    A7H

    A8H

    A9H

    Description

    TID

    P0301

    0BH

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    P0301

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    No. 1 cylinder misfire

    EC

    P0302

    0BH

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    P0302

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    P0303

    0BH

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    P0303

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    No. 2 cylinder misfire

    No. 3 cylinder misfire

    0BH

    No. 4 cylinder misfire

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    P0304

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    P0305

    0BH

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    P0305

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    J

    P0306

    0BH

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    K

    MISFIRE

    A6H

    A

    Unit and
    Scaling
    ID

    P0304
    A5H

    Test value and Test
    limit
    (GST display)

    No. 5 cylinder misfire

    No. 6 cylinder misfire

    I

    P0306

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    0BH

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    L

    P0307

    P0307

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    M

    P0308

    0BH

    24H

    EWMA (Exponential Weighted Moving
    Average) misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles

    P0308

    0CH

    24H

    Misfire counts for last/current driving
    cycles

    No. 7 cylinder misfire

    No. 8 cylinder misfire

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-85

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009022477

    ABBWA1067GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-86

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBWA1068GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-87

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBWA1069GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-88

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBWA1070GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-89

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBWA1071GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-90

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBWA1072GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-91

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1659GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-92

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBIA1660GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-93

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1661GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-94

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBIA1662GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-95

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1663GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-96

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBIA1664GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-97

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1665GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-98

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBIA1666GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-99

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1667GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-100

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBIA1668GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-101

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1669GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-102

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBIA1670GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-103

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1671GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-104

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABBIA1709GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-105

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABBIA1710GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-106

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009022478

    EC

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JSBIA1228GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-107

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    Get the detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when
    the incident/malfunction occurred) using the “Diagnostic Work Sheet”. (Refer to EC-109, «Diagnostic Work
    Sheet».)
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC
    1.
    2.

    Check DTC.
    Perform the following procedure if DTC is displayed.
    Record DTC and freeze frame data. (Print them out with CONSULT or GST.)
    Erase DTC.
    Study the relationship between the cause detected by DTC and the symptom described by the customer.
    (Symptom Table is useful. Refer to EC-327, «Symptom Table».)
    3. Check related service bulletins for information.
    Is any symptom described and is any DTC detected?
    Symptom is described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 3.
    Symptom is described, DTC is not detected>>GO TO 4.
    Symptom is not described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 5.

    3.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer (except MIL ON).
    Also study the normal operation and fail safe related to the symptom. Refer to EC-333, «Description» and EC73, «Fail Safe».
    Diagnostic Work Sheet is useful to verify the incident.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Also study the normal operation and fail safe related to the symptom. Refer to EC-333, «Description» and EC73, «Fail Safe».
    Diagnostic Work Sheet is useful to verify the incident.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.
    >> GO TO 6.

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for the displayed DTC, and then make sure that DTC is
    detected again.
    If two or more DTCs are detected, refer to EC-74, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart» and determine trouble
    diagnosis order.
    NOTE:
    • Freeze frame data is useful if the DTC is not detected.
    • Perform Component Function Check if DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE is not included on Service
    Manual. This simplified check procedure is an effective alternative though DTC cannot be detected during
    this check.
    If the result of Component Function Check is NG, it is the same as the detection of DTC by DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Check according to EC-76, «DTC Index».

    6.PERFORM BASIC INSPECTION

    Perform EC-118, «Work Procedure».
    Do you have CONSULT?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-108

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    A

    7.PERFORM “SPEC” IN DATA MONITOR MODE

    With CONSULT
    EC
    Make sure that “MAS A/F SE-B1”, “B/FUEL SCHDL” and “A/F ALPHA-B1” are within the SP value in “SPEC”
    of “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT. Refer to EC-129, «Component Function Check».
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    C
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    8.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE

    D

    Detect malfunctioning part according to EC-130, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    E

    9.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM BY SYMPTOM TABLE

    Detect malfunctioning system according to EC-327, «Symptom Table» based on the confirmed symptom in
    step 4, and determine the trouble diagnosis order based on possible causes and symptom.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 10.

    10.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSIS PROCEDURE
    Inspect according to Diagnosis Procedure of the system.
    NOTE:
    The Diagnosis Procedure in EC section described based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit inspection
    is also required for the circuit check in the Diagnosis Procedure. For details, refer to GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Monitor input data from related sensors or check the voltage of related ECM terminals using CONSULT. Refer to EC-62, «Reference Value».

    11.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnosis Procedure again after repair and replacement.
    Check DTC. If DTC is displayed, erase it.

    L

    M

    >> GO TO 12.

    12.FINAL CHECK

    When DTC was detected in step 2, perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE or Component Function
    Check again, and then make sure that the malfunction have been repaired securely.
    When symptom was described from the customer, refer to confirmed symptom in step 3 or 4, and make sure
    that the symptom is not detected.
    Is DTC detected and does symptom remain?
    YES-1 >> DTC is detected: GO TO 10.
    YES-2 >> Symptom remains: GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Before returning the vehicle to the customer, make sure to erase unnecessary DTC in ECM. If the
    completion of SRT is needed, drive vehicle under the specific “DRIVING PATTERN” in EC-125,
    «SRT Set Driving Pattern».

    Diagnostic Work Sheet

    INFOID:0000000009022479

    DESCRIPTION
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-109

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
    engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make troubleshooting faster and more accurate.
    In general, each customer feels differently about an incident. It is
    important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a customer complaint.
    Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the WORKSHEET SAMPLE
    below in order to organize all the information for troubleshooting.
    Some conditions may cause the MIL to come on steady or blink and
    DTC to be detected. Examples:
    Vehicle ran out of fuel, which caused the engine to misfire.

    SEF907L

    WORKSHEET SAMPLE

    MTBL0017

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-110

    2014 Note

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009022480

    When replacing ECM, perform additional service.
    EC
    NOTE:
    After replacing with a blank ECM, programming is required to write ECM information. To perform the operation, always follow the work instructions. Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    C

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022481

    1.CHECK ECM PART NUMBER

    D

    Check ECM part number to see whether it is blank ECM or not.
    NOTE:
    • Part number of blank ECM is 23703 — ×××××.
    • Check the part number when ordering ECM or with delivered package label.
    Is the ECM a blank ECM?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    E

    F

    2.SAVE ECM PART NUMBER

    Read out the part number from the old ECM and save the number, following the programming instructions.
    Refer to “CONSULT Operation Manual”.
    NOTE:
    • The ECM part number is saved in CONSULT.
    • Even when ECM part number is not saved in CONSULT, go to 3.
    >> GO TO 3.

    G

    H

    I

    3.PERFORM ECM PROGRAMMING
    After replacing ECM, perform the ECM programming. Refer to “CONSULT Operation Manual”.
    NOTE:
    • During programming, maintain the following conditions:
    — Ignition switch: ON
    — Electric load: OFF
    — Brake pedal: Not depressed
    — Battery voltage: 12 — 13.5 V (Be sure to check the value of battery voltage by selecting “BATTERY VOLT” in
    “Data monitor” of CONSULT.)

    J

    K

    L

    >> GO TO 5.

    4.REPLACE ECM

    M

    Replace ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    N

    >> GO TO 5.

    5.PERFORM INITIALIZATION OF NATS SYSTEM AND REGISTRATION OF ALL NATS IGNITION KEY IDS
    O

    Refer to SEC-61, «ECM : Work Procedure».
    >> GO TO 6.

    P

    6.PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
    Refer to EC-113, «Work Procedure».
    >> GO TO 7.

    7.PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
    Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-111

    2014 Note

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> GO TO 8.

    8.PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
    Refer to EC-115, «Work Procedure».
    >> END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-112

    2014 Note

    ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009022482

    Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is a function of ECM to learn the fully released position of the EC
    accelerator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed each
    time harness connector of accelerator pedal position sensor or ECM is disconnected.

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022483

    C

    1.START
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    D

    Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
    Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    E

    >> END

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-113

    2014 Note

    THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022484

    Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning is a function of ECM to learn the fully closed position of the throttle
    valve by monitoring the throttle position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time harness connector of electric throttle control actuator or ECM is disconnected or electric throttle control actuator inside is
    cleaned.

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022485

    1.START
    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “CLSD THL POS LEARN” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode.
    Follow the instructions on the CONSULT display.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Check that throttle valve moves during the above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound.
    Without CONSULT
    1. Start the engine.
    NOTE:
    Engine coolant temperature is 25°C (77°F) or less before engine starts.
    2. Warm up the engine.
    NOTE:
    Raise engine coolant temperature until it reaches 65°C (149°F) or more.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Check that throttle valve moves during the above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound.
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    >> END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-114

    2014 Note

    IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022486

    Idle Air Volume Learning is a function of ECM to learn the idle air volume that keeps each engine idle speed EC
    within the specific range. It must be performed under any of the following conditions:
    • Each time electric throttle control actuator or ECM is replaced.
    • Idle speed or ignition timing is out of specification.
    C

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022487

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    D

    Make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
    Learning will be cancelled if any of the following conditions are missed for even a moment.
    • Battery voltage: More than 12.9 V (At idle)
    • Engine coolant temperature: 70 — 100°C (158 — 212°F)
    • Selector lever: P or N (CVT), Neutral (M/T)
    • Electric load switch: OFF
    (Air conditioner, headlamp, rear window defogger)
    — For vehicles equipped with daytime light systems, perform one of the following procedures before
    starting engine not to illuminate headlamps.
    • Apply parking brake
    • Set lighting switch to the 1st position
    • Steering wheel: Neutral (Straight-ahead position) position
    • Vehicle speed: Stopped
    • Transmission: Warmed-up
    — CVT models
    • With CONSULT: Drive vehicle until “FLUID TEMP SE” in “DATA MONITOR” mode of “TRANSMISSION” system indicates less than 0.9 V.
    • Without CONSULT: Drive vehicle for 10 minutes.
    — M/T models
    • Drive vehicle for 10 minutes.
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    2.IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING

    With CONSULT
    Perform ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING. Refer to EC-113, «Work Procedure».
    2. Perform THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING. Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    4. Select “IDLE AIR VOL LEARN” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT.
    5. Touch “START” and wait 20 seconds.
    Is “CMPLT” displayed on CONSULT screen?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.
    1.

    3.IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    Without CONSULT
    NOTE:
    • It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
    • It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit has
    a malfunction.
    1. Perform ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING. Refer to EC-113, «Work Procedure».
    2. Perform THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING. Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Revision: April 2013

    E

    EC-115

    2014 Note

    P

    IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
    [HR16DE]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    5. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
    6. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
    Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
    Fully release the accelerator pedal.
    7. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 20 seconds until the MIL stops
    blinking and turned ON.
    8. Fully release the accelerator pedal within 3 seconds after the MIL turned ON.
    9. Start engine and let it idle.
    10. Wait 20 seconds.

    PBIB0665E

    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK IDLE SPEED AND IGNITION TIMING
    Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle speed and ignition timing are within the specifications.
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Idle Speed» and EC-339, «Ignition Timing».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following
    • Check that throttle valve is fully closed.
    • Check PCV valve operation.
    • Check that downstream of throttle valve is free from air leakage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part.

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Engine component parts and their installation condition are questionable. Check and eliminate the cause of
    the incident.
    It is useful to perform “TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE”. Refer to EC-129, «Description».
    If any of the following conditions occur after the engine has started, eliminate the cause of the incident and
    perform Idle Air Volume Learning all over again:
    • Engine stalls.
    • Erroneous idle.
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-116

    2014 Note

    MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE CLEAR
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE CLEAR
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009022488

    This describes how to erase the mixture ratio self-learning value. For the actual procedure, follow the instruc- EC
    tions in “Diagnosis Procedure”.

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022489

    C

    1.START
    With CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Select “SELF-LEARNING CONT” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT.
    Clear mixture ratio self-learning value by touching “CLEAR”.
    With GST
    1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector.
    4. Restart engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
    5. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector.
    6. Select Service $03 with GST. Make sure DTC P0102 is detected.
    7. Select Service $04 with GST to erase the DTC P0102.

    D

    1.
    2.
    3.

    E

    F

    G

    >> END

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-117

    2014 Note

    BASIC INSPECTION
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022490

    1.INSPECTION START
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related malfunction, or a current need for
    scheduled maintenance.
    Open engine hood and check the following:
    Harness connectors for improper connections
    Wiring harness for improper connections, pinches and cut
    Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections
    Hoses and ducts for leaks
    Air cleaner clogging
    Gasket
    Confirm that electrical or mechanical loads are not applied.
    Headlamp switch is OFF.
    Air conditioner switch is OFF.
    Rear window defogger switch is OFF.
    SEF983U
    Steering wheel is in the straight-ahead position, etc.
    Start engine and warm it up until engine coolant temperature
    indicator points to the middle of gauge.
    Ensure engine stays below 1,000 rpm.

    SEF976U

    5.

    Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no
    load.
    6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT or GST.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    SEF977U

    2.REPAIR OR REPLACE
    Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
    >> GO TO 3

    3.CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED
    1.

    Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no load.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-118

    2014 Note

    BASIC INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no
    load, then run engine at idle speed for about 1 minute.
    3. Check idle speed.
    For procedure, refer to EC-334, «Inspection».
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Idle Speed».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
    1.
    2.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    C
    PBIA8513J

    D

    Stop engine.
    Perform EC-113, «Work Procedure».

    E

    >> GO TO 5.

    5.PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING

    F

    Perform EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    G

    >> GO TO 6.

    6.PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
    Perform EC-115, «Work Procedure».
    Is Idle Air Volume Learning carried out successfully?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Follow the instruction of IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING. Then GO TO 4.

    H

    1.
    2.

    J

    I

    7.CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN

    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Check idle speed.
    For procedure, refer to EC-334, «Inspection».
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Idle Speed».

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    L

    8.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the Following.
    • Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-228, «DTC Logic».
    • Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-224, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace. Then GO TO 4.

    M

    N

    9.CHECK ECM FUNCTION
    1.
    2.

    O

    Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
    this is a rare case.)
    Perform initialization and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to SEC-61, «ECM : Work Procedure».
    >> GO TO 4.

    10.CHECK IGNITION TIMING
    1.

    Run engine at idle.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-119

    2014 Note

    P

    BASIC INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
    For procedure, refer to EC-335, «Inspection».
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Ignition Timing».

    [HR16DE]

    : Timing indicator

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 19.
    NO
    >> GO TO 11.

    11.PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
    1.
    2.

    MBIB1331E

    Stop engine.
    Perform EC-113, «Work Procedure».
    >> GO TO 12.

    12.PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
    Perform EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    >> GO TO 13.

    13.PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
    Perform EC-115, «Work Procedure».
    Is idle air volume learning carried out successfully?
    YES >> GO TO 14.
    NO
    >> Follow the instruction of IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING. Then GO TO 4.

    14.CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN

    1.
    2.

    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Check idle speed.
    For procedure, refer to EC-334, «Inspection».
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Idle Speed».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 15.
    NO
    >> GO TO 17.

    15.CHECK IGNITION TIMING AGAIN
    1.
    2.

    Run engine at idle.
    Check ignition timing with a timing light.
    For procedure, refer to EC-335, «Inspection».
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Ignition Timing».
    : Timing indicator

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 19.
    NO
    >> GO TO 16.
    MBIB1331E

    16.CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
    Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-51, «Exploded View».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 17.
    NO
    >> Repair the timing chain installation. Then GO TO 4.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-120

    2014 Note

    BASIC INSPECTION
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    17.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    A

    Check the following.
    • Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-228, «DTC Logic».
    • Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-224, «DTC Logic».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 18.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace. Then GO TO 4.

    EC

    C

    18.CHECK ECM FUNCTION
    1.
    2.

    Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
    this is a rare case.)
    Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to SEC-61,
    «ECM : Work Procedure».

    D

    E

    >> GO TO 4.

    19.INSPECTION END
    If ECM is replaced during this BASIC INSPECTION procedure, perform EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    >> INSPECTION END

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-121

    2014 Note

    FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022491

    FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE

    1.FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE
    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Perform “FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT.
    Start engine.
    After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel pressure.
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Without CONSULT
    1. Remove fuel pump fuse located in IPDM E/R.
    2. Start engine.
    3. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel pressure.
    4. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    5. Reinstall fuel pump fuse after servicing fuel system.
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    >> INSPECTION END

    FUEL PRESSURE CHECK

    1.FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
    CAUTION:
    • Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger.
    • The fuel hose connection method used when taking fuel pressure check must not be used for other
    purposes.
    • Be careful not to scratch or put debris around connection area when servicing, so that the quick
    connector maintains seal ability with O-rings inside.
    • Do not perform fuel pressure check with electrical systems operating (i.e. lights, rear defogger, A/C,
    etc.) Fuel pressure gauge may indicate false readings due to varying engine load and changes in
    manifold vacuum.
    NOTE:
    Prepare pans or saucers under the disconnected fuel line because the fuel may spill out. The fuel pressure cannot be completely released because this models do not have fuel return system.
    1. Release fuel pressure to zero.
    2. Prepare fuel hose for fuel pressure check (B) and fuel tube
    adapter [SST: KV10118400 or KV10120000] (D), then connect
    fuel pressure gauge (A).
    C

    : Hose clamp
    : To quick connector
    : To fuel tube (engine side)

    3.

    CAUTION:
    • Use suitable fuel hose for fuel pressure check (genuine
    NISSAN fuel hose without quick connector).
    • To avoid unnecessary force or tension to hose, use moderately long fuel hose for fuel pressure check.
    • Do not use the fuel hose for checking fuel pressure with damage or cracks on it.
    • Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
    Remove fuel hose.
    CAUTION:
    Do not twist or kink fuel hose because it is plastic hose.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-122

    PBIB2982E

    2014 Note

    FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    4. Connect fuel hose for fuel pressure check
    side) with clamp
    as shown in the figure.

    [HR16DE]
    to fuel tube (engine
    A

    : No.2 spool
    CAUTION:
    • Wipe off oil or dirt from hose insertion part using cloth
    moistened with gasoline.
    • Apply proper amount of gasoline between top of the fuel
    tube
    and No.1 spool .
    • Insert fuel hose for fuel pressure check until it touches
    the No.1 spool on fuel tube.
    • Use NISSAN genuine hose clamp (part number: 16439 N4710 or 16439 40U00).
    • When reconnecting fuel line, always use new clamps.
    • Use a torque driver to tighten clamps.
    • Install hose clamp to the position within 1 — 2 mm (0.04 — 0.08 in).

    EC

    C
    PBIB2983E

    D

    E

    Tightening torque : 1 — 1.5 N·m (0.1 — 0.15 kg-m, 9 — 13 in-lb)
    5.

    F

    • Make sure that clamp screw does not contact adjacent parts.
    Connect fuel tube adapter to quick connector .
    A : Fuel pressure gauge

    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    G

    After connecting fuel hose for fuel pressure check, pull the hose
    with a force of approximately 98 N (10 kg, 22 lb) to confirm fuel
    tube does not come off.
    Turn ignition switch ON and check for fuel leakage.
    Start engine and check for fuel leakage.
    Read the indication of fuel pressure gauge.
    CAUTION:
    ALBIA1073ZZ
    • Do not perform fuel pressure check with system operating. Fuel pressure gauge may indicate false readings.
    • During fuel pressure check, confirm for fuel leakage from fuel connection every 3 minutes.
    At idling

    : Approximately 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.57 kg/cm2, 51 psi)

    H

    I

    J

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    L

    2.CHECK FUEL HOSE AND FUEL TUBE
    If result is unsatisfactory, check fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace “fuel filter and fuel pump assembly”. Refer to FL-6, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-123

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SET SRT CODE
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    HOW TO SET SRT CODE
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022492

    OUTLINE
    In order to set all SRTs, the self-diagnoses as in the “SRT ITEM” table must have been performed at least
    once. Each diagnosis may require actual driving for a long period of time under various conditions.

    SRT ITEM
    The table below shows required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to “CMPLT”.
    SRT item*
    (CONSULT indication)

    Required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to “CMPLT”

    Corresponding DTC No.

    CATALYST

    Three way catalyst function

    P0420

    HO2S

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1

    P0130, P0133

    Heated oxygen sensor 2

    P0137

    Heated oxygen sensor 2

    P0138

    Heated oxygen sensor 2

    P0139

    *: Though displayed on the CONSULT screen, “HO2S HTR” is not SRT item.

    SRT SERVICE PROCEDURE
    If a vehicle has failed the state emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating “INCMP”, review
    the flowchart diagnostic sequence, referring to the following flowchart.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-124

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SET SRT CODE
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JSBIA0399GB

    SRT Set Driving Pattern

    K

    INFOID:0000000009022493

    L

    CAUTION:

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-125

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SET SRT CODE
    [HR16DE]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Always drive the vehicle in safe manner according to traffic conditions and obey all traffic laws.

    JSBIA1318GB

    NOTE:
    *1: Depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h (56 MPH), then release the accelerator pedal
    and keep it released for more than 10 seconds. Depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h
    (56 MPH) again.
    *2: Checking the vehicle speed with GST is advised.
    • The time required for each diagnosis varies with road surface conditions, weather, altitude, individual driving
    habits, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-126

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SET SRT CODE
    [HR16DE]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Zone A refers to the range where the time, required for the diagnosis under normal conditions*, is the shortest.
    A
    Zone B refers to the range where the diagnosis can still be performed if the diagnosis is not completed within
    zone A.
    *: Normal conditions refer to the following:
    EC
    • Sea level
    • Flat road
    • Ambient air temperature: 20 — 30°C (68 — 86°F)
    • Diagnosis is performed as quickly as possible under normal conditions.
    C
    Under different conditions [For example: ambient air temperature other than 20 — 30°C (68 — 86°F)], diagnosis may also be performed.

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022494

    1.CHECK DTC

    D

    E

    Check DTC.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Repair malfunction(s) and erase DTC. Refer to EC-76, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2.CHECK SRT STATUS

    G

    With CONSULT
    Select “SRT STATUS” in “DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Without CONSULT
    Perform “SRT status” mode with EC-49, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    With GST
    Select Service $01 with GST.
    Is SRT code(s) set?
    YES >> END
    NO-1 >> With CONSULT: GO TO 3.
    NO-2 >> Without CONSULT: GO TO 4.

    H

    I

    J

    3.DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    Select “SRT WORK SUPPORT” in “DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    For SRT(s) that is not set, perform the corresponding “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” according to
    the “Performance Priority” in the “SRT ITEM” table. Refer to EC-48, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : System Readiness Test (SRT) Code».
    3. Check DTC.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Repair malfunction(s) and erase DTC. Refer to EC-76, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    4.PERFORM ROAD TEST

    • Check the “Performance Priority” in the “SRT ITEM” table. Refer to EC-48, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION :
    System Readiness Test (SRT) Code».
    • Perform the most efficient SRT set driving pattern to set the SRT properly. Refer to EC-125, «SRT Set Driving Pattern».
    In order to set all SRTs, the SRT set driving pattern must be performed at least once.

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    >> GO TO 5.

    5.PATTERN 1

    P

    1. Check the vehicle condition;
    Engine coolant temperature is −10 to 35°C (14 to 95°F).
    Fuel tank temperature is more than 0°C (32°F).
    2. Start the engine.
    3. Keep engine idling until the engine coolant temperature is greater than 70°C (158°F)
    NOTE:
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-127

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SET SRT CODE
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    ECM terminal voltage is follows;
    • Engine coolant temperature
    — −10 to 35°C (14 to 95°F): 3.0 — 4.3 V
    — 70°(158°F): Less than 1.4 V
    • Fuel tank temperature: Less than 4.1 V
    Refer to EC-62, «Reference Value».
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.PATTERN 2
    1.

    Drive the vehicle. And depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h (56 MPH), then
    release the accelerator pedal and keep it released for more than 10 seconds.
    2. Depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h (56 MPH) again
    NOTE:
    • Checking the vehicle speed with GST is advised.
    • When steady-state driving is performed again even after it is interrupted, each diagnosis can be conducted.
    In this case, the time required for diagnosis may be extended.
    >> GO TO 7.

    7.CHECK SRT STATUS
    With CONSULT
    Select “SRT STATUS” in “DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Without CONSULT
    Perform “SRT status” mode with EC-49, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    With GST
    Select Service $01 with GST.
    Is SRT(s) set?
    YES >> END
    NO
    >> Call TECH LINE or take appropriate action.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-128

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022495

    The specification (SP) value indicates the tolerance of the value that is displayed in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode of CONSULT during normal operation of the Engine Control System. When the value in “SPEC” of
    “DATA MONITOR” mode is within the SP value, the Engine Control System is confirmed OK. When the value
    in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode is NOT within the SP value, the Engine Control System may have one
    or more malfunctions.
    The SP value is used to detect malfunctions that may affect the Engine Control System, but will not light the
    MIL.
    The SP value will be displayed for the following three items:
    • B/FUEL SCHDL (The fuel injection pulse width programmed into ECM prior to any learned on board correction)
    • A/F ALPHA-B1 (The mean value of air-fuel ratio feedback correction factor per cycle)
    • MAS A/F SE-B1 (The signal voltage of the mass air flow sensor)

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022496

    1.START
    Make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
    • Vehicle driven distance: More than 5,000 km (3,107 miles)
    • Barometric pressure: 98.3 — 104.3 kPa (0.983 — 1.043 bar, 1.003 — 1.064 kg/cm2, 14.25 — 15.12 psi)
    • Atmospheric temperature: 20 — 30°C (68 — 86°F)
    • Engine coolant temperature: 75 — 95°C (167 — 203°F)
    • Transmission: Warmed-up
    — CVT models: After the engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature, drive vehicle until “FLUID
    TEMP SE” (CVT fluid temperature sensor signal) indicates more than 60°C (140°F).
    — M/T models: After the engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature, drive vehicle for 5 minutes.
    • Electrical load: Not applied
    — Rear window defogger switch, air conditioner switch, lighting switch are OFF. Steering wheel is straight
    ahead.
    • Engine speed: Idle

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM “SPEC” OF “DATA MONITOR” MODE

    L

    With CONSULT
    NOTE:
    Perform “SPEC” in “DATA MONITOR” mode in maximum scale display.
    1. Perform EC-118, «Work Procedure».
    2. Select “B/FUEL SCHDL”, “A/F ALPHA-B1” and “MAS A/F SE-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode
    with CONSULT.
    3. Make sure that monitor items are within the SP value.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> END
    NO
    >> Go to EC-130, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-129

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022497

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    PBIB2318E

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-130

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    PBIB3213E

    DETAILED PROCEDURE

    P

    1.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Start engine.
    Confirm that the testing conditions are met. Refer to EC-129, «Component Function Check».
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within
    the SP value.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-131

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NOTE:
    Check “A/F ALPHA-B1” for approximately 1 minute because it may fluctuate. It is NG if the indication is
    out of the SP value even a little.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> GO TO 17.
    NO-1 >> Less than the SP value: GO TO 2.
    NO-2 >> More than the SP value: GO TO 3.

    2.CHECK “B/FUEL SCHDL”

    Select “B/FUEL SCHDL” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within the
    SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> More than the SP value: GO TO 19.

    3.CHECK “B/FUEL SCHDL”

    Select “B/FUEL SCHDL” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within the
    SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO-1 >> More than the SP value: GO TO 6.
    NO-2 >> Less than the SP value: GO TO 25.

    4.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Stop the engine.
    Disconnect PCV hose, and then plug it.
    Start engine.
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within
    the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    5.CHANGE ENGINE OIL

    1.
    2.

    Stop the engine.
    Change engine oil.
    NOTE:
    This symptom may occur when a large amount of gasoline is mixed with engine oil because of driving
    conditions (such as when engine oil temperature does not rise enough since a journey distance is too
    short during winter). The symptom will not be detected after changing engine oil or changing driving condition.
    >> INSPECTION END

    6.CHECK FUEL PRESSURE

    Check fuel pressure. (Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».)
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO-1 >> Fuel pressure is too high: Replace fuel filter and fuel pump assembly (Refer to FL-6, «Exploded
    View»), and then GO TO 8.
    NO-2 >> Fuel pressure is too low: GO TO 7.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace fuel filter and fuel pump assembly (Refer to FL-6, «Exploded View»), and then GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace and then GO TO 8.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-132

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    8.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”

    A
    Start engine.
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within
    the SP value.
    EC
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.
    C
    PERFORM POWER BALANCE TEST

    1.
    2.

    9.

    1. Perform “POWER BALANCE” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode.
    2. Make sure that the each cylinder produces a momentary engine speed drop.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> GO TO 10.

    D

    E

    10.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    1. Ignition coil and its circuit (Refer to EC-322, «Component Inspection (Ignition Coil with Power Transistor)».)
    2. Fuel injector and its circuit (Refer to EC-315, «Component Inspection».)
    3. Intake air leakage
    4. Low compression pressure (Refer to EM-13, «Inspection».)
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace fuel injector (Refer to EM-40, «Removal and Installation»), and then GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part and then GO TO 11.

    G

    1.
    2.

    I

    F

    H

    11.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”

    Start engine.
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within
    the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 12.

    12.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 FUNCTION

    J

    K

    Perform all DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE related with A/F sensor 1.
    • For DTC P0130, refer to EC-170, «DTC Logic».
    • For DTC P0131, refer to EC-173, «DTC Logic».
    • For DTC P0132, refer to EC-176, «DTC Logic».
    • For DTC P0133, refer to EC-179, «DTC Logic».
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 15.
    NO
    >> GO TO 13.

    L

    M

    13.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT

    N

    Perform DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE according to corresponding DTC.
    O

    >> GO TO 14.

    14.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”
    1.
    2.

    Start engine.
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within
    the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 15.

    15.DISCONNECT AND RECONNECT ECM HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-133

    2014 Note

    P

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Stop the engine.
    2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    3. Check pin terminal and connector for damage, and then reconnect it.

    [HR16DE]

    >> GO TO 16.

    16.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”
    1.
    2.

    Start engine.
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within
    the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Detect malfunctioning part according to EC-327, «Symptom Table».

    17.CHECK “B/FUEL SCHDL”

    Select “B/FUEL SCHDL” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within the
    SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO-1 >> More than the SP value: GO TO 18.
    NO-2 >> Less than the SP value: GO TO 25.

    18.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    1.
    2.

    Check for the cause of large engine friction. Refer to the following.
    Engine oil level is too high
    Engine oil viscosity
    Belt tension of power steering, alternator, A/C compressor, etc. is excessive
    Noise from engine
    Noise from transmission, etc.
    Check for the cause of insufficient combustion. Refer to the following.
    Valve clearance malfunction
    Intake valve timing control function malfunction
    Camshaft sprocket installation malfunction, etc.
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part, and then GO TO 30.

    19.CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM

    Check for the cause of uneven air flow through mass air flow sensor. Refer to the following.
    • Crushed air ducts
    • Malfunctioning seal of air cleaner element
    • Uneven dirt of air cleaner element
    • Improper specification of intake air system
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 21.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part, and then GO TO 20.

    20.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”, AND “B/FUEL SCHDL”

    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” and “B/FUEL SCHDL” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that
    each indication is within the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> “B/FUEL SCHDL” is more, “A/F ALPHA-B1” is less than the SP value: GO TO 21.

    21.DISCONNECT AND RECONNECT MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Stop the engine.
    Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector.
    Check pin terminal and connector for damage and then reconnect it again.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-134

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    >> GO TO 22.

    22.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1”

    A

    1.
    2.

    Start engine.
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within
    EC
    the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> Detect malfunctioning part of mass air flow sensor circuit and repair it. Refer to EC-158, «DTC
    C
    Logic». Then GO TO 29.
    NO
    >> GO TO 23.

    23.CHECK “MAS A/F SE-B1”

    D

    Select “MAS A/F SE-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within the
    SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> GO TO 24.
    NO
    >> More than the SP value: Replace mass air flow sensor (Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation»), and then GO TO 29.

    E

    1.
    2.

    G

    24.REPLACE ECM

    Replace ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    >> GO TO 29.

    H

    25.CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM
    Check for the cause of uneven air flow through mass air flow sensor. Refer to the following.
    • Crushed air ducts
    • Malfunctioning seal of air cleaner element
    • Uneven dirt of air cleaner element
    • Improper specification of intake air system
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 27.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part, and then GO TO 26.

    I

    J

    K

    26.CHECK “B/FUEL SCHDL”

    Select “B/FUEL SCHDL” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within the
    SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Less than the SP value: GO TO 27.

    27.CHECK “MAS A/F SE-B1”

    Select “MAS A/F SE-B1” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that the indication is within the
    SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> GO TO 28.
    NO
    >> Less than the SP value: Replace mass air flow sensor (Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation»), and then GO TO 30.

    28.CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Check for the cause of air leak after the mass air flow sensor. Refer to the following.
    • Disconnection, looseness, and cracks in air duct
    • Looseness of oil filler cap
    • Disconnection of oil level gauge
    • Open stuck, breakage, hose disconnection, or cracks of PCV valve
    • Disconnection or cracks of EVAP purge hose, open stuck of EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
    valve
    Revision: April 2013

    F

    EC-135

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS — SPECIFICATION VALUE
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    • Malfunctioning seal of rocker cover gasket
    • Disconnection, looseness, or cracks of hoses, such as vacuum hose, connecting to intake air system parts
    • Malfunctioning seal of intake air system, etc.
    >> GO TO 30.

    29.CHECK “A/F ALPHA-B1” AND “B/FUEL SCHDL”
    Select “A/F ALPHA-B1” and “B/FUEL SCHDL” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and make sure that
    each indication is within the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Detect malfunctioning part according to EC-327, «Symptom Table».

    30.CHECK “B/FUEL SCHDL”

    Select “B/FUEL SCHDL” in “SPEC” of “DATA MONITOR” mode, and then make sure that the indication is
    within the SP value.
    Is the measurement value within the SP value?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Detect malfunctioning part according to EC-327, «Symptom Table».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-136

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009022498

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    EC

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    C

    2.CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    D

    Disconnect ECM harness connectors.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    E

    F

    10

    F10

    11

    E16

    G

    108

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    H

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    I

    Check the following.
    • Harness connectors E55, F55
    • Harness for open or short between ECM and ground

    J

    >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Reconnect ECM harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    E16

    93

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    M

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    O

    Check the following.
    • 10 A fuse (No. 55)
    • Harness connectors E55, F55
    • Harness for open or short between ECM and fuse

    P

    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
    1.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-137

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and then OFF.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    E16

    105

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    After turning ignition switch OFF, battery voltage will exist for a few seconds, then drop to approximately 0 V.

    [HR16DE]

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    7.CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    F43

    50

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Exploded View».

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    9.CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    32

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 13.
    NO
    >> GO TO 10.

    10.CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector F43.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    ECM

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    32

    F43

    50

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> GO TO 11.

    11.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-138

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    • Harness for open or short between ECM and IPDM E/R

    [HR16DE]
    A

    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    12.CHECK 20 A FUSE

    EC

    1. Disconnect 20 A fuse (No. 53) from IPDM E/R.
    2. Check 20 A fuse.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 14.
    NO
    >> Replace 20 A fuse.

    C

    13.CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-VI

    D

    1.
    2.
    3.

    E

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector E44.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    ECM

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E16

    105

    E44

    11

    Continuity

    F

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 14.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short power in harness or connectors.

    G

    H

    14.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-139

    2014 Note

    U0101 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U0101 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    DTC Description

    INFOID:0000000009418245

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
    control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
    communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
    Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT screen terms
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    DTC No.
    U0101

    LOST COMM (TCM)
    (Lost communication with TCM)

    DTC detecting condition
    When ECM is not transmitting or receiving CAN communication signal of
    OBD (emission-related diagnosis) with TCM for 2 seconds or more.

    POSSIBLE CAUSE
    CAN communication line between TCM and ECM

    FAIL-SAFE
    Not applicable

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 3 seconds.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-140, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO-1 >> To check malfunction symptom before repair: Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».
    NO-2 >> Confirmation after repair: INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009418246

    Perform the trouble diagnosis for CAN communication system. Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow
    Chart».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-140

    2014 Note

    U1001 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1001 CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022499

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul- EC
    tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
    control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
    communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring. C
    Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022500

    D

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    U1001

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    CAN communication line

    When ECM is not transmitting or receiving CAN communication
    signal other than OBD (emission related diagnosis) for 2 seconds
    or more.

    Harness or connectors
    (CAN communication line
    is open or shorted)

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 3 seconds.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> EC-141, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    H

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I
    INFOID:0000000009022501

    Proceed to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-141

    2014 Note

    P0011 IVT CONTROL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0011 IVT CONTROL
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022502

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC P0011 is displayed with DTC P0075, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0075. Refer to
    EC-153, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Intake valve timing control
    performance

    P0011

    Detecting condition

    There is a gap between angle of
    target and phase-control angle
    degree.

    Possible cause



    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
    Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
    Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
    Accumulation of debris to the signal pick-up portion of the
    camshaft
    • Timing chain installation
    • Foreign matter caught in the oil groove for intake valve
    timing control

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10 V and 16 V at
    idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Maintain the following conditions for at least 6 consecutive seconds. Hold the accelerator pedal as steady
    as possible.

    ENG SPEED

    1,200 — 2,000 rpm

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    More than 60°C (140°F)

    Shift lever

    P or N position (CVT)
    Neutral position (M/T)

    4.
    5.

    Let engine idle for 10 seconds.
    Check 1st trip DTC.
    With GST
    Follow the procedure “With CONSULT” above.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-143, «Diagnosis Procedure»
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II
    1.

    With CONSULT
    Maintain the following conditions for at least 20 consecutive seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-142

    2014 Note

    P0011 IVT CONTROL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ENG SPEED

    1,200 — 3,175 rpm (A constant rotation is maintained.)

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    More than 60°C (140°F)

    Shift lever

    1st or 2nd position

    Driving location uphill

    Driving vehicle uphill
    (Increased engine load will help maintain the driving
    conditions required for this test.)

    A

    EC

    C

    CAUTION:
    Always drive at a safe speed.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    With GST
    Follow the procedure “With CONSULT” above.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-143, «Diagnosis Procedure»
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    E

    INFOID:0000000009022503

    F

    1.CHECK OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP
    1.
    2.

    Start engine.
    Check oil pressure warning lamp and confirm it is not illuminated.
    Is oil pressure warning lamp illuminated?
    YES >> Proceed to LU-7, «Inspection».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    2.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE

    PBIA8559J

    Refer to EC-144, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    K

    Refer to EC-226, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS). Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    M

    Refer to EC-230, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE). Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    O

    L

    3.CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)

    N

    4.CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)

    P

    5.CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
    Check the following.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-143

    2014 Note

    P0011 IVT CONTROL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    • Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
    • Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
    rear end or replace camshaft. Refer to EM-60, «Removal
    and Installation».

    JSBIA0599ZZ

    6.CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
    Check service records for any recent repairs that may cause timing chain misaligned.
    Are there any service records that may cause timing chain misaligned?
    YES >> Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-51, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    7.CHECK LUBRICATION CIRCUIT

    Perform “Inspection of Camshaft Sprocket (INT) Oil Groove”. Refer to EM-68, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Clean lubrication line.

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022504

    1.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Check resistance between intake valve timing control solenoid valve terminals as follows.
    Terminals

    Resistance [at 20°C (68°F)]

    1 and 2

    7.0 — 7.7 Ω

    1 or 2 and ground

    ∞Ω
    (Continuity should not exist)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    2.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-II

    1.
    2.

    Remove intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Apply 12 V between intake valve timing control solenoid valve
    terminals 1 and 2, and then interrupt it. Make sure that the
    plunger moves as shown in the figure.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply 12 V continuously for 5 seconds or more.
    Doing so may result in damage to the coil in intake valve
    timing control solenoid valve.
    NOTE:
    Always replace O-ring when intake valve timing control
    solenoid valve is removed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-144

    JMBIA2108ZZ

    2014 Note

    P0011 IVT CONTROL
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-145

    2014 Note

    P0014 EVT CONTROL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0014 EVT CONTROL
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022505

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC P0014 is displayed with DTC P0078, first perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0078. Refer to EC155, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P0014

    Trouble diagnosis name
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    EXH/V TIM CONT-B1
    (Exhaust valve timing control
    performance)

    DTC detecting condition

    There is a gap between angle of
    target and phase-control angle
    degree.

    Possible cause




    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
    Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor
    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve
    Accumulation of debris to the signal pick-up portion of
    the camshaft
    • Timing chain installation
    • Foreign matter caught in the oil groove for exhaust
    valve timing control

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10 V and 16 V at
    idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Maintain the following conditions for at least 6 consecutive seconds. Hold the accelerator pedal as steady
    as possible.

    ENG SPEED

    1,200 — 2,000 rpm (A constant rotation is maintained.)

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    More than 60°C (140°F)

    Selector lever

    P or N position (CVT)
    Neutral position (M/T)

    4.
    5.

    Let engine idle for 10 seconds.
    Check 1st trip DTC.
    With GST
    Follow the procedure “With CONSULT” above.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-147, «Diagnosis Procedure»
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II
    1.
    2.

    With CONSULT
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Maintain the following conditions for at least 20 consecutive seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-146

    2014 Note

    P0014 EVT CONTROL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ENG SPEED

    1,700 — 2,950 rpm (A constant rotation is maintained.)

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    More than 70°C (158°F)

    Selector lever

    1st or 2nd position

    Driving location uphill

    Driving vehicle uphill
    (Increased engine load will help maintain the driving
    conditions required for this test.)

    A

    EC

    C

    CAUTION:
    Always drive at a safe speed.
    3. Check 1st trip DTC.
    With GST
    Follow the procedure “With CONSULT” above.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-147, «Diagnosis Procedure»
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    E

    INFOID:0000000009022506

    F

    1.CHECK OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP
    1.
    2.

    Start engine.
    Check oil pressure warning lamp and confirm it is not illuminated.
    Is oil pressure warning lamp illuminated?
    YES >> Check the engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    G

    H

    I

    J
    PBIA8559J

    2.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    Check the exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EC-148, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    K

    Check the crankshaft position sensor (POS). Refer to EC-226, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS). Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    M

    Check the exhaust valve timing control position sensor. Refer to EC-230, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control position sensor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    O

    L

    3.CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)

    N

    4.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR

    5.CHECK CAMSHAFT (EXHAUST)
    Check the following.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-147

    2014 Note

    P

    P0014 EVT CONTROL
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    • Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
    • Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
    rear end or replace camshaft. Refer to EM-60, «Removal
    and Installation».

    [HR16DE]

    JSBIA0600ZZ

    6.CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
    Check service records for any recent repairs that may cause timing chain misaligned.
    Are there any service records that may cause timing chain misaligned?
    YES >> Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-51, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    7.CHECK LUBRICATION CIRCUIT

    Refer to EM-68, «Inspection», “INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION”.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Clean lubrication line.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022507

    1.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Check resistance between exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve terminals as per the following.

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve
    +

    Resistance

    2

    7.0 — 7.7 Ω [at 20°C (68°F)]

    Ground

    ∞Ω
    (Continuity should not exist)

    Terminal
    1
    1
    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    2.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-II

    1.
    2.

    Remove exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Provide 12 V DC between exhaust valve timing control solenoid
    valve terminals 1 and 2, and then interrupt it. Check that the
    plunger moves as shown in the figure.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply 12 V DC continuously for 5 seconds or more.
    Doing so may result in damage to the coil in exhaust valve
    timing control solenoid valve.
    NOTE:
    Always replace O-ring when exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve is removed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-148

    JMBIA2108ZZ

    2014 Note

    P0031, P0032 A/F SENSOR 1 HEATER
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0031, P0032 A/F SENSOR 1 HEATER

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022508

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    P0031

    P0032

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    heater control circuit low

    The current amperage in the A/F sensor 1 heater
    circuit is out of the normal range.
    (An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
    through the A/F sensor 1 heater.)

    • Harness or connectors
    (The A/F sensor 1 heater circuit is
    open or shorted.)
    • A/F sensor 1 heater

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    heater control circuit high

    The current amperage in the A/F sensor 1 heater
    circuit is out of the normal range.
    (An excessively high voltage signal is sent to ECM
    through the A/F sensor 1 heater.)

    • Harness or connectors
    (The A/F sensor 1 heater circuit is
    shorted.)
    • A/F sensor 1 heater

    C

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    F

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10 V and 16 V at
    idle.

    G

    H

    I

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    J

    1. Start engine and let it idle for at least 10 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-149, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NG
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    K

    INFOID:0000000009022509

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    L

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    M

    1.
    2.
    3.

    O

    N

    2.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    Disconnect air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1 harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground.

    P
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal

    F12

    4

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-149

    2014 Note

    P0031, P0032 A/F SENSOR 1 HEATER
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R harness connector F42
    • 20A fuse (No. 53)
    • Harness for open or short between A/F sensor 1 and fuse
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 HEATER OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    A/F sensor 1

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F12

    3

    F10

    3

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 HEATER

    Refer to GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Perform GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022510

    1.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Check resistance between A/F sensor 1 terminals as follows.
    Terminal

    Resistance

    3 and 4

    1.80 — 2.44 Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]

    3 and 1, 2

    ∞Ω
    (Continuity should not exist)

    4 and 1, 2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-150

    2014 Note

    P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022511

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    DTC No.

    P0037

    P0038

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    HO2 HTR (B1)
    (Heated oxygen sensor 2
    heater control circuit low)

    The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor 2
    heater circuit is out of the normal range.
    (An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
    through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.)

    • Harness or connectors
    (Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
    circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater

    HO2 HTR (B1)
    (Heated oxygen sensor 2
    heater control circuit high)

    The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor 2
    heater circuit is out of the normal range.
    (An excessively high voltage signal is sent to ECM
    through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.)

    • Harness or connectors
    (Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
    circuit is shorted.)
    • Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    C

    D

    E

    F

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11 V at idle.

    G

    H

    I

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Check 1st trip DTC.
    With GST
    Follow the procedure “With CONSULT” above.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-151, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022512

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    1.CHECK HO2S2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 (HO2S2) harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between HO2S2 harness connector and ground.
    HO2S2
    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    2

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-151

    2014 Note

    P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    2.CHECK HO2S2 HEATER OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    HO2S2

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    3

    F10

    5

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    3.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER

    Check the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater. Refer to EC-152, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022513

    1.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 (HO2S2) harness connector.
    Check resistance between HO2S2 terminals as per the following.
    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    +

    Resistance

    3

    3.4 — 4.4 Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]

    Terminal
    2

    2
    1

    3
    4
    1

    4

    ∞Ω
    (Continuity should not exist)

    2
    3

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-152

    2014 Note

    P0075 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0075 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022514

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Intake valve timing control
    solenoid valve circuit

    P0075

    DTC detecting condition
    An improper voltage is sent to the ECM
    through intake valve timing control solenoid
    valve.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
    circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Intake valve timing control solenoid valve

    C

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    H

    1. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-153, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    INFOID:0000000009022515

    J

    1.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect intake valve timing (IVT) control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector and ground.
    IVT control solenoid valve
    Connector

    Terminal

    F23

    2

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    L

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    N

    2.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    O

    Check the following.
    • Harness for open or short between intake valve timing control solenoid valve and IPDM E/R

    P

    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
    AND SHORT
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    EC-153

    2014 Note

    P0075 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check the continuity between intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    IVT control solenoid valve

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F23

    1

    F11

    73

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE

    Refer to EC-154, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022516

    1.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Check resistance between intake valve timing control solenoid valve terminals as follows.
    Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
    +

    Resistance

    2

    7.0 — 7.7 Ω [at 20°C (68°F)]

    Ground

    ∞Ω
    (Continuity should not exist)

    Terminal
    1
    1
    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View»

    2.CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-II

    1.
    2.

    Remove intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Apply 12 V between intake valve timing control solenoid valve
    terminals 1 and 2, and then interrupt it. Make sure that the
    plunger moves as shown in the figure.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply 12 V continuously for 5 seconds or more.
    Doing so may result in damage to the coil in intake valve
    timing control solenoid valve.
    NOTE:
    Always replace O-ring when intake valve timing control
    solenoid valve is removed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-154

    JMBIA2108ZZ

    2014 Note

    P0078 EVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0078 EVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022517

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    DTC No.

    EX V/T ACT/CIRC-B1
    (Exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve circuit)

    P0078

    DTC detecting condition
    An improper voltage is sent to the
    ECM through exhaust valve timing
    control solenoid valve.

    Possible cause

    C

    • Harness or connectors
    (Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve
    circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    H

    1. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-155, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    INFOID:0000000009022518

    J

    1.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect exhaust valve timing (EVT) control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector and ground.
    EVT control solenoid valve
    Connector

    Terminal

    F32

    2

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    K

    L

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    N

    2.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    O

    1.
    2.
    3.

    P

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Check the continuity between EVT control solenoid valve harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.

    EVT control solenoid valve

    4.

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F32

    2

    F42

    39

    Continuity
    Existed

    Also check harness for short to ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-155

    2014 Note

    P0078 EVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for power supply circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    [HR16DE]

    3.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between EVT control solenoid valve harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    EVT control solenoid valve

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F32

    1

    F11

    77

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    4.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE

    Check the exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EC-156, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022519

    1.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Check resistance between exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve terminals as per the following.

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve
    +

    Resistance

    2

    7.0 — 7.7 Ω [at 20°C (68°F)]

    Ground

    ∞Ω
    (Continuity should not exist)

    Terminal
    1
    1
    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    2.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE-II

    1.
    2.

    Remove exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Provide 12 V DC between exhaust valve timing control solenoid
    valve terminals 1 and 2, and then interrupt it. Check that the
    plunger moves as shown in the figure.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply 12 V DC continuously for 5 seconds or more.
    Doing so may result in damage to the coil in exhaust valve
    timing control solenoid valve.
    NOTE:
    Always replace O-ring when exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve is removed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-156

    JMBIA2108ZZ

    2014 Note

    P0078 EVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-157

    2014 Note

    P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022520

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    P0102

    Mass air flow sensor circuit
    low input

    An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
    sent to ECM.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Intake air leakage
    • Mass air flow sensor

    P0103

    Mass air flow sensor circuit
    high input

    An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
    sent to ECM.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Mass air flow sensor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Which DTC is detected?
    P0102 >> GO TO 2.
    P0103 >> GO TO 3.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0102

    1. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-158, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0103-I

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-158, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0103-II

    1. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-158, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022521

    1.INSPECTION START
    Confirm the detected DTC.
    Which DTC is detected?
    P0102 >> GO TO 2.
    P0103 >> GO TO 3.

    2.CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-158

    2014 Note

    P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check the following for connection.
    • Air duct
    • Vacuum hoses
    • Intake air passage between air duct to intake manifold
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Reconnect the parts.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    3.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    C

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    D

    4.CHECK MAF SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    E

    1.
    2.
    3.

    F

    Disconnect mass air flow (MAF) sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between MAF sensor harness connector and ground.
    MAF sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F31

    2

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    G

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK MAF SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    I

    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between MAF sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    MAF sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F31

    3

    F11

    52

    K

    Continuity
    Existed

    L

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    M

    6.CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between MAF sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    MAF sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F31

    4

    F11

    45

    N

    Continuity

    O

    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    P

    7.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
    Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-159

    2014 Note

    P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace mass air flow sensor. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022522

    1.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Connect CONSULT and select “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Select “MAS A/F SE-B1” and check indication.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.)

    0.5 — 0.6 V

    Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating temperature.)

    0.7 — 1.3 V

    Idle to about 4,000 rpm

    0.7 — 1.3 V to Approx. 4.3 V*

    *: Check for linear voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about 4,000 rpm.

    Without CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    4. Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    Terminal

    Condition

    +

    45
    (MAF sensor
    signal)

    52

    Voltage

    Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.)

    0.5 — 0.6 V

    Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating temperature.)

    0.7 — 1.3 V

    Idle to about 4,000 rpm

    0.7 — 1.3 V to Approx. 4.3 V*

    *: Check for linear voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about 4,000 rpm.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FOR THE CAUSE OF UNEVEN AIR FLOW THROUGH MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check for the cause of uneven air flow through mass air flow sensor. Refer to the following.
    Crushed air ducts
    Malfunctioning seal of air cleaner element
    Uneven dirt of air cleaner element
    Improper specification of intake air system parts
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR-II
    1.

    With CONSULT
    Repair or replace malfunctioning part.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-160

    2014 Note

    P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    3. Connect CONSULT and select “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    4. Select “MAS A/F SE-B1” and check indication.
    Monitor item

    A

    Condition

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    EC

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.)

    0.5 — 0.6 V

    Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating temperature.)

    0.7 — 1.3 V

    Idle to about 4,000 rpm

    C

    0.7 — 1.3 V to Approx. 4.3 V*

    *: Check for linear voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about 4,000 rpm.

    Without CONSULT
    1. Repair or replace malfunctioning part.
    2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    3. Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    D

    E

    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector

    F11

    Condition

    Voltage

    +
    45
    (MAF sensor
    signal)

    52

    Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.)

    0.5 — 0.6 V

    Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating temperature.)

    0.7 — 1.3 V

    Idle to about 4,000 rpm

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    I

    4.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR-III
    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Connect CONSULT and select “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Select “MAS A/F SE-B1” and check indication.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    G

    0.7 — 1.3 V to Approx. 4.3 V*

    *: Check for linear voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about 4,000 rpm.

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    F

    J

    K

    MAS A/F SE-B1

    Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.)

    0.5 — 0.6 V

    Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating temperature.)

    0.7 — 1.3 V

    Idle to about 4,000 rpm

    L

    M

    0.7 — 1.3 V to Approx. 4.3 V*

    *: Check for linear voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about 4,000 rpm.

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Without CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    N

    O

    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    Terminal
    +
    45
    (MAF sensor
    signal)

    Condition

    Voltage

    52

    Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.)

    0.5 — 0.6 V

    Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating temperature.)

    0.7 — 1.3 V

    Idle to about 4,000 rpm

    0.7 — 1.3 V to Approx. 4.3 V*

    *: Check for linear voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about 4,000 rpm.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-161

    2014 Note

    P

    P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Clean or replace mass air flow sensor. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-162

    [HR16DE]

    2014 Note

    P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022523

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    P0112

    Intake air temperature sensor
    circuit low input

    An excessively low voltage from the sensor
    is sent to ECM.

    P0113

    Intake air temperature sensor
    circuit high input

    An excessively high voltage from the sensor
    is sent to ECM.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Intake air temperature sensor

    C

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    H

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-163, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    INFOID:0000000009022524

    J

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    K

    L

    2.CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect mass air flow (MAF) sensor (with intake air temperature sensor) harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between mass air flow sensor harness connector and ground.
    MAF sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F31

    5

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    P

    3.CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between mass air flow sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-163

    N

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    2014 Note

    P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    MAF sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F31

    6

    F11

    55

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR

    Refer to EC-164, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor). Refer to EM-26, «Removal and
    Installation».

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022525

    1.CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector.
    Check resistance between mass air flow sensor terminals as follows.
    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Temperature [°C (°F)]

    Resistance
    25 (77)

    1.800 — 2.200 kΩ

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor). Refer to EM-26, «Removal and
    Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-164

    2014 Note

    P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022526

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    P0117

    Engine coolant temperature
    sensor circuit low input

    An excessively low voltage from the sensor
    is sent to ECM.

    P0118

    Engine coolant temperature
    sensor circuit high input

    An excessively high voltage from the sensor
    is sent to ECM.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Engine coolant temperature sensor

    C

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    H

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-165, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    INFOID:0000000009022527

    J

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    K

    L

    2.CHECK ECT SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    Disconnect engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECT sensor harness connector and ground.
    ECT sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F6

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    N

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    P

    3.CHECK ECT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between ECT sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-165

    2014 Note

    P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ECT sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F6

    2

    F11

    44

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR

    Refer to GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor. Refer to CO-24, «Exploded View».

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022528

    1.CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
    Remove engine coolant temperature sensor. Refer to CO-24, «Exploded View»
    Check resistance between engine coolant temperature sensor
    terminals by heating with hot water as shown in the figure.
    Terminals

    1 and 2

    Condition

    Temperature [°C (°F)]

    Resistance
    20 (68)

    2.10 — 2.90 kΩ

    50 (122)

    0.68 — 1.00 kΩ

    90 (194)

    0.236 — 0.260 kΩ

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor. Refer to
    CO-24, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-166

    JMBIA0080ZZ

    2014 Note

    P0122, P0123 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0122, P0123 TP SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022529

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    NOTE:
    If DTC P0122 or P0123 is displayed with DTC P0643, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0643.
    Refer to EC-252, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    P0122

    Throttle position sensor
    2 circuit low input

    An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor
    2 is sent to ECM.

    P0123

    Throttle position sensor
    2 circuit high input

    An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor
    2 is sent to ECM.

    • Harness or connectors
    (TP sensor 2 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Electric throttle control actuator
    (TP sensor 2)

    C

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    F

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-167, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009022530

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    L

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    M

    N

    2.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ground.
    Electric throttle control actuator
    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    2

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
    Revision: April 2013

    H

    I

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    G

    EC-167

    2014 Note

    P0122, P0123 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Electric throttle control actuator

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    4

    F11

    36

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.

    Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Electric throttle control actuator

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    3

    F11

    34

    Continuity
    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR

    Refer to EC-168, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    7.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022531

    1.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Perform EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Set selector lever to D (CVT) or 1st (M/T) position.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-168

    2014 Note

    P0122, P0123 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal
    +

    Condition

    Fully released

    33
    (TP sensor 1 signal)
    F11

    36
    34
    (TP sensor 2 signal)

    Voltage

    Accelerator
    pedal

    EC

    More than 0.36 V

    Fully depressed

    Less than 4.75 V

    Fully released

    Less than 4.75 V

    Fully depressed

    More than 0.36 V

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    D

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    E

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    F

    >> INSPECTION END

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-169

    2014 Note

    P0130 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0130 A/F SENSOR 1
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022532

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    To judge malfunctions, the diagnosis checks that the A/F signal computed by ECM from the A/F sensor 1 signal fluctuates according to fuel feedback control.
    DTC No.
    P0130

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible Cause

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    circuit

    The A/F signal computed by ECM from
    the A/F sensor 1 signal is constantly
    approx. 2.2 V.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The A/F sensor 1 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • A/F sensor 1

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11 V at idle.
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    2.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1 FUNCTION

    1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    2. Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    3. Select “A/F SEN1 (B1)” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    4. Check “A/F SEN1 (B1)” indication.
    Does the indication fluctuate around 2.2 V?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-171, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION -I

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “A/F SEN1 (B1) P1276” (for DTC P0130) of “A/F SEN1” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode.
    Touch “START”.
    When the following conditions are met, “TESTING” will be displayed on the CONSULT screen.

    ENG SPEED

    1,000 — 3,200 rpm

    VHCL SPEED SE

    More than 64 km/h (40 mph)

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    1.0 — 8.0 msec

    Selector lever

    D position (CVT models)
    4th position (M/T models)

    If “TESTING” is not displayed after 20 seconds, retry from step 2.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    Is “TESTING” displayed on CONSULT screen?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Check A/F sensor 1 function again. GO TO 2.

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION -II

    Release accelerator pedal fully.
    NOTE:
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-170

    2014 Note

    P0130 A/F SENSOR 1
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Never apply brake when releasing the accelerator pedal.
    Which does “TESTING” change to?
    COMPLETED>>GO TO 5.
    OUT OF CONDITION>>Retry DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE. GO TO 3.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION -III

    EC

    Touch “SELF-DIAG RESULT”.
    Which is displayed on CONSULT screen?
    OK
    >> INSPECTION END
    NG
    >> Proceed to EC-171, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    6.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK FOR MALFUNCTION

    D

    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-171, «Component Function Check».
    NOTE:
    Use component function check to check the overall function of the A/F sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a
    1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-171, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Component Function Check

    E

    F

    INFOID:0000000009022533

    G

    With GST
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Drive the vehicle at a speed of 80 km/h (50 MPH) for a few minutes in the suitable gear position.
    Shift the selector lever to D position (CVT) or 5th position (M/T), then release the accelerator pedal fully
    until the vehicle speed decreases to 50 km/h (30 MPH).
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    NOTE:
    Never apply brake when releasing the accelerator pedal.
    4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for five times.
    5. Stop the vehicle and turn ignition switch OFF.
    6. Turn ignition switch ON.
    7. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    8. Restart engine.
    9. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for five times.
    10. Stop the vehicle and connect GST to the vehicle.
    11. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-171, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    H

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022534

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    Disconnect A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground.

    EC-171

    K

    L

    M

    N

    P

    2.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    O

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.
    1.
    2.
    3.

    I

    2014 Note

    P0130 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal

    F12

    4

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R harness connector F42
    • 20A fuse (No. 53)
    • Harness for open or short between A/F sensor 1 and fuse
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    4.

    ECM
    Connector

    49

    F11

    2

    Terminal

    53

    Continuity

    Existed

    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground or ECM harness connector
    and ground.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    2

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    49
    53

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    5. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Perform GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace malfunctioning air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-172

    2014 Note

    P0131 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0131 A/F SENSOR 1

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022535

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    To judge the malfunction, the diagnosis checks that the A/F signal computed by ECM from the A/F sensor 1
    signal is not inordinately low.
    DTC No.
    P0131

    C

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible Cause

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    circuit low voltage

    The A/F signal computed by ECM from
    the A/F sensor 1 signal is constantly
    approx. 0 V.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The A/F sensor 1 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • A/F sensor 1

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    2. Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    3. Select “A/F SEN1 (B1)” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    4. Check “A/F SEN1 (B1)” indication.
    Is the indication constantly approx. 0 V?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-174, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    I

    J

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    3.

    K

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds and then restart engine.
    Drive and accelerate vehicle to more than 40 km/h (25 MPH) within 20 seconds after restarting engine.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    Maintain the following conditions for about 20 consecutive seconds.

    ENG SPEED

    1,000 — 3,200 rpm

    VHCL SPEED SE

    More than 40 km/h (25 mph)

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    1.5 — 9.0 msec

    Selector lever

    Suitable position

    L

    M

    N

    NOTE:
    • Keep the accelerator pedal as steady as possible during cruising.
    • If this procedure is not completed within 1 minute after restarting engine at step 1, return to step
    1.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-174, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    G

    H

    2.CHECK A/F SENSOR FUNCTION

    1.
    2.

    F

    EC-173

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    P0131 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022536

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal

    F12

    4

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R harness connector F42
    • 20A fuse (No. 53)
    • Harness for open or short between A/F sensor 1 and fuse
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    4.

    ECM
    Connector

    49

    F11

    2

    Terminal

    53

    Continuity

    Existed

    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground or ECM harness connector
    and ground.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    2

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    49
    53

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    5. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-174

    2014 Note

    P0131 A/F SENSOR 1
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Perform GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace malfunctioning air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-175

    2014 Note

    P0132 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0132 A/F SENSOR 1
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022537

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    To judge the malfunction, the diagnosis checks that the A/F signal computed by ECM from the A/F sensor 1
    signal is not inordinately high.
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    circuit high voltage

    P0132

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible Cause

    The A/F signal computed by ECM from
    the A/F sensor 1 signal is constantly
    approx. 5 V.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The A/F sensor 1 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • A/F sensor 1

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK A/F SENSOR FUNCTION
    1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    2. Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    3. Select “A/F SEN1 (B1)” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    4. Check “A/F SEN1 (B1)” indication.
    Is the indication constantly approx. 5 V?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-177, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds and then restart engine.
    Drive and accelerate vehicle to more than 40 km/h (25 MPH) within 20 seconds after restarting engine.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    Maintain the following conditions for about 20 consecutive seconds.

    ENG SPEED

    1,000 — 3,200 rpm

    VHCL SPEED SE

    More than 40 km/h (25 mph)

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    1.5 — 9.0 msec

    Selector lever

    Suitable position

    NOTE:
    • Keep the accelerator pedal as steady as possible during the cruising.
    • If this procedure is not completed within 1 minute after restarting engine at step 1, return to step
    1.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-177, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-176

    2014 Note

    P0132 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022538

    A

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    EC

    C

    2.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground.

    D

    E
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal

    F12

    4

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    G

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R harness connector F42
    • 20A fuse (No. 53)
    • Harness for open or short between A/F sensor 1 and fuse

    H

    I

    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    J

    1.
    2.
    3.

    K

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    4.

    ECM
    Connector

    49

    F11

    2

    Terminal

    53

    Continuity

    L

    Existed

    M

    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground or ECM harness connector
    and ground.
    N
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    2

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    O

    P
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    49
    53

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    5. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-177

    2014 Note

    P0132 A/F SENSOR 1
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Perform GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace malfunctioning air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-178

    2014 Note

    P0133 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0133 A/F SENSOR 1

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022539

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    To judge the malfunction of A/F sensor 1, this diagnosis measures response time of the A/F signal computed
    by ECM from the A/F sensor 1 signal. The time is compensated by engine operating (speed and load), fuel
    feedback control constant, and the A/F sensor 1 temperature index. Judgment is based on whether the compensated time (the A/F signal cycling time index) is inordinately long or not.
    DTC No.

    P0133

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1
    circuit slow response

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible Cause

    The response of the A/F signal computed
    by ECM from A/F sensor 1 signal takes
    more than the specified time.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The A/F sensor 1 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • A/F sensor 1
    • A/F sensor 1 heater
    • Fuel pressure
    • Fuel injector
    • Intake air leaks
    • Exhaust gas leaks
    • PCV
    • Mass air flow sensor

    C

    D

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11 V at idle.
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    H

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I

    With CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Restart engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1minute under no
    load.
    4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    5. Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    6. Select “A/F SEN1(B1) P1278/P1279” (for DTC P0133) of “A/F SEN1” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode.
    7. Touch “START”.
    Is “COMPLETED” displayed on CONSULT screen?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II

    Touch “SELF-DIAG RESULT”.
    Which is displayed on CONSULT screen?
    OK
    >> INSPECTION END
    NG
    >> Proceed to EC-180, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    After perform the following procedure, “TESTING” will be displayed on the CONSULT screen.
    Increase the engine speed up to between 4,000 and 5,000 rpm and maintain that speed for 10 seconds.

    EC-179

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    1.

    I

    2014 Note

    P0133 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Fully release accelerator pedal and then let engine idle for about 10 seconds.
    If “TESTING” is not displayed after 10 seconds, refer to EC-129, «Component Function Check».
    2. Wait for about 20 seconds at idle under the condition that “TESTING” is displayed on the CONSULT
    screen.
    3. Make sure that “TESTING” changes to “COMPLETED”.
    If “TESTING” changed to “OUT OF CONDITION”, refer to EC-129, «Component Function Check».
    4. Touch “SELF-DIAG RESULT”.
    Which is displayed on CONSULT screen?
    OK
    >> INSPECTION END
    NG
    >> Proceed to EC-180, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    5.CHECK AIR-FUEL RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE

    With GST
    1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    2. Select Service $01 with GST.
    3. Calculate the total value of “Short term fuel trim” and “Long term fuel trim” indications.
    Is the total percentage within ±15%?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • Intake air leaks
    • Exhaust gas leaks
    • Incorrect fuel pressure
    • Lack of fuel
    • Fuel injector
    • Incorrect PCV hose connection
    • PCV valve
    • Mass air flow sensor

    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part.

    7.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Restart engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1minute under no
    load.
    3. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    4. Increase the engine speed up to between 4,000 and 5,000 rpm and maintain that speed for 10 seconds.
    5. Fully release accelerator pedal and then let engine idle for about 1 minute.
    6. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-180, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022540

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.RETIGHTEN A/F SENSOR 1

    Loosen and retighten the A/F sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».
    >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-180

    2014 Note

    P0133 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK EXHAUST GAS LEAK
    1.
    2.

    A

    Start engine and run it at idle.
    Listen for an exhaust gas leak before three way catalyst 1.

    EC

    C

    D
    PBIB1216E

    Is exhaust gas leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    E

    4.CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK

    F

    Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
    Is intake air leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    G

    5.CLEAR THE MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE
    1. Clear the mixture ratio self-learning value. Refer to EC-117, «Work Procedure».
    2. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
    Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected? Is it difficult to start engine?
    YES >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or P0172. Refer to EC-201, «DTC Logic» or EC-205,
    «DTC Logic».
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal

    F12

    4

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    N

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R harness connector F42
    • 20A fuse (No. 53)
    • Harness for open or short between A/F sensor 1 and fuse

    O

    P

    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    8.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-181

    2014 Note

    P0133 A/F SENSOR 1
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    4.

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal
    49

    F11

    2

    53

    Continuity

    Existed

    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ground or ECM harness connector
    and ground.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    2

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    49
    53

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    5. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    9.CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR 1 HEATER
    Refer to EC-150, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 12.

    10.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR

    Check both mass air flow sensor.
    Refer to EC-160, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning mass air flow sensor. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».

    11.CHECK PCV VALVE

    Refer to EC-337, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace PCV valve. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    12.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Perform GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace malfunctioning air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-182

    2014 Note

    P0137 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0137 HO2S2

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022541

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
    between rich and lean than the air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. The oxygen storage capacity of the three way catalyst 1 causes the longer
    switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
    2, ECM monitors whether the maximum voltage of the sensor is sufficiently high during various driving conditions such as fuel-cut.

    C

    D

    E
    JSBIA0243GB

    F
    DTC No.

    P0137

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    circuit low voltage

    DTC detecting condition

    The maximum voltage from the sensor does not
    reach the specified voltage.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
    • Heated oxygen sensor 2
    • Fuel pressure
    • Fuel injector
    • Intake air leaks

    G

    H

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.INSPECTION START

    I

    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    J

    2.PRECONDITIONING

    K

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    For better results, perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” at a temperature of 0 to 30°C (32 to 86°F).
    >> GO TO 3.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C (158°F).
    If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN TEMP/S” indication reaches 70°C (158°F).
    7. Open engine hood.
    8. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P1147” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    9. Follow the instruction of CONSULT.
    NOTE:

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    EC-183

    M

    N

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    P0137 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    It will take at most 10 minutes until “COMPLETED” is displayed.
    10. Touch “SELF-DIAG RESULT”.
    Which is displayed on CONSULT screen?
    OK
    >> INSPECTION END
    NG
    >> Proceed to EC-185, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    CAN NOT BE DIAGNOSED>>GO TO 4.

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE AGAIN
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and leave the vehicle in a cool place (soak the vehicle).
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE again.
    >> GO TO 3.

    5.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK
    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-184, «Component Function Check».
    NOTE:
    Use component function check to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this
    check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-185, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022542

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-I
    Without CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Restart engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no
    load.
    4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    5. Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    1.
    2.
    3.

    ECM
    Connector
    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Voltage

    Revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load at least 10 times

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V
    at least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-II
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM
    Connector
    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Keeping engine at idle for 10 minutes

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V
    at least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-III
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-184

    2014 Note

    P0137 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.

    A
    ECM
    Connector
    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Voltage

    Coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D position (CVT), 4th
    gear position (M/T)

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V
    at least once during this procedure.

    EC

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-185, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    D
    INFOID:0000000009022543

    1.HECK GROUND CONNECTION

    E

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    F

    2.CLEAR THE MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE

    G

    1. Clear the mixture ratio self-learning value. Refer to EC-117, «Work Procedure».
    2. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
    Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected? Is it difficult to start engine?
    YES >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171. Refer to EC-201, «DTC Logic».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    H

    I

    3.CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    J

    K
    HO2S2

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    1

    F11

    59

    Continuity

    L

    Existed

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    M

    4.CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    HO2S2

    2.

    N

    O

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    F11

    50

    Continuity
    Existed

    P

    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector ground or ECM harness connector and ground.
    HO2S2
    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    Revision: April 2013

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    EC-185

    2014 Note

    P0137 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    50

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2

    Refer to EC-186, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022544

    1.INSPECTION START
    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    2.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON and select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Select “FUEL INJECTION” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode, and select “HO2S2 (B1)” as the monitor item with
    CONSULT.
    8. Check “HO2S2 (B1)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    JSBIA1202GB

    “HO2S2 (B1)” should be above 0.78 V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
    “HO2S2 (B1)” should be below 0.50 V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    3.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Without CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-186

    2014 Note

    P0137 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load at
    least 10 times

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    EC

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    D

    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.

    E

    4.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-II
    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Keeping engine at idle for 10 minutes

    F

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    G

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-III

    I

    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    J
    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Voltage

    K
    Coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D position (CVT), 4th gear position (M/T)

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-187

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0138 HO2S2
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022545

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time between rich and lean than the air fuel ratio (A/
    F) sensor 1. The oxygen storage capacity of the three way catalyst 1 causes the longer switching time.
    MALFUNCTION A
    To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor 2, ECM monitors
    whether the voltage is unusually high during various driving conditions such as fuel cut.

    PBIB1848E

    MALFUNCTION B
    To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor 2, ECM monitors
    whether the minimum voltage of sensor is sufficiently low during various driving conditions such as fuel cut.

    JSBIA3141GB

    DTC No.

    P0138

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    A)

    An excessively high voltage from the sensor
    is sent to ECM.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
    • Heated oxygen sensor 2

    B)

    The minimum voltage from the sensor is not
    reached to the specified voltage.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
    • Heated oxygen sensor 2
    • Fuel pressure
    • Fuel injector

    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    circuit high voltage

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING OF DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
    1.
    2.

    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-188

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Restart engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no
    load.
    A
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-191, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    EC
    NO-1 >> With CONSULT: GO TO 3.
    NO-2 >> Without CONSULT: GO TO 12.

    3.PRECONDITIONING OF DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B

    C

    “COMPLETED” will appear on CONSULT screen when all tests “COND1”, “COND2” and “COND3” are completed.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    • For the best results, perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” at a temperature of 0 to 30 °C (32 to 86 °F).
    • Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry procedure from PERFORM
    PROCEDURE FOR COND1-II.

    D

    E

    >> GO TO 4.

    4.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND1-I

    F

    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    G

    >> GO TO 5.

    5.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND1-II
    H

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 6.

    I

    6.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND1-III
    1. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    2. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    3. Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    4. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P1146” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode.
    5. Touch “START”.
    6. Let engine idle for at least 30 seconds.
    7. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm two or three times quickly under no load.
    Is “COMPLETED” appears on CONSULT screen?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    7.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND1-IV

    J

    K

    L

    M

    When the following conditions are met, “TESTING” will be displayed at “COND1” on the CONSULT screen.
    Maintain the conditions continuously until “TESTING” changes to “COMPLETED”
    N
    ENG SPEED

    More than 1,000 rpm

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    More than 1.0 msec

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    70 — 105°C

    Selector lever

    Suitable position

    O

    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    Which displayed on CONSULT screen?
    “COND1: OUT OF CONDITION”>>GO TO 5.
    “COND1: COMPLETED”, “COND2: INCOMPLETE”>>GO TO 8.
    “COND1: COMPLETED”, “COND2: COMPLETED”>>GO TO 9.

    P

    8.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND2
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-189

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    While driving, release accelerator pedal completed from the above condition (PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR
    COND1-III) until “INCOMPLETE” at “COND2” on CONSULT screen has turned to “COMPLETED” (It will take
    approximately 4 seconds).
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    Which displayed on CONSULT screen?
    “COND2: COMPLETED”, “COND3: INCOMPLETE”>>GO TO 9.
    “COND2: COMPLETED”, “COND3: COMPLETED”>>GO TO 10.

    9.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND3-I

    Stop vehicle and let it idle until “INCOMPLETE” of “COND3” on CONSULT screen has turned to “COMPLETED”
    >> GO TO 10.

    10.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND3-II
    Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS”.
    Which displayed on CONSULT screen?
    “OK” >> INSPECTION END.
    “NG” >> Proceed to EC-191, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    “CAN NOT BE DIAGNOSED”>>GO TO 11.

    11.PERFORM PROCEDURE FOR COND3-III
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and leave the vehicle in a cool place (soak the vehicle).
    Turn ignition switch ON and select ENGINE using CONSULT.
    Select “COOLAN TEMP/S” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up while monitoring “COOLAN TEMP/S” indication on CONSULT.
    When “COOLAN TEMP/S” indication reaches 70°C (158°F).
    >> GO TO 6.

    12.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK
    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-190, «Component Function Check».
    NOTE:
    Use component function check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this
    check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-191, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022546

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Without CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM

    Connector
    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2 signal)

    59

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    Revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load at
    least 10 times

    EC-190

    Voltage

    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    A

    2.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-II

    EC

    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM
    Connector
    F11

    C

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2 signal)

    59

    Condition

    Keeping engine at idle for 10 minutes

    Voltage

    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    E

    3.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-III

    F

    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.

    G

    ECM
    Connector
    F11

    D

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2 signal)

    59

    Condition

    Coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D position
    (CVT), 4th gear position (M/T)

    Voltage

    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-191, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    I

    INFOID:0000000009022547

    J

    1.INSPECTION START
    Confirm the detected malfunction (A or B). Refer to EC-188, «DTC Logic».
    Which malfunction is detected?
    A
    >> GO TO 2.
    B
    >> GO TO 7.

    K

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    M

    1.
    2.
    3.

    O

    L

    2.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    N

    3.CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    P
    HO2S2

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    1

    F11

    59

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-191

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    4.CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    HO2S2

    2.

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    F11

    50

    Continuity
    Existed

    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ground or ECM harness connector and
    ground.
    HO2S2
    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    50

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK HO2S2 CONNECTOR FOR WATER

    Check connectors for water.
    Water should not exist.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2

    Refer to EC-193, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    7.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    8.CLEAR THE MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE

    1. Clear the mixture ratio self-learning value. Refer to EC-117, «Work Procedure».
    2. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
    Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected? Is it difficult to start engine?
    YES >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-205, «DTC Logic».
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-192

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
    3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    4. Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    HO2S2

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    1

    F11

    59

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    Continuity
    Existed

    C

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    D

    10.CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    HO2S2

    2.

    E

    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    F11

    50

    Continuity

    F

    Existed

    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector or ECM harness connector and ground.
    HO2S2
    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    G

    H

    I
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    50

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    J

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    K

    11.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2

    L

    Refer to EC-193, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    M

    INFOID:0000000009582429

    N

    1.INSPECTION START
    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    O

    P

    2.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON and select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-193

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    5. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    6. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    7. Select “FUEL INJECTION” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode, and select “HO2S2 (B1)” as the monitor item with
    CONSULT.
    8. Check “HO2S2 (B1)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.

    JSBIA1202GB

    “HO2S2 (B1)” should be above 0.78 V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
    “HO2S2 (B1)” should be below 0.50 V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    3.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Without CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM

    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load at
    least 10 times

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-II
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Keeping engine at idle for 10 minutes

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-III

    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-194

    2014 Note

    P0138 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D position (CVT), 4th gear position (M/T)

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-195

    2014 Note

    P0139 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0139 HO2S2
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022549

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
    between rich and lean than the air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1. The oxygen storage capacity of the three way catalyst (manifold) causes the
    longer switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen
    sensor 2, ECM monitors whether the switching response of the sensor’s voltage is faster than specified during the various driving condition such as fuel cut.

    SEF302U

    DTC No.

    P0139

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Heated oxygen sensor 2
    circuit slow response

    DTC detecting condition

    It takes more time for the sensor to respond
    between rich and lean than the specified time.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
    • Heated oxygen sensor 2
    • Fuel pressure
    • Fuel injector
    • Intake air leaks

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.INSPECTION START

    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    2.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    For better results, perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” at a temperature of 0 to 30°C (32 to 86°F).
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C (158°F).
    If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
    9. Open engine hood.
    10. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P0139” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-196

    2014 Note

    P0139 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    11. Start engine and follow the instruction of CONSULT display.
    NOTE:
    It will take at most 10 minutes until “COMPLETED” is displayed.
    Is “COMPLETED” displayed on CONSULT screen?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    A

    EC

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE AGAIN
    1.
    2.

    C

    Turn ignition switch OFF and leave the vehicle in a cool place (soak the vehicle).
    Perform DTC confirmation procedure again.

    D

    >> GO TO 3.

    5.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS
    E

    With CONSULT
    Perform ECM self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “P0139” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-198, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    F

    6.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK

    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-197, «Component Function Check».
    NOTE:
    Use component function check to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this
    check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-198, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Component Function Check

    ECM

    F11

    K

    L

    M

    Terminal

    Condition

    +

    50
    (HO2S2 signal)

    59

    Revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load at
    least 10 times

    Voltage

    A change of voltage should be more than
    0.12 V for 1 second during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    N

    O

    2.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-II

    P

    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground under the following condition.

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    J

    Without CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground under the following condition.

    Connector

    H

    INFOID:0000000009022550

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    G

    EC-197

    2014 Note

    P0139 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector
    F11

    Condition

    +

    50
    (HO2S2 signal)

    59

    Keeping engine speed at idle for 10 minutes

    Voltage

    A change of voltage should be more than
    0.12 V for 1 second during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-III
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground under the following condition.
    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector
    F11

    Condition

    +

    50
    (HO2S2 signal)

    59

    Coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D position
    (CVT), 4th gear position (M/T)

    Voltage

    A change of voltage should be more than
    0.12 V for 1 second during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-198, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022551

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CLEAR THE MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING VALUE

    1. Clear the mixture ratio self-learning value. Refer to EC-117, «Work Procedure».
    2. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
    Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected? Is it difficult to start engine?
    YES >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or P0172. Refer to EC-201, «DTC Logic» or EC-205,
    «DTC Logic».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 (HO2S2) harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    HO2S2

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    1

    F11

    59

    Continuity
    Existed

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-198

    2014 Note

    P0139 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    A
    HO2S2

    2.

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    F11

    50

    Continuity

    EC

    Existed

    Check the continuity between HO2S2 harness connector or ECM harness connector and ground.
    C
    HO2S2
    Connector

    Terminal

    E63

    4

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    50

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    D

    Ground

    Continuity

    E

    Ground

    Not existed

    F

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    G

    5.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2

    Refer to EC-199, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    H

    I
    INFOID:0000000009582430

    1.INSPECTION START

    J

    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    K

    2.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2

    L

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON and select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Select “FUEL INJECTION” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode, and select “HO2S2 (B1)” as the monitor item with
    CONSULT.
    8. Check “HO2S2 (B1)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JSBIA1202GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-199

    2014 Note

    P0139 HO2S2
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    “HO2S2 (B1)” should be above 0.78 V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
    “HO2S2 (B1)” should be below 0.50 V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    3.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Without CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM

    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load at
    least 10 times

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-II
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Keeping engine at idle for 10 minutes

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2-III

    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.
    ECM
    Connector

    F11

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D position (CVT), 4th gear position (M/T)

    Voltage

    The voltage should be above 0.78 V at
    least once during this procedure.
    The voltage should be below 0.50 V at
    least once during this procedure.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-200

    2014 Note

    P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022553

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
    theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the A/F sensor 1. The ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical ratios.
    In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too lean.), the
    ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and lights up the MIL (2 trip detection logic).
    Sensor

    Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
    (Mixture ratio feedback signal)

    A/F sensor 1

    DTC No.

    P0171

    Input signal to ECM

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Fuel injection system too lean

    ECM function

    Actuator

    Fuel injection control

    D

    Fuel injector

    E

    DTC detecting condition

    • Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
    • The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
    large. (The mixture ratio is too lean.)

    C

    Possible cause







    Intake air leaks
    A/F sensor 1
    Fuel injector
    Exhaust gas leaks
    Incorrect fuel pressure
    Lack of fuel
    Mass air flow sensor
    Incorrect PCV hose connection

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I
    1. Clear the mixture ratio self-learning value. Refer to EC-117, «Work Procedure».
    2. Start engine.
    Is it difficult to start engine?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    L

    M

    3.RESTART ENGINE

    If it is difficult to start engine, the fuel injection system has a malfunction, too.
    Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
    NOTE:
    When depressing accelerator pedal three-fourths (3/4) or more, the control system may not start the engine.
    Do not depress accelerator pedal too much.
    Does engine start?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-202, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Check exhaust and intake air leak visually.

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II

    1. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 minutes.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-202, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-201

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-III
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine.
    Maintain the following conditions for at least 10 consecutive minutes.
    Hold the accelerator pedal as steady as possible.
    VHCL SPEED SE

    50 — 120 km/h (31 — 75 MPH)

    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-202, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022554

    1.CHECK EXHAUST GAS LEAK
    1.
    2.

    Start engine and run it at idle.
    Listen for an exhaust gas leak before three way catalyst (manifold).

    PBIB1216E

    Is exhaust gas leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK AND PCV HOSE

    1. Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
    2. Check PCV hose connection.
    Intake air leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect corresponding A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector
    F12

    5.

    ECM

    Terminal
    1
    2

    Connector
    F11

    Terminal
    49
    53

    Continuity

    Existed

    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector or ECM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-202

    2014 Note

    P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    2

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    49
    53

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    EC

    C

    D

    6. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    E

    4.CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
    1.
    2.

    F

    Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».

    G

    At idling: Approximately 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.57 kg/cm2, 51 psi)
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    H

    5. CHECK FUEL HOSES AND FUEL TUBES

    I

    Check fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace “fuel filter and fuel pump assembly”. Refer to FL-6, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace

    J

    6.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR

    K

    With CONSULT
    1. Install all removed parts.
    2. Check “MASS AIRFLOW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.

    L

    0.8 — 4.0 g/s:
    2.0 — 10.0 g/s:
    1.
    2.

    at idling
    at 2,500 rpm

    M

    With GST
    Install all removed parts.
    Check mass air flow sensor signal in Service $01 with GST.
    0.8 — 4.0 g/s:
    2.0 — 10.0 g/s:

    N

    at idling
    at 2,500 rpm

    O

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
    grounds. Refer to EC-158, «DTC Logic».

    7.CHECK FUNCTION OF FUEL INJECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Start engine.
    Perform “POWER BALANCE” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.
    Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine speed drop.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-203

    2014 Note

    P

    P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Without CONSULT
    1. Let engine idle.
    2. Listen to each fuel injector operating sound.
    Clicking noise should be heard.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis for FUEL INJECTOR. Refer
    to EC-314, «Component Function Check».

    PBIB3332E

    8.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
    Disconnect all fuel injector harness connectors.
    Remove fuel tube assembly. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».
    Keep fuel hose and all fuel injectors connected to fuel tube.
    Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
    Prepare pans or saucers under each fuel injector.
    Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
    Fuel should be sprayed evenly for each fuel injector.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Replace fuel injectors from which fuel does not spray
    out. Always replace O-ring with new ones. Refer to EM40, «Exploded View».
    PBIA9666J

    9.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-204

    2014 Note

    P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022555

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
    theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the A/F sensor 1. The ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical ratios.
    In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too rich.), the
    ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and lights up the MIL (2 trip detection logic).
    Sensor

    Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
    (Mixture ratio feedback signal)

    A/F sensor 1

    DTC No.

    P0172

    Input signal to ECM

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Fuel injection system too rich

    ECM function

    Actuator

    Fuel injection control

    D

    Fuel injector

    E

    DTC detecting condition
    • Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
    • The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
    large. (The mixture ratio is too rich.)

    C

    Possible cause




    A/F sensor 1
    Fuel injector
    Exhaust gas leaks
    Incorrect fuel pressure
    Mass air flow sensor

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    H

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    J

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-1

    K

    1. Clear the mixture ratio self-learning value. Refer to EC-117, «Work Procedure».
    2. Start engine.
    Is it difficult to start engine?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    L

    3.RESTART ENGINE

    M

    If it is difficult to start engine, the fuel injection system has a malfunction, too.
    Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
    NOTE:
    When depressing accelerator pedal three-fourths (3/4) or more, the control system may not start the engine.
    Do not depress accelerator pedal too much.
    Does engine start?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-206, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Remove spark plugs and check for fouling, etc.

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-2

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-3

    EC-205

    N

    O

    P

    1. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 minutes.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-206, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    2014 Note

    P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Start engine.
    3. Maintain the following conditions for at least 10 consecutive minutes.
    Hold the accelerator pedal as steady as possible.
    VHCL SPEED SE

    50 — 120 km/h (31 — 75 MPH)

    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-206, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022556

    1.CHECK EXHAUST GAS LEAK
    1.
    2.

    Start engine and run it at idle.
    Listen for an exhaust gas leak before three way catalyst (manifold).

    PBIB1216E

    Is exhaust gas leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK

    Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
    Is intake air leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect corresponding A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    5.

    ECM
    Connector

    49

    F11

    2

    Terminal

    53

    Continuity

    Existed

    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector or ECM harness connector and ground.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal

    F12

    Revision: April 2013

    1
    2

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    EC-206

    2014 Note

    P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    49
    53

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    EC

    6. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    C

    4.CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
    1.
    2.

    D

    Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».

    E

    At idling: Approximately 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.57 kg/cm2, 51 psi)
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    F

    5. CHECK FUEL HOSES AND FUEL TUBES

    G

    Check fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace “fuel filter and fuel pump assembly”. Refer to FL-6, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace

    H

    6.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
    1.
    2.

    With CONSULT
    Install all removed parts.
    Check “MASS AIRFLOW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    0.8 — 4.0 g/s:
    2.0 — 10.0 g/s:

    1.
    2.

    I

    J

    at idling
    at 2,500 rpm

    K

    With GST
    Install all removed parts.
    Check mass air flow sensor signal in “Service $01” with GST.
    0.8 — 4.0 g/s:
    2.0 — 10.0 g/s:

    L

    at idling
    at 2,500 rpm

    M

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
    grounds. Refer to EC-158, «DTC Logic».

    7.CHECK FUNCTION OF FUEL INJECTOR

    O

    With CONSULT
    1. Start engine.
    2. Perform “POWER BALANCE” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.
    3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine speed drop.
    Without CONSULT
    1. Let engine idle.

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    EC-207

    P

    2014 Note

    P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Listen to each fuel injector operating sound.
    Clicking noise should be heard.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis for FUEL INJECTOR. Refer
    to EC-314, «Component Function Check».

    PBIB3332E

    8.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR
    1.

    Remove fuel injector assembly. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».
    Keep fuel hose and all fuel injectors connected to fuel tube.
    2. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
    3. Disconnect all fuel injector harness connectors.
    4. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
    5. Prepare pans or saucers under each fuel injectors.
    6. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
    Make sure fuel does not drip from fuel injector.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Replace the fuel injectors from which fuel is dripping. Always replace O-ring with new one. Refer
    to EM-40, «Exploded View».

    9.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-208

    2014 Note

    P0196 EOT SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0196 EOT SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022557

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    NOTE:
    If DTC P0196 is displayed with P0197 or P0198, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0197 or
    P0198. Refer to EC-211, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P0196

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Engine oil temperature sensor
    range/performance

    Rationally incorrect voltage from the sensor
    is sent to ECM, compared with the voltage
    signals from engine coolant temperature
    sensor and intake air temperature sensor.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
    • Engine oil temperature sensor

    C

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11 V at idle.

    F

    G

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I

    I

    1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    5. Start engine and let it idle for 5 minutes and 10 seconds.
    6. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> EC-210, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    J

    K

    L

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II
    1.
    2.

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    Check that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates above 60°C (140°F).
    If it is above 60°C (140°F), go to the following steps.
    If it is below 60°C (140°F), warm engine up until “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 60°C (140°F).
    Then perform the following steps.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and soak the vehicle in a cool place.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    NOTE:
    Do not turn ignition switch OFF until step 10.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    Check the following.

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    Below 40°C (104°F)

    INT/A TEMP SE

    Below 40°C (104°F)

    Difference between “COOLAN TEMP/S” and “INT/A TEMP SE”

    Within 0°C (32°F)

    If they are within the specified range, perform the following steps.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-209

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    P0196 EOT SENSOR
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    If they are out of the specified range, soak the vehicle to meet the above conditions. Then perform the following steps.
    NOTE:
    • Do not turn ignition switch OFF.
    • If it is supposed to need a long period of time, do not deplete the battery.
    9. Start engine and let it idle for 5 minutes.
    10. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> EC-210, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022558

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E78. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CHECK ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR

    Refer to EC-210, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil temperature sensor.

    3.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022559

    1.CHECK ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect engine oil temperature sensor harness connector.
    Remove engine oil temperature sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».
    Check resistance between engine oil temperature sensor terminals by heating with hot water as shown in the figure.
    Terminals

    Condition

    Resistance (kΩ)
    20 (68)

    1 and 2

    Temperature [°C (°F)]

    2.10 — 2.90

    50 (122)

    0.68 — 1.00

    90 (194)

    0.236 — 0.260

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil temperature sensor. Refer to EM-92,
    «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-210

    JMBIA0080ZZ

    2014 Note

    P0197, P0198 EOT SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0197, P0198 EOT SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022560

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    DTC No.

    DTC Detecting Condition

    P0197

    EOT SEN/CIRC
    (Engine oil temperature
    sensor circuit low input)

    An excessively low voltage from the engine
    oil temperature sensor is sent to ECM.

    P0198

    EOT SEN/CIRC
    (Engine oil temperature
    sensor circuit high input)

    An excessively high voltage from the engine
    oil temperature sensor is sent to ECM.

    Possible Cause

    C

    • Harness or connectors
    (EOT sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Engine oil temperature sensor

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-211, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009022561

    K

    1.CHECK ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    G

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect engine oil temperature (EOT) sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between EOT sensor harness connector and ground.

    L

    M
    EOT sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F25

    1

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    5V

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    O

    2.CHECK ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    P

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between EOT sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    EOT sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F25

    1

    F11

    57

    Revision: April 2013

    Continuity
    Existed

    EC-211

    2014 Note

    P0197, P0198 EOT SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4. Also check harness for short to ground.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for power supply circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    [HR16DE]

    3.CHECK EOT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between EOT sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    EOT sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F25

    2

    F11

    54

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    4.CHECK ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR

    Check the engine oil temperature sensor. Refer to EC-212, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil temperature sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022562

    1.CHECK ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect engine oil temperature sensor harness connector.
    Remove engine oil temperature sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».
    Check resistance between engine oil temperature sensor terminals by heating with hot water as shown in the figure.

    Engine oil temperature sensor

    +

    Condition

    Resistance (kΩ)

    Terminal

    1

    2

    Temperature
    [°C (°F)]

    20 (68)

    2.10 — 2.90

    50 (122)

    0.68 — 1.00

    90 (194)

    0.236 — 0.260

    JMBIA0080ZZ

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil temperature sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-212

    2014 Note

    P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022563

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    NOTE:
    If DTC P0222 or P0223 is displayed with DTC P0643, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0643.
    Refer to EC-252, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    P0222

    Throttle position sensor
    1 circuit low input

    An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor
    1 is sent to ECM.

    P0223

    Throttle position sensor
    1 circuit high input

    An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor
    1 is sent to ECM.

    • Harness or connectors
    (TP sensor 1 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Electric throttle control actuator
    (TP sensor 1)

    C

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    F

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
    least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    H

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-213, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    J

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022564

    K

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    L

    M

    2.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ground.
    Electric throttle control actuator
    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    2

    N

    O
    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    G

    EC-213

    2014 Note

    P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Electric throttle control actuator

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    4

    F11

    36

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Electric throttle control actuator

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    1

    F11

    33

    Continuity
    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR

    Refer to EC-214, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    7.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022565

    1.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Perform EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Set selector lever to D (CVT) or 1st (M/T) position.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-214

    2014 Note

    P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector

    +

    Condition

    33
    (TP sensor 1 signal)
    F11

    36
    34
    (TP sensor 2 signal)

    Voltage

    Accelerator
    pedal

    Fully released

    More than 0.36 V

    Fully depressed

    Less than 4.75 V

    Fully released

    Less than 4.75 V

    Fully depressed

    More than 0.36 V

    EC

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    D

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    E

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    F

    >> INSPECTION END

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-215

    2014 Note

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022566

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    When a misfire occurs, engine speed will fluctuate. If the engine speed fluctuates enough to cause the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) signal to vary, ECM can determine that a misfire is occurring.
    Sensor
    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    Input signal to ECM

    ECM function

    Engine speed

    On board diagnosis of misfire

    The misfire detection logic consists of the following two conditions.
    1. One Trip Detection Logic (Three Way Catalyst Damage)
    On the 1st trip, when a misfire condition occurs that can damage the three way catalyst (TWC) due to
    overheating, the MIL will blink.
    When a misfire condition occurs, the ECM monitors the CKP sensor signal every 200 engine revolutions
    for a change.
    When the misfire condition decreases to a level that will not damage the TWC, the MIL will turn off.
    If another misfire condition occurs that can damage the TWC on a second trip, the MIL will blink.
    When the misfire condition decreases to a level that will not damage the TWC, the MIL will remain on.
    If another misfire condition occurs that can damage the TWC, the MIL will begin to blink again.
    2. Two Trip Detection Logic (Exhaust quality deterioration)
    For misfire conditions that will not damage the TWC (but will affect vehicle emissions), the MIL will only
    light when the misfire is detected on a second trip. During this condition, the ECM monitors the CKP sensor signal every 1,000 engine revolutions.
    A misfire malfunction can be detected on any one cylinder or on multiple cylinders.
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    P0300

    Multiple cylinder misfire detected

    Multiple cylinder misfire.

    P0301

    No.1 cylinder misfire detected

    No. 1 cylinder misfires.

    P0302

    No. 2 cylinder misfire detected

    No. 2 cylinder misfires.

    P0303

    No. 3 cylinder misfire detected

    No. 3 cylinder misfires.

    P0304

    No. 4 cylinder misfire detected

    No. 4 cylinder misfires.

    Possible cause



    Improper spark plug
    Insufficient compression
    Incorrect fuel pressure
    The fuel injector circuit is open or shorted







    Fuel injector*
    Intake air leak
    The ignition signal circuit is open or shorted
    Lack of fuel
    Signal plate
    A/F sensor 1
    Incorrect PCV hose connection

    *: DTC is detected even where a malfunction occurs one side of the dual injector.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I
    1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    3. Restart engine and let it idle for about 15 minutes.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-217, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-216

    2014 Note

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II
    1.
    2.

    A

    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and drive the vehicle under the similar conditions to (1st trip) Freeze Frame Data for a certain
    EC
    time. Refer to the table below.
    Hold the accelerator pedal as steady as possible.
    The similar conditions to (1st trip) Freeze Frame Data means the vehicle operation that the following conditions should be satisfied at the same time.
    C
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle in safe manner according to traffic conditions and obey all traffic laws when
    driving.
    D

    Engine speed

    Engine speed in the freeze frame data ± 400 rpm

    Vehicle speed

    Vehicle speed in the freeze frame data ± 10 km/h (6 MPH)

    Engine coolant temperature (T) condition

    E

    When the freeze frame data shows lower than 70°C (158°F),
    T should be lower than 70°C (158°F).

    F

    When the freeze frame data shows higher than or equal to 70°C (158°F),
    T should be higher than or equal to 70°C (158°F).

    The time to driving varies according to the engine speed in the freeze frame data.
    G
    Engine speed

    Time

    Around 1,000 rpm

    Approximately 10 minutes

    Around 2,000 rpm

    Approximately 5 minutes

    More than 3,000 rpm

    Approximately 3.5 minutes

    H

    3. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-217, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009022567

    1.CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK AND PCV HOSE

    K

    1. Start engine and run it at idle speed.
    2. Listen for the sound of the intake air leak.
    3. Check PCV hose connection.
    Is intake air leak detected?
    YES >> Discover air leak location and repair.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    L

    M

    2.CHECK FOR EXHAUST SYSTEM CLOGGING
    N

    Stop engine and visually check exhaust tube, three way catalyst and muffler for dents.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES-1 >> With CONSULT: GO TO 3.
    YES-2 >> Without CONSULT: GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace it.

    O

    3.PERFORM POWER BALANCE TEST

    P

    With CONSULT
    1. Start engine.
    2. Perform “POWER BALANCE” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.
    3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine speed drop.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-217

    2014 Note

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    4.CHECK FUNCTION OF FUEL INJECTOR
    1.
    2.

    Start engine and let engine idle.
    Listen to each fuel injector operating sound.
    Clicking noise should be heard.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis for FUEL INJECTOR. Refer
    to EC-314, «Component Function Check».

    PBIB3332E

    5.CHECK FUNCTION OF IGNITION COIL-I

    CAUTION:
    Do the following procedure in the place where ventilation is good without the combustible.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Remove fuel pump fuse in IPDM E/R to release fuel pressure.
    NOTE:
    Do not use CONSULT to release fuel pressure, or fuel pressure applies again during the following procedure.
    3. Start engine.
    4. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel pressure.
    5. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    6. Remove all ignition coil harness connectors to avoid the electrical discharge from the ignition coils.
    7. Remove ignition coil and spark plug of the cylinder to be checked.
    8. Crank engine for 5 seconds or more to remove combustion gas in the cylinder.
    9. Connect spark plug and harness connector to ignition coil.
    10. Fix ignition coil using a rope etc. with gap of 13 — 17 mm (0.52 0.66 in) between the edge of the spark plug and grounded metal
    portion as shown in the figure.
    11. Crank engine for about 3 seconds, and check whether spark is
    generated between the spark plug and the grounded metal portion.
    Spark should be generated.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not approach to the spark plug and the ignition coil
    JMBIA0066GB
    within 50 cm (19.7 in). Be careful not to get an electrical
    shock while checking, because the electrical discharge
    voltage becomes 20 kV or more.
    • It might cause to damage the ignition coil if the gap of more than 17 mm (0.66 in) is taken.
    NOTE:
    When the gap is less than 13 mm (0.52 in), the spark might be generated even if the coil is malfunctioning.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.CHECK FUNCTION OF IGNITION COIL-II

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect spark plug and connect a known-good spark plug.
    Crank engine for about 3 seconds, and recheck whether spark is generated between the spark plug and
    the grounded metal portion.
    Spark should be generated.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-218

    2014 Note

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Check ignition coil, power transistor and their circuits. Refer to EC-319, «Component Function
    Check».

    7.CHECK SPARK PLUG

    A

    EC

    Check the initial spark plug for fouling, etc.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace spark plug(s) with standard type one(s). For
    spark plug type, refer to EM-116, «Spark Plug».
    NO
    >> Repair or clean spark plug. Then GO TO 8.

    C

    D

    E
    SEF156I

    8.CHECK FUNCTION OF IGNITION COIL-III
    1.
    2.

    Reconnect the initial spark plugs.
    Crank engine for about 3 seconds, and recheck whether spark is generated between the spark plug and
    the grounded portion.

    F

    G

    Spark should be generated.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace spark plug(s) with standard type one(s). For spark plug type, refer to EM-116, «Spark
    Plug».

    H

    9.CHECK COMPRESSION PRESSURE

    I

    Check compression pressure. Refer to EM-13, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Check pistons, piston rings, valves, valve seats and cylinder head gaskets.

    J

    10.CHECK FUEL PRESSURE

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Install all removed parts.
    Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    At idling: Approximately 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.57 kg/cm2, 51 psi)

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> GO TO 11.

    11.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    N

    Check fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace “fuel filter and fuel pump assembly”. Refer to FL-6, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    O

    12.CHECK IGNITION TIMING

    P

    Check the following items.
    For procedure, refer to EC-335, «Inspection».
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Ignition Timing».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 13.
    NO
    >> Follow the EC-118, «Work Procedure».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-219

    2014 Note

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    13.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect A/F sensor 1 harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    5.

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal
    49

    F11

    2

    53

    Continuity

    Existed

    Check the continuity between A/F sensor 1 harness connector or ECM harness connector and ground.
    A/F sensor 1
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    F12

    2

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    49
    53

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    6. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 14.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    14.CHECK A/F SENSOR 1 HEATER

    Refer to EC-150, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 15.
    NO
    >> Replace A/F sensor 1. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».

    15.CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR

    With CONSULT
    Check “MASS AIRFLOW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    0.8 — 4.0 g/s:
    2.0 — 10.0 g/s:

    at idling
    at 2,500 rpm

    With GST
    Check mass air flow sensor signal in Service $01 with GST.
    0.8 — 4.0 g/s:
    2.0 — 10.0 g/s:

    at idling
    at 2,500 rpm

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 16.
    NO
    >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
    ground. Refer to EC-158, «DTC Logic».

    16.CHECK SYMPTOM TABLE

    Check items on the rough idle symptom in EC-327, «Symptom Table».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-220

    2014 Note

    P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 MISFIRE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 17.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    A

    17.ERASE THE 1ST TRIP DTC
    Some tests may cause a 1st trip DTC to be set.
    Erase the 1st trip DTC from the ECM memory after performing the tests.

    EC

    >> GO TO 18.

    C

    18.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    D

    >> INSPECTION END
    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-221

    2014 Note

    P0327, P0328 KS
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0327, P0328 KS
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022568

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detected condition

    P0327

    Knock sensor circuit low
    input

    An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
    sent to ECM.

    P0328

    Knock sensor circuit
    high input

    An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
    sent to ECM.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Knock sensor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-222, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022569

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CHECK KNOCK SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between knock sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Knock sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F14

    2

    F11

    40

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.

    Check the continuity between knock sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-222

    2014 Note

    P0327, P0328 KS
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Knock sensor

    A

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F14

    1

    F11

    37

    Continuity
    Existed

    EC

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    C

    4.CHECK KNOCK SENSOR

    D

    Refer to EC-223, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace knock sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    E

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    F

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    G

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022570

    1.CHECK KNOCK SENSOR

    H

    1.
    2.
    3.

    I

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
    Check resistance between knock sensor terminals as follows.
    NOTE:
    It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more than 10 MΩ.
    Terminals

    Resistance [at 20°C (68°F)]

    1 and 2

    Approx. 532 — 588 kΩ

    J

    CAUTION:
    Do not use any knock sensors that have been dropped or physically damaged. Use only new ones.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace knock sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-223

    2014 Note

    P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022571

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    P0335

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Crankshaft position sensor
    (POS) circuit

    • The crankshaft position sensor
    (POS) signal is not detected by the
    ECM during the first few seconds of
    engine cranking.
    • The proper pulse signal from the
    crankshaft position sensor (POS) is
    not sent to ECM while the engine is
    running.
    • The crankshaft position sensor
    (POS) signal is not in the normal
    pattern during engine running.

    • Harness or connectors
    [Crankshaft position sensor (POS) circuit is open
    or shorted.]
    (Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit is shorted.)
    (Accelerator pedal position sensor 2 circuit is
    shorted.)
    • Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor
    • Accelerator pedal position sensor 2
    • Signal plate

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5 V with ignition switch ON.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.

    Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
    If engine does not start, crank engine for at least 2 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-224, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022572

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR (POS) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between CKP sensor (POS) harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-224

    2014 Note

    P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    CKP sensor (POS)
    Connector

    Terminal

    F15

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    EC

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    C

    3.CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR (POS) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between CKP sensor (POS) harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    CKP sensor (POS)

    E

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F15

    1

    F11

    75

    Continuity
    Existed

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit.

    G

    4.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    Check harness for short to power and short to ground, between the following terminals.
    ECM

    H

    Sensor

    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    75

    E16

    D

    Name

    Connector

    Terminal

    CKP sensor (POS)

    F15

    1

    101

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    E17

    3

    102

    Accelerator pedal position sensor 2

    E12

    5

    I

    J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    K

    5.CHECK COMPONENTS

    L

    Check the following.
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor (Refer to EC-325, «Component Function Check»).
    • Accelerator pedal position sensor (Refer to EC-292, «Component Inspection»).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning component.

    M

    6.CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    N

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check the continuity between CKP sensor (POS) harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    CKP sensor (POS)

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F15

    2

    F11

    62

    Continuity

    P

    Existed

    3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    7.CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    Revision: April 2013

    O

    EC-225

    2014 Note

    P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    2. Check the continuity between CKP sensor (POS) harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    CKP sensor (POS)

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F15

    3

    F11

    61

    Continuity
    Existed

    3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    8.CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)

    Refer to EC-226, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS). Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    9.CHECK GEAR TOOTH

    Visually check for chipping signal plate gear tooth.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Replace the signal plate. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    10.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022573

    1.CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)-I
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
    3. Disconnect crankshaft position sensor (POS) harness connector.
    4. Remove the sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».
    5. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS). Refer to EM92, «Exploded View».

    2.CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)-II

    PBIA9210J

    Check resistance between crankshaft position sensor (POS) terminals as follows.
    Terminals (Polarity)

    Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)]

    1 (+) — 2 (−)
    1 (+) — 3 (−)

    Except 0 or ∞ Ω

    2 (+) — 3 (−)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-226

    2014 Note

    P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS). Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-227

    2014 Note

    P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022574

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC P0340 is displayed with DTC P0643, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0643. Refer to
    EC-252, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P0340

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Camshaft position sensor
    (PHASE) circuit

    • The cylinder No. signal is not sent
    to ECM for the first few seconds
    during engine cranking.
    • The cylinder No. signal is not sent
    to ECM during engine running.
    • The cylinder No. signal is not in
    the normal pattern during engine
    running.

    • Harness or connectors
    (Camshaft position sensor circuit is open or shorted)
    • Camshaft position sensor
    • Exhaust valve timing control position sensor
    • Intake camshaft
    • Exhaust camshaft
    • Starter motor
    • Starting system circuit
    • Dead (Weak) battery

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5 V with ignition switch ON.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I
    1.

    Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
    If engine does not start, crank engine for at least 2 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-228, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II

    1. Keep engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-228, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022575

    1.CHECK STARTING SYSTEM
    Turn ignition switch to START position.
    Does the engine turn over? Does the starter motor operate?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Check starting system.

    2.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-228

    2014 Note

    P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    3.CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR (PHASE) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect camshaft position (CMP) sensor (PHASE) harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between CMP sensor (PHASE) harness connector and ground.

    D

    CMP sensor (PHASE) / exhaust valve
    timing control position sensor
    Camshaft

    Connector

    Terminal

    Intake

    F21

    1

    Exhaust

    F56

    1

    C

    Ground

    Voltage

    E
    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    F

    4.CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    G

    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connectors.
    Check the continuity between CMP sensor (PHASE) harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    CMP sensor (PHASE) / exhaust
    valve timing control position sensor
    Camshaft

    Connector

    Terminal

    Intake

    F21

    2

    Exhaust

    F56

    2

    ECM

    I

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    63

    J

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    K

    5.CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    L

    Check the continuity between CMP sensor (PHASE) harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    M

    CMP sensor (PHASE) / exhaust
    valve timing control position sensor
    Camshaft

    Connector

    Terminal

    Intake

    F21

    3

    Exhaust

    F56

    3

    ECM
    Connector
    F11

    Continuity

    Terminal
    65
    48

    N
    Existed

    O

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    P

    6.CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)

    Refer to EC-230, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE). Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-229

    2014 Note

    P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    7.CHECK CAMSHAFT (INT)
    Check the following.
    • Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
    • Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
    rear end or replace camshaft. Refer to EM-60,
    «Exploded View».

    JSBIA0599ZZ

    8.CHECK CAMSHAFT (EXH)
    Check the following.
    • Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
    • Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
    rear end or replace camshaft. Refer to EM-60,
    «Exploded View».

    JSBIA0600ZZ

    9.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022576

    1.CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR-I
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
    3. Disconnect camshaft position sensor harness connector.
    4. Remove the sensor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».
    5. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace camshaft position sensor. Refer to EM-48,
    «Exploded View».

    PBIA9210J

    2.CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR-II
    Check resistance camshaft position sensor terminals as follows.
    Terminals (Polarity)

    Revision: April 2013

    Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)]

    EC-230

    2014 Note

    P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1 (+) — 2 (−)
    1 (+) — 3 (−)

    A

    Except 0 or ∞ Ω

    2 (+) — 3 (−)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace camshaft position sensor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-231

    2014 Note

    P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022577

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    The ECM monitors the switching frequency ratio of air fuel ratio (A/F)
    sensor 1 and heated oxygen sensor 2.
    A three way catalyst (manifold) with high oxygen storage capacity
    will indicate a low switching frequency of heated oxygen sensor 2.
    As oxygen storage capacity decreases, the heated oxygen sensor 2
    switching frequency will increase.
    When the frequency ratio of air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1 and heated
    oxygen sensor 2 approaches a specified limit value, the three way
    catalyst (manifold) malfunction is diagnosed.
    SEF484YB

    DTC No.

    P0420

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Catalyst system efficiency
    below threshold

    DTC detecting condition

    • Three way catalyst (manifold) does not operate
    properly.
    • Three way catalyst (manifold) does not have
    enough oxygen storage capacity.

    Possible cause






    Three way catalyst (manifold)
    Exhaust tube
    Intake air leaks
    Fuel injector
    Fuel injector leaks
    Spark plug
    Improper ignition timing

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.INSPECTION START

    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    2.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Do not hold engine speed for more than the specified minutes below.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I
    With CONSULT
    Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
    Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    Select “COOLAN TEMP/S” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C (158°F).
    If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
    7. Open engine hood.
    8. Select “DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION” then “SRT WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT.
    9. Rev engine up to 2,000 to 3,000 rpm and hold it for 3 consecutive minutes then release the accelerator
    pedal completely.

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-232

    2014 Note

    P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    10. Check the indication of “CATALYST”.
    Which is displayed on CONSULT screen?
    CMPLT >> GO TO 6.
    INCMP >> GO TO 4.

    A

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II

    EC

    1.
    2.

    Wait 5 seconds at idle.
    Rev engine up to 2,000 to 3,000 rpm and maintain it until “INCMP” of “CATALYST” changes to “CMPLT” (It
    will take approximately 5 minutes).
    Does the indication change to “CMPLT”?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    C

    D

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE AGAIN
    1.
    2.

    E

    Stop engine and cool it down to less than 70°C (158°F).
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE again.

    F

    >> GO TO 3.

    6.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-III
    Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-234, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    G

    H

    7.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK

    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-233, «Component Function Check».
    NOTE:
    Use component function check to check the overall function of the three way catalyst (manifold). During this
    check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-234, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    INFOID:0000000009022578

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK

    L

    Without CONSULT
    1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    3. Restart engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no
    load.
    4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
    5. Open engine hood.
    6. Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following condition.

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    50
    (HO2S2)

    59

    Condition

    Voltage (V)

    Keeping engine speed at 2500 rpm
    constant under no load

    The voltage fluctuation cycle takes more than 5 seconds.
    • 1 cycle: 0.6 — 1.0 → 0 — 0.3 → 0.6 — 1.0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-234, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    N

    O

    ECM

    F11

    J

    K

    Component Function Check

    Connector

    I

    EC-233

    2014 Note

    P

    P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022579

    1.CHECK EXHAUST SYSTEM
    Visually check exhaust tubes and muffler for dent.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    2.CHECK EXHAUST GAS LEAK

    1.
    2.

    Start engine and run it at idle.
    Listen for an exhaust gas leak before the three way catalyst (manifold).

    PBIB1216E

    Is exhaust gas leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK INTAKE AIR LEAK

    Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
    Is intake air leak detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK IGNITION TIMING AND IDLE SPEED

    Check the following items. Refer to EC-118, «Work Procedure».
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Ignition Timing»
    For specification, refer to EC-339, «Idle Speed».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Follow the EC-118, «Work Procedure».

    5.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR

    1.
    2.

    Stop engine and then turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    Cylinder
    No.

    Front / Rear

    ECM
    Connector

    1
    2
    3

    30

    Front

    29
    F10

    1

    3

    +

    Voltage

    31

    4

    2

    Terminal

    Rear

    4

    Revision: April 2013

    25
    12

    108

    Battery voltage

    20
    16
    24

    EC-234

    2014 Note

    P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Perform EC-314, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    [HR16DE]
    A

    6.CHECK FUNCTION OF IGNITION COIL-I

    CAUTION:
    Do the following procedure in the place where ventilation is good without the combustible.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Remove fuel pump fuse in IPDM E/R to release fuel pressure.
    NOTE:
    Do not use CONSULT to release fuel pressure, or fuel pressure applies again during the following procedure.
    3. Start engine.
    4. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel pressure.
    5. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    6. Remove all ignition coil harness connectors to avoid the electrical discharge from the ignition coils.
    7. Remove ignition coil and spark plug of the cylinder to be checked.
    8. Crank engine for 5 seconds or more to remove combustion gas in the cylinder.
    9. Connect spark plug and harness connector to ignition coil.
    10. Fix ignition coil using a rope etc. with gap of 13 — 17 mm (0.52 0.66 in) between the edge of the spark plug and grounded metal
    portion as shown in the figure.
    11. Crank engine for about 3 seconds, and check whether spark is
    generated between the spark plug and the grounded metal portion.

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    Spark should be generated.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not approach to the spark plug and the ignition coil
    JMBIA0066GB
    within 50 cm (19.7 in). Be careful not to get an electrical
    shock while checking, because the electrical discharge
    voltage becomes 20 kV or more.
    • It might cause to damage the ignition coil if the gap of more than 17 mm (0.66 in) is taken.
    NOTE:
    When the gap is less than 13 mm (0.52 in), the spark might be generated even if the coil is malfunctioning.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    7.CHECK FUNCTION OF IGNITION COIL-II
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect spark plug and connect a known-good spark plug.
    Crank engine for about 3 seconds, and recheck whether spark is generated between the spark plug and
    the grounded metal portion.

    M

    N

    Spark should be generated.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Check ignition coil, power transistor and their circuits. Refer to EC-319, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    8.CHECK SPARK PLUG

    Revision: April 2013

    O

    P

    EC-235

    2014 Note

    P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check the initial spark plug for fouling, etc. Refer to EM-21,
    «Removal and Installation».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace spark plug(s) with standard type one(s). For
    spark plug type, refer to EM-116, «Spark Plug».
    NO
    >> Repair or clean spark plug. Then GO TO 9

    SEF156I

    9.CHECK FUNCTION OF IGNITION COIL-III
    1.
    2.

    [HR16DE]

    Reconnect the initial spark plugs.
    Crank engine for about 3 seconds, and recheck whether spark is generated between the spark plug and
    the grounded portion.
    Spark should be generated.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace spark plug(s) with standard type one(s). For spark plug type, refer to EM-116, «Spark
    Plug».

    10.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove fuel injector assembly.
    Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».
    Keep fuel hose and all fuel injectors connected to fuel tube.
    3. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
    4. Reconnect all fuel injector harness connectors disconnected.
    5. Turn ignition switch ON.
    Does fuel drip from fuel injector?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Replace the fuel injector(s) from which fuel is dripping. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».

    11.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the trouble fixed?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace three way catalyst assembly. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-236

    2014 Note

    P0444 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0444 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    DTC Logic
    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    P0444

    A

    INFOID:0000000009022580

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name
    EVAP canister purge volume
    control solenoid valve circuit
    open

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    An excessively low voltage signal
    is sent to ECM through the valve

    • Harness or connectors
    (The solenoid valve circuit is open or shorted.)
    • EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve

    C

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm battery voltage is more than 11 V at idle.

    E

    1.CONDITIONING

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    H

    1. Start engine and let it idle for at least 13 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-237, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    INFOID:0000000009022581

    1.CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve harness connector and
    ground.
    EVAP canister purge volume
    control solenoid valve
    Connector

    Terminal

    F22

    1

    J

    K

    L

    M
    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    O

    2.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • Harness connector E55, F55
    • Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and IPDM E/R
    • Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and ECM
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-237

    2014 Note

    P

    P0444 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    3. Check the continuity between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve harness connector and
    ECM harness connector.
    EVAP canister purge volume
    control solenoid valve

    ECM

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F22

    2

    F10

    9

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES-1 >> With CONSULT: GO TO 4.
    YES-2 >> Without CONSULT: GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
    With CONSULT
    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Start engine.
    Perform “PURG VOL CONT/V” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT. Check that engine speed varies
    according to the valve opening.
    Does engine speed vary according to the valve opening?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    1.
    2.
    3.

    5.CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE

    Refer to EC-238, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Replace EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».

    6.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022582

    1.CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Disconnect EVAP purge hoses connected to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “PURG VOL CONT/V” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-238

    2014 Note

    P0444 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    6. Touch “Qd” and “Qu” on CONSULT screen to adjust “PURG
    VOL C/V” opening and check air passage continuity of EVAP
    canister purge volume control solenoid valve under the following
    conditions.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Condition
    (PURG VOL C/V value)

    Air passage continuity

    100%

    Existed

    0%

    Not existed

    between

    and

    C

    JSBIA0653ZZ
    Without CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve harness connector.
    Disconnect EVAP purge hoses connected to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
    Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume
    control solenoid valve under the following conditions.

    Condition
    12 V direct current supply between
    terminals 1 and 2
    No supply

    E

    F

    Air passage continuity
    between

    D

    and

    Existed

    G

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    JSBIA0653ZZ
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-239

    2014 Note

    P0500 VSS
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0500 VSS
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022583

    The vehicle speed signal is sent to the combination meter from the “ABS actuator and electric unit (control
    unit)” by CAN communication line. The combination meter then sends a signal to the ECM by CAN communication line.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022584

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC UXXXX, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC UXXXX.
    • If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC P0607, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0607. Refer
    to EC-251, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P0500

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Vehicle speed sensor

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    The almost 0 km/h (0 MPH) of vehicle
    speed signal is sent to ECM even
    when vehicle is being driven.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open or shorted)
    • Harness or connectors
    (The vehicle speed signal circuit is open or shorted)
    • Combination meter
    • ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.INSPECTION START

    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    2.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR FUNCTION
    NOTE:
    This procedure may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
    road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
    With CONSULT
    1. Start engine.
    2. Read “VHCL SPEED SE” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT. The vehicle speed on CONSULT
    should exceed 10 km/h (6 mph) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-241, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    Warm engine up to normal operating temperature.
    Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive seconds.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-240

    2014 Note

    P0500 VSS
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ENG SPEED

    A

    1,300 — 6,000 rpm (CVT)
    1,600 — 6,000 rpm (M/T)

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    More than 70°C (158°F)

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    7.5 — 31.8 msec

    Shift lever

    Except P or N position (CVT)
    Except Neutral position (M/T)

    PW/ST SIGNAL

    OFF

    EC

    C

    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-241, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    D

    5.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK

    E

    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-241, «Component Function Check».
    Use component function check to check the overall function of the vehicle speed signal circuit. During this
    check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-241, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Component Function Check

    F

    G

    INFOID:0000000009022585

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK

    H

    With GST
    Lift up drive wheels.
    Start engine.
    Read vehicle speed signal in Service $01 with GST.
    The vehicle speed signal on GST should be able to exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with
    suitable gear position.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-241, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J

    K

    INFOID:0000000009022586

    L

    1.CHECK DTC WITH ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    Check DTC with ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    M

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    N

    Check DTC with combination meter. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    O

    >> INSPECTION END

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-241

    2014 Note

    P0520 EOP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0520 EOP SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022587

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC P0520 is displayed with DTC P0643, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0643. Refer to
    EC-252, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P0520

    Trouble diagnosis
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    Detecting condition

    EOP SENSOR/SWITCH
    [Engine oil pressure sensor
    circuit]

    ECM detects the following status continuously for
    5 seconds or more:
    • A voltage signal transmitted from the engine oil
    pressure sensor is lower than 0.3 V.
    • A voltage signal transmitted from the engine oil
    pressure sensor is higher than 5.02 V.

    Possible cause

    • Harness or connectors
    (Engine oil pressure sensor circuit is
    open or shorted.)
    • Engine oil pressure sensor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
    Check engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check engine oil leak. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-242, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022588

    1.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect engine oil pressure sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between engine oil pressure sensor harness connector terminals.
    Engine oil pressure sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F38

    1

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    5V

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-242

    2014 Note

    P0520 EOP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between engine oil pressure sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F38

    3

    F11

    60

    A

    EC

    Continuity
    Existed

    C

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    D

    3.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between engine oil pressure sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F38

    2

    F11

    47

    Continuity

    E

    F

    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    G

    H

    4.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR

    Refer to EC-243, «Component Inspection».
    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil pressure sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009022589

    1.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect engine oil pressure sensor harness connector.
    Check resistance between engine oil pressure sensor connector terminals.

    Engine oil pressure sensor
    Terminal
    1

    2

    3

    Condition

    2

    Resistance (kΩ)
    4 – 10

    3

    2–8

    1

    4 – 10

    3

    M

    None

    N

    1–3

    1

    2–8

    2

    1–3

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END.
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil pressure sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-243

    P

    2014 Note

    P0524 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0524 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022590

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC P0524 is displayed with DTC P0520 or P0075, perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0520 or P0075
    first. Refer to EC-242, «DTC Logic» or EC-153, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
    (Engine oil pressure too low)

    P0524

    Detecting condition
    An engine oil pressure sensor signal
    voltage applied to ECM remains lower
    than the specified value continuously for
    10 seconds or more when the engine
    speed is 1,000 rpm ore more.

    Possible cause




    Decrease in engine oil pressure
    Decrease in engine oil level
    Engine oil condition
    Engine oil pressure sensor
    Engine body

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    If “Diagnosis Procedure” is unfinished, be sure to perform Step 3 and 4.

    1.PRECONDITIONING-I

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is 11 V or more at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PRECONDITIONING-II
    Is “Diagnosis Procedure” of DTC P0524 finished?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL

    Check engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-245, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    4.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Start the engine and check that “EOP SENSOR” changes, according to engine speeds.
    Monitor item

    EOP SENSOR

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    • Engine oil temperature: 80°C (176°F)
    • Selector lever: P or N position (CVT),
    Neutral position (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    Engine speed:
    600 rpm

    1,053 mV
    or more

    Engine speed:
    2,000 rpm

    1,802 mV
    or more

    Without CONSULT
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-244

    2014 Note

    P0524 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-245, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    A

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    EC

    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Maintain the following conditions for about 10 consecutive seconds.

    Selector lever

    P or N position (CVT)
    Neutral position (M/T)

    Engine coolant temperature

    70°C (158°F) or more

    Engine speed

    1,000 rpm or more

    C

    D

    E

    NOTE:
    With engine speed set around 4,000 rpm, the phenomenon can be reproduced more easily.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-245, «Diagnosis Procedure»
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    INFOID:0000000009022591

    1.CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL

    H

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    I

    2.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Start the engine and check that “EOP SENSOR” changes, according to engine speeds.
    Monitor item

    EOP SENSOR

    K

    L

    Value
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    • Engine oil temperature: 80°C (176°F)
    • Selector lever: P or N position (CVT),
    Neutral position (M/T)
    • Air conditioner switch: OFF
    • No load

    Engine speed:
    600 rpm

    1,053 mV
    or more

    Engine speed:
    2,000 rpm

    1,802 mV
    or more

    M

    N

    Without CONSULT
    Check engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check oil pressure. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».

    O

    3.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR

    P

    Check engine oil pressure sensor. Refer to EC-243, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil pressure sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    4.CHECK ENGINE OIL LEAKAGE

    Check engine oil leakage. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Revision: April 2013

    G

    EC-245

    2014 Note

    P0524 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    5.CHECK CAUSE OF ENGINE OIL CONSUMPTION
    Check the following item.
    Step

    Inspection item

    Equipment

    Standard

    Reference

    1

    PCV valve

    EC-337, «Inspection»

    2

    Exhaust front tube

    Visual

    • No blocking
    • No abnormal sounds

    3

    Oil pump

    Visual

    • No blocking
    • No damage

    • Piston
    • Piston pin
    • Piston ring

    • Piston to piston pin oil clearance
    EM-101, «Inspection»
    • Piston ring side clearance
    EM-101, «Inspection»
    • Piston ring end gap
    EM-101, «Inspection»

    Cylinder block

    • Cylinder block top surface distortion
    EM-101, «Inspection»
    • Piston to cylinder bore clearance
    EM-101, «Inspection»

    4

    5

    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022592

    1.CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect engine oil pressure sensor harness connector.
    Check the resistance between engine oil pressure sensor connector terminals.
    Engine oil pressure sensor
    +

    Resistance (kΩ)

    2

    4 – 10

    3

    2–8

    1

    4 – 10

    3

    1–3

    1

    2–8

    2

    1–3

    Terminal
    1

    2

    3

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace engine oil pressure sensor. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-246

    2014 Note

    P0603 ECM POWER SUPPLY
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0603 ECM POWER SUPPLY

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022593

    ECM has the memory function of the DTC memory, the air-fuel ratio
    feedback compensation value memory, the Idle Air Volume Learning
    value memory, etc. even when the ignition switch is turned OFF.

    EC

    C

    D

    PBIA9222J

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022594

    F

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    P0603

    Trouble diagnosis name
    ECM BACK UP/CIRCUIT
    (ECM power supply circuit)

    E

    DTC detecting condition
    ECM back-up RAM system
    does not function properly.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    [ECM power supply (back up) circuit is open or shorted.]
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    H

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 5 minutes
    3. Turn ignition switch ON, wait at least 10 seconds.
    4. Repeat step 2 and 3 for five times.
    5. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-247, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    L

    M

    N
    INFOID:0000000009022595

    1.INSPECTION START

    O

    1.
    2.

    Erase DTC.
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE.
    See EC-247, «DTC Logic».
    Is the 1st trip DTC P0603 displayed again?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    P

    2.REPLACE ECM
    1.

    Replace ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    K

    >> GO TO 2.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    EC-247

    2014 Note

    P0603 ECM POWER SUPPLY
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Perform EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-248

    2014 Note

    P0605 ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0605 ECM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022596

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition
    A)

    P0605

    Engine control module

    Possible cause

    ECM calculation function is malfunctioning.

    B)

    ECM EEP-ROM system is malfunctioning.

    C)

    ECM self shut-off function is malfunctioning.

    C

    ECM

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
    H

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-249, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    I

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B

    J

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn ON.
    3. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-249, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    K

    L

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn ON.
    3. Repeat step 2 for 32 times.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-249, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    M

    N

    INFOID:0000000009022597

    1.INSPECTION START

    P

    1.
    2.

    Erase DTC.
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE.
    See EC-249, «DTC Logic».
    Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-249

    O

    2014 Note

    P0605 ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.REPLACE ECM
    1.
    2.

    Replace ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-250

    2014 Note

    P0607 ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0607 ECM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022598

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    P0607

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name
    (Trouble diagnosis content)
    ECM
    (CAN communication bus)

    DTC detecting condition
    When detecting error during the initial diagnosis of
    CAN controller of ECM.

    Possible cause

    C

    ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-251, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    E

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    INFOID:0000000009022599

    1.INSPECTION START
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Erase DTC.
    3. Perform DTC confirmation procedure. Refer to EC-251, «DTC Logic».
    4. Check DTC.
    Is the DTC P0607 displayed again?
    YES >> Replace ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-251

    2014 Note

    P0643 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0643 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022600

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    P0643

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Sensor power supply
    circuit short

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    ECM detects a voltage of power source
    for sensor is excessively low or high.

    • Harness or connectors
    (Accelerator pedal position 1 circuit is shorted.)
    (Throttle position sensor 1 circuit is shorted.)
    [Camshaft position sensor circuit is shorted.]
    (Exhaust valve timing control position sensor circuit
    is shorted.)
    (Engine oil pressure sensor circuit is shorted.)
    • Accelerator pedal position sensor
    • Throttle position sensor
    • Camshaft position sensor
    • Exhaust valve timing control position sensor
    • Engine oil pressure sensor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-252, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022601

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-252

    2014 Note

    P0643 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal

    A

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    72
    F11

    74
    78

    E16

    EC
    Ground

    5V

    C

    106

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    D

    3.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check harness for short to power and short to ground, between the following terminals.
    ECM

    Connector

    Sensor

    Terminal

    Item

    F
    Connector

    Terminal

    72

    Throttle position sensor 1

    F7

    2

    74

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    F38

    1

    F11

    E16

    E

    Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)

    F21

    78

    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor

    F56

    106

    Accelerator pedal position sensor 1

    E12

    G

    1

    H

    4

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    I

    4.CHECK COMPONENTS

    J

    Check the following.
    • Throttle position sensor 1 (Refer to EC-214, «Component Inspection».)
    • Engine oil pressure sensor (Refer to EC-243, «Component Inspection».)
    • Camshaft position sensor (Refer to EC-230, «Component Inspection».)
    • Exhaust valve timing control position sensor (Refer to EC-230, «Component Inspection».)
    • Accelerator pedal position sensor 1 (Refer to EC-292, «Component Inspection».)
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning component.

    K

    L

    M

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    N

    >> INSPECTION END
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-253

    2014 Note

    P0850 PNP SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0850 PNP SWITCH
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022602

    When the selector lever position is P or N (CVT), Neutral position (M/T), park/neutral position (PNP) signal is
    ON.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022603

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    P0850

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Park/neutral position signal

    The park/neutral position (PNP) signal
    is not changed in the process of engine
    starting and driving.

    • Harness or connectors
    [The park/neutral position (PNP) signal circuit is
    open or shorted.]
    • Transmission range switch (CVT models)
    • Park/neutral position (PNP) switch (M/T models)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.INSPECTION START

    Do you have CONSULT?
    Do you have CONSULT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    2.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK PNP SIGNAL FUNCTION
    1.
    2.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “P/N POSI SW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT. Then check “P/N POSI SW” signal
    under the following conditions.
    Shift lever position

    Known-good signal

    N or P position (CVT)
    Neutral position (M/T)

    ON

    Except above position

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-255, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    4.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Maintain the following conditions for at least 50 consecutive seconds.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-254

    2014 Note

    P0850 PNP SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ENG SPEED

    1,500 — 6,375 rpm

    COOLAN TEMP/S

    More than 70°C (158°F)

    B/FUEL SCHDL

    4 (CVT) or 2.75 (M/T) — 31.8 msec

    VHCL SPEED SE

    More than 64 km/h (40 mph)

    Shift lever

    Suitable position

    EC

    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-255, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    C

    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-255, «Component Function Check».
    NOTE:
    Use component function check the overall function of the park/neutral position (PNP) signal circuit. During this
    check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-255, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    D

    5.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK

    Component Function Check

    G

    INFOID:0000000009022604

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK
    1.
    2.

    F

    H

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    I
    ECM

    +
    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    69
    (PNP
    signal)

    Connector
    E16

    Condition

    Voltage

    J

    Terminal
    108

    Shift
    lever

    P or N (CVT)
    Neutral (M/T)

    Battery voltage

    Except above

    Approx. 0 V

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-255, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    L
    INFOID:0000000009022605

    1.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH (CVT) OR PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH (M/T)
    POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect transmission range switch (CVT) or PNP switch (M/T) harness connector.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Check the voltage between transmission range switch (CVT) or PNP switch (M/T) harness connector and
    ground.
    Transmission range switch (CVT) /
    PNP switch (M/T)
    Connector

    Terminal

    F52 (CVT)

    7

    F24 (M/T)

    2

    N

    O

    P
    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    M

    EC-255

    2014 Note

    P0850 PNP SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • Harness connectors E7, M69 (M/T)
    • Harness connectors E55, F55
    • IPDM E/R harness connector E45 (CVT)
    • 10 A fuse (No. 3) (M/T)
    • 10 A fuse (No. 49) (CVT)
    • Harness for open or short between transmission range switch (CVT) or PNP switch (M/T) and fuse
    Is the inspection result normal?
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between transmission range switch (CVT) or PNP switch (M/T) harness connector
    and ECM harness connector.

    Transmission range switch (CVT) /
    PNP switch (M/T)
    Connector

    Terminal

    F52 (CVT)

    10

    F24 (M/T)

    3

    ECM

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    69

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH (CVT) OR PNP SWITCH (M/T)

    Refer to TM-146, «Component Inspection (Transmission Range Switch)» (CVT) or TM-14, «PARK/NEUTRAL
    POSITION (PNP) SWITCH : Component Inspection» (M/T).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace transmission range switch (CVT) or PNP switch (M/T). Refer to TM-250, «Removal and
    Installation» (CVT) or TM-23, «Removal and Installation» (M/T).

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-256

    2014 Note

    P1078 EVT CONTROL POSITION SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1078 EVT CONTROL POSITION SENSOR

    A

    DTC Description

    INFOID:0000000009418247

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    CONSULT screen terms
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    DTC No.

    EXH TIM SEN/CIR-B1
    (Exhaust valve timing control position sensor circuit)

    P1078

    DTC detecting condition

    C

    An excessively high or low voltage from the sensor is sent to ECM.

    D

    POSSIBLE CAUSE



    Harness or connectors
    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor circuit is open or shorted
    Sensor power supply 1 circuit is shorted.
    Accumulation of debris to the signal pick-up portion of the camshaft
    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor
    One (or more) sensor in sensor power supply 1 circuit

    E

    F

    FAIL-SAFE
    Not applicable

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    H

    I

    J

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    K

    1. Start engine and let it idle for 10 seconds.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-257, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO-1 >> To check malfunction symptom before repair: Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO-2 >> Confirmation after repair: INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    L

    INFOID:0000000009418248

    1.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT — 1
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect exhaust valve timing control position sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between exhaust valve timing control position sensor harness connector and ground.
    +
    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F56

    1

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    5V

    EC-257

    N

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    Revision: April 2013

    M

    2014 Note

    P1078 EVT CONTROL POSITION SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    2.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between exhaust valve timing control position sensor harness connector and ECM
    harness connector.
    +

    Exhaust valve timing control
    position sensor

    ECM

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F56

    2

    F11

    63

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    3.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    Check the continuity between exhaust valve timing control position sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    +

    Exhaust valve timing control
    position sensor

    ECM

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F56

    3

    F11

    48

    Existed

    Also check harness for short to ground and to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    4.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR

    Check exhaust valve timing control position sensor. Refer to EC-259, «Component Inspection (Exhaust Valve
    Timing Control Position Sensor)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control position sensor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    5.CHECK CAMSHAFT (EXH)

    Check the following.
    • Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
    • Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
    rear end or replace camshaft. Refer to EM-60, «Removal
    and Installation».

    JSBIA0600ZZ

    6.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT — 2
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-258

    2014 Note

    P1078 EVT CONTROL POSITION SENSOR
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check the continuity between exhaust valve timing control position sensor harness connector and ECM
    harness connector.
    +

    Exhaust valve timing control
    position sensor

    ECM

    EC

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F56

    1

    F11

    78

    A

    C

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    D

    7.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY 1 CIRCUIT

    E

    Check sensor power supply 1 circuit. Refer to EC-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Repair or replace error-detected parts.

    F

    Component Inspection (Exhaust Valve Timing Control Position Sensor)

    INFOID:0000000009418249

    G

    1.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR — 1
    H

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect exhaust valve timing control position sensor harness connector.
    3. Remove exhaust valve timing control position sensor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».
    4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control position sensor.
    Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    I

    J

    K

    JMBIA0065ZZ

    2.CHECK EXHAUST VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR — 2
    Check resistance exhaust valve timing control position sensor terminals as follows.

    M

    Exhaust valve timing control position sensor
    Condition

    +

    L

    N

    Resistance

    Terminal
    1

    2

    1

    3

    2

    3

    O
    Temperature

    25°C (77°F)

    Except 0 or ∞ Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace exhaust valve timing control position sensor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-259

    2014 Note

    P

    P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022606

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC UXXXX, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC UXXXX.
    • If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC P0607, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0607. Refer
    to EC-251, «DTC Logic».
    If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will
    rise.
    When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction is
    indicated.
    DTC No.

    P1217

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Engine over temperature
    (Overheat)

    • Cooling fan does not operate properly
    (Overheat).
    • Cooling fan system does not operate
    properly (Overheat).
    • Engine coolant was not added to the
    system using the proper filling method.
    • Engine coolant is not within the specified
    range.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The cooling fan circuit is open or shorted.)
    • IPDM E/R (Cooling fan relays -1, -2 and -3)
    • Cooling fan motor
    • Radiator hose
    • Radiator
    • Radiator cap
    • Reservoir tank
    • Water pump
    • Thermostat

    CAUTION:
    When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant. Refer to CO-9, «Refilling». Also,
    replace the engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Refilling».
    1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
    use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-13, «Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio».
    2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK
    Perform component function check. Refer to EC-260, «Component Function Check».
    NOTE:
    Use component function check to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might
    not be confirmed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-261, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022607

    1.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-I
    WARNING:
    Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator.
    Wrap a thick cloth around cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-up
    pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-260

    2014 Note

    P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
    Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
    Is the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator below the
    proper range?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-261, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    C

    2.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-II

    SEF621W

    D

    Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not.
    Did customer fill the coolant?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-261, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    E

    3.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-III

    F

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Perform “COOLING FAN” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT and touch “LOW” on the CONSULT
    screen.
    3. Make sure that cooling fan operates at low speed.
    Without CONSULT
    1. Start engine and let it idle.
    2. Turn air conditioner switch and blower fan switch ON.
    3. Make sure that cooling fan operates at low speed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-261, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    1.
    2.

    4.PERFORM COMPONENT FUNCTION CHECK-IV

    With CONSULT
    Touch “HI” on the CONSULT screen.
    Make sure that cooling fan operates at higher speed than low speed.
    Without CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Turn air conditioner switch and blower fan switch OFF.
    3. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
    4. Connect 150Ω resistor to engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
    5. Restart engine and make sure that cooling fan operates at higher speed than low speed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-261, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    H

    I

    J

    K

    1.
    2.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    G

    L

    M

    N

    INFOID:0000000009022608

    O

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Perform “COOLING FAN” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.
    Make sure that cooling fan motor operate at each speed (LOW/HI).
    Without CONSULT
    1. Perform IPDM E/R auto active test and check cooling fan motor operation. Refer to PCS-9, «Diagnosis
    Description».
    2. Make sure that cooling fan motor operate at each speed (Low/High).

    P

    1.CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-261

    2014 Note

    P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-309, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    [HR16DE]

    2.CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAK-I

    Check cooling system for leak. Refer to CO-8, «Inspection».
    Is leakage detected?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    3.CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAK-II

    Check the following for leak.
    • Hose (Refer to CO-25, «Removal and Installation».)
    • Radiator (Refer to CO-14, «Removal and Installation».)
    • Water pump (Refer to CO-19, «Removal and Installation».)
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part.

    4.CHECK RADIATOR CAP

    Check radiator cap. Refer to CO-12, «RADIATOR CAP : Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace radiator cap. Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».

    5.CHECK THERMOSTAT

    Check thermostat. Refer to CO-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Replace thermostat. Refer to CO-21, «Removal and Installation».

    6.CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR

    Refer to EC-166, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor. Refer to CO-24, «Exploded View».

    7.OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS

    If the cause cannot be isolated, check CO-6, «Troubleshooting Chart».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-262

    2014 Note

    P1225 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1225 TP SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022609

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    P1225

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Closed throttle position learning
    performance

    Closed throttle position learning value is excessively
    low.

    Electric throttle control actuator
    (TP sensor 1 and 2)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    C

    D

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.

    E

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    H

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-263, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009022610

    1.CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove the intake air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
    and the housing.

    M

    : Vehicle front

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
    control actuator inside, and then perform throttle valve
    closed position learning. Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    N

    O
    PBIB2974E

    P

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-263

    2014 Note

    P1226 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1226 TP SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022611

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    P1226

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Closed throttle position learning
    performance

    Closed throttle position learning is not performed
    successfully, repeatedly.

    Possible cause
    Electric throttle control actuator
    (TP sensor 1 and 2)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following procedure
    before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for 32 times.
    5. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-264, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022612

    1.CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove the intake air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
    and the housing.
    : Vehicle front

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
    control actuator inside, and then perform throttle valve
    closed position learning. Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    PBIB2974E

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-264

    2014 Note

    P1564 ASCD STEERING SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1564 ASCD STEERING SWITCH

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009418250

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    NOTE:
    If DTC P1564 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605. Refer to
    EC-249, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P1564

    Trouble diagnosis name

    ASCD steering switch

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    • An excessively high voltage signal from the ASCD
    steering switch is sent to ECM.
    • ECM detects that input signal from the ASCD
    steering switch is out of the specified range.
    • ECM detects that the ASCD steering switch is
    stuck ON.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The switch circuit is open or shorted.)
    • ASCD steering switch
    • ECM

    C

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    F

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    G

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    I

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Press MAIN switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
    3. Press CANCEL switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
    4. Press ACCEL/RES switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
    5. Press COAST/SET switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
    6. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to EC-265, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    J

    K

    L

    INFOID:0000000009418251

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    M

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    N

    2.CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    O

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “MAIN SW”, “CANCEL SW”, “RESUME/ACC SW” and “SET SW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Check each item indication under the following conditions.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-265

    2014 Note

    P

    P1564 ASCD STEERING SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Monitor item

    Condition

    MAIL SW

    MAIN switch

    CANCEL SW

    CANCEL switch

    RESUME/ACC SW

    ACCEL/RES switch

    SET SW

    COAST/SET switch

    1.
    2.

    Indication
    Pressed

    ON

    Released

    OFF

    Pressed

    ON

    Released

    OFF

    Pressed

    ON

    Released

    OFF

    Pressed

    ON

    Released

    OFF

    Without CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following conditions.
    ECM

    Connector

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    94
    (ASCD steering switch signal)

    E16

    95

    Condition

    Voltage (V)

    MAIN switch: Pressed

    Approx. 0

    CANCEL switch: Pressed

    Approx. 1

    COAST/SET switch: Pressed

    Approx. 2

    ACCEL/RES switch: Pressed

    Approx. 3

    All ASCD steering switches: Released

    Approx. 4

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Disconnect combination switch harness connector.
    Check the continuity between combination switch and ECM harness connector.
    Combination switch

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M88

    16

    E16

    95

    Continuity
    Existed

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • Combination switch (spiral cable)
    • Harness for open and short between ECM and combination switch
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between combination switch and ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-266

    2014 Note

    P1564 ASCD STEERING SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Combination switch

    A

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M88

    13

    E16

    94

    Continuity
    Existed

    EC

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    C

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    D

    Check the following.
    • Combination switch (spiral cable)
    • Harness for open and short between ECM and combination switch

    E

    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    7.CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH

    F

    Refer to EC-267, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace ASCD steering switch.

    G

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    H

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009418252

    1.CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH

    J

    Check resistance between combination switch (spiral cable) harness connector terminals under the following
    conditions.
    Combination switch
    Connector

    Terminals

    Condition

    Resistance (Ω)

    L
    MAIN switch: Pressed

    M88

    13 and 16

    K

    Approx. 0

    CANCEL switch: Pressed

    Approx. 250

    COAST/SET switch: Pressed

    Approx. 660

    ACCEL/RES switch: Pressed

    Approx. 1,480

    All ASCD steering switches: Released

    Approx. 4,000

    M

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace ASCD steering switch.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-267

    2014 Note

    P1572 ASCD BRAKE SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1572 ASCD BRAKE SWITCH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009418253

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC P1572 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605. Refer
    to EC-249, «DTC Logic».
    • This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic. When malfunction A is detected, DTC is not
    stored in ECM memory. And in that case, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip freeze frame data are displayed.
    1st trip DTC is erased when ignition switch is turned OFF. And even when malfunction A is detected
    in two consecutive trips, DTC is not stored in ECM memory.
    DTC No.

    P1572

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    A)

    When the vehicle speed is above
    30 km/h (19 MPH), ON signals
    from the stop lamp switch and the
    brake pedal position switch are
    sent to the ECM at the same time.

    B)

    Brake pedal position switch signal
    is not sent to ECM for extremely
    long time while the vehicle is being
    driven.

    ASCD brake switch

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The stop lamp switch circuit is shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    (The brake pedal position switch circuit is shorted.)
    • Stop lamp switch
    • Brake pedal position switch
    • Incorrect stop lamp switch installation
    • Incorrect brake pedal position switch installation
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    NOTE:
    The procedure for malfunction B is not described. It takes an extremely long time to complete the procedure
    for malfunction B. By performing the procedure for malfunction A, the condition that causes malfunction B can
    be detected.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Start engine (ESP switch OFF).
    Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Press MAIN switch and make sure that CRUISE lamp illuminates.
    Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the following conditions.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    NOTE:
    This procedure may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle.
    If a road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.

    VHCL SPEED SE

    More than 30 km/h (19 mph)

    Selector lever

    Suitable position

    6. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to EC-269, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-268

    2014 Note

    P1572 ASCD BRAKE SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE-II
    1.

    A
    Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the following conditions.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    EC
    NOTE:
    This procedure may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle.
    If a road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
    C

    VHCL SPEED SE

    More than 30 km/h (19 mph)

    Selector lever

    Suitable position

    Driving location

    Depress the brake pedal for more than 5 seconds so as
    not to come off from the above-mentioned vehicle speed.

    D

    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to EC-269, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    E

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009418254

    1.CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    G

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “BRAKE SW1” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Check “BRAKE SW1” indication under the following conditions.

    H

    I
    Monitor item
    BRAKE SW1

    1.
    2.

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Indication

    Slightly depressed

    OFF

    Fully released

    ON

    J

    Without CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals as follows.

    K

    ECM

    Terminal

    Terminal

    100
    (Brake pedal position switch signal)

    108

    Connector

    E16

    L

    +

    Condition

    Brake
    pedal

    Slightly depressed
    Fully released

    Voltage (V)

    M

    Approx. 0
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    N

    2.CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-II

    O

    With CONSULT
    Select “BRAKE SW2” and check indication under the following conditions.
    Monitor item
    BRAKE SW2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    P

    Indication

    Slightly depressed

    ON

    Fully released

    OFF

    Without CONSULT
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following conditions.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-269

    2014 Note

    P1572 ASCD BRAKE SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ECM
    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    99
    (Stop lamp switch signal)

    108

    Connector

    E16

    Condition

    Slightly depressed

    Brake
    pedal

    Fully released

    Voltage (V)

    Battery voltage
    Approx. 0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    3.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect brake pedal position switch harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between brake pedal position switch harness connector and ground.
    Brake pedal position switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E36

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • Harness connectors E7, M69
    • 10 A fuse (No. 5)
    • Harness for open or short between brake pedal position switch and fuse
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between brake pedal position switch harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Brake pedal position switch

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E36

    2

    E16

    100

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH

    Refer to EC-271, «Component Inspection (Brake Pedal Position Switch)»
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Replace brake pedal position switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View».

    7.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-270

    2014 Note

    P1572 ASCD BRAKE SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check the voltage between stop lamp switch harness connector and ground.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    Stop lamp switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E13 (CVT)
    E57 (M/T)

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    EC
    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    C

    8.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    D

    Check the following.
    • 10 A fuse (No. 30)
    • Harness for open or short between stop lamp switch and battery

    E

    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    9.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    F

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between stop lamp switch harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Stop lamp switch

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E13 (CVT)
    E57 (M/T)

    2

    E16

    99

    Continuity

    G

    H

    Existed

    I

    3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    J

    10.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH

    Refer to EC-272, «Component Inspection (Stop Lamp Switch)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Replace stop lamp switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View».

    K

    L

    11.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    M

    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection (Brake Pedal Position Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009418255

    N

    1.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect brake pedal position switch harness connector.
    Check the continuity between brake pedal position switch terminals under the following conditions.

    O

    P
    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Fully released
    Slightly depressed

    Continuity
    Existed
    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-271

    2014 Note

    P1572 ASCD BRAKE SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH-II
    1.
    2.

    Adjust brake pedal position switch installation. Refer to BR-20, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    Check the continuity between brake pedal position switch terminals under the following conditions.
    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Continuity

    Fully released

    Existed

    Slightly depressed

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace brake pedal position switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection (Stop Lamp Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009418256

    1.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
    Check the continuity between stop lamp switch terminals under the following conditions.

    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Fully released
    Slightly depressed

    Continuity
    Not existed
    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH-II

    1.
    2.

    Adjust stop lamp switch installation. Refer to BR-20, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    Check the continuity between stop lamp switch terminals under the following conditions.

    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Fully released
    Slightly depressed

    Continuity
    Not existed
    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace stop lamp switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-272

    2014 Note

    P1574 ASCD VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1574 ASCD VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009418257

    The ECM receives two vehicle speed sensor signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from combina- EC
    tion meter, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module). The ECM uses these signals for ASCD
    control. Refer to EC-34, «AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD) : System Description» for ASCD
    functions.
    C

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009418258

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC UXXXX, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC UXXXX.
    • If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0500, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0500. Refer
    to EC-240, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605. Refer
    to EC-249, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0607, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0607. Refer
    to EC-251, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P1574

    Trouble diagnosis name

    ASCD vehicle speed
    sensor

    DTC detecting condition

    The difference between the two vehicle
    speed signals is out of the specified
    range.

    Possible cause

    D

    E

    F

    G

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open or shorted.)
    • Combination meter
    • ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    • Wheel sensor
    • TCM
    • ECM

    H

    I

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    J

    K

    L

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    Start engine (VDC switch OFF).
    Drive the vehicle at more than 40 km/h (25 MPH).
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    NOTE:
    This procedure may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle.
    If a road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to EC-273, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009418259

    1.CHECK DTC WITH TCM
    Check DTC with TCM. Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-273

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    P1574 ASCD VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble shooting relevant to DTC indicated.

    [HR16DE]

    2.CHECK DTC WITH ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)
    Check DTC with ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    3.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    Check DTC with combination meter. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-274

    2014 Note

    P1715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022635

    ECM receives input speed sensor signal from TCM via the CAN communication line. ECM uses this signal for EC
    engine control.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022636

    C

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC P1715 is displayed with DTC UXXXX, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC UXXXX.
    • If DTC P1715 is displayed with DTC P0335, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0335. Refer
    to EC-224, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC P1715 is displayed with DTC P0340, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0340. Refer
    to EC-228, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC P1715 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605. Refer
    to EC-249, «DTC Logic».

    D

    E

    F
    DTC No.

    P1715

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Input speed sensor
    (TCM output)

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Input speed sensor signal is different
    from the theoretical value calculated by
    ECM from output speed sensor signal
    and engine rpm signal.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open or shorted)
    • Harness or connectors
    (Input speed sensor circuit is open or shorted)
    • TCM

    G

    H

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    I

    J

    K

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    L

    1.

    Start engine and drive the vehicle at more than 50 km/h (31 MPH) for at least 5 seconds.
    CAUTION:
    Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
    2. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-275, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    M

    N
    INFOID:0000000009022637

    1.CHECK DTC WITH TCM

    O

    Check DTC with TCM. Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble shooting relevant to DTC indicated.

    P

    2.REPLACE TCM

    Replace TCM. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    >> INSPECTION END
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-275

    2014 Note

    P1720 VSS
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1720 VSS
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022638

    ECM receives two vehicle speed signals via the CAN communication line. One is sent from “ABS actuator and
    electric unit (control unit)” via combination meter, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module).
    ECM uses these signals for engine control.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022639

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC P1720 is displayed with DTC UXXXX, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC UXXXX.
    • If DTC P1720 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605. Refer
    to EC-249, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC P1720 is displayed with DTC P0607, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0607. Refer
    to EC-251, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P1720

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Vehicle speed sensor
    (TCM output)

    DTC detecting condition

    The difference between two vehicle
    speed signals is out of the specified
    range.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (Secondary speed sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    (Wheel sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
    • TCM
    • Secondary speed sensor
    • ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    • Wheel sensor
    • Combination meter

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    Start engine.
    Drive vehicle at a speed of 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more for at least 5 seconds without depressing the brake
    pedal.
    3. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-276, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022640

    1.CHECK DTC WITH TCM
    Check DTC with TCM. Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble shooting relevant to DTC indicated.

    2.CHECK DTC WITH “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)”

    Check DTC with “ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)”. Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-276

    2014 Note

    P1720 VSS
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble shooting relevant to DTC indicated.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    3.CHECK COMBINATION METER FUNCTION

    Check combination meter function. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».

    EC

    >> INSPECTION END
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-277

    2014 Note

    P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022641

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P1805

    Brake switch

    DTC detecting condition
    A brake switch signal is not sent to ECM
    for extremely long time while the vehicle is
    driving.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (Stop lamp switch circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Stop lamp switch

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Fully depress the brake pedal for at least 5 seconds.
    3. Erase DTC.
    4. Check 1st trip DTC.
    Is 1st trip DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-278, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022642

    1.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check the stop lamp when depressing and releasing the brake pedal.
    Brake pedal

    Stop lamp

    Fully released

    Not illuminated

    Slightly depressed

    Illuminated

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
    Check the voltage between stop lamp switch harness connector and ground.
    Stop lamp switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E13 (CVT)
    E57 (M/T)

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for power supply circuit.

    3.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and stop lamp switch harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-278

    2014 Note

    P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    ECM

    A

    Stop lamp switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E16

    99

    E13 (CVT)
    E57 (M/T)

    2

    Continuity

    EC

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair error-detected parts.

    C

    4.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH

    D

    Refer to EC-279, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace stop lamp switch. Refer to BR-19, «Removal and Installation».

    E

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022643

    F

    1.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
    Check the continuity between stop lamp switch terminals under the following conditions.

    G

    H
    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Fully released
    Slightly depressed

    Continuity
    Not existed

    I

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    J

    2.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH-II
    1.
    2.

    Adjust stop lamp switch installation. Refer to BR-8, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    Check the continuity between stop lamp switch terminals under the following conditions.
    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Fully released
    Slightly depressed

    K

    L

    Continuity
    Not existed
    Existed

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace brake pedal assembly. Refer to BR-19, «Removal and Installation».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-279

    2014 Note

    P2100, P2103 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2100, P2103 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022644

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    P2100

    Throttle control motor
    relay circuit open

    ECM detects a voltage of power source for
    throttle control motor is excessively low.

    • Harness or connectors
    (Throttle control motor relay circuit is open)
    • Throttle control motor relay

    P2103

    Throttle control motor
    relay circuit short

    ECM detect the throttle control motor relay is
    stuck ON.

    • Harness or connectors
    (Throttle control motor relay circuit is shorted)
    • Throttle control motor relay

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8 V.
    Witch DTC is detected?
    P2100 >> GO TO 2.
    P2103 >> GO TO 3.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR DTC P2100

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
    2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-280, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR DTC P2103

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-280, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022645

    1.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM

    +

    Voltage

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    15

    E16

    108

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-280

    2014 Note

    P2100, P2103 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
    1.
    2.
    3.

    A

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector F42.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    ECM

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    15

    F42

    32

    EC

    Continuity

    C

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    D

    E

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R connector F42
    • Harness for open or short between IPDM E/R and ECM

    F

    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    G

    4.CHECK FUSE

    1. Disconnect 20 A fuse (No. 53) from IPDM E/R.
    2. Check 20 A fuse for blown.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace 20 A fuse.

    H

    I

    5.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-I
    1.

    Check voltage between ECM harness connector and ground under the following conditions.

    J

    ECM

    +
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    2

    E16

    108

    Conditions

    Voltage

    Ignition switch: OFF

    Approx. 0 V

    Ignition switch: ON

    Battery voltage

    K

    L

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    M

    6.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-II
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    N

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector F42.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    ECM

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    2

    F42

    29

    O

    Continuity

    P

    Existed

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-281

    2014 Note

    P2100, P2103 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R connector F42
    • Harness for open or short between IPDM E/R and ECM
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-282

    2014 Note

    P2101 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2101 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022646

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    NOTE:
    • If DTC P2101 is displayed with DTC P2100, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P2100. Refer
    to EC-280, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC P2101 is displayed with DTC P2119, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P2119. Refer
    to EC-289, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Electric throttle control
    performance

    P2101

    C

    D

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Electric throttle control function does not
    operate properly.

    • Harness or connectors
    (Throttle control motor circuit is open or shorted)
    • Electric throttle control actuator

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    F

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11 V when
    engine is running.

    G

    H

    I

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    J

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
    2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-283, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    K

    L

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022647

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    M

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    N

    2.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    O

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    P

    ECM

    +
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    2

    E16

    108

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    Voltage

    Ignition switch OFF

    Approx. 0 V

    Ignition switch ON

    Battery voltage

    EC-283

    2014 Note

    P2101 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM

    +

    Voltage

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    15

    E16

    108

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector F42.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    32

    F10

    15

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R connector F42
    • Harness for open or short between IPDM E/R and ECM
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK FUSE

    1. Disconnect 20A fuse (No. 53) from IPDM E/R.
    2. Check 20A fuse for blown.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Replace 20A fuse.

    7.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector F42.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    29

    F10

    2

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-284

    2014 Note

    P2101 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    8.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    A

    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R connector F42
    • Harness for open or short between IPDM E/R and ECM

    EC

    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    C

    9.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    D

    10.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT

    E

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    F

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Electric throttle control actuator
    Connector

    Terminal

    ECM
    Connector

    5
    F7

    F10
    6

    Terminal

    Continuity

    H

    1

    Not existed

    4

    Existed

    1

    Existed

    4

    Not existed

    I

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    J

    K

    11.CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
    1.
    2.

    Remove the intake air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
    and the housing.

    L

    : Vehicle front

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
    control actuator inside, and then perform throttle valve
    closed position learning. Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».

    12.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR

    N

    PBIB2974E

    Refer to EC-286, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 13.
    NO
    >> GO TO 14.

    O

    P

    13.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    G

    EC-285

    2014 Note

    P2101 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 14.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    14.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
    Replace malfunction electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022648

    1.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
    Check resistance between electric throttle control actuator terminals as follows.
    Terminals

    Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)]

    5 and 6

    Approx. 1 — 15 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-286

    2014 Note

    P2118 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2118 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022649

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Throttle control motor
    circuit short

    P2118

    EC
    DTC detecting condition
    ECM detects short in both circuits between
    ECM and throttle control motor.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (Throttle control motor circuit is shorted.)
    • Electric throttle control actuator
    (Throttle control motor)

    C

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    H

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
    2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-287, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    J

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022650

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    K

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    L

    2.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    M

    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Electric throttle control actuator
    Connector

    Terminal

    ECM
    Connector

    5
    F7

    F10
    6

    Terminal

    O

    Continuity

    1

    Not existed

    4

    Existed

    1

    Existed

    4

    Not existed

    P

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-287

    2014 Note

    P2118 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    3.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
    Refer to EC-288, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    5.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022651

    1.CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
    Check resistance between electric throttle control actuator terminals as follows.
    Terminals

    Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)]

    5 and 6

    Approx. 1 — 15 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-288

    2014 Note

    P2119 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2119 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022652

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    P2119

    EC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Electric throttle control actuator

    DTC detecting condition
    A)

    Electric throttle control actuator does not function
    properly due to the return spring malfunction.

    B)

    Throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is
    not in specified range.

    C)

    ECM detect the throttle valve is stuck open.

    Possible cause

    Electric throttle control actuator

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B

    G

    I

    J

    K

    L

    3.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
    2. Set selector lever to D (CVT) or 1st (M/T) position and wait at least 3 seconds.
    3. Set selector lever to P (CVT) or Neutral (M/T) position.
    4. Start engine and let it idle for 3 seconds.
    5. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-289, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    H

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
    2. Set selector lever to D (CVT) or 1st (M/T) position and wait at least 3 seconds.
    3. Set selector lever to P (CVT) or Neutral (M/T) position.
    4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    5. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
    6. Set selector lever to D (CVT) or 1st (M/T) position and wait at least 3 seconds.
    7. Set selector lever to P (CVT) or Neutral (M/T) position.
    8. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
    9. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-289, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    M

    N

    O
    INFOID:0000000009022653

    1.CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY

    P

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove the intake air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    D

    E

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    1.
    2.

    C

    EC-289

    2014 Note

    P2119 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
    and the housing.

    [HR16DE]

    : Vehicle front

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
    control actuator inside, and then perform throttle valve
    closed position learning. Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    PBIB2974E

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-290

    2014 Note

    P2122, P2123 APP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2122, P2123 APP SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022654

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    NOTE:
    If DTC P2122 or P2123 is displayed with DTC P0643, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0643.
    Refer to EC-252, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    P2122

    Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 1 circuit low input

    An excessively low voltage from the APP
    sensor 1 is sent to ECM.

    P2123

    Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 1 circuit high input

    An excessively high voltage from the APP
    sensor 1 is sent to ECM.

    C

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (APP sensor 1 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Accelerator pedal position sensor
    (APP sensor 1)

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    F

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-291, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009022655

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    L

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    M

    N

    2.CHECK APP SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between APP sensor harness connector and ground.
    APP sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    4

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    5V

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
    Revision: April 2013

    H

    I

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    Diagnosis Procedure

    G

    EC-291

    2014 Note

    P2122, P2123 APP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK APP SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    APP sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    2

    E16

    111

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK APP SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    1.

    Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    APP sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    3

    E16

    110

    Continuity
    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK APP SENSOR

    Refer to EC-292, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY

    Replace accelerator pedal assembly. Refer to ACC-3, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    7.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022656

    1.CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-292

    2014 Note

    P2122, P2123 APP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector

    +
    110
    (APP sensor 1 signal)

    Condition

    111
    Accelerator
    pedal

    E16
    103
    (APP sensor 2 signal)

    Voltage

    104

    Fully released

    0.6 — 0.9 V

    Fully depressed

    3.9 — 4.7 V

    Fully released

    0.3 — 0.6 V

    Fully depressed

    1.95 — 2.4 V

    EC

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    D

    2.REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY

    E

    Replace accelerator pedal assembly. Refer to ACC-3, «Exploded View».
    F

    >> INSPECTION END

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-293

    2014 Note

    P2127, P2128 APP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2127, P2128 APP SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022657

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    P2127

    Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 2 circuit low input

    An excessively low voltage from the
    APP sensor 2 is sent to ECM.

    P2128

    Accelerator pedal position
    sensor 2 circuit high input

    An excessively high voltage from the
    APP sensor 2 is sent to ECM.

    • Harness or connectors
    (APP sensor 2 circuit is open or shorted.)
    [Crankshaft position sensor (POS) circuit is shorted.]
    (Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit is shorted.)
    • Accelerator pedal position sensor (APP sensor 2)
    • Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-294, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022658

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between APP sensor harness connector and ground.
    APP sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    5

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-294

    2014 Note

    P2127, P2128 APP SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    3. Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    APP sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    5

    E16

    102

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EC

    Continuity
    Existed

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    D

    4.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    Check harness for short to power and short to ground, between the following terminals.
    E
    ECM

    Sensor

    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    75

    E16

    Item

    Connector

    Terminal

    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    F15

    1

    101

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    E17

    3

    102

    APP sensor

    E12

    5

    F

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    H

    5.CHECK COMPONENTS

    Check the following.
    • Crankshaft position sensor (POS) (Refer to EC-226, «Component Inspection».)
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor (Refer to EC-325, «Diagnosis Procedure».)
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning component.

    I

    J

    6.CHECK APP SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    APP sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    1

    E16

    104

    Continuity

    M

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    N

    O

    7.CHECK APP SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    APP sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    6

    E16

    103

    P

    Continuity
    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-295

    2014 Note

    P2127, P2128 APP SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    8.CHECK APP SENSOR

    Refer to EC-296, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY

    Replace accelerator pedal assembly. Refer to ACC-3, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    10.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022659

    1.CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector

    Condition

    +

    110
    (APP sensor 1 signal)

    111

    103
    (APP sensor 2 signal)

    104

    Accelerator
    pedal

    E16

    Voltage

    Fully released

    0.6 — 0.9 V

    Fully depressed

    3.9 — 4.7 V

    Fully released

    0.3 — 0.6 V

    Fully depressed

    1.95 — 2.4 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY

    Replace accelerator pedal assembly. Refer to ACC-3, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-296

    2014 Note

    P2135 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2135 TP SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022660

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    EC

    NOTE:
    If DTC P2135 is displayed with DTC P0643, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0643. Refer to
    EC-252, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P2135

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Throttle position sensor
    circuit range/performance

    Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
    compared with the signals from TP sensor
    1 and TP sensor 2.

    • Harness or connector
    (TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is open or shorted.)
    • Electric throttle control actuator
    (TP sensor 1 and 2)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    I

    1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-297, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    J

    K

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022661

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION

    L

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    M

    2.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ground.
    Electric throttle control actuator
    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    2

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-297

    2014 Note

    P2135 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    3. Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ground.
    Electric throttle control actuator

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F7

    4

    F11

    36

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between electric throttle control actuator harness connector and ground.
    Electric throttle control actuator
    Connector
    F7

    Terminal

    ECM
    Connector

    1
    3

    F11

    Terminal
    33
    34

    Continuity

    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR

    Refer to EC-298, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    7.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022662

    1.CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Perform EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Set selector lever to D (CVT) or 1st (M/T) position.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-298

    2014 Note

    P2135 TP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    ECM
    Connector

    Terminal
    +

    Condition

    Fully released

    33
    (TP sensor 1 signal)
    F11

    36
    34
    (TP sensor 2 signal)

    Voltage

    Accelerator
    pedal

    EC

    More than 0.36 V

    Fully depressed

    Less than 4.75 V

    Fully released

    Less than 4.75 V

    Fully depressed

    More than 0.36 V

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    D

    2.REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR

    E

    Replace electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    F

    >> INSPECTION END

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-299

    2014 Note

    P2138 APP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2138 APP SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009022663

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC P2138 is displayed with DTC P0643, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0643. Refer to
    EC-252, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P2138

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Accelerator pedal position sensor
    circuit range/performance

    Rationally incorrect voltage
    is sent to ECM compared
    with the signals from APP
    sensor 1 and APP sensor
    2.

    • Harness or connector
    (APP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is open or shorted.)
    [Crankshaft position sensor (POS) circuit is shorted.)
    (Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit is shorted.)
    • Accelerator pedal position sensor (APP sensor 1 and 2)
    • Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always perform the following before conducting the next test.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
    TESTING CONDITION:
    Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10 V at idle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
    2. Check DTC.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Proceed to EC-300, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022664

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    2.CHECK APP SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between APP sensor harness connector and ground.
    APP sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    4

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-300

    2014 Note

    P2138 APP SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or shot to power in harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    3.CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I

    A

    Check the voltage between APP sensor harness connector and ground.
    EC
    APP sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    5

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    D

    4.CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    E

    F
    APP sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E12

    5

    E16

    102

    Continuity

    G

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or shot to power in harness or connectors.

    H

    5.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    Check harness for short to power and short to ground, between the following terminals.
    ECM

    Sensor

    Connector

    Terminal

    F11

    75

    E16

    I

    Item

    Connector

    Terminal

    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    F15

    1

    101

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    E17

    3

    102

    APP sensor

    E12

    5

    J

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    L

    6.CHECK COMPONENTS

    M

    Check the following.
    • Crankshaft position sensor (POS) (Refer to EC-226, «Component Inspection».)
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor (Refer to EC-325, «Diagnosis Procedure».)
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning component.

    N

    O

    7.CHECK APP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector as follows.
    APP sensor
    Connector
    E12

    ECM

    Terminal
    1
    2

    Revision: April 2013

    Connector
    E16

    Terminal
    104
    111

    Continuity

    Existed

    EC-301

    2014 Note

    P

    P2138 APP SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or shot to power in harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    8.CHECK APP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between APP sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector as follows.
    APP sensor
    Connector

    ECM

    Terminal

    Connector

    3

    E12

    110

    E16

    6

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Existed

    103

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or shot to power in harness or connectors.

    9.CHECK APP SENSOR

    Refer to EC-302, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> GO TO 10.

    10.REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY

    Replace accelerator pedal assembly. Refer to ACC-3, «Exploded View».
    >> INSPECTION END

    11.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022665

    1.CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector

    Condition

    +

    110
    (APP sensor 1 signal)

    111

    103
    (APP sensor 2 signal)

    104

    Accelerator
    pedal

    E16

    Voltage

    Fully released

    0.6 — 0.9 V

    Fully depressed

    3.9 — 4.7 V

    Fully released

    0.3 — 0.6 V

    Fully depressed

    1.95 — 2.4 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY

    Replace accelerator pedal assembly. Refer to ACC-3, «Exploded View».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-302

    2014 Note

    P2138 APP SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    >> INSPECTION END

    EC

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-303

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009642384

    1.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “BRAKE SW1” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Check “BRAKE SW1” indication under the following conditions.
    Monitor item

    BRAKE SW1

    1.
    2.

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Indication

    Slightly depressed

    OFF

    Fully released

    ON

    Without CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector terminals under the following conditions.
    ECM

    Connector

    E16

    +

    Terminal

    Terminal

    100
    (Brake pedal position
    switch signal)

    108

    Condition

    Brake
    pedal

    Slightly depressed
    Fully released

    Voltage (V)

    Approx. 0
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Go to EC-304, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009642385

    1.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect brake pedal position switch harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between brake pedal position switch harness connector and ground.
    Brake pedal position switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E36

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • Harness connector E7, M69
    • 10A fuse (No. 5)
    • Harness for open or short between brake pedal position switch and fuse
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-304

    2014 Note

    BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH
    [HR16DE]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check the continuity between brake pedal position switch harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Brake pedal position switch

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E36

    2

    E16

    100

    Continuity

    A

    EC

    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Harness for open or short between ECM and brake pedal position switch

    C

    D

    4.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH

    Refer to EC-305, «Component Inspection (Brake Pedal Position Switch)»
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace brake pedal position switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View»

    E

    F

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    G

    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection (Brake Pedal Position Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009642609

    H

    1.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect brake pedal position switch harness connector.
    Check the continuity between brake pedal position switch terminals under the following conditions.
    Terminals
    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Slightly depressed

    J

    Continuity

    Fully released

    I

    Existed

    K

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    L

    2.CHECK BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH-II
    1.
    2.

    Adjust brake pedal position switch installation. Refer to BR-20, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    Check the continuity between brake pedal position switch terminals under the following conditions.

    M

    Terminals

    N

    1 and 2

    Condition
    Brake pedal

    Fully released
    Slightly depressed

    Continuity
    Existed
    Not existed

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace brake pedal position switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-305

    P

    2014 Note

    ASCD INDICATOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ASCD INDICATOR
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009642387

    1.CHECK ASCD INDICATOR FUNCTION
    Check ASCD indicator under the following conditions.
    ASCD INDICATOR

    CONDITION
    • MAIN switch: Pressed at the 1st time →
    at the 2nd time

    CRUISE LAMP

    • Ignition switch: ON

    SET LAMP

    • MAIN switch: ON
    • When vehicle speed is between 30 km/h
    (19 MPH) and 170 km/h (105 MPH)

    SPECIFICATION
    ON → OFF

    • ASCD: Operating

    ON

    • ASCD: Not operating

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Go to EC-306, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009642388

    1.CHECK DTC
    Check that DTC UXXXX is not displayed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC UXXXX.

    2.CHECK DTC WITH COMBINATION METER

    Check DTC with combination meter. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    3.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-306

    2014 Note

    CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009642392

    1.CHECK CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    EC

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “ENGINE” using CONSULT.
    Select “CLUTCH P/P SW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
    Check “CLUTCH P/P SW” indication under the following conditions.

    C

    D
    Monitor item
    CLUTCH P/P SW

    1.
    2.

    Condition
    Clutch pedal

    Indication

    Fully released

    OFF

    Fully depressed

    ON

    E

    Without CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    F

    ECM
    +

    Condition

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E16

    92
    (Clutch pedal position switch signal)

    E16

    108

    Clutch pedal

    Fully released
    Fully depressed

    Voltage

    Approx. 0V

    G

    H

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Go to EC-307, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    I

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009642393

    J

    1.CHECK CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    K

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect clutch pedal position switch harness connector.
    Check the continuity between clutch pedal position switch harness connector and ground.

    L
    Clutch pedal position switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E48

    4

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    M

    4. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.

    N

    2.CHECK CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between clutch pedal position switch harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Clutch pedal position switch

    3.

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E48

    3

    E16

    92

    Continuity
    Existed

    Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-307

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    [HR16DE]

    3.CHECK CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH

    Refer to EC-308, «Component Inspection (Clutch Pedal Position Switch)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace clutch pedal position switch. Refer to CL-10, «Exploded View».

    4.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection (Clutch Pedal Position Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009642394

    1.CHECK CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect clutch pedal position switch harness connector.
    Check the continuity between clutch pedal position switch terminals under the following conditions.
    Clutch pedal position switch
    Connector

    Terminals

    E48

    3 and 4

    Condition
    Clutch
    pedal

    Continuity

    Fully released

    Existed

    Fully depressed

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION SWITCH-II

    1.
    2.

    Adjust clutch pedal position switch installation. Refer to CL-5, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    Check the continuity between clutch pedal position switch terminals under the following conditions.
    Clutch pedal position switch
    Connector

    Terminals

    E48

    3 and 4

    Condition
    Clutch
    pedal

    Continuity

    Fully released

    Existed

    Fully depressed

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace clutch pedal position switch. Refer to CL-10, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-308

    2014 Note

    COOLING FAN
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    COOLING FAN

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022666

    1.CHECK COOLING FAN FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    EC

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Perform “COOLING FAN” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.
    Touch “LOW” and “Hi” on the CONSULT screen.
    Check that cooling fan operates at each speed.

    C

    Without CONSULT
    1. Perform IPDM E/R auto active test and check cooling fan motor operation. Refer to PCS-9, «Diagnosis
    Description».
    2. Check that cooling fan operates at each speed.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Refer to EC-309, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    CVT models

    Connector

    Cooling fan motor

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    7

    E5

    1

    5

    E32

    3

    E43

    Continuity

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    7

    E43

    3.

    Cooling fan motor
    Terminal
    2

    E31

    5

    1

    H

    I

    Existed

    J

    M/T models

    IPDM E/R

    F

    G

    Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connector.
    Check the continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and cooling fan motor harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    E

    INFOID:0000000009587164

    1.CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    D

    Continuity

    K

    Existed

    Check the continuity between cooling fan relay harness connector and cooling fan motor harness connector.
    CVT models

    L

    M

    Cooling fan relay

    Cooling fan motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E62

    5

    E32

    4

    Continuity

    N

    Existed

    M/T models

    Cooling fan relay

    4.

    Cooling fan motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E62

    5

    E31

    4

    O

    Continuity
    Existed

    P

    Check the continuity between cooling fan motor harness connector and ground.
    CVT models

    Cooling fan motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E5

    2

    Revision: April 2013

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    EC-309

    2014 Note

    COOLING FAN
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    M/T models

    Cooling fan motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E31

    3

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    2.CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect cooling fan relay harness connector.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Check the continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and cooling fan relay harness connector.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Connector

    65

    E46

    4.

    Cooling fan relay

    Terminal

    Terminal
    1

    E62

    59

    2

    Continuity

    Existed

    Check the continuity between cooling fan relay harness connector and ground.
    Cooling fan relay
    Connector

    Terminal

    E62

    3

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY

    Refer to EC-311, «Component Inspection (Cooling Fan Relay)».
    YES or NO
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace cooling fan relay.

    4.CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR

    Refer to EC-310, «Component Inspection (Cooling Fan Motor)».
    YES or NO
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace cooling fan motor. Refer to CO-17, «Exploded View».

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Perform GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    YES or NO
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    Component Inspection (Cooling Fan Motor)

    INFOID:0000000009587165

    1.CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connector.
    Supply cooling fan motor terminals with battery voltage and check operation.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-310

    2014 Note

    COOLING FAN
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    CVT models

    A

    Cooling fan motor
    Connector

    +

    Operation

    terminals

    E5

    1

    2

    E32

    3

    4

    EC
    Cooling fan motor operates

    C

    M/T models

    Cooling fan motor
    Connector

    E31

    +

    Operation

    D

    terminals
    2

    3

    1

    4

    Cooling fan motor operates

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace cooling fan motor. Refer to CO-17, «Exploded View».

    Component Inspection (Cooling Fan Relay)

    F
    INFOID:0000000009587163

    G

    1.CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove cooling fan relay.
    Check continuity between cooling fan relay terminals under the
    following conditions.
    Cooling fan relay
    terminals
    3

    5

    H

    I
    Conditions

    Continuity

    12 V direct current supply between
    terminals 1 and 2

    Existed

    No current supply

    J

    Not existed

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace cooling fan relay.

    JSBIA0671ZZ

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-311

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009022669

    The electrical load signal (Headlamp switch signal, rear window defogger switch signal, etc.) is transferred to
    ECM through the CAN communication line.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022670

    1.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    Select “LOAD SIGNAL” and check indication under the following conditions.
    Monitor item

    LOAD SIGNAL

    Condition
    Rear window defogger switch

    Indication
    ON

    ON

    OFF

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-312, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK LIGHTING SWITCH FUNCTION

    Check “LOAD SIGNAL” indication under the following conditions.
    Monitor item
    LOAD SIGNAL

    Condition
    Lighting switch

    Indication

    ON at 2nd position

    ON

    OFF

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-312, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    3.CHECK HEATER FAN CONTROL SWITCH FUNCTION

    Select “HEATER FAN SW” and check indication under the following conditions.
    Monitor item
    HEATER FAN SW

    Condition
    Heater fan control switch

    Indication
    ON

    ON

    OFF

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-312, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022671

    1.INSPECTION START
    Confirm the malfunctioning circuit (rear window defogger, headlamp or heater fan). Refer to EC-312, «Component Function Check».
    Which circuit is related to the incident?
    Rear window defogger>>GO TO 2
    Headlamp>>GO TO 3.
    Heater fan>>GO TO 4.

    2.CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM

    Perform trouble diagnosis of rear window defogger system. Refer to DEF-13, «Work Flow».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-312

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    >> INSPECTION END

    3.CHECK HEADLAMP SYSTEM

    A

    Perform trouble diagnosis of headlamp system. Refer to EXL-70, «Work Flow».
    EC

    >> INSPECTION END

    4.CHECK AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM

    C

    Perform trouble diagnosis of air conditioning system. Refer to HAC-27, «Workflow».
    >> INSPECTION END

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-313

    2014 Note

    FUEL INJECTOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FUEL INJECTOR
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022672

    1.INSPECTION START
    Turn ignition switch to START.
    Is any cylinder ignited?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-314, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR FUNCTION

    With CONSULT
    Start engine.
    Perform “POWER BALANCE” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.
    Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine speed drop.
    Without CONSULT
    1. Let engine idle.
    2. Listen to each fuel injector operating sound.
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Clicking noise should be heard.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-314, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    PBIB3332E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022673

    1.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect fuel injector harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between fuel injector harness connector and ground.
    Fuel injector

    Cylinder
    1

    2

    3

    4

    Connector

    Front / Rear

    F17

    Front

    F53

    Rear

    F18

    Front

    F54

    Rear

    F19

    Front

    F29

    Rear

    F20

    Front

    F30

    Rear

    Terminal

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    1

    1

    1

    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • IPDM E/R connector F42
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-314

    2014 Note

    FUEL INJECTOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    • 10 A fuse (No. 55)
    • Harness for open or short between fuel injector and fuse

    A

    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    EC

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between fuel injector harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    Fuel injector

    Cylinder
    1

    2

    3

    4

    Connector

    Front / Rear

    F17

    Front

    F53

    Rear

    F18

    Front

    F54

    Rear

    F19

    Front

    F29

    Rear

    F20

    Front

    F30

    Rear

    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    C

    D

    Continuity

    31

    2

    E

    12
    30

    2
    F10
    2

    2

    20
    29

    F

    Existed

    16

    G

    25
    24

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    H

    I

    4.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR

    Refer to EC-315, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning fuel injector. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View»

    J

    5.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    K

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    L

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022674

    1.CHECK FUEL INJECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    N

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect fuel injector harness connector.
    Check resistance between fuel injector terminals as follows.

    O
    Terminals

    Resistance

    1 and 2

    11.1 — 14.5 Ω [at 10 — 60°C (50 — 140°F)]

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning fuel injector. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-315

    2014 Note

    FUEL PUMP
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FUEL PUMP
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022675

    1.CHECK FUEL PUMP FUNCTION
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Pinch fuel feed hose
    with two fingers.
    Fuel pressure pulsation should be felt on the fuel feed
    hose for 1 second after ignition switch is turned ON.

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> EC-316, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    ALBIA1074ZZ

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022676

    1.CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.
    ECM

    +

    Voltage

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F10

    23

    E16

    108

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Check the continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ECM harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F43

    43

    F10

    23

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Disconnect “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-316

    2014 Note

    FUEL PUMP
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    Fuel level sensor unit
    and fuel pump
    Connector

    Terminal

    B44

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage should for exist 1 second
    after ignition switch is turn ON.

    EC

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    C

    4.CHECK FUSE

    D

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect 15 A fuse (No. 48) from IPDM E/R.
    3. Check 15 A fuse.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace 15 A fuse.

    E

    1.
    2.
    3.

    G

    F

    5.CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Check the continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”
    harness connector.

    H
    Fuel level sensor unit and
    fuel pump

    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E44

    9

    B44

    1

    Continuity

    I
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    J

    K

    6.CHECK FUEL PUMP GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check the continuity between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”harness connector and ground.

    Fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump
    Connector

    Terminal

    B44

    3

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    M

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.

    N

    O

    7.CHECK FUEL PUMP

    Refer to EC-318, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”. Refer to FL-6, «Exploded View».

    P

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-317

    L

    2014 Note

    FUEL PUMP
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Exploded View».
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit, short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    Component Inspection

    [HR16DE]

    INFOID:0000000009022677

    1.CHECK FUEL PUMP
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect “fuel level sensor unit (fuel pump)” harness connector.
    Check resistance between “fuel level sensor unit (fuel pump)” terminals as follows.
    Terminals

    Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)]

    1 and 3

    0.2 — 5.0 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace fuel level sensor unit, fuel filter and fuel pump assembly. Refer to FL-6, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-318

    2014 Note

    IGNITION SIGNAL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    IGNITION SIGNAL

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022678

    1.INSPECTION START

    EC

    Turn ignition switch OFF, and restart engine.
    Does the engine start?
    YES-1 >> With CONSULT: GO TO 2.
    YES-2 >> Without CONSULT: GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-319, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    2.IGNITION SIGNAL FUNCTION

    D

    With CONSULT
    1. Perform “POWER BALANCE” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT.
    2. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine speed drop.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-319, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    F

    3.IGNITION SIGNAL FUNCTION

    G

    Without CONSULT
    1. Let engine idle.
    2. Check the voltage signal between ECM harness connector and ground with an oscilloscope.

    H
    ECM

    +
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Voltage signal

    I

    Terminal

    17

    J

    18
    F10

    21

    E16

    108

    K

    22
    JMBIA0219GB

    L

    NOTE:
    The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at idle.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-319, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    M

    INFOID:0000000009022679

    1.CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    O

    ECM
    Connector
    E16

    P
    Terminal

    Voltage

    +

    105

    108

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Revision: April 2013

    N

    EC-319

    2014 Note

    IGNITION SIGNAL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect condenser harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between condenser harness connector and ground.
    Condenser
    Connector

    Terminal

    F26

    1

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector F42.
    Check the continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and condenser harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    Condenser

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    34

    F26

    1

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • Harness for open or short between IPDM E/R and condenser
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK CONDENSER GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check the continuity between condenser harness connector and ground.
    Condenser
    Connector

    Terminal

    F26

    2

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK CONDENSER

    Refer to EC-323, «Component Inspection (Condenser)»
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Replace condenser.

    7.CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-320

    2014 Note

    IGNITION SIGNAL
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Check the voltage between ignition coil harness connector and ground.
    Ignition coil
    Cylinder

    Connector

    Terminal

    1

    F34

    3

    2

    F35

    3

    3

    F36

    3

    4

    F37

    3

    [HR16DE]
    A

    Ground

    Voltage

    EC

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    C

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    8.CHECK IGNITION COIL GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check the continuity between ignition coil harness connector and ground.
    Ignition coil

    Cylinder

    Connector

    Terminal

    1

    F34

    2

    2

    F35

    2

    3

    F36

    2

    4

    F37

    2

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    F

    G

    H

    3. Also check harness for short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.

    I

    J

    9.CHECK IGNITION COIL OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and ignition coil harness connector.
    Ignition coil

    ECM

    Cylinder

    Connector

    Terminal

    1

    F34

    1

    2

    F35

    1

    3

    F36

    1

    4

    F37

    1

    Connector

    Terminal

    K

    L

    Continuity

    17
    F10

    18
    22

    M

    Existed

    21

    N

    3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    O

    10.CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR

    Refer to EC-322, «Component Inspection (Ignition Coil with Power Transistor)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning ignition coil with power transistor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    11.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Revision: April 2013

    EC-321

    2014 Note

    P

    IGNITION SIGNAL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    >> INSPECTION END

    Component Inspection (Ignition Coil with Power Transistor)

    INFOID:0000000009022680

    1.CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR-I
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
    Check resistance between ignition coil terminals as follows.
    Terminals

    Resistance

    1 and 2

    Except 0 or ∞ Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]

    1 and 3
    2 and 3

    Except 0 Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning ignition coil with power transistor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    2.CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR-II

    CAUTION:
    Do the following procedure in the place where ventilation is good without the combustible.
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
    3. Remove fuel pump fuse in IPDM E/R to release fuel pressure.
    NOTE:
    Do not use CONSULT to release fuel pressure, or fuel pressure applies again during the following procedure.
    4. Start engine.
    5. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel pressure.
    6. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    7. Remove all ignition coil harness connectors to avoid the electrical discharge from the ignition coils.
    8. Remove ignition coil and spark plug of the cylinder to be checked.
    9. Crank engine for 5 seconds or more to remove combustion gas in the cylinder.
    10. Connect spark plug and harness connector to ignition coil.
    11. Fix ignition coil using a rope etc. with gap of 13 — 17 mm (0.52 0.66 in) between the edge of the spark plug and grounded metal
    portion as shown in the figure.
    12. Crank engine for about three seconds, and check whether spark
    is generated between the spark plug and the grounded metal
    portion.
    Spark should be generated.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not approach to the spark plug and the ignition coil
    JMBIA0066GB
    within 50 cm (19.7 in). Be careful not to get an electrical
    shock while checking, because the electrical discharge
    voltage becomes 20 kV or more.
    • It might cause to damage the ignition coil if the gap of more than 17 mm (0.66 in) is taken.
    NOTE:
    When the gap is less than 13 mm (0.52 in), the spark might be generated even if the coil is malfunctioning.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace malfunctioning ignition coil with power transistor. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-322

    2014 Note

    IGNITION SIGNAL
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Component Inspection (Condenser)

    INFOID:0000000009022681

    A

    1.CHECK CONDENSER
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect condenser harness connector.
    Check resistance between condenser terminals as follows.
    Terminals

    Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)]

    1 and 2

    Above 1 MΩ

    EC

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace condenser.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-323

    2014 Note

    MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009022682

    1.CHECK MIL FUNCTION
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Make sure that MIL lights up.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-324, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009022683

    1.CHECK DTC
    Check that DTC UXXXX is not displayed.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC UXXXX.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK COMBINATION METER

    Check DTC with combination meter. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform troubleshooting relevant to DTC indicated.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-324

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
    Component Function Check

    A
    INFOID:0000000009022684

    1.CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR OVERALL FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    EC

    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Turn A/C switch and blower fan switch ON.
    Check the voltage between ECM harness connector and ground.

    C

    ECM
    Terminal

    Connector
    E16

    +

    101
    (Refrigerant pressure sensor signal)

    98

    Voltage

    D

    1.0 — 4.0V

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Proceed to EC-325, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F
    INFOID:0000000009022685

    G

    1.CHECK GROUND CONNECTION
    1. Turn A/C switch and blower fan switch OFF.
    2. Stop engine.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    4. Check ground connection E15. Refer to Ground Inspection in GI-44, «Circuit Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground connection.

    H

    I

    2.CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    Disconnect refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check the voltage between refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector and ground.
    Refrigerant pressure sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E17

    3

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    K

    L

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    N

    Check the following.
    • Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor

    O

    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    P

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect ECM harness connector.
    Check the continuity between refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector and ECM harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-325

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
    [HR16DE]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E17

    1

    E16

    98

    Continuity
    Existed

    4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    5.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
    1.

    Check the continuity between ECM harness connector and refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector.

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    ECM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E17

    2

    E16

    85

    Continuity
    Existed

    2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART

    Check the following.
    • Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace refrigerant pressure sensor. Refer to HAC-49, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-326

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009022686

    EC

    SYSTEM — BASIC ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
    C

    1

    2

    3

    2

    Fuel pressure regulator system

    3

    3

    4

    4

    4

    BATTERY DEAD (UNDER CHARGE)

    1

    EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION

    Fuel pump circuit

    EXCESSIVE FUEL CONSUMPTION

    AE

    OVERHEATS/WATER TEMPERATURE HIGH

    LACK OF POWER/POOR ACCELERATION

    AD

    SLOW/NO RETURN TO IDLE

    SPARK KNOCK/DETONATION

    AC

    IDLING VIBRATION

    HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT

    AB

    ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING

    ENGINE STALL

    AA

    Warranty symptom code

    HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE

    HARD/NO START/RESTART (EXCP. HA)

    SYMPTOM

    AF

    AG

    AH

    AJ

    AK

    AL

    AM

    HA

    2

    2

    4

    4

    D

    Fuel

    Fuel injector circuit

    Evaporative emission system
    Air

    Positive crankcase ventilation system
    Incorrect idle speed adjustment

    Electric throttle control actuator

    Ignition

    1

    3

    1

    3

    2

    4

    4
    3

    1

    3

    4

    4

    4

    2

    4

    4

    2

    4

    4

    3

    4

    2

    4

    4

    2

    2

    3

    3

    Reference page

    F

    G

    H
    EC-316, «Component Function
    Check»

    4

    EC-122, «Work Procedure»

    2

    EC-314, «Component Function
    Check»

    4

    EC-36, «EVAPORATIVE EMISSION
    SYSTEM : System
    Description»
    EC-337, «Inspection»

    4

    4

    4

    4

    4

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    EC-118, «Work Procedure»

    2

    EC-283, «DTC Logic»
    EC-287, «DTC Logic»
    EC-289, «DTC Logic»

    3

    1

    E

    2

    2

    2

    2

    2

    Incorrect ignition timing adjustment

    3

    3

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    EC-335, «Inspection»

    Ignition signal circuit

    1

    1

    2

    2

    2

    2

    2

    2

    EC-319, «Diagnosis
    Procedure»

    2

    2

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    EC-137, «Diagnosis
    Procedure»

    Main power supply and ground circuit

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-327

    2

    2014 Note

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    ENGINE STALL

    HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT

    SPARK KNOCK/DETONATION

    LACK OF POWER/POOR ACCELERATION

    HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE

    ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING

    IDLING VIBRATION

    SLOW/NO RETURN TO IDLE

    OVERHEATS/WATER TEMPERATURE HIGH

    EXCESSIVE FUEL CONSUMPTION

    EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION

    BATTERY DEAD (UNDER CHARGE)

    Warranty symptom code

    HARD/NO START/RESTART (EXCP. HA)

    SYMPTOM

    AA

    AB

    AC

    AD

    AE

    AF

    AG

    AH

    AJ

    AK

    AL

    AM

    HA

    Mass air flow sensor circuit
    Engine coolant temperature sensor
    circuit

    EC-158, «DTC Logic»

    2
    1
    3

    EC-165, «DTC Logic»

    3

    3
    Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1 circuit
    1

    2

    2

    2

    2

    2

    2

    3

    Knock sensor circuit

    2

    Engine oil pressure sensor circuit

    4

    2

    EC-170, «DTC Logic»
    EC-173, «DTC Logic»
    EC-176, «DTC Logic»
    EC-179, «DTC Logic»
    EC-167, «DTC Logic»
    EC-213, «DTC Logic»
    EC-263, «DTC Logic»
    EC-264, «DTC Logic»
    EC-297, «DTC Logic»

    Throttle position sensor circuit

    Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit

    Reference page

    2

    EC-291, «DTC Logic»
    EC-294, «DTC Logic»
    EC-300, «DTC Logic»

    1

    2

    3

    EC-222, «DTC Logic»

    3

    EC-242, «DTC Logic»

    Crankshaft position sensor circuit

    2

    2

    EC-224, «DTC Logic»

    Camshaft position sensor circuit

    3

    2

    EC-228, «DTC Logic»

    Vehicle speed signal circuit

    ECM

    Revision: April 2013

    2

    2

    2

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    EC-328

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    EC-240, «DTC Logic»

    3

    EC-247, «DTC Logic»
    EC-249, «DTC Logic»

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    SYMPTOM

    SPARK KNOCK/DETONATION

    LACK OF POWER/POOR ACCELERATION

    HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE

    ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING

    IDLING VIBRATION

    SLOW/NO RETURN TO IDLE

    OVERHEATS/WATER TEMPERATURE HIGH

    EXCESSIVE FUEL CONSUMPTION

    EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION

    BATTERY DEAD (UNDER CHARGE)

    AG

    AH

    AJ

    AK

    AL

    AM

    HA

    2

    1

    3

    2

    2

    3

    3

    EC-142, «DTC Logic»

    2

    1

    3

    2

    2

    3

    3

    EC-146, «DTC Logic»

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    EC-254, «DTC Logic»

    4

    EC-325, «Diagnosis
    Procedure»

    HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT

    AF

    ENGINE STALL

    AE

    HARD/NO START/RESTART (EXCP. HA)

    AD

    AA

    AB

    AC

    Intake valve timing control solenoid
    valve circuit

    3

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid
    valve circuit

    3

    Warranty symptom code

    PNP signal circuit
    Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit

    2

    3

    Electrical load signal circuit
    Air conditioner circuit

    A

    3

    2

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    3

    3

    3

    3

    3

    Reference page

    3

    3

    3

    2

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    HAC-27, «Workflow»
    BRC-34, «Work
    Flow»

    4

    C

    D

    EC-312, «Diagnosis
    Procedure»

    3
    2

    EC

    J

    1 — 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
    (continued on next table)

    K

    SYSTEM — ENGINE MECHANICAL & OTHER

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-329

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Fuel

    Fuel tank
    Fuel piping

    HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT

    SPARK KNOCK/DETONATION

    LACK OF POWER/POOR ACCELERATION

    HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE

    ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING

    IDLING VIBRATION

    SLOW/NO RETURN TO IDLE

    OVERHEATS/WATER TEMPERATURE HIGH

    EXCESSIVE FUEL CONSUMPTION

    EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION

    AA

    AB

    AC

    AD

    AE

    AF

    AG

    AH

    AJ

    AK

    AL

    A
    M

    HA

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    FL-5, «Inspection»

    5

    Valve deposit
    Poor fuel (Heavy weight
    gasoline, Low octane)
    Air


    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    Air duct

    EM-28, «Removal
    and Installation»

    Air cleaner

    EM-28, «Removal
    and Installation»

    Air leakage from air duct
    (Mass air flow sensor —
    electric throttle control actuator)
    Electric throttle control actuator

    Cranking

    Reference page

    FL-13, «Inspection»

    5

    Vapor lock

    BATTERY DEAD (UNDER CHARGE)

    ENGINE STALL

    Warranty symptom code

    HARD/NO START/RESTART (EXCP. HA)

    SYMPTOM

    5

    5

    5

    5
    5

    5

    5

    5

    EM-28, «Removal
    and Installation»

    5
    5

    EM-28, «Exploded
    View»

    Air leakage from intake
    manifold/Collector/Gasket

    EM-28, «Exploded
    View»

    Battery

    PG-60, «How to Handle Battery»
    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    Generator circuit

    1

    CHG-10, «Work Flow
    (With EXP-800 NI or
    GR8-1200 NI)»*,
    CHG-13, «Work Flow
    (Without EXP-800 NI
    or GR8-1200 NI)»*

    Starter circuit

    3

    STR-13, «Work Flow
    (With GR8-1200
    NI)»*, STR-16, «Work
    Flow (Without GR81200 NI)»*

    Signal plate

    6

    EM-101, «Inspection»

    PNP signal

    4

    EC-255, «Diagnosis
    Procedure»

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-330

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    5

    5

    5

    AF

    AG

    AH

    AJ

    AK

    AL

    A
    M

    5

    5

    4

    5

    3

    BATTERY DEAD (UNDER CHARGE)

    5

    EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION

    5

    EXCESSIVE FUEL CONSUMPTION

    AE

    OVERHEATS/WATER TEMPERATURE HIGH

    AD

    SLOW/NO RETURN TO IDLE

    AC

    IDLING VIBRATION

    AB

    ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING

    AA

    A

    HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE

    LACK OF POWER/POOR ACCELERATION

    Cylinder head gasket

    SPARK KNOCK/DETONATION

    Cylinder head

    HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT

    Engine

    ENGINE STALL

    Warranty symptom code

    HARD/NO START/RESTART (EXCP. HA)

    SYMPTOM

    EC

    C
    Reference page

    D

    E

    HA

    F
    EM-79, «Inspection»

    G

    Cylinder block
    4

    Piston
    Piston ring
    Connecting rod

    6

    6

    6

    6

    6

    6

    6

    6

    EM-101, «Inspection»

    H

    Bearing

    I

    Crankshaft
    Valve
    mechanism

    Timing chain

    EM-51, «Removal
    and Installation»

    Camshaft

    EM-68, «Inspection»

    Intake valve timing control

    EM-51, «Removal
    and Installation»

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    Exhaust valve timing control

    EM-51, «Removal
    and Installation»

    Intake valve

    3

    Exhaust valve
    Exhaust

    Exhaust manifold/Tube/
    Muffler/Gasket

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    Three way catalyst
    Lubrication

    Oil pan/Oil strainer/Oil
    pump/Oil filter/Oil gallery/
    Oil cooler
    Oil level (Low)/Filthy oil

    J

    K

    EM-79, «Inspection»

    L

    EM-31, «Removal
    and Installation»
    EX-4, «Inspection»

    M

    LU-7, «Inspection»

    N

    LU-7, «Inspection»

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-331

    2014 Note

    ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT

    SPARK KNOCK/DETONATION

    LACK OF POWER/POOR ACCELERATION

    HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE

    ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING

    IDLING VIBRATION

    SLOW/NO RETURN TO IDLE

    OVERHEATS/WATER TEMPERATURE HIGH

    EXCESSIVE FUEL CONSUMPTION

    EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION

    AA

    AB

    AC

    AD

    AE

    AF

    AG

    AH

    AJ

    AK

    AL

    A
    M

    Cooling

    Reference page

    HA
    CO-12, «RADIATOR :
    Inspection»
    CO-12, «RADIATOR
    CAP : Inspection»

    Radiator/Hose/Radiator
    filler cap

    Thermostat
    Water pump

    BATTERY DEAD (UNDER CHARGE)

    ENGINE STALL

    Warranty symptom code

    HARD/NO START/RESTART (EXCP. HA)

    SYMPTOM

    CO-21, «Removal
    and Installation»

    5
    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    5

    4

    5

    CO-19, «Removal
    and Installation»

    Water gallery

    CO-25, «Removal
    and Installation»

    Cooling fan

    CO-18, «Disassembly
    and Assembly»

    5

    Coolant level (Low)/Contaminated coolant
    NATS (NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer
    System)

    CO-8, «Inspection»
    1

    SEC-61, «ECM :
    Work Procedure»

    1

    1 — 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
    *: For details about type, refer to CHG-3, «Commercial Service Tool».

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-332

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009022687

    FUEL CUT CONTROL (AT NO LOAD AND HIGH ENGINE SPEED)

    EC

    If the engine speed is above 2,400 rpm under no load (for example, the shift lever position is neutral and
    engine speed is over 2,400 rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies based on engine speed.
    Fuel cut will be operated until the engine speed reaches 2,000 rpm, then fuel cut will be cancelled.
    NOTE:
    This function is different from deceleration control listed under Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System, EC-30,
    «MULTIPORT FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM : System Description».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-333

    2014 Note

    IDLE SPEED
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    IDLE SPEED
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022688

    1.CHECK IDLE SPEED
    With CONSULT
    Check idle speed in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT.
    With GST
    Check idle speed with Service $01 of GST.
    Without CONSULT
    Check idle speed by installing the pulse type tachometer clamp on the loop wire or on suitable high-tension
    wire which installed between No.1 ignition coil and No.1 spark plug.
    >> INSPECTION END

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-334

    2014 Note

    IGNITION TIMING
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    IGNITION TIMING

    A

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009022689

    1.CHECK IGNITION TIMING
    1.

    EC

    Attach timing light to loop wire as shown.
    C

    D

    E
    JSBIA0603ZZ

    F

    Loop wire
    A.

    Timing light

    B.

    Timing indicator

    G

    2.

    Check ignition timing.
    H

    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-335

    2014 Note

    EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
    Inspection
    1.
    2.
    a.
    b.
    3.

    INFOID:0000000009022690

    Visually inspect EVAP vapor lines for improper attachment and for cracks, damage, loose connections,
    chafing and deterioration.
    Check EVAP canister as follows:
    Block port . Orally blow air through port .
    Check that air flows freely through port .
    Block port . Orally blow air through port .
    Check that air flows freely through port .
    Visually inspect the fuel check valve for cracks, damage, loose
    connections chafing and deterioration.

    JMBIA0443ZZ

    4.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    Check fuel check valve as follows:
    Blow air through connector on the fuel tank side. A considerable
    resistance should be felt and a portion of air flow should be
    directed toward the EVAP canister side.
    Blow air through connector on EVAP canister side. Air flow
    should be smoothly directed toward fuel tank side.
    If fuel check valve is suspected or not properly functioning in
    step 1 and 2 above, replace it.
    JSBIA0080GB

    5.
    a.

    Inspect fuel tank filler cap vacuum relief valve for clogging, sticking, etc.
    Wipe clean valve housing.

    SEF989X

    b.

    Check valve opening pressure and vacuum.
    Pressure:
    Vacuum:

    c.

    15.3 — 20.0 kPa (0.153 — 0.200 bar, 0.156 — 0.204 kg/
    cm2, 2.22 — 2.90 psi)
    –6.0 to –3.4 kPa (–0.06 bar to –-0.034bar, –0.061 to –
    0.035 kg/cm2, –0.87 to –0.49 psi)

    If out of specification, replace fuel filler cap as an assembly.

    SEF943S

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-336

    2014 Note

    POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
    Inspection

    A
    INFOID:0000000009022691

    1.CHECK PCV VALVE

    EC

    With engine running at idle, remove PCV valve from rocker cover. A
    properly working valve makes a hissing noise as air passes through
    it. A strong vacuum should be felt immediately when a finger is
    placed over valve inlet.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace PCV valve. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».

    C

    D

    E
    PBIB1589E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-337

    2014 Note

    ECM
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    ECM
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009022692

    JPBIA4276ZZ

    ECM bracket

    ECM

    : Vehicle front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009022693

    CAUTION:
    Perform ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM. Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove fusible link bracket. Keep a service area.
    Disconnect ECM harness connectors.
    Remove ECM mounting nuts, and then remove ECM.

    INSTALLATION
    Install in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-338

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Idle Speed

    INFOID:0000000009022694

    Transmission

    Condition

    Specification

    CVT

    No load* (in P or N position)

    700 ± 50 rpm

    M/T

    No load* (in Neutral position)

    650 ± 50 rpm

    EC

    C

    D

    *: Under the following conditions
    • A/C switch: OFF
    • Electric load: OFF (Lights, heater fan & rear window defogger)

    E

    • Steering wheel: Kept in straight-ahead position

    Ignition Timing

    INFOID:0000000009022695

    F
    Transmission

    Condition

    Specification

    CVT

    No load* (in P or N position)

    11 ± 2°BTDC

    M/T

    No load* (in Neutral position)

    10 ± 2°BTDC

    G

    *: Under the following conditions
    • A/C switch: OFF

    H

    • Electric load: OFF (Lights, heater fan & rear window defogger)
    • Steering wheel: Kept in straight-ahead position

    Calculated Load Value

    INFOID:0000000009022696

    Condition

    Specification (Using CONSULT or GST)

    At idle

    10 – 35%

    At 2,500 rpm

    10 – 35%

    I

    J

    K

    Mass Air Flow Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009022697

    Supply voltage

    L

    Battery voltage (11 – 14 V)

    Output voltage at idle

    0.8 – 1.3 V*
    0.8 – 4.0 g/s at idle*
    2.0 – 10.0 g/s at 2,500 rpm*

    Mass air flow (Using CONSULT or GST)

    M

    *: Engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature and running under no load.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EC-339

    2014 Note

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    EM

    ENGINE MECHANICAL

    A

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    HR16DE
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover…… 3
    Draining Engine Coolant ……………………………………. 3
    Disconnecting Fuel Piping ………………………………….. 3
    Removal and Disassembly …………………………………. 3
    Inspection, Repair and Replacement …………………… 4
    Assembly and Installation ………………………………….. 4
    Parts Requiring Angle Tightening ……………………….. 4
    Precaution for Liquid Gasket ………………………………. 4

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 6

    Inspection ……………………………………………………….17
    Adjustment ………………………………………………………17

    AIR CLEANER FILTER ………………………………. 19
    Exploded View …………………………………………………19
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..19

    SPARK PLUG …………………………………………… 21

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 24
    Exploded View …………………………………………………24
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..24

    AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT ………………….. 26

    Inspection ………………………………………………………. 13

    INTAKE MANIFOLD ………………………………….. 28

    L

    Exploded View …………………………………………………28
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..28

    EXHAUST MANIFOLD ……………………………….. 31

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER ……………………. 34

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….14

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE ……………. 40
    Exploded View …………………………………………………40
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..40

    NVH troubleshooting Chart ………………………………. 14

    IGNITION COIL …………………………………………. 47
    Exploded View …………………………………………………47
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..47

    DRIVE BELT ……………………………………………….16

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    Exploded View …………………………………………………31
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..31

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 14

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 16
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 16

    J

    K

    Exploded View …………………………………………………34
    Removal and Installation (Lower Oil Pan) ……………34
    Removal and Installation (Upper Oil Pan) ……………37

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ……………………. 16

    I

    Exploded View …………………………………………………26
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..26

    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………….. 10

    COMPRESSION PRESSURE ……………………….13

    H

    DRIVE BELT IDLER PULLEY …………………….. 24

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 10
    CAMSHAFT VALVE CLEARANCE ……………….10

    G

    Exploded View …………………………………………………21
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..21

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 6
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 6
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 7

    F

    ROCKER COVER ……………………………………… 48

    EM-1

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 48
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 48

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY … 90

    TIMING CHAIN ………………………………………….. 51
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 51
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 51

    Setting …………………………………………………………… 90
    Disassembly …………………………………………………… 91
    Assembly ………………………………………………………. 91

    CAMSHAFT ………………………………………………. 60

    CYLINDER BLOCK ……………………………………. 92

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 60
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 60
    Inspection ……………………………………………………… 68

    ENGINE UNIT ……………………………………………. 90

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 92
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………… 93
    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 101

    OIL SEAL ………………………………………………….. 73

    HOW TO SELECT PISTON AND BEARING .. 110

    VALVE OIL SEAL …………………………………………….. 73
    VALVE OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation ……… 73

    Description …………………………………………………… 110
    Connecting Rod Bearing ………………………………… 110
    Main Bearing ……………………………………………….. 112

    FRONT OIL SEAL …………………………………………….. 74
    FRONT OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation …….. 74
    REAR OIL SEAL ………………………………………………. 74
    REAR OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation ………. 74

    CYLINDER HEAD ………………………………………. 76
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 76
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 76
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 77
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………… 78
    Inspection ……………………………………………………… 79

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ….. 85
    ENGINE ASSEMBLY ………………………………….. 85

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………… 115
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………………. 115
    General Specification …………………………………….. 115
    Drive Belt …………………………………………………….. 115
    Spark Plug …………………………………………………… 116
    Exhaust Manifold ………………………………………….. 116
    Camshaft ……………………………………………………… 116
    Cylinder head ……………………………………………….. 118
    Cylinder Block ………………………………………………. 120
    Main Bearing ………………………………………………… 123
    Connecting Rod Bearing ………………………………… 124

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 85
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 86

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [HR16DE]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    EM

    INFOID:0000000009444822

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009444823

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc.
    K

    L

    M
    PIIB3706J

    Draining Engine Coolant

    INFOID:0000000009444824

    N

    INFOID:0000000009444825

    O

    Drain engine coolant and engine oil when the engine is cooled.

    Disconnecting Fuel Piping
    • Before starting work, check no fire or spark producing items are in the work area.
    • Release fuel pressure before disconnecting and disassembly.
    • After disconnecting pipes, plug openings to stop fuel leakage.

    Removal and Disassembly

    P
    INFOID:0000000009444826

    • When instructed to use SST, use specified tools. Always be careful to work safely, avoid forceful or uninstructed operations.
    • Use care to avoid damage to mating or sliding surfaces.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-3

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [HR16DE]
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Dowel pins are used for several parts alignment. When replacing and reassembling parts with dowel pins,
    check that dowel pins are installed in the original position.
    • Cover openings of engine system with a tape or equivalent, if necessary, to seal out foreign materials.
    • Mark and arrange disassembly parts in an organized way for easy troubleshooting and reassembly.
    • When loosening nuts and bolts, start with the one furthest outside, then the one diagonally opposite, and so
    on. If the order of loosening is specified, do exactly as specified. Power tools may be used in the step.

    Inspection, Repair and Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009444827

    Before repairing or replacing, thoroughly inspect parts. Inspect new replacement parts in the same way, and
    replace if necessary.

    Assembly and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444828

    • Use torque wrench to tighten bolts or nuts to specification.
    • Tighten nuts and bolts in order exactly as specified in the procedure. If a tightening order or procedure is not
    specified, tighten nuts and bolts equally in several different steps. Start with the nuts or bolts in the center
    and then tighten diagonally starting with the inside and moving to the outside in a spiral pattern.
    • Replace with new gasket, packing, oil seal or O-ring.
    • Thoroughly wash, clean, and air-blow each part. Carefully check engine oil or engine coolant passages for
    restrictions and blockages.
    • Avoid damaging sliding or mating surfaces. Before assembling, completely remove foreign materials such
    as cloth lint or dust, and oil the sliding surfaces.
    • After refilling engine coolant, bleed the air from the cooling system.
    • After repairing, start the engine and increase engine speed to check for engine coolant leaks, fuel leaks,
    engine oil leaks, and exhaust gas leaks.

    Parts Requiring Angle Tightening

    INFOID:0000000009444829

    • For the final tightening of the following engine parts use Tool:
    Tool number

    : KV10112100 (BT-8653-A)

    Camshaft sprocket (INT) bolt
    Cylinder head bolts
    Main bearing cap bolts
    Connecting rod cap bolts
    Crankshaft pulley bolt (Note an angle wrench is required as bolt flange is provided with notches for angle
    tightening)
    • Do not use a torque value for final tightening.
    • The torque value for these parts are for a preliminary step.
    • Ensure thread and seat surfaces are clean and coated with engine oil.

    Precaution for Liquid Gasket

    INFOID:0000000009444830

    REMOVAL OF LIQUID GASKET SEALING
    • After removing the bolts and nuts, separate the mating surface and
    remove the liquid gasket using Tool (A).
    Tool Number

    : KV10111100 (J-37228)

    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage the mating surfaces.
    • In areas where the cutter is difficult to use, use a plastic hammer to
    lightly tap (1) the cutter where the liquid gasket is applied. Use a
    plastic hammer to slide (2) the cutter by tapping on the side.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the mating surfaces.

    AWBIA1249GB

    LIQUID GASKET APPLICATION PROCEDURE

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-4

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    1. Using suitable tool (A), remove old liquid gasket adhering to the
    liquid gasket application surface and the mating surface.
    • Remove liquid gasket completely from the groove of the liquid
    gasket application surface, mounting bolts, and bolt holes.
    2. Wipe the liquid gasket application surface and the mating surface with white gasoline (lighting and heating use) to remove
    adhering moisture, grease and foreign materials.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C
    JPBIA0053ZZ

    3.
    4.

    D

    Attach liquid gasket tube to the suitable tool.
    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant, or equivalent. Refer to
    EM-4, «Precaution for Liquid Gasket».
    Apply liquid gasket without gaps to the specified location according to the specified dimensions.
    • If there is a groove for liquid gasket application, apply liquid
    gasket to the groove.

    E

    F

    G
    EMA0622D

    • As for bolt holes (B), normally apply liquid gasket inside the
    holes. Occasionally, it should be applied outside the holes.
    Check to read the text of this manual.
    (A)

    H

    I

    : Groove
    : Inside

    • Within five minutes of liquid gasket application, install the mating component.
    • If liquid gasket protrudes, wipe it off immediately.
    • Do not retighten mounting bolts or nuts after the installation.
    JPBIA0010ZZ
    • After 30 minutes or more have passed from the installation, fill
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    CAUTION:
    If there are specific instructions in the procedures contained in this manual concerning liquid gasket application, observe them.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-5

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009444831

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV10111100
    (J-37228)
    Seal cutter

    Removing oil pan (lower and upper) etc.

    S-NT046

    KV10116200
    (J-26336-B)
    Valve spring compressor
    1. KV10115900
    (J-26336-20)
    Attachment
    2. KV10109220
    ( — )
    Adapter

    Disassembling and assembling valve mechanism
    Part (1) is a component of KV10116200, but
    Part (2) is not so.

    PBIC1650E

    KV10112100
    (BT-8653-A)
    Angle wrench

    Tightening bolts for main bearing cap, cylinder
    head, etc.

    S-NT014

    KV10117100
    ( — )
    Heated oxygen sensor wrench

    Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensor 1
    For 22 mm (0.87 in) width hexagon nut

    NT379

    KV10107902
    (J-38959)
    Valve oil seal puller

    Removing valve oil seal

    NT011

    KV10115600
    (J-PBIA0396ZZ)
    Valve oil seal drift

    Installing valve oil seal
    Use side A.
    a: 20 (0.79) dia. d: 8 (0.31) dia.
    b: 13 (0.51) dia. e: 10.7 (0.421)
    c: 10.3 (0.406) dia. f: 5 (0.20)
    G: Side A H: Side B
    Unit: mm (in)
    S-NT603

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-6

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PREPARATION >
    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    EM03470000
    (J-8037)
    Piston ring compressor

    Installing piston assembly into cylinder bore

    A

    EM

    C
    S-NT044

    ST16610001
    (J-23907)
    Pulley puller

    D

    Removing pilot converter

    E

    F

    S-NT045

    KV11103000
    ( — )
    Pulley puller

    Removing crankshaft pulley

    G

    H
    NT676

    KV11105210
    (J-44716)
    Stopper plate

    Holding drive plate and flywheel static

    I

    J

    ZZA0009D

    K

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009444832

    L
    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    M

    N
    PIIB1407E

    Quick connector release

    Removing fuel tube quick connectors in engine room

    O

    P

    PBIC0198E

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-7

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PREPARATION >
    Tool name

    Description

    Spark plug wrench

    Removing and installing spark plug
    a: 14 mm (0.55 in)

    JPBIA0399ZZ

    Pulley holder

    Crankshaft pulley removing and installing

    NT035

    Valve seat cutter set

    Finishing valve seat dimensions

    S-NT048

    Piston ring expander

    Removing and installing piston ring

    S-NT030

    Valve guide drift

    Removing and installing valve guide

    PBIC4012E

    Valve guide reamer

    (1): Reaming valve guide inner hole
    (2): Reaming hole for oversize valve guide

    PBIC4013E

    (J-43897-18)
    (J-43897-12)
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner

    JPBIA0238ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-8

    Reconditioning the exhaust system threads
    before installing a new air fuel ratio sensor
    (Use with anti-seize lubricant shown below.)
    A: [18 mm (0.71 in) dia.] for zirconia heated
    oxygen sensor
    B: [12 mm (0.47 in) dia.] for titania heated
    oxygen sensor
    C: Mating surface shave cylinder
    D: Flutes

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PREPARATION >
    Tool name

    Description

    Acoustic tension gauge

    Checking drive belt tension

    A

    EM

    C

    PBIC3881E

    Anti-seize lubricant (Permatex 133AR
    or equivalent meeting MIL specification MIL-A-907)

    Lubricating oxygen sensor thread cleaning
    tool when reconditioning exhaust system
    threads

    D

    E
    AEM489

    Manual lift table caddy

    Removing and installing engine

    F

    G

    H

    ZZA1210D

    1. Compression gauge
    2. Adapter

    Checking compression pressure

    I

    J
    ZZA0008D

    Tube presser

    Pressing the tube of liquid gasket

    K

    L
    S-NT052

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-9

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT VALVE CLEARANCE
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    CAMSHAFT VALVE CLEARANCE
    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009444833

    INSPECTION
    Perform inspection as follows after removal, replacement or installation of camshaft or valve-related parts, or if
    there are unusual engine conditions regarding valve clearance.
    1. Remove rocker cover. Refer to EM-48, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Measure the valve clearance with the following procedure:
    a. Set No. 1 cylinder at TDC of its compression stroke.
    • Rotate crankshaft pulley (2) clockwise and align TDC mark (no
    paint) (A) to timing indicator (1) on front cover.
    (B)

    : White paint mark (Not used for service)

    PBIC3673E

    • At the same time, check that both intake and exhaust cam
    lobes of No. 1 cylinder face inside ( ) as shown.
    (1)

    : Camshaft (INT)

    (2)

    : Camshaft (EXH)
    : Engine front

    • If the lobes do not face inside, rotate the crankshaft pulley 360
    degrees to align as shown.
    JPBIA4738ZZ

    b.

    Using suitable tool (A) measure the clearance between the valve
    lifter and camshaft.
    Valve clearance

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».

    JPBIA4116ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-10

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT VALVE CLEARANCE
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Measure the valve clearances at locations marked “×” [locations indicated with ( )] as shown using suitable tool.
    (A)

    : No. 1 cylinder

    (B)

    : No. 2 cylinder

    (C)

    : No. 3 cylinder

    (D)

    : No. 4 cylinder

    A

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4117ZZ

    D
    Measuring position

    No. 1 CYL.

    No. 1 cylinder at compression TDC

    c.

    EXH

    ×

    INT

    ×

    No. 2 CYL.

    No. 3 CYL.

    No. 4 CYL.

    E

    ×
    ×

    Set No. 4 cylinder at TDC of its compression stroke.
    • Rotate crankshaft pulley (2) one revolution (360 degrees) and
    align TDC mark (no paint) (A) to timing indicator (1) on front
    cover.
    (B)

    F

    G

    : White paint mark (Not use for service)

    H

    I
    PBIC3673E

    • Measure the valve clearances at locations marked “×” [locations indicated with ( )] as shown using suitable tool.
    (A)

    : No. 1 cylinder

    (B)

    : No. 2 cylinder

    (C)

    : No. 3 cylinder

    (D)

    : No. 4 cylinder

    J

    K

    L

    JPBIA4118ZZ

    Measuring position
    No. 4 cylinder at compression TDC

    No. 1 CYL.

    No. 2 CYL.

    No. 3 CYL.

    ×

    EXH

    ×
    ×

    INT

    No. 4 CYL.

    M

    N

    ×

    O

    3.

    If out of the specifications, adjust as necessary. Refer to “ADJUSTMENT”.

    ADJUSTMENT

    P

    NOTE:
    Proper valve clearance is obtained by selecting the correct valve lifter head thickness.
    1. Remove camshaft. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    2. Remove valve lifters from the locations that are out of the standard.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-11

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT VALVE CLEARANCE
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    3. Measure the center thickness of the removed valve lifters using
    a suitable tool (A).

    [HR16DE]

    PBIC3195J

    4.

    Use the equation below to calculate valve lifter thickness for replacement.
    Valve lifter thickness calculation:
    t = t1 + (C1 – C2)
    t
    = Valve lifter thickness to be replaced
    = Removed valve lifter thickness
    t1
    C1 = Measured valve clearance
    C2 = Standard valve clearance at 20°C (68°F):
    Intake
    : 0.30 mm (0.012 in)
    Exhaust
    : 0.33 mm (0.013 in)
    • Crown surface thickness of new valve lifter (B) can be identified by stamp mark (A) on the under side of the lifter.
    NOTE:
    Available thickness of valve lifter: 26 sizes range 3.00 to 3.50
    mm (0.1181 to 0.1378 in) in increments of 0.02 mm (0.0008 in)
    when manufactured at factory. Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».
    • Stamp mark “302” indicates 3.02 mm (0.1189 in) in thickness.

    PBIC3196J

    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.
    10.
    11.

    Install the correct thickness valve lifter.
    Install camshaft. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Install timing chain. Refer to EM-51, «Exploded View».
    Manually rotate crankshaft pulley a few rotations.
    Check that valve clearances are within specification. Refer to “INSPECTION”.
    Installation of remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.
    Warm up the engine, and check for unusual noise and vibration.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-12

    2014 Note

    COMPRESSION PRESSURE
    [HR16DE]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    COMPRESSION PRESSURE

    A

    Inspection
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    INFOID:0000000009444834

    Warm up engine to full operating temperature and then turn it off.
    Release fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    Remove ignition coil and spark plug from each cylinder. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».
    Connect engine tachometer (not required in use of CONSULT).
    Install compression gauge (B) with an adapter (A) into spark
    plug hole.

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F
    JPBIA4119ZZ

    G

    • Use an adapter with a diameter (a) smaller than 20 mm (0.79
    in). Otherwise, it may be caught by cylinder head during
    removal.
    (a)

    H

    : Less than 20 mm (0.79 in)

    I

    J
    JPBIA0171ZZ

    6.

    With accelerator pedal fully depressed, turn ignition switch to »»» for cranking. When the gauge pointer
    stabilizes, read the compression pressure and the engine rpm. Perform these steps to check each cylinder.
    Compression pressure

    7.
    8.
    9.

    : Refer to EM-115, «General Specification».

    L

    CAUTION:
    Always use a fully charged battery to obtain the specified engine speed.
    • If the engine speed is out of the specified range, check the battery. Check the engine speed again with a
    fully charged battery.
    • If some cylinders have low compression pressure, pour a small amount of engine oil into the spark plug
    hole to recheck the compression.
    — If the added engine oil improves the compression, the piston rings may be worn or damaged. Check the
    piston rings and replace if necessary.
    — If the compression pressure remains low despite the addition of engine oil, the valves may be malfunctioning. Check the valves for damage. Replace the valve or valve seat as necessary.
    • If two adjacent cylinders have respectively low compression pressure and their compression remains
    low even after the addition of engine oil the head gasket may be leaking, or valves in adjacent cylinders
    may be damaged. Inspect and repair as required.
    • If the compression pressure is below the minimum value, check the valve clearances and parts associated with the combustion chamber (valve, valve seat, piston, piston ring, cylinder bore, cylinder head,
    cylinder head gasket). After repairing, measure the compression pressure again.
    After inspection is completed, install removed parts.
    Start the engine, and ensure that the engine runs smoothly.
    Perform trouble diagnosis. If DTC appears, erase it. Refer to EC-107, «Work Flow».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-13

    K

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    NVH troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009444835

    JPBIA4739GB

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Locate the area where noise occurs.
    Confirm the type of noise.
    Specify the operating condition of engine.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-14

    2014 Note

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    [HR16DE]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    4. Check specified noise source.
    If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    A

    Operating condition of engine
    Location
    of noise

    Type of
    noise

    Top of engine rocker cover
    cylinder
    head

    Front of
    engine
    front cover

    Front of
    engine

    Reference page

    EM

    After
    warmup

    When
    starting

    When
    idling

    When
    racing

    While
    driving

    Ticking or
    clicking

    C

    A

    A

    B

    Tappet
    noise

    Valve clearance

    EM-10

    C

    Rattle

    C

    A

    A

    B

    C

    Camshaft
    bearing
    noise

    Camshaft journal oil
    clearance
    Camshaft runout

    EM-116

    D

    Piston pin
    noise

    Piston to piston pin oil
    clearance
    Connecting rod bushing
    oil clearance

    EM-120

    E

    Piston
    slap noise

    Piston to cylinder bore
    clearance
    Piston ring side clearance
    Piston ring end gap
    Connecting rod bend
    and torsion

    EM-120

    Connecting rod bushing
    oil clearance
    Connecting rod bearing
    oil clearance

    EM-120
    EM-124

    H

    I

    Slap or
    knock

    Crankshaft pulley
    cylinder
    block (side
    of engine)
    oil pan

    Source of
    noise

    Before
    warmup

    Slap or
    rap

    A

    A

    B

    B

    B

    B

    A

    Check item

    F

    G

    Knock

    A

    B

    C

    B

    B

    B

    Connecting rod
    bearing
    noise

    Knock

    A

    B

    A

    B

    C

    Main bearing noise

    Main bearing oil clearance
    Crankshaft runout

    EM-123
    EM-120

    B

    Timing
    chain and
    chain tensioner
    noise

    Timing chain cracks
    and wear
    Timing chain tensioner
    operation

    EM-51
    EM-51

    C

    Drive belt
    (Sticking
    or slipping)

    Drive belt deflection

    Tapping or
    ticking

    A

    A

    B

    B

    K

    Squeaking or fizzing

    A

    Creaking

    A

    B

    A

    B

    A

    B

    Drive belt
    (Slipping)

    Idler pulley bearing operation

    Squall
    Creak

    A

    B

    B

    A

    B

    Water
    pump
    noise

    Water pump operation

    A: Closely related B: Related

    B

    C: Sometimes related

    B

    J

    EM-115

    L

    M
    CO-19

    N

    —: Not related

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-15

    2014 Note

    DRIVE BELT
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    DRIVE BELT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444836

    ALBIA1157ZZ

    1.

    Generator

    2.

    Water pump

    3.

    Crankshaft pulley

    4.

    A/C compressor (with A/C models)
    Idler pulley (without A/C models)

    5.

    Tensioner idler pulley

    6.

    Drive belt

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444837

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove engine undercover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove wheel and tire (RH) using a power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Partially remove the fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Loosen the lock nut and then release the belt tension by turning the adjusting bolt.
    Remove the drive belt.

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Pull the idler pulley in the loosening direction, and then temporarily tighten the lock nut to the following
    torque.
    Lock nut
    (Temporary tightening)

    2.

    3.

    : 4.4 N·m (0.45 kg-m, 39 in-lb)

    NOTE:
    Do not move the lock nut from the temporary tightened position. Go to step 2.
    Install the drive belt on each pulley.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that there is no engine oil, grease, or engine coolant, etc. in pulley grooves.
    • Check that the belt seats securely inside the groove on each pulley.
    Adjust drive belt tension by turning the adjusting bolt. Refer to EM-17, «Adjustment».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform the belt tension adjustment with the lock nut temporarily tightened to the torque specification listed in step 1 which prevents the idler pulley from tilting.
    • When checking immediately after installation, first adjust it to the specified value. Then, after
    turning crankshaft two turns or more, readjust to the specified value to avoid variation in deflection between pulleys.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-16

    2014 Note

    DRIVE BELT
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    4. Tighten the lock nut to final tightening specification.

    A

    Lock nut (Final tightening)
    5.

    : 34.8 N·m (3.5 kg-m, 26 ft-lb)

    Check that belt tension is within the specification using suitable tool. Refer to EM-115, «Drive Belt».

    Inspection

    EM

    INFOID:0000000009444838

    • Inspection should be done only when engine is cold or over 30
    minutes after the engine is stopped.
    (1)

    : Generator

    (2)

    : Water pump

    C

    D

    (3)

    : Crankshaft pulley

    (4)

    : A/C compressor (with A/C models)
    Idler pulley (without A/C models)

    (5)

    : Idler pulley

    (6)

    : Drive belt

    E

    PBIC3642E

    • Visually check belt for wear, damage, and cracks on inside and
    edges.
    • Turn crankshaft pulley clockwise twice, and check that the tension on all pulleys equalizes before testing.
    • When measuring deflection, apply 98.1 N (10 kg, 22 lb) at the ( ) marked point.
    • Measure the belt tension and frequency using suitable tool at the ( ) marked point.
    CAUTION:
    • When checking immediately after installation, first adjust it to the specified value. Then, after turning
    crankshaft two turns or more, readjust to the specified value to avoid variation in deflection between
    pulleys.
    Belt deflection/belt tension and frequency

    INFOID:0000000009444839

    Location

    Location of adjuster and tightening method

    Drive belt

    Adjusting bolt on idler pulley

    CAUTION:
    • When belt is replaced with new one, adjust belt tension to the value for “New belt,” because new belt
    will not fully seat in the pulley groove.
    • When tension of the belt being used exceeds “Limit,” adjust it to the value for “After adjusted.”
    • When installing a belt, check it is correctly engaged with the pulley groove.
    • Do not allow engine oil or engine coolant to get on the belt.
    • Do not twist or bend the belt strongly.
    1. Partially remove the fender protector (RH) front side clip. Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Loosen lock nut (A) and temporarily set to the following torque.
    Lock nut (A)
    (Temporary tightening)

    : 4.4 N·m (0.45 kg-m, 39 in-lb)

    (1)

    : Generator

    (2)

    : Water pump

    (3)

    : Crankshaft pulley

    (4)

    : A/C compressor (with A/C models)
    Idler pulley (without A/C models)

    (5)

    : Idler pulley

    (6)

    : Drive belt

    (B)

    : Adjusting bolt

    Revision: April 2013

    G

    H

    I

    : Refer to EM-115, «Drive Belt».

    Adjustment

    F

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    PBIC3643E

    EM-17

    2014 Note

    DRIVE BELT
    [HR16DE]
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    3. Adjust the belt tension by turning the adjusting bolt. Refer to EM-115, «Drive Belt».
    CAUTION:
    • When checking immediately after installation, first adjust it to the specified value. Then, after
    turning crankshaft two turns or more, readjust to the specified value to avoid variation in deflection between pulleys.
    • When the tension adjustment is performed, the lock nut should be in the condition at Step 2. If
    the tension adjustment is performed when the lock nut is loosened more than the temporary
    tightening, the idler pulley tilts and the correct tension adjustment cannot be performed.
    4. Tighten the lock nut to final tightening specification.
    Lock nut (Final tightening)

    Revision: April 2013

    : 34.8 N·m (3.5 kg-m, 26 ft-lb)

    EM-18

    2014 Note

    AIR CLEANER FILTER
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    AIR CLEANER FILTER

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444840

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWBIA1598ZZ

    1.

    Air cleaner cover

    2.

    Mass air flow sensor

    3.

    Clamp

    4.

    Air duct

    5.

    Clamp

    6.

    Hose

    7.

    Clamp

    8.

    Grommet

    9.

    Grommet insert

    10. Grommet

    11. Grommet insert

    12. Air duct inlet

    13. Air cleaner body

    14. Air cleaner filter

    A.

    B.

    J

    K

    To electric throttle control actuator

    To rocker cover

    L

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444841

    REMOVAL
    1.

    M

    Unhook clips (A) and pull the air cleaner cover (1) upward.

    N

    O

    P
    JSBIA1092ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-19

    2014 Note

    AIR CLEANER FILTER
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    2. Remove the air cleaner filter (1) from the air cleaner body.

    [HR16DE]

    JSBIA1093ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    Check that the air cleaner filter is securely placed in the air cleaner body.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-20

    2014 Note

    SPARK PLUG
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    SPARK PLUG

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444842

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWBIA1599ZZ

    1.

    Ignition coil

    2.

    Spark plug

    3.

    Rocker cover

    H

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444843

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove ignition coil. Refer to EM-48, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock ignition coil.
    Remove spark plug using a suitable tool.
    Diameter (a)

    J

    K

    : 14 mm (0.55 in)

    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock spark plug.

    L

    M

    JPBIA0030ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL

    N

    • If the spark plug tip is covered with carbon, a spark plug cleaner may be used.
    Cleaner air pressure
    Cleaning time

    O

    : Less than 588 kPa (6 kg/cm2, 85 psi)
    : Less than 20 seconds

    P

    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-21

    2014 Note

    SPARK PLUG
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Do not use a wire brush for cleaning.

    SMA773C

    • Checking and adjusting spark plug gap is not required between
    change intervals. Do not adjust the gap; replace the spark plug as
    necessary if out of specification.

    SMA806CA

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock the spark plug.
    Make

    NGK

    Standard type*

    PLZKAR6A-11

    Gap (nominal)

    1.1 mm (0.043 in)

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    CAUTION:
    Always tighten the spark plug to specified torque to align the orientation of electrodes. The ground
    electrode of a genuine spark plug is positioned in the area of maximum ignitability by tightening to the
    specified torque. When replacing spark plugs, use genuine spark plugs of which the ground electrode
    is adjusted.
    NOTE:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-22

    2014 Note

    SPARK PLUG
    [HR16DE]
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    The ground electrode of the spark plug is positioned in the area of maximum ignitability to improve combustion
    eficiency in the cylinder, reduce CO2 (carbon dioxide) emission and improve fuel economy.

    A

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F
    JPBIA5996GB

    1.

    Ground electrode of spark plug

    C.

    Poor ignitability region

    A.

    Top view

    B.

    Air-fuel mixture flow

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-23

    2014 Note

    DRIVE BELT IDLER PULLEY
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    DRIVE BELT IDLER PULLEY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444844

    AWBIA1618ZZ

    1.

    Generator bracket

    2.

    Plate

    3.

    Tensioner idler pulley

    4.

    Washer

    5.

    Spacer

    6.

    Center shaft

    7.

    Adjusting bolt

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444845

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove the fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the air duct inlet assembly. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove drive belt. Refer to EM-16, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the lock nut, and then remove the plate, tensioner idler pulley, and washer.
    Remove the center shaft together with the spacer and the adjusting bolt.

    INSTALLATION

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-24

    2014 Note

    DRIVE BELT IDLER PULLEY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Insert the center shaft (1) into the slide groove of the spacer (2).
    Fully screw in the adjusting bolt (3) in the belt loosening direction ( ).
    • At that time, place the flange (a) of the adjusting bolt and the
    seat (b) of the center shaft on the spacer.
    2. Place each surface (c/d) of the spacer on the generator bracket.
    Install the washer, tensioner idler pulley, and plate, and then
    temporarily tighten the lock nut.
    Lock nut
    (Temporary tightening)

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C

    : 4.4 N·m (0.45 kg-m, 39 in-lb)
    D

    E

    F

    G
    PBIC3885E

    3.

    Installation of remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.
    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-25

    2014 Note

    AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444846

    AWBIA1598ZZ

    1.

    Air cleaner cover

    2.

    Mass air flow sensor

    3.

    Clamp

    4.

    Air duct

    5.

    Clamp

    6.

    Hose

    7.

    Clamp

    8.

    Grommet

    9.

    Grommet insert

    10. Grommet

    11. Grommet insert

    12. Air duct inlet

    13. Air cleaner body

    A.

    B.

    To electric throttle control actuator

    Removal and Installation

    To rocker cover
    INFOID:0000000009444847

    REMOVAL
    NOTE:
    Mass air flow sensor is removable as an assembly with the air cleaner cover.
    1. Remove air duct (inlet) from the air cleaner body.
    2. Disconnect PCV hose from the air duct.
    3. Remove the air duct (between air cleaner case and electric throttle control actuator).
    • Add matching marks if necessary for easier installation.
    4. Remove air cleaner assembly with the following steps:
    a. Disconnect the mass air flow sensor harness connector.
    b. Remove the air cleaner body bolts.
    c. Pull up on the air cleaner assembly to disengage it from the grommet and remove the air cleaner assembly.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not shock the mass air flow sensor.
    • Do not disassemble the mass air flow sensor.
    • Do not touch the sensor of the mass air flow sensor.

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Inspect air duct (inlet) and air duct for cracks, tears, or breaks.
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-26

    2014 Note

    AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Replace air duct (inlet) and air duct if any problems are found.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    Align marks, attach each joint and screw clamps firmly.

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-27

    2014 Note

    INTAKE MANIFOLD
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    INTAKE MANIFOLD
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444848

    AWBIA1612ZZ

    1.

    EVAP canister purge volume control
    solenoid valve

    2.

    Hose clamp

    3.

    Vacuum hose

    4.

    PCV hose

    5.

    Hose clamp

    6.

    Intake manifold gasket

    7.

    Intake manifold

    8.

    Electric throttle control actuator

    9.

    Electric throttle control actuator
    gasket

    C.

    A.

    To air duct

    B.

    To centralized under-floor piping

    D.

    To booster

    E.

    To PCV valve in rocker cover

    Removal and Installation

    To air duct
    Engine front
    INFOID:0000000009444849

    REMOVAL
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    1. Remove air duct (inlet), air duct and air cleaner. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Disconnect water hoses from the electric throttle actuator (if necessary).
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when the engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on the drive belt.
    3. Remove electric throttle control actuator and position aside.
    CAUTION:
    • Handle carefully to avoid any shock to electric throttle control actuator.
    • Do not disassemble electric throttle control actuator.
    4. Disconnect EVAP purge control solenoid valve harness connector and vacuum hose from EVAP purge
    control solenoid valve.
    CAUTION:
    Handle EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve carefully and avoid impacts.
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-28

    2014 Note

    INTAKE MANIFOLD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    5. Disconnect vacuum hose for brake booster from intake manifold.
    6. Remove intake manifold bolts (A) at the rocker cover.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C

    AWBIA1620ZZ

    7.

    Loosen bolts in reverse order as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Cover engine openings to avoid entry of foreign materials.

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWBIA1576ZZ

    8.
    9.

    H

    Remove intake manifold and intake manifold gasket.
    Remove EVAP purge control solenoid valve from intake manifold (if necessary).
    CAUTION:
    Handle EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve carefully and avoid impacts.

    I

    INSTALLATION

    J

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Intake Manifold

    1.

    Install the new intake manifold gasket to the intake manifold.
    • Align the protrusions used for checking gasket installation condition with the clearance grooves (A) of the intake manifold
    groove.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the intake manifold gasket.
    NOTE:
    New gasket for electric throttle control actuator can be installed
    when the electric throttle control actuator is installed.

    K

    L

    M

    N
    JSBIA1220ZZ

    2.

    Place the intake manifold into position.
    CAUTION:
    Check that the oil level gauge guide is not detached from the securing clip of the water inlet due to
    interference of intake manifold.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-29

    2014 Note

    INTAKE MANIFOLD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Tighten the bolts to specification in the numerical order as
    shown.

    [HR16DE]

    AWBIA1576ZZ

    4.

    Tighten the intake manifold bolts (A) to specification at the
    rocker cover.
    Intake manifold bolts (A)

    25.0 N·m (2.6 kg-m, 18 in-lb)

    AWBIA1620ZZ

    Electric Throttle Control Actuator
    1. Install electric throttle control actuator gasket to intake manifold.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse electric throttle control actuator gasket.
    2. Tighten bolts of electric throttle control actuator equally and diagonally in several steps.
    NOTE:
    After installation, it is necessary to re-calibrate the electric throttle control actuator as follows:
    • Perform “Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning” after repair when removing harness connector of the electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EC-114, «Work Procedure».
    • Perform “Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning” and “Idle Air Volume Learning” after repair when replacing
    electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EC-115, «Work Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-30

    2014 Note

    EXHAUST MANIFOLD
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    EXHAUST MANIFOLD

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444850

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    AWBIA1603ZZ

    1.

    Exhaust manifold cover (upper)

    2.

    Harness bracket

    3.

    Air-fuel ratio sensor 1

    4.

    Exhaust manifold stay

    5.

    Heat insulator

    6.

    Exhaust manifold

    7.

    Exhaust manifold cover (lower)

    8.

    Exhaust maifold gasket

    Engine front

    N

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444851

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    O

    Remove air duct (inlet), air duct and air cleaner assembly. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Remove exhaust front tube. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».
    Remove harness bracket from the cylinder head on the right rear side.
    Remove exhaust manifold upper and lower covers.
    Disconnect air fuel ratio sensor 1 harness connector.
    Remove exhaust manifold side bolt of exhaust manifold stay.

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    EM-31

    P

    2014 Note

    EXHAUST MANIFOLD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    7. Use Tool (A) to remove the air-fuel ratio sensor 1 with exhaust
    manifold installed on vehicle (if necessary).
    Tool number

    : KV10117100 ( — )

    CAUTION:
    • Handle air-fuel ratio sensor 1 carefully and avoid impacts.
    • Before installing a new air-fuel ratio sensor 1, clean the
    exhaust tube threads using suitable tool and approved
    anti-seize lubricant.
    • If air-fuel ratio sensor is dropped onto a hard surface,
    such as a concrete floor, from a height of 0.5 m or more,
    discard the sensor and use a new one.
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner
    8.

    [HR16DE]

    :
    :


    JPBIA4126ZZ

    (J-43897-12)
    (J-43897-18)

    Remove exhaust manifold.
    • Loosen nuts in reverse order as shown.

    JPBIA4127ZZ

    9. Remove exhaust manifold gasket.
    10. Remove stud bolt using suitable tool from cylinder head (if necessary).

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Mounting Surface Distortion
    • Using suitable tools (A) and (B), check the surface distortion of the
    exhaust manifold mating surface as shown.

    Limit

    : Refer to EM-116, «Exhaust Manifold».

    • Replace exhaust manifold if it exceeds the limit.

    PBIC3530J

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal. Note the following:
    Exhaust manifold

    1.

    Install new exhaust manifold gasket.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-32

    2014 Note

    EXHAUST MANIFOLD
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Do not reuse exhaust manifold gasket.

    A

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4127ZZ

    2.

    D

    Tighten nuts in numerical order as shown.

    E

    F

    G
    JPBIA4127ZZ

    3.

    Tighten nuts in numerical order to the specified torque again.

    H

    Air-fuel ratio sensor 1
    • Use Tool (A) to install the air-fuel ratio sensor 1 (if removed).

    Tool number

    I

    : KV10117100 ( — )

    CAUTION:
    • Handle it carefully and avoid impacts.
    • Before installing a new air-fuel ratio sensor 1, clean the
    exhaust tube threads using suitable tool and approved antiseize lubricant.
    • Do not over-tighten the air-fuel ratio sensor 1. Doing so may
    damage the air-fuel ratio sensor 1, resulting in the MIL coming on.
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner

    :
    :


    J

    K

    JPBIA4126ZZ

    (J-43897-12)
    (J-43897-18)

    L

    M

    Installation of remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    N

    Inspection
    • Start engine and raise engine speed to check for exhaust leaks.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-33

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009670757

    AWBIA1595ZZ

    1.

    Rear oil seal

    2.

    O-ring

    3.

    Oil pan (upper)

    4.

    Oil pump chain tensioner (for oil
    pump drive chain)

    5.

    Oil pump drive chain

    6.

    Crankshaft key

    7.

    Crankshaft sprocket

    8.

    Oil pump sprocket

    9.

    Oil pump

    10. O-ring

    11. O-ring

    13. Drain plug washer

    14. Oil pan (lower)

    15. Oil filter

    16. Connector bolt

    17. Oil cooler

    18. O-ring

    19. Relief valve

    A.

    B.

    C.

    12. Oil pan drain plug

    Refer to EM-37, «Removal and Installation (Upper Oil Pan)»

    Refer to LU-10, «Removal and Installation»

    Oil pan (lower) side

    Removal and Installation (Lower Oil Pan)

    INFOID:0000000009670758

    REMOVAL
    WARNING:
    • Be careful not to get burned, engine coolant and engine oil may be hot.
    • Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer; avoid direct skin contact with used oil. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as
    possible.
    1.

    Drain engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Draining».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-34

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Loosen bolts in reverse order as shown.

    A
    : Engine front

    EM

    C
    JSBIA1126ZZ

    3.

    Tool number

    4.
    5.

    D

    Insert Tool (A) between oil pan (upper) and oil pan (lower).
    : KV10111100 (J-37228)

    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage mating surfaces.
    • Do not insert a screwdriver. This damages the mating surfaces.
    Slide the Tool (A) by tapping on the side of tool with a suitable
    tool to loosen the oil pan (lower).
    Remove oil pan (lower).

    E

    F

    G
    JPBIA0276ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Clean debris from oil pan (lower) and from the strainer.

    H

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings or washers.
    1. Remove old liquid gasket from mating surfaces using suitable
    tool (A).
    • Also remove old liquid gasket from mating surface of oil pan
    (upper).
    • Remove old liquid gasket from the bolt holes and threads.
    CAUTION:
    Do not scratch or damage the mating surface when cleaning off old liquid gasket.

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSBIA1127ZZ

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-35

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Apply a continuous bead of liquid gasket (A) with a tube presser
    as shown.
    (1)

    : Oil pan (lower)

    (a)

    : 7.5 — 9.5 mm (0.295 — 0.374 in)

    (b)

    : 4.0 — 5.0 mm (0.157 — 0.197 in) diameter

    [HR16DE]

    : Engine outside

    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant or equivalent. Refer
    toGI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants»
    CAUTION:
    • Installation should be done within 5 minutes after applying liquid gasket.
    • Do not fill the engine with oil for at least 30 minutes after
    the components are installed to allow the sealant to cure.

    JSBIA1128ZZ

    3.

    Tighten bolts in numerical order as shown.
    : Engine front

    JSBIA1126ZZ

    4.

    5.

    Install oil pan drain plug.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse drain plug washer.
    • Refer to exploded view installation direction of drain plug washer. Refer to EM-34.
    Refill the engine with engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Refilling».

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leakage.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leakage at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leakage at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leakage of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-36

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Summary of the inspection items:

    A
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leakage

    Level/Leakage

    Leakage

    M/T Models

    Level/Leakage

    Leakage

    Level/Leakage

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid
    Other oils and fluids*
    Fuel
    Exhaust gas

    EM

    C

    D

    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Removal and Installation (Upper Oil Pan)

    INFOID:0000000009671305

    NOTE:
    The oil strainer is included in the oil pan (upper) and cannot be removed.

    F

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    a.

    E

    Remove the oil pan (lower). Refer to EM-34, «Removal and Installation (Lower Oil Pan)».
    Remove oil pump sprocket and crankshaft sprocket together with oil pump drive chain. Refer to EM-37,
    «Removal and Installation (Upper Oil Pan)».
    Remove oil pan (upper).
    Loosen oil pan (upper) bolts in the reverse of the order as
    shown.
    : Engine front

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JPBIA4199ZZ

    b.

    Insert a suitable tool into the position ( ) as shown and open up
    a crack between the oil pan (upper) cylinder block.

    K

    L

    : Engine front

    c.

    Tool number

    4.

    M

    Insert the Tool between the oil pan (upper) and cylinder block.
    Slide Tool by tapping on the side of Tool with a hammer.

    N

    : KV10111100 (J-37228)

    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage the mating surface.
    • The liquid gasket used at the factory is very strong. Pry only in the areas shown.
    • Do not remove oil pump and oil strainer from oil pan (upper).
    Remove rear oil seal from crankshaft.

    JPBIA4200ZZ

    O

    P

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings or washers.
    1. Install the oil pan (upper):
    a. Remove old liquid gasket from mating surfaces using a suitable tool.
    • Remove old liquid gasket from mating surface of cylinder block.
    • Remove old liquid gasket from the bolt holes and threads.
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-37

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    CAUTION:
    Do not scratch or damage the mating surfaces when cleaning off liquid gasket.
    b. Install O-ring to the cylinder block.
    c. Apply a continuous bead of liquid gasket to areas as shown
    using a suitable tool.
    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant or equivalent. Refer to
    GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».
    (1)

    : Cylinder block

    (2)

    : Oil pan (upper)

    [HR16DE]

    (A) : 2 mm (0.07 in) protruded to outside
    (B) : 2 mm (0.07 in) protruded to rear oil seal mounting side
    (d)

    : 5.5 — 7.5 mm (0.217 — 0.295 in)

    (e)

    : 4.0 — 5.0 mm (0.157 — 0.197 in) diameter
    : Engine front

    CAUTION:
    • Attaching should be done within 5 minutes after coating.
    • Allow 30 minutes for the liquid gasket to set before adding oil to the engine.

    JSBIA1301ZZ

    d.

    Tighten bolts in the numerical order as shown.
    : Engine front

    CAUTION:
    Install avoiding misalignment of both oil pan gasket and Oring.
    • The bolts are different according to the installation position.
    Refer to the numbers as shown.
    M8×180 mm
    (7.09 in) bolts
    M8×25 mm
    (0.98 in) bolts
    M8×90 mm
    (3.54 in) bolts
    2.

    a.
    b.

    : No. 9, 10
    : No. 4, 7, 8
    : No. 1, 2, 3, 5, 6

    25.0 N·m (2.6 kg-m,
    18 ft-lb)
    25.0 N·m (2.6 kg-m,
    18 ft-lb)
    25.0 N·m (2.6 kg-m,
    18 ft-lb)

    JPBIA4199ZZ

    Install rear oil seal:
    CAUTION:
    • Installation of rear oil seal should be completed within 5 minutes after installing oil pan (upper).
    • Do not reuse rear oil seal.
    • Do not touch oil seal lip.
    Wipe off any liquid gasket protruding to the rear oil seal mounting part of oil pan (upper) and cylinder block
    using a suitable tool.
    Apply the liquid gasket lightly to entire outside area of new rear oil seal.
    Use Genuine Liquid Gasket or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and
    Sealants».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-38

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    c. Press-fit the rear oil seal using a suitable drift (A) with outer
    diameter 113 mm (4.45 in) and inner diameter 90 mm (3.54 in).

    A

    EM

    C
    PBIC3660E

    D

    • Press-fit to the specified dimensions as shown.
    (1)

    E

    : Rear oil seal

    (A) : Rear end surface of cylinder block

    d.
    3.

    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the grease applied to the oil seal lip.
    • Be careful not to damage the rear oil seal mounting part
    of oil pan (upper) and cylinder block or the crankshaft.
    • Press-fit straight and check that oil seal does not curl or
    tilt.
    After press-fitting the rear oil seal, completely wipe off any liquid
    gasket protruding to rear end surface side.
    Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    F

    G
    PBIC3149J

    H

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leakage.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leakage at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leakage at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leakage of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    A/T and CVT Models

    Leakage

    Level/Leakage

    Leakage

    M/T Models

    Level/Leakage

    Leakage

    Level/Leakage

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid
    Other oils and fluids*
    Fuel
    Exhaust gas

    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-39

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444854

    AWBIA1579ZZ

    1.

    Stud bolt

    2.

    O-ring (green)

    3.

    Fuel injector (front)

    4.

    Clip

    5.

    Fuel injector (rear)

    6.

    O-ring (black)

    7.

    Fuel tube protector

    8.

    Fuel tube

    9.

    Clamp

    10. Quick connector cap (engine side)

    11. Fuel feed hose

    12. Quick connector cap (floor piping-side)

    13. Fuel connector protector

    14. Fuel pipe

    A.

    To centralized under-floor piping

    Front

    CAUTION:
    Do not remove or disassemble parts unless instructed.

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444855

    WARNING:
    • Put a “CAUTION: FLAMMABLE” sign in the workshop.
    • Be sure to work in a well-ventilated area and furnish workshop with a CO2 fire extinguisher.
    • Do not smoke while servicing fuel system. Keep open flames and sparks away from the work area.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Release the fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    Remove intake manifold. Refer to EM-28, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-40

    2014 Note

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Disconnect fuel feed hose from fuel tube. Disconnect quick connector:
    (1)

    [HR16DE]
    A

    : Quick connector cap (engine side)

    NOTE:
    There is no fuel return path.

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4130ZZ

    D

    a.
    b.

    Remove quick connector cap (engine side) (1) from quick connector connection.
    Disconnect fuel feed hose from hose clamp.

    E

    F

    G
    JPBIA4131ZZ

    c.
    d.

    e.

    With the sleeve (B) side of quick connector release (A) facing
    quick connector (2), install quick connector release (A) onto fuel
    tube (1) as shown.
    Insert quick connector release (A) into quick connector (2) until
    sleeve (B) contacts and goes no further. Hold quick connector
    release (A) in that position (D).
    CAUTION:
    Inserting quick connector release hard will not disconnect
    quick connector. Hold quick connector release where it
    contacts and goes no further.
    JPBIA2255ZZ
    Draw and pull out quick connector (E) straight up from fuel tube
    (1).
    CAUTION:
    • Pull quick connector up (E) from holding position (C) as shown.
    • Do not pull with lateral force applied. O-ring inside quick connector may be damaged.
    • Prepare container and cloth beforehand as fuel will leak out.
    • Discard O-ring, do not reuse.
    • Avoid fire and sparks.
    • Keep parts away from heat source. Be especially careful when welding is performed.
    • Do not expose parts to battery electrolyte or other acids.
    • Do not bend or twist connection between quick connector and fuel feed tube during installation
    or removal.
    • Be sure to cover openings of disconnected fuel feed hose
    (A) and fuel tube (C) with plug or plastic bag (B) to avoid
    fuel leaks and entry of foreign material.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JSBIA1295ZZ

    4.

    Disconnect fuel feed hose from fuel pipe as follows:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-41

    2014 Note

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    NOTE:
    There is no fuel return path.
    a. Remove quick connector cap (floor piping side) (1) from quick
    connector connection.

    [HR16DE]

    JSBIA1291ZZ

    b.

    Disconnect fuel feed hose from hose clamp (1).

    JSBIA1292ZZ

    c.

    Hold the quick connector (1) while pushing in tabs (F), and pull
    out the hard tube (A).
    (2)

    : Retainer

    (B)

    : Connection (cross-section)

    (C)

    : Resin tube

    (D)

    : To under floor fuel line

    (E)

    : To fuel tank

    (G)

    : Disconnection

    CAUTION:
    • Inserting quick connector release hard will not disconnect
    quick connector. Hold quick connector release where it
    contacts and goes no further.
    • The tube can be removed when the tabs are completely
    depressed. Do not twist it more than necessary.
    • Do not use any tools to remove the quick connector.
    • Keep the resin tube away from heat. Be especially careful
    when welding near the tube.
    • Prevent acid such as battery electrolyte etc. from getting
    on the resin tube.
    • Do not bend or twist the tube during installation and
    removal.
    • Remove the remaining retainer only when the tube is
    replaced.
    • When the tube is replaced, also replace the retainer.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-42

    JPBIA0130ZZ

    2014 Note

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Be sure to cover openings of disconnected pipes with
    plug or plastic bag (B) to avoid fuel leaks and entry of foreign material.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    (A) :Fuel feed hose

    EM

    (C) :Fuel tube

    C
    JSBIA1295ZZ

    5.
    6.
    7.

    D

    Disconnect harness connectors from fuel injectors.
    Disconnect harness connectors from intake and exhaust valve timing control solenoid valves.
    Remove fuel tube protector.
    • Loosen bolts in reverse order as shown.

    E

    : Engine front

    F

    G

    H
    JPBIA4132ZZ

    8.

    Remove fuel injector and fuel tube assembly:

    I

    : Engine front

    Loosen two nuts in reverse order as shown.
    Pull the fuel tube straight out until injector lower O-rings are
    clear.
    c. Remove the nuts and the fuel tube.
    CAUTION:
    • When removing, be careful to avoid interference with fuel
    injectors.
    • Use a shop cloth to absorb any fuel leaks from fuel tube.

    J

    a.
    b.

    9.
    a.
    b.

    K

    JPBIA4133ZZ

    M

    Remove fuel injector from fuel tube:
    Open and remove clip (1).
    Remove fuel injectors (3) and (4) from fuel tube (2) by pulling straight out.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful with remaining fuel that may leak from fuel tube.
    • Be careful not to damage fuel injector nozzle during removal.
    • Do not bump or drop fuel injector.
    • Do not disassemble fuel injector.
    • Do not reuse O-rings.

    N

    O

    P

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings.
    1. Install O-rings on the fuel injector.
    CAUTION:
    • Upper and lower O-rings are different. Be careful not to interchange them.

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    EM-43

    2014 Note

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Fuel tube side
    Nozzle side

    : Black
    : Green







    2.
    a.

    b.

    c.

    Handle O-ring with bare hands. Do not wear gloves.
    Lubricate O-ring with new engine oil.
    Do not clean O-ring with solvent.
    Check that O-ring and its mating part are free of foreign material.
    When installing O-ring, be careful not to scratch it.
    Do not twist or stretch O-ring. If O-ring was stretched while it was being attached, allow it to
    retract before inserting it into fuel tube.
    • Insert O-ring straight into fuel tube. Do not angle or twist it.
    Install fuel injector (4) to fuel tube (1):
    Insert new clip (2) into clip groove (G) on fuel injector (4).
    • Insert new clip (2) so that protrusion (F) of fuel injector
    matches cut-out (D) of clip.
    (3)

    : O-ring (black)

    (5)

    : O-ring (green)

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse clip. Replace it with a new one.
    • Be careful to keep clip from interfering with O-ring. If
    interference occurs, replace O-ring.
    Insert fuel injector (4) into fuel tube (1) with clip (2) attached.
    • Insert fuel injector (4) while matching it to the axial center.
    • Insert fuel injector (4) so that protrusion (B) of fuel tube
    matches cut-out (C) of clip (2).
    • Check that fuel tube flange (A) is securely located in flange
    groove (E) on clip (2).
    Check that installation is complete by checking that fuel injector
    (4) does not rotate or come off.

    JPBIA4530ZZ

    3.

    Set fuel tube and fuel injector assembly in position for installation on cylinder head.
    CAUTION:
    For installation, be careful not to interfere with fuel injector nozzle.
    • Tighten bolts in numerical order as shown.
    : Engine front

    JPBIA4133ZZ

    4.

    Install fuel tube protector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-44

    2014 Note

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Tighten bolts in numerical order as shown.

    A
    : Engine front

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4132ZZ

    5.
    6.
    7.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    d.
    e.

    f.
    8.
    a.
    b.

    D

    Connect harness connectors to fuel injectors.
    Connect harness connectors to intake and exhaust valve timing control solenoid valves.
    Connect fuel feed tube (engine side):
    Check for damage or foreign material on the fuel tube and quick connector.
    Apply new engine oil lightly to area around the top of fuel tube.
    Align center to insert quick connector straight into fuel tube.
    • Insert quick connector (1) to fuel tube until the top spool (C) on
    fuel tube is inserted completely and the 2nd level spool (D) is
    positioned slightly below quick connector bottom end.
    (B)

    : Upright insertion

    (E)

    : Correctly connected

    E

    F

    G

    CAUTION:
    • Hold in position (A) as shown when inserting fuel tube
    into quick connector.
    • Carefully align center to avoid inclined insertion to preJPBIA2256ZZ
    vent damage to O-ring inside quick connector.
    • Insert until you hear a “click” sound and actually feel
    the engagement.
    To avoid misidentification of engagement with a similar sound, pull quick connector hard by hand. Check it
    is completely engaged (connected) so that it does not come out from fuel tube.
    Install quick connector cap (engine side) (1) to quick connector
    connection.
    • Install quick connector cap (engine side) (1) with the side
    arrow facing quick connector side (fuel feed tube side) as
    shown.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that the quick connector and fuel tube are
    securely engaged with the quick connector cap (engine
    side) groove.
    • If the quick connector cap (engine side) cannot be
    installed easily the quick connector may not be conJPBIA4131ZZ
    nected correctly. Remove and reconnect.
    Install fuel feed hose to hose clamp.
    Connect fuel feed tube (floor piping side):
    Check the connection for damage or any foreign materials.
    Align the quick connector with the tube, then insert the connector straight into the centralized under floor
    piping until a click is heard.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-45

    2014 Note

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    c. After connecting, check that the connection is secure:
    • Visually confirm that the two retainer tabs are connected to the
    connector.
    • With the fuel feed hose not fixed to the clamp, pull quick connector (A) hard by hand to check that the quick connector (A)
    is not disconnected from the centralized underfloor piping (1)
    and that the quick connector (1) is securely connected.
    9. Install remaining parts in the reverse order of removal.

    [HR16DE]

    PBIC3795E

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check on Fuel Leaks

    1.

    2.

    Turn ignition switch “ON” (with the engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check there
    are no fuel leaks at connection points. Refer to.
    NOTE:
    Use mirrors for checking points out of clear sight.
    Start the engine. With engine speed increased, check again that there are no fuel leaks at connection
    points.
    • Perform procedures for “Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning” after finishing repairs. Refer to EC114, «Work Procedure».
    • If electric throttle control actuator is replaced, perform procedures for “Idle Air Volume Learning” after
    finishing repairs. Refer to EC-115, «Work Procedure».
    CAUTION:
    Do not touch the engine immediately after stopping, as the engine becomes extremely hot.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-46

    2014 Note

    IGNITION COIL
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    IGNITION COIL

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009671308

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWBIA1599ZZ

    1.

    Ignition coil

    2.

    Spark plug

    3.

    Rocker cover

    H

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009671309

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the battery negative terminal.
    Remove intake manifold. Refer to EM-28, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove ignition coil.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not drop or shock ignition coil.
    • Do not disassemble ignition coil.

    J

    K

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    L

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-47

    2014 Note

    ROCKER COVER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ROCKER COVER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444856

    AWBIA1474ZZ

    1.

    Exhaust camshaft position sensor

    2.

    Clip

    3.

    Rocker cover

    4.

    Clamp

    5.

    Hose

    6.

    PCV valve

    7.

    O-ring

    8.

    Rocker cover gasket

    9.

    Oil filler cap

    10.

    O-ring

    11.

    Intake camshaft position sensor

    12.

    O-ring

    A.

    To intake manifold

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444857

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove ignition coil. Refer to EM-47, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove fuel tube protector. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».
    Remove PCV hose from rocker cover.
    Remove PCV valve (if necessary).
    Remove rocker cover.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-48

    2014 Note

    ROCKER COVER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Loosen bolts in reverse order as shown.

    A
    : Engine front

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4135ZZ

    6.
    7.

    D

    Remove rocker cover gasket from rocker cover.
    Remove all traces of liquid gasket from cylinder head and front cover using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not scratch or damage the mating surface when cleaning off old liquid gasket.

    E

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-ring.
    1. Install the rocker cover:
    a. Press gasket onto the bosses for the rocker cover bolt holes as
    shown to prevent the gasket from dropping off.

    F

    G

    : Engine front

    H

    I

    JPBIA4136ZZ

    b.

    Apply liquid gasket to the cylinder head (1) and front cover (2) as
    shown.
    (a)

    J

    K

    : 2.5 — 3.5 mm diameter

    Use Genuine RTV Silicone Sealant or equivalent. Refer to
    GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».
    CAUTION:
    • The components must be installed within 5 minutes of the
    liquid gasket application.
    • Then allow 30 minutes for the liquid gasket to set before
    putting oil in the engine.

    L

    M
    JPBIA4137ZZ

    N

    c.

    Install rocker cover to cylinder head.
    CAUTION:
    Check that the gasket has not slipped out of position.
    • Tighten bolts in numerical order in at least three separate
    stages as shown.

    O

    P

    : Engine front

    JPBIA4135ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-49

    2014 Note

    ROCKER COVER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2.

    Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-50

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    TIMING CHAIN

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444858

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    AWBIA1609ZZ

    1.

    Timing chain slack guide

    2.

    Timing chain tensioner

    3.

    Camshaft sprocket (EXH)

    4.

    Camshaft sprocket (INT)

    5.

    Plug

    6.

    Front oil seal

    7.

    Crankshaft pulley

    8.

    Crankshaft pulley bolt

    9.

    Front cover

    10. Crankshaft sprocket

    11. Crankshaft sprocket key

    12. Oil pump sprocket

    13. Oil pump drive chain

    14. Oil pump drive chain tensioner

    15. Timing chain

    16. Timing chain tension guide

    A.

    M

    N

    Refer to INSTALLATION

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444859

    CAUTION:
    The rotation direction indicated in the text is as viewed from the engine front.
    NOTE:
    • When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from
    spilling.
    • When removing the camshafts, the oil pump drive chain does not need to be removed.

    REMOVAL
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-51

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    TIMING CHAIN
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Remove front wheel and tire (RH). Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Remove front fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    3. Drain engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Draining».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine oil on drive belt.
    4. Drain coolant. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    5. Remove the drive belt. Refer to EM-16, «Removal and Installation».
    6. Remove the rocker cover. Refer to EM-48, «Removal and Installation».
    7. Remove the water pump pulley. Refer to CO-19, «Removal and Installation».
    8. Support the bottom surface of engine (1) using a transmission jack (2), and then remove engine mounting
    insulator (RH). Refer to EM-85, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    • Position a suitable jack under the engine and transaxle assembly as shown.
    • Do not damage the front exhaust tube or transaxle oil pan
    with the jack.
    9. Set No. 1 cylinder at TDC of its compression stroke:

    a.

    Rotate crankshaft pulley (2) clockwise and align TDC mark
    (without paint mark) (A) to timing indicator (1) on front cover.
    (B)

    ALBIA0894GB
    PBIC3673E

    : White paint mark (Not use for service)

    PBIC3673E

    b.

    Check the matching marks on each camshaft sprocket are positioned as shown.
    (1)

    : Timing chain

    (2)

    : Camshaft sprocket (EXH)

    (3)

    : Camshaft sprocket (INT)

    (A) : Matching mark (Peripheral groove)
    (B) : Pink link
    (C) : Matching mark (Peripheral groove)

    • If not, rotate crankshaft pulley one more turn to align matching
    marks to the positions.

    JPBIA4138ZZ

    10. Remove crankshaft pulley:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-52

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    a. Secure crankshaft pulley (1) using suitable tool (A) and loosen
    crankshaft pulley bolt.
    CAUTION:
    Do not remove the crankshaft pulley bolt as it will be used
    as a supporting point for the pulley puller.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C
    PBIC3710E

    b.

    D

    Attach Tool (A) in the M 6 thread hole on crankshaft pulley, and
    remove crankshaft pulley.

    E

    (B) : M6 bolt

    Tool number

    : KV11123000 (

    )

    F

    G
    PBIC3711E

    11. Remove front cover:
    a. Loosen bolts in the reverse order as shown.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    JPBIA4139ZZ

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-53

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    b.

    Cut liquid gasket by prying the position (
    remove the front cover.

    ) as shown, and then

    JPBIA4140ZZ

    12. Remove front oil seal from front cover using a suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage the front cover.
    13. Remove chain tensioner (1):
    a. Fully push down the chain tensioner lever (A), and then push the
    plunger (C) into the inside of tensioner.
    • The tab (B) is released by fully pushing the lever down. Then
    the plunger can be moved.
    b. Pull up the lever to align its hole position with the body hole position.
    • When the lever hole is aligned with the body hole position, the
    plunger is secured.
    • When the protrusion parts of the plunger ratchet and the tab
    PBIC3713E
    face each other, both hole positions are not aligned. At that
    time, correctly engage them and align these hole positions by
    slightly moving the plunger.
    c. Insert the stopper pin (D) into the body hole through the lever hole, and then secure the lever at the upper
    position.
    NOTE:
    A hexagonal wrench of 2.5 mm (0.098 in) is used as a stopper pin (D).
    d. Remove chain tensioner.
    14. Remove the timing chain tension guide (2) and the timing chain
    slack guide (1).

    JPBIA4141ZZ

    15. Remove the timing chain (2).
    • Pull the timing chain slack toward the camshaft sprocket
    (EXH) (1), and then remove the timing chain and start the
    removal from camshaft sprocket (EXH) side.
    CAUTION:
    Do not rotate crankshaft or camshaft while timing chain is
    removed. It causes interference between valve and piston.

    JPBIA4142ZZ

    16. Remove the crankshaft sprocket and the oil pump drive:
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-54

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    a. Remove oil pump drive chain tensioner (1).
    • Pull out from the shaft (B) and spring attaching holes (A).

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4143ZZ

    b.
    c.

    D

    Hold the top of the oil pump shaft using the socket (size: E8),
    and then loosen the oil pump sprocket nut and remove it.
    Remove the crankshaft sprocket (1), the oil pump drive chain
    (2), and the oil pump sprocket (3) at the same time.

    E

    F

    G
    JPBIA4230ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    H

    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings.
    NOTE:
    For installation follow the relationship between the matching mark on
    each timing chain and that of the corresponding sprocket, with the
    components installed.
    (1)

    : Camshaft sprocket (EXH)

    (2)

    : Timing chain

    (3)

    : Timing chain slack guide

    (4)

    :Timing chain tensioner

    (5)

    : Crankshaft sprocket

    (6)

    : Oil pump drive chain

    (7)

    : Oil pump sprocket

    (8)

    : Timing chain tension guide

    (9)

    : Camshaft sprocket (INT)

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    (A) : Matching mark (Peripheral groove)
    (B) : Pink link

    N

    (C) : Matching mark (Peripheral groove)
    (D) : Orange link
    (E) : Matching mark (stamp)

    O

    (F) : Crankshaft key (point straight up)
    JPBIA4223ZZ

    P

    1.

    Install the crankshaft sprocket and the oil pump drive related parts:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-55

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    a. Install the crankshaft sprocket (1), the oil pump drive chain (2),
    and the oil pump sprocket (3) at the same time.

    [HR16DE]

    : Engine front

    • Install the crankshaft sprocket so that its invalid gear area (A)
    is toward the back of the engine.
    • Install the oil pump sprocket so that its protrusion faces the
    front of engine.
    NOTE:
    There is no matching mark in the oil pump drive related parts.
    JPBIA5248ZZ

    b.

    Hold the top of the oil pump shaft using the socket (size: E8),
    and then tighten the oil pump sprocket nut.
    (1)

    : Crankshaft sprocket

    (2)

    : Oil pump drive chain

    (3)

    : Oil pump sprocket

    JPBIA4230ZZ

    c.

    Install oil pump drive chain tensioner (1).
    • Insert the body into the shaft (B) while inserting the spring into
    the attaching hole (A) of cylinder block front surface.
    • Check that the tension is applied to the oil pump drive chain
    after installing.

    JPBIA4143ZZ

    2.

    Install timing chain:
    (A) : Matching mark (Peripheral groove)
    (B) : Pink link
    (C) : Matching mark (Peripheral groove)
    (D) : Orange link
    (E) : Matching mark (stamp)
    (F) : Crankshaft key (point straight up)

    • Install by aligning matching marks on each sprocket and timing chain.
    • If these matching marks are not aligned, rotate the camshaft
    slightly to correct the position.
    CAUTION:
    • After the matching marks are aligned, keep them aligned
    by holding them.
    • To avoid skipped teeth, do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft until front cover is installed.

    JPBIA4144ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-56

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Install timing chain tension guide (2) and timing chain slack
    guide (1).

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4141ZZ

    4.

    D

    Install chain tensioner (1).
    • Secure the plunger at the most compressed position using a
    stopper pin (A), and then install it.
    • Pull out the stopper pin after installing the chain tensioner.

    E

    F

    G
    PBIC3722E

    5.
    6.
    7.
    a.

    Check matching mark position of timing chain and each sprocket again.
    Install the front oil seal to the front cover. Refer to EM-74, «FRONT OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation».
    Install front cover with the following procedure:
    Apply a continuous bead of liquid gasket to the engine block joint locations (A) as shown.
    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products
    and Sealants»
    CAUTION:
    • Do not confirm torque after the 5 minutes have elapsed.
    • Do not confirm torque after the 5 minutes have elapsed.
    • Then allow 30 minutes for the liquid gasket to set before
    adding oil to the engine.
    (1)

    : Cylinder head

    (2)

    : Cylinder block

    (3)

    : Oil pan (upper)

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    (A) : Liquid gasket application area [3.0 — 4.0 mm (0.12 — 0.16 in) diameter]

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JPBIA4145ZZ

    b.

    Apply a continuous bead of liquid gasket to front cover as shown using suitable tool.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-57

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products
    and Sealants».
    CAUTION:
    • Do not confirm torque after the 5 minutes have elapsed.
    • Do not confirm torque after the 5 minutes have elapsed.
    • Then allow 30 minutes for the liquid gasket to set before
    adding oil to the engine.
    (1)

    : Front cover edge

    (A) : Liquid gasket application area
    (b)

    : 4.0 — 5.6 mm

    (c)

    : Liquid gasket application area [3.0 — 4.0 mm (0.12 — 0.16 in) diameter]

    JPBIA4146ZZ

    c.

    d.

    Tighten bolts in the numerical order as shown.
    NOTE:
    Refer to the following for the installation position of bolts.
    M6 bolt

    : No. 1

    M10 bolts

    : No. 11, 12, 13

    M10 bolts

    : No. 14, 15

    M8 bolts

    : Except above

    6.6 N·m (0.67 kg-m,
    58 in-lb)
    55.0 N·m (5.6 kg-m,
    41 ft-lb)
    55.0 N·m (5.6 kg-m,
    41 ft-lb)
    25.0 N·m (2.6 kg-m,
    18 ft-lb)

    After all bolts are tightened, retighten them to specified torque in
    numerical order as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Be sure to wipe off any excessive liquid gasket leaking to
    surface.

    JPBIA4139ZZ

    8.

    Insert crankshaft pulley by aligning with crankshaft key.
    • When inserting crankshaft pulley with a plastic hammer, tap on its center portion (not circumference).

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-58

    2014 Note

    TIMING CHAIN
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage front oil seal lip section.
    9. Tighten crankshaft pulley bolt:
    • Secure crankshaft pulley with a suitable tool and tighten crankshaft pulley bolt.
    a. Apply new engine oil to thread and seat surfaces of crankshaft pulley bolt.
    b. Tighten crankshaft pulley bolt.
    Crankshaft pulley bolt
    c.
    d.

    A

    EM

    C

    : 35.0 N·m (3.6 kg-m, 26 ft-lb)

    Put a paint mark (B) on crankshaft pulley, mating with any one of
    six easy to recognize angle marks (A) on crankshaft bolt flange
    (1).
    Turn another 60 degrees clockwise (angle tightening).
    • Check the tightening angle with movement of one angle mark.

    D

    E

    F
    PBIC3726E

    10. Check that crankshaft turns smoothly by rotating by hand clockwise using suitable tool.
    11. Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    H

    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there are no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-59

    2014 Note

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    CAMSHAFT
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CAMSHAFT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444860

    AWBIA1606ZZ

    1.

    Camshaft bracket (No. 2 to 5)

    2.

    Camshaft bracket (No. 1)

    3.

    Camshaft sprocket (EXH)

    4.

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve

    5.

    O-ring

    6.

    Camshaft sprocket (INT)

    7.

    Plug (EXH)

    8.

    Washer (EXH)

    9.

    Oil filter (for exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve)

    10. Cylinder head

    11. Oil filter (for intake valve timing
    control solenoid valve)

    12. Washer (INT)

    13. Plug (INT)

    14. O-ring

    15. Intake valve timing control solenoid
    valve

    16. Bracket

    17. Valve lifter (INT)

    18. Valve lifter (EXH)

    19. Camshaft (INT)

    20. Camshaft (EXH)

    A.

    Refer to INSTALLATION

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444861

    CAUTION:
    The rotation direction indicated in the procedure is as viewed from the engine front.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove timing chain. Refer to EM-51, «Removal and Installation»

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-60

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Remove camshaft sprocket (EXH) (1).
    CAUTION:
    A
    • Hold the camshaft hexagonal part (A), and then secure the
    camshaft.
    • Do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft separately, so as
    EM
    not to contact valve with piston.
    NOTE:
    The timing chain with the front cover installed is not disengaged
    from the crankshaft sprocket and it is not dropped into the front
    C
    cover. Therefore, the timing chain tension holding device is not
    necessary.
    JPBIA4160ZZ
    3. Turn the camshaft sprocket (INT) to the most advanced position.
    D
    CAUTION:
    Installation and removal of the camshaft sprocket (INT) must be done in the most advanced position. Make sure to follow the procedure exactly.
    E
    • The sprocket (C) and vane (camshaft coupling) (B) are
    designed to spin and move within the range of a certain
    angle.
    • With the engine stopped and the vane in the most
    F
    retarded angle, it will not spin because it is locked to the
    sprocket side by the internal lock pin (A).
    • If the camshaft sprocket bolts are turned in the situation
    G
    described above, the lock pin will become damaged and
    cause malfunctions because of the increased horizontal
    load (cutting force) on the lock pin.
    H

    PBIC3679E

    a.

    • Put the camshaft sprocket (INT) in the most advanced position:
    Remove camshaft bracket (No. 1) (1).
    NOTE:
    Timing chain is present only for illustration purposes. Timing
    chain is to be removed during removal procedure.

    I

    J

    : Engine front

    K

    • Loosen the bolts in several steps, and then remove them.

    L

    PBIC3680E

    b.

    M

    Apply the following air pressure to the No. 1 journal oil hole (A)
    of camshaft (INT) (1) shown using an air gun.
    Air pressure

    N

    : 300 kPa (3.1 kg/cm2, 44 psi) or more

    O

    : Engine front

    • Apply the air pressure into the oil hole on the second groove
    from the front of camshaft thrust (B).
    • Proceed all the way through step “e” with the air pressure on.
    • Attach the rubber nozzle narrowed to the top of the air gun to
    prevent air leaks from the oil hole (A). Securely apply the air
    pressure to the oil hole.
    WARNING:
    Eye protection should be worn as needed.
    CAUTION:
    • There are other oil holes in the side grooves. Do not use the incorrect oil holes.
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-61

    P
    JPBIA4150ZZ

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Be sure not to damage the oil path with the tip of the air gun.
    • Wipe all the oil off the air gun to prevent oil from being blown all over along with the air, and the
    area around the air gun should be wiped with a rag when applying air pressure.
    NOTE:
    The air pressure is used to move the lock pin into the disengage position.
    c.

    Hold the camshaft sprocket (INT) with hands, and then apply the power counterclockwise/clockwise alternately.
    (A) : Air gun
    (B) : Rubber nozzle

    • Finally rotate the sprocket of the camshaft sprocket (INT)
    counterclockwise [the direction shown by the arrow ( )].
    • Perform the work while continuously applying the air pressure
    to the oil hole.

    JPBIA4151ZZ

    • If the lock pin is not released, tap the camshaft sprocket (INT)
    lightly with a plastic hammer (A) using suitable tool.
    • If the camshaft sprocket (INT) is not rotated counterclockwise
    even if the above procedures are performed, check the air
    pressure and the oil hole position.

    JPBIA4152ZZ

    d.

    While doing the above, once you hear a click (the sound of the
    internal lock pin disengaging) from inside the camshaft sprocket
    (INT), start turning the camshaft sprocket (INT) in the counterclockwise direction in the most advanced angle position.
    (A/B) : Lock pin recess

    e.
    f.

    (C)

    : Lock pin engaged

    (D)

    : Most advanced angle

    • Keep the air pressure on.
    • If there is no click, as soon as the vane side (camshaft side)
    PBIC3684E
    starts moving independently of the sprocket, the lock pin has
    become disengaged.
    • Check that it is in the most advanced angle position by seeing if the stopper pin groove (A) and the stopper pin hole (B) are matched up as shown.
    Stop applying air pressure and release the camshaft (INT).
    Insert the stopper pin (A) into the stopper pin holes in the camshaft sprocket (INT) and lock in the most advanced angle position.
    CAUTION:
    No load is exerted on the stopper pin (spring reaction, etc.).
    Since it comes out easily, secure it with tape (B) to prevent
    it from falling out.
    NOTE:
    The stopper pin shows one example of a hexagonal wrench for
    2.5 mm (0.098 in) [length of inserted section: approximately15
    mm (0.59 in)].
    JPBIA4153ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-62

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4.
    a.

    Remove the camshaft sprocket (INT):
    Keeping the camshaft hexagonal part (A) in place using suitable
    tool, loosen the bolts for the camshaft sprocket (INT) (2).
    (1)

    A

    EM

    Camshaft (INT)

    C

    D
    JPBIA4154ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • Do not drop stopper pin.
    • Tape (C) the stopper pin (B) so it does not come out.
    • Do not subject it to impact by dropping.
    • Do not disassemble. [Do not loosen the three bolts (A)].
    NOTE:
    While removing the camshaft sprocket (INT), if you have taken
    out the stopper pin and the lock pin has been rejoined in the
    most retarded angle, do the following to restore it.
    i. Install the camshaft (INT) and tighten the bolts enough to prevent air from leaking out.
    CAUTION:
    The internal lock pin will get damaged, so keep the torque
    PBIC3691E
    on the bolts to the minimum required to prevent air from
    escaping.
    ii. Apply the air pressure, disengage the lock pin, and turn the vane to the most advanced angle position.
    iii. Insert the stopper pin.
    iv. Remove camshaft sprocket (INT) from the camshaft.
    5.

    Remove camshaft brackets (No. 2 to 5).
    • Loosen bolts in several steps in the reverse order as shown.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    (A) : EXH side

    L

    (B) : INT side
    : Engine front

    NOTE:
    The camshaft bracket (No. 1) has been already removed.

    M

    PBIC3686E

    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    Remove camshaft (EXH).
    Remove camshaft (INT).
    Remove valve lifter (if necessary).
    • Identify installation positions, and store lifters without mixing them up.
    Remove the alternator and bracket. Refer to CHG-23, «Exploded View»

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-63

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    10. Remove the intake valve timing control solenoid valve (1) and
    the plug (2) securing the oil filter for intake valve timing control
    solenoid valve.
    11. Remove the exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve.
    12. Remove the plug on the exhaust valve timing control solenoid
    valve.
    13. Remove the oil filter for exhaust valve timing control solenoid
    valve.
    14. For component inspection after removal, refer to EM-68,
    «Inspection».

    [HR16DE]

    PBIC3692E

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings or washers.
    1. Install oil filter (1) for intake and exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valves.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse washers.
    NOTE:
    The intake side is shown as an example.
    • The oil filter (1) and washer (2) are assembled to the plug (3),
    and then install them in to the cylinder head. Refer to EM-60,
    «Exploded View».
    AWBIA1146GB

    2.

    Install intake and exhaust valve timing control solenoid valves.
    • Insert it straight into the cylinder head.
    • Tighten bolts.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings.

    3.

    Install valve lifters.
    • If they are reused, install them in the original positions.
    Put a matching mark for positioning the camshaft (INT) and the camshaft sprocket (INT):
    NOTE:
    This helps prevent the knock pin from engaging with the incorrect pin hole after installing the camshaft
    (INT) and the camshaft sprocket (INT).
    Put the matching marks (A) on a line extending from the knock
    pin position of camshaft (INT) (1) front surface.
    • Put the marks on the visible position with the camshaft
    sprocket installed as shown.
    Put the matching marks on a line extending from the knock pin
    hole (B) position of camshaft sprocket (INT) (2) as shown.
    • Put the marks on the visible position with it installed to the
    camshaft.

    4.

    a.

    b.

    PBIC3696E

    5.

    Put a matching mark for positioning the camshaft (EXH) and the camshaft sprocket (EXH):
    NOTE:
    This helps prevent the knock pin from engaging with the incorrect pin hole after installing the camshaft
    (INT) and the camshaft sprocket (EXH).

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-64

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    a. Put the matching marks (A) on a line extending from the knock
    pin position of camshaft (EXH) (1) front surface.
    • Put the marks on the visible position with the camshaft
    sprocket installed as shown.
    b. Put the matching marks on a line extending from the knock pin
    hole (B) position of camshaft sprocket (EXH) (2) as shown.
    • Put the marks on the visible position with it installed to the
    camshaft.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C
    JPBIA4155ZZ

    6.

    D

    Install camshaft.
    (1)

    : Camshaft (EXH)

    (2)

    : Camshaft (INT)

    E

    (A) : Identification mark
    Indentification Color

    M1 (A)

    Camshaft (EXH)

    Yellow — Green x 2

    Camshaft (INT)

    White

    F

    G

    • Note that the camshafts (INT and EXH) have different shapes
    at the rear.

    JPBIA4156ZZ

    H

    • Install camshafts to the cylinder head so that knock pins (A) on
    front end are positioned as shown.
    (1)

    : Camshaft (EXH)

    (2)

    : Camshaft (INT)

    I

    J

    : Upper side

    NOTE:
    Though camshaft does not stop at the portion as shown for the
    placement of cam nose, it is generally accepted camshaft is
    placed for the same direction as shown.
    7.

    K

    JPBIA4157ZZ

    L

    Install camshaft brackets (2 to 5) and (A to D).
    M

    (A) : EXH side (2 to 5)
    (B) : INT side (A to D)
    : Engine front

    N

    O
    PBIC3703E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-65

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    8. Tighten bolts of camshaft brackets in the following steps, in
    numerical order as shown.

    [HR16DE]

    (A) : EXH side
    (B) : INT side
    : Engine front

    a.

    Tighten No. 9 to 11 in numerical order.
    Camshaft bracket bolts

    b.

    : 5.88 N·m (0.60 kg-m, 52 in-lb)

    Tighten all bolts in numerical order.
    Camshaft bracket bolts

    9.
    a.

    : 1.96 N·m (0.20 kg-m, 17 in-lb)

    Tighten all bolts in numerical order.
    Camshaft bracket bolts

    d.

    PBIC3686E

    Tighten No. 1 to 8 in numerical order.
    Camshaft bracket bolts

    c.

    : 1.96 N·m (0.20 kg-m, 17 in-lb)

    : 10.4 N·m (1.1 kg-m, 8 ft-lb)

    Install the camshaft sprocket (INT/EXH) to the camshaft (INT/EXH):
    Refer to the matching mark (A) added in step 4. Securely align
    the knock pin and the pin hole, and then install them.
    NOTE:
    The intake side is shown as an example.

    PBIC3700E

    10. Tighten the camshaft sprocket bolt (INT/EXH).
    (1)

    : Camshaft sprocket (INT)

    CAUTION:
    Hold the camshaft hexagonal part (A), using a suitable tool
    to secure the camshaft.

    JPBIA4158ZZ

    11. Align the matching mark (peripheral groove) (A/C) and the pink
    link (B) on the timing chain.
    (1)

    : Timing chain

    (2)

    : Camshaft sprocket (EXH)

    (3)

    : Camshaft sprocket (INT)

    • If the positions of knock pin and pin groove are not aligned,
    move the camshaft (EXH) slightly to correct these positions.
    JPBIA4159ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-66

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    12. Pull out the stopper pin (A), and then apply the tension to the
    timing chain by rotating the crankshaft pulley clockwise slightly.
    (1)

    : Plunger

    (2)

    : Chain tensioner

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    (B) : Lever
    (C) : Lever hole
    (D) : Front cover has been removed for clarity.

    C
    PBIC3772E

    13.
    14.
    15.
    a.

    D

    Pull out the stopper pin of chain tensioner.
    Install front cover.
    Return the camshaft sprocket (INT) in the most retarded position:
    Remove the stopper pin (A) from the camshaft sprocket (INT).

    E

    (B) : Tape

    F

    G

    H
    PBIC3685E

    b.

    Turn the crankshaft pulley (1) slowly clockwise (A) and return
    the camshaft sprocket (INT) to the most retarded angle position.

    I

    J

    K

    PBIC3704E

    • When first turning the crankshaft, the camshaft sprocket (INT)
    will turn. Once it is turned more, and the vane (camshaft) also
    turns, then it has reached the most retarded angle position.

    L

    M

    (B) : Stopper pin hole

    N

    (C) : Most advanced angle
    (D) : Lock pin engaged

    • The most retarded angle position can be checked by seeing if
    the stopper pin groove (A) is shifted clockwise.
    • After spinning the crankshaft slightly in the counterclockwise
    direction, you can check the lock pin has joined by seeing if
    the vane (camshaft) and the sprocket move together.

    O
    PBIC3705E

    P

    16. Install the camshaft position sensor (PHASE) to the rear end of cylinder head.
    • Tighten bolts with it completely inserted.
    17. Check and adjust valve clearance. Refer to EM-10, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    18. Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-67

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009444862

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Oil Filter
    • Check that there is no foreign material on the oil filter (1) and check
    it for clogging.
    • Check the oil filter for damage.
    • If there is some damage, replace the oil filter, the plug, and the
    washer as a set.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the washer.

    PBIC3693E

    Camshaft Runout

    1.

    2.
    3.

    Put V-block on a precise flat table, and support No. 2 and 5 journals of camshaft.
    CAUTION:
    Do not support No. 1 journal (on the side of camshaft
    sprocket) because it has a different diameter from the other
    four locations.
    Set a suitable tool vertically to No. 3 journal.
    Turn camshaft to one direction, and measure the camshaft
    runout using suitable tool. (Total indicator reading)
    PBIC2499E

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-68

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    A

    Standard and Limit
    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».
    4.

    If it exceeds the limit, replace camshaft.

    EM

    Camshaft Cam Height

    1.

    Measure the camshaft cam height using suitable tool (A).
    C

    Standard and Limit
    Intake
    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».
    Exhaust
    Cam wear limit:
    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».
    2.

    D

    E

    If wear exceeds the limit, replace camshaft.
    PBIC3178J

    F

    Camshaft Journal Oil Clearance
    CAMSHAFT JOURNAL DIAMETER
    Measure the outer diameter of camshaft journal using suitable tool
    (A).

    Standard:

    G

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».
    H

    I

    PBIC3179J

    CAMSHAFT BRACKET INNER DIAMETER
    • Tighten camshaft bracket bolts to the specified torque. Refer to «INSTALLATION» for the tightening procedure.
    • Measure inner diameter (b) of camshaft bracket using suitable tool
    (A).
    Standard

    J

    K

    L

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».

    M

    N
    JPBIA4192ZZ

    O

    CAMSHAFT JOURNAL OIL CLEARANCE
    • (Oil clearance) = (Camshaft bracket inner diameter) – (Camshaft journal diameter)
    Standard and Limit

    P

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace either or both camshaft and cylinder head.
    NOTE:
    Camshaft brackets cannot be replaced as single parts, because they are machined together with cylinder
    head. Replace whole cylinder head assembly.
    Camshaft End Play

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-69

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Install camshaft in cylinder head. Refer to EM-60, «Removal and Installation» for tightening procedure.
    2. Install a suitable tool (A) in thrust direction on front end of camshaft. Measure the camshaft end play using suitable tool when
    camshaft is moved forward/backward (in direction of axis).
    Standard and Limit

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».

    PBIC3694E

    • Measure the following parts if out of the standard.
    — Dimension “A” for cylinder head No. 1 journal bearing
    Standard

    : 4.000 — 4.030 mm (0.1574 — 0.1586 in)

    — Dimension “B” for camshaft thrust
    Standard

    : 3.877 — 3.925 mm (0.1526 — 0.1545 in)

    • Refer to the standards above, and then replace camshaft and/
    or cylinder head.
    KBIA3345J

    Camshaft Sprocket Runout

    1.

    2.

    Put V-block on precise flat table, and support No. 2 and 5 journals of camshaft.
    CAUTION:
    Do not support No. 1 journal (on the side of camshaft sprocket) because it has a different diameter
    from the other four locations.
    Measure the camshaft sprocket runout using suitable tool (A).
    (Total indicator reading)
    Limit

    : 0.15 mm (0.0059 in)

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace camshaft sprocket.

    JPBIA4193ZZ

    Valve Lifter
    Check if surface of valve lifter has any wear or cracks.
    • If anything above is found, replace valve lifter. Refer to EM-116,
    «Camshaft».

    KBIA0182E

    Valve Lifter Clearance
    VALVE LIFTER OUTER DIAMETER

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-70

    2014 Note

    CAMSHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Measure the outer diameter of valve lifter using suitable tool (A).

    [HR16DE]
    A

    Standard

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».
    EM

    C
    PBIC3185J

    D

    VALVE LIFTER HOLE DIAMETER
    Measure the diameter of valve lifter hole of cylinder head using suitable tool (A).
    Standard

    E

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».
    F

    G
    PBIC3184J

    H

    VALVE LIFTER CLEARANCE
    • (Valve lifter clearance) = (Valve lifter hole diameter) – (Valve lifter outer diameter)
    Standard

    I

    : Refer to EM-116, «Camshaft».

    • If out of the standard, referring to the each standard of valve lifter outer diameter and valve lifter hole diameter, replace either or both valve lifter and cylinder head.

    J

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Inspection of Camshaft Sprocket Oil Groove
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this inspection only when DTC P0011 or P0014 is detected in self-diagnostic results of CONSULT and it is directed according to inspection procedure of EC section. Refer to EC-143, «Diagnosis
    Procedure» (P0011) or EC-147, «Diagnosis Procedure» (P0014).
    • Check when engine is cold so as to prevent burns from the splashing engine oil.
    NOTE:
    This section provides the inspection method of oil passage of cam sprocket on the intake side. For oil passage
    on the exhaust side, the inspection procedure must be changed as instructed below:

    1.
    2.
    a.
    b.

    · Step 3

    : Remove exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».

    · Step 4

    : Crank engine, and then check that engine oil comes out from exhaust valve timing control solenoid
    valve hole (A). End crank after checking.

    ·Step 5

    Perform the following inspection if engine oil does not come out from exhaust valve timing control
    solenoid valve oil hole of the cylinder head.
    • Remove oil filter, and then clean it. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    • Clean oil groove between oil strainer and exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to
    EM-60, «Exploded View».

    ·Step 6

    : Remove components between exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve and camshaft sprocket
    (EXH), and then check each oil groove for clogging.

    Check engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Perform the following procedure so as to prevent the engine from being unintentionally started while
    checking.
    Release the fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    Remove intake manifold. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-71

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    CAMSHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    c. Disconnect ignition coil and injector harness connectors.
    3. Remove intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    4. Crank engine, and then check that engine oil comes out from
    intake valve timing control solenoid valve hole (A). End crank
    after checking.
    (1)

    [HR16DE]

    : Plug
    :Engine front

    5.

    6.
    7.

    WARNING:
    Be careful not to touch rotating parts (drive belts, idler pulley, and crankshaft pulley, etc.).
    CAUTION:
    JPBIA4194ZZ
    • Prevent splashing by using a shop cloth to prevent injury
    from splashing engine oil and so as to prevent engine oil contamination.
    • Use a shop cloth to prevent engine oil from being splashed to engine and vehicle. Especially be
    careful not to spill engine oil to rubber parts of drive belts, engine mounting insulator, etc. Wipe
    engine oil off immediately if it is splashed.
    Perform the following inspection if engine oil does not come out from intake valve timing control solenoid
    valve oil hole of the cylinder head.
    • Remove oil filter, and then clean it. Refer to LU-10, «Removal and Installation».
    • Clean oil groove between oil strainer and intake valve timing control solenoid valve. Refer to EM-60,
    «Exploded View».
    Remove components between intake valve timing control solenoid valve and camshaft sprocket (INT),
    and then check each oil groove for clogging.
    • Clean oil groove if necessary. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    After inspection, installation of components is in the reverse order of removal

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-72

    2014 Note

    OIL SEAL
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    OIL SEAL

    A

    VALVE OIL SEAL
    VALVE OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444863

    EM

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    Remove camshafts. Refer to EM-60, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove valve lifters. Refer to EM-60, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate crankshaft, and set piston with valve oil seal to be removed to TDC. This will prevent the valve
    from dropping into cylinder.
    CAUTION:
    When rotating crankshaft, be careful to avoid scarring front cover with timing chain.
    Remove valve collet, valve spring retainer, and valve spring
    using Tools.
    Tool number (A)
    Tool number (B)
    Tool number (C)

    : KV1016200 (J-26336-A)
    : KV10109220 ( — )
    : KV10115900 (J-26336-20)

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    JPBIA1365ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage valve lifter holes.
    • Install Tool (A) in the center of valve spring retainer to
    press it.
    (1)

    : Valve spring retainer

    (A)

    : Attachment

    Tool number

    I

    J

    : KV10115900 (J-26336-20)

    K

    AWBIA1422ZZ

    5.
    6.

    Remove valve spring retainer, valve spring and valve spring seat. Refer to EM-78, «Disassembly and
    Assembly».
    Remove valve oil seal with Tool (A).
    Tool number

    H

    : KV10107902 (J-38959)

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    PBIC3728E

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Apply new engine oil to valve oil seal joint surface and seal lip.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-73

    2014 Note

    OIL SEAL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Press in valve oil seal to the height “H” shown with Tool (A).
    Height “H”

    : 13.2 — 13.8 mm (0.520 — 0.543 in)

    Tool number

    : KV10115600 (J-38958)

    [HR16DE]

    PBIC3211J

    3.

    Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    FRONT OIL SEAL
    FRONT OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444864

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove front fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove drive belt. Refer to EM-16, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove crankshaft pulley. Refer to EM-51, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove front oil seal using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage front cover and crankshaft.

    5.

    Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Apply new engine oil to new front oil seal joint surface and seal lip.
    Install front oil seal so that each seal lip is oriented as shown.
    (A)

    : Dust seal lip

    (B)

    : Oil seal lip
    : Engine outside
    : Engine inside

    PBIC3485J

    • Press-fit front oil seal using a suitable drift.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage front cover and crankshaft.
    • Press-fit oil seal straight to avoid causing burrs or tilting.
    3.

    Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    REAR OIL SEAL
    REAR OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444865

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove engine and transaxle assembly. Refer to EM-86, «Removal and Installation» (M/T models) and
    EM-86, «Removal and Installation» (CVT models).
    Remove clutch cover and clutch disk (M/T models). Refer to CL-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove flywheel (M/T models) or drive plate (CVT models). Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-74

    2014 Note

    OIL SEAL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4. Remove rear oil seal using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage crankshaft and cylinder block.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Apply the liquid gasket lightly to entire outside area of new rear oil seal.
    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant or equivalent. Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    Install rear oil seal so that each seal lip is oriented as shown.
    (A)

    : Dust seal lip

    (B)

    : Oil seal lip

    EM

    C

    D

    : Engine outside
    : Engine inside

    E

    PBIC3485J

    • Press-fit rear oil seal with a suitable drift (A) outer diameter
    113 mm (4.45 in) and inner diameter 90 mm (3.54 in).
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage crankshaft and cylinder block.
    • Press-fit oil seal straight to avoid causing burrs or tilting.
    • Do not touch grease applied onto oil seal lip.

    F

    G

    H

    I
    PBIC3660E

    J

    • Press in rear oil seal (1) to the position as shown.
    (A)

    : Rear end surface of cylinder block

    (b)

    : 0 — 0.5 mm (0 — 0.020 in)

    K

    L

    M
    PBIC3149J

    3.

    Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-75

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CYLINDER HEAD
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009670525

    Cylinder Head Bolts

    JPBIA4097ZZ

    1.

    Cylinder head assembly

    2.

    Cylinder head bolt

    4.

    Cylinder head gasket

    A.

    INSTALLATION

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Washer

    INFOID:0000000009670526

    REMOVAL
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    1. Release fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    2. Remove the following components and related parts.
    • Air duct. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    • Fuel tube and fuel injector. Refer to EM-40, «Removal and Installation».
    • Water outlet. Refer to CO-25, «Removal and Installation».
    • Exhaust manifold. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».
    • Front cover and timing chain. Refer to EM-51, «Exploded View».
    • Camshaft. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    3. Remove cylinder head loosening bolts in reverse order as
    shown.
    (A) : EXH side
    (B) : INT side
    : Engine front

    PBIC3732E

    4.

    Remove cylinder head gasket.

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Install new cylinder head gasket.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-76

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Install cylinder head, and tighten cylinder head bolts in order as shown using Tool (A).
    • Clean threads and seating surfaces of bolts.
    A
    • Apply new engine oil to threads and seating surface of bolts.
    CAUTION:
    • If cylinder head bolts are reused, check their outer diameters before installation. Refer to EM-79,
    EM
    «Inspection».
    • Check and confirm the tightening angle by using Tool. Do
    not judge by visual inspection without the tool.
    C

    Tool number

    : KV10112100 (BT-8653-A)
    D

    E
    AWBIA1426ZZ

    F

    Step 1
    Step 2
    Step 3
    Step 4
    Step 5
    Step 6

    : 40.0 N·m (4.1 kg-m, 30 ft-lb)
    : 100° clockwise in order
    : 0 N·m (0 kg-m, 0 ft-lb)
    : 40.0 N·m (4.1 kg-m, 30 ft-lb)
    : 100° clockwise in order
    : 100° clockwise in order

    G

    H

    : Engine front

    3.

    AWBIA1425ZZ

    I

    Installation of the remaining components is in the reverse order of removal.

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009670527

    J

    Valve Components
    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JPBIA4098GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-77

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1.

    Spark plug

    2.

    Valve collet

    3.

    Valve spring retainer

    4.

    Valve spring

    5.

    Valve spring seat

    6.

    Valve oil seal

    7.

    Valve guide (INT)

    8.

    Valve guide (EXH)

    9.

    Valve seat (EXH)

    10. Valve (EXH)
    A.

    11. Valve (INT)

    12. Valve seat (INT)

    ASSEMBLY

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009670528

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove spark plug using suitable tool.
    Remove valve lifter.
    • Identify installation positions, and store lifters without mixing them up.
    Remove valve collet, valve spring retainer, and valve spring
    using Tools.
    Tool number (A)
    Tool number (B)
    Tool number (C)

    : KV1016200 (J-26336-A)
    : KV10109220 ( — )
    : KV10115900 (J-26336-20)

    JPBIA1365ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage valve lifter holes.
    • Install Tool (A) in the center of valve spring retainer to
    press it.
    (1)

    : Valve spring retainer

    (A)

    : Attachment

    Tool number

    : KV10115900 (J-26336-20)

    AWBIA1422ZZ

    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove valve spring retainer and valve spring.
    Push valve stem to combustion chamber side, and remove valve.
    • Identify installation positions, and store without mixing them up.
    Remove valve oil seal using Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : KV10107902 (J-38959)

    PBIC3728E

    7.
    8.
    9.

    Remove valve spring seat.
    When valve seat must be replaced, refer to EM-79, «Inspection» for removal.
    When valve guide must be replaced, refer to EM-79, «Inspection» for removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-78

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    ASSEMBLY
    1. Install valve guide if removed. Refer to EM-79, «Inspection».
    2. Install valve seat if removed. Refer to EM-79, «Inspection».
    3. Install valve oil seal.
    • Install with Tool (A) to match dimension as shown.
    Height “H”

    : 13.2 — 13.8 mm (0.520 — 0.543 in)

    Tool number

    : KV10115600 (J-38958)

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C

    D

    PBIC3211J

    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Install valve spring seat.
    Install valve.
    • Install larger diameter to intake side.
    Install valve spring.
    NOTE:
    It can be installed in either direction.
    Install valve spring retainer.
    Remove valve collet, valve spring retainer, and valve spring
    using Tools.
    Tool number (A)
    Tool number (B)
    Tool number (C)

    E

    F

    G

    H

    : KV1016200 (J-26336-A)
    : KV10109220 ( — )
    : KV10115900 (J-26336-20)

    I

    J
    JPBIA1365ZZ

    K

    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage valve lifter holes.
    • Install Tool (A) in the center of valve spring retainer to
    press it.
    (1)

    : Valve spring retainer

    (A)

    : Attachment

    Tool number

    L

    M

    : KV10115900 (J-26336-20)

    N

    AWBIA1422ZZ

    9. Install valve lifter.
    10. Install spark plug with a suitable tool.

    P

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670529

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Cylinder Head Bolts Outer Diameter

    Revision: April 2013

    O

    EM-79

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Cylinder head bolts are tightened by plastic zone tightening
    method. Whenever the size difference between “d1” and “d2”
    exceeds the limit, replace them with a new one.

    [HR16DE]

    Limit (“d1”–“d2”): 0.15 mm (0.0059 in)
    • If reduction of outer diameter appears in a position other than “d2”,
    use it as “d2” point.

    PBIC3717E

    Cylinder Head Distortion
    NOTE:
    When performing this inspection, cylinder block distortion should be also checking. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».
    1. Wipe off engine oil and remove water scale (like deposit), gasket, sealant, carbon, etc. using scraper.
    CAUTION:
    Use utmost care not to allow gasket debris to enter passages for engine oil or engine coolant.
    2. At each of several locations on bottom surface of cylinder head,
    measure the distortion in six directions using suitable tools (A/
    B).

    Limit

    : Refer to EM-79, «Inspection».

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace cylinder head.

    PBIC3207J

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    VALVE DIMENSIONS
    • Check the dimensions of each valve. For the dimensions, refer to EM-79, «Inspection».
    • If dimensions are out of the standard, replace valve and check valve seat contact. Refer to “VALVE SEAT
    CONTACT”.
    VALVE GUIDE CLEARANCE
    Valve Stem Diameter

    • Measure the diameter of valve stem using suitable tool (A).
    Standard

    : Refer to EM-79, «Inspection».

    Valve Guide Inner Diameter

    • Measure the inner diameter of valve guide using suitable tool (A).
    Standard

    : Refer to EM-79, «Inspection».

    Valve Guide Clearance

    • (Valve guide clearance) = (Valve guide inner diameter) – (Valve
    stem diameter)
    Standard and Limit

    PBIC3213J

    : Refer to EM-79, «Inspection».

    • If the calculated value exceeds the limit, replace valve and/or valve guide. Refer to EM-78, «Disassembly
    and Assembly».
    VALVE GUIDE REPLACEMENT
    When valve guide is removed, replace with oversized [0.2 mm (0.008 in)] valve guide.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-80

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. To remove valve guide, heat cylinder head to 110 to 130°C (230
    to 266°F) by soaking in heated oil.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    C
    SEM008A

    2.

    D

    Drive out valve guide with a press [under a 20 kN (2 ton, 2.2 US
    ton, 2.0 lmp ton) force] or suitable tool.
    WARNING:
    Cylinder head contains heat; when working, wear protective
    equipment to avoid getting burned.

    E

    F

    G
    SEM931C

    3.

    Ream cylinder head valve guide hole with a suitable tool.

    H

    Valve guide hole diameter (for service parts):
    Intake and exhaust
    : 9.175 — 9.201 mm (0.3612 — 0.3622 in)

    I

    J

    SEM932C

    4.

    K

    Heat cylinder head to 110 to 130°C (230 to 266°F) by soaking in
    heated oil.
    L

    M

    N
    SEM008A

    5.

    Using a suitable tool, press valve guide (1) from camshaft side
    of cylinder head (2) to dimensions as shown.
    Projection “H”:

    O

    : 11.4 — 11.8 mm (0.448 — 0.464 in)

    P

    WARNING:
    Cylinder head contains heat; when working, wear protective
    equipment to avoid getting burned.

    PBIC3217J

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-81

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Apply reamer finish to valve guide with a suitable tool.

    [HR16DE]

    Standard
    5.000 — 5.018 mm (0.1968 — 0.1975 in)

    SEM932C

    VALVE SEAT CONTACT
    • After confirming that the dimensions of valve guides and valves are within the specifications, perform this
    procedure.
    • Apply prussian blue (or white lead) onto contacting surface of valve seat to check the condition of the valve
    contact on the surface.
    • Check if the contact area band is continuous all around the circumference.
    (A)

    : OK

    • If not, grind to adjust valve fitting and check again. If the contacting
    surface still has “NG” conditions (B) even after the recheck,
    replace valve seat. Refer to EM-79, «Inspection».

    JPBIA0187ZZ

    VALVE SEAT REPLACEMENT
    When valve seat is removed, replace with oversized [0.5 mm (0.020 in)] valve seat.
    1. Bore out old seat until it collapses. Boring should not continue beyond the bottom face of the seat recess
    in cylinder head. Set the machine depth stop to ensure this.
    CAUTION:
    Prevent scoring cylinder head by excessive boring.
    2. Ream cylinder head recess diameter for service valve seat.

    Oversize [0.5 mm (0.020 in)]
    Intake
    : 32.500 — 32.527 mm (1.2795 — 1.2805 in)
    Exhaust : 26.400 — 26.427 mm (1.0393 — 1.0404 in)
    • Be sure to ream in circles concentric to the valve guide center.
    This will enable valve seat to fit correctly.

    SEM795A

    3.

    Heat cylinder head to 110 to 130°C (230 to 266°F) by soaking in
    heated oil.

    SEM008A

    4.

    Provide valve seats cooled well with dry ice. Press-fit valve seats into cylinder head.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-82

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER HEAD
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    WARNING:
    Cylinder head contains heat; when working, wear protective equipment to avoid getting burned.
    CAUTION:
    Avoid directly touching cold valve seats.
    5.

    A

    EM

    Using a suitable tool finish valve seat to the specified dimensions. For dimensions, refer to EM-118, «Cylinder head».
    CAUTION:
    When using a valve seat cutter, firmly grip the cutter handle
    with both hands. Then, press the contacting surface evenly
    around the valve seat to cut in a single attempt. Improper
    pressure or cutting several times may result in wavy valve
    seat.

    C

    D

    E
    SEM934C

    6.
    7.

    Using compound, grind to adjust valve fitting.
    Check again for normal contact. Refer to «VALVE SEAT CONTACT».

    F

    VALVE SPRING SQUARENESS
    • Set a tri-square (A) along the side of valve spring and rotate spring.
    Measure the maximum clearance between the top of spring and
    tri-square.
    (B)

    Limit

    G

    H

    : Contact

    : Refer to EM-118, «Cylinder head».
    I

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace valve spring.
    PBIC3219J

    VALVE SPRING DIMENSIONS AND VALVE SPRING PRESSURE LOAD
    • Check valve spring pressure with valve spring seat installed at the
    specified spring height.
    CAUTION:
    Do not remove valve spring seat from valve spring.

    Standard

    J

    K

    L

    : Refer to EM-118, «Cylinder head».

    • If the installation load or load with valve open is out of the standard, replace valve spring (with valve spring seat).

    M
    SEM113

    N

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there are no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-83

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    CYLINDER HEAD
    [HR16DE]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-84

    2014 Note

    ENGINE ASSEMBLY
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    ENGINE ASSEMBLY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444870

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AWBIA1586ZZ

    1.

    Engine mounting (RH) stay

    2.

    Engine mount (RH) stay

    3.

    Engine mounting insulator (RH)

    4.

    Rear engine mounting bracket

    5.

    Rear torque rod

    6.

    Engine mounting bracket (LH)

    7.

    Engine mounting bracket (LH)

    8.

    Engine mounting insulator (LH)

    9.

    Mass damper

    A.

    Front mark

    B.

    Transaxle (lower)

    C.

    CVT models

    CAUTION:
    Check that the stud bolt (*2) is tight at the specified torque before tightening the nut (*1) shown. [Stud
    bolt (*2) may be loosened after loosening the nut (*1)]

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-85

    2014 Note

    ENGINE ASSEMBLY
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    AWBIA1587ZZ

    1.

    Engine mounting (RH) stay

    2.

    Engine mount (RH) stay

    3.

    Engine mounting insulator (RH)

    4.

    Rear engine mounting bracket

    5.

    Rear torque rod

    6.

    Engine mounting bracket (LH)

    7.

    Mass damper

    8.

    Engine mounting insulator (LH)

    9.

    Engine mounting bracket (LH)

    10. Engine mount bracket (LH)

    A.

    Front mark

    B.

    Transaxle (upper)

    C.

    D.

    M/T models

    Transaxle (lower)

    CAUTION:
    Check that the stud bolt (*2) is tight at the specified torque before tightening the nut (*1) shown. [Stud
    bolt (*2) may be loosened after loosening the nut (*1)]

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444871

    WARNING:
    • Position the vehicle on a flat and solid surface.
    • Place chocks at front and back of rear wheels.
    • Attach proper slingers and bolts described in PARTS CATALOG if engine is not already equipped.
    CAUTION:
    • Always be careful to work safely.
    • Do not start working until exhaust system and coolant are cool enough.
    • If items or work required are not covered by the engine section, refer to the applicable sections.
    • Always use the support point specified for lifting.
    • Use either 2-pole lift type or separate type lift. If board-on type must be used, support the rear axle
    jacking point with a transmission jack or similar tool before starting work, in preparation for the
    backward shift of center of gravity.
    • For supporting points for lifting and jacking point at rear axle, refer to GI-29, «2-Pole Lift».
    NOTE:
    • When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from
    spilling.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-86

    2014 Note

    ENGINE ASSEMBLY
    [HR16DE]
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Remove the engine and the transaxle assembly from the vehicle downward. Separate the engine and the
    transaxle.

    A

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.
    10.
    11.
    12.
    13.
    14.
    15.
    16.
    17.
    18.
    19.
    20.

    Release fuel pressure. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    EM
    Drain engine coolant from radiator. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when the engine is cold.
    C
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belts.
    Front fender protector (RH/LH). Refer to EXT-24.
    Drive belt: Refer to EM-16, «Removal and Installation».
    D
    Battery and battery tray. Refer to CHG-23.
    Air duct (inlet), air duct, and air cleaner case assembly. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    Radiator hose (upper and lower). Refer to CO-14.
    E
    Exhaust front tube. Refer to EX-5.
    Disconnect engine room harness connector at the ECM and CVT (if equipped).
    CAUTION:
    F
    Protect connectors against foreign materials during the operation by wrapping in a plastic bag.
    Disconnect heater hoses. Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect fuel feed hose at engine side. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».
    G
    Disconnect control linkage cable from transaxle. Refer to TM-19, «Exploded View» (M/T models) and CL14, «Exploded View» (CVT models).
    Disconnect clutch tube on transaxle side from clutch damper. Refer to CL-14, «Exploded View».
    H
    Remove alternator. Refer to CHG-23, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect vacuum hose at engine side.
    I
    Remove EVAP hoses at engine side.
    Remove a/c compressor from the engine with the piping connected. Temporarily position the a/c compressor on the vehicle side with a rope without placing a heavy load on the piping.
    J
    Remove ground cable at transaxle side.
    Remove drive shafts (RH/LH). Refer to FAX-19, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove rear torque rod (1).
    K
    (2)

    : Rear engine mounting bracket
    : Front

    L

    M

    JSBIA0643ZZ

    21. When engine can be hoisted, install engine slinger to cylinder
    head front left side (A) and rear right side (B) and support the
    engine position with a suitable tool.

    N

    O

    : Engine front

    Slinger (A) bolts
    Slinger (B) bolts

    P

    : 65 N·m (6.6 kg-m, 48 ft-lb)
    : 25 N·m (2.6 kg-m, 18 ft-lb)
    AWBIA1134GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-87

    2014 Note

    ENGINE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    22. Use a suitable jack (A) to securely support the bottom of the
    engine and the transaxle assembly.
    CAUTION:
    Put a piece of wood or an equivalent as the supporting surface and secure in a stable condition.

    [HR16DE]

    PBIC3223J

    23. Remove engine mounting insulator (RH) (1).
    (2)

    : Engine mounting insulator (LH)

    (A)

    : Engine front side

    (B)

    : Transaxle side

    24. Remove engine through bolt-securing nut (C).

    JSBIA1223ZZ

    25. Carefully lower suitable jack, or raise lift to remove the engine and the transaxle assembly. Observe the
    following cautions:
    CAUTION:
    • Check that no part interferes with the vehicle side.
    • Before and during lifting, always check if any harnesses are left connected.
    • During removal, always be careful to prevent the vehicle from falling off the lift due to changes in
    the center of gravity.
    • If necessary, support the vehicle by setting jack or suitable tool at the rear.
    26. Remove starter motor. Refer to STR-23, «Exploded View».
    27. Lift with a hoist and separate the engine from the transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-23, «Exploded View»
    (M/T models) and TM-250, «Exploded View» (CVT models).

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not allow engine oil to get on engine mounting insulator. Be careful not to damage engine mounting insulator.
    • Check that each mounting insulator is seated properly, and tighten nuts and bolts.
    • When installation directions are specified, install parts according to the direction marks on them,
    referring to the figure of components. Refer to EM-85, «Exploded View».
    Engine Mounting Insulator (RH)
    • Tighten bolts in the numerical order as shown.
    : Front

    JPBIA2809ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-88

    2014 Note

    ENGINE ASSEMBLY
    [HR16DE]
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    A
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    EM
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide C
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there are no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including D
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specE
    ified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas

    F

    G

    H

    I

    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-89

    2014 Note

    ENGINE UNIT
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
    ENGINE UNIT
    Setting

    INFOID:0000000009444872

    NOTE:
    The following procedures explain how to disassemble the engine with the engine stand fastened to the bell
    housing. Some steps may be different if using a different type of engine stand.
    1. Install engine to engine stand:
    a. On (M/T models), remove flywheel.
    • Secure flywheel (1) using suitable tool (A) and remove bolts.
    Tool number

    : KV11105210 (J-44716)

    CAUTION:
    • Do not disassemble flywheel.
    • Do not place flywheel with signal plate facing down.
    • When handling signal plate, take care not to damage or
    scratch it.
    • Handle signal plate in a manner that prevents it from
    becoming magnetized.
    b.

    On (CVT models), remove driveplate.
    • Secure driveplate (1) using suitable tool (A) and remove bolts.
    Tool number

    : KV11105210 (J-44716)

    CAUTION:
    • Do not disassemble flywheel.
    • Do not place flywheel or drive plate with signal plate facing down.
    • When handling signal plate, take care not to damage or
    scratch it.
    • Handle signal plate in a manner that prevents it from
    becoming magnetized.
    c.

    MBIB1382E

    MBIB1382E

    Lift the engine with a hoist to install it onto a widely used engine stand.
    CAUTION:
    • Use the engine stand that has a load capacity approximately 150 kg (331 lb) or more large
    enough for supporting the engine weight.
    • If the load capacity of stand is not adequate, remove the following parts beforehand to reduce the potential risk of overturning stand.
    — Intake manifold. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    — Exhaust manifold. Refer to EM-31, «Removal and Installation».
    — Rocker cover. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».
    NOTE:
    The figure shows an example of widely used engine stand (A)
    that can support the mating surface of transaxle with flywheel
    removed.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the hanging chains, check the engine
    stand is stable and there is no risk of overturning.

    PBIC3227J

    2.

    Drain engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Draining».
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-90

    2014 Note

    ENGINE UNIT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Be sure to clean drain plug and install with new drain plug washer.
    • Do not reuse drain plug washer.
    3. Drain engine coolant by removing water drain plug (1) from
    inside of the engine.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM
    : Engine front

    Water drain plug
    tightening torque

    C

    : Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant or equivalent. Refer to
    GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».

    D
    AWBIA1607ZZ

    Disassembly
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    INFOID:0000000009444873

    Remove intake manifold. Refer to EM-28, «Exploded View».
    Remove exhaust manifold. Refer to EM-31, «Exploded View».
    Remove oil pan (lower). Refer to EM-34, «Exploded View».
    Remove ignition coil, spark plug, and rocker cover. Refer to EM-48, «Exploded View».
    Remove fuel injector and fuel tube. Refer to EM-40, «Exploded View».
    Remove front cover and timing chain. Refer to EM-51, «Exploded View».
    Remove camshaft. Refer to EM-60, «Exploded View».
    Remove cylinder head. Refer to EM-76, «Exploded View».

    Assembly

    E

    F

    G

    H
    INFOID:0000000009444874

    I

    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-91

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444877

    AWBIA1621ZZ

    1.

    Crankshaft position sensor cover

    2.

    Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    3.

    O-ring

    4.

    Drain plug

    5.

    Cylinder block

    6.

    Oil level gauge

    7.

    Oil level gauge guide

    8.

    O-ring

    9.

    Knock sensor

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-92

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    10. Oil temperature sensor

    11.

    13. Top ring

    14. Second ring

    Oil pressure sensor

    12. Oil jet

    A

    15. Oil ringS

    16. Piston

    17. Piston pin

    18. Connecting rod

    19. Connecting rod bearing (upper)

    20. Main bearing (upper)

    21. Thrust bearing

    22. Crankshaft key

    23. Connecting rod bolt

    24. Connecting rod cap

    25. Connecting rod bearing (lower)

    26. Main bearing (lower)

    27. Crankshaft

    28. Pilot converter (CVT models)

    29. Signal plate

    30. Rear oil seal

    31. Drive plate (CVT models)

    32. Reinforce plate (CVT models)

    33. Flywheel (M/T models)

    34. Main bearing cap

    35. Main bearing cap bolt

    A.

    B.

    Chamfered

    EM

    C

    Refer to ASSEMBLY

    Crankshaft side

    Disassembly and Assembly

    D
    INFOID:0000000009444878

    E

    DISASSEMBLY
    NOTE:
    The following procedures explain how to disassemble the engine with the engine stand fastened to the bell
    housing. Some steps may be different if using a different type of engine stand.
    1. Remove cylinder head. Refer to EM-76, «Exploded View».
    2. Remove knock sensor.
    CAUTION:
    Carefully handle knock sensor avoiding shocks.
    3. Remove the crankshaft position sensor cover (3), and then
    crankshaft position sensor (POS) (2).
    (1)

    O-ring

    (4)

    Cylinder block

    a.
    b.
    c.

    G

    H

    I

    : Engine front

    4.
    5.

    F

    CAUTION:
    • Avoid impacts such as a dropping.
    • Do not disassemble.
    • Keep sensor away from metal particles.
    JPBIA4202ZZ
    • Do not place the sensor in a location where it is exposed
    to magnetism.
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    Remove oil pan (upper and lower). Refer to EM-34.
    Remove piston and connecting rod assembly:
    • Before removing piston and connecting rod assembly, check the connecting rod side clearance. Refer to
    EM-101, «Inspection».
    Position crankshaft pin corresponding to connecting rod to be removed onto the bottom dead center.
    Remove connecting rod cap.
    Using a hammer handle or similar tool, push piston and connecting rod assembly out through the cylinder head side.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage mating surface with connecting rod cap.
    • Do not damage the cylinder wall or crankshaft pin.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    KBIA3365J

    6.

    Remove connecting rod bearings.
    CAUTION:
    Identify original positions for installation, and store the bearings without mixing them up.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-93

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    7. Remove piston rings from piston.
    • Before removing piston rings, check the piston ring side clearance. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».
    • Use a suitable tool (A) as shown.
    CAUTION:
    • When removing piston rings, be careful not to damage
    the piston.
    • Do not damage piston rings by expanding them excessively.

    PBIC3233J

    8.
    a.

    Remove piston from connecting rod using the following procedure:
    Remove snap rings using snap ring pliers (A).

    AWBIA1429ZZ

    b.

    Heat piston to 60 to 70°C (140 to 158°F) with a heat gun (A).

    AWBIA1430ZZ

    c.

    Push out piston pin using a punch of outer diameter approximately 18 mm (0.71 in).

    PBIC0262E

    9.

    Remove the main bearing cap.
    • Measure crankshaft end play before loosening main bearing cap bolts. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-94

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    a. Loosen and remove bolts in several steps in reverse of the
    numerical order as shown.

    A

    : Engine front

    EM

    NOTE:
    When removing or installing signal plate, use socket (size T40).

    C
    JPBIA4203ZZ

    b.

    Remove the main bearing cap from the cylinder block while tapping lightly with a plastic hammer.

    10. Remove crankshaft (2).
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage or deform signal plate (1) mounted on
    crankshaft.
    • When setting crankshaft on a flat floor surface, use a
    block of wood to avoid interference between signal plate
    and the floor surface.
    • Do not remove signal plate unless it is necessary to do
    so.
    NOTE:
    When removing or installing signal plate, use socket (size T40).
    JPBIA4531ZZ
    11. Pull rear oil seal out from rear end of crankshaft.
    12. Remove main bearing (upper/lower) and thrust bearings from cylinder block and main bearing caps.
    CAUTION:
    Identify original installation positions, and store the bearings without mixing them up.
    13. Remove oil jets.
    CAUTION:
    Insert the dowel pin of oil jet into the cylinder block dowel pin hole to loosen the bolt.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    ASSEMBLY
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings.
    1. Fully air-blow engine coolant and engine oil passages in cylinder block, cylinder bore and crankcase to
    remove any foreign material.
    WARNING:
    Use goggles to protect your eyes.
    2. Install cylinder block plugs.
    • Apply liquid gasket to the thread of water drain plug (3).
    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant, or equivalent. Refer to
    GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-ring.
    (2)

    : O-ring

    L

    M

    N

    O

    : Engine front
    AWBIA1607ZZ

    • Tighten each plug as specified below.
    Part

    Washer

    Tightening torque

    (1)

    Yes

    54.0 N·m (5.5 kg-m, 40 ft-lb)

    (3)

    No

    9.8 N·m (1.0 kg-m, 87 in-lb)

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    EM-95

    2014 Note

    P

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    3. Install oil jets.
    4. Install main bearings and thrust bearings:
    a. Remove dust, dirt, and engine oil on the bearing mating surfaces of cylinder block.
    b. Install thrust bearings to the both sides of the No. 3 journal housing (B) on cylinder block.

    [HR16DE]

    : Engine front

    • Install thrust bearings with the oil groove (A) facing crankshaft
    arm (outside).

    PBIC3258J

    c.

    Install the main bearings paying attention to the direction.
    • Before installing main bearings, apply new engine oil to the bearing surface (inside). Do not apply
    engine oil to the back surface, but thoroughly clean it.
    • When installing, align main bearing to the center position of cylinder block and main bearing cap.
    • Ensure the oil holes on cylinder block and oil holes (A) on the
    main bearings (1) are aligned.
    NOTE:
    For assembly, the center position can be visually identified.
    • To install the main bearing, obtain a proper fit. Do not allow the
    main bearing to lie off the cylinder block chamfer.
    • To install the main bearing, obtain a proper fit. Do not allow the
    main bearing to lie off bearing cap chamfer.

    PBIC3746E

    5.
    a.

    Install signal plate to crankshaft if removed.
    Set the signal plate (1) with the flange facing toward the counterweight side (engine front side) to the crankshaft rear surface.
    (A) : Dowel pin hole

    b.

    c.
    6.

    7.

    After positioning crankshaft and signal plate with positioning
    dowel pin, tighten bolt.
    NOTE:
    Dowel pin of crankshaft and signal plate is provided as a set for
    each.
    Remove dowel pin.
    CAUTION:
    Be sure to remove dowel pin.
    Install crankshaft to cylinder block.
    • While turning crankshaft by hand, check that it turns smoothly.
    CAUTION:
    Do not install rear oil seal at this time.
    Install main bearing caps.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-96

    JPBIA4231ZZ

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Install the main bearing cap while referring to the front mark
    (B) and the journal number stamp (A).

    [HR16DE]
    A

    : Engine front

    EM

    NOTE:
    Main bearing cap cannot be replaced as a single part,
    because it is machined together with cylinder block.

    C
    JPBIA4204ZZ

    8.

    D

    Tighten main bearing cap bolts in numerical order as shown with
    the following steps:

    E

    : Engine front

    a.
    b.

    Apply new engine oil to threads and seat surfaces of the bolts.
    Tighten main bearing cap bolts in numerical order.
    Step 1
    Step 2

    F

    : 32.4 N·m (3.3 kg-m, 24 ft-lb)
    : 60° clockwise

    G
    JPBIA4203ZZ

    c.

    Turn main bearing cap bolts 60 degrees clockwise (angle tightening) in numerical order as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Check and confirm the tightening angle by using the Tool
    (A) or protractor. Do not judge by visual inspection without
    the tool.
    Tool number

    H

    I

    : KV10112100 (BT-8653-A)

    J

    PBIC3750E

    • After installing the main bearing cap bolts, check that crankshaft can be rotated smoothly by hand.
    • Check crankshaft end play. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».
    9. Install piston to connecting rod with the following procedure:
    a. Using a heat gun, heat the piston until the piston pin can be pushed in by hand without excess force
    [approximately 60 to 70°C (140 to 158°F)]. From the front to the rear, insert piston pin into piston and connecting rod.
    b. Set so that the front mark (A) on the piston head and the cylinder number (C) are in the position as shown.

    K

    L

    M

    N
    (B) : Oil hole
    (D) : Connecting rod big end grade

    NOTE:
    The symbols without notes are for manufacturing.
    CAUTION:
    Press-fit the piston so as not to damage it.
    NOTE:
    The joint between the connecting rod and the piston pin is a
    press fit.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-97

    O

    P
    PBIC3766E

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Press-fit the piston pin (2) from piston surface (A) to the depth
    of 2.35 mm (0.092 in) (b).
    (1)

    [HR16DE]

    : Connecting rod
    : Press-fit direction

    • After finishing work, check that the piston (3) moves freely.

    JPBIA2058ZZ

    10. Using suitable tool (A), install piston rings.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage piston.
    • Do not damage piston rings by expanding them excessively.

    PBIC3233J

    • Position each ring with the gap as shown referring to the piston front mark (B).
    (A)

    : Oil ring upper or lower rail gap (either of them)

    (C)

    : Second ring and oil ring spacer gap

    (D)

    : Top ring gap

    • Install second ring with the stamped mark (E) facing upward.
    Stamped mark:
    Top ring
    Second ring

    : 1R
    : 2R

    PBIC3752E

    11. Install connecting rod bearings to connecting rod and connecting rod cap.
    • When installing connecting rod bearings, apply new engine oil to the bearing surface (inside). Do not
    apply engine oil to the back surface, but thoroughly clean it.
    • Install the bearing in the center position.
    NOTE:
    There is no stopper tab.
    • Check that the oil holes on connecting rod and connecting rod bearing are aligned.
    • Install the connecting rod in the dimension (A) as shown.
    (1)

    : Connecting rod

    (2)

    : Connecting rod bearing (upper)

    (3)

    : Connecting rod bearing (lower)

    (4)

    : Connecting rod cap

    (A)

    : 1.7 — 2.1 mm (0.067 — 0.083 in)
    : Engine front

    NOTE:
    Install the connecting rod bearing in the center position with
    the dimension as shown. For service operation, the center
    position can be checked visually.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-98

    PBIC4169E

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    12. Install piston and connecting rod assembly to crankshaft.
    • Position crankshaft pin corresponding to connecting rod to be installed onto the bottom dead center.
    A
    • Apply new engine oil sufficiently to the cylinder bore, piston and crankshaft pin.
    • Match the cylinder position with the cylinder number on connecting rod to install.
    • Using Tool (A) or suitable tool, install piston with the front mark
    EM
    on the piston head facing the front of the engine.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage mating surface with connecting rod cap.
    • Do not damage the cylinder wall or crankshaft pin.
    C
    Tool number

    : EM03470000 (J-8037)
    D

    PBIC3765E

    13. Install connecting rod cap.
    • Match the stamped cylinder number marks (C) on connecting
    rod with those on connecting rod cap to install.

    E

    F

    (A) : Front mark
    (B) : Oil hole

    G

    (D) : Connecting rod big end grade

    H
    PBIC3766E

    I

    14. Inspect outer diameter of connecting rod bolts. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».
    15. Tighten connecting rod bolt:
    a. Apply new engine oil to the threads and seats of connecting rod bolts.
    b. Install connecting rod bolts in several steps.
    Step 1
    Step 2
    Step 3
    c.

    Tighten to
    Completely loosen
    Tighten to

    J

    K

    : 27.4 N·m (2.8 kg-m, 20 ft-lb)
    : 0 N·m (0 kg-m, 0 ft-lb)
    : 19.6 N·m (2.0 kg-m, 14 ft-lb)

    L

    Then turn all connecting rod bolts 60 degrees clockwise (angle tightening).
    CAUTION:
    Check and confirm the tightening angle by using the Tool (A) or protractor. Avoid judgement by
    visual inspection without the Tool.
    Tool number

    : KV10112100 (BT-8653-A)

    M

    N

    O

    P
    PBIC3753E

    • After tightening connecting rod bolt, check that crankshaft rotates smoothly.
    • Check the connecting rod side clearance. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».
    16. Install oil pan (upper). Refer to EM-37, «Removal and Installation (Upper Oil Pan)».
    NOTE:
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-99

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Install the rear oil seal after installing the oil pan (upper).
    17. Install rear oil seal. Refer to EM-74, «REAR OIL SEAL : Removal and Installation».
    18. Install flywheel (M/T models) or drive plate (CVT models).

    [HR16DE]

    M/T models

    • Secure crankshaft with a stopper plate (A) and tighten bolts
    crosswise over several times.
    (1)

    Tool number

    :Flywheel

    : KV11105210 (J-44716)

    MBIB1382E

    CVT models

    • Secure crankshaft with a stopper plate (A) and tighten bolts
    crosswise over several times.
    (1)

    Tool number

    :Drive plate

    : KV11105210 (J-44716)

    PBIC3226J

    CAUTION:
    Do not damage or scratch and contact surface for clutch disc of flywheel.
    19. Install knock sensor (1).
    : Engine front

    • Install connectors so that they are positioned toward the rear
    of the engine.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not tighten bolt while holding the connector.
    • If any impact by dropping is applied to knock sensor,
    replace it with a new one.
    NOTE:
    • Check that there is no foreign material on the cylinder block
    mating surface and the back surface of knock sensor.
    • Check that knock sensor does not interfere with other parts.
    20. Install crankshaft position sensor (POS) (2) and O-ring (1) and
    then install the crankshaft position sensor cover (3) on the cylinder block (4).
    • Tighten bolts with sensor inserted completely.

    PBIC3754E

    : Engine front

    CAUTION:
    • Avoid impacts such as a dropping.
    • Do not disassemble.
    • Keep sensor away from metal particles.
    • Do not place the sensor in a location where it is exposed
    to magnetism.
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-100

    JPBIA4202ZZ

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    A

    21. For the oil level gauge guide (1), secure in position (B) shown to
    the water inlet clip (A) after inserting to the cylinder block side.

    EM

    C

    D
    PBIC3755E

    22. Assembly of the remaining components is in the reverse order of disassembly.

    Inspection

    E
    INFOID:0000000009444879

    CRANKSHAFT END PLAY

    F

    • Measure the clearance between thrust bearings and crankshaft
    arm when crankshaft is moved fully forward or backward using
    suitable tool (A).

    G

    Standard and Limit

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder
    Block».

    H

    • If the measured value exceeds the limit, replace thrust bearings,
    and measure again. If it still exceeds the limit, replace crankshaft
    also.

    I
    PBIC3762E

    CONNECTING ROD SIDE CLEARANCE

    J

    • Measure the side clearance between connecting rod and crankshaft arm using suitable tool (A).
    Standard and Limit

    K

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder
    Block».

    • If the measured value exceeds the limit, replace connecting rod,
    and measure again. If it still exceeds the limit, replace crankshaft
    also.

    L

    M
    PBIC3763E

    PISTON TO PISTON PIN OIL CLEARANCE
    N

    Piston Pin Hole Diameter
    Measure the inner diameter of piston pin hole using suitable tool (A).

    Standard

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    O

    P

    PBIC3265J

    Piston Pin Outer Diameter

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-101

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Measure the outer diameter of piston pin using suitable tool (A).
    Standard

    [HR16DE]

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    PBIC3266J

    Piston to Piston Pin Oil Clearance
    (Piston to piston pin oil clearance) = (Piston pin hole diameter) – (Piston pin outer diameter)

    Standard

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    • If oil clearance is out of the standard, replace piston and piston pin assembly.
    • When replacing piston and piston pin assembly. Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    NOTE:
    • Piston is available together with piston pin as assembly.
    • Piston pin (piston pin hole) grade is provided only for the parts installed at the factory. For service parts, no
    grades can be selected. Only grade “0” is available.

    PISTON RING SIDE CLEARANCE
    • Measure the side clearance of piston ring and piston ring groove
    with a suitable tool (A).
    Standard and Limit

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder
    Block».

    • If the measured value exceeds the limit, replace piston ring, and
    measure again. If it still exceeds the limit, replace piston also.

    PBIC3280J

    PISTON RING END GAP
    • Check that cylinder bore inner diameter is within specification. Refer to “PISTON TO CYLINDER BORE
    CLEARANCE”.
    • Lubricate piston (1) and piston ring (2) with new engine oil and
    then insert (A) piston ring until middle of cylinder (B) with piston,
    and measure piston ring end gap using feeler gauge (C).
    Standard and Limit

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder
    Block».

    • If the measured value exceeds the limit, replace piston ring, and
    measure again. If it still exceeds the limit, replace cylinder block.
    PBIC3267J

    CONNECTING ROD BEND AND TORSION

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-102

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Check using connecting rod aligner.

    A
    (A)

    : Bend

    (B)

    : Torsion

    (C)

    : Feeler gauge

    Limit

    EM

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».
    C

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace connecting rod assembly.

    D

    E

    F

    G
    PBIC3268J

    CONNECTING ROD BIG END DIAMETER
    • Install connecting rod cap (1) without connecting rod bearing
    installed, and tightening connecting rod cap bolts to the specified
    torque. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».
    (2)

    H

    I

    : Connecting rod

    (A)

    : Example

    (B)

    : Measuring direction of inner diameter

    J

    • Measure the inner diameter (B) of connecting rod big end using
    suitable tool.
    Standard

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    PBIC3269J

    K

    • If out of the standard, replace connecting rod assembly.

    CONNECTING ROD BUSHING OIL CLEARANCE

    L

    Connecting Rod Bushing Inner Diameter
    Measure the inner diameter of connecting rod bushing using suitable
    tool (A).

    M

    Inner diameter
    (Standard)

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder
    Block».

    N

    O

    JPBIA0223ZZ

    Piston Pin Outer Diameter

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-103

    2014 Note

    P

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Measure the outer diameter of piston pin using micrometer (A).
    Outer diameter
    (Standard)

    [HR16DE]

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder
    Block».

    JPBIA0218ZZ

    Connecting Rod Bushing Oil Clearance
    (Connecting rod bushing oil clearance) = (Connecting rod bushing inner diameter) – (Piston pin outer diameter)

    Oil clearance
    (Standard and Limit)

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    • If the measured value is out of the standard range, replace connecting rod assembly and/or piston and piston pin assembly.
    • If replacing piston and piston pin assembly. Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».
    • If replacing connecting rod assembly. Refer to EM-124, «Connecting Rod Bearing».

    CYLINDER BLOCK TOP SURFACE DISTORTION
    • Using a scraper, remove gasket on the cylinder block surface, and also remove engine oil, scale, carbon, or
    other contamination.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to allow gasket particles to enter engine oil or engine coolant passages.
    • Measure the distortion on the cylinder block upper face at different
    points in six directions using suitable tool (A / B).
    Limit

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace cylinder block.

    JPBIA0224ZZ

    MAIN BEARING HOUSING INNER DIAMETER
    • Install main bearing cap without main bearings installed, and tighten main bearing cap bolts to the specified
    torque. Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    • Measure the inner diameter of main bearing housing using suitable tool.
    • Measure the position shown [5 mm (0.20 in)] backward from main
    bearing housing front side in the 2 directions as shown. The
    smaller one is the measured value.
    (1)

    : Cylinder block

    (2)

    : Main bearing cap
    : Engine front

    Standard

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    PBIC4005E
    • If out of the standard, replace cylinder block and main bearing
    caps assembly.
    NOTE:
    Main bearing caps cannot be replaced individually, because they are machined together with cylinder block.

    PISTON TO CYLINDER BORE CLEARANCE
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-104

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Cylinder Bore Inner Diameter
    • Using a suitable tool, measure the cylinder bore for wear, out-ofround and taper at six different points on each cylinder. [(A) and (B)
    directions at (C), (D), and (E)] [(A) is in longitudinal direction of
    engine]
    (f)

    : 10 mm (0.39 in)

    (g)

    : 60 mm (2.36 in)

    (h)

    : 124 mm (4.88 in)

    A

    EM

    C

    NOTE:
    When determining cylinder bore grade, measure the cylinder bore
    (B) direction at (D) position.

    JPBIA2059ZZ

    Standard:
    Cylinder bore inner diameter
    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    E

    F

    Limit:
    Out-of-round [Difference between (A) and (B)]
    Taper [Difference between (C) and (E)]
    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    G

    • If the measured value exceeds the limit, or if there are scratches and/or seizure on the cylinder inner wall,
    replace cylinder block.
    NOTE:
    Oversize piston is not available.

    H

    I

    Piston Skirt Diameter
    Measure the outer diameter of piston skirt using suitable tool (A).

    Standard

    D

    J

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    K

    L
    PBIC3272J

    M

    Piston to Cylinder Bore Clearance
    Calculate by piston skirt diameter and cylinder bore inner diameter
    [direction (B), position (D)].

    N
    (A)

    : Direction A

    (C)

    : Position C

    (E)

    : Position E

    (f)

    : 10 mm (0.39 in)

    (g)

    : 60 mm (2.36 in)

    (h)

    : 124 mm (4.88 in)

    O

    P

    (Clearance) = (Cylinder bore inner diameter) – (Piston skirt diameter)
    Standard and Limit

    JPBIA2059ZZ

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace piston and piston pin assembly and/or cylinder block. Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».
    Revision: April 2013

    EM-105

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    CRANKSHAFT MAIN JOURNAL DIAMETER
    • Measure the outer diameter of crankshaft main journals using suitable tool (A).
    Standard

    [HR16DE]

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    • If out of the standard, measure the main bearing oil clearance.
    Then use undersize bearing. Refer to EM-123, «Main Bearing».

    PBIC3457J

    CRANKSHAFT PIN JOURNAL DIAMETER
    • Measure the outer diameter of crankshaft pin journal using suitable tool.
    Standard

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    • If out of the standard, measure the connecting rod bearing oil clearance. Then use undersize bearing. Refer
    to EM-124, «Connecting Rod Bearing».

    OUT-OF-ROUND AND TAPER OF CRANKSHAFT
    • Measure the dimensions at four different points as shown on each
    main journal and pin journal using suitable tool.
    • Out-of-round is indicated by the difference in dimensions between
    (a) and (b) at (c) and (d).
    • Taper is indicated by the difference in dimension between (c) and
    (d) at (a) and (b).
    Limit:
    Out-of-round [Difference between (a) and (b)]
    Taper [Difference between (c) and (d)]
    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder Block».

    JPBIA0229ZZ

    • If the measured value exceeds the limit, correct or replace crankshaft.
    • If corrected, measure the bearing oil clearance of the corrected main journal and/or pin journal. Then select
    main bearing and/or connecting rod bearing. Refer to EM-124, «Connecting Rod Bearing» and/or EM-123,
    «Main Bearing».

    CRANKSHAFT RUNOUT
    • Place a V-block on a precise flat table to support the journals on both ends of the crankshaft.
    • Place a suitable tool (A) straight up on the No. 3 journal.
    • While rotating crankshaft, read the movement of the pointer on the
    suitable tool. (Total indicator reading)
    Standard and Limit

    : Refer to EM-120, «Cylinder
    Block».

    • If it exceeds the limit, replace crankshaft.

    PBIC3458J

    CONNECTING ROD BEARING OIL CLEARANCE
    Method by Calculation

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-106

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Install connecting rod bearings (2) to connecting rod (3) and connecting rod cap (1), and tighten connecting rod cap bolts to the
    specified torque. Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    (A)

    : Example

    (B)

    : Inner diameter measuring direction

    [HR16DE]
    A

    EM

    • Measure the inner diameter of connecting rod bearing using suitable tool.
    (Bearing oil clearance) = (Connecting rod bearing inner diameter)
    – (Crankshaft pin journal diameter)

    C
    PBIC3275J

    Standard and Limit

    D

    : Refer to EM-124, «Connecting Rod Bearing».

    • If clearance exceeds the limit, select proper connecting rod bearing according to connecting rod big end
    diameter and crankshaft pin journal diameter to obtain specified bearing oil clearance. Refer to EM-124,
    «Connecting Rod Bearing».
    Method of Using Plastigage
    • Remove engine oil and dust on crankshaft pin and the surfaces of each bearing completely.
    • Cut a plastigage slightly shorter than the bearing width, and place it in crankshaft axial direction, avoiding oil
    holes.
    • Install connecting rod bearings to connecting rod and cap, and tighten connecting rod cap bolts to the specified torque. Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    CAUTION:
    Do not rotate crankshaft.
    • Remove connecting rod cap and bearing, and using the scale (A)
    on the plastigage bag, measure the plastigage width.
    NOTE:
    The procedure when the measured value exceeds the limit is
    same as that described in the “Method by Calculation”.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PBIC3276J

    K

    MAIN BEARING OIL CLEARANCE
    Method by Calculation
    • Install main bearings (3) to cylinder block (1) and main bearing cap
    (2), and tighten main bearing cap bolts to the specified torque.
    Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    (A)

    : Example

    (B)

    : Inner diameter measuring direction

    L

    M

    N

    • Measure the inner diameter (B) of main bearing (3) using suitable
    tool.
    (Bearing oil clearance) = (Main bearing inner diameter) – (Crankshaft main journal diameter)

    O
    PBIC3277J

    Standard and Limit

    : Refer to EM-123, «Main Bearing».

    • If clearance exceeds the limit, select proper main bearing according to main bearing inner diameter and
    crankshaft main journal diameter to obtain specified bearing oil clearance. Refer to EM-123, «Main Bearing».
    Method of Using Plastigage
    • Remove engine oil and dust on crankshaft main journal and the surfaces of each bearing completely.
    • Cut a plastigage slightly shorter than the bearing width, and place it in crankshaft axial direction, avoiding oil
    holes.
    • Install main bearings to cylinder block and main bearing cap, and tighten main bearing cap bolts to the specified torque. Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and Assembly».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-107

    2014 Note

    P

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    CAUTION:
    Do not rotate crankshaft.
    • Remove main bearing cap and bearings, and using the scale (A)
    on the plastigage bag, measure the plastigage width.
    NOTE:
    The procedure when the measured value exceeds the limit is
    same as that described in the “Method by Calculation”.

    [HR16DE]

    PBIC3278J

    MAIN BEARING CRUSH HEIGHT
    • When main bearing cap is removed after being tightened to the
    specified torque with main bearings (1) installed, the tip end of
    bearing must protrude (B). Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly and
    Assembly».
    (A)

    : Example

    Standard

    : There must be crush height.

    • If the standard is not met, replace main bearings.
    PBIC3279J

    CONNECTING ROD BEARING CRUSH HEIGHT
    • When connecting rod cap is removed after being tightened to the
    specified torque with connecting rod bearings (1) installed, the tip
    end of bearing must protrude (B). Refer to EM-93, «Disassembly
    and Assembly».
    (A)

    : Example

    Standard

    : There must be crush height.

    • If the standard is not met, replace connecting rod bearings.
    PBIC3279J

    MAIN BEARING CAP BOLT OUTER DIAMETER
    • Measure the outer diameters (d1) and (d2) at two positions as
    shown.
    (A)

    : (d1) measuring position

    (B)

    : (d2) measuring position

    • If reduction appears in places other than (B) range, regard it as
    (d2).
    Limit [(d1) – (d2)]: 0.2 mm (0.0078 in)
    • If it exceeds the limit (a large difference in dimensions), replace
    main bearing cap bolt with a new one.

    PBIC4015E

    CONNECTING ROD CAP BOLT OUTER DIAMETER

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-108

    2014 Note

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Measure the outer diameter (d) at position as shown.
    • If reduction appears in a position other than (d), regard it as (d).

    [HR16DE]
    A

    Limit: 7.75 mm (0.3051 in)
    EM

    • When (d) is less than the limit (when it becomes thinner), replace
    connecting rod cap bolt with a new one.

    C
    PBIC4016E

    D

    FLYWHEEL DEFLECTION (M/T models)
    • Measure the deflection of flywheel contact surface to torque with a
    suitable tool (A).
    • Measure the deflection at 210 mm (8.27 in) diameter.
    Limit

    E

    : 0.45 mm (0.0177 in) or less.

    • If measured value is out of the standard, replace flywheel.
    • If a trace of burn or discoloration is found on the surface, clean it
    with sandpaper.
    CAUTION:
    When measuring, keep magnetic fields (such as dial indicator
    stand) away from signal plate of the rear end of crankshaft.

    F

    G
    PBIC4006E

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-109

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SELECT PISTON AND BEARING
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    HOW TO SELECT PISTON AND BEARING
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009444880

    Selection points

    Selection parts

    Between cylinder block and
    crankshaft

    Between crankshaft and connecting rod

    Selection items

    Selection methods

    Main bearing

    Main bearing grade (bearing
    thickness)

    Determined by match of cylinder block bearing housing
    grade (inner diameter of housing) and crankshaft journal
    grade (outer diameter of journal)

    Connecting rod bearing

    Connecting rod bearing grade
    (bearing thickness)

    Combining service grades for
    connecting rod big end diameter and crankshaft pin outer diameter determine connecting
    rod bearing selection.

    • The identification grade stamped on each part is the grade for the dimension measured in new condition.
    This grade cannot apply to reused parts.
    • For reused or repaired parts, measure the dimension accurately. Determine the grade by comparing the
    measurement with the values of each selection table.
    • For details of the measurement method of each part, the reuse standards and the selection method of the
    selective fitting parts, refer to the text for the appropriate part.

    Connecting Rod Bearing

    INFOID:0000000009444881

    WHEN NEW CONNECTING ROD AND CRANKSHAFT ARE USED
    1.

    Apply connecting rod big end diameter grade stamped (C) on
    connecting rod side face to the row in the “Connecting Rod
    Bearing Selection Table”.
    (A)

    : Oil hole

    (B)

    : Cylinder number

    (D)

    : Front mark

    PBIC3756E

    2.

    Apply crankshaft pin journal diameter grade stamped on crankshaft front side to the column in the “Connecting Rod Bearing
    Selection Table”.
    (A) : Main journal diameter grade (No. 1 to 5 from left)
    (B) : Crankshaft pin journal diameter grade (No. 1 to 4 from left)

    PBIC3757E

    3.
    4.

    Read the symbol at the cross point of selected row and column in the “Connecting Rod Bearing Selection
    Table”.
    Apply the symbol obtained to the “Connecting Rod Bearing Grade Table” to select connecting rod bearing.

    WHEN CONNECTING ROD AND CRANKSHAFT ARE REUSED
    1.

    Measure the dimensions of the connecting rod big end diameter and crankshaft pin journal diameter individually. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-110

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SELECT PISTON AND BEARING
    [HR16DE]
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    2. Apply the measured dimension to the “Connecting Rod Bearing Selection Table”.
    3. Read the symbol at the cross point of selected row and column in the “Connecting Rod Bearing Selection
    Table”.
    4. Apply the symbol obtained to the “Connecting Rod Bearing Grade Table” to select connecting rod bearing.

    A

    EM

    Connecting Rod Bearing Selection Table

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    JPBIA4823GB

    N

    : Refer to EM-124, «Connecting Rod Bearing».

    O

    Connecting Rod Bearing Grade Table

    Connecting Rod Bearing Grade Table

    Undersize Bearings Usage Guide
    • When the specified connecting rod bearing oil clearance is not obtained with standard size connecting rod
    bearings, use undersize (US) bearings.
    • When using undersize (US) bearing, measure the connecting rod bearing inner diameter with bearing
    installed, and grind the crankshaft pin so that the connecting rod bearing oil clearance satisfies the standard.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-111

    2014 Note

    P

    HOW TO SELECT PISTON AND BEARING
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    In grinding crankshaft pin to use undersize bearings, keep the
    fillet R (A) [0.8 — 1.2 mm (0.031 — 0.047 in)].

    [HR16DE]

    Bearing undersize table:
    Refer to EM-124, «Connecting Rod Bearing».

    PBIC3263J

    Main Bearing

    INFOID:0000000009444882

    HOW TO SELECT MAIN BEARING
    When New Cylinder Block and Crankshaft Are Used

    1.

    “Main Bearing Selection Table” rows correspond to main bearing
    housing grade on left side of cylinder block.
    (A) : Basic stamp mark
    : Engine front

    • If there is a corrected stamp mark (B) on cylinder block, use it
    as a correct reference.

    PBIC3760E

    2.

    Apply main journal diameter grade stamped on crankshaft front
    side to column in the “Main Bearing Selection Table”.
    (A) : Main journal diameter grade (No. 1 to 5 from left)
    (B) : Crankshaft pin journal diameter grade (No. 1 to 4 from left)

    PBIC3757E

    3.
    4.

    Read the symbol at the cross point of selected row and column in the “Main Bearing Selection Table”.
    Apply the symbol obtained to the “Main Bearing Grade Table” to select main bearing.
    NOTE:
    Service part is available as a set of both upper and lower.

    When Cylinder Block and Crankshaft Are Reused

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Measure the dimensions of the cylinder block main bearing housing inner diameter and crankshaft main
    journal diameter individually. Refer to EM-101, «Inspection».
    Apply the measured dimension to the “Main Bearing Selection Table”.
    Read the symbol at the cross point of selected row and column in the “Main Bearing Selection Table”.
    Apply the symbol obtained to the “Main Bearing Grade Table” to select main bearing.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-112

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SELECT PISTON AND BEARING
    [HR16DE]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Main Bearing Selection Table

    A

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    PBIC3759E

    Main Bearing Grade Table

    Main Bearing Grade Table

    M

    : Refer to EM-123, «Main Bearing».

    Use Undersize Bearing Usage Guide
    • When the specified main bearing oil clearance is not obtained with standard size main bearings, use undersize (US) bearing.
    • When using undersize (US) bearing, measure the main bearing inner diameter with bearing installed, and
    grind main journal so that the main bearing oil clearance satisfies the standard.
    CAUTION:

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-113

    2014 Note

    HOW TO SELECT PISTON AND BEARING
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    In grinding crankshaft main journal to use undersize bearings,
    keep fillet (A) [0.8 — 1.2 mm (0.031 — 0.047 in)].
    Bearing undersize table:

    [HR16DE]

    Refer to EM-123, «Main Bearing».

    PBIC3263J

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-114

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    General Specification

    INFOID:0000000009444883

    EM

    GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
    Engine type

    HR16DE

    Cylinder arrangement

    In-line 4
    cm3 (cu in)

    Displacement
    Bore and stroke

    D

    1,598 (97.51)
    78.0× 83.6 (3.071 ×3.291)

    mm (in)

    Valve arrangement

    DOHC

    Firing order

    1-3-4-2

    Number of piston rings

    C

    Compression

    2

    Oil

    1

    Compression ratio

    E

    F

    9.8:1

    Compression pressure
    kPa (kg/cm2, psi) / 200 rpm

    Standard

    1,510 (15.4, 219)

    Minimum

    1,270 (12.95, 184)

    Differential limit between cylinders

    G

    100 (1.0, 14.5)

    H

    Valve Timing
    Unit: degree

    I

    J
    Valve timing
    : Intake valve

    K

    : Exhaust valve

    L

    JPBIA4228ZZ

    (

    a

    b

    c

    d

    e

    f

    216

    228

    11 (−27)
    ATDC

    59 (-21)
    ABDC

    -1 (49)
    ATDC

    37 (-13)
    BBDC

    M

    INFOID:0000000009444884

    N

    ): Valve timing control “ON”

    Drive Belt
    DRIVE BELT

    O

    Belt Deflection

    Deflection adjustment *
    Location

    Drive belt

    Used belt

    Unit: mm (in)
    New belt

    Limit

    After adjusted

    With A/C

    10.0 (0.39)

    4.9 — 5.2 (0.19 — 0.20)

    4.1 — 4.4 (0.16 — 0.17)

    Without A/C

    9.1 (0.36)

    4.3 — 4.7 (0.17 — 0.19)

    3.7 — 3.9 (0.146 — 0.154)

    Applied pushing force

    98.1 N (10.0 kg-f, 22.0 lb-f)

    *: When engine is cold.

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-115

    2014 Note

    P

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Belt Tension and Frequency

    Tension adjustment *
    Location

    Unit: N (kg-f,
    lb-f)

    Used belt
    Limit

    With A/C
    Drive belt

    350 (35.7, 78.7)
    Without A/C

    New belt

    After adjusted

    Frequency adjustment *

    Unit: Hz

    Used belt
    Limit

    After adjusted

    New belt

    881 — 951
    (89.9 — 97.0,
    198.0 — 213.8)

    1070 — 1138
    (109.1 — 116.1,
    240.5 — 255.8)

    145.5

    230.5 — 239.5

    254 — 262

    876 — 964
    (89.4 — 98.3,
    196.9 — 216.7)

    1064 — 1152
    (108.5 — 117.5,
    239.2 — 259.0)

    162

    256.5 — 268.5

    282.5 — 293.5

    *: When engine is cold.

    Spark Plug

    INFOID:0000000009444885

    SPARK PLUG (PLATINUM-TIPPED TYPE)
    Make

    NGK

    Standard type*

    PLZKAR6A-11

    Gap (nominal)

    1.1 mm (0.043 in)

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    Exhaust Manifold

    INFOID:0000000009444886

    EXHAUST MANIFOLD
    Unit: mm (in)

    Items

    Limit

    Surface distortion

    0.3 (0.012)

    Camshaft

    INFOID:0000000009444887

    CAMSHAFT
    Unit: mm (in)

    Items
    Camshaft runout [TIR*]

    Standard

    Limit

    0.02 (0.0008)

    0.1 (0.0039)

    SEM671

    Camshaft cam height “A”

    Camshaft journal outer diameter

    Camshaft bracket inner diameter

    Revision: April 2013

    Intake

    41.705 — 41.895 (1.6419 — 1.6494)

    41.505 (1.6341)

    Exhaust

    40.915 — 41.105 (1.6108 — 1.6183)

    40.715 (1.6029)

    No. 1

    27.935 — 27.955 (1.0998 — 1.1006)

    No. 2, 3, 4, 5

    24.950 — 24.970 (0.9822 — 0.9830)

    No. 1

    28.000 — 28.021 (1.1024 — 1.1032)

    No. 2, 3, 4, 5

    25.000 — 25.021 (0.9842 — 0.9850)

    EM-116

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Items
    Camshaft journal oil clearance

    Standard

    Limit

    No. 1

    0.045 — 0.086 (0.0018 — 0.0034)

    No. 2, 3, 4, 5

    0.030 — 0.071 (0.0011 — 0.0027)

    0.075 — 0.153 (0.0029 — 0.0060)

    0.2 (0.0078)

    0.1 (0.0039)

    Camshaft end play
    Camshaft sprocket runout [TIR*]

    A

    EM

    *: Total indicator reading

    C

    VALVE LIFTER
    Unit: mm (in)

    Items

    Standard

    Valve lifter outer diameter

    29.977 — 29.987 (1.1802 — 1.1806)

    Valve lifter hole diameter

    28 — 28.4 (1.024 — 1.1181)

    Valve lifter clearance

    D

    E

    0.013 — 0.044 (0.0005 — 0.0017)

    VALVE CLEARANCE
    Unit: mm (in)

    Cold1

    Hot 2

    Intake

    0.26 — 0.34 (0.010 — 0.013)

    0.304 — 0.416 (0.012 — 0.016)

    Exhaust

    0.29 — 0.37 (0.011 — 0.015)

    0.308 — 0.432 (0.012 — 0.017)

    1:Approximately

    20°C (68°F)

    2:Approximately

    80°C (176°F)

    F

    G

    H

    AVAILABLE VALVE LIFTER
    Unit: mm (in)

    Identification mark (A)

    I

    Thickness (B)

    J

    K

    L

    JPBIA0170ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    300

    3.00 (0.1181)

    302

    3.02 (0.1189)

    304

    3.04 (0.1197)

    306

    3.06 (0.1205)

    308

    3.08 (0.1213)

    310

    3.10 (0.1220)

    312

    3.12 (0.1228)

    314

    3.14 (0.1236)

    316

    3.16 (0.1244)

    318

    3.18 (0.1252)

    320

    3.20 (0.1260)

    322

    3.22 (0.1268)

    324

    3.24 (0.1276)

    EM-117

    M

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Identification mark (A)

    Thickness (B)

    326

    3.26 (0.1283)

    328

    3.28 (0.1291)

    330

    3.30 (0.1299)

    332

    3.32 (0.1307)

    334

    3.34 (0.1315)

    336

    3.36 (0.1323)

    338

    3.38 (0.1331)

    340

    3.40 (0.1339)

    342

    3.42 (0.1346)

    344

    3.44 (0.1354)

    346

    3.46 (0.1362)

    348

    3.48 (0.1370)

    350

    3.50 (0.1378)

    Cylinder head

    INFOID:0000000009444888

    CYLINDER HEAD
    Unit: mm (in)

    Items

    Limit

    Head surface distortion

    0.1 (0.004)

    VALVE DIMENSIONS
    Unit: mm (in)

    PBIC3878E

    Valve head diameter “D”

    Valve length “a”

    “b”

    “c”

    “c′”

    “d ”

    Valve seat angle “α”

    Revision: April 2013

    Intake

    31.6 — 31.9 (1.244 — 1.256)

    Exhaust

    25.3 — 25.6 (0.996 — 1.007)

    Intake

    101.73 (4.01)

    Exhaust

    102.49 (4.04)

    Intake

    1.0 (0.0393)

    Exhaust

    1.0 (0.0393)

    Intake

    2.1 — 2.8 (0.0826 — 0.1102)

    Exhaust

    2.3 — 3.0 (0.0905 — 0.1181)

    Intake

    3.0 (0.1181)

    Exhaust

    Intake

    4.965 — 4.980 (0.1954 — 0.1960)

    Exhaust

    4.955 — 4.970 (0.1950 — 0.1956)

    Intake

    45°15′ — 45°45′

    Exhaust

    EM-118

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    VALVE GUIDE

    Unit: mm (in)

    A

    EM

    C

    D
    PBIC0184E

    Items
    Outer diameter

    Valve guide

    Standard part

    Service part

    9.023 — 9.034 (0.3552 — 0.3556)

    9.223 — 9.234 (0.3631 — 0.3635)

    Inner diameter (Finished size)

    Cylinder head valve guide hole diameter

    5.000 — 5.018 (0.1968 — 0.1975)
    8.975 — 9.001 (0.3533 — 0.3544)

    Interference fit of valve guide

    F

    0.022 — 0.059 (0.0009 — 0.0023)

    Items
    Valve guide clearance

    9.175 — 9.201 (0.3612 — 0.3622)

    E

    G

    Standard

    Limit

    Intake

    0.020 — 0.053 (0.0008 — 0.0021)

    0.1 (0.004)

    Exhaust

    0.030 — 0.063 (0.0012 — 0.0025)

    0.1 (0.004)

    Projection length “L”

    H

    11.4 — 11.8 (0.448 — 0.464)

    VALVE SEAT
    Unit: mm (in)

    I

    J

    K

    L
    PBIC2745E

    Items
    Cylinder head seat recess diameter “D”

    Valve seat outer diameter “d”

    Valve seat interference fit
    Diameter “d1”*1
    Diameter “d2”*2
    Angle “α1”

    Revision: April 2013

    Standard

    Oversize [0.5 (0.02)] (Service)

    29.75 — 30.25 (1.1713 — 1.1909)

    30.43 — 30.73 (1.1980 — 1.2098)

    Exhaust

    25.991 — 26.007 (1.0233 — 1.0239)

    26.491 — 26.507 (1.0430 — 1.0436)

    Intake

    32.108 — 32.124 (1.2641 — 1.2647)

    32.608 — 32.624 (1.2838 — 1.2844)

    23.65 — 24.15 (.9311 — .9508)

    23.69 — 26.007 (.9327 — 1.0239)

    Intake

    Exhaust
    Intake

    0.081 — 0.124 (0.0032 — 0.0049)

    Exhaust

    0.064 — 0.107 (0.0025 — 0.0042)

    Intake

    21.7 — 22.1 (.8543 — .8701)

    Intake

    31.2 — 31.4 (1.228 — 1.236)

    Exhaust

    24.9 — 25.1 (0.980 — 0.988)

    Intake

    60°

    Exhaust

    45°

    EM-119

    N

    O

    27.8 — 28.2 (1.0945 — 1.1102)

    Exhaust

    M

    P

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Angle “α2”

    Angle “α3”

    Intake

    88°45′ — 90°15′

    Exhaust

    88°45′ — 90°15′

    Intake

    120°

    Exhaust

    120°

    Intake

    Contacting width “W”*3
    Height “h”

    Depth “H”

    1.44 — 2.1 (0.0567 — .0827)

    Exhaust

    1.1 — 1.9 (.0433 — .0748) or 0.9 — 2.1 (.0354 — .0827)

    Intake

    4.7 (0.185)

    4.15 (0.163)

    Exhaust

    6.0 (0.236)

    5.43 (0.213)

    Intake

    4.7 (0.185)

    Exhaust

    6.0 (0.236)

    *1: Diameter made by intersection point of conic angles α1 and α2
    *2: Diameter made by intersection point of conic angles α2 and α3
    *3: Machining data

    VALVE SPRING
    Free height

    46.73 mm (1.8398 in)

    Installation height

    32.40 mm (1.2756 in)

    Installation load

    136 — 154 N (13.9 — 15.7 kg, 30.6 — 34.6 lb)

    Height during valve open

    23.96 mm (0.9433 in)

    Load with valve open

    242 — 272 N (24.7 — 27.7 kg, 54.4 — 61.1 lb)

    Cylinder Block

    INFOID:0000000009444889

    CYLINDER BLOCK
    Unit: mm (in)

    PBIC3924E

    Surface distortion
    Cylinder bore

    Limit
    Inner diameter

    Out-of-round (Difference between “X” and “Y”)
    Taper (Difference between “A” and “C”)

    Revision: April 2013

    0.1 (0.004)

    Standard

    78.000 — 78.015 (3.0709 — 3.0715)

    Wear limit


    0.015 (0.0006)

    Limit

    0.010 (0.0004)

    EM-120

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Cylinder block main bearing housing inner diameter grade*

    Difference in inner diameter between cylinders

    51.997 — 51.998 (2.0471 — 2.0472)
    51.998 — 51.999 (2.0472 — 2.0472)
    51.999 — 52.000 (2.0472 — 2.0472)
    52.000 — 52.001 (2.0472 — 2.0473)
    52.001 — 52.002 (2.0473 — 2.0473)
    52.002 — 52.003 (2.0473 — 2.0474)
    52.003 — 52.004 (2.0474 — 2.0474)
    52.004 — 52.005 (2.0474 — 2.0474)
    52.005 — 52.006 (2.0474 — 2.0475)
    52.006 — 52.007 (2.0475 — 2.0475)
    52.007 — 52.008 (2.0475 — 2.0475)
    52.008 — 52.009 (2.0476 — 2.0476)
    52.009 — 52.010 (2.0476 — 2.0476)
    52.010 — 52.011 (2.0476 — 2.0477)
    52.011 — 52.012 (2.0477 — 2.0477)
    52.012 — 52.013 (2.0477 — 2.0478)
    52.013 — 52.014 (2.0478 — 2.0478)
    52.014 — 52.015 (2.0478 — 2.0478)
    52.015 — 52.016 (2.0478 — 2.0479)
    52.016 — 52.017 (2.0479 — 2.0479)

    Grade No. A
    Grade No. B
    Grade No. C
    Grade No. D
    Grade No. E
    Grade No. F
    Grade No. G
    Grade No. H
    Grade No. J
    Grade No. K
    Grade No. L
    Grade No. M
    Grade No. N
    Grade No. P
    Grade No. R
    Grade No. S
    Grade No. T
    Grade No. U
    Grade No. V
    Grade No. W

    Standard

    Less than 0.03 (0.0012)

    A

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    * : Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    G

    AVAILABLE PISTON
    Unit: mm (in)

    H

    I

    J

    K

    PBIC0188E

    Piston skirt diameter “A”

    77.965 — 77.980 (3.0694 — 3.0700)

    Piston height “H” dimension

    37.1 (1.460)

    Piston pin hole diameter

    19.006 — 19.012 (0.7482 — 0.7485)

    Piston to cylinder bore clearance

    L

    0.020 — 0.050 (0.0008 — 0.0020)

    M

    PISTON RING
    Unit: mm (in)

    Items

    Side clearance

    Standard

    Limit

    Top

    0.04 — 0.08 (0.0016 — 0.0031)

    0.11 (0.0043)

    2nd

    0.03 — 0.07 (0.0012 — 0.0028)

    0.10 (0.0039)

    0.045 — 0.125 (0.0018 — 0.0049)

    Top

    0.20 — 0.30 (0.0079 — 0.0118)

    2nd

    0.35 — 0.50 (0.0138 — 0.0197)

    Oil (rail ring)

    0.20 — 0.45 (0.0079 — 0.0177)

    Oil (rail ring)

    End gap

    N

    O

    P

    PISTON PIN
    Unit: mm (in)

    Piston pin outer diameter

    18.999 — 19.002 (0.7480 — 0.7481)

    Piston to piston pin oil clearance

    Standard

    0.010 — 0.014 (0.0004 — 0.0006)

    Connecting rod bushing oil clearance

    Standard

    –0.018 to –0.044 (–0.0007 to –0.0017)

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-121

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    CONNECTING ROD

    Unit: mm (in)

    Center distance

    129.84 — 129.94 (5.1118 — 5.1157)

    Bend [per 100 (3.94)]

    Limit

    0.15 (0.0059)

    Torsion [per 100 (3.94)]

    Limit

    0.30 (0.0118)

    Connecting rod bushing inner diameter*1

    18.958 — 18.978 (0.7463 — 0.7471)

    Side clearance

    Standard

    Connecting rod big end diameter grade*2

    Grade No. A
    Grade No. B
    Grade No. C
    Grade No. D
    Grade No. E
    Grade No. F
    Grade No. G
    Grade No. H
    Grade No. J
    Grade No. K
    Grade No. L
    Grade No. M
    Grade No. N

    0.200 — 0.352 (0.0079 — 0.0138)
    43.000 — 43.001 (1.6929 — 1.6929)
    43.001 — 43.002 (1.6929 — 1.6930)
    43.002 — 43.003 (1.6930 — 1.6930)
    43.003 — 43.004 (1 6930 — 1.6931)
    43.004 — 43.005 (1.6931 — 1.6931)
    43.005 — 43.006 (1.6931 — 1.6931)
    43.006 — 43.007 (1.6931 — 1.6932)
    43.007 — 43.008 (1.6932 — 1.6932)
    43.008 — 43.009 (1.6932 — 1.6933)
    43.009 — 43.010 (1.6933 — 1.6933)
    43.010 — 43.011 (1.6933 — 1.6933)
    43.011 — 43.012 (1.6933 — 1.6934)
    43.012 — 43.013 (1.6934 — 1.6934)

    *1 : After installing in connecting rod
    *2 : Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    CRANKSHAFT
    Unit: mm (in)

    PBIC3459J
    SEM645

    Center distance “r”

    41.68 — 41.76 (1.6409 — 1.6441)

    Out-of-round

    Limit

    0.003 (0.0001)

    Taper

    Limit

    0.004 (0.0002)

    Runout [TIR*1]

    Limit

    0.10 (0.0039)

    Crankshaft end play

    Revision: April 2013

    Standard

    0.098 — 0.260 (0.0039 — 0.0102)

    Limit

    0.35 (0.0138)

    EM-122

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Crankshaft pin journal diameter grade.*2“Dp”*3

    Crankshaft main journal diameter grade.*2
    “Dm”*4

    Grade No. A
    Grade No. B
    Grade No. C
    Grade No. D
    Grade No. E
    Grade No. F
    Grade No. G
    Grade No. H
    Grade No. J
    Grade No. K
    Grade No. L
    Grade No. M
    Grade No. N
    Grade No. P
    Grade No. R
    Grade No. S
    Grade No. T
    Grade No. U

    39.970 — 39.971 (1.5736 — 1.5737)
    39.969 — 39.970 (1.5736 — 1.5736)
    39.968 — 39.969 (1.5735 — 1.5736)
    39.967 — 39.968 (1.5735 — 1.5735)
    39.966 — 39.967 (1.5735 — 1.5735)
    39.965 — 39.966 (1.5734 — 1.5735)
    39.964 — 39.965 (1.5734 — 1.5734)
    39.963 — 39.964 (1.5733 — 1.5734)
    39.962 — 39.963 (1.5733 — 1.5733)
    39.961 — 39.962 (1.5733 — 1.5733)
    39.960 — 39.961 (1.5732 — 1.5733)
    39.959 — 39.960 (1.5732 — 1.5732)
    39.958 — 39.959 (1.5731 — 1.5732)
    39.957 — 39.958 (1.5731 — 1.5731)
    39.956 — 39.957 (1.5731 — 1.5731)
    39.955 — 39.956 (1.5730 — 1.5731)
    39.954 — 39.955 (1.5730 — 1.5730)
    39.953 — 39.954 (1.5729 — 1.5730)

    Grade No. A
    Grade No. B
    Grade No. C
    Grade No. D
    Grade No. E
    Grade No. F
    Grade No. G
    Grade No. H
    Grade No. J
    Grade No. K
    Grade No. L
    Grade No. M
    Grade No. N
    Grade No. P
    Grade No. R
    Grade No. S
    Grade No. T
    Grade No. U
    Grade No. V
    Grade No. W

    47.978 — 47.979 (1.8889 — 1.8889)
    47.977 — 47.978 (1.8889 — 1.8889)
    47.976 — 47.977 (1.8888 — 1.8889)
    47.975 — 47.976 (1.8888 — 1.8888)
    47.974 — 47.975 (1.8887 — 1.8888)
    47.973 — 47.974 (1.8887 — 1.8887)
    47.972 — 47.973 (1.8887 — 1.8887)
    47.971 — 47.972 (1.8886 — 1.8886)
    47.970 — 47.971 (1.8886 — 1.8886)
    47.969 — 47.970 (1.8885 — 1.8886)
    47.968 — 47.969 (1.8885 — 1.8885)
    47.967 — 47.968 (1.8885 — 1.8885)
    47.966 — 47.967 (1.8884 — 1.8885)
    47.965 — 47.966 (1.8884 — 1.8884)
    47.964 — 47.965 (1.8883 — 1.8884)
    47.963 — 47.964 (1.8883 — 1.8883)
    47.962 — 47.963 (1.8883 — 1.8883)
    47.961 — 47.962 (1.8882 — 1.8883)
    47.960 — 47.961 (1.8882 — 1.8882)
    47.959 — 47.960 (1.8881 — 1.8882)

    A

    EM

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    *1: Total indicator reading
    *2: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    *3: Grade No. B through U reflects less than maximum specification.

    L

    *4: Grade No. B through W reflects less than maximum specification.

    Main Bearing

    INFOID:0000000009444890

    M

    MAIN BEARING

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-123

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Unit: mm (in)

    SEM685D

    Grade number*

    Thickness

    Identification color

    0

    1.996 — 1.999 (0.0786 — 0.0787)

    Black

    1

    1.999 — 2.002 (0.0787 — 0.0788)

    Brown

    2

    2.002 — 2.005 (0.0788 — 0.0789)

    Green

    3

    2.005 — 2.008 (0.0789 — 0.0791)

    Yellow

    4

    2.008 — 2.011 (0.0791 — 0.0792)

    Blue

    5

    2.011 — 2.014 (0.0792 — 0.0793)

    Pink

    1.996 — 1.999 (0.0786 — 0.0787)

    Black

    UPR

    01

    12

    23

    34

    45

    LWR

    1.999 — 2.002 (0.0787 — 0.0788)

    Brown

    UPR

    1.999 — 2.002 (0.0787 — 0.0788)

    Brown

    LWR

    2.002 — 2.005 (0.0788 — 0.0789)

    Green

    UPR

    2.002 — 2.005 (0.0788 — 0.0789)

    Green

    LWR

    2.005 — 2.008 (0.0789 — 0.0791)

    Yellow

    UPR

    2.005 — 2.008 (0.0789 — 0.0791)

    Yellow

    LWR

    2.008 — 2.011 (0.0791 — 0.0792)

    Blue

    UPR

    2.008 — 2.011 (0.0791 — 0.0792)

    Blue

    LWR

    2.011 — 2.014 (0.0792 — 0.0793)

    Pink

    Remarks

    Grade and color are the same
    for upper and lower bearings.

    Grade and color are different
    for upper and lower bearings.

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    Undersize
    Unit: mm (in)

    Items

    Thickness

    Main journal diameter

    US 0.25 (0.0098)

    2.126 — 2.134 (0.0837 — 0.0840)

    Grind so that bearing clearance is the specified value.

    Standard

    0.024 — 0.034 (0.0009 — 0.0013)

    Bearing Oil Clearance
    Unit: mm (in)

    Main bearing oil clearance

    Connecting Rod Bearing

    INFOID:0000000009444891

    CONNECTING ROD BEARING
    Unit: mm (in)

    Grade number*

    Thickness

    Identification color

    1

    1.501 — 1.504 (0.0591 — 0.0592)

    Brown

    2

    1.504 — 1.507 (0.0592 — 0.0593)

    Green

    3

    1.507 — 1.510 (0.0593 — 0.0594)

    Yellow

    4

    1.510 — 1.513 (0.0594 — 0.0596)

    Blue

    5

    1.513 — 1.516 (0.0596 — 0.0597)

    Pink

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-124

    Remarks

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    12

    23

    34

    56

    UPR

    1.501 — 1.504 (0.0591 — 0.0592)

    Brown

    LWR

    1.504 — 1.507 (0.0592 — 0.0593)

    Green

    UPR

    1.504 — 1.507 (0.0592 — 0.0593)

    Green

    LWR

    1.507 — 1.510 (0.0593 — 0.0594)

    Yellow

    UPR

    1.507 — 1.510 (0.0593 — 0.0594)

    Yellow

    LWR

    1.510 — 1.513 (0.0594 — 0.0596)

    Blue

    UPR

    1.513 — 1.516 (0.0596 — 0.0597)

    Pink

    LWR

    1.516 — 1.519 (0.0597 — 0.0598)

    Purple

    A
    Grade and color are different
    between upper and lower bearings.

    EM

    C

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    D

    Undersize
    Unit: mm (in)

    E

    Items

    Thickness

    Crankshaft pin journal diameter

    US 0.25 (0.0098)

    1.627 — 1.635 (0.0640 — 0.0644)

    Grind so that bearing clearance is the specified value.

    Bearing Oil Clearance
    Unit: mm (in)

    Connecting rod bearing oil clearance

    Standard

    F

    0.020 — 0.030 (0.0008 — 0.0012)

    Limit

    G

    0.10 (0.0039)

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EM-125

    2014 Note

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    EX

    EXHAUST SYSTEM

    A

    EX

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    Commercial Service Tool ………………………………….. 3

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ……………………. 4

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    EXHAUST SYSTEM ……………………………………. 4

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 5

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3

    EXHAUST SYSTEM ……………………………………. 5

    F

    G

    Inspection ……………………………………………………….. 4

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 5

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EX-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009405630

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least 3 minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    EX-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009405631

    EX

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV10114400
    (J-38365-N1)
    Heated oxygen sensor wrench

    Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors:
    a: 22 mm (0.87 in)

    C

    D

    E
    S-NT636

    F

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009405632

    G

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-43897-18)
    (J-43897-12)
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner

    Reconditioning the exhaust system threads
    before installing a new oxygen sensor (Use
    with anti-seize lubricant shown below):
    a: J-43897-18 (18 mm dia.) for zirconia oxygen sensor
    b: J-43897-12 (12 mm dia.) for titania oxygen sensor
    AEM488

    Anti-seize lubricant (Permatex 133AR
    or equivalent meeting MIL specification MIL-A-907)

    Lubricating oxygen sensor thread cleaning
    tool when reconditioning exhaust system
    threads

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    AEM489

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    M

    N
    PIIB1407E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EX-3

    2014 Note

    EXHAUST SYSTEM
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    EXHAUST SYSTEM
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009405633

    Check exhaust pipes, muffler, and mounting for improper attachment, leaks, cracks, damage or deterioration.
    • If anything is found, repair or replace damaged parts.

    SMA211A

    Revision: April 2013

    EX-4

    2014 Note

    EXHAUST SYSTEM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    EXHAUST SYSTEM
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015345

    EX

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JPBIA6358GB

    1.

    Seal bearing

    2.

    Spring

    3.

    Heated oxygen sensor 2

    4.

    Front Exhaust tube

    5.

    Seal bearing

    6.

    Mounting rubber

    7.

    Center muffler

    8.

    Ring gasket

    9.

    Main muffler

    A.

    To Exhaust manifold

    K

    WARNING:
    • Perform the procedures with the exhaust system fully cooled down to avoid injury from the hot
    exhaust system.
    • Be careful not to cut your hand on the insulator edge.
    CAUTION:
    Use genuine NISSAN exhaust system parts or equivalent, which are specifically designed for heat
    resistance, corrosion resistance, and shape.

    REMOVAL
    • Disconnect each joint and mounting.
    • Remove heated oxygen sensor 2 (1) using Tool (A).
    Tool number

    M

    N

    O

    : KV10114400 (J-38365-N1)
    P

    : Front

    ALBIA1136ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    EX-5

    2014 Note

    EXHAUST SYSTEM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse gasket.
    • Do not reuse seal bearing.
    • Discard any heated oxygen sensor 2 which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
    in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor. Use a new one.
    • Before installing a new heated oxygen sensor 2, clean exhaust system threads using a suitable tool
    and apply anti-seize lubricant.
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner
    Oxygen sensor thread cleaner

    : J-43897-12
    : J-43897-18

    • Do not over tighten heated oxygen sensor 2. Doing so may cause damage to the heated oxygen sensor 2, resulting in the “MIL” coming on.
    • Prevent rust preventives from adhering to the sensor body.
    • If heat insulator is badly deformed, repair or replace it. If deposits such as mud pile up on the heat
    insulator, remove them.
    • When installing heat insulator avoid large gaps or interference between heat insulator and each
    exhaust pipe.
    • Remove deposits from the sealing surface of each connection. Connect them securely to avoid
    exhaust gas leaks.
    • When installing each mounting rubber, use silicon oil to avoid twisting.
    • Temporarily tighten nuts and bolts. Check each part for unusual interference and mounting rubber
    interference, and then tighten them to the specified torque.
    • When installing each mounting rubber, avoid twisting or unusual extension in up/down, front/rear
    and right/left directions.
    Exhaust Manifold to Exhaust Front Tube

    1.

    Place a piece of wood (A) on seal bearing (2) and securely
    insert the seal bearing on the exhaust manifold (1) side, using a
    plastic hammer (B).
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage the seal bearing surface during insertion.
    • If seal bearing is inserted by hammering directly without
    using a piece of wood, the seal bearing is deformed and
    exhaust gas leaks. To insert seal bearing, always use a
    piece of wood and insert straight.
    JPBIA6288ZZ

    2.

    Check that seal bearing (1) is in absolute contact (C) with the
    flange (A). If there is clearance (B), insert seal bearing straight
    by hand to bring the seal bearing into absolute contact with the
    flange.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not use a tool for insertion.
    • Do not insert seal bearing by tightening exhaust front
    tube.

    JPBIA6289ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EX-6

    2014 Note

    EXHAUST SYSTEM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. With spring (3), tighten nut (4).
    CAUTION:
    • Ensure springs are seated correctly on the flange and not
    sitting on locator dimple (A).
    • Be careful that stud bolt does not interfere with mounting
    hole of exhaust front tube ( ).

    4.

    (1)

    : Spring

    (2)

    : Seal bearing

    (5)

    : Bolt

    (6)

    : Front exhaust tube

    A

    EX

    C
    AWBIA1528ZZ

    D

    After installing, check that bolt does not interfere with mounting hole of exhaust front tube.

    Exhaust Front Tube to Center Muffler

    1.

    2.

    3.

    E

    Securely insert seal bearing (2) into exhaust front tube (1).
    (3)

    : Spring

    (4)

    : Bolt

    (5)

    : Center muffler

    F

    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage seal bearing surface when installing.
    With spring, tighten bolt.
    CAUTION:
    • Ensure springs are seated correctly on the flange and not
    sitting on locator dimple (A).
    • Be careful that bolt does not interfere with mounting hole of center muffler.
    After installing, check that bolt does not interfere with mounting hole of center muffler.

    G

    AWBIA1529ZZ

    H

    I

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • With the engine running, check the exhaust tube joints for exhaust gas leaks and unusual noises.
    • Check that the mounting brackets and mounting insulators are installed properly and free from excessive
    stress. Improper installation could result in excessive noise, leaks, and vibration.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EX-7

    2014 Note

    DRIVER CONTROLS

    SECTION

    EXL

    EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 4
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 4
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 4
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 4

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 5
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 5
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 5

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 6

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER
    AND TAIL LAMP SYSTEM : System Description ….10
    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER
    AND TAIL LAMP SYSTEM : Fail-safe …………………11
    FRONT FOG LAMP SYSTEM ……………………………..11
    FRONT FOG LAMP SYSTEM : System Description …………………………………………………………………12
    FRONT FOG LAMP SYSTEM : Fail-safe …………….12
    EXTERIOR LAMP BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM …….12
    EXTERIOR LAMP BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM :
    System Description …………………………………………..13

    F

    G

    H

    I

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………… 14

    J

    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 6
    Daytime Running Light Relay ……………………………… 7
    Hazard Switch ………………………………………………….. 7

    COMMON ITEM …………………………………………………14
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) ……………………………………………..14

    K

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 8

    HEADLAMP ………………………………………………………14
    HEADLAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — HEAD
    LAMP) …………………………………………………………….15

    EXL

    FLASHER ………………………………………………………….15
    FLASHER : CONSULT Function (BCM — FLASHER) ………………………………………………………………..15

    M

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 6

    HEADLAMP SYSTEM …………………………………………. 8
    HEADLAMP SYSTEM : System Description …………. 8
    HEADLAMP SYSTEM : Fail-safe ………………………… 8
    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) ……………. 9
    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) : System Diagram …………………………………………………….. 9
    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) : System Description ………………………………………………… 9
    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM …………………… 9
    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : System
    Description ………………………………………………………. 9
    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMP
    SYSTEM ………………………………………………………….. 10
    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMP
    SYSTEM : System Description …………………………. 10
    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND
    TAIL LAMP SYSTEM ………………………………………… 10

    Revision: April 2013

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R) ………………. 17
    Diagnosis Description ……………………………………….17
    CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R) ………………………..18

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 21

    N

    O

    BCM, IPDM E/R …………………………………………. 21
    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………21

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 22
    HEADLAMP ……………………………………………… 22
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..22

    DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM …………………………. 27
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..27

    EXL-1

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT FOG LAMP ……………………………………. 32

    FRONT FOG LAMP CIRCUIT ……………………… 89

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 32

    Component Function Check …………………………….. 89
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 89
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 91

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING
    LAMPS ……………………………………………………… 37
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 37

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL
    LAMPS ……………………………………………………… 43
    Wiring Diagram-With Daytime Light System ……….. 43
    Wiring Diagram-Without Daytime Light System …… 50

    STOP LAMP ……………………………………………… 57
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 57

    BACK-UP LAMP ………………………………………… 61
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 61

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) …… 65
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 65

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 70
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ……… 70
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………… 70

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 73
    HEADLAMP (HI) CIRCUIT ………………………….. 73
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 73
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 73

    HEADLAMP (LO) CIRCUIT …………………………. 75
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 75
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 75

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) …… 77
    Description …………………………………………………….. 77
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 77

    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY CIRCUIT
    … 79
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 79
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 79
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 80

    PARKING LAMP CIRCUIT ………………………….. 81
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 81
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 81

    TAIL LAMP CIRCUIT ………………………………….. 83

    HAZARD SWITCH ……………………………………… 92
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 92
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 92

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 94
    EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS… 94
    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM … 94
    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM
    : Symptom Table …………………………………………….. 94
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM ……….. 95
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM :
    Symptom Table ………………………………………………. 95

    BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (HI) ARE NOT
    TURNED ON ……………………………………………… 98
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM ……….. 98
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Description …………………………………………………………. 98
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………….. 98
    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM … 98
    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM
    : Description …………………………………………………… 98
    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM
    : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 98

    BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (LO) ARE NOT
    TURNED ON …………………………………………….. 100
    Description …………………………………………………… 100
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 100

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER
    AND TAIL LAMPS ARE NOT TURNED ON …. 101
    Description …………………………………………………… 101
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 101

    BOTH SIDE FRONT FOG LAMPS ARE NOT
    TURNED ON …………………………………………….. 102
    Description …………………………………………………… 102
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 102

    Component Function Check …………………………….. 83
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 83

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………. 103

    LICENSE PLATE LAMP CIRCUIT ……………….. 85

    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 103
    Aiming Adjustment Procedure ………………………… 104

    Component Function Check …………………………….. 85
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 85

    TURN SIGNAL LAMP CIRCUIT …………………… 86
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 86
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 86

    Revision: April 2013

    HEADLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT ………….. 103

    FRONT FOG LAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT .. 106
    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 106
    Aiming Adjustment Procedure ………………………… 106

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………. 108

    EXL-2

    2014 Note

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP …………………… 108
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 108
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 108
    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………. 108

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 117
    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………. 117

    A

    LICENSE PLATE LAMP …………………………… 118
    B

    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 110
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 110
    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………. 110

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 118
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 118
    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………. 118

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY . 119

    C

    COMBINATION SWITCH …………………………… 112

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP …………………. 119

    FRONT FOG LAMP …………………………………… 110

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 112

    HAZARD SWITCH …………………………………….. 113
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 113
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 113

    HEADLAMP AIMING SWITCH …………………… 114
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 114
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 114

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP …………………….. 115
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 115
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 115
    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………. 115

    HIGH-MOUNTED STOP LAMP …………………… 117

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 119
    Disassembly and Assembly …………………………….. 119

    D

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP ……………………. 121
    Exploded View — Non LED ………………………………. 121
    Disassembly and Assembly — Non LED …………….. 121
    Exploded View — LED ……………………………………… 122
    Disassembly and Assembly — LED …………………… 122

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………. 123
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………… 123
    Bulb specification …………………………………………… 123

    E

    F

    G

    H

    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 117
    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-3

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009606279

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009606280

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-4

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009445896

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    TrimTool Set

    Removing trim components

    C

    D

    E
    AWJIA0483ZZ

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-5

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009472848

    ALLIA1287ZZ

    No.

    Part

    Function

    1.

    Hazard switch

    Refer to EXL-10, «TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMP SYSTEM : System Description».

    2.

    Combination meter

    Refer to MWI-7, «METER SYSTEM : System Description».

    3.

    Combination switch
    (Lighting & turn signal switch)

    Refer to EXL-10, «TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMP SYSTEM : System Description».

    4.

    Headlamp aiming switch

    Refer to EXL-9, «HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) : System Description».

    5.

    BCM

    Refer to BCS-5, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    6.

    7.

    Part

    IPDM E/R

    Stop lamp switch

    Function
    • Controls the integrated relay, and supplies voltage to the load according to the request from BCM (via CAN communication).
    • Refer to PCS-5, «RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description» for detailed
    installation location.

    A

    B

    Refer to EXL-10, «PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND TAIL LAMP
    SYSTEM : System Description».

    C

    Daytime Running Light Relay

    INFOID:0000000009472850

    Daytime running light relay ground circuit is switched according to request from IPDM E/R.

    Hazard Switch

    D
    INFOID:0000000009472851

    Inputs the hazard switch ON/OFF signal to BCM.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-7

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    HEADLAMP SYSTEM
    HEADLAMP SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009472853

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JPLIA0167GB

    OUTLINE
    Headlamp is controlled by combination switch reading function and headlamp control function of BCM, and
    relay control function of IPDM E/R.

    HEADLAMP (LO) OPERATION
    • BCM detects the combination switch condition with the combination switch reading function.
    • BCM transmits the low beam request signal to IPDM E/R with CAN communication according to the headlamp (LO) ON condition.
    Headlamp (LO) ON condition

    Lighting switch 2ND
    Lighting switch AUTO (auto light function ON judgment)
    Lighting switch AUTO, with the front fog lamp switch ON and the ignition switch ON
    Lighting switch PASS
    IPDM E/R turns the integrated headlamp low relay ON, and turns the headlamp ON according to the low
    beam request signal.

    HEADLAMP (HI) OPERATION
    • BCM transmits the high beam request signal to IPDM E/R and the combination meter with CAN communication according to the headlamp (HI) ON condition.
    Headlamp (HI) ON condition


    Lighting switch HI with the lighting switch 2ND or AUTO (auto light function ON judgment)
    Lighting switch PASS
    Lighting switch AUTO, with the front fog lamp switch ON, the ignition switch ON and lighting switch HI
    Combination meter turns the high beam indicator lamp ON according to the high beam request signal.
    IPDM E/R turns the integrated headlamp high relay ON, and turns the headlamp ON according to the high
    beam request signal.

    HEADLAMP SYSTEM : Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009472855

    CAN COMMUNICATION CONTROL
    When CAN communication with ECM and BCM is impossible, IPDM E/R performs fail-safe control. After CAN
    communication recovers normally, it also returns to normal control.
    If No CAN Communication Is Available With BCM

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-8

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Control part
    Headlamp

    Fail-safe operation

    A

    • Turns ON the headlamp low relay when the ignition switch is turned ON
    • Turns OFF the headlamp low relay when the ignition switch is turned OFF
    • Headlamp high relay OFF

    B

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) : System Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009549365

    C

    D

    E

    AWLIA0023GB

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL) : System Description

    F

    INFOID:0000000009549366

    The headlamp aiming system (manual) controls the headlamp light axis height according to input from the
    headlamp aiming switch. The variable internal resistance of the headlamp aiming switch controls the signal
    ground of the headlamp aiming motors located on the front combination lamp LH and RH. The headlamp aiming system operates when the combination switch (lighting and turn signal switch) is in the 2nd position.

    G

    H

    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM

    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009472860

    I

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N
    AWLIA2141GB

    OUTLINE
    • Daytime running lamp is controlled by daytime running lamp control function and combination switch reading
    function of BCM, and relay control function of IPDM E/R.

    DAYTIME RUNNING LAMP OPERATION
    • BCM detects the combination switch condition by the combination switch reading function.
    • BCM detects the engine condition according to push-button ignition switch
    • BCM detects the parking brake condition by the parking brake switch signal received from combination
    meter using CAN communication.
    • BCM transmits the daytime running lamp request signal to IPDM E/R using CAN communication according
    to the daytime running lamp ON condition.
    Daytime running light ON condition

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-9

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    — Engine running
    — Lighting switch OFF or 1ST
    — Lighting switch AUTO, and the auto light function OFF judgment
    — Parking brake switch OFF
    • IPDM E/R controls the daytime running lamp relay (ground-side) to turn ON according to the daytime running lamp request signal.
    • Power is supplied from the daytime running lamp to the daytime running lamps.

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMP SYSTEM

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMP SYSTEM : System Description
    INFOID:0000000009472862

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    AWLIA1721GB

    OUTLINE
    Turn signal and the hazard warning lamp is controlled by combination switch reading function, flasher control
    function and auto hazard function of BCM.

    TURN SIGNAL LAMP OPERATION
    • BCM detects the combination switch condition by the combination switch reading function.
    • BCM supplies voltage to the right (left) turn signal lamp circuit when the ignition switch is turned ON and the
    turn signal switch is in the right (left) position. BCM blinks the turn signal lamp.

    HAZARD WARNING LAMP OPERATION
    BCM supplies voltage to both turn signal lamp circuit when the hazard switch is turned ON. BCM blinks the
    hazard warning lamp.

    HIGH FLASHER OPERATION
    • BCM detects the turn signal lamp circuit status from the current value.
    • BCM increases the turn signal lamp blinking speed if the bulb or harness open is detected with the turn signal lamp operating.
    NOTE:
    The blinking speed is normal while operating the hazard warning lamp.

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND TAIL LAMP SYSTEM

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND TAIL LAMP SYSTEM : System De-

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-10

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    scription

    INFOID:0000000009472864

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    B

    C

    D

    E

    JMLIA1349GB

    F

    OUTLINE
    Parking, license plate, side marker and tail lamps are controlled by combination switch reading function and
    headlamp control function of BCM, and relay control function of IPDM E/R.

    G

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND TAIL LAMPS OPERATION
    • BCM detects the combination switch condition by the combination switch reading function.
    • BCM transmits the position light request signal to IPDM E/R and the combination meter via CAN communication according to the ON/OFF condition of the parking, license plate, side marker (Without Daytime running lamps) and tail lamps.

    H

    I

    Parking, license plate, side marker and tail lamps ON condition

    Lighting switch 1ST
    Lighting switch 2ND
    Lighting switch AUTO, and the auto light function ON judgment.
    Lighting switch AUTO, with the front fog lamp switch ON and the ignition switch ON
    IPDM E/R turns the integrated tail lamp relay ON and turns the parking, license plate, side marker (without
    daytime running lamps) and tail lamps ON according to the position light request signal.
    • Combination meter turns the tail lamp indicator lamp ON according to the position light request signal.

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND TAIL LAMP SYSTEM : Fail-safe
    INFOID:0000000009472866

    J

    K

    EXL

    CAN COMMUNICATION CONTROL
    When CAN communication with ECM and BCM is impossible, IPDM E/R performs fail-safe control. After CAN
    communication recovers normally, it also returns to normal control.
    If No CAN Communication Is Available With BCM

    N

    Control part




    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Illumination
    Tail lamp
    Side marker lamp (Without daytime running lamps)

    Fail-safe operation

    O
    • Turns ON the tail lamp relay when the ignition switch is turned ON
    • Turns OFF the tail lamp relay when the ignition switch is turned OFF

    P

    FRONT FOG LAMP SYSTEM

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    EXL-11

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    FRONT FOG LAMP SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009472867

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JMLIA1154GB

    OUTLINE
    Front fog lamp is controlled by combination switch reading function, front fog lamp control function of BCM,
    and relay control function of IPDM E/R.

    FRONT FOG LAMP OPERATION
    • BCM detects the combination switch condition by the combination switch reading function.
    • BCM transmits the front fog light request signal to IPDM E/R via CAN communication according to the front
    fog lamp ON condition.
    Front fog lamp ON condition

    — Front fog lamp switch ON, and any of the following condition is satisfied. (except for the high beam ON)
    • Lighting switch 2ND
    • Lighting switch AUTO (auto light function ON judgment)
    IPDM E/R turns the integrated front fog lamp relay ON, and turns the front fog lamp ON according to the front
    fog light request signal.

    FRONT FOG LAMP SYSTEM : Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009472869

    CAN COMMUNICATION CONTROL
    When CAN communication with ECM and BCM is impossible, IPDM E/R performs fail-safe control. After CAN
    communication recovers normally, it also returns to normal control.
    If No CAN Communication Is Available With BCM
    Control part
    Front fog lamp

    Fail-safe operation
    Front fog lamp relay OFF

    EXTERIOR LAMP BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-12

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    EXTERIOR LAMP BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009472870

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    B

    C

    D

    E

    JPLIA1037GB

    F

    OUTLINE
    • Exterior lamp battery saver system is controlled by each function of BCM and IPDM E/R.

    G

    Control by BCM

    — Combination switch reading function
    — Headlamp control function
    — Exterior lamp battery saver function

    H

    Control by IPDM E/R

    — Relay control function
    • BCM turns the exterior lamps* OFF after a period of time to prevent the battery from over-discharge when
    the ignition switch is turned OFF with the exterior lamps ON.
    *: Headlamp (LO/HI), parking lamp, tail lamp, side marker lamp, license plate lamp and front fog lamp

    EXTERIOR LAMP BATTERY SAVER ACTIVATION

    I

    J

    BCM activates the timer and turns the exterior lamp OFF 5 minutes after the ignition switch is turned from ON
    → OFF with the exterior lamps ON.
    K
    NOTE:
    • Headlamp control function turns the exterior lamps ON normally when the ignition switch is turned ACC or
    ON (both before and after the exterior lamp battery saver is turned OFF).
    • The timer starts at the time that the lighting switch is turned from OFF → 1ST or 2ND with the exterior lamps EXL
    OFF.
    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-13

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009578842

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    HEADLAMP

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    HEADLAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — HEAD LAMP)

    INFOID:0000000009578843

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    B

    Description

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    ENGINE STATE [Stop/Stall/Crank/Run]

    Indicates engine status received from ECM on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 1 [km/h]

    Indicates vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    C

    TURN SIGNAL R [On/Off]

    D

    TURN SIGNAL L [On/Off]
    TAIL LAMP SW [On/Off]
    HI BEAM SW [On/Off]
    HEAD LAMP SW 1 [On/Off]

    E

    Indicates condition of combination switch.

    HEAD LAMP SW 2 [On/Off]
    PASSING SW [On/Off]

    F

    FR FOG SW [On/Off]
    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    G

    H

    ACTIVE TEST

    I

    Test Item

    Description

    FR FOG LAMP

    This test is able to check front fog lamp operation [On/Off].

    HEAD LAMP

    This test is able to check head lamp operation [Hi/Low/Off].

    ILL DIM SIGNAL

    This test is able to check head lamp illumination dimming operation [On/Off].

    TAIL LAMP

    This test is able to check tail lamp operation [On/Off].

    J

    K

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    BATTERY SAVER SET

    ILL DELAY SET

    Setting

    EXL

    Description

    On*

    Exterior lamp battery saver function ON.

    Off

    Exterior lamp battery saver function OFF.

    MODE 8

    180 sec.

    MODE 7

    150 sec.

    MODE 6

    120 sec.

    MODE 4

    60 sec.

    MODE 5

    90 sec.

    MODE 3

    30 sec.

    MODE 2

    OFF

    MODE 1*

    45 sec.

    M

    N
    Sets delay timer function operation time
    (All doors closed).

    O

    P

    *: Initial setting

    FLASHER
    FLASHER : CONSULT Function (BCM — FLASHER)

    INFOID:0000000009578844

    DATA MONITOR
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-15

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    TURN SIGNAL R [On/Off]
    TURN SIGNAL L [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of turn signal function of combination switch.

    HAZARD SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of hazard switch.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    FLASHER

    Description
    This test is able to check turn signal lamp operation [Off/LH/RH].

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item

    Setting

    Description

    Lock/Unlock*

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked or unlocked with
    Intelligent Key.

    Unlock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are unlocked with Intelligent
    Key.

    Lock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked with Intelligent
    Key.

    Off

    No hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked or unlocked
    with Intelligent Key.

    HAZARD ANSWER BACK

    * : Initial setting

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-16

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)

    A

    Diagnosis Description

    INFOID:0000000009578845

    AUTO ACTIVE TEST

    B

    Description
    In auto active test, the IPDM E/R sends a drive signal to the following systems to check their operation.
    • Front wiper (LO, HI)
    • Parking lamp
    • License plate lamp
    • Tail lamp
    • Front fog lamp
    • Headlamp (LO, HI)
    • A/C compressor (magnet clutch)
    • Cooling fan
    Operation Procedure
    NOTE:
    Never perform auto active test in the following conditions.
    • Passenger door is open
    • CONSULT is connected
    1. Close the hood and lift the wiper arms from the windshield. (Prevent windshield damage due to wiper
    operation)
    NOTE:
    When auto active test is performed with hood opened, sprinkle water on windshield beforehand.
    2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    3. Turn the ignition switch ON, and within 20 seconds, press the driver door switch 10 times. Then turn the
    ignition switch OFF.
    4. Turn the ignition switch ON within 10 seconds. After that the horn sounds once and the auto active test
    starts.
    5. After a series of the following operations is repeated 3 times, auto active test is completed.
    NOTE:
    • When auto active test has to be cancelled halfway through test, turn the ignition switch OFF.
    • When auto active test is not activated, door switch may be the cause. Check door switch. Refer to DLK-84,
    «Component Function Check».
    Inspection in Auto Active Test
    When auto active test is actuated, the following operation sequence is repeated 3 times.
    Operation sequence

    Inspection location

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    Operation

    M

    1

    Front wiper

    LO for 5 seconds → HI for 5 seconds

    2




    10 seconds

    3

    Headlamp

    LO for 10 seconds →HI ON ⇔ OFF 5 times

    4

    A/C compressor (magnet clutch)

    ON ⇔ OFF 5 times

    5

    Cooling fan

    LO for 5 seconds → MID for 3 seconds → HI for 2 seconds

    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Tail lamp
    Front fog lamp

    C

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-17

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Concept of Auto Active Test

    JMMIA0812GB

    • IPDM E/R starts the auto active test with the door switch signals transmitted by BCM via CAN communication. Therefore, the CAN communication line between IPDM E/R and BCM is considered normal if the auto
    active test starts successfully.
    • The auto active test facilitates troubleshooting if any systems controlled by IPDM E/R cannot be operated.
    Diagnosis Chart in Auto Active Test
    Symptom





    Inspection contents

    Any of the following components do not operate
    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Tail lamp
    Front fog lamp
    Headlamp (HI, LO)
    Front wiper (HI, LO)

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the applicable system operate?

    Possible cause
    YES

    BCM signal input circuit

    NO

    • Lamp or motor
    • Lamp or motor ground circuit
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and applicable system
    • IPDM E/R

    YES

    • BCM signal input circuit
    • CAN communication signal between BCM and ECM
    • CAN communication signal between ECM and IPDM E/R

    NO

    • Magnet clutch
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and magnet clutch
    • IPDM E/R

    YES

    • ECM signal input circuit
    • CAN communication signal between ECM and IPDM E/R

    NO

    • Cooling fan motor
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and cooling fan motor
    • IPDM E/R

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the magnet clutch operate?

    A/C compressor does not operate

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the cooling fan operate?

    Cooling fan does not operate

    CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R)

    INFOID:0000000009578846

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with IPDM E/R.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    Ecu Identification

    The IPDM E/R part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The IPDM E/R self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The IPDM E/R input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-18

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    Active Test

    The IPDM E/R activates outputs to test components.

    CAN Diag Support Mntr

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    A

    ECU IDENTIFICATION

    B

    The IPDM E/R part number is displayed.

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    C

    Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR
    D

    Main
    Signals

    Description

    MOTOR FAN REQ [%]

    ×

    Indicates cooling fan speed signal received from ECM on CAN communication
    line

    AC COMP REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates A/C compressor request signal received from ECM on CAN communication line

    TAIL&CLR REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates position light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HL LO REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates low beam request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    HL HI REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates high beam request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    FR FOG REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates front fog light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    FR WIP REQ [Stop/1LOW/Low/Hi]

    ×

    Indicates front wiper request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    WIP AUTO STOP [STOP P/ACT P]

    ×

    Indicates condition of front wiper auto stop signal

    WIP PROT [Off/BLOCK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of front wiper fail-safe operation

    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Indicates ignition switch ON signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    IGN RLY1 -REQ [On/Off]
    IGN RLY [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of ignition relay
    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch

    INTER/NP SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of CVT shift position

    ST RLY CONT [On/Off]

    Indicates starter relay status signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    IHBT RLY -REQ [On/Off]

    Indicates starter control relay signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    ST/INHI RLY [Off/ ST /INHI]

    Indicates condition of starter relay and starter control relay

    DETENT SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    DTRL REQ [Off]

    Indicates daytime light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HOOD SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of hood switch

    THFT HRN REQ [On/Off]

    Indicates theft warning horn request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HORN CHIRP [On/Off]

    Indicates horn reminder signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    ACTIVE TEST
    Description

    HORN

    This test is able to check horn operation [On].

    FRONT WIPER

    This test is able to check wiper motor operation [Hi/Lo/Off].

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-19

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Test item

    E

    2014 Note

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Test item

    Description

    MOTOR FAN

    This test is able to check cooling fan operation [4/3/2/1].

    EXTERNAL LAMPS

    This test is able to check external lamp operation [Fog/Hi/Lo/TAIL/Off].

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR
    Refer to LAN-12, «CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-20

    2014 Note

    BCM, IPDM E/R
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION

    A

    BCM, IPDM E/R
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009472877

    ECU

    Reference

    C

    BCS-28, «Reference Value»
    BCM

    B

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»

    D

    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»
    PCS-13, «Reference Value»

    IPDM E/R

    E

    PCS-18, «Fail-safe»
    PCS-20, «DTC Index»

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-21

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    HEADLAMP
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009472996

    AALWA0624GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-22

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1369GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-23

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1370GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-24

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1371GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-25

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1372GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-26

    2014 Note

    DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM

    A

    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009472998

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AALWA0643GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-27

    2014 Note

    DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1408GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-28

    2014 Note

    DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1409GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-29

    2014 Note

    DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1410GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-30

    2014 Note

    DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1411GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-31

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009473000

    AALWA0631GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-32

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1381GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-33

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1382GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-34

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1383GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-35

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1384GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-36

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMPS
    Wiring Diagram

    A
    INFOID:0000000009473001

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AALWA0634GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-37

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1391GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-38

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1392GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-39

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1393GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-40

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1394GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-41

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1395GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-42

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    Wiring Diagram-With Daytime Light System

    A
    INFOID:0000000009473002

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AALWA0636GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-43

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1402GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-44

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1403GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-45

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1404GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-46

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1405GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-47

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1406GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-48

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1407GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-49

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    Wiring Diagram-Without Daytime Light System

    INFOID:0000000009473007

    AALWA0635GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-50

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1396GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-51

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1397GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-52

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1398GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-53

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1399GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-54

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1400GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-55

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1401GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-56

    2014 Note

    STOP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    STOP LAMP

    A

    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009473003

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AALWA0630GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-57

    2014 Note

    STOP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1379GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-58

    2014 Note

    STOP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1380GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-59

    2014 Note

    STOP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABLIA4894GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-60

    2014 Note

    BACK-UP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    BACK-UP LAMP

    A

    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009473004

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AALWA0622GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-61

    2014 Note

    BACK-UP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1364GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-62

    2014 Note

    BACK-UP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1365GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-63

    2014 Note

    BACK-UP LAMP
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1452GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-64

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    Wiring Diagram

    A
    INFOID:0000000009473370

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AALWA0629GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-65

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1375GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-66

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1376GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-67

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1377GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-68

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1378GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-69

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009472882

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    JMKIA8652GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-70

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    1.
    2.

    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when
    the incident/malfunction occurs).
    Check operation condition of the function that is malfunctioning.

    A

    B

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC

    C

    1. Check DTC.
    2. Perform the following procedure if DTC is detected.
    Record DTC and freeze frame data (Print them out using CONSULT.)
    Erase DTC.
    Study the relationship between the cause detected by DTC and the symptom described by the customer.
    3. Check related service bulletins for information.
    Are any symptoms described and any DTC detected?
    Symptom is described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 3.
    Symptom is described, DTC is not detected>>GO TO 4.
    Symptom is not described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 5.

    D

    E

    F

    3.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    G

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Also study the normal operation and fail-safe related to the symptom.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.

    H

    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    I

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.

    J

    >> GO TO 6.

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for the detected DTC, and then check that DTC is detected K
    again. At this time, always connect CONSULT to the vehicle, and check self diagnostic results in real time.
    If two or more DTCs are detected, refer to DTC INSPECTION PRIORITY CHART, and determine trouble diagnosis order.
    EXL
    NOTE:
    • Freeze frame data is useful if the DTC is not detected.
    • Perform Component Function Check if DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE is not included on Service
    M
    Manual. This simplified check procedure is an effective alternative though DTC cannot be detected during
    this check.
    If the result of Component Function Check is NG, it is the same as the detection of DTC by DTC CONFIRN
    MATION PROCEDURE.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    O
    NO
    >> Check according to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM BY SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    Detect malfunctioning system according to SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS based on the confirmed symptom in step
    4, and determine the trouble diagnosis order based on possible causes and symptom.
    Is the symptom described?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Monitor input data from related sensors or check voltage of related module terminals using CONSULT.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSIS PROCEDURE
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-71

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Inspect according to Diagnosis Procedure of the system.
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Check according to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    8.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnosis Procedure again after repair and replacement.
    Check DTC. If DTC is detected, erase it.
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.FINAL CHECK

    When DTC is detected in step 2, perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE again, and then check that the
    malfunction is repaired securely.
    When symptom is described by the customer, refer to confirmed symptom in step 3 or 4, and check that the
    symptom is not detected.
    Is DTC detected and does symptom remain?
    YES-1 >> DTC is detected: GO TO 7.
    YES-2 >> Symptom remains: GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Before returning the vehicle to the customer, always erase DTC.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-72

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP (HI) CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    HEADLAMP (HI) CIRCUIT
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472883

    B

    1.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) OPERATION
    C

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    1. Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    2. With operating the test items, check that the headlamp (HI) is turned ON.
    Hi
    Off

    D

    : Headlamp (HI) ON
    : Headlamp (HI) OFF

    E

    NOTE:
    ON/OFF is repeated 1 second each.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Headlamp (HI) circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-73, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472884

    G

    1.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect headlamp high connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the test items, check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    H

    I

    J

    (+)
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    (−)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Test item

    Terminal

    RH

    Hi

    25
    E45

    Ground

    LH

    EXTERNAL
    LAMPS

    27

    Battery voltage

    Off

    0V

    Hi

    Battery voltage

    Off

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    K

    EXL

    M

    2.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) OPEN CIRCUIT

    N

    1.
    2.
    3.

    O

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and headlamp high harness connector.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector
    RH

    Headlamp high
    Terminal

    Connector

    27

    E26 (without
    DTRL)
    E73 (with DTRL)

    25

    E25 (without
    DTRL)
    E74 (with DTRL)

    E45
    LH

    Terminal

    1

    Continuity

    P

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-73

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP (HI) CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuses are not fusing.
    Unit

    Location

    Headlamp HI (RH)

    Fuse No.
    #34

    IPDM E/R

    Headlamp HI (LH)

    Capacity
    10 A

    #35

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) SHORT CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector
    RH

    Terminal
    E45

    LH

    27

    Continuity
    Ground
    No

    25

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace fuse. (Replace IPDM E/R if the fuse is fusing again.)
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness. And then replace the fuse.

    5.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) GROUND OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect headlamp high connector.
    Check continuity between headlamp high harness connector and ground.
    Headlamp high
    Connector
    RH

    E26 (with DTRL)
    E73 (without DTRL)

    LH

    E25 (without DTRL)
    E74 (with DTRL)

    Continuity

    Terminal
    Ground
    2

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace headlamp (HI) bulb. (Bulb socket is abnormal.)
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-74

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP (LO) CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    HEADLAMP (LO) CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472887

    1.CHECK HEADLAMP (LO) OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    B

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the test items, check that the headlamp (LO) is turned ON.
    Lo
    Off

    C

    : Headlamp (LO) ON
    : Headlamp (LO) OFF

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Headlamp (LO) is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-75, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472888

    F

    1.CHECK HEADLAMP (LO) OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect headlamp low connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the test items, check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    (−)

    G

    H

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    I

    Lo

    Battery voltage

    J

    Off

    0V

    Lo

    Battery voltage

    Off

    0V

    Test item

    Terminal

    RH

    16
    E44

    Ground

    LH

    EXTERNAL
    LAMPS

    14

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    K

    EXL

    2.CHECK HEADLAMP (LO) OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and headlamp low harness connector.

    M

    N
    IPDM E/R
    Connector
    RH

    Headlamp low
    Terminal

    Connector

    16

    E26 (without
    DTRL)
    E73 (with DTRL)

    14

    E25 (without
    DTRL)
    E73 (with DTRL)

    E44
    LH

    Terminal

    Continuity

    O
    3

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK HEADLAMP (LO) FUSE
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-75

    2014 Note

    P

    HEADLAMP (LO) CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check that the following fuses are not blown.
    Unit

    Lotion

    Headlamp LO (RH)

    Fuse No.
    #40

    IPDM E/R

    Headlamp LO (LH)

    Capacity
    15 A

    #41

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK HEADLAMP (LO) SHORT CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector
    RH

    Terminal
    E44

    LH

    16

    Continuity
    Ground
    No

    14

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace fuse. (Replace IPDM E/R if the fuse is blown again.)
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness. And then replace the fuse.

    5.CHECK HEADLAMP (LO) GROUND OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect headlamp low connector.
    Check continuity between headlamp low harness connector and ground.
    Headlamp low
    Connector
    RH

    E26 (without DTRL)
    E73 (with DTRL)

    LH

    E25 (without DTRL)
    E74 (with DTRL)

    Continuity

    Terminal
    Ground
    2

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace headlamp (LO) bulb. (Bulb socket is abnormal.)
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-76

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009667167

    The manual headlamp aiming system uses a headlamp aiming switch to adjust the axis of the headlamp aiming motor. The headlamp aiming switch has four settings, each with a different resistance value. The headlamp aiming motor adjusts to the proper axis based off the position of the headlamp aiming switch.

    B

    Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    INFOID:0000000009667168

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to EXL-65, «Wiring Diagram».

    D

    1.CHECK HEADLAMP AIMING MOTOR POWER SUPPLY

    E

    1.
    2.
    3.

    F

    Disconnect headlamp aiming motor harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between headlamp aiming motor harness connectors and ground.
    Headlamp aiming motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E65 (RH)

    3

    E66 (LH)

    Voltage

    G

    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    H

    Is the inspection normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Check the following:
    • 10A fuse No. 5 located in the fuse block (J/B).
    • Harness for open or short between headlamp aiming motor and fuse block (JB).

    I

    2.CHECK HEADLAMP AIMING SWITCH SIGNAL FOR OPEN OR SHORT CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Headlamp aiming switch
    Connector

    Front combination lamp

    Terminal

    M105

    3.

    J

    Disconnect headlamp aiming switch connector M140.
    Check continuity between the headlamp aiming switch harness connector and headlamp aiming motor
    harness connector.

    Connector

    3

    Terminal

    LH

    E66

    RH

    E65

    2

    Continuity

    EXL

    Yes

    M

    Check continuity between the headlamp aiming switch harness connector and ground.
    Headlamp aiming switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M105

    3

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    N

    O

    Are continuity results as specified?
    YES >> GO TO 3
    NO
    >> Repair the harness or connector.

    3.CHECK HEADLAMP AIMING MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT

    P

    Check continuity between headlamp aiming motor and ground.
    Front combination lamp
    Connector

    Revision: April 2013

    Terminal

    K

    Continuity

    EXL-77

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SYSTEM (MANUAL)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    LH

    E66

    RH

    E65

    1

    Ground

    Yes

    Does continuity exist?
    YES >> GO TO 4
    NO
    >> Repair the harness or connector.

    4.CHECK HEADLAMP AIMING SWITCH

    Check continuity between the headlamp aiming switch terminals 1 and 2 in each switch position.
    Component

    Headlamp
    aiming switch

    Terminal

    1

    3

    Switch Position

    Continuity

    0

    604 ohms

    1

    324 ohms

    2

    191 ohms

    3

    130 ohms

    Are continuity results as specified?
    YES >> GO TO 5
    NO
    >> Replace the headlamp aiming switch.

    5.CHECK HEADLAMP AIMING SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between headlamp aiming switch harness connector and ground.
    Connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    M105

    2

    Ground

    Yes

    Is continuity present?
    YES >> Inspect headlamp aiming motors.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-78

    2014 Note

    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472889

    1.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    B

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select “DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT” of BCM (HEADLAMP) active test item.
    With operating the test items, check that daytime running light operation.
    On
    Off

    C

    : Daytime running light ON
    : Daytime running light OFF

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Daytime running light relay circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-79, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472890

    F

    1.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not fusing.
    Unit
    Daytime running light relay

    G
    Fuse No.

    Capacity

    #37

    10 A

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the fuse after repairing the applicable circuit.

    I

    2.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.

    Remove daytime running light relay.
    Check voltage between daytime running light relay harness connector and ground.

    J

    (+)
    Daytime running light relay
    Connector

    K

    (−)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Terminal

    E67

    2
    5

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    M

    3.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY

    N

    Check daytime running light relay. Refer to EXL-80, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace daytime running light relay.

    O

    4.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY CONTROL SIGNAL OUTPUT
    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    1. Install daytime running light relay.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Select “DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT” of BCM (HEADLAMP) active test item.
    4. With operating the test item, check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL

    EXL-79

    2014 Note

    P

    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    IPDM E/R

    (−)

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    69

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Test item
    DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT

    Ground

    On

    0V

    Off

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Daytime running light relay circuit is OK.
    NO-1 (Fixed at 0 V)>>GO TO 5.
    NO-2 (Fixed at battery voltage) >>Replace IPDM E/R.

    5.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY CONTROL SIGNAL OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove daytime running light relay.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and daytime running light relay harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    Daytime running light relay

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    69

    E67

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    6.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY CONTROL SIGNAL SHORT CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    69

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009472891

    1.CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Remove daytime running light relay.
    Apply battery voltage to daytime running light relay- between terminals 1 and 2.
    Check continuity between daytime running light relay terminals.
    Daytime running lamp relay
    Connector
    E67

    Condition

    Terminal
    3
    5

    Voltage

    Continuity
    Apply

    Yes

    Not Apply

    No

    he inspection result normal?
    YES >> Daytime running light relay is normal.
    NO
    >> Replace daytime running light relay.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-80

    2014 Note

    PARKING LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    PARKING LAMP CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472892

    1.CHECK PARKING LAMP OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    B

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the test items, check that the parking lamp is turned ON.
    TAIL
    Off

    C

    : Parking lamp ON
    : Parking lamp OFF

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Parking lamp circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-81, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472893

    F

    1.CHECK PARKING LAMP FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not blown.
    Unit
    • Parking lamp
    • Front side marker lamp

    G

    Location
    IPDM E/R

    Fuse No.

    Capacity

    #37

    10 A

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    I

    2.CHECK PARKING LAMP SHORT CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    J

    Disconnect the following connectors.
    IPDM E/R
    Front combination lamp
    Front side marker lamp
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    23

    Ground

    K

    Continuity
    No

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace fuse. (Replace IPDM E/R if fuse is blown again.)
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness. And then replace the fuse.

    N

    3.CHECK PARKING LAMP BULB
    Check applicable lamp bulb.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace bulb.

    O

    4.CHECK PARKING LAMP OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    P

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Disconnect front combination lamp connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the test items, check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL

    EXL-81

    2014 Note

    PARKING LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    (−)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Test item

    Terminal
    TAIL

    RH
    E45

    23

    EXTERNAL
    LAMPS

    Ground

    LH

    Off

    Battery voltage
    0V

    TAIL
    Off

    Battery voltage
    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R.

    5.CHECK PARKING LAMP OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and front combination lamp harness connector.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Front combination lamp
    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    RH

    E28 (Without
    DTRL)

    7

    LH

    E27 (Without
    DTRL)

    7

    E30 (Without
    DTRL)

    5

    LH

    E29 (Without
    DTRL)

    5

    RH

    E77 (With DTRL)

    6

    LH

    E78 (With DTRL)

    6

    RH

    E45

    23

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    6.CHECK PARKING LAMP GROUND OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between front combination lamp harness connector and ground.
    Front combination lamp
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    RH

    E28 (Without DTRL)

    8

    LH

    E27 (Without DTRL)

    8

    RH

    E30 (Without DTRL)

    6

    LH

    E29 (Without DTRL)

    6

    RH

    E77 (With DTRL)

    7

    LH

    E78 (With DTRL)

    7

    Ground
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check corresponding bulb socket and harness. Repair or replace if necessary.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-82

    2014 Note

    TAIL LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    TAIL LAMP CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472896

    1.CHECK TAIL LAMP OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    B

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the test items, check that the tail lamp is turned ON.
    TAIL
    Off

    C

    : Tail Lamp ON
    : Tail lamp OFF

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Tail lamp circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-83, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472897

    F

    1.CHECK TAIL LAMP FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not blown.
    Unit

    G

    Location

    • Tail lamp
    • license plate lamp

    IPDM E/R

    Fuse No.

    Capacity

    #37

    10 A

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    I

    2.CHECK TAIL LAMP SHORT CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector, licence plate lamp connector and rear combination lamp connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    K

    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    23

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    EXL

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace fuse. (Replace IPDM E/R if the fuse is blown again.)
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness. And then replace the fuse.

    M

    3.CHECK TAIL LAMP BULB

    Check applicable lamp bulb.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace bulb.

    N

    O

    4.CHECK TAIL LAMP OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Disconnect rear combination lamp connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the test items, check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    EXL-83

    2014 Note

    P

    TAIL LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    IPDM E/R

    (−)

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    23

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Test item

    EXTERNAL
    LAMPS

    Ground

    TAIL

    Battery voltage

    Off

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R.

    5.CHECK TAIL LAMP OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and rear combination lamp harness connector.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector
    RH

    Rear combination lamp
    Terminal

    E45

    LH

    Connector

    Terminal

    B27

    23

    1

    B25

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    6.CHECK TAIL LAMP GROUND OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between rear combination lamp harness connector and ground.
    Rear combination lamp
    Connector

    Terminal

    RH

    B27

    LH

    B25

    Continuity
    Ground

    6

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check corresponding bulb socket and harness. Repair or replace if necessary.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-84

    2014 Note

    LICENSE PLATE LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    LICENSE PLATE LAMP CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472898

    1.CHECK TAIL LAMP OPERATION

    B

    Check that the tail lamp is turned ON.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Check tail lamp circuit. Refer to EXL-83, «Component Function Check».

    C

    2.CHECK LICENSE PLATE LAMP OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    D

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select “EXTERNAL LAMPS” of IPDM E/R active test item.
    With operating the lighting switch, check that the license plate lamp is turned ON.
    TAIL
    Off

    E

    : License plate lamp ON
    : License plate lamp OFF

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> License plate lamp circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-85, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    G

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472899

    1.CHECK LICENSE PLATE LAMP BULB

    H

    Check the applicable lamp bulb.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace bulb.

    I

    2.CHECK LICENSE PLATE LAMP OPEN CIRCUIT

    J

    1.
    2.
    3.

    K

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector and license plate lamp connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and license plate lamp harness connector.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector
    RH

    Terminal
    E45

    LH

    License plate lamp
    Connector

    Terminal

    D508

    23

    1

    D507

    Continuity

    Yes

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    N

    3.CHECK LICENSE PLATE LAMP GROUND OPEN CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between license plate lamp harness connector and ground.
    License plate lamp
    Connector
    RH

    D508

    LH

    D507

    Terminal

    O
    Continuity

    Ground

    2

    P
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check corresponding bulb socket and harness. Repair or replace if necessary.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-85

    EXL

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    TURN SIGNAL LAMP CIRCUIT
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472900

    1.CHECK TURN SIGNAL LAMP
    1.
    2.

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select “FLASHER” of BCM (FLASHER) active test item.
    With operating the test items, check that the turn signal lamps is turned ON.
    LH
    RH
    Off

    : Turn signal lamps (LH) ON
    : Turn signal lamps (RH) ON
    : Turn signal lamps OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Turn signal lamp circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-86, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472901

    1.CHECK TURN SIGNAL LAMP
    1.
    2.

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select “FLASHER” of BCM (FLASHER) active test item.
    With operating the test items, check that the turn signal lamps is turned ON.
    LH
    RH
    Off

    : Turn signal lamps (LH) ON
    : Turn signal lamps (RH) ON
    : Turn signal lamps OFF

    Which turn signal lamp does not turn ON?
    Side turn signal lamp>>GO TO 3.
    Other than side turn signal lamp>>GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK TURN SIGNAL LAMP BULB
    Check the applicable lamp bulb.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace bulb.

    3.CHECK TURN SIGNAL LAMP OUTPUT VOLTAGE

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front combination lamp connector, side turn signal lamp connector and rear combination lamp
    connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    With operating the turn signal switch, check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-86

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    Connector

    A

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal

    LH

    B

    C

    LH

    60

    PKID0926E

    M99

    Turn signal
    switch

    Ground

    RH

    OFF

    0V

    E

    RH

    61

    F

    PKID0926E

    OFF

    G

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    H

    4.CHECK TURN SIGNAL LAMP OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    D

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and front combination lamp, door mirror or rear combination lamp harness connector.

    I

    J

    Front turn signal lamp

    BCM
    Connector
    RH
    LH

    M99

    RH
    LH

    Front combination lamp
    Terminal

    Connector

    61

    E30 (Without DTRL)

    60

    E29 (Without DTRL)

    61

    E76 (With DTRL)

    60

    E75 (With DTRL)

    Terminal

    4

    Continuity

    Yes

    Connector
    RH
    LH

    M99

    Rear combination lamp
    Terminal

    Connector

    61

    B27

    60

    B25

    Terminal
    4

    Continuity

    N
    Yes

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    5.CHECK TURN SIGNAL LAMP SHORT CIRCUIT

    P

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL

    M

    Rear turn signal lamp

    BCM

    K

    EXL-87

    2014 Note

    TURN SIGNAL LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM
    Connector
    RH

    Terminal
    61

    M99

    LH

    Continuity
    Ground
    No

    60

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> (When lamp other than side turn signal lamp does not turn ON) Check each bulb socket for internal short circuit, and if check result is normal, replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and
    Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    6.CHECK TURN SIGNAL LAMP GROUND OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and front combination lamp, door mirror or rear combination lamp and ground.
    Front turn signal lamp

    Front combination lamp
    Connector
    RH

    E30 (Without DTRL)

    LH

    E29 (Without DTRL)

    RH

    E76 (With DTRL)

    LH

    E75 (With DTRL)

    Continuity

    Terminal
    6

    Ground
    Yes

    5

    Rear turn signal lamp

    Rear combination lamp
    Connector
    RH

    B27

    LH

    B25

    Terminal

    Continuity
    Ground

    6

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check corresponding bulb socket and harness. Repair or replace if necessary.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-88

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT FOG LAMP CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009486641

    1.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP OPERATION

    B

    WITHOUT CONSULT
    Start IPDM E/R auto active test. Refer to PCS-9, «Diagnosis Description».
    Check that the front fog lamp is turned ON.
    CONSULT
    1. Select EXTERNAL LAMPS of IPDM E/R active test item.
    2. While operating the test items, check that the front fog lamp is turned ON.
    1.
    2.

    FOG
    OFF

    C

    D

    : Front fog lamp ON
    : Front fog lamp OFF

    E

    Is the front fog lamp turned ON?
    YES >> Front fog lamp circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-89, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009486642

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to EXL-32, «Wiring Diagram».
    H

    1.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not blown.

    I

    Unit

    Fuse No.

    Capacity

    31

    15 A

    Front fog lamp

    J

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the fuse after repairing the affected circuit.

    K

    2.CHECK FOG LAMP BULB

    Check the applicable fog lamp bulb to be sure the proper bulb standard is in use and the bulb is not open.
    Is the bulb OK?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the bulb.

    EXL

    M

    3.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front fog lamp connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select EXTERNAL LAMPS of IPDM E/R active test item.
    While operating the fog lamps, check voltage between front fog lamp harness connector and ground.

    Front fog lamp

    Revision: April 2013

    O

    P

    (+)

    Connector

    N

    (−)

    Test item

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Terminal

    EXL-89

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    RH

    E54
    1

    LH

    Ground

    EXTERNAL LAMPS

    E53

    Fog

    Battery voltage

    Off

    0V

    Fog

    Battery voltage

    Off

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between front fog lamp harness connector and ground.
    Front fog lamp
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    RH

    E54

    LH

    E53

    Ground

    2

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace malfunctioning lamp.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.

    5.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP RELAY TO FRONT FOG LAMPS CIRCUIT FOR OPEN

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect front fog lamp relay connector E58.
    Check continuity between the front fog lamp relay harness connector E58 and the front fog lamp connectors E53 and E54.
    Connector

    Terminal

    E58

    3

    Connector

    Terminal

    E53

    1

    E54

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.

    6.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    Check the voltage between the front fog lamp relay connector E58 and ground.
    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal
    2

    E58

    5

    (−)

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.

    7.CHECK IPDM E/R TO FRONT FOG LAMP RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector E46.
    Check continuity between the front fog lamp relay harness connector E58 and the IPDM E/R connector
    E46.
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    E58

    1

    E46

    71

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check the front fog lamp relay. Refer to EXL-91, «Component Inspection».
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-90

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.
    A

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009486643

    1. CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP RELAY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove front fog lamp relay.
    Check the continuity between front fog lamp relay terminals 3 and 5 when voltage is supplied between terminals 1 and 2.
    Terminals
    3 and 5

    Condition

    Continuity

    12V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2

    Yes

    No current supply

    No

    B

    C

    D

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace front fog lamp relay.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-91

    2014 Note

    HAZARD SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    HAZARD SWITCH
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009472906

    1.CHECK HAZARD SWITCH SIGNAL BY CONSULT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “HAZARD SW” of BCM (FLASHER) data monitor item.
    With operating the hazard switch, check the monitor status.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    HAZARD SW

    Monitor status

    Hazard switch

    ON

    On

    OFF

    Off

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Hazard switch circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to EXL-92, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472907

    1.CHECK HAZARD SWITCH SIGNAL INPUT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect hazard switch connector.
    Check voltage between hazard switch connector and ground.
    (+)
    Hazard switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M55

    2

    (−)

    Voltage (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK HAZARD SWITCH SIGNAL OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between hazard switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Hazard switch

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M55

    2

    M18

    29

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK HAZARD SWITCH SIGNAL SHORT CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between hazard switch harness connector and ground.
    Hazard switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M55

    2

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-92

    2014 Note

    HAZARD SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    4.CHECK HAZARD SWITCH GROUND OPEN CIRCUIT

    A

    Check continuity between hazard switch harness connector and ground.
    Hazard switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M55

    3

    Ground

    Continuity

    B

    Yes

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace hazard switch.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-93

    2014 Note

    EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM
    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009472912

    CAUTION:
    Perform the self-diagnosis with CONSULT before the symptom diagnosis. Perform the trouble diagnosis if any DTC is detected.
    Symptom

    Possible cause

    Inspection item

    One side

    • Fuse
    • Halogen bulb (HI)
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and headlamp (HI)
    • Harness between headlamp
    (HI) and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Both sides

    Symptom diagnosis
    “BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (HI) ARE NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-98, «WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure».

    Headlamp (HI) is not
    turned ON.

    Headlamp (HI) circuit
    Refer to EXL-73, «Component
    Function Check».

    Combination meter

    • Combination meter
    Data monitor “HI-BEAM IND”
    • BCM (HEAD LAMP)
    Active test “HEADLAMP”

    One side

    • Fuse
    • Halogen bulb (LO)
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and headlamp lamp (LO)
    • Harness between headlamp
    (LO) and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Headlamp (LO) circuit
    Refer to EXL-75, «Component
    Function Check».

    Both sides

    Symptom diagnosis
    “BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (LO) ARE NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-100, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    High beam indicator lamp is not turned ON.
    [Headlamp (HI) is turned ON.]

    Headlamp (LO) is not
    turned ON.

    Parking lamp is not turned ON.

    • Fuse
    • Parking lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and front combination lamp
    • Harness between front combination lamp and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Parking lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-81, «Component
    Function Check».

    Front side marker lamp is not turned ON.

    • Front side marker lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and front side marker lamp
    • Harness between front side
    marker lamp and ground

    Front side marker lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-81, «Component
    Function Check».

    Tail lamp is not turned ON.

    • Fuse
    • Tail lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and rear combination lamp
    • Harness between rear combination lamp and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Tail lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-83, «Component
    Function Check».

    License plate lamp is not turned ON.

    • License plate lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and license plate lamp
    • Harness between license plate
    lamp and ground

    License plate lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-85, «Component
    Function Check».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-94

    2014 Note

    EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom
    Parking lamp, side marker lamp, tail lamp and license plate lamp are not turned ON.

    Tail lamp indicator is not turned ON.
    (Exterior lamps are turned ON.)

    Indicator lamp is normal.
    (Applicable side performs high flasher activation.)

    Possible cause

    Symptom diagnosis
    “PARKING, SIDE MARKER, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS ARE
    NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-101, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Combination meter

    Turn signal indicator lamp
    does not blink.
    (Turn signal lamp is normal.)

    • Combination meter
    Data monitor “LIGHT IND”
    • BCM (HEADLAMP)
    Active test “TAIL LAMP”

    • Turn signal lamp bulb
    • Door mirror
    • Harness between BCM and
    each turn signal lamp
    • Harness between each turn signal lamp and ground

    Turn signal lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-86, «Component
    Function Check».

    • Combination switch
    • Harness between combination
    switch and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination meter
    Power supply and ground circuit
    Refer to EXL-94, «WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM :
    Symptom Table»(without DRL) or
    EXL-95, «WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom
    Table»(with DRL).

    Turn signal lamp does not
    blink.
    Indicator lamp is included.

    Inspection item

    One side

    Combination meter

    Both sides
    (Always)

    • Turn signal indicator lamp signal
    • BCM
    • Combination meter

    • Combination meter
    Data monitor “TURN IND”
    • BCM (FLASHER)
    Active test “FLASHER”

    • Combination meter power supply and ground circuit
    • Combination meter

    Combination meter
    Power supply and ground circuit
    Refer to EXL-94, «WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM :
    Symptom Table»(without DRL) or
    EXL-95, «WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom
    Table»(with DRL).

    Both sides
    (Only when activating
    hazard warning lamp
    with ignition switch
    OFF)

    • Hazard warning lamp does not activate.
    • Hazard warning lamp continues activating.
    (Turn signal is normal.)

    One side
    Front fog lamp is not
    turned ON.
    Both sides

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    • Hazard switch
    • Harness between hazard
    switch and BCM
    • Harness between hazard
    switch and ground
    • BCM

    Hazard switch circuit
    Refer to EXL-92, «Component
    Function Check».

    • Front fog lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and front fog lamp
    • Harness between front fog lamp
    and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Front fog lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-89, «Component
    Function Check».

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    Symptom diagnosis
    “BOTH SIDE FRONT FOG LAMPS ARE NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-102, «Description».

    N

    O

    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom Table

    P
    INFOID:0000000009472913

    CAUTION:
    Perform the self-diagnosis with CONSULT before the symptom diagnosis. Perform the trouble diagnosis if any DTC is detected.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-95

    2014 Note

    EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom

    Possible cause

    Inspection item

    One side

    • Fuse
    • Halogen bulb (HI)
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and headlamp (HI)
    • Harness between headlamp
    (HI) and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Both sides

    Symptom diagnosis
    “BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (HI) ARE NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-98, «WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure».

    Headlamp (HI) is not
    turned ON.

    High beam indicator lamp is not turned ON.
    [Headlamp (HI) is turned ON.]

    Headlamp (HI) circuit
    Refer to EXL-73, «Component
    Function Check».

    Combination meter

    • Combination meter
    Data monitor “HI-BEAM IND”

    One side

    • Fuse
    • Halogen bulb (LO)
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and headlamp lamp (LO)
    • Harness between headlamp
    (LO) and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Headlamp (LO) circuit
    Refer to EXL-79, «Component
    Function Check».

    Both sides

    Symptom diagnosis
    “BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (LO) ARE NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-100, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Headlamp (LO) is not
    turned ON.

    Daytime running light is not turned ON.

    • Fuse
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and daytime running light relay
    • Daytime running light relay
    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM
    • ECM
    • Combination meter

    • Daytime running light relay circuit
    Refer to EXL-79, «Component
    Function Check».
    • Combination meter
    Data monitor “PKB SW”
    • BCM
    Active test “DAYTIME RUNNING
    LIGHT”

    Parking lamp is not turned ON.

    • Fuse
    • Parking lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and front combination lamp
    • IPDM E/R

    Parking lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-81, «Component
    Function Check».

    Front side marker lamp is not turned ON.

    • Front side marker lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and front side marker lamp
    • Harness between front side
    marker lamp and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Front side marker lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-81, «Component
    Function Check».

    Tail lamp (Rear side marker lamp) is not turned ON.

    • Fuse
    • Tail lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and rear combination lamp
    • Harness between and rear
    combination lamp and ground

    Tail lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-83, «Component
    Function Check».

    License plate lamp is not turned ON.

    • License plate lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and license plate lamp
    • Harness between license plate
    lamp and ground

    License plate lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-85, «Component
    Function Check».

    Parking lamp, side marker lamp, tail lamp and license plate lamp are not turned ON.

    Symptom diagnosis
    “PARKING, SIDE MARKER, LICENSE PLATE AND TAIL LAMPS ARE
    NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-101, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-96

    2014 Note

    EXTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom
    Tail lamp indicator is not turned ON.
    (Exterior lamps are turned ON.)

    Possible cause

    Combination meter

    • Combination meter
    Data monitor “LIGHT IND”
    • BCM (HEADLAMP)
    Active test “TAIL LAMP”

    • Turn signal lamp bulb
    • Door mirror
    • Harness between BCM and
    each turn signal lamp
    • Harness between each turn signal lamp and ground

    Turn signal lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-86, «Component
    Function Check».

    Indicator lamp is included.

    • Combination switch
    • Harness between combination
    switch and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination meter
    Power supply and ground circuit
    Refer to EXL-95, «WITH DAYTIME
    RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM :
    Symptom Table» (with DRL) or EXL94, «WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom
    Table» (without DRL).

    One side

    Combination meter

    Both sides
    (Always)

    • Turn signal indicator lamp signal
    • BCM
    • Combination meter

    • Combination meter
    Data monitor “TURN IND”
    • BCM (FLASHER)
    Active test “FLASHER”

    • Combination meter power supply and ground circuit
    • Combination meter

    Combination meter
    Power supply and ground circuit
    Refer to EXL-95, «WITH DAYTIME
    RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM :
    Symptom Table» (with DRL) or EXL94, «WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom
    Table» (without DRL).

    Indicator lamp is normal.
    (Applicable side performs high flasher activation.)
    Turn signal lamp does not
    blink.

    Turn signal indicator lamp
    does not blink.
    (Turn signal lamp is normal.)

    Inspection item

    Both sides
    (Only when activating
    hazard warning lamp
    with ignition switch
    OFF)

    • Hazard warning lamp does not activate.
    • Hazard warning lamp continues activating.
    (Turn signal is normal.)

    One side
    Front fog lamp is not
    turned ON.
    Both sides

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    • Hazard switch
    • Harness between hazard
    switch and BCM
    • Harness between hazard
    switch and ground
    • BCM

    Hazard switch circuit
    Refer to EXL-92, «Component
    Function Check».

    • Front fog lamp bulb
    • Harness between IPDM E/R
    and front fog lamp
    • Harness between front fog lamp
    and ground
    • IPDM E/R

    Front fog lamp circuit
    Refer to EXL-89, «Component
    Function Check».

    K

    EXL

    M

    Symptom diagnosis
    “BOTH SIDE FRONT FOG LAMPS ARE NOT TURNED ON”
    Refer to EXL-102, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-97

    2014 Note

    BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (HI) ARE NOT TURNED ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (HI) ARE NOT TURNED ON
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM
    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Description

    INFOID:0000000009472915

    Both side headlamps (HI) are not turned ON when setting to the lighting switch HI or PASS.

    WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472916

    1.COMBINATION SWITCH INSPECTION
    Check combination switch. Refer to EXL-95, «WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom Table».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    2.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) REQUEST SIGNAL INPUT
    1.
    2.

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR
    Select “HL HI REQ” of IPDM E/R data monitor item.
    With operating the lighting switch, check the monitor status.
    Monitor item
    HL HI REQ

    Condition
    Lighting switch
    (2ND)

    Monitor status

    HI or PASS

    On

    LO

    Off

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    3.HEADLAMP (HI) CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    Check headlamp (HI) circuit. Refer to EXL-98, «WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Description».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM

    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Description

    INFOID:0000000009472917

    Both side headlamps (HI) are not turned ON when setting to the lighting switch HI or PASS.

    WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472918

    1.COMBINATION SWITCH INSPECTION
    Check combination switch. Refer to EXL-94, «WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom
    Table».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    2.CHECK HEADLAMP (HI) REQUEST SIGNAL INPUT
    1.
    2.

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR
    Select “HL HI REQ” of IPDM E/R data monitor item.
    With operating the lighting switch, check the monitor status.
    Monitor item
    HL HI REQ

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition
    Lighting switch
    (2ND)

    Monitor status

    HI or PASS

    On

    LO

    Off

    EXL-98

    2014 Note

    BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (HI) ARE NOT TURNED ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    A

    3.HEADLAMP (HI) CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    B

    Check headlamp (HI) circuit. Refer to EXL-73, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-99

    2014 Note

    BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (LO) ARE NOT TURNED ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    BOTH SIDE HEADLAMPS (LO) ARE NOT TURNED ON
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009472919

    Both side headlamps (LO) are not turned ON in any condition.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472920

    1.CHECK COMBINATION SWITCH
    Check combination switch. Refer to EXL-95, «WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom Table»
    (with DRL) or EXL-94, «WITHOUT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM : Symptom Table» (without DRL).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    2.CHECK HEADLAMP (LO) REQUEST SIGNAL INPUT
    1.
    2.

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR
    Select “HL LO REQ” of IPDM E/R data monitor item.
    With operating the lighting switch, check the monitor status.
    Monitor item
    HL LO REQ

    Condition
    Lighting switch

    Monitor status

    2ND

    On

    OFF

    Off

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    3.HEADLAMP (LO) CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    Check headlamp (LO) circuit. Refer to EXL-75, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-100

    2014 Note

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND TAIL LAMPS ARE NOT
    TURNED ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    PARKING, LICENSE PLATE, SIDE MARKER AND TAIL LAMPS ARE NOT
    TURNED ON
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009472921

    A

    B

    The parking, license plate, side marker, tail lamps and each illumination are not turned ON in any condition.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472922

    C

    1.COMBINATION SWITCH INSPECTION
    Check combination switch. Refer to EXL-101, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the combination switch normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    D

    E

    2.CHECK TAIL LAMP RELAY REQUEST SIGNAL INPUT
    1.
    2.

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR
    Select “TAIL & CLR REQ” of IPDM E/R data monitor item.
    With operating the lighting switch, check the monitor status.
    Monitor item
    TAIL & CLR REQ

    Condition
    Lighting switch

    F

    Monitor status

    1ST

    On

    OFF

    Off

    G

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-101

    2014 Note

    BOTH SIDE FRONT FOG LAMPS ARE NOT TURNED ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    BOTH SIDE FRONT FOG LAMPS ARE NOT TURNED ON
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009472923

    The front fog lamps are not turned ON in any condition.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009472924

    1.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not fusing.
    Unit

    Front fog lamp

    Fuse No.

    Capacity

    #31

    15 A

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP SHORT CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect front fog connector and IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector
    RH

    Terminal
    E46

    LH

    Continuity
    Ground

    71

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace fuse. (Replace IPDM E/R if the fuse is blown again.)
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness. And then replace the fuse.

    3.COMBINATION SWITCH INSPECTION

    Check combination switch. Refer to EXL-102, «Description».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    4.CHECK FRONT FOG LAMP REQUEST SIGNAL INPUT
    1.
    2.

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR
    Select “FR FOG REQ” of IPDM E/R data monitor item.
    With operating the front fog lamp switch, check the monitor status.
    Monitor item
    FR FOG REQ

    Condition
    Front fog lamp switch
    (With lighting switch 2ND)

    Monitor status

    ON

    On

    OFF

    Off

    Is the item status normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    5.FRONT FOG LAMP CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    Check the front fog lamp circuit. Refer to EXL-89, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-102

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    HEADLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009445897

    B

    PREPARATION BEFORE ADJUSTING
    Before performing aiming adjustment, check the following:
    • Ensure all tires are inflated to correct pressure.
    • Place vehicle and screen on level surface.
    • Ensure there is no load in vehicle other than the driver (or equivalent weight placed in driver’s position).
    • Coolant and engine oil filled to correct level, and fuel tank full.
    • Remove cargo and/or luggage to maintain an unloaded vehicle condition.
    • Confirm spare tire, jack and tools are properly stowed.
    • Carefully wipe off any dirt from headlamp lens.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use organic solvent (thinner, gasoline etc.)
    • Place a driver or equivalent weight of 68.5 kg (150 lb) on the driver seat.
    • By hand, bounce the front and rear of the vehicle to settle the suspension and eliminate any static load.
    • Place the front tires in the straight ahead position.
    • Confirm headlamp aiming switch is set to «0» (zero) position.
    • Aim each headlamp individually and ensure other headlamp beam pattern is blocked from screen.
    NOTE:
    • For headlamp aiming details, refer to regulations in your area.
    • By regulation, no means for horizontal aim adjustment is provided from the factory; only vertical aim is
    adjustable.
    • Use adjusting screw to perform aiming adjustment.
    • Perform headlamp aiming if:
    — The vehicle front body has been repaired.
    — The front combination lamp has been removed or replaced.
    — Any outfitting has been installed.
    — The vehicle’s standard load condition has been substantially increased.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AIMING ADJUSTMENT SCREW
    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    AWLIA2171ZZ

    A.

    Headlamp (LH) (UP/DOWN)
    adjustment screw

    B.

    Headlamp (RH) (UP/DOWN)
    adjustment screw

    P

    AIMING ADJUSTMENT SCREW

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-103

    O

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    AWLIA2170ZZ

    1.

    Front combination lamp

    A.

    Suitable tool (for aiming adjustment)

    Aiming Adjustment Procedure
    1.

    B.

    Adjusting screw
    INFOID:0000000009445898

    Use the aiming adjustment screw to adjust the elbow point projected by the low beams on the screen, so
    that it is within the aiming adjustment area.
    Low beam distribution on the screen
    A.

    : 150 mm (5.91 in)

    B.

    : 100 mm (3.94 in)

    C.

    : 100 mm (3.94 in)

    JSLIA0028ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-104

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E
    JSLIA0029ZZ

    C.

    Vertical center line of headlamp H.

    Horizontal center line of headlamp L.

    X.

    Aiming adjustment area
    (lateral)

    Aiming adjustment area
    (vertical)

    Y.

    Distance from headlamp center to screen (L)

    Distance from headlamp center to screen

    F

    G

    : 10 m (33 ft)
    Unit: mm (in)

    H

    Aiming adjustment area
    Vertical direction (Y)
    (Lower side from headlamp center height)
    Highest light axis

    100 (3.94)

    Target light axis

    100 (3.94)

    Lowest light axis

    150 (5.91)

    Lateral direction (X)
    (Left side from headlamp center line)

    I
    0 — 100 (3.94)

    J

    LOW BEAM AND HIGH BEAM
    NOTE:
    • Basic illuminating area for evaluation and/or adjustment should be within range shown on aiming chart.
    K
    1. Use adjustment screw to perform aiming adjustment.
    • Ensure fog lamps (if equipped) are turned off.
    2. Block the opposite headlamp from projecting a beam pattern onto the adjustment screen, using a suitable EXL
    object. Aim each headlamp individually.
    CAUTION:
    Do not cover the lens surface with tape etc. The lens is made of resin.
    M
    3. Place the screen on the same level and flat surface as the vehicle.
    NOTE:
    • Surface should be free of any debris that would cause a difference between the headlamp center and
    N
    the adjustment screen.
    4. Face the front of the vehicle to the screen and measure distance between the headlamp center and the
    screen surface.
    O
    Distance (D) between the headlamp center and the screen
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    : 10 m (33 ft)

    Start the engine and turn the headlamp on.
    Determine the preferred vertical aim range dimensions, using the aiming chart.
    Measure the projected beam within the aim evaluation segment on the screen.
    Adjust the beam pattern of each headlamp until the aim evaluation segment (the area relative to both the
    highest and lowest cutoff line height) is positioned within the vertical aim range dimensions shown on the
    aiming chart.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-105

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT FOG LAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    FRONT FOG LAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009445899

    PREPARATION BEFORE ADJUSTING
    Before performing aiming adjustment procedure, check the following:
    • Ensure all tires are inflated to correct pressure.
    • Place vehicle and screen on level surface.
    • Ensure there is no load in vehicle other than the driver (or equivalent weight placed in driver’s position).
    • Coolant and engine oil filled to correct level, and fuel tank full.
    • Remove cargo and/or luggage to maintain an unloaded vehicle condition.
    • Confirm spare tire, jack and tools are properly stowed.
    • Carefully wipe off any dirt from fog lamp lens.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use organic solvent (thinner, gasoline etc.)
    • Place a driver or equivalent weight of 68.5 kg (150 lb) on the driver seat.
    • By hand, bounce the front and rear of the vehicle to settle the suspension and eliminate any static load.
    • Place the front tires in the straight ahead position.
    • Aim each headlamp individually and ensure other headlamp beam pattern is blocked from screen.
    NOTE:
    • For headlamp aiming details, refer to regulations in your area.
    • By regulation, no means for horizontal aim adjustment is provided from the factory; only vertical aim is
    adjustable.
    • Use adjusting screw to perform aiming adjustment.
    • Perform headlamp aiming if:
    — The vehicle front body has been repaired.
    — The front combination lamp has been removed or replaced.
    — Any outfitting has been installed.
    — The vehicle’s standard load condition has been substantially increased.

    AIMING ADJUSTMENT SCREW
    • Turn the aiming adjusting screw using a suitable tool to aim the fog
    lamp.
    A: UP
    B: DOWN

    JMLIA2040ZZ

    Aiming Adjustment Procedure
    1.

    2.

    INFOID:0000000009445909

    Screen placement.
    NOTE:
    • Place the screen perpendicular to the level road.
    • Position the vehicle facing the screen with 10 m (33 ft) between the front fog lamp center and the
    screen.
    Start the engine. Illuminate the front fog lamp.
    CAUTION:
    Do not cover the lens surface with a tape etc. The lens are made of resin.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-106

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    3. Adjust the cutoff line height (A) with the aiming adjustment
    screw so that the distance (X) between the horizontal center line
    of front fog lamp (H) and (A) becomes 200 mm (7.87 in).
    Front fog lamp light distribution on the screen
    • A :Cutoff line
    • B :High illuminance
    • H :Horizontal center line of front fog lamp
    • V :Vertical center line of front fog lamp
    • X :Cutoff line height

    A

    B

    C
    JPLIA0008ZZ

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-107

    2014 Note

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015732

    JMLIA3217GB

    1.

    Front fender

    2.

    Radiator core upper support

    3.

    Front combination lamp

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015733

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove front bumper fascia. Refer to EXT-16, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the front combination lamp bolts.
    Pull front combination lamp forward.
    Disconnect the harness connectors from front combination lamp and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    After installation, perform headlamp aiming adjustment procedure. Refer to EXL-104, «Aiming Adjustment Procedure».

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009015734

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb by hand while it is lit or right after being turned off. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent damage to the bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp. When replacing bulb, be sure to replace it with new one.

    HEADLAMP BULB
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-108

    2014 Note

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    A

    Remove plastic cover.
    Remove bulb from the front combination lamp.

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install the bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    B

    C

    SIDE MARKER LAMP BULB
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    D

    Rotate bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove the bulb from bulb socket.

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install the bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    E

    F

    FRONT TURN SIGNAL/PARKING LAMP BULB
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    G

    Rotate bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove the bulb from bulb socket.

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install the bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-109

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009445901

    AWLIA2178ZZ

    1.

    Front fog lamp

    2.

    Front bumper fascia

    A.

    Front fog lamp bracket

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009445902

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Partially remove front fender protector. Refer to EXT-24, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect the harness connector from front fog lamp.
    Remove screws and front fog lamp.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    After installation, perform fog lamp aiming adjustment procedure. Refer to EXL-104, «Aiming Adjustment Procedure».

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009445910

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb by hand while it is lit or right after being turned off. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent damage to the bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp. When replacing bulb, be sure to replace it with new one.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Partially remove fender protector. Refer to EXT-24, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-110

    2014 Note

    FRONT FOG LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Disconnect harness connector (1) from front fog lamp bulb.
    3. Rotate the bulb (2) counterclockwise and remove.

    A

    B

    C
    SKIB8304J

    D

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install the bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-111

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    COMBINATION SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606282

    CAUTION:
    • Before servicing, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery terminals and wait at least
    three minutes.
    • Do not use air or electric tools when removing or installing the combination switch.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove the steering column covers. Refer to IP-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate steering wheel clockwise to access first combination
    switch screw (A) and remove.

    ALMIA0648ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Rotate steering wheel counter-clockwise to access second combination switch screw (A) and remove.
    Disconnect the harness connector (B) from the combination
    switch (1) and remove.

    ALMIA0649ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After the work is completed, make sure no system malfunction is detected by air bag warning lamp.
    • In case a malfunction is detected by the air bag warning lamp, reset with the self-diagnosis function
    and delete the memory with CONSULT.
    • If a malfunction is still detected after the above operation, perform self-diagnosis to repair malfunctions. Refer to EXL-70, «Work Flow».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-112

    2014 Note

    HAZARD SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    HAZARD SWITCH

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015739

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWLIA2163ZZ

    1.

    Cluster lid C

    2.

    Hazard switch

    Removal and Installation

    G

    Pawl
    INFOID:0000000009445907

    H

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, «Removal and Installation».
    Release pawls and remove hazard switch.

    I

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-113

    2014 Note

    HEADLAMP AIMING SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    HEADLAMP AIMING SWITCH
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015743

    AWLIA2172ZZ

    1.

    Instrument lower panel LH

    2.

    Headlamp aiming switch

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009641646

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    While pressing pawls, push the headlamp aiming switch to remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-114

    2014 Note

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015744

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWLIA2167ZZ

    1.

    Rear combination lamp

    A.

    Grommet

    B.

    G

    Clip

    Locating pin

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015745

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    H

    I

    Remove rear combination lamp bolts.
    Release the locating pin (A) of the rear combination lamp using
    a suitable tool (B) as shown.

    J

    K

    EXL
    AWLIA2169ZZ

    3.

    M

    Disconnect the harness connector from the rear combination lamp and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    N

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009015746

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb with bare hand while it is lit or right after being turned off. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent damage to the bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp. When replacing bulb, be sure to replace it with new one.

    STOP/TAIL LAMP BULB
    Removal

    1.

    Remove rear combination lamp. Refer to EXL-115, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-115

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Rotate stop/tail lamp bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    3. Remove stop/tail lamp bulb from bulb socket.
    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    REAR TURN SIGNAL LAMP BULB
    Removal

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove rear combination lamp. Refer to EXL-115, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate rear turn signal lamp bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove rear turn signal lamp bulb from bulb socket.

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    BACK-UP LAMP BULB
    Removal

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove rear combination lamp. Refer to EXL-115, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate back-up lamp bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove back-up lamp bulb from bulb socket.

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-116

    2014 Note

    HIGH-MOUNTED STOP LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    HIGH-MOUNTED STOP LAMP

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015747

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWLIA2164ZZ

    1.

    High-mounted stop lamp

    2.

    High-mounted stop lamp LED

    G

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015748

    H

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Release high-mounted stop lamp pawls using a suitable tool.
    Disconnect the harness connector from high-mounted stop lamp and remove.

    I

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    J

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009015749

    K

    HIGH-MOUNTED STOP LAMP BULB
    The high-mounted stop lamp bulb is a LED and is integrated into the high-mounted stop lamp and is serviced
    as an assembly. Refer to EXL-117, «Removal and Installation».

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-117

    2014 Note

    LICENSE PLATE LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    LICENSE PLATE LAMP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015750

    AWLIA2173ZZ

    1.

    License plate lamp bulb socket

    4.

    License plate lamp

    2.

    License plate lamp bulb

    3.

    Seal

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015751

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-34, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect harness connector from license plate lamp.
    Release license plate lamp pawl and remove license plate lamp.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009015752

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb with your hand while it is on or right after being turned off. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent damage to the bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp. When replacing bulb, be sure to replace it with new one.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove license plate lamp. Refer to EXL-118, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate license plate lamp bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove license plate lamp bulb from bulb socket.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installing the bulb, install the bulb socket securely for watertightness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-118

    2014 Note

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY

    A

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009670495

    B

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP — WITHOUT AIMING MOTOR
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWLIA2165ZZ

    1.

    Front combination lamp

    2.

    Side marker lamp bulb

    3.

    Side marker lamp socket

    4.

    Headlamp bulb

    5.

    Lock ring

    6.

    Front turn signal/Parking
    lamp bulb socket

    7.

    Front turn signal/Parking lamp bulb

    H

    I

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP — WITH AIMING MOTOR
    J

    K

    EXL

    M

    N
    JMLIA3219ZZ

    1.

    Front combination lamp

    2.

    Side marker lamp bulb

    3. Side marker lamp bulb socket

    4.

    Lock ring

    5.

    Front turn signal/parking lamp
    bulb socket

    6. Front turn signal/parking lamp
    bulb

    7.

    Headlamp Bulb

    8.

    Retaining spring

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009670496

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb while it is lit or right after being turned off. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-119

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    FRONT COMBINATION LAMP
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Do not touch glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent
    damage to bulb.
    • Do not leave the bulb out of the lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture, smoke, etc.
    may affect the performance of the lamp.

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Remove front combination lamp. Refer to EXL-108, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate lock ring counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove headlamp bulb.
    Rotate side marker bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove the side marker lamp bulb from the side marker bulb socket.
    Rotate turn signal/parking lamp bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.
    Remove turn signal/parking lamp bulb from turn signal/parking lamp bulb socket.

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    CAUTION:
    • After installing the headlamp bulb, be sure to install lock ring securely to ensure watertightness.
    • After installing, be sure to install the bulb sockets securely to ensure watertightness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-120

    2014 Note

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP

    A

    Exploded View — Non LED

    INFOID:0000000009670499

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP — NON LED

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWLIA2166ZZ

    1.
    4.

    Rear combination lamp
    Rear turn signal lamp bulb

    2.

    Rear tail lamp bulb

    5.

    Rear combination lamp harness connector

    3.

    G

    Rear back-up lamp bulb

    Disassembly and Assembly — Non LED

    H
    INFOID:0000000009670500

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP

    I

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb while it is lit or right after being turned off. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent
    damage to bulb.
    • Do not leave the bulb out of the lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture, smoke, etc.
    may affect the performance of the lamp.

    J

    K

    Disassembly

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Remove rear combination lamp. Refer to EXL-115, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate rear turn signal lamp bulb socket counterclockwise to remove from rear combination lamp.
    Remove the rear turn signal lamp bulb from bulb socket.
    Rotate back-up lamp bulb socket counterclockwise to remove from rear combination lamp.
    Remove the back-up lamp bulb from bulb socket.
    Rotate stop/tail lamp bulb socket counterclockwise to remove from rear combination lamp.
    Remove the stop/tail lamp bulb from bulb socket.

    Assembly
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    CAUTION:
    After installing, be sure to install the bulb sockets securely to ensure watertightness.

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-121

    2014 Note

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    Exploded View — LED

    INFOID:0000000009670501

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP — LED

    JMLIA3231ZZ

    1.

    Rear combination lamp

    2.

    Rear tail lamp bulb

    4.

    Rear back-up lamp bulb

    5.

    Rear turn signal lamp bulb

    3. Rear LED lamp harness connector

    Disassembly and Assembly — LED

    INFOID:0000000009670502

    REAR COMBINATION LAMP
    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb while it is lit or right after being turned off. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent
    damage to bulb.
    • Do not leave the bulb out of the lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture, smoke, etc.
    may affect the performance of the lamp.
    Disassembly

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Remove rear combination lamp. Refer to EXL-115, «Removal and Installation».
    Rotate rear turn signal lamp bulb socket counterclockwise to remove from rear combination lamp.
    Remove the rear turn signal lamp bulb from bulb socket.
    Rotate back-up lamp bulb socket counterclockwise to remove from rear combination lamp.
    Remove the back-up lamp bulb from bulb socket.
    Disconnect the harness connector from the LED lamp.
    Rotate side marker lamp bulb socket counterclockwise to remove from rear combination lamp.
    Remove the side marker lamp bulb from bulb socket.

    Assembly
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    CAUTION:
    After installing, be sure to install the bulb sockets securely to ensure watertightness.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-122

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Bulb specification

    INFOID:0000000009015753

    B

    ARGENTINA MODELS ONLY
    Item

    Wattage (W)*
    Headlamp (HI/LO)

    Front combination

    60/55

    Front turn signal lamp

    21

    Side marker lamp

    5

    Fog lamp (if equipped)

    55

    Daytime running lamp built-in fog lamp

    19

    Rear combination

    Stop lamp

    LED

    Tail lamp

    5

    Rear turn signal lamp

    21

    Back-up lamp

    21

    License plate lamp

    5

    High-mounted stop lamp

    C

    Normal glass

    LED

    Privacy glass

    LED

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts info.

    NON ARGENTINA MODELS

    I
    Item

    Front combination

    Wattage (W)*
    Headlamp (HI/LO)

    65/55

    Front turn signal/Parking lamp

    27/8

    Side marker lamp
    Fog lamp (if equipped)

    55
    Stop/Tail lamp

    Rear combination

    K

    21/5

    Rear turn signal lamp

    21

    Back-up lamp

    21

    License plate lamp
    High-mounted stop lamp

    5

    J

    5
    Normal glass

    LED

    Privacy glass

    LED

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts info.

    EXL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXL-123

    2014 Note

    BODY EXTERIOR, DOORS, ROOF & VEHICLE SECURITY

    SECTION

    EXT

    EXTERIOR

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    COWL TOP ………………………………………………. 22

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    Exploded View …………………………………………………22
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..23

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Procedure without Cowl Top Cover ………………….. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………. 4
    Commercial Service Tools ………………………………… 4

    CLIP LIST …………………………………………………… 5
    Descriptions for Clips ………………………………………… 5

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 9
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES ………………………………………………………. 9
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….. 9
    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting ………. 10
    Diagnostic Worksheet ……………………………………… 13

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 15
    FRONT BUMPER ………………………………………..15
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 15
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 16

    REAR BUMPER ………………………………………….18
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 18
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 18

    FRONT GRILLE ………………………………………….21
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 21
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 21

    Revision: April 2013

    FENDER PROTECTOR ……………………………… 24
    Exploded View …………………………………………………24
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..24

    F

    G

    H

    UNDER COVER ………………………………………… 25
    FRONT UNDER COVER ……………………………………..25
    FRONT UNDER COVER : Exploded View …………..25
    FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………………25
    Exploded View …………………………………………………26
    FLOOR UNDER COVER …………………………………….26
    FLOOR UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………………26
    REAR WIND DEFLECTOR ………………………………….27
    REAR WIND DEFLECTOR : Removal and Installation ………………………………………………………………27

    ROOF SIDE MOLDING ………………………………. 28

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    Exploded View …………………………………………………28
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..28

    M

    DOOR SASH TAPE …………………………………… 30

    N

    Exploded View …………………………………………………30
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..31

    DOOR OUTSIDE MOLDING ……………………….. 32

    O

    Exploded View …………………………………………………32
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..33

    BACK DOOR FINISHER …………………………….. 34
    Exploded View …………………………………………………34
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..34

    EXT-1

    2014 Note

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009446816

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009444681

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc. to prevent damage to
    the windshield.

    PIIB3706J

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009443525

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009671259

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-39570)
    Chassis Ear

    Locating the noise

    SIIA0993E


    (J-50397)
    NISSAN Squeak and Rattle
    Kit

    Repairing the cause of noise

    ALJIA1232ZZ


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009671260

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39565)
    Engine Ear

    Locating the noise

    SIIA0995E

    ( — )
    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-4

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    CLIP LIST

    A

    Descriptions for Clips

    INFOID:0000000009442998

    Replace any clips which are damaged during removal or installation.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SIIA0315E

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-5

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    SIIA0316E

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-6

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N

    O
    SIIA0317E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-7

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    ALJIA0564GB

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-8

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671261

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    SBT842

    CUSTOMER INTERVIEW

    H
    Interview the customer if possible, to determine the conditions that exist when the noise occurs. Use the Diagnostic Worksheet during the interview to document the facts and conditions when the noise occurs and any
    customer’s comments; refer to EXT-13, «Diagnostic Worksheet». This information is necessary to duplicate the
    I
    conditions that exist when the noise occurs.
    • The customer may not be able to provide a detailed description or the location of the noise. Attempt to obtain
    all the facts and conditions that exist when the noise occurs (or does not occur).
    • If there is more than one noise in the vehicle, be sure to diagnose and repair the noise that the customer is J
    concerned about. This can be accomplished by test driving the vehicle with the customer.
    • After identifying the type of noise, isolate the noise in terms of its characteristics. The noise characteristics
    are provided so the customer, service adviser and technician are all speaking the same language when
    EXT
    defining the noise.
    • Squeak —(Like tennis shoes on a clean floor)
    Squeak characteristics include the light contact/fast movement/brought on by road conditions/hard surfaces
    L
    = higher pitch noise/softer surfaces = lower pitch noises/edge to surface = chirping.
    • Creak—(Like walking on an old wooden floor)
    Creak characteristics include firm contact/slow movement/twisting with a rotational movement/pitch dependent on materials/often brought on by activity.
    M
    • Rattle—(Like shaking a baby rattle)
    Rattle characteristics include the fast repeated contact/vibration or similar movement/loose parts/missing
    clip or fastener/incorrect clearance.
    N
    • Knock —(Like a knock on a door)
    Knock characteristics include hollow sounding/sometimes repeating/often brought on by driver action.
    • Tick—(Like a clock second hand)
    Tick characteristics include gentle contacting of light materials/loose components/can be caused by driver
    O
    action or road conditions.
    • Thump—(Heavy, muffled knock noise)
    Thump characteristics include softer knock/dead sound often brought on by activity.
    P
    • Buzz—(Like a bumble bee)
    Buzz characteristics include high frequency rattle/firm contact.
    • Often the degree of acceptable noise level will vary depending upon the person. A noise that you may judge
    as acceptable may be very irritating to the customer.
    • Weather conditions, especially humidity and temperature, may have a great effect on noise level.

    DUPLICATE THE NOISE AND TEST DRIVE

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-9

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    If possible, drive the vehicle with the customer until the noise is duplicated. Note any additional information on
    the Diagnostic Worksheet regarding the conditions or location of the noise. This information can be used to
    duplicate the same conditions when you confirm the repair.
    If the noise can be duplicated easily during the test drive, to help identify the source of the noise, try to duplicate the noise with the vehicle stopped by doing one or all of the following:
    1) Close a door.
    2) Tap or push/pull around the area where the noise appears to be coming from.
    3) Rev the engine.
    4) Use a floor jack to recreate vehicle “twist”.
    5) At idle, apply engine load (electrical load, half-clutch on M/T model, drive position on CVT and A/T models).
    6) Raise the vehicle on a hoist and hit a tire with a rubber hammer.
    • Drive the vehicle and attempt to duplicate the conditions the customer states exist when the noise occurs.
    • If it is difficult to duplicate the noise, drive the vehicle slowly on an undulating or rough road to stress the
    vehicle body.

    CHECK RELATED SERVICE BULLETINS
    After verifying the customer concern or symptom, check ASIST for Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) related
    to that concern or symptom.
    If a TSB relates to the symptom, follow the procedure to repair the noise.

    LOCATE THE NOISE AND IDENTIFY THE ROOT CAUSE
    1.
    2.

    Narrow down the noise to a general area. To help pinpoint the source of the noise, use a listening tool
    (Chassis Ear: J-39570, Engine Ear: J-39565 and mechanic’s stethoscope).
    Narrow down the noise to a more specific area and identify the cause of the noise by:
    • removing the components in the area that you suspect the noise is coming from.
    Do not use too much force when removing clips and fasteners, otherwise clips and fasteners can be
    broken or lost during the repair, resulting in the creation of new noise.
    • tapping or pushing/pulling the component that you suspect is causing the noise.
    Do not tap or push/pull the component with excessive force, otherwise the noise will be eliminated only
    temporarily.
    • feeling for a vibration with your hand by touching the component(s) that you suspect is (are) causing the
    noise.
    • placing a piece of paper between components that you suspect are causing the noise.
    • looking for loose components and contact marks.
    Refer to EXT-10, «Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting».

    REPAIR THE CAUSE


    If the cause is a loose component, tighten the component securely.
    If the cause is insufficient clearance between components:
    separate components by repositioning or loosening and retightening the component, if possible.
    insulate components with a suitable insulator such as urethane pads, foam blocks, felt cloth tape or urethane
    tape. A NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) is available through your authorized NISSAN Parts Department.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use excessive force as many components are constructed of plastic and may be damaged.
    NOTE:
    • Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    • The materials contained in the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) are listed on the inside cover of the
    kit; and can each be ordered separately as needed.
    • The following materials not found in the kit can also be used to repair squeaks and rattles.
    — SILICONE GREASE: Use instead of UHMW tape that will be visible or does not fit. The silicone grease will
    only last a few months.
    — SILICONE SPRAY: Use when grease cannot be applied.
    — DUCT TAPE: Use to eliminate movement.

    CONFIRM THE REPAIR
    Confirm that the cause of a noise is repaired by test driving the vehicle. Operate the vehicle under the same
    conditions as when the noise originally occurred. Refer to the notes on the Diagnostic Worksheet.

    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting

    INFOID:0000000009671262

    Refer to Table of Contents for specific component removal and installation information.
    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-10

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    INSTRUMENT PANEL
    Most incidents are caused by contact and movement between:
    1. Cluster lid A and the instrument panel
    2. Acrylic lens and combination meter housing
    3. Instrument panel to front pillar finisher
    4. Instrument panel to windshield
    5. Instrument panel pins
    6. Wiring harnesses behind the combination meter
    7. A/C defroster duct and duct joint
    These incidents can usually be located by tapping or moving the components to duplicate the noise or by
    pressing on the components while driving to stop the noise. Most of these incidents can be repaired by applying felt cloth tape or silicone spray (in hard to reach areas). Urethane pads can be used to insulate wiring harness.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use silicone spray to isolate a squeak or rattle. If you saturate the area with silicone, you will
    not be able to recheck the repair.

    C

    CENTER CONSOLE

    F

    Components to pay attention to include:
    1. Shift selector assembly cover to finisher
    2. A/C control unit and cluster lid C
    3. Wiring harnesses behind audio and A/C control unit
    The instrument panel repair and isolation procedures also apply to the center console.

    A

    B

    D

    E

    G

    H

    DOORS
    Pay attention to the:
    I
    1. Finisher and inner panel making a slapping noise
    2. Inside handle escutcheon to door finisher
    3. Wiring harnesses tapping
    J
    4. Door striker out of alignment causing a popping noise on starts and stops
    Tapping or moving the components or pressing on them while driving to duplicate the conditions can isolate
    many of these incidents. You can usually insulate the areas with felt cloth tape or insulator foam blocks from
    EXT
    the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) to repair the noise.

    TRUNK
    Trunk noises are often caused by a loose jack or loose items put into the trunk by the owner.
    In addition look for:
    1. Trunk lid bumpers out of adjustment
    2. Trunk lid striker out of adjustment
    3. The trunk lid torsion bars knocking together
    4. A loose license plate or bracket
    Most of these incidents can be repaired by adjusting, securing or insulating the item(s) or component(s) causing the noise.

    SUNROOF/HEADLINING
    Noises in the sunroof/headlining area can often be traced to one of the following:
    1. Sunroof lid, rail, linkage or seals making a rattle or light knocking noise
    2. Sun visor shaft shaking in the holder
    3. Front or rear windshield touching headlining and squeaking
    Again, pressing on the components to stop the noise while duplicating the conditions can isolate most of these
    incidents. Repairs usually consist of insulating with felt cloth tape.

    OVERHEAD CONSOLE (FRONT AND REAR)
    Overhead console noises are often caused by the console panel clips not being engaged correctly. Most of
    these incidents are repaired by pushing up on the console at the clip locations until the clips engage.
    In addition look for:
    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-11

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Loose harness or harness connectors.
    2. Front console map/reading lamp lens loose.
    3. Loose screws at console attachment points.

    SEATS
    When isolating seat noise it’s important to note the position the seat is in and the load placed on the seat when
    the noise is present. These conditions should be duplicated when verifying and isolating the cause of the
    noise.
    Cause of seat noise include:
    1. Headrest rods and holder
    2. A squeak between the seat pad cushion and frame
    3. The rear seatback lock and bracket
    These noises can be isolated by moving or pressing on the suspected components while duplicating the conditions under which the noise occurs. Most of these incidents can be repaired by repositioning the component
    or applying urethane tape to the contact area.

    UNDERHOOD
    Some interior noise may be caused by components under the hood or on the engine wall. The noise is then
    transmitted into the passenger compartment.
    Causes of transmitted underhood noise include:
    1. Any component installed to the engine wall
    2. Components that pass through the engine wall
    3. Engine wall mounts and connectors
    4. Loose radiator installation pins
    5. Hood bumpers out of adjustment
    6. Hood striker out of adjustment
    These noises can be difficult to isolate since they cannot be reached from the interior of the vehicle. The best
    method is to secure, move or insulate one component at a time and test drive the vehicle. Also, engine rpm or
    load can be changed to isolate the noise. Repairs can usually be made by moving, adjusting, securing, or
    insulating the component causing the noise.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-12

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnostic Worksheet

    INFOID:0000000009671263

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N

    O

    LAIA0072E

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-13

    P

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    LAIA0071E

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-14

    2014 Note

    FRONT BUMPER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    FRONT BUMPER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015848

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N
    AWKIA2583ZZ

    1.

    Front bumper fascia side bracket 2.
    (RH)

    Front bumper reinforcement

    4.

    Front fascia side deflector (RH)

    5.

    Front fog lamp (RH) (if equipped) 6.

    Tow cover

    7.

    Front license plate bracket

    8.

    Front bumper fascia

    9.

    Front fog lamp (LH) (if equipped)

    10. Front fascia side deflector (LH)

    11.

    Front under cover

    12. Front bumper fascia side bracket
    (LH)

    13. Front bumper reinforcement
    bracket (RH)

    14. Front bumper reinforcement
    bracket (LH)

    B.

    Front fog lamp bracket

    Revision: April 2013

    3.

    A.

    Front energy absorber

    O

    J nut

    Pawl

    EXT-15

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT BUMPER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015849

    CAUTION:
    Bumper fascia is made of resin. Use care when handling to prevent damage. Avoid contact with oily
    substances.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove the front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the four front bumper fascia upper clips.
    Remove the front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    Partially remove front fender protectors (LH/RH) at the front edge to access front bumper fascia bolts.
    Refer to EXT-24, «Exploded View».
    Remove front bumper fascia bolts (A) (LH/RH).

    JMKIA8017ZZ

    6.

    Remove the front bumper fascia from the front bumper fascia
    side brackets (LH/RH) by releasing the pawls as shown.
    : Pawl
    CAUTION:
    When removing front bumper fascia, two people are
    required to avoid damaging.

    AWKIA1890ZZ

    7.
    8.
    9.

    Disconnect the harness connectors from the front fog lamps (LH/RH) (if equipped).
    Remove front bumper fascia.
    Remove the following parts after removing front bumper fascia (if necessary).
    • Tow cover
    • Front fog lamps (LH/RH) (if equipped). Refer to EXL-110, «Removal and Installation».
    • Front license plate bracket
    10. Remove the front energy absorber (if necessary).
    11. Remove nuts and front bumper reinforcement (if necessary).

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Tighten the front bumper reinforcement nuts to specification (if removed). Refer to EXT-15, «Exploded View».
    NOTE:
    • The following table shows the specified values for checking normal installation specifications.
    • Fitting adjustment cannot be performed.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-16

    2014 Note

    FRONT BUMPER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    AWKIA2515ZZ

    Section

    Measurement

    Minimum

    Target Value

    Maximum

    A-A

    Clearance

    0.0 (0.00)

    2.0 (0.08)

    4.0 (0.16)

    B-B

    Clearance

    2.4 (0.09)

    4.4 (0.17)

    6.4 (0.25)

    B-B

    Surface height

    -1.5 (-0.06)

    0.5 (0.02)

    1.99 (0.08)

    C-C

    Clearance

    0.0 (0.00)

    2.0 (0.08)

    4.0 (0.16)

    D-D

    Clearance

    0.0 (0.00)

    1.5 (0.06)

    3.0 (0.12)

    D-D

    Surface height

    0.0 (0.00)

    1.5 (0.06)

    3.0 (0.12)

    E-E

    Clearance

    0.01 (0.00)

    2.0 (0.08)

    4.0 (0.16)

    F-F

    Clearance

    0.1 (0.00)

    0.3 (0.01)

    1.0 (0.04)

    F-F

    Surface height

    -0.1 (0.00)

    0.7 (0.03)

    1.7 (0.07)

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-17

    2014 Note

    REAR BUMPER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR BUMPER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015850

    AWKIA2520ZZ

    1.

    Rear bumper fascia side
    bracket (LH)

    2.

    Rear bumper reinforcement support 3.
    (LH)

    Rear bumper closing (LH)

    4.

    Rear bumper fascia

    5.

    Rear bumper finisher

    6.

    Rear bumper fascia spacer

    7.

    Rear bumper reinforcement

    8.

    Rear bumper closing (RH)

    9.

    Rear bumper reinforcement
    support (RH)

    A.

    J nut

    10. Rear bumper fascia side
    bracket (RH)

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015851

    CAUTION:
    Bumper fascia is made of resin. Use care when handling to prevent damage. Avoid contact with oily
    substances.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove rear combination lamps (LH/RH). Refer to EXL-115, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-18

    2014 Note

    REAR BUMPER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Remove screws (A) and clip (B) from rear bumper closings (1)
    (LH/RH).

    A

    B

    C
    ALKIA2525ZZ

    3.

    D

    Remove the rear bumper fascia upper bolt (A) (LH/RH) from
    each side of the rear bumper fascia (1).

    E

    F

    G
    AWKIA2526ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Remove rear bumper fascia lower clips.
    Remove the rear bumper fascia from the rear bumper fascia
    side brackets (LH/RH) by releasing the pawls as shown.
    : Pawl
    CAUTION:
    When removing rear bumper fascia, two people are
    required to avoid damaging.

    H

    I

    J

    EXT
    AWKIA2523ZZ

    6.

    7.
    8.

    Remove the following parts after removing rear bumper fascia (if necessary).
    • Two clips each and rear bumper closings (LH/RH)
    • Two screws and rear bumper finisher
    • Rear bumper fascia spacers
    • Two bolts each and rear bumper side brackets (LH/RH)
    Remove rear bumper reinforcement nuts and rear bumper reinforcement (if necessary).
    Remove rear bumper reinforcement support nuts from each and the rear bumper reinforcement supports
    (LH/RH) (if necessary).

    L

    M

    N

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    • The following table shows the specified values for checking normal installation specifications.
    • Fitting adjustment cannot be performed.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-19

    2014 Note

    REAR BUMPER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ALKIA3207ZZ

    Section

    Measurement

    Minimum

    Target Value

    Maximum

    A-A

    Clearance

    0.1 (0.00)

    0.3 (0.01)

    1.0 (0.04)

    B-B

    Clearance

    0.0 (0.00)

    1.5 (0.06)

    3.5 (0.14)

    B-B

    Surface height

    -1.5 (-0.06)

    0.5 (0.02)

    2.5 (0.10)

    C-C

    Clearance

    3.0 (0.12)

    5.0 (0.20)

    7.0 (0.28)

    C-C

    Surface height

    -2.0 (-0.08)

    -1.5 (-0.06)

    3.5 (0.14)

    D-D

    Clearance

    5.0 (0.20)

    7.0 (0.28)

    9.0 (0.35)

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-20

    2014 Note

    FRONT GRILLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT GRILLE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015852

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2553ZZ

    1.

    Front grille finisher
    Pawl

    2.

    Front grille

    3.

    Front emblem

    J

    Clip

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015853

    EXT

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the front grille finisher clips.
    Release pawls using a suitable tool and remove the front grille finisher.
    Release the clips using a suitable tool, then pull the front grille away from vehicle to release pawls and
    remove.
    Release pawls and remove front emblem from front grille (if necessary).

    INSTALLATION

    L

    M

    N

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-21

    2014 Note

    COWL TOP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    COWL TOP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015856

    AWKIA2518ZZ

    1.

    Cowl top side cover (RH)

    2.

    Front fender seal (RH)

    3.

    Cowl top extension

    4.

    EPT seal [t: 5.0 mm (0.197 in)]

    5.

    Cowl top cover seal

    6.

    Front fender seal (LH)

    7.

    One-way valve

    8.

    Cowl top cover

    9.

    Cowl top cover cap

    10. Cowl top side cover (LH)
    Front

    Revision: April 2013

    11. EPT seal [t: 3.0 mm (0.118 in)] 12. EPT seal [t: 15.0 mm (0.591 in)]
    Clip

    Pawl

    EXT-22

    2014 Note

    COWL TOP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015857

    A

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove front wiper arms (LH/RH). Refer to WW-58, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove cowl top side covers (LH/RH).
    Remove cowl top cover clips.
    Pull forward to release cowl top cover from windshield.
    CAUTION:
    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top
    cover, cover the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc.
    to prevent damage to the windshield.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    JMKIA8047ZZ

    5.
    6.
    7.

    Disconnect the washer tube connector and harness clips.
    Remove cowl top cover.
    Remove the following parts after removing cowl top cover (if necessary).
    • EPT seals
    • Cowl top cover seal
    • Washer tube
    • Washer nozzles (LH/RH). Refer to WW-55, «WASHER NOZZLE : Removal and Installation».

    F

    G

    H

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Always replace EPT seals with new ones when reusing the cowl top cover.
    • When installing EPT seal (2) of portion (A) on cowl top cover (1), install EPT seal by aligning to the
    line of (B) and setting portion (C) in cowl top cover.

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M
    JMKIB0738ZZ

    • After installing cowl top cover (2), check that side surface of EPT seal (1) makes contact with windshield glass (3).

    N

    O

    P

    JMKIB0739ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-23

    2014 Note

    FENDER PROTECTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FENDER PROTECTOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015858

    AWKIA2513ZZ

    1.

    Front fender protector

    A.

    J nut

    Removal and Installation

    Front
    INFOID:0000000009444684

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove fender protector screws and clips.
    Remove fender protector.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-24

    2014 Note

    UNDER COVER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UNDER COVER

    A

    FRONT UNDER COVER
    FRONT UNDER COVER : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009444682

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    AWKIA2555ZZ

    1.

    M

    Front under cover

    FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444683

    N

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove the front bumper fascia. Refer to EXT-16, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the front under cover clips and nuts.
    Slide the front under cover forward slightly to release pawls and to allow clearance of studs, then remove
    the front under cover.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-25

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    UNDER COVER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009645124

    JMKIB0581ZZ

    1.

    Rear floor under cover (RH)

    4.

    Rear wind deflector

    2.

    Rear floor under cover (LH)

    3.

    Grommet

    Front

    FLOOR UNDER COVER
    FLOOR UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009645125

    REMOVAL
    Remove the rear floor under cover nuts and the rear floor under cover.
    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-26

    2014 Note

    UNDER COVER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    A

    REAR WIND DEFLECTOR

    REAR WIND DEFLECTOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009645126

    B

    REMOVAL
    Remove the rear wind deflector screws and the rear wind deflector.

    C

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-27

    2014 Note

    ROOF SIDE MOLDING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ROOF SIDE MOLDING
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015860

    AWKIA2556ZZ

    1.

    Roof side molding

    2.

    Roof side molding clip

    3.

    Roof panel

    4.

    Body side outer panel

    5.

    Double-sided tape
    [t: 2.5 mm (0.098 in)]

    6.

    Double-sided tape
    [t: 4.0 mm (0.157 in)]

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015861

    ROOF SIDE MOLDING
    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-28

    2014 Note

    ROOF SIDE MOLDING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Removal
    Lift using a suitable tool (A), then pull the roof side molding from the
    roof panel, starting from the front of vehicle and moving toward the
    rear.
    : Clip

    A

    B

    C

    AWKIA2560ZZ

    D

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Replace the double-sided tape on the back surface with new double-sided tape when reusing the roof
    side molding.

    E

    ROOF SIDE MOLDING CLIP

    F

    Removal

    1.
    2.

    Remove roof side molding.
    Heat double sided tape using a suitable tool, then remove roof side molding clips using a suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Use care not to damage the body paint.

    G

    H

    Installation

    1.
    2.

    Clean tape removed surface with a shop cloth soaked in white gasoline or IPA.
    Use two-part epoxy adhesive.
    Adhesive

    3.

    J

    : Approximately 0.5 mm (0.02 in)

    EXT

    Position clip to the proper location, then sufficiently press-fit until the adhesive protrudes to tape side.
    Press-fit limit

    5.

    : 3M-weld DP–100 or equivalent

    Apply adhesive evenly to clip tape surface.
    Thickness

    4.

    I

    : 19.6 N (2.0 Kg — 4.41 lb) × 2 seconds

    L

    Tape clips after press fit to temporarily hold for specified time based on the following conditions.
    M

    5 to 10 °C (41 to 50 °F)
    : 1 hour or more
    11 to 23 °C (52 to 73 °F)
    : 30 minutes or more
    24 °C or more (75 °F or more) : 15 minutes or more

    N

    6. Install roof side molding from rear of vehicle to front after removing the temporary hold tape.
    CAUTION:
    • When installing roof side molding, check that the molding is securely inserted into the clips.
    • Do not wash the vehicle within 24 hours so as to keep adhesive dry.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-29

    2014 Note

    DOOR SASH TAPE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR SASH TAPE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015862

    JMKIB0613ZZ

    1.

    Front door sash front tape

    2.

    Front door sash rear tape

    4.

    Rear door sash rear tape

    5.

    Center pillar tape

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-30

    3.

    Rear door sash front tape

    2014 Note

    DOOR SASH TAPE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009645128

    A

    REMOVAL
    Heat door sash tape surface using a suitable tool and remove door sash tape.
    CAUTION:
    Use care not to damage body paint.

    B

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    • Degrease door assembly surface for sash tape.
    • Grit or dust on surface of sash tape may spoil exterior appearance if not removed. Clean the surface
    and check that no grit or dust remains before starting the operation.
    • Do not reuse blackout tape.
    1. Affix door sash tape (2) to door panel (3) by applying pressure using a squeegee (A) while peeling off
    release coated paper (1).
    NOTE:
    • Peel release coated paper at distance of 10 – 20 mm (0.4 – 0.8 in) ahead (B) of squeegee and affix
    blackout paper.
    • To prevent any bubbles from forming, slightly lift the portion not yet affixed using a squeegee, so that
    portion dose not contact with panel surface. Apply pressure and affix at a low and constant speed using
    squeegee tilted at 40 – 50° angle (pushing direction) (C) 30 – 45° angle (pulling direction) (D).

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    EXT
    JMKIA4862GB

    2.

    L

    For small radius portion of hemming part, gradually apply pressure and affix door sash tape (1) using squeegee (A) as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not wash the vehicle with in 24 hours so as to keep
    adhesive dry.

    M

    N

    O
    JMKIA4655ZZ

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-31

    2014 Note

    DOOR OUTSIDE MOLDING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR OUTSIDE MOLDING
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015864

    AWKIA2517ZZ

    1.

    Front door outside molding

    Revision: April 2013

    2.

    Rear door outside molding

    EXT-32

    3.

    Front door panel

    2014 Note

    DOOR OUTSIDE MOLDING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4.

    Rear door panel

    5.

    Rear door glass

    6.

    Front door glass

    A

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444686

    B

    FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOLDING
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    Lower front door glass fully.
    Release the pawls using a suitable tool, then rotate front door outside molding toward the outside of the
    vehicle and lift up to remove.

    C

    D

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    E

    REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOLDING
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    Lower rear door glass fully.
    Release the pawl using a suitable tool, then rotate rear door outside molding toward the outside of the
    vehicle and lift up to remove.

    F

    G

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    H

    I

    J

    EXT

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-33

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR FINISHER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BACK DOOR FINISHER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015865

    AWKIA2514ZZ

    1.

    Rear camera (if equipped)

    2.

    Back door outer finisher

    3.

    Back door request switch

    Clip

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015866

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove back door inner finisher. Refer to INT-34, «BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from back door request switch.
    Remove back door outer finisher nuts.
    Release clips and remove the back door outer finisher.
    Remove back door request switch from the back door outer finisher (if necessary).

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    When installing back door finisher, check that clips are securely placed into body panel holes.

    Revision: April 2013

    EXT-34

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION & DRIVELINE

    SECTION

    FAX

    FRONT AXLE

    A

    B

    C

    FAX

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Drive Shaft ………………………………….. 2
    Precautions for Wheel Hub and Knuckle ……………… 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 3
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 4

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 6
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….. 6
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………….. 6

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 7
    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE ………….. 7
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 7

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 9
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 9
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….11
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….13

    F

    G

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BOOT …………………….. 14
    Exploded View …………………………………………………14

    H

    WHEEL SIDE …………………………………………………….14
    WHEEL SIDE : Removal and Installation …………….15
    TRANSAXLE SIDE …………………………………………….18
    TRANSAXLE SIDE : Removal and Installation …….18
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….18

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ………………………………. 19
    Exploded View …………………………………………………19
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..19

    I

    J

    K

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY … 21
    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ………………………………. 21
    Exploded View …………………………………………………21
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….22

    L

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 27

    M

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 9

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 27

    N

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE ………….. 9

    Wheel Bearing …………………………………………………27
    Drive Shaft ………………………………………………………27

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT …………………………………. 8
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 8

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009541306

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Drive Shaft

    INFOID:0000000009541307

    Observe the following precautions when disassembling and assembling drive shaft.
    • Do not disassemble joint sub-assembly because it is non-overhaul parts.
    • Perform work in a location which is as dust-free as possible.
    • Clean the parts, before disassembling and assembling.
    • Prevent the entry of foreign objects during disassembly of the service location.
    • Reassemble disassembled parts carefully in the correct order. If work is interrupted, a clean cover must be
    placed over parts.
    • Use paper waste. Fabric shop cloths must not be used because of the danger of lint adhering to parts.
    • Clean disassembled parts (except for rubber parts) with kerosene which shall be removed by blowing with
    air or wiping with paper waste.

    Precautions for Wheel Hub and Knuckle

    INFOID:0000000009541308

    Observe the following precautions when assembling wheel hub and knuckle.
    • Perform work in a location which is as dust-free as possible.
    • Use paper waste. Fabric shop cloths must not be used because of the danger of lint adhering to parts.
    • If any of wheel hub, steering knuckle, wheel bearing, and wheel hub lock nut is dropped, it must not be used.
    • Always check that the tools used for press-fit work of wheel hub and wheel bearing have no wear and deformation so that a pressure can be applied vertically.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009541309

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV40104000
    (

    )
    Hub lock nut wrench

    Removing and Installing wheel hub lock nut
    a: 85 mm (3.35 in)
    b: 65 mm (2.56 in)

    C

    FAX

    E
    ZZA0802D

    ST33710000
    (

    )
    Drift

    F

    Removing wheel hub
    a: 30 mm (1.18 in) dia.
    b: 23 mm (0.91 in) dia.

    G

    H
    ZZA1233D

    ST30031000
    (

    )
    Puller

    Removing wheel bearing inner race (outer)

    I

    J
    ZZA0700D

    ST35321000
    (

    )
    Drift

    • Removing wheel bearing
    • Installing wheel hub
    a: 49 mm (1.93 in) dia.
    b: 41 mm (1.61 in) dia.

    K

    L

    M

    ZZA1051D

    ST35271000
    (

    )
    Drift

    Installing wheel bearing
    a: 72 mm (2.83 in) dia.
    b: 63 mm (2.48 in) dia.

    N

    O
    ZZA0837D

    ST33061000
    (

    )
    Drift

    Installing wheel hub
    a: 38 mm (1.50 in) dia.
    b: 28.5 mm (1.122 in) dia.

    P

    ZZA1051D

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV40107300
    (

    )
    Boot band crimping tool

    Installing boot band

    ZZA1229D

    KV40107500
    (

    )
    Drive shaft attachment

    Removing drive shaft

    ZZA1230D

    KV38107900
    (

    )
    Differential side oil seal protector

    Installing drive shaft
    a: 32 mm (1.26 in) dia.

    PDIA1183J

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009541310

    Tool name

    Description

    Drive shaft puller

    Removing drive shaft joint sub-assembly

    JPDIG0152ZZ

    Sliding hammer

    Removing drive shaft

    ZZA0023D

    Ball joint remover

    Removing wheel stud

    NT146

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-4

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    Tool name

    Description

    Drift

    • Installing wheel bearing
    • Installing splash guard
    a: 68 mm (2.68 in) dia.

    A

    B

    C

    ZZA0898D

    Drift

    Installing splash guard
    a: 95 mm (3.74 in) dia.

    FAX

    E
    JPDIC0679ZZ

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    F

    G

    H

    PIIB1407E

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-5

    2014 Note

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009541311

    FRONT
    AXLE

    WT-5

    WT-4

    BR-7

    ST-7

    FRONT AXLE

    TIRE

    ROAD WHEEL

    DRIVE SHAFT

    BRAKE

    STEERING

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    FSU-6

    ×

    FRONT SUSPENSION

    ×

    FAX-7

    Symptom

    ×

    Parts interference

    Shake

    FAX-7

    ×

    Wheel bearing damage

    DRIVE
    SHAFT

    Improper installation, looseness

    ×

    Possible cause and SUSPECTED PARTS

    FSU-20
    Joint sliding resistance

    Noise

    Reference

    Imbalance


    Excessive joint angle

    Use chart below to find the cause of the symptom. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    Noise

    ×

    Shake

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Vibration

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shimmy

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shudder

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Poor quality ride or handling

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×: Applicable

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-6

    2014 Note

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009541312

    B

    COMPONENT PART
    • Check that the mounting conditions (looseness, backlash) of each component and component conditions
    (wear, damage) are normal.
    • Check the axle and suspension parts for excessive play, weary or damage.
    • Shake each front wheel to check for excessive play.

    C

    FAX

    E

    F

    SMA525A

    FRONT WHEEL BEARING INSPECTION
    Check the following items, and replace the part if necessary.
    • Move the wheel bearing in the axial direction by hand. Make sure there is no looseness in the wheel bearing.
    Axial end play

    G

    H

    : Refer to FAX-27.

    • Rotate the wheel bearing and make sure there is no unusual noise or other irregular conditions. If there are
    any irregular conditions, replace wheel bearing.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-7

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009541313

    Check the following items, and replace the part if necessary.
    • Check drive shaft mounting point and joint for looseness and other damage.
    CAUTION:
    Replace entire drive shaft when noise or vibration occurs from drive shaft.
    • Check boot for cracks and other damage.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-8

    2014 Note

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009541314

    B

    C

    FAX

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    AWDIA1108ZZ

    1.

    Steering knuckle

    2.

    Splash guard

    3.

    Wheel bearing

    4.

    Snap ring

    5.

    Wheel stud

    6.

    Wheel hub

    7.

    Disc brake rotor

    8.

    Wheel hub lock nut

    9.

    Cotter pin

    Removal and Installation

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009541315

    L

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    5.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove wheel sensor and sensor harness. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and
    Installation».
    Remove brake caliper using power tool, leaving brake hose connected. Reposition brake caliper aside
    with wire. Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View».
    NOTE:
    Avoid depressing brake pedal while brake caliper is removed.
    Put matching marks on disc brake rotor and wheel hub, then remove disc brake rotor.
    CAUTION:
    • Use paint for matching parts. Do not damage the disc brake rotor or wheel hub.
    • Do not drop disc rotor.
    Remove and discard cotter pin, and then loosen wheel hub lock nut, using Tool.
    Tool number

    6.

    : KV40104000 (

    )

    Separate the drive shaft from the wheel hub by lightly tapping the end of the drive shaft using a suitable
    tool and a wood block.
    NOTE:

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-9

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Use suitable puller if wheel hub and drive shaft cannot be separated after performing the above procedure.
    7. Remove wheel hub lock nut.
    8. Remove the nut and separate the steering outer socket from steering knuckle. Refer to ST-14, «Exploded
    View».
    9. Remove the nuts and bolts, then separate the steering knuckle from strut. Refer to FSU-9, «Exploded
    View».
    10. Suspend the drive shaft with suitable wire.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not place drive shaft joint at an extreme angle. Also be careful not to overextend slide joint.
    • Do not allow drive shaft to hang down without support for joint sub-assembly, shaft and the
    other parts.
    11. Remove transverse link outer nut and bolt. Remove steering knuckle from transverse link.
    12. If necessary, remove wheel studs (1) from wheel hub using the
    suitable tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    • Remove stud only when necessary.
    • Do not hammer the wheel stud or damage to the wheel
    bearing may occur.
    • Press the wheel stud straight out to avoid damaging the
    stud.

    JPDIF0299ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of the removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse the transverse link outer nut.
    • Do not damage the wheel bearing seal. If damage has occurred, replace wheel bearing.
    • Do not allow paint to adhere to the wheel bearing seal.
    • Check each mating surface for water and foreign matter. If there is any water or foreign matter, clean
    the mounting surface.
    • Position the stud (1) to the wheel hub flange. Place a washer (A)
    and nut (B) on the opposite end of the stud. Tighten to press the
    stud into the wheel hub flange.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that no clearance exists between wheel hub and
    wheel stud after installation.
    • Do not reuse wheel stud.

    JPDIF0300ZZ

    • Clean the mating surfaces of wheel hub lock nut and wheel hub.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply lubricating oil to the mating surface of the wheel hub lock nut and the wheel hub.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-10

    2014 Note

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Clean the mating surfaces of drive shaft, wheel hub, and wheel
    bearing. Apply Molykote M77 to surface (A) of joint sub-assembly.
    CAUTION:
    Apply Molykote M77 to cover entire flat surface of joint subassembly.
    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    A

    B

    C

    Molykote M77 quantity

    : FAX-27, «Drive Shaft»
    JSDIA2844ZZ

    FAX

    • When reusing disc rotor, align the matching marks during removal.
    • When installing a cotter pin, securely bend the cotter pin to prevent rattles.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse cotter pin.

    Disassembly and Assembly

    E
    INFOID:0000000009541316

    F

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.

    Remove wheel hub using Tool.
    Tool number

    2.

    : ST33710000 (

    G

    )

    Remove splash guard from steering knuckle.

    H

    I

    SDIA0758J

    3.

    J

    Remove wheel bearing inner race (outer side) from wheel hub
    using Tools.
    K

    Tool number
    Tool number

    : ST33710000 (
    : ST30031000 (


    )
    )
    L

    M
    SDIA0759J

    4.
    5.

    Remove snap ring from steering knuckle using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage steering knuckle.
    Remove wheel bearing from steering knuckle using Tool.
    Tool number

    : ST35321000 (

    N

    O

    )
    P

    SDIA0760J

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-11

    2014 Note

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    ASSEMBLY
    1. Install wheel bearing to steering knuckle using the Tool (A) and a
    suitable tool (B).
    Tool number

    : ST35271000 (

    )

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse wheel bearing.
    • Do not apply a cleaning agent or anticorrosive to the
    mounting surfaces of the wheel bearing and steering
    knuckle.
    • Install wheel bearing with the wheel sensor rotor rubber
    JPDIF0306ZZ
    part (C) faced to the steering knuckle inner side.
    • The wheel sensor rotor of the wheel bearing must be kept
    free of foreign matter.
    • The press-fit load must be applied to the wheel bearing outer race and the steering knuckle.
    • Do not apply press-fit load to the wheel bearing inner race, the seal (C) on the rubber surface
    side (wheel sensor rotor side), and the seal (D) on the metallic surface side. If a press-fit load is
    applied, the wheel bearing must be replaced with a new one.
    Wheel bearing
    press-fit load

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel
    Bearing»

    2.

    Install snap ring to steering knuckle.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage the wheel bearing seal.
    • The snap ring must be installed evenly into the groove.

    3.

    Press splash guard (1) into the steering knuckle using suitable
    tools (A and B).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse splash guard.

    JSDIA2728ZZ

    4.

    Install wheel hub using Tools.
    Tool number (A)
    Tool number (B)

    : ST33061000 (
    : ST35321000 (


    )
    )

    CAUTION:
    • Do not apply lubricating oil to the press-fit surface of the
    wheel hub bearing.
    • Set wheel hub and wheel bearing horizontally and insert
    them vertically.
    • The press-fit load must be applied to the wheel hub and
    JPDIF0284ZZ
    the wheel bearing inner race.
    • Do not apply press-fit load to the steering knuckle and the wheel bearing, the seal. If a press-fit
    load is applied, the wheel bearing must be replaced with a new one.
    • Apply a press-fit load and maintain the loaded state for 30 seconds.
    • If the inserted wheel hub is removed again, the wheel bearing must be replaced with a new one.
    Wheel bearing
    press-fit load

    Revision: April 2013

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel
    Bearing»

    FAX-12

    2014 Note

    FRONT WHEEL HUB AND KNUCKLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009541317

    A

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check the following items, and replace the part if necessary.
    • Check components for deformation, cracks, and other damage.
    • Check boots of transverse link and steering outer socket ball joint for breakage, axial end play, and swing
    torque. Refer to FSU-20, «Ball Joint» and FAX-27, «Wheel Bearing».

    B

    C

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Wheel Hub
    • Check wheel hub for cracks (with magnetic exploration or dye testing). Replace if necessary.
    Steering Knuckle
    • Check steering knuckle for deformation, cracks, and other damage. Replace if any non-standard conditions
    are found.

    FAX

    E

    Snap Rings
    • Check snap ring for wear or cracks. Replace if necessary.

    INSPECTION AFTER ASSEMBLY

    F

    Check wheel bearing rotating torque as per the following instructions.
    NOTE:
    The adequacy of turning torque can be judged from a measurement value by a spring balancer.
    1. For a proper fit of the bearing, turn the wheel hub clockwise and counterclockwise, respectively, 10 times
    or more with a press-fit load applied.

    G

    H

    Wheel bearing
    press-fit load
    2.

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel
    Bearing»
    I

    Set a spring balance on strut mounting hole (upper). Measure
    rotating torque at an rpm of 8 — 12 rpm.
    Rotating torque
    Spring balance
    measurement

    • If the turning torque cannot be obtained by the above method,
    measure the torque, according to the instructions below.
    — Install drive shaft and tighten the hub lock nut to the specified
    torque. Rotate the wheel hub to fit properly.
    — Set a spring balancer to the hub bolt and measure turning torque
    at turning speeds of 8 to 12 rpm.
    Rotating torque
    Spring balance
    measurement

    J

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel Bearing».
    : Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel Bearing».

    K

    SDIA0762J

    L

    M

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel Bearing»
    : Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel Bearing»

    N

    INSPECTION BEFORE INSTALLATION
    Check wheel sensor rotor for foreign matter. Clean the rotor, if necessary.

    O

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Check wheel sensor harness to be sure the connectors are fully seated. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT
    WHEEL SENSOR : Exploded View».
    Check the wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-7, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-13

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BOOT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BOOT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009541318

    (LH)

    JPDIF0266ZZ

    1.

    Circular clip

    2.

    Dust shield

    3.

    Slide joint housing

    4.

    Snap ring

    5.

    Spider assembly

    6.

    Boot band

    7.

    Boot

    8.

    Shaft

    9.

    Damper band

    10.

    Dynamic damper

    11.

    Circular clip

    12.

    Joint sub-assembly

    Wheel side

    (RH)

    JPDIF0269ZZ

    1.

    Circular clip

    2.

    Dust shield

    3.

    Slide joint housing

    4.

    Snap ring

    5.

    Spider assembly

    6.

    Boot band

    7.

    Boot

    8.

    Shaft

    9.

    Damper Band

    10.

    Dynamic damper

    11.

    Circular clip

    12.

    Joint sub-assembly

    Wheel side

    WHEEL SIDE
    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-14

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BOOT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    WHEEL SIDE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009541319

    A

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool.
    B
    Remove the brake caliper torque member bolts, leaving the brake hose attached. Position the brake caliper aside with wire. Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    C
    Do not depress the brake pedal while the brake caliper is removed.
    Put alignment marks on the disc brake rotor and on the wheel hub. Remove the disc brake rotor.
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop the disc brake rotor.
    FAX
    Remove the wheel sensor bolt. Position the wheel sensor and the wheel sensor harness aside. Refer to
    BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation».
    E
    Remove the cotter pin from the drive shaft.
    Hold the wheel hub using Tool. Loosen the wheel hub lock nut.
    Tool number

    7.

    8.
    9.
    10.
    11.
    12.
    13.

    : KV4010104000 (

    F

    )

    Using a piece of wood and a suitable tool, tap on the wheel hub lock nut to disengage the drive shaft from
    the wheel hub.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not place the drive shaft joint at an extreme angle. Also be careful not to overextend slide
    joint.
    • Do not allow the drive shaft to hang down without support.
    NOTE:
    Use a suitable puller if the drive shaft cannot be separated from the wheel hub even after performing the
    above procedure.
    Remove the wheel hub lock nut.
    Remove the nut and bolt from the lower ball joint. Disconnect the steering knuckle from the transverse
    link.
    Remove the drive shaft from the wheel hub.
    Remove the boot bands.
    Separate the boot from the joint sub-assembly.
    Screw a suitable tool (A) into the joint sub-assembly screw part
    to a length of 30 mm (1.18 in) or more. Support the drive shaft
    with one hand and pull out the joint sub-assembly from the shaft.
    CAUTION:
    • Align the suitable tool and the drive shaft. Remove the
    joint sub-assembly by pulling firmly and uniformly.
    • If the joint sub-assembly cannot be pulled out, try after
    removing the drive shaft from the vehicle. Refer to FAX22, «Disassembly and Assembly».

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    JPDIF0258ZZ

    14. Remove the circular clip (1) from the shaft.
    15. Remove the outer boot from the shaft.

    O

    P

    JPDIF0007ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-15

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BOOT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    1. Clean the old grease from the joint sub-assembly using paper waste.
    2. Fill the serration slot on the joint sub-assembly (1) with NISSAN
    genuine grease or equivalent until the serration slot and ball
    groove become full to the brim.
    CAUTION:
    After applying the grease, use paper waste to wipe off the
    grease that has oozed out.
    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts
    information.
    3. Install the outer boot and the boot bands to the shaft.
    CAUTION:
    • Wrap the serration on the shaft with tape to protect the
    boot from damage.
    • Do not reuse the boot.
    • Do not reuse the boot bands.
    4. Remove the tape wrapped around the serration on the shaft.
    5.

    6.

    JPDIF0008ZZ

    Position the circular clip (1) on the groove at the shaft edge.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the circular clip.
    NOTE:
    A drive joint inserter is recommended when installing the circular
    clip.
    Align the shaft and the joint sub-assembly. Assemble the shaft
    with the joint sub-assembly while holding the circular clip.

    JPDIF0007ZZ

    7.

    Install the joint sub-assembly (1) to the shaft using a suitable
    tool.
    CAUTION:
    • Make sure the circular clip is properly positioned on the
    groove of the joint sub-assembly.
    • Confirm that the joint sub-assembly is correctly engaged
    while rotating the drive shaft.

    JPDIF0011ZZ

    8.

    Apply the specified amount of grease to the inside of the large diameter side of the boot.
    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    Grease amount

    Revision: April 2013

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    FAX-16

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BOOT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    9. Install the boot securely into the grooves (indicated by “*” marks)
    as shown.
    CAUTION:
    If there is grease on the boot mounting surfaces (indicated
    by “*” marks) on the shaft or the joint sub-assembly, the
    boot may come off. Remove all grease from the boot
    mounting surfaces.
    10. To prevent the deformation of the boot, adjust the boot installation length to the specified value by inserting a suitable tool into
    the inside of the boot from the large diameter side of the boot
    and discharging the inside air.

    A

    B

    C
    JSDIA2261ZZ

    FAX

    Boot installation length (L) : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».
    CAUTION:
    • The boot may break if the boot installation length is not correct.
    • Be careful not to touch the inside of the boot with the tip of the suitable tool.
    11. Install new large and small boot bands securely using Tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the boot bands.
    Tool number : KV40107300 (

    E

    F

    )

    G

    H
    JPDIF0012ZZ

    I

    12. Secure the boot band so that dimension (A) meets the specification.
    Dimension (A)

    J

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    13. Attempt to rotate the boot to check whether or not the boot
    bands are securing the boot. If the boot is not secure, remove
    the boot bands, reposition the boot, and install new boot bands.

    K

    L
    JPDIF0268ZZ

    14. Clean the mating surfaces of wheel hub lock nut and wheel hub.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply lubricating oil to these mating surfaces.
    15. Clean the mating surfaces of the drive shaft, wheel hub, and
    wheel bearing. Apply Molykote M77 lubricant to the surface (A)
    of the joint sub-assembly.
    CAUTION:
    Apply Molykote M77 to cover the entire flat mating surface
    of the joint sub-assembly.
    Molykote M77 quantity

    M

    N

    O

    Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts
    JSDIA2844ZZ
    information.
    16. Install the drive shaft to the wheel hub. Temporarily install, but do not tighten, the wheel hub lock nut.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage the wheel bearing seal. If damage has occurred, replace wheel bearing.
    • Do not allow paint to adhere to the wheel bearing seal.
    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-17

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BOOT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check each mating surface for water and foreign matter. If there is any water or foreign matter,
    clean the mating surface.
    17. Install the transverse link to the steering knuckle with the nut and bolt. Refer to FSU-10, «Exploded View».
    18. Hold the wheel hub using a Tool. Tighten the wheel hub lock nut.
    CAUTION:
    • Since the drive shaft is assembled by press-fitting, use a torque wrench to tighten the wheel hub
    lock nut. Do not use a power tool.
    • Too much torque causes axle noise. Too little torque causes wheel bearing looseness. Tighten
    the wheel hub lock nut to the specification.
    Tool number

    : KV4010104000 (

    )

    19. Install the cotter pin. Securely bend the cotter pin to prevent rattles.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the cotter pin.
    20. Install the wheel sensor, the wheel sensor bolt, and the wheel sensor harness. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT
    WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation».
    21. Align the matching marks on the disc brake rotor and on the wheel hub. Install the disc brake rotor.
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop the disc brake rotor.
    22. Remove the wire from the brake caliper. Install the brake caliper and the brake caliper torque member
    bolts. Refer to BR-36, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Do not twist the brake hose.
    23. Install the wheel and tire. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    24. Complete the inspection. Refer to FAX-18, «Inspection».

    TRANSAXLE SIDE
    TRANSAXLE SIDE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009541320

    Remove boot after drive shaft is removed from the vehicle.
    • For drive shaft removal and installation, refer to FAX-19, «Removal and Installation».
    • For drive shaft disassembly and assembly, refer to FAX-22, «Disassembly and Assembly».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009541321

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Check the wheel sensor harness to be sure the connectors are fully seated.
    Check the wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-7, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-18

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009541322

    B

    C

    FAX

    AWDIA0951GB

    1.

    Drive shaft

    2.

    Cotter pin

    A.

    Removal and Installation

    E

    Apply Molykote M77
    INFOID:0000000009541323

    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes, lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    F

    G

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    5.

    6.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove wheel sensor and sensor harness. Refer to BRC-69, «FRONT WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and
    Installation».
    Remove brake lock plate from strut.
    Remove brake caliper using power tool, leaving brake hose connected. Reposition brake caliper aside
    with wire. Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View».
    NOTE:
    Do not depress brake pedal while brake caliper is removed.
    Put matching marks on disc brake rotor and wheel hub, then remove disc brake rotor.
    CAUTION:
    • Put matching marks on the wheel hub and the disc brake rotor before removing the disc brake
    rotor.
    • Do not drop disc brake rotor.
    Remove and discard cotter pin, and then loosen wheel hub lock nut, using Tool.
    Tool number

    : KV40104000 (

    )

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    7.

    Separate the drive shaft from the wheel hub by lightly tapping the end of the drive shaft using a suitable
    tool and a wood block.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not place drive shaft joint at an extreme angle. Also be careful not to overextend slide joint.
    • Do not allow drive shaft to hang down without support for joint sub-assembly, shaft and the
    other parts.
    NOTE:
    Use suitable puller if wheel hub and drive shaft cannot be separated even after performing the above procedure.
    8. Remove wheel hub lock nut.
    9. Remove the nuts and bolts, then separate the steering knuckle from strut. Refer to FSU-9, «Exploded
    View».
    10. Remove drive shaft from wheel hub.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-19

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    11. Insert the Tool (A) between the drive shaft and the transaxle.
    Insert the suitable tool (B) to the Tool (A). Remove the drive
    shaft from the transaxle.
    Tool number

    : KV40107500 (

    )

    CAUTION:
    • Do not place drive shaft joint at an extreme angle when
    removing drive shaft. Also be careful not to overextend
    slide joint.
    • Confirm that the circular clip is attached to the drive shaft.
    12. Remove the differential side oil seal. Refer to TM-17, «Removal
    and Installation» (5MT:RS5F91R), or TM-243, «Removal and Installation» (CVT:RE0F11A).

    JPDIF0004ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Transaxle Side
    • Install a new differential side oil seal. Refer to TM-17, «Removal and Installation» (5MT:RS5F91R), or TM243, «Removal and Installation» (CVT:RE0F11A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the differential side oil seal.
    • Place the Tool (A) onto transaxle to prevent damage to the oil seal
    while inserting drive shaft. Slide drive shaft sliding joint and tap
    with a hammer to install securely.

    Tool number

    : KV38107900 (

    )

    CAUTION:
    • Check that circular clip is completely engaged.
    • Check the transaxle fluid level. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection» (5MT), or TM-224, «Inspection» (CVT).
    JPDIF0023ZZ

    Wheel Hub Side
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage the wheel bearing seal. If damage has occurred, replace wheel bearing with a new
    one.
    • Do not allow paint to adhere to the wheel bearing seal.
    • Check each mating surface for water and foreign matter. If there is any water or foreign matter, clean
    the mating surface.
    • Clean the mating surfaces of wheel hub lock nut and wheel hub.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply lubricating oil to the mating surface of the wheel hub lock nut and the wheel hub.
    • Clean the mating surfaces of drive shaft, wheel hub, and wheel
    bearing. Apply Molykote M77 to surface (A) of joint sub-assembly.
    CAUTION:
    Apply Molykote M77 to cover entire flat surface of joint subassembly.
    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    Molykote M77 quantity

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive
    Shaft».

    JSDIA2844ZZ

    When installing a cotter pin, securely bend the cotter pin to prevent
    rattles.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse cotter pin.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-20

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY

    A

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009541324

    B

    (LH)
    C

    FAX

    E

    F

    G

    JPDIF0266ZZ

    1.

    Circular clip

    2.

    Dust shield

    3.

    Slide joint housing

    4.

    Snap ring

    5.

    Spider assembly

    6.

    Boot band

    7.

    Boot

    8.

    Shaft

    9.

    Damper band

    10.

    Dynamic damper

    11.

    Circular clip

    12.

    Joint sub-assembly

    H

    I

    Wheel side

    J

    (RH)
    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JPDIF0269ZZ

    1.

    Circular clip

    2.

    Dust shield

    3.

    Slide joint housing

    4.

    Snap ring

    5.

    Spider assembly

    6.

    Boot band

    7.

    Boot

    8.

    Shaft

    9.

    Damper Band

    10.

    Dynamic damper

    11.

    Circular clip

    12.

    Joint sub-assembly

    P

    Wheel side

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-21

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009541325

    DISASSEMBLY (WHEEL SIDE)
    1.

    2.
    3.

    4.
    5.
    6.

    Mount the drive shaft in a vise.
    CAUTION:
    When mounting the drive shaft in a vise, always use aluminum or copper plates between the vise
    and the drive shaft.
    Remove the boot bands and slide the boot back.
    Screw a suitable tool (A) into the joint sub-assembly screw part
    to a length of 30 mm (1.18 in) or more. Support the drive shaft
    with one hand and pull out the joint sub-assembly from the shaft.
    CAUTION:
    • Align the suitable tool and the drive shaft. Remove the
    joint sub-assembly by pulling firmly and uniformly.
    • If the joint sub-assembly cannot be removed after five or
    more attempts, replace the shaft and the joint sub-assembly as a set.
    Remove the circular clip from the shaft.
    JPDIG0151ZZ
    Remove the outer boot from the shaft.
    Inspect the components. Refer to FAX-8, «Inspection».

    DISASSEMBLY (TRANSAXLE SIDE)
    1.

    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Mount the drive shaft in a vise.
    CAUTION:
    When mounting the drive shaft in a vise, always use aluminum or copper plates between the vise
    and the drive shaft.
    Remove the boot bands and slide the boot back.
    Put matching marks on the slide joint housing and on the shaft.
    CAUTION:
    Use paint or an equivalent for matching marks. Do not scratch the surfaces.
    Remove the slide joint housing from the shaft.
    Put matching marks (A) on the spider assembly and on the
    shaft.
    CAUTION:
    Use paint or an equivalent for matching marks. Do not
    scratch the surfaces.

    JPDIF0006ZZ

    6.
    7.
    8.

    Remove the snap ring (1).
    Remove the spider assembly from the shaft.
    Remove the inner boot from the shaft.

    JPDIF0014ZZ

    9.

    Remove the dust shield from the slide joint housing.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-22

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    10. Remove the circular clip from the slide joint housing.
    11. Clean the old grease from the slide joint housing with paper waste.
    12. Remove the damper bands.
    13. Remove the dynamic damper from the shaft.
    14. Inspect the components. Refer to FAX-8, «Inspection».

    A

    B

    ASSEMBLY (WHEEL SIDE)
    1.
    2.

    Clean the old grease from the joint sub-assembly using paper waste.
    Fill the serration slot on the joint sub-assembly (1) with NISSAN
    genuine grease or equivalent until the serration slot and ball
    groove become full to the brim.
    CAUTION:
    After applying the grease, use paper waste to wipe off the
    grease that has oozed out.
    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts
    information.

    C

    FAX

    E

    F
    JPDIF0008ZZ

    3.

    4.

    Install the outer boot and the boot bands to the shaft.
    CAUTION:
    • Wrap the serration on the shaft with tape (A) to protect the
    boot from damage.
    • Do not reuse the boot.
    • Do not reuse the boot bands.
    Remove the tape wrapped around the serration on the shaft.

    G

    H

    I

    JPDIF0009ZZ

    5.

    6.

    Position the circular clip (1) on the groove at the shaft edge.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the circular clip.
    NOTE:
    A drive joint inserter is recommended when installing the circular
    clip.
    Align the shaft and the joint sub-assembly. Assemble the shaft
    with the joint sub-assembly while holding the circular clip.

    J

    K

    L

    M
    JPDIF0305ZZ

    7.

    N

    Install the joint sub-assembly to the shaft using a suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    • Make sure the circular clip is properly positioned on the
    groove of the joint sub-assembly.
    • Confirm that the joint sub-assembly is correctly engaged
    while rotating the drive shaft.

    O

    P

    RAC0049D

    8.

    Apply the specified amount of grease to the inside of the large diameter side of the boot.
    NOTE:

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-23

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    Grease amount

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    9.

    Install the boot securely into the grooves (indicated by “*” marks)
    as shown.
    CAUTION:
    If there is grease on the boot mounting surfaces (indicated
    by “*” marks) on the shaft or the joint sub-assembly, the
    boot may come off. Remove all grease from the boot
    mounting surfaces.
    10. To prevent the deformation of the boot, adjust the boot installation length to the specified value by inserting a suitable tool into
    the inside of the boot from the large diameter side of the boot
    and discharging the inside air.
    Boot installation length (L)

    JSDIA2261ZZ

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    CAUTION:
    • The boot may break if the boot installation length is not correct.
    • Be careful not to touch the inside of the boot with the tip of the suitable tool.
    11. Install new large and small boot bands securely using Tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the boot bands.
    Tool number

    : KV40107300 (

    )

    JPDIF0012ZZ

    12. Secure the boot band so that dimension (A) meets the specification.
    Dimension (A) : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».
    13. Attempt to rotate the boot to check whether or not the boot
    bands are securing the boot. If the boot is not secure, remove
    the boot bands, reposition the boot, and install new boot bands.

    JPDIF0268ZZ

    ASSEMBLY (TRANSAXLE SIDE)
    1.
    a.

    Install the dynamic damper using the following procedure:
    Install the dynamic damper to the shaft.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-24

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    b. Secure the dynamic damper in the correct position with new
    damper bands.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the damper bands.
    Dimension (A)

    A

    B

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    C
    JPDIF0178ZZ

    2.

    3.

    FAX

    Install the inner boot and the boot bands to the shaft.
    CAUTION:
    • Wrap the serration on the shaft with tape (A) to protect the
    boot from damage.
    • Do not reuse the boot.
    • Do not reuse the boot bands.
    Remove the tape wrapped around the serration on the shaft.

    E

    F

    G
    JPDIF0009ZZ

    4.

    Align the matching mark (A) on the spider assembly (1) with the
    matching mark on the shaft (2). Install the spider assembly to
    the shaft with the chamfer (B) facing the shaft.

    H

    I

    J

    JPDIF0017ZZ

    5.
    6.

    7.

    Secure the spider assembly onto the shaft with the snap ring (1).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the snap ring.
    Apply the appropriate amount of grease (Genuine NISSAN
    Grease or equivalent) to the spider assembly and to the sliding
    surface.
    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts
    information.
    Install the slide joint housing onto the spider assembly and pack
    the balance of the specified amount grease (Genuine NISSAN
    Grease or equivalent) into the slide joint housing.
    NOTE:
    Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    Grease amount

    8.

    L

    M

    N
    JPDIF0014ZZ

    O

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    P

    Align the matching marks on the slide joint housing and on the shaft.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-25

    K

    2014 Note

    FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    9. Install the boot securely into the grooves (indicated by “*” marks)
    as shown.
    CAUTION:
    If there is grease on the boot mounting surfaces (indicated
    by “*” marks) on the shaft or the joint sub-assembly, the
    boot may come off. Remove all grease from the boot
    mounting surfaces.
    10. To prevent the deformation of the boot, adjust the boot installation length to the specified value by inserting a suitable tool into
    the inside of the boot from the large diameter side of the boot
    and discharging the inside air.
    Boot installation length (L)

    JSDIA2063ZZ

    : Refer to FAX-27, «Drive Shaft».

    CAUTION:
    • The boot may break if the boot installation length is not correct.
    • Be careful not to touch the inside of the boot with the tip of the suitable tool.
    11. Install the boot bands securely.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the boot bands.
    a. Put boot band in the groove on drive shaft boot. Then fit pawls into holes for temporary installation.
    NOTE:
    For the large diameter side, fit projection (A) and guide slit (B) at
    first.
    b. Pinch projection on the band with suitable pliers to tighten band.

    JPDIF0157ZZ

    c.

    Insert the tip of band into the lower part of pawl (marked with
    dotted circle) as shown.
    12. Attempt to rotate the boot to check whether or not the boot
    bands are securing the boot. If the boot is not secure, remove
    the boot bands, reposition the boot, and install new boot bands.

    JPDIF0158ZZ

    13. Install the dust shield to the slide joint housing.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the dust shield.
    14. Install the circular clip to the slide joint housing.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the circular clip.

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-26

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Wheel Bearing

    INFOID:0000000009541326

    Item

    Standard

    C

    Axial end play

    0.0 mm (0.0 in)

    Rotating torque

    1.9 N·m (0.19 kg-m, 17 in-lb) or less

    Spring balance measurement

    13.7 N (1.40 kg-f, 3.08 lb-f) or less

    Wheel bearing press-fit load

    49 kN (4,998.0 kg-f, 11,015.2 lb-f)

    Drive Shaft

    B

    FAX

    INFOID:0000000009541327

    E

    Drive Shaft Specifications
    F

    G

    H

    I
    ALDIA0269ZZ

    Application
    Joint type

    M/T
    Wheel side
    (RH)

    (LH)

    90 — 100 g
    (3.17 — 3.53 oz)

    Boot installed length (L)

    J

    Transaxle side

    (LH)

    Grease quantity*

    (RH)
    141.1- 157.1 g
    (4.98 — 5.54 oz)

    135.5 mm (5.33 in)

    Molykote M77*

    K

    154 mm (6.06 in)
    1.0 — 3.0 g (0.04 — 0.10 oz)

    Application
    Joint type

    ALDIA0268ZZ

    L

    CVT
    Wheel side

    Transaxle side

    (LH)

    Grease quantity*
    Boot installed length (L)
    Molykote M77*

    (RH)

    (LH)

    (RH)

    90 — 100 g
    (3.17 — 3.53 oz)

    132.7 — 148.7 g
    (4.68 — 5.25 oz)

    136.8 mm (5.39 in)

    145.5 mm (5.73 in)

    M

    N

    1.0 — 3.0 g (0.04 — 0.10 oz)

    *Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    O

    Dynamic Damper Specifications
    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FAX-27

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Unit: mm (in)

    ALDIA0270ZZ

    M/T

    Application
    Dimension (A)

    CVT

    (LH)

    (RH)

    (LH)

    (RH)

    240 ± 3 (9.45 ± 0.1)

    457 ± 3 (17.99 ± 0.1)

    242.9 ± 3 (9.56 ± 0.1)

    457 ± 3 (17.99 ± 0.1)

    Dimension (B)

    70 (2.76)

    Boot Band Specification
    Unit: mm (in)

    JPDIF0268ZZ

    Dimension (A) — maximum

    Revision: April 2013

    7.0 (0.28)

    FAX-28

    2014 Note

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    FL

    FUEL SYSTEM

    A

    FL

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 6
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….. 9

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    General Precaution …………………………………………… 2

    FUEL TANK ……………………………………………… 10

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4

    EVAP CANISTER ………………………………………. 14

    Exploded View …………………………………………………10
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..10
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….13
    Exploded View …………………………………………………14
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..14
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….15

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 4
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 4

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 5
    FUEL SYSTEM ……………………………………………. 5
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 5
    Quick Connector ………………………………………………. 5

    DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY ………….. 16
    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT ……………………… 16
    Exploded View …………………………………………………16
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….16

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 6

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 18

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER
    AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY …………………….. 6

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 18

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 6

    Fuel Tank ………………………………………………………..18

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009405641

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least 3 minutes before performing any service.

    General Precaution

    INFOID:0000000009405642

    WARNING:
    When replacing fuel line parts, be sure to observe the following.
    • Put a “CAUTION: FLAMMABLE” sign in the work area.
    • Be sure to work in a well ventilated area and have a CO2 fire extinguisher.
    • Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames and sparks away from the work
    area.
    CAUTION:
    • Before removing fuel line parts, carry out the following procedures:
    — Put drained fuel in an explosion-proof container and put the lid on securely. Keep the container in
    safe area.
    — Release fuel pressure from the fuel lines. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    — Disconnect the battery ground cable.
    • Always replace O-rings and clamps with new ones.
    • Do not kink or twist tubes when they are being installed.
    • Do not tighten hose clamps excessively to avoid damaging hoses.
    Tighten high-pressure rubber hose clamp so that clamp end
    is 3 mm (0.12 in) from hose end.
    Tightening torque specifications are the same for all rubber
    hose clamps.
    Ensure that screw does not contact adjacent parts.

    MMA104A

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • After connecting the fuel tube quick connectors, make sure
    the quick connectors are secure.
    Check that the connector and resin tube do not contact any
    adjacent parts.
    — a) Apply fuel pressure to the fuel system by turning the ignition switch to ON (without starting the engine). Then check for
    fuel leaks at the fuel tube connections.
    — b) Start the engine and rev the engine, then check for fuel
    leaks at the fuel tube connections.
    • After installing the tubes, run the engine and check for fuel
    leaks at the connections.
    • Use only a Genuine NISSAN fuel filler cap as a replacement. If
    an incorrect fuel filler cap is used, the MIL may come on.
    • For servicing “Evaporative Emission System” parts, refer to
    EC-336, «Inspection».

    A

    FL

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    PBIC0199E

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009445831

    The actual shape of the Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV10119900
    (J-45722)
    Lock ring wrench

    Removing and installing fuel tank lock ring

    JPBIA3555ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009445832

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-4

    2014 Note

    FUEL SYSTEM
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    FUEL SYSTEM
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009405643

    Inspect fuel lines, fuel filler cap, and fuel tank for improper attachment, leaks, cracks, damage, loose connections, chafing or deterioration.
    (A)

    : Engine

    (B)

    : Fuel line

    (C)

    : Fuel tank

    FL

    C

    D

    If necessary, repair or replace damaged parts.

    E
    JPBIA0129ZZ

    Quick Connector

    INFOID:0000000009405644

    CAUTION:
    • Quick connector (1) can be disconnected when the tabs (F)
    are depressed completely. Do not twist it more than necessary.
    (B)

    G

    H

    : Connection (cross-section)

    (D)

    : To under floor fuel line

    (E)

    : To fuel tank

    (G)

    : Disconnection

    F

    I

    • Do not use any tools to disconnected quick connector.
    • Keep resin tube (C) away from heat. Be especially careful
    when welding near the resin tube.
    • Prevent acid liquid such as battery electrolyte, etc. from getting on resin tube.
    • Do not bend or twist resin tube during installation and disconnection.
    • Do not remove the remaining retainer (2) on hard tube (or the
    equivalent) (A) except when resin tube or retainer is replaced.
    • When resin tube or hard tube (or the equivalent) is replaced,
    also replace retainer with new one.

    J

    K

    L

    M
    JPBIA0130ZZ

    N

    • To keep the connecting portion clean and to avoid damage
    and foreign materials, cover them completely with plastic
    bags (A) or something similar.

    O

    P

    JPBIA0135ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-5

    2014 Note

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009445833

    ALBIA1129ZZ

    1. Lock ring

    2.

    Fuel level sensor unit, fuel filter and fuel pump assembly 3.

    O-ring

    4. Fuel tank

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009445834

    WARNING:
    Read “General Precautions” when working on the fuel system. Refer to FL-2, «General Precaution».
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Release the fuel pressure from the fuel lines. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».
    Disconnect the battery negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Open fuel filler lid.
    Open fuel filler cap and release the pressure inside fuel tank.
    Remove the rear seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the inspection hole cover.
    NOTE:
    Inspection hole cover is held down by an adhesive.
    Disconnect the harness connector (B), fuel feed tube (C) and
    EVAP tube (A).
    : Front

    ALBIA1150ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-6

    2014 Note

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Remove the quick connector as follows:
    • Hold the sides of the connector, push in tabs (B) and pull (A)
    out the tube.
    • If the connector and the tube are stuck together, push and pull
    several times until they start to move. Then disconnect them
    by pulling.

    A

    FL

    C
    JPBIA0134ZZ

    D

    CAUTION:
    • Quick connector (1) can be disconnected when the tabs
    (F) are depressed completely. Do not twist it more than
    necessary.
    (B)

    : Connection (cross-section)

    (D)

    : To under floor fuel line

    (E)

    : To fuel tank

    (G)

    : Disconnection

    E

    F

    G

    • Do not use any tools to disconnected quick connector.
    • Keep resin tube (C) away from heat. Be especially careful
    when welding near the resin tube.
    • Prevent acid liquid such as battery electrolyte, etc. from
    getting on resin tube.
    • Do not bend or twist resin tube during installation and disconnection.
    • Do not remove the remaining retainer (2) on hard tube (or
    the equivalent) (A) except when resin tube or retainer is
    replaced.
    • When resin tube or hard tube (or the equivalent) is
    replaced, also replace retainer with new one.

    H

    I

    J

    K
    JPBIA0130ZZ

    • To keep the connecting portion clean and to avoid damage and foreign materials, cover them completely with
    plastic bags (A) or something similar.

    L

    M

    N

    JPBIA0135ZZ

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-7

    2014 Note

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    8. Remove lock ring for fuel level sensor unit, fuel filter and fuel
    pump assembly using Tool (A) by turning counterclockwise.
    Tool number

    : KV10119900 (J-45722)

    ALBIA1059ZZ

    9.

    Remove fuel level sensor unit, fuel filter and fuel pump assembly.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not bend float arm during removal.
    • Do not allow contaminants to fall inside of the fuel tank.
    • Do not cause impacts such by dropping when handling components.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Install the fuel level sensor, fuel filter, and fuel pump assembly with
    the fuel feed tube (C) facing the front of the vehicle as shown. Use
    a new O-ring.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-ring.
    : Front
    (A)

    : EVAP tube

    (B)

    : Harness connector
    ALBIA1150ZZ

    • Connect the quick connector as follows:
    — Check the connection for damage or any foreign materials.
    — Align the connector with the tube, then insert the connector straight
    into the tube until a click is heard.
    • After the tube is connected, make sure the connection is secure by
    performing the following checks:
    — Pull (A) the tube and the connector to make sure they are securely
    connected.

    JPBIA0140ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-8

    2014 Note

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    — Visually confirm that the two retainer tabs (F) are connected to the
    quick connector (1).
    (B)

    : Connection (cross-section)

    (C)

    : Resin tube

    (D)

    : To under floor fuel line

    (E)

    : To fuel tank

    (G)

    : Disconnection

    A

    FL

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JPBIA0130ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009445835

    H

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Use the following procedure to check for fuel leaks.
    1. Turn ignition switch “ON” (with engine stopped), then check fuel system connections for leaks by applying
    fuel pressure to fuel piping.
    2. Start engine and let it idle and check there are no fuel leaks at the fuel system connections.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-9

    2014 Note

    FUEL TANK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FUEL TANK
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009445836

    AWBIA1594ZZ

    1.

    Fuel tank

    2.

    Fuel tank mounting band (RH)

    3.

    Fuel tank mounting band (LH)

    4.

    Clamp

    5.

    Fuel filler hose

    6.

    Fuel filler tube

    7.

    Grommet

    8.

    Fuel filler cap

    9.

    Clamp

    11.

    EVAP vent line

    10. Vent hose

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009445837

    WARNING:
    Read “General Precautions” when working on the fuel system. Refer to FL-2, «General Precaution».
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    a.
    b.

    2.

    Check the fuel level with the vehicle on a level surface. If the fuel
    gauge indicates more than the level as shown (1/2 full), drain
    the fuel from the fuel tank until the fuel gauge indicates a level at
    or below as shown (1/2 full).
    • In case the fuel pump does not operate, use the following procedure.
    Disconnect the fuel filler hose from the fuel filler tube.
    Insert fuel tubing of less than 20 mm (0.79 in) diameter into the
    fuel filler tube through the fuel filler opening to drain fuel from the
    fuel filler tube.
    • As a guide, if the fuel tank is full the fuel level reaches or is
    less than the level on the fuel gauge as shown, when approximately 20-1/2
    (5-3/8 US gal, 4-1/2 Imp gal) of fuel is drained from a full fuel tank.
    Release the fuel pressure from the fuel lines. Refer to EC-122, «Work Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-10

    ALBIA1130ZZ

    2014 Note

    FUEL TANK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Open fuel filler lid.
    4. Open fuel filler cap and release the pressure inside fuel tank.
    5. Remove the rear seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation».
    6. Remove the inspection hole cover.
    NOTE:
    Inspection hole cover is held by an adhesive.
    7. Disconnect the harness connector (B), fuel feed tube (C) and
    EVAP tube (A).

    A

    FL

    C

    : Front

    D

    E

    ALBIA1150ZZ

    Remove the quick connector as follows:
    • Hold the sides of the connector, push in tabs (B) and pull (A)
    out the tube.
    • If the connector and the tube are stuck together, push and pull
    several times until they start to move. Then disconnect them
    by pulling.

    F

    G

    H

    I
    JPBIA0134ZZ

    J

    CAUTION:
    • Quick connector (1) can be disconnected when the tabs
    (F) are depressed completely. Do not twist it more than
    necessary.
    (B)

    : Connection (cross-section)

    (D)

    : To under floor fuel line

    (E)

    : To fuel tank

    (G)

    : Disconnection

    K

    L

    • Do not use any tools to disconnected quick connector.
    • Keep resin tube (C) away from heat. Be especially careful
    when welding near the resin tube.
    • Prevent acid liquid such as battery electrolyte, etc. from
    getting on resin tube.
    • Do not bend or twist resin tube during installation and disconnection.
    • Do not remove the remaining retainer (2) on hard tube (or
    the equivalent) (A) except when resin tube or retainer is
    replaced.
    • When resin tube or hard tube (or the equivalent) is
    replaced, also replace retainer with new one.
    Retainer color

    Revision: April 2013

    : Blue

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JPBIA0130ZZ

    FL-11

    2014 Note

    FUEL TANK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • To keep the connecting portion clean and to avoid damage and foreign materials, cover them completely with
    plastic bags (A) or something similar.

    JPBIA0135ZZ

    8.
    9.

    Remove center muffler. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».
    Remove nut (A) and remove center floor insulators.

    ALBIA1147ZZ

    10. Disconnect the rear park brake cable brackets (LH). Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».
    11. Disconnect fuel filler hose (2) at fuel filler tube (1) side.
    12. Disconnect vent hose (3) from fuel tank side.

    JPBIA3423ZZ

    13. Support the center part of fuel tank (1) using a suitable jack (A).

    JPBIA3424ZZ

    14. Remove fuel tank mounting bands (LH/RH).
    15. Lower suitable jack carefully to remove fuel tank while holding it by hand.
    CAUTION:
    Fuel tank may be in an unstable condition because of the shape of fuel tank bottom. Be sure to
    hold tank securely.
    16. If replacing the fuel tank, remove the fuel level sensor unit, fuel filter and fuel pump assembly to transfer to
    the new fuel tank.
    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    FL-12

    2014 Note

    FUEL TANK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Do not reuse O-ring.
    A

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Fuel Filler Hose
    • Insert fuel filler hose to the length below.

    Fuel filler hose
    The other hose

    FL

    : 35 mm (1.38 in)
    : 25 mm (0.98 in)

    C

    • Be sure hose clamp is not placed on swelled area of fuel filler tube.
    • Install fuel filler hose to fuel tank, paying attention to install mark.

    D

    EVAP Hose

    1.
    2.

    Check connections for damage or foreign material.
    Align the matching side connection part with the center of shaft, and insert connector straight until a «click»
    sound is heard.

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009445838

    E

    F

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Use the following procedure to check for fuel leaks.
    1. Turn ignition switch “ON” (with engine stopped), then check fuel system connections for leaks by applying
    fuel pressure to fuel piping.
    2. Start engine and let it idle and check there are no fuel leaks at the fuel system connections.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-13

    2014 Note

    EVAP CANISTER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    EVAP CANISTER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009445839

    ALBIA0765ZZ

    1.

    EVAP breather valve

    2.

    EVAP canister drain hose

    3.

    EVAP canister hose

    4.

    EVAP hose

    5.

    EVAP canister assembly

    A.

    To EVAP control hose

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009445840

    NOTE:
    The EVAP canister vent control valve and EVAP canister system pressure sensor can be removed without
    removing the EVAP canister.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove battery. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove the TCM (if equipped). Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the battery tray.
    Remove IPDM E/R bracket, IPDM E/R and position aside. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove EVAP canister cover.
    Disconnect EVAP canister purge hose, EVAP canister hose and Evap hose from the EVAP canister.

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-14

    2014 Note

    EVAP CANISTER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    7. Remove the EVAP canister.
    A

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Inspection
    1.
    2.
    a.
    b.
    3.

    INFOID:0000000009634426

    Visually inspect EVAP vapor lines for improper attachment and for cracks, damage, loose connections,
    chafing and deterioration.
    Check EVAP canister as follows:
    Block port . Orally blow air through port .
    Check that air flows freely through port .
    Block port . Orally blow air through port .
    Check that air flows freely through port .
    Visually inspect the fuel check valve for cracks, damage, loose
    connections chafing and deterioration.

    FL

    C

    D

    E

    F
    JMBIA0443ZZ

    4.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    Check fuel check valve as follows:
    Blow air through connector on the fuel tank side. A considerable
    resistance should be felt and a portion of air flow should be
    directed toward the EVAP canister side.
    Blow air through connector on EVAP canister side. Air flow
    should be smoothly directed toward fuel tank side.
    If fuel check valve is suspected or not properly functioning in
    step 1 and 2 above, replace it.

    G

    H

    I

    JSBIA0080GB

    5.
    a.

    Inspect fuel tank filler cap vacuum relief valve for clogging, sticking, etc.
    Wipe clean valve housing.

    J

    K

    L

    M
    SEF989X

    b.

    Pressure:
    Vacuum:

    c.

    N

    Check valve opening pressure and vacuum.
    15.3 — 20.0 kPa (0.153 — 0.200 bar, 0.156 — 0.204 kg/

    O

    cm2, 2.22 — 2.90 psi)
    –6.0 to –3.4 kPa (–0.06 bar to –-0.034bar, –0.061 to –
    0.035 kg/cm2, –0.87 to –0.49 psi)

    P

    If out of specification, replace fuel filler cap as an assembly.

    SEF943S

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-15

    2014 Note

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT
    < DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009486654

    Fuel Level Sensor Unit

    ALBIA1152ZZ

    1. Fuel filter and pump assembly

    2. Float arm assembly 3. Fuel level sensor unit

    4. Fuel level sensor unit sensor harness connector

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009486655

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.

    Disconnect fuel level sensor unit harness connector (1).
    NOTE:
    Hold connector with your fingers, because there is no tab for
    releasing stopper. Pull it out straight downward.

    ALBIA1153ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-16

    2014 Note

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT
    < DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    2.

    Using a suitable tool push tab (A) in the driection ( ) shown
    and remove fuel level sensor unit (2) from fuel filter and fuel
    pump assembly (1).
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage the fuel level sensor unit.
    • Do not disassemble fuel filter and fuel pump assembly.

    A

    FL

    C
    ALBIA1154ZZ

    D

    ASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Check for damage of fuel level sensor unit installation position on the side of fuel filter and pump assembly.
    Slide fuel level sensor unit until it aligns to installation groove, then insert it until it stops.
    • After inserting, apply force in reverse direction (removal direction) to ensure it cannot be pulled out.
    Connect fuel level sensor unit harness connector.

    E

    F

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Use the following procedure to check for fuel leaks.
    1. Turn ignition switch “ON” (with engine stopped), then check fuel system connections for leaks by applying
    fuel pressure to fuel piping.
    2. Start engine and let it idle and check there are no fuel leaks at the fuel system connections.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FL-17

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Fuel Tank

    INFOID:0000000009445850

    Standard and Limit
    Unit:

    Fuel tank capacity

    Approx. 41.0

    Fuel recommendation

    Revision: April 2013

    (US gal, lmp gal)

    (10-7/8 US gal, 9.0 Imp gal)
    Refer to MA-12

    FL-18

    2014 Note

    SUSPENSION

    SECTION

    FSU

    FRONT SUSPENSION

    A

    B

    C

    D

    FSU

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    TRANSVERSE LINK ………………………………….. 10

    F

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    Exploded View …………………………………………………10
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..10
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….10

    G

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover…… 2
    Precaution for Suspension …………………………………. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 3
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 3

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 5
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….. 5
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………….. 5

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 6
    FRONT SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY ………………. 6
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 6

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT …………………………………… 7
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 7
    Adjustment ………………………………………………………. 8

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 9
    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT ……………… 9
    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 9
    Removal and Installation ……………………………………. 9

    FRONT STABILIZER …………………………………. 12
    Exploded View …………………………………………………12
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..12
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….13

    H

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …… 14

    I

    FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER ………………… 14
    Exploded View …………………………………………………14
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..14
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….15

    J

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY … 16

    K

    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT ……………. 16
    Exploded View …………………………………………………16
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….16
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….18
    Disposal ………………………………………………………….19

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 20
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 20
    Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1) ……………………………20
    Ball Joint …………………………………………………………20
    Wheelarch Height (Unladen*) …………………………….21

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009578923

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009578924

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc to prevent damage to
    windshield.

    PIIB3706J

    Precaution for Suspension

    INFOID:0000000009578925

    • When installing rubber bushings, the final tightening must be carried out under unladen conditions with tires
    on ground. Spilled oil might shorten the life of rubber bushings. Be sure to wipe off any spilled oil.
    — Unladen conditions mean that fuel, engine coolant and lubricant are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools and
    mats are in designated positions.
    • After servicing suspension parts, be sure to check wheel alignment.
    • Self-lock nuts are not reusable. Always use new ones when installing. Since new self-lock nuts are pre-oiled,
    tighten as they are.
    • When jacking up the vehicle with a floor jack, do not hang the jack on the torque rod.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009578926

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-44372)
    Pull Gauge

    Measuring ball joint swinging force

    C

    D

    FSU
    LST024

    ST35652000
    (

    )
    Strut attachment

    Disassembling and assembling strut

    F

    G

    H
    ZZA0807D

    KV10106700
    (

    )
    Drift

    Disassembling and assembling strut
    mount bearing
    a: 25 mm (0.98 in) dia.
    b: 18.5 mm (0.728 in) dia.

    I

    J
    ZZA0534D


    (J-49286)
    Drift and pull gauge

    Measuring drift and pull

    K

    L

    M

    AWEIA0156ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009578927

    N
    Tool name

    Description

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    Spring compressor

    Removing and installing coil spring

    S-NT717

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-4

    2014 Note

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009578928

    B

    Bushing or mount deterioration

    Parts interference

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shake

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Vibration

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shimmy

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shudder

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Poor quality ride or
    handling

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ST-7

    BR-7

    FAX-6

    WT-4

    WT-5

    FAX-6

    FSU-13

    FSU-7

    FSU-7, FSU-13, FSU-15, FSU-18

    FSU-18

    C

    D

    FSU

    F

    G

    FRONT AXLE

    TIRE

    ROAD WHEEL

    DRIVE SHAFT

    BRAKE

    STEERING

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Stabilizer bar fatigue

    Suspension looseness

    ×

    Incorrect wheel alignment

    H

    Spring fatigue

    FRONT SUSPENSION

    Shock absorber deformation, damage or deflection

    Noise

    Possible cause and SUSPECTED PARTS

    Symptom

    Improper installation, looseness

    Reference

    FSU-18

    FSU-6, FSU-7, FSU-15, FSU-18

    Use chart below to find the cause of the symptom. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    I

    ×

    ×

    ×: Applicable

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-5

    2014 Note

    FRONT SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    FRONT SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009578929

    COMPONENT PART
    Check the mount conditions (looseness, backlash) of each component. Verify the component conditions
    (wear, damage) are normal.
    Ball Joint Axial End Play

    1.
    2.

    Set the front wheels in a straight-ahead position.
    Hold the axle side of the transverse link, and check the axial end
    play by move the transverse link up and down.
    Axial end play

    : Refer to FSU-20, «Ball Joint».

    CAUTION:
    • Do not depress the brake pedal when measuring.
    • Do not perform this inspection with the tires on the
    ground.
    • Be careful not to damage ball joint boot. Do not damage
    the components by applying excessive force.
    JSEIA0444ZZ

    STRUT ASSEMBLY
    Check for oil leaks or damage. Replace the parts if necessary.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-6

    2014 Note

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT

    A

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009578930

    PRELIMINARY INSPECTION

    B

    WARNING:
    Always adjust the wheel alignment with the vehicle on a flat surface.
    NOTE:
    C
    If the wheel alignment is out of specification, inspect and replace any damaged or worn rear suspension parts
    before making any adjustments.
    1. Check and adjust the wheel alignment with the vehicle under unladen conditions. “Unladen conditions” D
    means that the fuel, engine coolant, and lubricants are full; the spare tire, jack, hand tools and mats are in
    designated positions.
    2. Check the tires for incorrect air pressure and excessive wear.
    FSU
    3. Check the wheels for run out and damage. Refer to WT-4, «Inspection».
    4. Check the wheel bearing axial end play. Refer to FAX-27, «Wheel Bearing».
    5. Check the shock absorbers for leaks or damage.
    F
    6. Check each mount point of the suspension components for any excessive looseness or damage.
    7. Check each link, arm, and the suspension member for any damage.
    G
    8. Check the vehicle height. Refer to FSU-21, «Wheelarch Height (Unladen*)».

    GENERAL INFORMATION AND RECOMMENDATIONS
    1.

    2.

    A Four-Wheel Thrust Alignment should be performed.
    • This type of alignment is recommended for any NISSAN/INFINITI vehicle.
    • The four-wheel “thrust” process helps ensure that the vehicle is properly aligned and the steering wheel
    is centered.
    • The alignment machine itself should be capable of accepting any NISSAN/INFINITI vehicle.
    • The alignment machine should be checked to ensure that it is level.
    Make sure the alignment machine is properly calibrated.
    • Your alignment machine should be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information.
    • Check with the manufacturer of your specific alignment machine for their recommended Service/Calibration Schedule.

    I

    J

    K

    ALIGNMENT PROCESS
    IMPORTANT: Use only the alignment specifications listed in this Service Manual. Refer to FSU-21,
    «Wheelarch Height (Unladen*)».
    • When displaying the alignment settings, many alignment machines use “indicators”: (Green/red, plus or
    minus, Go/No Go). Do NOT use these indicators.
    — The alignment specifications programmed into your alignment machine that operate these indicators may
    not be correct.
    — This may result in an ERROR.
    • Most camera-type alignment machines are equipped with «Rolling Compensation» method and optional
    «Jacking Compensation» method to «compensate» the alignment targets or head units.
    «Rolling Compensation» is the preferred method.
    — If using the «Rolling Compensation» method, after installing the alignment targets or head units, push or pull
    on the rear wheel to move the vehicle. Do not push or pull on the vehicle body.
    — If using the «Jacking Compensation» method, after installing the alignment targets or head units, raise the
    vehicle and rotate the wheels 1/2 turn in either direction.
    NOTE:
    Do not use the «Rolling Compensation» method if you are using sensor-type alignment equipment.
    • Follow all instructions for the alignment machine you’re using for more information.

    CAMBER, CASTER AND KINGPIN INCLINATION ANGLES INSPECTION
    • Camber, caster, kingpin inclination angles cannot be adjusted.
    • Before inspection, set the front wheels onto a turning radius gauge. Set the rear wheels onto a pad that has
    the same height so the vehicle will remain horizontal.

    TOTAL TOE-IN INSPECTION
    Measure the total toe-in using the following procedure.
    Revision: April 2013

    H

    FSU-7

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    WARNING:
    • Always perform the following procedure on a flat surface.
    • Make sure that no person is in front of vehicle before pushing it.
    1. Bounce the front of vehicle up and down to stabilize the vehicle height (posture).
    2. Push on the rear wheel to move the vehicle straight ahead about 5 m (16 ft).
    3. Put a mark on base line of the tread (rear side) of each tire at the
    same height of hub center. These are measuring points.

    AFA050

    4.
    5.

    6.

    Measure the distance (A) from the rear side.
    Push on the rear wheel to move the vehicle slowly ahead and to
    rotate the wheels 180 degrees (1/2 turn).
    CAUTION:
    If the wheels have rotated more than 180 degrees (1/2 turn),
    try the above procedure again from the beginning. Do not
    push vehicle backward.
    Measure the distance (B) from the front side.

    SFA234AC

    7.

    Use the formula below to calculate total toe-in.
    Total toe-in
    Total toe-in specification

    :A-B
    : Refer to FSU-20, «Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1)».

    • If the total toe-in is outside the specification, adjust the total toe-in. Refer to FSU-8, «Adjustment».

    Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009578931

    TOTAL TOE-IN
    Loosen the steering outer socket. Adjust the length using the steering inner socket.
    Toe-in

    : Refer to FSU-20, «Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1)».

    CAUTION:
    • Always evenly adjust toe-in alternately and adjust the difference between the left and right to the
    standard.
    • Always hold the steering inner socket when tightening the steering outer socket.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-8

    2014 Note

    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009578932

    B

    C

    D

    FSU

    F

    G
    JPEIA0261GB

    1.

    Strut

    2.

    Coil spring

    3.

    4.

    Spring upper seat

    7.

    Strut mount insulator

    5.

    Strut mount bearing

    6.

    Piston rod lock nut

    8.

    Stopper insulator

    9.

    Stopper insulator lock nut

    H

    Bound bumper

    Removal and Installation

    I

    INFOID:0000000009578933

    J

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove brake hose lock plate from strut.
    Disconnect stabilizer connecting rod from strut. Refer to FSU-12, «Exploded View».
    Remove strut bolts and nuts from steering knuckle.
    Remove stopper insulator lock nut and stopper insulator.
    Remove strut.

    K

    L

    M

    N

    WEIA0179E

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Secure the head of strut piston rod to keep it from rotating, then tighten the stopper insulator lock nut to the
    specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse stopper insulator lock nut.
    • Do not reuse the nuts that secure the strut to the steering knuckle.
    • Perform inspection after installation. Refer to FSU-18, «Inspection».
    • After replacing the strut, always follow the disposal procedure to discard the strut. Refer to FSU-19, «Disposal».
    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-9

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    TRANSVERSE LINK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    TRANSVERSE LINK
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009578934

    AWEIA0210GB

    1.

    Front suspension member

    2.

    Transverse link

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009645134

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove transverse link from steering knuckle. Refer to FSU-10, «Exploded View».
    Remove the bolts and nut, then remove the transverse link from front suspension member.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the transverse link nuts.
    Perform the final tightening of the nuts and bolts under unladen conditions with tires on level ground.

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009645135

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check the following items and replace the components as necessary.
    Transverse link
    • Check the transverse link and bushing for deformation, cracks or damage.
    • Check the ball joint boot for cracks or other damage, and also for grease leakage.
    Swing Torque

    1.

    Move the ball stud at least ten times by hand to check for smooth movement with no binding.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-10

    2014 Note

    TRANSVERSE LINK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Hook the Tool (A) on the ball joint (B). Confirm the measurement
    value is within specifications when the ball stud begins moving.
    Tool number

    :

    A

    (J-44372)
    B

    Swing torque
    Rotating torque

    : Refer to FSU-20, «Ball Joint».
    : Refer to FSU-20, «Ball Joint».
    C

    If swing torque or rotating torque exceeds the specified range,
    replace transverse link.
    JPEIA0138ZZ

    D

    Axial End Play

    1.
    2.

    Move the ball stud at least ten times by hand to check for smooth movement with no binding.
    Move the tip of the ball joint in the axial direction to check for looseness.
    Axial end play

    FSU

    : Refer to FSU-20, «Ball Joint».

    If the axial end play exceeds the specified range, replace transverse link.

    F

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-7, «Inspection».
    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-11

    2014 Note

    FRONT STABILIZER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT STABILIZER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009578936

    JPEIA0272GB

    1.

    Stabilizer bar

    2.

    Stabilizer clamp

    3.

    Stabilizer bushing

    4.

    Stabilizer connecting rod

    5.

    Strut

    6.

    Front suspension member

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009645136

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the nuts, then separate the stabilizer connecting rod from the stabilizer bar.
    Remove the front suspension member. Refer to FSU-14, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the stabilizer clamp bolts, stabilizer clamps and stabilizer bushings from front suspension member.
    Remove stabilizer bar.

    WEIA0182E

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-12

    2014 Note

    FRONT STABILIZER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Install the stabilizer bushing with the slit (A) facing the rear of the
    vehicle.
    : Rear

    A

    B

    C
    JPEIA0273ZZ

    D

    • To install stabilizer clamp bolt, temporarily tighten them in numerical order as shown, then tighten them to the specified torque.
    Refer to FSU-12, «Exploded View».
    : Front

    FSU

    F

    G
    JPEIA0274ZZ

    H

    • To connect the stabilizer connecting rod (1), tighten the nut while
    holding the hexagonal part (A) on the stabilizer connecting rod.

    I

    J

    K
    JPEIA0252ZZ

    • Perform final tightening of bolts and nuts with the vehicle under unladen conditions with tires on level
    ground.
    • Perform inspection after installation. Refer to FSU-13, «Inspection».

    Inspection

    L

    INFOID:0000000009645137

    M

    Check the stabilizer bar, the stabilizer connecting rod, the stabilizer bushing, and the stabilizer clamp for deformation, cracks, or damage. Replace components if necessary.

    N

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check the wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-7, «Inspection».

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-13

    2014 Note

    FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009645138

    AWEIA0210GB

    1.

    Front suspension member

    2.

    Transverse link

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009645139

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.
    10.
    11.
    12.
    13.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect steering outer sockets from steering knuckles. Refer to ST-14, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect transverse links from steering knuckle. Refer toFSU-10, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect stabilizer connecting rods from stabilizer bar. Refer to FSU-12, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect the lower joint from the steering gear. Refer to ST-12, «Exploded View».
    Set suitable jack under front suspension member.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the front suspension member with suitable jack.
    Remove the engine rear torque rod. Refer to EM-85, «Exploded View».
    Remove suspension member bolts.
    Gradually lower the jack to remove front suspension member from vehicle body.
    If necessary, remove steering gear from front suspension member. Refer to ST-14, «Removal and Installation».
    If necessary, remove transverse links. Refer to FSU-10, «Exploded View».
    If necessary, remove stabilizer bar, stabilizer bar clamps, and stabilizer bushings. Refer to FSU-12,
    «Exploded View».
    Inspect the front suspension member. Refer to FSU-15, «Inspection».

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-14

    2014 Note

    FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Install the member stay bolts, the upper link bolts, and the front
    suspension member bolts in the order of 1-6 as shown.
    : Front

    A

    B

    C
    AWEIA0211ZZ

    D

    • After installation, perform the final tightening of each part under unladen conditions with tires on level
    ground.
    • Complete the inspection. FSU-15, «Inspection»
    FSU

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009645140

    F

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check the front suspension member for cracks, wear or damage. Replace components if necessary.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    G

    Check the wheel sensor harness to be sure the connectors are fully seated.
    Check the wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-7, «Inspection».
    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-15

    2014 Note

    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009578941

    JPEIA0261GB

    1.

    Strut

    2.

    Coil spring

    3.

    Bound bumper

    4.
    7.

    Spring upper seat

    5.

    Strut mount bearing

    6.

    Piston rod lock nut

    Strut mount insulator

    8.

    Stopper insulator

    9.

    Stopper insulator lock nut

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009578942

    DISASSEMBLY
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage strut piston rod when removing components from strut.
    1. Remove strut mount insulator.
    2. Install Tool (A) to the front coil spring and strut.
    CAUTION:
    When installing Tool (A), wrap a shop cloth around the front
    coil spring and strut to protect the parts from damage.
    Tool number
    3.

    : ST35652000 (

    )

    Secure Tool (A) in a vise.

    JPEIA0006ZZ

    4.

    Slightly loosen the piston rod lock nut.
    WARNING:
    Do not remove the piston rod lock nut completely. If the piston rod lock nut is removed completely, the coil spring can jump out and may cause serious damage or injury.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-16

    2014 Note

    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    5. Compress coil spring using a suitable tool (A).
    WARNING:
    Make sure that the pawls of the suitable tool are firmly
    hooked on the coil spring. The suitable tool must be tightened alternately so as to not tilt the coil spring.

    A

    B

    C
    JPEIA0007ZZ

    D
    Make sure the coil spring is free between the spring upper seat and the strut.
    Hold the piston rod and remove the piston rod lock nut.
    FSU
    Remove strut mount bearing, spring upper seat, and bound bumper as a set.
    Remove bound bumper from spring upper seat.
    Gradually release the suitable tool and remove the coil spring.
    F
    CAUTION:
    Release the suitable tool while making sure the position of the suitable tool on the coil spring
    does not move.
    11. Remove the Tool from strut.
    G

    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.
    10.

    Tool number

    : ST35652000 (

    )
    H

    12. If necessary, remove strut mount bearing (1) from spring upper
    seat (2), using a Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : KV10106700 (

    )

    I

    CAUTION:
    Do not disassemble the strut mount bearing unless damage
    exists.
    13. Inspect the components. Refer to FSU-18, «Inspection».

    J

    JPEIA0228ZZ

    K

    ASSEMBLY
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the piston rod when removing components from the front coil spring and strut.
    1. Install Tool (A) to the front coil spring and strut.
    CAUTION:
    When installing Tool (A), wrap a shop cloth around the front
    coil spring and strut to protect the parts from damage.
    Tool number
    2.

    L

    M

    N

    : ST35652000

    Secure Tool (A) in a vise.
    O
    JPEIA0006ZZ

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-17

    2014 Note

    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    3. Compress coil spring using a suitable tool (A).
    WARNING:
    Make sure that the pawls of the suitable tool are firmly
    hooked on the coil spring. The suitable tool must be tightened alternately so as to not tilt the coil spring.

    JPEIA0007ZZ

    CAUTION:
    Face tube side of coil spring (1) downward. Align the lower
    end to lower seat (2).
    Maximum gap (A)

    :5 mm (0.2 in)

    JPEIA0095ZZ

    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    8.

    9.

    Apply soapy water to bound bumper.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use machine oil.
    Insert bound bumper into spring upper seat.
    Install strut mount bearing, spring upper seat, and bound bumper as a set.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply oil, such as grease, when installing the strut mount bearing.
    Secure piston rod tip so that piston rod does not turn, then install piston rod lock nut and tighten to the
    specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse piston rod lock nut.
    Gradually release the suitable tool, and remove the suitable tool from the coil spring.
    CAUTION:
    Release the suitable tool while making sure the position of the suitable tool on the coil spring
    does not move.
    Remove the Tool (A) from the vise.
    Tool number

    : ST35652000 (

    )

    10. Remove Tool (A) from the front coil spring and strut.
    11. Install strut mount insulator.
    12. After replacing the strut, always follow the disposal procedure to
    discard the old strut. Refer to FSU-19, «Disposal».

    JPEIA0006ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009645141

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Check the following items and replace the parts if necessary.
    Strut
    • Check the strut for oil leaks, deformation, cracks, or damage.

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-18

    2014 Note

    FRONT COIL SPRING AND STRUT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Check the piston rod for damage, uneven wear, or distortion.
    A

    Strut Mount Insulator and bound bumper
    Check the strut mount insulator and the bound bumper for cracks, wear, or damage.
    Coil Spring
    Check the coil spring for cracks, wear, or damage.

    B

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Disposal

    INFOID:0000000009578944

    1.

    Set the strut horizontally with the piston rod fully extended.

    2.

    Drill a 2 – 3 mm (0.08 – 0.12 in) hole at the position ( ) from top
    as shown to release gas gradually.
    CAUTION:
    • Wear eye protection (safety glasses).
    • Wear gloves.
    • Be careful with metal chips or oil blown out by the compressed gas.
    NOTE:
    • Drill vertically in this direction ( ).
    • Drill directly to the outer tube avoiding brackets.
    • The gas is clear, colorless, odorless, and harmless.
    (A)

    3.

    C

    Check the wheel sensor harness to be sure the connectors are fully seated.
    Check the wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-7, «Inspection».

    D

    FSU

    F

    G

    JPEIA0160ZZ

    H

    : 20 – 30 mm (0.79 – 1.18 in)

    Position the drilled hole downward and drain oil by moving the piston rod several times.
    CAUTION:
    Dispose of drained oil according to the law and local regulations.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-19

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1)

    Camber
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    INFOID:0000000009578945

    Minimum

    −0° 50′ (−0.83°)

    Nominal

    −0° 05′ (−0.08°)

    Maximum

    0° 40′ (0.67°)

    (LH) and (RH) difference*2

    Caster
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    Minimum

    3° 00′ (3.00°)

    Nominal

    3° 45′ (3.75°)

    Maximum

    4° 30′ (4.50°)

    (LH) and (RH) difference*2
    Kingpin inclination
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    –0° 45′ (–0.75°) — 0° 45′ (0.75°)

    –0° 45′ (–0.75°) — 0° 45′ (0.75°)

    Minimum

    11° 00′ (11.00°)

    Nominal

    11° 45′ (11.75°)

    Maximum

    12° 30′ (12.50°)

    SFA234AC

    Minimum
    Distance (A — B)
    Total toe-in
    Angle (LH and RH)
    Degree minute
    (Decimal degree)

    0 mm (0.00 in)

    Nominal

    In 1 mm (In 0.04 in)

    Maximum

    In 2 mm (In 0.08 in)

    Minimum

    0° 00′ 00″ (0.00°)

    Nominal

    In 0° 03′ 00″ (In 0.05°)

    Maximum

    In 0° 06′ 00″ (In 0.10°)

    *1: Fuel, engine coolant and lubricant are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools and mats are in designated positions.
    *2: The difference when assuming the (LH) side is the standard.

    Ball Joint
    Swing torque

    INFOID:0000000009578946

    0.5 – 3.4 N·m (0.05 – 0.35 kg-m, 4 – 30 in-lb)

    Rotating torque

    15.4 – 104.7 N (1.6 – 10.7 kg-f, 3.5 – 23.5 lb-f)

    Axial end play

    .01 mm (0.004 in)

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-20

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Wheelarch Height (Unladen*)

    INFOID:0000000009578947

    A
    Unit: mm (in)

    B

    C

    D
    LEIA0085E

    Tire size

    185/65R15

    195/55R16

    Front (Hf)

    690 (27.17)

    687 (27.05)

    Rear (Hr)

    679 (26.73)

    678 (26.69)

    *: Fuel, engine coolant, and lubricants are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and mats are in designated positions.

    FSU

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    FSU-21

    2014 Note

    Edition: April 2013
    Revision: April 2013
    Pub. No. SM14E00E12X0

    QUICK REFERENCE INDEX
    A GENERAL INFORMATION
    A
    B ENGINE

    GI
    EM
    LU
    CO
    EC
    FL
    EX
    STR
    ACC

    General Information
    Engine Mechanical
    Engine Lubrication System
    Engine Cooling System
    Engine Control System
    Fuel System
    Exhaust System
    Starting System
    Accelerator Control System

    CL
    TM
    DLN
    FAX
    RAX
    FSU
    RSU
    SCS
    WT
    BR
    PB
    BRC
    ST
    STC
    SB
    SBC
    SRS
    SRC
    VTL
    HA
    HAC
    INT
    IP
    SE
    ADP
    DLK
    SEC
    GW
    PWC
    RF
    EXT
    BRM
    MIR
    EXL
    INL
    WW
    DEF
    HRN
    PWO
    BCS
    LAN
    PCS
    CHG
    PG
    MWI
    WCS
    SN
    AV
    CCS
    MA

    Clutch
    Transaxle & Transmission
    Driveline
    Front Axle
    Rear Axle
    Front Suspension
    Rear Suspension
    Suspension Control System
    Road Wheels & Tires
    Brake System
    Parking Brake System
    Brake Control System
    Steering System
    Steering Control System
    Seat Belt
    Seat Belt Control System
    SRS Airbag
    SRS Airbag Control System
    Ventilation System
    Heater & Air Conditioning System
    Heater & Air Conditioning Control System
    Interior
    Instrument Panel
    Seat
    Automatic Drive Positioner
    Door & Lock
    Security Control System
    Glass & Window System
    Power Window Control System
    Roof
    Exterior
    Body Repair Manual
    Mirrors
    Exterior Lighting System
    Interior Lighting System
    Wiper & Washer
    Defogger
    Horn
    Power Outlet
    Body Control System
    LAN System
    Power Control System
    Charging System
    Power Supply, Ground & Circuit Elements
    Meter, Warning Lamp & Indicator
    Warning Chime System
    Sonar System
    Audio, Visual & Navigation System
    Cruise Control System
    Maintenance

    C

    D
    D TRANSMISSION & DRIVELINE

    E SUSPENSION

    F BRAKES

    G STEERING
    H RESTRAINTS

    I

    VENTILATION, HEATER &
    AIR CONDITIONER

    J BODY INTERIOR

    K BODY EXTERIOR,
    DOORS, ROOF & VEHICLE
    SECURITY

    L DRIVER CONTROLS

    All rights reserved. No part M ELECTRICAL & POWER
    CONTROL
    of this Service Manual may
    be reproduced or stored in a
    retrieval system, or transmitted in any form, or by any
    means, electronic, mechani- N DRIVER INFORMATION &
    MULTIMEDIA
    cal, photo-copying, recording or otherwise, without the
    prior written permission of
    O CRUISE CONTROL
    Nissan Mexicana S.A de C.V.
    P MAINTENANCE

    A
    B
    C
    D
    E
    F
    G
    H
    I
    J
    K
    L
    M
    N
    O
    P

    FOREWORD
    This manual contains maintenance and repair procedure for the 2014
    NISSAN NOTE.
    In order to assure your safety and the efficient functioning of the vehicle,
    this manual should be read thoroughly. It is especially important that the
    PRECAUTIONS in the GI section be completely understood before starting
    any repair task.
    All information in this manual is based on the latest product information
    at the time of publication. The right is reserved to make changes in specifications and methods at any time without notice.

    IMPORTANT SAFETY NOTICE
    The proper performance of service is essential for both the safety of
    the technician and the efficient functioning of the vehicle.
    The service methods in this Service Manual are described in such a
    manner that the service may be performed safely and accurately.
    Service varies with the procedures used, the skills of the technician
    and the tools and parts available. Accordingly, anyone using service
    procedures, tools or parts which are not specifically recommended
    by NISSAN must first be completely satisfied that neither personal
    safety nor the vehicle’s safety will be jeopardized by the service
    method selected.

    PLEASE HELP MAKE THIS SERVICE MANUAL BETTER!
    Your comments are important to NISSAN and will help us to improve our Service Manuals.
    Use this form to report any issues or comments you may have regarding our Service Manuals.
    Please print this form and type or write your comments below. Mail or fax to:
    NISSAN MEXICANA, S.A. DE C.V.
    Technical Publications
    [email protected]
    FAX: (52) (55) 56-28-27-26
    SERVICE MANUAL: Model:

    Year:

    PUBLICATION NO. (Refer to Quick Reference Index ):
    Please describe any Service Manual issues or problems in detail:

    Note: Please include a copy of each page, marked with your comments.

    Page number(s)

    Are the trouble diagnosis procedures logical and easy to use? (circle your answer)

    YES

    NO

    Note: Please include a copy of each page, marked with your comments.

    If no, what page number(s)?

    Please describe the issue or problem in detail:

    Is the organization of the manual clear and easy to follow? (circle your answer)

    YES

    NO

    Please comment:

    What information should be included in NISSAN Service Manuals to better support you in servicing or
    repairing customer vehicles?

    DATE:
    DEALER:
    CITY:

    YOUR NAME:
    DEALER NO.:
    STATE/COUNTRY:

    POSITION:
    ADDRESS:
    ZIP/POSTAL CODE:

    QUICK REFERENCE CHART: NOTE
    2014

    QUICK REFERENCE CHART: NOTE
    Engine Tune-up Data

    INFOID:0000000009725684

    GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
    Engine type

    HR16DE

    Cylinder arrangement

    In-line 4
    cm3 (cu in)

    Displacement
    Bore and stroke

    1,598 (97.51)
    78.0× 83.6 (3.071 ×3.291)

    mm (in)

    Valve arrangement

    DOHC

    Firing order

    1-3-4-2

    Number of piston rings

    Compression

    2

    Oil

    1

    Compression ratio

    9.8:1

    Compression pressure
    kPa (kg/cm2, psi) / 200 rpm

    Standard

    1,510 (15.4, 219)

    Minimum

    1,270 (12.95, 184)

    Differential limit between cylinders

    100 (1.0, 14.5)

    Valve Timing
    Unit: degree

    Valve timing
    : Intake valve
    : Exhaust valve

    JPBIA4228ZZ

    (

    a

    b

    c

    d

    e

    f

    216

    228

    11 (−27)
    ATDC

    59 (-21)
    ABDC

    -1 (49)
    ATDC

    37 (-13)
    BBDC

    ): Valve timing control “ON”

    Drive Belt

    INFOID:0000000009725685

    DRIVE BELT
    Belt Deflection

    Deflection adjustment *
    Location

    Drive belt

    Unit: mm (in)
    New belt

    Limit

    After adjusted

    With A/C

    10.0 (0.39)

    4.9 — 5.2 (0.19 — 0.20)

    4.1 — 4.4 (0.16 — 0.17)

    Without A/C

    9.1 (0.36)

    4.3 — 4.7 (0.17 — 0.19)

    3.7 — 3.9 (0.146 — 0.154)

    Applied pushing force
    *: When engine is cold.

    Used belt

    98.1 N (10.0 kg-f, 22.0 lb-f)

    QUICK REFERENCE CHART: NOTE
    2014
    Belt Tension and Frequency

    Tension adjustment *
    Location

    Used belt
    Limit

    350 (35.7, 78.7)
    Without A/C

    New belt

    After adjusted

    With A/C
    Drive belt

    Unit: N (kg-f,
    lb-f)

    Frequency adjustment *
    Used belt
    Limit

    After adjusted

    Unit: Hz
    New belt

    881 — 951
    (89.9 — 97.0,
    198.0 — 213.8)

    1070 — 1138
    (109.1 — 116.1,
    240.5 — 255.8)

    145.5

    230.5 — 239.5

    254 — 262

    876 — 964
    (89.4 — 98.3,
    196.9 — 216.7)

    1064 — 1152
    (108.5 — 117.5,
    239.2 — 259.0)

    162

    256.5 — 268.5

    282.5 — 293.5

    *: When engine is cold.

    Spark Plug

    INFOID:0000000009725686

    SPARK PLUG (PLATINUM-TIPPED TYPE)
    Make

    NGK

    Standard type*

    PLZKAR6A-11

    Gap (nominal)

    1.1 mm (0.043 in)

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    Front Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1)

    Camber
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    INFOID:0000000009725683

    Minimum

    −0° 50′ (−0.83°)

    Nominal

    −0° 05′ (−0.08°)

    Maximum

    0° 40′ (0.67°)

    (LH) and (RH) difference*2

    Caster
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    Minimum

    3° 00′ (3.00°)

    Nominal

    3° 45′ (3.75°)

    Maximum

    4° 30′ (4.50°)

    (LH) and (RH) difference*2
    Kingpin inclination
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    –0° 45′ (–0.75°) — 0° 45′ (0.75°)

    –0° 45′ (–0.75°) — 0° 45′ (0.75°)

    Minimum

    11° 00′ (11.00°)

    Nominal

    11° 45′ (11.75°)

    Maximum

    12° 30′ (12.50°)

    SFA234AC

    Distance (A — B)
    Total toe-in
    Angle (LH and RH)
    Degree minute
    (Decimal degree)

    Minimum

    0 mm (0.00 in)

    Nominal

    In 1 mm (In 0.04 in)

    Maximum

    In 2 mm (In 0.08 in)

    Minimum

    0° 00′ 00″ (0.00°)

    Nominal

    In 0° 03′ 00″ (In 0.05°)

    Maximum

    In 0° 06′ 00″ (In 0.10°)

    *1: Fuel, engine coolant and lubricant are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools and mats are in designated positions.

    QUICK REFERENCE CHART: NOTE
    2014
    *2: The difference when assuming the (LH) side is the standard.

    Rear Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1)

    Camber
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    INFOID:0000000009725681

    Minimum

    −1° 55′ (−1.92°)

    Nominal

    −1° 25′ (−1.42°)

    Maximum

    −0° 55′ (−0.92°)

    SFA234AC

    Distance (A — B)
    Total toe-in
    Angle (LH and RH)*2
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    Minimum

    Out 2.0 mm (Out 0.079 in)

    Nominal

    In 2.0 mm (In 0.079 in)

    Maximum

    In 6.0 mm (In 0.236 in)

    Minimum

    Out 0° 45′ (Out 0.75°)

    Nominal

    In 0° 10′ (In 0.17°)

    Maximum

    In 0° 35′ (In 0.58°)

    *1: Fuel, engine coolant, and lubricants are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and mats are in designated positions.
    *2: Since an adjustment mechanism is not included, the value of the left and right wheels must be used as the standard value.

    Wheelarch Height (Unladen*)

    INFOID:0000000009725682

    Unit: mm (in)

    LEIA0085E

    Tire size

    185/65R15

    195/55R16

    Front (Hf)

    690 (27.17)

    687 (27.05)

    Rear (Hr)

    679 (26.73)

    678 (26.69)

    *: Fuel, engine coolant, and lubricants are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and mats are in designated positions.

    Brake Specifications

    INFOID:0000000009725679

    Unit: mm (in)

    Cylinder bore diameter
    Front brake

    Pad length × width × thickness
    Rotor outer diameter × thickness
    Cylinder bore diameter

    Rear brake

    Lining length × width × thickness
    Drum inner diameter — new

    54.025 (2.13)
    115.0 × 42.0 × 9.0 (4.53 × 1.654 × 0.354)
    260 × 22.0 (10.24 × 0.87)
    19.05 (3/4)
    Trailing: 172 × 37 × 4.8 (6.77 × 1.46 × 0.19)
    Leading: 155 × 37 × 4.8 (6.10 ×1.46 × 0.19)
    203.2 (8.00)

    QUICK REFERENCE CHART: NOTE
    2014
    Master cylinder

    Cylinder bore diameter

    Control valve

    Valve type

    Brake booster

    Diaphragm diameter

    22.23 (0.875)
    Electric brake force distribution
    255 (10)

    Brake Pedal

    INFOID:0000000009725680

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item

    Standard
    158 ±5 (6.22 ±0.20)

    Brake pedal height
    Clearance between brake pedal lever and the stop lamp switch threaded end

    0.2 – 1.96 (0.008 – 0.077)

    Brake pedal full stroke

    128 (5.04)

    Front Disc Brake

    INFOID:0000000009725677

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item
    Brake pad

    Disc rotor

    Limit

    Wear thickness

    2.0 (0.08)

    Wear thickness

    20.0 (0.787)

    Thickness variation (measured at 8 positions)

    0.013 (0.001)

    Runout (with it attached to the vehicle)

    0.055 (0.002)

    Rear Drum Brake

    INFOID:0000000009725678

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item

    Limit

    Brake lining

    Wear thickness

    1.0 (0.04)

    Brake drum

    Wear inner diameter- maximum

    204.2 (8.04)

    Fluids and Lubricants

    INFOID:0000000009725676

    Capacity
    (Approximate)

    Description
    Liter

    US measure

    Imp measure

    41.0

    10-7/8 gal

    9.0 gal

    With oil filter change

    3.5

    3-3/4 qt

    3-1/8 qt

    Without oil filter change

    3.2

    3-3/8 qt

    2-7/8 qt

    3.5

    3-3/4 qt

    3-1/8 qt

    CVT

    7.3

    7-3/4 qt

    6-3/8 qt

    M/T

    6.7

    7-1/8 qt

    5-7/8 qt

    0.7

    3/4 qt

    5/8 qt

    With oil cooler

    7.1

    7-1/2 qt

    6-1/4 qt

    Without oil cooler

    6.9

    7-1/4 qt

    6-1/8 qt

    2.67

    5-5/8 pt

    4-3/4 pt

    Fuel
    Engine oil
    Drain and refill
    Dry engine (Overhaul)
    Cooling system (with reservoir)
    Reservoir tank
    CVT fluid

    Manual transaxle fluid gear oil
    Brake and clutch fluid

    Multi-purpose grease

    Windshield washer fluid

    2.5

    2-5/8 qt

    2-1/4 qt

    Air conditioner system refrigerant

    0.4

    0.88 lb

    0.88 lb

    110 — 130

    3.9 — 4.6 fl oz

    3.9 — 4.6 fl oz

    Air conditioner system oil

    GENERAL INFORMATION

    SECTION

    GI

    GENERAL INFORMATION

    GI

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL …………………. 3

    Cautions in Removing Battery Terminal and AV
    Control Unit (Models with AV Control Unit) ………….23
    General Precautions …………………………………………24
    Three Way Catalyst ………………………………………….25
    Fuel (Regular Unleaded Gasoline Recommended) HR16DE ……………………………………………………25
    Multiport Fuel Injection System or Engine Control
    System ……………………………………………………………26
    Hoses …………………………………………………………….26
    Engine Oils ……………………………………………………..27
    Air Conditioning ……………………………………………….27

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL ………………………. 3
    Description ………………………………………………………. 3
    Terms ……………………………………………………………… 3
    Units ……………………………………………………………….. 3
    Contents ………………………………………………………….. 3
    Relation between Illustrations and Descriptions …… 4
    Components …………………………………………………….. 4

    HOW TO FOLLOW TROUBLE DIAGNOSES ….. 6
    Description ………………………………………………………. 6
    How to Follow Test Groups in Trouble Diagnosis…… 6
    Key to Symbols Signifying Measurements or Procedures …………………………………………………………… 7

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………28
    Garage Jack and Safety Stand …………………………..28
    2-Pole Lift ……………………………………………………….29
    Board-on Lift ……………………………………………………30
    Tow Truck Towing ……………………………………………31
    Vehicle Recovery (Freeing a Stuck Vehicle) ………..31

    Abbreviation List ……………………………………………… 14

    VEHICLE INFORMATION ……………………… 33

    TIGHTENING TORQUE OF STANDARD
    BOLTS ……………………………………………………….19

    IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION ……………….. 33
    Model Variation ………………………………………………..33
    Identification Number ………………………………………..34
    Engine Serial Number ………………………………………35
    CVT Number ……………………………………………………35
    Manual Transaxle Number ………………………………..35
    Dimensions ……………………………………………………..36
    Wheels & Tires ………………………………………………..36

    Description …………………………………………………….. 19
    Tightening Torque Table (New Standard Included) ………………………………………………………………… 19

    RECOMMENDED CHEMICAL PRODUCTS
    AND SEALANTS …………………………………………22

    PRECAUTION ………………………………………. 23
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………..23
    Description …………………………………………………….. 23
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» ……………………………………………………….. 23
    Procedures without Cowl Top Cover ………………….. 23

    Revision: April 2013

    H

    I

    J

    K

    TOW TRUCK TOWING ………………………………. 31

    ABBREVIATIONS ……………………………………….14

    Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants…. 22

    G

    LIFTING POINT …………………………………………. 28

    HOW TO READ WIRING DIAGRAMS ……………. 9
    Connector Symbols …………………………………………… 9
    Sample/Wiring Diagram -Example- ……………………. 10
    Connector Information ……………………………………… 12

    F

    L

    M

    N

    O

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 37
    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL
    INCIDENT …………………………………………………. 37

    GI-1

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….37
    Control Units and Electrical Parts ……………………….37
    How to Check Terminal …………………………………….38
    Intermittent Incident ………………………………………….41
    Circuit Inspection ……………………………………………..44

    2014 Note

    P

    CONSULT/GST CHECKING SYSTEM ………….. 49
    Description …………………………………………………….. 49
    Function and System Application ……………………… 49

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-2

    CONSULT Data Link Connector (DLC) Circuit ……. 49
    Wiring Diagram — CONSULT/GST CHECKING
    SYSTEM ……………………………………………………….. 51

    2014 Note

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL

    GI

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009464384

    This volume explains “Removal, Disassembly, Installation, Inspection and Adjustment” and “Trouble Diagnoses”.

    Terms

    B

    C

    INFOID:0000000009464385

    • The captions WARNING and CAUTION warn you of steps that must be followed to prevent personal injury
    and/or damage to some part of the vehicle.
    WARNING indicates the possibility of personal injury if instructions are not followed.
    CAUTION indicates the possibility of component damage if instructions are not followed.
    BOLD TYPED STATEMENTS except WARNING and CAUTION give you helpful information.
    Standard value: Tolerance at inspection and adjustment.
    Limit value: The maximum or minimum limit value that should not be exceeded at inspection and adjustment.

    Units

    D

    E

    F

    INFOID:0000000009464386

    • The UNITS given in this manual are primarily expressed as the SI UNIT (International System of Unit), and
    alternatively expressed in the metric system and in the yard/pound system.
    Also with regard to tightening torque of bolts and nuts, there are descriptions both about range and about the
    standard tightening torque.

    G

    H

    “Example”
    Range
    Outer Socket Lock Nut

    I

    : 59 — 78 N·m (6.0 — 8.0 kg-m, 43 — 58 ft-lb)

    Standard
    Drive Shaft Installation Bolt

    J

    : 44.3 N·m (4.5 kg-m, 33 ft-lb)
    K

    Contents

    INFOID:0000000009464387

    • A QUICK REFERENCE INDEX, a black tab (e.g.
    ) is provided on the first page. You can quickly find the
    first page of each section by matching it to the section’s black tab.
    • THE CONTENTS are listed on the first page of each section.
    • THE TITLE is indicated on the upper portion of each page and shows the part or system.
    • THE PAGE NUMBER of each section consists of two or three letters which designate the particular section
    and a number (e.g. “BR-5”).
    • THE SMALL ILLUSTRATIONS show the important steps such as inspection, use of special tools, knacks of
    work and hidden or tricky steps which are not shown in the previous large illustrations.
    Assembly, inspection and adjustment procedures for the complicated units such as the automatic transaxle
    or transmission, etc. are presented in a step-by-step format where necessary.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-3

    2014 Note

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    Relation between Illustrations and Descriptions

    INFOID:0000000009464388

    The following sample explains the relationship between the part description in an illustration, the part name in
    the text and the service procedures.

    SAIA0519E

    Components

    INFOID:0000000009464389

    • THE LARGE ILLUSTRATIONS are exploded views (see the following) and contain tightening torques, lubrication points, section number of the PARTS CATALOG (e.g. SEC. 440) and other information necessary to
    perform repairs.
    The illustrations should be used in reference to service matters only. When ordering parts, refer to the appropriate PARTS CATALOG.
    Components shown in an illustration may be identified by a circled number. When this style of illustration is
    used, the text description of the components will follow the illustration.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-4

    2014 Note

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    GI

    B

    C

    D

    E

    JPFIA0511GB

    1.

    Cap

    2.

    Bleeder valve

    3.

    4.

    Piston seal

    5.

    Piston

    6.

    Piston boot

    7.

    Sliding pin

    8.

    Sliding pin boot

    9.

    Bushing

    F

    Cylinder body

    G

    10. Torque member
    : Apply rubber grease.

    H

    : Apply brake fluid.
    : N·m (kg-m, in-lb)

    I

    : Always replace after every disassembly

    SYMBOLS
    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    SAIA0749E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-5

    2014 Note

    HOW TO FOLLOW TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    HOW TO FOLLOW TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009464390

    NOTICE:
    Trouble diagnoses indicate work procedures required to diagnose problems effectively. Observe the following
    instructions before diagnosing.
    • Before performing trouble diagnoses, read the “Work Flow” in each section.
    • After repairs, re-check that the problem has been completely eliminated.
    • Refer to Component Parts and Harness Connector Location for the Systems described in each section for
    identification/location of components and harness connectors.
    • When checking circuit continuity, ignition switch should be OFF.
    • Refer to the Circuit Diagram for quick pinpoint check.
    If you need to check circuit continuity between harness connectors in more detail, such as when a sub-harness is used, refer to Wiring Diagram in each individual section and Harness Layout in PG section for identification of harness connectors.
    • Before checking voltage at connectors, check battery voltage.
    • After accomplishing the Diagnosis Procedures and Electrical Components Inspection, make sure that all
    harness connectors are reconnected as they were.

    How to Follow Test Groups in Trouble Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009464391

    JPAIA0021GB

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Test group number and test group title
    • Test group number and test group title are shown in the upper portion of each test group.
    Work and diagnosis procedure
    • Start to diagnose a problem using procedures indicated in enclosed test groups.
    Questions and results
    • Questions and required results are indicated in test group.
    Action
    • Next action for each test group is indicated based on result of each question.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-6

    2014 Note

    HOW TO FOLLOW TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    Key to Symbols Signifying Measurements or Procedures

    INFOID:0000000009464392

    GI

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    JPAIA0982GB

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-7

    2014 Note

    HOW TO FOLLOW TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    JSAIA1461GB

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-8

    2014 Note

    HOW TO READ WIRING DIAGRAMS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    HOW TO READ WIRING DIAGRAMS
    Connector Symbols

    GI
    INFOID:0000000009472879

    Most of connector symbols in wiring diagrams are shown from the terminal side.
    • Connector symbols shown from the terminal side are enclosed by
    a single line and followed by the direction mark.
    • Connector symbols shown from the harness side are enclosed by
    a double line and followed by the direction mark.
    • Certain systems and components, especially those related to
    OBD, may use a new style slide-locking type harness connector.
    For description and how to disconnect, refer to PG section,
    “Description”, “HARNESS CONNECTOR”.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    SAIA0257E

    I

    • Male and female terminals
    Connector guides for male terminals are shown in black and
    female terminals in white in wiring diagrams.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    SGI363

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-9

    2014 Note

    P

    HOW TO READ WIRING DIAGRAMS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    Sample/Wiring Diagram -Example-

    INFOID:0000000009472880

    Each section includes wiring diagrams.

    JCAWA0150GB

    Description

    Number

    Item

    Description

    1

    Power supply

    • This means the power supply of fusible link or fuse.

    2

    Fuse

    • “/” means the fuse.

    3

    Current rating of fusible
    link/fuse

    • This means the current rating of the fusible link or fuse.

    4

    Number of fusible link/
    fuse

    • This means the number of fusible link or fuse location.

    5

    Fusible link

    • “X” means the fusible link.

    6

    Connector number

    • Alphabetic characters show to which harness the connector is placed.
    • Numeric characters show the identification number of connectors.

    7

    Switch

    • This shows that continuity exists between terminals 1 and 2 when the switch is in the A position. Continuity exists between terminals 1 and 3 when the switch is in the B position.

    8

    Circuit (Wiring)

    • This means the wiring.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-10

    2014 Note

    HOW TO READ WIRING DIAGRAMS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    Number

    Item

    Description

    GI

    9

    Shielded line

    • The line enclosed by broken line circle shows shield wire.

    10

    Connectors

    • This means that a transmission line bypasses two connectors or more.

    11

    Option abbreviation

    • This means the vehicle specifications which layouts the circuit between “

    12

    Relay

    • This shows an internal representation of the relay.

    13

    Optional splice

    • The open circle shows that the splice is optional depending on vehicle application.

    14

    Splice

    • The shaded circle “

    15

    System branch

    • This shows that the circuit is branched to other systems.

    16

    Page crossing

    • This circuit continues to an adjacent page.

    17

    Component name

    • This shows the name of a component.

    18

    Terminal number

    • This means the terminal number of a connector.

    19

    Ground (GND)

    • This shows the ground connection.

    20

    Explanation of option
    description

    • This shows a description of the option abbreviation used on the page.

    B

    ”.

    ” means the splice.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    SWITCH POSITIONS
    Switches are shown in wiring diagrams as if the vehicle is in the “normal” condition.
    A vehicle is in the “normal” condition when:
    • ignition switch is “OFF”
    • doors, hood and trunk lid/back door are closed
    • pedals are not depressed
    • parking brake is released

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    SGI860

    MULTIPLE SWITCH
    The continuity of multiple switch is described in two ways as shown below.
    • The switch chart is used in schematic diagrams.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-11

    2014 Note

    HOW TO READ WIRING DIAGRAMS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    • The switch diagram is used in wiring diagrams.

    JSAIA0017GB

    Connector Information

    INFOID:0000000009472881

    HOW TO USE CONNECTOR INFORMATION

    JCAWA0152GB

    Description

    Number

    Item

    Description

    1

    Connector number

    • Alphabetic characters show to which harness the connector is placed.
    • Numeric characters show the identification number of connectors.

    2

    Connector type

    • This means the connector number.

    3

    Terminal number

    • This means the terminal number of a connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-12

    2014 Note

    HOW TO READ WIRING DIAGRAMS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    Number

    Item

    Description

    GI

    • This shows a code for the color of the wire.

    4

    Wire color

    BR = Brown
    OR or O = Orange
    P = Pink
    PU or V (Violet) = Purple
    GY or GR = Gray
    SB = Sky Blue
    CH = Dark Brown
    DG = Dark Green

    B = Black
    W = White
    R = Red
    G = Green
    L = Blue
    Y = Yellow
    LG = Light Green
    BG = Beige

    B

    C

    • When the wire color is striped, the base color is given first, followed by the stripe color as
    shown below:
    Example: L/W = Blue with White Stripe
    5

    Connector

    • This means the connector information.
    • This unit-side is described by the connector symbols.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-13

    2014 Note

    ABBREVIATIONS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    ABBREVIATIONS
    Abbreviation List

    INFOID:0000000009464393

    The following ABBREVIATIONS are used:
    A

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    A/C

    Air conditioner

    A/C

    Air conditioning

    A/F sensor

    Air fuel ratio sensor

    A/T

    Automatic transaxle/transmission

    ABS

    Anti-lock braking system

    ACCS
    ACL
    AP

    Advance climate control system
    Air cleaner
    Accelerator pedal

    APP

    Accelerator pedal position

    ATF

    Automatic transmission fluid

    AV

    Audio visual

    AWD

    All wheel drive

    B

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    BARO

    Barometric pressure

    BCM

    Body control module

    BLSD

    Brake limited slip differential

    BPP

    Brake pedal position

    BSW

    Blind spot warning

    C

    ABBREVIATION
    CKP
    CL

    DESCRIPTION
    Crankshaft position
    Closed loop

    CMP

    Camshaft position

    CPP

    Clutch pedal position

    CTP

    Closed throttle position

    CVT

    Continuously variable transaxle/transmission

    D

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    D1

    Drive range first gear

    D2

    Drive range second gear

    D3

    Drive range third gear

    D4

    Drive range fourth gear

    DCA

    Distance control assist

    DDS

    Downhill drive support

    DFI

    Direct fuel injection system

    DLC

    Data link connector

    DTC

    Diagnostic trouble code

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-14

    2014 Note

    ABBREVIATIONS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    E

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    E/T

    Exhaust temperature

    EBD

    Electric brake force distribution

    EC

    Engine control

    ECL

    Engine coolant level

    ECM

    Engine control module

    ECT

    Engine coolant temperature

    ECV

    Electrical control valve

    EEPROM

    B

    C

    Engine fuel temperature

    EGR

    Exhaust gas recirculation

    EGRT

    Exhaust gas recirculation temperature

    EGT

    Exhaust gas temperature

    EOP

    Engine oil pressure

    E

    F

    Exhaust pressure

    EPR

    Exhaust pressure regulator

    EPS

    Electronically controlled power steering

    ESP

    Electronic stability program system

    EVAP canister
    EVSE
    EXC

    D

    Electrically erasable programmable read only memory

    EFT

    EP

    GI

    G

    H

    Evaporative emission canister
    Electric vehicle supply equipment
    Exhaust control

    I

    F

    ABBREVIATION
    FC
    FCW

    DESCRIPTION
    Fan control

    J

    Forward collision warning

    FIC

    Fuel injector control

    FP

    Fuel pump

    FR

    Front

    FRP

    Fuel rail pressure

    FRT

    Fuel rail temperature

    FTP

    Fuel tank pressure

    FTT

    Fuel tank temperature

    K

    L

    M

    G

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    GND

    Ground

    GPS

    Global positioning system

    GST

    Generic scan tool

    N

    O

    H

    ABBREVIATION
    HBMC

    DESCRIPTION

    HDD

    Hard disk drive

    HO2S

    Heated oxygen sensor

    HOC

    Heated oxidation catalyst

    HPCM

    Revision: April 2013

    P

    Hydraulic body-motion control system

    Hybrid power train control module

    GI-15

    2014 Note

    ABBREVIATIONS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    I

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    I/M

    Inspection and maintenance

    IA

    Intake air

    IAC

    Idle air control

    IAT

    Intake air temperature

    IBA

    Intelligent brake assist

    IC

    Ignition control

    ICC

    Intelligent cruise control

    ICM

    Ignition control module

    IPDM E/R

    Intelligent power distribution module engine room

    ISC

    Idle speed control

    ISS

    Input shaft speed

    K

    ABBREVIATION
    KS

    DESCRIPTION
    Knock sensor

    L

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    LBC

    Li-ion battery controller

    LCD

    Liquid crystal display

    LCU

    Local control unit

    LDP

    Lane departure prevention

    LDW

    Lane departure warning

    LED

    Light emitting diode

    LH

    Left-hand

    LIN

    Local interconnect network

    M

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    M/T

    Manual transaxle/transmission

    MAF

    Mass airflow

    MAP

    Manifold absolute pressure

    MDU

    Multi display unit

    MI

    Malfunction indicator

    MIL

    Malfunction indicator lamp

    N

    ABBREVIATION
    NOX

    DESCRIPTION
    Nitrogen oxides

    O

    ABBREVIATION
    O2

    DESCRIPTION
    Oxygen

    O2S

    Oxygen sensor

    OBD

    On board diagnostic

    OC

    Oxidation catalytic converter

    OD

    Overdrive

    OL

    Open loop

    OSS

    Revision: April 2013

    Output shaft speed

    GI-16

    2014 Note

    ABBREVIATIONS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    P

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    P/S

    Power steering

    PBR

    Potentio balance resistor

    PCV

    Positive crankcase ventilation

    PNP

    Park/Neutral position

    PSP

    Power steering pressure

    PTC

    Positive temperature coefficient

    PTO

    Power takeoff

    PWM

    Pulse width modulation

    GI

    B

    C

    D

    R

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    RAM

    Random access memory

    RAS

    Rear active steer

    RH

    F

    Right-hand

    ROM

    Read only memory

    RPM

    Engine speed

    RR

    E

    G

    Rear

    S

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    SAE

    Society of Automotive Engineers, Inc.

    SCK

    Serial clock

    SDS

    Service Data and Specifications

    SRT

    System readiness test

    SST

    Special Service Tools

    H

    I

    J

    T

    ABBREVIATION
    TC

    DESCRIPTION

    Transmission control module

    TCS

    Traction control system

    TCU

    Telematics communication unit

    TP
    TPMS

    K

    Turbocharger

    TCM

    L

    Throttle position
    Tire pressure monitoring system

    TSS

    Turbine shaft speed

    TWC

    Three way catalytic converter

    M

    N

    U

    ABBREVIATION
    USS

    DESCRIPTION
    Uphill start support

    O

    V

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    VCM

    Vehicle control module

    VDC

    Vehicle dynamics control system

    VIN

    Vehicle identification number

    VSS

    Vehicle speed sensor

    Revision: April 2013

    P

    GI-17

    2014 Note

    ABBREVIATIONS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    W

    ABBREVIATION
    WOT

    DESCRIPTION
    Wide open throttle

    1

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    11

    1st range first gear

    12

    1st range second gear

    1GR

    First gear

    2

    ABBREVIATION

    DESCRIPTION

    21

    2nd range first gear

    22

    2nd range second gear

    2GR

    Second gear

    2WD

    2-wheel drive

    3

    ABBREVIATION
    3GR

    DESCRIPTION
    Third gear

    4

    ABBREVIATION
    4GR

    DESCRIPTION
    Fourth gear

    4WAS

    Four wheel active steer

    4WD

    Four wheel drive

    5

    ABBREVIATION
    5GR

    DESCRIPTION
    Fifth gear

    6

    ABBREVIATION
    6GR

    DESCRIPTION
    Sixth gear

    7

    ABBREVIATION
    7GR

    Revision: April 2013

    DESCRIPTION
    Seventh gear

    GI-18

    2014 Note

    TIGHTENING TORQUE OF STANDARD BOLTS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    TIGHTENING TORQUE OF STANDARD BOLTS

    GI

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009464394

    This vehicle has both new standard based on ISO* and previous standard bolts/nuts. There are some differences between these two types of bolts/ nuts; shape of the head, grade of strength, hexagonal width across
    flats and the standard tightening torque.
    • For guidance in discriminating, refer to GI-19, «Tightening Torque Table (New Standard Included)».
    • If the tightening torque is not described in the description or figure, refer to GI-19, «Tightening Torque Table
    (New Standard Included)».
    *ISO: International Organization for Standardization

    Tightening Torque Table (New Standard Included)

    INFOID:0000000009464395

    CAUTION:
    • The special parts are excluded.
    • The bolts/nuts in these tables have a strength (discrimination) number/symbol assigned to the head
    or the like. As to the relation between the strength grade in these tables and the strength (discrimination) number/symbol, refer to “DISCRIMINATION OF BOLTS AND NUTS”.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    PREVIOUS STANDARD
    Grade
    (Strength
    grade)

    4T

    7T

    9T

    Bolt diameter
    mm

    Hexagonal
    width
    across flats
    mm

    Pitch
    mm

    M6

    6.0

    10

    M8

    8.0

    12

    M10

    10.0

    14

    Bolt
    size

    G

    Tightening torque (Without lubricant)
    Hexagon head bolt

    Hexagon flange bolt

    N·m

    kg-m

    ft-lb

    in-lb

    N·m

    kg-m

    ft-lb

    in-lb

    1.0

    5.5

    0.56

    4

    49

    7

    0.71

    5

    62

    1.25

    13.5

    1.4

    10

    17

    1.7

    13

    1.0

    13.5

    1.4

    10

    17

    1.7

    13

    1.5

    28

    2.9

    21

    35

    3.6

    26

    1.25

    28

    2.9

    21

    35

    3.6

    26

    1.75

    45

    4.6

    33

    55

    5.6

    41

    1.25

    45

    4.6

    33

    65

    6.6

    48

    M12

    12.0

    17

    M14

    14.0

    19

    1.5

    80

    8.2

    59

    100

    10

    74

    M6

    6.0

    10

    1.0

    9

    0.92

    7

    80

    11

    1.1

    8

    97

    M8

    8.0

    12

    1.25

    22

    2.2

    16

    28

    2.9

    21

    1.0

    22

    2.2

    16

    28

    2.9

    21

    M10

    10.0

    14

    M12

    12.0

    17

    M14

    14.0

    M6
    M8

    1.5

    45

    4.6

    33

    55

    5.6

    41

    1.25

    45

    4.6

    33

    55

    5.6

    41

    1.75

    80

    8.2

    59

    100

    10

    74

    1.25

    80

    8.2

    59

    100

    10

    74

    19

    1.5

    130

    13

    96

    170

    17

    125

    6.0

    10

    1.0

    11

    1.1

    8

    13.5

    1.4

    10

    8.0

    12

    1.25

    28

    2.9

    21

    35

    3.6

    26

    1.0

    28

    2.9

    21

    35

    3.6

    26

    1.5

    55

    5.6

    41

    80

    8.2

    59

    1.25

    55

    5.6

    41

    80

    8.2

    59

    1.75

    100

    10

    74

    130

    13

    96

    1.25

    100

    10

    74

    130

    13

    96

    1.5

    170

    17

    125

    210

    21

    155

    M10

    10.0

    14

    M12

    12.0

    17

    M14

    14.0

    19

    CAUTION:
    The parts with aluminum or the cast iron washer surface/thread surface are excluded.
    Revision: April 2013

    GI-19

    2014 Note

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    TIGHTENING TORQUE OF STANDARD BOLTS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    NEW STANDARD BASED ON ISO
    Grade
    (Strength
    grade)

    4.8
    (Without
    lubricant)

    4.8
    (With lubricant)

    8.8
    (With lubricant)

    10.9
    (With lubricant)

    Bolt diameter
    mm

    Hexagonal
    width
    across flats
    mm

    Pitch
    mm

    M6

    6.0

    10

    1.0

    M8

    8.0

    13

    M10

    10.0

    16

    M12

    12.0

    18

    M14

    14.0

    M6

    Bolt
    size

    Tightening torque
    Hexagon head bolt

    Hexagon flange bolt

    N·m

    kg-m

    ft-lb

    in-lb

    N·m

    kg-m

    ft-lb

    in-lb

    5.5

    0.56

    4

    49

    7

    0.71

    5

    62

    1.25

    13.5

    1.4

    10

    17

    1.7

    13

    1.0

    13.5

    1.4

    10

    17

    1.7

    13

    1.5

    28

    2.9

    21

    35

    3.6

    26

    1.25

    28

    2.9

    21

    35

    3.6

    26

    1.75

    45

    4.6

    33

    55

    5.6

    41

    1.25

    45

    4.6

    33

    65

    6.6

    48

    21

    1.5

    80

    8.2

    59

    100

    10

    74

    6.0

    10

    1.0

    4

    0.41

    3

    35

    5.5

    0.56

    4

    49

    M8

    8.0

    13

    1.25

    11

    1.1

    8

    13.5

    1.4

    10

    1.0

    11

    1.1

    8

    13.5

    1.4

    10

    M10

    10.0

    16

    1.5

    22

    2.2

    16

    28

    2.9

    21

    1.25

    22

    2.2

    16

    28

    2.9

    21

    M12

    12.0

    18

    1.75

    35

    3.6

    26

    45

    4.6

    33

    1.25

    35

    3.6

    26

    45

    4.6

    33

    M14

    14.0

    21

    1.5

    65

    6.6

    48

    80

    8.2

    59

    M6

    6.0

    10

    M8

    8.0

    13

    M10

    10.0

    16

    M12

    12.0

    18

    M14

    14.0

    21

    M6

    6.0

    10

    M8

    8.0

    13

    M10

    10.0

    16

    M12

    12.0

    18

    M14

    14.0

    21

    1.0

    8

    0.82

    6

    71

    10

    1.0

    7

    89

    1.25

    21

    2.1

    15

    25

    2.6

    18

    1.0

    21

    2.1

    15

    25

    2.6

    18

    1.5

    40

    4.1

    30

    50

    5.1

    37

    1.25

    40

    4.1

    30

    50

    5.1

    37

    1.75

    70

    7.1

    52

    85

    8.7

    63

    1.25

    70

    7.1

    52

    85

    8.7

    63

    1.5

    120

    12

    89

    140

    14

    103

    1.0

    10

    1.0

    7

    89

    12

    1.2

    9

    106

    1.25

    27

    2.8

    20

    32

    3.3

    24

    1.0

    27

    2.8

    20

    32

    3.3

    24

    1.5

    55

    5.6

    41

    65

    6.6

    48

    1.25

    55

    5.6

    41

    65

    6.6

    48

    1.75

    95

    9.7

    70

    110

    11

    81

    1.25

    95

    9.7

    70

    110

    11

    81

    1.5

    160

    16

    118

    180

    18

    133

    CAUTION:
    1. Use tightening torque with lubricant for the new standard bolts/nuts in principle. Friction coefficient stabilizer is applied to the new standard bolts/nuts.
    2. However, use tightening torque without lubricant for the following cases. Friction coefficient stabilizer is not applied to the following bolts/nuts.
    Grade 4.8, M6 size bolt, Conical spring washer installed
    Paint removing nut (Size M6 and M8) for fixing with weld bolt

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-20

    2014 Note

    TIGHTENING TORQUE OF STANDARD BOLTS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >
    DISCRIMINATION OF BOLTS AND NUTS
    GI

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    SAIA0453E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-21

    2014 Note

    RECOMMENDED CHEMICAL PRODUCTS AND SEALANTS
    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    RECOMMENDED CHEMICAL PRODUCTS AND SEALANTS
    Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants

    INFOID:0000000009464396

    Refer to the following chart for help in selecting the appropriate chemical product or sealant.

    1

    2

    3

    4

    5

    6

    NISSAN North America
    Part No. (USA)

    NISSAN Canada Part
    No. (Canada)

    Aftermarket Crossreference Part Nos.

    Product Description

    Purpose

    Rear View Mirror Adhesive

    Used to permanently remount rear view mirrors to
    windows.

    999MP-AM000P

    99998-50505

    Permatex 81844

    Anaerobic Liquid Gasket

    For metal-to-metal flange
    sealing.
    Can fill a 0.38 mm (0.015
    inch) gap and provide instant sealing for most powertrain applications.

    999MP-AM001P

    99998-50503

    Permatex 51813 and
    51817

    High Performance
    Thread Sealant

    Provides instant sealing on
    any threaded straight or
    parallel threaded fitting.
    (Thread sealant only, no
    locking ability.)
    • Do not use on plastic.

    999MP-AM002P

    999MP-AM002P

    Permatex 56521

    99998-50506
    (Ultra Grey)

    Permatex Ultra Grey
    82194;
    Three Bond
    1207,1215, 1216,
    1217F, 1217G and
    1217H
    Nissan RTV Part No.
    999MP-A7007

    999MP-AM004P

    Permatex 27200;
    Three Bond 1360,
    1360N, 1305 N&P,
    1307N, 1335,
    1335B, 1363B,
    1377C, 1386B, D&E
    and 1388
    Loctite 648

    999MP-AM005P

    Permatex 24200,
    24206, 24240,
    24283 and 09178;
    Three Bond 1322,
    1322N, 1324 D&N,
    1333D, 1361C,
    1364D, 1370C and
    1374

    Silicone RTV

    High Temperature,
    High Strength Thread
    Locking Sealant (Red)

    Medium Strength
    Thread Locking Sealant (Blue)

    Revision: April 2013

    Gasket Maker

    Threadlocker

    Threadlocker (service tool
    removable)

    999MP-AM003P
    (Ultra Grey)

    999MP-AM004P

    999MP-AM005P

    GI-22

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    GI

    PRECAUTIONS
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009464411

    Observe the following precautions to ensure safe and proper servicing. These precautions are not
    described in each individual section.

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    C

    INFOID:0000000009464412

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least 3 minutes before performing any service.

    Procedures without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009464413

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    PIIB3706J

    Cautions in Removing Battery Terminal and AV Control Unit (Models with AV Control
    Unit)

    O

    INFOID:0000000009015320

    CAUTION:
    Remove battery terminal and AV control unit after a lapse of 30 seconds or more after turning the ignition switch OFF.
    NOTE:
    After the ignition switch is turned OFF, the AV control unit continues operating for approximately 30 seconds.
    Therefore, data corruption may occur if battery voltage is cut off within 30 seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-23

    2014 Note

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    General Precautions

    INFOID:0000000009464414

    • Do not operate the engine for an extended period of time without
    proper exhaust ventilation.
    Keep the work area well ventilated and free of any inflammable
    materials. Special care should be taken when handling any inflammable or poisonous materials, such as gasoline, refrigerant gas,
    etc. When working in a pit or other enclosed area, be sure to properly ventilate the area before working with hazardous materials.
    Do not smoke while working on the vehicle.

    SGI285

    • Before jacking up the vehicle, apply wheel chocks or other tire
    blocks to the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving. After jacking up the vehicle, support the vehicle weight with safety stands at
    the points designated for proper lifting before working on the vehicle.
    These operations should be done on a level surface.
    • When removing a heavy component such as the engine or transaxle/transmission, be careful not to lose your balance and drop
    them. Also, do not allow them to strike adjacent parts, especially
    the brake tubes and master cylinder.
    SGI231

    • Before starting repairs which do not require battery power:
    Turn off ignition switch.
    Disconnect the negative battery terminal.
    • If the battery terminals are disconnected, recorded memory of
    radio and each control unit is erased.

    SEF289H

    • To prevent serious burns:
    Avoid contact with hot metal parts.
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot.
    • Dispose of drained oil or the solvent used for cleaning parts in an
    appropriate manner.
    • Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank after the fuel pump nozzle
    shuts off automatically.
    Continued refueling may cause fuel overflow, resulting in fuel spray
    and possibly a fire.
    • Clean all disassembled parts in the designated liquid or solvent
    prior to inspection or assembly.
    • Replace oil seals, gaskets, packings, O-rings, locking washers,
    cotter pins, self-locking nuts, etc. with new ones.
    • Replace inner and outer races of tapered roller bearings and needle bearings as a set.
    • Arrange the disassembled parts in accordance with their assembled locations and sequence.
    • Do not touch the terminals of electrical components which use microcomputers (such as ECM).
    Static electricity may damage internal electronic components.
    • After disconnecting vacuum or air hoses, attach a tag to indicate the proper connection.
    • Use only the fluids and lubricants specified in this manual.
    • Use approved bonding agent, sealants or their equivalents when required.
    Revision: April 2013

    GI-24

    SGI233

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Use hand tools, power tools (disassembly only) and recommended
    special tools where specified for safe and efficient service repairs.
    • When repairing the fuel, oil, water, vacuum or exhaust systems,
    check all affected lines for leaks.

    GI

    B

    C
    JPAIA0335ZZ

    D

    • Before servicing the vehicle:
    Protect fenders, upholstery and carpeting with appropriate covers.
    Take caution that keys, buckles or buttons do not scratch paint.

    E

    F

    G
    SGI234

    WARNING:
    To prevent ECM from storing the diagnostic trouble codes, do not carelessly disconnect the harness
    connectors which are related to the engine control system and TCM (transmission control module)
    system. The connectors should be disconnected only when working according to the WORK FLOW of
    TROUBLE DIAGNOSES in EC and TM sections.

    Three Way Catalyst

    INFOID:0000000009464415

    If a large amount of unburned fuel flows into the catalyst, the catalyst temperature will be excessively high. To
    prevent this, follow the instructions.
    • Use unleaded gasoline only. Leaded gasoline will seriously damage the three way catalyst.
    • When checking for ignition spark or measuring engine compression, make tests quickly and only when necessary.
    • Do not run engine when the fuel tank level is low, otherwise the engine may misfire, causing damage to the
    catalyst.
    Do not place the vehicle on flammable material. Keep flammable material off the exhaust pipe and the three
    way catalyst.

    Fuel (Regular Unleaded Gasoline Recommended) HR16DE

    INFOID:0000000009464416

    Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research
    octane number 91). E-85 fuel (85% fuel ethanol, 15% unleaded gasoline) may only be used in vehicles specifically designed for E-85 fuel (i.e. Flexible Fuel Vehicle — FFV models).
    CAUTION:
    Do not use leaded gasoline. Using leaded gasoline will damage the three way catalyst. Do not use E-85
    fuel (85% fuel ethanol, 15% unleaded gasoline) unless the vehicle is specifically designed for E-85 fuel
    (i.e. Flexible Fuel Vehicle — FFV models). Using a fuel other than that specified could adversely affect
    the emission control devices and systems, and could also affect the warranty coverage validity.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-25

    2014 Note

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    Multiport Fuel Injection System or Engine Control System

    INFOID:0000000009464418

    • Before connecting or disconnecting any harness connector for the
    multiport fuel injection system or ECM:
    Turn ignition switch to “OFF” position.
    Disconnect negative battery terminal.
    Otherwise, there may be damage to ECM.
    • Before disconnecting pressurized fuel line from fuel pump to injectors, be sure to release fuel pressure.
    • Be careful not to jar components such as ECM and mass air flow
    sensor.
    SGI787

    Hoses

    INFOID:0000000009464419

    HOSE REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    • To prevent damage to rubber hose, do not pry off rubber hose with
    tapered tool or screwdriver.

    SMA019D

    • To reinstall the rubber hose securely, make sure that hose insertion
    length and orientation is correct. (If tube is equipped with hose
    stopper, insert rubber hose into tube until it butts up against hose
    stopper.)

    SMA020D

    HOSE CLAMPING
    • If old rubber hose is re-used, install hose clamp in its original position (at the indentation where the old clamp was). If there is a trace
    of tube bulging left on the old rubber hose, align rubber hose at
    that position.
    • Discard old clamps; replace with new ones.

    SMA021D

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-26

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • After installing plate clamps, apply force to them in the direction of
    the arrow, tightening rubber hose equally all around.

    GI

    B

    C
    SMA022D

    D

    Engine Oils

    INFOID:0000000009464420

    Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer. Try to avoid direct skin contact
    with used oil.
    If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as possible.

    HEALTH PROTECTION PRECAUTIONS











    Avoid prolonged and repeated contact with oils, particularly used engine oils.
    Wear protective clothing, including impervious gloves where practicable.
    Do not put oily rags in pockets.
    Avoid contaminating clothes, particularly underpants, with oil.
    Heavily soiled clothing and oil-impregnated footwear should not be worn. Overalls must be cleaned regularly.
    First aid treatment should be obtained immediately for open cuts and wounds.
    Use barrier creams, applying them before each work period, to help the removal of oil from the skin.
    Wash with soap and water to ensure all oil is removed (skin cleansers and nail brushes will help). Preparations containing lanolin replace the natural skin oils which have been removed.
    Do not use gasoline, kerosene, diesel fuel, gas oil, thinners or solvents for cleaning skin.
    If skin disorders develop, obtain medical advice without delay.
    Where practical, degrease components prior to handling.
    Where there is a risk of eye contact, eye protection should be worn, for example, chemical goggles or face
    shields; in addition an eye wash facility should be provided.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION PRECAUTIONS
    Dispose of used oil and used oil filters through authorized waste disposal contractors to licensed waste disposal sites, or to the waste oil reclamation trade. If in doubt, contact the local authority for advice on disposal
    facilities.
    It is illegal to pour used oil on to the ground, down sewers or drains, or into water sources.
    The regulations concerning pollution vary between regions.

    Air Conditioning

    K

    L

    INFOID:0000000009464421

    Use an approved refrigerant recovery unit any time the air conditioning system must be discharged. Refer to
    HA-17, «Description».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-27

    2014 Note

    LIFTING POINT
    < PRECAUTION >

    LIFTING POINT
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009464405

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.
    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    LM4086-0200
    ( — )
    Board on attachment

    S-NT001

    LM4519-0000
    ( — )
    Safety stand attachment

    S-NT002

    CAUTION:
    • Every time the vehicle is lifted up, maintain the complete vehicle curb condition.
    • Since the vehicle’s center of gravity changes when removing main parts on the front side (engine,
    transmission, suspension etc.), support a jack up point on the rear side garage jack with a transmission jack or equivalent.
    • Since the vehicle’s center of gravity changes when removing main parts on the rear side (rear axle,
    suspension, etc.), support a jack up point on the front side garage jack with a transmission jack or
    equivalent.
    • Be careful not to smash or do anything that would affect piping parts.

    Garage Jack and Safety Stand

    INFOID:0000000009464406

    WARNING:
    • Park the vehicle on a level surface when using the jack. Make sure to avoid damaging pipes, tubes,
    etc. under the vehicle.
    • Never get under the vehicle while it is supported only by the jack. Always use safety stands when
    you have to get under the vehicle.
    • Place wheel chocks at both front and back of the wheels on the ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-28

    2014 Note

    LIFTING POINT
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Lift at reinforced area of front suspension member where lower control arm attaches, staying in center line of wheels.
    GI

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    ALAIA0040GB

    I

    Vehicle front
    1.

    Front garage jack points

    2. Safety stand points

    3.

    Rear garage jack point

    J

    2-Pole Lift

    INFOID:0000000009464407

    WARNING:
    When lifting the vehicle, open the lift arms as wide as possible and ensure that the front and rear of the
    vehicle are well balanced.

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-29

    2014 Note

    LIFTING POINT
    < PRECAUTION >
    When setting the lift arm, do not allow the arm to contact the brake tubes, brake cable, fuel lines and
    sill spoiler.

    ALAIA0039ZZ

    Vehicle front
    1.

    Sill

    2. Lift pad

    Board-on Lift

    INFOID:0000000009464408

    CAUTION:
    Make sure vehicle is empty when lifting.
    • The board-on lift attachment (LM4086-0200) set at front end of
    vehicle should be set on the front of the sill under the front
    door opening.
    • Position attachments at front and rear ends of board-on lift.

    AGI016

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-30

    2014 Note

    TOW TRUCK TOWING
    < PRECAUTION >

    TOW TRUCK TOWING

    GI

    Tow Truck Towing

    INFOID:0000000009464409

    CAUTION:
    • Never tow a CVT model with the rear wheels raised and the front wheels on the ground. This may
    cause serious and expensive damage to the transaxle. If it is necessary to tow the vehicle with the
    rear wheels raised, always use towing dollies under the front wheels.
    • Never tow a CVT model from the rear (that is backward) with four wheels on the ground. This may
    cause serious and expensive damage to the transaxle.
    NISSAN recommends that the vehicle be towed with the driving
    (front) wheels off the ground.
    CAUTION:
    • Always release the parking brake when towing the vehicle
    with the front wheels raised with the rear wheels on the
    ground.
    • When towing manual transaxle models with the front wheels
    on the ground (if a towing dolly is not used), turn the ignition
    key to the OFF position, and secure the steering wheel in the
    straight-ahead position with a rope or similar device.
    Move the shift lever to the N (Neutral) position.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J
    SGI986

    Vehicle Recovery (Freeing a Stuck Vehicle)

    INFOID:0000000009464410

    K

    FRONT
    WARNING:
    • Stand clear of a stuck vehicle.
    • Do not spin your tires at high speed. This could cause them to explode and result in serious injury.
    Parts of your vehicle could also overheat and be damaged.
    CAUTION:
    • Tow chains or cables must be attached only to the vehicle recovery hooks or main structural members of the vehicle. Otherwise, the vehicle body will be damaged.
    • Do not use the vehicle tie downs to free a vehicle stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc. Never tow the vehicle using the vehicle tie downs or recovery hooks.
    • Always pull the cable straight out from the front of the vehicle. Never pull on the hook at an angle.
    • Pulling devices should be routed so they do not touch any part of the suspension, steering, brake or
    cooling systems.
    • Pulling devices such as ropes or canvas straps are not recommended for use in vehicle towing or
    recovery.

    CVT

    M

    N

    O

    P

    To tow a vehicle equipped with a CVT, an appropriate vehicle dolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicle’s
    drive wheels. Always follow the dolly manufacture’s recommendations when using their product.
    If the vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc., use the following procedure:
    1. Make sure the area in front and behind the vehicle is clear of obstructions.
    2. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clear an area around the front tires.
    Revision: April 2013

    L

    GI-31

    2014 Note

    TOW TRUCK TOWING
    < PRECAUTION >
    3. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and backward.
    Shift back and forth between R (reverse) and D (drive).
    Apply the accelerator as little as possible to maintain the rocking motion.
    Release the accelerator pedal before shifting between R and D.
    Do not spin the tires above 35 m.p.h. (55 km/h).
    4. If the vehicle can not be freed after a few tries, contact a professional towing service to remove the vehicle.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-32

    2014 Note

    IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
    < VEHICLE INFORMATION >

    VEHICLE INFORMATION

    GI

    IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
    Model Variation

    INFOID:0000000009464398

    B

    Model Codes

    Body

    Engine

    Grade

    Transmission

    Base (Sense)
    Hatchback

    HR16DE
    Mid (Advance)

    Destination
    Mexico/LAM

    Argentina

    5 M/T

    TDTALDF-EJA

    TDTALDF-ELA

    CVT

    TDTALDZ-EJA

    TDTALDZ-ELA

    5 M/T

    TDTALEF-EJA

    TDTALEF-ELA

    CVT

    TDTALEZ-EJA

    TDTALEZ-ELA

    C

    D

    E

    Prefix and Suffix Designations

    Position

    Character

    1

    T

    2
    3

    DT

    Qualifier

    Definition

    Body type

    T: Hatchback

    Engine

    DT: HR16DE

    4

    A

    Axle

    A: 2WD

    5

    L

    Drive

    L: LH

    6

    D

    Grade

    7

    F

    Transmission

    F

    G

    H

    D: Base (Sense)
    E: Mid (Advance)
    F: 5 M/T

    I

    Z: CVT

    8
    9

    E12

    Model

    E12: Note

    E

    Intake

    E: EGI

    J

    10
    11

    K

    J: Mexico/LAM

    12

    J

    Zone

    13

    A

    Equipment

    A: Standard

    Option Codes

    Option Codes

    L: Argentina

    L

    14
    15
    16

    XXXXX

    M

    17

    N

    18

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-33

    2014 Note

    IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
    < VEHICLE INFORMATION >

    Identification Number

    INFOID:0000000009464399

    ALAIA0093ZZ

    1. Air conditioner specification label

    2. Vehicle identification number chassis number (right side of bulkhead)

    3. Emission control information label (if
    equipped)

    4. Tire placard
    Vehicle Identification Number Arrangement

    Position

    Character

    Qualifier

    Definition

    1
    2

    3N1

    Manufacturer

    3N1: NISSAN Passenger Car [Nismex]

    C

    Engine type

    C: HR16DE

    E2

    Model series

    E2: NISSAN Note model code E12

    7

    C

    Body type

    C: 4 door hatchback

    8

    D

    Restraint system

    D: Driver and Passenger Air Bags and 3-point manual seat belts

    9

    *

    Check digit

    (0 to 9 or X) The code for the check digit is determined by a mathematical computation

    10

    E

    Model year

    11

    L

    Manufacturing plant

    3
    4
    5
    6

    Revision: April 2013

    E: 2014
    Z: General exportation
    L: Aguascalientes, Mexico
    K: Civac, Mexico

    GI-34

    2014 Note

    IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
    < VEHICLE INFORMATION >
    Position

    Character

    Qualifier

    XXXXXX

    Vehicle serial number

    Definition

    GI

    12
    13
    14
    15

    B

    Chassis number

    16

    C

    17

    Engine Serial Number

    INFOID:0000000009464400

    D

    HR16DE

    E

    F

    G
    STI0429

    : Vehicle front
    H

    CVT Number

    INFOID:0000000009464401

    I

    J

    K
    LAIA0074E

    L

    Manual Transaxle Number

    INFOID:0000000009464402

    M

    N

    O
    PCIB1612E

    P

    : Vehicle front

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-35

    2014 Note

    IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
    < VEHICLE INFORMATION >

    Dimensions

    INFOID:0000000009464403

    Unit:mm (in)

    Overall length

    4,141 (163)

    Overall width

    1,645 (64.8)

    Overall height

    1,537 (60.5)

    Front tread

    15 inch wheel: 1,480 (58.3)
    16 inch wheel: 1,470 (57.9)

    Rear tread

    15 inch wheel: 1,485 (58.5)
    16 inch wheel: 1,475 (58.1)

    Wheelbase

    2,600 (102.4)

    Wheels & Tires

    INFOID:0000000009464404

    Conventional
    Road wheel/offset mm (in)

    Tire size

    Revision: April 2013

    15 X 5.5J Aluminum/40 (1.57)
    16 X 6.0J Aluminum/45 (1.77)
    P185/65R15
    P195/55R16

    GI-36

    Spare

    T125/70D15

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    GI

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009464422

    B

    WORK FLOW
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    SGI838

    STEP

    DESCRIPTION
    Get detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the incident occurred.
    The following are key pieces of information required to make a good analysis:

    STEP 1

    WHAT

    Vehicle Model, Engine, Transmission/Transaxle and the System (i.e. Radio).

    WHEN

    Date, Time of Day, Weather Conditions, Frequency.

    WHERE

    Road Conditions, Altitude and Traffic Situation.

    HOW

    System Symptoms, Operating Conditions (Other Components Interaction).
    Service History and if any After Market Accessories have been installed.

    I

    J

    K

    STEP 2

    Operate the system, road test if necessary.
    Verify the parameter of the incident.
    If the problem cannot be duplicated, refer to “Incident Simulation Tests”.

    STEP 3

    Get the proper diagnosis materials together including:
    • Power Supply Routing
    • System Operation Descriptions
    • Applicable Service Manual Sections
    • Check for any Service Bulletins
    Identify where to begin diagnosis based upon your knowledge of the system operation and the customer comments.

    STEP 4

    Inspect the system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage.
    Determine which circuits and components are involved and diagnose using the Power Supply Routing and Harness Layouts.

    STEP 5

    Repair or replace the incident circuit or component.

    STEP 6

    Operate the system in all modes. Verify the system works properly under all conditions. Make sure you have not inadvertently created a new incident during your diagnosis or repair steps.

    Control Units and Electrical Parts

    INFOID:0000000009464423

    PRECAUTIONS



    Never reverse polarity of battery terminals.
    Install only parts specified for a vehicle.
    Before replacing the control unit, check the input and output and functions of the component parts.
    Do not apply excessive force when disconnecting a connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-37

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Do not apply excessive shock to the control unit by dropping or hitting it.
    • Be careful to prevent condensation in the control unit due to rapid
    temperature changes and do not let water or rain get on it. If water
    is found in the control unit, dry it fully and then install it in the vehicle.
    • Be careful not to let oil to get on the control unit connector.
    • Avoid cleaning the control unit with volatile oil.
    • Do not disassemble the control unit, and do not remove the upper
    and lower covers.
    SAIA0255E

    • When using a DMM, be careful not to let test probes get close to
    each other to prevent the power transistor in the control unit from
    damaging battery voltage because of short circuiting.
    • When checking input and output signals of the control unit, use the
    specified check adapter.

    SEF348N

    How to Check Terminal

    INFOID:0000000009464424

    CONNECTOR AND TERMINAL PIN KIT
    • Use the connector and terminal pin kits listed below when replacing connectors or terminals.
    • The connector and terminal pin kits contain some of the most commonly used NISSAN/INFINITI connectors
    and terminals. For detailed connector and terminal pin replacement procedures, refer to the latest NISSAN/
    INFINITI CONNECTOR AND TERMINAL PIN SERVICE MANUAL.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-38

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name
    (J38751-95NI)
    Connector and terminal
    pin kit (NISSAN)
    (J38751-95INF)
    Connector and terminal
    pin kit (INFINITI)
    (J42992-98KIT)
    OBD and terminal repair
    kit
    (J42992-2000UPD)
    OBD-II Connector Kit Update

    GI

    Description

    B

    C

    D

    E
    WAIA0004E

    WAIA0005E

    F

    HOW TO PROBE CONNECTORS
    • Connector damage and an intermittent connection can result from improperly probing of the connector during circuit checks.
    • The probe of a digital multimeter (DMM) may not correctly fit the connector cavity. To correctly probe the
    connector, follow the procedures below using a “T” pin. For the best contact grasp the “T” pin using an alligator clip.
    Probing from Harness Side
    Standard type (not waterproof type) connector should be probed
    from harness side with “T” pin.
    • If the connector has a rear cover such as a ECM connector,
    remove the rear cover before probing the terminal.
    • Do not probe waterproof connector from harness side. Damage to
    the seal between wire and connector may result.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    SGI841

    L

    Probing from Terminal Side
    FEMALE TERMINAL

    • There is a small notch above each female terminal. Probe each
    terminal with the “T” pin through the notch.
    Do not insert any object other than the same type male terminal
    into female terminal.

    M

    N

    O

    SEL265V

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-39

    2014 Note

    P

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Some connectors do not have a notch above each terminal. To
    probe each terminal, remove the connector retainer to make contact space for probing.

    SEL266V

    MALE TERMINAL

    • Carefully probe the contact surface of each terminal using a “T”
    pin.
    CAUTION:
    Dot not bend terminal.

    SEL267V

    How to Check Enlarged Contact Spring of Terminal
    • An enlarged contact spring of a terminal may create intermittent signals in the circuit.
    • If the intermittent open circuit occurs, follow the procedure below to inspect for open wires and enlarged contact spring of female terminal.
    1. Assemble a male terminal and approx. 10 cm (3.9 in) of wire.
    NOTE:
    Use a male terminal which matches the female terminal.
    2. Disconnect the suspected faulty connector and hold it terminal
    side up.

    SEL270V

    3.

    While holding the wire of the male terminal, try to insert the male
    terminal into the female terminal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not force the male terminal into the female terminal with
    your hands.

    SEL271V

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-40

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    4. While moving the connector, check whether the male terminal
    can be easily inserted or not.

    GI

    B

    C
    SEL272V

    D

    • If the male terminal can be easily inserted into the female terminal, replace the female terminal.
    E

    F

    G
    SEL273V

    Waterproof Connector Inspection
    If water enters the connector, it can short interior circuits. This may lead to intermittent problems.
    Check the following items to maintain the original waterproof characteristics.

    H

    RUBBER SEAL INSPECTION

    I

    • Most waterproof connectors are provided with a rubber seal
    between the male and female connectors. If the seal is missing,
    the waterproof performance may not meet specifications.
    • The rubber seal may come off when connectors are disconnected.
    Whenever connectors are reconnected, make sure the rubber seal
    is properly installed on either side of male or female connector.

    J

    K

    WIRE SEAL INSPECTION

    • The wire seal must be installed on the wire insertion area of a
    waterproof connector. Be sure that the seal is installed properly.

    L
    SEL275V

    Terminal Lock Inspection
    Check for unlocked terminals by pulling wire at the end of connector.
    An unlocked terminal may create intermittent signals in the circuit.

    M

    N

    O

    SEL330V

    Intermittent Incident

    INFOID:0000000009464425

    DESCRIPTION
    Sometimes the symptom is not present when the vehicle is brought in for service. If possible, re-create the
    conditions present at the time of the incident. Doing so may help avoid a No Trouble Found Diagnosis. The fol-

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-41

    2014 Note

    P

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    lowing section illustrates ways to simulate the conditions/environment under which the owner experiences an
    electrical incident.
    The section is broken into the six following topics:

    • Vehicle vibration
    • Heat sensitive
    • Freezing
    • Water intrusion
    • Electrical load
    • Cold or hot start up
    Get a thorough description of the incident from the customer. It is important for simulating the conditions of the
    problem.

    VEHICLE VIBRATION
    The problem may occur or become worse while driving on a rough road or when engine is vibrating (idle with
    A/C on). In such a case, you will want to check for a vibration related condition. Refer to the following illustration.
    Connector & Harness
    Determine which connectors and wiring harness would affect the electrical system you are inspecting. Gently
    shake each connector and harness while monitoring the system for the incident you are trying to duplicate.
    This test may indicate a loose or poor electrical connection.
    Hint
    Connectors can be exposed to moisture. It is possible to get a thin film of corrosion on the connector terminals. A visual inspection may not reveal this without disconnecting the connector. If the problem occurs intermittently, perhaps the problem is caused by corrosion. It is a good idea to disconnect, inspect and clean the
    terminals on related connectors in the system.
    Sensor & Relay
    Gently apply a slight vibration to sensors and relays in the system you are inspecting.
    This test may indicate a loose or poorly mounted sensor or relay.

    SGI839

    Engine Compartment
    There are several reasons a vehicle or engine vibration could cause an electrical complaint. Some of the
    things to check for are:
    • Connectors not fully seated.
    • Wiring harness not long enough and is being stressed due to engine vibrations or rocking.
    • Wires laying across brackets or moving components.
    • Loose, dirty or corroded ground wires.
    • Wires routed too close to hot components.
    To inspect components under the hood, start by verifying the integrity of ground connections. (Refer to Ground
    Inspection described later.) First check that the system is properly grounded. Then check for loose connection
    by gently shaking the wiring or components as previously explained. Using the wiring diagrams inspect the
    wiring for continuity.
    Behind the Instrument Panel
    An improperly routed or improperly clamped harness can become pinched during accessory installation. Vehicle vibration can aggravate a harness which is routed along a bracket or near a screw.
    Under Seating Areas

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-42

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    An unclamped or loose harness can cause wiring to be pinched by seat components (such as slide guides)
    during vehicle vibration. If the wiring runs under seating areas, inspect wire routing for possible damage or GI
    pinching.

    HEAT SENSITIVE

    B

    • The customer’s concern may occur during hot weather or after car
    has sat for a short time. In such cases you will want to check for a
    heat sensitive condition.
    • To determine if an electrical component is heat sensitive, heat the
    component with a heat gun or equivalent.
    CAUTION:
    Do not heat components above 60°C (140°F).
    • If incident occurs while heating the unit, either replace or properly
    insulate the component.

    C

    D

    SGI842

    E

    FREEZING
    • The customer may indicate the incident goes away after the car
    warms up (winter time). The cause could be related to water freezing somewhere in the wiring/electrical system.
    • There are two methods to check for this. The first is to arrange for
    the owner to leave his car overnight. Make sure it will get cold
    enough to demonstrate his complaint. Leave the car parked outside overnight. In the morning, do a quick and thorough diagnosis
    of those electrical components which could be affected.
    • The second method is to put the suspect component into a freezer
    long enough for any water to freeze. Reinstall the part into the car
    and check for the reoccurrence of the incident. If it occurs, repair or
    replace the component.

    F

    G

    H

    SGI843

    I

    WATER INTRUSION
    The incident may occur only during high humidity or in rainy/snowy
    weather. In such cases the incident could be caused by water intrusion on an electrical part. This can be simulated by soaking the car
    or running it through a car wash.
    CAUTION:
    Do not spray water directly on any electrical components.

    J

    K

    L

    SGI844

    ELECTRICAL LOAD
    The incident may be electrical load sensitive. Perform diagnosis with
    all accessories (including A/C, rear window defogger, radio, fog
    lamps) turned on.

    M

    N

    O

    P
    SGI845

    COLD OR HOT START UP
    On some occasions an electrical incident may occur only when the car is started cold, or it may occur when
    the car is restarted hot shortly after being turned off. In these cases you may have to keep the car overnight to
    make a proper diagnosis.
    Revision: April 2013

    GI-43

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    Circuit Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009464426

    DESCRIPTION
    • In general, testing electrical circuits is an easy task if it is approached in a logical and organized method.
    Before beginning it is important to have all available information on the system to be tested. Also, get a thorough understanding of system operation. Then you will be able to use the appropriate equipment and follow
    the correct test procedure.
    • You may have to simulate vehicle vibrations while testing electrical components. Gently shake the wiring
    harness or electrical component to do this.
    OPEN

    A circuit is open when there is no continuity through a section of the circuit.
    There are two types of shorts.

    SHORT

    • SHORT CIRCUIT

    When a circuit contacts another circuit and causes the normal resistance to
    change.

    • SHORT TO GROUND

    When a circuit contacts a ground source and grounds the circuit.

    NOTE:
    Refer to GI-38, «How to Check Terminal» to probe or check terminal.

    TESTING FOR “OPENS” IN THE CIRCUIT
    Before you begin to diagnose and test the system, you should rough sketch a schematic of the system. This
    will help you to logically walk through the diagnosis process. Drawing the sketch will also reinforce your working knowledge of the system.

    SGI846-A

    Continuity Check Method
    The continuity check is used to find an open in the circuit. The digital multimeter (DMM) set on the resistance
    function will indicate an open circuit as over limit (no beep tone or no ohms symbol). Make sure to always start
    with the DMM at the highest resistance level.
    To help in understanding the diagnosis of open circuits, please refer to the previous schematic.
    • Disconnect the battery negative cable.
    • Start at one end of the circuit and work your way to the other end. (At the fuse block in this example)
    • Connect one probe of the DMM to the fuse block terminal on the load side.
    • Connect the other probe to the fuse block (power) side of SW1. Little or no resistance will indicate that portion of the circuit has good continuity. If there were an open in the circuit, the DMM would indicate an over
    limit or infinite resistance condition. (point A)
    • Connect the probes between SW1 and the relay. Little or no resistance will indicate that portion of the circuit
    has good continuity. If there were an open in the circuit, the DMM would indicate an over limit or infinite resistance condition. (point B)
    • Connect the probes between the relay and the solenoid. Little or no resistance will indicate that portion of the
    circuit has good continuity. If there were an open in the circuit, the DMM would indicate an over limit or infinite resistance condition. (point C)
    Any circuit can be diagnosed using the approach in the previous example.
    Voltage Check Method
    To help in understanding the diagnosis of open circuits please refer to the previous schematic.
    In any powered circuit, an open can be found by methodically checking the system for the presence of voltage.
    This is done by switching the DMM to the voltage function.
    • Connect one probe of the DMM to a known good ground.
    • Begin probing at one end of the circuit and work your way to the other end.
    • With SW1 open, probe at SW1 to check for voltage.
    voltage; open is further down the circuit than SW1.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-44

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    no voltage; open is between fuse block and SW1 (point A).
    • Close SW1 and probe at relay.
    voltage; open is further down the circuit than the relay.
    no voltage; open is between SW1 and relay (point B).
    • Close the relay and probe at the solenoid.
    voltage; open is further down the circuit than the solenoid.
    no voltage; open is between relay and solenoid (point C).
    Any powered circuit can be diagnosed using the approach in the previous example.

    GI

    B

    C

    TESTING FOR “SHORTS” IN THE CIRCUIT
    To simplify the discussion of shorts in the system, please refer to the following schematic.

    D

    E

    F
    SGI847-A

    Resistance Check Method
    • Disconnect the battery negative cable and remove the blown fuse.
    • Disconnect all loads (SW1 open, relay disconnected and solenoid disconnected) powered through the fuse.
    • Connect one probe of the DMM to the load side of the fuse terminal. Connect the other probe to a known
    good ground.
    • With SW1 open, check for continuity.
    continuity; short is between fuse terminal and SW1 (point A).
    no continuity; short is further down the circuit than SW1.
    • Close SW1 and disconnect the relay. Put probes at the load side of fuse terminal and a known good ground.
    Then, check for continuity.
    continuity; short is between SW1 and the relay (point B).
    no continuity; short is further down the circuit than the relay.
    • Close SW1 and jump the relay contacts with jumper wire. Put probes at the load side of fuse terminal and a
    known good ground. Then, check for continuity.
    continuity; short is between relay and solenoid (point C).
    no continuity; check solenoid, retrace steps.
    Voltage Check Method
    • Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads (i.e. SW1 open, relay disconnected and solenoid disconnected) powered through the fuse.
    • Turn the ignition key to the ON or START position. Verify battery voltage at the battery + side of the fuse terminal (one lead on the battery + terminal side of the fuse block and one lead on a known good ground).
    • With SW1 open and the DMM leads across both fuse terminals, check for voltage.
    voltage; short is between fuse block and SW1 (point A).
    no voltage; short is further down the circuit than SW1.
    • With SW1 closed, relay and solenoid disconnected and the DMM leads across both fuse terminals, check for
    voltage.
    voltage; short is between SW1 and the relay (point B).
    no voltage; short is further down the circuit than the relay.
    • With SW1 closed, relay contacts jumped with fused jumper wire check for voltage.
    voltage; short is down the circuit of the relay or between the relay and the disconnected solenoid (point C).
    no voltage; retrace steps and check power to fuse block.

    GROUND INSPECTION
    • Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits. Ground
    connections are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The corrosion (rust) can
    become an unwanted resistance. This unwanted resistance can change the way a circuit works.
    • Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground can
    drastically affect an electronically controlled circuit. A poor or corroded ground can easily affect the circuit.
    Even when the ground connection looks clean, there can be a thin film of rust on the surface.
    Revision: April 2013

    GI-45

    2014 Note

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • When inspecting a ground connection follow these rules:
    — Remove the ground bolt or screw.
    — Inspect all mating surfaces for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
    — Clean as required to assure good contact.
    — Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
    — Inspect for “add-on” accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
    — If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure all of the
    wires are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are cased in one eyelet make sure no ground wires have excess wire insulation.
    • For detailed ground distribution information, refer to “Ground Distribution” in PG section.

    SGI853

    VOLTAGE DROP TESTS
    • Voltage drop tests are often used to find components or circuits which have excessive resistance. A voltage
    drop in a circuit is caused by a resistance when the circuit is in operation.
    • Check the wire in the illustration. When measuring resistance with DMM, contact by a single strand of wire
    will give reading of 0 ohms. This would indicate a good circuit. When the circuit operates, this single strand
    of wire is not able to carry the current. The single strand will have a high resistance to the current. This will
    be picked up as a slight voltage drop.
    • Unwanted resistance can be caused by many situations as follows:
    — Undersized wiring (single strand example)
    — Corrosion on switch contacts
    — Loose wire connections or splices.
    • If repairs are needed always use wire that is of the same or larger gauge.
    Measuring Voltage Drop — Accumulated Method
    • Connect the DMM across the connector or part of the circuit you want to check. The positive lead of the
    DMM should be closer to power and the negative lead closer to ground.
    • Operate the circuit.
    • The DMM will indicate how many volts are being used to “push” current through that part of the circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-46

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Note in the illustration that there is an excessive 4.1 volt drop between the battery and the bulb.
    GI

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    SGI974

    Measuring Voltage Drop — Step-by-Step
    • The step-by-step method is most useful for isolating excessive drops in low voltage systems (such as those
    in “Computer Controlled Systems”).
    • Circuits in the “Computer Controlled System” operate on very low amperage.
    • The (Computer Controlled) system operations can be adversely affected by any variation in resistance in the
    system. Such resistance variation may be caused by poor connection, improper installation, improper wire
    gauge or corrosion.
    • The step by step voltage drop test can identify a component or wire with too much resistance.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M
    SAIA0258E

    N

    CONTROL UNIT CIRCUIT TEST
    System Description
    • When the switch is ON, the control unit lights up the lamp.

    O

    CASE 1

    P

    MGI034A

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-47

    2014 Note

    SERVICE INFORMATION FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    INPUT-OUTPUT VOLTAGE CHART

    Terminal No.
    +

    1

    2

    Description
    Signal name

    Body
    ground

    Switch

    Body
    ground

    Lamp

    Value (Approx.)

    In case of high resistance such as single
    strand (V) *

    Switch ON

    Battery voltage

    Lower than battery voltage Approx. 8 (Example)

    Switch OFF

    0V

    Switch ON

    Battery voltage

    Switch OFF

    0V

    Condition

    Input/
    Output
    Input

    Output

    Approx. 0
    Approx. 0 (Inoperative lamp)
    Approx. 0

    • The voltage value is based on the body ground.
    • *: If high resistance exists in the switch side circuit (caused by a single strand), terminal 1 does not detect battery voltage. Control unit
    does not detect the switch is ON even if the switch does not turn ON. Therefore, the control unit does not supply power to light up the
    lamp.

    CASE 2

    MGI035A

    INPUT-OUTPUT VOLTAGE CHART

    Terminal No.
    +

    Description
    Signal name

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    1

    Body
    ground

    Lamp

    Output

    2

    Body
    ground

    Switch

    Input

    Value (Approx.)

    In case of high resistance such as single
    strand (V) *

    Switch ON

    0V

    Battery voltage (Inoperative lamp)

    Switch OFF

    Battery voltage

    Switch ON

    0V

    Higher than 0 Approx. 4 (Example)

    Switch OFF

    5V

    Approx. 5

    Battery voltage

    • The voltage value is based on the body ground.
    • *: If high resistance exists in the switch side circuit (caused by a single strand), terminal 2 does not detect approx. 0V. Control unit
    does not detect the switch is ON even if the switch does not turn ON. Therefore, the control unit does not control ground to light up the
    lamp.

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-48

    2014 Note

    CONSULT/GST CHECKING SYSTEM
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    CONSULT/GST CHECKING SYSTEM

    GI

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009464427

    NOTE:
    This vehicle is diagnosed using the CONSULT-III plus.
    • When CONSULT is connected with a data link connector equipped
    on the vehicle side, it will communicate with the control unit
    equipped in the vehicle and then enable various kinds of diagnostic tests.
    1

    : Hood release handle

    2

    : Data link connector

    B

    C

    D

    • Refer to “CONSULT-III plus Operation Manual” for more information.

    E
    ALAIA0095ZZ

    Function and System Application

    ENGINE

    ABS

    METER/M&A

    BCM

    AIR BAG

    TRANSMISSION1

    EPS

    IPDM E/R

    MULTI AV

    INFOID:0000000009464428

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The ECU self diagnostic results are displayed.

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    Data Monitor

    The ECU input/output data is displayed in real time.

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    Work support

    The settings for ECU functions can be changed.

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    Active Test

    The ECU activates outputs to test components.

    x

    x

    x

    x

    ECU identification

    The ECU part number is displayed.

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    DTC Work Support

    The status of system monitoring tests and the self diagnosis status/results can be confirmed.

    x

    Warning History

    Displays the history of the combination meter warning
    lamp indicators.

    x

    TROUBLE DIAG RECORD

    Self diagnostic history and trouble diagnosis records in
    ECU are displayed.

    x

    CAN Diag

    This mode displays network diagnostic results of CAN
    communication using a diagram.

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    x

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing
    ECU.

    x

    CALIB DATA

    The calibration values of the ECU are displayed.

    x

    SRT & P-DTC Confirmation

    The status of system monitoring tests and the self diagnosis status/results can be confirmed.

    x

    Diagnosis (All Systems)

    Description

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    x: Applicable
    1: With continuously variable transmission

    CONSULT Data Link Connector (DLC) Circuit

    INFOID:0000000009464429

    INSPECTION PROCEDURE
    If the CONSULT cannot diagnose the system properly, check the following items.
    Revision: April 2013

    F

    GI-49

    2014 Note

    CONSULT/GST CHECKING SYSTEM
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Symptom

    Check item

    CONSULT cannot access any
    system.

    • CONSULT DLC power supply circuit (Terminal 8) and ground circuit (Terminal 4)

    CONSULT cannot access individual system. (Other systems
    can be accessed.)

    • Power supply and ground circuit for the control unit of the system (For detailed circuit, refer to wiring
    diagram for each system.)
    • Open or short circuit between the system and CONSULT DLC (For detailed circuit, refer to wiring
    diagram for each system.)
    • Open or short circuit CAN communication line. Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    NOTE:
    The DDL2 circuits and CAN communication lines from DLC pins 6, 7 and 14 may be connected to more than
    one system. A short in a DDL circuit or CAN lines connected to a control unit in one system may affect CONSULT access to other systems. For a complete DDL circuit layout, refer to GI-51, «Wiring Diagram — CONSULT/GST CHECKING SYSTEM». For a complete CAN line layout, refer to LAN-31, «Wiring Diagram».

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-50

    2014 Note

    CONSULT/GST CHECKING SYSTEM
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    Wiring Diagram — CONSULT/GST CHECKING SYSTEM

    INFOID:0000000009464430

    GI

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    AAAWA0059GB

    Revision: April 2013

    GI-51

    2014 Note

    P

    BODY EXTERIOR, DOORS, ROOF & VEHICLE SECURITY

    SECTION

    GW

    GLASS & WINDOW SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..12

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    OPERA WINDOW ……………………………………… 14

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Handling for Adhesive and Primer ………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 4
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 4

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 5
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES ………………………………………………………. 5
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….. 5
    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting ………… 6
    Diagnostic Worksheet ……………………………………….. 9

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 11
    WINDSHIELD GLASS ………………………………….11
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 11

    Exploded View …………………………………………………14
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..14

    F

    G

    SIDE WINDOW GLASS ……………………………… 16
    Exploded View …………………………………………………16
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..17

    BACK DOOR WINDOW GLASS …………………. 19

    H

    Exploded View …………………………………………………19
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..19

    I

    FRONT DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR ….. 21

    J

    Exploded View …………………………………………………21
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..21

    FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR …………….. 24 GW
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..24

    REAR DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR ……. 25
    Exploded View …………………………………………………25
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..25

    REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR ………………. 28

    L

    M

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..28
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009509403

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Handling for Adhesive and Primer

    INFOID:0000000009509404

    • Do not use an adhesive which is past its usable date. Shelf life of this product is limited to six months after
    the date of manufacture. Carefully adhere to the expiration or manufacture date printed on the box.
    • Keep primers and adhesive in a cool, dry place. Ideally, they should be stored in a refrigerator.
    • Open the seal of the primer and adhesive just before application. Discard the remainder.
    • Before application, be sure to shake the primer container to stir the contents. If any floating material is found,
    do not use it.
    • If any primer or adhesive contacts the skin, wipe it off with gasoline or equivalent and wash the skin with
    soap.
    • When using primer and adhesive, always observe the precautions in the instruction manual.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009509405

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    Revision: April 2013

    GW-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    GW

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009509406

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-39570)
    Chassis Ear

    Locating the noise

    SIIA0993E


    (J-50397)
    NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit

    Repairing the cause of noise

    ALJIA1232ZZ


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009509407

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39565)
    Engine Ear

    Locating the noise

    SIIA0995E

    ( — )
    Suction Lifter

    Holding door glass

    LIIA1991E

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-4

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671273

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    SBT842

    CUSTOMER INTERVIEW

    H
    Interview the customer if possible, to determine the conditions that exist when the noise occurs. Use the Diagnostic Worksheet during the interview to document the facts and conditions when the noise occurs and any
    customer’s comments; refer to GW-9, «Diagnostic Worksheet». This information is necessary to duplicate the
    I
    conditions that exist when the noise occurs.
    • The customer may not be able to provide a detailed description or the location of the noise. Attempt to obtain
    all the facts and conditions that exist when the noise occurs (or does not occur).
    • If there is more than one noise in the vehicle, be sure to diagnose and repair the noise that the customer is J
    concerned about. This can be accomplished by test driving the vehicle with the customer.
    • After identifying the type of noise, isolate the noise in terms of its characteristics. The noise characteristics
    are provided so the customer, service adviser and technician are all speaking the same language when
    GW
    defining the noise.
    • Squeak —(Like tennis shoes on a clean floor)
    Squeak characteristics include the light contact/fast movement/brought on by road conditions/hard surfaces
    L
    = higher pitch noise/softer surfaces = lower pitch noises/edge to surface = chirping.
    • Creak—(Like walking on an old wooden floor)
    Creak characteristics include firm contact/slow movement/twisting with a rotational movement/pitch dependent on materials/often brought on by activity.
    M
    • Rattle—(Like shaking a baby rattle)
    Rattle characteristics include the fast repeated contact/vibration or similar movement/loose parts/missing
    clip or fastener/incorrect clearance.
    N
    • Knock —(Like a knock on a door)
    Knock characteristics include hollow sounding/sometimes repeating/often brought on by driver action.
    • Tick—(Like a clock second hand)
    Tick characteristics include gentle contacting of light materials/loose components/can be caused by driver
    O
    action or road conditions.
    • Thump—(Heavy, muffled knock noise)
    Thump characteristics include softer knock/dead sound often brought on by activity.
    P
    • Buzz—(Like a bumble bee)
    Buzz characteristics include high frequency rattle/firm contact.
    • Often the degree of acceptable noise level will vary depending upon the person. A noise that you may judge
    as acceptable may be very irritating to the customer.
    • Weather conditions, especially humidity and temperature, may have a great effect on noise level.

    DUPLICATE THE NOISE AND TEST DRIVE

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-5

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    If possible, drive the vehicle with the customer until the noise is duplicated. Note any additional information on
    the Diagnostic Worksheet regarding the conditions or location of the noise. This information can be used to
    duplicate the same conditions when you confirm the repair.
    If the noise can be duplicated easily during the test drive, to help identify the source of the noise, try to duplicate the noise with the vehicle stopped by doing one or all of the following:
    1) Close a door.
    2) Tap or push/pull around the area where the noise appears to be coming from.
    3) Rev the engine.
    4) Use a floor jack to recreate vehicle “twist”.
    5) At idle, apply engine load (electrical load, half-clutch on M/T model, drive position on CVT and A/T models).
    6) Raise the vehicle on a hoist and hit a tire with a rubber hammer.
    • Drive the vehicle and attempt to duplicate the conditions the customer states exist when the noise occurs.
    • If it is difficult to duplicate the noise, drive the vehicle slowly on an undulating or rough road to stress the
    vehicle body.

    CHECK RELATED SERVICE BULLETINS
    After verifying the customer concern or symptom, check ASIST for Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) related
    to that concern or symptom.
    If a TSB relates to the symptom, follow the procedure to repair the noise.

    LOCATE THE NOISE AND IDENTIFY THE ROOT CAUSE
    1.
    2.

    Narrow down the noise to a general area. To help pinpoint the source of the noise, use a listening tool
    (Chassis Ear: J-39570, Engine Ear: J-39565 and mechanic’s stethoscope).
    Narrow down the noise to a more specific area and identify the cause of the noise by:
    • removing the components in the area that you suspect the noise is coming from.
    Do not use too much force when removing clips and fasteners, otherwise clips and fasteners can be
    broken or lost during the repair, resulting in the creation of new noise.
    • tapping or pushing/pulling the component that you suspect is causing the noise.
    Do not tap or push/pull the component with excessive force, otherwise the noise will be eliminated only
    temporarily.
    • feeling for a vibration with your hand by touching the component(s) that you suspect is (are) causing the
    noise.
    • placing a piece of paper between components that you suspect are causing the noise.
    • looking for loose components and contact marks.
    Refer to GW-6, «Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting».

    REPAIR THE CAUSE


    If the cause is a loose component, tighten the component securely.
    If the cause is insufficient clearance between components:
    separate components by repositioning or loosening and retightening the component, if possible.
    insulate components with a suitable insulator such as urethane pads, foam blocks, felt cloth tape or urethane
    tape. A NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) is available through your authorized NISSAN Parts Department.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use excessive force as many components are constructed of plastic and may be damaged.
    NOTE:
    • Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    • The materials contained in the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) are listed on the inside cover of the
    kit; and can each be ordered separately as needed.
    • The following materials not found in the kit can also be used to repair squeaks and rattles.
    — SILICONE GREASE: Use instead of UHMW tape that will be visible or does not fit. The silicone grease will
    only last a few months.
    — SILICONE SPRAY: Use when grease cannot be applied.
    — DUCT TAPE: Use to eliminate movement.

    CONFIRM THE REPAIR
    Confirm that the cause of a noise is repaired by test driving the vehicle. Operate the vehicle under the same
    conditions as when the noise originally occurred. Refer to the notes on the Diagnostic Worksheet.

    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting

    INFOID:0000000009671274

    Refer to Table of Contents for specific component removal and installation information.
    Revision: April 2013

    GW-6

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    INSTRUMENT PANEL
    Most incidents are caused by contact and movement between:
    1. Cluster lid A and the instrument panel
    2. Acrylic lens and combination meter housing
    3. Instrument panel to front pillar finisher
    4. Instrument panel to windshield
    5. Instrument panel pins
    6. Wiring harnesses behind the combination meter
    7. A/C defroster duct and duct joint
    These incidents can usually be located by tapping or moving the components to duplicate the noise or by
    pressing on the components while driving to stop the noise. Most of these incidents can be repaired by applying felt cloth tape or silicone spray (in hard to reach areas). Urethane pads can be used to insulate wiring harness.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use silicone spray to isolate a squeak or rattle. If you saturate the area with silicone, you will
    not be able to recheck the repair.

    C

    CENTER CONSOLE

    F

    Components to pay attention to include:
    1. Shift selector assembly cover to finisher
    2. A/C control unit and cluster lid C
    3. Wiring harnesses behind audio and A/C control unit
    The instrument panel repair and isolation procedures also apply to the center console.

    A

    B

    D

    E

    G

    H

    DOORS
    Pay attention to the:
    I
    1. Finisher and inner panel making a slapping noise
    2. Inside handle escutcheon to door finisher
    3. Wiring harnesses tapping
    J
    4. Door striker out of alignment causing a popping noise on starts and stops
    Tapping or moving the components or pressing on them while driving to duplicate the conditions can isolate
    many of these incidents. You can usually insulate the areas with felt cloth tape or insulator foam blocks from
    GW
    the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) to repair the noise.

    TRUNK
    Trunk noises are often caused by a loose jack or loose items put into the trunk by the owner.
    In addition look for:
    1. Trunk lid bumpers out of adjustment
    2. Trunk lid striker out of adjustment
    3. The trunk lid torsion bars knocking together
    4. A loose license plate or bracket
    Most of these incidents can be repaired by adjusting, securing or insulating the item(s) or component(s) causing the noise.

    SUNROOF/HEADLINING
    Noises in the sunroof/headlining area can often be traced to one of the following:
    1. Sunroof lid, rail, linkage or seals making a rattle or light knocking noise
    2. Sun visor shaft shaking in the holder
    3. Front or rear windshield touching headlining and squeaking
    Again, pressing on the components to stop the noise while duplicating the conditions can isolate most of these
    incidents. Repairs usually consist of insulating with felt cloth tape.

    OVERHEAD CONSOLE (FRONT AND REAR)
    Overhead console noises are often caused by the console panel clips not being engaged correctly. Most of
    these incidents are repaired by pushing up on the console at the clip locations until the clips engage.
    In addition look for:
    Revision: April 2013

    GW-7

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Loose harness or harness connectors.
    2. Front console map/reading lamp lens loose.
    3. Loose screws at console attachment points.

    SEATS
    When isolating seat noise it’s important to note the position the seat is in and the load placed on the seat when
    the noise is present. These conditions should be duplicated when verifying and isolating the cause of the
    noise.
    Cause of seat noise include:
    1. Headrest rods and holder
    2. A squeak between the seat pad cushion and frame
    3. The rear seatback lock and bracket
    These noises can be isolated by moving or pressing on the suspected components while duplicating the conditions under which the noise occurs. Most of these incidents can be repaired by repositioning the component
    or applying urethane tape to the contact area.

    UNDERHOOD
    Some interior noise may be caused by components under the hood or on the engine wall. The noise is then
    transmitted into the passenger compartment.
    Causes of transmitted underhood noise include:
    1. Any component installed to the engine wall
    2. Components that pass through the engine wall
    3. Engine wall mounts and connectors
    4. Loose radiator installation pins
    5. Hood bumpers out of adjustment
    6. Hood striker out of adjustment
    These noises can be difficult to isolate since they cannot be reached from the interior of the vehicle. The best
    method is to secure, move or insulate one component at a time and test drive the vehicle. Also, engine rpm or
    load can be changed to isolate the noise. Repairs can usually be made by moving, adjusting, securing, or
    insulating the component causing the noise.

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-8

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnostic Worksheet

    INFOID:0000000009671275

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    GW

    L

    M

    N

    O

    LAIA0072E

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-9

    P

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    LAIA0071E

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-10

    2014 Note

    WINDSHIELD GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    WINDSHIELD GLASS
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009509408

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    GW

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AWKIA2557ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-11

    2014 Note

    WINDSHIELD GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1.

    Windshield glass molding

    2.

    Windshield glass

    3.

    Spacer

    4.

    Spacer

    5.

    Roof

    6.

    Dam rubber

    7.

    Headlining

    8.

    Adhesive

    9.

    Cowl top cover

    10. Front pillar finisher

    11. Body side outer

    12. Body primer

    13. Primer

    D.

    3.8 mm (0.15 in)

    E.

    5.0 mm (0.20 in)

    F.

    8.0 mm (0.31 in)

    G.

    6.2 mm (0.24 in)

    H.

    12.0 — 14.0 mm (0.47 — 0.55 in)

    J.

    7.0 — 9.0 mm (0.28 — 0.35 in)

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009509409

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove front pillar finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-19, «FRONT PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Partially remove the headlining (front edge).
    Remove cowl top cover. Refer to EXT-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove inside mirror. Refer to MIR-14, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove windshield glass using piano wire or power cutting tool (A) and an inflatable pump bag (B).

    PIIB5779E

    • Apply protective tape around the windshield glass to protect the painted surface from damage.
    • If the windshield glass is to be reused, mark the body and the glass with matching marks.
    WARNING:
    When cutting the glass from the vehicle, always wear safety glasses and heavy gloves to help prevent glass splinters from entering your eyes or cutting your hands.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to scratch the glass when removing.
    • Be careful not to set or stand the glass on its edge. Small chips may develop into cracks.
    • Apply protective tape around the windshield glass to protect the painted surface from damage.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Use a genuine NISSAN Urethane Adhesive Kit (if available) or equivalent and follow the instructions furnished with it.
    • Adhesive shall be continuously applied to assure watertightness. Glass installation shall be finished within
    five minutes after applying the adhesive.
    • While the urethane adhesive is curing, open a door window. This will prevent the glass from being forced out
    by passenger compartment air pressure when a door is closed.
    • The molding must be installed securely so that it is in position and leaves no gap.
    • Inform the customer that the vehicle should remain stationary until the urethane adhesive has completely
    cured (preferably 24 hours). Curing time varies with temperature and humidity.
    WARNING:
    • Keep heat and open flames away as primers and adhesive are flammable.
    • The materials contained in the kit are harmful if swallowed, and may irritate skin and eyes. Avoid
    contact with the skin and eyes.
    • Use in an open, well ventilated location. Avoid breathing the vapors. They can be harmful if inhaled.
    If affected by vapor inhalation, immediately move to an area with fresh air.
    • Driving the vehicle before the urethane adhesive has completely cured may affect the performance
    of the windshield in case of an accident.
    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    GW-12

    2014 Note

    WINDSHIELD GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Do not use an adhesive which is past its usable term. Shelf life of this product is limited to six
    months after the date of manufacture. Carefully adhere to the expiration or manufacture date printed
    on the box.
    • Keep primers and adhesive in a cool, dry place. Ideally, they should be stored in a refrigerator.
    • Do not leave primers or adhesive cartridge unattended with their caps open or off.
    • The vehicle should not be driven for at least 24 hours or until the urethane adhesive has completely
    cured. Curing time varies depending on temperature and humidity. The curing time will increase
    under lower temperatures and lower humidity.

    A

    B

    C

    REPAIRING WATER LEAKS FOR WINDSHIELD GLASS
    • Leaks can be repaired without removing and reinstalling windshield glass.
    • If water is leaking between the urethane adhesive material and body or glass, determine the extent of the
    leak.
    • This can be done by applying water to the windshield glass area while pushing glass outward.
    • To stop the leak, apply primer (if necessary) and urethane adhesive to the leak point.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    GW

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-13

    2014 Note

    OPERA WINDOW
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    OPERA WINDOW
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009509410

    AWKIA2460ZZ

    1.

    Opera window glass

    2.

    Adhesive

    3.

    Front pillar finisher

    4.

    Body side outer

    5.

    Body primer

    6.

    Primer

    7.

    Front fender

    E.

    12.0 mm (0.47 in)

    F.

    11.0 mm (0.43 in)

    G.

    20.0 mm (0.79 in)

    Clip

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009509411

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove front pillar finisher. Refer to INT-19, «FRONT PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove front fender. Refer to DLK-125, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the opera window glass using piano wire or power cutting tool (A) and an inflatable pump bag
    (B).

    PIIB5779E

    WARNING:
    Revision: April 2013

    GW-14

    2014 Note

    OPERA WINDOW
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    When cutting glass from the vehicle, always wear safety glasses and heavy gloves to prevent
    glass splinters from entering your eyes or cutting your hands.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to scratch the glass when removing.
    • Do not set or stand the glass on its edge. Small chips may develop into cracks.
    • Apply protective tape around the opera window glass to protect the painted surface from damage.

    INSTALLATION
    • Use a genuine NISSAN Urethane Adhesive Kit (if available) or equivalent and follow the instructions furnished with it.
    • Adhesive shall be continuously applied to assure watertightness. Glass installation shall be finished within
    five minutes after applying the adhesive.
    • The start and finisher of the urethane adhesive application should be located at the bottom to assure watertightness.
    • While the urethane adhesive is curing, open a door window. This will prevent the glass from being forced out
    by passenger compartment air pressure when a door is closed.
    • Inform the customer that the vehicle should remain stationary until the urethane adhesive has completely
    cured (preferably 24 hours). Curing time varies with temperature and humidity.
    WARNING:
    • Keep heat and open flames away as primers and adhesive are flammable.
    • The materials contained in the kit are harmful if swallowed, and may irritate skin and eyes. Avoid
    contact with skin and eyes.
    • Use in an open, well ventilated location. Avoid breathing the vapors. They can be harmful if inhaled.
    If affected by vapor inhalation, immediately move to an area with fresh air.
    • Driving the vehicle before the urethane adhesive is completely cured may affect the performance of
    the opera window glass in case of an accident.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not use an adhesive which is past its usable term. Shelf life of this product is limited to six
    months after the date of manufacture. Carefully adhere to the expiration or manufacture date printed
    on the box.
    • Keep primers and adhesive in a cool, dry place. Ideally, they should be stored in a refrigerator.
    • Do not leave primers or adhesive cartridge unattended with their caps open or off.
    • The vehicle should not be driven for at least 24 hours or until the urethane adhesive is completely
    cured. Curing time varies depending on temperature and humidity. The curing time increases under
    lower temperature and lower humidity.

    REPAIRING WATER LEAKS FOR OPERA WINDOW GLASS
    • Leaks can be repaired without removing and reinstalling opera window glass.
    • If water is leaking between the urethane adhesive material and body or glass, determine the extent of the
    leak.
    • This can be done by applying water to the opera window glass area while pushing glass outward.
    • To stop the leak, apply primer (if necessary) and then urethane adhesive to the leak point.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    GW

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-15

    2014 Note

    SIDE WINDOW GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    SIDE WINDOW GLASS
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009509412

    AWKIA2558ZZ

    1.

    Spacer

    2.

    Side window glass

    3.

    Adhesive

    4.

    Luggage side upper finisher

    5.

    Primer

    6.

    Body primer

    7.

    Body side outer

    D.

    15.0 mm (0.59 in)

    E.

    22.4 mm (0.88 in)

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-16

    2014 Note

    SIDE WINDOW GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    F.

    24.0 mm (0.94 in)

    G.

    12.0 mm (0.47 in)

    H.

    7.0 mm (0.28 in)

    A

    Clip

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009509413

    B

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove luggage side upper finisher. Refer to INT-33, «LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation».
    Remove the side window glass using piano wire or power cutting tool (A) and an inflatable pump bag (B).

    C

    D

    E

    F
    PIIB5779E

    WARNING:
    When cutting glass from the vehicle, always wear safety glasses and heavy gloves to prevent
    glass splinters from entering your eyes or cutting your hands.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to scratch the glass when removing.
    • Do not set or stand the glass on its edge. Small chips may develop into cracks.
    • Apply protective tape around the side window glass to protect the painted surface from damage.

    INSTALLATION

    G

    H

    I
    • Use a genuine NISSAN Urethane Adhesive Kit (if available) or equivalent and follow the instructions furnished with it.
    • Adhesive shall be continuously applied to assure watertightness. Glass installation shall be finished within
    J
    five minutes after applying the adhesive.
    • The start and finisher of the urethane adhesive application should be located at the bottom to assure watertightness.
    • While the urethane adhesive is curing, open a door window. This will prevent the glass from being forced out GW
    by passenger compartment air pressure when a door is closed.
    • Inform the customer that the vehicle should remain stationary until the urethane adhesive has completely
    cured (preferably 24 hours). Curing time varies with temperature and humidity.
    L
    WARNING:
    • Keep heat and open flames away as primers and adhesive are flammable.
    • The materials contained in the kit are harmful if swallowed, and may irritate skin and eyes. Avoid
    M
    contact with skin and eyes.
    • Use in an open, well ventilated location. Avoid breathing the vapors. They can be harmful if inhaled.
    If affected by vapor inhalation, immediately move to an area with fresh air.
    • Driving the vehicle before the urethane adhesive is completely cured may affect the performance of N
    the side window glass in case of an accident.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not use an adhesive which is past its usable term. Shelf life of this product is limited to six
    months after the date of manufacture. Carefully adhere to the expiration or manufacture date printed O
    on the box.
    • Keep primers and adhesive in a cool, dry place. Ideally, they should be stored in a refrigerator.
    • Do not leave primers or adhesive cartridge unattended with their caps open or off.
    P
    • The vehicle should not be driven for at least 24 hours or until the urethane adhesive is completely
    cured. Curing time varies depending on temperature and humidity. The curing time increases under
    lower temperature and lower humidity.

    REPAIRING WATER LEAKS FOR SIDE WINDOW GLASS
    • Leaks can be repaired without removing and reinstalling side window glass.
    • If water is leaking between the urethane adhesive material and body or glass, determine the extent of the
    leak.
    Revision: April 2013

    GW-17

    2014 Note

    SIDE WINDOW GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • This can be done by applying water to the side window glass area while pushing glass outward.
    • To stop the leak, apply primer (if necessary) and then urethane adhesive to the leak point.

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-18

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR WINDOW GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BACK DOOR WINDOW GLASS

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009509414

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2559ZZ

    1.

    Back door window glass weatherstrip

    4.

    Back door window glass

    2.

    Back door window glass locator

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Back door window glass spacer

    INFOID:0000000009509415

    J

    GW

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove high-mounted stop lamp. Refer to EXL-117, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the back door inner finisher. Refer to INT-34, «BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and
    Installation».
    Remove back door window glass using piano wire or power cutting tool (A) and an inflatable pump bag
    (B).

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    PIIB5779E

    • Mark the body and the glass with matching marks if the back door window glass is reused.
    • Apply protective tape around the back door window glass to protect the painted surface from damage.
    WARNING:
    When cutting the glass from the vehicle, always wear safety glasses and heavy gloves to help prevent glass splinters from entering your eyes or cutting your hands.
    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    GW-19

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR WINDOW GLASS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Be careful not to scratch the glass when removing.
    • Do not set or stand the glass on its edge. Small chips may develop into cracks.
    • Apply protective tape around the back door window glass to protect the painted surface from
    damage.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Use a genuine NISSAN Urethane Adhesive Kit (if available) or equivalent and follow the instructions furnished with it.
    • Adhesive shall be continuously applied to assure watertightness. Glass installation shall be finished within
    five minutes after applying the adhesive.
    • While the urethane adhesive is curing, open a door window. This will prevent the glass from being forced out
    by passenger compartment air pressure when a door is closed.
    • The molding must be installed securely so that it is in position and leaves no gap.
    • Inform the customer that the vehicle should remain stationary until the urethane adhesive has completely
    cured (preferably 24 hours). Curing time varies with temperature and humidity.
    WARNING:
    • Keep heat and open flames away as primers and adhesive are flammable.
    • The materials contained in the kit are harmful if swallowed, and may irritate skin and eyes. Avoid
    contact with the skin and eyes.
    • Use in an open, well ventilated location. Avoid breathing the vapors. They can be harmful if inhaled.
    If affected by vapor inhalation, immediately move to an area with fresh air.
    • Driving the vehicle before the urethane adhesive has completely cured may affect the performance
    of the back door window glass in case of an accident.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not use an adhesive which is past its usable term. Shelf life of this product is limited to six
    months after the date of manufacture. Carefully adhere to the expiration or manufacture date printed
    on the box.
    • Keep primers and adhesive in a cool, dry place. Ideally, they should be stored in a refrigerator.
    • Do not leave primers or adhesive cartridge unattended with their caps open or off.
    • The vehicle should not be driven for at least 24 hours or until the urethane adhesive has completely
    cured. Curing time varies depending on temperature and humidity. The curing time will increase
    under lower temperatures and lower humidity.

    REPAIRING WATER LEAKS FOR BACK DOOR WINDOW GLASS
    • Leaks can be repaired without removing and reinstalling back door window glass.
    • If water is leaking between the urethane adhesive material and body or glass, determine the extent of the
    leak.
    • This can be done by applying water to the back door window glass area while pushing glass outward.
    • To stop the leak, apply primer (if necessary) and urethane adhesive to the leak point.

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-20

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009509416

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2561ZZ

    1.

    Front door panel

    2.

    Vapor barrier

    3.

    Front door glass front run

    4.

    Front door glass rear run

    5.

    Front door glass

    6.

    Front door glass rubber run

    7.

    Front door regulator

    8.

    Front power window motor

    9.

    Front door glass handle grommet

    10. Front door glass handle

    A.

    With power window

    B.

    Without power window

    Removal and Installation

    J

    GW
    INFOID:0000000009509417

    L

    FRONT DOOR GLASS
    Removal

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the vapor barrier. Refer to GW-21, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Use care not to damage or tear vapor barrier during removal.
    Disconnect the harness connector from the door mirror.
    Temporarily reconnect both battery terminals and the main power window and door lock/unlock switch (LH
    door) or power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH door) to raise/lower the front door glass until the
    bolts can be seen through the access holes (with power window).
    Temporarily reinstall the front door glass handle and raise/lower the front door glass until the bolts can be
    seen through the access holes (without power window).

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-21

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    FRONT DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Remove front door glass bolts (A).

    ALKIA3164ZZ

    7.

    While holding the front door glass, raise it at the rear end and
    pull it out of the front door glass front rear toward the outside of
    the door to remove.

    JMKIA8064ZZ

    8.
    9.

    Remove the front door glass front run bolts and remove (if necessary).
    Remove the front door glass rear run bolts and remove (if necessary).

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten bolts to specification. Refer to GW-21, «Exploded View».
    Fitting Inspection
    • Make sure that the glass fits securely into the front door glass run groove.
    • Lower the glass slightly [approximately 10 to 20 mm (0.394 to 0.787 in)], and check that the clearance to the
    sash is parallel. Loosen the regulator bolts, door sash bolts and glass bolts to correct the glass position if the
    clearance between the glass and sash is not parallel.

    FRONT DOOR GLASS REGULATOR
    Removal

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the vapor barrier. Refer to GW-21, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Use care not to damage or tear vapor barrier during removal.
    Disconnect the harness connector from the door mirror.
    Temporarily reconnect both battery terminals and the main power window and door lock/unlock switch (LH
    door) or power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH door) to raise/lower the front door glass until the
    bolts can be seen through the access holes (with power window).
    Temporarily reinstall the front door glass handle and raise/lower the front door glass until the bolts can be
    seen through the access holes (without power window).

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-22

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Remove front door glass bolts (A).
    A

    B

    C
    ALKIA3164ZZ

    7.
    8.
    9.

    Raise the front door glass and hold it in place with a suitable tool or approximately two inches of masking
    tape.
    Remove bolts and front door regulator.
    Remove front power window motor from front door regulator (if necessary). Refer to GW-24, «Removal
    and Installation».

    D

    E

    F

    Inspection After Removal
    Check the front door glass regulator for the following items:
    • Wire wear
    • Regulator deformation
    • Grease condition for each sliding part
    If a malfunction is detected, replace or grease it.
    The arrows in the figure show the application points of a suitable
    multi-purpose grease (if necessary).

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JMKIA4453ZZ

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten front door regulator bolts to specification. Refer to GW-21, «Exploded View».

    GW

    L

    Fitting Inspection
    • Make sure that the glass fits securely into the sash groove.
    • Lower the glass slightly [approximately 10 to 20 mm (0.394 to 0.787 in)], and check that the clearance to the
    sash is parallel. Loosen the regulator bolts, door sash bolts and glass bolts to correct the glass position if the
    clearance between the glass and sash is not parallel.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-23

    2014 Note

    FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009654180

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove front door glass regulator. Refer to GW-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove bolts and front power window motor.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-24

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009509418

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2562ZZ

    1.

    Rear door panel

    2.

    Vapor barrier

    3.

    Rear door glass front run

    4.

    Rear door glass

    5.

    Rear door glass rear run

    6.

    Rear door glass rubber run

    7.

    Rear door corner finisher

    8.

    Rear door glass regulator

    9.

    Rear power window motor

    A.

    With power window

    10. Rear door glass handle grommet
    B.

    Without power window

    11. Rear door glass handle

    J

    GW

    Clip

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009509419

    L

    REAR DOOR GLASS
    M

    Removal

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove vapor barrier. Refer to GW-25, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Use care not to damage or tear vapor barrier during removal.
    Temporarily reconnect the rear power window switch to raise/lower the rear door glass until the bolts can
    be seen through the access holes (with power window).
    Temporarily reinstall the rear door glass handle and raise/lower the rear door glass until the bolts can be
    seen through the access holes (without power window).

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-25

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    5. Remove rear door glass bolts (A) and rear door glass (1).

    ALKIA3166ZZ

    6.
    7.

    Remove rear door glass front run bolts and remove (if necessary).
    Remove rear door glass rear run bolts and remove (if necessary).

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten bolts to specification. Refer to GW-25, «Exploded View».
    Fitting Inspection
    • Make sure that the glass fits securely into the rear door glass run groove.
    • Lower the glass slightly [approximately 10 to 20 mm (0.394 to 0.787 in)], and check that the clearance to the
    sash is parallel. Loosen the regulator bolts, door sash bolts and glass bolts to correct the glass position if the
    clearance between the glass and sash is not parallel.

    REAR DOOR GLASS REGULATOR
    Removal

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove vapor barrier. Refer to GW-25, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Use care not to damage or tear vapor barrier during removal.
    Temporarily reconnect the rear power window switch to raise/lower the rear door glass until the bolts can
    be seen through the access holes (with power window).
    Temporarily reinstall the rear door glass handle and raise/lower the rear door glass until the bolts can be
    seen through the access holes (without power window).
    Remove rear door glass bolts (A).
    1: Rear door glass

    ALKIA3166ZZ

    6.
    7.
    8.

    Raise the rear door glass and hold it in place with a suitable tool or approximately two inches of masking
    tape.
    Remove bolts and rear door glass regulator.
    Remove rear power window motor from rear door glass regulator (if necessary). Refer to GW-28,
    «Removal and Installation».

    Inspection After Removal
    Check the rear door glass regulator for the following items:
    • Wire wear
    • Regulator deformation
    • Grease condition for each sliding part

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-26

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    If a malfunction is detected, replace or grease it.
    The arrows in the figure show the application points of a suitable
    multi-purpose grease (if necessary).

    A

    B

    C

    JMKIA7739ZZ

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten rear door regulator bolts to specification. Refer to GW-25, «Exploded View».

    D

    E

    Fitting Inspection
    • Make sure that the glass fits securely into the sash groove.
    • Lower the glass slightly [approximately 10 to 20 mm (0.394 to 0.787 in)], and check that the clearance to the
    sash is parallel. Loosen the regulator bolts, door sash bolts and glass bolts to correct the glass position if the
    clearance between the glass and sash is not parallel.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    GW

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-27

    2014 Note

    REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009654181

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove rear door glass regulator. Refer to GW-25, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove bolts and rear power window motor.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    GW-28

    2014 Note

    VENTILATION, HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER

    SECTION

    HA

    HEATER & AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3

    OIL …………………………………………………………… 21
    Description ………………………………………………………21
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….21
    Perform Oil Return Operation …………………………….21
    Oil Adjusting Procedure for Components Replacement Except Compressor ………………………………….21
    Oil Adjusting Procedure for Compressor Replacement ……………………………………………………………….22

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover…… 3
    Precautions For Refrigerant System Service ………… 3
    Service Equipment ……………………………………………. 6

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 8
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 8
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 8
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 8
    Sealant and/or Oil …………………………………………… 10

    F

    G

    H

    PERFORMANCE TEST ……………………………… 23
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….23

    HA

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 25
    COMPRESSOR …………………………………………. 25

    J

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………….. 11

    Exploded View …………………………………………………25
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..25
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….25

    K

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………11

    COOLER PIPE AND HOSE ………………………… 27

    Component Parts Location ……………………………….. 11

    Exploded View …………………………………………………27

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 12

    LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE …………………….27
    LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal
    and Installation ………………………………………………..27

    M

    HIGH-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE ……………………28
    HIGH-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal
    and Installation ………………………………………………..28

    N

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ………12
    Workflow ……………………………………………………….. 12

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 14
    REFRIGERATION SYSTEM SYMPTOMS ………14
    Trouble Diagnosis For Unusual Pressure …………… 14
    Symptom Table ………………………………………………. 14

    NOISE ………………………………………………………..16
    Symptom Table ………………………………………………. 16

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ……………………. 17

    HIGH-PRESSURE PIPE ……………………………………..28
    HIGH-PRESSURE PIPE : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………………28

    O

    CONDENSER ……………………………………………. 29
    Exploded View …………………………………………………29

    REFRIGERANT …………………………………………..17

    CONDENSER …………………………………………………….29
    CONDENSER : Removal and Installation ……………29

    Description …………………………………………………….. 17
    Leak Test ………………………………………………………. 17
    Recycle Refrigerant …………………………………………. 19
    Charge Refrigerant ………………………………………….. 19

    LIQUID TANK ……………………………………………………30
    LIQUID TANK : Removal and Installation of Liquid
    Tank ……………………………………………………………….30

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    HA-1

    2014 Note

    P

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR ……………….. 30
    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………. 30

    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY… 31
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 31
    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY ………. 32
    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY :
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 32
    HEATER CORE ………………………………………………… 33
    HEATER CORE : Removal and Installation ……….. 33

    Revision: April 2013

    EVAPORATOR …………………………………………………. 33
    EVAPORATOR : Removal and Installation …………. 33
    EXPANSION VALVE …………………………………………. 33
    EXPANSION VALVE : Removal and Installation … 33

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………. 35
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 35
    Compressor …………………………………………………… 35
    Oil …………………………………………………………………. 35
    Refrigerant …………………………………………………….. 35

    HA-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009452293

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Igni- H
    tion ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the HA
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009014853

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc to prevent damage to
    windshield.

    J

    K

    L

    M
    PIIB3706J

    Precautions For Refrigerant System Service

    INFOID:0000000009667164

    N

    WORKING WITH HFC-134a (R-134a)
    CAUTION:
    • CFC-12 (R-12) refrigerant and HFC-134a (R-134a) refrigerant are not compatible. Compressor malfunction is likely to occur if the refrigerants are mixed, refer to “CONTAMINATED REFRIGERANT”
    below. To determine the purity of HFC-134a (R-134a) in the vehicle and recovery tank, use Refrigerant recovery/recycling recharging equipment and Refrigerant Identifier.
    • Use only specified oil for the HFC-134a (R-134a) A/C system and HFC-134a (R-134a) components.
    Compressor malfunction is likely to occur if oil other than that specified is used.
    • The specified HFC-134a (R-134a) oil rapidly absorbs moisture from the atmosphere. The following
    handling precautions must be observed:
    — Cap (seal) the component immediately to minimize the entry of moisture from the atmosphere when
    removing refrigerant components from a vehicle.

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-3

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    — Do not remove the caps (unseal) until just before connecting the components when installing refrigerant components to a vehicle. Connect all refrigerant loop components as quickly as possible to
    minimize the entry of moisture into system.
    — Use only the specified oil from a sealed container. Reseal containers of oil immediately. Oil becomes
    moisture saturated and should not be used without proper sealing.
    — Do not allow oil to come in contact with styrene foam parts. Damage may result.

    GENERAL REFRIGERANT PRECAUTION
    WARNING:
    • Do not breathe A/C refrigerant and oil vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose and throat.
    Remove HFC-134a (R-134a) from the A/C system, using certified service equipment meeting requirements of SAE J-2210 [HFC-134a (R-134a) recycling equipment] or J-2209 [HFC-134a (R-134a) recovery equipment]. Ventilate work area before resuming service if accidental system discharge occurs.
    Additional health and safety information may be obtained from refrigerant and oil manufacturers.
    • Do not release refrigerant into the air. Use approved recovery/recycling recharging equipment to
    capture the refrigerant each time an air conditioning system is discharged.
    • Always wear eye and hand protection (goggles and gloves) when working with any refrigerant or air
    conditioning system.
    • Do not store or heat refrigerant containers above 52°C (126°F).
    • Do not heat a refrigerant container with an open flame; Place the bottom of the container in a warm
    pail of water if container warming is required.
    • Do not intentionally drop, puncture or incinerate refrigerant containers.
    • Do not refrigerant away from open flames; poisonous gas is produced if refrigerant burns.
    • Refrigerant displaces oxygen; therefore be certain to work in well ventilated areas to prevent suffocation.
    • Do not pressure test or leak test HFC-134a (R-134a) service equipment and/or vehicle air conditioning systems with compressed air during repair. Some mixtures of air and HFC-134a (R-134a) have
    been shown to be combustible at elevated pressures. These mixtures, if ignited, may cause injury or
    property damage. Additional health and safety information may be obtained from refrigerant manufacturers.

    REFRIGERANT CONNECTION
    A new type of refrigerant connection has been introduced to all refrigerant lines except the following locations:
    • Expansion valve to evaporator
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor to liquid tank
    WARNING:
    Check that all refrigerant is discharged into the recycling equipment and the pressure in the system is
    less than atmospheric pressure. Then gradually loosen the discharge side hose fitting and remove it.
    CAUTION:
    Observe the following when replacing or cleaning refrigerant cycle components.
    • Store it in the same way as it is when mounted on the vehicle when the compressor is removed. Failure to do so will cause oil to enter the low-pressure chamber.
    • Always use a torque wrench and a back-up wrench when connecting tubes.
    • Immediately plug all openings to prevent entry of dust and moisture after disconnecting tubes.
    • Connect the pipes at the final stage of the operation when installing an air conditioner in the vehicle.
    Do not remove the seal caps of pipes and other components until just before required for connection.
    • Allow components stored in cool areas to warm to working area temperature before removing seal
    caps. This prevents condensation from forming inside A/C components.
    • Remove moisture thoroughly from the refrigeration system before charging the refrigerant.
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply oil to circle of the O-rings shown in illustration when connecting tube. Be careful not to apply
    oil to threaded portion.
    • O-ring must be closely attached to the groove portion of tube.
    • Be careful not to damage O-ring and tube when replacing the O-ring.
    • Connect tube until a click can be heard. Then tighten the nut or bolt by hand. Check that the O-ring is
    installed to tube correctly.

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-4

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Perform leak test and make sure that there are no leaks from connections after connecting line. Disconnect that line and replace the O-ring when the refrigerant leaking point is found. Then tighten
    connections of seal seat to the specified torque.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    RHA861F

    CONTAMINATED REFRIGERANT

    G
    Take appropriate steps shown below if a refrigerant other than pure HFC-134a (R-134a) is identified in
    a vehicle:
    • Explain to the customer that environmental regulations prohibit the release of contaminated refrigerant into H
    the atmosphere.
    • Explain that recovery of the contaminated refrigerant could damage service equipment and refrigerant supply.
    • Suggest the customer return the vehicle to the location of previous service where the contamination may HA
    have occurred.
    • In case of repairing, recover the refrigerant using only dedicated equipment and containers. Do not
    recover contaminated refrigerant into the existing service equipment. Contact a local refrigerant prod- J
    uct retailer for available service if the facility does not have dedicated recovery equipment. This refrigerant
    must be disposed of in accordance with all federal and local regulations. In addition, replacement of all
    refrigerant system components on the vehicle is recommended.
    • The air conditioner warranty is void if the vehicle is within the warranty period. Please contact Nissan Cus- K
    tomer Affairs for further assistance.

    COMPRESSOR
    CAUTION:
    • Cap or plug all openings to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
    • Store it in the same way as it is when mounted on the car when the compressor is removed.
    • Follow “Maintenance of Oil Level” exactly when replacing or repairing compressor. Refer to HA-21,
    «Description».
    • Keep friction surfaces between clutch and pulley clean. Wipe it off by using a clean waste cloth
    moistened with thinner if the surface is contaminated with oil.
    • Turn the compressor shaft by hand more than five turns in both directions after compressor service
    operation. This distributes oil equally inside the compressor. Let the engine idle and operate the
    compressor for one hour after the compressor is installed.
    • Apply voltage to the new one and check for normal operation after replacing the compressor magnet
    clutch.

    LEAK DETECTION DYE
    CAUTION:
    • The A/C system contains a fluorescent leak detection dye used for locating refrigerant leaks. An
    ultraviolet (UV) lamp is required to illuminate the dye when inspecting for leaks.
    • Always wear fluorescence enhancing UV safety goggles to protect eyes and enhance the visibility of
    the fluorescent dye.
    • The fluorescent dye leak detector is not a replacement for an electrical leak detector (SST: J-41995).
    The fluorescent dye leak detector should be used in conjunction with an electrical leak detector
    (SST: J-41995) to pin-point refrigerant leaks.
    Revision: April 2013

    HA-5

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Read and follow all manufacture’s operating instructions and precautions prior to performing the
    work for the purpose of safety and customer’s satisfaction.
    • A compressor shaft seal should not necessarily be repaired because of dye seepage. The compressor shaft seal should only be repaired after confirming the leak with an electrical leak detector (SST:
    J-41995).
    • Always remove any remaining dye from the leak area after repairs are completed to avoid a misdiagnosis during a future service.
    • Do not allow dye to come into contact with painted body panels or interior components. Clean immediately with the approved dye cleaner if dye is spilled. Fluorescent dye left on a surface for an
    extended period of time cannot be removed.
    • Do not spray the fluorescent dye cleaning agent on hot surfaces (engine exhaust manifold, etc.).
    • Do not use more than one refrigerant dye bottle [1/4 ounce (7.4 cc)] per A/C system.
    • Leak detection dyes for HFC-134a (R-134a) and CFC-12 (R-12) A/C systems are different. Do not use
    HFC-134a (R-134a) leak detection dye in CFC-12 (R-12) A/C system or CFC-12 (R-12) leak detection
    dye in HFC-134a (R-134a) A/C system or A/C system damage may result.
    • The fluorescent properties of the dye remains for three or more years unless a compressor malfunction occurs.
    NOTE:
    Identification
    • Vehicles with factory installed fluorescent dye have a green label.
    • Vehicles without factory installed fluorescent dye have a blue label.

    Service Equipment

    INFOID:0000000009667162

    RECOVERY/RECYCLING RECHARGING EQUIPMENT
    Be certain to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for machine operation and machine maintenance. Do not
    introduce any refrigerant other than that specified into the machine.

    ELECTRONIC LEAK DETECTOR
    Be certain to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for tester operation and tester maintenance.

    VACUUM PUMP
    The oil contained inside the vacuum pump is not compatible with the
    specified oil for HFC-134a (R-134a) A/C systems. The vent side of
    the vacuum pump is exposed to atmospheric pressure. Vacuum
    pump oil may migrate out of the pump into the service hose. This is
    possible when the pump is switched OFF after evacuation (vacuuming) and hose is connected to it.
    To prevent this migration, use a manual valve placed near the hoseto-pump connection, as per the following.
    • Vacuum pumps usually have a manual isolator valve as part of the
    pump. Close this valve to isolate the service hose from the pump.
    • Use a hose equipped with a manual shut-off valve near the pump
    end for pumps without an isolator. Close the valve to isolate the
    hose from the pump.
    • Disconnect the hose from the pump if the hose has an automatic
    shut-off valve. As long as the hose is connected, the valve is open
    and lubricating oil may migrate.
    Some one-way valves open when vacuum is applied and close
    under no vacuum condition. Such valves may restrict the pump’s
    ability to pull a deep vacuum and are not recommended.

    RHA270DA

    MANIFOLD GAUGE SET

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-6

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    Be certain that the gauge face indicates HFC-134a or R-134a. Be
    sure the gauge set has 1/2″-16 ACME threaded connections for service hoses. Confirm the set has been used only with refrigerant
    HFC-134a (R-134a) and specified oils.

    A

    B

    C
    SHA533D

    D

    SERVICE HOSES
    Be certain that the service hoses display the markings described
    (colored hose with black stripe). All hoses must be equipped with
    positive shut-off devices (either manual or automatic) near the end of
    the hoses opposite to the manifold gauge.

    E

    F

    G
    RHA272D

    SERVICE COUPLERS

    H

    Do not attempt to connect HFC-134a (R-134a) service couplers to
    the CFC-12 (R-12) A/C system. The HFC-134a (R-134a) couplers
    do not properly connect to the CFC-12 (R-12) system. However, if an
    improper connection is attempted, discharging and contamination
    may occur.
    Shut-off valve rotation

    A/C service valve

    Clockwise

    Open

    Counterclockwise

    Close

    HA

    J

    K
    RHA273D

    REFRIGERANT WEIGHT SCALE

    L

    Verify that no refrigerant other than HFC-134a (R-134a) and specified oils have been used with the scale. The hose fitting must be 1/
    2″-16 ACME if the scale controls refrigerant flow electronically.

    M

    N

    RHA274D

    O

    CHARGING CYLINDER
    Using a charging cylinder is not recommended. Refrigerant may be vented into air from cylinder’s top valve
    when filling the cylinder with refrigerant. Also, the accuracy of the cylinder is generally less than that of an
    electronic scale or of quality recycle/recharge equipment.

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-7

    2014 Note

    P

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009457703

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-41425-NIS)
    Aluminum tube repair kit

    Repairing leaks in A/C tubes

    ALIIA0390ZZ

    (J-38873-A)
    Drive plate installer

    Installing pulley

    WJIA0367E

    (J-46534)
    Trim tool set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009457704

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-41810-NI)
    Refrigerant identifier equipment (R134a)

    For checking refrigerant purity and
    system contamination

    RJIA0197E

    ( — )
    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-8

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-48710)
    NISSAN ACR2009 RRR Unit

    Refrigerant recovery, recycling and recharging

    A

    B

    C
    WJIA0293E

    (J-41995)
    Electronic refrigerant leak detector

    Power supply:
    • DC 12V (battery terminal)

    D

    E

    F

    AHA281A

    Power supply:
    • DC 12V (battery terminal)

    (J-43926)
    Refrigerant dye leak detection kit
    Kit includes:
    (J-42220)
    UV lamp and UV safety goggles
    (J-41459)
    Refrigerant dye injector
    (J-41447)
    Fluorescent leak detection dye
    (box of 24, 1/4 ounce bottles)
    (J-43872)
    Refrigerant dye cleaner

    G

    H

    HA

    J
    ZHA200H

    (J-39183-C)
    Manifold gauge set (with hoses and
    couplers)

    Identification:
    • The gauge face indicates R-134a.
    Fitting size-Thread size
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    K

    L

    M

    RJIA0196E

    Hose color:
    • Low side hose: Blue with black stripe
    • High side hose: Red with black
    stripe
    • Utility hose: Yellow with black stripe
    or green with black stripe
    Hose fitting to gauge:
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    Service hoses:
    • High side hose
    (J-39500-72B)
    • Low side hose
    (J-39500-72R)
    • Utility hose
    (J-39500-72Y)
    S-NT201

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-9

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    Service couplers
    • High side coupler
    (J-39500-20A)
    • Low side coupler
    (J-39500-24A)

    Hose fitting to service hose:
    • M14 x 1.5 fitting is optional or permanently attached.

    S-NT202

    (J-39699)
    Refrigerant weight scale

    For measuring of refrigerant
    Fitting size-Thread size
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    S-NT200

    (J-39649)
    Vacuum pump
    (Including the isolator valve)

    Capacity:
    • Air displacement: 4 CFM
    • Micron rating: 20 microns
    • Oil capacity: 482 g (17 oz)
    Fitting size-Thread size
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    S-NT203

    Sealant and/or Oil

    INFOID:0000000009457705

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    ( — )
    HFC-134a (R-134a) Refrigerant

    Container color: Light blue
    Container marking: HFC-134a (R134a)
    Fitting size: Thread size
    • large container 1/2”-16 ACME

    S-NT196

    ( — )
    NISSAN A/C System Oil Type DHPR (Type R)

    Type: Poly alkylene glycol (PAG), type
    DH-PR (Type R)
    Application: HFC-134a (R-134a) Vanerotary compressors
    Capacity: 110 — 130 m (3.7 — 4.4 US fl
    oz, 3.9 — 4.6 Imp fl oz)
    JMIIA1759ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-10

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009014859

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HA

    J

    AWIIA1694ZZ

    Component

    K

    Function

    L

    1.

    Compressor

    Intakes, compresses, discharges and circulates refrigerant.

    2.

    Condenser

    Cools the high-temperature high-pressure refrigerant discharged from the compressor to
    change it into a liquid.

    3.

    Liquid tank

    Filters and stores a reserve of liquid refrigerant.

    4.

    Pressure sensor

    Senses refrigerant pressure for proper A/C cycle operation.

    5.

    Evaporator

    Evaporates refrigerant which removes heat from the air lowering its temperature.

    6.

    Expansion valve

    Transforms high-pressure liquid refrigerant to low-pressure liquid refrigerant.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-11

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Workflow

    INFOID:0000000009477967

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    ALIIA0440GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.INTERVIEW CUSTOMER
    Interview the customer to obtain as much information as possible about the conditions and environment under
    which the malfunction occurred.
    Revision: April 2013

    HA-12

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    A

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.SYMPTOM CHECK
    Verify symptoms.

    B

    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK FOR DTCS

    C

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    D

    E

    4.PERFORM DTC DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE

    Perform the diagnostic procedure for the detected DTC. Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart».

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 7.

    5.OPERATION CHECK
    Perform the operation check. Refer to HAC-29, «Work Procedure».

    H

    >> GO TO 6.

    6.SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    HA

    Check the symptom diagnosis table. Refer to HA-14, «Symptom Table».
    J

    >> GO TO 8.

    7.VERIFY REPAIR.

    K

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    L

    M

    8.PERFORM FINAL OPERATION CHECK

    Perform the operation check. Refer to HAC-29, «Work Procedure».
    Does it operate normally?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-13

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERATION SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    REFRIGERATION SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    Trouble Diagnosis For Unusual Pressure

    INFOID:0000000009014871

    Diagnose using a manifold gauge set whenever refrigerant pressures are unusual. The marker above the
    gauge scale in the following table indicates the standard (usual) pressure range. Refer to HA-23, «Inspection».

    Symptom Table
    Gauge indication

    Both high and low-pressure sides
    are too high.

    INFOID:0000000009014872

    Refrigerant cycle

    Probable cause

    The pressure returns to normal soon after sprinkling water on condenser.

    Overfilled refrigerant.

    Recover refrigerant, evacuate
    system, and recharge with the
    specified amount of refrigerant.
    Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».

    Air flow to condenser is insufficient.

    Insufficient condenser cooling
    performance.
    • Poor cooling fan rotation.
    • Missing and/or improper installation of air guides.
    • Clogged or dirty condenser
    fins.

    • Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    • Clean and/or repair condenser fins.

    Air mixed with refrigerant.

    Recover refrigerant, evacuate
    system, and recharge with the
    specified amount of refrigerant.
    Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».

    • Low-pressure pipe is cooler
    than the outlet of evaporator.
    • Low-pressure pipe is frosted.

    Expansion valve opened too
    much (excessive flow of refrigerant).

    Replace expansion valve. Refer
    to HA-33, «EXPANSION VALVE
    : Removal and Installation».

    High-pressure pipe and upper
    side of condenser become
    hot, however, liquid tank does
    not become so hot.

    Clogged or crushed high-pressure pipe located between
    compressor and condenser.

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    • The readings of both sides
    become equal soon after
    compressor stops.
    • There is no temperature difference between high and
    low-pressure sides.

    Malfunctioning compressor (insufficient compressor pressure
    operation).
    • Damaged or broken of internal components.
    • Malfunctioning gaskets.

    Replace compressor. Refer to
    HA-25, «Removal and Installation».

    When compressor stops,
    high-pressure gauge quickly
    drops by approximately 196
    AC359A

    Corrective action

    kPa (2 kg/cm2, 28 psi), then
    gradually decreases.

    High-pressure side is excessively
    high and low-pressure side is too
    low.

    AC360A

    High-pressure side is too low and
    low-pressure side is too high.

    AC356A

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-14

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERATION SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Gauge indication

    Both high and low-pressure sides
    are too low.

    Refrigerant cycle

    Probable cause

    Corrective action

    • The area around evaporator outlet does not become
    cold.
    • The area around evaporator inlet becomes frosted.

    Clogged expansion valve.
    • Breakage of temperature
    sensor.
    • Clogging by foreign material.

    Eliminate foreign material from
    expansion valve, or replace it.

    • There is a temperature difference between the areas
    around outlet and inlet
    pipes of liquid tank.
    • Liquid tank becomes frosted.

    Malfunction inside liquid tank
    (clogged strainer).

    Replace condenser (includes
    liquid tank). Refer to HA-29,
    «CONDENSER : Removal and
    Installation».

    Clogged or crushed low-pressure pipe.

    Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Malfunctioning thermo amp.

    Check thermo amp. system.
    Refer to HAC-11, «Component
    Parts Location».

    • Low refrigerant charge.
    • Leak or leaks in A/C system.

    • Check for leaks. Refer to HA17, «Leak Test».
    • Recover refrigerant, evacuate system, and recharge
    with the specified amount of
    refrigerant. Refer to HA-19,
    «Recycle Refrigerant».

    • Icing caused by moisture
    mixed with refrigerant.
    • Deteriorated dryer material
    in liquid tank.

    Recover refrigerant then replace condenser (includes liquid tank). Refer to HA-29,
    «CONDENSER : Removal and
    Installation». Evacuate system
    and recharge with the specified
    amount of refrigerant. Refer to
    HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».

    AC353A

    Low-pressure side sometimes becomes negative.

    • Sometimes the area
    around evaporator outlet
    does not become cold.
    • Sometimes the area
    around evaporator inlet is
    frosted.

    B

    C

    D

    Evaporator becomes frosted.

    There is a small temperature
    difference between the high
    and low pressure pipes.

    A

    AC354A

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HA

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-15

    2014 Note

    NOISE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    NOISE
    Symptom Table
    Symptom

    Unusual noise from compressor
    when A/C is ON.

    Unusual noise from cooler piping.

    Unusual noise from expansion
    valve when A/C is ON.

    Unusual noise from belt.

    Revision: April 2013

    INFOID:0000000009014873

    Noise source

    Probable cause

    Corrective action

    Inside of compressor

    Worn, broken, or clogged internal components.

    Check compressor oil. Refer to HA-21, «Description».

    Magnet clutch

    Contact of clutch disc with pulley.

    Check clearance between
    clutch disc and pulley. Refer
    to HA-25, «Inspection».

    Compressor body

    Loose compressor mounting bolts.

    Check torque of mounting
    bolts. Refer to HA-25, «Exploded View».

    Cooler piping (pipe and
    flexible hose)

    Loose or improper installation of clip
    and bracket.

    Check installation of cooler
    piping. Refer to HA-27, «Exploded View».

    Low refrigerant charge.

    • Check for leaks. Refer to
    HA-17, «Leak Test».
    • Recover refrigerant,
    evacuate system, and recharge with the specified
    amount of refrigerant.

    Worn, broken, or clogged internal components.

    Eliminate foreign material
    from expansion valve, or replace it.

    Loose belt

    Check belt tension. Refer to
    EM-17, «Adjustment».

    Damaged or broken components inside compressor.

    Replace compressor. Refer
    to HA-25, «Removal and Installation».

    Expansion valve

    HA-16

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERANT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    REFRIGERANT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009460333

    B

    CONNECTION OF SERVICE TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JSIIA0239ZZ

    1.

    Shut-off valve

    2.

    A/C service valve

    3.

    Recovery/recycling/recharging
    equipment

    4.

    Refrigerant container (HFC-134a)

    5.

    Weight scale

    6.

    Vacuum pump

    7.

    Manifold gauge set

    A.

    Preferred (best) method

    B.

    Alternative method

    C.

    For charging

    Leak Test

    HA

    J
    INFOID:0000000009460334

    K

    CHECK REFRIGERANT LEAKS USING FLUORESCENT LEAK DETECTION DYE

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    RJIA3815J

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Install a fender cover (1).
    Wear UV safety goggles (2) provided with refrigerant dye leak detection kit.
    Connect power cable (4) of UV lamp (6) to positive and negative terminals of the battery (3).

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-17

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERANT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    4. Press UV lamp switch (5) and check A/C system for refrigerant leaks. (Where refrigerant leaks occur, fluorescent leak detection dye appears green in color.)
    WARNING:
    Do not look directly into UV lamp light source.
    NOTE:
    • For continuous operating time of UV lamp, follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions.
    • Illuminate pipe joints from different angles using UV lamp to check for leaks.
    • Use a mirror in areas that are difficult to see to check for leaks.
    • Refrigerant leaks from the evaporator can be detected by soaking a cotton swab or similar material with
    drain hose water and illuminating it using the UV lamp.
    • Dust, dirt, and packing material adhesives used for condenser, evaporator, and other components may
    fluoresce. Be careful not to misidentify leaks.
    5. Repair or replace parts where refrigerant leaks occur and wipe off fluorescent leak detection dye.
    NOTE:
    Completely wipe off fluorescent leak detection dye from gaps between parts, screw threads, and other
    components using a cotton swab or similar material.
    6. Use a UV lamp to check that no fluorescent leak detection dye remains after finishing work.
    WARNING:
    Do not look directly into UV lamp light source.
    NOTE:
    • For continuous operating time of UV lamp, follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions.
    • Dust, dirt, and packing material adhesives used for condenser, evaporator, and other components may
    fluoresce. Be careful not to misidentify leaks.

    CHECK REFRIGERANT LEAKS USING ELECTRONIC LEAK DETECTOR
    WARNING:
    Do not check for refrigerant leaks while the engine is running.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the following items so that inaccurate checks or misidentifications are avoided.
    • Do not allow refrigerant vapor, shop chemical vapors, cigarette smoke or other contaminates around
    the vehicle.
    • Always check refrigerant leaks in a low air flow environment so that refrigerant may not disperse.
    1. Stop the engine.
    2. Connect recovery/recycling/recharging equipment or manifold gauge set to the A/C service valves.
    3.

    4.

    5.
    6.

    Check that A/C refrigerant pressure is 345 kPa (3.52 kg/cm2, 50 psi) or more when temperature is 16°C
    (61°F) or more. When pressure is lower than the specified value, recycle refrigerant completely and
    recharge refrigerant to the specified level.
    NOTE:
    Leaks may not be detected if A/C refrigerant pressure is 345 kPa (3.52 kg/cm2, 50 psi) or less when temperature is less than 16°C (61°F).
    Clean the area where the refrigerant leak check is performed and check for refrigerant leaks along all surfaces of pipe connections and A/C system components using electronic leak detector probe.
    CAUTION:
    • Continue checking once leaks are found. Always continue and complete checking along all pipe
    connections and A/C system components for additional leaks.
    • When leaks are detected, clean leak area using compressed air and re-check.
    • When checking the evaporator for leaks, always clean inside of drain hose so that the probe surface may not be exposed to water or dirt.
    NOTE:
    • Always check for leaks starting from the high-pressure side and continue to the low-pressure side.
    • When checking the evaporator for leaks, operate blower motor for 15 minutes or more at the maximum
    speed while the engine is stopped. Insert electronic leak detector probe into drain hose and hold for 10
    minutes or more.
    • When disconnecting shut-off valve that is connected to A/C service valve, always evacuate remaining
    refrigerant so that misidentification can be avoided.
    Repair or replace parts where refrigerant leaks occur.
    Start the engine and set A/C control in the following conditions.
    • A/C switch: ON

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-18

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERANT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    • Air flow: VENT (ventilation)
    • Intake door position: Recirculation
    • Temperature setting: Full cold
    • Blower speed: Maximum
    7. Run the engine at approximately 1,500 rpm for two minutes or more.
    8. Stop the engine. Check for refrigerant leaks. Go to step 4.
    WARNING:
    Be careful not to get burned when the engine is hot.
    NOTE:
    • Start refrigerant leak check immediately after the engine is
    stopped.
    • When refrigerant circulation is stopped, pressure on the lowpressure side rises gradually and pressure on the high-pressure side falls gradually.
    • The higher the pressure is, the easier it is to find refrigerant
    leaks.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    SHA839E

    Recycle Refrigerant

    INFOID:0000000009460335

    G

    WARNING:
    • Always use HFC-134a for A/C refrigerant. If CFC-12 is accidentally charged, compressor damage H
    may result due to insufficient lubrication.
    • Always observe and follow precautions described on refrigerant container. Incorrect handling may
    result in an explosion of refrigerant container, frostbite or the loss of eyesight.
    HA
    • Do not breathe A/C refrigerant and oil vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose, or throat.
    • Do not allow HFC-134a to be exposed to an open flame. Poisonous gas is produced if refrigerant
    burns. Keep workshop well ventilated.
    1. Perform oil return operation. Refer to HA-21, «Perform Oil Return Operation». (If refrigerant or oil leaks are J
    detected in a large amount, omit this step, and go to step 2.)
    CAUTION:
    Do not perform oil return operation if a large amount of refrigerant or oil has leaked.
    K
    2. Check pressure gauge readings of recovery/recycling/recharging equipment. When remaining pressure
    exists, recycle refrigerant from high-pressure hose and low-pressure hose.
    NOTE:
    L
    Follow manufacturer instructions for the handling or maintenance of the equipment. Do not fill the equipment with non-specified refrigerant.
    3. Remove A/C service valve caps from the vehicle.
    M
    4. Connect recovery/recycling/recharging equipment to A/C service valves.
    5. Operate recovery/recycling/recharging equipment, and recycle refrigerant from the vehicle.
    6. Evacuate air for 10 minutes or more to remove any remaining refrigerant integrated in the compressor oil, N
    etc.
    7. Refrigerant recycle operation is complete.

    Charge Refrigerant

    INFOID:0000000009460336

    WARNING:
    • Always use HFC-134a for A/C refrigerant. If CFC-12 is accidentally charged, compressor damage
    may result due to insufficient lubrication.
    • Always observe and follow precautions described on refrigerant container. Incorrect handling may
    result in an explosion of refrigerant container, frostbite, or the loss of eyesight.
    • Do not breathe A/C refrigerant and oil vapor or mist. Exposure my irritate eyes, nose, or throat.
    • Do not allow HFC-134a to be exposed to an open flame. Poisonous gas is produce if refrigerant
    burns. Keep workshop well ventilated.
    1. Connect recovery/recycling/recharging equipment to the A/C service valves.
    Revision: April 2013

    HA-19

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    REFRIGERANT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    2. Operate recovery/recycling/recharging equipment, and evacuate air from A/C system for 25 minutes or
    more.
    CAUTION:
    Evacuate air for 15 minutes or more if parts are replaced.
    3. Check the airtightness of A/C system for 25 minutes or more. If pressure raises more than the specified
    level, charge A/C system with approximately 200g of refrigerant and check that there are no refrigerant
    leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».
    CAUTION:
    Check the airtightness for 15 minutes or more if parts are replaced.
    4. If parts other than the compressor are replaced, fill compressor oil according to parts that are replaced.
    Refer to HA-21, «Oil Adjusting Procedure for Components Replacement Except Compressor».
    5. Charge the specified amount of refrigerant into A/C system.
    6. Check that the A/C system operates normally.
    7. Collect the refrigerant from the high-pressure hose and low-pressure hose of recovery/recycling/recharging equipment. Disconnect recovery/recycling/recharging equipment.
    8. Install A/C service valve caps.
    9. Refrigerant charge is complete.

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-20

    2014 Note

    OIL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    OIL

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009014865

    MAINTENANCE OF OIL LEVEL

    B

    The compressor oil circulates in the system together with the refrigerant. It is necessary to add oil to the compressor when replacing A/C system components or when a large amount of refrigerant leaks from the system.
    It is important to always maintain oil level within the specified level. Otherwise, the following conditions may
    occur.
    • Insufficient oil amount: Stuck compressor
    • Excessive oil amount: Insufficient cooling (caused by insufficient heat exchange)

    C

    Name

    D

    A/C System Oil Type: DH-PR

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009014866

    E

    If a compressor is malfunctioning (internal noise, insufficient cooling), check the compressor oil.

    1.COMPRESSOR OIL JUDGMENT
    1.
    2.

    F

    Remove the compressor. Refer to HA-25, «Removal and Installation».
    Sample the compressor oil and judge on the figure.
    G

    H

    HA
    JSIIA0927GB

    J

    Judgement result 1>>Replace compressor only.
    Judgement result 2>>Replace compressor and condenser (includes liquid tank).

    Perform Oil Return Operation

    INFOID:0000000009014867

    CAUTION:
    If a large amount of refrigerant or oil leaks from the system, do not perform oil return operation.
    1. Start the engine and set the front air control to the following conditions.
    • Engine speed: Idling to 1,200 rpm
    • A/C switch: ON
    • Blower speed: Maximum
    • Intake door position: Recirculation
    • Temperature setting: Full cold
    2. Perform oil return operation for approximately 10 minutes.
    3. Stop the engine.
    4. Oil return operation is complete.

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    Oil Adjusting Procedure for Components Replacement Except Compressor
    INFOID:0000000009014868

    P

    Add the amount of oil that is calculated according to the following conditions.
    Example: Oil amount to be added when replacing evaporator [m (Imp fl oz.)] = 35 (1.2) + α
    Oil amount to be added to A/C system
    m (Imp fl oz.)

    Conditions
    Replace evaporator

    35 (1.2)

    Replace condenser (includes liquid tank)

    20 (0.7)

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-21

    2014 Note

    OIL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Oil amount to be added to A/C system
    m (Imp fl oz.)

    Conditions
    Refrigerant leak is detected

    Large amount leakage

    30 (1.1)

    Small amount leakage

    Oil amount that is recycled together with refrigerant during recycle operation

    α

    Oil Adjusting Procedure for Compressor Replacement
    1.

    INFOID:0000000009014869

    Drain oil from removed compressor and measure amount drained.
    • Drain oil from high-pressure port (A) and low-pressure port (B)
    while rotating magnet clutch.
    • Measure total amount of oil that is drained from removed compressor.

    JMIIA0940ZZ

    2.

    Drain oil from a new compressor that is calculated according to
    the following conditions.
    Amount to be drained (A) [m (Imp fl oz.)] = F − (D
    + S + R + α)
    F: Oil amount that a new compressor contains
    [120 (4.2)]
    D: Oil amount that is drained from removed compressor
    S: Oil amount that remains inside of removed
    compressor [20 (0.7)]
    R: Oil amount to be added according to components that are removed except compressor
    α: Oil amount that is recycled together with refrigerant during recycle operation
    CAUTION:
    If oil amount that is drained from removed compressor is less than 60 m
    calculation by setting “D” as 40 m (1.4 Imp fl oz.).
    Conditions

    (2.1 Imp fl oz.), perform

    Oil amount to be added to A/C system
    m (Imp fl oz.)

    Replace evaporator

    35 (1.2)

    Replace condenser (includes liquid tank)

    20 (0.7)

    3.

    JPIIA1455GB

    Example: Oil amount to be drained from a new compressor when replacing compressor [m
    [D = 60 (2.1), α = 5 (0.2)]
    120 (4.2) − [60 (2.1) + 20 (0.7) + 5 (0.2)] = 35 (1.1)
    Install compressor and check the operation.

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-22

    (Imp fl oz.)]

    2014 Note

    PERFORMANCE TEST
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERFORMANCE TEST

    A

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009014870

    INSPECTION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    B

    Connect recovery/recycling/recharging equipment (for HFC-134a) or manifold gauge set.
    Start the engine, and set to the following condition.

    C

    Test condition

    Surrounding condition

    Vehicle condition

    A/C condition (front/rear)

    3.
    4.
    5.

    In a well-ventilated place away from direct sunlight.
    Doors

    Closed

    Door glass

    Closed

    Hood

    Open

    Engine speed

    Idle speed

    Temperature control

    Full cold

    A/C switch

    ON

    Air outlet

    VENT (ventilation)

    Intake door position

    Recirculation

    Blower speed

    Maximum

    D

    E

    F

    G

    Maintain test condition until A/C system becomes stable. (Approximately 10 minutes)
    Check that test results of “recirculating-to-discharge air temperature” and “ambient air temperature-toH
    operating pressure” are within the specified value.
    When test results are within the specified value, inspection is complete.
    If any test result is out of the specified value, perform diagnosis by manifold gauge set. Refer to HA-14,
    HA
    «Symptom Table».

    RECIRCULATING-TO-DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE TABLE
    FRONT

    J

    Inside air (Recirculating air) at blower assembly inlet
    Relative humidity
    %

    50 – 60

    60 – 70

    Discharge air temperature from center ventilator
    °C (°F)

    Air temperature
    °C (°F)
    20 (68)

    4.7 — 6.7 (40 — 44)

    25 (77)

    8.6 — 11.1 (47 — 52)

    30 (86)

    12.6 — 15.6 (55 — 60)

    35 (95)

    19.0 — 22.5 (66 — 73)

    20 (68)

    6.7 — 8.7 (44 — 48)

    25 (77)

    11.1 — 13.6 (52 — 56)

    30 (86)

    15.6 — 18.6 (60 — 65)

    35 (95)

    22.5 — 26.0 (73 — 79)

    K

    L

    M

    N

    AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE-TO-OPERATING PRESSURE TABLE

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-23

    2014 Note

    PERFORMANCE TEST
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Fresh air
    Relative humidity
    %

    High-pressure (Discharge side)

    Low-pressure (Suction side)

    kPa (kg/cm2, psi)

    kPa (kg/cm2, psi)

    25 (77)

    900 — 1,112
    (9.2 — 11.3, 130.5 — 161.2)

    159 — 194
    (1.6 — 2.0, 23.1 — 28.1)

    30 (86)

    1,073 — 1,312
    (10.9 — 13.4, 155.6 — 190.2)

    211 — 259
    (2.2 — 3.1, 30.6 — 37.6)

    35 (95)

    1,445 — 1,766
    (14.7 — 18.0, 209.5 — 256.1)

    247 — 300
    (2.5 — 3.1, 35.8 — 43.5)

    40 (104)

    1,650 — 2,017
    (16.8 — 20.6, 239.3 — 292.5)

    290 — 355
    (3.0 — 3.6, 42.1 — 51.5)

    Air temperature
    °C (°F)

    50 – 70

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-24

    2014 Note

    COMPRESSOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    COMPRESSOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014874

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    JMIIA1211GB

    1.

    High-pressure flexible hose

    2.

    O-ring

    3.

    Compressor

    4.

    Low-pressure flexible hose

    A.

    To condenser

    B.

    To evaporator

    Removal and Installation

    H

    HA
    INFOID:0000000009395299

    REMOVAL

    J

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    K

    5.
    6.
    7.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove low-pressure flexible hose and high-pressure flexible hose from compressor.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C hoses and compressor with suitable material such as vinyl tape to
    avoid the entry of air.
    Remove drive belt. Refer to EM-16, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect magnet clutch harness connector.
    Remove bolts and compressor.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to the new O-rings of the low-pressure flexible hose and high-pressure flexible
    hose for installation.
    • Perform oil adjusting procedure before installing new compressor. Refer to HA-22, «Oil Adjusting
    Procedure for Compressor Replacement».
    • Check drive belt tension after installing compressor. Refer to EM-17, «Adjustment».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009395300

    CHECK DISC TO PULLEY CLEARANCE

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-25

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    COMPRESSOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check the clearance (B) between pulley assembly (1) and clutch
    disc (2) along the entire periphery with a feeler gauge (A).
    Clearance

    : Refer to HA-35, «Compressor».

    If specified clearance is not obtained, replace adjusting spacer and
    readjust.

    AWIIA1462ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-26

    2014 Note

    COOLER PIPE AND HOSE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    COOLER PIPE AND HOSE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014875

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HA

    J
    AWIIA1685GB

    1.

    Heating and cooling unit assembly

    2.

    O-ring

    3.

    High-pressure pipe

    4.

    Condenser

    5.

    High-pressure flexible hose

    6.

    Compressor

    7.

    Low-pressure flexible hose

    K

    L

    LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE
    LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395304

    M

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    7.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Disconnect vacuum hose from intake manifold. Refer to BR-32, «Exploded View».
    Remove ground wire from engine to radiator core support upper.
    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove low-pressure flexible hose nut and bolt, then position lower dash insulator as necessary.
    Remove bolt and low-pressure flexible hose from expansion valve.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C hose and expansion valve with suitable material such as vinyl tape
    to avoid the entry of air.
    Remove bolt and low-pressure flexible hose from compressor.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C hose and compressor with suitable material such as vinyl tape to
    avoid the entry of air.

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-27

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    COOLER PIPE AND HOSE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-rings of low-pressure flexible hose for installation.
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    HIGH-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE

    HIGH-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395305

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove bolt and high-pressure flexible hose from condenser.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C hose and condenser with suitable material such as vinyl tape to
    avoid the entry of air.
    Remove bolt and high-pressure flexible hose from compressor.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C hose and compressor with suitable material such as vinyl tape to
    avoid the entry of air.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-rings of the high-pressure flexible hose for installation.
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    HIGH-PRESSURE PIPE

    HIGH-PRESSURE PIPE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395306

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    6.

    7.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Remove radiator core support upper. Refer to DLK-122, «RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Remove low-pressure flexible hose. Refer to HA-27, «LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal and
    Installation».
    Remove high-pressure flexible hose. Refer to HA-28, «HIGH-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal
    and Installation».
    Disconnect high-pressure pipe from expansion valve.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C piping and expansion valve with suitable material such as vinyl
    tape to avoid the entry of air.
    Remove bolt and high-pressure pipe from condenser.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C piping and condenser with suitable material such as vinyl tape to
    avoid the entry of air.
    Release clips and remove high-pressure pipe from vehicle.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-rings of the high-pressure pipe for installation.
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-28

    2014 Note

    CONDENSER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CONDENSER

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014876

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HA
    AWIIA1695ZZ

    1.

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    2.

    Condenser with liquid tank

    3.

    O-ring

    J

    CONDENSER
    CONDENSER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395310

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    6.

    7.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove air guides. Refer to DLK-122, «Exploded View».
    Remove radiator core support upper. Refer to DLK-122, «RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Remove bolt and high-pressure flexible hose from condenser.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C hose and condenser with suitable material such as vinyl tape to
    avoid the entry of air.
    Remove bolt and high-pressure pipe from condenser.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C piping and condenser with suitable material such as vinyl tape to
    avoid the entry of air.
    Disconnect the harness connector from the refrigerant pressure sensor and remove condenser.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage core surface of condenser.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    Revision: April 2013

    HA-29

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    CONDENSER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-rings of the high-pressure flexible hose and high-pressure pipe for
    installation.
    • Perform oil adjusting procedure before installing new condenser. Refer to HA-21, «Oil Adjusting Procedure for Components Replacement Except Compressor».
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    LIQUID TANK

    LIQUID TANK : Removal and Installation of Liquid Tank

    INFOID:0000000009395311

    The liquid tank is only serviced as part of the condenser. Refer to HA-29, «CONDENSER : Removal and Installation».

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395312

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove upper air guide and air guide (LH). Refer to DLK-122, «Exploded View».
    Clean refrigerant pressure sensor and surrounding area.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure to clean carefully.
    Disconnect the harness connector from the refrigerant pressure
    sensor.
    Support liquid tank, then remove refrigerant pressure sensor (1).
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage liquid tank.
    • Be careful not to damage core surface of condenser.
    • Cap or wrap the joint of the condenser and liquid tank
    with suitable material such as vinyl tape to avoid the entry
    of air.
    ALIIA0004ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-ring of the refrigerant pressure sensor for installation.
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-30

    2014 Note

    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014877

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HA

    J

    AWIIA1689ZZ

    1.

    Heating and cooling unit assembly

    4.

    Bracket

    2.

    Steering member

    3.

    K

    Cap

    Pawl

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-31

    2014 Note

    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    AWIIA1696ZZ

    1.

    Intake case

    2.

    Thermo control amp.

    3.

    Evaporator

    4.

    O-ring

    5.

    Expansion valve

    6.

    O-ring

    7.

    Grommet

    8.

    Heater pipe flange

    9.

    Heater core

    10. Front blower motor

    11. Heating and cooling unit assembly

    12. Seal

    13. Seal

    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY
    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395313

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    5.
    6.
    7.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Drain engine coolant. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    Disconnect low-pressure flexible hose from expansion valve. Refer to HA-27, «LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C hose and expansion valve with suitable material such as vinyl tape
    to avoid the entry of air.
    Disconnect high-pressure pipe from expansion valve. Refer to HA-28, «HIGH-PRESSURE PIPE :
    Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the A/C piping and expansion valve with suitable material such as vinyl
    tape to avoid the entry of air.
    Disconnect heater hoses from heater core.
    Remove instrument panel assembly. Refer to IP-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect evaporator drain hose from heating and cooling unit assembly.

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-32

    2014 Note

    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    8. Disconnect harness connectors, grounds, retainers, etc., and remove bolts required to remove steering
    member.
    9. Remove steering member and heating and cooling unit assembly.
    10. Remove heating and cooling unit assembly from steering member. Refer to HA-31, «Exploded View».

    B

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-rings of the low-pressure flexible hose and high-pressure pipe for
    installation.
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».
    NOTE:
    When refilling engine coolant, refer to CO-9, «Refilling».

    HEATER CORE

    D

    INFOID:0000000009395314

    F

    REMOVAL

    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    C

    E

    HEATER CORE : Removal and Installation
    1.

    A

    Remove the heating and cooling unit assembly. Refer to HA-32, «HEATING AND COOLING UNIT
    ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Remove foot duct (LH). Refer to VTL-7, «FOOT DUCT : Removal and Installation».
    Remove heater packing.
    Remove heater pipe flange.
    Remove heater core.

    G

    H

    INSTALLATION
    HA

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    When refilling engine coolant, refer to CO-9, «Refilling».

    EVAPORATOR

    J

    EVAPORATOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395315

    K

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove heating and cooling unit assembly. Refer to HA-32, «HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Remove foot duct (RH). Refer to VTL-7, «FOOT DUCT : Removal and Installation».
    Remove intake case. Refer to HA-31, «Exploded View».
    Remove expansion valve. Refer to HA-33, «EXPANSION VALVE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove evaporator cover and evaporator assembly.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-rings for installation.
    • Perform oil adjusting procedure after installing new evaporator. Refer to HA-21, «Oil Adjusting Procedure for Components Replacement Except Compressor».
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    EXPANSION VALVE

    EXPANSION VALVE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009395316

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-33

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    HEATING AND COOLING UNIT ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Disconnect low-pressure flexible hose from expansion valve. Refer to HA-27, «LOW-PRESSURE FLEXIBLE HOSE : Removal and Installation».
    3. Disconnect high-pressure pipe from expansion valve. Refer to HA-28, «HIGH-PRESSURE PIPE :
    Removal and Installation».
    4. Remove bolts and expansion valve.
    CAUTION:
    Cap or wrap the joint of the evaporator and expansion valve with suitable material such as vinyl
    tape to avoid the entry of air.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-rings of the low-pressure flexible hose and high-pressure pipe for
    installation.
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-34

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Compressor

    INFOID:0000000009014878

    Model

    CALSONIC KANSEI CR08b

    Type

    Vane rotary

    Displacement

    83 cm3 (5.1cu in)/rev

    Maximum

    Direction of rotation

    Clockwise (viewed from clutch)

    Drive belt
    Disc to pulley clearance

    B

    C

    D

    Poly V
    Standard

    0.25 – 0.55 mm (0.010 – 0.022 in)

    Oil

    E

    INFOID:0000000009014879

    F
    Name

    A/C System Oil Type DH-PR (Type R)
    Total in system

    Capacity

    110 — 130 m

    Replacement compressor charging
    amount

    (3.9 — 4.6 Imp fl oz)

    G

    Refer to HA-22, «Oil Adjusting Procedure for
    Compressor Replacement».

    H

    Refrigerant

    INFOID:0000000009014880

    Type

    HA

    HFC-134a (R-134a)

    Capacity

    0.4 kg (0.9 lb)

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HA-35

    2014 Note

    VENTILATION, HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER

    SECTION

    HAC

    HEATER & AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 20

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3

    BCM, ECM, IPDM E/R ………………………………… 20

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………20

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover…… 3
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 3
    Precautions For Refrigerant System Service ………… 4
    Service Equipment ……………………………………………. 6

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 21

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 8

    Workflow …………………………………………………………27

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 8
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 8
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 8
    Sealant and/or Oil …………………………………………… 10

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………….. 11
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………11
    Component Parts Location ……………………………….. 11

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….13
    System Description …………………………………………. 13
    Compressor Control ………………………………………… 13
    Door Control …………………………………………………… 14

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM ……… 21

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 27

    OPERATION INSPECTION ………………………… 29

    HAC

    J

    Work Procedure ……………………………………………….29

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 31

    K

    A/C ON SIGNAL ………………………………………… 31
    Component Function Check ………………………………31
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..31
    Component Inspection ………………………………………32

    L

    BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL ……………………….. 34

    M

    Component Function Check ………………………………34
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..34

    A/C INDICATOR ………………………………………… 36

    Switch Name and Function ………………………………. 17

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR …………………………. 37

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….18

    Description ………………………………………………………37
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..37
    Component Inspection (Front Blower Motor) ………..39
    Component Inspection (Blower Relay) ………………..39
    Component Inspection (Front Blower Motor Resistor) ……………………………………………………………..39
    Component Inspection (Fan Switch) …………………..39

    Revision: April 2013

    H

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …….. 27

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..36

    AIR CONDITIONER …………………………………………… 18
    AIR CONDITIONER : CONSULT Function (BCM AIR CONDITIONER) ……………………………………….. 19

    G

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..21

    OPERATION ……………………………………………….17

    COMMON ITEM ………………………………………………… 18
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) …………………………………………….. 18

    F

    MAGNET CLUTCH ……………………………………. 41
    Description ………………………………………………………41

    HAC-1

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    Component Function Check …………………………….. 41
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 41

    THERMO CONTROL AMPLIFIER ……………….. 48

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………….. 43

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR ………… 49

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM ……… 43

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 48
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 49

    Symptom Table ……………………………………………… 43

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR ………… 50

    INSUFFICIENT COOLING …………………………… 44

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 50
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 50

    Description …………………………………………………….. 44
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 44

    INSUFFICIENT HEATING …………………………… 45
    Description …………………………………………………….. 45
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 45

    COMPRESSOR DOES NOT OPERATE ……….. 46
    Description …………………………………………………….. 46
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 46

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 47
    FRONT AIR CONTROL ………………………………. 47
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 47
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 47

    Revision: April 2013

    DOOR CABLE …………………………………………… 51
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 51
    INTAKE DOOR CABLE …………………………………….. 51
    INTAKE DOOR CABLE : Removal and Installation
    … 51
    INTAKE DOOR CABLE : Adjustment ………………… 51
    MODE DOOR CABLE ……………………………………….. 52
    MODE DOOR CABLE : Removal and Installation… 52
    MODE DOOR CABLE : Adjustment …………………… 52
    AIR MIX DOOR CABLE …………………………………….. 52
    AIR MIX DOOR CABLE : Removal and Installation
    … 52
    AIR MIX DOOR CABLE : Adjustment ………………… 52

    HAC-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009515769

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Igni- H
    tion ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the HAC
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009515770

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc to prevent damage to
    windshield.

    J

    K

    L

    M
    PIIB3706J

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009643769

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-3

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Precautions For Refrigerant System Service

    INFOID:0000000009515771

    GENERAL REFRIGERANT PRECAUTION
    WARNING:
    • Do not breathe A/C refrigerant and oil vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose and throat.
    Use only approved recovery/recycling equipment to discharge HFC-134a (R-134a) refrigerant. Ventilate work area before resuming service if accidental system discharge occurs. Additional health and
    safety information may be obtained from refrigerant and oil manufacturers.
    • Do not release refrigerant into the air. Use approved recovery/recycling recharging equipment to
    capture the refrigerant each time an air conditioning system is discharged.
    • Wear always eye and hand protection (goggles and gloves) when working with any refrigerant or air
    conditioning system.
    • Do not store or heat refrigerant containers above 52°C (126°F).
    • Do not heat a refrigerant container with an open flame. Place the bottom of the container in a pail of
    warm water if container warming is required.
    • Do not intentionally drop, puncture, or incinerate refrigerant containers.
    • Keep refrigerant away from open flames. Poisonous gas is produced if refrigerant burns.
    • Refrigerant displaces oxygen, therefore be certain to work in well ventilated areas to prevent suffocation.
    • Do not pressure test or leakage test HFC-134a (R-134a) service equipment and/or vehicle air conditioning systems with compressed air during repair. Some mixtures of air and HFC-134a (R-134a)
    have been shown to be combustible at elevated pressures. These mixtures, if ignited, may cause
    injury or property damage. Additional health and safety information may be obtained from refrigerant manufacturers.

    WORKING WITH HFC-134a (R-134a)
    CAUTION:
    • CFC-12 (R-12) refrigerant and HFC-134a (R-134a) refrigerant are not compatible. These refrigerants
    must never be mixed, even in the smallest amounts. Compressor malfunction is likely occur if the
    refrigerants are mixed.
    • Use only specified oil for the HFC-134a (R-134a) A/C system and HFC-134a (R-134a) components.
    Compressor malfunction is likely to occur if oil other than that specified is used.
    • The specified HFC-134a (R-134a) oil rapidly absorbs moisture from the atmosphere. The following
    handling precautions must be observed:
    — Cap (seal) immediately the component to minimize the entry of moisture from the atmosphere when
    removing refrigerant components from a vehicle.
    — Do not remove the caps (unseal) until just before connecting the components when installing refrigerant components to a vehicle. Connect all refrigerant loop components as quickly as possible to
    minimize the entry of moisture into system.
    — Use only the specified oil from a sealed container. Reseal immediately containers of oil. Oil becomes
    moisture saturated and should not be used without proper sealing.
    — Do not allow oil (A/C System Oil Type: DH-PR) to come in contact with styrene foam parts. Damage
    may result.

    REFRIGERANT CONNECTION
    A new type refrigerant connection has been introduced to all refrigerant lines except the following location.
    • Expansion valve to evaporator
    • Refrigerant pressure sensor to liquid tank
    WARNING:
    Check that all refrigerant is discharged into the recycling equipment and the pressure in the system is
    less than atmospheric pressure. Then gradually loosen the discharge side hose fitting and remove it.
    CAUTION:
    Observe the following when replacing or cleaning refrigerant cycle components.
    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-4

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    < PRECAUTION >
    • When the compressor is removed, store it in the same way as it is when mounted on the vehicle.
    Failure to do so will cause oil to enter the low-pressure chamber.
    • Use always a torque wrench and a back-up wrench when connecting tubes.
    • Plug immediately all openings to prevent entry of dust and moisture after disconnecting tubes.
    • Connect the pipes at the final stage of the operation when installing an air conditioner in the vehicle.
    Do not remove the seal caps of pipes and other components until just before required for connection.
    • Allow components stored in cool areas to warm to working area temperature before removing seal
    caps. This prevents condensation from forming inside A/C components.
    • Remove thoroughly moisture from the refrigeration system before charging the refrigerant.
    • Replace always used O-rings.
    • Apply oil to the O-rings shown in illustrations when connecting tubes. Be careful not to apply oil to
    threaded portion.
    Name

    : A/C System Oil Type: DH-PR

    • O-ring must be closely attached to the groove portion of tube.
    • Be careful not to damage O-ring and tube when replacing the O-ring.
    • Connect tube until a click can be heard. Then tighten the nut or bolt by hand. Check that the O-ring is
    installed to tube correctly.
    • Perform leak test and make sure there are no leaks from connections after connecting lines. Disconnect that line and replace the O-ring when the refrigerant leak point is found. Then tighten connections of seal seat to the specified torque.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L
    RHA861F

    COMPRESSOR
    CAUTION:
    • Plug all openings to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
    • When the compressor is removed, store it in the same way as it is when mounted on the vehicle.
    • Follow “MAINTENANCE OF OIL LEVEL” exactly when replacing or repairing compressor. Refer to
    HA-21, «Description».
    • Keep friction surfaces between clutch and pulley clean. Wipe them off by using a clean waste cloth
    moistened with solvent if the surfaces are contaminated with oil.
    • Turn the compressor shaft by hand more than five turns in both directions after compressor service
    operation. This equally distributes oil inside the compressor. Let the engine idle and operate the
    compressor for one hour after the compressor is installed.
    • After replacing the compressor magnet clutch, apply voltage to the new clutch to check for normal
    operation.

    LEAK DETECTION DYE
    CAUTION:
    • The A/C system contains a fluorescent leak detection dye used for locating refrigerant leaks. An
    ultraviolet (UV) lamp is required to illuminate the dye when inspecting for leaks.
    • Always wear fluorescence enhancing UV safety goggles to protect eyes and enhance the visibility of
    the fluorescent dye.
    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-5

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    < PRECAUTION >
    • The fluorescent leak detection dye is not a replacement for an electronic leak detector. The fluorescent leak detection dye should be used in conjunction with an electronic leak detector to pin-point
    refrigerant leaks.
    • Read and follow all manufacture’s operating instructions and precautions prior to performing the
    work for the purpose of safety and customer’s satisfaction.
    • A compressor shaft seal should not necessarily be repaired because of dye seepage. The compressor shaft seal should only be repaired after confirming the leak with an electronic leak detector.
    • Always remove any remaining dye from the leak area after repairs are completed to avoid a misdiagnosis during a future service.
    • Do not allow dye to come into contact with painted body panels or interior components. Clean immediately with the approved dye cleaner if dye is spilled. Fluorescent dye left on a surface for an
    extended period of time cannot be removed.
    • Do not spray the fluorescent dye cleaning agent on hot surfaces (engine exhaust manifold, etc.).
    • Do not use more than one refrigerant dye bottle [1/4 ounce (7.4 cc)] per A/C system.
    • Leak detection dyes for HFC-134a (R-134a) and CFC-12 (R-12) A/C systems are different. Do not use
    HFC-134a (R-134a) leak detection dye in CFC-12 (R-12) A/C system, or CFC-12 (R-12) leak detection
    dye in HFC-134a (R-134a) A/C system, or A/C system damage may result.
    • The fluorescent properties of the dye remains for three or more years unless a compressor malfunction occurs.
    NOTE:
    Identification
    • Vehicles with factory installed fluorescent dye have a green label.
    • Vehicles without factory installed fluorescent dye have a blue label.

    Service Equipment

    INFOID:0000000009515772

    RECOVERY/RECYCLING RECHARGING EQUIPMENT
    Be certain to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for machine operation and machine maintenance. Do not
    introduce any refrigerant other than that specified into the machine.

    ELECTRICAL LEAK DETECTOR
    Be certain to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for tester operation and tester maintenance.

    VACUUM PUMP
    The oil contained inside the vacuum pump is not compatible with the
    specified oil for HFC-134a (R-134a) A/C systems. The vent side of
    the vacuum pump is exposed to atmospheric pressure. Vacuum
    pump oil may migrate out of the pump into the service hose. This is
    possible when the pump is switched OFF after evacuation (vacuuming) and hose is connected to it.
    To prevent this migration, use a manual valve placed near the hoseto-pump connection, as per the following.
    • Vacuum pumps usually have a manual isolator valve as part of the
    pump. Close this valve to isolate the service hose from the pump.
    • Use a hose equipped with a manual shut-off valve near the pump
    end for pumps without an isolator. Close the valve to isolate the
    hose from the pump.
    • Disconnect the hose from the pump if the hose has an automatic
    shut-off valve. As long as the hose is connected, the valve is open
    and lubricating oil may migrate.
    Some one-way valves open when vacuum is applied and close
    under no vacuum condition. Such valves may restrict the pump’s
    ability to pull a deep vacuum and are not recommended.

    RHA270DA

    MANIFOLD GAUGE SET

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-6

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    Be certain that the gauge face indicates HFC-134a or R-134a. Be
    sure the gauge set has 1/2″-16 ACME threaded connections for service hoses. Confirm the set has been used only with refrigerant
    HFC-134a (R-134a) and specified oils.

    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    A

    B

    C
    SHA533D

    D

    SERVICE HOSES
    Be certain that the service hoses display the markings described
    (colored hose with black stripe). All hoses must be equipped with
    positive shut-off devices (either manual or automatic) near the end of
    the hoses opposite to the manifold gauge.

    E

    F

    G
    RHA272D

    SERVICE COUPLERS

    H

    Do not attempt to connect HFC-134a (R-134a) service couplers to
    the CFC-12 (R-12) A/C system. The HFC-134a (R-134a) couplers
    do not properly connect to the CFC-12 (R-12) system. However, if an
    improper connection is attempted, discharging and contamination
    may occur.
    Shut-off valve rotation

    A/C service valve

    Clockwise

    Open

    Counterclockwise

    Close

    HAC

    J

    K
    RHA273D

    REFRIGERANT WEIGHT SCALE

    L

    Verify that no refrigerant other than HFC-134a (R-134a) and specified oils have been used with the scale. The hose fitting must be 1/
    2″-16 ACME if the scale controls refrigerant flow electronically.

    M

    N

    RHA274D

    O

    CHARGING CYLINDER
    Using a charging cylinder is not recommended. Refrigerant may be vented into air from cylinder’s top valve
    when filling the cylinder with refrigerant. Also, the accuracy of the cylinder is generally less than that of an
    electronic scale or of quality recycle/recharge equipment.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-7

    2014 Note

    P

    PREPARATION
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009643776

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009667202

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-41810-NI)
    Refrigerant identifier equipment (R134a)

    For checking refrigerant purity and
    system contamination

    RJIA0197E

    ( — )
    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    (J-48710)
    NISSAN ACR2009 RRR Unit

    Refrigerant recovery, recycling and recharging

    WJIA0293E

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-8

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < PREPARATION >
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-41995)
    Electronic refrigerant leak detector

    Power supply:
    • DC 12V (battery terminal)

    A

    B

    C

    D
    AHA281A

    Power supply:
    • DC 12V (battery terminal)

    (J-43926)
    Refrigerant dye leak detection kit
    Kit includes:
    (J-42220)
    UV lamp and UV safety goggles
    (J-41459)
    Refrigerant dye injector
    (J-41447)
    Fluorescent leak detection dye
    (box of 24, 1/4 ounce bottles)
    (J-43872)
    Refrigerant dye cleaner

    E

    F

    G

    H

    ZHA200H

    (J-39183-C)
    Manifold gauge set (with hoses and
    couplers)

    Identification:
    • The gauge face indicates R-134a.
    Fitting size-Thread size
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    HAC

    J

    K
    RJIA0196E

    Hose color:
    • Low side hose: Blue with black stripe
    • High side hose: Red with black
    stripe
    • Utility hose: Yellow with black stripe
    or green with black stripe
    Hose fitting to gauge:
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    Service hoses:
    • High side hose
    (J-39500-72B)
    • Low side hose
    (J-39500-72R)
    • Utility hose
    (J-39500-72Y)
    S-NT201

    Service couplers
    • High side coupler
    (J-39500-20A)
    • Low side coupler
    (J-39500-24A)

    Hose fitting to service hose:
    • M14 x 1.5 fitting is optional or permanently attached.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    S-NT202

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-9

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < PREPARATION >
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39699)
    Refrigerant weight scale

    For measuring of refrigerant
    Fitting size-Thread size
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    S-NT200

    (J-39649)
    Vacuum pump
    (Including the isolator valve)

    Capacity:
    • Air displacement: 4 CFM
    • Micron rating: 20 microns
    • Oil capacity: 482 g (17 oz)
    Fitting size-Thread size
    • 1/2”-16 ACME

    S-NT203

    Sealant and/or Oil

    INFOID:0000000009643779

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    ( — )
    HFC-134a (R-134a) Refrigerant

    Container color: Light blue
    Container marking: HFC-134a (R134a)
    Fitting size: Thread size
    • large container 1/2”-16 ACME

    S-NT196

    ( — )
    NISSAN A/C System Oil Type DHPR

    Type: Poly alkylene glycol oil (PAG),
    type DH-PR
    Application: HFC-134a (R-134a) Vanerotary compressors
    Capacity: 110 — 130 m (3.7 — 4.4 US fl
    oz, 3.9 — 4.6 Imp fl oz)
    JMIIA1759ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-10

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009477926

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    ALIIA0811ZZ

    A.

    RH front of engine compartment

    B.

    J

    Behind LH side of front fascia

    K
    No.

    Component

    Description

    1.

    ECM

    The ECM sends a compressor ON request to the IPDM E/R based on the status of engine
    operation and load as well as refrigerant pressure information. If all the conditions are met for
    A/C operation, the ECM transmits the compressor ON request to the IPDM E/R.

    2.

    IPDM E/R

    A/C relay is integrated in IPDM E/R. IPDM E/R operates A/C relay when receiving A/C compressor request signal from ECM via CAN communication line.

    3.

    A/C compressor

    Vaporized refrigerant is drawn into the A/C compressor from the evaporator, where it is compressed to a high pressure, high temperature vapor. The hot, compressed vapor is then discharged to the condenser.

    4.

    Refrigerant pressure sensor

    Refer to EC-22, «Refrigerant Pressure Sensor».

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-11

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    ALIIA0812ZZ

    A.

    LH side of instrument panel

    No.

    B.

    Behind center of instrument panel

    Component

    C.

    Center of instrument panel

    Description

    1.

    BCM

    The BCM receives the fan ON and A/C ON signals from the front air control and sends a compressor ON request to the ECM.

    2.

    Fuse Block (J/B)

    Located in the passenger compartment, behind the left lower IP, the Fuse Block (J/B) contains the front blower motor relay and several fuses required for the air conditioner control
    system.

    3.

    Front blower motor relay

    The front blower motor relay controls the flow of current to fuse 20, 21 and 22 in the Fuse
    Block (J/B). The relay is connected directly to ground, and is energized when the ignition
    switch is in the ON or START position.

    4.

    Front blower motor

    The front blower motor varies the speed at which the air flows through the ventilation system.

    Front blower motor resistor

    Ground for the blower is supplied through blower resistor and the blower speed switch. As
    the switch is moved from position 1 through 4, more current is allowed to flow through the
    motor, for a higher speed. This is because less resistors are in the path as the switch is
    moved to a higher position. When the switch is on the highest position, all resistors are bypassed.

    6.

    Thermo control amp.

    Thermo control amp. is composed of thermistor and amplifier. When the A/C switch signal is
    received from the front air control, the thermo control amp. transmits the A/C ON signal to the
    BCM according to evaporator fin temperature. When the thermistor detecting temperature of
    the air that passes through evaporator is extremely low, the thermo control amp. sends the
    A/C OFF signal to BCM, and stops the compressor.

    7.

    Front air control

    The front air control controls the operation of the A/C and heating system.

    5.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-12

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009477929

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC
    ALIIA0477GB

    J

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    • The manual air conditioning system is controlled by a sequence of functions from the front air control, BCM,
    ECM, and IPDM E/R.
    • The fan speed of the front blower motor is changed by the combination of the fan control dial (fan switch)
    operation and blower resistor control.
    Module/Function

    Door control

    A/C request signal

    Compressor control

    Cooling fan control

    HAC-14

    HAC-13

    BCM

    BCS-5

    ECM

    HAC-13

    EC-35

    IPDM E/R

    HAC-13

    EC-35

    Front air control

    Compressor Control

    INFOID:0000000009477930

    DESCRIPTION
    • When A/C switch signal is received from front air control, the thermo control amp. transmits A/C ON signal to
    the BCM according to evaporator fin temperature.
    • When the front blower motor is operated, the front air control transmits blower fan ON signal to the BCM.
    • BCM transmits the A/C ON signal and blower fan ON signal to ECM via CAN communication line. Refer to
    LAN-24, «CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description»
    • ECM judges the conditions of each sensor (Refrigerant pressure sensor signal, accelerator position signal,
    etc.), and transmits the A/C compressor request signal to IPDM E/R via CAN communication line.
    • By receiving the A/C compressor request signal from ECM, IPDM E/R turns the A/C relay to ON, and activates the compressor. Refer to PCS-5, «RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description»

    CONTROL BY THERMO CONTROL AMP.
    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-13

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Low Temperature Protection Control
    • When thermo control amp. detects that evaporator fin temperature
    is 1.5°C (35°F) or less, thermo control amp. switches A/C ON signal to OFF and stops the compressor.
    When the evaporator fin temperature returns to 3°C (37°F) or
    more, the compressor is activated.

    JMIIA1228GB

    CONTROL BY ECM
    Refrigerant Pressure Protection
    The refrigerant system is protected against excessively high- or low-pressures by the refrigerant pressure sensor, located on the liquid tank on the condenser. The refrigerant pressure sensor detects the pressure inside
    the refrigerant line and sends a voltage signal to the ECM. If the system pressure rises above or falls below
    the following values, the ECM requests the IPDM E/R to de-energize the A/C relay and disengage the compressor.
    • 3.12 MPa (31.82 kg/cm2, 452.4 psi) or more (When the engine speed is less than 1,500 rpm)
    • 2.74 MPa (27.95 kg/cm2, 397.3 psi) or more (When the engine speed is 1,500 rpm or more)
    • 0.14 MPa (1.43 kg/cm2, 20.3 psi) or less
    Compressor Oil Circulation Control
    When the engine starts while the engine coolant temperature is 56°C (133°F) or less, ECM activates the compressor for approximately 6 seconds and circulates the compressor oil once.
    Air Conditioning Cut Control
    When the engine is under a high load condition, the ECM transmits an A/C relay OFF request to IPDM E/R,
    and stops the compressor. Refer to EC-33, «AIR CONDITIONING CUT CONTROL : System Description».

    Door Control

    INFOID:0000000009477931

    SWITCHES AND THEIR CONTROL FUNCTIONS

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-14

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    ALIIA0807ZZ

    1.

    Intake door

    2.

    Blower motor

    3.

    Evaporator

    4.

    Air mix door

    5.

    Heater core

    6.

    Foot door

    7.

    HAC

    Ventilator and defroster door
    Fresh air intake

    Recirculation air

    Defroster

    Center ventilator

    Side ventilator

    Foot

    J

    K

    B
    MODE dial

    Air mix door

    A–B

    A–B

    N

    A
    Air intake lever

    Temperature control dial

    O

    A

    Full cold

    B

    Full hot

    A
    B

    AIR DISTRIBUTION

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-15

    L

    M

    A

    A–B
    A

    Intake door

    Switch/Dial
    position

    Foot door

    Ventilator and
    defroster door

    Door position

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Discharge air flow
    Air outlet/distribution
    Mode position indication

    Revision: April 2013

    Ventilator

    Foot

    Defroster

    50%

    30%

    30%

    40%

    14%

    66%

    20%

    14%

    51%

    35%

    22%

    78%

    Center

    Side

    50%

    HAC-16

    2014 Note

    OPERATION
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    OPERATION

    A

    Switch Name and Function

    INFOID:0000000009477932

    CONTROLLER

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JMIIA0933ZZ

    1.

    Fan control dial (fan switch)

    2.

    MODE dial

    4.

    Temperature control dial

    5.

    A/C switch

    3.

    H

    Intake lever

    HAC

    SWITCH OPERATION
    Fan control dial (fan
    switch)

    Fan speed can be adjusted within a range from 1st to 4th.

    MODE dial

    Mode position is selected to an optimal position by operating this dial.

    Intake lever

    The air inlet changes REC ⇔ FRE each time by operation this lever.

    Temperature control dial

    The setting temperature can be selected to an optimum temperature by operating this dial.

    A/C switch

    The compressor control (switch indicator) is turned ON ⇔ OFF each time by pressing this switch
    while the blower motor is activated.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-17

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009567625

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    AIR CONDITIONER

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-18

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    AIR CONDITIONER : CONSULT Function (BCM — AIR CONDITIONER)

    INFOID:0000000009567627

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    B

    Description

    FAN ON SIG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of fan switch.

    AIR COND SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of A/C switch.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-19

    2014 Note

    BCM, ECM, IPDM E/R
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    BCM, ECM, IPDM E/R
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009477937

    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»
    EC-62, «Reference Value»

    ECM

    EC-73, «Fail Safe»
    EC-74, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    EC-76, «DTC Index»
    PCS-13, «Reference Value»

    IPDM E/R

    PCS-18, «Fail-safe»
    PCS-20, «DTC Index»

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-20

    2014 Note

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009477938

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AAIWA0144GB

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-21

    2014 Note

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAIIA0267GB

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-22

    2014 Note

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAIIA0268GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-23

    2014 Note

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAIIA0269GB

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-24

    2014 Note

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAIIA0270GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-25

    2014 Note

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAIIA0271GB

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-26

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Workflow

    INFOID:0000000009477940

    B

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    ALIIA0440GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.INTERVIEW CUSTOMER
    Interview the customer to obtain as much information as possible about the conditions and environment under
    which the malfunction occurred.
    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-27

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.SYMPTOM CHECK
    Verify symptoms.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK FOR DTCS
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.PERFORM DTC DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE

    Perform the diagnostic procedure for the detected DTC. Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart».
    >> GO TO 7.

    5.OPERATION CHECK
    Perform the operation check. Refer to HAC-29, «Work Procedure».
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    Check the symptom diagnosis table. Refer to HAC-43, «Symptom Table».
    >> GO TO 8.

    7.VERIFY REPAIR.

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    3. Check DTC.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    8.PERFORM FINAL OPERATION CHECK

    Perform the operation check. Refer to HAC-29, «Work Procedure».
    Does it operate normally?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-28

    2014 Note

    OPERATION INSPECTION
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    OPERATION INSPECTION

    A

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477941

    The purpose of the operation inspection is to check that the individual system operates normally.
    Check condition

    B

    : Engine running at normal operating temperature.

    1.CHECK FRONT BLOWER MOTOR

    C

    1. Operate fan control dial.
    2. Check that fan speed changes. Check operation for all fan speeds.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    D

    E

    2.CHECK DISCHARGE AIR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Operate fan control dial to set the fan speed to maximum speed.
    Operate MODE dial to each position.
    Check that air outlets change according to each indicated air outlet by placing a hand in front of the air
    outlets. Refer to VTL-4, «System Description».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    3.CHECK INTAKE AIR

    G

    H

    1. Operate intake lever to each position.
    2. Listen to intake sound and confirm air inlets change.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    HAC

    J

    4.CHECK COMPRESSOR

    1. Turn fan control dial ON.
    2. Press A/C switch. The A/C switch indicator is turns ON.
    3. Check visually and by sound that the compressor operates.
    4. Press A/C switch again. The A/C switch indicator is turns OFF.
    5. Check that compressor stops.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    K

    L

    M

    5.CHECK DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE

    1. Operate temperature control dial.
    2. Check that discharge air temperature changes.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    N

    O

    6.CHECK TEMPERATURE DECREASE

    1. Operate compressor.
    2. Turn temperature control dial to full cold position.
    3. Check that cool air blows from the air outlets.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    P

    7.CHECK TEMPERATURE INCREASE
    Revision: April 2013

    F

    HAC-29

    2014 Note

    OPERATION INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    1. Turn temperature control dial to full hot position.
    2. Check that warm air blows from air outlets.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    8.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSIS WITH CONSULT

    1. Perform self-diagnosis with CONSULT.
    2. Check that any DTC is detected.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform trouble diagnosis for the detected DTC.
    NO
    >> Refer to HAC-43, «Symptom Table» and perform the appropriate diagnosis.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-30

    2014 Note

    A/C ON SIGNAL
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    A/C ON SIGNAL
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009477942

    B

    1.CHECK A/C ON SIGNAL
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Operate front blower motor.
    3. Select “AIR CONDITIONER” of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    4. Select “AIR COND SW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode, and check status under the following condition.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    AIR COND SW

    A/C switch

    Status

    ON

    On

    OFF

    Off

    F

    G

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477943

    H

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to HAC-21, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSE

    HAC

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check 10A fuse (No. 21, located in fuse block (J/B)].
    NOTE:
    Refer to PG-37, «Terminal Arrangement».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.

    J

    K

    2.CHECK THERMO CONTROL AMP. POWER SUPPLY

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect thermo control amp. connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between thermo control amp. harness connector and ground.

    M

    +
    Thermo control amp.
    Connector

    Terminal

    M42

    3

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    N

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector between thermo control amp. and fuse.

    P

    3.CHECK THERMO CONTROL AMP. GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
    1.
    2.
    3.

    D

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to HAC-31, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    C

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front air control connector.
    Check continuity between thermo control amp. harness connector and front air control harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-31

    2014 Note

    A/C ON SIGNAL
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Thermo control amp.

    Front air control

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M42

    1

    M33

    14

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    4.CHECK A/C ON SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check output waveform between thermo control amp. harness connector and ground with using oscilloscope.
    +

    Thermo control amp.
    Connector

    Terminal

    M42

    2

    Output waveform

    Ground

    JPMIA0012GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    5.CHECK FRONT AIR CONTROL

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check front air control. Refer to HAC-32, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace thermo control amp. Refer to HAC-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    6.CHECK A/C ON SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between thermo control amp. harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Thermo control amp.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M42

    2

    M18

    27

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009477944

    1.CHECK A/C CONTROL
    Check continuity front air control terminals.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-32

    2014 Note

    A/C ON SIGNAL
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Terminal
    14

    Condition
    6

    A/C switch: ON
    Fan control dial: Except OFF position

    A

    Continuity
    Yes

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-33

    2014 Note

    BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009477945

    1.CHECK BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “AIR CONDITIONER” of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Select “FAN ON SIG” in “DATA MONITOR” mode, and check status under the following condition.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    FAN ON SIG

    Fan control dial

    Status

    Except OFF position

    On

    OFF position

    Off

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to HAC-34, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477946

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to HAC-21, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front air control harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check output waveform between front air control and ground with using oscilloscope.
    +

    Front air control
    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    5

    Output waveform

    Ground

    PKIB4960J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity front air control harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Front air control

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    5

    M18

    28

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-34

    2014 Note

    BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    3.CHECK BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR SHORT

    A

    Check continuity between front air control harness connector and ground.
    B
    Front air control
    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    5

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-35

    2014 Note

    A/C INDICATOR
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A/C INDICATOR
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477947

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to HAC-21, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK A/C INDICATOR POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front air control harness connector and ground.
    +
    Front air control
    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    15

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector between front air control and fuse.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-36

    2014 Note

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477948

    The front blower motor utilizes a brush-less motor with a rotating magnet. Quietness is improved over previous
    motors where the brush was the point of contact and the coil rotated.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    B

    INFOID:0000000009477949

    C

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to HAC-21, «Wiring Diagram».
    D

    1.CHECK SYMPTOM
    E

    Check symptom (A or B).
    Symptom

    F

    A

    Front blower motor does not operate at any dial position

    B

    Front blower motor does not operate at any dial position other than 4th,
    or operation speed is not normal.

    G

    Which symptom is detected?
    A
    >> GO TO 2.
    B
    >> GO TO 7.

    H

    2.CHECK FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check 15A fuses (Nos. 20 and 22, located in fuse block (J/B)].
    NOTE:
    Refer to PG-37, «Terminal Arrangement».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.

    HAC

    J

    3.CHECK FRONT BLOWER MOTOR POWER SUPPLY

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Disconnect front blower motor connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front blower motor harness connector and ground.
    +
    Front blower motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    M62

    1

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    M

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    O

    4.CHECK BLOWER RELAY

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check blower relay. Refer to HAC-39, «Component Inspection (Blower Relay)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Repair harness or connector between front blower motor and fuse.
    NO
    >> Replace blower relay.

    P

    5.CHECK FAN SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
    1.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-37

    2014 Note

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Disconnect front air control connector.
    3. Check continuity between front air control harness connector and ground.
    Front air control
    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    6

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    6.CHECK FAN SWITCH 4TH POSITION CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
    Check continuity between front air control harness connector and front blower motor harness connector.
    Front air control

    Front blower motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    1

    M62

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> Repair the harness or connector.

    7.CHECK FRONT BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR POWER SUPPLY

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front blower motor resistor connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front blower motor resistor harness connector and ground.
    +
    Front blower motor resistor
    Connector

    Terminal

    M151

    3

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector between front blower motor resistor and front blower motor.

    8.CHECK FAN SWITCH 1ST, 2ND, AND 3RD POSITION CIRCUIT FOR OPEN

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front air control.
    Check continuity between front air control harness connector and front blower motor resistor.
    Front air control

    Front blower motor resistor

    Connector

    Terminal

    M33

    3

    Connector

    2

    Terminal

    Continuity

    1
    M151

    4

    4

    Yes

    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    9.CHECK FRONT BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR

    Check front blower motor resistor. Refer to HAC-39, «Component Inspection (Front Blower Motor Resistor)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-38

    2014 Note

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Replace front blower motor resistor. Refer to HAC-50, «Removal and Installation».

    10.CHECK FAN SWITCH

    A

    Check fan switch. Refer to HAC-39, «Component Inspection (Fan Switch)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front blower motor. Refer to VTL-8, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    B

    Component Inspection (Front Blower Motor)

    INFOID:0000000009477950

    1.CHECK FRONT BLOWER MOTOR

    D

    1. Connect battery voltage to terminal 1 of front blower motor.
    2. Connect ground to terminal 2 of front blower motor.
    Does the front blower motor operate?
    YES >> Intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace front blower motor. Refer to VTL-8, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection (Blower Relay)

    C

    E

    INFOID:0000000009477951

    F

    1.CHECK BLOWER RELAY
    1.
    2.

    Remove blower relay. Refer to PG-37, «Terminal Arrangement».
    Check continuity between blower relay terminal 3 and 5 when
    the voltage is supplied between terminal 1 and 2.

    G

    H
    Terminal
    3

    5

    Voltage

    Continuity

    ON

    Yes

    OFF

    No

    HAC

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace blower relay.

    J
    JSIIA1551ZZ

    Component Inspection (Front Blower Motor Resistor)

    INFOID:0000000009477952

    1.CHECK FRONT BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect front blower motor resistor connector.
    Check resistance between front blower motor resistor terminals. Refer to applicable table for the normal
    value.

    3

    1

    0.54

    4

    1.56

    2

    3.07

    N

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace front blower motor resistor. Refer to HAC-50, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection (Fan Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009477953

    1.CHECK FAN SWITCH
    1.
    2.

    Remove front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».
    Check continuity between front air control terminals.

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    M

    Resistance: Ω
    (Approx.)

    Terminal

    K

    HAC-39

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Condition
    Terminal

    6

    Fan control dial (fan
    switch) position
    4

    1st

    3

    2nd

    2

    3rd

    1

    4th

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-40

    2014 Note

    MAGNET CLUTCH
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    MAGNET CLUTCH

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477954

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    B

    When the blower speed dial is in one of the fan speed positions, the front air control outputs a fan ON signal to
    the BCM. When the A/C switch is pressed, the A/C switch LED illuminates and the front air control outputs a
    compressor ON signal to the BCM. Any mode control button can be selected. As long as the BCM receives a
    compressor ON signal and a fan ON signal from the front air control, the conditions required for the BCM to
    transmit a compressor ON request to the ECM have been met.

    C

    The BCM sends a compressor ON signal to ECM, via CAN communication line.

    D

    The ECM judges whether the compressor can be turned ON, based on each sensor status (refrigerant pressure sensor signal, throttle angle sensor, etc.). If it judges the compressor can be turned ON, it sends a compressor ON signal to IPDM E/R, via CAN communication line.

    E

    Upon receipt of a compressor ON signal from ECM, IPDM E/R turns the A/C relay ON to operate the compressor.

    F

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009477955

    G

    1.CHECK MAGNET CLUTCH OPERATION
    Perform auto active test of IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-10, «CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to HAC-41, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    H

    HAC

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477956

    J

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to HAC-21, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSE

    K

    Check 10A fuse (No. 42, located in IPDM E/R).
    NOTE:
    Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.

    L

    M

    2.CHECK MAGNET CLUTCH

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect compressor connector.
    3. Directly apply battery voltage to the magnet clutch. Check for operation visually and by sound.
    Does it operate normally?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace magnet clutch. Refer to HA-25, «Removal and Installation».

    N

    O

    3.CHECK MAGNET CLUTCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
    1.
    2.

    P

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and compressor harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    Compressor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    28

    F3

    1

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-41

    Continuity
    Yes

    2014 Note

    MAGNET CLUTCH
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-42

    2014 Note

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009477957

    B

    SYMPTOM TABLE
    Symptom

    C

    Reference Page

    A/C system does not come on.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for A/C System.

    HAC-29

    A/C system cannot be controlled.

    Go to Self-diagnosis Function.

    HAC-27

    Air outlet does not change.

    Go to Adjustment Procedure for Mode Door.

    HAC-52

    Discharge air temperature does not change.

    Go to Adjustment Procedure for Air Mix Door.

    HAC-52

    Intake door does not change.

    Go to Adjustment Procedure for Intake Door.

    HAC-51

    Front blower motor operation is malfunctioning.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Front Blower Motor.

    HAC-37

    Magnet clutch does not engage.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Magnet Clutch.

    HAC-41

    Insufficient cooling.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Insufficient Cooling.

    HAC-44

    Insufficient heating.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Insufficient Heating.

    HAC-45

    Noise.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Noise.

    A/C switch LED does not illuminate.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for A/C System.

    Both high- and low-pressure sides are too
    high.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Abnormal Pressure.

    HA-14

    High-pressure side is too high and low pressure side is too low.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Abnormal Pressure.

    HA-14

    High-pressure side is too low and low-pressure side is too high.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Abnormal Pressure.

    HA-14

    Both high- and low-pressure side sometimes
    become negative.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Abnormal Pressure.

    HA-14

    Low-pressure side sometimes becomes negative.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Abnormal Pressure.

    HA-14

    Low-pressure side becomes negative.

    Go to Trouble Diagnosis Procedure for Abnormal Pressure.

    HA-14

    D

    E

    F

    G

    HA-16
    HAC-36

    H

    HAC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-43

    2014 Note

    INSUFFICIENT COOLING
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    INSUFFICIENT COOLING
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477958

    Symptom

    • Insufficient cooling
    • No cool air comes out. (Air flow volume is normal.)

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477959

    NOTE:
    Perform self-diagnosis with CONSULT before performing symptom diagnosis. If any malfunction result or DTC
    is detected, perform the corresponding diagnosis.

    1.CHECK MAGNET CLUTCH OPERATION

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn fan control dial ON.
    3. Press A/C switch.
    4. Check that A/C indicator turns ON. Check visually and by sound that compressor operates.
    5. Press A/C switch again.
    6. Check that A/C indicator turns OFF. Check that compressor stops.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Check compressor operation. Refer to HAC-46, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK DRIVE BELT

    Check tension of drive belt. Refer to EM-17, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Adjust or replace drive belt depending on the inspection results.

    3.CHECK REFRIGERANT CYCLE PRESSURE

    Connect the recovery/recycling recharging equipment to the vehicle and perform the pressure inspection
    using gauge. Refer to HA-14, «Symptom Table».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace parts depending on the inspection results.

    4.CHECK AIR LEAKAGE FROM EACH DUCT

    Check duct and nozzle, etc. of the air conditioner system for leakage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check air mix door cable installation and air mix door operation.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace parts depending on the inspection results.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-44

    2014 Note

    INSUFFICIENT HEATING
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    INSUFFICIENT HEATING

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477960

    B

    Symptom

    • Insufficient heating
    • No warm air comes out. (Air flow volume is normal.)

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477961

    NOTE:
    Perform self-diagnosis with CONSULT before performing symptom diagnosis. If any malfunction result or DTC
    is detected, perform the corresponding diagnosis.

    1.CHECK COOLING SYSTEM

    1. Check engine coolant level and check for leakage. Refer to CO-8, «Inspection».
    2. Check radiator cap. Refer to CO-8, «Inspection».
    3. Check water flow sounds of the engine coolant. Refer to CO-9, «Refilling».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refill engine coolant and repair or replace the parts depending on the inspection results.

    2.CHECK HEATER HOSE

    Check installation of heater hose by visually or touching.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace parts depending on the inspection results.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK HEATER CORE

    HAC

    1.
    2.

    Check temperature of inlet hose and outlet hose of heater core.
    Check that inlet side of heater core is hot and the outlet side is slightly lower than/almost equal to the inlet
    side.
    CAUTION:
    Always perform the temperature inspection in a short period of time because the engine coolant
    temperature is very hot.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace heater core. Refer to HA-33, «HEATER CORE : Removal and Installation».

    4.CHECK AIR LEAKAGE FROM EACH DUCT

    Check duct and nozzle, etc. of air conditioning system for air leakage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check air mix door cable installation and air mix door operation.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace parts depending on the inspection results.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-45

    2014 Note

    COMPRESSOR DOES NOT OPERATE
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    COMPRESSOR DOES NOT OPERATE
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009477962

    SYMPTOM
    Compressor does not operate.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009477963

    NOTE:
    • Perform self-diagnosis with CONSULT before performing symptom diagnosis. If any malfunction result or
    DTC is detected, perform the corresponding diagnosis.
    • Check that refrigerant system is fully charged. If the refrigerant charge is low, perform the inspection for
    refrigerant leakage

    1.CHECK MAGNET CLUTCH OPERATION

    Check magnet clutch. Refer to HAC-41, «Component Function Check».
    Does it operate normally?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR

    Check refrigerant pressure sensor. Refer to EC-325, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK A/C ON SIGNAL

    Check A/C ON signal. Refer to HAC-31, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    4.CHECK BLOWER FAN ON SIGNAL

    Check blower fan ON signal. Refer to HAC-34, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts

    5.CHECK BCM OUTPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    With CONSULT
    Select “DATA MONITOR” mode of “ECM” using CONSULT.
    Select “AIR COND SIG” and “HEATER FAN SW”, and check status under the following conditions.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    AIR COND SIG

    A/C switch

    HEATER FAN SW

    Blower motor

    Status

    OFF (A/C indicator: OFF)

    Off

    ON (A/C indicator: ON)

    On

    OFF

    Off

    ON

    On

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-46

    2014 Note

    FRONT AIR CONTROL
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    FRONT AIR CONTROL
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009405613

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWIIA1693ZZ

    1.

    Front air control

    2.

    H

    Intake door lever knob

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405614

    HAC

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove front air control finisher. Refer to IP-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove audio unit or AV control unit. Refer to AV-33, «Removal and Installation» (AUDIO UNIT), or AV-93,
    «Removal and Installation» (DISPLAY AUDIO), or AV-178, «Removal and Installation» (NAVIGATION).
    Remove air mix door cable, mode door cable, and intake door cable from the heating and cooling unit
    assembly.
    Remove screws and front air control.

    J

    K

    L

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-47

    2014 Note

    THERMO CONTROL AMPLIFIER
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    THERMO CONTROL AMPLIFIER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009645133

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove evaporator. Refer to HA-33, «EVAPORATOR : Removal and Installation».
    Remove thermo control amplifier from evaporator.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-48

    2014 Note

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
    Removal and Installation

    A
    INFOID:0000000009515775

    CAUTION:
    Perform lubricant return operation before each A/C system disassembly. However, if a large amount of
    refrigerant or lubricant leaks from the system, do not perform lubricant return operation. Refer to HA21, «Perform Oil Return Operation».

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Discharge the refrigerant. Refer to HA-19, «Recycle Refrigerant».
    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove upper air guide and air guide (LH). Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».
    Clean refrigerant pressure sensor and surrounding area.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure to clean carefully.
    Disconnect refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector.
    Support liquid tank, then remove refrigerant pressure sensor (1).
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to damage liquid tank.
    • Be careful not to damage core surface of condenser.
    • Cap or wrap the joint of the condenser and liquid tank
    with suitable material such as vinyl tape to avoid the entry
    of air.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    ALIIA0004ZZ

    HAC

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply compressor oil to new O-ring of the refrigerant pressure sensor for installation.
    • After charging refrigerant, check for leaks. Refer to HA-17, «Leak Test».

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-49

    2014 Note

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009405616

    AWIIA1465ZZ

    1. Heating and cooling unit assembly

    2. Front blower motor

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Front blower motor resistor
    INFOID:0000000009405617

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect harness connector from front blower motor resistor.
    Remove screws and front blower motor resistor.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-50

    2014 Note

    DOOR CABLE
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR CABLE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009405618

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    HAC
    JMIIA1742ZZ

    1.

    Heating and cooling unit assembly

    2.

    Plate

    3.

    Air mix door linkage 2

    4.

    Air mix door linkage 1

    5.

    Air mix door cable

    6.

    Intake door lever

    7.

    Intake door linkage

    8.

    Intake door cable

    9.

    Foot door lever

    10. Mode door cable

    11. Main linkage

    J

    12. Ventilator door rod

    K

    13. Ventilator door lever
    A.

    To front air control

    L

    INTAKE DOOR CABLE
    INTAKE DOOR CABLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405619

    M

    The intake door cable is not serviced separately. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    INTAKE DOOR CABLE : Adjustment
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    INFOID:0000000009405620

    Remove glove box assembly. Refer to IP-25, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect intake door cable (1) from clip (A).
    Set intake door lever to REC position.
    Push intake door link (2) in the direction shown, then carefully
    pull outer cable to front air control side and connect clip.

    O

    P

    JMIIA0617ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-51

    N

    2014 Note

    DOOR CABLE
    [MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    5. Operate intake door lever to make sure that inner cable moves smoothly.
    CAUTION:
    When clipping outer cable, do not move inner cable.

    MODE DOOR CABLE
    MODE DOOR CABLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405621

    The mode door cable is not serviced separately. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    MODE DOOR CABLE : Adjustment
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    INFOID:0000000009405622

    Remove glove box assembly. Refer to IP-25, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect mode door cable (1) from clip (A).
    Set mode dial to VENT position.
    Push main link (2) in the direction shown, then carefully pull
    outer cable to front air control side and connect clip.

    JMIIA0618ZZ

    5.

    Operate mode dial to make sure that inner cable moves smoothly.
    CAUTION:
    When clipping outer cable, do not move inner cable.

    AIR MIX DOOR CABLE
    AIR MIX DOOR CABLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405623

    The air mix door cable is not serviced separately. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».

    AIR MIX DOOR CABLE : Adjustment
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    INFOID:0000000009405624

    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove foot duct (LH). Refer to VTL-7, «FOOT DUCT : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect air mix door cable (1) from clip (A).
    Set temperature dial to full cold position.
    Push air mix door link (2) in the direction shown, then carefully
    pull outer cable to front air control side and connect clip.

    JMIIA0619ZZ

    6.

    Operate temperature dial to make sure that inner cable moves smoothly.
    CAUTION:
    When clipping outer cable, do not move inner cable.

    Revision: April 2013

    HAC-52

    2014 Note

    DRIVER CONTROLS

    SECTION

    HRN

    HORN

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………… 3

    HORN ……………………………………………………….. 3

    F

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………… 3

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 6

    G

    HORN ……………………………………………………….. 6
    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 6
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 6

    H

    I

    J

    K

    HRN

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HRN-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009486656

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    HRN-2

    2014 Note

    HORN
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    HORN
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009015868

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    HRN

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AALWA0621GB

    Revision: April 2013

    HRN-3

    2014 Note

    HORN
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1362GB

    Revision: April 2013

    HRN-4

    2014 Note

    HORN
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    HRN

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1363GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    HRN-5

    2014 Note

    HORN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    HORN
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009499766

    AWLIA2176ZZ

    1. Horn

    A. Connector

    Removal and Installation

    B. Nut
    INFOID:0000000009499767

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove front grille. Refer to EXT-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the horn.
    Remove horn nut and the horn.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    HRN-6

    2014 Note

    DRIVER CONTROLS

    SECTION

    INL

    INTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 3

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 4

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 5
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 5
    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 5

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 7
    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM ………. 7
    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM :
    System Description …………………………………………… 7
    ILLUMINATION CONTROL SYSTEM ……………………. 8
    ILLUMINATION CONTROL SYSTEM : System
    Description ………………………………………………………. 8

    BCM …………………………………………………………. 12

    F

    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………12

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 13
    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    … 13
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..13

    G

    H

    ILLUMINATION …………………………………………. 19
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..19

    I

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 26
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …….. 26

    J

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….26

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 28

    K

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT …. 28
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM …………………………………28
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………………………………….28

    INL

    BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT ……………………………………………. 29

    M

    N

    COMMON ITEM ………………………………………………….. 9
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) ………………………………………………. 9

    Description ………………………………………………………29
    Component Function Check ………………………………29
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..29

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL CIRCUIT
    … 31

    O

    INT LAMP ………………………………………………………….. 9
    INT LAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — INT
    LAMP) …………………………………………………………… 10

    Description ………………………………………………………31
    Component Function Check ………………………………31
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..31

    P

    BATTERY SAVER …………………………………………….. 10
    BATTERY SAVER : CONSULT Function (BCM BATTERY SAVER) …………………………………………. 10

    CARGO LAMP CONTROL CIRCUIT ……………. 33

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….. 9

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 12
    Revision: April 2013

    Description ………………………………………………………33
    Component Function Check ………………………………33
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..33

    INL-1

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT ………………………………………. 34
    Description …………………………………………………….. 34
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 34
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 34

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 39
    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………… 39

    CARGO ROOM LAMP ……………………………….. 40

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………….. 36

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 40
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 40
    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………… 40

    INTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS … 36

    SHIFT SELECTOR LAMP …………………………… 41

    Symptom Table ……………………………………………… 36

    Bulb Replacement …………………………………………… 41

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 37

    ILLUMINATION CONTROL SWITCH …………… 42

    MAP LAMP ……………………………………………….. 37
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 37
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 37
    Bulb Replacement ………………………………………….. 37

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 42

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………. 43

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP …………………………….. 39

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 43

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 39

    Bulb Specifications ………………………………………….. 43

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009541368

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009445821

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component K
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    INL
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    M
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    N
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    O
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.
    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009445822

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-4

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009560561

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N
    ALLIA1296ZZ

    A. View right of steering column

    B. Instrument panel view

    C. B-pillar LH side (view with door open)

    D. C-pillar LH side (view with door open)

    No.

    Part

    Description

    1.

    Cargo lamp

    Refer to INL-43, «Bulb Specifications».

    2.

    Interior room lamp

    Refer to INL-43, «Bulb Specifications».

    3.

    Map lamp

    Refer to INL-43, «Bulb Specifications».

    4.

    Push-button ignition switch

    Refer to STR-4, «STARTING SYSTEM : Component Parts Location».

    Revision: April 2013

    O

    INL-5

    P

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Part

    Description

    5.

    BCM

    • Activates the interior room lamp timer depending on the vehicle condition to turn the
    interior room lamps ON/OFF.
    • Operates the interior room lamp battery saver depending on the vehicle condition to
    cut the interior room lamp power supply.
    • Detects each switch condition by the combination switch reading function.
    • Judges the illumination lamp ON/OFF status depending on the vehicle condition.
    And then it transmits position light request signal to IPDM E/R and combination
    meter (with CAN communication).
    Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location» for detailed
    installation location.

    6.

    Front door switch LH (RH side similar)

    Refer to EXL-6, «Component Parts Location».

    7.

    Rear door switch LH (RH side similar)

    Refer to EXL-6, «Component Parts Location».

    8.

    Back door switch

    Refer to EXL-6, «Component Parts Location».

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-6

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009671253

    B

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    ALLIA1322GB

    K

    OUTLINE
    • Interior room lamp is controlled by the interior room lamp timer control function of the BCM.
    INL
    • Cargo lamp is controlled by the cargo room lamp control function of the BCM.
    The timer control functions of the BCM activate based on inputs from the key cylinder lock/unlock switch LH,
    the door switches, the key switch and door lock/unlock switches.
    M
    ROOM LAMP TIMER OPERATION
    When the interior room lamp switch is in the DOOR position and when all conditions below are met, the BCM
    begins timer control (maximum 30 seconds) for interior room lamp ON/OFF.
    • When the front door LH is unlocked with key fob, main power window and door lock/unlock switch, power
    window and door lock/unlock switch RH or front door lock assembly LH (key cylinder switch).
    • When a door opens → closes and the push-button ignition switch is not pressed (with Intelligent Key).
    • When a door opens → closes and the key is not inserted in the ignition switch (without Intelligent Key).
    Timer control is cancelled under the following conditions.
    • When the front door LH is locked with key fob, main power window and door lock/unlock switch, power window and door lock/unlock switch RH or front door lock assembly LH (key cylinder switch).
    • A door is opened (door switch turns ON).
    • Ignition switch is turned ON.
    Interior lamp operational settings can be changed with the function setting of CONSULT.

    INTERIOR LAMP BATTERY SAVER CONTROL
    If an interior lamp is left ON and does not turn OFF even when the doors are closed, the BCM turns off power
    to the interior lamps automatically to save the battery 15 minutes after the ignition switch is turned OFF.
    Revision: April 2013

    INL-7

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    The BCM controls power and ground to all interior lamps.
    After the battery saver system turns the lamps OFF, the lamps will illuminate again when
    • a signal is received from a key fob, main power window and door lock/unlock switch, power window and
    door lock/unlock switch RH or when the front door lock assembly LH (key cylinder switch) is locked or
    unlocked
    • a door is opened or closed
    • the key is removed from or inserted into the ignition switch (without intelligent key).
    The interior lamp battery saver control time period can be changed with the function setting of CONSULT.

    ILLUMINATION CONTROL SYSTEM

    ILLUMINATION CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009671255

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    AWLIA2182GB

    OUTLINE
    The illumination lamps operation is dependent upon the position of the combination switch (lighting and turn
    signal switch). When the combination switch (lighting and turn signal switch) is placed in the 1ST or 2ND position the BCM (body control module) receives input requesting the parking lamps to illuminate. This input is
    communicated to the IPDM E/R (intelligent power distribution module engine room) via the CAN communication lines. The CPU (central processing unit) of the IPDM E/R controls the tail lamp relay coil. When energized,
    this relay directs power to the parking and illumination lamps, which then illuminate.

    BATTERY SAVER CONTROL
    When the combination switch (lighting and turn signal switch) is in the 1st or 2nd position and the ignition
    switch is turned from ON or ACC to OFF, the battery saver control feature is activated. Under this condition,
    the illumination lamps remain illuminated for 15 minutes unless the combination switch (lighting and turn signal
    switch) position is changed. If the combination switch (lighting and turn signal switch) position is changed, then
    the illumination lamps are turned off after a 30 second delay. When the combination switch (lighting and turn
    signal switch) is turned from OFF to 1st or 2nd position after illumination lamps have been turned off by the
    battery saver control, the illumination lamps illuminate again.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-8

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)

    A

    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009578847

    B

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    C

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    D

    E

    F

    SYSTEM APPLICATION

    G

    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Active Test

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ECU identification

    Sub System

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    Configuration

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N
    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    INL-9

    O

    P

    ×

    INT LAMP

    Revision: April 2013

    H

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    INT LAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — INT LAMP)

    INFOID:0000000009578848

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]
    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Description
    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    PUSH -SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    CDL UNLOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    KEY CYL LK-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    KEY CYL UN-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    INT LAMP

    Description
    This test is able to check interior room lamp operation [On/Off].

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    R LAMP TIMER LOGIC SET

    SET I/L D-UNLCK INTCON

    ROOM LAMP TIMER SET

    Setting

    Description

    MODE 2

    Interior room lamp timer activates with all doors.

    MODE 1*

    Interior room lamp timer activates with the driver door only.

    On*

    Interior room lamp timer function ON.

    Off

    Interior room lamp timer function OFF.

    MODE 4

    30 sec.

    MODE 3*

    15 sec.

    MODE 2

    7.5 sec.

    Sets the interior room lamp ON time. (Timer operating time).

    *: Initial setting

    BATTERY SAVER
    BATTERY SAVER : CONSULT Function (BCM — BATTERY SAVER)

    INFOID:0000000009578849

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-10

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    A

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    CDL UNLOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    KEY CYL LK-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    KEY CYL UN-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test item
    BATTERY SAVER

    Description

    F

    This test is able to check battery saver operation [On/Off].

    WORK SUPPORT
    G
    Support Item
    BATTERY SAVER SET

    ROOM LAMP TIMER SET

    Setting

    Description

    ON*

    Exterior lamp battery saver function ON.

    OFF

    Exterior lamp battery saver function OFF.

    MODE 3*

    10 min.

    MODE 2

    60 min.

    MODE 1

    15 min.

    H

    Sets interior room lamp battery saver timer operating time.

    I

    *: Initial setting

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-11

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    BCM
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009560574

    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-12

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009560575

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AALWA0644GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-13

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1413GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-14

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1414GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-15

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1415GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-16

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1416GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-17

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1417GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-18

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ILLUMINATION

    A

    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009560576

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AALWA0645GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-19

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALWA0646GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-20

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1418GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-21

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1419GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-22

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1420GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-23

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1421GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-24

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1422GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-25

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671214

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    AWLIA1823GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.INTERVIEW FOR MALFUNCTION
    Interview the symptom to the customer.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-26

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.SYMPTOM CHECK

    A

    Check the symptom from the customer’s information.
    B

    >> GO TO 3.

    3.BASIC INSPECTION
    Check the operation of each part. Check that any symptom occurs other than the interviewed symptom.
    >> GO TO 4.

    C

    D

    4.SELF-DIAGNOSIS WITH CONSULT
    Perform the self-diagnosis with CONSULT. Check that any DTC is detected.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    E

    5.TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS BY DTC

    F

    Perform the trouble diagnosis for the detected DTC. Specify the malfunctioning part.
    G

    >> GO TO 9.

    6.FAIL-SAFE ACTIVATION CHECK

    H

    Check that the symptom is applied to the fail-safe activation.
    Does the fail-safe activate?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    I

    7.SYSTEM DIAGNOSIS

    Perform the system diagnosis for the system that the fail-safe activates. Specify the malfunctioning part.
    >> GO TO 9.

    J

    K

    8.SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    Perform the symptom diagnosis. Specify the malfunctioning part.

    INL

    >> GO TO 9.

    9.MALFUNCTION PART REPAIR

    M

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    N

    >> GO TO 10.

    10.REPAIR CHECK (SELF-DIAGNOSIS WITH CONSULT)
    Perform the self-diagnosis with CONSULT. Check that any DTC is not detected. Erase DTC if DTC is detected
    before the repair. Check that DTC is not detected again.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 11.

    11.REPAIR CHECK (OPERATION CHECK)
    Check the operation of each part.
    Does it operate normally?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    INL-27

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009671216

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSES AND FUSIBLE LINK
    Check that the following fuses and fusible link are not blown.
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    57

    Fuses and fusible link No.
    12 (10A)

    Battery power supply

    70

    G (40A)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector M99.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal
    57

    M99

    70

    Ground

    Voltage

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    67

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-28

    2014 Note

    BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009671202

    Provides the battery saver output/power supply. Also cuts the power supply when the interior lamp battery
    saver is activated.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009671203

    C

    1.CHECK BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Turn each interior lamp to the ON position.
    Interior room lamp
    Map lamp
    Cargo lamp
    Select BATTERY SAVER of BCM (BATTERY SAVER) active test item.
    While operating the test item, check that each interior room lamp turns ON/OFF.
    OFF
    ON

    B

    D

    E

    F

    : Interior room lamp OFF
    : Interior room lamp ON

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Battery saver output/power supply circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to INL-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    H

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009671204

    I

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to INL-13, «Wiring Diagram».
    J

    1.CHECK BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY OUTPUT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select BATTERY SAVER of BCM (BATTERY SAVER) active test item.
    While operating the test item, check voltage between BCM connector and ground.

    K

    INL
    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    56

    Test item

    (-)

    BATTERY SAVER

    Ground

    Voltage

    M

    OFF

    0V

    ON

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM after making sure battery saver output/power supply circuit is not shorted to voltage. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    2.CHECK BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the following connectors.
    BCM
    Interior room lamp
    Map lamp
    Cargo lamp
    Check continuity between BCM connector and each interior lamp connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-29

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM
    Connector

    M99

    Each interior lamp
    Terminal

    56

    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Interior room lamp

    R7

    2

    Map lamp

    R2

    4

    Cargo lamp

    B21

    1

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.

    3.CHECK BATTERY SAVER OUTPUT/POWER SUPPLY SHORT CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between BCM connector and ground.
    Connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    M99

    56

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check that each interior room lamp has no internal short circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-30

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009671205

    Controls each interior room lamp (ground side) by PWM signal.
    NOTE:
    PWM signal control period is approximately 250 Hz (in the gradual brightening/dimming).

    Component Function Check

    B

    INFOID:0000000009671206

    CAUTION:
    Before performing the diagnosis, check that the following are normal.
    • Interior room lamp power supply
    • Map lamp bulb
    • Room lamp bulb

    D

    1.CHECK INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    E

    CONSULT
    Switch the map lamp switch or interior room lamp switch to DOOR.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select INT LAMP of BCM (INT LAMP) ACTIVE TEST item.
    While operating the test item, check that each interior room lamp turns ON/OFF.
    On
    Off

    C

    F

    G

    : Interior room lamp gradual brightening
    : Interior room lamp gradual dimming

    H

    Does the interior room lamp turns ON/OFF (gradual brightening/dimming)?
    YES >> Interior room lamp control circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to INL-31, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    I

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009671207

    J

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to INL-13, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL OUTPUT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    K

    CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove all the bulbs of map lamp and interior room lamp.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select INT LAMP of BCM (INT LAMP) ACTIVE TEST item.
    While operating the test item, check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    63

    Test item
    Ground
    INT LAMP

    INL

    M

    Continuity
    On

    Yes

    Off

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    Fixed ON>>GO TO 3.
    Fixed OFF>>Replace BCM after making sure battery saver output/power supply circuit is not shorted to voltage. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    2.CHECK INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector and map lamp connector or interior room lamp connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and map lamp harness connector or interior room
    lamp harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-31

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    With map lamp

    BCM

    Map lamp

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    63

    R2

    2

    BCM

    Interior room lamp

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    63

    R7

    3

    Continuity
    Yes

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check that map lamp or interior room lamp has no internal open circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    3.CHECK INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SHORT CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    63

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM after making sure battery saver output/power supply circuit is not shorted to voltage. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK INTERIOR ROOM LAMP CONTROL SHORT CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect interior room lamp connector or map lamp connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    63

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check that map lamp or interior room lamp has no internal short circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-32

    2014 Note

    CARGO LAMP CONTROL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    CARGO LAMP CONTROL CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009671208

    Controls the cargo lamp (ground side) to turn the cargo lamp ON and OFF.

    B

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009671209

    CAUTION:
    Before performing the diagnosis, check that the following is normal.
    • Battery saver output/power supply
    • Cargo lamp bulb

    C

    D

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009671210

    E

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to INL-13, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK CARGO LAMP OUTPUT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    F

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove the cargo bulb.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    49

    G

    Condition
    Ground
    Back door

    Continuity
    Open

    Yes

    Closed

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    Fixed ON>>GO TO 3.
    Fixed OFF>>Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    K

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and cargo lamp harness connector.
    Cargo lamp

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    49

    B21

    4

    Continuity

    M

    3.CHECK CARGO LAMP SHORT CIRCUIT

    N

    Disconnect BCM harness connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    49

    Ground

    O
    Continuity

    P

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace cargo lamp. Refer to INL-40, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connector.
    1.
    2.

    I

    J

    2.CHECK CARGO ROOM LAMP OPEN CIRCUIT
    BCM

    H

    INL-33

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009671211

    Provides the power supply and the ground to control the push-button ignition switch illumination.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009671212

    1.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    CONSULT
    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Select ENGINE SW ILLUMI of BCM (INTELLGENT KEY) active test item.
    While operating the test item, check that the push-button ignition switch illumination turns ON/OFF
    ON
    OFF

    : Push-button ignition switch illumination ON
    : Push-button ignition switch illumination OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Push-button ignition switch illumination circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to INL-34, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009671213

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to INL-19, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    CONSULT
    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Select ENGINE SW ILLUMI of BCM (INTELLIGENT KEY) active test item.
    While operating the test item, check voltage between push-button ignition switch connector and ground.
    Terminals
    (+)

    (-)

    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    5

    Test item
    Voltage
    (Approx.)
    ENGINE SW ILLUMI

    Ground

    ON

    5V

    OFF

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION POWER SUPPLY OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98 and push-button ignition switch connector.
    Check continuity between BCM connector and push-button ignition switch connector.
    BCM

    Push-button ignition switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    90

    M25

    5

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connectors.
    Revision: April 2013

    INL-34

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION POWER SUPPLY SHORT CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between BCM connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    90

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    D

    4.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ILLUMINATION GROUND CIRCUIT
    Turn the ignition switch OFF
    Disconnect push-button ignition switch connector.
    Check continuity between push-button ignition switch connector and ground.
    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    6

    Ground

    B

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connectors.

    1.
    2.
    3.

    A

    E

    Continuity
    Yes

    F

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace push-button ignition switch. Refer to PCS-74, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repiar or replace harness.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-35

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    INTERIOR LIGHTING SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009560588

    CAUTION:
    Perform the self-diagnosis with CONSULT before the symptom diagnosis. Perform the trouble diagnosis if any DTC is detected.
    Symptom

    Possible cause

    All the following lamps do not turn ON.
    • Map lamp
    • Interior room lamp
    • Cargo lamp

    • Harness between BCM and each
    interior room lamp
    • BCM

    • Interior room lamp does not turn ON even
    though the door is open.
    (It turns ON when turning the interior room
    lamp ON.)
    • Interior room lamp does not turn OFF even
    though the door is closed.

    • Harness between BCM and each
    door switch
    • Harness between BCM and each
    interior room lamp
    • BCM

    Inspection item
    Interior room lamp power supply circuit
    Refer to INL-31, «Component Function Check».
    Door switch circuit
    Refer to INL-31, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Interior room lamp control circuit
    Refer to INL-31, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Check the interior room lamp setting.
    Refer to INL-10, «INT LAMP : CONSULT Function (BCM — INT LAMP)».

    Interior room lamp timer does not activate.
    (It turns ON/ OFF when the door opens/closes.)

    Cargo lamp does not turn ON even though the
    back door is open.

    • Harness between BCM and back
    door switch
    • Harness between BCM and cargo
    lamp
    • BCM

    Cargo lamp circuit
    Refer to INL-31, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Push-button ignition switch illumination does not
    illuminate.

    • Harness between BCM and pushbutton ignition switch
    • BCM

    Push-button ignition switch illumination circuit
    Refer to INL-31, «Component Function Check».

    Interior room lamp battery saver does not activate.

    BCM

    Replace BCM.
    Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-36

    2014 Note

    MAP LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    MAP LAMP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015798

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    AWLIA2175ZZ

    1.

    Map lamp

    2.

    Bulb

    3.

    Lens

    H

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015799

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Release lens pawls using a suitable tool (A) and remove.
    : Pawl

    J

    K

    INL

    AWLIA2150ZZ

    2.
    3.

    Release map lamp pawl using suitable tool (A).
    : Pawl
    Disconnect the harness connector from map lamp and remove.

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AWLIA2144ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009015800

    WARNING:
    Revision: April 2013

    INL-37

    2014 Note

    MAP LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Do not touch bulb while it is lit or right after being turned OFF. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent damage to bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Release lens pawls using suitable tool (A) and remove.
    : Pawl

    AWLIA2150ZZ

    2.

    Remove the bulb.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-38

    2014 Note

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    INTERIOR ROOM LAMP

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015801

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F
    AWLIA2174ZZ

    1.

    Interior room lamp

    2.

    A.

    Pawls to release first for lens removal B.

    Bulb
    Pawl to install first for lens installation

    3.

    G

    Lens
    Pawl

    Metal clip

    H

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015802

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Release interior room lamp metal clips using a suitable tool.
    Disconnect the harness connector from room lamp and remove.

    J

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    K

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009015803

    WARNING:
    INL
    Do not touch bulb while it is lit or right after being turned OFF. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to preM
    vent damage to bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp.
    N

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Release interior room lamp lens pawls using a suitable tool and remove.
    Remove bulb.

    O

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    Insert the lens hook end RH side first when installing lens.

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-39

    P

    2014 Note

    CARGO ROOM LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CARGO ROOM LAMP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009445827

    AWLIA2148ZZ

    1.

    Cargo room lamp
    Front

    2.

    Bulb

    3.

    Lens

    Pawl

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009445828

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.

    Release cargo room lamp pawl with a suitable tool (A)
    : Pawl
    : Front
    Disconnect harness connector from cargo room lamp and
    remove.

    AWLIA2149ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009445829

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb while it is lit or right after being turned OFF. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to prevent damage to bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Release cargo room lamp lens pawl using a suitable tool.
    Remove the bulb.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Revision: April 2013

    INL-40

    2014 Note

    SHIFT SELECTOR LAMP
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    SHIFT SELECTOR LAMP

    A

    Bulb Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009445826

    WARNING:
    Do not touch bulb while it is lit or right after being turned OFF. Burning may result.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the glass surface of the bulb with bare hands or allow oil or grease to get on it to protect damage to bulb.
    • Do not leave bulb out of lamp reflector for a long time because dust, moisture smoke, etc. may affect
    the performance of lamp.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove shift selector lamp bulb from bulb socket (1).
    : Front

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    AWLIA2147ZZ

    H

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-41

    2014 Note

    ILLUMINATION CONTROL SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    ILLUMINATION CONTROL SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009445830

    The illumination control switch is part of the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-42

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Bulb Specifications

    INFOID:0000000009541369

    Item

    Wattage (W)*

    Map lamp (if equipped)

    5

    Interior room lamp

    8

    Cargo room lamp

    5

    Shift selector lamp

    B

    C

    D

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts info.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    INL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INL-43

    2014 Note

    BODY INTERIOR

    SECTION

    INT

    INTERIOR

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3

    KICKING PLATE : Removal and Installation ………..20

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    DASH SIDE FINISHER ……………………………………….22
    DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation
    ….22

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 3

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 4
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 4

    CLIP LIST …………………………………………………… 5
    Descriptions for Clips ………………………………………… 5

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 9
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES ………………………………………………………. 9
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….. 9
    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting ………. 10
    Diagnostic Worksheet ……………………………………… 13

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 15
    FRONT DOOR FINISHER …………………………….15
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 15
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 15

    REAR DOOR FINISHER ………………………………17
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 17
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 17

    BODY SIDE TRIM ……………………………………….19
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 19
    FRONT PILLAR FINISHER ………………………………… 19
    FRONT PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation ……………………………………………………………… 19
    KICKING PLATE ………………………………………………. 20

    Revision: April 2013

    F

    G

    BODY SIDE WELT ……………………………………………..22
    BODY SIDE WELT : Removal and Installation ……..22

    H

    CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER …………………..23
    CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation ………………………………………………..23

    I

    CENTER PILLAR UPPER FINISHER ……………………23
    CENTER PILLAR UPPER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation ………………………………………………..23

    INT

    FLOOR TRIM ……………………………………………. 25
    Exploded View …………………………………………………25
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..25

    HEADLINING ……………………………………………. 28
    Exploded View …………………………………………………28
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..29

    LUGGAGE TRIM ……………………………………….. 31
    Exploded View …………………………………………………31
    LUGGAGE REAR PLATE …………………………………..31
    LUGGAGE REAR PLATE : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………………32
    LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER ……………………32
    LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation ………………………………………………..32
    LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER …………………….33
    LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation ………………………………………………..33

    BACK DOOR TRIM ……………………………………. 34
    Exploded View …………………………………………………34
    BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER ………………………….34

    INT-1

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and
    Installation …………………………………………………….. 34

    Revision: April 2013

    BACK DOOR PULL HANDLE ……………………………. 34
    BACK DOOR PULL HANDLE : Removal and Installation ………………………………………………………… 34

    INT-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009509330

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009509367

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-3

    2014 Note

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009440059

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-39570)
    Chassis Ear

    Locating the noise

    SIIA0993E


    (J-50397)
    NISSAN Squeak and Rattle
    Kit

    Repairing the cause of noise

    ALJIA1232ZZ


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009439746

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39565)
    Engine Ear

    Locating the noise

    SIIA0995E

    ( — )
    Power tools

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-4

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    CLIP LIST

    A

    Descriptions for Clips

    INFOID:0000000009440060

    Replace any clips which are damaged during removal or installation.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SIIA0315E

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-5

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    SIIA0316E

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-6

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    SIIA0317E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-7

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    ALJIA0564GB

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-8

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671237

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    SBT842

    CUSTOMER INTERVIEW

    H
    Interview the customer if possible, to determine the conditions that exist when the noise occurs. Use the Diagnostic Worksheet during the interview to document the facts and conditions when the noise occurs and any
    customer’s comments; refer to INT-13, «Diagnostic Worksheet». This information is necessary to duplicate the
    I
    conditions that exist when the noise occurs.
    • The customer may not be able to provide a detailed description or the location of the noise. Attempt to obtain
    all the facts and conditions that exist when the noise occurs (or does not occur).
    • If there is more than one noise in the vehicle, be sure to diagnose and repair the noise that the customer is INT
    concerned about. This can be accomplished by test driving the vehicle with the customer.
    • After identifying the type of noise, isolate the noise in terms of its characteristics. The noise characteristics
    are provided so the customer, service adviser and technician are all speaking the same language when
    K
    defining the noise.
    • Squeak —(Like tennis shoes on a clean floor)
    Squeak characteristics include the light contact/fast movement/brought on by road conditions/hard surfaces
    L
    = higher pitch noise/softer surfaces = lower pitch noises/edge to surface = chirping.
    • Creak—(Like walking on an old wooden floor)
    Creak characteristics include firm contact/slow movement/twisting with a rotational movement/pitch dependent on materials/often brought on by activity.
    M
    • Rattle—(Like shaking a baby rattle)
    Rattle characteristics include the fast repeated contact/vibration or similar movement/loose parts/missing
    clip or fastener/incorrect clearance.
    N
    • Knock —(Like a knock on a door)
    Knock characteristics include hollow sounding/sometimes repeating/often brought on by driver action.
    • Tick—(Like a clock second hand)
    Tick characteristics include gentle contacting of light materials/loose components/can be caused by driver
    O
    action or road conditions.
    • Thump—(Heavy, muffled knock noise)
    Thump characteristics include softer knock/dead sound often brought on by activity.
    P
    • Buzz—(Like a bumble bee)
    Buzz characteristics include high frequency rattle/firm contact.
    • Often the degree of acceptable noise level will vary depending upon the person. A noise that you may judge
    as acceptable may be very irritating to the customer.
    • Weather conditions, especially humidity and temperature, may have a great effect on noise level.

    DUPLICATE THE NOISE AND TEST DRIVE

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-9

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    If possible, drive the vehicle with the customer until the noise is duplicated. Note any additional information on
    the Diagnostic Worksheet regarding the conditions or location of the noise. This information can be used to
    duplicate the same conditions when you confirm the repair.
    If the noise can be duplicated easily during the test drive, to help identify the source of the noise, try to duplicate the noise with the vehicle stopped by doing one or all of the following:
    1) Close a door.
    2) Tap or push/pull around the area where the noise appears to be coming from.
    3) Rev the engine.
    4) Use a floor jack to recreate vehicle “twist”.
    5) At idle, apply engine load (electrical load, half-clutch on M/T model, drive position on CVT and A/T models).
    6) Raise the vehicle on a hoist and hit a tire with a rubber hammer.
    • Drive the vehicle and attempt to duplicate the conditions the customer states exist when the noise occurs.
    • If it is difficult to duplicate the noise, drive the vehicle slowly on an undulating or rough road to stress the
    vehicle body.

    CHECK RELATED SERVICE BULLETINS
    After verifying the customer concern or symptom, check ASIST for Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) related
    to that concern or symptom.
    If a TSB relates to the symptom, follow the procedure to repair the noise.

    LOCATE THE NOISE AND IDENTIFY THE ROOT CAUSE
    1.
    2.

    Narrow down the noise to a general area. To help pinpoint the source of the noise, use a listening tool
    (Chassis Ear: J-39570, Engine Ear: J-39565 and mechanic’s stethoscope).
    Narrow down the noise to a more specific area and identify the cause of the noise by:
    • removing the components in the area that you suspect the noise is coming from.
    Do not use too much force when removing clips and fasteners, otherwise clips and fasteners can be
    broken or lost during the repair, resulting in the creation of new noise.
    • tapping or pushing/pulling the component that you suspect is causing the noise.
    Do not tap or push/pull the component with excessive force, otherwise the noise will be eliminated only
    temporarily.
    • feeling for a vibration with your hand by touching the component(s) that you suspect is (are) causing the
    noise.
    • placing a piece of paper between components that you suspect are causing the noise.
    • looking for loose components and contact marks.
    Refer to INT-10, «Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting».

    REPAIR THE CAUSE


    If the cause is a loose component, tighten the component securely.
    If the cause is insufficient clearance between components:
    separate components by repositioning or loosening and retightening the component, if possible.
    insulate components with a suitable insulator such as urethane pads, foam blocks, felt cloth tape or urethane
    tape. A NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) is available through your authorized NISSAN Parts Department.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use excessive force as many components are constructed of plastic and may be damaged.
    NOTE:
    • Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    • The materials contained in the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) are listed on the inside cover of the
    kit; and can each be ordered separately as needed.
    • The following materials not found in the kit can also be used to repair squeaks and rattles.
    — SILICONE GREASE: Use instead of UHMW tape that will be visible or does not fit. The silicone grease will
    only last a few months.
    — SILICONE SPRAY: Use when grease cannot be applied.
    — DUCT TAPE: Use to eliminate movement.

    CONFIRM THE REPAIR
    Confirm that the cause of a noise is repaired by test driving the vehicle. Operate the vehicle under the same
    conditions as when the noise originally occurred. Refer to the notes on the Diagnostic Worksheet.

    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting

    INFOID:0000000009671238

    Refer to Table of Contents for specific component removal and installation information.
    Revision: April 2013

    INT-10

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    INSTRUMENT PANEL
    Most incidents are caused by contact and movement between:
    1. Cluster lid A and the instrument panel
    2. Acrylic lens and combination meter housing
    3. Instrument panel to front pillar finisher
    4. Instrument panel to windshield
    5. Instrument panel pins
    6. Wiring harnesses behind the combination meter
    7. A/C defroster duct and duct joint
    These incidents can usually be located by tapping or moving the components to duplicate the noise or by
    pressing on the components while driving to stop the noise. Most of these incidents can be repaired by applying felt cloth tape or silicone spray (in hard to reach areas). Urethane pads can be used to insulate wiring harness.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use silicone spray to isolate a squeak or rattle. If you saturate the area with silicone, you will
    not be able to recheck the repair.

    C

    CENTER CONSOLE

    F

    Components to pay attention to include:
    1. Shift selector assembly cover to finisher
    2. A/C control unit and cluster lid C
    3. Wiring harnesses behind audio and A/C control unit
    The instrument panel repair and isolation procedures also apply to the center console.

    A

    B

    D

    E

    G

    H

    DOORS
    Pay attention to the:
    I
    1. Finisher and inner panel making a slapping noise
    2. Inside handle escutcheon to door finisher
    3. Wiring harnesses tapping
    INT
    4. Door striker out of alignment causing a popping noise on starts and stops
    Tapping or moving the components or pressing on them while driving to duplicate the conditions can isolate
    many of these incidents. You can usually insulate the areas with felt cloth tape or insulator foam blocks from
    K
    the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) to repair the noise.

    TRUNK
    Trunk noises are often caused by a loose jack or loose items put into the trunk by the owner.
    In addition look for:
    1. Trunk lid bumpers out of adjustment
    2. Trunk lid striker out of adjustment
    3. The trunk lid torsion bars knocking together
    4. A loose license plate or bracket
    Most of these incidents can be repaired by adjusting, securing or insulating the item(s) or component(s) causing the noise.

    SUNROOF/HEADLINING
    Noises in the sunroof/headlining area can often be traced to one of the following:
    1. Sunroof lid, rail, linkage or seals making a rattle or light knocking noise
    2. Sun visor shaft shaking in the holder
    3. Front or rear windshield touching headlining and squeaking
    Again, pressing on the components to stop the noise while duplicating the conditions can isolate most of these
    incidents. Repairs usually consist of insulating with felt cloth tape.

    OVERHEAD CONSOLE (FRONT AND REAR)
    Overhead console noises are often caused by the console panel clips not being engaged correctly. Most of
    these incidents are repaired by pushing up on the console at the clip locations until the clips engage.
    In addition look for:
    Revision: April 2013

    INT-11

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Loose harness or harness connectors.
    2. Front console map/reading lamp lens loose.
    3. Loose screws at console attachment points.

    SEATS
    When isolating seat noise it’s important to note the position the seat is in and the load placed on the seat when
    the noise is present. These conditions should be duplicated when verifying and isolating the cause of the
    noise.
    Cause of seat noise include:
    1. Headrest rods and holder
    2. A squeak between the seat pad cushion and frame
    3. The rear seatback lock and bracket
    These noises can be isolated by moving or pressing on the suspected components while duplicating the conditions under which the noise occurs. Most of these incidents can be repaired by repositioning the component
    or applying urethane tape to the contact area.

    UNDERHOOD
    Some interior noise may be caused by components under the hood or on the engine wall. The noise is then
    transmitted into the passenger compartment.
    Causes of transmitted underhood noise include:
    1. Any component installed to the engine wall
    2. Components that pass through the engine wall
    3. Engine wall mounts and connectors
    4. Loose radiator installation pins
    5. Hood bumpers out of adjustment
    6. Hood striker out of adjustment
    These noises can be difficult to isolate since they cannot be reached from the interior of the vehicle. The best
    method is to secure, move or insulate one component at a time and test drive the vehicle. Also, engine rpm or
    load can be changed to isolate the noise. Repairs can usually be made by moving, adjusting, securing, or
    insulating the component causing the noise.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-12

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnostic Worksheet

    INFOID:0000000009440063

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    LAIA0072E

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-13

    P

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    LAIA0071E

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-14

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR FINISHER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    FRONT DOOR FINISHER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009016036

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    AWJIA1139ZZ

    1.

    Front door panel

    2.

    Front door finisher

    3.

    Front door inside seal

    4.

    Power window and door
    lock/unlock switch (RH) finisher

    5.

    Door pull handle escutcheon

    A.

    Grommet

    Clip

    K

    Pawl

    L

    NOTE:
    RH side door shown; LH side door similar.

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016037

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    Remove door pull handle escutcheon using a suitable tool.
    Remove screw (B) from power window and door lock/unlock
    switch (RH) finisher.
    Remove power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH) finisher (1) using a suitable tool (A).
    : Pawl

    O

    P

    AWKIA2505ZZ

    4.

    Disconnect the harness connector from the power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH).

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-15

    M

    2014 Note

    FRONT DOOR FINISHER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    5. Remove front door finisher bolt (A).

    JMJIA6023ZZ

    6.

    Release clips using a suitable tool (A) remove front door finisher
    as shown.
    : Clip

    AWJIA1122ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips and pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing front door finisher, check that clips and pawls are securely placed into door panel
    holes.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-16

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR FINISHER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR DOOR FINISHER

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009016038

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWJIA1099ZZ

    1.

    Rear door panel

    2.

    Rear door finisher

    4.

    Rear door pull handle escutcheon

    5.

    Rear power window switch fin- A.
    isher

    Pawl

    3.

    Rear door corner finisher

    INT

    Grommet

    Clip

    K

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016039

    L

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Release rear door corner finisher clip using a suitable tool.
    Remove rear door pull handle escutcheon using a suitable tool.
    Remove screw (B) from power window and door lock/unlock
    switch (RH) finisher.
    Remove power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH) finisher (1) using a suitable tool (A).
    : Pawl

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AWKIA2505ZZ

    5.

    Disconnect the harness connector from the power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH).

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-17

    2014 Note

    REAR DOOR FINISHER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Remove rear door finisher bolt (A).

    JMJIA6028ZZ

    7.

    Release rear door finisher clips using a suitable tool (A) and
    remove rear door finisher as shown.
    : Clip

    AWJIA1121ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips and pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing rear door finisher, check that clips and pawls are securely placed into door panel
    holes.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-18

    2014 Note

    BODY SIDE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BODY SIDE TRIM

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009016040

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M
    AWJIA1141ZZ

    N
    1.

    Center pillar upper finisher (RH)

    2.

    Front body side welt (RH)

    3.

    Front pillar finisher (RH)

    4.

    Dash side finisher (RH)

    5.

    Front kicking plate (RH)

    6.

    Center pillar lower finisher (RH)

    7.

    Rear kicking plate (RH)

    8.

    Rear body side welt (RH)

    Clip

    Front

    O

    Pawl

    FRONT PILLAR FINISHER

    P

    FRONT PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016041

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove front pillar portion of front body side welt.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-19

    2014 Note

    BODY SIDE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Pull front pillar finisher downward as shown to release the front
    pillar finisher clip (bottom).
    : Clip
    : Pawl

    AWJIA1124ZZ

    3.
    4.

    Cut and discard front pillar finisher tether clips.
    Remove the remaining piece of the tether clip (B) using a suitable tool (A).

    AWJIA1111ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    2.

    Install new front pillar finisher tether clips (A) to the front pillar
    finisher by inserting clip end and rotating 90 degrees to fit.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse tether clips. Replace with new part after
    removal.
    • Make sure to install tether clip to front pillar finisher
    before installing front pillar finisher.
    • When installing tether clip to front pillar finisher, be sure
    to install by aligning to the cutout.
    • Visually check the clip for deformation and damage during installation. Replace with new one if necessary.
    • When installing front pillar finisher, check that clip and
    tether clips are securely placed into body panel holes.
    Install the front pillar finisher to the front pillar.

    AWJIA1088ZZ

    KICKING PLATE
    KICKING PLATE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016043

    FRONT KICKING PLATE
    Removal

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-20

    2014 Note

    BODY SIDE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Release front kicking plate pawls and metal clip using a suitable
    tool (A) and remove front kicking plate as shown.
    : Pawl
    : Metal clip

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWJIA1123ZZ

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips and pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing front kicking plate, check that clips and pawls are securely placed into body panel
    holes.

    REAR KICKING PLATE

    I

    INT

    Removal

    1.
    2.

    H

    Remove rear seat cushion. Refer toSE-32, «Seat Cushion».
    Lift rear end of rear kicking plate to release metal clip, then
    rotate front end of rear kicking plate to release pawls and
    remove.
    : Pawl
    : Metal clip

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AWJIA1091ZZ

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-21

    2014 Note

    BODY SIDE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips and pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing rear kicking plate, check that clips and pawls are securely placed into body panel
    holes.

    DASH SIDE FINISHER

    DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016044

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove front kicking plate. Refer to INT-20, «KICKING PLATE : Removal and Installation».
    Lift up rear end of dash side finisher to release pawls.
    : Pawl

    AWJIA1092ZZ

    3.

    Pull back dash side finisher to release dash side finisher from
    stud and remove.

    AWJIA1093ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing, check that finisher is aligned with stud bolt located on floor panel.
    • When installing dash side finisher, check that pawls are securely placed into body panel holes.

    BODY SIDE WELT

    BODY SIDE WELT : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016045

    FRONT BODY SIDE WELT
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    Remove the dash side finisher. Refer to INT-22, «DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove front body side welt.

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    REAR BODY SIDE WELT
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    Remove rear kicking plate. Refer to INT-20, «KICKING PLATE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove rear body side welt.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-22

    2014 Note

    BODY SIDE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    A

    CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER
    CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016046

    B

    Remove front kicking plate and rear kicking plate. Refer to INT-20, «KICKING PLATE : Removal and
    Installation».
    Remove center pillar lower finisher as shown.

    C

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    D

    E

    F
    JMJIA6045ZZ

    G

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the pawls and clips for deformation and damage during installation. Replace component if necessary.

    CENTER PILLAR UPPER FINISHER

    H

    I

    CENTER PILLAR UPPER FINISHER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016047

    INT

    REMOVAL
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to apply excessive force when removing center pillar upper finisher. Otherwise, clip
    may be damaged and fragments may drop in body panels.
    1. Slide front seat to the full forward position.
    2. Release pawls, using a suitable tool and remove the seat belt
    height adjuster finisher (1).
    : Pawl

    K

    L

    M

    N
    AWHIA0539ZZ

    3.

    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove front D-ring anchor bolt.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing D-ring anchor bolt note the positions of washers and spacers for correct installation.
    Remove front body side welt and rear body side welt. Refer to INT-22, «BODY SIDE WELT : Removal and
    Installation».
    Remove center pillar lower finisher. Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation».
    Release center pillar upper finisher upper clip using a suitable tool as shown.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-23

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    BODY SIDE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    When releasing molded in clip, follow the steps as shown to prevent finisher or clip damage.

    PIIB2600J

    7.

    Release center pillar upper finisher lower clip using a suitable
    tool (A) and remove.
    : Clip
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse center pillar upper finisher.

    AWJIA1094ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse center pillar upper finisher. Replace with new part for installation.
    • When installing center pillar upper finisher, check that clips are securely placed in body panel holes.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-24

    2014 Note

    FLOOR TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FLOOR TRIM

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009541591

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT
    AWJIA1142ZZ

    1.

    Harness clip A

    2.

    Harness clip B

    3.

    Floor trim

    4.

    Carpet hook

    5.

    Front floor spacer (RH)

    6.

    Front floor spacer (LH)

    7.

    Rear floor spacer (LH)

    8.

    Rear floor spacer (RH)

    K

    Front

    L

    Clip

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016049

    M

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn the ignition switch off, disconnect both battery terminals then wait at
    least three minutes.
    • Do not drop the seat belt retractor. Always handle it with care.
    • Always point pretensioner cylinder away from body when handling.

    N

    REMOVAL

    O

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove front seats. Refer to SE-14, «DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation» (Driver side) and SE-16,
    «PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation» (Passenger side).
    Remove rear seatback hinge. Refer to SE-20, «SEATBACK HINGE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove center console lower. Refer to IP-20, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove dash side finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-22, «DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove center pillar lower finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-25

    2014 Note

    P

    FLOOR TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    WARNING:
    Before servicing the SRS, turn the ignition switch off, disconnect both battery terminals then wait
    at least three minutes.
    7. Disconnect the harness connector (A) from the seat belt retractor (1).
    WARNING:
    • Do not drop the seat belt retractor. Always handle it with
    care.
    • Always point pretensioner cylinder away from body when
    handling.

    ALHIA0316ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • For removing/installing the shoulder belt pre-tensioner
    harness connector, insert a thin screwdriver wrapped in
    tape into the notch, then lift the lock and remove the harness connector as shown.
    • Install the harness connector with the lock raised, and
    push the lock into the harness connector as shown.
    • After installing the harness connector, check that the lock
    is pushed in securely.

    PHIA0953J

    8.

    Remove seat belt lower anchor bolt.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the seat belt lower anchor bolt, note the positions of washers and spacers for
    correct installation.
    9. Remove diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    10. Remove shift selector. Refer to (5MT) or TM-227, «Removal and Installation» (CVT)
    11. Remove A/C unit assembly bolt (C) and bracket (1) from vehicle.
    12. Remove instrument panel lower bracket bolt (B) and screw (A)
    and reposition bracket as necessary to remove floor trim.

    ALJIA0712ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-26

    2014 Note

    FLOOR TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    13. Release carpet hook clips with a suitable tool (A) and remove.
    : Clip

    A

    B

    C
    AWJIA0736ZZ

    D

    14. Release pawls using a suitable tool (A) and open the harness
    clips.
    : Pawl

    E

    F

    G
    AWJIA0737ZZ

    15. Remove floor trim.

    H

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Replace harness protector B with a new part after removal. Do not reuse harness protector B.

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-27

    2014 Note

    HEADLINING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    HEADLINING
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009016050

    AWJIA1143ZZ

    1.

    Headlining

    4.

    Microphone (if equipped)

    7.

    Map lamp (if equipped)

    10. Interior room lamp

    2.

    Rear assist grip (RH)

    3.

    Front assist grip (RH)

    5.

    Sun visor holder (RH)

    6.

    Sun visor holder (LH)

    8.

    Sun visor (RH)

    9.

    Sun visor (LH)

    11. Rear assist grip (LH)

    A.

    Headlining clip

    Pawl

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-28

    2014 Note

    HEADLINING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016051

    A

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Remove front pillar finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-19, «FRONT PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove sun visor screws and sun visorS (LH/RH).
    Remove map lamp (if equipped). Refer to INL-37, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove interior room lamp. Refer to INL-39, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove microphone (if equipped). Refer to AV-101, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove center pillar upper finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR UPPER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Remove luggage side upper finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-33, «LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Insert a suitable tool (A) at approximately a 30 degree angle into
    the sun visor holder notch on the front of the sun visor holder (1)
    and press in the locking tab (B) to release it. While holding in
    lock tab (B), rotate the sun visor holder (1) 90 degrees to release
    it from the headlining.
    : Front
    CAUTION:
    Do not force the sun visor holder when removing as the
    locking tab may be damaged if the suitable tool is not positioned correctly.
    NOTE:
    If the sun visor holder (1) does not fully rotate, make sure that
    the suitable tool (A) is pressing in on the locking tab (B) and is
    not positioned under locking tab (B). Reinsert the suitable tool
    (A) as necessary to release the locking tab (B).

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K
    ALJIA0537ZZ

    Release assist grip pawls and remove bolt (A) using a suitable
    tool and remove all assist grips.
    :Pawl
    10. Remove headlining clips.
    11. Remove headlining through the back door.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse headlining.

    L

    9.

    M

    N

    O
    AWJIA1126ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    P

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Remove all remaining adhesive from roof panel.
    • Do not reuse headlining. Replace with new part after removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-29

    2014 Note

    HEADLINING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Apply adhesive as shown before installing headlining.

    AWJIA1102ZZ

    1. Headlining

    A. Adhesive application location

    B. Adhesive

    C. 8 mm

    D. 5 mm

    • Do not bend headlining when installing.
    • When installing headlining, start by installing both sun visor holders and headlining clips to hold
    headlining in position.
    • Be careful that the surface is not wrinkled when installing.

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-30

    2014 Note

    LUGGAGE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    LUGGAGE TRIM

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009016052

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M
    AWJIA1129ZZ

    N
    1.

    Parcel shelf finisher

    4.
    7.

    2.

    3.

    Luggage side upper finisher (LH)

    Luggage side front reinforcement (LH) 5.

    Luggage side rear reinforcement (LH) 6.

    Luggage side lower finisher (LH)

    Luggage rear plate

    Luggage side lower finisher (RH)

    Luggage side rear reinforcement (RH)

    8.

    Luggage floor board (if equipped)

    9.

    10. Luggage side front reinforcement
    (RH)

    11. Luggage side upper finisher (RH)

    12. Luggage side front cover (RH)

    13. Luggage side clip

    14. Luggage side rear cover (RH)

    15. Luggage floor box

    16. Luggage side rear cover (LH)

    17. Luggage side front cover (LH)

    18. Luggage floor trim

    Pawl

    Metal clip

    P

    Clip

    Front

    LUGGAGE REAR PLATE
    Revision: April 2013

    INT-31

    O

    2014 Note

    LUGGAGE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    LUGGAGE REAR PLATE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016053

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove luggage floor board (if equipped).
    Remove luggage floor trim.
    Remove luggage rear plate clips (A).

    AWJIA1127ZZ

    4.

    Release luggage rear plate clips using a suitable tool (A) and
    remove luggage rear plate as shown.
    : Clip

    AWJIA1128ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips and pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing luggage rear plate, check that clips are securely placed into body holes.

    LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER

    LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016054

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Partially remove rear body side welt. Refer to INT-22, «BODY SIDE WELT : Removal and Installation».
    Remove luggage floor board (if equipped).
    Remove luggage floor trim.
    Remove seat back hinge. Refer to SE-20, «SEATBACK HINGE : Removal and Installation».
    Release rear parcel shelf finisher clips using a suitable tool and remove rear parcel shelf finisher (if
    equipped).
    Remove luggage side lower finisher pawls using a suitable tool.

    Revision: April 2013

    I N

    T

    — 3 2

    2014 Note

    LUGGAGE TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    : Pawl

    A

    B

    C
    AWJIA1095ZZ

    7.

    Release the harness connector from cargo room lamp (RH only) and remove luggage side lower finisher.

    INSTALLATION

    D

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips and pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing luggage side clip, press luggage side clip so that upper side stamp mark faces
    toward passenger room, and then completely engage luggage side clip pawls.

    E

    LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER : Removal and Installation

    G

    F

    LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER

    INFOID:0000000009016055

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove luggage side lower finisher. Refer to INT-32, «LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation».
    Remove seat belt lower anchor bolt.
    Release luggage side upper finisher clips using a suitable tool
    and remove luggage side upper finisher.
    : Clip

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L
    AWJIA1097ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    M

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing luggage side upper finisher, check that clips are placed in body holes.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-33

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BACK DOOR TRIM
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009016056

    AWJIA1103ZZ

    1. Back door inner finisher

    2. Back door panel

    Clip

    3. Back door pull handle

    Pawl

    BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER
    BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016057

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Release back door inner finisher clips using a suitable tool and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the clips for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing back door inner finisher, check that locate pin and clips are placed in body panel
    holes.

    BACK DOOR PULL HANDLE

    BACK DOOR PULL HANDLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016058

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Release pawls using a suitable tool and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    INT-34

    2014 Note

    BACK DOOR TRIM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the pawls for deformation and damage during installation.
    • When installing, confirm upper and lower orientation of back door pull handle, then install it.
    • When installing back door pull handle, check that pawls are placed in body panel holes.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    INT

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    INT-35

    2014 Note

    BODY INTERIOR

    SECTION

    IP

    INSTRUMENT PANEL

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..15

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    STEERING COLUMN COVERS ………………….. 17

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..17
    Exploded View …………………………………………………18
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..18

    Special Service Tools ………………………………………. 3
    Commercial Service Tools ………………………………… 3

    CLUSTER LID A ……………………………………….. 21

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 8
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES ………………………………………………………. 8
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….. 8
    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting ………… 9
    Diagnostic Worksheet ……………………………………… 12

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 14
    INSTRUMENT PANEL ASSEMBLY ………………14

    H

    CENTER CONSOLE LOWER ……………………… 20
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..20

    Descriptions for Clips ………………………………………… 4

    G

    CENTER CONSOLE ASSEMBLY ……………….. 18

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3

    CLIP LIST …………………………………………………… 4

    F

    I

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..21

    CLUSTER LID C ……………………………………….. 22

    IP

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..22

    FRONT AIR CONTROL FINISHER ………………. 23

    K

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..23

    INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL LH ……………… 24
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..24

    L

    GLOVE BOX ASSEMBLY ………………………….. 25
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..25

    M

    UPPER GLOVE BOX …………………………………. 26

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 14

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..26

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009472925

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009472926

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009472927

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-39570)
    Chassis Ear

    Locating the noise

    C

    D

    E
    SIIA0993E


    (J-50397)
    NISSAN Squeak and Rattle
    Kit

    F

    Repairing the cause of noise

    G

    H
    ALJIA1232ZZ


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    I

    IP
    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009472928

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39565)
    Engine Ear

    Locating the noise

    K

    L

    M

    N
    SIIA0995E

    ( — )
    Power Tool

    O

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    P

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-3

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    CLIP LIST
    Descriptions for Clips

    INFOID:0000000009472929

    Replace any clips which are damaged during removal or installation.

    SIIA0315E

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-4

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    SIIA0316E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-5

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    SIIA0317E

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-6

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    ALJIA0564GB

    I

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-7

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671285

    SBT842

    CUSTOMER INTERVIEW
    Interview the customer if possible, to determine the conditions that exist when the noise occurs. Use the Diagnostic Worksheet during the interview to document the facts and conditions when the noise occurs and any
    customer’s comments; refer to IP-12, «Diagnostic Worksheet». This information is necessary to duplicate the
    conditions that exist when the noise occurs.
    • The customer may not be able to provide a detailed description or the location of the noise. Attempt to obtain
    all the facts and conditions that exist when the noise occurs (or does not occur).
    • If there is more than one noise in the vehicle, be sure to diagnose and repair the noise that the customer is
    concerned about. This can be accomplished by test driving the vehicle with the customer.
    • After identifying the type of noise, isolate the noise in terms of its characteristics. The noise characteristics
    are provided so the customer, service adviser and technician are all speaking the same language when
    defining the noise.
    • Squeak —(Like tennis shoes on a clean floor)
    Squeak characteristics include the light contact/fast movement/brought on by road conditions/hard surfaces
    = higher pitch noise/softer surfaces = lower pitch noises/edge to surface = chirping.
    • Creak—(Like walking on an old wooden floor)
    Creak characteristics include firm contact/slow movement/twisting with a rotational movement/pitch dependent on materials/often brought on by activity.
    • Rattle—(Like shaking a baby rattle)
    Rattle characteristics include the fast repeated contact/vibration or similar movement/loose parts/missing
    clip or fastener/incorrect clearance.
    • Knock —(Like a knock on a door)
    Knock characteristics include hollow sounding/sometimes repeating/often brought on by driver action.
    • Tick—(Like a clock second hand)
    Tick characteristics include gentle contacting of light materials/loose components/can be caused by driver
    action or road conditions.
    • Thump—(Heavy, muffled knock noise)
    Thump characteristics include softer knock/dead sound often brought on by activity.
    • Buzz—(Like a bumble bee)
    Buzz characteristics include high frequency rattle/firm contact.
    • Often the degree of acceptable noise level will vary depending upon the person. A noise that you may judge
    as acceptable may be very irritating to the customer.
    • Weather conditions, especially humidity and temperature, may have a great effect on noise level.

    DUPLICATE THE NOISE AND TEST DRIVE

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-8

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    If possible, drive the vehicle with the customer until the noise is duplicated. Note any additional information on
    the Diagnostic Worksheet regarding the conditions or location of the noise. This information can be used to
    duplicate the same conditions when you confirm the repair.
    If the noise can be duplicated easily during the test drive, to help identify the source of the noise, try to duplicate the noise with the vehicle stopped by doing one or all of the following:
    1) Close a door.
    2) Tap or push/pull around the area where the noise appears to be coming from.
    3) Rev the engine.
    4) Use a floor jack to recreate vehicle “twist”.
    5) At idle, apply engine load (electrical load, half-clutch on M/T model, drive position on CVT and A/T models).
    6) Raise the vehicle on a hoist and hit a tire with a rubber hammer.
    • Drive the vehicle and attempt to duplicate the conditions the customer states exist when the noise occurs.
    • If it is difficult to duplicate the noise, drive the vehicle slowly on an undulating or rough road to stress the
    vehicle body.

    CHECK RELATED SERVICE BULLETINS
    After verifying the customer concern or symptom, check ASIST for Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) related
    to that concern or symptom.
    If a TSB relates to the symptom, follow the procedure to repair the noise.

    LOCATE THE NOISE AND IDENTIFY THE ROOT CAUSE
    1.
    2.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    Narrow down the noise to a general area. To help pinpoint the source of the noise, use a listening tool
    (Chassis Ear: J-39570, Engine Ear: J-39565 and mechanic’s stethoscope).
    G
    Narrow down the noise to a more specific area and identify the cause of the noise by:
    • removing the components in the area that you suspect the noise is coming from.
    Do not use too much force when removing clips and fasteners, otherwise clips and fasteners can be H
    broken or lost during the repair, resulting in the creation of new noise.
    • tapping or pushing/pulling the component that you suspect is causing the noise.
    Do not tap or push/pull the component with excessive force, otherwise the noise will be eliminated only
    I
    temporarily.
    • feeling for a vibration with your hand by touching the component(s) that you suspect is (are) causing the
    noise.
    • placing a piece of paper between components that you suspect are causing the noise.
    IP
    • looking for loose components and contact marks.
    Refer to IP-9, «Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting».

    REPAIR THE CAUSE


    If the cause is a loose component, tighten the component securely.
    If the cause is insufficient clearance between components:
    separate components by repositioning or loosening and retightening the component, if possible.
    insulate components with a suitable insulator such as urethane pads, foam blocks, felt cloth tape or urethane
    tape. A NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) is available through your authorized NISSAN Parts Department.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use excessive force as many components are constructed of plastic and may be damaged.
    NOTE:
    • Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    • The materials contained in the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) are listed on the inside cover of the
    kit; and can each be ordered separately as needed.
    • The following materials not found in the kit can also be used to repair squeaks and rattles.
    — SILICONE GREASE: Use instead of UHMW tape that will be visible or does not fit. The silicone grease will
    only last a few months.
    — SILICONE SPRAY: Use when grease cannot be applied.
    — DUCT TAPE: Use to eliminate movement.

    CONFIRM THE REPAIR
    Confirm that the cause of a noise is repaired by test driving the vehicle. Operate the vehicle under the same
    conditions as when the noise originally occurred. Refer to the notes on the Diagnostic Worksheet.

    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting

    INFOID:0000000009671286

    Refer to Table of Contents for specific component removal and installation information.
    Revision: April 2013

    IP-9

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    INSTRUMENT PANEL
    Most incidents are caused by contact and movement between:
    1. Cluster lid A and the instrument panel
    2. Acrylic lens and combination meter housing
    3. Instrument panel to front pillar finisher
    4. Instrument panel to windshield
    5. Instrument panel pins
    6. Wiring harnesses behind the combination meter
    7. A/C defroster duct and duct joint
    These incidents can usually be located by tapping or moving the components to duplicate the noise or by
    pressing on the components while driving to stop the noise. Most of these incidents can be repaired by applying felt cloth tape or silicone spray (in hard to reach areas). Urethane pads can be used to insulate wiring harness.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use silicone spray to isolate a squeak or rattle. If you saturate the area with silicone, you will
    not be able to recheck the repair.

    CENTER CONSOLE
    Components to pay attention to include:
    1. Shift selector assembly cover to finisher
    2. A/C control unit and cluster lid C
    3. Wiring harnesses behind audio and A/C control unit
    The instrument panel repair and isolation procedures also apply to the center console.

    DOORS
    Pay attention to the:
    1. Finisher and inner panel making a slapping noise
    2. Inside handle escutcheon to door finisher
    3. Wiring harnesses tapping
    4. Door striker out of alignment causing a popping noise on starts and stops
    Tapping or moving the components or pressing on them while driving to duplicate the conditions can isolate
    many of these incidents. You can usually insulate the areas with felt cloth tape or insulator foam blocks from
    the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) to repair the noise.

    TRUNK
    Trunk noises are often caused by a loose jack or loose items put into the trunk by the owner.
    In addition look for:
    1. Trunk lid bumpers out of adjustment
    2. Trunk lid striker out of adjustment
    3. The trunk lid torsion bars knocking together
    4. A loose license plate or bracket
    Most of these incidents can be repaired by adjusting, securing or insulating the item(s) or component(s) causing the noise.

    SUNROOF/HEADLINING
    Noises in the sunroof/headlining area can often be traced to one of the following:
    1. Sunroof lid, rail, linkage or seals making a rattle or light knocking noise
    2. Sun visor shaft shaking in the holder
    3. Front or rear windshield touching headlining and squeaking
    Again, pressing on the components to stop the noise while duplicating the conditions can isolate most of these
    incidents. Repairs usually consist of insulating with felt cloth tape.

    OVERHEAD CONSOLE (FRONT AND REAR)
    Overhead console noises are often caused by the console panel clips not being engaged correctly. Most of
    these incidents are repaired by pushing up on the console at the clip locations until the clips engage.
    In addition look for:
    Revision: April 2013

    IP-10

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Loose harness or harness connectors.
    2. Front console map/reading lamp lens loose.
    3. Loose screws at console attachment points.

    A

    SEATS
    When isolating seat noise it’s important to note the position the seat is in and the load placed on the seat when
    the noise is present. These conditions should be duplicated when verifying and isolating the cause of the
    noise.
    Cause of seat noise include:
    1. Headrest rods and holder
    2. A squeak between the seat pad cushion and frame
    3. The rear seatback lock and bracket
    These noises can be isolated by moving or pressing on the suspected components while duplicating the conditions under which the noise occurs. Most of these incidents can be repaired by repositioning the component
    or applying urethane tape to the contact area.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    UNDERHOOD
    Some interior noise may be caused by components under the hood or on the engine wall. The noise is then F
    transmitted into the passenger compartment.
    Causes of transmitted underhood noise include:
    1. Any component installed to the engine wall
    G
    2. Components that pass through the engine wall
    3. Engine wall mounts and connectors
    4. Loose radiator installation pins
    H
    5. Hood bumpers out of adjustment
    6. Hood striker out of adjustment
    I
    These noises can be difficult to isolate since they cannot be reached from the interior of the vehicle. The best
    method is to secure, move or insulate one component at a time and test drive the vehicle. Also, engine rpm or
    load can be changed to isolate the noise. Repairs can usually be made by moving, adjusting, securing, or
    insulating the component causing the noise.
    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-11

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnostic Worksheet

    INFOID:0000000009671287

    LAIA0072E

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-12

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    LAIA0071E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-13

    2014 Note

    INSTRUMENT PANEL ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    INSTRUMENT PANEL ASSEMBLY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567640

    AWJIA1105ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-14

    2014 Note

    INSTRUMENT PANEL ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1.

    Instrument side finisher (RH)

    2.

    Passenger air bag module

    3.

    Instrument panel assembly

    4.

    Instrument side finisher (LH)

    5.

    Side ventilator grille (LH)

    6.

    Combination meter

    7.

    Cluster lid A

    8.

    Instrument lower panel LH

    9.

    Steering column upper cover

    10. Steering column lower cover

    11. Steering lock escutcheon

    12. Center console lower

    13. Front air control finisher

    14. Front air control

    15. Center ventilator grille (RH)

    B

    16. Center ventilator grille (LH)

    17. Cluster lid C

    18. Audio unit/AV control unit

    19. Glove box lid

    20. Glove box assembly

    21. Glove box striker

    22. Side ventilator grille (RH)

    23. Upper glove box

    Metal clip

    A

    C

    Pawl

    Clip

    D

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567641

    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to scratch instrument panel pad or other parts.
    • Before servicing, turn the ignition switch off, disconnect both battery terminals and wait at least
    three minutes.
    • Do not tamper with or force air bag lid open, as this may adversely affect air bag performance.

    E

    F

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69, G
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove front pillar finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-19, «FRONT PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    H
    Remove dash side finishers (LH/RH). Refer to INT-22, «DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Partially remove front body side welts (LH/RH). Refer to INT-22, «BODY SIDE WELT : Removal and
    I
    Installation».
    Release the pawls using a suitable tool (A) and then remove
    instrument side finisher (LH) as shown.
    IP
    : Pawl
    K

    L
    AWJIA1130ZZ

    6.

    M

    Release the pawls using a suitable tool (A) and then remove
    instrument side finisher (RH) as shown.
    : Pawl

    N

    O

    P
    AWJIA1131ZZ

    7.
    8.
    9.
    10.
    11.

    Remove center console lower. Refer to IP-20, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove steering wheel. Refer to ST-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove steering column covers. Refer to IP-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove combination switch. Refer to EXL-112, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-15

    2014 Note

    INSTRUMENT PANEL ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    12. Remove audio unit. Refer to AV-33, «Removal and Installation» (BASE AUDIO) or AV-93, «Removal and
    Installation» (DISPLAY AUDIO).
    13. Remove AV control unit (NAVIGATION). Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    14. Remove front air control. Refer to HAC-47, «Removal and Installation».
    15. Remove glove box assembly. Refer to IP-25, «Removal and Installation».
    16. Remove front passenger air bag module. Refer to SR-17, «Removal and Installation».
    17. Remove instrument panel assembly.
    a. Remove instrument panel assembly screws (A).

    ALJIA1252ZZ

    b.
    c.

    Disconnect the harness connectors from the instrument panel assembly.
    Remove instrument panel assembly through passenger door opening.
    CAUTION:
    • Cover shift selector assembly with a shop cloth to prevent damage to instrument panel assembly.
    • When removing instrument panel assembly, two people are required to prevent from damage.
    18. Removal of the following components is only necessary if replacing the instrument panel assembly.
    • Side ventilator grille (LH/RH): Refer to VTL-6, «SIDE VENTILATOR GRILLE : Removal and Installation».
    • Center ventilator duct (LH/RH): Refer to VTL-6, «CENTER VENTILATOR DUCT : Removal and Installation».
    • Side defroster duct (LH/RH): Refer to VTL-7, «SIDE DEFROSTER DUCT : Removal and Installation».

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    If replacing instrument panel, transfer all the necessary parts to the new instrument panel.

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-16

    2014 Note

    STEERING COLUMN COVERS
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    STEERING COLUMN COVERS

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567642

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    B

    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove steering column cover screws (A).
    NOTE:
    Rotate steering wheel to access steering column cover screws.
    Pull steering column upper cover (1) upward to disengage steering column upper cover pawls.
    : Pawl
    Remove steering column upper cover (1) and lower cover (2).

    C

    D

    E

    AWJIA0707ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    F

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    G

    H

    I

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-17

    2014 Note

    CENTER CONSOLE ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CENTER CONSOLE ASSEMBLY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009567643

    TYPE 1

    AWJIA1134ZZ

    1.

    Shift selector boot (5MT: RS5F91R)

    2.

    Center console assembly

    3.

    USB connector (if equipped)

    4.

    Power socket

    A.

    Clip

    B.

    Screw

    TYPE 2

    AWJIA1135ZZ

    1.

    Shift selector boot (5MT: RS5F91R)

    2.

    Center console assembly

    3.

    Power socket

    4.

    USB connector (if equipped)

    5.

    Heated seat switch (RH) (if equipped)

    6.

    Heated seat switch (LH)
    (if equipped)

    A.

    Clip

    B.

    Screw

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567644

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Move shift selector to “N” position (CVT: RE0F11A).
    Remove shift selector handle (5MT: RS5F91R). Refer to TM-19, «Exploded View».
    Raise parking brake lever.

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-18

    2014 Note

    CENTER CONSOLE ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4. Remove center console assembly clips (A).
    A

    B

    C
    JMJIA6093ZZ

    D

    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Remove the center console assembly rear screws.
    Slide driver side seat to the full rearward position and recline.
    Slide passenger side seat to the full rearward position and recline.
    Lift rear right corner of center console assembly, rotating slightly,
    making sure to lift assembly upward over the parking brake handle.
    9. Disconnect the harness connectors from the center console
    assembly.
    10. Remove center console assembly.

    E

    F

    G

    H
    AWJIA0695ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    I

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-19

    2014 Note

    CENTER CONSOLE LOWER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CENTER CONSOLE LOWER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567645

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    a.

    Remove center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove center console lower.
    Remove center console lower clips (LH/RH) (A).

    JMJIA6052ZZ

    b.

    Release center console lower pawls using a suitable tool and
    remove.
    : Pawl

    AWJIA0706ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-20

    2014 Note

    CLUSTER LID A
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CLUSTER LID A

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567646

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove steering column covers. Refer to IP-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove cluster lid A.

    C

    D

    E

    AWJIA1075ZZ

    Pawl

    a.
    b.
    c.

    F

    Metal clip

    Remove combination meter finisher and cluster lid A as an assembly by pulling rearward to release pawls
    and metal clips.
    Disconnect the harness connector and remove cluster lid A.
    Separate cluster lid A (2) from combination meter finisher (1) by releasing the metal clips (If necessary).

    G

    H

    INSTALLATION
    I

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-21

    2014 Note

    CLUSTER LID C
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CLUSTER LID C
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567647

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Release the cluster lid C (1) clips using a suitable tool.
    : Metal clip

    ALJIA1231ZZ

    2.

    Disconnect harness connectors from cluster lid C and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-22

    2014 Note

    FRONT AIR CONTROL FINISHER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT AIR CONTROL FINISHER

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567648

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove intake door lever knob (2).
    Release the front air control finisher (1) clips using a suitable
    tool and remove.
    : Metal clip

    C

    D

    E

    ALJIA1234ZZ

    F

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    G

    H

    I

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-23

    2014 Note

    INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL LH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL LH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567649

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove data link connector from instrument lower panel LH.
    Remove bolts (A) and position hood lock/fuel filler door release
    handle aside.

    JMKIA7998ZZ

    3.
    a.
    b.

    Remove instrument lower panel LH.
    Release instrument lower panel LH metal clips and pawls using a suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Release pawls and metal clips slowly so that they are not damaged.
    Disconnect the harness connectors from instrument lower panel LH and remove.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-24

    2014 Note

    GLOVE BOX ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    GLOVE BOX ASSEMBLY

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567650

    REMOVAL
    1.
    a.
    b.

    B

    Remove glove box lid.
    Open glove box lid.
    Pull glove box lid rearward and glove box lid hinges down and
    rearward to release, then remove the glove box lid.

    C

    D

    E
    JMJIA6060ZZ

    2.
    a.
    b.

    Remove glove box assembly.
    Remove glove box assembly screws (A).
    Pull glove box assembly rearward to release pawls and remove.
    : Pawl

    F

    G

    H

    AWJIA0714ZZ

    I

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    IP

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-25

    2014 Note

    UPPER GLOVE BOX
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UPPER GLOVE BOX
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009667864

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Remove upper glove box screws (A).

    ALJIA1253ZZ

    2.

    Release the clips and pawls using a suitable tool and remove upper glove box.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    IP-26

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL & POWER CONTROL

    SECTION

    LAN

    LAN SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    CAN FUNDAMENTAL

    HOW TO USE THIS SECTION ……………………. 20

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL …………………. 4

    Information ………………………………………………………20
    Abbreviation List ………………………………………………20

    HOW TO USE THIS SECTION ………………………. 4

    PRECAUTION ………………………………………. 21

    Information ………………………………………………………. 4

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 5

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………. 21

    Precautions for Trouble Diagnosis ………………………. 5
    Precautions for Harness Repair ………………………….. 5

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» ………………………………………………………..21
    Precautions for Trouble Diagnosis ……………………..21
    Precautions for Harness Repair …………………………21

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 6

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………….. 23

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 6

    COMPONENT PARTS ……………………………….. 23

    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM ……………………….. 6
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description …………………………………………………………… 6

    Component Parts Location ………………………………..23

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 5

    DIAG ON CAN ……………………………………………………. 6
    DIAG ON CAN : System Description …………………… 6

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS ……………………………….. 8
    Component Description ……………………………………… 8
    Condition of Error Detection ……………………………….. 8
    Symptom When Error Occurs in CAN Communication System …………………………………………………… 9
    CAN Diagnosis with CONSULT ………………………… 11
    Self-Diagnosis ………………………………………………… 12
    CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor ………………………. 12
    How to Use CAN Communication Signal Chart …… 14

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 15
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ………15
    Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart …………………………… 15
    Trouble Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………. 15

    CAN
    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL ………………… 20
    Revision: April 2013

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………… 24
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM ……………………….24
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description ………………………………………………………….24
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN Communication Control Circuit …………………………………27
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN System
    Specification Chart …………………………………………..28
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN Communication Signal Chart ……………………………………29

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 31
    CAN SYSTEM …………………………………………… 31

    O

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..31

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 36
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …….. 36
    Interview Sheet ………………………………………………..36

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 37
    MALFUNCTION AREA CHART …………………… 37

    LAN-1

    2014 Note

    P

    Main Line ………………………………………………………. 37
    Branch Line …………………………………………………… 37
    Short Circuit …………………………………………………… 37

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………… 57

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC
    CIRCUIT ……………………………………………………. 38

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 58

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 38

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 39
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 39

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 40
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 40

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………… 41
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 41

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 42
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 42

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………. 43
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 43

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………….. 44
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 44

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………… 45
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 45

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………… 46
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 46

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 47
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 47

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 48
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 48

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT ……………….. 49
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 49

    CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 57

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 58
    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 59
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 59

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT ………………. 60
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 60

    CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)
    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS …………………… 62
    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC
    CIRCUIT ……………………………………………………. 62
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 62

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 63
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 63

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 64
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 64

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………… 65
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 65

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………. 66
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 66

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………….. 67
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 67

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 68
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 68

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………… 69
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 69

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 70

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 51
    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC
    CIRCUIT ……………………………………………………. 51
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 51

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 52
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 52

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 53
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 53

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………… 54
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 54

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………. 55
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 55

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………… 56
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 56

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 70

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 71
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 71

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT ………………. 72
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 72

    CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)
    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS …………………… 74
    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC
    CIRCUIT ……………………………………………………. 74
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 74

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 75
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 75

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 76
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 76

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………… 77
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-2

    2014 Note

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 77

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..87

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………………78

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 88

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 78

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..88

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………..79

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………… 89

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 79

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..89

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………………80

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 90

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 80

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..90

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………………81

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………. 91

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 81

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..91

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………..82

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………………. 92

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 82

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..92

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………..83

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 93

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 83

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..93

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT ………………..84

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT …………………….. 94

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 84

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..94

    CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………. 95

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 86

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..95

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC
    CIRCUIT …………………………………………………….86

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ……………………. 96

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 86

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT ………………. 97

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT ………………………87

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..97

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..96

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-3

    2014 Note

    HOW TO USE THIS SECTION
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
    HOW TO USE THIS SECTION
    Information

    INFOID:0000000009014719

    • “CAN FUNDAMENTAL” of LAN Section describes the basic knowledge of the CAN communication system
    and the method of trouble diagnosis.
    • For information peculiar to a vehicle and inspection procedure, refer to “CAN”.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-4

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precautions for Trouble Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009014720

    CAUTION:
    Follow the instructions listed below. Failure to do this may cause damage to parts:
    • Never apply 7.0 V or more to the measurement terminal.
    • Use a tester with open terminal voltage of 7.0 V or less.
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal when
    checking the harness.

    Precautions for Harness Repair

    B

    C

    D

    INFOID:0000000009014721

    • Solder the repaired area and wrap tape around the soldered area.
    NOTE:
    A fray of twisted lines must be within 110 mm (4.33 in).

    E

    F

    G

    SKIB8766E

    • Bypass connection is never allowed at the repaired area.
    NOTE:
    Bypass connection may cause CAN communication error. The
    spliced wire becomes separated and the characteristics of twisted
    line are lost.

    H

    I

    J

    K
    SKIB8767E

    L

    • Replace the applicable harness as an assembly if error is detected on the shield lines of CAN communication line.
    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-5

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    SYSTEM
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009014722

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
    control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
    communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
    Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DIAG ON CAN

    DIAG ON CAN : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009014723

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSMIA0526GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-6

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Name

    Harness

    Description

    A

    DDL1

    Tx
    Rx

    For communications with the diagnostic tool. (CAN-H and CAN-L are used for controlling)

    DDL2

    K-LINE

    For communications with the diagnostic tool. (CAN-H and CAN-L are used for controlling)

    Diag on CAN

    CAN-H
    CAN-L

    For communications with the diagnostic tool. (CAN-H and CAN-L are also used for control and diagnoses.)

    B

    C

    DESCRIPTION
    “Diag on CAN” is a diagnosis method which uses the CAN communication line for the communication between
    the control unit and the diagnostic tool.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-7

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    Component Description

    INFOID:0000000009014724

    JSMIA0527GB

    Component

    Description

    Main line

    CAN communication line between splices

    Branch line

    CAN communication line between splice and a control unit

    Splice

    A point connecting a branch line with a main line

    Termination circuit

    Circuit connected across the CAN communication system. (Resistor)

    Condition of Error Detection

    INFOID:0000000009014725

    DTC (e.g. U1000 and U1001) of CAN communication is indicated on SELF-DIAG RESULTS on CONSULT if a
    CAN communication signal is not transmitted or received between units for 2 seconds or more.

    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM ERROR
    • CAN communication line open (CAN-H, CAN-L, or both)
    • CAN communication line short (ground, between CAN communication lines, other harnesses)
    • Error of CAN communication control circuit of the unit connected to CAN communication line

    WHEN DTC OF CAN COMMUNICATION IS INDICATED EVEN THOUGH CAN COMMUNICATION
    SYSTEM IS NORMAL
    • Removal/installation of parts: Error may be detected when removing and installing CAN communication unit
    and related parts while turning the ignition switch ON. (A DTC except for CAN communication may be
    detected.)
    • Fuse blown out (removed): CAN communication of the unit may cease.
    • Voltage drop: Error may be detected if voltage drops due to discharged battery when turning the ignition
    switch ON (Depending on the control unit which carries out CAN communication).
    • Error may be detected if the power supply circuit of the control unit, which carries out CAN communication,
    malfunctions (Depending on the control unit which carries out CAN communication).
    • Error may be detected if reprogramming is not completed normally.
    NOTE:
    CAN communication system is normal if DTC of CAN communication is indicated on SELF-DIAG RESULTS of
    CONSULT under the above conditions. Erase the memory of the self-diagnosis of each control unit.
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-8

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Symptom When Error Occurs in CAN Communication System

    INFOID:0000000009014726

    A

    In CAN communication system, multiple control units mutually transmit and receive signals. Each control unit
    cannot transmit and receive signals if any error occurs on CAN communication line. Under this condition, multiple control units related to the root cause malfunction or go into fail-safe mode.

    B

    ERROR EXAMPLE
    NOTE:
    Each vehicle differs in symptom of each control unit under fail-safe mode and CAN communication line wiring.

    C

    Example: Main Line Between Data Link Connector and ABS Actuator and Electric Unit (Control Unit) Open Circuit
    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JSMIA0442GB

    Unit name

    I

    Major symptom

    ECM

    Engine torque limiting is affected, and shift harshness increases.
    • Reverse warning buzzer does not sound.
    • The front wiper moves under continuous operation mode even though the front wiper switch being in the intermittent position.

    J

    BCM
    EPS control unit

    The steering effort increases.

    K

    Combination meter

    • The shift position indicator and OD OFF indicator turn OFF.
    • The speedometer is inoperative.
    • The odo/trip meter stops.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Normal operation.

    TCM

    No impact on operation.

    IPDM E/R

    When the ignition switch is ON,
    • The headlamps (Lo) turn ON.
    • The cooling fan continues to rotate.

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-9

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Example: TCM Branch Line Open Circuit

    JSMIA0443GB

    Unit name

    Major symptom

    ECM

    Engine torque limiting is affected, and shift harshness increases.

    BCM

    Reverse warning buzzer does not sound.

    EPS control unit

    Normal operation.

    Combination meter

    • Shift position indicator and O/D OFF indicator turn OFF.
    • Warning lamps turn ON.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Normal operation.

    TCM

    No impact on operation.

    IPDM E/R

    Normal operation.

    NOTE:
    The model (all control units on CAN communication system are Diag on CAN) cannot perform CAN diagnosis
    with CONSULT if the following error occurs. The error is judged by the symptom.
    Error

    Difference of symptom

    Data link connector branch line open circuit

    Normal operation.

    CAN-H, CAN-L harness short-circuit

    Most of the control units which are connected to the CAN communication system enter fail-safe mode or are deactivated.

    Example: Data Link Connector Branch Line Open Circuit

    JSMIA0444GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-10

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Unit name

    Major symptom

    A

    ECM
    BCM

    B

    EPS control unit
    Combination meter

    Normal operation.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    C

    TCM
    IPDM E/R

    NOTE:
    When data link connector branch line is open, transmission and reception of CAN communication signals are
    not affected. Therefore, no symptoms occur. However, be sure to repair malfunctioning circuit.

    D

    E

    Example: CAN-H, CAN-L Harness Short Circuit

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J
    JSMIA0445GB

    Unit name

    Major symptom

    K

    ECM

    • Engine torque limiting is affected, and shift harshness increases.
    • Engine speed drops.

    BCM

    • Reverse warning buzzer does not sound.
    • The front wiper moves under continuous operation mode even though the front
    wiper switch being in the intermittent position.
    • The room lamp does not turn ON.
    • The engine does not start (if an error or malfunction occurs while turning the ignition switch OFF.)
    • The steering lock does not release (if an error or malfunction occurs while turning
    the ignition switch OFF.)

    EPS control unit

    The steering effort increases.

    Combination meter

    • The tachometer and the speedometer do not move.
    • Warning lamps turn ON.
    • Indicator lamps do not turn ON.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Normal operation.

    TCM

    No impact on operation.

    IPDM E/R

    When the ignition switch is ON,
    • The headlamps (Lo) turn ON.
    • The cooling fan continues to rotate.

    CAN Diagnosis with CONSULT

    N

    P

    INFOID:0000000009014727

    LAN-11

    LAN

    O

    CAN diagnosis on CONSULT extracts the root cause by receiving the following information.
    Revision: April 2013

    L

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Response to the system call
    • Control unit diagnosis information
    • Self-diagnosis
    • CAN diagnostic support monitor

    Self-Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009014728

    If communication signals cannot be transmitted or received among control units communicating via CAN communication line, CAN communication-related DTC is displayed on the CONSULT “Self Diagnostic Result”
    screen.
    NOTE:
    The following table shows examples of CAN communication-related DTC. For other DTC, refer to the applicable sections.
    Self-diagnosis item
    (CONSULT indication)

    DTC

    U1000

    DTC detection condition

    ECM

    When ECM is not transmitting or receiving CAN
    communication signal of OBD (emission-related diagnosis) for 2 seconds or more.

    Except
    for ECM

    When a control unit (except for ECM) is not
    transmitting or receiving CAN communication
    signal for 2 seconds or more.

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    When ECM is not transmitting or receiving CAN communication signal other than OBD (emission-related diagnosis)
    for 2 seconds or more.

    U1001

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    U1002

    SYSTEM COMM

    When a control unit is not transmitting or receiving CAN
    communication signal for 2 seconds or less.

    U1010

    CONTROL UNIT(CAN)

    When an error is detected during the initial diagnosis for
    CAN controller of each control unit.

    CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor

    Inspection/Action

    Start the inspection. Refer to the applicable section of the indicated
    control unit.

    Replace the control unit
    indicating “U1010”.
    INFOID:0000000009014729

    MONITOR ITEM (CONSULT)
    Example: CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR indication

    JSMIA0964GB

    Without PAST
    Item
    Initial diagnosis

    Revision: April 2013

    PRESENT

    Description

    OK

    Normal at present

    NG

    Control unit error (Except for some control units)

    LAN-12

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Item

    PRESENT
    OK

    Transmission diagnosis

    UNKWN
    OK

    Control unit name
    (Reception diagnosis)

    Description

    A

    Normal at present
    Unable to transmit signals for 2 seconds or more.
    Diagnosis not performed

    B

    Normal at present
    Unable to receive signals for 2 seconds or more.

    UNKWN

    C

    Diagnosis not performed
    No control unit for receiving signals. (No applicable optional parts)

    With PAST

    D
    Item

    PRESENT

    PAST
    OK

    Transmission diagnosis

    OK

    UNKWN

    1 – 39
    0
    OK

    OK
    Control unit name
    (Reception diagnosis)

    1 – 39

    UNKWN

    0

    Not diagnosed

    Description
    Normal at present and in the past

    E

    Normal at present, but unable to transmit signals for 2 seconds or more
    in the past. (The number indicates the number of ignition switch cycles
    from OFF to ON.)

    F

    Unable to transmit signals for 2 seconds or more at present.
    Normal at present and in the past
    Normal at present, but unable to receive signals for 2 seconds or more
    in the past. (The number indicates the number of ignition switch cycles
    from OFF to ON.)
    Unable to receive signals for 2 seconds or more at present.

    G

    H

    Diagnosis not performed.
    No control unit for receiving signals. (No applicable optional parts)

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-13

    2014 Note

    TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    How to Use CAN Communication Signal Chart

    INFOID:0000000009014730

    The CAN communication signal chart lists the signals transmitted/received among control units. It is useful for
    detecting the root cause by finding a signal related to the symptom, and by checking transmission and reception unit.

    JSMIA0446GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart

    INFOID:0000000009014731

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSMIA0528GB

    Trouble Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014732

    INTERVIEW WITH CUSTOMER

    LAN

    Interview with the customer is important to detect the root cause of CAN communication system errors and to
    understand vehicle condition and symptoms for proper trouble diagnosis.

    N

    Points in interview

    O





    What: Parts name, system name
    When: Date, Frequency
    Where: Road condition, Place
    In what condition: Driving condition/environment
    Result: Symptom

    P

    Notes for checking error symptoms:

    • Check normal units as well as error symptoms.
    — Example: Circuit between ECM and the combination meter is judged normal if the customer indicates
    tachometer functions normally.
    • When a CAN communication system error is present, multiple control units may malfunction or go into failsafe mode.
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-15

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Indication of the combination meter is important to detect the root cause because it is the most obvious to
    the customer, and it performs CAN communication with many units.

    SKIB8717E

    INSPECTION OF VEHICLE CONDITION
    Check whether the symptom is reproduced or not.
    NOTE:
    Do not turn the ignition switch OFF or disconnect the battery cable while reproducing the error. The error may
    temporarily correct itself, making it difficult to determine the root cause.

    CHECK OF CAN SYSTEM TYPE (HOW TO USE CAN SYSTEM TYPE SPECIFICATION CHART)
    Determine CAN system type based on vehicle equipment.
    NOTE:
    • This chart is used if CONSULT does not automatically recognize CAN system type.
    • There are two styles for CAN system type specification charts. Depending on the number of available system types, either style A or style B may be used.
    CAN System Type Specification Chart (Style A)
    NOTE:

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-16

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    CAN system type is easily checked with the vehicle equipment identification information shown in the chart.
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N
    JSMIA0529GB

    CAN System Type Specification Chart (Style B)
    NOTE:

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-17

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    CAN system type is easily checked with the vehicle equipment identification information shown in the chart.

    JSMIA0530GB

    CREATE INTERVIEW SHEET
    Fill out the symptom described by the customer, vehicle condition, and CAN system type on the interview
    sheet.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-18

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [CAN FUNDAMENTAL]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Interview Sheet (Example)

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSMIA0531GB

    LAN

    DETECT THE ROOT CAUSE
    CAN diagnosis function of CONSULT detects the root cause.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-19

    2014 Note

    HOW TO USE THIS SECTION
    [CAN]

    < HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL >

    HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
    HOW TO USE THIS SECTION
    Information

    INFOID:0000000009014733

    • “CAN” of LAN Section describes information peculiar to a vehicle and inspection procedures.
    • For trouble diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart» of “CAN FUNDAMENTAL”.

    Abbreviation List

    INFOID:0000000009014734

    Unit name abbreviations in CONSULT CAN diagnosis and in this section are as per the following list.
    Abbreviation

    Unit name

    A-BAG

    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    ABS

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    AV

    AV control unit

    BCM

    BCM

    DLC

    Data link connector

    ECM

    ECM

    EPS

    EPS control unit

    IPDM-E

    IPDM E/R

    M&A

    Combination meter

    TCM

    TCM

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-20

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [CAN]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009705471

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precautions for Trouble Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009014736

    CAUTION:
    Follow the instructions listed below. Failure to do this may cause damage to parts:
    • Never apply 7.0 V or more to the measurement terminal.
    • Use a tester with open terminal voltage of 7.0 V or less.
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal when
    checking the harness.

    Precautions for Harness Repair

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    INFOID:0000000009014737

    • Solder the repaired area and wrap tape around the soldered area.
    NOTE:
    A fray of twisted lines must be within 110 mm (4.33 in).

    LAN

    N

    O

    SKIB8766E

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-21

    2014 Note

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Bypass connection is never allowed at the repaired area.
    NOTE:
    Bypass connection may cause CAN communication error. The
    spliced wire becomes separated and the characteristics of twisted
    line are lost.

    [CAN]

    SKIB8767E

    • Replace the applicable harness as an assembly if error is detected on the shield lines of CAN communication line.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-22

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009014738

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    ALMIA0651ZZ

    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    Combination meter

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    AV control unit

    EPS control unit

    Data link connector

    TCM

    IPDM E/R

    ECM

    BCM

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-23

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009014739

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSMIA1476GB

    DESCRIPTION
    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
    control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
    communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
    Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
    CAN Communication Signal Generation
    • Termination circuits (resistors) are connected across the CAN communication system. When transmitting a
    CAN communication signal, each control unit passes a current to the CAN-H line and the current returns to
    the CAN-L line.

    JSMIA0450GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-24

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • The current flows separately into the termination circuits connected
    across the CAN communication system and the termination circuits drop voltage to generate a potential difference between the
    CAN-H line and the CAN-L line.
    NOTE:
    A signal with no current passage is called “Recessive” and one
    with current passage is called “Dominant”.

    A

    B

    C
    JSMIA0543GB

    D

    • The system produces digital signals for signal communications, by
    using the potential difference.
    E

    F

    G
    JSMIA0544ZZ

    The Construction of CAN Communication Signal (Message)

    H

    I

    J

    JSMIA0545ZZ

    No.

    Message name

    Description

    1

    Start of frame (1 bit)

    Start of message.

    2

    Arbitration of field (11 bit)

    Priorities of message-sending are shown when there is a possibility that multiple messages are sent at the same time.

    3

    Control field (6 bit)

    Signal quantity in data field is shown.

    4

    Data field (0-64 bit)

    Actual signal is shown.

    5

    CRC field (16 bit)

    • The transmitting control unit calculates sending data in advance and writes the calculated value in a message.
    • The receiving control unit calculates received data and judges that the data reception is normal when the calculated value is the same as the value written in the sent data.

    6

    ACK field (2 bit)

    The completion of normal reception is sent to the transmitting
    unit.

    7

    End of frame (7 bit)

    End of message.

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    CAN Communication Line

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    LAN-25

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    The CAN communication line is a twisted pair wire consisting of
    strands of CAN-H (1) and CAN-L (2) and has noise immunity.

    JSMIA0382ZZ

    NOTE:
    The CAN communication system has the characteristics of noise-resistant because this system produces digital signals by using the potential difference between the CAN-H line and the CAN-L line and has the twisted
    pair wire structure.
    Since the CAN-H line and the CAN-L line are always adjacent to
    each other, the same degree of noise occurs, respectively, when a
    noise (1) occurs. Although the noise changes the voltage, the potential difference (2) between the CAN-H line and the CAN-L line is
    insensitive to noise. Therefore, noise-resistant signals can be
    obtained.

    JSMIA0383ZZ

    CAN Signal Communications
    Each control unit of the CAN communication system transmits signals through the CAN communication control circuit included in the control unit and receives only necessary signals from each control unit to perform
    various kinds of control.
    • Example: Transmitted signals

    JSMIA0576GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-26

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Example: Received signals

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JSMIA0577GB

    NOTE:
    The above signal names and signal communications are provided for reference purposes. For CAN communications signals of this vehicle, refer to LAN-29, «CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN Communication
    Signal Chart».

    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN Communication Control Circuit

    INFOID:0000000009014740

    I

    J

    CAN communication control circuit is incorporated into the control unit and transmits/receives CAN communication signals.
    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    JSMIA0453GB

    Component

    System description

    CAN controller

    It controls CAN communication signal transmission and reception, error detection, etc.

    Transceiver IC

    It converts digital signal into CAN communication signal, and CAN communication signal into digital
    signal.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-27

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Component

    System description

    Noise filter

    It eliminates noise of CAN communication signal.

    Termination circuit*
    (Resistance of approx. 120 Ω)

    Generates a potential difference between CAN-H and CAN-L.

    *: These are the only control units wired with both ends of CAN communication system.

    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN System Specification Chart

    INFOID:0000000009014741

    Determine CAN system type from the following specification chart.
    NOTE:
    Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Procedure» for how to use CAN system specification chart.
    Body type

    Hatch back

    Axle

    2WD

    Engine

    HR16DE

    Transmission

    M/T

    CVT

    Brake control

    ABS
    ×

    Navigation system
    CAN system type

    503

    504

    ×
    505

    506

    CAN communication control unit
    ECM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    IPDM E/R

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    TCM
    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    ×

    ×
    ×

    AV control unit

    ×

    Data link connector

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    EPS control unit

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Combination meter

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    BCM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×: Applicable

    VEHICLE EQUIPMENT IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
    NOTE:
    Check CAN system type from the vehicle shape and equipment.

    ALMIA0645ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-28

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    NAVI switches

    A

    With navigation system

    CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : CAN Communication Signal Chart

    INFOID:0000000009014742

    Refer to LAN-14, «How to Use CAN Communication Signal Chart» for how to use CAN communication signal
    chart.
    NOTE:
    • Refer to LAN-20, «Abbreviation List» for the abbreviations of the connecting units.
    • The air bag diagnosis sensor unit and AV control unit uses CAN communication only for communicating with
    the diagnostic tool (not with other connected control units).

    T

    Closed throttle position signal

    T

    Cooling fan speed request signal

    T

    ECO pedal guide signal

    T

    Engine and CVT integrated control signal

    F

    R

    G

    R

    T

    R

    R

    R
    T

    Engine speed signal

    T

    R

    Engine status signal

    T

    R

    Power generation command value signal

    R

    H

    R

    R

    R

    R
    R

    T

    R

    R

    T

    I

    R

    J

    T

    R

    R

    T

    T

    K

    R

    ABS malfunction signal

    T

    R

    ABS operation signal

    T

    R

    ABS warning lamp signal

    T

    R

    VDC warning lamp signal

    T

    R

    VDC OFF indicator lamp signal

    T

    R

    Vehicle speed signal (ABS)

    T

    Brake warning lamp signal

    T

    R

    R

    R

    L

    LAN
    R

    R

    Detention switch signal

    T

    R

    Front wiper stop position signal

    T

    R

    High beam status signal

    R

    Interlock/PNP switch signal
    Low beam status signal

    R

    Push-button ignition switch status signal

    O

    R

    T

    T

    R

    R

    T

    T

    T

    LAN-29

    N

    R

    T

    Oil pressure switch signal

    Revision: April 2013

    T
    T

    Ignition switch ON signal

    E

    R

    T

    Malfunctioning indicator lamp signal

    D

    R
    R

    Engine coolant temperature signal

    N idle instruction signal

    C

    R: Receive

    BCM

    A/C compressor request signal

    M&A

    R

    EPS

    T

    TCM

    ABS

    Accelerator pedal position signal

    Signal name

    IPDM-E

    ECM

    T: Transmit

    B

    R
    R

    R

    R

    T

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM

    Starter control relay signal

    Starter relay status signal

    Steering lock relay signal
    Steering lock unit status signal

    T

    T

    R

    R

    T

    T

    R

    R

    T

    T

    R

    R

    R

    R

    T

    T

    R

    R

    T
    T

    R

    R

    T
    T

    Target gear ratio signal

    R

    EPS operation signal

    R

    R

    T

    Shift position signal

    R

    R

    T
    T

    EPS warning lamp signal

    T

    Odometer signal

    R
    T

    Overdrive control switch signal
    Vehicle speed signal (Meter)

    M&A

    EPS

    R

    OD OFF indicator signal
    Output shaft revolution signal

    TCM

    R

    T

    Wake up signal
    Input shaft revolution signal

    T

    T

    Sleep-ready signal

    Rear window defogger control signal

    IPDM-E

    ABS

    ECM

    Signal name

    BCM

    [CAN]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    R
    R

    T
    R

    Wake up signal

    R

    T

    R

    T

    R

    A/C ON signal

    R

    T

    Blower fan ON signal

    R

    T

    Buzzer output signal

    R

    T

    Dimmer signal

    R

    T

    R

    T

    R

    T

    Door switch signal

    R

    Engine start operation indicator lamp signal
    Front wiper request signal

    R

    High beam request signal

    R

    T

    Key warning lamp signal
    Low beam request signal

    R

    Position light request signal

    R

    Shift P warning lamp signal
    Sleep wake up signal

    R

    Stop lamp switch signal

    R

    Turn indicator signal

    R

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-30

    R

    T

    R

    T

    R

    T

    R

    T

    R

    T

    R

    T
    T

    R

    T

    2014 Note

    CAN SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    CAN SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009014743

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    ABMWA1993GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-31

    2014 Note

    CAN SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABMIA4638GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-32

    2014 Note

    CAN SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O
    ABMIA4639GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-33

    2014 Note

    CAN SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABMIA4640GB

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-34

    2014 Note

    CAN SYSTEM
    [CAN]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O
    ABMIA4641GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-35

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    [CAN]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Interview Sheet

    INFOID:0000000009014744

    NOTE:
    Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Procedure» for how to use interview sheet.

    SKIB8898E

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-36

    2014 Note

    MALFUNCTION AREA CHART
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    MALFUNCTION AREA CHART
    Main Line

    INFOID:0000000009014745

    Malfunction area

    Reference

    Main line between IPDM E/R and data link connector

    C

    LAN-38, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Branch Line

    INFOID:0000000009014746

    Malfunction area

    D

    Reference

    ECM branch line circuit

    LAN-39, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line circuit

    LAN-40, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    IPDM E/R branch line circuit

    LAN-41, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    TCM branch line circuit

    LAN-42, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Air bag diognosis sensor unit branch line ciecuit

    LAN-43, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    AV control unit branch line circuit

    LAN-44, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Data link connector branch line circuit

    LAN-45, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    EPS control unit branch line circuit

    LAN-46, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Combination meter branch line circuit

    LAN-47, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    BCM branch line circuit

    LAN-48, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    Short Circuit

    E

    F

    G

    H

    INFOID:0000000009014747

    Malfunction area
    CAN communication circuit

    B

    I

    J

    Reference
    LAN-49, «Diagnosis Procedure»

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-37

    2014 Note

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014748

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (connector side
    and harness side).
    Harness connector E7
    Harness connector M69
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the following harness connectors.
    IPDM E/R
    Harness connectors E7 and M69
    Check the continuity between the IPDM E/R harness connector and the harness connector.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.
    62

    E46

    61

    Harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.

    E7

    Continuity

    21A

    Existed

    20A

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the IPDM E/R and the harness connector E7.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the harness connector and the data link connector.
    Harness connector
    Connector No.
    M69

    Data link connector

    Terminal No.
    21A
    20A

    Connector No.
    M22

    Terminal No.

    Continuity

    6

    Existed

    14

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the main line between the IPDM E/R and the data link connector.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the harness connector M69 and the data link connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-38

    2014 Note

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014749

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ECM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of ECM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM harness connector terminals.
    ECM harness connector
    Connector No.
    E16

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    83

    D

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ECM branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ECM. Refer to EC-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ECM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-39

    2014 Note

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014750

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) for damage, bend
    and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    Check the resistance between the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector terminals.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector
    Connector No.
    E33

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    11

    10

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to
    BRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal
    and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-40

    2014 Note

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014751

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the IPDM E/R for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side
    and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of IPDM E/R.
    Check the resistance between the IPDM E/R harness connector terminals.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.
    E46

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    62

    61

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the IPDM E/R branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the IPDM E/R branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-41

    2014 Note

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014752

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    TCM
    Harness connector F8
    Harness connector E8
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of TCM.
    Check the resistance between the TCM harness connector terminals.
    TCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    F44

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    33

    23

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the TCM branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the TCM. Refer to TM-211, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the TCM. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the TCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-42

    2014 Note

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009553799

    WARNING:
    Always observe the following items for preventing accidental activation.
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    B

    C

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the air bag diagnosis sensor unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the main harness.

    2.CHECK AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    Check the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SRC-21, «Work Flow».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the main harness.
    NO
    >> Replace parts whose air bag system has a malfunction.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-43

    2014 Note

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009553800

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the AV control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of AV control unit.
    Check the resistance between the AV control unit harness connector terminals.
    AV control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M70

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    8

    17

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the AV control unit branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the AV control unit. Refer to AV-153, «AV CONTROL UNIT :
    Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the AV control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-44

    2014 Note

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014753

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the data link connector for damage, bend and loose connection
    (connector side and harness side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    E

    Check the resistance between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.
    M22

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    6

    D

    14

    F

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the data link connector branch line circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair the data link connector branch line.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-45

    2014 Note

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014754

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the EPS control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of EPS control unit.
    Check the resistance between the EPS control unit harness connector terminals.
    EPS control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M53

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    2

    1

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the EPS control unit branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the EPS control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-46

    2014 Note

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014755

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the combination meter for damage, bend and loose connection
    (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of combination meter.
    Check the resistance between the combination meter harness connector terminals.
    Combination meter harness connector
    Connector No.
    M24

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    1

    2

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the combination meter branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the combination meter. Refer to MWI-39, «COMBINATION
    METER : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the combination meter branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-47

    2014 Note

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014757

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the BCM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of BCM.
    Check the resistance between the BCM harness connector terminals.
    BCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    M18

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the BCM branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the BCM. Refer to BCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the BCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-48

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009014758

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION

    B

    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect all the unit connectors on CAN communication system.
    4. Check terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    C

    D

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    E

    Check the continuity between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    M22

    6

    14

    F

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    G

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    H

    Check the continuity between the data link connector and the ground.
    I

    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    Ground

    6

    M22

    14

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    K

    4.CHECK ECM AND BCM TERMINATION CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    LAN

    ECM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.

    3.

    L

    Remove the ECM and the BCM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM terminals.

    84

    J

    Not existed

    83

    N

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Check the resistance between the BCM terminals.
    O

    BCM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    Approx. 108 – 132

    P

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace the ECM and/or the BCM.

    5.CHECK SYMPTOM

    Connect all the connectors. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom (Results from interview with
    customer)” are reproduced.
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-49

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>GO TO 6.
    Non-reproduced>>Start the diagnosis again. Follow the trouble diagnosis procedure when past error is
    detected.

    6.CHECK UNIT REPRODUCTION

    Perform the reproduction test as per the following procedure for each unit.
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect one of the unit connectors of CAN communication system.
    NOTE:
    ECM and BCM have a termination circuit. Check other units first.
    4. Connect the battery cable to the negative terminal. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom
    (Results from interview with customer)” are reproduced.
    NOTE:
    Although unit-related error symptoms occur, do not confuse them with other symptoms.
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>Connect the connector. Check other units as per the above procedure.
    Non-reproduced>>Replace the unit whose connector was disconnected.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-50

    2014 Note

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644555

    B

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (connector side
    and harness side).
    Harness connector E7
    Harness connector M69
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    C

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.

    Connector No.

    Terminal No.
    62

    E46

    61

    E

    F

    Disconnect the following harness connectors.
    IPDM E/R
    Harness connectors E7 and M69
    Check the continuity between the IPDM E/R harness connector and the harness connector.
    IPDM E/R harness connector

    D

    Harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.

    E7

    G

    Continuity

    21A

    Existed

    20A

    Existed

    H

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the IPDM E/R and the harness connector E7.

    J

    Check the continuity between the harness connector and the data link connector.

    K

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    Harness connector
    Connector No.
    M69

    Data link connector

    Terminal No.
    21A
    20A

    Connector No.
    M22

    Terminal No.

    Continuity

    6

    Existed

    14

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the main line between the IPDM E/R and the data link connector.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the harness connector M69 and the data link connector.

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-51

    2014 Note

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554630

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ECM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of ECM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM harness connector terminals.
    ECM harness connector
    Connector No.
    E16

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    83

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ECM branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ECM. Refer to EC-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ECM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-52

    2014 Note

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554631

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) for damage, bend
    and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    Check the resistance between the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector terminals.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector
    Connector No.
    E33

    E

    F

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    11

    D

    10

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to
    BRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal
    and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-53

    2014 Note

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554632

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the IPDM E/R for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side
    and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of IPDM E/R.
    Check the resistance between the IPDM E/R harness connector terminals.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.
    E46

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    62

    61

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the IPDM E/R branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the IPDM E/R branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-54

    2014 Note

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554633

    WARNING:
    Always observe the following items for preventing accidental activation.
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    B

    C

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the air bag diagnosis sensor unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the main harness.

    2.CHECK AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    Check the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SRC-21, «Work Flow».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the main harness.
    NO
    >> Replace parts whose air bag system has a malfunction.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-55

    2014 Note

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554634

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the data link connector for damage, bend and loose connection
    (connector side and harness side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check the resistance between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.
    M22

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    6

    14

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the data link connector branch line circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair the data link connector branch line.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-56

    2014 Note

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554635

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the EPS control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of EPS control unit.
    Check the resistance between the EPS control unit harness connector terminals.
    EPS control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M53

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    2

    1

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the EPS control unit branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the EPS control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-57

    2014 Note

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554636

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the combination meter for damage, bend and loose connection
    (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of combination meter.
    Check the resistance between the combination meter harness connector terminals.
    Combination meter harness connector
    Connector No.
    M24

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    1

    2

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the combination meter branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the combination meter. Refer to MWI-39, «COMBINATION
    METER : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the combination meter branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-58

    2014 Note

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554637

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the BCM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of BCM.
    Check the resistance between the BCM harness connector terminals.
    BCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    M18

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    D

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the BCM branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the BCM. Refer to BCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the BCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-59

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644558

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect all the unit connectors on CAN communication system.
    4. Check terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    M22

    6

    14

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the data link connector and the ground.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    Ground

    6

    M22

    14

    Not existed
    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    4.CHECK ECM AND BCM TERMINATION CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Remove the ECM and the BCM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM terminals.
    ECM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    3.

    83

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Check the resistance between the BCM terminals.
    BCM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace the ECM and/or the BCM.

    5.CHECK SYMPTOM

    Connect all the connectors. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom (Results from interview with
    customer)” are reproduced.
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-60

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 503)]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>GO TO 6.
    Non-reproduced>>Start the diagnosis again. Follow the trouble diagnosis procedure when past error is
    detected.

    6.CHECK UNIT REPRODUCTION

    A

    B

    Perform the reproduction test as per the following procedure for each unit.
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect one of the unit connectors of CAN communication system.
    NOTE:
    ECM and BCM have a termination circuit. Check other units first.
    4. Connect the battery cable to the negative terminal. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom
    (Results from interview with customer)” are reproduced.
    NOTE:
    Although unit-related error symptoms occur, do not confuse them with other symptoms.
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>Connect the connector. Check other units as per the above procedure.
    Non-reproduced>>Replace the unit whose connector was disconnected.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-61

    2014 Note

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644559

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (connector side
    and harness side).
    Harness connector E7
    Harness connector M69
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the following harness connectors.
    IPDM E/R
    Harness connectors E7 and M69
    Check the continuity between the IPDM E/R harness connector and the harness connector.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.
    62

    E46

    61

    Harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.

    E7

    Continuity

    21A

    Existed

    20A

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the IPDM E/R and the harness connector E7.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the harness connector and the data link connector.
    Harness connector
    Connector No.
    M69

    Data link connector

    Terminal No.
    21A
    20A

    Connector No.
    M22

    Terminal No.

    Continuity

    6

    Existed

    14

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the main line between the IPDM E/R and the data link connector.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the harness connector M69 and the data link connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-62

    2014 Note

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554770

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ECM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of ECM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM harness connector terminals.
    ECM harness connector
    Connector No.
    E16

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    83

    D

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ECM branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ECM. Refer to EC-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ECM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-63

    2014 Note

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554771

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) for damage, bend
    and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    Check the resistance between the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector terminals.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector
    Connector No.
    E33

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    11

    10

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to
    BRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal
    and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-64

    2014 Note

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554772

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the IPDM E/R for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side
    and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of IPDM E/R.
    Check the resistance between the IPDM E/R harness connector terminals.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.
    E46

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    62

    61

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the IPDM E/R branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the IPDM E/R branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-65

    2014 Note

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554773

    WARNING:
    Always observe the following items for preventing accidental activation.
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the air bag diagnosis sensor unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the main harness.

    2.CHECK AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    Check the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SRC-21, «Work Flow».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the main harness.
    NO
    >> Replace parts whose air bag system has a malfunction.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-66

    2014 Note

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554774

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the AV control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of AV control unit.
    Check the resistance between the AV control unit harness connector terminals.
    AV control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M70

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    8

    17

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the AV control unit branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the AV control unit. Refer to AV-153, «AV CONTROL UNIT :
    Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the AV control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-67

    2014 Note

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554775

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the data link connector for damage, bend and loose connection
    (connector side and harness side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check the resistance between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.
    M22

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    6

    14

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the data link connector branch line circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair the data link connector branch line.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-68

    2014 Note

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554776

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the EPS control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of EPS control unit.
    Check the resistance between the EPS control unit harness connector terminals.
    EPS control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M53

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    2

    1

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the EPS control unit branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the EPS control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-69

    2014 Note

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554777

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the combination meter for damage, bend and loose connection
    (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of combination meter.
    Check the resistance between the combination meter harness connector terminals.
    Combination meter harness connector
    Connector No.
    M24

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    1

    2

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the combination meter branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the combination meter. Refer to MWI-39, «COMBINATION
    METER : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the combination meter branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-70

    2014 Note

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554778

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the BCM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of BCM.
    Check the resistance between the BCM harness connector terminals.
    BCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    M18

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    D

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the BCM branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the BCM. Refer to BCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the BCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-71

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644560

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect all the unit connectors on CAN communication system.
    4. Check terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    M22

    6

    14

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the data link connector and the ground.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    Ground

    6

    M22

    14

    Not existed
    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    4.CHECK ECM AND BCM TERMINATION CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Remove the ECM and the BCM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM terminals.
    ECM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    3.

    83

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Check the resistance between the BCM terminals.
    BCM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace the ECM and/or the BCM.

    5.CHECK SYMPTOM

    Connect all the connectors. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom (Results from interview with
    customer)” are reproduced.
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-72

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 504)]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>GO TO 6.
    Non-reproduced>>Start the diagnosis again. Follow the trouble diagnosis procedure when past error is
    detected.

    6.CHECK UNIT REPRODUCTION

    A

    B

    Perform the reproduction test as per the following procedure for each unit.
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect one of the unit connectors of CAN communication system.
    NOTE:
    ECM and BCM have a termination circuit. Check other units first.
    4. Connect the battery cable to the negative terminal. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom
    (Results from interview with customer)” are reproduced.
    NOTE:
    Although unit-related error symptoms occur, do not confuse them with other symptoms.
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>Connect the connector. Check other units as per the above procedure.
    Non-reproduced>>Replace the unit whose connector was disconnected.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-73

    2014 Note

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644561

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (connector side
    and harness side).
    Harness connector E7
    Harness connector M69
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the following harness connectors.
    IPDM E/R
    Harness connectors E7 and M69
    Check the continuity between the IPDM E/R harness connector and the harness connector.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.
    62

    E46

    61

    Harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.

    E7

    Continuity

    21A

    Existed

    20A

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the IPDM E/R and the harness connector E7.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the harness connector and the data link connector.
    Harness connector
    Connector No.
    M69

    Data link connector

    Terminal No.
    21A
    20A

    Connector No.
    M22

    Terminal No.

    Continuity

    6

    Existed

    14

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the main line between the IPDM E/R and the data link connector.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the harness connector M69 and the data link connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-74

    2014 Note

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554818

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ECM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of ECM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM harness connector terminals.
    ECM harness connector
    Connector No.
    E16

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    83

    D

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ECM branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ECM. Refer to EC-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ECM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-75

    2014 Note

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554819

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) for damage, bend
    and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    Check the resistance between the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector terminals.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector
    Connector No.
    E33

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    11

    10

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to
    BRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal
    and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-76

    2014 Note

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554820

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the IPDM E/R for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side
    and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of IPDM E/R.
    Check the resistance between the IPDM E/R harness connector terminals.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.
    E46

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    62

    61

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the IPDM E/R branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the IPDM E/R branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-77

    2014 Note

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554821

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    TCM
    Harness connector F8
    Harness connector E8
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of TCM.
    Check the resistance between the TCM harness connector terminals.
    TCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    F44

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    33

    23

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the TCM branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the TCM. Refer to TM-211, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the TCM. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the TCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-78

    2014 Note

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554822

    WARNING:
    Always observe the following items for preventing accidental activation.
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    B

    C

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the air bag diagnosis sensor unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the main harness.

    2.CHECK AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    Check the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SRC-21, «Work Flow».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the main harness.
    NO
    >> Replace parts whose air bag system has a malfunction.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-79

    2014 Note

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554823

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the data link connector for damage, bend and loose connection
    (connector side and harness side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    Check the resistance between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.
    M22

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    6

    14

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the data link connector branch line circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair the data link connector branch line.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-80

    2014 Note

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554824

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the EPS control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of EPS control unit.
    Check the resistance between the EPS control unit harness connector terminals.
    EPS control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M53

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    2

    1

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the EPS control unit branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the EPS control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-81

    2014 Note

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009554825

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the combination meter for damage, bend and loose connection
    (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of combination meter.
    Check the resistance between the combination meter harness connector terminals.
    Combination meter harness connector
    Connector No.
    M24

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    1

    2

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the combination meter branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the combination meter. Refer to MWI-39, «COMBINATION
    METER : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the combination meter branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-82

    2014 Note

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555071

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the BCM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of BCM.
    Check the resistance between the BCM harness connector terminals.
    BCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    M18

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    D

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the BCM branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the BCM. Refer to BCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the BCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-83

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644562

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect all the unit connectors on CAN communication system.
    4. Check terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    M22

    6

    14

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the data link connector and the ground.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    Ground

    6

    M22

    14

    Not existed
    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    4.CHECK ECM AND BCM TERMINATION CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Remove the ECM and the BCM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM terminals.
    ECM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    3.

    83

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Check the resistance between the BCM terminals.
    BCM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace the ECM and/or the BCM.

    5.CHECK SYMPTOM

    Connect all the connectors. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom (Results from interview with
    customer)” are reproduced.
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-84

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 505)]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>GO TO 6.
    Non-reproduced>>Start the diagnosis again. Follow the trouble diagnosis procedure when past error is
    detected.

    6.CHECK UNIT REPRODUCTION

    A

    B

    Perform the reproduction test as per the following procedure for each unit.
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect one of the unit connectors of CAN communication system.
    NOTE:
    ECM and BCM have a termination circuit. Check other units first.
    4. Connect the battery cable to the negative terminal. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom
    (Results from interview with customer)” are reproduced.
    NOTE:
    Although unit-related error symptoms occur, do not confuse them with other symptoms.
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>Connect the connector. Check other units as per the above procedure.
    Non-reproduced>>Replace the unit whose connector was disconnected.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-85

    2014 Note

    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    MAIN LINE BETWEEN IPDM-E AND DLC CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644564

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (connector side
    and harness side).
    Harness connector E7
    Harness connector M69
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the following harness connectors.
    IPDM E/R
    Harness connectors E7 and M69
    Check the continuity between the IPDM E/R harness connector and the harness connector.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.
    62

    E46

    61

    Harness connector
    Connector No.

    Terminal No.

    E7

    Continuity

    21A

    Existed

    20A

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the IPDM E/R and the harness connector E7.

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)

    Check the continuity between the harness connector and the data link connector.
    Harness connector
    Connector No.
    M69

    Data link connector

    Terminal No.
    21A
    20A

    Connector No.
    M22

    Terminal No.

    Continuity

    6

    Existed

    14

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the main line between the IPDM E/R and the data link connector.
    NO
    >> Repair the main line between the harness connector M69 and the data link connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-86

    2014 Note

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ECM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555072

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ECM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of ECM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM harness connector terminals.
    ECM harness connector
    Connector No.
    E16

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    84

    83

    D

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ECM branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ECM. Refer to EC-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ECM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-87

    2014 Note

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    ABS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555073

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) for damage, bend
    and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    Check the resistance between the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector terminals.
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) harness connector
    Connector No.
    E33

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    11

    10

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to
    BRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit). Refer to BRC-73, «Removal
    and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-88

    2014 Note

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    IPDM-E BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555074

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the IPDM E/R for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side
    and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of IPDM E/R.
    Check the resistance between the IPDM E/R harness connector terminals.
    IPDM E/R harness connector
    Connector No.
    E46

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    62

    61

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the IPDM E/R branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the IPDM E/R branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-89

    2014 Note

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    TCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555075

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the following terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    TCM
    Harness connector F8
    Harness connector E8
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of TCM.
    Check the resistance between the TCM harness connector terminals.
    TCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    F44

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    33

    23

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the TCM branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the TCM. Refer to TM-211, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the TCM. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the TCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-90

    2014 Note

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A-BAG BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555076

    WARNING:
    Always observe the following items for preventing accidental activation.
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    B

    C

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the air bag diagnosis sensor unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the main harness.

    2.CHECK AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    Check the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SRC-21, «Work Flow».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the main harness.
    NO
    >> Replace parts whose air bag system has a malfunction.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-91

    2014 Note

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    AV BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555077

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the AV control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of AV control unit.
    Check the resistance between the AV control unit harness connector terminals.
    AV control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M70

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    8

    17

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the AV control unit branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the AV control unit. Refer to AV-153, «AV CONTROL UNIT :
    Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the AV control unit. Refer to AV-178, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the AV control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-92

    2014 Note

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DLC BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555078

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the data link connector for damage, bend and loose connection
    (connector side and harness side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    E

    Check the resistance between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.
    M22

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    6

    D

    14

    F

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES (Present error)>>Check CAN system type decision again.
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the data link connector branch line circuit.
    NO
    >> Repair the data link connector branch line.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-93

    2014 Note

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    EPS BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555079

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the EPS control unit for damage, bend and loose connection (unit
    side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of EPS control unit.
    Check the resistance between the EPS control unit harness connector terminals.
    EPS control unit harness connector
    Connector No.
    M53

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    2

    1

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the EPS control unit branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the EPS control unit branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-94

    2014 Note

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    M&A BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555080

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the combination meter for damage, bend and loose connection
    (unit side and connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    E

    Disconnect the connector of combination meter.
    Check the resistance between the combination meter harness connector terminals.
    Combination meter harness connector
    Connector No.
    M24

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    1

    2

    D

    Approx. 54 – 66

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the combination meter branch line.

    F

    G

    H

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the combination meter. Refer to MWI-39, «COMBINATION
    METER : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the combination meter branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    LAN

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-95

    2014 Note

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BCM BRANCH LINE CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009555081

    1.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    Check the terminals and connectors of the BCM for damage, bend and loose connection (unit side and
    connector side).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    2.CHECK HARNESS FOR OPEN CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the connector of BCM.
    Check the resistance between the BCM harness connector terminals.
    BCM harness connector
    Connector No.
    M18

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair the BCM branch line.

    3.CHECK POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check the power supply and the ground circuit of the BCM. Refer to BCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES (Present error)>>Replace the BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    YES (Past error)>>Error was detected in the BCM branch line.
    NO
    >> Repair the power supply and the ground circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-96

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009644565

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION

    B

    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect all the unit connectors on CAN communication system.
    4. Check terminals and connectors for damage, bend and loose connection.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair the terminal and connector.

    C

    D

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    E

    Check the continuity between the data link connector terminals.
    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    M22

    6

    14

    F

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    G

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (SHORT CIRCUIT)

    H

    Check the continuity between the data link connector and the ground.
    I

    Data link connector
    Connector No.

    Continuity

    Terminal No.

    Ground

    6

    M22

    14

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Check the harness and repair the root cause.

    K

    4.CHECK ECM AND BCM TERMINATION CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    LAN

    ECM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.

    3.

    L

    Remove the ECM and the BCM.
    Check the resistance between the ECM terminals.

    84

    J

    Not existed

    83

    N

    Approx. 108 – 132

    Check the resistance between the BCM terminals.
    O

    BCM

    Resistance (Ω)

    Terminal No.
    39

    40

    Approx. 108 – 132

    P

    Is the measurement value within the specification?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace the ECM and/or the BCM.

    5.CHECK SYMPTOM

    Connect all the connectors. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom (Results from interview with
    customer)” are reproduced.
    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-97

    2014 Note

    CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
    [CAN SYSTEM (TYPE 506)]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>GO TO 6.
    Non-reproduced>>Start the diagnosis again. Follow the trouble diagnosis procedure when past error is
    detected.

    6.CHECK UNIT REPRODUCTION

    Perform the reproduction test as per the following procedure for each unit.
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    3. Disconnect one of the unit connectors of CAN communication system.
    NOTE:
    ECM and BCM have a termination circuit. Check other units first.
    4. Connect the battery cable to the negative terminal. Check if the symptoms described in the “Symptom
    (Results from interview with customer)” are reproduced.
    NOTE:
    Although unit-related error symptoms occur, do not confuse them with other symptoms.
    Inspection result
    Reproduced>>Connect the connector. Check other units as per the above procedure.
    Non-reproduced>>Replace the unit whose connector was disconnected.

    Revision: April 2013

    LAN-98

    2014 Note

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    LU

    ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM

    A

    LU

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    HR16DE
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    Draining ………………………………………………………….. 8
    Refilling …………………………………………………………… 8

    OIL FILTER ………………………………………………. 10
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..10
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….10

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Liquid Gasket …………………………………………………… 2

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 11

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4

    Exploded View …………………………………………………11
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..11

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 4
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 4

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 5
    DESCRIPTION ……………………………………………. 5
    Engine Lubrication System ………………………………… 5
    Engine Lubrication System Schematic …………………. 6

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 7

    F

    G

    H

    OIL PUMP ………………………………………………… 11
    I

    OIL COOLER ……………………………………………. 13
    Exploded View …………………………………………………13
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..13

    J

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 15

    K

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 15

    L

    ENGINE OIL ……………………………………………….. 7

    Periodical Maintenance Specification ………………….15
    Engine Oil Pressure ………………………………………….15
    M

    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 7

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [HR16DE]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009561113

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Liquid Gasket

    INFOID:0000000009654175

    REMOVAL OF LIQUID GASKET SEALING
    • After removing the bolts and nuts, separate the mating surface and
    remove the liquid gasket using Tool (A).
    Tool Number

    : KV10111100 (J-37228)

    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to damage the mating surfaces.
    • In areas where the cutter is difficult to use, use a plastic hammer to
    lightly tap (1) the cutter where the liquid gasket is applied. Use a
    plastic hammer to slide (2) the cutter by tapping on the side.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the mating surfaces.

    AWBIA1249GB

    LIQUID GASKET APPLICATION PROCEDURE
    1.

    2.

    Using suitable tool (A), remove old liquid gasket adhering to the
    liquid gasket application surface and the mating surface.
    • Remove liquid gasket completely from the groove of the liquid
    gasket application surface, mounting bolts, and bolt holes.
    Wipe the liquid gasket application surface and the mating surface with white gasoline (lighting and heating use) to remove
    adhering moisture, grease and foreign materials.

    JPBIA0053ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    3. Attach liquid gasket tube to the suitable tool.
    Use Genuine Silicone RTV Sealant, or equivalent. Refer to
    GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».
    4. Apply liquid gasket without gaps to the specified location according to the specified dimensions.
    • If there is a groove for liquid gasket application, apply liquid
    gasket to the groove.

    [HR16DE]
    A

    LU

    C
    EMA0622D

    D

    • As for bolt holes (B), normally apply liquid gasket inside the
    holes. Occasionally, it should be applied outside the holes.
    Check to read the text of this manual.
    (A)

    E

    : Groove
    : Inside

    F

    • Within five minutes of liquid gasket application, install the mating component.
    • If liquid gasket protrudes, wipe it off immediately.
    • Do not retighten mounting bolts or nuts after the installation.
    JPBIA0010ZZ
    • After 30 minutes or more have passed from the installation, fill
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    CAUTION:
    If there are specific instructions in the procedures contained in this manual concerning liquid gasket application, observe them.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [HR16DE]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009444894

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV10111100
    (J-37228)
    Seat cutter

    Removing oil pan (lower) etc.

    NT046

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009444895

    Tool name

    Description

    Deep socket

    Removing and installing oil pressure sensor
    27 mm (1.06 in)

    PBIC4066E

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Tube presser

    Pressing the tube of liquid gasket

    NT052

    KV10115801
    (J-38956)
    Oil filter wrench

    Removing oil filter
    64.3 mm (2.531 in)

    S-NT375

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-4

    2014 Note

    DESCRIPTION
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    DESCRIPTION
    Engine Lubrication System

    INFOID:0000000009561116

    LU

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    ALBIA1142ZZ

    1.

    Exhaust camshaft

    Intake valve timing controller

    3.

    Exhaust valve timing controller

    4.

    Exhaust valve timing control solenoid 5.
    valve

    2.

    Exhaust timing control oil filter

    6.

    Chain tensioner

    7.

    Chain oil jet

    Oil strainer

    9.

    Oil pump

    8.

    J

    K

    10. Oil cooler

    11. Oil filter

    13. Piston oil jet

    14. Intake valve timing control oil filter 15. Intake valve timing control solenoid
    valve

    12. Main bearing

    16. Intake camshaft

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-5

    2014 Note

    DESCRIPTION
    [HR16DE]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Engine Lubrication System Schematic

    INFOID:0000000009444897

    AWBIA1597ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-6

    2014 Note

    ENGINE OIL
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    ENGINE OIL
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009444898

    LU

    ENGINE OIL LEVEL
    NOTE:
    Before starting engine, position the vehicle so that it is level and check the engine oil level. If engine is already
    started, stop it and allow 10 minutes before checking.
    1. Pull out oil level gauge and wipe it clean.
    2. Insert oil level gauge and check that the engine oil level is within
    the range (A) as shown.
    3. If it is out of range, adjust it.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JPBIA0554ZZ

    ENGINE OIL APPEARANCE
    • Check engine oil for white milky appearance or excessive contamination.
    • If engine oil becomes turbid and white, it is highly probable that it is contaminated with engine coolant.
    Repair or replace damaged parts.

    H

    ENGINE OIL LEAKS

    I

    Check for engine oil leaks around the following areas:
    • Oil pan (upper and lower)
    • Oil pan drain plug
    • Oil pressure sensor
    • Oil filter
    • Oil cooler
    • Oil level sensor
    • Engine oil temperature sensor
    • Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
    • Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve
    • Mating surface between front cover and rocker cover
    • Mating surface between cylinder block and cylinder head
    • Mating surface between cylinder head and rocker cover
    • Crankshaft oil seals (front and rear)
    • Front cover

    J

    K

    L

    M

    ENGINE OIL PRESSURE CHECK
    WARNING:
    • Be careful not to burn yourself, as engine oil may be hot.
    • When checking engine oil pressure, shift selector should be in the «P» (Park) or «N» (Neutral) position, and apply parking brake securely.
    1. Check engine oil level.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-7

    2014 Note

    ENGINE OIL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    2. Disconnect harness connector at oil pressure switch. Remove
    oil pressure switch using suitable tool and install suitable tools
    (A/B).
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock oil pressure switch.

    [HR16DE]

    JPBIA0074ZZ

    3.
    4.

    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Check engine oil pressure with engine running under no-load.
    NOTE:
    • When engine oil temperature is low, engine oil pressure becomes high.
    • If difference is extreme, check oil passage and oil pump for engine oil leaks.
    Engine oil pressure

    5.
    a.
    b.

    After the inspections, install oil pressure switch as follows:
    Remove old liquid gasket adhering to oil pressure switch and engine.
    Apply liquid gasket and tighten oil pressure switch to specification.
    Use Genuine Liquid Gasket or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and
    Sealants».
    Tightening torque

    6.
    7.

    : Refer to LU-15, «Engine Oil Pressure».

    : Refer to LU-11, «Exploded View».

    Check engine oil level.
    After warming up engine, check that there is no engine oil leaks with the running engine.

    Draining

    INFOID:0000000009444899

    WARNING:
    • Be careful not to get burned, as engine oil may be hot.
    • Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer. Try to avoid direct skin
    contact with used engine oil. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as
    soon as possible.
    1. Warm up the engine, park the vehicle on a level surface and check for engine oil leaks. Refer to LU-7,
    «Inspection».
    2. Stop the engine and wait for 10 minutes.
    3. Loosen oil filler cap.
    4. Remove drain plug and then drain engine oil.

    Refilling
    1.

    2.

    INFOID:0000000009444900

    Install drain plug with new copper sealing washer. Refer to EM-34, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to clean drain plug.
    • Do not reuse copper sealing washer.
    Refill with new engine oil.
    Engine oil capacity and viscosity

    : Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    CAUTION:
    • The refill capacity depends on the engine oil temperature and drain time. Use these specifications for reference only.
    • Always use oil level gauge to determine the proper amount of engine oil in the engine.
    Revision: April 2013

    LU-8

    2014 Note

    ENGINE OIL
    [HR16DE]
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    3. Warm up engine and check area around drain plug and oil filter for engine oil leaks. Repair as necessary.
    4. Stop engine and wait for 10 minutes.
    5. Check the engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».

    A

    LU

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-9

    2014 Note

    OIL FILTER
    [HR16DE]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    OIL FILTER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444901

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Drain engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Draining».
    Remove oil filter using suitable tool (A).
    : Front
    WARNING:
    Be careful not to get burned; engine and engine oil may be
    hot.
    CAUTION:
    • When removing, prepare a shop cloth to absorb engine oil
    leaks and spills.
    • Do not spill engine oil on drive belt.
    • Completely wipe off any engine oil that spills on engine
    and vehicle.
    • Oil filter is provided with relief valve. Use Genuine NISSAN oil filter or equivalent.

    JSBIA0620ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Remove foreign materials adhering to the oil filter installation surface.
    Apply new engine oil to the oil seal contact surface of new oil filter.

    SMA010

    3.

    Screw oil filter manually until it touches the installation surface,
    then tighten it by 2/3 turn (A), or tighten to specification.
    Oil filter

    : 17.7 N·m (1.8 kg-m, 13 ft-lb)

    JPBIA0077ZZ

    4.

    Refill engine with new engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Refilling».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009444902

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.

    Check the engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-10

    2014 Note

    OIL PUMP
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    OIL PUMP
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009643047

    LU

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    AWBIA1595ZZ

    1.

    Rear oil seal

    2.

    O-ring

    3.

    Oil pan (upper)

    4.

    Oil pump chain tensioner (for oil
    pump drive chain)

    5.

    Oil pump drive chain

    6.

    Crankshaft key

    7.

    Crankshaft sprocket

    8.

    Oil pump sprocket

    9.

    Oil pump

    10. O-ring

    11. O-ring

    12. Oil pan drain plug

    13. Drain plug washer

    14. Oil pan (lower)

    15. Oil filter

    16. Connector bolt

    17. Oil cooler

    18. O-ring

    19. Relief valve

    A.

    B.

    C.

    Refer to LU-11

    K

    L

    M

    Refer to LU-10

    N

    Oil pan (lower) side

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009444904

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Drain engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Draining».
    Remove timing chain and oil pump drive chain. Refer to EM-51, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-11

    P

    2014 Note

    OIL PUMP
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Loosen the oil pump bolts in the reverse order as shown.
    4. Remove oil pump and O-rings.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Do not disassemble oil pump.

    AWBIA1122GB

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Install new O-rings on the oil pan (upper) before installing the oil pump. Refer to EM-34, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings.
    Install the oil pump.
    Tighten the oil pump bolts to specification in the order shown.
    Install timing chain and oil pump drive chain. Refer to EM-51,
    «Removal and Installation».
    Refill engine with new engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Refilling».

    AWBIA1122GB

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels, including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-12

    2014 Note

    OIL COOLER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    OIL COOLER

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009643048

    LU

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J
    AWBIA1596ZZ

    1.

    Radiator hose (upper)

    2.

    Hose clamp

    3.

    Water hose

    4.

    Radiator hose (lower)

    5.

    Connector bolt

    6.

    Oil cooler

    7.

    O-ring

    8.

    Relief valve

    9.

    Water hose

    A.

    To radiator (upper side)

    B.

    To radiator (lower side)

    Removal and Installation

    K

    L
    INFOID:0000000009444906

    M

    REMOVAL
    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the radiator cap. Slowly turn it a
    quarter of a turn to release built-up pressure. Carefully remove radiator cap by turning it all the way.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    1. Drain engine oil. Refer to LU-8, «Draining».
    2. Drain engine coolant. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    3. Remove oil filter. Refer to LU-10, «Removal and Installation».
    4. Remove water hoses from the oil cooler.
    5. Remove oil cooler and O-ring.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-rings.
    Revision: April 2013

    LU-13

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    OIL COOLER
    [HR16DE]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL

    Oil Cooler
    Check oil cooler for cracks. Check oil cooler for clogging by blowing compressed air through engine coolant
    inlet. If necessary, replace oil cooler.
    Relief Valve
    Inspect relief valve for movement, cracks and breaks by pushing the ball. If replacement is necessary, remove
    the valve by prying it out using a suitable tool. Install a new valve by tapping it in place.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Ensure that no foreign objects are adhering to the sealing surfaces of the oil cooler and oil pan (upper).
    • Tighten connector bolt after aligning cutout (1) on oil cooler with
    protrusion (2) on oil pan (upper) side.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    • Replace relief valve if removed.

    AWBIA1139GB

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels, including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels, including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-14

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [HR16DE]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Periodical Maintenance Specification

    INFOID:0000000009444907

    LU

    (US qt, lmp qt)

    C

    ENGINE OIL CAPACITY (APPROXIMATE)
    Unit:

    Drain and refill

    With oil filter change

    3.5 (3 3/4, 3 1/8)

    Without oil filter change

    3.2 (3 3/8, 2 7/8)

    Dry engine (Overhaul)

    3.5 (3 3/4, 3 1/8)

    Engine Oil Pressure

    D

    INFOID:0000000009444908

    E
    Unit: kPa (kg/cm2, psi)

    Approximate discharge pressure*

    Engine Speed

    M/T

    600 rpm

    F

    CVT
    More than 98 (1.0, 14.2)
    More than 294 (3.0, 42.6)
    More than 392 (4.0, 56.8)

    2,000 rpm
    6,000 rpm

    G

    *: Engine oil temperature at 80°C (176°F).

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    LU-15

    2014 Note

    MAINTENANCE

    SECTION

    MA

    MAINTENANCE

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 4
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 4

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 5
    GENERAL MAINTENANCE ………………………….. 5
    General Maintenance ………………………………………… 5

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ………………………….. 7
    FOR MEXICO …………………………………………………….. 7
    FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance …………………. 7
    EXCEPT FOR MEXICO ……………………………………….. 9
    EXCEPT FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance …… 9

    RECOMMENDED FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS ……………………………………………………….12
    Fluids and Lubricants ………………………………………. 12
    SAE Viscosity Number …………………………………….. 12
    Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio …………………………… 13

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE ……………………………..14
    DRIVE BELT …………………………………………………….. 14
    DRIVE BELT : Exploded View ………………………….. 14
    DRIVE BELT : Removal and Installation …………….. 14
    DRIVE BELT : Inspection …………………………………. 15
    DRIVE BELT : Adjustment ……………………………….. 15
    ENGINE COOLANT …………………………………………… 16
    ENGINE COOLANT : Inspection ……………………….. 16
    ENGINE COOLANT : Draining Engine Coolant …… 17

    Revision: April 2013

    ENGINE COOLANT : Refilling ……………………………17
    ENGINE COOLANT : Flushing Cooling System ……19

    F

    FUEL LINES ………………………………………………………19
    FUEL LINES : Inspection …………………………………..19

    G

    AIR CLEANER FILTER ………………………………………19
    AIR CLEANER FILTER : Exploded View …………….20
    AIR CLEANER FILTER : Removal and Installation
    ….20

    H

    I

    ENGINE OIL ………………………………………………………21
    ENGINE OIL : Inspection …………………………………..21
    ENGINE OIL : Draining ……………………………………..22
    ENGINE OIL : Refilling ……………………………………..22

    J

    OIL FILTER ……………………………………………………….23
    OIL FILTER : Removal and Installation ……………….23
    OIL FILTER : Inspection ……………………………………24

    K

    SPARK PLUG ……………………………………………………24
    SPARK PLUG : Exploded View ………………………….24
    SPARK PLUG : Removal and Installation ……………24
    EVAP VAPOR LINES …………………………………………26
    EVAP VAPOR LINES : Inspection ………………………26

    L

    M

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE ……….. 27
    EXHAUST SYSTEM ……………………………………………27
    EXHAUST SYSTEM : Inspection ……………………….27
    CVT FLUID ………………………………………………………..27
    CVT FLUID : Inspection …………………………………….27
    CVT FLUID : Replacement ………………………………..27
    CVT FLUID : Adjustment …………………………………..29
    CLUTCH FLUID …………………………………………………30
    CLUTCH FLUID : Inspection ……………………………..30
    CLUTCH FLUID : Draining ………………………………..30
    CLUTCH FLUID : Refilling …………………………………31
    CLUTCH FLUID : Air Bleeding …………………………..32
    GEAR OIL …………………………………………………………33

    MA-1

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    MA

    GEAR OIL : Inspection ……………………………………. 33
    GEAR OIL : Draining ………………………………………. 33
    GEAR OIL : Refilling ……………………………………….. 34
    ROAD WHEEL …………………………………………………. 34
    ROAD WHEEL : Inspection ……………………………… 34
    ROAD WHEEL : Adjustment ……………………………. 34
    BRAKE FLUID LEVEL AND LEAKS …………………… 36
    BRAKE FLUID LEVEL AND LEAKS : Inspection … 36
    BRAKE LINES AND CABLES ……………………………. 36
    BRAKE LINES AND CABLES : Inspection …………. 36
    BRAKE FLUID …………………………………………………. 37
    BRAKE FLUID : Inspection ………………………………. 37
    BRAKE FLUID : Draining …………………………………. 37
    BRAKE FLUID : Refilling …………………………………. 37
    BRAKE FLUID : Bleeding Brake System ……………. 38
    BRAKE PAD ……………………………………………………. 38
    BRAKE PAD : Inspection …………………………………. 38
    DISC ROTOR …………………………………………………… 38
    DISC ROTOR : Inspection ……………………………….. 39
    BRAKE LINING ………………………………………………… 39
    BRAKE LINING : Inspection …………………………….. 39

    Revision: April 2013

    BRAKE DRUM …………………………………………………. 40
    BRAKE DRUM : Inspection ………………………………. 40
    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE ……………………… 40
    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE : Inspection …… 40
    AXLE AND SUSPENSION PARTS ……………………… 41
    AXLE AND SUSPENSION PARTS : Inspection ….. 41
    DRIVE SHAFT ………………………………………………….. 41
    DRIVE SHAFT : Inspection ………………………………. 41
    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH ………………… 41
    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded
    View ……………………………………………………………… 42
    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded
    View ……………………………………………………………… 42
    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded
    View ……………………………………………………………… 43
    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded
    View ……………………………………………………………… 43
    SEAT BELT, BUCKLES, RETRACTORS, ANCHORS AND ADJUSTERS ……………………………….. 44
    SEAT BELT, BUCKLES, RETRACTORS, ANCHORS AND ADJUSTERS : Inspection …………….. 44

    MA-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009561082

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    MA

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009417622

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV991J0070
    (J-45695)
    Coolant Refill Tool

    Refilling engine cooling system

    LMA053

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009417623

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    KV10115801
    (J-38956)
    Oil filter wrench

    Removing oil filter
    a: 64.3 mm (2.531 in)

    S-NT375

    Spark plug wrench

    Removing and installing spark plug
    a: 14 mm (0.55 in)

    JPBIA0399ZZ

    Acoustic tension gauge

    Checking drive belt tension

    PBIC3881E

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-4

    2014 Note

    GENERAL MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    GENERAL MAINTENANCE
    General Maintenance

    INFOID:0000000009452294

    General maintenance includes those items which should be checked during the normal day-to-day operation
    of the vehicle. They are essential if the vehicle is to continue operating properly. The owners can perform the
    checks and inspections themselves or they can have their NISSAN dealers do them.

    B

    C

    OUTSIDE THE VEHICLE
    The maintenance items listed here should be performed from time to time, unless otherwise specified.

    Item
    Doors and engine hood

    Lamps

    Tires

    Tire rotation

    Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
    transmitter components
    (if equipped)

    Reference page

    Check that all doors and the engine hood operate smoothly as well as the back door,
    trunk lid and hatch. Also make sure that all latches lock securely. Lubricate if necessary. Make sure that the secondary latch keeps the hood from opening when the primary latch is released. When driving in areas using road salt or other corrosive
    materials, check lubrication frequently.

    MA-42
    MA-42
    MA-43
    MA-43

    Clean the headlamps on a regular basis. Make sure that the headlamps, stop lamps,
    tail lamps, turn signal lamps, and other lamps are all operating properly and installed
    securely. Also check the aim of the headlamps.

    Check the pressure with a gauge often and always prior to long distance trips. Adjust
    the pressure in all tires, including the spare, to the pressure specified. Check carefully
    for damage, cuts or excessive wear.

    WT-9

    In the case that Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) and front & rear tires are same size; Tires
    should be rotated every 10,000 km (6,000 miles). Tires marked with directional indicators can only be rotated between front and rear. Make sure that the directional indicators point in the direction of wheel rotation after the tire rotation is completed.
    In the case that Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) and front & rear tires are same size; Tires
    should be rotated every 5,000 km (3,000 miles). Tires marked with directional indicators can only be rotated between front and rear. Make sure that the directional indicators point in the direction of wheel rotation after the tire rotation is completed.
    In the case that front tires are different size from rear tires; Tires cannot be rotated.
    However, the timing for tire rotation may vary according to your driving habits and the
    road surface conditions.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    WT-5

    I

    J

    K

    Replace the TPMS transmitter grommet seal, valve core and cap when the tires are
    replaced due to wear or age.

    Wheel alignment and
    balance

    If the vehicle should pull to either side while driving on a straight and level road, or if
    you detect uneven or abnormal tire wear, there may be a need for wheel alignment. If
    the steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal highway speeds, wheel balancing may
    be needed.

    FSU-7
    FSU-6
    FSU-8

    Windshield

    Clean the windshield on a regular basis. Check the windshield at least every six
    months for cracks or other damage. Repair as necessary.

    Wiper blades

    Check for cracks or wear if not functioning correctly.

    L

    M

    N

    INSIDE THE VEHICLE
    The maintenance items listed here should be checked on a regular basis, such as when performing periodic maintenance, cleaning the vehicle,
    etc.

    Item

    Reference page

    Accelerator pedal

    Check the pedal for smooth operation and make sure that the pedal does not catch or
    require uneven effort. Keep the floor mats away from the pedal.

    Brake pedal

    Check the pedal for smooth operation and make sure that it attains the proper distance
    from the floor mat when depressed fully. Check the brake booster function. Be sure to
    keep the floor mats away from the pedal.

    BR-15

    Check the parking brake operation regularly. Check that the lever (if equipped) or the
    pedal (if equipped) has the proper travel. Also make sure that the vehicle is held securely on a fairly steep hill when only the parking brake is applied.

    PB-4

    Parking brake

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-5

    2014 Note

    O

    MA

    GENERAL MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Item
    Seat belts

    Steering wheel

    Warning lamps and
    chimes
    Windshield defogger
    Windshield wiper and
    washer

    Reference page

    Check that all parts of the seat belt system (for example, buckles, anchors, adjusters
    and retractors) operate properly and smoothly, and are installed securely. Check the
    belt webbing for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.

    MA-44

    Check for changes in the steering condition, such as excessive play, hard steering or
    strange noises. Check that it has the specified play.
    Free play: Less than 35 mm (1.38 in)

    Make sure that all warning lamps and chimes are operating properly.

    Check that the air comes out of the defogger outlets properly and in good quantity when
    operating the heater or air conditioner.

    Check that the wipers and washer operate properly and that the wipers do not streak.

    UNDER THE HOOD AND VEHICLE
    The maintenance items listed here should be checked periodically (for example, each time you check the engine oil or refuel.)

    Item
    Battery

    Reference page

    Except for maintenance free battery; Check the fluid level in each cell. It should be between the “UPPER” and “LOWER” lines. Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under severe conditions require frequent checks of the battery fluid level.

    PG-60

    Brake (and clutch) fluid
    level(s)

    For Manual Transmission (MT) model; Make sure that the brake and clutch fluid levels
    are between the “MAX” and “MIN” lines on the reservoir(s).
    Except for Manual Transmission (MT) model; Make sure that the brake fluid level is between the “MAX” and “MIN” lines on the reservoir.

    MA-36
    MA-30

    Engine coolant level

    Check the coolant level when the engine is cold. Make sure that the coolant level is between the “MAX” and “MIN” lines on the reservoir.

    CO-8

    Engine drive belt(s)

    Make sure that drive belt(s) is/are not frayed, worn, cracked or oily.

    EM-17

    Engine oil level

    Check the level after parking the vehicle (on a level ground) and turning off the engine.

    LU-7

    Fluid leaks

    Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil, water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle has been
    parked for a while. Water dripping from the air conditioner after use is normal. If you
    should notice any leaks or if fuel fumes are evident, check for cause and have it corrected immediately.

    Check that there is adequate fluid in the reservoir tank.

    Windshield washer fluid

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-6

    2014 Note

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    FOR MEXICO
    FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance

    INFOID:0000000009452295

    The following tables show the normal maintenance schedule. Depending upon weather and atmospheric conditions, varying road surfaces, individual driving habits and vehicle usage, additional or more frequent maintenance may be required.
    Periodic maintenance beyond the last period shown on the tables requires similar maintenance.

    B

    C

    ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL MAINTENANCE (HR16DE ENGINE)
    Abbreviations: I = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary,

    R = Replace,

    MAINTENANCE OPERATION

    E = Check and correct the engine coolant mixture ratio.

    D

    MAINTENANCE INTERVAL

    Perform either at number of kilometers (miles)
    or months, whichever comes first.

    km x 1,000
    (Miles x 1,000)
    Months

    10
    (6)
    6

    20
    (12)
    12

    30
    (18)
    18

    40
    (24)
    24

    50
    (30)
    30

    60
    (36)
    36

    70
    (42)
    42

    80
    (48)
    48

    Reference
    page

    E

    EM-10

    F

    Underhood and under vehicle
    Intake & exhaust valve clearance

    See NOTE (1)

    Drive belts

    See NOTE (2)

    I

    I

    EM-17

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    LU-8

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    LU-10

    E

    E

    CO-8

    Cooling system

    I

    I

    CO-12
    CO-12

    Fuel lines

    I

    I

    FL-5

    Air cleaner filter (Viscous paper type)

    R

    R

    EM-19

    Engine oil (Use recommended oil.)
    Engine oil filter (Use genuine NISSAN engine
    oil filter or equivalent)
    Engine coolant

    See NOTE (3)

    Fuel filter (In-tank type)

    See NOTE (4)

    Spark plugs (Iridium-tipped type)

    Replace every 100,000 km (60,000 miles)

    EVAP vapor lines (With carbon canister)

    I

    H

    I

    J

    EM-21
    I

    EC-336

    NOTE:
    • Maintenance items with “
    tions”.

    G

    K

    ” should be performed more frequently according to “Maintenance Under Severe Driving Condi-

    L

    • (1) Periodic maintenance is not required. However, if valve noise increases, check valve clearance.
    • (2) Replace the drive belts if found damaged.
    • (3) Use Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant (blue) or equivalent in its quality, in order to avoid possible aluminium corrosion within the
    engine cooling system caused by the use of non-genuine engine coolant. Check and correct the engine coolant mixture ratio every
    40,000 km (24,000 miles) or 24 months. First replacement interval is 160,000 km (96,000 miles) or 96 months. After first replacement,
    replace every 80,000 km (48,000 miles) or 48 months.
    • (4) Maintenance-free item.

    M

    N

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE (HR16DE ENGINE)
    Abbreviations: I = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary,

    MAINTENANCE OPERATION
    Perform either at number of kilometers (miles)
    or months, whichever comes first.

    R = Replace.

    MAINTENANCE INTERVAL
    km x 1,000
    (Miles x 1,000)
    Months

    10
    (6)
    6

    20
    (12)
    12

    30
    (18)
    18

    40
    (24)
    24

    50
    (30)
    30

    60
    (36)
    36

    70
    (42)
    42

    80
    (48)
    48

    Reference
    page

    Underhood and under vehicle
    Brake and clutch fluid (For level & leaks)

    I

    I

    I

    I

    BR-11
    CL-6

    Brake line & cable

    I

    I

    I

    I

    MA-36

    Clutch system

    I

    I

    I

    I

    CL-19

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-7

    2014 Note

    O

    MA

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    MAINTENANCE OPERATION

    MAINTENANCE INTERVAL

    Perform either at number of kilometers (miles)
    or months, whichever comes first.

    km x 1,000
    (Miles x 1,000)
    Months

    10
    (6)
    6

    20
    (12)
    12

    30
    (18)
    18

    40
    (24)
    24

    50
    (30)
    30

    60
    (36)
    36

    70
    (42)
    42

    80
    (48)
    48

    Reference
    page

    Exhaust system

    I

    I

    MA-27

    Brake fluid

    R

    R

    MA-36

    CVT fluid (For leaks)

    See NOTE (1)

    Manual transaxle gear oil (For leaks)

    I

    I

    I

    I

    TM-224

    I

    I

    I

    I

    TM-16

    I

    MA-40
    MA-41

    Steering gear & linkage, axle & suspension

    I

    parts
    I

    Drive shafts

    I

    I

    I

    MA-41

    Outside and inside
    Wheel alignment (If necessary, rotate & balance wheels)

    I

    I

    I

    I

    FSU-6
    FSU-7
    FSU-8

    Brake pads, rotors, drums & linings

    I

    I

    I

    I

    MA-38
    MA-39

    Foot brake, parking brake & clutch
    (For free play, stroke & operation)

    I

    I

    I

    I

    MA-39
    BR-8
    CL-5

    NOTE:
    Maintenance items with “
    tions”.

    ” should be performed more frequently according to “Maintenance Under Severe Driving Condi-

    (1) Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT fluid. If towing a trailer, using a camper or a car-top carrier, or driving on rough or muddy roads,
    inspect CVT fluid deterioration at NISSAN dealers every 100,000 km (60,000 miles), then change the CVT fluid if necessary. And if the
    inspection is not performed, change (not just inspect) CVT fluid every 100,000 miles (60,000 miles). Using transmission fluid other than
    Genuine NISSAN CVT fluid will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the warranty.

    MAINTENANCE UNDER SEVERE DRIVING CONDITIONS (HR16DE ENGINE)
    The maintenance intervals shown on the preceding pages are for normal operating conditions. If the vehicle is
    mainly operated under severe driving conditions as shown below, more frequent maintenance must be performed on the following items as shown in the table.
    Severe driving conditions
    A — Driving under dusty conditions
    B — Driving repeatedly short distances
    C — Towing a trailer or caravan
    D — Extensive idling
    E —Driving in extremely adverse weather conditions or in areas where ambient temperatures are either
    extremely low or extremely high
    F — Driving in high humidity or mountainous areas
    G — Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive areas
    H — Driving on rough and/or muddy roads or in the desert
    I — Driving with frequent use of braking or in mountainous areas
    Maintenance operation: Inspect = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary.

    Driving condition

    Maintenance
    operation

    Maintenance item

    Maintenance interval

    Reference
    page

    A

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    Air cleaner filter

    Replace

    More frequently

    A

    B

    C D

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    Engine oil

    Replace

    Every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) or
    3 months

    LU-8

    A

    B

    C D

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    Engine oil filter

    Replace

    Every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) or
    3 months

    LU-10

    .

    .

    .

    .

    F

    .

    .

    .

    Brake fluid

    Replace

    Every 20,000 km (12,000 miles)
    or 12 months

    BR-11
    BR-11

    .

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-8

    EM-19

    2014 Note

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    G H

    .

    Steering gear & linkage, axle & suspension parts

    Inspect

    Every 20,000 km (12,000 miles)
    or 12 months

    MA-41
    MA-40

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    G H

    .

    Drive shafts

    Inspect

    Every 10,000 km (6,000 miles)
    or 6 months

    MA-41

    A

    .

    C

    .

    .

    .

    G H

    I

    Brake pads, rotors, drums & linings

    Inspect

    Every 10,000 km (6,000 miles)
    or 6 months

    MA-38
    MA-39

    EXCEPT FOR MEXICO

    A

    B

    C

    EXCEPT FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance

    INFOID:0000000009452296

    The following tables show the normal maintenance schedule. Depending upon weather and atmospheric conditions, varying road surfaces, individual driving habits and vehicle usage, additional or more frequent maintenance may be required.
    Periodic maintenance beyond the last period shown on the tables requires similar maintenance.

    D

    E

    ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL MAINTENANCE (HR16DE ENGINE)
    Abbreviations: I = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary,

    R = Replace, E = Check and correct the engine coolant mixture ratio.

    MAINTENANCE OPERATION

    F

    MAINTENANCE INTERVAL

    Perform either at number of kilometers
    (miles) or months, whichever comes first.

    km x 1,000
    (Miles x 1,000)
    Months

    10
    (6)
    6

    20
    (12)
    12

    30
    (18)
    18

    40
    (24)
    24

    50
    (30)
    30

    60
    (36)
    36

    70
    (42)
    42

    80
    (48)
    48

    Reference
    page

    G

    Underhood and under vehicle
    Intake & exhaust valve clearance

    See NOTE (1)

    Drive belts

    See NOTE (2)

    Engine oil (Use recommended oil.)
    Engine oil filter (Use Genuine NISSAN engine oil filter or equivalent.)
    Engine coolant

    EM-10
    I

    I

    EM-17

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    LU-8

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    R

    LU-10

    E

    CO-8

    I

    CO-12
    CO-12
    CO-8

    See NOTE (3)

    E

    Cooling system

    I

    I

    I

    Fuel lines

    I

    I

    EX-4

    Air cleaner filter (Viscous paper type)

    R

    R

    EM-19

    R
    Fuel filter (In-tank type)

    R

    See NOTE (4)

    Spark plugs (Iridium-tipped type)

    Replace every 100,000 km (60,000 miles)
    I

    Maintenance items with “
    ditions”.

    K

    M

    EM-21
    I

    EC-336

    N

    NOTE:

    J

    EM-19

    EVAP vapor lines (With carbon canister)

    I

    L

    Clean every 5,000 km (3,000 miles)

    Air cleaner filter (dry paper type)

    H

    ” should be performed more frequently according to “Maintenance Under Severe Driving Con-

    O

    • (1) Periodic maintenance is not required. However, if valve noise increases, check valve clearance.
    • (2) Replace the drive belts if found damaged.
    • (3) Use Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant (blue) or equivalent in its quality, in order to avoid possible aluminium corrosion within the
    engine cooling system caused by the use of non-genuine engine coolant. Check and correct the engine coolant mixture ratio every
    40,000 km (24,000 miles) or 24 months. First replacement interval is 160,000 km (96,000 miles) or 96 months. After first replacement,
    replace every 80,000 km (48,000 miles) or 48 months.
    • (4) Maintenance-free item. For service procedures, refer to FL section.

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE (HR16DE ENGINE)

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-9

    2014 Note

    MA

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Abbreviations: I = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary,

    MAINTENANCE OPERATION
    Perform either at number of kilometers
    (miles) or months, whichever comes
    first.

    R = Replace,

    L = Lubricate.

    MAINTENANCE INTERVAL
    km x 1,000
    (Miles x 1,000)
    Months

    10
    (6)
    6

    20
    (12)
    12

    30
    (18)
    18

    Reference
    page

    40
    (24)
    24

    50
    (30)
    30

    60
    (36)
    36

    70
    (42)
    42

    80
    (48)
    48

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    BR-11
    CL-6

    Underhood and under vehicle
    Brake & clutch fluid (For level & leaks)

    I

    I

    I

    Brake fluid

    R

    R

    BR-11
    BR-11

    Brake booster vacuum hoses, connections & check valve

    I

    I

    BR-14

    I

    MA-36,
    CL-19,
    EX-4

    Brake, clutch & exhaust systems
    CVT fluid (For leaks)

    I
    See NOTE (1)

    Manual transaxle gear oil (For leaks)

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    TM-224

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    I

    TM-16

    Steering gear & linkage, axle & suspen-

    I

    sion parts & front drive shafts

    I

    I

    I

    MA-40
    MA-41
    MA-41

    I

    I

    I

    FSU-7
    FSU-8
    WT-4

    I

    BR-15
    BR-15
    BR-13
    BR-8

    I

    BR-17
    BR-17

    L

    MA-42
    MA-42
    MA-43
    MA-43

    I

    MA-44

    I

    BR-8
    PB-4
    CL-5

    Outside and inside
    Wheel alignment (If necessary, rotate &
    balance wheels)
    Brake pads, rotors & other brake components

    I

    I

    Brake linings, drums & other brake

    L

    Seat belts, buckles, retractors, anchors
    & adjusters
    Foot brake, parking brake & clutch
    (For free play, stroke & operation)

    I

    I

    components

    Lock, hinges & hood latch

    I

    L

    I

    I

    I

    L

    I

    I

    I

    L

    I

    I

    I

    L

    I

    I

    I

    L

    L

    I

    I

    I

    I

    NOTE:
    • Maintenance items with “
    tions”.

    ” should be performed more frequently according to “Maintenance Under Severe Driving Condi-

    (1) Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT fluid. If towing a trailer, using a camper or a car-top carrier, or driving on rough or muddy roads,
    inspect CVT fluid deterioration at NISSAN dealers every 60,000 miles (100,000 km), then change the CVT fluid if necessary. And if the
    inspection is not performed, change (not just inspect) CVT fluid every 60,000 miles (100,000 km). Using transmission fluid other than
    Genuine NISSAN CVT fluid will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the warranty.

    MAINTENANCE UNDER SEVERE DRIVING CONDITIONS (HR16DE ENGINE)
    The maintenance intervals shown on the preceding pages are for normal operating conditions. If the vehicle is
    mainly operated under severe driving conditions as shown below, more frequent maintenance must be performed on the following items as shown in the table.
    Severe driving conditions
    A — Driving under dusty conditions
    B — Driving repeatedly short distances
    C — Towing a trailer or caravan
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-10

    2014 Note

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    D — Extensive idling
    E — Driving in extremely adverse weather conditions or in areas where ambient temperatures are either
    extremely low or extremely high
    F — Driving in high humidity or mountainous areas
    G — Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive areas
    H — Driving on rough and/or muddy roads or in the desert
    I — Driving with frequent use of braking or in mountainous areas
    J — Frequent driving in water
    Maintenance operation: Inspect = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary.

    Driving condition

    Maintenance
    operation

    Maintenance item

    Maintenance interval

    A

    B

    C

    Reference
    page

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    Air cleaner filter

    Replace

    More frequently

    EM-21

    D

    A B C D .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    Engine oil & engine oil filter

    Replace

    Every 5,000 km (3,000 miles)
    or 3 months

    LU-8
    LU-8
    LU-10

    E

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    F .

    .

    .

    .

    Brake fluid

    Replace

    Every 20,000 km (12,000
    miles) or 12 months

    BR-11
    BR-11

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    G H .

    .

    Steering gear & linkage, axle &
    suspension parts & front drive
    shafts

    Inspect

    Every 10,000 km (6,000 miles)
    or 6 months

    MA-40
    MA-41
    MA-41

    F

    .

    A .

    C .

    .

    .

    G H I

    .

    Brake pads, rotors & other brake
    components

    Inspect

    Every 5,000 km (3,000 miles)
    or 3 months

    BR-15
    BR-15

    G

    A .

    C .

    .

    .

    G H I

    .

    Brake linings, drums & other
    brake components

    Inspect

    Every 10,000 km (6,000 miles)
    or 6 months

    BR-17
    BR-17

    Every 5,000 km (3,000 miles)
    or 3 months

    MA-42
    MA-42
    MA-43
    MA-43

    A .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    .

    G .

    .

    .

    Lock, hinges & hood latch

    Lubricate

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    MA

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-11

    2014 Note

    RECOMMENDED FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    RECOMMENDED FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS
    Fluids and Lubricants

    INFOID:0000000009452309

    Capacity
    (Approximate)

    Description
    Liter

    Imp measure

    41.0

    10-7/8 gal

    9.0 gal

    Unleaded regular gasoline with an octane
    rating of at least 87 AKI (RON 91)

    With oil filter change

    3.5

    3-3/4 qt

    3-1/8 qt

    For Mexico:

    Without oil filter change

    3.2

    3-3/8 qt

    2-7/8 qt

    Fuel
    Engine oil
    Drain and refill

    Recommended Fluids/Lubricants

    US measure

    Genuine NISSAN engine oil*1
    API grade SL, SM or SN*1
    ILSAC grade GF-3, GF-4 or GF-5*1

    Dry engine (Overhaul)

    3.5

    3-3/4 qt

    3-1/8 qt

    Viscosity SAE 10W-30*1
    Except for Mexico:
    Genuine NISSAN engine oil*1
    API grade SL, SM or SN*1
    ILSAC grade GF-3, GF-4 or GF-5*1

    CVT

    7.3

    7-3/4 qt

    6-3/8 qt

    M/T

    6.7

    7-1/8 qt

    5-7/8 qt

    0.7

    3/4 qt

    5/8 qt

    With oil cooler

    7.1

    7-1/2 qt

    6-1/4 qt

    Without oil cooler

    6.9

    7-1/4 qt

    6-1/8 qt

    2.67

    5-5/8 pt

    4-3/4 pt

    Cooling system (with reservoir)
    Reservoir tank
    CVT fluid

    Manual transaxle fluid gear oil

    Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant (blue)
    or equivalent in its quality*2

    Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3*3
    Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission
    Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi 75W-85 or equivalent*4

    Brake and clutch fluid

    Multi-purpose grease

    Genuine NISSAN Brake Fluid, or equivalent DOT 3
    (US FMVSS No. 116)
    NLGI No. 2 (Lithium soap base)

    Windshield washer fluid

    2.5

    2-5/8 qt

    2-1/4 qt

    Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer
    Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze or
    equivalent

    Air conditioner system refrigerant

    0.4

    0.88 lb

    0.88 lb

    HFC-134a (R-134a) *5

    110 — 130

    3.9 — 4.6 fl oz

    3.9 — 4.6 fl oz

    Air conditioner system oil

    NISSAN A/C System Oil Type DH-PR
    (Type R) or equivalent *5

    *1: For additional information, see “SAE Viscosity Number”.
    *2: Use Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant (blue) or equivalent in its quality, in order to avoid possible aluminum corrosion within the
    engine cooling system caused by the use of non-genuine engine coolant.
    Note that any repairs for the incidents within the engine cooling system while using non-genuine engine coolant may not be
    covered by the warranty even if such incidents occurred during the warranty period.
    *3: Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 will damage the
    CVT, which is not covered by the warranty.
    *4: If Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi is not available, API GL-4, Viscosity SAE 75W-85 may be used as a
    temporary replacement. However, use Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi as soon as it is available.
    *5: For further information, see “Air conditioning specification label”.

    SAE Viscosity Number

    INFOID:0000000009452310

    GASOLINE ENGINE
    • 10W-30 is preferable.
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-12

    2014 Note

    RECOMMENDED FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    If 10W-30 is not available, select the viscosity, from the chart, that
    is suitable for outside temperature range.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JPPIA0003GB

    Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio

    INFOID:0000000009452311

    The engine cooling system is filled at the factory with a high-quality,
    year-round and extended life engine coolant. The high quality engine
    coolant contains the specific solutions effective for the anti-corrosion
    and the anti-freeze function. Therefore, additional cooling system
    additives are not necessary.
    CAUTION:
    • When adding or replacing engine coolant, be sure to use only
    a Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant or equivalent in its quality
    with the proper mixture ratio. See the examples shown.
    The use of other types of engine coolant may damage the
    engine cooling system.
    SMA089D
    • When checking the engine coolant mixture ratio by the coolant
    hydrometer, use the chart below to correct your hydrometer reading (specific gravity) according to coolant
    temperature.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    Mixed coolant specific gravity
    Unit: specific gravity

    M

    Coolant temperature °C (°F)

    Engine coolant mixture
    ratio

    15 (59)

    25 (77)

    35 (95)

    45 (113)

    30%

    1.046 — 1.050

    1.042 — 1.046

    1.038 — 1.042

    1.033 — 1.038

    50%

    1.076 — 1.080

    1.070 — 1.076

    1.065 — 1.071

    1.059 — 1.065

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly push down and
    turn it a quarter turn to allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by pushing it down
    and turning it all the way.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-13

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    MA

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    DRIVE BELT
    DRIVE BELT : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009670478

    JSBIA1053ZZ

    1.

    Generator

    2.

    Water pump

    3.

    Crankshaft pulley

    4.

    A/C compressor (with A/C models)
    Idler pulley (without A/C models)

    5.

    Tensioner idler pulley

    6.

    Drive belt

    DRIVE BELT : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009670479

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove engine undercover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove wheel and tire (RH) using a power tool. Refer to WT-5, «Adjustment».
    Partially remove the fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Exploded View».
    Loosen the lock nut and then release the belt tension by turning the adjusting bolt.
    Remove the drive belt.

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Pull the idler pulley in the loosening direction, and then temporarily tighten the lock nut to the following
    torque.
    Lock nut
    (Temporary tightening)

    2.

    3.

    : 4.4 N·m (0.45 kg-m, 39 in-lb)

    NOTE:
    Do not move the lock nut from the temporary tightened position. Go to step 2.
    Install the drive belt on each pulley.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that there is no engine oil, grease, or engine coolant, etc. in pulley grooves.
    • Check that the belt seats securely inside the groove on each pulley.
    Adjust drive belt tension by turning the adjusting bolt. Refer to MA-15, «DRIVE BELT : Adjustment».
    CAUTION:
    • Perform the belt tension adjustment with the lock nut temporarily tightened to the torque specification listed in step 1 which prevents the idler pulley from tilting.
    • When checking immediately after installation, first adjust it to the specified value. Then, after
    turning crankshaft two turns or more, readjust to the specified value to avoid variation in deflection between pulleys.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-14

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    4. Tighten the lock nut to final tightening specification.
    A

    Lock nut (Final tightening)
    5.

    : 34.8 N·m (3.5 kg-m, 26 ft-lb)

    Check that belt tension is within the specification using suitable tool. Refer to EM-115, «Drive Belt».

    DRIVE BELT : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670480

    • Inspection should be done only when engine is cold or over 30
    minutes after the engine is stopped.
    (1)

    : Generator

    (2)

    : Water pump

    C

    D

    (3)

    : Crankshaft pulley

    (4)

    : A/C compressor (with A/C models)
    Idler pulley (without A/C models)

    (5)

    : Idler pulley

    (6)

    : Drive belt

    E

    PBIC3642E

    • Visually check belt for wear, damage, and cracks on inside and
    edges.
    • Turn crankshaft pulley clockwise twice, and check that the tension on all pulleys equalizes before testing.
    • When measuring deflection, apply 98.1 N (10 kg, 22 lb) at the ( ) marked point.
    • Measure the belt tension and frequency using suitable tool at the ( ) marked point.
    CAUTION:
    • When checking immediately after installation, first adjust it to the specified value. Then, after turning
    crankshaft two turns or more, readjust to the specified value to avoid variation in deflection between
    pulleys.
    Belt deflection/belt tension and frequency

    INFOID:0000000009670481

    Location

    Location of adjuster and tightening method

    Drive belt

    Adjusting bolt on idler pulley

    CAUTION:
    • When belt is replaced with new one, adjust belt tension to the value for “New belt,” because new belt
    will not fully seat in the pulley groove.
    • When tension of the belt being used exceeds “Limit,” adjust it to the value for “After adjusted.”
    • When installing a belt, check it is correctly engaged with the pulley groove.
    • Do not allow engine oil or engine coolant to get on the belt.
    • Do not twist or bend the belt strongly.
    1. Partially remove the fender protector (RH) front side clip. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER :
    Removal and Installation».
    2. Loosen lock nut (A) and temporarily set to the following torque.
    Lock nut (A)
    (Temporary tightening)
    : Generator

    (2)

    : Water pump
    : Crankshaft pulley

    (4)

    : A/C compressor (with A/C models)
    Idler pulley (without A/C models)

    (5)

    : Idler pulley

    Revision: April 2013

    G

    H

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    : 4.4 N·m (0.45 kg-m, 39 in-lb)

    (3)

    F

    I

    : Refer to EM-115, «Drive Belt».

    DRIVE BELT : Adjustment

    (1)

    B

    MA

    PBIC3643E

    MA-15

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    3.

    4.

    (6)

    : Drive belt

    (B)

    : Adjusting bolt

    Adjust the belt tension by turning the adjusting bolt. Refer to EM-115, «Drive Belt».
    CAUTION:
    • When checking immediately after installation, first adjust it to the specified value. Then, after
    turning crankshaft two turns or more, readjust to the specified value to avoid variation in deflection between pulleys.
    • When the tension adjustment is performed, the lock nut should be in the condition at Step 2. If
    the tension adjustment is performed when the lock nut is loosened more than the temporary
    tightening, the idler pulley tilts and the correct tension adjustment cannot be performed.
    Tighten the lock nut to final tightening specification.
    Lock nut (Final tightening)

    : 34.8 N·m (3.5 kg-m, 26 ft-lb)

    ENGINE COOLANT
    ENGINE COOLANT : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670482

    CHECKING COOLING SYSTEM HOSES
    Check hoses for the following:
    • Improper attachment
    • Leaks
    • Cracks
    • Damage
    • Loose connections
    • Chafing
    • Deterioration

    CHECKING RESERVOIR LEVEL
    • Check that the reservoir tank engine coolant level is within the
    MAX (A) to MIN (B) range when the engine is cool.
    • Adjust the engine coolant level if necessary.
    CAUTION:
    Refill the engine cooling system with the specified coolant or
    equivalent. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    JPBIA0102ZZ

    CHECKING COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly push down and
    turn it a quarter turn to allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by pushing it down
    and turning it all the way.
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when the engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on drive belt.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-16

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    To check for leaks, apply pressure to the cooling system using suitable tool (A) and Tool (B).
    Tool number (B)

    A

    : EG17650301 (J-33984-A)
    B

    Testing pressure

    : Refer to CO-26, «Standard
    and Limit».
    C
    PBIC5121J

    D

    ENGINE COOLANT : Draining Engine Coolant

    INFOID:0000000009670483

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly push down and
    turn it a quarter turn to allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by pushing it down
    and turning it all the way.
    1. Remove front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    2. Connect a suitable hose to the radiator drain plug.
    • Use a suitable hose with the dimensions as shown.
    Diameter (A)
    Length (B)

    E

    F

    G

    H

    : 0.8 mm (0.31 in)
    : 300 mm (11.81 in)

    I

    J
    JPBIA4770ZZ

    3.

    Open radiator drain plug (A) at the bottom of radiator, and then
    remove radiator cap.
    (A): Suitable hose
    : Front
    CAUTION:
    • Perform this step when engine is cold.
    • Do not spill engine coolant on the drive belt.

    K

    L

    M

    ALBIA1140ZZ

    4.
    5.
    6.

    It is necessary to drain the cylinder block when draining all of engine coolant in the system. To drain the
    cylinder block, open the water drain plugs on cylinder block. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».
    Remove reservoir tank if necessary, and drain engine coolant and clean reservoir tank before installing. O
    Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».
    Check drained engine coolant for contaminants such as rust, corrosion or discoloration. If contaminated,
    MA
    flush the engine cooling system. Refer to CO-11, «Flushing Cooling System».

    ENGINE COOLANT : Refilling
    1.

    N

    INFOID:0000000009670484

    Install the radiator drain plug. Install the reservoir tank and cylinder block drain plug, if removed for a total
    system drain or for engine removal or repair.
    • The radiator must be completely empty of engine coolant and water.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-17

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    • Apply sealant to the threads of the cylinder block drain plug. Use Genuine High Performance
    Thread Sealant or equivalent. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    Radiator drain plug
    2.
    3.
    4.

    If disconnected, reattach the upper radiator hose at the engine side.
    Set the vehicle heater controls to the full HOT and heater ON position. Turn the vehicle ignition ON with
    the engine OFF as necessary to activate the heater mode.
    Install the Tool by installing the radiator cap adapter onto the
    radiator neck opening. Then attach the gauge body assembly
    with the refill tube and the venturi assembly to the radiator cap
    adapter.
    Tool number

    5.

    : Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    : KV991J0070 (J-45695)

    Insert the refill hose into the engine coolant mixture container
    that is placed at floor level. Make sure the ball valve is in the
    closed position.
    • Use recommended engine coolant or equivalent.
    Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    Engine coolant capacity
    (with reservoir tank)

    6.

    CAUTION:
    Do not use any cooling system additives such as radiator
    sealer. Additives may clog the cooling system and cause
    damage to the engine, transmission and/or cooling system.
    Install an air hose to the venturi assembly, the air pressure must
    be within specification.
    Compressed air
    supply pressure

    7.

    8.

    : Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and
    Lubricants».

    : 549 — 824 kPa (5.6 — 8.4 kg/cm2,
    80 — 119 psi)

    LLIA0058E

    CAUTION:
    The compressed air supply must be equipped with an air dryer.
    The vacuum gauge will begin to rise and there will be an audible hissing noise. During this process open
    the ball valve on the refill hose slightly. Engine coolant will be visible rising in the refill hose. Once the refill
    hose is full of engine coolant, close the ball valve. This will purge any air trapped in the refill hose.
    Continue to draw the vacuum until the gauge reaches 28 inches
    of vacuum. The gauge may not reach 28 inches in high altitude
    locations, use the vacuum specifications based on the altitude
    above sea level.
    Altitude above sea level
    0 — 100 m (328 ft)
    300 m (984 ft)
    500 m (1,641 ft)
    1,000 m (3,281 ft)

    Vacuum gauge reading
    : 28 inches of vacuum
    : 27 inches of vacuum
    : 26 inches of vacuum
    : 24 — 25 inches of vacuum

    LLIA0057E

    9.

    When the vacuum gauge has reached the specified amount, disconnect the air hose and wait 20 seconds
    to see if the system loses any vacuum. If the vacuum level drops, perform any necessary repairs to the
    system and repeat steps 6 — 8 to bring the vacuum to the specified amount. Recheck for any leaks.
    10. Place the engine coolant container (with the refill hose inserted) at the same level as the top of the radiator. Then open the ball valve on the refill hose so the engine coolant will be drawn up to fill the cooling system. The cooling system is full when the vacuum gauge reads zero.
    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-18

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Do not allow the engine coolant container to get too low when filling, to avoid air from being drawn
    into the cooling system.
    11. Remove the Tool from the radiator neck opening.
    12. Fill the cooling system reservoir tank to the specified level and install the radiator cap. Run the engine to
    warm up the cooling system and top up the system as necessary.
    13. Install the front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».

    ENGINE COOLANT : Flushing Cooling System
    1.

    3.
    4.

    B

    C

    Install radiator drain plug and reservoir tank, if removed.
    Radiator drain plug

    2.

    INFOID:0000000009670485

    A

    D

    : Refer to CO-14, «Exploded View».

    CAUTION:
    Be sure to clean drain plug and install with new O-ring.
    If water drain plugs on cylinder block were removed, close and tighten them. Refer to EM-92, «Exploded
    View».
    Remove air duct from between air cleaner case and electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-19,
    «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect heater hose (1) at location ( ) as shown.
    • Position heater hose as high as possible.
    : Front

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    JSBIA0616ZZ

    5.

    Fill radiator until engine coolant flows out of the disconnected heater hose and then reconnect the heater
    hose.
    6. Finish filling the engine and reservoir tank with water and reinstall the radiator cap.
    7. Install air duct in between air cleaner case and electric throttle control actuator. Refer to EM-19, «Removal
    and Installation».
    8. Run the engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    9. Rev the engine two or three times under no-load.
    10. Stop the engine and wait until it cools down.
    11. Drain water from the system. Refer to CO-8, «Draining Engine Coolant».
    12. Repeat steps 1 through 11 until clear water begins to drain from radiator.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    FUEL LINES
    N

    FUEL LINES : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417638

    Inspect fuel lines, fuel filler cap, and fuel tank for improper attachment, leakage, cracks, damage, loose connections, chafing or deterioration.
    (A)

    : Engine

    (B)

    : Fuel line

    (C)

    : Fuel tank

    O

    MA

    If necessary, repair or replace damaged parts.
    JPBIA0129ZZ

    AIR CLEANER FILTER
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-19

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    AIR CLEANER FILTER : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009670486

    AWBIA1598ZZ

    1.

    Air cleaner cover

    2.

    Mass air flow sensor

    3.

    Clamp

    4.

    Air duct

    5.

    Clamp

    6.

    Hose

    7.

    Clamp

    8.

    Grommet

    9.

    Grommet insert

    10. Grommet

    11. Grommet insert

    12. Air duct inlet

    13. Air cleaner body

    14. Air cleaner filter

    A.

    B.

    To electric throttle control actuator

    To rocker cover

    AIR CLEANER FILTER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009670487

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Unhook clips (A) and pull the air cleaner cover (1) upward.

    JSBIA1092ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-20

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    2. Remove the air cleaner filter (1) from the air cleaner body.
    A

    B

    C
    JSBIA1093ZZ

    D

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    Check that the air cleaner filter is securely placed in the air cleaner body.

    E

    ENGINE OIL

    ENGINE OIL : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670490

    F

    ENGINE OIL LEVEL
    NOTE:
    Before starting engine, position the vehicle so that it is level and check the engine oil level. If engine is already
    started, stop it and allow 10 minutes before checking.
    1. Pull out oil level gauge and wipe it clean.
    2. Insert oil level gauge and check that the engine oil level is within
    the range (A) as shown.
    3. If it is out of range, adjust it.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    JPBIA0554ZZ

    ENGINE OIL APPEARANCE
    • Check engine oil for white milky appearance or excessive contamination.
    • If engine oil becomes turbid and white, it is highly probable that it is contaminated with engine coolant.
    Repair or replace damaged parts.

    L

    ENGINE OIL LEAKS

    M

    Check for engine oil leaks around the following areas:
    • Oil pan (upper and lower)
    • Oil pan drain plug
    • Oil pressure sensor
    • Oil filter
    • Oil cooler
    • Oil level sensor
    • Engine oil temperature sensor
    • Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
    • Exhaust valve timing control solenoid valve
    • Mating surface between front cover and rocker cover
    • Mating surface between cylinder block and cylinder head
    • Mating surface between cylinder head and rocker cover
    • Crankshaft oil seals (front and rear)
    • Front cover

    N

    O

    MA

    ENGINE OIL PRESSURE CHECK
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-21

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    WARNING:
    • Be careful not to burn yourself, as engine oil may be hot.
    • When checking engine oil pressure, shift selector should be in the «P» (Park) or «N» (Neutral) position, and apply parking brake securely.
    1. Check engine oil level.
    2. Disconnect harness connector at oil pressure switch. Remove
    oil pressure switch using suitable tool and install suitable tools
    (A/B).
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock oil pressure switch.

    JPBIA0074ZZ

    3.
    4.

    Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
    Check engine oil pressure with engine running under no-load.
    NOTE:
    • When engine oil temperature is low, engine oil pressure becomes high.
    • If difference is extreme, check oil passage and oil pump for engine oil leaks.
    Engine oil pressure

    5.
    a.
    b.

    After the inspections, install oil pressure switch as follows:
    Remove old liquid gasket adhering to oil pressure switch and engine.
    Apply liquid gasket and tighten oil pressure switch to specification.
    Use Genuine Liquid Gasket or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and
    Sealants».
    Tightening torque

    6.
    7.

    : Refer to LU-15, «Engine Oil Pressure».

    : Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View».

    Check engine oil level.
    After warming up engine, check that there is no engine oil leaks with the running engine.

    ENGINE OIL : Draining

    INFOID:0000000009670491

    WARNING:
    • Be careful not to get burned, as engine oil may be hot.
    • Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer. Try to avoid direct skin
    contact with used engine oil. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as
    soon as possible.
    1. Warm up the engine, park the vehicle on a level surface and check for engine oil leaks. Refer to MA-21,
    «ENGINE OIL : Inspection».
    2. Stop the engine and wait for 10 minutes.
    3. Loosen oil filler cap.
    4. Remove drain plug and then drain engine oil.

    ENGINE OIL : Refilling
    1.

    2.

    INFOID:0000000009670492

    Install drain plug with new copper sealing washer. Refer to EM-34, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to clean drain plug.
    • Do not reuse copper sealing washer.
    Refill with new engine oil.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-22

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Engine oil capacity and viscosity

    3.
    4.
    5.

    : Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    A

    CAUTION:
    • The refill capacity depends on the engine oil temperature and drain time. Use these specifications for reference only.
    • Always use oil level gauge to determine the proper amount of engine oil in the engine.
    Warm up engine and check area around drain plug and oil filter for engine oil leaks. Repair as necessary.
    Stop engine and wait for 10 minutes.
    Check the engine oil level. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».

    OIL FILTER
    INFOID:0000000009670493

    REMOVAL

    E

    Drain engine oil. Refer to MA-22, «ENGINE OIL : Draining».
    Remove oil filter using suitable tool (A).
    : Front
    WARNING:
    Be careful not to get burned; engine and engine oil may be
    hot.
    CAUTION:
    • When removing, prepare a shop cloth to absorb engine oil
    leaks and spills.
    • Do not spill engine oil on drive belt.
    • Completely wipe off any engine oil that spills on engine
    and vehicle.
    • Oil filter is provided with relief valve. Use Genuine NISSAN oil filter or equivalent.

    F

    G

    H

    JSBIA0620ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    C

    D

    OIL FILTER : Removal and Installation
    1.
    2.

    B

    I

    J

    Remove foreign materials adhering to the oil filter installation surface.
    Apply new engine oil to the oil seal contact surface of new oil filter.

    K

    L

    M
    SMA010

    3.

    N

    Screw oil filter manually until it touches the installation surface,
    then tighten it by 2/3 turn (A), or tighten to specification.
    Oil filter

    O

    : 17.7 N·m (1.8 kg-m, 13 ft-lb)

    MA

    JPBIA0077ZZ

    4.

    Refill engine with new engine oil. Refer to MA-22, «ENGINE OIL : Refilling».

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-23

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    OIL FILTER : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670494

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.

    Check the engine oil level. Refer to MA-21, «ENGINE OIL : Inspection».

    SPARK PLUG
    SPARK PLUG : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009670488

    AWBIA1599ZZ

    1.

    Ignition coil

    2.

    Spark plug

    3.

    Rocker cover

    Front

    SPARK PLUG : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009670489

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove ignition coil. Refer to EM-48, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock ignition coil.
    Remove spark plug using a suitable tool.
    Diameter (a)

    : 14 mm (0.55 in)

    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock spark plug.

    JPBIA0030ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    • If the spark plug tip is covered with carbon, a spark plug cleaner may be used.
    Cleaner air pressure
    Cleaning time

    : Less than 588 kPa (6 kg/cm2, 85 psi)
    : Less than 20 seconds

    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-24

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Do not use a wire brush for cleaning.
    A

    B

    C
    SMA773C

    D

    • Checking and adjusting spark plug gap is not required between
    change intervals. Do not adjust the gap; replace the spark plug as
    necessary if out of specification.

    E

    F

    G
    SMA806CA

    INSTALLATION

    H

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not drop or shock the spark plug.

    I

    Make

    NGK

    Standard type*

    PLZKAR6A-11

    Gap (nominal)

    1.1 mm (0.043 in)

    J

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    CAUTION:
    Always tighten the spark plug to specified torque to align the orientation of electrodes. The ground
    electrode of a genuine spark plug is positioned in the area of maximum ignitability by tightening to the
    specified torque. When replacing spark plugs, use genuine spark plugs of which the ground electrode
    is adjusted.
    NOTE:

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    MA

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-25

    2014 Note

    ENGINE MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    The ground electrode of the spark plug is positioned in the area of maximum ignitability to improve combustion
    eficiency in the cylinder, reduce CO2 (carbon dioxide) emission and improve fuel economy.

    JPBIA5996GB

    1.

    Ground electrode of spark plug

    C.

    Poor ignitability region

    A.

    Top view

    B.

    Air-fuel mixture flow

    EVAP VAPOR LINES
    EVAP VAPOR LINES : Inspection
    1.
    2.

    INFOID:0000000009417648

    Visually inspect EVAP vapor lines for improper attachment and for cracks, damage, loose connections,
    chafing and deterioration.
    Inspect fuel tank filler cap vacuum relief valve for clogging, sticking, etc. Refer to EC-336, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-26

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE

    A

    EXHAUST SYSTEM
    EXHAUST SYSTEM : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670503

    Check exhaust pipes, muffler, and mounting for improper attachment, leaks, cracks, damage or deterioration.
    • If anything is found, repair or replace damaged parts.

    B

    C

    D

    E
    SMA211A

    CVT FLUID

    F

    CVT FLUID : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670504

    FLUID LEAKAGE

    G

    • Check transaxle surrounding area (oil seal and plug etc.)for fluid
    leakage.
    • If anything is found, repair or replace damaged parts and adjust
    CVT fluid level. Refer to MA-29, «CVT FLUID : Adjustment».

    H

    I

    J
    SMA146B

    CVT FLUID : Replacement
    CVT fluid
    Fluid capacity

    INFOID:0000000009670505

    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».
    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».

    K

    L

    CAUTION:
    • Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN
    CVT Fluid NS-3 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the (NISSAN new vehicle limited) war- M
    ranty.
    • Always use shop paper. Never use shop cloth.
    • Replace a drain plug gasket with new ones at the final stage of the operation when installing.
    N
    • Use caution when looking into the drain hole as there is a risk of dripping fluid entering the eye.
    • After replacement, always perform CVT fluid leakage check.
    1. Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION” using CONSULT.
    O
    2. Select “FLUID TEMP” and confirm that the CVT fluid temperature is 40°C (104°F) or less.
    3. Check that the selector lever is in the “P” position, then completely engage the parking brake.
    4. Lift up the vehicle.
    MA
    5. Remove the drain plug and overflow tube and drain the CVT fluid from the oil pan. TM-238, «Removal and
    Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-27

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    6. Install the charging pipe set (KV311039S0) (A) into the drain
    hole.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten the charging pipe by hand.
    7. Install the ATF changer hose (B) to the charging pipe.
    CAUTION:
    Press the ATF changer hose all the way onto the charging
    pipe until it stops.
    8. Fill approximately 3 liter (2-5/8 lmp qt) of the CVT fluid.
    9. Remove the ATF changer hose and charging pipe, then install
    JSDIA1876ZZ
    the drain plug.
    NOTE:
    Perform this work quickly because CVT fluid leaks.
    10. Lift down the vehicle.
    11. Start the engine.
    12. While depressing the brake pedal, shift the selector lever to the entire position from “P” to “L”, and shift it
    to the “P” position.
    NOTE:
    Hold the lever at each position for 5 seconds.
    13. Check that the CONSULT “Data monitor” in “FLUID TEMP” is 35°C (95°F) to 45°C (113°F).
    14. Stop the engine.
    15. Lift up the vehicle.
    16. Remove the drain plug, and then drain CVT fluid from oil pan.
    17. Repeat steps 6 to 16 (one time).
    18. Install the overflow tube. Refer to TM-238, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Be sure to tighten to the specified torque. If it is not tightened to the specified torque, the tube may
    be damaged.
    19. Install the charging pipe set (KV311039S0) (A) into the drain
    hole.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten the charging pipe by hand.
    20. Install the ATF changer hose (B) to the charging pipe.
    CAUTION:
    Press the ATF changer hose all the way onto the charging
    pipe until it stops.
    21. Fill approximately 3 liter (2-5/8 lmp qt) of the CVT fluid.
    22. Remove the ATF changer hose and charging pipe, then install
    JSDIA1876ZZ
    the drain plug.
    NOTE:
    Perform this work quickly because CVT fluid leaks.
    23. Lift down the vehicle.
    24. Start the engine.
    25. While depressing the brake pedal, shift the selector lever to the entire position from “P” to “L”, and shift it
    to the “P” position.
    NOTE:
    Hold the lever at each position for 5 seconds.
    26. Check that the CONSULT “Data monitor” in “FLUID TEMP” is 35°C (95°F) to 45°C (113°F).
    27. Lift up the vehicle.
    28. Remove the drain plug and confirm that the CVT fluid is drained from the overflow tube.
    CAUTION:
    Perform this work with the vehicle idling.
    NOTE:
    If the CVT fluid is not drained, refer to “Adjustment” and refill with the CVT fluid.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-28

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    29. When the flow of CVT fluid slows to a drip, tighten the drain plug to the specified torque. TM-238,
    «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Never reuse drain plug gasket.
    30. Lift down the vehicle.
    31. Select “Work Support” in “TRANSMISSION” using CONSULT.
    32. Select “CONFORM CVTF DETERIORTN”.
    33. Select “Erase”.
    34. Stop the engine.

    CVT FLUID : Adjustment
    CVT fluid
    Fluid capacity

    INFOID:0000000009670506

    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».
    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».

    9.

    10.
    11.

    12.
    13.
    14.
    15.

    Install the charging pipe set (KV311039S0) (A) into the drain
    plug hole.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten the charging pipe by hand.
    Install the ATF changer hose (B) to the charging pipe.
    CAUTION:
    Press the ATF changer hose all the way onto the charging
    pipe until it stops.
    Fill approximately 0.5 liter (1/2 lmp qt) of the CVT fluid.
    Remove the ATF changer hose from the charging pipe, and
    check that the CVT fluid drains out from the charging pipe. If it
    does not drain out, perform charging again.
    CAUTION:
    Perform this work with the vehicle idling.
    When the flow of CVT fluid slows to a drip, remove the charging pipe from the oil pan.
    Tighten the drain plug to the specified torque. Refer to TM-238, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Never reuse drain plug gasket.
    Lift down the vehicle.
    Stop the engine.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-29

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CAUTION:
    • Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN
    CVT Fluid NS-3 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the (NISSAN new vehicle limited) warranty.
    • During adjustment of the CVT fluid level, check CONSULT so that the oil temperature may be maintained from 35 to 45°C (95 to 113°F).
    • Use caution when looking into the drain hole as there is a risk of dripping fluid entering the eye.
    1. Check that the selector lever is in the “P” position, then completely engage the parking brake.
    2. Start the engine.
    3. Adjust the CVT fluid temperature to be approximately 40°C (104°F).
    NOTE:
    The CVT fluid is largely affected by temperature. Therefore be sure to use CONSULT and check the
    “FLUID TEMP” under “TRANSMISSION” in “Data Monitor” while adjusting.
    4. While depressing the brake pedal, shift the selector lever to the entire position from “P” to “L”, and shift it
    to the “P” position.
    NOTE:
    Hold the lever at each position for 5 seconds.
    5. Lift up the vehicle.
    6. Check that there is no CVT fluid leakage.
    7. Remove the drain plug. Refer to TM-238, «Removal and Installation».
    8.

    A

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JSDIA1876ZZ

    MA

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    CLUTCH FLUID
    CLUTCH FLUID : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670507

    CLUTCH FLUID LEAKS
    • Check clutch line for cracks, deterioration or other damage. Replace any damaged parts.
    • Check for clutch fluid leaks by fully depressing clutch pedal while engine is running.
    CAUTION:
    If leaks occur around connections, reinstall the lines or replace damaged parts, if necessary.

    CLUTCH FLUID LEVEL
    • Check that the clutch fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the
    specified range, between the MAX and MIN lines as shown.
    • Visually check for any clutch fluid leaks around the reservoir tank.
    • Check the clutch system for any leaks if the clutch fluid level is
    extremely low (lower than MIN).

    JPFIA0007ZZ

    CLUTCH FLUID : Draining

    INFOID:0000000009670508

    CAUTION:
    Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash the
    affected area with water.
    1. Connect a transparent vinyl hose to air bleeder of bleeding connector (1).

    JPDIB0144ZZ

    2.

    Press the lock pin (1) into the bleeding connector (2), and maintain the position.

    PCIB1495E

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-30

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    3. Slide clutch tube (1) for the specified distance (A) in the direction
    of the arrow ( ) as shown.
    (2)

    A

    : Bleeding connector

    B

    Dimension (A)

    : 5 mm (0.20 in)

    CAUTION:
    Do not allow the clutch tube to disconnect from the bleeding connector.

    C
    JPDIB0147ZZ

    4.

    Depress clutch pedal to gradually discharge clutch fluid.
    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the clutch tube to disconnect from the
    bleeding connector.

    CLUTCH FLUID : Refilling

    D

    E

    INFOID:0000000009670509

    CAUTION:
    Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash the
    affected area with water.
    1. Check that there is no foreign material in reservoir tank and then fill with new clutch fluid.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained clutch fluid.
    2. Connect a transparent vinyl hose to air bleeder of bleeding connector (1).

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JPDIB0144ZZ

    3.

    Press the lock pin (1) into the bleeding connector (2), and maintain the position.

    K

    L

    M

    N
    PCIB1495E

    O

    MA

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-31

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    4. Slide clutch tube (1) for the specified distance (A) in the direction
    of the arrow ( ) as shown.
    (2)

    : Bleeding connector

    Dimension (A)

    : 5 mm (0.20 in)

    JPDIB0147ZZ

    5.

    6.
    7.
    8.

    Slowly depress clutch pedal to the full stroke position and then release the pedal.
    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the clutch tube to disconnect from the
    bleeding connector.
    Repeat step 5 at intervals of 2 or 3 seconds until new clutch fluid is discharged.
    CAUTION:
    Monitor clutch fluid level in reservoir tank so as not to empty the tank.
    Return clutch tube and lock pin in their original positions while clutch pedal is depressed.
    Perform the air bleeding. Refer to MA-32, «CLUTCH FLUID : Air Bleeding».

    CLUTCH FLUID : Air Bleeding

    INFOID:0000000009670510

    CAUTION:
    • Monitor clutch fluid level in reservoir tank so as not to empty the tank.
    • Do not spill clutch fluid onto painted surfaces. If clutch fluid spills, wipe up immediately and wash
    the affected area with water.
    1. Fill reservoir tank with new clutch fluid.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse drained clutch fluid.
    2. Connect a transparent vinyl hose to air bleeder of bleeding connector (1).
    3. Depress and release the clutch pedal slowly and fully 15 times
    at an interval of 2 to 3 seconds and release the clutch pedal.

    JPDIB0144ZZ

    4.

    Press the lock pin (1) into the bleeding connector (2), and maintain the position.
    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the
    clutch tube to disconnect from the bleeding connector.

    PCIB1495E

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-32

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    5. Slide clutch tube (1) for the specified distance (A) in the direction
    of the arrow ( ) as shown and immediately depress the clutch
    pedal and hold it, to bleed the air from the system.
    (2)

    : Bleeding connector

    Dimension (A)

    B

    : 5 mm (0.20 in)

    CAUTION:
    Clutch tube is under hydraulic pressure; do not allow the
    clutch tube to disconnect from the bleeding connector.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    A

    C
    JPDIB0147ZZ

    Return clutch tube and lock pin in their original positions.
    Release clutch pedal and wait for 5 seconds.
    Repeat steps 3 to 7 until no bubbles are observed in the clutch fluid.
    Check that the clutch fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the specified range after air bleeding. Refer
    to MA-30, «CLUTCH FLUID : Inspection».

    GEAR OIL

    D

    E

    F

    GEAR OIL : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670511

    G

    GEAR OIL LEAKS
    Make sure that gear oil is not leaking from transaxle or around it.

    H

    GEAR OIL LEVEL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    Remove filler plug (1) and gasket from transaxle case.
    Check the gear oil level from filler plug hole as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not start engine while checking gear oil level.
    Install a new gasket on filler plug and then install filler plug to
    transaxle case.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    Tighten filler plug to the specified torque. Refer to TM-25,
    «Exploded View».

    I

    J

    K
    SCIA7119E

    GEAR OIL : Draining
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    INFOID:0000000009670512

    Start engine and let it run to warm up transaxle.
    Stop engine. Remove drain plug (1) and gasket, using suitable
    tool and then drain gear oil.
    Install a new gasket on drain plug (1) and install drain plug to
    clutch housing, using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    Tighten drain plug (1) to the specified torque. Refer to TM-25,
    «Exploded View».

    M

    N

    O

    PCIB1504E

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-33

    L

    2014 Note

    MA

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    GEAR OIL : Refilling
    1.
    2.

    Remove filler plug (1) and gasket from transaxle case.
    Fill with new gear oil until gear oil level reaches the specified
    limit at filler plug hole as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not start engine while checking gear oil level.
    Oil capacity
    and viscosity

    3.

    4.

    INFOID:0000000009670513

    : Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    Install a new gasket on filler plug and then install filler plug to
    transaxle case.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    Tighten filler plug to the specified torque. Refer to TM-25, «Exploded View».

    SCIA7119E

    ROAD WHEEL
    ROAD WHEEL : Inspection
    1.
    2.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    INFOID:0000000009670515

    Check tires for wear and improper inflation.
    Check wheels for deformation, cracks and other damage. If deformed, remove wheel and check wheel
    runout.
    Remove tire from wheel and mount wheel on a balancer machine.
    Set dial indicator as shown.
    Check runout, if runout value exceeds the limit, replace wheel.
    Limit
    Axial Runout (A)
    Radial Runout (B)

    Refer to WT-9, «Wheel».
    Refer to WT-9, «Wheel».

    SEIA0737E

    ROAD WHEEL : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009670514

    BALANCING WHEELS (ADHESIVE WEIGHT TYPE)
    Preparation Before Adjustment
    Remove inner and outer balance weights from the wheel and tire. Using releasing agent, remove double-faced
    adhesive tape from the wheel and tire.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to scratch the wheel and tire during removal.
    • After removing double-faced adhesive tape, wipe clean all traces of releasing agent from the wheel
    and tire.
    Wheel Balance Adjustment
    CAUTION:
    • DO NOT use center hole cone-type clamping machines to hold the wheel during tire removal/installation or balancing or damage to the wheel paint, cladding or chrome may result. Use only rim-type or
    universal lug-type clamping machines to hold the wheel during servicing.
    • If a balancer machine has an adhesive weight mode setting, select the adhesive weight mode setting and
    skip Step 2 below. If a balancer machine only has the clip-on (rim flange) weight mode setting, follow Step 2
    to calculate the correct size adhesive weight.
    1. Set wheel and tire on balancer machine using the center hole as a guide. Start the balancer machine.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-34

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    2. For balancer machines that only have a clip-on (rim flange) weight mode setting, follow this step to calculate the correct size adhesive weight to use. When inner and outer imbalance values are shown on the
    balancer machine indicator, multiply outer imbalance value by 5/3 (1.67) to determine balance weight that
    should be used. Select the outer balance weight with a value closest to the calculated value above and
    install in to the designated outer position of or at the designated angle in relation to the wheel and tire.
    a. Indicated imbalance value × 5/3 (1.67) = balance weight to be
    installed
    Calculation example:
    23 g (0.81 oz) × 5/3 (1.67) = 38.33 g (1.35 oz) ⇒ 40 g (1.41 oz)
    balance weight (closer to calculated balance weight value)
    NOTE:
    Note that balance weight value must be closer to the calculated
    balance weight value.
    Example:
    37.4 ⇒ 35 g (1.23 oz)
    37.5 ⇒ 40 g (1.41 oz)

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    SMA054D

    3.

    Install balance weight in the position shown.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not install the inner balance weight before installing
    the outer balance weight.
    • Before installing the balance weight, be sure to clean the
    mating surface of the wheel and tire.
    • When installing balance weight (1) to wheel and tire, set it into
    the grooved area (A) on the inner wall of the wheel and tire as
    shown so that the balance weight center (B) is aligned with the
    balancer machine indication position (angle) (C).
    CAUTION:
    • Always use Genuine NISSAN adhesive balance weights.
    • Balance weights are non-reusable; always replace with
    new ones.
    • Do not install more than three sheets of balance
    weights.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JPEIC0040ZZ

    4.

    5.
    6.

    7.
    8.

    If calculated balance weight value exceeds 50 g (1.76 oz), install
    two balance weight sheets in line with each other as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not install one balance weight sheet on top of another.
    Start balancer machine again.
    Install balance weight on inner side of wheel and tire in the balancer machine indication position (angle).
    CAUTION:
    Do not install more than two balance weights.
    Start balancer machine. Make sure that inner and outer residual
    imbalance values are 5 g (0.17 oz) each or below.
    If either residual imbalance value exceeds 5 g (0.17 oz), repeat installation procedures.
    Wheel balance

    Maximum allowable imbalance

    Revision: April 2013

    Dynamic (At flange)

    M

    N

    O

    PEIA0033E

    Static (At flange)

    Refer to WT-9, «Wheel».

    MA-35

    2014 Note

    MA

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    TIRE ROTATION
    • Follow the maintenance schedule for tire rotation service intervals.
    Refer to MA-7, «FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance» (FOR
    MEXICO), or MA-9, «EXCEPT FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance» (EXCEPT FOR MEXICO).
    • Rotate the wheel and tires front to back in the pattern as shown.
    • When installing the wheel, tighten wheel nuts to the specified
    torque.
    WARNING:
    • After rotating the tires, check and adjust the tire pressure.
    • Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven
    for 1,000 km (600 mi) (also in case of a flat tire, etc.).
    • Do not include the spare tire when rotating the tires.

    SMA829C

    CAUTION:
    • When installing wheels, tighten them diagonally by dividing the work two to three times in order to
    prevent the wheels from developing any distortion.
    • Be careful not to tighten the wheel nuts to a torque exceeding specification to prevent strain on the
    disc rotor.
    • Use Genuine NISSAN wheel nuts.
    Wheel nut tightening
    torque

    : WT-8, «Exploded View»

    BRAKE FLUID LEVEL AND LEAKS
    BRAKE FLUID LEVEL AND LEAKS : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417664

    BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
    • Check that the fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the specified
    range between the MAX – MIN lines as shown.
    • Visually check for any brake fluid leakage around the reservoir
    tank.
    • Check the brake system for any leakage if the fluid level is
    extremely low (lower than MIN).
    • Check the brake system for fluid leakage if the warning lamp
    remains illuminated even after the parking brake is released.
    • Check the reservoir tank for foreign matter (e.g., dust) and oils
    other than brake fluid.
    JPFIA0007ZZ

    BRAKE LINES AND CABLES
    BRAKE LINES AND CABLES : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417665

    BRAKE LINES
    1.
    2.

    Check brake lines (pipes and hoses) for cracks, deterioration or
    other damage. Replace any damaged parts.
    Check for brake fluid leaks by fully depressing brake pedal while
    engine is running.
    CAUTION:
    Retighten the applicable connection to the specified torque
    and repair any abnormal (damaged, worn or deformed) part
    if any brake fluid leaks are present.

    SBR389C

    PARKING BRAKE CABLES
    Check parking brake cables for improper attachment, leaks, chafing, abrasions, deterioration, etc.
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-36

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    BRAKE FLUID

    A

    BRAKE FLUID : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670516

    BRAKE FLUID LEVEL

    B

    • Check that the fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the specified
    range between the MAX – MIN lines as shown.
    • Visually check for any brake fluid leaks around the reservoir tank.
    • Check the brake system for any leaks if the fluid level is extremely
    low (lower than MIN).
    • Check the brake system for fluid leaks if the warning lamp remains
    illuminated even after the parking brake is released.
    • Check the reservoir tank for the mixing of foreign matter (e.g. dust)
    and oils other than brake fluid.

    C

    D

    E
    JPFIA0007ZZ

    BRAKE LINE
    1.
    2.

    F

    Check brake tubes and hoses for cracks, deterioration or other
    damage. Replace any damaged parts.
    Check for brake fluid leaks by fully depressing brake pedal while
    engine is running.
    CAUTION:
    Retighten the applicable connection to the specified torque
    and repair any abnormal (damaged, worn or deformed) part
    if any brake fluid leaks are present.

    G

    H

    I
    SBR389C

    BRAKE FLUID : Draining

    INFOID:0000000009670517

    CAUTION:
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) or battery
    negative terminal before performing work.
    1. Connect a vinyl tube to the bleeder valve.
    2. Depress the brake pedal and loosen the bleeder valve to gradually discharge brake fluid.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    BRA0007D

    BRAKE FLUID : Refilling

    O

    INFOID:0000000009670518

    CAUTION:
    MA
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) or battery
    negative terminal before performing work.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Monitor the brake fluid level in the reservoir while performing the air bleeding procedure.
    • Always use new brake fluid for refilling. Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-37

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    1. Check that there is no foreign material in the reservoir tank, and
    refill with new brake fluid. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    2. Loosen the bleeder valve, slowly depress the brake pedal to the
    full stroke, and then release the pedal. Repeat this operation at
    intervals of 2 or 3 seconds until new brake fluid is discharged.
    Then close the bleeder valve with the brake pedal depressed.
    Repeat the same work on each wheel.
    3. Perform the air bleeding procedure. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding
    Brake System».
    PFIA0403J

    BRAKE FLUID : Bleeding Brake System

    INFOID:0000000009670519

    CAUTION:
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) or battery
    negative terminal before performing the work.
    • Monitor the fluid level in the reservoir tank while performing the air bleeding.
    • Do not spill or splash brake fluid on painted surfaces. Brake fluid may seriously damage paint. Wipe
    it off immediately and wash with water if it gets on a painted surface.
    • Always use new brake fluid for refilling. Do not reuse drained brake fluid.
    • Do not allow foreign matter (e.g. dust) and oils other than brake fluid to enter the reservoir tank.
    1. Connect a vinyl tube to the bleeder valve.
    2. Fully depress the brake pedal 4 to 5 times.
    3. Loosen the bleeder valve and bleed air with the brake pedal depressed, and then quickly tighten the
    bleeder valve.
    4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 until all of the air is out of the brake line.
    5. Tighten the bleeder valve to the specified torque.
    • Front disc brake: Refer to BR-35, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Exploded View».
    • Rear drum brake: Refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».
    6. Perform steps 1 to 5 in the following order: Front (RH) brake → front (LH) brake → rear (RH) brake → rear
    (LH) brake.
    7. Check that the fluid level in the reservoir tank is within the specified range after air bleeding. Refer to BR11, «Inspection».
    8. Add brake fluid as necessary to keep the brake fluid level within the specified range. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    9. Inspect the brake pedal height and play. Adjust it if the measurement value is not the standard. Refer to
    BR-8, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    BRAKE PAD
    BRAKE PAD : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670521

    INSPECTION
    Check brake pad wear thickness from an inspection hole on cylinder
    body. Check using a scale if necessary.
    Wear thickness

    : Refer to BR-15, «BRAKE PAD : Inspection».

    BRA0010D

    DISC ROTOR
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-38

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    DISC ROTOR : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670522

    A

    INSPECTION
    Appearance
    Check surface of disc brake rotor for uneven wear, cracks, and serious damage. Replace it if necessary. Refer
    to BR-15, «DISC ROTOR : Inspection».
    Runout

    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.
    5.

    C

    Secure the disc brake rotor to the wheel hub with wheel nuts (2
    points at least).
    Check the wheel bearing axial end play before the inspection.
    Refer to FAX-13, «Inspection».
    Inspect the runout with a dial indicator to measure at 10 mm
    (0.39 in) inside the disc edge.
    Runout

    B

    D

    E

    : Refer to BR-44, «Front Disc Brake».

    Find the installation position that has a minimum runout by shifting the disc brake rotor-to-wheel hub installation position by one
    BRA0013D
    hole at a time if the runout exceeds the limit value.
    Refinish or replace the disc brake rotor if the runout is outside the limit even after performing the above
    operation.
    CAUTION:
    If the thickness is less than wear thickness + 0.3 mm (0.012 in), replace the disc brake rotor. Refer
    to BR-36, «BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY : Removal and Installation».
    Wear thickness

    : Refer to BR-44, «Front Disc Brake».

    F

    G

    H

    I

    Thickness
    Check the thickness of the disc brake rotor using a micrometer.
    Replace the disc brake rotor if the thickness is below the wear limit.
    Refer to BR-15, «DISC ROTOR : Inspection».

    J

    Wear thickness

    : Refer to BR-44, «Front
    Disc Brake».
    Thickness variation (mea- : Refer to BR-44, «Front
    sured at 8 positions)
    Disc Brake».

    K

    L
    SBR020B

    M

    BRAKE LINING
    BRAKE LINING : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670523

    N

    INSPECTION
    Brake Lining

    1.

    O

    Remove plug from back plate. Refer to BR-40, «Exploded View».

    MA

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-39

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    2. Check brake lining wear thickness (A) from an inspection hole
    on back plate. Check using a scale if necessary.
    Wear thickness

    : Refer to BR-45, «Rear Drum Brake».

    JSFIA1039ZZ

    BRAKE DRUM
    BRAKE DRUM : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009670524

    INSPECTION
    Appearance
    Check surface of brake drum for uneven wear, cracks and serious damage. Replace it if necessary. Refer to
    BR-40, «Removal and Installation».
    NOTE:
    • Make sure the parking brake control is fully released prior to removal of the brake drum.
    • The rear wheel hub is part of the brake drum.
    Brake Drum Inner Diameter
    Check inner diameter (B) of the brake drum.

    Inner diameter : Refer to BR-45, «Rear Drum Brake».

    JPFIA0113ZZ

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417671

    STEERING GEAR

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-40

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    • Check gear housing and boots for looseness, damage and grease
    leakage.
    • Check connection with steering column for looseness.

    A

    B

    C
    JPPIA0013GB

    D

    STEERING LINKAGE
    Check ball joint, dust cover and other component parts for looseness, wear, damage and grease leakage.

    AXLE AND SUSPENSION PARTS

    E

    AXLE AND SUSPENSION PARTS : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417672

    Check front and rear axle and suspension parts for excessive play,
    cracks, wear or other damage.
    • Shake each wheel to check for excessive play.
    • Check wheel bearings for smooth operation.
    • Check axle and suspension nuts and bolts for looseness.
    • Check strut (shock absorber) for oil leakage or other damage.
    • Check suspension ball joint for grease leakage and ball joint dust
    cover for cracks or other damage.

    F

    G

    H

    SMA525A

    I

    J

    K

    L
    SFA392B

    DRIVE SHAFT

    M

    DRIVE SHAFT : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417673

    N

    Check boot and drive shaft for cracks, wear, damage and grease
    leakage.

    O

    MA

    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH
    Revision: April 2013

    MA-41

    SFA108A

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009671244

    AWKIA2572ZZ

    1.

    Hood lock/fuel filler lid release handle

    A.

    Clip

    2.

    Hood lock assembly

    3.

    Hood lock release cable assembly

    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009671245

    AWKIA2573ZZ

    1.

    Key cylinder (driver side)

    2.

    Outside handle bracket

    3.

    Outside handle escutcheon
    (passenger side)

    4.

    Front gasket

    5.

    Outside handle

    6.

    Inside handle

    7.

    Door lock

    8.

    Key cylinder rod (driver side)

    9.

    Rear gasket

    A.

    Clip

    B.

    Bolt

    Revision: April 2013

    Pawl

    MA-42

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009671246

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    AWKIA2575ZZ

    1.

    Outside handle bracket

    2.

    Outside handle escutcheon

    3.

    Front gasket

    4.

    Outside handle

    5.

    Inside handle

    6.

    Door lock

    7.

    Door lock

    A.

    Clip

    B.

    Bolt

    I

    J

    Pawl

    LOCKS, HINGES AND HOOD LATCH : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009671247

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    MA

    AWKIA2578ZZ

    1.

    Outside handle

    2.

    Back door lock cable

    4.

    Back door lock

    5.

    Door striker

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-43

    3.

    Back door lock actuator

    2014 Note

    CHASSIS AND BODY MAINTENANCE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    SEAT BELT, BUCKLES, RETRACTORS, ANCHORS AND ADJUSTERS
    SEAT BELT, BUCKLES, RETRACTORS, ANCHORS AND ADJUSTERS : Inspection
    INFOID:0000000009417675

    Check the seat belt buckles, webbing, retractors, anchors and adjusters. Replace any seat belt assembly as
    necessary. Refer to MA-44, «SEAT BELT, BUCKLES, RETRACTORS, ANCHORS AND ADJUSTERS :
    Inspection».
    • Check the seat belt anchors for loose bolts, damage, or excessive wear.
    • Check the seat belt webbing for any damage, cuts, fraying, or excessive wear.
    • Check the retractor for smooth operation.
    • Check the function of the buckles by inserting the seat belt tongue and checking for proper engagement of
    the buckle and press the button on the buckle to check for proper release of the seat belt tongue.
    CAUTION:
    • After any collision, inspect all seat belt assemblies, including retractors and other attached components, such as the guide rail set. NISSAN recommends replacing all seat belt assemblies in use during a collision, unless they are not damaged and are inspected to confirm they are operating
    properly after a minor collision.
    Also inspect all seat belt assemblies that are not in use during a collision, and replace any components if damaged or not operating properly. The seat belt pre-tensioner should be replaced even if
    the seat belts are not in use during a frontal collision where the driver and passenger air bags have
    been deployed.
    • If any component of the seat belt assembly is suspected of being damaged or not operating properly, do not repair the component. Replace the components as an assembly.
    • If the seat belt webbing is cut, frayed, or damaged then replace the seat belt assembly.
    • Do not lubricate the seat belt buckle or tongue.
    • When replacing any seat belt assembly always use a Genuine NISSAN seat belt assembly.

    Revision: April 2013

    MA-44

    2014 Note

    DRIVER CONTROLS

    SECTION

    MIR

    MIRRORS

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    Component Inspection ………………………………………. 7

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 8

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES ……………………………………………………… 8

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….. 8
    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting ………… 9
    Diagnostic Worksheet ……………………………………….12

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 14

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3
    Commercial Service Tools ………………………………… 3

    INSIDE MIRROR ……………………………………….. 14

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………… 4

    Exploded View …………………………………………………14
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..14

    DOOR MIRROR SYSTEM …………………………….. 4

    DOOR MIRROR ………………………………………… 15

    OUTSIDE MIRROR ……………………………………………… 4
    OUTSIDE MIRROR : Wiring Diagram ………………….. 4

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS …………………….. 7
    DOOR MIRROR REMOTE CONTROL
    SWITCH (MIRROR SWITCH/CHANGEOVER
    SWITCH) …………………………………………………….. 7

    Exploded View …………………………………………………15
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..15

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    DOOR MIRROR REAR FINISHER ………………. 17
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..17

    DOOR MIRROR REMOTE CONTROL
    SWITCH ……………………………………………………. 18
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..18

    MIR

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009579058

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009579057

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009444934

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-39570)
    Chassis ear

    Locating the noise

    C

    D

    E
    SIIA0993E


    (J-50397)
    NISSAN Squeak and Rattle
    Kit

    F

    Repairing the cause of noise

    G

    H
    ALJIA1232ZZ


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    I

    J
    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009444933

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39565)
    Engine Ear

    Locating the noise

    K

    MIR

    M

    N
    SIIA0995E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-3

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    DOOR MIRROR SYSTEM
    OUTSIDE MIRROR
    OUTSIDE MIRROR : Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009014892

    AALWA0625GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-4

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    MIR

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1373GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-5

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1374GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-6

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR REMOTE CONTROL SWITCH (MIRROR SWITCH/
    CHANGEOVER SWITCH)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    DOOR MIRROR REMOTE CONTROL SWITCH (MIRROR SWITCH/
    CHANGEOVER SWITCH)
    Component Inspection

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009549399

    1.CHECK MIRROR SWITCH & CHANGEOVER SWITCH

    C

    1.
    2.
    3.

    D

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect door mirror remote control switch connector.
    Check door mirror remote control switch.
    Door mirror remote control switch

    Condition
    Change over
    switch

    Terminal

    RH

    LH

    13

    7

    12

    4

    13

    4

    12

    7

    13

    3

    12

    7

    13

    7

    12

    3

    13

    6

    12

    5

    13

    5

    12

    6

    13

    2

    12

    6

    13

    6

    12

    2

    Mirror switch

    Continuity

    RIGHT

    E

    F

    LEFT

    G

    RIGHT
    UP

    H

    DOWN
    Yes

    I

    RIGHT

    LEFT

    J

    LEFT
    UP

    K
    DOWN

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection end.
    NO
    >> Replace door mirror remote control switch. Refer to MIR-18, «Removal and Installation».

    MIR

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-7

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671235

    SBT842

    CUSTOMER INTERVIEW
    Interview the customer if possible, to determine the conditions that exist when the noise occurs. Use the Diagnostic Worksheet during the interview to document the facts and conditions when the noise occurs and any
    customer’s comments; refer to MIR-12, «Diagnostic Worksheet». This information is necessary to duplicate the
    conditions that exist when the noise occurs.
    • The customer may not be able to provide a detailed description or the location of the noise. Attempt to obtain
    all the facts and conditions that exist when the noise occurs (or does not occur).
    • If there is more than one noise in the vehicle, be sure to diagnose and repair the noise that the customer is
    concerned about. This can be accomplished by test driving the vehicle with the customer.
    • After identifying the type of noise, isolate the noise in terms of its characteristics. The noise characteristics
    are provided so the customer, service adviser and technician are all speaking the same language when
    defining the noise.
    • Squeak —(Like tennis shoes on a clean floor)
    Squeak characteristics include the light contact/fast movement/brought on by road conditions/hard surfaces
    = higher pitch noise/softer surfaces = lower pitch noises/edge to surface = chirping.
    • Creak—(Like walking on an old wooden floor)
    Creak characteristics include firm contact/slow movement/twisting with a rotational movement/pitch dependent on materials/often brought on by activity.
    • Rattle—(Like shaking a baby rattle)
    Rattle characteristics include the fast repeated contact/vibration or similar movement/loose parts/missing
    clip or fastener/incorrect clearance.
    • Knock —(Like a knock on a door)
    Knock characteristics include hollow sounding/sometimes repeating/often brought on by driver action.
    • Tick—(Like a clock second hand)
    Tick characteristics include gentle contacting of light materials/loose components/can be caused by driver
    action or road conditions.
    • Thump—(Heavy, muffled knock noise)
    Thump characteristics include softer knock/dead sound often brought on by activity.
    • Buzz—(Like a bumble bee)
    Buzz characteristics include high frequency rattle/firm contact.
    • Often the degree of acceptable noise level will vary depending upon the person. A noise that you may judge
    as acceptable may be very irritating to the customer.
    • Weather conditions, especially humidity and temperature, may have a great effect on noise level.

    DUPLICATE THE NOISE AND TEST DRIVE

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-8

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    If possible, drive the vehicle with the customer until the noise is duplicated. Note any additional information on
    the Diagnostic Worksheet regarding the conditions or location of the noise. This information can be used to
    duplicate the same conditions when you confirm the repair.
    If the noise can be duplicated easily during the test drive, to help identify the source of the noise, try to duplicate the noise with the vehicle stopped by doing one or all of the following:
    1) Close a door.
    2) Tap or push/pull around the area where the noise appears to be coming from.
    3) Rev the engine.
    4) Use a floor jack to recreate vehicle “twist”.
    5) At idle, apply engine load (electrical load, half-clutch on M/T model, drive position on CVT and A/T models).
    6) Raise the vehicle on a hoist and hit a tire with a rubber hammer.
    • Drive the vehicle and attempt to duplicate the conditions the customer states exist when the noise occurs.
    • If it is difficult to duplicate the noise, drive the vehicle slowly on an undulating or rough road to stress the
    vehicle body.

    CHECK RELATED SERVICE BULLETINS
    After verifying the customer concern or symptom, check ASIST for Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) related
    to that concern or symptom.
    If a TSB relates to the symptom, follow the procedure to repair the noise.

    LOCATE THE NOISE AND IDENTIFY THE ROOT CAUSE
    1.
    2.

    Narrow down the noise to a general area. To help pinpoint the source of the noise, use a listening tool
    (Chassis Ear: J-39570, Engine Ear: J-39565 and mechanic’s stethoscope).
    Narrow down the noise to a more specific area and identify the cause of the noise by:
    • removing the components in the area that you suspect the noise is coming from.
    Do not use too much force when removing clips and fasteners, otherwise clips and fasteners can be
    broken or lost during the repair, resulting in the creation of new noise.
    • tapping or pushing/pulling the component that you suspect is causing the noise.
    Do not tap or push/pull the component with excessive force, otherwise the noise will be eliminated only
    temporarily.
    • feeling for a vibration with your hand by touching the component(s) that you suspect is (are) causing the
    noise.
    • placing a piece of paper between components that you suspect are causing the noise.
    • looking for loose components and contact marks.
    Refer to MIR-9, «Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting».

    REPAIR THE CAUSE

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    If the cause is a loose component, tighten the component securely.
    If the cause is insufficient clearance between components:
    separate components by repositioning or loosening and retightening the component, if possible.
    MIR
    insulate components with a suitable insulator such as urethane pads, foam blocks, felt cloth tape or urethane
    tape. A NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) is available through your authorized NISSAN Parts Department.
    M
    CAUTION:
    Do not use excessive force as many components are constructed of plastic and may be damaged.
    NOTE:
    • Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    N
    • The materials contained in the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) are listed on the inside cover of the
    kit; and can each be ordered separately as needed.
    • The following materials not found in the kit can also be used to repair squeaks and rattles.
    — SILICONE GREASE: Use instead of UHMW tape that will be visible or does not fit. The silicone grease will O
    only last a few months.
    — SILICONE SPRAY: Use when grease cannot be applied.
    — DUCT TAPE: Use to eliminate movement.
    P



    CONFIRM THE REPAIR
    Confirm that the cause of a noise is repaired by test driving the vehicle. Operate the vehicle under the same
    conditions as when the noise originally occurred. Refer to the notes on the Diagnostic Worksheet.

    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting

    INFOID:0000000009671234

    Refer to Table of Contents for specific component removal and installation information.
    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-9

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    INSTRUMENT PANEL
    Most incidents are caused by contact and movement between:
    1. Cluster lid A and the instrument panel
    2. Acrylic lens and combination meter housing
    3. Instrument panel to front pillar finisher
    4. Instrument panel to windshield
    5. Instrument panel pins
    6. Wiring harnesses behind the combination meter
    7. A/C defroster duct and duct joint
    These incidents can usually be located by tapping or moving the components to duplicate the noise or by
    pressing on the components while driving to stop the noise. Most of these incidents can be repaired by applying felt cloth tape or silicone spray (in hard to reach areas). Urethane pads can be used to insulate wiring harness.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use silicone spray to isolate a squeak or rattle. If you saturate the area with silicone, you will
    not be able to recheck the repair.

    CENTER CONSOLE
    Components to pay attention to include:
    1. Shift selector assembly cover to finisher
    2. A/C control unit and cluster lid C
    3. Wiring harnesses behind audio and A/C control unit
    The instrument panel repair and isolation procedures also apply to the center console.

    DOORS
    Pay attention to the:
    1. Finisher and inner panel making a slapping noise
    2. Inside handle escutcheon to door finisher
    3. Wiring harnesses tapping
    4. Door striker out of alignment causing a popping noise on starts and stops
    Tapping or moving the components or pressing on them while driving to duplicate the conditions can isolate
    many of these incidents. You can usually insulate the areas with felt cloth tape or insulator foam blocks from
    the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) to repair the noise.

    TRUNK
    Trunk noises are often caused by a loose jack or loose items put into the trunk by the owner.
    In addition look for:
    1. Trunk lid bumpers out of adjustment
    2. Trunk lid striker out of adjustment
    3. The trunk lid torsion bars knocking together
    4. A loose license plate or bracket
    Most of these incidents can be repaired by adjusting, securing or insulating the item(s) or component(s) causing the noise.

    SUNROOF/HEADLINING
    Noises in the sunroof/headlining area can often be traced to one of the following:
    1. Sunroof lid, rail, linkage or seals making a rattle or light knocking noise
    2. Sun visor shaft shaking in the holder
    3. Front or rear windshield touching headlining and squeaking
    Again, pressing on the components to stop the noise while duplicating the conditions can isolate most of these
    incidents. Repairs usually consist of insulating with felt cloth tape.

    OVERHEAD CONSOLE (FRONT AND REAR)
    Overhead console noises are often caused by the console panel clips not being engaged correctly. Most of
    these incidents are repaired by pushing up on the console at the clip locations until the clips engage.
    In addition look for:
    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-10

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Loose harness or harness connectors.
    2. Front console map/reading lamp lens loose.
    3. Loose screws at console attachment points.

    A

    SEATS
    When isolating seat noise it’s important to note the position the seat is in and the load placed on the seat when
    the noise is present. These conditions should be duplicated when verifying and isolating the cause of the
    noise.
    Cause of seat noise include:
    1. Headrest rods and holder
    2. A squeak between the seat pad cushion and frame
    3. The rear seatback lock and bracket
    These noises can be isolated by moving or pressing on the suspected components while duplicating the conditions under which the noise occurs. Most of these incidents can be repaired by repositioning the component
    or applying urethane tape to the contact area.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    UNDERHOOD
    Some interior noise may be caused by components under the hood or on the engine wall. The noise is then
    transmitted into the passenger compartment.
    Causes of transmitted underhood noise include:
    1. Any component installed to the engine wall
    2. Components that pass through the engine wall
    3. Engine wall mounts and connectors
    4. Loose radiator installation pins
    5. Hood bumpers out of adjustment
    6. Hood striker out of adjustment
    These noises can be difficult to isolate since they cannot be reached from the interior of the vehicle. The best
    method is to secure, move or insulate one component at a time and test drive the vehicle. Also, engine rpm or
    load can be changed to isolate the noise. Repairs can usually be made by moving, adjusting, securing, or
    insulating the component causing the noise.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    MIR

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-11

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnostic Worksheet

    INFOID:0000000009671233

    LAIA0072E

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-12

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    MIR

    M

    N

    O
    LAIA0071E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-13

    2014 Note

    INSIDE MIRROR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    INSIDE MIRROR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014893

    AWLIA2177ZZ

    1.

    Windshield glass

    2.

    Mirror base

    3.

    Inside mirror

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009014894

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Hold the inside mirror at the base and push upward, while using
    a suitable tool to release the retainer and remove the inside mirror.
    CAUTION:
    Use care when removing inside mirror to avoid damaging.

    ALLIA1034ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • When installing the inside mirror, check that the retainer is secure on the mirror base.

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-14

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR MIRROR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014895

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J
    AWLIA2160ZZ

    1.

    Door mirror rear finisher

    2.

    Door mirror

    A.

    Door mirror base finisher

    B.

    Door mirror glass

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    K

    Side camera (if equipped)
    Pawl
    INFOID:0000000009014896

    MIR

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    M

    Remove the door mirror rear finisher. Refer to MIR-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Release door mirror harness connector clip from inside door and disconnect harness connector.
    Partially remove the vapor barrier.
    Remove door mirror inner bolt.
    Release door mirror base finisher pawls using a suitable tool (A)
    and remove.
    : Pawl

    N

    O

    P

    AWLIA2183ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-15

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    7. Remove the door mirror outer bolts (A) and the door mirror (1).

    AWLIA2181ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order or removal.
    CAUTION:
    Visually check door mirror base cover pawls for deformation and damage during installation.

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-16

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR REAR FINISHER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR MIRROR REAR FINISHER

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009671236

    REMOVAL
    1.
    a.
    b.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    B

    Remove door mirror glass.
    Tilt the door mirror glass upward.
    Remove door mirror glass by placing a suitable tool in the recesses between door mirror glass and actuator and rotating (twisting) to releasing the pawls.
    Disconnect the harness connector (if equipped) from the door mirror glass.
    Remove actuator screws (A) using a suitable tool (B) and
    remove actuator.
    NOTE:
    Actuator is removed only to access door mirror rear finisher
    pawls. It is not a serviceable component.
    Release pawls using a suitable tool (C) and remove door mirror
    rear finisher (1) from the door mirror (2).
    : Pawl

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J
    AWLIA2179ZZ

    K

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Visually check door mirror rear finisher pawls for deformation and damage during installation.

    MIR

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-17

    2014 Note

    DOOR MIRROR REMOTE CONTROL SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DOOR MIRROR REMOTE CONTROL SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009014900

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove door mirror remote control switch (1) from the instrument lower panel LH using a suitable tool.
    : Pawl

    AWLIA2157ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    MIR-18

    2014 Note

    DRIVER INFORMATION & MULTIMEDIA

    SECTION

    MWI

    METER, WARNING LAMP & INDICATOR

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 4

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 5
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 5
    METER SYSTEM ………………………………………………… 5
    METER SYSTEM : Component Parts Location …….. 5
    METER SYSTEM : Combination Meter ……………….. 6

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 7
    METER SYSTEM ………………………………………………… 7
    METER SYSTEM : System Description ……………….. 7
    METER SYSTEM : Fail-safe ………………………………. 8
    SPEEDOMETER …………………………………………………. 9
    SPEEDOMETER : System Description ………………… 9
    TACHOMETER …………………………………………………… 9
    TACHOMETER : System Description ………………….. 9
    SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR ……………………………… 9
    SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR : System Description ……………………………………………………………….. 10
    OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP ……………………… 10
    OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP : System Description …………………………………………………………. 10
    METER ILLUMINATION CONTROL ……………………. 10
    METER ILLUMINATION CONTROL : System Description …………………………………………………………. 10

    Revision: April 2013

    INFORMATION DISPLAY ……………………………………11
    INFORMATION DISPLAY : System Description ….11

    OPERATION …………………………………………….. 13
    Switch Name and Function ………………………………..13

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION
    METER) ……………………………………………………. 14

    F

    G

    H

    On Board Diagnosis Function …………………………….14
    CONSULT Function ………………………………………….15

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 17

    I

    COMBINATION METER …………………………….. 17
    Reference Value ………………………………………………17
    Fail-safe ………………………………………………………….19
    DTC Index ………………………………………………………20

    J

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE) …………….. 21

    K

    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………21

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 22

    L

    METER SYSTEM ………………………………………. 22
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..22

    M

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 33
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW ……. 33 MWI
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….33

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 34
    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ……………………… 34
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….34
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….34

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ……………………. 35
    Description ………………………………………………………35
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….35
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..35

    B2205 VEHICLE SPEED ……………………………. 36

    MWI-1

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    Description …………………………………………………….. 36
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 36
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 36

    B2267 ENGINE SPEED ………………………………. 37
    Description …………………………………………………….. 37
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 37
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 37

    B2268 WATER TEMP …………………………………. 38
    Description …………………………………………………….. 38
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 38
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 38

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ….. 39
    COMBINATION METER ……………………………………. 39
    COMBINATION METER : Diagnosis Procedure … 39
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM ……………………………….. 39
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………………………………… 40

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT ……. 41

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 43

    THE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP
    DOES NOT TURN ON ………………………………… 44
    Description …………………………………………………….. 44
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 44

    THE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP
    DOES NOT TURN OFF ………………………………. 45
    Description …………………………………………………….. 45
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 45

    THE DOOR OPEN WARNING CONTINUES
    DISPLAYING, OR DOES NOT DISPLAY ……… 46
    Description …………………………………………………….. 46
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 46

    THE PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING
    CONTINUES DISPLAYING, OR DOES NOT
    DISPLAY …………………………………………………… 47
    Description …………………………………………………….. 47
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 47

    Description …………………………………………………….. 41
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 41
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 41
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 42

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …. 48

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………….. 43

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY … 49

    THE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR DOES NOT
    OPERATE …………………………………………………. 43

    COMBINATION METER ……………………………… 49

    Description …………………………………………………….. 43

    Revision: April 2013

    COMBINATION METER ……………………………… 48
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 48

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 49
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………… 49

    MWI-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009473005

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009482448

    Tool name

    Description

    Power Tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-4

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    METER SYSTEM

    B

    METER SYSTEM : Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009561107

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    AWNIA3079ZZ

    A.
    No.

    Combination meter

    B.

    L

    View with inspection hole cover removed.

    Component

    Function

    M

    1.

    Parking brake switch

    Transmits the parking brake switch signal to the combination meter.

    2.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Transmits the vehicle speed signal to the combination meter via CAN communication.
    Refer to BRC-6, «Component Parts Location» for detailed installation location.

    3.

    Engine oil pressure sensor

    Transmits the engine oil pressure sensor signal to the ECM.
    Refer to EM-92, «Exploded View» for detailed installation location.

    TCM

    Transmits the shift position signal to the combination meter via CAN communication.
    Refer to TM-59, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location» for detailed installation location.

    ECM

    Transmits the following signals to the combination meter via CAN communication.
    • Engine speed signal
    • Engine coolant temperature signal
    • Fuel consumption monitor signal
    • Engine oil pressure sensor signal
    Refer to EC-11, «ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location» for
    detailed installation location.

    4.

    5.

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-5

    2014 Note

    MWI

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component

    Function

    6.

    BCM

    Transmits the following signals to the combination meter via CAN communication.
    • Door switch signal
    • Buzzer signal
    Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location» for detailed installation location.

    7.

    Combination meter

    Refer to MWI-6, «METER SYSTEM : Combination Meter».

    8.

    Fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump (fuel
    level sensor)

    Transmits the fuel level sensor signal to the combination meter.

    METER SYSTEM : Combination Meter

    INFOID:0000000009561108

    The combination meter controls the following items according to the signals received from each unit via CAN
    communication and the signals from switches and sensors.
    • Measuring instruments
    • Indicator lamps
    • Warning lamps
    • Meter illumination control
    • Information display

    ARRANGEMENT OF COMBINATION METER

    AWNIA3078ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-6

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    METER SYSTEM
    METER SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009561109

    B

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    AWNIA3080GB

    J

    COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL (CAN COMMUNICATION SIGNAL)
    Transmit unit
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    BCM
    TCM

    K

    Signal name
    Vehicle speed signal
    Door switch signal

    L

    Buzzer signal
    Shift position signal
    Engine speed signal

    M

    Engine coolant temperature signal
    ECM

    Engine oil pressure signal

    MWI

    Fuel consumption signal
    Loose fuel cap signal

    DESCRIPTION

    O

    Combination Meter
    • The combination meter receives necessary signals from each unit, switch, and sensor to control the following functions.
    — Measuring instruments
    — Warning lamps
    — Indicator lamps
    — Meter illumination control
    — Information display
    • The combination meter incorporates a buzzer function that sounds an audible alarm with the integrated
    buzzer device. Refer to WCS-5, «WARNING CHIME SYSTEM : System Description» for further details.

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-7

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • The combination meter includes an on board diagnosis function.
    • The combination meter can be diagnosed with CONSULT.

    METER CONTROL FUNCTION LIST
    System

    Description
    Indicates vehicle speed.

    MWI-9, «SPEEDOMETER : System Description»

    Indicates engine speed.

    MWI-9, «TACHOMETER :
    System Description»

    Indicates shift position.

    MWI-10, «SHIFT
    POSITION INDICATOR : System
    Description»

    The warning lamp turns ON or turns OFF,
    according to engine hydraulic pressure.

    MWI-10, «OIL
    PRESSURE
    WARNING LAMP
    : System Description»

    Meter illumination control function

    Controls the back light of combination meter.

    MWI-10, «METER
    ILLUMINATION
    CONTROL : System Description»

    Odo/trip meter

    Indicates mileage.

    Engine coolant temperature gauge

    Indicates engine coolant temperature.

    Fuel gauge

    Indicates fuel level.

    Loose fuel cap warning

    Indicates loose fuel cap.

    Low fuel warning

    Indicates fuel level.

    Speedometer
    Measuring instruments
    Tachometer

    Shift position indicator

    Warning lamp/indicator
    lamp

    Meter illumination control

    Information display

    Reference

    Engine oil pressure warning lamp

    Trip computer

    Instant fuel consumption

    Displays current fuel consumption.

    Average fuel consumption

    Displays average fuel consumption.

    Distance to empty

    Displays distance to empty.

    Travel distance

    Displays mileage.

    METER SYSTEM : Fail-safe

    MWI-11, «INFORMATION DISPLAY : System
    Description»

    INFOID:0000000009643043

    The combination meter activates the fail-safe control if CAN communication with each unit is malfunctioning.
    Function

    Specifications

    Speedometer

    Reset to zero by suspending communication.

    Tachometer
    Illumination control

    When suspending communication, changes to nighttime mode.

    Shift position indicator

    When suspending communication, not indicate.
    Current fuel consumption
    Trip computer

    Information display

    Average fuel consumption
    Distance to empty

    Buzzer

    Revision: April 2013

    • When reception time of an abnormal signal is 2 seconds or
    less, the last received datum is used for calculation to indicate the result.
    • When reception time of an abnormal signal is more than two
    seconds, the last result calculated during normal condition is
    indicated.

    Engine coolant temperature gauge

    Reset to zero by suspending communication.

    Odo/trip meter

    An indicated value is maintained at communications blackout.
    The buzzer turns OFF by suspending communication.

    MWI-8

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Function

    Specifications

    A

    ABS warning lamp
    Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL)
    EPS warning lamp

    The lamp turns ON by suspending communication.

    B

    Brake warning lamp
    High beam indicator lamp

    C

    Turn signal indicator lamp
    Warning lamp/indicator lamp

    Door warning lamp
    Light indicator lamp

    D

    Engine oil pressure warning lamp

    The lamp turns OFF by suspending communication.

    Key warning lamp

    E

    O/D OFF indicator lamp
    Shift P warning lamp
    Engine start operation indicator lamp

    F

    SPEEDOMETER
    SPEEDOMETER : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009549333

    G

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    H

    I

    J
    AWNIA2379GB

    DESCRIPTION

    K

    The ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) receives each wheel speed sensor signal and provides a vehicle speed signal to the combination meter via CAN communication.

    TACHOMETER

    L

    TACHOMETER : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009549335

    M

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    MWI

    O

    P
    JSNIA2462GB

    DESCRIPTION
    The crank position sensor sends a crankshaft position signal to the ECM. The ECM provides an engine speed
    signal to the combination meter via CAN communication lines. The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions per minute (rpm).

    SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR
    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-9

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009549337

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    AWNIA3081GB

    DESCRIPTION
    The combination meter receives the shift position signal from TCM via CAN communication, and displays the
    position of the shift indicator.

    OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP

    OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009549339

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    AWNIA2885GB

    DESCRIPTION
    The combination meter turns the engine oil pressure warning lamp ON when receiving a signal from the ECM
    via CAN communication.

    METER ILLUMINATION CONTROL

    METER ILLUMINATION CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009549341

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSNIA2919GB

    DESCRIPTION
    • Combination meter controls meter illumination, based on the following signal.
    — Position light request signal
    • The combination meter turns ON meter illumination when the following conditions are satisfied.
    Condition
    Combination switch (Lighting switch)

    Revision: April 2013

    1st or 2nd position

    MWI-10

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • The combination meter turns OFF meter illumination when the following conditions are satisfied.
    A
    Condition
    Combination switch (Lighting switch)

    OFF

    B

    INFORMATION DISPLAY
    INFORMATION DISPLAY : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009549343

    C

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    AWNIA2439GB

    DESRIPTION
    • The combination meter receives signals from switches, sensors and modules for operating the following
    functions on the information display.
    — Odo/trip meter
    — Engine coolant temperature gauge
    — Fuel gauge
    — Trip computer
    — Interrupt indication
    — Meter illumination level
    — Low fuel warning
    — Loose fuel cap warning

    ODO/TRIP METER
    The combination meter calculates mileage using the vehicle speed signal from the ABS actuator and electric
    unit (control unit) and displays the mileage on the information display.

    ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE GAUGE
    The engine coolant temperature gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature.
    The ECM provides an engine coolant temperature signal to the combination meter via CAN communication.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    FUEL GAUGE
    Control Outline
    The fuel level sensor unit sends a variable resistor signal to the combination meter. The fuel gauge indicates
    the approximate fuel level in the fuel tank.
    Refuel Control
    The unit detects the driver is refueling the vehicle and accelerates the fuel gauge segment movement if the
    fuel level changes by 9 (2-3/8 US, 2 lmp gal) or more.

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-11

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Lighting segment-resistance relationship

    AWNIA3088GB

    INTERRUPT INDICATION
    Low Fuel Warning
    The low fuel warning turns ON when the fuel level in the fuel tank reaches approximately 7.3
    1-5/8 Imp gal).

    (1-7/8 US gal,

    LOOSE FUEL CAP WARNING
    The LOOSE FUEL CAP message will display in the information display when the fuel-filler cap is not tightened
    correctly. The message will turn off as soon as the ECM detects the fuel-filler cap is properly tightened. The
    ECM provides a loose fuel cap signal to the combination meter via CAN communication lines.

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-12

    2014 Note

    OPERATION
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    OPERATION

    A

    Switch Name and Function

    INFOID:0000000009643045

    B

    C

    D

    JSNIA3909ZZ

    Switch name

    Operation

    Illumination control switch (1)

    Meter control switch (2)

    Description
    An illuminance level of the back light of the combination meter can be adjusted.

    Press




    The information display screen can be switched.
    The trip meter can be switched between A and B.
    Trip meter A/B can be reset by pressing and holding the meter control switch.
    Time can be adjusted.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-13

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    On Board Diagnosis Function

    INFOID:0000000009549344

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSIS ITEM
    Information display, speedometer and tachometer can be checked in self-diagnosis mode.

    STARTING COMBINATION METER SELF-DIAGNOSIS MODE
    METHOD OF STARTING

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Turn ignition switch ON, and switch the trip meter to “trip A” or “trip B”.
    Turn ignition switch to OFF.
    While pressing the meter control switch (1), turn the ignition
    switch ON.
    Make sure that the trip meter displays “0000.0”.
    Press the meter control switch (1) at least 3 times. (Within 7 seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON).

    JSNIA3904ZZ

    6.

    The combination meter is turned to self-diagnosis mode.
    • All segments of the information display and shift position indicator (A) for CVT models are displayed.

    JSNIA3900ZZ

    NOTE:
    • Check combination meter power supply and ground circuit when the self-diagnosis mode of the combination
    meter does not start. replace combination meter if power supply and ground circuit are normal.
    • If any of the segments are not displayed, replace combination meter.
    7.

    Each meter activates by pressing the meter control switch.

    AWNIA2440ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    NOTE:
    • If any of the meters or gauges is not activated, replace combination meter.
    • The figure is reference.

    CONSULT Function

    A
    INFOID:0000000009549345

    B

    APPLICATION ITEMS
    CONSULT can display each diagnostic item using the diagnostic test modes shown.
    METER/M&A Diagnosis mode

    C

    Description

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    The combination meter self-diagnosis results.

    Data Monitor

    D

    Displays combination meter input/output data in real time.

    Warning History

    Lighting history of the warning lamp and indicator lamp can be checked.

    SELF DIAG RESULT

    E

    Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR

    F

    Display Item List
    X: Applicable

    Display item [Unit]
    SPEED METER
    [km/h] or [mph]
    SPEED OUTPUT
    [km/h] or [mph]

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    G

    Description

    X

    Displays the value of vehicle speed signal.

    X

    Displays the value of vehicle speed signal, which is transmitted to each unit with
    CAN communication.

    ODO OUTPUT
    [km/h or mph]

    H

    Displays odometer signal value transmitted to other units via CAN communication.

    TACHO METER
    [rpm]

    X

    Displays the value of engine speed signal, which is input from ECM.

    FUEL METER
    [L]

    X

    Displays the fuel level.

    W TEMP METER
    [°C] or [°F]

    X

    Displays the value of engine coolant temperature signal, which is input from ECM.

    ABS W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of ABS warning indicator

    BRAKE W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of brake warning indicator.

    DOOR W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of door warning indicator.

    HI-BEAM IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of high beam indicator.

    TURN IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of turn indicator.

    LIGHT IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of light indicator.

    OIL W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of engine oil pressure warning indicator.

    MIL
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of malfunction indicator.

    CRUISE IND
    [Off]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of CRUISE indicator.

    O/D OFF IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of O/D OFF indicator.

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    MWI-15

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Display item [Unit]

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    Description

    FUEL W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of low-fuel warning indicator.

    O/D OFF SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of O/D OFF switch.

    REAR DEF SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of rear window defogger switch.

    BRAKE SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of brake switch.

    EPS W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of EPS indicator.

    CHAGE W/L
    [Off]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of charge warning indicator.

    SHIFT IND
    [P, R, N, D, L]

    Displays shift selector position.

    FUEL CAP W/L
    [Off]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of loose fuel cap warning message.

    PKB SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Status of parking brake switch.

    BUCKLE SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Status of seat belt buckle switch (LH).

    BRAKE OIL SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Status of brake fluid level switch.

    DISTANCE
    [km] or [Mi]

    Displays distance to empty.

    BUZZER
    [ON/OFF]

    X

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of buzzer.

    FR FOG IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of front fog lamp indicator.

    KEY G/Y W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of Intelligent Key warning lamp.

    NOTE:
    Some items are not available according to vehicle specification.

    WARNING HISTORY
    Display item
    W/L ON HISTORY

    Description
    Lighting history of warning lamp and indicator lamp can be checked.

    W/L ON HISTORY
    • Stores histories when warning/indicator lamp is turned on.
    • “W/L ON HISTORY” indicates the “TIME” when the warning/ indicator lamp is turned on.
    • The “TIME” above is:
    — 0: The condition that the warning/indicator lamp has been turned on 1 or more times after starting the engine
    and waiting for 30 seconds.
    — 1 — 39: The number of times the engine was restarted after the 0 condition.
    — NO W/L ON HISTORY: Stores NO (0) turning on history of warning/indicator lamp.
    NOTE:
    • W/L ON HISTORY is not stored for approximately 30 seconds after the engine starts.
    • Brake warning lamp does not store any history when the parking brake is applied or the brake fluid level gets
    low.

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-16

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION

    A

    COMBINATION METER
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009015874

    B

    VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL
    Monitor Item

    C

    Data monitor

    Display content

    Condition

    Reference value in normal operation

    SPEED METER
    [km/h or mph]

    Speed meter
    operation

    While driving

    Vehicle speed matches speed meter

    SPEED OUTPUT
    [km/h or mph]

    Vehicle speed

    While driving

    The speed output signal value via CAN
    communication is approx. value of vehicle speed.

    ODO OUTPUT
    [km/h or mph]

    ODO meter operation

    Driving

    Distance driven

    TACHO METER
    [rpm]

    Tacho meter
    operation

    Engine running

    The tacho meter is approx. value of engine speed via CAN communication.

    FUEL METER
    [L]

    Fuel level

    Ignition ON

    Fuel level is approx. value of fuel
    gauge.

    W TEMP METER
    [°C] or [°F]

    Engine coolant
    temperature

    Engine running

    Input value of engine coolant temperature signal via CAN communication.

    ABS W/L

    ABS warning
    lamp

    When ABS warning lamp is ON

    On

    When ABS warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    BRAKE W/L

    Brake warning
    lamp

    When Brake warning lamp is ON

    On*

    When Brake warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    DOOR W/L

    Door open
    warning lamp

    When Door warning lamp is ON

    On

    When Door warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    HI-BEAM IND

    HI-Beam indicator lamp

    When High-beam indicator lamp is ON

    On

    When High-beam indicator lamp is OFF

    Off

    TURN IND

    Turn signal indicator

    When Turn signal indicator lamp is ON

    On

    When Turn signal indicator lamp is OFF

    Off

    LIGHT IND

    Light indicator

    When Tail lamp indicator lamp is ON

    On

    When Tail lamp indicator lamp is OFF

    Off

    FR FOG IND

    Front fog lamp
    indicator

    Front fog lamp indicator lamp ON

    On

    Front fog lamp indicator lamp OFF

    Off

    When engine oil pressure warning lamp is
    ON

    On

    OIL W/L

    Engine oil pressure warning
    light

    When engine oil pressure warning lamp is
    OFF

    Off

    When Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is
    ON

    On

    When Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is
    OFF

    Off

    Cruise indicator
    lamp

    When cruise indicator lamp is ON.

    ON

    When cruise indicator lamp is OFF.

    Off

    O/D OFF indicator

    When O/D OFF indicator lamp is OFF.

    Off

    When O/D OFF indicator lamp is ON.

    On

    MIL

    CRUISE IND
    O/D OFF IND

    Revision: April 2013

    MIL warning
    lamp

    MWI-17

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item

    Data monitor

    Display content

    O/D OFF SW

    O/D OFF
    switch
    Rear defogger
    switch

    REAR DEF SW

    Condition

    Reference value in normal operation

    When O/D OFF switch is pressed to OFF.

    Off

    When O/D OFF switch is pressed to ON.

    On

    When rear defogger switch is pressed to
    ON

    On

    When rear defogger is pressed to Off

    Off

    When brake pedal is applied

    On

    When brake pedal is released

    Off
    On

    BRAKE SW

    Brake switch

    FUEL W/L

    Low fuel warning

    When low fuel warning is ON
    When low fuel warning is Off

    Off

    EPS W/L

    EPS warning
    lamp

    EPS warning lamp ON

    On

    EPS warning lamp OFF

    Off

    CHAGE W/L

    Charge warning lamp

    Engine running

    Off

    SHIFT IND

    Shift position
    indicator

    The position of the shift position selector.

    FUEL CAP W/L

    Loose fuel cap
    warning

    Loose fuel filler cap warning is On

    On

    Loose fuel filler cap warning is Off

    Off

    PKB SW

    Parking brake
    switch

    When parking brake is active

    On

    When parking brake is inactive

    Off

    BUCKLE SW

    Seat belt buckle switch LH

    BRAKE OIL SW

    Brake fluid level
    switch

    DISTANCE

    Distance to
    empty

    BUZZER

    Buzzer operation

    [P, R, N, D, L]

    When seat belt buckle is unfastened (LH).

    On

    When seat belt buckle is fastened (LH).

    Off

    When brake fluid level switch ON

    On

    When brake fluid level switch OFF

    Off

    While driving

    [km/h or mph]

    When Buzzer is ON

    On

    When Buzzer is OFF

    Off

    *: Displays “Off” if the brake warning lamp is illuminated when the valve check starts, the parking brake switch
    is turned ON or the brake fluid level switch is turned ON.

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    JSNIA5390ZZ

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    Terminal
    No.

    Wire
    color

    1

    L

    2

    P

    Condition
    Ignition
    switch

    Operation or condition

    Reference value (V)
    (Approx.)

    CAN-H

    CAN-L

    Item

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-18

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    No.

    Wire
    color

    3

    SB

    4

    Condition
    Ignition
    switch

    Operation or condition

    Reference value (V)
    (Approx.)

    2P/R

    LG

    8P/R

    6

    W

    Fuel level sensor signal (+)

    7

    V

    Air bag

    8

    P

    O/D OFF switch

    ON

    9

    V

    Seat belt buckle switch LH

    ON

    Item

    10

    SB

    Parking Brake switch

    ON

    11

    BR

    Brake fluid level switch

    ON

    15

    R

    18

    R/Y

    21

    B

    22

    B

    23

    B

    24

    B

    Refer to MWI-42, «Component Inspection».

    O/D OFF switch pressed

    0

    O/D OFF switch released

    Battery voltage

    Unfastened (ON)

    0

    Fastened (OFF)

    Battery voltage

    Parking brake is inactive
    Parking brake is active

    0

    F

    Battery voltage

    Ignition switch ON or ACC

    Battery voltage

    Ground

    0

    GR

    Fuel level sensor ground (-)

    ON

    0

    27

    R/W

    Battery power supply

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    28

    GR

    Ignition switch ON or START

    ON

    Battery voltage

    Y

    Generator

    Generator voltage low

    ON

    Generator voltage normal

    E

    Battery voltage

    Security

    38

    C

    D

    0

    Brake fluid level low
    Brake fluid level normal

    A

    G

    H

    I

    0

    J

    Battery voltage

    Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009015875

    K

    The combination meter activates the fail-safe control if CAN communication with each unit is malfunctioning.
    Function

    L

    Specifications

    Speedometer

    Reset to zero by suspending communication.

    Tachometer
    Illumination control

    When suspending communication, changes to nighttime mode.

    Shift position indicator

    When suspending communication, not indicate.
    Current fuel consumption
    Trip computer

    Information display

    Average fuel consumption
    Distance to empty

    Buzzer

    Revision: April 2013

    • When reception time of an abnormal signal is 2 seconds or
    less, the last received datum is used for calculation to indicate the result.
    • When reception time of an abnormal signal is more than two
    seconds, the last result calculated during normal condition is
    indicated.

    Engine coolant temperature gauge

    Reset to zero by suspending communication.

    Odo/trip meter

    An indicated value is maintained at communications blackout.
    The buzzer turns OFF by suspending communication.

    MWI-19

    2014 Note

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Function

    Specifications

    ABS warning lamp
    Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL)
    EPS warning lamp

    The lamp turns ON by suspending communication.

    Brake warning lamp
    High beam indicator lamp
    Turn signal indicator lamp
    Warning lamp/indicator lamp

    Door warning lamp
    Light indicator lamp
    Engine oil pressure warning lamp

    The lamp turns OFF by suspending communication.

    Key warning lamp
    O/D OFF indicator lamp
    Shift P warning lamp
    Engine start operation indicator lamp

    DTC Index
    Display contents of CONSULT

    INFOID:0000000009015876

    Diagnostic item is detected when…

    Refer to

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [U1000]

    When combination meter is not transmitting or receiving CAN communication signal for
    2 seconds or more.

    MWI-34

    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [U1010]

    When detecting error during the initial diagnosis of the CAN controller of combination
    meter.

    MWI-35

    VEHICLE SPEED
    [B2205]

    The abnormal vehicle speed signal is input from the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) for 2 seconds or more.

    MWI-36

    ENGINE SPEED
    [B2267]

    If ECM continuously transmits abnormal engine speed signals for 2 seconds or more.

    MWI-37

    WATER TEMP
    [B2268]

    If ECM continuously transmits abnormal engine coolant temperature signals for 60 seconds or more.

    MWI-38

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-20

    2014 Note

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE)
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE)

    A

    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009549346

    B
    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    C

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-21

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    METER SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009015878

    AANWA0867GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-22

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O
    AANWA0868GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-23

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANWA0869GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-24

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O
    AANIA1737GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-25

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1738GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-26

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O
    AANIA1739GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-27

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1740GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-28

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O
    AANIA1741GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-29

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1742GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-30

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O
    AANIA1743GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-31

    2014 Note

    METER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1744GB

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-32

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009549347

    B

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    AWNIA2458GB

    H

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.CONFIRM SYMPTOM

    I

    Confirm symptom or customer complaint.
    >> GO TO 2.

    J

    2.SELF-DIAGNOSIS OF COMBINATION METER
    Perform self-diagnosis of combination meter. Refer to MWI-14, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> If self-diagnosis will not start, check power supply and ground circuit of combination meter. Refer
    to MWI-39, «COMBINATION METER : Diagnosis Procedure». If power supply and ground circuits
    are OK, replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    K

    L

    3.CHECK COMBINATION METER WITH CONSULT

    M
    Select METER/M&A on CONSULT and perform self-diagnosis of combination meter. Refer to MWI-15, «CONSULT Function».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    MWI
    YES >> Check symptom. GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».

    4.CHECK SYSTEM OPERATION

    O

    Check the combination meter to verify that the repair has been completed successfully.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 1.

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-33

    2014 Note

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009549371

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Display Item

    Malfunction detected condition

    Possible malfunction

    U1000

    CAN COMM CIRC
    [U1000]

    When combination meter is not receiving CAN communication
    signals for 2 seconds or more.

    Combination meter

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549372

    1.CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION
    Select SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode for METER/M&A with CONSULT.
    >> GO TO LAN system. Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-34

    2014 Note

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549373

    Initial diagnosis of combination meter.

    B

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009549374

    C

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    U1010

    Display Item
    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [U1010]

    Malfunction detected condition

    Possible malfunction

    When detecting error during the initial diagnosis of
    the CAN controller of combination meter.

    Combination meter

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549375

    D

    E

    1.REPLACE COMBINATION METER
    When DTC U1010 is detected, replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    >> Inspection End.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-35

    2014 Note

    B2205 VEHICLE SPEED
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2205 VEHICLE SPEED
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549376

    The ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) provides a vehicle speed signal to the combination meter via
    CAN communication lines.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009549377

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    B2205

    Display Item
    VEHICLE SPEED CIRC
    [B2205]

    Malfunction detected condition
    Malfunction is detected when an erroneous
    speed signal is received for 2 seconds or
    more.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    Possible malfunction
    • Combination meter
    • ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    INFOID:0000000009549378

    1.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Start engine and select METER/M&A on CONSULT.
    Using SPEED METER on DATA MONITOR, compare the value of DATA MONITOR with speedometer
    pointer of combination meter. Speedometer and DATA MONITOR indications should be close.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Perform ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) self-diagnosis. Refer to BRC-19, «CONSULT
    Function (ABS)».
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-36

    2014 Note

    B2267 ENGINE SPEED
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2267 ENGINE SPEED

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549379

    The engine speed signal is transmitted from ECM to the combination meter via CAN communication.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009549380

    C

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    B2267

    B

    Display Item
    TACHO METER
    [B2267]

    Malfunction detected condition
    ECM continuously transmits abnormal engine
    speed signals for 2 seconds or more

    Possible malfunction
    • Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
    • ECM

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549381

    D

    E

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS OF ECM
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of ECM, and repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    F

    >> Refer to EC-53, «CONSULT Function».

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-37

    2014 Note

    B2268 WATER TEMP
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2268 WATER TEMP
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549382

    The engine coolant temperature signal is transmitted from ECM to the combination meter via CAN communication.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009549383

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    B2268

    Display Item
    WATER TEMP METER
    [B2268]

    Malfunction detected condition
    ECM continuously transmits abnormal engine coolant
    temperature signals for 60 seconds or more

    Possible malfunction
    • Engine coolant temperature sensor
    • ECM

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549384

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS OF ECM
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of ECM, and repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    >> Refer to EC-53, «CONSULT Function».

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-38

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    A

    COMBINATION METER
    COMBINATION METER : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549348

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to MWI-22, «Wiring Diagram».

    B

    C

    1.CHECK FUSE
    D

    Check that the following fuses are not blown.
    Power source

    Fuse No.

    Battery

    8

    Ignition switch ON or START

    3

    Ignition switch ACC or ON

    18

    E

    F

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.

    G

    2.POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT CHECK
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect combination meter connector.
    Check voltage between combination meter harness connector M24, terminals 27, 28, 15 and ground.
    Terminals

    Ignition switch position

    (+)
    Connector

    (–)

    Terminal
    27

    M24

    28

    I

    OFF

    ACC

    ON

    START

    Battery voltage

    Battery voltage

    Battery
    voltage

    Battery voltage

    0V

    0V

    Battery
    voltage

    Battery voltage

    0V

    Battery voltage

    Battery
    voltage

    0V

    Ground

    15

    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    3.GROUND

    H

    L

    CIRCUIT CHECK

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination meter connector.
    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector M24, terminals 21, 22, 23 and ground.

    MWI

    Terminals
    (+)
    Connector

    (–)

    Terminal

    O

    Continuity

    21
    M24

    P

    22

    Ground

    Yes

    23

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM
    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-39

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009643044

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSES AND FUSIBLE LINK
    Check that the following fuses and fusible link are not blown.
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    57

    Fuses and fusible link No.
    12 (10A)

    Battery power supply

    70

    G (40A)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector M99.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal
    57

    M99

    70

    Ground

    Voltage

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    67

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-40

    2014 Note

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549351

    The fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump detects the approximate fuel level in the fuel tank and transmits the
    fuel level signal to the combination meter.

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009549352

    C

    1.COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    B

    Select METER/M&A on CONSULT.
    Using FUEL METER of DATA MONITOR, compare the DATA MONITOR value with the fuel gauge position.
    Fuel gauge indication position

    Reference value of data monitor [L]

    1

    Approx. 39.7

    3/4

    Approx. 32.9

    1/2

    Approx. 22.7

    1/4

    Approx. 11.9

    0

    Approx. 2.7

    D

    E

    F

    G

    Does monitor value match fuel gauge reading?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H
    INFOID:0000000009549353

    I

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to MWI-22, «Wiring Diagram».
    J

    1.CHECK HARNESS CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check combination meter and fuel level sensor unit terminals (meter-side and harness-side) for poor connection.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace terminals or connectors.

    K

    L

    2.CHECK FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    3.

    M
    Disconnect combination meter harness connector M24 and fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness
    connector B44.
    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector M24 terminal 6 and fuel level sensor unit
    MWI
    and fuel pump harness connector B44 terminal 2.
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    M24

    6

    B44

    2

    Yes

    Check continuity between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness connector B44 terminal 2 and
    ground.
    Connector

    Terminal

    B44

    2

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.
    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-41

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    FUEL LEVEL SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK FUEL LEVEL SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.

    2.

    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector M24 terminal 24 and fuel level sensor
    unit and fuel pump harness connector B44 terminal 5.
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    M24

    24

    B44

    5

    Yes

    Check continuity between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness connector B44 terminal 5 and
    ground.
    Connector

    Terminal

    B44

    5

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    4.CHECK INSTALLATION CONDITION

    Check fuel level sensor unit installation, and verify the float arm does not interfere or bind with the internal
    components in the fuel tank.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Install the fuel level sensor unit properly.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009549354

    1.REMOVE FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT
    Remove the fuel level sensor unit. Refer to FL-6, «Removal and Installation».
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT
    Check the resistance between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump.
    Terminals
    Fuel level sensor unit
    2

    5

    Condition

    Resistance (Ω)
    (Approx.)

    Height [mm (in)]

    Full* (A)

    51

    168.2 (6.62)

    283

    17.5 (0.69)

    Empty*

    (B)

    *: When float rod is in contact with stopper.

    Is inspection result OK?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump. Refer to
    FL-6, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-42

    JPNIA0841ZZ

    2014 Note

    THE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    THE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR DOES NOT OPERATE
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549355

    B

    INFOID:0000000009549356

    C

    Fuel gauge will not indicate from a certain position.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    1.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Select METER/M&A on CONSULT.
    Using DATA MONITOR, compare the monitor value with the fuel gauge reading on the combination meter.
    Refer to MWI-41, «Component Function Check».
    Does monitor value match fuel gauge reading?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    D

    E

    2.CHECK FUEL LEVEL SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    F

    Check the fuel level sensor signal circuit. Refer to MWI-41, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    G

    3.COMPONENT INSPECTION

    H

    Perform a component inspection on the fuel level sensor unit. Refer to MWI-42, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace fuel level sensor unit. Refer to FL-6, «Removal and Installation».

    I

    4.CHECK FLOAT INTERFERENCE

    J

    Check that the float arm does not interfere or bind with components in the fuel tank.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-43

    2014 Note

    THE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    THE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549357

    The engine oil pressure warning lamp stays off when the ignition switch is turned ON.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549358

    1.CHECK COMBINATION METER ENGINE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
    1.
    2.

    Select METER/M&A on CONSULT.
    Observe OIL W/L DATA MONITOR while operating the ignition switch.
    Component
    Engine oil pressure warning light

    Condition

    CONSULT

    Ignition ON

    ON

    Ignition OFF

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-44

    2014 Note

    THE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN OFF
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    THE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN OFF
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009549359

    The engine oil pressure warning lamp remains on while the engine is running (normal oil pressure).

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549360

    1.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    B

    C

    Start the engine and select METER/M&A on CONSULT.
    Observe OIL W/L DATA MONITOR and the operation of the engine oil pressure warning lamp on the combination meter.
    Component

    Condition

    CONSULT

    Engine oil pressure warning light

    Engine running

    OFF

    D

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Perform ECM self-diagnosis. Refer to EC-53, «CONSULT Function».
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-45

    2014 Note

    THE DOOR OPEN WARNING CONTINUES DISPLAYING, OR DOES NOT DISPLAY
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    THE DOOR OPEN WARNING CONTINUES DISPLAYING, OR DOES NOT
    DISPLAY
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549367

    • The door ajar warning is displayed even though all of the doors are closed.
    • The door ajar warning is not displayed even though a door is ajar.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549368

    1.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL
    Check the BCM input signal. Refer to DLK-84, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    2.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL

    Select the METER/M&A Data Monitor and check the DOOR W/L monitor value while opening and closing
    doors.
    Monitor item
    DOOR W/L

    Condition

    Status

    Door open

    ON

    Door closed

    OFF

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    3.CHECK DOOR SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    Check the door switch signal circuit. Refer to DLK-84, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    4.CHECK DOOR SWITCH

    Check the door switch. Refer to DLK-85, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace applicable door switch. Refer to DLK-158, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-46

    2014 Note

    THE PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CONTINUES DISPLAYING, OR
    DOES NOT DISPLAY
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    THE PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CONTINUES DISPLAYING,
    OR DOES NOT DISPLAY
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009549369

    • The parking brake warning is displayed while driving the vehicle even though the parking brake is released.
    • The parking brake warning is not displayed while driving the vehicle even though the parking brake is
    applied.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    B

    C

    INFOID:0000000009549370

    1.CHECK PARKING BRAKE WARNING LAMP OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    A

    D

    Start engine.
    Check the operation of the brake warning lamp while operating the parking brake.
    Condition

    Warning lamp status

    Parking brake applied

    ON

    Parking brake released

    OFF

    E

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    G

    2.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH

    H

    Check the parking brake switch. Refer to BRC-59, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace parking brake switch. Refer to PB-9, «Removal and Installation».

    I

    3.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    J

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Check the parking brake switch signal circuit. Refer to BRC-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    K

    L

    M

    MWI

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-47

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    COMBINATION METER
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009482449

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove cluster lid A. Refer to IP-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove combination meter screws (A).

    ALNIA1519ZZ

    4.

    Pull the combination meter straight out to release clips.
    NOTE:
    Back side of the combination meter shown for clip position (
    clarity.

    )

    JSNIA3895ZZ

    5.

    Disconnect the harness connector from the combination meter.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-48

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY

    A

    COMBINATION METER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009482450

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    AWNIA3052ZZ

    1.

    Combination meter

    2.

    Combination meter lens

    3.

    J

    Combination meter finisher

    Pawl

    K

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009482451

    CAUTION:
    • Do not touch the display, pointer, the inside of combination meter and the printed area of the dial
    during the work.
    • Keep away from magnetic sources.
    • Do not damage the combination meter finisher.

    L

    M

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    MWI

    Remove the combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    Release the pawls and remove combination meter finisher.
    Remove screws, then release pawls and remove combination meter lens.

    O

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    MWI-49

    2014 Note

    BRAKES

    SECTION

    PB

    PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    PARKING BRAKE CONTROL ……………………… 6 PB
    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 6
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 6

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    PARKING BRAKE CABLE ………………………….. 7

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    PARKING BRAKE REAR CABLE ………………… 8

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 3

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 4
    PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM …………………………. 4
    Inspection and Adjustment …………………………………. 4

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 6

    G

    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 7
    H

    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 8

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ………………………… 9
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 9

    I

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 10

    J

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 10

    K

    Parking Brake Control ………………………………………10

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009619502

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009365037

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    B

    C

    D

    E
    PIIB1407E

    PB

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-3

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009365038

    INSPECTION
    Parking Brake Control Stroke

    1.

    When parking brake control is operated with a force of 196 N
    (20.0 kg-f, 44.1 lb-f), make sure parking brake control stroke is
    within the specified number of notches. (Check by listening and
    counting the number of ratchet clicks.)
    Number of
    notches

    2.

    : Refer to PB-10, «Parking Brake
    Control».

    Check that the parking brake lamp illuminates, after parking
    brake has been operated to the specified number of notches.
    Number of
    notches

    : Refer to PB-10, «Parking Brake
    Control».

    WFIA0508E

    Inspect Components
    • Check the parking brake components for bends, wear and or damage. Replace if any damage is noted.
    • Check that the parking brake operates properly; be sure that it is not bound up or sticking.
    • Check that the brake warning light illuminates after parking brake has been operated to the specified number
    of notches. Refer to PB-10, «Parking Brake Control».
    • Inspect and adjust the rear brakes if necessary. Refer to BR-42, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    ADJUSTMENT
    1.
    2.

    Pull parking brake control (1) until the access hole (2) is visible.
    Use suitable tool to adjust nut (A).
    Turn adjusting nut (A) using suitable tool to loosen the front
    cable.

    AWFIA1013ZZ

    3.
    4.

    Depress the brake pedal with a force of 196 N (20.0 kg-f, 44.1 lb-f) about 10 times and adjust the brake
    shoe clearance.
    Adjust the cable with the following procedure.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-4

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    To prevent damage to parts, do not bend the parking brake cables.
    a. Adjust the parking brake lever stroke by turning the adjusting nut using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the adjusting nut if the nut is removed.
    b. Operate the parking brake lever with a force of 196 N (20.0 kg-f, 44.1lb-f). Check that the lever stroke is
    within the specified number of notches. (Check by listening and counting the number of the ratchet clicks.)
    Number of notches

    : Refer to PB-10, «Parking Brake Control».

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    PB

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-5

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009365039

    JPFIB0133GB

    1.

    Parking brake control

    2.

    Adjusting nut

    3.

    Parking brake switch

    4.

    Parking brake front cable

    5.

    Parking brake rear cable (LH)

    6.

    Parking brake rear cable (RH)

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009365040

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the adjusting nut.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the adjusting nut.
    Separate the parking brake front cable from the parking brake rear cables (RH/LH).
    Disconnect the harness connector from the parking brake switch.
    Remove the screw and remove the parking brake switch.
    Remove the nuts and remove the parking brake control.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of the removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Replace the parking brake control if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    • Replace the parking brake switch if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    • Do not reuse the adjusting nut.
    Inspect and adjust the parking brake. Refer to PB-4, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-6

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE CABLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PARKING BRAKE CABLE

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009619499

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    B

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the adjusting nut. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».
    Separate the parking brake front cable from parking brake rear cables (RH/LH). Refer to PB-6, «Exploded
    View».
    CAUTION:
    To prevent damage to the parts, do not bend the parking brake cables.
    Remove the parking brake front cable.

    INSTALLATION

    C

    D

    E

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the adjusting nut.
    • Inspect and adjust the parking brake. Refer to PB-4, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    PB

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-7

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE REAR CABLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PARKING BRAKE REAR CABLE
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009619500

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Loosen the adjusting nut. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».
    NOTE:
    It is not necessary to remove the parking brake front cable.
    Separate the parking brake rear cables (RH/LH) from the parking brake front cable. Refer to PB-6,
    «Exploded View».
    Remove the rear wheels and tires using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Exploded View».
    Remove rear wheel sensors. Refer to BRC-70, «REAR WHEEL SENSOR : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the rear drum brake components. Refer to BR-40, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Do not separate the brake tube from the wheel cylinders.
    Remove the center muffler. Refer to EX-5, «Exploded View».
    Remove nuts (A) and remove center floor insulators.

    ALBIA1147ZZ

    9.

    Remove the bolts and remove the parking brake rear brake cables (RH/LH).
    CAUTION:
    Do not excessively bend the parking brake cables.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the adjusting nut if the nut is removed.
    • Inspect and adjust the rear brakes. Refer to BR-42, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    • Inspect and adjust the parking brake. Refer to PB-4, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-8

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009619501

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect the harness connector from parking brake switch. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».
    Remove the screw and remove the parking brake switch. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».

    C

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Replace the parking brake switch if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    Adjust the parking brake cable if necessary. Refer to PB-4, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    D

    E

    PB

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PB-9

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Parking Brake Control

    INFOID:0000000009365041

    Item

    Standard

    Number of notches [under force of 196 N (20.0 kg-f, 44.1 lb-f)]
    Number of notches when brake warning light illuminates

    Revision: April 2013

    11 − 12 notches
    1 notch maximum

    PB-10

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL & POWER CONTROL

    SECTION

    PCS

    POWER CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS

    F

    IPDM E/R

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 26

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ……………………… 26

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    Description ………………………………………………………26
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….26
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..26

    G

    B2098 IGNITION RELAY ON STUCK ………….. 27

    H

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….27
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..27

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4

    B2099 IGNITION RELAY OFF STUCK ………… 28

    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 4

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….28
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..28

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 5
    RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM ……………………………….. 5
    RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description …………………………………………………………………. 5
    RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail-safe ………………. 6
    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM ……… 7
    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM :
    System Description …………………………………………… 7

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R) …………………. 9
    Diagnosis Description ……………………………………….. 9
    CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R) ……………………….. 10

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 13
    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM) ……………..13
    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 13
    Fail-safe ………………………………………………………… 18
    DTC Index …………………………………………………….. 20

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..29

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 30

    K

    IPDM E/R ………………………………………………….. 30
    Exploded View …………………………………………………30
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..30

    L

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    PRECAUTION ………………………………………. 32
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………. 32
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» ………………………………………………………..32

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………….. 33

    PCS

    N

    O

    COMPONENT PARTS ……………………………….. 33
    Component Parts Location ………………………………..33

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………… 34

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM) ……………..21

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM ……………………….34
    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM : System Description ………………………………………………………….34

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT …. 29

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 21

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 21

    I

    PCS-1

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ………………………. 36
    COMMON ITEM ……………………………………………….. 36
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) ……………………………………………. 36
    INTELLIGENT KEY …………………………………………… 36
    INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM INTELLIGENT KEY) ……………………………………….. 37

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 40

    B2616 IGNITION RELAY CIRCUIT ………………. 57
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 57
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 57
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 58

    B2618 BCM ………………………………………………. 59
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 59
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 59

    B261A PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ….. 61

    BCM …………………………………………………………. 40

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 61
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 61

    List of ECU Reference …………………………………….. 40

    B26F1 IGNITION RELAY ……………………………. 63

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………. 41

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 63
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 63

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM ………………. 41
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 41

    B26F2 IGNITION RELAY ……………………………. 65

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 48

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 65
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 65

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW …….. 48

    B26F6 BCM ………………………………………………. 67

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………… 48

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 51
    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ………………………. 51
    Description …………………………………………………….. 51
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 51
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 51

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ……………………. 52
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 52
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 52

    B2614 ACC RELAY CIRCUIT ……………………… 53

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 67
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 67

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH …………….. 69
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 69
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 69
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 70

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 72
    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH DOES
    NOT OPERATE …………………………………………. 72
    Description …………………………………………………….. 72
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 72

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 53
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 53
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 54

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ………….. 73

    B2615 BLOWER RELAY CIRCUIT ………………. 55

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 73

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 55
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 55
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 56

    Revision: April 2013

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE) ……………… 73
    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH …………….. 74
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 74

    PCS-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [IPDM E/R]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009607429

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-3

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009567560

    AWMIA1435ZZ

    1.

    IPDM E/R

    A.

    Engine compartment (LH)

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-4

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM
    RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009567562

    B

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    AWMIA1439GB

    DESCRIPTION
    IPDM E/R activates the internal control circuit to perform the relay ON-OFF control according to the input signals from various sensors and the request signals received from control units via CAN communication.
    CAUTION:
    IPDM E/R integrated relays cannot be removed.
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-5

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Control relay
    • Headlamp low relay
    • Headlamp high relay

    Input/output
    • Low beam request signal
    • High beam request signal

    Transmit unit
    BCM (CAN)

    Tail lamp relay

    Position light request signal

    BCM (CAN)

    • Front wiper relay
    • Front wiper high relay

    Front wiper request signal

    BCM (CAN)

    Front wiper stop position signal

    Front wiper motor

    Starter control relay signal

    BCM (CAN)

    Transmission range switch signal (CVT models)

    Transmission range
    switch

    Clutch interlock switch signal
    (M/T models)

    Clutch interlock switch

    • Cooling fan low relay
    • Cooling fan high relay

    Cooling fan speed request signal

    A/C relay

    Starter control relay

    Ignition relay

    Control part

    Reference page

    • Headlamp LO
    • Headlamp HI

    EXL-8

    • Parking lamp
    • License plate lamp
    • Tail lamp

    EXL-10

    Illuminations

    INL-8

    Front wiper motor

    WW-8

    Starter motor

    STR-6

    ECM (CAN)

    Cooling fan

    EC-35

    A/C compressor request signal

    ECM (CAN)

    A/C compressor
    (Magnet clutch)

    Ignition switch ON signal

    BCM (CAN)

    Vehicle speed signal (Meter)

    Combination meter
    (CAN)

    Push-button ignition switch signal

    Push-button ignition
    switch

    Each control unit,
    sensor, actuator and
    relay (Ignition power
    supply)

    RELAY CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail-safe

    HAC-13

    EC-32

    INFOID:0000000009667165

    CAN COMMUNICATION CONTROL
    When CAN communication with ECM and BCM is impossible, IPDM E/R performs fail-safe control. After CAN
    communication recovers normally, it also returns to normal control.
    If No CAN Communication Is Available With ECM
    Control part

    Fail-safe operation

    Cooling fan

    • The cooling fan relay turn ON when the ignition switch is turned ON (Cooling fan HI operation)
    • The cooling fan relay turn OFF when the ignition switch is turned OFF

    A/C compressor

    A/C relay OFF

    If No CAN Communication Is Available With BCM
    Control part

    Fail-safe operation

    Headlamp

    • Turns ON the headlamp low relay when the ignition switch is turned ON
    • Turns OFF the headlamp low relay when the ignition switch is turned OFF
    • Headlamp high relay OFF




    • Turns ON the tail lamp relay when the ignition switch is turned ON
    • Turns OFF the tail lamp relay when the ignition switch is turned OFF

    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Illumination
    Tail lamp

    Front wiper motor

    • The status just before activation of fail-safe control is maintained until the ignition switch is
    turned OFF while the front wiper is operating at LO or HI speed.
    • The wiper is operated at LO speed until the ignition switch is turned OFF if the fail-safe control
    is activated while the front wiper is set in the INT mode and the front wiper motor is operating.
    • Returns automatically wiper to stop position when ignition switch is turned ON if fail-safe control
    is activated while front wiper motor is operated and wiper stop in the other position than stop
    position.

    Front fog lamp

    Front fog lamp relay OFF

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-6

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Control part

    Fail-safe operation

    Horn

    Horn OFF

    Ignition relay

    The status just before activation of fail-safe is maintained.

    Starter motor

    Starter control relay OFF

    A

    B

    IGNITION RELAY MALFUNCTION DETECTION FUNCTION
    • IPDM E/R monitors the voltage at the contact circuit and excitation coil circuit of the ignition relay inside it.
    • IPDM E/R judges the ignition relay error if the voltage differs between the contact circuit and the excitation
    coil circuit.
    • If the ignition relay cannot turn OFF due to contact seizure, it activates the tail lamp relay for 10 minutes to
    alert the user to the ignition relay malfunction when the ignition switch is turned OFF.
    DTC

    Ignition switch

    Ignition relay

    Tail lamp relay

    ON

    ON

    C

    D

    E

    OFF

    OFF

    B2098: IGN RELAY ON

    OFF

    ON

    ON (10 minutes)

    B2099: IGN RELAY OFF

    ON

    OFF

    F

    NOTE:
    The tail lamp turns OFF when the ignition switch is turned ON.

    G

    FRONT WIPER CONTROL
    IPDM E/R detects front wiper stop position by a front wiper auto stop signal.
    When a front wiper auto stop signal is in the conditions listed below, IPDM E/R stops power supply to wiper
    after repeating a front wiper 10 second activation and 20 second stop five times.
    Ignition switch

    Front wiper switch

    Auto stop signal

    OFF

    Front wiper stop position signal cannot be
    input 10 seconds.

    ON

    The signal does not change for 10 seconds.

    ON

    NOTE:
    This operation status can be confirmed on the IPDM E/R “Data Monitor” that displays “BLOCK” for the item
    “WIP PROT” while the wiper is stopped.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    STARTER MOTOR PROTECTION FUNCTION
    IPDM E/R turns OFF the starter control relay to protect the starter motor when the starter control relay remains
    active for 90 seconds.

    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM

    POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009567564

    L

    PCS

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    N

    O

    P

    ALCIA0030GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-7

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    DESCRIPTION

    Outline
    • IPDM E/R incorporates a power consumption control function that reduces the power consumption according to the vehicle status.
    • IPDM E/R changes its status (control mode) with the sleep wake up signal received from BCM via CAN communication.
    Normal mode (wake-up)

    — CAN communication is normally performed with other control units.
    — Individual unit control by IPDM E/R is normally performed.
    Low power consumption mode (sleep)

    — Low power consumption control is active.
    — CAN transmission is stopped.
    Sleep Mode Activation
    • IPDM E/R judges that the sleep-ready conditions are fulfilled when the ignition switch is OFF and none of the
    conditions below are present. Then it transmits a sleep-ready signal (ready) to BCM via CAN communication.
    — Outputting signals to actuators
    — Switches or relays operating
    — Output requests are being received from control units via CAN communication.
    • IPDM E/R stops CAN communication and enters the low power consumption mode when it receives a sleep
    wake up signal (sleep) from BCM and the sleep-ready conditions are fulfilled.
    Wake-up Operation
    • IPDM E/R changes from the low power consumption mode to the normal mode when it receives a sleep
    wake-up signal (wake up) from BCM or any of the following conditions is fulfilled. In addition, it transmits a
    sleep-ready signal (not-ready) to BCM via CAN communication to report the CAN communication start.
    — Ignition switch ON
    — An output request is received from a control unit via CAN communication.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-8

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)

    A

    Diagnosis Description

    INFOID:0000000009567565

    AUTO ACTIVE TEST

    B

    Description
    In auto active test, the IPDM E/R sends a drive signal to the following systems to check their operation.
    • Front wiper (LO, HI)
    • Parking lamp
    • License plate lamp
    • Tail lamp
    • Front fog lamp
    • Headlamp (LO, HI)
    • A/C compressor (magnet clutch)
    • Cooling fan
    Operation Procedure
    NOTE:
    Never perform auto active test in the following conditions.
    • Passenger door is open
    • CONSULT is connected
    1. Close the hood and lift the wiper arms from the windshield. (Prevent windshield damage due to wiper
    operation)
    NOTE:
    When auto active test is performed with hood opened, sprinkle water on windshield beforehand.
    2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    3. Turn the ignition switch ON, and within 20 seconds, press the driver door switch 10 times. Then turn the
    ignition switch OFF.
    4. Turn the ignition switch ON within 10 seconds. After that the horn sounds once and the auto active test
    starts.
    5. After a series of the following operations is repeated 3 times, auto active test is completed.
    NOTE:
    • When auto active test has to be cancelled halfway through test, turn the ignition switch OFF.
    • When auto active test is not activated, door switch may be the cause. Check door switch. Refer to DLK-84,
    «Component Function Check».
    Inspection in Auto Active Test
    When auto active test is actuated, the following operation sequence is repeated 3 times.
    Operation sequence

    Inspection location

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    Operation

    PCS

    1

    Front wiper

    LO for 5 seconds → HI for 5 seconds

    2




    10 seconds

    3

    Headlamp

    LO for 10 seconds →HI ON ⇔ OFF 5 times

    4

    A/C compressor (magnet clutch)

    ON ⇔ OFF 5 times

    5

    Cooling fan

    LO for 5 seconds → MID for 3 seconds → HI for 2 seconds

    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Tail lamp
    Front fog lamp

    C

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-9

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Concept of Auto Active Test

    JMMIA0812GB

    • IPDM E/R starts the auto active test with the door switch signals transmitted by BCM via CAN communication. Therefore, the CAN communication line between IPDM E/R and BCM is considered normal if the auto
    active test starts successfully.
    • The auto active test facilitates troubleshooting if any systems controlled by IPDM E/R cannot be operated.
    Diagnosis Chart in Auto Active Test
    Symptom





    Inspection contents

    Any of the following components do not operate
    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Tail lamp
    Front fog lamp
    Headlamp (HI, LO)
    Front wiper (HI, LO)

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the applicable system operate?

    Possible cause
    YES

    BCM signal input circuit

    NO

    • Lamp or motor
    • Lamp or motor ground circuit
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and applicable system
    • IPDM E/R

    YES

    • BCM signal input circuit
    • CAN communication signal between BCM and ECM
    • CAN communication signal between ECM and IPDM E/R

    NO

    • Magnet clutch
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and magnet clutch
    • IPDM E/R

    YES

    • ECM signal input circuit
    • CAN communication signal between ECM and IPDM E/R

    NO

    • Cooling fan motor
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and cooling fan motor
    • IPDM E/R

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the magnet clutch operate?

    A/C compressor does not operate

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the cooling fan operate?

    Cooling fan does not operate

    CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R)

    INFOID:0000000009567566

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with IPDM E/R.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    Ecu Identification

    The IPDM E/R part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The IPDM E/R self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The IPDM E/R input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-10

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    Active Test

    The IPDM E/R activates outputs to test components.

    CAN Diag Support Mntr

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    A

    ECU IDENTIFICATION

    B

    The IPDM E/R part number is displayed.

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    C

    Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR
    D

    Main
    Signals

    Description

    MOTOR FAN REQ [%]

    ×

    Indicates cooling fan speed signal received from ECM on CAN communication
    line

    AC COMP REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates A/C compressor request signal received from ECM on CAN communication line

    TAIL&CLR REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates position light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HL LO REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates low beam request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    HL HI REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates high beam request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    FR FOG REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates front fog light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    FR WIP REQ [Stop/1LOW/Low/Hi]

    ×

    Indicates front wiper request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    WIP AUTO STOP [STOP P/ACT P]

    ×

    Indicates condition of front wiper auto stop signal

    WIP PROT [Off/BLOCK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of front wiper fail-safe operation

    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Indicates ignition switch ON signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    IGN RLY1 -REQ [On/Off]
    IGN RLY [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of ignition relay
    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch

    INTER/NP SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of CVT shift position

    ST RLY CONT [On/Off]

    Indicates starter relay status signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    IHBT RLY -REQ [On/Off]

    Indicates starter control relay signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    ST/INHI RLY [Off/ ST /INHI]

    Indicates condition of starter relay and starter control relay

    DETENT SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    DTRL REQ [Off]

    Indicates daytime light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HOOD SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of hood switch

    THFT HRN REQ [On/Off]

    Indicates theft warning horn request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HORN CHIRP [On/Off]

    Indicates horn reminder signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    ACTIVE TEST
    Description

    HORN

    This test is able to check horn operation [On].

    FRONT WIPER

    This test is able to check wiper motor operation [Hi/Lo/Off].

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-11

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Test item

    E

    2014 Note

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Test item

    Description

    MOTOR FAN

    This test is able to check cooling fan operation [4/3/2/1].

    EXTERNAL LAMPS

    This test is able to check external lamp operation [Fog/Hi/Lo/TAIL/Off].

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR
    Refer to LAN-12, «CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor».

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-12

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE
    ROOM)
    Reference Value

    Monitor Item
    Engine idle speed

    AC COMP REQ

    Engine running

    HL HI REQ

    FR FOG REQ

    FR WIP REQ

    C
    Condition

    MOTOR FAN REQ

    HL LO REQ

    Changes depending on engine coolant temperature, air conditioner operation status, vehicle speed, etc.

    Off

    A/C switch ON
    (Compressor is operating)

    On

    Lighting switch 1ST or 2ND

    On

    Lighting switch OFF

    Off

    Lighting switch 2ND

    On

    Lighting switch 2ND

    Lighting switch 2ND

    Ignition switch ON

    WIP PROT

    Ignition switch ON

    Lighting switch other than HI and
    PASS

    Off

    Lighting switch HI or PASS

    On

    Front fog lamp switch OFF

    Off

    Front fog lamp switch ON

    On

    Front wiper switch OFF

    Stop

    Front wiper switch INT

    1LOW

    Front wiper switch LO

    Low

    Front wiper switch HI

    Hi

    Any position other than front wiper
    stop position
    Front wiper operates normally.
    Front wiper stops at fail-safe operation.

    STOP P

    Off

    Ignition switch ON

    On

    Ignition switch OFF or ACC

    Off

    Ignition switch ON

    On

    Release the push-button ignition switch

    Off

    Press the push-button ignition switch

    On

    Revision: April 2013

    On

    Ignition switch ON

    Off

    At engine cranking

    On

    PCS-13

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Depress clutch pedal (M/T models)
    ST RLY CONT

    G

    Off

    Release clutch pedal (M/T models)
    Selector lever in P or N position
    (CVT models)

    F

    BLOCK
    Off

    Ignition switch ON

    E

    ACT P

    Ignition switch OFF or ACC

    Selector lever in any position other
    than P or N (CVT models)
    INTER/NP SW

    1/2/3/4

    A/C switch OFF

    Front wiper stop position

    PUSH SW

    D

    Off

    Ignition switch ON

    IGN RLY

    Value/Status

    Lighting switch OFF

    WIP AUTO STOP

    IGN RLY1 -REQ

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567567

    VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL

    TAIL&CLR REQ

    A

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item
    IHBT RLY -REQ

    ST/INHI RLY

    DETENT SW

    DTRL REQ

    HOOD SW

    THFT HRN REQ

    HORN CHIRP

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    Value/Status

    Ignition switch ON

    Off

    At engine cranking

    On

    Ignition switch ON

    Off

    At engine cranking

    INHI ON → ST ON

    The status of starter relay or starter control relay cannot be recognized by
    the battery voltage malfunction, etc. when the starter relay is ON and the
    starter control relay is OFF.
    • Press the selector button with selector lever in P position.
    • Selector lever in any position other than P.

    Ignition switch ON

    UNKWN

    Off

    Release the selector button with selector lever in P position.

    On

    Daytime running lamps OFF

    Off

    Daytime running lamps ON

    On

    Hood closed

    Off

    Hood open

    On

    Not operation

    Off

    • Panic alarm is activated
    • Theft warning alarm is activated

    On

    Not operated

    Off

    Door locking with keyfob (horn chirp mode)

    On

    PCS-14

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    ALMIA0600ZZ

    K

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    L
    Terminal

    Wire
    color

    1

    R

    2

    Y

    3

    SB

    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Condition

    Value

    Battery power supply

    Input

    OFF

    9 – 16 V

    Battery power supply

    Input

    OFF

    9 – 16 V

    Input

    OFF
    ACC
    ON

    0V

    START

    9 – 16 V

    Circuit

    Ignition switch power
    supply (START)

    Cooling fan OFF
    5

    6

    Y

    R

    Cooling fan power supply (HIGH)

    Starter motor power
    supply

    Revision: April 2013

    Output

    Output

    ON or
    START

    N

    O

    0V

    Cooling fan LO

    4–8V

    Cooling fan MID or HI

    9 – 16 V

    OFF
    ACC
    ON

    0V

    START

    6 – 16 V

    PCS-15

    PCS

    2014 Note

    P

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal

    Wire
    color

    Circuit

    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Condition
    Cooling fan OFF

    7

    8

    9

    11

    13

    P

    G

    BR

    G

    R

    14

    L

    15

    LG

    16

    P

    17

    LG

    18

    GR

    19

    B

    20

    BR

    21

    R

    Cooling fan power supply (LOW)

    Battery power supply

    Fuel pump power supply

    ECM relay power supply

    Clutch interlock switch
    power supply
    Headlamp LOW (LH)
    power supply
    Starter relay coil power
    supply

    Output

    Input

    Output

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    power supply

    9 – 16 V

    OFF

    9 – 16 V

    ON
    RUN

    Approximately 1 second after turning the ignition
    switch ON

    9 – 16 V

    ON

    Approximately 1 second after turning the ignition
    switch ON

    0-1V

    OFF

    More than a few seconds
    after turning ignition switch
    OFF

    0–1V

    ON
    OFF

    For a few seconds after
    turning ignition switch OFF

    6 – 16 V

    Clutch pedal depressed

    0–1V

    Clutch pedal released

    9 – 16 V

    Lighting switch OFF

    0–1V

    Lighting switch 2ND

    9 – 16 V

    ON

    0–1V
    9 – 16 V

    ON

    Lighting switch OFF

    0–1V

    Lighting switch 2ND

    9 – 16 V

    Front wiper switch OFF

    0–1V

    Front wiper switch LO

    9 – 16 V

    Front wiper switch OFF

    0–1V

    Front wiper switch HI

    9 – 16 V

    ON

    OFF

    0V

    ON or
    START

    9 – 16 V

    Output

    Transmission range
    switch power supply

    Output

    P

    Illumination power supply

    Output

    23

    R

    Combination lamp power supply

    Output

    24

    W

    Daytime light relay 1
    power supply

    Output

    G

    Headlamp HIGH (LH)
    power supply

    Revision: April 2013

    Cooling fan HI

    Output

    22

    25

    4–8V

    Input

    Front wiper motor LOW
    power supply

    Ground

    Cooling fan MID

    ON or
    START

    Output

    Output

    Front wiper motor HIGH
    power supply

    9 – 16 V

    Output

    Headlamp LOW (RH)
    power supply

    0V

    Cooling fan LO

    Output

    Input

    Value

    Output

    OFF or
    ACC

    0–1V

    ON

    9 – 16 V
    Lighting switch OFF

    0–1V

    Lighting switch 1ST

    9 – 16 V

    Lighting switch OFF

    0–1V

    Lighting switch 1ST

    9 – 16 V

    Lighting switch OFF

    0–1V

    Lighting switch 1ST

    9 – 16 V

    Lighting switch other than
    HI and PASS

    0–1V

    Lighting switch HI
    Lighting switch PASS

    9 – 16 V

    PCS-16

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal

    27

    28

    29

    32

    34

    35

    36

    39

    40

    43

    47

    50

    Wire
    color

    Y

    V

    L/W

    G/W

    Circuit

    Headlamp HIGH (RH)
    power supply

    A/C compressor power
    supply

    Throttle control motor
    relay power supply

    Throttle control motor
    relay control

    Input/
    Output

    Ignition
    switch

    Output

    Output

    Value

    A

    Lighting switch other than
    HI and PASS

    0–1V

    Lighting switch HI
    Lighting switch PASS

    9 – 16 V

    A/C switch OFF

    0–1V
    9 – 16 V

    OFF

    More than a few seconds
    after turning ignition switch
    OFF

    0–1V

    ON
    OFF

    For a few seconds after
    turning ignition switch OFF

    9 – 16 V

    RUN

    D

    ON →
    OFF

    0–1V

    9 – 16 V

    0–1V

    ON

    0–1V

    OFF or
    ACC

    0–1V

    ON

    9 – 16 V

    Output

    BR

    NATS antenna amp
    power supply

    Output

    OFF

    9 – 16 V

    SB

    Fuel injector power supply

    Output

    OFF or
    ACC

    0–1V

    ON

    9 – 16 V

    L

    BR

    GR

    R/W

    P

    Timing control solenoid
    valve power
    supply

    Transmission range
    switch power supply

    Fuel pump relay control

    ECM power supply

    ECM relay control

    Revision: April 2013

    F

    H

    I

    J

    OFF

    More than a few seconds
    after turning ignition switch
    OFF

    0–1V

    ON
    OFF

    For a few seconds after
    turning ignition switch OFF

    9 – 16 V

    ON

    Select lever in any position
    other than P or N

    0–1V

    Select lever P or N

    9 – 16 V

    ON
    RUN

    Approximately 1 second after turning the ignition
    switch ON

    0–1V

    PCS

    ON

    Approximately 1 second or
    more after turning the ignition switch

    9 – 16 V

    N

    OFF

    More than a few seconds
    after turning ignition switch
    OFF

    0–1V

    O

    ON
    OFF

    For a few seconds after
    turning ignition switch OFF

    9 – 16 V

    OFF

    More than a few seconds
    after turning ignition switch
    OFF

    0–1V

    ON
    OFF

    For a few seconds after
    turning ignition switch OFF

    9 – 16 V

    Output

    Input

    E

    G

    Ignition coil power supply

    Y

    B

    C

    A/C switch ON
    (A/C compressor is operating)

    Output

    Output

    Condition

    Output

    Output

    Output

    PCS-17

    K

    L

    P

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Wire
    color

    Terminal

    59

    Y

    60

    B

    Input/
    Output

    Circuit

    Cooling fan relay control

    Ignition
    switch

    Output

    Condition

    Value

    Cooling fan OFF or LO operated

    9 – 16 V

    Cooling fan MID or HI operated

    0–1V

    Ground

    61

    P

    CAN-L

    Input/
    Output

    62

    L

    CAN-H

    Input/
    Output

    64

    LG

    Hood switch

    Input

    ON

    65

    BR

    Cooling fan relay power
    supply

    Output

    OFF or
    ACC

    0–1V

    ON

    9 – 16 V

    GR

    Daytime light relay 1
    control

    Output

    71

    W

    Front fog lamp relay
    control

    Output

    73

    SB

    Horn relay control

    Output

    74

    V

    Front wiper motor stop
    position

    Input

    ON

    80

    R

    PNP switch

    Input

    ON

    SB

    Push-button ignition
    switch

    89

    B

    Ground

    90

    L

    Ignition relay power supply

    Input

    0–1V

    Hood open

    9 – 16 V

    9 – 16 V

    69

    81

    Hood closed

    0–1V

    ON

    Input

    ON

    Front fog lamp switch OFF

    9 – 16 V

    Front fog lamp switch ON

    0–1V

    Horn is not activated

    9 – 16 V

    Horn is activated

    0–1V

    Front wiper stop position

    0–1V

    Any position other than front
    wiper stop position

    9 – 16 V

    Selector Lever in P

    0–1V

    Selector lever in any position other than P

    9 – 16 V

    Press the push-button ignition switch

    0–1V

    Release the push button ignition switch

    9 – 16 V

    Ignition switch OFF or ACC

    0–1V

    Ignition switch ON

    9 – 16 V

    Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009567568

    CAN COMMUNICATION CONTROL
    When CAN communication with ECM and BCM is impossible, IPDM E/R performs fail-safe control. After CAN
    communication recovers normally, it also returns to normal control.
    If No CAN Communication Is Available With ECM
    Control part

    Fail-safe operation

    Cooling fan

    • The cooling fan relay turn ON when the ignition switch is turned ON (Cooling fan HI operation)
    • The cooling fan relay turn OFF when the ignition switch is turned OFF

    A/C compressor

    A/C relay OFF

    If No CAN Communication Is Available With BCM

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-18

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Control part

    A

    • Turns ON the headlamp low relay when the ignition switch is turned ON
    • Turns OFF the headlamp low relay when the ignition switch is turned OFF
    • Headlamp high relay OFF

    Headlamp



    Fail-safe operation

    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Illumination
    Tail lamp

    Front wiper motor

    B

    • Turns ON the tail lamp relay when the ignition switch is turned ON
    • Turns OFF the tail lamp relay when the ignition switch is turned OFF

    C

    • The status just before activation of fail-safe control is maintained until the ignition switch is
    turned OFF while the front wiper is operating at LO or HI speed.
    • The wiper is operated at LO speed until the ignition switch is turned OFF if the fail-safe control
    is activated while the front wiper is set in the INT mode and the front wiper motor is operating.
    • Returns automatically wiper to stop position when ignition switch is turned ON if fail-safe control
    is activated while front wiper motor is operated and wiper stop in the other position than stop
    position.

    Front fog lamp

    Front fog lamp relay OFF

    Horn

    Horn OFF

    Ignition relay

    The status just before activation of fail-safe is maintained.

    Starter motor

    Starter control relay OFF

    D

    E

    F

    IGNITION RELAY MALFUNCTION DETECTION FUNCTION

    G

    • IPDM E/R monitors the voltage at the contact circuit and excitation coil circuit of the ignition relay inside it.
    • IPDM E/R judges the ignition relay error if the voltage differs between the contact circuit and the excitation
    coil circuit.
    • If the ignition relay cannot turn OFF due to contact seizure, it activates the tail lamp relay for 10 minutes to
    alert the user to the ignition relay malfunction when the ignition switch is turned OFF.

    H

    DTC

    Ignition switch

    Ignition relay

    Tail lamp relay

    ON

    ON

    OFF

    OFF

    B2098: IGN RELAY ON

    OFF

    ON

    ON (10 minutes)

    B2099: IGN RELAY OFF

    ON

    OFF

    I

    J

    K

    NOTE:
    The tail lamp turns OFF when the ignition switch is turned ON.

    FRONT WIPER CONTROL

    L
    IPDM E/R detects front wiper stop position by a front wiper auto stop signal.
    When a front wiper auto stop signal is in the conditions listed below, IPDM E/R stops power supply to wiper
    after repeating a front wiper 10 second activation and 20 second stop five times.
    PCS
    Ignition switch

    Front wiper switch

    Auto stop signal

    OFF

    Front wiper stop position signal cannot be
    input 10 seconds.

    ON

    The signal does not change for 10 seconds.

    ON

    N

    NOTE:
    This operation status can be confirmed on the IPDM E/R “Data Monitor” that displays “BLOCK” for the item
    “WIP PROT” while the wiper is stopped.

    O

    STARTER MOTOR PROTECTION FUNCTION

    P

    IPDM E/R turns OFF the starter control relay to protect the starter motor when the starter control relay remains
    active for 90 seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-19

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    DTC Index

    INFOID:0000000009567569

    TIMENOTE

    CONSULT display

    Fail-safe

    Refer to

    No DTC is detected. Further testing may be required.

    U1000: CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    ×

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    PCS-26

    B2098: IGN RELAY ON

    ×

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    PCS-27

    B2099: IGN RELAY OFF

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    PCS-28

    B210B: PNP RELAY ON stuck failure

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    SEC-108

    B210C: PNP RELAY OFF stuck failure

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    SEC-109

    B210D: STARTER relay ON stuck failure

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    SEC-111

    B210E: STARTER relay OFF stuck failure

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    SEC-113

    B210F: Interlock/NP switch ON stuck failure

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    SEC-115

    B2110: Interlock/NP switch OFF stuck failure

    CRNT

    1 – 39

    SEC-117

    NOTE:
    The details of TIME display are as follows.
    • CRNT: The malfunctions that are detected now
    • 1 — 39: The number is indicated when it is normal at present and a malfunction was detected in the past. It
    increases like 0 → 1 → 2 ··· 38 → 39 after returning to the normal condition whenever IGN OFF → ON. It is
    fixed to 39 until the self-diagnosis results are erased if it is over 39. It returns to 0 when a malfunction is
    detected again in the process.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-20

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE
    ROOM)
    Wiring Diagram

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567570

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    AAMWA0770GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-21

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMWA0771GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-22

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O
    AAMIA1680GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-23

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1681GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-24

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    [IPDM E/R]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O
    AAMIA1682GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-25

    2014 Note

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [IPDM E/R]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009567571

    Refer to LAN-6, «CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description».

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567572

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [U1000]

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    When IPDM E/R cannot communicate with CAN communication signal continuously for 2 seconds or more

    In CAN communication system, any item (or items) of
    the following listed below is malfunctioning.
    • Transmission
    • Receiving (ECM)
    • Receiving (BCM)
    • Receiving (Combination meter)

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567573

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 second or more.
    2. Check “SELF-DIAG RESULTS” of IPDM E/R.
    Is “CAN COMM CIRCUIT” displayed?
    YES >> Refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-26

    2014 Note

    B2098 IGNITION RELAY ON STUCK
    [IPDM E/R]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2098 IGNITION RELAY ON STUCK

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567575

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display
    IGN RELAY ON
    [B2098]

    DTC Detection Condition
    The ignition relay ON is detected for 1 second at
    ignition switch OFF
    (CPU monitors the status at the contact and excitation coil circuits of the ignition relay inside it)

    Possible Cause

    C
    IPDM E/R

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION

    E

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC B2098 displayed?
    YES >> Refer to PCS-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    G
    INFOID:0000000009567576

    H

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is display history of DTC B2098 CRNT?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-27

    2014 Note

    B2099 IGNITION RELAY OFF STUCK
    [IPDM E/R]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2099 IGNITION RELAY OFF STUCK
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567578

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    IGN RELAY OFF
    [B2099]

    DTC Detection Condition
    The ignition relay OFF is detected for 1 second at
    ignition switch ON
    (CPU monitors the status at the contact and excitation coil circuits of the ignition relay inside it)

    Possible Cause

    IPDM E/R

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC B2099 displayed?
    YES >> Refer to PCS-28, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567579

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is display history of DTC B2099 CRNT?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-28

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [IPDM E/R]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567580

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-21, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1. CHECK FUSE AND FUSIBLE LINKS
    Check that the following IPDM E/R fuse or fusible links are not blown.

    D
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    Fuse and fusible link Nos.

    1

    Battery

    A (120A), E (80A)

    2

    Battery

    B (60A)

    E

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2. CHECK BATTERY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector E42.
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connector E42 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal
    1

    E42

    2

    G

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    H

    Battery voltage

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    J

    3. CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    K

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connectors and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    19

    E46

    60

    E47

    89

    Ground

    Continuity

    L

    Yes

    PCS

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-29

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R
    [IPDM E/R]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    IPDM E/R
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009607430

    AWMIA1423ZZ

    1.

    IPDM E/R

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009607431

    CAUTION:
    IPDM E/R integrated relays are not serviceable and must not be removed from unit.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Release pawls on IPDM E/R cover (1) and remove.
    :Pawl

    ALMIA0654ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-30

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Release pawls, then lift IPDM E/R (1) as shown and position
    aside.
    :Pawl
    4. Disconnect the harness connectors from the IPDM E/R (1) and
    remove.

    [IPDM E/R]
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    ALMIA0655ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-31

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009607420

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-32

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009567585

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    AWMIA1438ZZ

    No.

    1.

    Component

    Accessory relay-2

    Description
    • Accessory relay-2 is controlled by BCM.
    • Accessory relay-2 supplies accessory power supply or ignition switch ACC signal to each ECU
    when ignition switch is turned to ACC or ON.
    • BCM compares status of accessory relay-2 control signal, and ignition switch position judged
    by BCM.

    2.

    BCM

    • BCM controls power distribution system.
    • BCM judges ignition switch position by push-button ignition switch (push switch) and vehicle
    condition.
    • BCM checks ignition switch position internally.

    3.

    Push-button ignition
    switch

    Push-button ignition switch (push switch) is pressed, and transmits status signal to BCM and
    IPDM E/R.

    IPDM E/R

    • IPDM E/R detects push-button ignition switch (push switch) status, and transmits push-button
    ignition switch status signal (CAN) to BCM.
    • IPDM E/R receives ignition relay-1 (IPDM E/R) control signal and ignition switch ON signal
    (CAN) from BCM, and controls ignition relay-1 (built into IPDM E/R)

    Blower relay (in fuse
    block)

    • Blower relay is controlled by BCM.
    • Blower relay supplies ignition switch ON power supply or ignition switch ON signal to air conditioning system when ignition switch is turned ON.
    • BCM compares status of blower relay control signal and ignition switch position judged by
    BCM.

    Accessory relay-1 (in
    fuse block)

    • Accessory relay-1 is controlled by BCM.
    • Accessory relay-1 supplies accessory power supply or ignition switch ACC signal to each ECU
    when ignition switch is turned ACC or ON.
    • BCM compares status of accessory relay-1 control signal, and ignition switch position judged
    by BCM.

    4.

    5.

    6.

    7.

    Ignition relay-2 (in fuse
    block)

    Revision: April 2013

    • Ignition relay-2 is controlled by BCM.
    • Ignition relay-2 supplies ignition switch ON power supply or ignition switch ON signal to each
    ECU and system when ignition switch is turned ON.
    • BCM compares status of ignition relay-2 control signal and ignition switch position judged by
    BCM.
    • BCM monitors ignition relay-2 operating status by ignition relay feedback signal.

    PCS-33

    2014 Note

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009567588

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    ALMIA0602GB

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    • PDS (POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM) is the system that BCM controls with the operation of the pushbutton ignition switch and performs the power distribution to each power circuit. This system is used instead
    of the mechanical power supply changing mechanism with the operation of the conventional key cylinder.
    • The push-button ignition switch can be operated when Intelligent Key is in the following condition.
    — Intelligent Key is in the detection area of the inside key antenna.
    — Intelligent Key backside is contacted to push-button ignition switch.
    • The push-button ignition switch operation is input to BCM as a signal. BCM changes the power supply position according to the status and operates the following relays to supply power to each power circuit.
    — Ignition relay-1
    — Ignition relay-2
    — Accessory relay-1
    — Accessory relay-2
    — Blower motor relay
    NOTE:
    The engine switch operation changes due to the conditions of brake pedal, selector lever and vehicle speed.
    • The power supply position can be confirmed with the lighting of the indicators in the push-button ignition
    switch.

    BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM
    When all the following conditions are met for 30 minutes, the battery saver system will cut off the power supply
    to prevent battery discharge.
    • The ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position
    • All doors are closed
    • Selector lever is in the P (park) position
    Reset Condition of Battery Saver System
    In order to prevent the battery from discharging, the battery saver system will cut off the power supply when all
    doors are closed, the selector lever is in P (park) position and the ignition switch is left in the ACC or ON position for 30 minutes. If any of the following conditions are met the battery saver system is released and the
    steering will change automatically to lock position from OFF position.
    • Opening any door
    • Operating door request switch on door handle
    • Operating Intelligent Key

    POWER SUPPLY POSITION CHANGE TABLE BY PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OPERARevision: April 2013

    PCS-34

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    TION
    The power supply position changing operation can be performed with the following operations.
    NOTE:
    • When an Intelligent Key is within the detection area of inside key antenna and when Intelligent Key backside
    is contacted to push-button ignition switch, it is equivalent to the operations below.
    • When starting the engine, the BCM monitors under the engine start conditions:
    — Brake pedal operating condition
    — Selector lever position
    — Vehicle speed

    A

    B

    C

    Vehicle speed: less than 4 km/h (2.5 MPH)
    Engine start/stop condition
    Selector lever position

    Brake pedal operation condition

    Push-button ignition switch
    operation frequency

    OFF → ACC

    Not depressed

    1

    OFF → ACC → ON

    Not depressed

    2

    OFF → ACC → ON → OFF

    Not depressed

    3

    P or N position

    Depressed

    1

    1

    Power supply position

    OFF → START
    ACC → START
    ON → START
    Engine is running → OFF

    D

    E

    F

    G

    Vehicle speed: 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or more
    Power supply position
    Engine is running → ACC
    Engine stall return operation
    while driving

    Engine start/stop condition
    Selector lever position

    Brake pedal operation condition

    Push-button ignition switch
    operation frequency

    Emergency stop operation

    N position

    Not depressed

    1

    Emergency stop operation

    H

    I

    J

    • Press and hold the push-button ignition switch for 2 seconds or more.
    • Press the push-button ignition switch 3 times or more within 1.5 seconds.

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-35

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009654077

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-36

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)

    INFOID:0000000009654078

    A

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».

    B

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Main

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    REQ SW -BD/TR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of back door request switch.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    C

    D

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    BRAKE SW 1 [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of brake switch.

    CLUTCH SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of clutch interlock switch.

    BRAKE SW 2 [On/Off]

    E

    Indicates condition of brake switch.

    DETE/CANCL SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of P (park) position.

    SFT PN/N SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of P (park) or N (neutral) position.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    F

    PUSH SW -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch received from IPDM E/R on
    CAN communication line.

    IGN RLY1 -F/B [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of ignition relay 1 received from IPDM E/R on CAN communication line.

    DETE SW -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of detent switch received from TCM on CAN communication
    line.

    SFT PN -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of P (park) or N (neutral) position from TCM on CAN communication line.

    SFT P -MET [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of P (park) position from TCM on CAN communication line.

    SFT N -MET [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of N (neutral) position from IPDM E/R on CAN communication line.

    ENGINE STATE [Stop/Start/Crank/Run]

    ×

    Indicates condition of engine state from ECM on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 1 [mph/km/h]

    ×

    Indicates condition of vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 2 [mph/km/h]

    ×

    Indicates condition of vehicle speed signal received from combination meter on
    CAN communication line.

    DOOR STAT -DR [LOCK/READY/UNLK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of driver side door status.

    DOOR STAT -AS [LOCK/READY/UNLK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of passenger side door status.

    ID OK FLAG [Set/Reset]

    Indicates condition of Intelligent Key ID.

    PRMT ENG STRT [Set/Reset]

    Indicates condition of engine start possibility.
    ×

    When remote keyless entry receiver receives the signal transmitted while operating on Intelligent Key, the numerical value start changing.

    RKE OPE COUN2 [0-19]

    ×

    When remote keyless entry receiver receives the signal transmitted while operating on Intelligent Key, the numerical value start changing.
    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-MODE CHG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of mode change signal from Intelligent Key.

    PCS-37

    I

    J

    K

    L

    N

    O

    P

    ACTIVE TEST

    Revision: April 2013

    H

    PCS

    RKE OPE COUN1 [0-19]

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    G

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Test Item

    Description

    INSIDE BUZZER

    This test is able to check combination meter warning chime operation [Take Out/Knob/Key/
    Off].

    LCD

    This test is able to check combination meter display information [Off/LK WN/OUTKEY/NO
    KY/BATT/INSRT/SFT P/ROTAT/ID NG/B&P I/B&P N].

    BATTERY SAVER

    This test is able to check battery saver operation [On/Off].

    ENGINE SW ILLUMI

    This test is able to check push-button ignition switch START indicator operation [On/Off].

    PUSH SWITCH INDICATOR

    This test is able to check back door lock actuator operation [On/Off].

    INT LAMP

    This test is able to check interior room lamp operation [On/Off].

    INDICATOR

    This test is able to check combination meter warning lamp operation [KEY ON/KEY IND/Off].

    FLASHER

    This test is able to check hazard lamp operation [LH/RH/Off].

    OUTSIDE BUZZER

    This test is able to check Intelligent Key warning buzzer operation [On/Off].

    HORN

    This test is able to check horn operation [On].

    P RANGE

    This test is able to check CVT shift selector illumination operation [On/Off].

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY

    ANTI KEY LOCK IN FUNCTI

    ANS BACK I-KEY UNLOCK

    ANS BACK I-KEY LOCK

    HORN WITH KEYLESS LOCK

    Setting

    Description

    On*

    Door lock/unlock function from Intelligent Key ON.

    Off

    Door lock/unlock function from Intelligent Key OFF.

    On*

    Anti lock out setting ON.

    Off

    Anti lock out setting OFF.

    Off

    No buzzer reminder when doors are unlocked with request switch.

    On*

    Buzzer reminder when doors are unlocked with request switch.

    Horn Chirp

    Horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Buzzer*

    Buzzer reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Off

    No reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Off

    Horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with Intelligent Key.

    On*

    No horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with Intelligent Key.

    Lock/Unlock*

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked/unlocked
    with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Unlock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are unlocked with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Lock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Off

    No hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked/unlocked
    with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    HAZARD ANSWER BACK

    INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS

    This function allows inside key antenna self-diagnosis.

    CONFIRM KEY FOB ID

    Intelligent Key ID code can be checked.
    70 msec

    SHORT CRANKING OUTPUT

    Start

    100 msec

    Starter motor operation duration time setting.

    200 msec
    End

    LO- BATT OF KEY FOB WARN

    Revision: April 2013

    On*

    Intelligent Key low battery warning ON.

    Off

    Intelligent Key low battery warning OFF.

    PCS-38

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Support Item

    AUTO LOCK SET

    Setting
    MODE7

    5 min

    MODE6

    4 min

    MODE5

    3 min

    Description

    A

    B

    MODE4

    2 min

    MODE3*

    1 min

    Auto door lock time setting.

    MODE2

    30 sec

    MODE1

    Off

    C

    *: Initial Setting

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-39

    2014 Note

    BCM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    BCM
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009567591

    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-40

    2014 Note

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009567592

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    AAMWA0772GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-41

    2014 Note

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMWA0773GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-42

    2014 Note

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O
    AAMIA1683GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-43

    2014 Note

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1684GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-44

    2014 Note

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O
    AAMIA1685GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-45

    2014 Note

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1686GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-46

    2014 Note

    POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O
    AAMIA1687GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-47

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009567593

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    JMKIA8652GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-48

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    1.
    2.

    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when
    the incident/malfunction occurs).
    Check operation condition of the component or system that is malfunctioning.

    A

    B

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC

    C

    1. Check DTC.
    2. Perform the following procedure if DTC is detected.
    Record DTC and freeze frame data (Print them out using CONSULT).
    Erase DTC.
    Study the relationship between the cause detected by DTC and the symptom described by the customer.
    3. Check related service bulletins for information.
    Are any symptoms described and any DTC detected?
    Symptom is described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 3.
    Symptom is described, DTC is not detected>>GO TO 4.
    Symptom is not described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 5.

    D

    E

    F

    3.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    G

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Also study the normal operation and fail-safe related to the symptom.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.

    H

    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    I

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.
    NOTE:
    Freeze frame data is useful if the DTC is not detected.

    J

    >> GO TO 6.

    K

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for the detected DTC, and then check that DTC is detected
    again. At this time, always connect CONSULT to the vehicle, and check self diagnostic results in real time.
    L
    If two or more DTCs are detected, refer to BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart», and determine trouble
    diagnosis order.
    Is DTC detected?
    PCS
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM BY SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    N

    Detect malfunctioning system according to SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS based on the confirmed symptom in step
    4, and determine the trouble diagnosis order based on possible causes and symptom.
    Is the symptom described?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Monitor input data from related sensors or check voltage of related module terminals using CONSULT.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSIS PROCEDURE
    Inspect according to Diagnosis Procedure of the system.
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-49

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    8.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnosis Procedure again after repair and replacement.
    Check DTC. If DTC is detected, erase it.
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.FINAL CHECK

    When DTC is detected in step 2, perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE again, and then check that the
    malfunction is repaired securely.
    When symptom is described by the customer, refer to confirmed symptom in step 3 or 4, and check that the
    symptom is not detected.
    Is DTC detected and does symptom remain?
    YES-1 >> DTC is detected: GO TO 7.
    YES-2 >> Symptom remains: GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-50

    2014 Note

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009567594

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567595

    C

    Refer to LAN-6, «CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM : System Description».

    DTC Logic
    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    NOTE:
    U1000 can be set if a module harness was disconnected and reconnected, perhaps during a repair. Confirm
    that there are actual CAN diagnostic symptoms and a present DTC by performing the Self Diagnostic Result
    procedure.
    CONSULT Display

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [U1000]

    DTC Detection Condition

    When any listed module cannot communicate
    with CAN communication signal continuously for
    2 seconds or more with ignition switch ON

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    E

    Possible Cause
    In CAN communication system, any item (or
    items) of the following listed below is malfunctioning.
    • Transmission
    • Receiving (ECM)
    • Receiving (VDC/TCS/ABS)
    • Receiving (METER/M&A)
    • Receiving (TCM)
    • Receiving (IPDM E/R)

    F

    G

    H

    INFOID:0000000009567596

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    I

    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 second or more.
    2. Check “SELF- DIAG RESULTS”.
    Is “CAN COMM CIRCUIT” displayed?
    YES >> Perform CAN Diagnosis as described in DIAGNOSIS section of CONSULT Operation Manual.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-51

    2014 Note

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567597

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    CONSULT Display
    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [U1010]

    DTC Detection Condition
    BCM detected internal CAN communication circuit malfunction.

    Possible Cause
    BCM

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567598

    1.REPLACE BCM
    When DTC “U1010” is detected, replace BCM.
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-52

    2014 Note

    B2614 ACC RELAY CIRCUIT
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2614 ACC RELAY CIRCUIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567599

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    An immediate operation of accessory relay-2 is
    requested by BCM, but there is no response for
    more than 1 second.

    ACC RELAY REQ F/B
    [B2614]

    C

    • Harness or connectors
    • Accessory relay-2
    • BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1. Turn ignition switch to ACC, and wait for 1 second or more.
    2. Perform Self-diagnosis result of BCM with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B2614 displayed?
    YES >> Go to PCS-53, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    E

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567600

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».

    H

    1.CHECK ACCESSORY RELAY-2 CONTROL SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    I

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    96

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98 and accessory relay-2 connector.
    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and accessory relay-2 connector M39.
    BCM

    4.

    Accessory relay-2

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    96

    M39

    1

    PCS

    Continuity

    O

    BCM
    Terminal

    M98

    96

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK ACCESSORY RELAY-2
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-53

    N

    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and ground.

    Connector

    K

    L

    2.CHECK ACCESSORY RELAY-2 CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    2014 Note

    P

    B2614 ACC RELAY CIRCUIT
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Refer to PCS-54, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace accessory relay-2.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567601

    1.CHECK ACCESSORY RELAY-2
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect accessory relay-2.
    Check the continuity between accessory relay-2 terminals.

    Terminals
    3 and 5

    Condition

    Continuity

    12 V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2

    Yes

    No current supply

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace accessory relay-2.
    PBIB0098E

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-54

    2014 Note

    B2615 BLOWER RELAY CIRCUIT
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2615 BLOWER RELAY CIRCUIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567602

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    BLOWER RELAY CIRCUIT
    [B2615]

    Possible Cause

    An immediate operation of front blower motor relay is requested by BCM, but there is no response for more than 1 second.




    C

    Harness or connectors.
    Blower relay.
    Fuse block J/B.
    BCM.

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    E

    1. Turn ignition switch ON, and wait for 1 second or more.
    2. Perform Self-diagnosis result with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B2615 displayed?
    YES >> Go to PCS-57, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567603

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».

    H

    1. CHECK BLOWER RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    I

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove blower relay.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98.
    Check continuity between blower relay connector J-1 and BCM connector M98.
    Blower relay

    5.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    J-1

    2

    M98

    106

    J

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between Blower relay connector J-1 and ground.
    Blower relay
    Connector

    Terminal

    J-1

    2

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    2. CHECK BLOWER RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT

    O

    Check continuity between Blower relay connector J-1 terminal 1 and ground.
    P
    Blower relay
    Connector

    Terminal

    J-1

    1

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-55

    2014 Note

    B2615 BLOWER RELAY CIRCUIT
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3. CHECK BLOWER RELAY
    Perform the relay component inspection. Refer to PCS-56, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace blower relay.

    4. CHECK BLOWER RELAY POWER SUPPLY (BCM)

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    106

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567604

    1.CHECK BLOWER RELAY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn blower switch OFF.
    Remove blower relay.
    Check continuity between blower relay terminals.

    Terminals
    3 and 5

    Condition

    Continuity

    12 V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2

    Yes

    No current supply

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace blower relay.
    PBIB0098E

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-56

    2014 Note

    B2616 IGNITION RELAY CIRCUIT
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2616 IGNITION RELAY CIRCUIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567605

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    An immediate operation of ignition relay-2 is requested by BCM, but there is no response for
    more than 1 second.

    IGN RELAY2 CIRCUIT
    [B2616]




    C

    Harness or connectors.
    Ignition relay-2.
    Fuse block J/B.
    BCM.

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    E

    1. Turn ignition switch ON under the following conditions, and wait for at least 1 second.
    CVT selector lever is in the P (park) or N (neutral) position.
    Release brake pedal
    2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of BCM with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B2616 displayed?
    YES >> Refer to PCS-57, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    G
    INFOID:0000000009567606

    H

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».
    I

    1. CHECK IGNITION RELAY-2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove ignition relay-2.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98.
    Check continuity between ignition relay-2 connector J-3 and BCM connector M98.
    Ignition relay-2

    5.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    J-3

    1

    M98

    99

    J

    K
    Continuity

    L
    Yes

    Check continuity between ignition relay-2 connector J-3 and ground.
    Ignition relay-2
    Connector

    Terminal

    J-3

    1

    PCS

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    O

    2. CHECK IGNITION RELAY-2 GROUND CIRCUIT

    P

    Check continuity between ignition relay-2 connector J-3 and ground.
    Ignition relay-2
    Connector

    Terminal

    J-3

    2

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-57

    2014 Note

    B2616 IGNITION RELAY CIRCUIT
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3. CHECK IGNITION RELAY-2

    Perform the relay component inspection. Refer to PCS-58, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace ignition relay-2.

    4. CHECK IGNITION RELAY-2 POWER SUPPLY (BCM)

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    99

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567607

    1.CHECK IGNITION RELAY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Remove ignition relay-2.
    Check the continuity between ignition relay-2 terminals.

    Terminals
    3 and 5

    Condition

    Continuity

    12 V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2

    Yes

    No current supply

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace ignition relay-2.
    PBIB0098E

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-58

    2014 Note

    B2618 BCM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2618 BCM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567608

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2618 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    PCS-51, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2618 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    PCS-52, «DTC Logic».

    C

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition
    An immediate operation of ignition relay-1 is requested by BCM, but there is no response for
    more than 1 second

    BCM
    [B2618]

    D

    Possible Cause
    • Harness or connectors
    • BCM
    • IPDM E/R

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    F

    1. Turn ignition switch ON under the following conditions, and wait for at least 1 second.
    CVT selector lever is in the P (park) or N (neutral) position.
    Release brake pedal
    2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of BCM with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B2618 displayed?
    YES >> Refer to PCS-59, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    G

    H
    INFOID:0000000009567609

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».

    I

    J

    1.CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    K

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    98

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98 and IPDM E/R connector E47.
    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and IPDM E/R connector E47.
    BCM

    4.

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    98

    E47

    90

    O

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-59

    PCS

    N

    2.CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    2014 Note

    P

    B2618 BCM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    98

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK VOLTAGE OF IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT (IPDM E/R SIDE)
    1.
    2.

    Connect IPDM E/R connector E47.
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    90

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-60

    2014 Note

    B261A PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B261A PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567610

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    C

    BCM detects a difference of signal for 1 second
    or more between the following information:
    • Power supply position by push-button ignition
    switch.
    • Power supply position from IPDM E/R (CAN).

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION
    SWITCH
    [B261A]

    • Harness or connectors
    • Push-button ignition switch
    • BCM

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    E

    1. Press the push-button ignition switch under the following conditions, and wait for at least 1 second.
    CVT selector lever is in the P (park) or N (neutral) position.
    Release the brake pedal.
    2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of BCM with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B261A displayed?
    YES >> Refer to PCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567611

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».

    G

    H

    I

    1. CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT SIGNAL (PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH)
    1.
    2.

    F

    Disconnect push-button ignition switch connector.
    Check voltage between push-button ignition switch connector M25 and ground.

    J

    K

    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    8

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    L

    PCS

    2. CHECK IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT SIGNAL (IPDM E/R)
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connector E47 terminal 81 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    81

    N

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».

    P

    3. CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector E47 and BCM connector M98.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E47 and push-button ignition switch connector M25.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-61

    O

    2014 Note

    B261A PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    IPDM E/R

    4.

    Push-button ignition switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    81

    M25

    8

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    81

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4. CHECK IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT SIGNAL (BCM)
    Check voltage between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    76

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    5. CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT (BCM)

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98 and IPDM E/R connector E47.
    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and push-button ignition switch connector M25.
    BCM

    4.

    Push-button ignition switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    76

    M25

    8

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    76

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-62

    2014 Note

    B26F1 IGNITION RELAY
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26F1 IGNITION RELAY

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567612

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM transmits the ignition relay-1 control signal,
    but does not receive ignition switch ON signal
    (CAN) from IPDM E/R.

    IGN RELAY OFF
    [B26F1]

    C

    • Harness or connectors
    • BCM
    • IPDM E/R

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1. Turn ignition switch ON, and wait for 2 seconds or more.
    2. Perform Self-diagnosis result of BCM with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B26F1 displayed?
    YES >> Go to PCS-63, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    E

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567613

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».

    H

    1.CHECK IPDM E/R SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    I

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Erase the DTC of IPDM E/R.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    4. Turn ignition switch ON and check the DTC again.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part. Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    J

    K

    2.CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    98

    L

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    0V

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    3.CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    O

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98 and IPDM E/R connector E47.
    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and IPDM E/R connector E47.
    BCM

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    98

    E47

    90

    P

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-63

    PCS

    2014 Note

    B26F1 IGNITION RELAY
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-64

    2014 Note

    B26F2 IGNITION RELAY
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26F2 IGNITION RELAY

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567614

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    CONSULT Display

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM transmits the ignition relay-1 control signal,
    but does not receive ignition switch ON signal
    (CAN) from IPDM E/R.

    IGN RELAY ON
    [B26F2]

    C

    • Harness or connectors
    • BCM
    • IPDM E/R

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1. Turn ignition switch ON, and wait for 2 seconds or more.
    2. Perform Self-diagnosis result of BCM with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B26F2 displayed?
    YES >> Go to PCS-65, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    E

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567615

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».

    H

    1.CHECK IPDM E/R SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    I

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Erase the DTC of IPDM E/R.
    3. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    4. Turn ignition switch ON and check the DTC again.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning part. Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    J

    K

    2.CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    90

    L

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT — 1 (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    O

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector M98 and IPDM E/R connector E47.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    90

    Ground

    P

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-65

    PCS

    2014 Note

    B26F2 IGNITION RELAY
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT — 2 (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.

    Connect IPDM E/R connector E47.
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    90

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-66

    2014 Note

    B26F6 BCM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26F6 BCM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567616

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B26F6 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    PCS-51, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B26F6 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    PCS-52, «DTC Logic».

    C

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition
    Ignition relay-1 ON signal is not transmitted from
    IPDM E/R (CAN) when BCM turns ignition relay
    ON.

    BCM
    [B26F6]

    D

    Possible Cause
    BCM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    1. Turn ignition switch ON, and wait for 0.5 second or more.
    2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of BCM with CONSULT.
    Is DTC B26F6 displayed?
    YES >> Go to PCS-67, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    G

    H

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567617

    I

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».

    1. CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT FOR IPDM E/R

    J

    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R with CONSULT.
    Are any DTCs detected?
    YES >> Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2

    K

    2. CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 POWER SUPPLY (IPDM E/R)

    L

    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    90

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    Check voltage between BCM connector M98 and ground.

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    98

    P
    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-67

    N

    O

    3. CHECK IGNITION RELAY-1 POWER SUPPLY (BCM)
    BCM

    PCS

    2014 Note

    B26F6 BCM
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-68

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009567618

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    1.
    2.

    B

    Select “PUSH SW” in “Data Monitor” of BCM with CONSULT.
    Check the push-button ignition switch signal under the following conditions.
    C
    Test item

    Condition

    PUSH SW

    Status

    Push-button ignition switch is pressed

    On

    Push-button ignition switch is not pressed

    Off

    D

    Is the indication normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Go to PCS-69, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567619

    F

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PCS-41, «Wiring Diagram».
    G

    1. CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT SIGNAL (PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect push-button ignition switch connector and IPDM E/R connector E47.
    Check voltage between push-button ignition switch connector M25 terminal 8 and ground.

    H

    I
    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    8

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    J

    K

    2. CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT (BCM)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector M98.
    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and push-button ignition switch connector M25.
    BCM

    3.

    Push-button ignition switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    76

    M25

    8

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM connector M98 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    76

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    3. CHECK IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT SIGNAL (IPDM E/R)
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.

    PCS-69

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    L

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    81

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4. CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector M98.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E47 and push-button ignition switch connector M25.
    IPDM E/R

    3.

    Push-button ignition switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    81

    M25

    8

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E47 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E47

    81

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    5.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between push-button ignition switch connector M25 and ground.
    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    4

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    6.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH

    Refer to PCS-70, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace push-button ignition switch. Refer to PCS-74, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567620

    1.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect push-button ignition switch connector.
    Check continuity between push-button ignition switch terminals.
    Push-button ignition switch terminals
    4–8

    Condition

    Continuity

    Pressed

    Yes

    Not pressed

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-70

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Replace push-button ignition switch. Refer to PCS-74, «Removal and Installation».
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-71

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009567621

    Check that vehicle is under the condition shown in “Conditions of vehicle” before starting diagnosis, and check
    each symptom.
    NOTE:
    The engine start function, door lock function, power distribution system, and NATS-IVIS/NVIS in the Intelligent
    Key system are closely related to each other regarding control. The vehicle security function can operate only
    when the door lock and power distribution system are operating normally.

    Conditions of Vehicle (Operating Conditions)
    • “ENGINE START BY I-KEY” in “WORK SUPPORT” is ON when setting on CONSULT.
    • One or more of Intelligent Keys with registered Intelligent Key ID is in the vehicle.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567622

    1.PERFORM WORK SUPPORT
    Perform INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS in Work Support of INTELLIGENT KEY.
    Refer to PCS-37, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULT
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of BCM.
    Is any DTCs displayed?
    YES >> Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH

    Check push-button ignition switch.
    Refer to PCS-69, «Component Function Check».
    Is the operation normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    4.CONFIRM THE OPERATION

    Confirm the operation again.
    Is the inspection normal?
    YES >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> GO TO 1.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-72

    2014 Note

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE)
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    BCM (BODY CONTROL MODULE)
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009607422

    B

    For removal and installation of the BCM (Body Control Module), refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PCS

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-73

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    [POWER DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009607424

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove NATS antenna amp. Refer to SEC-121, «Removal and Installation».
    Release pawls and remove the push-button ignition switch (1).
    : Pawl

    ALKIA3180ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    PCS-74

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL & POWER CONTROL

    SECTION

    PG

    POWER SUPPLY, GROUND & CIRCUIT ELEMENTS

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    ELECTRICAL UNITS LOCATION ……………….. 56
    Electrical Units Location ……………………………………56

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 60

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT ……………… 63

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4
    Circuit Breaker …………………………………………………. 4
    Battery …………………………………………………………….. 4
    Harness Connector …………………………………………… 4
    Standardized Relay …………………………………………… 7

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 10
    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT …………..10
    Wiring Diagram — Battery Power Supply — ……….. 10
    Wiring Diagram — Accessory Power Supply — …. 18
    Wiring Diagram — Ignition Power Supply — ………. 22

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REMOVING BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL ……………………………..63
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REMOVING
    BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL : Special Repair Requirement ……………………………………………..63

    FUSE INSPECTION …………………………………… 64
    How To Check …………………………………………………64
    How To Check …………………………………………………68

    FUSE BLOCK — JUNCTION BOX (J/B) ………….37

    BATTERY TERMINAL WITH FUSIBLE LINK … 71

    L

    N

    O

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 72

    P

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 72

    HARNESS ………………………………………………….40

    Battery ……………………………………………………………72

    Harness Layout ………………………………………………. 40

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    Exploded View …………………………………………………71
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..71

    Terminal Arrangement …………………………………….. 37

    IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement ……………………… 39

    J

    BATTERY …………………………………………………. 69 PG

    Ground Distribution …………………………………………. 30

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM) ……………..39

    I

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 69

    GROUND ……………………………………………………30

    Terminal Arrangement …………………………………….. 38

    H

    FUSIBLE LINK INSPECTION ……………………… 68

    Exploded View …………………………………………………69
    Removal and Installation (Battery) ……………………..69
    Removal and Installation (Battery Tray) ………………70

    FUSE, FUSIBLE LINK AND RELAY BOX ………38

    G

    BATTERY …………………………………………………. 60
    How to Handle Battery ………………………………………60
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….60

    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 3

    F

    PG-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009594986

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009594987

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    C

    Description


    (—) Model GR8-1200 NI
    Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station

    B

    D
    Tests batteries, starting and charging systems and charges batteries.
    For operating instructions, refer to diagnostic
    station instruction manual.

    E

    AWIIA1239ZZ

    F


    (—) Model EXP-800 NI
    Battery and electrical diagnostic analyzer

    Tests batteries and charging systems.
    For operating instructions, refer to diagnostic
    analyzer instruction manual.

    G

    H

    JSMIA0806ZZ

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-3

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Circuit Breaker

    INFOID:0000000009725280

    The PTC thermistor generates heat in response to current flow. The
    temperature (and resistance) of the thermistor element varies with
    current flow. Excessive current flow will cause the element’s temperature to rise. When the temperature reaches a specified level, the
    electrical resistance will rise sharply to control the circuit current.
    Reduced current flow will cause the element to cool. Resistance falls
    accordingly and normal circuit current flow is allowed to resume.

    SEL109W

    Battery

    INFOID:0000000009725282

    Type
    5 hour rate minimum

    Q-85
    [V – Ah]

    Cold cranking current A (For reference value)

    A

    12 – 36
    470

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    Harness Connector

    INFOID:0000000009707860

    HARNESS CONNECTOR (TAB-LOCKING TYPE)
    • The tab-locking type connectors help prevent accidental looseness or disconnection.
    • The tab-locking type connectors are disconnected by pushing or lifting the locking tab(s). Refer to the figure
    below.
    Refer to the next page for description of the slide-locking type connector.
    CAUTION:
    Do not pull the harness or wires when disconnecting the connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-4

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    [Example]
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    SEL769DA

    HARNESS CONNECTOR (SLIDE-LOCKING TYPE)
    • A new style slide-locking type connector is used on certain systems and components, especially those
    related to OBD.
    • The slide-locking type connectors help prevent incomplete locking and accidental looseness or disconnection.
    • The slide-locking type connectors are disconnected by pushing or pulling the slider. Refer to the figure
    below.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not pull the harness or wires when disconnecting the connector.
    • Be careful not to damage the connector support bracket when disconnecting the connector.

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-5

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    [Example]

    SEL769V

    HARNESS CONNECTOR (LEVER LOCKING TYPE)
    • Lever locking type harness connectors are used on certain control units and control modules such as ECM,
    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit), etc.
    • Lever locking type harness connectors are also used on super multiple junction (SMJ) connectors.
    • Always confirm the lever is fully locked in place by moving the lever as far as it will go to ensure full connection.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Always confirm the lever is fully released (loosened) before attempting to disconnect or connect
    these connectors to avoid damage to the connector housing or terminals.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    LKIA0670E

    1.

    Control unit with single lever

    2.

    Control unit with dual lever

    3.

    J

    SMJ connector

    A. Fasten

    A. Lever

    A. Lever

    B. Loosen

    B. Fasten

    B. Fasten

    C. Lever

    C. Loosen

    C. Loosen

    K

    HARNESS CONNECTOR (DIRECT-CONNECT SRS COMPONENT TYPE)
    • SRS direct-connect type harness connectors are used on certain SRS components such as air bag modules L
    and seat belt pre-tensioners.
    • Always pull up to release black locking tab prior to removing connector from SRS components.
    • Always push down to lock black locking tab after installing connector to SRS components. When locked, the
    PG
    black locking tab is level with the connector housing.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not pull the harness or wires when removing connectors
    from SRS components.
    N

    O

    P
    WHIA0103E

    Standardized Relay

    INFOID:0000000009707861

    NORMAL OPEN, NORMAL CLOSED AND MIXED TYPE RELAYS
    Revision: April 2013

    PG-7

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Relays can mainly be divided into three types: normal open, normal closed and mixed type relays.

    SEL881H

    TYPE OF STANDARDIZED RELAYS
    1M ···················· 1 Make

    2M

    1T ···················· 1 Transfer

    1M·1B ···················· 1 Make 1 Break

    ···················· 2 Make

    SEL882H

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-8

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    SEL188W

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-9

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    Wiring Diagram —Battery Power Supply —

    INFOID:0000000009707852

    AAMWA0801GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-10

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMWA0802GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-11

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMWA0803GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-12

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMWA0804GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-13

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMWA0805GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-14

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1740GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-15

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1741GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-16

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1742GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-17

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    Wiring Diagram —Accessory Power Supply —

    INFOID:0000000009707853

    AAMWA0806GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-18

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1743GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-19

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1744GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-20

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1745GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-21

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    Wiring Diagram —Ignition Power Supply —

    INFOID:0000000009707854

    AAMWA0807GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-22

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMWA0808GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-23

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMWA0809GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-24

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1746GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-25

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1747GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-26

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1748GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-27

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1749GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-28

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY ROUTING CIRCUIT
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1750GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-29

    2014 Note

    GROUND
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    GROUND
    Ground Distribution

    INFOID:0000000009707857

    MAIN HARNESS

    AAMIA1751GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-30

    2014 Note

    GROUND
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1752GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-31

    2014 Note

    GROUND
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1753GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-32

    2014 Note

    GROUND
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    ENGINE ROOM HARNESS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1754GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-33

    2014 Note

    P

    GROUND
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1755GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-34

    2014 Note

    GROUND
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    ENGINE CONTROL HARNESS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1756GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-35

    2014 Note

    P

    GROUND
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    BODY HARNESS

    AAMIA1757GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-36

    2014 Note

    FUSE BLOCK — JUNCTION BOX (J/B)
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    FUSE BLOCK — JUNCTION BOX (J/B)
    Terminal Arrangement

    A
    INFOID:0000000009707862

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P
    AAMIA1762GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-37

    2014 Note

    FUSE, FUSIBLE LINK AND RELAY BOX
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    FUSE, FUSIBLE LINK AND RELAY BOX
    Terminal Arrangement

    INFOID:0000000009707863

    FUSE, FUSIBLE LINK AND RELAY BOX

    AAMIA1763GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-38

    2014 Note

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE ROOM)
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    IPDM E/R (INTELLIGENT POWER DISTRIBUTION MODULE ENGINE
    ROOM)
    IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement

    INFOID:0000000009707864

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    AAMIA0161ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-39

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    HARNESS
    Harness Layout

    INFOID:0000000009707858

    HOW TO READ HARNESS LAYOUT
    The following Harness Layouts use a map style grid to help locate
    connectors on the drawings:
    • Main Harness
    • Engine Room Harness
    • Engine Room Harness (Passenger Compartment)
    • Engine Control Harness
    • Body Harness
    • Room Lamp Harness
    To use the grid reference
    1. Find the desired connector number on the connector list.
    2. Find the grid reference.
    3. On the drawing, find the crossing of the grid reference letter column and number row.
    4. Find the connector number in the crossing zone.
    5. Follow the line (if used) to the connector.

    SEL252V

    OUTLINE

    AAMIA1764GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-40

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    MAIN HARNESS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA0162ZZ

    B1

    M1

    W/8

    : To R1

    A2

    M3

    W/1

    : Fuse block (J/B)

    D3

    M45

    W/20

    : Audio unit (With display audio system)

    D1

    M5

    BR/20

    : Joint connector-M03

    D3

    M51

    GR/20

    : Joint connector-M04

    B3

    M7

    W/16

    : Door mirror remote control switch

    C2

    M53

    B/8

    : EPS control unit

    A3

    M9

    W/12

    : To D1

    D1

    M55

    W/4

    : Hazard switch

    Revision: April 2013

    D2

    PG-41

    M44

    G/5

    : Audio unit (With display audio system)

    2014 Note

    P

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    D3

    M10

    L/20

    : Joint connector–M01

    B2

    M57

    : Body ground

    B4

    M11

    W/2

    : To B28

    B1

    M61

    : Body ground

    F3

    M12

    W/16

    : To B29

    C1

    M62

    W/2

    : Front blower motor

    B3

    M14

    L/4

    : Rear window defogger relay

    D5

    M66

    B/2

    : Console power socket

    B4

    M15

    W/16

    : To B23

    A4

    M69

    SMJ

    : To E7

    A4

    M16

    W/24

    : To B24

    E3

    M70

    W/20

    : AV control unit

    D5

    M17

    B/1

    : Parking brake switch

    D2

    M71

    W/24

    : AV control unit

    A2

    M18

    B/40

    : BCM (Body control module)

    E4

    M72

    L/5

    : USB interface

    C2

    M21

    W/4

    : NATS antenna amp.

    E1

    M77

    Y/2

    : Front passenger air bag module

    B3

    M22

    W/16

    : Data link connector

    A4

    M78

    B/2

    : T0 E11

    E4

    M23

    W/4

    : AUX in jack

    F1

    M79

    : Body ground

    C1

    M24

    W/40

    : Combination meter

    F2

    M81

    W/12

    : To D115

    C3

    M25

    W/8

    : Push–button ignition swtich

    D5

    M83

    B/3

    : G sensor

    C3

    M28

    W/16

    : Combination switch

    F5

    M89

    L/2

    : Inside key antenna (Console)

    E3

    M29

    W/24

    : To B1

    F1

    M90

    B/4

    : Remote keyless entry receiver

    C3

    M30

    GR/8

    : Combination switch (Spiral cable)

    F2

    M92

    W/12

    : To D116

    C4

    M31

    Y/6

    : Combination switch (Spiral cable)

    A3

    M93

    W/24

    : To D16

    E3

    M33

    B/15

    : Front air control

    D3

    M95

    L/2

    : Inside key antenna (Instrument center)

    D4

    M35

    Y/28

    : Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    A2

    M98

    W/40

    : BCM (Body control module)

    E4

    M38

    W/8

    : CVT shift selector

    A2

    M99

    W/15

    : BCM (Body control module)

    A3

    M39

    L/4

    : Accessory relay–2

    A2

    M100

    B/15

    : BCM (Body control module)

    D2

    M40

    W/32

    : Audio unit (With display audio system)

    D2

    M101

    W/16

    : Audio unit (With base audio system)

    A3

    M41

    B/5

    : Back door lock actuator relay

    B3

    M105

    W/4

    : Headlamp aiming switch

    C3

    M42

    BR/4

    : Thermo control amp.

    C2

    M151

    BR/4

    : Front blower motor resistor

    D3

    M43

    W/20

    : Audio unit (With base audio system)

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-42

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    ENGINE ROOM HARNESS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA0163ZZ

    E1

    E1

    GR/5

    : Front wiper motor

    F2

    E41

    L/4

    : Starter relay

    A5

    E2

    W/2

    : Front washer motor

    E2

    E42

    B/2

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    D3

    E4

    Y/2

    : Crash zone sensor

    E2

    E43

    B/6

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-43

    2014 Note

    P

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    E4

    E5

    B/2

    : Cooling fan motor

    F2

    E44

    BR/8

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    C3

    E6

    B/2

    : Hood switch

    E1

    E45

    BR/12

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    E2

    E8

    W/24

    : To F8

    F2

    E46

    W/24

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    E3

    E9

    BR/2

    : Fusible link box (Battery)

    F2

    E47

    W/16

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    E3

    E10

    GR/2

    : Fusible link box (Battery)

    F3

    E51

    B/2

    : Front wheel sensor LH

    G2

    E15

    : Body ground

    C4

    E52

    B/2

    : Front wheel sensor RH

    F3

    E16

    B/32

    : ECM

    G4

    E53

    B/2

    : Front fog lamp LH

    F4

    E17

    B/3

    : Refrigerant pressure sensor

    B5

    E54

    B/2

    : Front fog lamp RH

    C4

    E18

    BR/1

    : Horn

    E2

    E55

    GR/12

    : To F55

    E2

    E19

    W/6

    : To F33

    F4

    E56

    B/2

    : Pre–wiring for front fog lamps

    C4

    E20

    B/1

    : Horn

    G3

    E62

    B/4

    : Cooling fan relay

    A2

    E24

    : Body ground

    C3

    E63

    GR/4

    : Heated oxygen sensor 2

    G3

    E25

    B/3

    : Front combination lamp LH (Without
    daytime light system)

    F3

    E65

    B/3

    : Front combination lamp RH (Headlamp
    aiming motor)

    A3

    E26

    B/3

    : Front combination lamp RH (Without
    daytime light system)

    B2

    E66

    B/3

    : Front combination lamp LH (Headlamp
    aiming motor)

    G2

    E27

    B/2

    : Front combination lamp LH (Without
    daytime light system)

    A5

    E68

    GR/2

    : Front combination lamp RH (With daytime
    light system)

    A2

    E28

    B/2

    : Front combination lamp RH (Without
    daytime light system)

    E5

    E69

    GR/2

    : Front combination lamp LH (With daytime
    light system)

    F4

    E29

    GR/3

    : Front combination lamp LH (Without
    daytime light system)

    F5

    E70

    BR/3

    : Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    B3

    E30

    GR/3

    : Front combination lamp RH (Without
    daytime light system)

    A3

    E73

    B/3

    : Front combination lamp RH (With daytime
    light system)

    E3

    E31

    GR/4

    : Cooling fan motor

    G3

    E74

    B/3

    : Front combination lamp LH (With daytime
    light system)

    E4

    E32

    W/2

    : Cooling fan motor

    F4

    E75

    GR/2

    : Front combination lamp LH (With daytime
    light system)

    B2

    E33

    B/38

    : ABS actuator and electric unit (Control
    unit)

    C3

    E76

    GR/2

    : Front combination lamp RH (With daytime
    light system)

    E2

    E39

    W/3

    : Horn relay

    A3

    E77

    B/2

    : Front combination lamp RH (With daytime
    light system)

    E2

    E40

    B/2

    : Brake fluid level switch

    G2

    E78

    B/2

    : Front combination lamp LH (With daytime
    light system)

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-44

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    ENGINE ROOM HARNESS (PASSENGER COMPARTMENT)
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA0164ZZ

    A3

    E7

    A4

    E11

    D4

    E12

    C3

    E13

    B3

    E14

    SMJ

    : To M69

    C3

    B/2

    : To M78

    D2

    E48

    W/4

    : Clutch position switch

    B/6

    : Accelerator pedal position sensor

    C3

    E57

    B/2

    : Stop lamp switch (With M/T)

    W/4

    : Stop lamp switch (With CVT)

    B2

    E58

    L/4

    : Front fog lamp relay

    L/12

    : Joint connector-E03

    A3

    E59

    : Body ground

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-45

    E36

    BR/2

    : Brake pedal position switch

    2014 Note

    P

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A4

    E21

    GR/16

    : To B12

    A2

    E60

    : Body ground

    B2

    E22

    W/22

    : Joint connector–E02

    B3

    E61

    : Body ground

    B3

    E23

    B/2

    : EPS control unit

    B1

    E67

    L/4

    : Daytime light relay

    C2

    E34

    BR/2

    : Clutch interlock switch

    ENGINE CONTROL HARNESS

    AAMIA0165ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-46

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    B3

    F1

    B/3

    : Generator

    D3

    F29

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 3 (Rear)

    B3

    F2

    : Generator

    D3

    F30

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 4 (Rear)

    B5

    F3

    B/1

    : A/C compressor

    C1

    F31

    B/6

    : Mass air flow sensor

    B4

    F4

    : Generator

    E1

    F32

    GR/2

    : Exhaust valve timing control solenoid
    valve

    C4

    F5

    : Engine ground

    F1

    F33

    W/6

    : To E19

    E2

    F6

    GR/2

    : Engine coolant temperature sensor

    B1

    F34

    GR/3

    : Ignition coil No. 1 (With power
    transistor)

    D1

    F7

    B/6

    : Electric throttle control actuator

    C1

    F35

    GR/3

    : Ignition coil No. 2 (With power
    transistor)

    E1

    F8

    W/24

    : To E8

    C1

    F36

    GR/3

    : Ignition coil No. 3 (With power
    transistor)

    G2

    F10

    GR/32

    : ECM

    D2

    F37

    GR/3

    : Ignition coil No. 4 (With power
    transistor)

    G1

    F11

    BR/48

    : ECM

    C4

    F38

    B/3

    : Engine oil pressure sensor

    D2

    F12

    BR/4

    : Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor 1

    G3

    F39

    : Fusible link box (Battery)

    C3

    F14

    B/2

    : Knock sensor

    G3

    F40

    : Fusible link box (Battery)

    E2

    F15

    B/3

    : Crankshaft position sensor (POS)

    G4

    F41

    B/3

    : Output speed sensor

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    D4

    F16

    : Engine ground

    F2

    F42

    W/12

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    B3

    F17

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 1 (Front)

    F2

    F43

    W/12

    : IPDM E/R (Intelligent power distribution
    module engine room)

    C3

    F18

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 2 (Front)

    F2

    F44

    B/48

    : TCM (Transmission control module)

    C3

    F19

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 3 (Front)

    F4

    F46

    GR/22

    : CVT unit

    D3

    F20

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 4 (Front)

    G4

    F48

    B/3

    : Secondary speed sensor

    D2

    F21

    B/3

    : Intake camshaft position sensor

    G4

    F50

    B/3

    : Primary speed sensor

    C1

    F22

    G/2

    : EVAP canister purge volume control
    solenoid valve

    F3

    F52

    B/10

    : Transmission range switch

    B3

    F23

    G/2

    : Intake valve timing control solenoid
    valve

    B3

    F53

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 1 (Rear)

    E4

    F24

    G/3

    : Park/neutral position (PNP) switch

    C3

    F54

    B/2

    : Fuel injector No. 2 (Rear)

    C4

    F25

    GR/2

    : Engine oil temperature sensor

    G1

    F55

    GR/12

    : To E55

    C3

    F26

    W/2

    : Condenser

    D2

    F56

    B/3

    : Exhaust camshaft position sensor

    D3

    F27

    : Starter motor

    D3

    F59

    : Engine ground

    D4

    F28

    : Starter motor

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-47

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    BODY HARNESS

    AAMIA0166ZZ

    G2

    B1

    W/24

    : To M29

    E1

    B24

    W/24

    : To M16

    F4

    B4

    W/10

    : To D201

    A3

    B25

    W/6

    : Rear combination lamp LH

    C2

    B6

    W/4

    : Rear door switch LH

    C4

    B27

    W/6

    : Rear combination lamp RH

    D4

    B7

    : Body ground

    E1

    B28

    W/2

    : To M11

    D2

    B8

    W/4

    : Front door switch LH

    G2

    B29

    W/16

    : To M12

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-48

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    E2

    B9

    Y/22

    : Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    D5

    B33

    W/32

    : Bluetooth® control unit

    E3

    B11

    W/10

    : To D301

    C5

    B34

    W/8

    : Bluetooth® control unit

    E1

    B12

    GR/16

    : To E21

    C4

    B35

    B/2

    : Rear wheel sensor RH

    E3

    B13

    W/3

    : Seat belt buckle switch LH

    F2

    B37

    Y/22

    : Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    C2

    B14

    Y/2

    : Front LH seat belt pre–tensioner

    F4

    B39

    Y/2

    : Front RH seat belt pre–tensioner

    F3

    B16

    W/4

    : Front door switch RH

    B3

    B42

    B/1

    : Condenser

    E4

    B17

    W/4

    : Rear door switch RH

    D3

    B44

    GR/5

    : Fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump

    B3

    B18

    B/2

    : High–mounted stop lamp

    C4

    B48

    B/2

    : Inside key antenna (Trunk room)

    A3

    B19

    : Body ground

    B5

    B49

    B/2

    : Outside key antenna (Rear bumper)

    D4

    B21

    W/4

    : Cargo lamp

    B3

    B52

    W/4

    : To D504

    C3

    B22

    GR/2

    : Rear wheel sensor LH

    B4

    B53

    W/8

    : To D503

    F1

    B23

    W/16

    : To M15

    A4

    B85

    : Body ground

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-49

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    ROOM LAMP HARNESS

    AAMIA0167ZZ

    D5

    R1

    W/8

    : To M1

    E1

    R7

    W/3

    : Interior room lamp

    C2

    R2

    W/6

    : Map lamp

    D2

    R15

    W/4

    : Microphone

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-50

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    FRONT DOOR LH HARNESS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AAMIA0168ZZ

    D1

    W/12

    : To M9

    D9

    B/2

    : Front power window motor LH

    D4

    W/12

    : Door mirror LH

    D12

    W/2

    : Front door speaker LH

    D6

    GR/2

    : Front outside handle LH (Outside key
    antenna)

    D14

    GR/6

    : Front door lock assembly LH

    D7

    W/16

    : Main power window and door lock/unlock
    switch

    D16

    W/24

    : To M93

    D8

    W/3

    : Main power window and door lock/unlock
    switch

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-51

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    FRONT DOOR RH HARNESS

    AAMIA0169ZZ

    D104

    B/2

    : Front power window motor RH

    D112

    W/2

    : Front door speaker RH

    D105

    W/12

    : Power window and door lock/unlock switch
    RH

    D113

    GR/2

    : Front outside handle RH (Request switch)

    D106

    GR/2

    : Front outside handle RH (Outside key
    antenna)

    D114

    GR/6

    : Front door lock actuator RH

    D107

    W/12

    : Door mirror RH

    D116

    W/12

    : To M92

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-52

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    REAR DOOR LH HARNESS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AAMIA0170ZZ

    D201

    W/10

    : To B4

    D205

    GR/6

    : Rear door lock actuator LH

    D203

    W/8

    : Rear power window switch LH

    D207

    W/2

    : Rear door speaker LH

    D204

    B/2

    : Rear power window motor LH

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-53

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    REAR DOOR RH HARNESS

    AAMIA0171ZZ

    D301

    W/10

    : To B11

    D305

    GR/6

    : Rear door lock actuator RH

    D303

    W/8

    : Rear power window switch RH

    D307

    W/2

    : Rear door speaker RH

    D304

    B/2

    : Rear power window motor RH

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-54

    2014 Note

    HARNESS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    BACK DOOR HARNESS
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA0172ZZ

    D3

    D501

    B/6

    : Rear view camera

    C3

    D506

    BR/2

    : Back door request switch

    D3

    D502

    W/4

    : Rear wiper motor

    D3

    D507

    BR/2

    : License plate lamp LH

    E3

    D503

    W/8

    : To B53

    C4

    D508

    BR/2

    : License plate lamp RH

    E4

    D504

    W/4

    : To B52

    D5

    D509

    W/3

    : Back door switch

    D5

    D505

    W/2

    : Back door lock actuator

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-55

    2014 Note

    P

    ELECTRICAL UNITS LOCATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ELECTRICAL UNITS LOCATION
    Electrical Units Location

    INFOID:0000000009707859

    ENGINE COMPARTMENT

    AAMIA1758GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-56

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL UNITS LOCATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1759GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-57

    2014 Note

    P

    ELECTRICAL UNITS LOCATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAMIA1760GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-58

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL UNITS LOCATION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O
    AAMIA1761GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-59

    2014 Note

    P

    BATTERY
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    BATTERY
    How to Handle Battery

    INFOID:0000000009643749

    CAUTION:
    • If it becomes necessary to start the engine with a booster battery and jumper cables, use a 12-volt
    booster battery.
    • After connecting battery cables, ensure that they are tightly clamped to battery terminals for good
    contact.
    • Never add distilled water through the hole used to check specific gravity.

    METHODS OF PREVENTING OVER-DISCHARGE
    The following precautions must be taken to prevent over-discharging a battery.

    • The battery surface (particularly its top) should always be kept
    clean and dry.
    • The terminal connections should be clean and tight.
    • At every routine maintenance, check the electrolyte level.
    This also applies to batteries designated as “low maintenance” and
    “maintenance-free”.

    MEL040F

    • When the vehicle is not going to be used over a long period of
    time, disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal. (If
    the vehicle has an extended storage switch, turn it off.)

    ELA0349D

    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009643750

    BATTERY DIAGNOSIS WITH EXP-800 NI OR GR8-1200 NI
    To diagnose and confirm the condition of the battery, use the following special service tools:
    • EXP-800 NI Battery and electrical diagnostic analyzer
    • GR8-1200 NI Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station
    NOTE:
    Refer to the applicable Instruction Manual for proper battery diagnosis procedures.

    BATTERY DIAGNOSIS WITHOUT EXP-800 NI OR GR8-1200 NI
    Checking Electrolyte Level

    WARNING:
    Never allow battery fluid to come in contact with skin, eyes, fabrics, or painted surfaces. After touching a battery, never touch or rub your eyes until you have thoroughly washed your hands. If acid contacts eyes, skin or clothing, immediately flush with water for 15 minutes and seek medical attention.
    Failure to do this may cause personal injury or damage to clothing or the painted surfaces.

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-60

    2014 Note

    BATTERY
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Remove the cell plug using a suitable tool.
    • Add distilled water up to the MAX level.

    A

    B

    C
    MEL043F

    D
    SULFATION

    • A battery will be completely discharged if it is left unattended
    for a long time and the specific gravity will become less than
    1.100. This may result in sulfation on the cell plates.
    • To determine if a battery has been “sulfated”, note its voltage
    and current when charging it. As shown in the figure, less current and higher voltage are observed in the initial stage of
    charging sulfated batteries.
    • A sulfated battery may sometimes be brought back into service by means of a long, slow charge, 12 hours or more, followed by a battery capacity test.

    E

    F

    G
    PKIA2353E

    Specific Gravity Check
    NOTE:
    Check the charge condition of the battery.
    Periodically check the specific gravity of the electrolyte. Keep a close check on charge condition to prevent
    over-discharge.
    1. Read hydrometer and thermometer indications at eye level.
    2. Use the chart below to correct your hydrometer reading according to electrolyte temperature.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    MEL042FA

    Hydrometer Temperature Correction

    Battery electrolyte temperature [°C (°F)]

    Add to specific gravity reading

    71 (160)

    0.032

    66 (150)

    0.028

    60 (140)

    0.024

    54 (130)

    0.020

    49 (120)

    0.016

    43 (110)

    0.012

    38 (100)

    0.008

    32 (90)

    0.004

    27 (80)

    0

    21 (70)

    −0.004

    16 (60)

    −0.008

    10 (50)

    −0.012

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-61

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    BATTERY
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Battery electrolyte temperature [°C (°F)]

    Add to specific gravity reading

    4 (40)

    −0.016

    −1 (30)

    −0.020

    −7 (20)

    −0.024

    −12 (10)

    −0.028

    −18 (0)

    −0.032

    Corrected specific gravity

    Approximate charge condition

    1.260 — 1.280

    Fully charged

    1.230 — 1.250

    3/4 charged

    1.200 — 1.220

    1/2 charged

    1.170 — 1.190

    1/4 charged

    1.140 — 1.160

    Almost discharged

    1.110 — 1.130

    Completely discharged

    Charging The Battery
    CAUTION:
    • Never “quick charge” a fully discharged battery.
    • Keep the battery away from open flame while it is being charged.
    • When connecting the charger, connect the leads first, then turn on the charger. Never turn on the
    charger first, as this may cause a spark.
    • If battery electrolyte temperature rises above 55 °C (131 °F), stop charging. Always charge battery at
    a temperature below 55 °C (131 °F).
    Charging Rates (Standard Charge)

    Approximate charge condition

    Charge current (A)

    Charge time (h)

    Fully charged

    2

    3/4 charged

    2.5

    1/2 charged
    1/4 charged

    7

    5
    7.5

    Almost discharged

    9

    Completely discharged

    10

    Charging Rates (Quick Charge)

    Approximate charge condition

    Charge current (A)

    Charge time (h)

    Fully charged

    3/4 charged

    16

    1/2 charged
    1/4 charged

    33

    0.5

    Almost discharged
    Completely discharged

    NOTE:
    The ammeter reading on your battery charger will automatically decrease as the battery charges. This indicates that the voltage of the battery is increasing normally as the state of charge improves. The charging amps
    indicated above refer to initial charge rate.
    • If, after charging, the specific gravity of any two cells varies more than 0.050, the battery should be replaced.

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-62

    2014 Note

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REMOVING BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REMOVING BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL : Special Repair Requirement

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009643751

    Required Procedure After Battery Disconnection

    System
    Engine Control System
    Audio, Visual and Navigation System

    Item
    Idle Air Volume Learning

    Reference

    C

    EC-115

    Audio (Radio Preset)

    Refer to Owner’s Manual.

    Navigation System

    Refer to Owner’s Manual.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-63

    2014 Note

    FUSE INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    FUSE INSPECTION
    How To Check

    INFOID:0000000009725276

    • If fuse is blown, be sure to eliminate cause of malfunction before
    installing new fuse.
    • Use fuse of specified rating. Never use fuse of more than specified
    rating.
    • Do not partially install fuse; always insert it into fuse holder properly.
    • Remove fuse for “ELECTRICAL PARTS (BAT)” if vehicle is not
    used for a long period of time.

    CEL083

    EXTENDED STORAGE FUSE SWITCH (IF EQUIPPED)
    The following switch may be mounted on the fuse block (Junction Box) for transportation and storage.

    JSMIA0793ZZ

    1.

    Extended storage fuse switch

    A.

    Type A

    B.

    Type B

    C.

    Type C

    • Remove the extended storage fuse switch when replacing the fuse of extended storage fuse switch.
    • Remove the extended storage fuse switch if it causes the interference when the fuse or the other fuses is
    checked.
    How To Extended Storage Fuse Switch ON/OFF
    CAUTION:
    • Turn the ignition switch OFF when operating the extended storage fuse switch.
    • Under normal conditions, keep the extended storage fuse switch in ON state. Never operate the
    extended storage fuse switch except when necessary.

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-64

    2014 Note

    FUSE INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Type A
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E
    JSMIA0472ZZ

    — To turn the extended storage fuse switch OFF, pull it up in (A) direction as shown in the figure.
    — To turn the extended storage fuse switch ON, press it in (B) direction as shown in the figure.
    • Type B

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JSMIA0473ZZ

    — To turn the extended storage fuse switch OFF, hold (A) of the switch and pull up in (B) direction as shown in
    the figure.
    — To turn the extended storage fuse switch ON, press it in (C) direction as shown in the figure.
    • Type C

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P
    JSMIA0794ZZ

    — To turn the extended storage fuse switch OFF, pull it up in (A) direction as shown in the figure.
    — To turn the extended storage fuse switch ON, press it in (B) direction as shown in the figure.
    How To Remove Extended Storage Fuse Switch
    Type A

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-65

    2014 Note

    FUSE INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    2. Turn the extended storage fuse switch OFF.
    3. Press pawl (A) and tilt to disengage the extended storage fuse
    switch. Press pawl (B) and tilt to remove the extended storage
    fuse switch.

    JSMIA0476ZZ

    NOTE:
    • Extended storage fuse switch and fuse are removed together. Remove fuse from extended storage fuse
    switch, if necessary.
    • Extended storage fuse switch is for transportation and storage. Reinstallation is not required after the
    removal.
    Type B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Turn the extended storage fuse switch OFF.
    Hold (A) and pull up the extended storage fuse switch hard in
    (B) direction.

    JSMIA0477ZZ

    NOTE:
    • Extended storage fuse switch and fuse may be removed together. Remove fuse from extended storage
    fuse switch, if necessary.
    • Extended storage fuse switch is for transportation and storage. Reinstallation is not required after the
    removal.
    Type C

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Turn the extended storage fuse switch OFF.
    Hold (A) and pull up the extended storage fuse switch hard in
    (B) direction.

    JSMIA0795ZZ

    NOTE:
    • Extended storage fuse switch and fuse are removed together. Remove fuse from extended storage fuse
    switch, if necessary.
    Revision: April 2013

    PG-66

    2014 Note

    FUSE INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    • Extended storage fuse switch is for transportation and storage. Reinstallation is not required after the
    removal.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PG

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-67

    2014 Note

    FUSIBLE LINK INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    FUSIBLE LINK INSPECTION
    How To Check

    INFOID:0000000009725277

    A melted fusible link can be detected either by visual inspection or by
    feeling with finger tip. If its condition is questionable, use circuit
    tester or test lamp.
    1

    :Fusible link

    CAUTION:
    • If fusible link should melt, it is possible that critical circuit
    (power supply or large current carrying circuit) is shorted. In
    such a case, carefully check and eliminate cause of malfunction.
    • Never wrap outside of fusible link with vinyl tape. Important:
    Never let fusible link touch any other wiring harness, vinyl or
    rubber parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-68

    JPMIA1291ZZ

    2014 Note

    BATTERY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    BATTERY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015555

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    AWGIA0296ZZ

    1.

    Battery cover

    2.

    Battery

    4.

    Battery tray

    5.

    Battery tray bracket

    3.

    Removal and Installation (Battery)

    Battery wedge bracket
    Front

    K
    INFOID:0000000009015556

    CAUTION:
    To prevent damage to the parts, disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal first.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    N

    O

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Replace the battery if it has been dropped or sustained and impact.
    To install the battery, carefully read the following instructions:
    • To prevent damage to the parts, connect the battery cable to the positive terminal first.
    • After connecting battery cables, to securely supply battery voltage, ensure that they are tightly
    clamped to battery terminals for good contact.
    • To securely supply battery voltage, check battery terminal for poor connection caused by corrosion.
    Reset electronic systems as necessary. Refer to PG-63, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REMOVING BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL : Special Repair Requirement».

    PG-69

    L

    PG

    Remove the air duct inlet. Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal and set aside.
    Disconnect the battery cable from the positive terminal and set aside.
    Remove the remove the battery wedge bracket.
    Remove the battery cover and the battery.

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    2014 Note

    P

    BATTERY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Removal and Installation (Battery Tray)

    INFOID:0000000009643002

    CAUTION:
    To prevent damage to the parts, disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal first.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove battery. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove the battery bracket. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    Remove the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the TCM and remove the TCM bracket. Refer toTM-235,
    «Exploded View».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the battery tray and battery tray bracket.
    Remove the nuts and bolts and remove the battery tray bracket and battery tray. Refer to PG-69,
    «Exploded View».

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Replace electrical components as necessary, if any have been dropped or sustained and impact.
    To install the battery, carefully read the following instructions:
    • To prevent damage to the parts, connect the battery cable to the positive terminal first.
    • After connecting battery cables, to securely supply battery voltage, ensure that they are tightly
    clamped to battery terminals for good contact.
    • To securely supply battery voltage, check battery terminal for poor connection caused by corrosion.
    Reset electronic systems as necessary. Refer to PG-63, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REMOVING BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL : Special Repair Requirement».

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-70

    2014 Note

    BATTERY TERMINAL WITH FUSIBLE LINK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    BATTERY TERMINAL WITH FUSIBLE LINK

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015557

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWGIA0297ZZ

    1.

    Battery

    2.

    Fusible link box (battery)

    3.

    J

    Terminal connector

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015558

    CAUTION:
    To prevent damage to the parts, disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal first.

    K

    L

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal and set aside. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    PG
    Disconnect the battery cable with the fusible link box (battery) from positive terminal.
    Open cover of the fusible link box (battery).
    Remove harness nut from the fusible link box (battery) and separate the fusible link box (battery) from terN
    minal connector.
    Disconnect harness connectors and remove the fusible link box (battery).

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Replace the fusible link box (battery) if it has been dropped or sustained and impact.
    To install the battery, carefully read the following instructions:
    • To prevent damage to the parts, connect the battery cable to the positive terminal first.
    • After connecting battery cables, to securely supply battery voltage, ensure that they are tightly
    clamped to battery terminals for good contact.
    • To securely supply battery voltage, check battery terminal for poor connection caused by corrosion.
    Reset electronic systems as necessary. Refer to PG-63, «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REMOVING BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL : Special Repair Requirement».
    Revision: April 2013

    PG-71

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Battery

    INFOID:0000000009015560

    Type
    5 hour rate minimum
    Cold cranking current A (For reference value)

    Q-85
    [V – Ah]
    A

    12 – 36
    470

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    Revision: April 2013

    PG-72

    2014 Note

    BODY EXTERIOR, DOORS, ROOF & VEHICLE SECURITY

    SECTION

    PWC

    POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 12

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM ……………………….. 12

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 3

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..12

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 19

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….19

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 21

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 4

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 5
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 5
    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 5
    Power Window Main Switch ……………………………….. 6
    Power Window Switch ……………………………………….. 6
    Power Window Motor ………………………………………… 6

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 7
    System Diagram ……………………………………………….. 7
    System Description …………………………………………… 7

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….. 8
    COMMON ITEM ………………………………………………….. 8
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) ………………………………………………. 8
    RETAINED PWR ………………………………………………… 8
    RETAINED PWR : CONSULT Function (BCM RETAINED PWR) …………………………………………….. 9

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW ……. 19

    POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH ……………………….21
    POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH : Diagnosis
    Procedure ……………………………………………………….21

    PWC

    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) ………………………………………………………..22
    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………..22

    L

    M

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH ………………………23
    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH : Diagnosis
    Procedure ……………………………………………………….23

    N

    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) …………………………………………. 25

    O

    BCM …………………………………………………………..10

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    J

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH ……………… 27

    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 11

    H

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM …………………………………21
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………………………………….21

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 10

    POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH ………………..11

    G

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT …. 21

    Component Function Check ………………………………25
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..25
    Component Inspection ………………………………………26

    List of ECU Reference …………………………………….. 10

    F

    Component Function Check ………………………………27
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..27
    Component Inspection ………………………………………28

    POWER WINDOW MOTOR ………………………

    PWC-1

    2014 Note

    P

    DRIVER SIDE …………………………………………………… 29
    DRIVER SIDE : Component Function Check ……… 29
    DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure ……………….. 29

    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    AND REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH ARE
    OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure …………………… 38

    PASSENGER SIDE …………………………………………… 30
    PASSENGER SIDE : Component Function Check
    … 30
    PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure ……….. 30

    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH IS
    OPERATED ……………………………………………………… 38
    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH IS
    OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure …………………… 38

    REAR LH …………………………………………………………. 31
    REAR LH : Component Function Check ……………. 31
    REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure ………………………. 31

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED ………………………………………………………….. 38
    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………….. 39

    REAR RH ………………………………………………………… 32
    REAR RH : Component Function Check ……………. 32
    REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………… 32

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………….. 34
    POWER WINDOWS DO NOT OPERATE
    WITH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH ……… 34
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 34

    DRIVER SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT
    OPERATE …………………………………………………. 35
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 35

    FRONT PASSENGER SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE ………………………. 36
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    AND FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH ARE
    OPERATED ……………………………………………………… 36
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    AND FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH ARE
    OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure ………………….. 36
    WHEN FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) IS OPERATED ………………………….. 36
    WHEN FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH
    (PASSENGER SIDE) IS OPERATED : Diagnosis
    Procedure ……………………………………………………… 36

    REAR RH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES
    NOT OPERATE …………………………………………. 40
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    AND REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH ARE
    OPERATED ……………………………………………………… 40
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    AND REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH ARE
    OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure …………………… 40
    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH IS
    OPERATED ……………………………………………………… 40
    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH IS
    OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure …………………… 40
    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED ………………………………………………………….. 40
    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………….. 41

    POWER WINDOW RETAINED POWER OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE PROPERLY
    … 42
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 42

    POWER WINDOW LOCK SWITCH DOES
    NOT FUNCTION ………………………………………… 43
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 43

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED ………………………………………………………….. 36
    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………….. 37

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ………….. 44

    REAR LH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES
    NOT OPERATE …………………………………………. 38

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 44

    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    AND REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH ARE
    OPERATED ……………………………………………………… 38

    MAIN POWER WINDOW AND DOOR LOCK/
    UNLOCK SWITCH ……………………………………… 44
    POWER WINDOW AND DOOR LOCK/UNLOCK SWITCH RH …………………………………….. 45
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 45

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH ……………… 46
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 46

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567634

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009567635

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component PWC
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    L
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    M
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    N
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    O
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.
    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009567636

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-4

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009015827

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N
    ALKIA3202ZZ

    A.

    View with LH front door finisher removed

    No.

    B.

    View with LH rear door finisher removed

    Component parts

    O

    Function

    1.

    BCM

    • Supplies power supply to power window switch.
    • Controls retained power.
    • Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location»
    for detailed installation location.

    2.

    Power window main switch

    Refer to PWC-6, «Power Window Main Switch».

    3.

    Front power window motor (driver side)

    Refer to PWC-6, «Power Window Motor».

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-5

    2014 Note

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component parts

    Function

    4.

    Front door switch (driver side)

    • Inputs door open/close condition to BCM.
    • Refer to DLK-16, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM : Door Switch» for detailed installation location.

    5.

    Rear power window switch LH

    Refer to PWC-6, «Power Window Switch».

    6.

    Rear power window motor LH

    Refer to PWC-6, «Power Window Switch».

    Power Window Main Switch

    INFOID:0000000009578748

    • Power window main switch controls all power windows.
    • Power window main switch integrates UP/DOWN switch, power
    window lock switch, and door lock/unlock switch.
    • Power window main switch controls the power window lock
    function.

    ALKIA3203ZZ

    Power Window Switch

    INFOID:0000000009578749

    • Each power window switch transmits UP/DOWN signal to each
    motor.
    • Each power window switch transmits UP/DOWN signal from power
    window main switch to each motor.

    ALKIA3204ZZ

    Power Window Motor

    INFOID:0000000009578750

    • Starts operation according to signals from power window main
    switch (front driver side).
    • Transmits front power window motor (driver side) rotation as a
    pulse signal to power window main switch.
    • Excepting power window motor for driver door, starts operation
    according to signals from power window main switch or each
    power window switches.

    JMKIA6528ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-6

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    System Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009578780

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    ALKIA2285GB

    System Description

    I

    INFOID:0000000009578781

    J

    BASIC OPERATION



    Power window system is activated by power window switch when ignition switch turns ON.
    Power window main switch opens/closes all door glass.
    PWC
    Front and rear power window switch opens/closes the corresponding door glass.
    AUTO DOWN operation can be performed when power window main switch is depressed to the second
    detent.
    L
    • Power window lock switch can lock all power windows other than driver seat.

    POWER WINDOW AUTO-OPERATION (FRONT DRIVER SIDE)
    AUTO DOWN operation can be performed when power window main switch is depressed to the second
    detent.

    M

    POWER WINDOW LOCK
    Ground circuit inside power window main switch shuts off when power window lock switch is ON. This inhibits
    each power window switch operation except the power window main switch.

    N

    RETAINED POWER OPERATION
    • Retained power operation is an additional power supply function that enables power window system to operate for an additional 45 seconds after the ignition switch is turned OFF.

    O

    RETAINED ACCESSORY POWER CANCEL CONDITIONS:
    • Front door CLOSE (door switch OFF)→OPEN (door switch ON).
    • When ignition switch is ON again.
    • When timer expires. (45 seconds)

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-7

    P

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009578818

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    RETAINED PWR

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-8

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    RETAINED PWR : CONSULT Function (BCM — RETAINED PWR)

    INFOID:0000000009578834

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    B

    Description

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-9

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    BCM
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009015829

    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»
    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»

    BCM

    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-10

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    A

    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009015830

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    B

    C

    D

    JMKIA5358ZZ

    E

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    F

    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)

    Description
    Condition

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    +

    Signal name

    Input/
    Output

    1
    (BR)

    Ground

    Rear power window motor LH
    UP signal

    Output

    When the rear LH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pulled UP.

    Battery Voltage

    3
    (G)

    Ground

    Rear power window motor LH
    DOWN signal

    Output

    When the rear LH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pressed DOWN.

    Battery Voltage

    5
    (Y)

    Ground

    Rear power window motor RH
    DOWN signal

    Output

    When the rear RH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pressed DOWN.

    Battery Voltage

    Output

    When the rear RH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pulled UP.

    Battery Voltage

    Output

    When the front LH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pulled UP.

    Battery Voltage

    Ignition switch ON

    Battery Voltage

    Other than above

    0

    7
    (V)

    G

    H

    I

    J

    Ground

    Rear power window motor RH
    UP signal

    8
    (R)

    Ground

    Front power window motor
    (driver side) UP signal

    10
    (L)

    Ground

    Ignition switch power supply

    11
    (LG)

    Ground

    Front power window motor
    (driver side) DOWN
    signal

    Output

    When the front LH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pressed DOWN.

    Battery Voltage

    12
    (SB)

    Ground

    Front power window motor
    (passenger side) DOWN signal

    Output

    When the front RH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pressed DOWN.

    Battery Voltage

    N

    16
    (W)

    Ground

    Front power window motor
    (passenger side) UP signal

    Output

    When the front RH switch
    (power window main switch)
    is pulled UP.

    Battery Voltage

    O

    17
    (B)

    Ground

    Ground

    0

    Revision: April 2013

    Input

    PWC-11

    PWC

    L

    M

    P

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009015832

    AAKWA0622GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-12

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1252GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-13

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1253GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-14

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1254GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-15

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1255GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-16

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1256GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-17

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1257GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-18

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009578841

    B

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    ALKIA1982GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1. OBTAIN INFORMATION ABOUT SYMPTOM
    Interview the customer to obtain as much information as possible about the conditions and environment under
    which the malfunction occurred.
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-19

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> GO TO 2.

    2. CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
    Check the malfunction on the vehicle that the customer describes.
    Inspect the relation of the symptoms and the condition when the symptoms occur.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3. IDENTIFY THE MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM WITH SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    Use Symptom diagnosis from the symptom inspection result in step 2 and then identify where to start performing the diagnosis based on possible causes and symptoms.
    >> GO TO 4.

    4. PERFORM THE COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OF THE OF THE APPLICABLE SYSTEM
    Perform the diagnosis with Component diagnosis of the applicable system.
    >> GO TO 5.

    5. REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
    Repair or replace the specified malfunctioning parts.
    >> GO TO 6.

    6. FINAL CHECK

    Check that malfunctions are not reproduced when obtaining the malfunction information from the customer,
    referring to the symptom inspection result in step 2.
    Are the malfunctions corrected?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-20

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM

    B

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578884

    C

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».
    D

    1.CHECK FUSES AND FUSIBLE LINK
    Check that the following fuses and fusible link are not blown.

    E
    Terminal No.

    Signal name

    57

    Fuses and fusible link No.
    12 (10A)

    Battery power supply

    70

    F

    G (40A)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    G

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    H

    Disconnect BCM connector M99.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M99 and ground.

    I

    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ground

    Voltage

    Battery voltage

    57

    M99

    70

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    PWC

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    L

    Check continuity between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    67

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    O

    POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578867

    P

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH POWER SUPPLY
    Turn ignition switch OFF.

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    1.

    J

    PWC-21

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Disconnect power window main switch connector.
    3. Check voltage between power window main switch harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Power window main switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    D7

    10

    (-)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Ground

    Ignition switch

    ON

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and power window main switch harness connector.
    BCM

    4.

    Power window main switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    68

    D7

    10

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    68

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between power window main switch harness connector and ground.
    Power window main switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    D8

    17

    Ground

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE)
    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) : Diagnosis Procedure
    INFOID:0000000009578868

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front power window switch RH connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front power window switch RH harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-22

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    (-)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Front power window switch RH
    Connector

    Terminal

    D105

    8

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    A

    B

    C

    2.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and front power window switch RH harness connector.

    D

    E
    BCM

    4.

    Front power window switch RH

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    68

    D105

    8

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    G

    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    68

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    H

    I

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578869

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».

    J

    PWC

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    F

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear power window switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between rear power window switch harness connector and ground.

    M

    (+)
    Rear power window switch
    Connector

    (-)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    N

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    O

    Terminal

    LH

    D203

    RH

    D303

    4

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    P

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and rear power window switch harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-23

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM

    4.

    Rear power window switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    68

    Connector

    Terminal

    LH

    D203

    RH

    D303

    Continuity

    4

    Yes

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    68

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-24

    2014 Note

    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE)

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578870

    1. CHECK FUNCTION

    B

    Check front power window motor RH operation with front power window switch RH.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to PWC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578871

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».

    E

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    F

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front power window switch RH connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front power window switch RH harness connector and ground.

    G

    (+)
    Front power window switch RH
    Connector

    (-)

    D

    Condition

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    H

    0

    I

    Terminal
    NEUTRAL

    11
    D105

    Ground
    12

    Power window main
    switch
    (front RH)

    UP

    Battery voltage

    NEUTRAL
    DOWN

    0
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    J

    PWC

    2.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect power window main switch connector.
    Check continuity between power window main switch harness connector and front power window switch
    RH harness connector.
    Power window main switch
    Connector

    Connector

    12

    D7

    4.

    Front power window switch RH

    Terminal

    Terminal

    N
    Yes

    12

    O

    Check continuity between power window main switch harness connector and ground.
    Power window main switch
    Connector
    D7

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    12

    No

    16

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace power window main switch. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-25

    M

    Continuity

    11

    D105

    16

    L

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE)
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH
    Check front power window switch RH.
    Refer to PWC-6, «Power Window Switch».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check Intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace front power window switch RH. Refer to PWC-45, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009578872

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front power window switch RH connector.
    Check front power window switch RH terminals under the following conditions.
    Front power window switch RH

    Condition

    Terminal
    6

    8

    7

    12

    6

    11

    7

    12

    6

    11

    7

    8

    Continuity

    UP

    NEUTRAL

    Yes

    DOWN

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace front power window switch RH. Refer to PWC-45, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-26

    2014 Note

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578873

    1. CHECK FUNCTION

    B

    Check rear power window motor operation with rear power window switch.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to PWC-31, «REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578874

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».

    E

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    F

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear power window switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between rear power window switch harness connector and ground.

    G

    (+)
    Rear power window switch
    Connector

    (-)

    Condition

    NEUTRAL
    Power window main
    switch
    (rear LH)

    D203
    8

    7

    H

    0

    I

    8

    Battery voltage

    NEUTRAL

    0
    Battery voltage

    NEUTRAL
    Power window main
    switch
    (rear RH)

    D303

    DOWN

    UP

    Ground

    RH

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Terminal
    7

    LH

    DOWN
    NEUTRAL
    UP

    Battery voltage

    L

    Power window main switch

    D7

    3
    5

    Connector
    LH

    Terminal
    D203

    RH

    D303

    Continuity

    8
    7
    7

    P
    Yes

    8

    Check continuity between power window main switch harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-27

    N

    O

    Rear power window switch

    Terminal

    7

    4.

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect power window main switch connector.
    Check continuity between power window main switch harness connector and rear power window switch
    harness connector.

    1

    PWC

    0

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH CIRCUIT

    Connector

    J

    0
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.
    1.
    2.
    3.

    D

    2014 Note

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Power window main switch
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal
    1

    Ground

    3

    D7

    No

    5
    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace power window main switch. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH

    Check rear power window switch.
    Refer to PWC-31, «REAR LH : Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace rear power window switch. Refer to PWC-46, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009578875

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear power window switch connector.
    Check rear power window switch terminals under the following conditions.
    Rear power window switch

    Condition

    Terminal
    4

    6

    8

    5

    8

    5

    7

    6

    4

    5

    7

    6

    Continuity

    UP

    NEUTRAL

    Yes

    DOWN

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace rear power window switch. Refer to PWC-46, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-28

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER WINDOW MOTOR

    A

    DRIVER SIDE
    DRIVER SIDE : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578876

    1. CHECK FUNCTION
    Check front power window motor LH operation with power window main switch.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to PWC-31, «REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure».

    B

    C

    D

    DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578877

    E

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».
    F

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR LH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front power window motor LH connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front power window motor LH harness connector and ground.

    G

    H

    (+)
    Front power window motor LH
    Connector

    (-)

    Condition

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Terminal

    I
    NEUTRAL

    1
    D9

    Ground

    Power window main
    switch

    2

    DOWN

    0
    Battery voltage

    NEUTRAL
    UP

    0

    J

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front power window motor LH.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    PWC

    2.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR LH CIRCUIT

    L

    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect power window main switch connector.
    Check continuity between power window main switch harness connector and front power window motor
    LH harness connector.
    Power window main switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    8

    D7

    4.

    Front power window motor LH
    Terminal
    2

    D9

    11

    Continuity

    Yes

    1

    N

    O

    Check continuity between power window main switch harness connector and ground.
    P

    Power window main switch
    Connector
    D7

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    8

    No

    11

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace power window main switch. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-29

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    PASSENGER SIDE

    PASSENGER SIDE : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578878

    1. CHECK FUNCTION
    Check front power window motor RH operation with power window main switch or front power window switch
    RH.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to PWC-30, «PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure».

    PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578879

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR RH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front power window motor RH connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front power window motor RH harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Front power window motor RH
    Connector

    (-)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal
    NEUTRAL

    1
    D104

    Ground

    Front power window
    switch RH

    2

    DOWN

    0
    Battery voltage

    NEUTRAL
    UP

    0
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front power window motor RH.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR RH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front power window switch RH connector.
    Check continuity between front power window switch RH harness connector and front power window
    motor RH harness connector.
    Front power window switch RH
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    6

    D105

    4.

    Front power window motor RH
    Terminal
    1

    D104

    7

    Continuity

    Yes

    2

    Check continuity between front power window switch RH harness connector and ground.
    Front power window switch RH
    Connector
    D105

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    6

    No

    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front power window switch RH. Refer to PWC-45, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-30

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    REAR LH

    A

    REAR LH : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578880

    B

    1.CHECK FUNCTION
    Check rear power window motor LH operation with power window main switch or rear power window switch
    LH.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to PWC-31, «REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure».

    REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    D

    INFOID:0000000009578881

    E

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».
    F

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR LH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear power window motor LH connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between rear power window motor LH harness connector and ground.

    G

    H
    (+)
    Rear power window motor LH
    Connector

    (-)

    Condition

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Terminal
    NEUTRAL

    1
    D204

    Ground

    Rear power window switch LH

    2

    UP

    0
    Battery voltage

    NEUTRAL
    DOWN

    Battery voltage

    PWC

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR LH CIRCUIT

    Connector

    Rear power window motor LH

    Terminal

    Connector

    6

    D203

    4.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear power window switch LH connector.
    Check continuity between rear power window switch LH harness connector and rear power window motor
    LH harness connector.
    Rear power window switch LH

    Terminal
    2

    D204

    5

    J

    0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear power window motor LH.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.
    1.
    2.
    3.

    I

    1

    M

    N
    Continuity

    Yes

    O

    Check continuity between rear power window switch LH connector and ground.
    P

    Rear power window switch LH
    Connector
    D203

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    6

    No

    5

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear power window switch LH. Refer to PWC-46, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-31

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    REAR RH

    REAR RH : Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578882

    1. CHECK FUNCTION
    Check rear power window motor RH operation with power window main switch or rear power window switch
    RH.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to PWC-32, «REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure».

    REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578883

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to PWC-12, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR RH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear power window motor RH connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between rear power window motor RH harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Rear power window motor RH
    Connector

    (-)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal
    NEUTRAL

    1
    D304

    Rear power window
    switch RH

    Ground
    2

    UP

    0
    Battery voltage

    NEUTRAL
    DOWN

    0
    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear power window motor RH.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR RH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear power window switch RH connector.
    Check continuity between rear power window switch RH harness connector and rear power window motor
    RH harness connector.
    Rear power window switch RH
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    6

    D303

    4.

    Rear power window motor RH

    2

    D304

    5

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    1

    Check continuity between rear power window switch RH harness connector and ground.
    Rear power window switch RH
    Connector
    D303

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    6

    No

    5

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace rear power window switch RH. Refer to PWC-46, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-32

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-33

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOWS DO NOT OPERATE WITH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    POWER WINDOWS DO NOT OPERATE WITH POWER WINDOW MAIN
    SWITCH
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578852

    1.CHECK BCM POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check BCM power supply and ground circuit.
    Refer to BCS-61, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check power window main switch power supply and ground circuit.
    Refer to PWC-21, «POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-34

    2014 Note

    DRIVER SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    DRIVER SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009578853

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR (DRIVER SIDE)

    B

    Check front power window motor (driver side).
    Refer to PWC-29, «DRIVER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    C

    2.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    D

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-35

    2014 Note

    FRONT PASSENGER SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT PASSENGER SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH AND FRONT POWER WINDOW
    SWITCH ARE OPERATED
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH AND FRONT POWER WINDOW
    SWITCH ARE OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578854

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE)
    Check front power window switch (passenger side).
    Refer to PWC-22, «FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW MOTOR (PASSENGER SIDE)

    Check front power window motor (passenger side).
    Refer to PWC-30, «PASSENGER SIDE : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».

    WHEN FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) IS OPERATED
    WHEN FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) IS OPERATED :
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578855

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE) POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check front power window switch (passenger side) power supply and ground circuit.
    Refer to PWC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE)

    Check front power window switch (passenger side).
    Refer to PWC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to PWC-44, «Removal and Installation».

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-36

    2014 Note

    FRONT PASSENGER SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure
    INFOID:0000000009578856

    A

    1.CHECK FRONT POWER WINDOW SWITCH (PASSENGER SIDE)
    B

    Check front power window switch (passenger side).
    Refer to PWC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    C

    2.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    D

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-37

    2014 Note

    REAR LH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR LH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH AND REAR POWER WINDOW
    SWITCH LH ARE OPERATED
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH AND REAR POWER WINDOW
    SWITCH LH ARE OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578857

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH
    Check rear power window switch LH.
    Refer to PWC-23, «REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR LH

    Check rear power window motor LH.
    Refer to PWC-31, «REAR LH : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH IS OPERATED
    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure
    INFOID:0000000009578858

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check rear power window switch LH power supply and ground circuit.
    Refer to PWC-23, «REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH

    Check rear power window switch LH.
    Refer to PWC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-38

    2014 Note

    REAR LH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure
    INFOID:0000000009578859

    A

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH LH
    B

    Check rear power window switch LH.
    Refer to PWC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    C

    2.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    D

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-39

    2014 Note

    REAR RH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR RH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH AND REAR POWER WINDOW
    SWITCH RH ARE OPERATED
    WHEN BOTH POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH AND REAR POWER WINDOW
    SWITCH RH ARE OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578860

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH
    Check rear power window switch RH.
    Refer to PWC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW MOTOR RH

    Check rear power window motor RH.
    Refer to PWC-32, «REAR RH : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH IS OPERATED
    WHEN REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure
    INFOID:0000000009578861

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check rear power window switch RH power supply and ground circuit.
    Refer to PWC-23, «REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH

    Check rear power window switch RH.
    Refer to PWC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    3.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED
    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-40

    2014 Note

    REAR RH SIDE POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    WHEN POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH IS OPERATED : Diagnosis Procedure
    INFOID:0000000009578862

    A

    1.CHECK REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH RH
    B

    Check rear power window switch RH.
    Refer to PWC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    C

    2.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    D

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-41

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW RETAINED POWER OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE
    PROPERLY
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER WINDOW RETAINED POWER OPERATION DOES NOT OPERATE PROPERLY
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578863

    1.CHECK FRONT DOOR SWITCH
    Check front door switch.
    Refer to PWC-25, «Component Function Check».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.REPLACE BCM

    • Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-42

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW LOCK SWITCH DOES NOT FUNCTION
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    POWER WINDOW LOCK SWITCH DOES NOT FUNCTION
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009578864

    1.REPLACE POWER WINDOW MAIN SWITCH

    B

    • Replace power window main switch.
    • Confirm the operation after replacement.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-43

    2014 Note

    MAIN POWER WINDOW AND DOOR LOCK/UNLOCK SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    MAIN POWER WINDOW AND DOOR LOCK/UNLOCK SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567637

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove main power window and door lock/unlock switch finisher door handle pull escutcheon.
    Remove screw (A) from main power window and door lock/
    unlock switch finisher.
    Remove main power window and door lock/unlock switch finisher (1) using a suitable tool (B).
    : Pawl

    AWKIA2536ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the harness connectors from the main power window and door lock/unlock switch.
    Release pawls and remove main power window and door lock/
    unlock switch (1) from main power window and door lock/unlock
    switch finisher assembly (2) using a suitable tool.
    : Pawl
    CAUTION:
    Do not bend back the pawls on the switch finisher too far or
    damage may occur.

    AWKIA2506ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    When the main power window and door lock/unlock switch is removed or replaced, it is necessary to perform
    the initialization procedure. Refer to PWC-19, «Work Flow».

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-44

    2014 Note

    POWER WINDOW AND DOOR LOCK/UNLOCK SWITCH RH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    POWER WINDOW AND DOOR LOCK/UNLOCK SWITCH RH
    Removal and Installation

    A
    INFOID:0000000009567638

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH) finisher door handle pull escutcheon.
    Remove screw (B) from power window and door lock/unlock
    switch (RH) finisher.
    Remove power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH) finisher (1) using a suitable tool (A).
    : Pawl

    C

    D

    E

    AWKIA2505ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the harness connector from the power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH).
    Release pawls and remove power window and door lock/unlock
    switch (1) from power window and door lock/unlock switch (RH)
    finisher (2) using a suitable tool.
    : Pawl
    CAUTION:
    Do not bend back the pawls on the switch finisher too far or
    damage may occur.

    F

    G

    H

    I
    AWKIA2507ZZ

    J

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    PWC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-45

    2014 Note

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009567639

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove rear power window switch door handle pull escutcheon.
    Remove screw (A) from rear power window switch finisher.
    Remove rear power window switch finisher (1) using a suitable
    tool (B).
    : Pawl

    AWKIA2510ZZ

    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the harness connector from the rear power window switch.
    Release pawls and remove rear power window switch (1) from
    rear power window switch finisher (2) using a suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not bend back the pawls on the switch finisher too far or
    damage may occur.

    AWKIA2511ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    PWC-46

    2014 Note

    ELECTRICAL & POWER CONTROL

    SECTION

    PWO

    POWER OUTLET

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    POWER SOCKET ………………………………………. 4
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………… 4

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 6

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………. 7

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………… 4

    F

    G

    CONSOLE POWER SOCKET ……………………… 6
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 6

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………………… 7
    Power Socket ………………………………………………….. 7

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PWO

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWO-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009578837

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009642978

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    PWO-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009578838

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-42059)
    Power Socket Removal Tool

    Removing power sockets

    C

    D

    E
    AWMIA1148GB

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PWO

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWO-3

    2014 Note

    POWER SOCKET
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    POWER SOCKET
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009015563

    AAMWA0757GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PWO-4

    2014 Note

    POWER SOCKET
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PWO

    N

    O
    AAMIA1654GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWO-5

    2014 Note

    CONSOLE POWER SOCKET
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    CONSOLE POWER SOCKET
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009578839

    REMOVAL
    NOTE:
    If unable to use the tool because of power socket location or access to the harness connector, then further
    removal of interior components may be required. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    1. Insert one side of Tool (A) into one of the square holes inside the
    power socket.
    Tool number:
    2.
    3.

    (J-42059)

    Lift up the handle of the Tool as shown ( ) until the other side
    snaps into the other square hole in the power socket.
    Pull the power socket straight out with the Tool.

    AWMIA1182GB

    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the harness connector from the power socket.
    Remove the ring from the power socket while pressing the pawls
    with a suitable tool.

    WKIA1035E

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    Make sure to align the tabs with the square notched areas as shown
    ( ) during installation.

    AWMIA1183GB

    Revision: April 2013

    PWO-6

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Power Socket

    INFOID:0000000009578840

    Rated voltage

    DC 12 V

    Maximum electric capacity

    120 W or less (Total)

    Maximum current

    10 A or less (Total)

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    PWO

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    PWO-7

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION & DRIVELINE

    SECTION

    RAX

    REAR AXLE

    A

    B

    C

    RAX

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ……………………. 5

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    REAR WHEEL HUB ……………………………………. 5

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precautions for Wheel Hub ………………………………… 2

    Inspection ……………………………………………………….. 5

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 3
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 3

    F

    G

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 6
    REAR WHEEL HUB ……………………………………. 6
    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 6
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 6
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….. 7
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….. 8

    H

    I

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 4

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 10

    J

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….. 4

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 10

    K

    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………….. 4

    Wheel Bearing …………………………………………………10
    Wheel Hub ………………………………………………………10

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009499770

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precautions for Wheel Hub

    INFOID:0000000009499771

    Observe the following precautions when assembling wheel hub.
    • Perform work in a location that is free from dust, dirt and debris.
    • Use paper shop towels while performing repairs. Fabric shop cloths must not be used because of the danger
    of lint adhering to parts.
    • Do not drop any of the components such as the brake drum, wheel bearing, spindle, or wheel hub lock nut. If
    any of these parts have been dropped, they must be replaced.
    • Always check that the tools used to press-fit the wheel bearing to the brake drum have no wear and deformation. Damaged tools will not guarantee that pressure can be applied vertically and damage parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009499772

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    ST30720000
    (

    )
    Drift

    Installing hub cap
    a: 77 mm (3.03 in) dia.
    b: 55 mm (2.17 in) dia.

    C

    RAX

    E
    ZZA0701D

    KV40104730
    (

    )
    Drift

    F

    Installing wheel bearing
    a: 53.7 mm (2.114 in) dia.
    b: 47 mm (1.85 in) dia.
    c: 15 mm (0.59 in).

    G

    H
    ZZA1133D

    ST33710000
    (

    )
    Drift

    Removing wheel bearing
    a: 30 mm (1.18 in) dia.
    b: 23 mm (0.91 in) dia.

    I

    J
    ZZA1234D

    ST30032000
    (

    )
    Drift

    Installing sensor rotor
    a: 38 mm (1.50 in) dia.
    b: 80 mm (3.15 in) dia.

    K

    L

    M

    ZZA0881D

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009499773

    N
    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    O

    P
    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-3

    2014 Note

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009499774

    RAX-5

    RSU-4

    WT-5

    WT-4

    BR-7

    Wheel bearing damage

    REAR AXLE AND REAR SUSPENSION

    TIRE

    ROAD WHEEL

    BRAKE

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shake

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Vibration

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shimmy

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shudder

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Poor quality ride or handling

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Reference page

    Possible cause and SUSPECTED PARTS

    Symptom


    Parts interference

    Noise

    RAX-6
    Improper installation, looseness

    Use chart below to find the cause of the symptom. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    ×

    ×: Applicable

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-4

    2014 Note

    REAR WHEEL HUB
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    REAR WHEEL HUB
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009499775

    • Check the axle and suspension parts for excessive play, wear, or damage.
    • Shake each rear wheel to check for excessive play as shown.

    B

    C

    RAX

    E

    SMA525A

    REAR WHEEL BEARING INSPECTION

    F

    • Move wheel in the axial direction by hand. Make sure the axial end play is within specification.
    Axial end play

    G

    : Refer to RAX-10, «Wheel Bearing».

    • Check that the wheel bearing operates smoothly.
    • Replace the wheel bearing if the axial end play exceeds specification, or if the wheel bearing does not turn
    smoothly. Refer to RAX-6, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    The wheel bearing does not require maintenance. If any of the following symptoms are noted,
    replace the wheel bearing.
    • Growling noise is emitted from the wheel bearing during operation.
    • Wheel bearing drags or turns roughly.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-5

    2014 Note

    REAR WHEEL HUB
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    REAR WHEEL HUB
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009499776

    AWDIA1107ZZ

    1.

    Rear suspension beam

    2.

    Rear brake components

    3.

    Spindle

    4.

    Sensor rotor

    5.

    Snap ring

    6.

    Wheel bearing

    7.

    Wheel stud

    8.

    Brake drum

    9.

    Wheel hub lock nut

    10. Hub cap

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009499777

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.
    5.

    Remove the wheel and tire using power tool. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove hub cap from brake drum using a suitable tool.
    Remove wheel hub lock nut and brake drum.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not depress brake pedal while rear drum is removed.
    • Do not apply force to the brake drum to avoid damage to the wheel bearing. If the wheel bearing
    inner race is separated due to force, replace the wheel bearing with a new one.
    Remove spindle bolts. Separate back plate and spindle from rear suspension beam.
    CAUTION:
    Do not remove rear brake components. Support the rear brake components using wire.
    If required, remove the wheel studs from brake drum using a suitable press.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not hammer the wheel stud and avoid impact to the brake drum.
    • Press the wheel stud straight out to avoid damage.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-6

    2014 Note

    REAR WHEEL HUB
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    If required, position the wheel stud (1) to the brake drum. Place
    Position the stud (1) to the brake drum. Place a washer (A) on the
    opposite end of the stud and by use of a nut (B), tighten to press the
    stud into the brake drum.
    Wheel stud press-fit load

    A

    B

    : Refer to RAX-10, «Wheel
    Hub».

    CAUTION:
    • Check that no clearance exists between brake drum, and the
    wheel stud after installation.
    • Do not reuse wheel stud.

    C

    JPDIF0300ZZ

    Insert brake drum in a straight line onto the spindle.
    CAUTION:
    • If the brake drum becomes stuck and must be pulled out, do not use tools. Replace the wheel bearing with a new one if the brake drum cannot be pulled out without use of tools.
    • If the brake drum becomes stuck and the wheel bearing inner race is damaged, replace the wheel
    bearing with a new one.
    • Do not damage the wheel bearing seal. If damaged, replace wheel bearing with new one.
    Using the Tool, install hub cap on brake drum as shown.

    RAX

    E

    F

    G

    Tool number

    : ST30720000 (

    )

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse hub cap.
    • Do not reuse wheel hub lock nut.
    • Tighten the wheel hub lock nut to the specified torque. Refer
    to RAX-6, «Exploded View».

    H

    I
    SDIA0766J

    Disassembly and Assembly
    DISASSEMBLY
    1.

    J

    INFOID:0000000009499778

    K

    Remove sensor rotor, using a suitable tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the brake drum.

    L

    M

    N
    JPDIG0097ZZ

    2.

    Remove snap ring (1).

    O

    P

    JPDIG0092ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-7

    2014 Note

    REAR WHEEL HUB
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Remove wheel bearing, using the Tool.
    Tool number

    : ST33710000 (

    )

    JPDIG0079ZZ

    ASSEMBLY
    1.

    Install wheel bearing (1) to brake drum (2), using the Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : KV40104730 (

    )

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse wheel bearing.
    • Do not apply lubricating oil to the press-fit surface of the
    wheel hub bearing.
    • Install wheel bearing with the seal rubber part (B) faced to
    the brake drum side.
    • Set brake drum and wheel bearing horizontally and insert
    JPDIG0200ZZ
    them vertically.
    • The press-fit load must be applied to the wheel bearing
    outer race and the brake drum.
    • Do not apply press-fit load to the wheel bearing inner race, the seal (B) on the rubber surface
    side, and the seal (C) on the metallic surface side. If a press-fit load is applied, the wheel bearing
    must be replaced with a new one.
    Wheel bearing
    press-fit load
    2.

    3.

    : Refer to RAX-10, «Wheel
    Bearing»

    Install snap ring to brake drum.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage the wheel bearing seal.
    • The snap ring must be installed evenly into the groove.
    Install sensor rotor, using the Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : ST30032000 (

    )

    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse sensor rotor.

    JPDIG0191ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009499779

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check the brake drum and spindle for wear, cracks, and damage. Replace if necessary.

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    • Check brake drum for wear, cracks, or any other damage. Replace if necessary.
    • Check snap ring for wear or cracks. Replace if necessary.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.

    Check wheel bearing rotating torque per the following instructions.

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-8

    2014 Note

    REAR WHEEL HUB
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    NOTE:
    The adequacy of turning torque can be judged from a measurement value by a suitable tool.
    a. Check the contact surface of the brake drum and spindle for foreign matter. If there is any foreign matter,
    clean the contact surface.
    b. Check that the wheel hub lock nut is tightened to the specified torque.
    c. Turn the brake drum 10 times or more both clockwise and counterclockwise for proper fit.
    d. Set a suitable tool to the wheel nut and measure turning torque
    at turning speeds of 8 to 12 rpm.
    Wheel bearing rotating torque
    2.

    : Refer to RAX-10, «Wheel Bearing».

    A

    B

    C

    RAX

    Adjust parking brake operation (stroke). Refer to PB-4, «Inspection and Adjustment».

    E

    MDIA0060E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RAX-9

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Wheel Bearing

    INFOID:0000000009499780

    Item

    Standard

    Axial end play

    0.0 mm (0.00 in) or less

    Rotating torque

    1.71 N·m (0.17 kg-m, 15 in-lb) or less

    Spring balance measurement

    34.2 N (3.49 kg, 7.69 lb) or less

    Wheel bearing press-fit load

    44.1 — 53.9 kN (4,498.2 — 5,497.8 kg-f, 9,913.7 — 12,116.7 lb-f)

    Wheel Hub

    INFOID:0000000009499781

    Item
    Wheel stud press-fit load

    Revision: April 2013

    Standard
    26.5 — 32.3 kN (2,703.0 — 3,294.6 kg-f, 5,957.2 — 7,261.0 lb-f)

    RAX-10

    2014 Note

    SUSPENSION

    SECTION

    RSU

    REAR SUSPENSION

    A

    B

    C

    D

    RSU

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 8

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ………………………… 8

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Suspension …………………………………. 2

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 8
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 8
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….. 9
    Disposal ………………………………………………………….10

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    COIL SPRING …………………………………………… 11

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 3

    Exploded View …………………………………………………11
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..11
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….12

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 4

    REAR SUSPENSION BEAM ………………………. 13

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….. 4

    Exploded View …………………………………………………13
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..13
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….14

    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………….. 4

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 5
    REAR SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY ………………… 5

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 15

    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 5

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 15

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT …………………………………… 6

    Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1) ……………………………15
    Wheelarch Height (Unladen*) …………………………….15

    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 6

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009515807

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Suspension

    INFOID:0000000009515808

    • When installing rubber bushings, the final tightening must be carried out under unladen conditions with tires
    on ground. Spilled oil might shorten the life of rubber bushings. Be sure to wipe off any spilled oil.
    — Unladen conditions mean that fuel, engine coolant and lubricant are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools and
    mats are in designated positions.
    • After servicing suspension parts, be sure to check wheel alignment.
    • Self-lock nuts are not reusable. Always use new ones when installing. Since new self-lock nuts are pre-oiled,
    tighten as they are.
    • The tightening surface must be kept free of oil/grease.
    • When jacking up the vehicle with a floor jack, never hang the jack on the suspension beam.

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009515809

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    B

    C

    D

    RSU
    PIIB1407E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-3

    2014 Note

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009515810

    Symptom

    REAR SUSPENSION

    ×

    ×

    Shimmy

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Shudder

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Poor quality ride or handling

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    BR-7

    ×

    BRAKE

    ×

    WT-4

    Vibration

    ROAD WHEEL

    ×

    WT-5

    ×

    TIRE

    ×

    RAX-4

    ×

    REAR AXLE

    Shake

    RSU-6

    ×

    Incorrect wheel alignment

    ×

    RSU-8, RSU-11, RSU-13

    Parts interference

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Suspension looseness

    Bushing or mounting deterioration

    ×

    RSU-12

    Shock absorber deformation, damage or deflection

    Noise

    Possible cause and SUSPECTED PARTS

    Spring fatigue

    Improper installation, looseness

    Reference

    RSU-8

    RSU-8, RSU-11, RSU-13

    Use chart below to find the cause of the symptom. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×: Applicable

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-4

    2014 Note

    REAR SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE

    A

    REAR SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009515811

    B

    Check the mounting conditions (looseness, backlash) of each component. Verify the component conditions
    (wear, damage) are normal.

    C

    COMPONENT PART

    SHOCK ABSORBER
    Check the shock absorber for oil leaks or damage. Replace the components if necessary.

    D

    RSU

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-5

    2014 Note

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009515812

    DESCRIPTION
    Measure the wheel alignment under unladen conditions.
    NOTE:
    “Unladen conditions” means that fuel, engine coolant, and lubricants are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools and
    mats are in designated positions.

    PRELIMINARY
    Check the following:
    1. Tires for improper air pressure and wear.
    2. Road wheels for runout. Refer to WT-4, «Inspection».
    3. Wheel bearing axial end play. Refer to RAX-5, «Inspection».
    4. Shock absorber operation.
    5. Each mounting part of suspension for looseness and deformation.
    6. Rear suspension beam for cracks, deformation, and other damage.
    7. Vehicle height (posture).

    GENERAL INFORMATION AND RECOMMENDATIONS
    1.

    2.

    A Four-Wheel Thrust Alignment should be performed.
    • This type of alignment is recommended for any NISSAN/INFINITI vehicle.
    • The four-wheel “thrust” process helps ensure that the vehicle is properly aligned and the steering wheel
    is centered.
    • The alignment machine itself should be capable of accepting any NISSAN/INFINITI vehicle.
    • The alignment machine should be checked to ensure that it is level.
    Make sure the alignment machine is properly calibrated.
    • Your alignment machine should be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information.
    • Check with the manufacturer of your specific alignment machine for their recommended Service/Calibration Schedule.

    THE ALIGNMENT PROCESS
    IMPORTANT: Use only the alignment specifications listed in this Service Manual. Refer to RSU-15, «Wheel
    Alignment (Unladen*1)».
    1. When displaying the alignment settings, many alignment machines use “indicators”: (Green/red, plus or
    minus, Go/No Go). Do NOT use these indicators.
    • The alignment specifications programmed into your alignment machine that operate these indicators
    may not be correct.
    • This may result in an ERROR.
    2. Most camera-type alignment machines are equipped with both «Rolling Compensation» method and
    optional «Jacking Compensation» method to «compensate» the alignment targets or head units.
    «Rolling Compensation» is the preferred method.
    • If using the «Rolling Compensation» method, after installing the alignment targets or head units, push or
    pull on the rear wheel to move the vehicle. Do not push or pull the vehicle body.
    • If using the «Jacking Compensation» method, after installing the alignment targets or head units, raise
    the vehicle and rotate the wheels 1/2 turn both ways.
    NOTE:
    Do not use the «rolling compensation» if you are using sensor-type alignment equipment.
    • Follow all instructions for the alignment machine you’re using for more information.

    CAMBER INSPECTION
    • Measure camber of both right and left wheels with a suitable alignment gauge.
    Camber

    : Refer to RSU-15, «Wheel Alignment
    (Unladen*1)».

    • If it is out of the specification value, inspect and replace any damaged or worn rear suspension parts.
    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-6

    2014 Note

    WHEEL ALIGNMENT
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    TOTAL TOE-IN INSPECTION
    Measure the total toe-in using following procedure. If it is out of the specification, inspect and replace any
    damaged or worn rear suspension parts.
    WARNING:
    • Always perform the following procedure on a flat surface.
    • Make sure that no person is in front of the vehicle before pushing it.
    1. Bounce the rear of the vehicle up and down to stabilize the vehicle height (posture).
    2. Push the rear wheel to move the vehicle straight ahead about 5 m (16 ft).
    3. Put a mark on the base line of the tread (rear side) of both tires
    at the same height of hub center. These are measuring points.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    RSU

    F
    SEIA0362E

    4.
    5.

    6.

    Measure the distance (A) from the rear side.
    Push the rear wheel to move the vehicle slowly ahead and to
    rotate the wheels 180 degrees (1/2 turn).
    CAUTION:
    If the wheels have rotated more than 180 degrees (1/2 turn),
    try the above procedure again from the beginning. Do not
    push the vehicle backward.
    Measure the distance (B) from the front side.
    Total toe-in

    : Refer to RSU-15, «Wheel Alignment
    (Unladen*1)».

    G

    H

    I

    SFA234AC

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-7

    2014 Note

    REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009515813

    AWEIA0322ZZ

    1.

    Cap

    2.

    Piston rod lock nut

    3.

    Washer

    4.

    Bushing

    5.

    Distance tube

    6.

    Bound bumper cover

    7.

    Bound bumper

    8.

    Shock absorber

    9.

    Rear suspension beam

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009515814

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    Remove the rear shock absorber mask. Refer to INT-31, «Exploded View».
    Remove the cap from the rear shock absorber.
    Remove the piston rod lock nut (1).
    NOTE:
    To loosen the piston rod lock nut, hold the tip (A) of the piston
    rod.
    Remove the washer and the bushing.

    JPEIB0241ZZ

    5.

    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    Set a suitable jack under the rear suspension beam.
    CAUTION:
    • At this step, the jack must be set only for supporting the removal procedure. For details on jacking up the vehicle, refer to GI-28, «Garage Jack and Safety Stand».
    • Do not damage the rear suspension beam with the jack.
    • Make sure the rear suspension beam is stable when using the jack.
    Remove the lower shock absorber bolt.
    Remove the rear shock absorber.
    Remove the bushing, the distance tube, the washer, the bound bumper cover, and the bound bumper
    from the shock absorber.
    Inspect the components. Refer to RSU-9, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-8

    2014 Note

    REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • To install the bushings (1), securely insert the protrusion (A) into
    the hole in the vehicle body.

    A

    B

    C

    D
    JPEIB0240ZZ

    RSU

    • Install the washer (1) in the direction shown.
    : Bushing side

    F

    G

    JPEIB0248ZZ

    • Perform the final tightening of the bolts and nuts under unladen conditions with the tires on level ground.
    • Hold the tip (A) of the piston rod. Tighten the piston rod lock nut (1)
    to the specification.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the piston rod lock nut.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    JPEIB0241ZZ

    • When installing the cap, securely engage the cap groove (A) with
    the flange on the vehicle body.

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JPEIB0244ZZ

    P

    • After replacing the shock absorber, always follow the disposal procedure to discard the old shock absorber.
    Refer to RSU-10, «Disposal».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009515815

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-9

    2014 Note

    REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Shock Absorber
    Check the following items and replace the parts if necessary.
    • Check the shock absorber for oil leaks, deformation, cracks, and other damage.
    • Check the piston rod for damage, uneven wear, and distortion.
    Bound Bumper, Bushing
    Check for cracks and damage. Replace the parts if necessary.
    Washer, Bound Bumper Cover, Distance Tube
    • Check for cracks and damage. Replace the parts if necessary.

    Disposal

    INFOID:0000000009515816

    1.

    Set the shock absorber horizontally with the piston rod fully extended.

    2.

    Drill a 2 – 3 mm (0.08 – 0.12 in) hole at the position ( ) from the
    top as shown to release gas gradually.
    CAUTION:
    • Wear eye protection (safety glasses).
    • Wear gloves.
    • Be careful with metal chips or oil blown out by the compressed gas.
    NOTE:
    • Drill vertically in this direction ( ).
    • Drill directly to the outer tube avoiding brackets.
    • The gas is clear, colorless, odorless, and harmless.
    (A)

    3.

    JPEIA0161ZZ

    : 20 – 30 mm (0.79 – 1.18 in)

    Position the drilled hole downward and drain oil by moving the piston rod several times.
    CAUTION:
    Dispose of drained oil according to the law and local regulations.

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-10

    2014 Note

    COIL SPRING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    COIL SPRING

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009515817

    B

    C

    D

    RSU

    F

    G
    JPEIB0162ZZ

    1.

    Upper rubber seat

    4.

    Rear suspension beam

    2.

    Coil spring

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Lower rubber seat

    H
    INFOID:0000000009515818

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.

    4.

    Set a suitable jack under the rear suspension beam.
    CAUTION:
    • At this step, the jack must be set only for supporting the removal procedure. For details on jacking up the vehicle, refer to GI-28, «Garage Jack and Safety Stand».
    • Do not damage the rear suspension beam with the jack.
    Remove the lower shock absorber bolts. Refer to RSU-8, «Exploded View».
    Slowly lower the suitable jack. Remove the upper rubber seat, the coil spring, and the lower rubber seat
    from the rear suspension beam.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure the rear suspension beam is stable when using the jack.
    Inspect the components. Refer to RSU-12, «Inspection».

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Identify the upper side of the coil spring.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    : Upper side

    NOTE:
    The top of the coil spring has a flat shape.

    O

    P

    JSEIA0430ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-11

    2014 Note

    COIL SPRING
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Install the lower rubber seat (A) to the rear suspension beam
    mounting hole (B).
    • Match up lower rubber seat indentions and rear suspension beam
    grooves and attach.

    JPEIB0223ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009515819

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check the upper rubber seat, the lower rubber seat, and the coil spring for deformation, cracks, and damage.
    Replace the parts if necessary.

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-12

    2014 Note

    REAR SUSPENSION BEAM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR SUSPENSION BEAM

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009592946

    B

    C

    D

    RSU

    F

    G
    AWEIA0323ZZ

    1.

    Rear suspension beam

    H

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009592947

    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes, lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL

    J

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the rear wheels and tires using power tools. Refer to WT-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the brake hoses from the rear suspension beam.
    Remove the spindles and rear drum brake components. Refer to RAX-6, «Exploded View».
    Remove the wheel sensors and position the wheel sensor harnesses aside. Refer to BRC-70, «REAR
    WHEEL SENSOR : Exploded View».
    5. Disconnect the parking brake cables from the rear suspension beam and position the rear drum brake
    back plates aside with wire. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».
    6. Set a suitable jack under the rear suspension beam.
    CAUTION:
    • At this step, the jack must be set only for supporting the removal procedure. For details on jacking up the vehicle, refer to GI-28, «Garage Jack and Safety Stand».
    • Do not damage the rear suspension beam with the jack.
    7. Remove the lower shock absorber bolts. Refer to RSU-8, «Exploded View».
    8. Slowly lower the suitable jack. Remove the upper rubber seats, the coil springs, and the lower rubber
    seats from the rear suspension beam.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure the rear suspension beam is stable when using the jack.
    9. Remove the rear suspension beam bolts.
    10. Slowly lower the suitable jack. Remove the rear suspension beam from the vehicle.
    11. Inspect the components. Refer to RSU-14, «Inspection».

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse the rear suspension beam nuts.
    Revision: April 2013

    I

    RSU-13

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    REAR SUSPENSION BEAM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Perform the final tightening of the rear suspension beam nuts and bolts under unladen conditions with the
    tires on level ground.
    • Adjust the parking brake. Refer to PB-4, «Inspection and Adjustment».
    • Fill the hydraulic brake system. Refer to BR-11, «Refilling».
    • Bleed the hydraulic brake system. Refer to BR-12, «Bleeding Brake System».
    • Complete the inspection. Refer to RSU-14, «Inspection».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009592948

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check the rear suspension beam for deformation, cracks or damage. Replace the parts if necessary.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Check the wheel sensor harness to be sure the connectors are fully seated.
    Check the wheel alignment. Refer to RSU-6, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-14

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Wheel Alignment (Unladen*1)

    Camber
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    INFOID:0000000009515823

    Minimum

    −1° 55′ (−1.92°)

    Nominal

    −1° 25′ (−1.42°)

    Maximum

    −0° 55′ (−0.92°)

    B

    C

    D

    RSU

    F

    SFA234AC

    Distance (A — B)
    Total toe-in
    Angle (LH and RH)*2
    Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    Minimum

    Out 2.0 mm (Out 0.079 in)

    Nominal

    In 2.0 mm (In 0.079 in)

    Maximum

    In 6.0 mm (In 0.236 in)

    Minimum

    Out 0° 45′ (Out 0.75°)

    Nominal

    In 0° 10′ (In 0.17°)

    Maximum

    In 0° 35′ (In 0.58°)

    G

    H

    *1: Fuel, engine coolant, and lubricants are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and mats are in designated positions.
    *2: Since an adjustment mechanism is not included, the value of the left and right wheels must be used as the standard value.

    Wheelarch Height (Unladen*)

    I

    INFOID:0000000009515824

    J
    Unit: mm (in)

    K

    L

    M

    N

    LEIA0085E

    Tire size

    185/65R15

    195/55R16

    Front (Hf)

    690 (27.17)

    687 (27.05)

    Rear (Hr)

    679 (26.73)

    678 (26.69)

    O

    *: Fuel, engine coolant, and lubricants are full. Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and mats are in designated positions.

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    RSU-15

    2014 Note

    RESTRAINTS

    SECTION

    SB

    SEAT BELT

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Seat Belt Service …………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR ………………………………….. 9
    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR : Removal and Installation ………………………………………………………………. 9
    SEAT BELT HEIGHT ADJUSTER ………………………..10
    SEAT BELT HEIGHT ADJUSTER : Removal and
    Installation ………………………………………………………10

    REAR SEAT BELT …………………………………….. 12

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4

    Exploded View …………………………………………………12

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4

    REAR SEAT BELT BUCKLE ………………………………12
    REAR SEAT BELT BUCKLE : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………12

    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 4

    BASIC INSPECTION ……………………………… 5
    COMPONENT INSPECTION …………………………. 5
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 5

    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR ………………………………….13
    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR : Removal and Installation ………………………………………………………………13

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 8

    LATCH (LOWER ANCHORS AND TETHER
    FOR CHILDREN) SYSTEM …………………………. 15

    FRONT SEAT BELT …………………………………….. 8

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..15

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 8

    F

    G

    SB

    I

    J

    K

    L

    TOP TETHER STRAP CHILD RESTRAINT ….. 16

    FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE ……………………………… 8
    FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE : Removal and Installation ………………………………………………………….. 8

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..16

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009561083

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Seat Belt Service

    INFOID:0000000009561084

    CAUTION:
    • Before removing the seat belt pre-tensioner assembly, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect both
    battery terminals and wait at least three minutes. For approximately three minutes after the battery
    terminals have been removed, it is still possible for the air bag and seat belt pre-tensioner to deploy.
    Therefore, do not attempt work on any SRS connectors or wires until at least three minutes have
    passed.
    • After replacing or reinstalling seat belt pre-tensioner assembly or reconnecting seat belt pre-tensioner assembly connector, make sure entire SRS operates properly. Refer to SRC-9, «Description».
    • Do not disassemble buckle or seat belt assembly.
    • Replace anchor bolts if they are deformed or worn out.
    • Do not oil tongue or buckle.
    • If any component of seat belt assembly is questionable, do not repair. Replace the whole seat belt
    assembly.
    • If webbing is cut, frayed or damaged, replace seat belt assembly.
    • When replacing seat belt assembly, use a genuine NISSAN seat belt assembly.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009561085

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    Revision: April 2013

    S B -2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SB

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009561086

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-4

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    COMPONENT INSPECTION
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009561087

    B

    WARNING:
    Inspect all seat belt assemblies including retractors and attaching hardware after any collision.
    NISSAN/INFINITI recommends that all seat belt assemblies in use during a collision be replaced
    unless the collision was minor and the belts show no damage and continue to operate properly. Failure to do so could result in serious personal injury in an accident. Seat belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted. Seat belt pretensioners should be replaced even if the seat belts are not in use during a frontal collision in which
    the air bags are deployed.
    Replace any seat belt assembly (including anchor bolts) if:
    • The seat belt was in use at the time of a collision (except for minor collisions and the belts, retractors and
    buckles show no damage and continue to operate properly).
    • The seat belt was damaged in an accident (i.e. torn webbing, bent retractor or guide, etc.).
    • The seat belt attaching point is damaged in an accident. Inspect the seat belt attaching area for damage or
    distortion and repair if necessary before installing a new seat belt assembly.
    • Anchor bolts are deformed or worn out.
    • The seat belt pre-tensioner should be replaced even if the seat belts are not in use during the collision in
    which the air bags are deployed.

    C

    AFTER A COLLISION

    3.
    4.
    5.
    a.
    b.
    c.
    d.

    6.

    Check the seat belt warning lamp for proper operation per the following:
    Turn ignition switch ON. The seat belt warning lamp should illuminate.
    Fasten driver seat belt. The seat belt warning lamp should turn OFF.
    If the air bag warning lamp is blinking, perform self-diagnosis with CONSULT and air bag warning lamp.
    Refer to SRC-9, «Description».
    Check that the seat belt retractor, seat belt anchor and buckle bolts are tightened firmly.
    Check the shoulder seat belt guide and shoulder belt height adjuster for front seats. Check that guide
    swivels freely and that webbing lays flat and does not bind in guide. Check that height adjuster operates
    properly and holds securely.
    Check retractor operation:
    Fully extend the seat belt webbing and check for twists, tears or other damage.
    Allow the seat belt to retract. Check that webbing returns smoothly and completely into the retractor. If the
    seat belt does not return smoothly, wipe the inside of the loops with a clean paper cloth. Dirt build-up in the
    loops of the upper anchors can cause the seat belts to retract slowly.
    Fasten the seat belt. Check that seat belt returns smoothly and completely to the retractor. If the webbing
    does not return smoothly, the cause may be an accumulation of dust or dirt. Use the “SEAT BELT TAPE
    SET” and perform the following steps.
    Inspect the front seat belt D-ring anchor
    1. Pull the seat belt out to a length of 500 mm (19.69 in) or more.
    2. Hold the seat belt at the center pillar webbing opening with a clip or other device.
    3. Pass a thin wire through the D-ring anchor webbing opening. Hold both ends of the wire and pull it
    tightly while moving it up and down several times along the webbing opening surface to remove dirt
    stuck there.
    4. Any dirt that cannot be removed with the wire can be removed by cleaning the opening with a clean
    cloth.
    5. Apply tape at the point where the webbing contacts the D-ring anchor webbing opening.
    NOTE:
    Apply the tape so that there is no slack or wrinkling.
    6. Remove the clip holding the seat belt and check that the webbing returns smoothly.
    Repeat steps above if necessary to check the other seat belts.

    Revision: April 2013

    E

    F

    G

    SB

    PRELIMINARY CHECKS
    1.
    a.
    b.
    2.

    D

    SB-5

    2014 Note

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    COMPONENT INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR ON-VEHICLE CHECK
    Emergency Locking Retractors (ELR) and Automatic Locking Retractors (ALR)
    NOTE:
    All seat belt retractors are Emergency Locking Retractors (ELR) type. In an emergency (sudden stop) the
    retractor will lock and prevent the webbing from extending any further. All 3-point type seat belt retractors
    except the driver seat belt also have an Automatic Locking Retractors (ALR) mode. The ALR mode (also
    called child restraint mode) is used when installing child seats. The ALR mode is activated when the seat belt
    is fully extended. When the webbing is then retracted partially, the ALR mode automatically locks the seat belt
    in a specific position so the webbing cannot be extended any further. To cancel the ALR mode, allow the seat
    belt to fully wind back into the retractor.
    Check the seat belt retractors with the following test(s) to determine if a retractor assembly is operating properly.
    ELR Function Stationary Check
    Grasp the shoulder webbing and pull forward quickly. The retractor should lock and prevent the belt from
    extending further.
    ALR Function Stationary Check

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Pull out the entire length of seat belt from retractor until a click is heard.
    Retract the webbing partially. A clicking noise should be heard as the webbing retracts, indicating that the
    retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractors (ALR) mode.
    Grasp the seat belt and try to pull out the retractor. The webbing must lock and not extend any further. If it
    does not operate normally, replace the retractor assembly.
    Allow the entire length of the webbing to retract to cancel the automatic locking mode.

    ELR Function Moving Check

    WARNING:
    Perform the following test in a safe, open area clear of other vehicles and obstructions (for example, a
    large, empty parking lot). Road surface must be paved and dry. Never perform the following test on
    wet or gravel roads or on public streets and highways. This could result in an accident and serious
    personal injury. The driver and passenger must be prepared to brace themselves in the event that the
    retractor does not lock.
    1. Fasten driver seat belt. Buckle a passenger into the seat for the belt that is to be tested.
    2. Proceed to the designated safe area.
    3. Drive the vehicle at approximately 16 km/h (10 mph). Notify any passengers of a pending sudden stop
    and the driver and passenger must be prepared to brace themselves in the event that the retractor does
    not lock. Apply brakes firmly and make a very hard stop.
    During stopping, seat belts should lock and not be extended. If the seat belt retractor assembly does not lock,
    perform the retractor off-vehicle check.

    FRONT SEAT BELT RETRACTOR OFF-VEHICLE CHECK
    1.
    2.

    Remove the front seat belt retractor. Refer to SB-9, «SEAT BELT RETRACTOR : Removal and Installation».
    Slowly pull out webbing while tilting the seat belt retractor forward from the mounted position without twisting the seat belt retractor as shown.
    A : The webbing can be pulled out if the retractor is tilted 17°
    degree or less.
    B : The webbing can not be pulled out if the retractor is tilted 27°
    degrees or more.
    NOTE:
    A and B show tilting angles.
    : Front

    JMHIA1056ZZ

    3.

    Replace the seat belt retractor if it does not operate within specifications.

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT INSPECTION
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    REAR SEAT BELT RETRACTOR OFF-VEHICLE CHECK
    1. Remove the rear seat belt retractor. Refer to SB-13, «SEAT BELT RETRACTOR : Removal and Installation».
    2. Slowly pull out webbing while tilting the seat belt retractor forward from the mounted position without twisting the seat belt retractor as shown.
    A : The webbing can be pulled out if the retractor is tilted 17°
    degree or less.
    B : The webbing can not be pulled out if the retractor is tilted 27°
    degrees or more.
    NOTE:
    A and B show tilting angles.
    : Front

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E
    JMHIA1056ZZ

    3.

    Replace the seat belt retractor if it does not operate within specifications.

    F

    G

    SB

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-7

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT BELT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    FRONT SEAT BELT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009561088

    AWHIA0542ZZ

    1.

    Seat belt height adjuster (LH/RH) 2.

    Seat belt height adjuster finisher (LH/RH)

    3. Seat belt retractor (RH)

    4.

    Seat belt buckle (RH)

    Seat belt buckle (LH)

    6. Seat belt retractor (LH)

    5.

    FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE
    FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009654081

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove front seat. Refer to SE-14, «DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation» (Driver Side) or SE-16,
    «PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation» (Passenger Side).
    Unclip seat belt buckle harness from the seat frame (driver side only).

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-8

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT BELT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Remove seat belt buckle anchor bolt and the seat belt buckle.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the seat belt buckle anchor bolt, note the positions of washers and spacers for
    correct installation.

    A

    INSTALLATION

    B

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Tighten the seat belt buckle anchor bolt to specification. Refer to SB-8, «Exploded View».
    • Always perform an inspection after repair to make sure the system is functioning within specifications. Refer
    to SB-5, «Inspection».

    C

    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR

    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009561090

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn the ignition switch off, disconnect both battery terminals then wait at
    least three minutes.
    • Do not drop the seat belt retractor. Always handle it with care.
    • Always point pretensioner cylinder away from body when handling.

    D

    E

    F

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    G
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Slide front seat to the full forward position.
    Remove center pillar lower finisher. Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    SB
    and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector (A) from the seat belt retractor (1).
    I

    J

    K
    ALHIA0316ZZ

    L

    CAUTION:
    • For removing/installing the shoulder belt pre-tensioner
    harness connector, insert a thin screwdriver wrapped in
    tape into the notch, then lift the lock and remove the harness connector as shown.
    • Install the harness connector with the lock raised, and
    push the lock into the harness connector as shown.
    • After installing the harness connector, check that the lock
    is pushed in securely.

    M

    N

    O
    PHIA0953J

    5.

    Remove seat belt lower anchor bolt.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the seat belt lower anchor bolt, note the positions of washers and spacers for
    correct installation.

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-9

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT SEAT BELT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Release pawls, using a suitable tool and remove the seat belt
    height adjuster finisher (1).
    : Pawl

    AWHIA0539ZZ

    7.

    8.

    Remove D-ring anchor bolt.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the D-ring anchor bolt, note the positions of washers and spacers for correct
    installation.
    Remove bolts (A) and the seat belt retractor (1).

    ALHIA0317ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Make sure the seat belt height adjuster is locked in the lowest position during installation.
    • Install the seat belt retractor upper bolt first.
    • Tighten the D-ring anchor bolt, seat belt lower anchor bolt, and the seat belt retractor bolts to specification.
    Refer to SB-8, «Exploded View».
    • Make sure both the D-ring anchors and seat belt height adjuster operate freely.
    • Always perform an inspection after repair to make sure the system is functioning within specifications. Refer
    to SB-5, «Inspection».

    SEAT BELT HEIGHT ADJUSTER

    SEAT BELT HEIGHT ADJUSTER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009561091

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Slide front seat to the full forward position.
    Release pawls, using a suitable tool and remove the seat belt
    height adjuster finisher (1).
    : Pawl

    AWHIA0539ZZ

    3.

    Remove D-ring anchor bolt.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-10

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT BELT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Before removing the D-ring anchor bolt, note the positions of washers and spacers for correct
    installation.
    4. Remove center pillar upper finisher. Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR UPPER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation».
    5. Remove seat belt height adjuster bolts and the seat belt height adjuster.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the seat belt height adjuster bolts, note the positions of washers and spacers for
    correct installation.

    A

    B

    C

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Make sure that the seat belt height adjuster is locked in the lowest position during installation.
    • Make sure both the D-ring anchor and seat belt height adjuster operate freely.
    • Tighten the D-ring anchor bolt and seat belt height adjuster bolts to specification. Refer to SB-8, «Exploded
    View».
    • Always perform an inspection after repair to make sure the system is functioning within specifications. Refer
    to SB-5, «Inspection».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SB

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-11

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT BELT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR SEAT BELT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009561092

    ALHIA0314ZZ

    1.

    Seat belt retractor (RH)

    2.

    Seat belt buckle (RH/center)

    3.

    Seat belt buckle (LH)

    4.

    Seat belt retractor (LH)

    5.

    Seat belt retractor (center)

    6.

    Seat belt guide finisher

    7.

    Seat belt guide

    REAR SEAT BELT BUCKLE
    REAR SEAT BELT BUCKLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009561093

    REMOVAL — Seat Belt Buckle (LH)
    1.

    Remove rear seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-12

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT BELT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Release seat belt retractor (center) (1) from seat belt buckle
    (LH) (2) using a suitable tool (A) as shown.

    A

    B

    C
    ALHIA0315ZZ

    3.

    Remove seat belt buckle anchor bolt and seat belt buckle (LH).
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the seat belt buckle anchor bolt, note the positions of washers and spacers for
    correct installation.

    D

    E

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Tighten the seat belt buckle anchor bolt to specification. Refer to SB-12, «Exploded View».
    • Always perform an inspection after repair to make sure the system is functioning within specifications. Refer
    to SB-5, «Inspection».

    REMOVAL — Seat Belt Buckle (RH)
    1.
    2.

    F

    G

    Remove rear seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation».
    SB
    Remove seat belt buckle anchor bolt and seat belt buckle (RH).
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the seat belt buckle anchor bolt, note the positions of washers and spacers for
    correct installation.
    I

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Tighten the seat belt buckle anchor bolt to specification. Refer to SB-12, «Exploded View».
    • Always perform an inspection after repair to make sure the system is functioning within specifications. Refer
    to SB-5, «Inspection».

    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR

    K

    SEAT BELT RETRACTOR : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009561095

    L

    REMOVAL — Seat Belt Retractor (LH/RH)
    1.

    J

    Remove luggage side upper finisher (LH/RH). Refer to INT-33, «LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-13

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT BELT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. For seat belt retractor (LH) (1).
    a. Remove D-ring anchor bolt (A).
    : Front
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the D-ring anchor bolt, note the positions
    of washers and spacers for correct installation.
    b. Remove bolts (B) and the seat belt retractor (LH) (1).
    (2): Seat belt retractor (center)
    3. For seat belt retractor (RH) (3).
    : Front
    a. Remove D-ring anchor bolt (C).
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the D-ring anchor bolt, note the positions
    of washers and spacers for correct installation.
    b. Remove bolts (D) and seat belt retractor (RH) (3).

    ALHIA0318ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Install the seat belt retractor upper bolt first.
    • Tighten the D-ring anchor bolt and the seat belt retractor bolts to specification. Refer to SB-12, «Exploded
    View».
    • Make sure the D-ring anchor operates freely.
    • Always perform an inspection after repair to make sure the system is functioning within specifications. Refer
    to SB-5, «Inspection».

    REMOVAL — Seat Belt Retractor (center)
    1.
    2.

    3.

    Remove luggage side upper finisher (LH). Refer to INT-33, «LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Remove D-ring anchor bolt (A).
    : Front
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the D-ring anchor bolt, note the positions
    of washers and spacers for correct installation.
    Remove bolts (B) and seat belt retractor (center) (1).
    (2): Seat belt retractor (LH)

    ALHIA0313ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Install the center seat belt retractor upper bolt first.
    • Tighten the D-ring anchor bolt and the seat belt retractor bolts to specification. Refer to SB-12, «Exploded
    View».
    • Make sure the D-ring anchor operates freely.
    • Always perform an inspection after repair to make sure the system is functioning within specifications. Refer
    to SB-5, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-14

    2014 Note

    LATCH (LOWER ANCHORS AND TETHER FOR CHILDREN) SYSTEM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    LATCH (LOWER ANCHORS AND TETHER FOR CHILDREN) SYSTEM
    Removal and Installation

    A

    INFOID:0000000009561096

    The LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tether for Children) system is not serviceable.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SB

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-15

    2014 Note

    TOP TETHER STRAP CHILD RESTRAINT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    TOP TETHER STRAP CHILD RESTRAINT
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009561097

    The Top Tether Strap Child Restraint system is not serviceable.

    Revision: April 2013

    SB-16

    2014 Note

    BODY INTERIOR

    SECTION

    SE

    SEAT

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3

    REAR SEAT ……………………………………………… 18
    Exploded View …………………………………………………18
    SEAT CUSHION ………………………………………………..19
    SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation ………..19
    SEATBACK ……………………………………………………….19
    SEATBACK : Removal and Installation ……………….19

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3

    SEATBACK HINGE ……………………………………………20
    SEATBACK HINGE : Removal and Installation …….20

    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 3
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 3

    SEATBACK STRIKER ………………………………………..20
    SEATBACK STRIKER : Removal and Installation….20

    CLIP LIST …………………………………………………… 4

    SEAT CUSHION HOOK ………………………………………21
    SEAT CUSHION HOOK : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………………21

    Descriptions for Clips ………………………………………… 4

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 8
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES ………………………………………………………. 8
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….. 8
    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting ………… 9
    Diagnostic Worksheet ……………………………………… 12

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 14
    FRONT SEAT ……………………………………………..14
    DRIVER SIDE …………………………………………………… 14
    DRIVER SIDE : Exploded View ………………………… 14
    DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation …………… 14
    PASSENGER SIDE …………………………………………… 15
    PASSENGER SIDE : Exploded View …………………. 16
    PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation …… 16

    Revision: April 2013

    F

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY … 22
    FRONT SEAT ……………………………………………. 22
    DRIVER SIDE …………………………………………………….22
    DRIVER SIDE : Exploded View ………………………….22
    DRIVER SIDE : Seatback ………………………………….22
    DRIVER SIDE : Seat Cushion ……………………………24
    PASSENGER SIDE …………………………………………….26
    PASSENGER SIDE : Exploded View ………………….27
    PASSENGER SIDE : Seatback ………………………….27
    PASSENGER SIDE : Seat Cushion ……………………29

    G

    H

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    REAR SEAT ……………………………………………… 31

    O

    Exploded View …………………………………………………31
    Seat Cushion …………………………………………………..32
    Seatback …………………………………………………………33

    P

    SE-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009643071

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009643073

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009643068

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-39570)
    Chassis Ear

    Locating the noise

    C

    D

    E
    SIIA0993E


    (J-50397)
    NISSAN Squeak and Rattle
    Kit

    F

    Repairing the cause of noise

    G

    H
    ALJIA1232ZZ


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    I

    SE
    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009643069

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    (J-39565)
    Engine Ear

    Locating the noise

    K

    L

    M

    N
    SIIA0995E

    ( — )
    Hook and Pick Tool

    O

    Removes snap rings

    P

    JMJIA0490ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-3

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    CLIP LIST
    Descriptions for Clips

    INFOID:0000000009643070

    Replace any clips which are damaged during removal or installation.

    SIIA0315E

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-4

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    SIIA0316E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-5

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >

    SIIA0317E

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-6

    2014 Note

    CLIP LIST
    < PREPARATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    ALJIA0564GB

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-7

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009671302

    SBT842

    CUSTOMER INTERVIEW
    Interview the customer if possible, to determine the conditions that exist when the noise occurs. Use the Diagnostic Worksheet during the interview to document the facts and conditions when the noise occurs and any
    customer’s comments; refer to SE-12, «Diagnostic Worksheet». This information is necessary to duplicate the
    conditions that exist when the noise occurs.
    • The customer may not be able to provide a detailed description or the location of the noise. Attempt to obtain
    all the facts and conditions that exist when the noise occurs (or does not occur).
    • If there is more than one noise in the vehicle, be sure to diagnose and repair the noise that the customer is
    concerned about. This can be accomplished by test driving the vehicle with the customer.
    • After identifying the type of noise, isolate the noise in terms of its characteristics. The noise characteristics
    are provided so the customer, service adviser and technician are all speaking the same language when
    defining the noise.
    • Squeak —(Like tennis shoes on a clean floor)
    Squeak characteristics include the light contact/fast movement/brought on by road conditions/hard surfaces
    = higher pitch noise/softer surfaces = lower pitch noises/edge to surface = chirping.
    • Creak—(Like walking on an old wooden floor)
    Creak characteristics include firm contact/slow movement/twisting with a rotational movement/pitch dependent on materials/often brought on by activity.
    • Rattle—(Like shaking a baby rattle)
    Rattle characteristics include the fast repeated contact/vibration or similar movement/loose parts/missing
    clip or fastener/incorrect clearance.
    • Knock —(Like a knock on a door)
    Knock characteristics include hollow sounding/sometimes repeating/often brought on by driver action.
    • Tick—(Like a clock second hand)
    Tick characteristics include gentle contacting of light materials/loose components/can be caused by driver
    action or road conditions.
    • Thump—(Heavy, muffled knock noise)
    Thump characteristics include softer knock/dead sound often brought on by activity.
    • Buzz—(Like a bumble bee)
    Buzz characteristics include high frequency rattle/firm contact.
    • Often the degree of acceptable noise level will vary depending upon the person. A noise that you may judge
    as acceptable may be very irritating to the customer.
    • Weather conditions, especially humidity and temperature, may have a great effect on noise level.

    DUPLICATE THE NOISE AND TEST DRIVE

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-8

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    If possible, drive the vehicle with the customer until the noise is duplicated. Note any additional information on
    the Diagnostic Worksheet regarding the conditions or location of the noise. This information can be used to
    duplicate the same conditions when you confirm the repair.
    If the noise can be duplicated easily during the test drive, to help identify the source of the noise, try to duplicate the noise with the vehicle stopped by doing one or all of the following:
    1) Close a door.
    2) Tap or push/pull around the area where the noise appears to be coming from.
    3) Rev the engine.
    4) Use a floor jack to recreate vehicle “twist”.
    5) At idle, apply engine load (electrical load, half-clutch on M/T model, drive position on CVT and A/T models).
    6) Raise the vehicle on a hoist and hit a tire with a rubber hammer.
    • Drive the vehicle and attempt to duplicate the conditions the customer states exist when the noise occurs.
    • If it is difficult to duplicate the noise, drive the vehicle slowly on an undulating or rough road to stress the
    vehicle body.

    CHECK RELATED SERVICE BULLETINS
    After verifying the customer concern or symptom, check ASIST for Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) related
    to that concern or symptom.
    If a TSB relates to the symptom, follow the procedure to repair the noise.

    LOCATE THE NOISE AND IDENTIFY THE ROOT CAUSE
    1.
    2.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    Narrow down the noise to a general area. To help pinpoint the source of the noise, use a listening tool
    (Chassis Ear: J-39570, Engine Ear: J-39565 and mechanic’s stethoscope).
    G
    Narrow down the noise to a more specific area and identify the cause of the noise by:
    • removing the components in the area that you suspect the noise is coming from.
    Do not use too much force when removing clips and fasteners, otherwise clips and fasteners can be H
    broken or lost during the repair, resulting in the creation of new noise.
    • tapping or pushing/pulling the component that you suspect is causing the noise.
    Do not tap or push/pull the component with excessive force, otherwise the noise will be eliminated only
    I
    temporarily.
    • feeling for a vibration with your hand by touching the component(s) that you suspect is (are) causing the
    noise.
    • placing a piece of paper between components that you suspect are causing the noise.
    SE
    • looking for loose components and contact marks.
    Refer to SE-9, «Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting».

    REPAIR THE CAUSE


    If the cause is a loose component, tighten the component securely.
    If the cause is insufficient clearance between components:
    separate components by repositioning or loosening and retightening the component, if possible.
    insulate components with a suitable insulator such as urethane pads, foam blocks, felt cloth tape or urethane
    tape. A NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) is available through your authorized NISSAN Parts Department.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use excessive force as many components are constructed of plastic and may be damaged.
    NOTE:
    • Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.
    • The materials contained in the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) are listed on the inside cover of the
    kit; and can each be ordered separately as needed.
    • The following materials not found in the kit can also be used to repair squeaks and rattles.
    — SILICONE GREASE: Use instead of UHMW tape that will be visible or does not fit. The silicone grease will
    only last a few months.
    — SILICONE SPRAY: Use when grease cannot be applied.
    — DUCT TAPE: Use to eliminate movement.

    CONFIRM THE REPAIR
    Confirm that the cause of a noise is repaired by test driving the vehicle. Operate the vehicle under the same
    conditions as when the noise originally occurred. Refer to the notes on the Diagnostic Worksheet.

    Generic Squeak and Rattle Troubleshooting

    INFOID:0000000009671303

    Refer to Table of Contents for specific component removal and installation information.
    Revision: April 2013

    SE-9

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    INSTRUMENT PANEL
    Most incidents are caused by contact and movement between:
    1. Cluster lid A and the instrument panel
    2. Acrylic lens and combination meter housing
    3. Instrument panel to front pillar finisher
    4. Instrument panel to windshield
    5. Instrument panel pins
    6. Wiring harnesses behind the combination meter
    7. A/C defroster duct and duct joint
    These incidents can usually be located by tapping or moving the components to duplicate the noise or by
    pressing on the components while driving to stop the noise. Most of these incidents can be repaired by applying felt cloth tape or silicone spray (in hard to reach areas). Urethane pads can be used to insulate wiring harness.
    CAUTION:
    Do not use silicone spray to isolate a squeak or rattle. If you saturate the area with silicone, you will
    not be able to recheck the repair.

    CENTER CONSOLE
    Components to pay attention to include:
    1. Shift selector assembly cover to finisher
    2. A/C control unit and cluster lid C
    3. Wiring harnesses behind audio and A/C control unit
    The instrument panel repair and isolation procedures also apply to the center console.

    DOORS
    Pay attention to the:
    1. Finisher and inner panel making a slapping noise
    2. Inside handle escutcheon to door finisher
    3. Wiring harnesses tapping
    4. Door striker out of alignment causing a popping noise on starts and stops
    Tapping or moving the components or pressing on them while driving to duplicate the conditions can isolate
    many of these incidents. You can usually insulate the areas with felt cloth tape or insulator foam blocks from
    the NISSAN Squeak and Rattle Kit (J-50397) to repair the noise.

    TRUNK
    Trunk noises are often caused by a loose jack or loose items put into the trunk by the owner.
    In addition look for:
    1. Trunk lid bumpers out of adjustment
    2. Trunk lid striker out of adjustment
    3. The trunk lid torsion bars knocking together
    4. A loose license plate or bracket
    Most of these incidents can be repaired by adjusting, securing or insulating the item(s) or component(s) causing the noise.

    SUNROOF/HEADLINING
    Noises in the sunroof/headlining area can often be traced to one of the following:
    1. Sunroof lid, rail, linkage or seals making a rattle or light knocking noise
    2. Sun visor shaft shaking in the holder
    3. Front or rear windshield touching headlining and squeaking
    Again, pressing on the components to stop the noise while duplicating the conditions can isolate most of these
    incidents. Repairs usually consist of insulating with felt cloth tape.

    OVERHEAD CONSOLE (FRONT AND REAR)
    Overhead console noises are often caused by the console panel clips not being engaged correctly. Most of
    these incidents are repaired by pushing up on the console at the clip locations until the clips engage.
    In addition look for:
    Revision: April 2013

    SE-10

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Loose harness or harness connectors.
    2. Front console map/reading lamp lens loose.
    3. Loose screws at console attachment points.

    A

    SEATS
    When isolating seat noise it’s important to note the position the seat is in and the load placed on the seat when
    the noise is present. These conditions should be duplicated when verifying and isolating the cause of the
    noise.
    Cause of seat noise include:
    1. Headrest rods and holder
    2. A squeak between the seat pad cushion and frame
    3. The rear seatback lock and bracket
    These noises can be isolated by moving or pressing on the suspected components while duplicating the conditions under which the noise occurs. Most of these incidents can be repaired by repositioning the component
    or applying urethane tape to the contact area.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    UNDERHOOD
    Some interior noise may be caused by components under the hood or on the engine wall. The noise is then F
    transmitted into the passenger compartment.
    Causes of transmitted underhood noise include:
    1. Any component installed to the engine wall
    G
    2. Components that pass through the engine wall
    3. Engine wall mounts and connectors
    4. Loose radiator installation pins
    H
    5. Hood bumpers out of adjustment
    6. Hood striker out of adjustment
    I
    These noises can be difficult to isolate since they cannot be reached from the interior of the vehicle. The best
    method is to secure, move or insulate one component at a time and test drive the vehicle. Also, engine rpm or
    load can be changed to isolate the noise. Repairs can usually be made by moving, adjusting, securing, or
    insulating the component causing the noise.
    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-11

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnostic Worksheet

    INFOID:0000000009671304

    LAIA0072E

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-12

    2014 Note

    SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAGNOSES
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    LAIA0071E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-13

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    FRONT SEAT
    DRIVER SIDE
    DRIVER SIDE : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009643055

    AWJIA1116ZZ

    1.

    Armrest

    2.

    Seatback trim

    3.

    Seatback pad

    4.

    Seat cushion trim

    5.

    Seat cushion pad

    6.

    Seat cushion frame

    7.

    Seat belt buckle

    8.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (RH)

    9.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (LH)

    10. Lift lever

    11. Lift lever finisher

    12. Recline lever

    13. Slide finisher rear (LH/RH)

    14. Headrest holder (locked)

    15. Headrest holder (free)

    16. Seat frame

    17. Headrest

    DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009643056

    CAUTION:
    Revision: April 2013

    SE-14

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    When removing and installing the seat, use shop cloths to protect components from damage.
    A

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Slide the seat to the full forward position.
    Remove the seat rear bolts.
    Slide the seat to the full rearward position.
    Remove the seat front bolts.
    Tilt the seat rearward and disconnect the harness connector from the seat and remove.

    B

    C

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure that the seat harness or the floor trim is not damaged during installation.
    When installing the driver side front seat, tighten the bolts in the
    order shown.
    Driver side front seat bolt
    torque

    D

    E

    : 40 Nm (4.1 kg-m, 30 ft-lb)
    F

    G
    AWJIA0920ZZ

    H

    PASSENGER SIDE

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-15

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PASSENGER SIDE : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009643057

    AWJIA1117ZZ

    1.

    Headrest

    2.

    Headrest holder (locked)

    3.

    Headrest holder (free)

    4.

    Slide finisher rear (LH/RH)

    5.

    Recline lever

    6.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (RH)

    7.

    Seat frame

    8.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (LH)

    9.

    Seat belt buckle

    10. Seat cushion pad

    11. Seat cushion trim

    12. Seatback pad

    13. Seatback trim

    PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009643058

    CAUTION:
    When removing and installing the seat, use shop cloths to protect components from damage.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Slide the seat to the full forward position.
    Remove the seat rear bolts.
    Slide the seat to the full rearward position.

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-16

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4. Remove the seat front bolts.
    A

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure that the floor trim is not damaged during installation.
    When installing the passenger side front seat, tighten the bolts in the
    order shown.
    Passenger side front seat
    bolt torque

    B

    C

    : 40 Nm (4.1 kg-m, 30 ft-lb)

    D

    E
    AWJIA0921ZZ

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-17

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR SEAT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009643061

    AWJIA1138ZZ

    1.

    Seatback hinge trim

    2.

    Seatback hinge

    3.

    Seatback striker

    4.

    Headrest

    5.

    Seatback (RH)

    6.

    Headrest holder (locked)

    7.

    Headrest holder (free)

    8.

    Seatback latch bracket (RH)

    9.

    Seatback latch (RH)

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-18

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    10. Seatback frame (RH)

    11. Seatback latch finisher (RH)

    12. Seatback latch release knob

    13. Seatback trim (RH)

    14. Seatback pad (RH)

    15. Seat cushion hook

    A

    16. Seat cushion

    17. Seat cushion pad

    18. Seat cushion trim

    19. Cup holder

    20. Armrest

    21. Armrest hinge bracket

    22. Armrest pivot bolt bushing

    23. Armrest pivot bolt

    24. Armrest hinge bracket finisher
    (RH)

    25. Bushing

    26. Armrest hinge bracket finisher (LH) 27. Seatback pad (LH)

    28. Seatback trim (LH)

    29. Seatback latch finisher (LH)

    30. Seatback frame (LH)

    31. Seatback latch bracket (LH)

    32. Seatback latch (LH)

    33. Seatbelt guide finisher

    34. Seat belt guide

    35. Seatback (LH)

    C

    Pawl

    D

    SEAT CUSHION
    SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation

    B

    INFOID:0000000009643062

    E

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Lift up the seat cushion assembly front edge (B) to release it from the seat cushion hooks (A) (LH/RH) and
    remove.
    : Front

    F

    G

    H

    I
    JMJIA4835ZZ

    SE

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    SEATBACK

    K

    SEATBACK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009643063

    REMOVAL

    L

    Seatback (LH)

    1.

    Release seat belt retractor (center) (1) from seat belt buckle
    (LH) (2) using a suitable tool (A) as shown ( ).

    M

    N

    O

    ALHIA0315ZZ

    2.

    Place the seatback (LH) in the folded down position.

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-19

    2014 Note

    P

    REAR SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Release hook fasteners (A).
    4. Remove bolts (B) and the seatback (LH) (1).

    ALJIA1242ZZ

    Seatback (RH)

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Place the seatback (RH) in the folded down position.
    Release hook fasteners (A).
    Remove bolts (B) and the seatback (RH) (1).

    ALJIA1243ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Tighten the seatback assembly bolts to specification. Refer to SE-18, «Exploded View».

    SEATBACK HINGE

    SEATBACK HINGE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009643064

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove the seatbacks (LH/RH). Refer to SE-19, «SEATBACK : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation»
    Remove bolts (A) and the seatback hinge (1).

    ALJIA1244ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Tighten the seatback hinge assembly bolts to specification. Refer to SE-18, «Exploded View».

    SEATBACK STRIKER

    SEATBACK STRIKER : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009643065

    REMOVAL
    Revision: April 2013

    SE-20

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    1. Remove the luggage side upper finisher. Refer to INT-33, «LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    2. Remove bolts and the seatback strikers.

    INSTALLATION

    B

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Tighten the seatback striker bolts to specification. Refer to SE-18, «Exploded View».

    SEAT CUSHION HOOK

    C

    SEAT CUSHION HOOK : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009643066

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    A

    D

    Remove the seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation».
    Release the seat cushion hook pawls as shown and remove.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the seat cushion hook, check its orientation (front/rear).

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JMJIA6035ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    I

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-21

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
    FRONT SEAT
    DRIVER SIDE
    DRIVER SIDE : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009645122

    AWJIA1116ZZ

    1.

    Armrest

    2.

    Seatback trim

    3.

    Seatback pad

    4.

    Seat cushion trim

    5.

    Seat cushion pad

    6.

    Seat cushion frame

    7.

    Seat belt buckle

    8.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (RH)

    9.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (LH)

    10. Lift lever

    11. Lift lever finisher

    12. Recline lever

    13. Slide finisher rear (LH/RH)

    14. Headrest holder (locked)

    15. Headrest holder (free)

    16. Seat frame

    17. Headrest

    DRIVER SIDE : Seatback

    INFOID:0000000009643078

    DISASSEMBLY
    Revision: April 2013

    SE-22

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    1. Remove the driver side front seat. Refer to SE-14, «DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation».
    2. Remove the headrest.
    3. Release trim strap (A) from the seat cushion frame.

    A

    B

    C

    D
    JMJIA6015ZZ

    4.
    a.
    b.

    Remove the armrest (1).
    Unzip the armrest to access armrest bolt (A).
    Remove armrest bolt (A) and armrest (1).

    E

    F

    G

    ALJIA0994ZZ

    5.

    Release the J-hook retainer (C), unzip seatback zippers (A) and
    release J-clips (B).

    H

    I

    SE

    K
    AWJIA1114ZZ

    6.

    L

    Release the headrest holder locks as shown and remove.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the headrest holder, check its orientation
    (front/rear and right/left).

    M

    N

    O
    JMJIA4073ZZ

    7.

    Lift the seatback trim and seatback pad from the seat frame.

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-23

    P

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    8. Remove the hog rings and separate the seatback trim (1) from
    the seatback pad.
    : Hog ring
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    ALJIA0988ZZ

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    • Install new hog rings on the seatback trim in original positions.
    • Use only one hog ring in each designated location.
    • Make sure hog rings are correctly fastened around both the seatback trim and seatback pad wires.
    • Smooth out all wrinkles during assembly.
    • Use NISSAN standard hog rings and tools to assemble.

    PIIB3356J

    DRIVER SIDE : Seat Cushion

    INFOID:0000000009643079

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    a.
    b.

    Remove the drive side front seat. Refer to SE-14, «DRIVER SIDE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the lift lever (2).
    Release pawls and remove the lift lever finisher (1).
    Remove screws and the lift lever.
    : Pawl

    AWJIA0932ZZ

    3.

    Remove snap ring (1) as shown (
    the recline lever (2).

    ) using a suitable tool, then

    JMJIA6005ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-24

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    4. Remove the seat cushion outer finisher (LH) (1).
    a. Remove screw (A).
    b. Pull to release metal clips as shown ( ) and remove.
    : Metal clip

    A

    B

    C
    JMJIA6006ZZ

    5.
    6.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    Remove the seat belt buckle (LH). Refer to SB-8, «FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the seat cushion outer finisher (RH) (1).
    Remove screw (B).
    Position seat cushion trim (A) aside.
    Slide seat cushion outer finisher (RH) rearward, as shown (
    to release pawl and remove.
    : Pawl

    D

    E

    F

    ),

    G

    AWJIA0933ZZ

    7.
    a.
    b.

    Remove the seat cushion from the seat frame.
    Release the seatback trim J-clips (C) and seat cushion J-clips
    (B) from the seat cushion frame.
    Remove bolts (A) and the seat cushion.

    H

    I

    SE

    K

    ALJIA0997ZZ

    8.
    a.
    b.

    Remove seat cushion trim and seat cushion pad from the seat
    cushion frame.
    Release string at locations (A) from seat cushion frame (1).
    : Front
    Loosen string then remove the seat cushion trim and seat cushion pad.

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JMJIA6008ZZ

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-25

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    9. Remove the hog rings and separate the seat cushion trim (1)
    from the seat cushion pad.
    : Hog ring
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    ALJIA0990ZZ

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    • Install new hog rings on the seat cushion trim in original positions.
    • Use only one hog ring in each designated location.
    • Make sure hog rings are correctly fastened around both the seat
    cushion trim and seat cushion pad wires.
    • Smooth out all wrinkles during assembly.
    • Use NISSAN standard hog rings and tools to assemble.

    PIIB3356J

    PASSENGER SIDE

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-26

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    PASSENGER SIDE : Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009645123

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    AWJIA1117ZZ

    1.

    Headrest

    2.

    Headrest holder (locked)

    3.

    Headrest holder (free)

    4.

    Slide finisher rear (LH/RH)

    5.

    Recline lever

    6.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (RH)

    7.

    Seat frame

    8.

    Seat cushion outer finisher (LH)

    9.

    Seat belt buckle

    10. Seat cushion pad

    11. Seat cushion trim

    O

    PASSENGER SIDE : Seatback

    INFOID:0000000009643081

    P

    DISASSEMBLY
    Remove the passenger side front seat. Refer to SE-16, «PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the headrest.

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    12. Seatback pad

    13. Seatback trim

    1.
    2.

    M

    SE-27

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    3. Release trim strap (A) from the seat frame.

    AWJIA0913ZZ

    4.

    Release the J-hook retainer (C), unzip seatback zippers (A) and
    release J-clips (B).

    AWJIA1115ZZ

    5.

    Release the headrest holder locks as shown and remove.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the headrest holder, check its orientation
    (front/rear and right/left).

    JMJIA4073ZZ

    6.
    7.

    Lift the seatback trim and seatback pad from the seat frame.
    Remove the hog rings and separate the seatback trim (1) from
    the seatback pad.
    : Hog ring
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    ALJIA0988ZZ

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-28

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Install new hog rings on the seatback trim in original positions.
    • Use only one hog ring in each designated location.
    • Make sure hog rings are correctly fastened around both the seatback trim and seatback pad wires.
    • Smooth out all wrinkles during assembly.
    • Use NISSAN standard hog rings and tools to assemble.

    A

    B

    C
    PIIB3356J

    D

    PASSENGER SIDE : Seat Cushion

    INFOID:0000000009643082

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.

    Remove the passenger side front seat. Refer to SE-16, «PASSENGER SIDE : Removal and Installation».

    2.

    Remove snap ring (1) as shown (
    remove the recline lever (2).

    E

    ) using a suitable tool, then
    F

    G

    H
    AWJIA0907ZZ

    3.
    a.

    Remove the seat cushion outer finisher (RH) (1).
    Remove the screw (A).

    b.

    Pull to release metal clips as shown (
    : Metal clip

    I

    ) and remove.

    SE

    K

    L
    AWJIA0917ZZ

    4.
    5.
    a.
    b.

    Remove seat belt buckle (RH). Refer to SB-8, «FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the seat cushion outer finisher (LH) (2).
    Remove seat cushion trim retainer (A).
    Remove the screw (B).

    c.

    Slide seat cushion outer finisher (LH) rearward as shown (
    release pawl and remove.
    (1): Seat cushion trim
    : Pawl

    M

    N

    ) to
    O

    P
    AWJIA0918ZZ

    6.

    Remove the seat cushion trim and seat cushion pad from the seat frame.

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-29

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    a. Remove trim strap (A) and J-hook retainers (B).

    AWJIA0919ZZ

    b.

    Remove the hog rings, then the seat cushion trim and seat
    cushion pad from the seat frame.
    : Hog ring
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    AWJIA0923ZZ

    7.

    Remove the hog rings and separate the seat cushion trim (1)
    from the seat cushion pad.
    : Hog ring
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    ALJIA0990ZZ

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    • Install new hog rings on the seat cushion trim in original positions.
    • Use only one hog ring in each designated location.
    • Make sure hog rings are correctly fastened around both the seat
    cushion trim and seat cushion pad wires.
    • Smooth out all wrinkles during assembly.
    • Use NISSAN standard hog rings and tools to assemble.

    PIIB3356J

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-30

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    REAR SEAT

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009645127

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SE

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ALJIA1240ZZ

    1.

    Seatback hinge trim

    2.

    Seatback hinge

    3.

    4.

    Headrest

    5.

    Seatback (RH)

    6.

    Headrest holder (locked)

    7.

    Headrest holder (free)

    8.

    Seatback latch bracket (RH)

    9.

    Seatback latch (RH)

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-31

    Seatback striker

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    10. Seatback frame (RH)

    11. Seatback latch finisher (RH)

    12. Seatback latch release knob

    13. Seatback trim (RH)

    14. Seatback pad (RH)

    15. Seat cushion hook

    16. Seat cushion

    17. Seat cushion pad

    18. Seat cushion trim

    19. Cup holder

    20. Armrest

    21. Armrest hinge bracket

    22. Armrest pivot bolt bushing

    23. Armrest pivot bolt

    24. Armrest hinge bracket finisher
    (RH)

    25. Bushing

    26. Armrest hinge bracket finisher (LH) 27. Seatback pad (LH)

    28. Seatback trim (LH)

    29. Seatback latch finisher (LH)

    30. Seatback frame (LH)

    31. Seatback latch bracket (LH)

    32. Seatback latch (LH)

    33. Seatbelt guide finisher

    34. Seat belt guide

    35. Seatback (LH)

    Pawl

    Seat Cushion

    INFOID:0000000009643084

    SEAT CUSHION

    ALJIA1251ZZ

    1.

    Seat cushion pad

    2.

    Seat cushion trim

    Hog ring

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove the seat cushion. Refer to SE-19, «SEAT CUSHION : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the hog rings on the bottom side of seat cushion.
    Remove the hog rings on the top side of seat cushion and separate the seat cushion trim from the seat
    cushion pad.
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-32

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Install new hog rings on the seat cushion trim in original positions.
    • Use only one hog ring in each designated location.
    • Make sure hog rings are correctly fastened around both the seat
    cushion trim and seat cushion pad wires.
    • Smooth out all wrinkles during assembly.
    • Use NISSAN standard hog rings and tools to assemble.

    A

    B

    C
    PIIB3356J

    D

    Seatback

    INFOID:0000000009643085

    E

    DISASSEMBLY
    Seatback (LH)

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove the seatback (LH). Refer to SE-19, «SEATBACK : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the headrest.
    Release clips and remove latch finisher.
    Release pawls and remove the seat belt guide finisher.
    Remove nut and the seat belt guide.
    Rotate the seatback latch release knob counterclockwise as
    shown ( ) and remove.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    SE

    JMJIA4374ZZ

    7.
    a.
    b.

    Remove the armrest (1).
    Remove clip (A) using a suitable tool, then the armrest finisher
    (RH) (2) as shown ( ).
    Remove nuts (B), then the armrest.

    K

    L

    M

    N
    ALJIA1247ZZ

    8.
    9.

    Release hook fasteners (A), then J-hook retainer (B).
    Unzip the seatback trim zipper (C), then release J-clip retainers
    (D).

    O

    P

    ALJIA1246ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-33

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    10. Release the headrest holder locks as shown and remove.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the headrest holder, check its orientation
    (front/rear and right/left).

    JMJIA4073ZZ

    11. Remove the seatback trim and seatback pad as an assembly from the seatback frame.
    12. Remove bolts and the seatback latch assembly.
    13. Remove the hog rings and separate the seatback trim (1) from
    the seatback pad.
    : Hog ring
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    ALJIA1248ZZ

    Seatback (RH)

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the seatback (RH). Refer to SE-19, «SEATBACK : Removal and Installation».
    Remove the headrest.
    Release clips and remove latch finisher.
    Rotate the seatback latch release knob counterclockwise as
    shown ( ) and remove.

    JMJIA4374ZZ

    5.
    6.

    Release hook fasteners (A), then J-hook retainer (B).
    Unzip the seatback trim zipper (C), then release J-clip retainers
    (D).

    ALJIA1250ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-34

    2014 Note

    REAR SEAT
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    7. Release the headrest holder locks as shown and remove.
    CAUTION:
    Before removing the headrest holder, check its orientation
    (front/rear and right/left).

    A

    B

    C
    JMJIA4073ZZ

    D

    8. Remove the seatback trim and seatback pad from the seatback frame.
    9. Remove bolts and the seatback latch.
    10. Remove the hog rings and separate the seatback trim (1) from
    the seatback pad.
    : Hog ring
    NOTE:
    Remove all pieces of hog rings and discard them.

    E

    F

    G

    ALJIA1249ZZ

    H

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    • Install new hog rings on the seatback trim in original positions.
    • Use only one hog ring in each designated location.
    • Make sure hog rings are correctly fastened around both the seatback trim and seatback pad wires.
    • Smooth out all wrinkle during assembly.
    • Use NISSAN standard hog rings and tools to assemble.

    I

    SE

    K

    L
    PIIB3356J

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SE-35

    2014 Note

    BODY EXTERIOR, DOORS, ROOF & VEHICLE SECURITY

    SECTION

    SEC

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 4
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 4

    THEFT ALM : CONSULT Function (BCM THEFT) …………………………………………………………..21

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 4
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 4

    IMMU ………………………………………………………………..21
    IMMU : CONSULT Function (BCM — IMMU) …………22

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 5

    ECM, IPDM E/R, BCM ………………………………… 23

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 5

    F

    G

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 23
    H

    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………23

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 24

    I

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 6

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE
    START FUNCTION ……………………………………. 24

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 6

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..24

    J

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 5

    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 6

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM …………………. 38

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….10

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..38

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START
    FUNCTION ……………………………………………………….. 10
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START
    FUNCTION : System Description ………………………. 10

    NVIS ………………………………………………………… 49

    NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM ………………………….. 12
    NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM : System Description …………………………………………………………. 13

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW ……. 58

    VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM …………………………… 15
    VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM : System Description ……………………………………………………………….. 15

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….18
    COMMON ITEM ………………………………………………… 18
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) …………………………………………….. 18
    INTELLIGENT KEY …………………………………………… 18
    INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM INTELLIGENT KEY) ………………………………………… 19
    THEFT ALM ……………………………………………………… 21

    Revision: April 2013

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..49

    SEC

    L

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 58
    M

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….58

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
    CONTROL UNIT ………………………………………… 61

    N

    ECM ………………………………………………………………….61
    ECM : Description …………………………………………….61
    ECM : Work Procedure ……………………………………..61

    O

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 62
    P1610 LOCK MODE ………………………………….. 62
    Description ………………………………………………………62
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….62
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..62

    P1611 ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM ………………… 63
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….63

    SEC-1

    2014 Note

    P

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 63

    B2608 STARTER RELAY …………………………… 91

    P1612 CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU ……………………… 64

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 91
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 91
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 92

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 64
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 64

    B2192 ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM …………………. 65

    B260F ENGINE STATUS ……………………………. 93

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 65
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 65

    Description …………………………………………………….. 93
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 93
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 93

    B2193 CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU ……………………… 66

    B261F ASCD CLUTCH SWITCH …………………. 94

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 66
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 66

    B2195 ANTI-SCANNING …………………………….. 67
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 67
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 67

    B2198 NATS ANTENNA AMP. ……………………. 68
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 68
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 68

    B2555 STOP LAMP ……………………………………. 71
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 71
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 71
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 72

    B2556 PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ….. 74
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 74
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 74
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 75

    B2557 VEHICLE SPEED …………………………….. 76
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 76
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 76

    B2601 SHIFT POSITION …………………………….. 77
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 77
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 77

    B2602 SHIFT POSITION …………………………….. 79

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 94
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 94
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 96

    B2620 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH… 97
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 97
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 97
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 99

    B26E8 CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH ………. 100
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 100
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 100
    Component Inspection (Clutch Interlock Switch) . 102

    B26F3 STARTER CONTROL RELAY …………. 103
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 103
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 103

    B26F4 STARTER CONTROL RELAY …………. 104
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 104
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 104

    B26F7 BCM ……………………………………………… 105
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 105
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 105

    B26FB CLUTCH SWITCH ………………………….. 106
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 106
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 106

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 79
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 79
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 81

    B26FC KEY REGISTRATION …………………….. 107

    B2603 SHIFT POSITION …………………………….. 82

    B210B STARTER CONTROL RELAY …………. 108

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 82
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 82
    Component Inspection (Transmission Range
    Switch) ………………………………………………………….. 85
    Component Inspection [CVT Shift Selector (Park
    Position Switch)] …………………………………………….. 85

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 107
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 107
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 108
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 108

    B210C STARTER CONTROL RELAY …………. 109
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 109
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 109

    B2604 SHIFT POSITION …………………………….. 86

    B210D STARTER RELAY ………………………….. 111

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 86
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 86
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 88

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 111
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 111

    B2605 SHIFT POSITION …………………………….. 89
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 89
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 89

    Revision: April 2013

    B210E STARTER RELAY ………………………….. 113
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 113
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 113

    SEC-2

    2014 Note

    B210F SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH …………………………………………. 115

    SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP DOES NOT
    TURN ON OR BLINK ……………………………….. 120

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 115
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 115

    Description ……………………………………………………. 120
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 120

    B2110 SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH …………………………………………. 117

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………. 121

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 117
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 117

    NATS ANTENNA AMP. ……………………………. 121

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 119

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH ………….. 122

    ENGINE DOES NOT START WHEN INTELLIGENT KEY IS INSIDE OF VEHICLE ……………. 119
    Description …………………………………………………… 119
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 119

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 121
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 122

    A

    B

    C

    D

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER ……. 123
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 123
    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-3

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009541297

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009541299

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-4

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009541300

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    C

    D

    E
    AWJIA0483ZZ

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-5

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009016098

    ALKIA3206ZZ

    A.

    View right of steering column

    Revision: April 2013

    B.

    View with glove box cover removed

    SEC-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    1.

    2.

    3.

    4.

    Component

    Function

    A

    Combination meter transmits the vehicle
    speed signal to BCM via CAN communication.
    BCM also receives the vehicle speed signal
    from ABS actuator and electric unit (control
    unit) via CAN communication. BCM compares both signals to detect the vehicle
    speed.
    Security indicator lamp is located on combination meter.
    Security indicator lamp blinks when ignition
    switch is in any position other than ON to
    warn that NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER
    SYSTEM-NATS [NVIS (NATS)] is on board.
    Refer to MWI-6, «METER SYSTEM : Combination Meter».

    Combination meter

    Inside key antenna (instrument center) detects whether Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or not, and then transmits the signal to
    the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-12, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM :
    Inside Key Antenna (Instrument Center)».

    Inside key antenna (instrument center)

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
    transmits the vehicle speed signal to BCM via
    CAN communication.
    BCM also receives the vehicle speed signal
    from the combination meter via CAN communication. BCM compares both signals to detect the vehicle speed.
    Refer to BRC-6, «Component Parts Location»
    for detailed installation location.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer warns the user, who is outside the vehicle, of operation
    confirmation according to Intelligent Key operation and door request switch operation, or
    of an inappropriate operation.
    Refer to DLK-14, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM :
    Intelligent Key Warning Buzzer».

    Intelligent Key warning buzzer

    5.

    Hood switch

    Hood switch detects that brake hood is open
    or closed, and then transmits that signal to
    the IPDM E/R

    6.

    Transmission range switch

    Transmission range switch detects the CVT
    shift selector lever position.

    IPDM E/R

    Starter control relay is integrated in IPDM E/R
    and used for the engine starting function.
    Starter relay is controlled by BCM, and starter
    control relay is controlled by IPDM E/R while
    communicating with BCM. IPDM E/R sends
    the starter control relay and starter relay status signal to BCM.

    7.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-7

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component

    Function

    8.

    BCM

    BCM controls INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM
    (ENGINE START FUNCTION), NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM-NATS [NVIS
    (NATS)] and VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM.
    BCM performs the ID verification between
    BCM and Intelligent Key when the Intelligent
    Key is carried into the detection area of inside
    key antenna, and push-button ignition switch
    is pressed. If the ID verification result is OK,
    ignition switch operation is available.
    Then, when the ignition switch is turned ON,
    BCM performs ID verification between BCM
    and ECM. If the ID verification result is OK,
    ECM can start engine.
    Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM
    : Component Parts Location» for detailed installation location.

    9.

    Clutch interlock switch

    Clutch interlock switch detects that clutch
    pedal is depressed, and then transmits ON/
    OFF signal to the BCM

    10.

    Stop lamp switch

    Stop lamp switch detects that brake pedal is
    depressed, and then transmits ON/OFF signal to the BCM

    Main power window and door lock/unlock switch

    Door lock and unlock switch is integrated into
    the power window main switch.
    Door lock and unlock switch transmits door
    lock/unlock operation signal to BCM.
    Refer to PWC-6, «Power Window Main
    Switch».

    12.

    CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    Park position switch is integrated into the
    CVT shift selector and detects that the selector lever is in the P (park) position, then transmits ON/OFF signal to the BCM and IPDM E/
    R.

    13.

    Front door switch LH

    Door switch detects door open/close condition and then transmits ON/OFF signal to
    BCM.

    14.

    Rear door switch LH

    Door switch detects door open/close condition and then transmits ON/OFF signal to
    BCM.

    Inside key antenna (trunk room)

    Inside key antenna (trunk room) detects
    whether Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or
    not, and then transmits the signal to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-13, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM :
    Inside Key Antenna (Trunk Room)».

    Inside key antenna (console)

    Inside key antenna (console) detects whether
    Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or not, and
    then transmits the signal to the BCM.
    Refer to DLK-13, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM :
    Inside Key Antenna (Console)».

    Push button ignition switch

    Push-button ignition switch has push switch
    inside which detects that push-button ignition
    switch is pressed, and then transmits ON/
    OFF signal to BCM. BCM changes the ignition switch position with the operation of
    push-button ignition switch. BCM maintains
    the ignition switch position status while pushbutton ignition switch is not operated.

    11.

    15.

    16.

    17.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-8

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.
    18.

    19.

    Component

    Function

    NATS antenna amp.

    ID verification is performed between the BCM
    and the transponder integrated into the Intelligent Key via the NATS antenna amp.

    Remote keyless entry receiver

    Remote keyless entry receiver receives button operation signal and key ID signal of Intelligent Key, and them transmits them to the
    BCM.
    Refer to DLK-14, «DOOR LOCK SYSTEM :
    Remote Keyless Entry Receiver».

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-9

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION : System Description
    INFOID:0000000009606330

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    ALKIA2976GB

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    • The engine start function of Intelligent Key system makes it possible to start and stop the engine without
    using the key, based on the electronic ID verification. The electronic ID verification is performed between
    BCM and Intelligent Key when the push-button ignition switch is pressed while the Intelligent Key is within
    the detection area of inside key antenna.
    NOTE:
    The driver should carry the Intelligent Key at all times.
    • Intelligent Key has 2 IDs (Intelligent Key ID and NATS ID). It can perform the door lock/unlock operation and
    the push-button ignition switch operation when the registered Intelligent Key is carried.
    • If the ID is successfully verified, when push-button ignition switch is pressed the engine can be started.
    • Up to 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered (Including the standard Intelligent Key) upon request from the customer.
    NOTE:
    Refer to SEC-13, «NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM : System Description» for any functions other than engine
    start function of Intelligent Key system.
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-10

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    PRECAUTIONS FOR INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM
    The transponder (the chip for NATS ID verification) is integrated into the Intelligent Key. (For the conventional models, it is integrated into the mechanical key.) Therefore, ID verification cannot be performed by mechanical key only.
    In that case, NATS ID verification can be performed when Intelligent Key backside is contacted to
    push-button ignition switch while brake pedal is depressed. If verification result is OK, engine can be
    started.

    OPERATION WHEN INTELLIGENT KEY IS CARRIED

    A

    B

    C

    1.

    When the push-button ignition switch is pressed, the BCM activates the inside key antenna and transmits
    the request signal to the Intelligent Key.
    2. The Intelligent Key receives the request signal and transmits the Intelligent Key ID signal to the BCM.
    3. BCM receives the Intelligent Key ID signal via remote keyless entry receiver and verifies it with the registered ID.
    4. BCM turns ACC relay ON and transmits the ignition power supply ON signal to IPDM E/R.
    5. IPDM E/R turns the ignition relay ON and starts the ignition power supply.
    6. IPDM E/R turns the starter control relay ON for engine starting in advance.
    7. BCM detects the selector lever position and brake pedal operation condition.
    8. BCM transmits the starter request signal to IPDM E/R and turns the starter relay ON if BCM judges that
    the engine start condition* is satisfied.
    9. Power supply is supplied through the starter relay and the starter control relay to operate the starter motor.
    CAUTION:
    If a malfunction is detected in the Intelligent Key system, the “KEY” warning lamp on the combination meter illuminates. At that time, the engine cannot be started.
    10. When BCM receives feedback signal from ECM indicating that the engine is started, the BCM transmits a
    stop signal to IPDM E/R and stops cranking by turning OFF the starter motor relay. (If engine start is
    unsuccessful, cranking stops automatically within 5 seconds.)
    CAUTION:
    When the Intelligent Key is carried outside of the vehicle (inside key antenna detection area) while
    the power supply is in the ACC or ON position, even if the engine start condition* is satisfied, the
    engine cannot be started.
    *: For the engine start condition, refer to “IGNITION SWITCH POSITION CHANGE TABLE BY PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OPERATION”.

    OPERATION RANGE
    Engine can be started when Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle. However, sometimes engine may not start
    when Intelligent Key is on instrument panel or in glove box.

    ENGINE START OPERATION WHEN INTELLIGENT KEY IS CONTACTED TO PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    When Intelligent Key battery is discharged, NATS ID verification between transponder in Intelligent Key and
    BCM is performed when Intelligent Key backside is contacted to push-button ignition switch while brake pedal
    is depressed. If the verification result is OK, engine can be started.

    M

    IGNITION SWITCH POSITION CHANGE TABLE BY PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OPERATION

    N

    The ignition switch position can be changed by the following operations.
    NOTE:
    • When an Intelligent Key is within the detection area of inside key antenna or when Intelligent Key backside is
    contacted to push-button ignition switch, it is equivalent to the operations below.
    • When starting the engine, the BCM monitors under the engine start conditions,
    — Brake pedal operation condition
    — Selector lever position
    — Vehicle speed
    Vehicle speed: less than 4 km/h (2.5 MPH)

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-11

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Condition
    Power supply position

    Push-button ignition switch
    operation frequency

    Selector lever

    Brake pedal operation
    condition

    OFF → ACC

    Not depressed

    1

    OFF → ACC → ON

    Not depressed

    2

    OFF → ACC → ON →
    OFF

    Not depressed

    3

    P or N position

    Depressed

    1

    1

    OFF → START
    ACC → START
    ON → START
    Engine is running →
    OFF

    Vehicle speed: 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or more
    Condition
    Power supply position
    Engine is running →
    ACC
    Engine stall return operation while driving

    Push-button ignition switch
    operation frequency

    Selector lever

    Brake pedal operation
    condition

    Emergency stop operation

    N position

    Not depressed

    1

    Emergency stop operation
    • Press and hold the push-button ignition switch for 2 seconds or more.
    • Press the push-button ignition switch 3 times or more within 1.5 seconds.

    NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-12

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009606331

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    ALKIA3205GB

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    • The Nissan Anti-Theft System (NATS) prevents the engine from being started by Intelligent Key whose ID is
    not registered to the vehicle (BCM). It has higher protection against auto theft involving the duplication of
    mechanical keys.
    • The ignition key integrated in the Intelligent Key cannot start the engine. When the Intelligent Key battery is
    discharged, the NATS ID verification is performed between the transponder integrated with Intelligent Key
    and BCM via NATS antenna amp. when the Intelligent Key backside is contacted to push-button ignition
    switch while brake pedal is depressed. If the verification result is OK, the engine start operation can be performed by the push-button ignition switch operation.
    • Locate the security indicator lamp and always blinks it when the ignition switch is in any position except ON
    to warn that the vehicle is equipped with Nissan Anti-Theft System (NATS).
    • Up to 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered (including the standard ignition key) upon request from the owner.
    • When replacing ECM, BCM or Intelligent Key, the specified procedure (Initialization and registration) using
    CONSULT is required.
    • Possible symptom of NATS malfunction is “Engine can not start”. This symptom also occurs because of
    other than NATS malfunction, so start the trouble diagnosis according to SEC-58, «Work Flow».
    • If ECM other than genuine part is installed, the engine cannot be started.
    For ECM replacement procedure, refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».

    PRECAUTIONS FOR KEY REGISTRATION
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-13

    2014 Note

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • The ID registration is a procedure that erases the current NATS ID once, and then registers a new ID. Therefore before starting the registration operation, collect all registered Intelligent Keys from the customer.
    • When registering the Intelligent Key, perform only one procedure to simultaneously register both IDs (NATS
    ID and Intelligent Key ID).

    SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP
    • Security indicator lamp warns that the vehicle is equipped with NATS.
    • Security indicator lamp always blinks when the ignition switch is in any position other than ON.
    NOTE:
    Because security indicator lamp is highly efficient, the battery is barely affected.

    ENGINE START OPERATION WHEN INTELLIGENT KEY IS CONTACTED TO PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    1.

    When brake pedal is depressed while selector lever is in the P position the BCM activates NATS antenna
    amp. that is located behind push-button ignition switch.
    2. When Intelligent Key (transponder built-in) backside is contacted to push-button ignition switch, BCM
    starts NATS ID verification between BCM and Intelligent Key (transponder built-in) via NATS antenna
    amp.
    3. When NATS ID verification result is OK, buzzer in combination meter sounds and BCM transmits the
    result to ECM.
    4. BCM turns ACC relay ON and transmits ignition power supply ON signal to IPDM E/R.
    5. IPDM E/R turns the ignition relay ON and starts the ignition power supply.
    6. IPDM E/R turns the starter control relay ON for engine starting in advance.
    7. BCM detects that the selector lever position and brake pedal operation condition.
    8. BCM transmits starter request signal to IPDM E/R and turns the starter relay ON if BCM judges that the
    engine start condition* is satisfied.
    9. Power supply is supplied through the starter relay and the starter control relay to operate the starter motor.
    10. When BCM receives feedback signal from ECM indicating that the engine is started, BCM transmits a
    stop signal to IPDM E/R and stops cranking by turning off the starter motor relay. (If engine start is unsuccessful, cranking stops automatically within 5 seconds.)
    *: For the engine start condition, refer to “IGNITION SWITCH POSITION CHANGE TABLE BY PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OPERATION” below.

    IGNITION SWITCH POSITION CHANGE TABLE BY PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OPERATION
    The ignition switch position can be changed by the following operations.
    NOTE:
    • When an Intelligent Key is within the detection area of inside key antenna or when Intelligent Key backside is
    contacted to push-button ignition switch, it is equivalent to the operations below.
    • When starting the engine, the BCM monitors under the engine start conditions,
    — Brake pedal operation condition
    — Selector lever position
    — Vehicle speed
    Vehicle speed: less than 4 km/h (2.5 MPH)
    Condition
    Power supply position

    Push-button ignition switch
    operation frequency

    Selector lever

    Brake pedal operation
    condition

    OFF → ACC

    Not depressed

    1

    OFF → ACC → ON

    Not depressed

    2

    OFF → ACC → ON →
    OFF

    Not depressed

    3

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-14

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Condition
    Power supply position
    OFF → START
    ACC → START
    ON → START

    Push-button ignition switch
    operation frequency

    A

    Depressed

    1

    B

    1

    Selector lever

    Brake pedal operation
    condition

    P or N position

    Engine is running →
    OFF

    C

    Vehicle speed: 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or more
    D

    Condition
    Power supply position

    Selector lever

    Emergency stop operation

    N position

    Not depressed

    1

    Engine is running →
    ACC
    Engine stall return operation while driving

    Push-button ignition switch
    operation frequency

    Brake pedal operation
    condition

    E

    F

    Emergency stop operation
    • Press and hold the push-button ignition switch for 2 seconds or more.

    G

    • Press the push-button ignition switch 3 times or more within 1.5 seconds.

    VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM
    H

    VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009606332

    THEFT WARNING ALARM
    • The theft warning alarm function activates horns and headlamps intermittently when BCM detects that any
    door is opened by unauthorized means while the system is in the ARMED state.
    • Security indicator lamp on combination meter always blinks when power supply position is any position other
    than ON. Security indicator lamp blinking warns that the vehicle is equipped with a vehicle security system.

    I

    J

    Operation Flow
    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    JMKIA5416GB

    No.
    1

    2

    System state

    Switching condition

    DISARMED to
    PRE-ARMED

    When all conditions of A and
    one condition of B is satisfied.

    PRE-ARMED
    to ARMED

    When all of the following
    conditions are satisfied for
    30 seconds.

    Revision: April 2013

    O

    A
    • Power supply position: OFF/LOCK
    • All doors: Closed

    P

    B
    All doors are locked by:
    • Door key cylinder LOCK switch
    • LOCK button of Intelligent Key
    • Door request switch

    • Power supply position: OFF/LOCK
    • All doors: Locked

    SEC-15

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.
    3

    System state

    Switching condition

    ARMED to
    ALARM

    When one condition of A and
    one condition of B are satisfied.

    A

    4

    DISARMED to
    PRE-RESET

    No conditions

    5

    PRE-ARMED
    to PRE-RESET

    6

    ARMED to
    PRE-RESET

    7

    ALARM to
    PRE-RESET

    8

    PRE-RESET to
    DISARMED

    9

    PRE-RESET to
    PRE-ARMED

    10

    PRE-ARMED
    to DISARMED

    When one of the following
    conditions is satisfied.





    Power supply position: ACC/ON/CRANKING/RUN
    Door key cylinder UNLOCK switch: ON
    UNLOCK button of Intelligent Key: ON
    Door request switch: ON
    Any door: Open

    11

    ARMED to
    DISARMED

    When one of the following
    conditions is satisfied.

    12

    ALARM to
    DISARMED




    Power supply position: ACC/ON/CRANKING/RUN
    Door key cylinder UNLOCK switch: ON
    UNLOCK button of Intelligent Key: ON
    Door request switch: ON

    13

    RE-ALARM

    When one of the following
    conditions is satisfied after
    the ALARM operation is finished.

    • Any door: Open

    Intelligent Key: Not used

    B
    • Any door: Open

    NOTE:
    • BCM ignores the door key cylinder UNLOCK switch signal input for 1 second after the door key cylinder LOCK switch signal input.
    • To lock/unlock all doors by operating remote controller button of Intelligent Key or door request switch, Intelligent Key must be within
    the detection area of outside key antenna. For details, refer to SEC-10, «INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION :
    System Description».

    DISARMED Phase
    The vehicle security system is not set in the DISARMED phase. The vehicle security system stays in this
    phase while any door is open because it is assumed that the owner is inside or nearby the vehicle. Security
    indicator lamp blinks every 2.4 seconds.
    When the vehicle security system is reset, each phase switches to the DISARMED phase directly.
    PRE-ARMED Phase
    The PRE-ARMED phase is the transient state between the DISARMED phase and the ARMED phase. This
    phase is maintained for 30 seconds so that the owner can reset the setting due to a mis-operation. This phase
    switches to the ARMED phase when vehicle conditions are not changed for 30 seconds. Security indicator
    lamp illuminates while being in this phase.
    To reset the PRE-ARMED phase, refer to the switching condition of No. 10 in the table above.
    ARMED Phase
    The vehicle security system is set and BCM monitors all necessary inputs. If any door is opened without using
    Intelligent Key, vehicle security system switches to the ALARM phase. Security indicator lamp blinks every 2.4
    seconds.
    To reset the ARMED phase, refer to the switching condition of No. 11 in the table above.
    ALARM Phase
    BCM transmits “Theft Warning Horn Request” signal and “High Beam Request” signal intermittently to IPDM
    E/R via CAN communication. In this phase, horns and headlamps are activated intermittently for approximately 50 seconds to warn that the vehicle is accessed by unauthorized means. ON/OFF timing of horns and
    headlamps are synchronized. After 50 seconds, the vehicle security system returns to the ARMED phase. At

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-16

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    this time, if BCM still detects unauthorized access to the vehicle, the system is switched to the ALARM phase
    again. This RE-ALARM operation is carried out a maximum of 2 times.
    To cancel the ALARM operation, refer to the switching condition of No. 12 in the table above.
    NOTE:
    If a battery terminal is disconnected during the ALARM phase, theft warning alarm stops. But when the battery
    terminal is reconnected, theft warning alarm is activated again.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-17

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009606333

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-18

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)

    INFOID:0000000009606334

    A

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».

    B

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Main

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    REQ SW -BD/TR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of back door request switch.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    C

    D

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    BRAKE SW 1 [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of brake switch.

    CLUTCH SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of clutch interlock switch.

    BRAKE SW 2 [On/Off]

    E

    Indicates condition of brake switch.

    DETE/CANCL SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of P (park) position.

    SFT PN/N SW [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of P (park) or N (neutral) position.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    F

    PUSH SW -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch received from IPDM E/R on
    CAN communication line.

    IGN RLY1 -F/B [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of ignition relay 1 received from IPDM E/R on CAN communication line.

    DETE SW -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of detent switch received from TCM on CAN communication
    line.

    SFT PN -IPDM [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of P (park) or N (neutral) position from TCM on CAN communication line.

    SFT P -MET [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of P (park) position from TCM on CAN communication line.

    SFT N -MET [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of N (neutral) position from IPDM E/R on CAN communication line.

    ENGINE STATE [Stop/Start/Crank/Run]

    ×

    Indicates condition of engine state from ECM on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 1 [mph/km/h]

    ×

    Indicates condition of vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    VEH SPEED 2 [mph/km/h]

    ×

    Indicates condition of vehicle speed signal received from combination meter on
    CAN communication line.

    DOOR STAT -DR [LOCK/READY/UNLK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of driver side door status.

    DOOR STAT -AS [LOCK/READY/UNLK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of passenger side door status.

    ID OK FLAG [Set/Reset]

    Indicates condition of Intelligent Key ID.

    PRMT ENG STRT [Set/Reset]

    Indicates condition of engine start possibility.
    ×

    When remote keyless entry receiver receives the signal transmitted while operating on Intelligent Key, the numerical value start changing.

    RKE OPE COUN2 [0-19]

    ×

    When remote keyless entry receiver receives the signal transmitted while operating on Intelligent Key, the numerical value start changing.
    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-MODE CHG [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of mode change signal from Intelligent Key.

    SEC-19

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    N

    O

    P

    ACTIVE TEST

    Revision: April 2013

    H

    M

    RKE OPE COUN1 [0-19]

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    G

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Test Item

    Description

    INSIDE BUZZER

    This test is able to check combination meter warning chime operation [Take Out/Knob/Key/
    Off].

    LCD

    This test is able to check combination meter display information [Off/LK WN/OUTKEY/NO
    KY/BATT/INSRT/SFT P/ROTAT/ID NG/B&P I/B&P N].

    BATTERY SAVER

    This test is able to check battery saver operation [On/Off].

    ENGINE SW ILLUMI

    This test is able to check push-button ignition switch START indicator operation [On/Off].

    PUSH SWITCH INDICATOR

    This test is able to check back door lock actuator operation [On/Off].

    INT LAMP

    This test is able to check interior room lamp operation [On/Off].

    INDICATOR

    This test is able to check combination meter warning lamp operation [KEY ON/KEY IND/Off].

    FLASHER

    This test is able to check hazard lamp operation [LH/RH/Off].

    OUTSIDE BUZZER

    This test is able to check Intelligent Key warning buzzer operation [On/Off].

    HORN

    This test is able to check horn operation [On].

    P RANGE

    This test is able to check CVT shift selector illumination operation [On/Off].

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    LOCK/UNLOCK BY I-KEY

    ANTI KEY LOCK IN FUNCTI

    ANS BACK I-KEY UNLOCK

    ANS BACK I-KEY LOCK

    HORN WITH KEYLESS LOCK

    Setting

    Description

    On*

    Door lock/unlock function from Intelligent Key ON.

    Off

    Door lock/unlock function from Intelligent Key OFF.

    On*

    Anti lock out setting ON.

    Off

    Anti lock out setting OFF.

    Off

    No buzzer reminder when doors are unlocked with request switch.

    On*

    Buzzer reminder when doors are unlocked with request switch.

    Horn Chirp

    Horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Buzzer*

    Buzzer reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Off

    No reminder when doors are locked with request switch.

    Off

    Horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with Intelligent Key.

    On*

    No horn chirp reminder when doors are locked with Intelligent Key.

    Lock/Unlock*

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked/unlocked
    with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Unlock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are unlocked with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Lock Only

    Hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    Off

    No hazard warning lamp activation when doors are locked/unlocked
    with Intelligent Key or request switch.

    HAZARD ANSWER BACK

    INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS

    This function allows inside key antenna self-diagnosis.

    CONFIRM KEY FOB ID

    Intelligent Key ID code can be checked.
    70 msec

    SHORT CRANKING OUTPUT

    Start

    100 msec

    Starter motor operation duration time setting.

    200 msec
    End

    LO- BATT OF KEY FOB WARN

    Revision: April 2013

    On*

    Intelligent Key low battery warning ON.

    Off

    Intelligent Key low battery warning OFF.

    SEC-20

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Support Item

    Setting

    AUTO LOCK SET

    MODE7

    5 min

    MODE6

    4 min

    MODE5

    3 min

    Description

    A

    B

    MODE4

    2 min

    MODE3*

    1 min

    Auto door lock time setting.

    MODE2

    30 sec

    MODE1

    Off

    C

    *: Initial Setting

    D

    THEFT ALM
    THEFT ALM : CONSULT Function (BCM — THEFT)

    INFOID:0000000009606335

    E

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitored Item

    F

    Description

    REQ SW -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch LH.

    REQ SW -AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door request switch RH.

    REQ SW -BD/TR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door request switch.

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-AS [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch RH.

    DOOR SW-RL [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of rear door switch LH.

    DOOR SW-BK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of back door switch.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    CDL UNLOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    KEY CYL LK-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    KEY CYL UN-SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from door key cylinder switch.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    RKE-LOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from Intelligent Key.

    RKE-UNLOCK [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of unlock signal from Intelligent Key.

    SEC

    L

    ACTIVE TEST

    M

    Test Item

    Description

    VEHICLE SECURITY HORN

    This test is able to check vehicle security horn operation [On].

    FLASHER

    This test is able to check turn signal lamp operation [LH/RH/Off].

    THEFT IND

    This test is able to check security indicator lamp operation [On/Off].

    HEADLAMP(HI)

    This test is able to check vehicle security lamp operation [On].

    N

    O

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item

    Setting

    THEFT ALM TRG
    SECURITY ALARM SET

    P

    Description
    Displays status of components that can trigger the theft alarm.

    On

    Security alarm ON.

    Off

    Security alarm OFF.

    IMMU
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-21

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    IMMU : CONSULT Function (BCM — IMMU)

    INFOID:0000000009606336

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Description

    CONFIRM ID ALL [Yet/DONE]
    CONFIRM ID4 [Yet/DONE]
    CONFIRM ID3 [Yet/DONE]

    Switches to DONE when an Intelligent Key is registered.

    CONFIRM ID2 [Yet/DONE]
    CONFIRM ID1 [Yet/DONE]
    TP 4 [Yet/DONE]
    TP 3 [Yet/DONE]
    TP 2 [Yet/DONE]

    DONE indicates the number of Intelligent Key ID which has been registered.

    TP 1 [Yet/DONE]
    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    THEFT IND

    Revision: April 2013

    Description
    This test is able to check security indicator operation [On/Off].

    SEC-22

    2014 Note

    ECM, IPDM E/R, BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION

    A

    ECM, IPDM E/R, BCM
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009016101

    ECU

    Reference

    C

    PCS-13, «Reference Value»
    IPDM E/R

    B

    PCS-18, «Fail-safe»

    D

    PCS-20, «DTC Index»
    EC-62, «Reference Value»
    ECM

    EC-73, «Fail Safe»

    E

    EC-74, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    EC-76, «DTC Index»
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    F

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»

    G

    BCS-46, «DTC Index»

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-23

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM
    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009619367

    AAKWA0632GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-24

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKWA0633GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-25

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKWA0634GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-26

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKWA0635GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-27

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1265GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-28

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1266GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-29

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1267GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-30

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1268GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-31

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1269GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-32

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1270GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-33

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1271GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-34

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1272GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-35

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1273GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-36

    2014 Note

    INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM/ENGINE START FUNCTION
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1274GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-37

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009016102

    AAKWA0640GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-38

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKWA0641GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-39

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKWA0642GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-40

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1286GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-41

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1287GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-42

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1288GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-43

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1289GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-44

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1290GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-45

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1291GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-46

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1292GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-47

    2014 Note

    SECURITY CONTROL SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1293GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-48

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    NVIS

    A

    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009619368

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AAKWA0624GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-49

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKWA0625GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-50

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1258GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-51

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1259GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-52

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1260GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-53

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1261GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-54

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1262GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-55

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAKIA1263GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-56

    2014 Note

    NVIS
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAKIA1264GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-57

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009016103

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    JMKIA8652GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-58

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
    1.
    2.

    Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when
    the incident/malfunction occurs).
    Check operation condition of the function that is malfunctioning.

    A

    B

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC

    C

    1. Check DTC.
    2. Perform the following procedure if DTC is detected.
    Record DTC and freeze frame data (Print them out using CONSULT.)
    Erase DTC.
    Study the relationship between the cause detected by DTC and the symptom described by the customer.
    3. Check related service bulletins for information.
    Are any symptoms described and any DTC detected?
    Symptom is described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 3.
    Symptom is described, DTC is not detected>>GO TO 4.
    Symptom is not described, DTC is detected>>GO TO 5.

    D

    E

    F

    3.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    G

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Also study the normal operation and fail-safe related to the symptom.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.

    H

    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM

    I

    Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer.
    Verify relation between the symptom and the condition when the symptom is detected.

    J

    >> GO TO 6.

    5.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for the detected DTC, and then check that DTC is detected SEC
    again. At this time, always connect CONSULT to the vehicle, and check self diagnostic results in real time.
    If two or more DTCs are detected, refer to BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart» (BCM) or PCS-20,
    «DTC Index» (IPDM E/R) and determine trouble diagnosis order.
    L
    NOTE:
    • Freeze frame data is useful if the DTC is not detected.
    • Perform Component Function Check if DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE is not included on Service
    M
    Manual. This simplified check procedure is an effective alternative though DTC cannot be detected during
    this check.
    If the result of Component Function Check is NG, it is the same as the detection of DTC by DTC CONFIRN
    MATION PROCEDURE.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    O
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident.

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM BY SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    Detect malfunctioning system according to SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS based on the confirmed symptom in step
    4, and determine the trouble diagnosis order based on possible causes and symptom.
    Is the symptom described?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Monitor input data from related sensors or check voltage of related module terminals using CONSULT.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSIS PROCEDURE
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-59

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Inspect according to Diagnosis Procedure of the system.
    Is malfunctioning part detected?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident.

    8.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnosis Procedure again after repair and replacement.
    Check DTC. If DTC is detected, erase it.
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.FINAL CHECK

    When DTC is detected in step 2, perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE again, and then check that the
    malfunction is repaired securely.
    When symptom is described by the customer, refer to confirmed symptom in step 3 or 4, and check that the
    symptom is not detected.
    Is DTC detected and does symptom remain?
    YES-1 >> DTC is detected: GO TO 7.
    YES-2 >> Symptom remains: GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Before returning the vehicle to the customer, always erase DTC.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-60

    2014 Note

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING CONTROL UNIT

    A

    ECM
    ECM : Description

    INFOID:0000000009016104

    Performing the following procedure can automatically activate re-communication of ECM and BCM, but only
    when the ECM is replaced with a new one*.
    *: New one means an ECM that has never been energized on-board.
    (In this step, initialization procedure using CONSULT is not necessary)
    NOTE:
    • When the replaced ECM is not a brand new, the specified procedure (Initialization and registration)
    using CONSULT is necessary.
    • If multiple keys are attached to the key holder, separate them before beginning work.
    • Distinguish keys with unregistered key IDs from those with registered IDs.

    ECM : Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009016105

    1.PERFORM ECM RE-COMMUNICATING FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Install ECM.
    Contact backside of registered Intelligent key* to push-button ignition switch, then turn ignition switch ON.
    *: To perform this step, use the key that is used before performing ECM replacement.
    Maintain ignition switch in the ON position for at least 5 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Start the engine.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM

    I

    Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    >> Inspection End.

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-61

    2014 Note

    P1610 LOCK MODE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    P1610 LOCK MODE
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009567408

    ECM forcibly switches to the mode that inhibits engine start, when engine start operation is performed 5 times
    or more while communication between ECM and BCM is not normal.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567409

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC P1610 is displayed with other DTC (for BCM or ENGINE), first perform the trouble diagnosis for other
    DTC.
    DTC No.
    P1610

    Trouble diagnosis name
    LOCK MODE

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    When ECM detects a communication malfunction between
    ECM and BCM 5 times or more.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of ENGINE using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-62, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567410

    1.CHECK ENGINE START FUNCTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Check that DTC except for DTC P1610 is not detected.
    If detected, erase the DTC after fixing.
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Depress brake pedal and contact the registered Intelligent Key backside to push-button ignition switch,
    then wait 5 seconds.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Turn ignition switch OFF and wait 5 seconds.
    Repeat steps 3 and 5 twice (a total of 3 times).
    Check that engine can start.
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-62

    2014 Note

    P1611 ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1611 ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567411

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P1611

    ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM

    B
    DTC detecting condition
    The ID verification results between BCM
    and ECM are invalid.

    Possible cause

    C

    • BCM
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of ENGINE using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-63, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    E

    F
    INFOID:0000000009567412

    1.PERFORM INITIALIZATION

    G

    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT
    Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    Can the system be initialized and can the engine be started with registered Intelligent Key?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    1. Select Self Diagnostic Result mode of ENGINE using CONSULT.
    2. Erase DTC.
    3. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC P1611. Refer to SEC-63, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Inspection End

    3.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    Can the system be initialized and can the engine be started with registered Intelligent Key?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.REPLACE ECM
    1.
    2.

    Replace ECM.
    Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform “ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM”.
    Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-63

    2014 Note

    P1612 CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1612 CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567413

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC P1612 is displayed with DTC U1000 (for BCM), first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000.
    Refer to BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC P1612 is displayed with DTC U1010 (for BCM), first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010.
    Refer to BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    P1612

    Trouble diagnosis name

    CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU

    DTC detecting condition

    Inactive communication between ECM
    and BCM

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open or
    shorted.)
    • BCM
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of ENGINE using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-64, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567414

    1.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    Does the engine start?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE ECM

    1.
    2.

    Replace ECM.
    Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform “ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM”.
    Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-64

    2014 Note

    B2192 ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2192 ID DISCORD, IMMU-ECM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567415

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    B2192

    Trouble diagnosis name
    ID DISCORD BCM-ECM

    B
    DTC detecting condition
    The ID verification results between
    BCM and ECM are NG.

    Possible cause

    C

    • BCM
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-65, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    E

    F
    INFOID:0000000009567416

    1.PERFORM INITIALIZATION

    G

    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT
    Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    Can the system be initialized and can the engine be started with registered Intelligent Key?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULT

    1. Select “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    2. Erase DTC.
    3. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC B2192. Refer to SEC-65, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Inspection End

    3.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    Can the system be initialized and can the engine be started with registered Intelligent Key?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.REPLACE ECM
    1.
    2.

    Replace ECM.
    Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform “ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM”.
    Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-65

    2014 Note

    B2193 CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2193 CHAIN OF ECM-IMMU
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567417

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2193 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2193 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    B2193

    Trouble diagnosis name

    CHAIN OF BCM-ECM

    DTC detecting condition

    Inactive communication between BCM
    and ECM

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open or
    shorted.)
    • BCM
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-66, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567418

    1.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    Does the engine start?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.REPLACE ECM

    1.
    2.

    Replace ECM.
    Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform “ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM”.
    Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-66

    2014 Note

    B2195 ANTI-SCANNING
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2195 ANTI-SCANNING

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567419

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    B2195

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name
    ANTI-SCANNING

    DTC detecting condition
    ID verification between BCM and ECM that is
    out of the specified specification is detected.

    Possible cause
    ID verification request out of the
    specified specification

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SEC-67, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    E

    F
    INFOID:0000000009567420

    1.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT 1

    G

    1. Select Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    2. Erase DTC.
    3. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC B2195. Refer to SEC-67, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    H

    I

    2.CHECK EQUIPMENT OF THE VEHICLE

    J

    Check that unspecified accessory part related to engine start is not installed.
    Is unspecified accessory part related to engine start installed?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    SEC

    3.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT 2
    1.

    Obtain the customers approval to remove unspecified accessory part related to engine start, and then
    remove it.
    2. Select Self Diagnostic Result of BCM using CONSULT.
    3. Erase DTC.
    4. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC B2195. Refer to SEC-67, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    L

    M

    N

    4.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.

    O

    P

    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-67

    2014 Note

    B2198 NATS ANTENNA AMP.
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2198 NATS ANTENNA AMP.
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567424

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    B2198

    Trouble diagnosis name

    NATS ANTENNA AMP

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    Inactive communication between NATS
    antenna amp. and BCM is detected when
    BCM enters in the low power consumption
    mode (BCM sleep condition)

    • Harness or connectors
    (NATS antenna amp. circuit is open or
    shorted.)
    • NATS antenna amp.
    • BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.

    Make the conditions that BCM enters in the low power consumption mode (BCM sleep condition).
    Refer to BCS-13, «POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-68, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567425

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-49, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn power switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse in IPDM E/R is not blown.
    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    Battery power supply

    53 (20 A)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the cause of blowing.

    2.CHECK NATS ANTENNA AMP. POWER SUPPLY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect NATS antenna amp. connector.
    Check voltage between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    NATS antenna amp.
    Connector

    Terminal

    M21

    1

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK NATS ANTENNA AMP. POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and NATS antenna amp. connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-68

    2014 Note

    B2198 NATS ANTENNA AMP.
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    IPDM E/R

    NATS antenna amp.

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    35

    M21

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    A

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    C

    4.CHECK NATS ANTENNA AMP. GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and ground.
    D
    NATS antenna amp.
    Connector

    Terminal

    M21

    4

    Continuity

    Ground

    E

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    F

    5.CHECK NATS ANTENNA AMP. COMMUNICATION SIGNAL 1
    Check voltage signal between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and ground using an oscilloscope.

    G

    (+)
    NATS antenna amp.
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    H

    Terminal

    I

    M21

    2

    Intelligent Key: Intelligent
    Key battery is removed

    Ground

    Brake pedal: Depressed
    NOTE:
    Waveform varies each time
    when brake pedal is depressed

    J

    JMKIA6232JP

    Brake pedal: Not depressed

    12

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    SEC

    L

    6.CHECK NATS ANTENNA AMP. OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT 1
    1.
    2.

    NATS antenna amp.

    3.

    M

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and BCM connector.
    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M21

    2

    M18

    21

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and ground.
    NATS antenna amp.
    Connector

    Terminal

    M21

    2

    Ground

    No

    7.CHECK NATS ANTENNA AMP. COMMUNICATION SIGNAL 2
    SEC-69

    O

    P

    Continuity

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    2014 Note

    B2198 NATS ANTENNA AMP.
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check voltage signal between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and ground using an oscilloscope.
    (+)
    NATS antenna amp.
    Connector

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Terminal

    M21

    3

    Intelligent Key: Intelligent
    Key battery is removed

    Ground

    Brake pedal: Depressed
    NOTE:
    Waveform varies each time
    when brake pedal is depressed
    JMKIA6233JP

    Brake pedal: Not depressed

    12

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace NATS antenna amp. Refer to SEC-121, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    8.CHECK NATS ANTENNA AMP. OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT 2
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and BCM connector.
    NATS antenna amp.

    3.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M21

    3

    M18

    25

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between NATS antenna amp. harness connector and ground.
    NATS antenna amp.
    Connector

    Terminal

    M21

    3

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    9.REPLACE BCM

    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    >> Inspection End

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-70

    2014 Note

    B2555 STOP LAMP
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2555 STOP LAMP

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567426

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    B2555

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    STOP LAMP CIRCUIT

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM makes a comparison between the
    upper voltage and lower voltage of stop
    lamp switch. It judges from their values to
    detect the malfunctioning circuit.

    • Harness or connectors
    (Stop lamp switch circuit is open or
    shorted.)
    • Stop lamp switch
    • Fuse
    • BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    C

    D

    E

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Depress brake pedal and wait 1 second or more.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-71, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    G
    INFOID:0000000009567427

    H

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».
    I

    1.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL 1
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    J

    SEC

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    105

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    L

    Is the inspection normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO-1 >> Check 10 A fuse [No. 30, located in the fuse block (J/B)].
    NO-2 >> Check harness for open or short between BCM and fuse.

    M

    2.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    N

    Disconnect stop lamp switch connector.
    Check voltage between stop lamp switch harness connector and ground.

    O

    (+)
    Stop lamp switch
    Connector
    E13 (CVT)
    E57 (MT)

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Terminal
    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check harness for open or short between stop lamp switch and fuse.
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-71

    2014 Note

    P

    B2555 STOP LAMP
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL 2
    1.
    2.

    Connect stop lamp switch connector.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    M18

    9

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    Ground

    Brake pedal

    Depressed

    Battery voltage

    Not depressed

    0

    Is the inspecting result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.REPLACE BCM

    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    >> Inspection End.

    5.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect stop lamp switch connector.
    Check continuity between stop lamp switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Stop lamp switch
    Connector
    E13 (CVT)
    E57 (MT)

    3.

    BCM
    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    2

    M18

    9

    Continuity

    Yes

    Check continuity between stop lamp switch harness connector and ground.
    Stop lamp switch
    Connector
    E13 (CVT)
    E57 (MT)

    Terminal

    Continuity
    Ground

    2

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    6.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH

    Refer to SEC-72, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Replace stop lamp switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View».

    7.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567428

    1.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
    1.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-72

    2014 Note

    B2555 STOP LAMP
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Disconnect stop lamp switch connector.
    3. Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals.
    Stop lamp switch

    Condition

    Terminal
    1

    A

    2

    Brake pedal

    Continuity
    Not depressed

    No

    Depressed

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace stop lamp switch. Refer to BR-19, «Exploded View».

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-73

    2014 Note

    B2556 PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2556 PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567429

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    B2556

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (Push-button ignition switch circuit is
    shorted.)
    • Push-button ignition switch
    • BCM

    BCM detects the push-button ignition switch
    stuck at ON for 100 seconds or more.

    ENG START SW

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Press push-button ignition switch under the following condition.
    Brake pedal: Not depressed
    2. Release push-button ignition switch and wait 100 seconds or more.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-74, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567430

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect push-button ignition switch connector.
    Check voltage between push-button ignition switch harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    8

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    12

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector and IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between push-button ignition switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Push-button ignition switch

    3.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    8

    M98

    76

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between push-button ignition switch harness connector and ground.
    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    8

    Revision: April 2013

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    SEC-74

    2014 Note

    B2556 PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    A

    3.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.

    B

    C

    >> Inspection End.

    4.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT

    D

    Check continuity between push-button ignition switch harness connector and ground.
    Push-button ignition switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    M25

    4

    Ground

    Continuity
    Yes

    E

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    G

    5.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    Refer to SEC-75, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Replace push-button ignition switch. Refer to SEC-122, «Removal and Installation».

    H

    6.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    I

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    J

    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567431

    1.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect push-button ignition switch connector.
    Check continuity between push-button ignition switch terminals.
    Condition

    Terminal
    8

    L

    M

    Push-button ignition switch

    4

    SEC

    Push-button ignition
    switch

    Continuity
    Pressed

    Yes

    Not pressed

    No

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace push-button ignition switch. Refer to SEC-122, «Removal and Installation».

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-75

    2014 Note

    B2557 VEHICLE SPEED
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2557 VEHICLE SPEED
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567432

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2557 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2557 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    B2557

    Trouble diagnosis name

    VEHICLE SPEED

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible causes

    BCM detects one of the following conditions for 10
    seconds continuously.
    • Vehicle speed signal from “combination meter”
    is 10 km/h (6.2 MPH) or more and vehicle
    speed signal from “ABS actuator and electric
    unit (control unit)” is 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or less
    • Vehicle speed signal from “combination meter”
    is 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or less and vehicle speed
    signal from “ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)” is 10 km/h (6.2 MPH) or more

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is
    open or shorted.)
    • Combination meter
    • ABS actuator and electric unit
    (control unit)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start engine and wait 10 seconds or more.
    2. Drive the vehicle at a vehicle speed of 10 km/h (6.2 MPH) or more for 10 seconds or more.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-76, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567433

    1.CHECK DTC OF “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)”
    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of ABS using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC OF COMBINATION METER

    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of METER/M&A using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-76

    2014 Note

    B2601 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2601 SHIFT POSITION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567434

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2601 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2601 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».

    C

    DTC No.

    B2601

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detecting condition

    • Harness or connectors
    (CAN communication line is open or
    shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    [CVT shift selector (park position
    switch) circuit is open or shorted.]
    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM

    When there is a difference between P range
    signal from CVT shift selector (park position
    switch) and P position signal from IPDM E/R
    (CAN).

    SHIFT P SIGNAL

    D

    Possible cause

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    E

    F

    G

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Shift the selector lever to the P position.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait 2 seconds or more.
    3. Shift the selector lever to any position other than P and wait 2 seconds or more.
    4. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-77, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    H

    I

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567435

    J

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR CIRCUIT (BCM)

    L

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT shift selector (park position switch) connector.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and BCM harness
    connector.

    N
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    5.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    8

    M18

    37

    Continuity
    Yes

    O

    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and ground.
    P

    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    8

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-77

    2014 Note

    B2601 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR CIRCUIT (IPDM E/R)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    8

    E47

    80

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.REPLACE BCM

    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    3. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC B2601. Refer to SEC-77, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC B2601 detected again?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-78

    2014 Note

    B2602 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2602 SHIFT POSITION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567436

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2602 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2602 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».

    C

    DTC No.

    B2602

    Trouble diagnosis name

    SHIFT P DIAG

    DTC detecting condition

    BCM detects the following status for 10 seconds.
    • Selector lever is in the P position
    • Vehicle speed is 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or more
    • Ignition switch is in the ON position

    D

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is
    open or shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    [CVT shift selector (park position
    switch) circuit is open or shorted.]
    • CVT shift selector (park position
    switch)
    • Combination meter

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    1. Start engine.
    2. Drive vehicle at a speed of 4 km/h (2.5 MPH) or more for 10 seconds or more.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-79, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    H

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    INFOID:0000000009567437

    J

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DTC OF ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)

    L

    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of ABS using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to BRC-26, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    M

    2.CHECK DTC OF COMBINATION METER

    N

    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of METER/M&A using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT shift selector (park position switch) connector.
    Check voltage between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-79

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    B2602 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    12

    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and BCM harness
    connector.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    3.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    7

    M98

    104

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and ground.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    7

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    >> Inspection End.

    6.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector and IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and BCM harness
    connector.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    3.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    8

    M18

    37

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and ground.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    8

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    7.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR (PARK POSITION SWITCH)

    Refer to SEC-81, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-80

    2014 Note

    B2602 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace CVT shift selector. Refer to TM-227, «Removal and Installation».

    A

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    B

    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567438

    1.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR (PARK POSITION SWITCH)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    D

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT shift selector connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) terminals.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Terminal

    7

    8

    Condition

    Selector lever: P position

    Selector button: Released
    Selector button: Pressed

    Selector lever: Other than P position

    C

    E
    Continuity

    F

    No
    Yes

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace CVT shift selector. Refer to TM-227, «Removal and Installation».

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-81

    2014 Note

    B2603 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2603 SHIFT POSITION
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567439

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2603 is displayed with DTC B2601, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC B2601. Refer to
    SEC-77, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    B2603

    Trouble diagnosis name

    SHIFT POSITION

    DTC detecting condition

    BCM detects the following status when ignition
    switch is in the ON position.
    • Transmission range switch signal: approx. 0 V
    • CVT shift selector (park position switch) signal: approx. 0 V

    Possible causes
    • Harness or connector
    [CVT shift selector (park position
    switch) circuit is open or shorted.]
    • Harness or connectors
    (Transmission range switch circuit is
    open or shorted.)
    • CVT shift selector (park position
    switch)
    • Transmission range switch
    • BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE 1
    1. Shift the selector lever to the P position.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-82, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE 2

    1. Shift the selector lever to the position other than P and N, and wait 1 second or more.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-82, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567440

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.INSPECTION START
    Perform inspection in accordance with procedure that confirms DTC.
    Which procedure confirms DTC?
    DTC confirmation procedure 1>>GO TO 2.
    DTC confirmation procedure 2>>GO TO 8.

    2.CHECK FUSE

    1.
    2.

    Turn power switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse in IPDM E/R is not blown.
    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    Ignition power supply

    49 (10 A)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-82

    2014 Note

    B2603 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the cause of blowing.

    A

    3.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between transmission range switch harness connector and ground.

    B

    C

    (+)
    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Transmission range switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    E

    4.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between transmission range switch harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Transmission range switch

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    7

    E45

    21

    Continuity

    SEC

    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    M98

    102

    Condition

    Ground

    Selector lever

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    P or N position

    Battery voltage

    Other than above

    0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 13.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    M

    O

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between transmission range switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Transmission range switch

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    10

    M98

    102

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    L

    N

    6.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    H

    J

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Connect transmission range switch harness connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    Terminal

    G

    I

    5.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL

    Connector

    F

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    D

    SEC-83

    2014 Note

    P

    B2603 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    7.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH
    Refer to SEC-85, «Component Inspection (Transmission Range Switch)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Replace transmission range switch.

    8.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR POWER SUPPLY

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT shift selector (park position switch) connector.
    Check voltage between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    7

    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    12

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 10.
    NO
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and BCM harness
    connector.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    3.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    7

    M98

    104

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and ground.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    7

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    10.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and BCM harness
    connector.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    3.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    8

    M18

    37

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) harness connector and ground.
    CVT shift selector (park position switch)
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    8

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-84

    2014 Note

    B2603 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    A

    11.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR (PARK POSITION SWITCH)
    Refer to SEC-85, «Component Inspection [CVT Shift Selector (Park Position Switch)]».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 13.
    NO
    >> Replace CVT shift selector. Refer to TM-227, «Removal and Installation».

    B

    C

    12.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    D

    >> Inspection End.

    13.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    E

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.

    F

    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection (Transmission Range Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009567441

    1.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Check continuity between transmission range switch terminals.
    Transmission range switch
    Terminal
    7

    10

    I

    Condition

    Continuity

    P or N position

    Yes

    Other than above

    No

    J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Replace transmission range switch.

    SEC

    Component Inspection [CVT Shift Selector (Park Position Switch)]

    INFOID:0000000009567442

    1.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR (DETENTION SWITCH)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Terminal

    7

    8

    Condition

    Selector lever: P position

    Selector button: Released
    Selector button: Pressed

    Selector lever: Other than P position

    N
    Continuity

    O

    No
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace CVT shift selector. Refer to TM-227, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-85

    L

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT shift selector connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector (park position switch) terminals.
    CVT shift selector (detention switch)

    G

    2014 Note

    P

    B2604 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2604 SHIFT POSITION
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567443

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2604 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2604 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    B2604

    Trouble diagnosis name

    SHIFT PN DIAG CAN

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    The following states are detected for 5 seconds
    while ignition switch is ON.
    • P/N position signal is sent from transmission
    range switch but shift position signal input
    (CAN) from TCM is other than P and N
    • P/N position signal is not sent from transmission range switch but shift position signal input
    (CAN) from TCM is P or N

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is
    open or shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    (Transmission range switch circuit
    is open or shorted.)
    • TCM
    • BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Shift the selector lever to the P position.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait 5 seconds or more.
    3. Shift the selector lever to the N position and wait 5 seconds or more.
    4. Shift the selector lever to any position other than P and N, and wait 5 seconds or more.
    5. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-86, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567444

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DTC OF TCM
    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of TCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK FUSE

    1.
    2.

    Turn power switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse in IPDM E/R is not blown.
    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    Ignition power supply

    49 (10 A)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the cause of blowing.

    3.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-86

    2014 Note

    B2604 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check voltage between transmission range switch harness connector and ground.
    A
    (+)
    Transmission range switch

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    7

    Ground

    B

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    C

    4.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    D

    1.
    2.
    3.

    E

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between transmission range switch harness connector and IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Transmission range switch

    IPDM E/R

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    7

    E45

    21

    Continuity

    F

    Yes

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    5.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL

    H

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    I

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Reconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    J

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Condition

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Terminal

    M98

    SEC

    102

    Ground

    Selector lever

    P or N position

    Battery voltage

    Other than above

    0

    L

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    M

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    N

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between transmission range switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Transmission range switch

    5.

    O

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    10

    M98

    102

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between transmission range switch harness connector and ground.
    Transmission range switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    10

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-87

    2014 Note

    P

    B2604 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    7.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH
    Refer to SEC-88, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace transmission range switch.

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> Inspection End.

    9.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567445

    1.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Check continuity between transmission range switch terminals.
    Transmission range switch
    Terminal
    7

    10

    Condition

    Continuity

    P or N position

    Yes

    Other than above

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace transmission range switch.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-88

    2014 Note

    B2605 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2605 SHIFT POSITION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567446

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2605 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2605 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».

    C

    DTC No.

    B2605

    Trouble diagnosis name

    SHIFT PN DIAG IPDM

    D

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    When ignition switch is ON, P/N position
    signal input from transmission range switch
    and P/N position signal (CAN) input from
    IPDM E/R do not match.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open or
    shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    (Transmission range switch circuit is
    open or shorted.)
    • Transmission range switch
    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    1. Shift the selector lever to the P position.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Shift the selector lever to the N position and wait 1 second or more.
    4. Shift the selector lever to any position other than P and N, and wait 1 second or more.
    5. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-89, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    H

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009567447

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».
    L

    1.CHECK IPDM E/R INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    M

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    IPDM E/R

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    Condition

    Ground

    Selector lever

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    P or N position

    Battery voltage

    Other than above

    0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    O

    P

    2.CHECK IPDM E/R INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    SEC-89

    2014 Note

    B2605 SHIFT POSITION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4. Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and transmission range switch harness connector.
    IPDM E/R

    5.

    Transmission range switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    F52

    10

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL
    1.

    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    102

    Condition

    Ground

    Selector lever

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    P or N position

    Battery voltage

    Other than above

    0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK BCM INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and transmission range switch harness connector.
    BCM

    5.

    Transmission range switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    102

    F52

    10

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    102

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the
    on-screen instructions.
    3. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for B2605. Refer to SEC-89, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC B2605 detected again?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.
    Revision: April 2013

    S E C -9 0

    2014 Note

    B2608 STARTER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2608 STARTER RELAY

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567448

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2608 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2608 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2608 is displayed with other DTC (BCM), first perform the trouble diagnosis for other DTC detected.

    C

    DTC No.

    B2608

    Trouble diagnosis name

    STARTER RELAY

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM outputs starter relay OFF signal but
    BCM receives starter relay ON signal from
    IPDM E/R (CAN).

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open or
    shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    (Starter relay circuit is open or shorted.)
    • IPDM E/R
    • Starter relay

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    E

    F

    G

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Press push-button ignition switch under the following conditions to start engine.
    Selector lever: In the P position
    Brake pedal: Depressed
    2. Wait 1 second after engine started.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-91, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009567449

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».
    L

    1.CHECK DTC OF IPDM E/R
    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK STARTER RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    M

    N

    O

    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    97

    Ground

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    CVT selector lever

    N or P position
    Other than above

    Battery voltage
    0

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-91

    2014 Note

    P

    B2608 STARTER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK STARTER RELAY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect starter relay.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between starter relay harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Starter relay

    5.

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E41

    1

    M98

    97

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between starter relay harness connector and ground.
    Starter relay
    Connector

    Terminal

    E41

    1

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    4.CHECK STARTER RELAY

    Refer to SEC-92, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace starter relay.

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    3. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for B2605. Refer to SEC-89, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC B2605 detected again?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009567450

    1.CHECK STARTER RELAY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect starter relay.
    Check continuity between starter relay terminals.
    Starter relay

    Condition

    Terminal
    3

    5

    Continuity

    12 V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2

    Yes

    No current supply

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace starter relay.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-92

    2014 Note

    B260F ENGINE STATUS
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B260F ENGINE STATUS

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009567451

    BCM receives the engine status signal from ECM via CAN communication.

    DTC Logic

    B
    INFOID:0000000009567452

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    C

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B260F is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B260F is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».

    D

    DTC No.

    B260F

    Trouble diagnosis name

    ECM CAN COMM

    E

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM has not yet received the engine status
    signal from ECM when ignition switch is in
    the ON position.

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open
    or shorted.)
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait 2 seconds or more.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-93, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    I
    INFOID:0000000009567453

    J

    1.INSPECTION START
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    3. Touch ERASE.
    4. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC B260F. Refer to SEC-93, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.REPLACE ECM
    1.
    2.

    F

    SEC

    L

    M

    Replace ECM.
    Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform “ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING ECM”.
    Refer to EC-111, «Work Procedure».

    N

    >> Inspection End.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-93

    2014 Note

    B261F ASCD CLUTCH SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B261F ASCD CLUTCH SWITCH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009606317

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC B261F is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B261F is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    B261F

    CONSULT screen items
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    ASCD CNCL/CLTCH SW
    (ASCD clutch interlock
    switch)

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM detects the following status for 10 seconds
    3 times
    • Clutch interlock switch input: 0 V
    • Vehicle speed: 40 km/h (24.8 MPH) or more

    • Harness or connectors.
    (CAN communication line is open
    or shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors.
    (Clutch interlock switch circuit is
    open or shorted)
    • Clutch interlock switch
    • Combination meter
    • BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start the engine.
    2. Drive vehicle at a speed of 40 km/h (24.8 MPH) or more for 10 seconds.
    3. Decrease the vehicle speed to below 40 km/h (24.8 MPH).
    4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 twice (total of 3 times).
    5. Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-94, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009606318

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DTC OF COMBINATION METER
    Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “METER/M&A” using CONSULT.
    Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK FUSE

    1.
    2.

    Turn power switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse in the fuse block (J/B) is not blown.
    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    Ignition power supply

    10 (10 A)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the cause of blowing.
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-94

    2014 Note

    B261F ASCD CLUTCH SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    A

    Disconnect clutch interlock switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between clutch interlock switch harness connector and ground.

    B

    (+)
    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Clutch interlock switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E34

    1

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    4.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    C

    E

    Connect clutch interlock switch connector.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    F

    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    101

    Condition

    Ground

    Clutch pedal

    Voltage

    Released

    6 – 16 V

    Depressed

    0 – 1.5 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    G

    H

    I

    5.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.

    SEC

    >> Inspection End

    6.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between clutch interlock switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Clutch interlock switch

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E34

    2

    M98

    101

    L

    M

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    N

    O

    7.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    P

    Refer to SEC-96, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace clutch interlock switch. Refer to CL-10, «Exploded View».

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-95

    2014 Note

    B261F ASCD CLUTCH SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    >> Inspection End

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009606319

    1.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect clutch interlock switch connector.
    Check continuity between clutch interlock switch terminals.
    Clutch interlock switch

    Condition

    Terminal
    1

    2

    Clutch pedal

    Continuity
    Not depressed

    No

    Depressed

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Replace clutch interlock switch. Refer to CL-10, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-96

    2014 Note

    B2620 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2620 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009606320

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B2620 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B2620 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».

    B

    C

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    B2620

    D

    CONSULT screen items
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    NEUTRAL SW
    (Neutral switch)

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM detects the following status for 10 seconds 3 times
    • Park/neutral position switch input: Battery
    voltage
    • Vehicle speed: 40 km/h (24.8 MPH) or more

    • Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is open
    or shorted.)
    • Harness or connector
    (Park/neutral position switch circuit
    is open or shorted)
    • Park/neutral position switch
    • Combination meter
    • BCM

    E

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    H

    1. Start the engine.
    2. Drive vehicle at a speed of 40 km/h (24.8 MPH) or more for 10 seconds.
    3. Decrease the vehicle speed to below 40 km/h (24.8 MPH).
    4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 twice (total of 3 times).
    5. Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-97, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End

    I

    J

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009606321

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-49, «Wiring Diagram».

    L

    1.CHECK DTC OF COMBINATION METER

    M

    Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “METER/M&A” using CONSULT.
    Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    N

    2.CHECK FUSE
    1.
    2.

    O

    Turn power switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse in the fuse block (J/B) is not blown.

    P

    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    Ignition power supply

    3 (10 A)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the cause of blowing.
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-97

    2014 Note

    B2620 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect park/neutral position switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between park/neutral position switch harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Park/neutral position switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    F24

    2

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    4.CHECK PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Connect park/neutral position switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.
    (+)
    BCM

    (–)

    Connector

    Terminal

    M98

    102

    Condition

    Ground

    Shift lever

    Voltage

    Neutral position

    Battery voltage

    Except neutral position

    0 – 1.5 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    5.REPLACE BCM

    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    >> Inspection End

    6.CHECK PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect park/neutral position switch connector.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between park/neutral position switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Park/neutral position switch

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F24

    3

    M98

    102

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    7.CHECK PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH

    Refer to SEC-99, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace park/neutral position switch. Refer to TM-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-98

    2014 Note

    B2620 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    A

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> Inspection End

    B

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009606322

    1.CHECK PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect park/neutral position switch connector.
    Check continuity between park/neutral position switch terminals.
    Park/neutral position switch

    Condition

    Terminal
    2

    3

    Shift lever

    D

    Continuity

    Neutral position

    Yes

    Except neutral position

    No

    E

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Replace park/neutral position switch. Refer to TM-18, «Removal and Installation».

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-99

    2014 Note

    B26E8 CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26E8 CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009606323

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.

    B26E8

    CONSULT screen items
    (Trouble diagnosis content)

    CLUTCH SW
    (Clutch switch)

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM detects the following conditions for 2
    seconds or more.
    • Clutch pedal position switch: ON
    (Clutch pedal is released)
    • Clutch interlock switch: ON
    (Clutch pedal is depressed)

    • Harness or connector
    (Clutch interlock switch circuit is
    open or shorted)
    • Harness or connector
    (Clutch pedal position switch circuit
    is open or shorted)
    • Clutch interlock switch
    • Clutch pedal position switch
    • BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE 1
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Wait 2 seconds or more under the following conditions.
    Shift lever: In the neutral position.
    Clutch pedal: Depressed
    3. Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-100, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE 2

    1. Release clutch pedal and wait 2 seconds or more.
    2. Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-100, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009634425

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DTC OF COMBINATION METER
    Check DTC in “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “METER/M&A” using CONSULT.
    Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK FUSE

    1.
    2.

    Turn power switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse in the fuse block (J/B) is not blown.
    Signal name

    Fuse No.

    Ignition power supply

    10 (10 A)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-100

    2014 Note

    B26E8 CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the cause of blowing.

    A

    3.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect clutch interlock switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between clutch interlock switch harness connector and ground.

    B

    C

    (+)
    (–)

    Voltage (V)
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Clutch interlock switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E34

    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    E

    4.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    F

    Connect clutch interlock switch connector.
    Check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    G

    (+)
    BCM
    Connector

    (–)

    Condition

    Voltage

    Terminal

    M98

    101

    Ground

    Clutch pedal

    Released

    6 – 16 V

    Depressed

    0 – 1.5 V

    5.REPLACE BCM

    J

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSEC
    SULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    >> Inspection End

    L

    6.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    1.
    2.

    D

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM connector.
    Check continuity between clutch interlock switch harness connector and BCM harness connector.
    Clutch interlock switch

    BCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E34

    2

    M98

    101

    Continuity

    N

    Yes

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    7.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH

    P

    Refer to SEC-96, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Replace clutch interlock switch. Refer to CL-10, «Exploded View».

    8.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Revision: April 2013

    M

    SEC-101

    2014 Note

    B26E8 CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> Inspection End

    Component Inspection (Clutch Interlock Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009606325

    1.CHECK CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.
    .

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect clutch interlock switch connector.
    Check continuity between clutch interlock switch terminals.
    Clutch interlock switch

    Condition

    Terminal
    1

    2

    Clutch pedal

    Continuity

    Depressed

    Yes

    Not depressed

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End
    NO
    >> Replace clutch interlock switch. Refer to CL-10, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-102

    2014 Note

    B26F3 STARTER CONTROL RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26F3 STARTER CONTROL RELAY

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567454

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B26F3 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B26F3 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».

    C

    DTC No.

    B26F3

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    D

    BCM requests IPDM E/R to turn starter
    control relay OFF, but BCM cannot receive
    starter control relay OFF state signal from
    IPDM E/R (CAN).

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open
    or shorted.)
    • IPDM E/R

    E

    Trouble diagnosis name

    START CONT RLY ON

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Press push-button ignition switch under the following conditions to start engine.
    Selector lever: In the P position
    Brake pedal: Not depressed
    2. Wait 2 seconds after engine started.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-103, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    G

    H

    I
    INFOID:0000000009567455

    1.CHECK DTC OF IPDM E/R

    J

    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the diagnosis procedure related to the detected DTC. Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    SEC

    L

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    M

    >> Inspection End.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-103

    2014 Note

    B26F4 STARTER CONTROL RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26F4 STARTER CONTROL RELAY
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567456

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC B26F4 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B26F4 is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    B26F4

    Trouble diagnosis name

    START CONT RLY OFF

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    BCM requests IPDM E/R to turn starter
    control relay ON, but BCM cannot receive
    starter control relay ON state signal from
    IPDM E/R (CAN).

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open
    or shorted.)
    • IPDM E/R

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.

    Press push-button ignition switch under the following conditions to start engine, and wait 1 second or
    more.
    Selector lever: In the P position
    Brake pedal: Not depressed
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-104, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567457

    1.CHECK DTC OF IPDM E/R
    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the diagnosis procedure related to the detected DTC. Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-104

    2014 Note

    B26F7 BCM
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26F7 BCM

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567458

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    B26F7

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name
    BCM

    DTC detecting condition
    Inside key antenna output circuit in BCM is malfunctioning.

    Possible cause

    C

    BCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1. Press door request switch.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-105, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    E

    F
    INFOID:0000000009567459

    1.INSPECTION START

    G

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    3. Touch ERASE.
    4. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC B26F7. Refer to SEC-105, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC B26F7 detected again?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    H

    I

    J

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    SEC
    >> Inspection End.
    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-105

    2014 Note

    B26FB CLUTCH SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26FB CLUTCH SWITCH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009606327

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    • If DTC B26FB is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B26FB is displayed with DTC U1010, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1010. Refer to
    BCS-58, «DTC Logic».
    DTC No.

    B26FB

    CONSULT screen items
    (Trouble diagnosis content)
    CLUTCH SWITCH
    (Clutch switch)

    DTC detecting condition
    BCM receives the abnormal signal of clutch
    pedal position switch from ECM via CAN
    communication.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is
    open or shorted)
    • ECM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-106, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009606328

    1.INSPECTION START
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select Self diagnostic result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    3. Touch ERASE.
    4. Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for DTC B26FB. Refer to SEC-106, «DTC Logic».
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End

    2.REPLACE ECM

    Replace ECM. Refer to EC-338, «Removal and Installation»
    >> Inspection End

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-106

    2014 Note

    B26FC KEY REGISTRATION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B26FC KEY REGISTRATION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567460

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC No.
    B26FC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name
    KEY REGISTRATION

    DTC detecting condition
    Intelligent Key that does not match the vehicle is
    registered.

    Possible cause
    • Improper registration operation
    • Intelligent Key
    • BCM

    C

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    1.

    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    2. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-107, «Diagnosis Procedure»
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    G

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    INFOID:0000000009567461

    1.REPLACE INTELLIGENT KEY
    1.
    2.

    Prepare Intelligent Key that matches the vehicle.
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    3. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    F

    H

    I

    J

    2.REPLACE BCM
    1.
    2.

    Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    SEC
    Perform initialization of BCM and registration of all Intelligent Keys using CONSULT. Refer to the CONSULT Immobilizer mode and follow the on-screen instructions.
    L

    >> Inspection End.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-107

    2014 Note

    B210B STARTER CONTROL RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B210B STARTER CONTROL RELAY
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567462

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    NOTE:
    If DTC B210B is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to BCS57, «DTC Logic».
    CONSULT Display

    START CONT RLY ON
    [B210B]

    DTC Detection Condition
    When comparing the following items, IPDM E/R
    detects that starter control relay is stuck in the
    ON position for 1 second or more.
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter relay status signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter control relay and starter relay status
    signal (IPDM E/R input)
    • Starter control relay control signal (IPDM E/R
    output)
    • Transmission range switch signal input

    Possible Cause

    IPDM E/R

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC B210B displayed?
    YES >> Refer to SEC-108, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567463

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is display history of DTC B210B CRNT?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-108

    2014 Note

    B210C STARTER CONTROL RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B210C STARTER CONTROL RELAY

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567464

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B210C is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • When IPDM E/R power supply voltage is low (Approx. 7 — 8 V for about 1 second), the DTC B210C may be
    detected.

    C

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    STR CONT RLY OFF CIRC
    [B210C]

    D

    Possible Cause

    When comparing the following items, IPDM E/R
    detects that starter control relay is stuck in the
    OFF position for 1 second or more.
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter relay status signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter control relay and starter relay status
    signal (IPDM E/R input)
    • Starter control relay control signal (IPDM E/R
    output)

    E
    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM
    • Battery

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC B210C displayed?
    YES >> Refer to SEC-109, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    H

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION

    I

    J

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567465

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».
    L

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is display history of DTC B210C CRNT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    M

    2.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUITS VOLTAGE

    N

    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connectors and ground.
    O

    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E44 (WITH M/T)

    13

    F42 (WITH CVT)

    40

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO (WITH M/T)>>GO TO 3.
    NO (WITH CVT)>>GO TO 4.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-109

    2014 Note

    P

    B210C STARTER CONTROL RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector E44 and clutch interlock switch connector E34.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E44 and clutch interlock switch connector E34.
    IPDM E/R

    3.
    4.

    Clutch interlock switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E44

    13

    E34

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Disconnect BCM connector M98.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E44 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E44

    13

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector F42 and transmission range switch connector F52.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector F42 and transmission range switch connector F52.
    IPDM E/R

    3.
    4.

    Transmission range switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    F52

    10

    Continuity
    Yes

    Disconnect BCM connector M98.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector F42 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-110

    2014 Note

    B210D STARTER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B210D STARTER RELAY

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567466

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    If DTC B210D is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to BCS57, «DTC Logic».

    C

    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    Possible Cause

    When comparing the following items, IPDM E/R
    detects that starter control relay is stuck in the
    ON position for 5 second or more.
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter relay status signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter control relay and starter relay status
    signal (IPDM E/R input)
    • Starter control relay control signal (IPDM E/R
    output)

    STARTER RLY ON CIRC
    [B210D]

    D
    • Harness or connectors (starter motor relay
    control circuit open or short)
    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION

    G

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC B210D displayed?
    YES >> Refer to SEC-111, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    H

    I

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567467

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    J

    SEC

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    L

    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is display history of DTC B210D CRNT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    M

    2.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUITS VOLTAGE
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connectors and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E44

    13

    F42

    40

    N
    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO (WITH M/T)>>GO TO 3.
    NO (WITH CVT)>>GO TO 4.

    3.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connectors E44, BCM connector M98, clutch interlock switch connector E34.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-111

    O

    2014 Note

    B210D STARTER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E44 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E44

    13

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to SEC-91, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connectors F42, BCM connector M98, transmission range switch connector F52.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector F42 and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to SEC-91, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-112

    2014 Note

    B210E STARTER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B210E STARTER RELAY

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567469

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    • If DTC B210E is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
    BCS-57, «DTC Logic».
    • If DTC B210E is displayed with DTC B2605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC B2605. Refer to
    SEC-89, «DTC Logic».
    • When IPDM E/R power supply voltage is low (Approx. 7 — 8 V for about 1 second), the DTC B210F may be
    detected.
    CONSULT Display

    DTC Detection Condition

    D

    Possible Cause

    E

    When comparing the following items, IPDM E/R
    detects that starter control relay is stuck in the
    OFF position for 5 second or more.
    • Starter control relay signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter relay status signal (CAN) from BCM
    • Starter control relay and starter relay status
    signal (IPDM E/R input)
    • Starter control relay control signal (IPDM E/R
    output)

    STARTER RELAY OFF
    [B210E]

    C

    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM
    • Battery

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION

    H

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON.
    4. Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC B210E displayed?
    YES >> Refer to SEC-113, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    I

    J

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567470

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    L

    1. PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    M

    Perform Self Diagnostic Result of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is display history of DTC B210E CRNT?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    N

    2.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUITS VOLTAGE

    O

    Check voltage between IPDM E/R connectors and ground.
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E44

    13

    F42

    40

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO (WITH M/T)>>GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-113

    2014 Note

    P

    B210E STARTER RELAY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO (WITH CVT)>>GO TO 4.

    3.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector E44 and clutch interlock switch connector E34.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector E44 and clutch interlock switch connector E34.
    IPDM E/R

    Clutch interlock switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E44

    13

    E34

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    4.CHECK STARTER CONTROL RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector F42 and transmission range switch connector F52.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R connector F42 and transmission range switch connector F52.
    IPDM E/R

    Transmission range switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    F52

    10

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-114

    2014 Note

    B210F SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B210F SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567472

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    If DTC B210F is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to BCS57, «DTC Logic».

    C

    DTC No.

    B210F

    Trouble diagnosis name

    INTRLCK/PNP SW ON

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    IPDM E/R detects a difference between the
    following signals
    • P/N position signal from transmission
    range switch and P/N position signal
    (CAN) from BCM

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open
    or shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    (Transmission range switch circuit is
    open or shorted.)
    • Transmission range switch
    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM

    D

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    1. Shift selector lever to the P position.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Shift selector lever to the N position and wait 1 second or more.
    4. Shift selector lever to the position other than P and N, and wait 1 second or more.
    5. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-115, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    I

    INFOID:0000000009567473

    J

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DTC OF BCM

    L

    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    M

    2.CHECK IPDM E/R SIGNAL CIRCUIT OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    IPDM E/R

    5.

    N

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and transmission range switch harness connector.
    Transmission range switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    F52

    10

    P
    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-115

    O

    2014 Note

    B210F SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    (–)

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-116

    2014 Note

    B2110 SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B2110 SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009567474

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC

    B

    NOTE:
    If DTC B2110 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to BCS57, «DTC Logic».

    C

    DTC No.

    B210F

    Trouble diagnosis name

    INTRLCK/PNP SW OFF

    DTC detecting condition

    Possible cause

    IPDM E/R detects a difference between the
    following signals
    • P/N position signal from transmission
    range switch and P/N position signal
    (CAN) from BCM

    • Harness or connectors
    (The CAN communication line is open
    or shorted.)
    • Harness or connectors
    (Transmission range switch circuit is
    open or shorted.)
    • Transmission range switch
    • IPDM E/R
    • BCM

    D

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    1. Shift selector lever to the P position.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait 1 second or more.
    3. Shift selector lever to the N position and wait 1 second or more.
    4. Shift selector lever to the position other than P and N, and wait 1 second or more.
    5. Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of IPDM E/R using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Go to SEC-117, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    I

    INFOID:0000000009567475

    J

    SEC

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to SEC-24, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK DTC OF BCM

    L

    Check DTC in Self Diagnostic Result mode of BCM using CONSULT.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis related to the detected DTC. Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    M

    2.CHECK IPDM E/R SIGNAL CIRCUIT OPEN AND SHORT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    IPDM E/R

    5.

    N

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and transmission range switch harness connector.
    Transmission range switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    F52

    10

    P
    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-117

    O

    2014 Note

    B2110 SHIFT POSITION/CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    (+)
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    F42

    40

    (–)

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-118

    2014 Note

    ENGINE DOES NOT START WHEN INTELLIGENT KEY IS INSIDE OF VEHICLE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    ENGINE DOES NOT START WHEN INTELLIGENT KEY IS INSIDE OF VEHICLE
    Description

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009567487

    Engine does not start when push-button ignition switch is pressed while carrying Intelligent Key.
    NOTE:
    • Check that vehicle is under the condition shown in “Conditions of vehicle” before starting diagnosis, and
    check each symptom.
    • The engine start function, door lock function, power distribution system, and NATS-IVIS/NVIS in the Intelligent Key system are closely related to each other regarding control. The vehicle security function can operate only when the door lock and power distribution system are operating normally.

    C

    Conditions of Vehicle (Operating Conditions)

    E

    • “ENGINE START BY I-KEY” setting in “WORK SUPPORT” mode of “INTELLIGENT KEY” of “BCM” is ON.
    • One or more of Intelligent Keys with registered Intelligent Key ID is in the vehicle.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    F

    INFOID:0000000009567488

    1.PERFORM WORK SUPPORT

    G

    Perform “INSIDE ANT DIAGNOSIS” in “Work Support” mode of “INTELLIGENT KEY” of “BCM” using CONSULT.
    Refer to BCS-21, «INTELLIGENT KEY : CONSULT Function (BCM — INTELLIGENT KEY)».

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULT

    I

    Select “Self Diagnostic Result” mode of “BCM”, and check whether or not DTC of inside key antenna is
    detected.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for detected DTC. Refer to BCS-46, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH

    Check push-button ignition switch.
    Refer to SEC-75, «Component Inspection».
    Is the operation normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    4.CONFIRM THE OPERATION

    Confirm the operation again.
    Is the inspection normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> GO TO 1.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-119

    2014 Note

    SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON OR BLINK
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON OR BLINK
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009567489

    Security indicator lamp does not blink when power supply position is other than the ON position.
    NOTE:
    • Before performing the diagnosis, perform “Work Flow”. Refer to SEC-58, «Work Flow».
    • Check that vehicle is under the condition shown in “Conditions of vehicle” before starting diagnosis, and
    check each symptom.

    Conditions of Vehicle (Operating Conditions)
    Power supply position is other than the ON position.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009567490

    1.CHECK SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP
    Check security indicator lamp.
    Refer to SEC-15, «VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM : System Description».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CONFIRM THE OPERATION

    Confirm the operation again.
    Is the result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> GO TO 1.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-120

    2014 Note

    NATS ANTENNA AMP.
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    NATS ANTENNA AMP.
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009541301

    B

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove cluster lid A. Refer to IP-21, «Removal and Installation».
    Release pawls and remove NATS antenna amp. (1).
    : Pawl

    C

    D

    E

    F
    ALKIA3179ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    • If NATS antenna amp. is not installed correctly, NVIS (NATS) system will not operate properly and «SELFDIAG RESULTS» on CONSULT screen will show «LOCK MODE» or «CHAIN OF IMMU-KEY».
    • Initialization is not necessary when only the NATS antenna amp. is replaced with a new one.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-121

    2014 Note

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009541302

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove NATS antenna amp. Refer to SEC-121, «Removal and Installation».
    Release pawls and remove push-button ignition switch (1).
    : Pawl

    ALKIA3180ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-122

    2014 Note

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY RECEIVER
    Removal and Installation

    A
    INFOID:0000000009541303

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    Remove the glove box assembly. Refer to IP-25, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector (A) from remote keyless entry
    receiver (1).
    Remove screw (B) and remove remote keyless entry receiver.

    C

    D

    E

    ALKIA3178ZZ

    INSTALLATION

    F

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    G

    H

    I

    J

    SEC

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SEC-123

    2014 Note

    RESTRAINTS

    SECTION

    SR

    SRS AIRBAG

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..12

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    SPIRAL CABLE ………………………………………… 15

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Service ……………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 4

    Exploded View …………………………………………………15
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..15

    F

    G

    FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE …… 17
    Exploded View …………………………………………………17
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..17

    CRASH ZONE SENSOR …………………………….. 19

    SR

    I

    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 4

    Exploded View …………………………………………………19
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..19

    BASIC INSPECTION ……………………………… 5

    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT ……………………….. 21

    J

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 4

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS ……………………………… 5

    Exploded View …………………………………………………21
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..21

    For Frontal Collision ………………………………………….. 5
    For Side and Rollover Collision …………………………… 7

    SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER …………………… 23

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 12

    K

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..23

    FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH ………. 24

    DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE …………………………12

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..24

    L

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 12
    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009486765

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Service

    INFOID:0000000009486767

    • Do not use electrical test equipment to check SRS circuits unless instructed to in this Service Manual.
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery cables and wait at least three
    minutes.
    For approximately three minutes after the cables are removed, it is still possible for the air bag and seat belt
    pre-tensioner to deploy. Therefore, do not work on any SRS connectors or wires until at least three minutes
    have passed.
    • Diagnosis sensor unit must always be installed with their arrow marks “⇐” pointing towards the front of the
    vehicle for proper operation. Also check diagnosis sensor unit for cracks, deformities or rust before installation and replace as required.
    • The spiral cable must be aligned with the neutral position since its rotations are limited. Do not turn steering
    wheel and column after removal of steering gear.
    • Handle air bag module carefully. Always place driver and front passenger air bag modules with the pad side
    facing upward and seat mounted front side air bag module standing with the stud bolt side facing down.
    • Conduct self-diagnosis to check entire SRS for proper function after replacing any components.
    • After air bag inflates, the instrument panel assembly should be replaced if damaged.
    • Always replace instrument panel pad following front passenger air bag deployment.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009486766

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    Revision: April 2013

    SR-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SR

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009486770

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-4

    2014 Note

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    For Frontal Collision

    INFOID:0000000009486771

    B

    FOR FRONTAL COLLISION: When SRS is activated in a collision
    C

    CAUTION:
    Due to varying models and option levels, not all parts listed in the chart below apply to all vehicles.
    WORK PROCEDURE
    1. Before performing any of the following steps, ensure that all vehicle body and structural repairs have been
    completed.
    2. Replace the diagnosis sensor unit.
    3. Remove the front air bag modules, crash zone sensor assembly, bracket and seat belt pre-tensioner
    assemblies.
    4. Check the SRS components using the table below:
    Replace any SRS components showing visible signs of damage. (dents, cracks and deformation, etc.)
    5. Install new front air bag modules, crash zone sensor assembly, bracket and seat belt pre-tensioner
    assemblies.
    6. Perform self-diagnosis using CONSULT or air bag warning lamp. Refer to SRC-9, «Description» for details.
    Ensure entire SRS operates properly.
    7. After the work is completed, perform self-diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    SRS INSPECTION (FOR FRONTAL COLLISION)
    Part

    Inspection

    Driver air bag module

    If the driver air bag has deployed:
    REPLACE
    Install with new fasteners.

    Front passenger air bag module
    (if equipped)

    If the front passenger air bag has deployed:
    REPLACE
    Install with new fasteners.

    Crash zone sensor

    If any of the front air bags or seat belt pre-tensioners* have been activated:
    REPLACE the crash zone sensor and bracket with new fasteners.
    *: Confirm seat belt pre-tensioner activation using CONSULT only.

    Seat belt pre-tensioner assemblies
    (All applicable locations: buckle,
    reel, lap outer)

    If either the driver or passenger seat belt pre-tensioner* has been activated:
    REPLACE all seat belt pre-tensioner assemblies with new fasteners.
    *: Confirm seat belt pre-tensioner activation using CONSULT only.

    Diagnosis sensor unit

    If any of the SRS components have been activated:
    REPLACE the diagnosis sensor unit.
    Install with new fasteners.

    Steering wheel

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    If the driver front air bag has deployed:
    REPLACE the spiral cable.

    Occupant classification system
    (Passenger seat)

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Revision: April 2013

    F

    G

    SR

    J

    K

    L

    M

    Remove passenger seat assembly.
    Check control unit case for dents, cracks of deformities.
    Check connectors for damage and terminals for deformities.
    Check seat frame and cushion pan for dents or deformities.
    If no damage is found, reinstall seat with new fasteners.
    If damaged — REPLACE seat cushion assembly with new fasteners.

    SR-5

    E

    I

    Visually check steering wheel for deformities.
    Check harness (built into steering wheel) and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    Install driver air bag module into the steering wheel to check fit and alignment with the wheel.
    Check steering wheel for excessive free play.
    If no damage is found, reinstall.
    If damaged—REPLACE.

    Spiral cable

    D

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Part

    Inspection

    Harness and connectors

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Check connectors for poor connection, damage, and terminals for deformities.
    Check harness for binding, chafing, cuts, or deformities.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the harness and connectors.
    If damaged—REPLACE the damaged harness. Do not attempt to repair, splice or modify any
    SRS harness.

    Instrument panel assembly

    If the passenger front air bag has deployed:
    REPLACE the instrument panel assembly. (integrated type)

    FOR FRONTAL COLLISION: When SRS is not activated in a collision
    CAUTION:
    Due to varying models and option levels, not all parts listed in the chart below apply to all vehicles.
    WORK PROCEDURE
    1. Before performing any of the following steps, ensure that all vehicle body and structural repairs have been
    completed.
    2. Check the SRS components using the table below:
    Replace any SRS components showing visible signs of damage. (dents, cracks and deformation, etc.)
    3. Perform self-diagnosis using CONSULT or air bag warning lamp. Refer to SRC-9, «Description» for details.
    Ensure entire SRS operates properly.
    4. After the work is completed, perform self-diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    SRS INSPECTION (FOR FRONTAL COLLISION)
    Part

    Inspection

    Driver air bag module

    If the driver air bag has NOT been activated:
    1.
    Remove driver air bag module. Check harness cover and connectors for damage, terminals
    for deformities, and harness for binding.
    2.
    Install driver air bag module into the steering wheel to check fit and alignment with the wheel.
    3.
    If no damage is found, reinstall with new fasteners.
    4.
    If damaged—REPLACE. Install driver air bag modules with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.

    Front passenger air bag module
    (if equipped)

    If the front passenger air bag has NOT been activated:
    1.
    Remove front passenger air bag module. Check harness cover and connectors for damage,
    terminals for deformities, and harness for binding.
    2.
    Install front passenger air bag module into the instrument panel to check fit with the instrument
    panel.
    3.
    If no damage is found, reinstall with new fasteners.
    4.
    If damaged—REPLACE. Install front passenger air bag modules with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.

    Crash zone sensor

    If the front air bags or seat belt pre-tensioners have NOT been activated:
    1.
    Remove the crash zone sensor. Check harness connectors for damage, terminals for deformities, and harness for binding.
    2.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, cracks, deformation) of the crash zone sensor and
    bracket.
    3.
    Install the crash zone sensor to check fit.
    4.
    If no damage is found, reinstall with new fasteners.
    5.
    If damaged—REPLACE the crash zone sensor and bracket with new fasteners.

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-6

    2014 Note

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Part
    Seat belt pre-tensioner assemblies
    (All applicable locations: buckle,
    reel, lap outer)

    Diagnosis sensor unit

    Steering wheel

    Inspection
    If the pre-tensioners have NOT been activated:
    1.
    Remove seat belt pre-tensioners.
    Check harness cover and connectors for damage, terminals for deformities, and harness for
    binding.
    2.
    Check belts for damage and anchors for loose mounting.
    3.
    Check retractor for smooth operation.
    4.
    Check seat belt adjuster for damage.
    5.
    Check for deformities of the center pillar inner.
    6.
    If no damage is found, reinstall seat belt pre-tensioner assembly with new fasteners.
    7.
    If damaged—REPLACE. Install the seat belt pre-tensioner assembly with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.

    C

    D

    E

    1.
    2.

    F

    Visually check steering wheel for deformities.
    Check harness (built into steering wheel) and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    Install driver air bag module into the steering wheel to check fit and alignment with the wheel.
    Check steering wheel for excessive free play.
    If no damage is found, reinstall.
    If damaged—REPLACE.

    If the driver front air bag has not deployed:
    1.
    Visually check spiral cable and combination switch for damage.
    2.
    Check connectors and protective tape for damage.
    3.
    Check steering wheel for noise, binding or heavy operation.
    4.
    If no damage is found, reinstall.
    5.
    If damaged—REPLACE.

    I

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove passenger seat assembly.
    Check control unit case for dents, cracks of deformities.
    Check connectors for damage and terminals for deformities.
    Check seat frame and cushion pan for dents or deformities.
    If no damage is found, reinstall seat with new fasteners.
    If damaged — REPLACE seat cushion assembly with new fasteners.

    Harness and connectors

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Check connectors for poor connection, damage, and terminals for deformities.
    Check harness for binding, chafing, cuts, or deformities.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the harness and connectors.
    If damaged—REPLACE the damaged harness. Do not attempt to repair, splice or modify any
    SRS harness.

    J

    K

    If the passenger front air bag has NOT deployed:
    1.
    Visually check instrument panel for damage.
    2.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the instrument panel assembly.
    3.
    If damaged—REPLACE the instrument panel assembly.

    For Side and Rollover Collision

    G

    SR

    Occupant classification system
    (Passenger seat)

    Instrument panel assembly

    B

    If none of the SRS components have been activated:
    1.
    Check case for dents, cracks or deformities.
    2.
    Check connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    3.
    If no damage is found, reinstall with new fasteners.
    4.
    If damaged—REPLACE. Install diagnosis sensor unit with new fasteners.

    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    Spiral cable

    A

    L

    M

    INFOID:0000000009486772

    N

    FOR SIDE AND ROLLOVER COLLISION: When SRS is activated in a collision
    CAUTION:
    Due to varying models and option levels, not all parts listed in the chart below apply to all vehicles.
    WORK PROCEDURE
    1. Before performing any of the following steps, ensure that all vehicle body and structural repairs have been
    completed.
    2. Replace the following components:
    Front seat back assembly (on the side on which side air bag is activated).
    Door finisher (on the side on which door-mounted curtain air bag is activated).
    Pop-up roll bar assemblies and pop-up roll bar covers.
    Side air bag (satellite) sensor LH/RH (on the side on which side air bag is activated).
    Diagnosis sensor unit.

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-7

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Seat belt pre-tensioner assemblies.
    3. Check the SRS components and the related parts using the following table.
    Replace any SRS components and the related parts showing visible signs of damage (dents, cracks,
    deformation, etc.).
    4. Perform self-diagnosis using CONSULT and “AIR BAG” warning lamp. Refer to SRC-9, «Description» for
    details. Make sure entire SRS operates properly.
    5. After the work is completed, perform self-diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    SRS INSPECTION (FOR SIDE AND ROLLOVER COLLISION)
    Part

    Inspection

    Side curtain air bag module LH

    If the side curtain air bag LH has deployed:
    REPLACE the side curtain air bag module LH.
    Install with new fasteners.

    Side curtain air bag module RH

    If the side curtain air bag RH has deployed:
    REPLACE the side curtain air bag module RH.
    Install with new fasteners.

    Front side air bag module LH

    If the front side air bag LH has deployed:
    REPLACE front seatback assembly LH.

    Front side air bag module RH

    If the front side air bag RH has deployed:
    REPLACE front seatback assembly RH.

    Side air bag (satellite) sensor (LH
    or RH)

    If any of the SRS components have deployed:
    REPLACE the side air bag (satellite) sensor on the collision side with new fasteners.

    Door (satellite) sensor (LH or RH)

    If any of the SRS components have deployed:
    REPLACE the door (satellite) sensor on the collision side with new fasteners.

    Diagnosis sensor unit

    If any of the SRS components have deployed:
    REPLACE the diagnosis sensor unit with new fasteners.

    Seat belt pre-tensioner assemblies
    (All applicable locations: buckle,
    reel, lap outer)

    If either the driver or passenger seat belt pre-tensioner* has been activated:
    REPLACE all seat belt pre-tensioner assemblies with new fasteners.
    *: Confirm seat belt pre-tensioner activation using CONSULT only.

    Center inner pillar

    1.
    2.

    Seat (if equipped with front side
    air bag)

    If either the front LH or front RH side air bag modules has been deployed:
    REPLACE front seatback assembly on the deployed side.

    Trim/headlining

    1.
    2.

    Check the center inner pillar on the collision side for damage (dents, cracks, deformation).
    If damaged—REPAIR the center inner pillar.

    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, cracks, deformation) of the interior trim on the collision side.
    If damaged—REPLACE the damaged trim parts.

    Door-mounted curtain air bag
    module LH

    If the door-mounted curtain air bag module LH has been deployed:
    REPLACE the door finisher LH and door-mounted curtain air bag module.
    Install with new fasteners.

    Door-mounted curtain air bag
    module RH

    If the door-mounted curtain air bag module RH has been deployed:
    REPLACE the door finisher RH and door-mounted curtain air bag module.
    Install with new fasteners.

    Occupant classification system
    (Passenger seat)

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Pop-up roll bar assemblies

    If the pop-up roll bar has deployed:
    REPLACE pop-up roll bar assemblies and pop-up roll bar covers.
    Install with new fasteners.

    Remove passenger seat assembly.
    Check control unit case for dents, cracks of deformities.
    Check connectors for damage and terminals for deformities.
    Check seat frame and cushion pan for dents or deformities.
    If no damage is found, reinstall seat with new fasteners.
    If damaged — REPLACE seat cushion assembly with new fasteners.

    FOR SIDE AND ROLLOVER COLLISION: When SRS is not activated in a collision
    CAUTION:
    Due to varying models and option levels, not all parts listed in the chart below apply to all vehicles.
    Revision: April 2013

    SR-8

    2014 Note

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    WORK PROCEDURE
    1. Before performing any of the following steps, ensure that all vehicle body and structural repairs have been
    completed.
    2. Check the SRS components and the related parts using the following table.
    If the front seat back assembly is damaged, the front seat back assembly must be replaced.
    If the door finisher assembly is damaged, the door finisher assembly and door-mounted curtain air bag
    module must be replaced.
    3. Perform self-diagnosis using CONSULT and “AIR BAG” warning lamp. Refer to SRC-9, «Description» for
    details. Make sure entire SRS operates properly.
    4. After the work is completed, perform self-diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    Side curtain air bag module LH

    Side curtain air bag module RH

    Front side air bag module LH

    Front side air bag module RH

    Side air bag (satellite) sensor (LH
    or RH)

    Revision: April 2013

    B

    C

    D

    SRS INSPECTION (FOR SIDE AND ROLLOVER COLLISION)
    Part

    A

    Inspection
    If the side curtain air bag LH has NOT deployed:
    1.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, tears, deformation) of the center pillar on the collision side.
    2.
    If damaged—Remove the side curtain air bag module LH.
    3.
    Check for visible signs of damaged (tears etc.) of the side curtain air bag module LH.
    4.
    Check harness and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    5.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the side curtain air bag module LH with new fasteners.
    6.
    If damaged—REPLACE the side curtain air bag module LH with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.
    If the side curtain air bag RH has NOT deployed:
    1.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, tears, deformation) of the center pillar on the collision side.
    2.
    If damaged—Remove the side curtain air bag module RH.
    3.
    Check for visible signs of damaged (tears etc.) of the side curtain air bag module RH.
    4.
    Check harness and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    5.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the side curtain air bag module RH with new fasteners.
    6.
    If damaged—REPLACE the side curtain air bag module RH with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.
    If the front LH side air bag has NOT deployed:
    1.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, tears, deformation) of the seat back on the collision
    side.
    2.
    Check harness and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    3.
    If damaged—REPLACE the front seatback assembly LH.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.
    If the front side air bag RH has NOT deployed:
    1.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, tears, deformation) of the seat back on the collision
    side.
    2.
    Check harness and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    3.
    If damaged—REPLACE the front seatback assembly RH.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.
    If none of the SRS components have been activated:
    1.
    Remove the side air bag (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) on the collision side. Check harness
    connectors for damage, terminals for deformities, and harness for binding.
    2.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, cracks, deformation) of the side air bag (satellite)
    sensor (LH or RH).
    3.
    Install the side air bag (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) to check fit.
    4.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the side sir bag (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) with new fasteners.
    5.
    If damaged—REPLACE the side air bag (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) with new fasteners.

    SR-9

    2014 Note

    E

    F

    G

    SR

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Part

    Inspection

    Door (satellite) sensor (LH or RH)

    If none of the SRS components have been activated:
    1.
    Remove the door (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) on the collision side. Check harness connectors for damage, terminals for deformities, and harness for binding.
    2.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, cracks, deformation) of the door (satellite) sensor
    (LH or RH).
    3.
    Install the door (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) to check fit.
    4.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the door (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) with new fasteners.
    5.
    If damaged—REPLACE the door (satellite) sensor (LH or RH) with new fasteners.

    Diagnosis sensor unit

    If none of the SRS components have been activated:
    1.
    Check case and bracket for dents, cracks or deformities.
    2.
    Check connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    3.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the diagnosis sensor unit with new fasteners.
    4.
    If damaged—REPLACE the diagnosis sensor unit with new fasteners.

    Seat belt pre-tensioner assemblies
    (All applicable locations: buckle,
    reel, lap outer)

    If the pre-tensioners have NOT been activated:
    1.
    Remove seat belt pre-tensioners.
    Check harness cover and connectors for damage, terminals for deformities, and harness for
    binding.
    2.
    Check belts for damage and anchors for loose mounting.
    3.
    Check retractor for smooth operation.
    4.
    Check seat belt adjuster for damage.
    5.
    Check for deformities of the center pillar inner.
    6.
    If no damage is found, reinstall seat belt pre-tensioner assembly with new fasteners.
    7.
    If damaged—REPLACE. Install the seat belt pre-tensioner assembly with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.

    Seat (with front side air bag)

    If the front LH or front RH side air bag modules have NOT deployed:
    1.
    Visually check the seat on the collision side.
    2.
    Remove the seat on the collision side and check the following for damage and deformities.
    Harness, connectors and terminals
    Frame and recliner (for front and rear seat), and also adjuster and slides (for front seat)
    3.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the seat.
    4.
    If damaged—REPLACE the damaged seat parts using new fasteners. If the front seat back is
    damaged, the front seat back assembly must be replaced.

    Center inner pillar

    1.
    2.

    Trim/headlining

    1.
    2.

    Door-mounted curtain air bag
    module LH

    Revision: April 2013

    Check the center inner pillar on the collision side for damage (dents, cracks, deformation,
    etc.).
    If damaged — REPAIR the center inner pillar.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, cracks, deformation, etc.) of the interior trim on the
    collision side.
    If damaged — REPLACE the damaged trim parts.

    If the door-mounted curtain air bag LH has NOT deployed:
    1.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, tears, deformation, etc.) of the door finisher on the
    collision side.
    2.
    If damaged — REPLACE the door finisher LH with new fasteners.
    3.
    Check for visible signs of damaged (tears etc.) of the door-mounted curtain air bag module
    LH.
    4.
    Check harness and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    5.
    If no damage is found, reinstall door finisher.
    CAUTION:
    When removing door mounted curtain air bag module from door finisher, never reuse
    door finisher.
    6.
    If damaged — REPLACE the door finisher LH and door-mounted curtain air bag module LH
    with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.

    SR-10

    2014 Note

    COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Part

    Door-mounted curtain air bag
    module RH

    Occupant classification system
    (Passenger seat)

    Pop-up roll bar

    Inspection
    If the door-mounted curtain air bag RH has NOT deployed:
    1.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, tears, deformation, etc.) of the door finisher on the
    collision side.
    2.
    If damaged — REPLACE the door finisher RH with new fasteners.
    3.
    Check for visible signs of damaged (tears etc.) of the door-mounted curtain air bag module
    RH.
    4.
    Check harness and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    5.
    If no damage is found, reinstall door finisher.
    CAUTION:
    When removing door mounted curtain air bag module from door finisher, never reuse
    door finisher.
    6.
    If damaged — REPLACE the door finisher RH and door-mounted curtain air bag module RH
    with new fasteners.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove passenger seat assembly.
    Check control unit case for dents, cracks of deformities.
    Check connectors for damage and terminals for deformities.
    Check seat frame and cushion pan for dents or deformities.
    If no damage is found, reinstall seat with new fasteners.
    If damaged — REPLACE seat cushion assembly with new fasteners.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    If the pop-up roll bar NOT deployed:
    1.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, tears, deformation, etc.) of the pop-up roll bar.
    2.
    If damaged — REPLACE the pop-up roll bar with new fasteners.
    3.
    Check harness and connectors for damage, and terminals for deformities.
    4.
    If no damage is found, reinstall the pop-up roll bar with new fasteners.
    5.
    Check for visible signs of damage (dents, cracks, deformation, etc.) of the seatback support
    brace assembly.
    6.
    If damaged — REPAIR the seatback support brace assembly.
    CAUTION:
    Before disposing of such systems, deploy the systems.

    G

    SR

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-11

    2014 Note

    DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015619

    AWHIA0452ZZ

    1.

    Steering wheel

    2.

    Driver air bag module

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015620

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery terminals then wait at
    least three minutes.
    • Always work from the side of driver air bag module. Do not work in front of it.
    • If driver air bag module is being replaced due to deployment, the spiral cable must also be replaced.
    Refer to SR-15, «Removal and Installation».
    • Do not insert any foreign objects (screwdriver, etc.) into the driver air bag module.
    • Do not attempt to disassemble the driver air bag module.
    • Do not expose the driver air bag module to temperatures exceeding 90°C (194°F).
    • Do not use air tools or electric tools for servicing.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not allow oil, grease, detergent or water to come in contact with the driver air bag module.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-12

    2014 Note

    DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Locate the access holes on side of steering wheel rear finisher
    (1) and insert ( ) a 5.0 mm (0.20 in) diameter suitable tool (A).
    3. Push suitable tool inward ( ) and make sure the tool contacts
    the spring (D). While pushing on spring (D), push on the driver
    air bag module. The driver air bag module hook will release,
    then pull to release from steering wheel. Repeat procedure on
    springs (B) and (C).
    NOTE:
    Driver air bag module removed for clarity.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWHIA0528ZZ

    4.

    Lift driver air bag module away from the steering wheel and disconnect the driver air bag module harness connector (A) and the
    horn harness connector (B). Then remove the wire harness from
    hook (C).
    NOTE:
    Take note of harness routing for correct installation.

    SR

    I

    J

    AWHIA0532ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • For removing/installing the driver air bag module harness
    connector, insert a thin screwdriver wrapped in tape into
    the notch, then lift the lock and remove the harness connector as shown.
    • Install the harness connector with the lock raised, and
    push the lock into the connector as shown.
    • After installing the connector, check that the lock is
    pushed in securely.

    K

    L

    M

    N

    PHIA0953J

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-13

    2014 Note

    DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    5. Remove the driver air bag module.
    CAUTION:
    • Always place the driver air bag module with pad side facing upward.
    : Upward

    JMHIA2077ZZ

    • Replace the driver air bag module if it has been dropped
    or sustained an impact.
    • Do not strike the driver air bag module.

    JMHIA0009ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    NOTE:
    To install the driver air bag module onto the steering wheel, align the hooks over the springs and push to snap
    into place.
    CAUTION:
    • Always route driver air bag module harness in original location.
    • Be careful not to damage or pinch the harness while installing.
    • After the work is completed, check the function of the horn and each steering switch.
    • After the work is completed, perform diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-14

    2014 Note

    SPIRAL CABLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    SPIRAL CABLE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015621

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWHIA0533ZZ

    1.

    Combination switch

    2. Spiral cable

    Removal and Installation

    Pawl

    SR
    INFOID:0000000009015622

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery terminals then wait at
    least three minutes.
    • Do not disassemble the spiral cable.
    • Do not use air tools or electric tools for servicing.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not allow oil, grease, detergent or water to come in contact with the spiral cable.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove steering wheel. Refer to ST-8, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove steering column covers. Refer to IP-17, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from spiral cable.
    Remove screws (A), then release pawls and remove spiral cable
    (1).
    : Pawl
    CAUTION:
    Do not turn the spiral cable quickly or beyond the limit
    number of turns (approximately 2.5 turns from the neutral
    position), this may cause the cable to snap.

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    ALHIA0307ZZ

    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-15

    2014 Note

    SPIRAL CABLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Do not strike or drop the spiral cable.
    • Replace the spiral cable if it has been dropped or sustained
    an impact.

    JMHIA0009ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • The turn signal lever must be in the neutral position for spiral cable installation.
    • Set the spiral cable neutral position by carefully turning the spiral
    cable (1) clockwise to the stop position. Turn the spiral cable counterclockwise 2.5 turns stopping when the locating pin (A) is at the
    top most position, triangles (B) are aligned as shown and the window (C) appears white.
    NOTE:
    If a new service part is installed, the neutral position is already set
    with a stopper clip in place and should not be adjusted after the
    stopper clip is removed. Make sure the stopper clip is removed
    before installing the steering wheel.
    • During steering wheel (2) installation, make sure the locating pin
    hole (D) is aligned with the locating pin (A) of the spiral cable.

    AWHIA0534ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • The spiral cable may snap during steering operation if the spiral cable is installed in an improper
    position.
    • Do not overturn the spiral cable or go beyond the maximum number of turns allowed. This will cause
    the cable to snap.
    • The turn signal lever must be in the neutral position for spiral cable installation.
    • Do not apply lubricant to the spiral cable.
    • After the work is completed, perform diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-16

    2014 Note

    FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015623

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SR

    I

    J
    AWHIA0529ZZ

    1.

    Front passenger air bag module

    2.

    Instrument panel assembly

    Removal and Installation

    K

    Pawl
    INFOID:0000000009015624

    L

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery terminals then wait at
    least three minutes.
    • Always work from the side of air bag module. Do not work in front of it.
    • Do not expose the front passenger air bag module to temperatures exceeding 90°C (194°F).
    • Do not attempt to disassemble the front passenger air bag module.
    • Do not insert any foreign objects (screwdriver, etc.) into the front passenger air bag module.
    • Do not use air tools or electric tools for servicing.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not allow oil, grease, detergent, or water to come in contact with the front passenger air bag module.

    M

    N

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove the glove box assembly. Refer to IP-25, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-17

    2014 Note

    P

    FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    3. Disconnect the harness connector (A) from front passenger air
    bag module.
    4. Remove and discard the front passenger air bag module bolts
    (B).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse front passenger air bag module bolts.

    JMHIA2022ZZ

    5.

    Release pawls using a suitable tool and remove front passenger
    air bag module (1).
    : Pawl

    AWHIA0527ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • Always place the front passenger air bag module with pad
    side facing upward.
    : Upward

    JMHIA2461ZZ

    • Do not strike the front passenger air bag module.
    • Replace the front passenger air bag module if it has been
    dropped or sustained an impact.

    JMHIA0009ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse the front passenger air bag module bolts.
    • Do not damage the front passenger air bag module harness during installation.
    • After the work is completed, perform diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-18

    2014 Note

    CRASH ZONE SENSOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CRASH ZONE SENSOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009486784

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SR

    I

    J
    ALHIA0305ZZ

    1. Crash zone sensor

    2.

    Removal and Installation

    K

    Bracket
    INFOID:0000000009486785

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery terminals then wait at
    least three minutes.
    • Replace the crash zone sensor if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    • Replace the crash zone sensor if either the driver air bag module, the front passenger air bag module, or a front seat belt pre-tensioner has been deployed.
    • Do not strike the crash zone sensor.
    • Do not use air tools or electric tools for servicing.

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-19

    2014 Note

    CRASH ZONE SENSOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Remove and discard crash zone sensor nut (A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse crash zone sensor nut.
    3. Remove bracket (1) and crash zone sensor (2).

    ALHIA0306ZZ

    4.

    Disconnect the slide double locking type harness connector from the crash zone sensor, as shown.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Position the crash zone sensor using the locating pin before tightening the nut to specification.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse the crash zone sensor nut.
    • Do not damage the harness connector during installation.
    • After the work is completed, perform diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-20

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009015631

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SR

    I

    J
    AWHIA0553ZZ

    1.

    Bracket

    2.

    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    Removal and Installation

    K

    Front
    INFOID:0000000009015632

    L

    REMOVAL
    WARNING:
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect both battery terminals then wait at
    least three minutes.
    • Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit if any SRS air bag has been deployed or if any front seat
    belt pre-tensioner has been deployed.
    • Before disconnecting the air bag diagnosis sensor unit harness connectors, be sure to disconnect
    each harness connector of the front seat belt pre-tensioners (LH/RH) to prevent accidental air bag
    deployment by static electricity and seat belt pre-tensioner operation.
    • Do not use the air tools or electric tools for servicing.
    • When replacing the air bag diagnosis sensor unit, always check with the parts department for the latest parts information. Installing an incorrect air bag diagnosis sensor unit may or may not cause the
    air bag warning lamp to illuminate and may cause incorrect deployment of the supplemental air bags
    and seat belt pre-tensioners in a collision resulting in serious personal injury or death.
    1. Always check the air bag diagnosis sensor unit ECU discriminated number (identification number) or part
    number using CONSULT.
    2. Disconnect negative and positive battery terminals, then wait at least three minutes. Refer to PG-69,
    «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    3. Remove center pillar lower finisher. Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER : Removal
    and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    SR-21

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4. Disconnect the harness connectors from the front seat belt pre-tensioners (LH/RH).
    CAUTION:
    • For removing/installing the front seat belt pre-tensioner
    harness connector, insert a thin screwdriver wrapped in
    tape into the notch, then lift the lock and remove the harness connector as shown.
    • Install the harness connector with the lock raised, and
    push the lock into the harness connector as shown.
    • After installing the harness connector, check that the lock
    is pushed in securely.

    PHIA0953J

    5.
    6.
    7.

    Remove the center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors (A) from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Remove and discard bolts (B), then remove bracket and diagnosis sensor unit.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse air bag diagnosis sensor unit bolts.
    NOTE:
    Shown with bracket removed for clarity.
    : Front
    JMHIA2027ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • Do not strike the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    • Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit if it has been
    dropped or sustained an impact.

    SGI787

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse the air bag diagnosis sensor unit bolts.
    • The air bag diagnosis sensor unit must always be installed with the label arrow mark » » pointing
    toward the front of the vehicle for proper operation.
    • Do not damage the air bag diagnosis sensor unit harness or connectors during installation.
    • After replacing the air bag diagnosis sensor unit, confirm using CONSULT that the ECU discriminated number (identification number) or part number of the new replacement air bag diagnosis sensor unit matches the ECU discriminated number (identification number) or part number of the
    replaced (old) air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    • After the work is completed, perform diagnosis to check that no malfunction is detected. Refer to
    SRC-9, «Description».
    NOTE:
    If the ECU discriminated number or part number of the new replacement air bag diagnosis sensor unit differs
    from the ECU discriminated number or part number of the replaced air bag diagnosis sensor unit, reconfirm
    the parts information and verify that the correct air bag diagnosis sensor unit was installed.

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-22

    2014 Note

    SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009015634

    The front seat belt pre-tensioner is part of the front seat belt retractor. Refer to SB-9, «SEAT BELT RETRACTOR : Removal and Installation».

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SR

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-23

    2014 Note

    FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009486764

    The front seat belt buckle switch is part of the front seat belt buckle. Refer to SB-8, «FRONT SEAT BELT
    BUCKLE : Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    SR-24

    2014 Note

    RESTRAINTS

    SECTION

    SRC

    SRS AIRBAG CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW ……. 21
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….21

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Service ……………………………………………………………. 3

    INTERMITTENT INCIDENT ………………………… 24

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4

    B1033, B1034 CRASH ZONE SENSOR ……….. 25

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4
    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 4
    Driver Air Bag Module ……………………………………….. 5
    Front Passenger Air Bag Module ………………………… 5
    Front Seat Belt Pre-tensioner ……………………………… 5
    Air Bag Diagnosis Sensor Unit ……………………………. 6
    Crash Zone Sensor …………………………………………… 6
    SRS Component Connectors ……………………………… 6

    Inspection Procedure ……………………………………….24

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 25
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….25
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..25
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….27
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..27
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….29
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..29

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM ………………………………………. 8
    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM : System Diagram ………….. 8
    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM : System Description ……… 8

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….32
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..32

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 12
    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT …………………………12
    DTC Index …………………………………………………….. 12
    Flash Code Index ……………………………………………. 13

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 15
    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM ……………………………….15
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 15

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 21
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC

    I

    J

    B1049 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE ……………… 29

    B1050 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE ……………… 32

    Description ………………………………………………………. 9
    On Board Diagnosis Function …………………………….. 9
    Trouble Diagnosis with CONSULT …………………….. 11
    CONSULT Function (AIR BAG) ………………………… 11

    G

    B1035 CRASH ZONE SENSOR ………………….. 27

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 8

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AIR BAG) …………………. 9

    F

    B1051 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE ……………… 34

    K

    L

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….34
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..34

    M

    B1052 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE ……………… 36

    N

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….36
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..36

    B1065 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE …….. 38

    O

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….38
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..38

    B1066 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE …….. 40
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….40
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..40

    B1067 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE …….. 42
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….42
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..42

    SRC-1

    2014 Note

    P

    B1068 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE …….. 44

    B1088 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH ……. 58

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 44
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 44

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 58
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 58

    B1081 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH ……. 46

    B1089 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH ……. 60

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 46
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 46

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 60
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 60

    B1082 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH ……. 48

    B1209 FRONTAL COLLISION DETECTION … 62

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 48
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 48

    Description …………………………………………………….. 62
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 62
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 62

    B1083 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH ……. 50
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 50
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 50

    B1084 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH ……. 52
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 52
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 52

    B1086 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH ……. 54
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 54
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 54

    B1087 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH ……. 56
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 56
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 56

    Revision: April 2013

    B1XXX AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT… 63
    Description …………………………………………………….. 63
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 63
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 63

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 65
    SRS AIR BAG WARNING LAMP DOES NOT
    TURN OFF ………………………………………………… 65
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 65

    SRS AIR BAG WARNING LAMP DOES NOT
    TURN ON ………………………………………………….. 66
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 66

    SRC-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009560124

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Igni- SRC
    tion ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    I
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Service

    INFOID:0000000009015644

    • Never use electrical test equipment to check SRS circuits unless instructed to in this Service Manual.
    • Before servicing the SRS, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal and wait 3 minutes
    or more.
    For approximately 3 minutes after the cables are removed, it is still possible for the air bag and seat belt pretensioner to deploy. Therefore, never work on any SRS connectors or wires until at least 3 minutes have
    passed.
    • Diagnosis sensor unit must always be installed with their arrow marks “⇐” pointing towards the front of the
    vehicle for proper operation. Also check diagnosis sensor unit for cracks, deformities or rust before installation and replace as required.
    • The spiral cable must be aligned with the neutral position since its rotations are limited. Never turn steering
    wheel and column after removal of steering gear.
    • Handle air bag module carefully. Always place driver and front passenger air bag modules with the pad side
    facing upward and seat mounted front side air bag module standing with the stud bolt side facing down.
    • Conduct self-diagnosis to check entire SRS for proper function after replacing any components.
    • After air bag inflates, the front instrument panel assembly should be replaced if damaged.
    • Always replace instrument panel pad following front passenger air bag deployment.
    • Never solder the harness when making repairs. Check that harness is not pinched and that there is no contact with other components.
    • Never allow harness to come in contact with oil, grease, waste oil, or water.
    • Never insert foreign materials, such as a screwdriver, into the harness connector. (This is to prevent accidental activation caused by static electricity.)
    • Always use CONSULT or SRS air bag warning lamp to perform the circuit diagnosis. (Never use an electric
    tester such as a circuit tester.)

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-3

    2014 Note

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009015645

    ALHIA0311ZZ

    A.

    Instrument panel

    B.

    View with center console removed

    D.

    Combination meter

    E.

    Radiator core support assembly

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-4

    C.

    View with lower B-pillar finisher
    removed

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component

    Function

    A

    1.

    Combination switch (spiral cable)

    The spiral cable provides a rotating physical connection to the drivers
    air bag module.

    2.

    Driver air bag module

    Refer to SRC-5, «Driver Air Bag Module».

    3.

    Front passenger air bag module

    Refer to SRC-5, «Front Passenger Air Bag Module».

    4.

    Seat belt buckle switch LH

    The driver seat belt buckle switch provides the seat belt buckle signal
    to the air bag diagnosis sensor unit and the combination meter.

    5.

    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit

    Refer to SRC-6, «Air Bag Diagnosis Sensor Unit».

    6.

    Front seat belt pre-tensioner LH (RH similar)

    Refer to SRC-5, «Front Seat Belt Pre-tensioner».

    Combination meter (air bag warning lamp)

    The combination meter displays the air bag warning lamp and the
    seat belt warning lamp. The air bag warning lamp is used for diagnosis in User Mode and may be used to display diagnostic trouble
    codes without the use of the CONSULT.

    7.

    8.

    Crash zone sensor

    B

    C

    D

    E

    Refer to SRC-6, «Crash Zone Sensor».

    Driver Air Bag Module

    INFOID:0000000009515825

    The driver air bag module is single stage and located in the steering
    wheel assembly. It operates with the SRS system in a frontal collision exceeding a specified level.

    F

    G

    SRC

    I
    AWHIA0462ZZ

    Front Passenger Air Bag Module

    INFOID:0000000009515826

    The front passenger air bag module is single stage and is located
    behind the instrument panel assembly. It operates with the SRS system in a frontal collision exceeding a specified level.

    J

    K

    L

    M
    AWHIA0411ZZ

    Front Seat Belt Pre-tensioner

    INFOID:0000000009515827

    The seat belt pre-tensioner system with load limiter is installed for
    both the driver’s seat and the front passenger’s seat. It operates
    simultaneously with the SRS air bag system in the event of a frontal
    collision with an impact exceeding a specified level.
    When the frontal collision with an impact exceeding a specified level
    occurs, seat belt slack resulting from clothing or other factors is
    immediately taken up by the belt pre-tensioner. Vehicle passengers
    are securely restrained.
    When passengers in a vehicle are thrown forward in a collision and
    the restraining force of the seat belt exceeds a specified level, the
    load limiter permits the specified extension of the seat belt by the
    twisting of the ELR shaft, and a relaxation of the chest-area seat belt
    web tension while maintaining force.
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-5

    N

    O

    P

    AWHIA0535ZZ

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Air Bag Diagnosis Sensor Unit

    INFOID:0000000009515828

    The air bag diagnosis sensor unit is located under the center console assembly. The air bag diagnosis sensor unit receives signals
    from multiple SRS sensors and controls the deployment of the air
    bags. The deployment of the air bags depends on the type and
    severity of the collision. The air bag diagnosis sensor unit has selfdiagnosis capability through the use of the CONSULT as well as
    flash codes displayed by the air bag warning lamp.

    AWHIA0536ZZ

    Crash Zone Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009515829

    The crash zone sensor is located in front of the radiator. The crash
    zone sensor sends signals to the air bag diagnosis sensor unit during a frontal collision. This sensor may be identified by a yellow connector.

    AWHIA0537ZZ

    SRS Component Connectors

    INFOID:0000000009641655

    DIRECT CONNECT
    The following SRS components use direct-connect style harness connectors.
    • Driver front air bag module
    • Passenger front air bag module
    • LH side curtain air bag module
    • RH side curtain air bag module
    • Front LH seat belt pre-tensioner
    • Front RH seat belt pre-tensioner
    Always pull up to release locking tab prior to removing connector from SRS component.
    Always push down to lock locking tab after installing connector to
    SRS component. When locked, the locking tab is level with the connector housing.

    WHIA0103E

    SLIDE DOUBLE LOCKING
    • A new style slide double locking type connector is used on certain systems and components, especially
    those related to airbag control systems.
    • The slide double locking type connectors help prevent incomplete locking and accidental looseness or disconnection.
    • The slide double locking type connectors are disconnected by pushing or pulling the slider. Refer to the figure below.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • Do not pull the harness or wires when disconnecting the connector.
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E
    AAMIA0498GB

    F

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-7

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM : System Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009541304

    AWHIA0500GB

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009541305

    • The air bag deploys if the air bag diagnosis sensor unit is activated while the ignition switch is in the ON or
    START position.
    • The collision modes for which supplemental restraint systems are activated are different among the SRS
    systems. For example, the driver air bag module, front passenger air bag module and front seat belt pre-tensioners are activated in a frontal collision but not in a side collision.
    SRS Collision Modes
    SRS configuration

    Frontal collision

    Left side collision

    Right side collision

    Driver air bag module

    x

    Front passenger air bag module

    x

    Front LH seat belt pre-tensioner

    x

    Front RH seat belt pre-tensioner

    x

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-8

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AIR BAG)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AIR BAG)

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009518933

    CAUTION:
    • Never use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed in this Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness
    connectors.
    • Never repair, splice or modify the SRS wiring harness. If the harness is damaged, replace it with a
    new one.
    • Keep ground portion clean.

    B

    C

    DIAGNOSIS FUNCTION

    D

    • The SRS self-diagnostic results can be read with air bag warning lamp and/or CONSULT.
    • The user mode is exclusively prepared for the customer (driver). This mode warns the driver of a system
    malfunction through the operation of the air bag warning lamp.
    • The diagnosis mode allows the technician to locate and inspect the malfunctioning part.
    • The mode applications for the air bag warning lamp and CONSULT are as per the following items.

    E

    ×: Application, —: Not application

    Diagnosis tool

    User mode

    Diagnosis mode

    Air bag warning lamp

    ×

    ×

    CONSULT

    ×

    On Board Diagnosis Function

    F

    G
    INFOID:0000000009518934

    SRC

    ON-BOARD DIAGNOSIS
    There are two self diagnosis functions with air bag warning lamp per the following items.
    • USER MODE
    • DIAGNOSIS MODE

    I

    METHOD OF STARTING
    • Diagnosis mode changes from user mode to diagnosis mode when changing operation is performed.
    • In user mode, when SRS air bag warning lamp is not turning ON, changing to diagnosis mode by ignition
    switch operation is not possible.
    • In diagnosis mode, when repair is complete and system is normal, the mode changes to user mode when
    ignition switch is turned from OFF to ON.
    Procedure to Change Diagnosis Mode
    1. Turn ignition switch from OFF to ON.
    2. SRS air bag lamp turns ON for 7 seconds and turns OFF, then turn ignition switch OFF within 2 seconds
    after the lamp turns OFF.
    NOTE:
    When in Diagnosis Mode, the air bag warning lamp may illuminate for more than 7 seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON. If this is the case, the ignition switch must still be cycled OFF after 7 seconds.
    3. After turning ignition switch OFF, wait for 3 seconds or more.
    4. Repeat operation 1 to 3 for 2 times so that operation 1 to 3 is repeated for 3 times in total.
    5. Turn ignition switch from OFF to ON. Diagnosis mode changes.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    USER MODE
    In USER MODE, air bag warning lamp on combination meter turning ON when a malfunction is detected and
    warns the customer (driver).

    O

    How to Read Air Bag Warning Lamp

    1.
    2.

    P

    Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON, and check that the air bag warning lamp turns ON.
    Compare the air bag warning lamp operation pattern with the examples.
    Air Bag Warning Lamp Examples:

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-9

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AIR BAG)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Air bag warning lamp flashing pattern (User Mode)

    Warning lamp

    SRS condition

    Reference item

    • No malfunction is detected.
    • No further action is necessary.

    The system is malfunctioning and
    needs to be repaired.

    Refer to SRC-11, «Trouble Diagnosis
    with CONSULT» or SRC-9, «On
    Board Diagnosis Function».

    • Air bag is deployed.
    • Seat belt pre-tensioner is deployed.

    Refer to SR-5, «For Frontal Collision»
    or SR-7, «For Side and Rollover Collision».

    • Air bag diagnosis sensor unit is malfunctioning.
    • Air bag power supply circuit is malfunctioning.
    • SRS air bag warning lamp circuit is
    malfunctioning.

    Refer to SRC-65, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    • Air bag diagnosis sensor unit is malfunctioning.
    • Air bag warning lamp circuit is malfunctioning.

    Refer to SRC-66, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    SHIA0011E

    SHIA0012E

    SHIA0013E

    SHIA0014E

    DIAGNOSIS MODE
    NOTE:
    Diagnosis Mode can not be entered if a malfunction is not detected in User Mode.
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. After AIR BAG warning lamp lights for 7 seconds, turn ignition switch OFF within 1 second.
    3. Wait more than 3 seconds.
    4. Repeat steps 1 to 3 two more times (3 times total).
    5. Turn ignition switch ON.
    SRS is now in Diagnosis Mode. Refer to SRC-13, «Flash Code Index».

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-10

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AIR BAG)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Trouble Diagnosis with CONSULT
    1.
    2.

    INFOID:0000000009518935

    A

    Connect CONSULT.
    DTC is displayed on SELF-DIAG RESULTS.

    NOTE:
    If a malfunction is not detected on SELF-DIAG RESULTS [CURRENT], but a malfunction is detected during
    SRS Operation Check, the following cases may exist:
    • SELF-DIAG [PAST] memory might not be erased. Refer to SRC-11, «Trouble Diagnosis with CONSULT».
    • SRS system malfunctions intermittently. Refer to SRC-24, «Inspection Procedure».

    B

    C

    DIAGNOSIS MODE
    1.
    2.

    3.

    4.
    5.
    6.

    D
    Connect CONSULT.
    If no DTCs are detected on “SELF-DIAG RESULTS [CURRENT]”, repair of SRS is completed. Go to step
    4.
    If any DTCs are detected on “SELF-DIAG RESULTS [CURRENT]”, the malfunction has not been repaired E
    completely or another malfunction is being detected. Perform SRS Operation Check again. Refer to SRC9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    Touch “ERASE”.
    F
    NOTE:
    Touching “ERASE” will clear the SRS memory of the malfunction (“SELF-DIAG [PAST]”). If “SELFDIAG [PAST]” is not erased, User Mode may show the previous system malfunction even if the
    G
    malfunction has been repaired completely.
    Check that no malfunction is detected in “SELF-DIAG [PAST]”.
    Exit Diagnosis Mode and disconnect the CONSULT.
    Perform SRS Operation Check. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    SRC

    SRS HISTORY CHECK
    1.
    2.

    Check repair history of the SRS. If no repairs have been made, perform SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis
    Function». If repairs have been made, GO TO step 2.
    Erase ”SELF-DIAG [PAST]” after repair. Refer to SRC-11, «Trouble Diagnosis with CONSULT».

    CONSULT Function (AIR BAG)

    INFOID:0000000009518939

    I

    J

    CONSULT can display each diagnostic item using the diagnostic test modes shown following.
    Diagnostic Test Mode

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Data Monitor

    ECU Identification

    Trouble Diagnostic Record

    K

    Diagnostic Item

    Description

    SELF-DIAG RESULT [CURRENT]

    A current Self-diagnosis result (also indicated by the number of
    warning lamp flashes in the Diagnosis mode) is displayed on the
    CONSULT screen in real time. This refers to a malfunctioning part
    requiring repairs.

    DATA MONITOR

    Displays air bag diagnosis sensor unit input/output data in real time.

    ECU DISCRIMINATED NO.

    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit ECU discriminated number (identification number) or part number is displayed. Air bag diagnosis sensor
    unit has individual ECU discriminated number (identification number) or part number based on model and equipment.

    TROUBLE DIAG RECORD [PAST]

    With TROUBLE DIAG RECORD, diagnosis results previously
    erased by a reset operation can be displayed on the CONSULT
    screen.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-11

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    DTC Index

    INFOID:0000000009015647

    DTC

    Diagnostic item

    NO DTC IS DETECTED.

    Explanation

    When malfunction is
    indicated by the “AIR
    BAG” warning lamp
    in the user mode

    Reference page

    Low battery voltage (Less than 9 V)
    or High battery voltage (more than
    16 V)

    Self-diagnostic result is not erased
    after repair

    Intermittent malfunction is detected
    in the past

    No malfunction is detected

    B1033
    B1034

    CRASH ZONE SEN
    [UNIT FAIL]

    Crash zone sensor is malfunctioning.

    SRC-25, «DTC Logic»

    B1035

    CRASH ZONE SEN
    [COMM FAIL]

    Crash zone sensor is malfunctioning.

    SRC-27, «DTC Logic»

    B1049

    DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    [OPEN]

    Driver air bag module circuit is open (including the spiral
    cable).

    SRC-29, «DTC Logic»

    B1050

    DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    [VB-SHORT]

    Driver air bag module circuit is shorted to power supply
    circuit (including the spiral cable).

    SRC-32, «DTC Logic»

    B1051

    DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    [GND-SHORT]

    Driver air bag module circuit is shorted to ground (including
    the spiral cable).

    SRC-34, «DTC Logic»

    B1052

    DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    [SHORT]

    Driver air bag module circuits are shorted to each other
    (including spiral cable).

    SRC-36, «DTC Logic»

    B1065

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [OPEN]

    Passenger air bag module circuit is open.

    SRC-38, «DTC Logic»

    B1066

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [VB-SHORT]

    Passenger air bag module circuit is shorted to power
    supply circuit.

    SRC-40, «DTC Logic»

    B1067

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [GND-SHORT]

    Passenger air bag module circuit is shorted to ground.

    SRC-42, «DTC Logic»

    B1068

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [SHORT]

    Passenger air bag module circuits are shorted to each
    other.

    SRC-44, «DTC Logic»

    B1081

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [OPEN]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuit is open.

    SRC-46, «DTC Logic»

    B1082

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [VB-SHORT]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuit is shorted to power
    supply circuit.

    SRC-48, «DTC Logic»

    B1083

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [GND-SHORT]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuit is shorted to ground.

    SRC-50, «DTC Logic»

    B1084

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [SHORT]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuits are shorted to each
    other.

    SRC-52, «DTC Logic»

    B1086

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [OPEN]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuit is open.

    SRC-54, «DTC Logic»

    B1087

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [VB-SHORT]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuit is shorted to power
    supply circuit.

    SRC-56, «DTC Logic»

    B1088

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [GND-SHORT]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuit is shorted to ground.

    SRC-58, «DTC Logic»

    B1089

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [SHORT]

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuits are shorted to each
    other.

    SRC-60, «DTC Logic»

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-12

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    DTC

    Diagnostic item

    Explanation

    Reference page

    B1209

    FRONTAL COLLISION
    DETECTION

    Driver and/or front passenger air bag modules are
    deployed.

    SRC-62, «DTC Logic»

    B1XXX

    CONTROL UNIT

    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit malfunctioning.

    SRC-63, «DTC Logic»

    Flash Code Index

    A

    B

    INFOID:0000000009520718

    C

    WARNING LAMP FLASH CODE CHART
    NOTE:
    Follow the procedures in numerical order when repairing malfunctioning parts. Confirm whether malfunction is
    eliminated using air bag warning lamp each time repair is finished. If malfunction is still observed, proceed to
    the next step. When malfunction is eliminated, further repair work is not required.

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWHIA0300GB

    SRC

    I

    J

    AWHIA0306GB

    K

    L

    M

    N
    WHIA0198E

    O

    P

    AWHIA0307GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-13

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    WHIA0200E

    WHIA0263E

    WHIA0262E

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-14

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009015648

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AAHWA0061GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-15

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAHWA0062GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-16

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAHIA0149GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-17

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAHIA0150GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-18

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAHIA0151GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-19

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAHIA0152GB

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-20

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009015649

    B

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JMHIA1324GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-21

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    1.INTERVIEW THE CUSTOMER FOR THE SYMPTOM
    Interview the customer for the symptom (the condition and the environment when the incident/malfunction
    occurs).
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK SYMPTOM
    Check the symptom from the customer information.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK WARNING LAMP OPERATION
    Check air bag warning lamp operation in the user mode.
    Are any malfunction detected?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK LOW VOLTAGE

    Check low voltage with CONSULT.
    Are any malfunction detected?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    5.CHECK SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS

    Check self diagnostic result with CONSULT or diagnosis mode.
    If it is impossible to switch to diagnosis mode, follow the same procedure that DTC is not detected.
    NOTE:
    Perform the following procedure if DTC is detected.
    • Record DTC (Print them out with CONSULT.)
    • Erase self diagnostic result.
    • Study the relationship between the malfunction that DTC or air bag warning lamp indicates and the symptom
    that the customer describes.
    • Check related service bulletins for information.
    Is DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    6.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    Perform DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE for the DTC.
    >> GO TO 8.

    7.PERFORM DIAGNOSIS ACCORDING TO WARNING LAMP OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    Check air bag warning lamp operation in the user mode.
    Perform Diagnosis Procedure for the air bag warning lamp operation.
    >> GO TO 9.

    8.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
    Inspect according to Diagnostic Procedure of the DTC.
    >> GO TO 9.

    9.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTION PART
    Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-22

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    >> GO TO 10.

    10.FINAL CHECK

    A

    Check self diagnostic result and air bag warning lamp operation in the user mode.
    Is the malfunction repaired?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-23

    2014 Note

    INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Inspection Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009518941

    INTERMITTENT TROUBLE
    An intermittent incident may have occurred in the past but is not being detected currently. This DTC will not be
    detected on SELF-DIAG [CURRENT], but may be viewed on SELF-DIAG [PAST] if the DTC has not been
    erased. Refer to SRC-11, «Trouble Diagnosis with CONSULT».

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-24

    2014 Note

    B1033, B1034 CRASH ZONE SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    B1033, B1034 CRASH ZONE SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460184

    B

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1033
    B1034

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    CRASH ZONE SEN
    [UNIT FAIL]

    C
    DTC detecting condition

    Crash zone sensor is malfunctioning.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the crash zone sensor.
    Replace the related harness.

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    F

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    G

    SRC

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    I

    J

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    K

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    L

    M
    INFOID:0000000009460185

    N

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-25

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    B1033, B1034 CRASH ZONE SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    6.CRASH ZONE SENSOR

    1. Replace the crash zone sensor. Refer to SR-19, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.
    >> END

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-26

    2014 Note

    B1035 CRASH ZONE SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1035 CRASH ZONE SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460186

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1035

    B

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    CRASH ZONE SEN
    [COMM FAIL]

    DTC detecting condition

    Crash zone sensor is malfunctioning or
    out of the specified specification.

    Possible cause
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    C

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the crash zone sensor.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    E

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    F

    G

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    SRC

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    I

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    J

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    K

    L

    INFOID:0000000009460187

    M

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-27

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    B1035 CRASH ZONE SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    6.CRASH ZONE SENSOR

    1. Replace the crash zone sensor. Refer to SR-19, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.
    >> END

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-28

    2014 Note

    B1049 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1049 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460188

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1049

    B

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    DRIVER AIRBAG
    MODULE
    [OPEN]

    DTC detecting condition

    Driver air bag module circuit is open
    (including the spiral cable).

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    C

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Inspect the spiral cable circuit.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the driver air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    F

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    G

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    SRC

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    I

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    J

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    K

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Diagnosis Procedure

    L

    M
    INFOID:0000000009460189

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR

    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-29

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    B1049 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CHECK SPIRAL CABLE CIRCUIT

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect driver air bag module harness connector and combination switch (spiral cable) harness connector.
    Check continuity between driver air bag module harness connector and combination switch (spiral cable)
    harness connector.
    Driver air bag module
    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    10

    M87

    4.

    Combination switch (spiral cable)

    28

    M31

    11

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    30

    Check continuity between driver air bag module harness connector and ground.
    Driver side air bag module
    Connector
    M87

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Ground

    10

    No

    11

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace combination switch (spiral cable). Refer to SR-15, «Removal and Installation».

    5.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    6.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-30

    2014 Note

    B1049 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    A

    7.DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE

    1. Replace the driver air bag module. Refer to SR-12, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    B

    C

    8.RELATED HARNESS

    D

    Replace the related harness.
    E

    >> END

    F

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-31

    2014 Note

    B1050 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1050 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460190

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1050

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    DRIVER AIRBAG
    MODULE
    [VB-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Driver air bag module circuit is shorted to
    power supply circuit (including the spiral
    cable).

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Inspect the spiral cable circuit.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the driver air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-32, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-32, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-32, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460191

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-32

    2014 Note

    B1050 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    A

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    B

    C

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    D

    E

    F

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    G

    SRC

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    I

    J

    6.DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE

    K

    1. Replace the driver air bag module. Refer to SR-12, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    L

    M

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    N

    >> END
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-33

    2014 Note

    B1051 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1051 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460192

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1051

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    DRIVER AIRBAG
    MODULE
    [GND-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Driver air bag module circuit is shorted to
    ground (including the spiral cable).

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Inspect the spiral cable circuit.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the driver air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-34, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-34, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-34, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460193

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    1.CHECK HARNESS CONNECTOR

    Check the harness connector.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace harness connector.

    2.CHECK WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness externals.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-34

    2014 Note

    B1051 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Replace wiring harness.

    3.CHECK SPIRAL CABLE CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    A

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect driver air bag module harness connector and combination switch (spiral cable) harness connector.
    Check continuity between driver air bag module harness connector and combination switch (spiral cable)
    harness connector.

    B

    C
    Driver air bag module
    Connector

    Connector

    10

    M87

    4.

    Combination switch (spiral cable)

    Terminal

    D

    28

    M31

    11

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    30

    Check continuity between driver air bag module harness connector and ground.
    Driver side air bag module
    Connector
    M87

    E
    Continuity

    Terminal

    F

    Ground

    10

    No

    11

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace combination switch (spiral cable). Refer to SR-15, «Removal and Installation».

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    K

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    L

    6.DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE

    M

    1. Replace the driver air bag module. Refer to SR-12, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    N

    O

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    P

    Replace the related harness.
    >> END

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-35

    2014 Note

    B1052 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1052 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460194

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1052

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    DRIVER AIRBAG
    MODULE
    [SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Driver air bag module circuit are shorted to
    each other (including the spiral cable).

    Possible cause
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Inspect the spiral cable circuit.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the driver air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-36, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-36, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-36, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460195

    WARNING:
    • Before servicing, turn ignition switch OFF, disconnect battery negative terminal, and wait 3 minutes
    or more. (To discharge backup capacitor.)
    • Never use unspecified tester or other measuring device.

    1.CHECK HARNESS CONNECTOR

    Check the harness connector.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace harness connector.

    2.CHECK WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness externals.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-36

    2014 Note

    B1052 DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Replace wiring harness.

    3.CHECK SPIRAL CABLE CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    A

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect driver air bag module harness connector and combination switch (spiral cable) harness connector.
    Check continuity between driver air bag module harness connector and combination switch (spiral cable)
    harness connector.

    B

    C
    Driver air bag module
    Connector

    Connector

    10

    M87

    4.

    Combination switch (spiral cable)

    Terminal

    D

    28

    M31

    11

    Continuity

    Terminal

    Yes

    30

    Check continuity between driver air bag module harness connector and ground.
    Driver side air bag module
    Connector
    M87

    E
    Continuity

    Terminal

    F

    Ground

    10

    No

    11

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace combination switch (spiral cable). Refer to SR-15, «Removal and Installation».

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    G

    SRC

    I

    J

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    K

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    L

    6.DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE

    M

    1. Replace the driver air bag module. Refer to SR-12, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    N

    O

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    P

    Replace the related harness.
    >> END

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-37

    2014 Note

    B1065 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1065 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460196

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1065

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [OPEN]

    DTC detecting condition

    Passenger air bag module circuit is
    open.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front passenger air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-38, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-38, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-38, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460197

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-38

    2014 Note

    B1065 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    B

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    SRC

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    I

    J

    6.FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE

    1. Replace the front passenger air bag module. Refer to SR-17, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    M

    Replace the related harness.
    N

    >> END

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-39

    2014 Note

    B1066 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1066 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460198

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1066

    Display contents of CONSULT

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [VB-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Passenger air bag module circuit is
    shorted to power supply circuit.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front passenger air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-40, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-40, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-40, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460199

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-40

    2014 Note

    B1066 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    B

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    SRC

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    I

    J

    6.FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE

    1. Replace the front passenger air bag module. Refer to SR-17, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    M

    Replace the related harness.
    N

    >> END

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-41

    2014 Note

    B1067 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1067 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460200

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1067

    Display contents of CONSULT

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [GND-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Passenger air bag module circuit is
    shorted to ground.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front passenger air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-42, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460201

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-42

    2014 Note

    B1067 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    B

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    SRC

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    I

    J

    6.FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE

    1. Replace the front passenger air bag module. Refer to SR-17, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    M

    Replace the related harness.
    N

    >> END

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-43

    2014 Note

    B1068 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1068 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460202

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1068

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    ASSIST A/B MODULE
    [SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Passenger air bag module circuits are
    shorted to each other.

    Possible cause
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front passenger air bag module.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-44, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-44, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-44, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460203

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis unit to the end component (including
    any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-44

    2014 Note

    B1068 PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    B

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    SRC

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    I

    J

    6.FRONT PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE

    1. Replace the front passenger air bag module. Refer to SR-17, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    M

    Replace the related harness.
    N

    >> END

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-45

    2014 Note

    B1081 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1081 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460204

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1081

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [OPEN]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuit is
    open.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front RH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-46, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-46, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-46, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460205

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-46

    2014 Note

    B1081 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner RH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-47

    2014 Note

    B1082 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1082 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460206

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1082

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [VB-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuit is
    shorted to power supply circuit.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front RH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-48, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-48, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-48, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460207

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-48

    2014 Note

    B1082 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner RH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-49

    2014 Note

    B1083 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1083 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460208

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1083

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [GND-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuit is
    shorted to ground.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front RH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-50, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-50, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-50, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460209

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-50

    2014 Note

    B1083 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner RH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-51

    2014 Note

    B1084 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1084 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460210

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1084

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT RH
    [SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner RH circuits are
    shorted to each other.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front RH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-52, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-52, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-52, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460211

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-52

    2014 Note

    B1084 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER RH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner RH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-53

    2014 Note

    B1086 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1086 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460212

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1086

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [OPEN]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuit is
    open.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front LH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-54, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-54, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-54, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460213

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-54

    2014 Note

    B1086 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner LH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-55

    2014 Note

    B1087 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1087 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460214

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1087

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [VB-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuit is
    shorted to power supply circuit.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front LH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-56, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-56, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-56, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460215

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-56

    2014 Note

    B1087 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner LH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-57

    2014 Note

    B1088 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1088 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460216

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1088

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [GND-SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuit is
    shorted to ground.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front LH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460217

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-58

    2014 Note

    B1088 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner LH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-59

    2014 Note

    B1089 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1089 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460218

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B1089

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    PRE-TEN FRONT LH
    [SHORT]

    DTC detecting condition

    Seat belt pre-tensioner LH circuits are
    shorted to each other.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the front LH seat belt pre-tensioner.
    Replace the related harness.

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-60, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-60, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-60, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009460219

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR
    Check the harness connector for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1.
    2.

    Reconnect all harness connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-60

    2014 Note

    B1089 SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    A

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    B

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    C

    D

    E

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    F

    G

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    SRC

    I

    6.SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER LH

    J

    1. Replace the seat belt pre-tensioner LH. Refer to SR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    K

    L

    7.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.

    M

    >> END
    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-61

    2014 Note

    B1209 FRONTAL COLLISION DETECTION
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1209 FRONTAL COLLISION DETECTION
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009461213

    DTC B1209 FRONTAL COLLISION DETECTION
    The air bag diagnosis sensor unit will set this DTC if it has detected a collision which has resulted in a deployment of one or more air bags or pre-tensioners. If this DTC is detected after a SRS repair, the air bag diagnosis sensor unit has not yet been replaced. This DTC can not be erased.

    PART LOCATION
    Refer to SRC-4, «Component Parts Location».

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009461214

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    With CONSULT
    CONSULT name

    DTC

    DTC detecting condition

    FRONTAL COLLISION
    DETECTION

    B1209

    Driver and/or front passenger air bag modules are deployed.

    Repair order
    Refer to SR-5, «For Frontal Collision».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.INSPECTION START
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT
    Check for the DTC on CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-62, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009461215

    Refer to SR-5, «For Frontal Collision».

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-62

    2014 Note

    B1XXX AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    B1XXX AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009460138

    DTC B1XXX AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    B

    The air bag diagnosis sensor unit will run self diagnostics when the ignition switch is turned ON. It has the
    potential to set many diagnostic trouble codes which will conform to the B1XXX format, but will not match any
    other SRS diagnostic trouble codes. Refer to SRC-11, «CONSULT Function (AIR BAG)».

    C

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009460139

    D

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    With CONSULT
    DTC

    B1XXX

    E

    Display contents of
    CONSULT

    CONTROL UNIT

    DTC detecting condition
    Air bag diagnosis sensor unit is malfunctioning.

    Repair order
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Visually check the wiring harness connection.
    Replace the harness if it has visible damage.
    Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit.
    Replace the related harness.

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (With CONSULT)

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    SRC

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES (Current DTC)>>Refer to SRC-63, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    YES (Past DTC)>>GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    I

    J

    2.ERASE SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Erase the DTC using CONSULT.
    Can the DTC be erased?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to SRC-63, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    K

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT)

    L

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the air bag warning lamp status. Refer to SRC-9, «On Board Diagnosis Function».
    NOTE:
    SRS will not enter diagnosis mode if no malfunction is detected in user mode.
    Is the DTC detected?
    YES >> Refer to SRC-63, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    M

    1.CHECK SELF-DIAG RESULT

    Diagnosis Procedure

    N

    O
    INFOID:0000000009460140

    1.HARNESS CONNECTOR

    P

    Visually inspect all applicable harness connectors for the following:
    • Visible damage to connector or terminal
    • Loose terminal
    • Poor connection
    NOTE:
    All harness connectors should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-63

    2014 Note

    B1XXX AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform one of the following repairs:
    • Visible damage: Replace the harness.
    • Loose terminal: Secure the terminal.
    • Poor connection: Secure the connection.

    2.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    3.WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness for visible damage.
    NOTE:
    The entire wiring harness should be inspected from the air bag diagnosis sensor unit to the end component
    (including any in-line connectors).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace the harness.

    4.CONFIRM DTC

    1. Reconnect all harness connectors.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».

    5.AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    1. Replace the air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Check for DTC using CONSULT.
    Is DTC still current?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Clear DTC. Inspection End.

    6.RELATED HARNESS

    Replace the related harness.
    >> END

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-64

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN OFF
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    SRS AIR BAG WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN OFF
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009519215

    B

    1.CHECK AIR BAG MODULE AND SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER
    Check the deployment of air bag module.
    Is air bag module deployed?
    YES >> Replace the malfunctioning parts.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    C

    D

    2.CHECK AIR BAG FUSE

    Check 10 A fuse [No.7, located in fuse block (J/B)].
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace the fuse.

    E

    F

    3.CHECK HARNESS CONNECTOR

    Check the harness connector.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace harness connectors.

    G

    SRC

    4.CHECK WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness externals.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Replace wiring harness.

    I

    5.REPLACE AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    J

    1. Replace air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Check air bag warning lamp operation.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    K

    L

    6.REPLACE COMBINATION METER

    1. Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Check air bag warning lamp operation.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 1.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-65

    2014 Note

    SRS AIR BAG WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SRS AIR BAG WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009519216

    1.CHECK COMBINATION METER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check combination meter unit power supply and ground circuit. Refer to MWI-39, «COMBINATION METER :
    Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONNECTOR

    Check the harness connector.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace harness connectors.

    3.CHECK WIRING HARNESS

    Check the wiring harness externals.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace wiring harness.

    4.CHECK AIR BAG DIAGNOSIS SENSOR UNIT

    Disconnect air bag diagnosis sensor unit connector and turn ignition switch ON.
    Does air bag warning lamp turn ON?
    YES >> Replace air bag diagnosis sensor unit. Refer to SR-21, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    SRC-66

    2014 Note

    STEERING

    SECTION

    ST

    STEERING SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    Inspection ……………………………………………………….10

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    STEERING SHAFT ……………………………………. 12

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Service Notice or Precautions for Steering System
    …… 2

    Exploded View …………………………………………………12
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..12
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….13

    ST

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE ………………. 14

    H

    Exploded View …………………………………………………14
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..14
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….14

    I

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3

    F

    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 3

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY … 16
    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE ………………. 16

    J

    BASIC INSPECTION ……………………………… 5

    Exploded View …………………………………………………16
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………….16
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….18

    K

    STEERING WHEEL ……………………………………… 5
    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 5

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS …………………………. 7

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 19

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….. 7

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 19

    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………….. 7

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 8
    STEERING WHEEL ……………………………………… 8
    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 8
    Removal and Installation ……………………………………. 8

    STEERING COLUMN …………………………………… 9
    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 9
    Removal and Installation ……………………………………. 9

    General Specifications ………………………………………19
    Steering Wheel Axial End Play and Play ……………..19
    Steering Wheel Turning Force ……………………………19
    Steering Angle …………………………………………………19
    Steering Column Operating Range …………………….19
    Rack Stroke …………………………………………………….20
    Ball Joint Swing Force ………………………………………20
    Ball Joint Axial End Play ……………………………………20
    Inner Socket Length …………………………………………20

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009541329

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Service Notice or Precautions for Steering System

    INFOID:0000000009385580

    • In case of removing the steering gear, make the final tightening with grounded and unloaded vehicle condition, and then check wheel alignment.
    • Observe the following precautions when disassembling.
    — Before disassembly, thoroughly clean the outside of the unit.
    — Disassembly should be done in a clean work area. It is important to prevent the internal parts from becoming
    contaminated by dirt or other foreign matter.
    — For easier and proper assembly, place disassembled parts in order on a parts rack.
    — Use nylon cloth or paper towels to clean the parts; common shop rags can leave lint that might interfere with
    their operation.
    — Do not reuse non-reusable parts.
    — Before assembling, apply the specified grease to the directed parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009385581

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    C

    ST3127S000
    (J-25765-A)
    Preload gauge

    Inspecting steering column rotating torque,
    pinion rotating torque and ball joint rotating
    torque

    D

    E
    ZZA0806D


    (J-44372)
    Pull gauge

    Measuring steering wheel turning force or rack
    sliding force

    F

    ST

    H
    LST024

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009385582

    I
    Tool name

    Description

    Ball joint remover

    Remove steering outer socket

    J

    K

    L

    S-NT146

    Boot band crimping tool

    Installing boot clamp (large diameter)

    M

    N
    ZZA1229D

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-3

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >
    Tool name

    Description

    Steering wheel puller

    Removing steering wheel

    ZZA0819D

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-4

    2014 Note

    STEERING WHEEL
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    STEERING WHEEL
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009385583

    B

    CONDITION OF INSTALLATION
    • Check installation conditions of steering gear, front suspension, axle and steering column.
    • Check if movement exists when steering wheel is moved up and down, to the left and right and to the axial
    direction.
    Steering wheel axial end play

    C

    D

    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering Wheel
    Axial End Play and Play».

    E

    • Verify that the steering gear nuts are tightened to specification. Refer to ST-14, «Exploded View».

    STEERING WHEEL PLAY
    1.

    Set the front wheels and tires in the straight-ahead position, start engine, then lightly turn steering wheel
    to the left and right until the front wheels start to move. Measure steering wheel movement on the outer
    circumference.
    Steering wheel play on the
    outer circumference

    2.

    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering Wheel Axial End Play and Play».

    When the measurement value is outside the standard value, check backlash for each joint of steering column and installation condition of steering gear.

    F

    ST

    H

    STEERING WHEEL NEUTRAL POSITION
    Check steering wheel neutral position using the following procedure:
    1. Confirm that front wheel alignment is correct. Refer to FSU-8, «Adjustment».
    2. Set the front wheels and tires in the straight-ahead position, check if steering wheel is in the neutral position.
    3. If it is not in the neutral position, remove steering wheel and reinstall it correctly.
    4. If the neutral position cannot be attained by repositioning the steering wheel two teeth or less on steering
    stem, loosen the steering gear outer socket lock nuts, then adjust the inner sockets by the same amount
    in the opposite direction.
    5. Re-check the front wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-8, «Adjustment».

    STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Park vehicle on a level and dry surface, set parking brake.
    Tires need to be inflated normal pressure. Refer to WT-9, «Tire Air Pressure».
    Start engine.
    Check steering wheel turning force using Tool when steering
    wheel has been turned 360° from the neutral position.
    Tool number

    :

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    (J-44372)
    O

    Steering wheel turning
    force
    5.
    6.

    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering
    Wheel Turning Force».

    If steering wheel turning force is out of specification, inspect
    steering column. Refer to ST-19, «Steering Wheel Turning
    Force».
    If steering column meets specification, inspect steering gear.
    Refer to ST-14, «Inspection».

    P
    SGIA1523J

    FRONT WHEEL TURNING ANGLE
    1.

    Perform toe-in inspection. Refer to FSU-8, «Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-5

    2014 Note

    STEERING WHEEL
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    CAUTION:
    Perform front wheel turning angle inspection, after toe-in inspection.
    2. Place front wheels on turning radius gauges and rear wheels on
    stands, so that vehicle can be level.
    3. Check the maximum inner and outer wheel turning angles for
    (LH/ RH) wheels and tires.

    FAA0016D

    • With the engine at idle, turn steering wheel from full left stop to
    full right stop and measure the turning angles.
    Inner wheel (Angle: A)
    Outer wheel (Angle: B)

    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering
    Angle».
    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering
    Angle».

    SGIA0055E

    • Check the following items when turning angle is out of the standard.
    — Check rack stroke (L).
    Rack stroke (L)

    : Refer to ST-20, «Rack Stroke».

    — Disassemble steering gear to check the cause that rack stroke
    is outside of the standard.
    • Steering angles are not adjustable. Check steering gear, steering column and front suspension components for wear or damage if any of the turning angles are different from the specified
    value. Replace any of them, if any non-standard condition
    exists.
    JSGIA0272ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-6

    2014 Note

    Symptom

    Revision: April 2013
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    Shudder

    ST-7
    ×

    Shake
    ×
    ×
    ×

    Vibration
    ×
    ×
    ×

    Shimmy
    ×
    ×

    ×
    AXLE and SUSPENSION

    TIRE
    ROAD WHEEL
    DRIVE SHAFT
    BRAKE

    ×

    BR-7, «NVH Troubleshooting Chart»

    FAX-6, «NVH Troubleshooting Chart»

    WT-4, «Inspection»

    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    WT-4, «Inspection»

    FAX-6, «NVH Troubleshooting Chart»
    RAX-4, «NVH Troubleshooting Chart»
    FSU-5, «NVH Troubleshooting Chart»
    RSU-4, «NVH Troubleshooting Chart»

    ST-14, «Inspection»

    ST-10, «Inspection»

    Improper installation or looseness of steering column

    ×
    Steering linkage looseness

    ST-10, «Inspection»

    ST-10, «Inspection»

    ST-10, «Inspection»

    ST-5, «Inspection»

    ST-5, «Inspection»

    ST-18, «Inspection»

    ST-18, «Inspection»

    Steering column deformation or damage

    Mounting looseness

    Improper installation or looseness of tilt lock lever

    Improper steering wheel

    Steering wheel play

    Noise
    Outer/inner socket ball joint end play

    Possible cause and SUSPECTED PARTS
    Outer/inner socket ball joint rotating torque

    ST-18, «Inspection»

    Reference page

    Outer/inner socket ball joint swinging torque

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    A

    INFOID:0000000009385584

    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×: Applicable

    2014 Note

    B

    Use the chart below to find the cause of the symptom. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    ST

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    ×

    M

    N

    O

    P

    STEERING WHEEL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    STEERING WHEEL
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009385585

    JSGIA0704GB

    1.

    Steering wheel

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009385586

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Set the front wheels and tires in the straight-ahead position.
    Remove driver air bag module. Refer to SR-12, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove steering wheel lock nut.
    Remove steering wheel using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Place a piece of tape across the spiral cable so it will not be rotated out of position.
    Inspect steering wheel near the puller holes for damage. Replace as necessary.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Align spiral cable correctly before installing steering wheel. Make sure that the spiral cable is in the neutral
    position. Refer to SR-15, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    • The spiral cable may snap due to steering operation if the cable is not installed in the correct position.
    • With the steering linkage disconnected, the cable may snap by turning the steering wheel beyond
    the limited number of turns.

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-8

    2014 Note

    STEERING COLUMN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    STEERING COLUMN

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009385587

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    ST
    AWGIA0294ZZ

    1.

    Steering column

    2.

    Clamp

    H

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009385588

    CAUTION:
    • Any time the ignition switch has been disconnected, removed or installed; the vehicle keys must be
    re-registered in the BCM. Refer to CONSULT operations manual.
    • Care must be taken not to rotate the steering gear during the removal or installation of the steering
    column.
    • Care must be taken not to allow axial impact to the steering column during removal or installation.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Set the front wheels and tires in the straight-ahead position.
    Set the steering column tilt to the lowest position.
    CAUTION:
    Securely lock the tilt lever.
    3. Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    4. Remove spiral cable. Refer to SR-15, «Removal and Installation».
    5. Remove combination switch. Refer to BCS-68, «Removal and Installation».
    6. Remove the cluster lid A. Refer to IP-21, «Removal and Installation».
    7. Disconnect the switch harness connectors.
    8. Set the steering column tilt to the middle position.
    CAUTION:
    Do not change the position of the tilt mechanism until the steering column is reinstalled.
    9. Loosen the steering shaft lower joint bolt.
    10. Remove the steering intermediate shaft upper bolt and separate the steering intermediate shaft from the
    steering column. Refer to ST-12, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    • Place a matching mark on both steering intermediate shaft and steering column before removing
    the steering intermediate shaft.
    • When removing steering intermediate shaft, do not insert any tool into the yoke groove to pull
    out the steering intermediate shaft or damage could occur. Replace steering intermediate shaft if
    damaged.
    11. Disconnect EPS control unit harness connectors.
    Revision: April 2013

    ST-9

    2014 Note

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    STEERING COLUMN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    12. Remove steering column.
    13. Remove EPS control unit from steering column if necessary. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    14. Remove clamp from steering column if necessary.
    15. Inspect steering column after removal. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    • During installation, finger-tighten all of the bracket and joint retaining bolts, then tighten them to
    specification.
    • When installing the steering column cover, check that the vehicle harness is not stuck in the cover.
    • Replace the steering column if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • For intermediate shaft bolt direction, refer to ST-12, «Exploded View».
    • When connecting intermediate shaft upper side (1) and column
    shaft, make sure the bolt is securely seated in groove (A) of column shaft before final tightening.
    • After installing steering column, perform self-diagnosis with CONSULT to ensure correct operation. Refer to STC-6, «CONSULT
    Function».
    • Inspect steering column after installation. Refer to ST-10, «Inspection».

    SGIA1295E

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009385589

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    • Check each part of steering column assembly for damage or other malfunctions. Replace if there are any
    abnormal conditions.
    • Measure steering column rotating torque using Tool (A). Replace
    steering column if the rotating torque is outside specification
    Tool number

    :

    (J-25765-A)

    Rotating torque

    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering Column Operating Range».

    JPGIA0085ZZ

    • Measure the steering column length (L) as shown, if vehicle has
    been involved in a minor collision. Replace steering column if outside specification.
    Steering column length (L)

    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering
    Column Operating Range».

    JPGIA0111ZZ

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Rotate steering wheel to make sure it is centered and there is no binding, noise or excessive steering effort.
    • Make sure that the number of turns are the same from the straight-ahead position to the left and right locks.
    • Check each part of steering column for damage or other malfunctions. Replace if there are any abnormal
    conditions. Refer to ST-19, «Steering Column Operating Range».
    Revision: April 2013

    ST-10

    2014 Note

    STEERING COLUMN
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Check the steering wheel play, neutral position steering wheel, steering wheel turning force, and front wheel
    turning angle. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».
    • Check tilt mechanism operating range (T) as shown.
    Tilt operating range (T)

    : Refer to ST-19, «Steering Column Operating Range».

    A

    B

    C

    D
    JPGIA0043ZZ

    E

    F

    ST

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-11

    2014 Note

    STEERING SHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    STEERING SHAFT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009385590

    JPGIA0112GB

    1.

    Lower joint

    2.

    Steering intermediate shaft

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Steering column
    INFOID:0000000009385591

    REMOVAL
    CAUTION:
    Spiral cable may be cut if steering wheel turns while separating steering column and steering gear. Be
    sure to secure steering wheel using string to avoid turning.
    1. Set the front wheels and tires in the straight-ahead position.
    2. Set the steering column tilt to the middle position.
    CAUTION:
    Securely lock the tilt lever.
    3. Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    4. Loosen lower joint upper bolt.
    5. Remove lower joint lower bolt and separate lower joint from the steering gear lower shaft.
    CAUTION:
    • Place a matching mark on both lower joint and steering gear lower shaft before removing lower
    joint.
    • When removing lower joint, do not insert any tool into the yoke groove to pull out the lower joint.
    Replace the lower joint if damaged.
    6. Remove lower joint from steering intermediate shaft.
    7. Remove the steering intermediate shaft bolt, from steering column, and remove steering intermediate
    shaft from steering column.
    CAUTION:
    • Place a matching mark on both steering intermediate shaft and steering column before removing
    steering intermediate shaft.
    • When removing the steering intermediate shaft, do not insert any tool into the yoke groove to
    pull out the steering intermediate shaft or damage could occur. Replace the steering intermediate shaft if damaged.

    INSTALLATION
    CAUTION:
    During installation, finger-tighten all of the bracket and joint retaining bolts; then tighten them to specification. Do not apply undue stress to the steering column.
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    Revision: April 2013

    ST-12

    2014 Note

    STEERING SHAFT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Before installation, check that steering column tilt is in the middle position.
    • For intermediate shaft bolt, and lower joint bolt direction, refer to ST-12, «Exploded View».
    • To install align the steering gear guide protrusion (A) with the
    groove of lower joint (1), make sure the bolt is securely seated in
    groove (B) of steering gear before final tightening.
    CAUTION:
    If a guide protrusion is not included, align with the matching
    mark placed at the removal step.
    • When tightening lower joint bolt to the steering gear lower shaft,
    temporarily tighten it and make sure there is no sticking or galling
    before final tightening.

    A

    B

    C

    D
    JPGIA0041ZZ

    • When connecting intermediate shaft upper side (1) and column
    shaft, make sure the bolt is securely seated in groove (A) of column shaft before final tightening.

    E

    F

    ST

    SGIA1295E

    H

    • Perform inspection after installation. Refer to ST-13, «Inspection».
    I

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009385592

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    • Check each part of steering intermediate shaft, lower joint, and steering column for damage or other malfunctions. Replace if there are any abnormal conditions.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Rotate steering wheel to make sure it is centered and there is no binding, noise or excessive steering effort.
    • Make sure that the number of turns are the same from the straight-ahead position to the left and right locks.
    • Check each part of steering intermediate shaft, lower joint, and steering column for damage or other malfunctions. Replace if there are any abnormal conditions.
    • Check the steering wheel play, neutral position steering wheel, steering wheel turning force, and front wheel
    turning angle. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-13

    2014 Note

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009385593

    AWGIA0236ZZ

    1.

    Guide

    4.

    Front suspension member

    2.

    Cowl seal

    3.

    Steering gear

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009385594

    CAUTION:
    • Spiral cable may be cut if steering wheel turns while separating steering column and steering gear;
    Always secure the steering wheel using string to avoid turning.
    • Place a matching mark on both lower joint and steering gear before removing lower joint.
    • When removing lower joint, do not place any tool into the yoke groove to pull out the lower joint.
    Replace the lower joint if damaged.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Set the front wheels and tires in the straight-ahead position.
    Set the steering column tilt to the middle position.
    CAUTION:
    Securely lock the tilt lever.
    Remove front suspension member. Refer to FSU-14, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the steering gear bolts and nuts and separate the steering gear from the front suspension member.
    Separate cowl seal from steering gear if necessary.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • During installation, finger-tighten all of the bracket and joint retaining bolts; then tighten them to
    specification. Do not apply undue stress to the steering column.
    • The guide protrusion is not required to be reinstalled.
    • Before installation, check that the steering column tilt is in the middle position.
    • Clean mating surface on the body side of cowl seal when installing steering gear assembly.
    • Inspect steering gear after installation. Refer to ST-14, «Inspection».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009385595

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    • Check each part of steering gear for damage or other malfunctions. Replace if there are any abnormal conditions. Refer to ST-14, «Inspection».
    Revision: April 2013

    ST-14

    2014 Note

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Rotate steering wheel to make sure it is centered and there is no binding, noise or excessive steering effort.
    • Make sure that the number of turns are the same from the straight-ahead position to the left and right locks.
    • Check each part of steering system for damage or other malfunctions. Replace if there are any abnormal
    conditions.
    • Check the steering wheel play, neutral position steering wheel, steering wheel turning force, and front wheel
    turning angle. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».
    • Check wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-8, «Adjustment».

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    ST

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-15

    2014 Note

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009385596

    ALGIA0098GB

    1.

    Joint cover

    2.

    Steering gear

    3.

    Inner socket

    4.

    Inner boot clamp

    5.

    Boot

    6.

    Outer boot clamp

    7.

    Outer socket

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009385597

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.

    2.
    3.

    Remove outer socket lock nut and outer socket.
    CAUTION:
    When loosening outer socket lock nut, be sure to hold outer socket with a suitable tool to prevent
    ball joint from contacting knuckle.
    Remove inner boot clamp, outer boot clamp and remove boot.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage inner socket or steering gear housing when removing boot.
    Remove inner socket.

    ASSEMBLY
    1.

    Apply (Autolex A or Dow Corning 111) or equivalent to inner socket and turn pinion fully to retract inner
    socket into gear housing assembly.
    CAUTION:
    Make sure there are no contaminants in the grease, on the inner socket, or inside the steering gear
    housing.

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-16

    2014 Note

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    2. Install large end (1) of boot (2) to gear housing assembly.
    3. Install small end (3) of boot (2) to inner socket boot mounting
    groove.

    A

    B

    C
    AWGIA0107ZZ

    D

    4.
    5.

    Install outer boot clamp to boot small end using suitable tool.
    Install inner boot clamp to boot large end using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse boot clamps.

    E

    F

    ST

    H

    I

    J

    AST139

    6.
    7.

    Install outer socket.
    Adjust inner socket to standard length (L) and then tighten lock
    nut to the specified torque. Check length of inner socket (L)
    again after tightening lock nut.
    Inner socket length (L)

    L

    M

    : Refer to ST-20, «Inner
    Socket Length».

    CAUTION:
    The length achieved after toe-in adjustment is not necessarily the above value.

    N

    SGIA0167E

    8.

    Check wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-7, «Inspection».
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-17

    K

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    STEERING GEAR AND LINKAGE
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    When tightening outer socket lock nut (1), be sure to hold
    outer socket (2) using a suitable tool to prevent ball joint
    from contacting knuckle.

    JSGIA0538ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009385598

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Boot
    • Check boot for cracks and replace it if damage exists.
    Steering gear
    • Check steering gear for damage and scratches to the inner wall. Replace if there are any abnormal conditions.
    Outer Socket and Inner Socket
    Check the following items and replace the component if outside specification:
    BALL JOINT SWINGING FORCE

    • Hook a Tool at the point shown and pull the spring balance. Make
    sure that the Tool reads the specified value when ball stud and
    inner socket start to move. Replace outer socket (1) and inner
    socket (2) if they are outside the standard.
    Tool number

    :

    (J-44372)

    Measuring point of outer
    socket (1)
    Measuring point of inner
    socket (2)
    Swinging force

    : Ball stud upper side (A)
    : Point (B)

    JPGIA0188ZZ

    : Refer to ST-20, «Ball Joint Swing
    Force».

    BALL JOINT AXIAL END PLAY

    • Apply an axial load of 490 N (50 kg-f, 110 lb-f) to ball stud. Using a
    dial gauge, measure amount of stud movement and make sure
    that the value is within the following specified range. Replace outer
    socket (1) and inner socket (2) if the measured value is outside the
    standard.
    Axial end play

    : Refer to ST-20, «Ball Joint Axial End
    Play».

    JSGIA0109ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    ST-18

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    General Specifications

    INFOID:0000000009385599

    Steering gear model

    R24K

    B

    C

    Steering Wheel Axial End Play and Play

    INFOID:0000000009385600

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item

    Standard

    Steering wheel axial end play

    D

    0 (0)

    Steering wheel play on the outer circumference

    E

    0 — 35 (0 — 1.38)

    Steering Wheel Turning Force

    INFOID:0000000009385601

    Unit: N (kg-f, lb-f)

    Item

    F

    Standard

    Steering wheel turning force

    ST

    36 (3.7, 8.09) or less

    Steering Angle

    INFOID:0000000009385602

    Unit: Degree minute (Decimal degree)

    H

    I

    J

    K
    SGIA0055E

    Item

    Inner wheel (Angle A)

    Outer wheel (Angle B)

    Minimum

    34° 30′ (34.5°)

    Nominal

    37° 30′ (37.5°)

    Maximum

    38° 30′ (38.5°)

    Nominal

    32° 00′ (32.0°)

    Steering Column Operating Range

    M

    INFOID:0000000009385603

    Item
    Tilt operating

    L

    Standard

    Standard

    range*

    O

    39.4 mm (1.551 in)

    Rotating torque

    1.4 – 2.1 N·m (0.14 – 0.21 kg-m, 12 – 19 in-lb)

    Steering column length*

    477.9 mm (18.81 in)

    *: For measuring position, refer to ST-10, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    ST-19

    2014 Note

    P

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Rack Stroke

    INFOID:0000000009385604

    Unit: mm (in)

    JSGIA0272ZZ

    Item

    Standard

    Rack stroke neutral position (L)

    64.6 (2.543)

    Ball Joint Swing Force

    INFOID:0000000009385605

    Item

    Standard

    Outer socket

    Spring balance measurement

    *

    6.0 – 58 N (0.61 – 5.9 kg-f, 1.35 – 13.03 lb-f)

    Inner socket

    Spring balance measurement*

    3.5 – 34.7 N (0.36 – 3.5 kg-f, 0.79 – 7.8 lb-f)

    *: For measuring position, refer to ST-14, «Inspection».

    Ball Joint Axial End Play

    INFOID:0000000009385606

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item

    Standard

    Outer socket

    0.5 (0.020) or less

    Inner socket

    0.2 (0.008 in) or less

    Inner Socket Length

    INFOID:0000000009385607

    Unit: mm (in)

    Item

    Standard

    SGIA0167E

    Inner socket length (L)

    Revision: April 2013

    67.4 (2.654)

    ST-20

    2014 Note

    STEERING

    SECTION

    STC

    STEERING CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..18

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    C1604 TORQUE SENSOR ………………………….. 21

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Service Notice and Precautions for EPS System …… 3

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….21
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..21

    F

    STC

    C1606 EPS MOTOR …………………………………… 23
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….23
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..23
    Component Inspection ………………………………………23

    H

    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 4
    EPS Control Unit ………………………………………………. 5
    EPS Motor, Torque Sensor, Reduction Gear ………… 5

    C1607, C1608 EPS CONTROL UNIT …………… 25

    I

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (EPS CONTROL UNIT)
    ….. 6

    C1609 VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL ……………….. 26

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4

    CONSULT Function ………………………………………….. 6

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION …………… 8
    EPS CONTROL UNIT …………………………………… 8
    Reference Value ………………………………………………. 8
    Fail-Safe ………………………………………………………….. 9
    Protection Function …………………………………………. 10
    DTC Inspection Priority Chart …………………………… 10
    DTC Index ……………………………………………………… 10

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….25
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..25
    Description ………………………………………………………26
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….26
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..26
    Description ………………………………………………………27
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….27
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..27

    L

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ……………………… 28

    M

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 11
    EPS SYSTEM ……………………………………………..11

    EPS WARNING LAMP ……………………………….. 29

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 15
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ………15
    Work Flow ……………………………………………………… 15
    Diagnostic Work Sheet …………………………………….. 16

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 18

    Component Function Check ………………………………29
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..29

    N

    O

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 30
    EPS WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON… 30
    Description ………………………………………………………30
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..30

    C1601 BATTERY POWER SUPPLY ……………..18

    EPS WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN
    OFF ………………………………………………………….. 31

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………… 18

    Description ………………………………………………………31

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    C1610 ENGINE STATUS SIGNAL ………………. 27

    Description ………………………………………………………28
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………….28
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..28

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………. 11

    J

    STC-1

    2014 Note

    P

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 31

    STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE IS
    HEAVY OR LIGHT ……………………………………… 32
    Description …………………………………………………….. 32
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 32

    UNBALANCE STEERING WHEEL TURNING
    FORCE AND RETURN BETWEEN RIGHT
    AND LEFT …………………………………………………. 34

    UNBALANCE STEERING WHEEL TURNING
    FORCE (TORQUE VARIATION) ………………….. 35
    Description …………………………………………………….. 35
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 35

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ………….. 37
    EPS CONTROL UNIT …………………………………. 37
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 37
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 37

    Description …………………………………………………….. 34
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 34

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009499764

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Service Notice and Precautions for EPS System

    INFOID:0000000009016063

    • Check the following item when performing the trouble diagnosis:
    — Check for possible causes of the malfunction by interviewing the customer as to what conditions were
    present when the symptom occurred.
    — Check if the steering wheel and the EPS control unit are genuine parts.
    — Check if the air pressure and size of each tire is correct.
    — Check if the installation of the links and suspension components are correct.
    — Check if the tires are worn evenly, indicating the wheel alignment is correct.
    — Check if the installation of the steering column and the steering gear are correct. Check for loose bolts, damaged links, cracked boots and leaking grease, etc.
    — Check for damage or modification to suspension or body resulting in increased weight or altered ground
    clearance.
    — Check if the battery voltage is proper.
    — Check the EPS control unit harness to be sure the harness connectors are fully seated.
    • Before connecting or disconnecting the EPS control unit harness connector, turn ignition switch “OFF” and
    disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal. Battery voltage is applied to the EPS control unit
    even if ignition switch is turned “OFF”.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    STC

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-3

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009016064

    ALGIA0166ZZ

    A.

    Steering column assembly

    No.

    1.

    2.

    3.

    Component

    Function

    Combination meter
    (EPS warning lamp)

    • Transmits mainly the following signal to EPS control unit via
    CAN communication.
    — Vehicle speed signal (Meter)
    • Turns ON the EPS warning lamp according to the signal
    from EPS control unit via CAN communication.
    • For detailed installation location, refer to MWI-5, «METER
    SYSTEM : Component Parts Location».

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    • Transmits mainly the following signal to EPS control unit via
    CAN communication.
    — Vehicle speed signal (ABS)
    • For detailed installation location, refer to BRC-6, «Component Parts Location».

    ECM

    • Transmits mainly the following signals to EPS control unit
    via CAN communication.
    — Engine status signal
    • For detailed installation location, refer to EC-11, «ENGINE
    CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location».
    • Receives mainly the following signal from EPS control unit
    via CAN communication.
    — EPS torque signal

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-4

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component

    Function

    EPS motor

    Refer to STC-5, «EPS Motor, Torque Sensor, Reduction
    Gear».

    Reduction gear

    Refer to STC-5, «EPS Motor, Torque Sensor, Reduction
    Gear».

    5.

    EPS control unit

    Refer to STC-5, «EPS Control Unit».

    6.

    Torque sensor

    4.

    Refer to STC-5, «EPS Motor, Torque Sensor, Reduction
    Gear».

    EPS Control Unit

    A

    B

    C

    INFOID:0000000009499783

    D

    • EPS control unit (1) is installed to steering column assembly.
    • EPS control unit performs an arithmetical operation on data, such
    as steering wheel turning force (sensor signal) from the torque
    sensor, vehicle speed signal, etc. Then it generates an optimum
    assist torque signal to the EPS motor according to the driving condition.
    • EPS control unit decreases the output signal to EPS motor while
    extremely using the power steering function (e.g., full steering)
    consecutively for protecting EPS motor and EPS control unit
    (Overload protection control).

    E

    F

    STC
    JSGIA0852ZZ

    EPS Motor, Torque Sensor, Reduction Gear

    INFOID:0000000009499784

    H

    EPS motor (1), torque sensor (2) and reduction gear (3) are installed
    to steering column assembly.
    I

    J

    K
    JSGIA0853ZZ

    EPS MOTOR

    L

    EPS motor provides the assist torque by the control signal from EPS control unit.

    TORQUE SENSOR
    Torque sensor detects the steering torque, and transmits the signal to EPS control unit.

    M

    REDUCTION GEAR
    Reduction gear increases the assist torque provided from EPS motor with worm gears, and outputs to the column shaft.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-5

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (EPS CONTROL UNIT)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (EPS CONTROL UNIT)
    CONSULT Function

    INFOID:0000000009499768

    FUNCTION
    CONSULT can display each diagnostic item using the diagnostic test modes shown following.
    Diagnostic test mode

    Function

    ECU identification

    The part number stored in the control unit can be read.

    Self diagnostic result

    Self-diagnostic results and freeze frame data can be read and erased quickly.*

    Data monitor

    Input/Output data in the EPS control unit can be read.

    *: The following diagnosis information is erased by erasing.
    • DTC
    • Freeze frame data (FFD)

    ECU IDENTIFICATION
    Displays the part number stored in the control unit.

    SELF-DIAG RESULTS MODE
    Refer to STC-10, «DTC Index».
    When “CRNT” is displayed on self-diagnosis result.

    • The system is presently malfunctioning.

    When “PAST” is displayed on self-diagnosis result.

    • System malfunction in the past is detected, but the system is presently normal.
    FREEZE FRAME DATA (FFD)
    The following vehicle status is recorded when DTC is detected and is displayed on CONSULT.
    Item name

    Display item
    The number of times that ignition switch is turned ON after the DTC is detected is displayed.
    • When “0” is displayed: It indicates that the system is presently malfunctioning.
    • When except “0” is displayed: It indicates that system malfunction in the past is detected, but the system is presently normal.
    NOTE:
    Each time when ignition switch is turned OFF to ON, numerical number increases in 1→2→3…38→39.
    When the operation number of times exceeds 39, the number does not increase and “39” is displayed until selfdiagnosis is erased.

    IGN COUNTER
    (0-39)

    DATA MONITOR MODE
    Monitor item (Unit)

    Remarks

    BATTERY VOLT (V)

    Displays the power supply voltage for EPS control unit.

    TORQUE SENSOR (Nm)

    Displays steering wheel turning force detected by torque sensor.

    MOTOR CURRENT (A)

    Displays the current value consumed by EPS motor.*1

    MOTOR SIG (A)

    Displays the current commanded value to EPS motor.

    ASSIST TORQUE (Nm)

    Displays assist torque being output by the electric power steering.

    C/U TEMP (°C or °F )

    Displays the temperature of the EPS control unit.

    ASSIST LEVEL (%)

    Normally displays 100%. In case of an excessive stationary steering, the assist
    curvature gradually falls. However, it return to 100% when left standing.*2

    VEHICLE SPEED (km/h or MPH)

    Vehicle speed is displayed from vehicle speed signal via CAN communication.*3

    WARNING LAMP (On/Off)

    EPS warning lamp control status is displayed.

    ENGINE STATUS (Stop/Run)

    Engine speed is displayed from engine status signal via CAN communication.

    *1: Almost in accordance with the value of “MOTOR SIG”. It is not a malfunction though these values are not
    accorded when steering quickly.
    Revision: April 2013

    STC-6

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (EPS CONTROL UNIT)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    *2: Normally displays 100%. In case of an excessive stationary steering, the assist curvature gradually falls.
    However, it returns to 100% when left standing.
    *3: It is not a malfunction, though it might not be corresponding just after ignition switch in turned ON.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    STC

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-7

    2014 Note

    EPS CONTROL UNIT
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    EPS CONTROL UNIT
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009485778

    VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL
    CAUTION:
    The output signal indicates the EPS control unit calculation data. The normal values will be displayed
    even in the event that the output circuit (harness) is open.
    Data monitor

    Monitor item
    BATTERY VOLT

    TORQUE SENSOR

    MOTOR CURRENT

    Condition
    Ignition switch: ON

    Engine running

    Engine running

    Battery voltage
    Steering wheel: Not steering (There is
    no steering force)

    Approx. 0 Nm

    Steering wheel: Right turn

    Positive value (Nm)

    Steering wheel: Left turn

    Negative value (Nm)

    Steering wheel: Not steering (There is
    no steering force)

    Approx. 0 A

    Steering wheel: Right or left turn

    MOTOR SIG

    Engine running

    Display value

    Displays consumption current of
    EPS motor (A)*1

    Steering wheel: Not steering (There is
    no steering force)

    Approx. 0 A

    Steering wheel: Right turn

    Positive value (A)

    Steering wheel: Left turn

    Negative value (A)

    ASSIST TORQUE

    Engine running

    Approx. 0 Nm*2

    C/U TEMP

    Ignition switch ON or engine running

    Displays temperature of inside of
    EPS control unit (°C or °F)

    ASSIST LEVEL

    Engine running

    100 %*3

    Vehicle stopped

    0 km/h or mph

    VEHICLE SPEED

    WARNING LAMP

    ENGINE STATUS

    Approximately equal to the indication
    While driving

    on speedometer*4
    (inside of ±10%)

    EPS warning lamp: ON

    On

    EPS warning lamp: OFF

    Off

    Engine not running

    Stop

    Engine running

    Run

    *1: Almost in accordance with the value of “MOTOR SIG”. It is not a malfunction though these values are not
    accorded when steering quickly.
    *2: A fixed value is indicated regardless of steering turning.
    *3: Normally displays 100%. In case of an excessive stationary steering, the assist curvature gradually falls.
    However, it returns to 100% when left standing.
    *4: It is not a malfunction, though it might not be corresponding just after ignition switch in turned ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-8

    2014 Note

    EPS CONTROL UNIT
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    TERMINAL LAYOUT
    A

    B

    C
    ALGIA0167ZZ

    D

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    Terminal No.
    (Wire Color)

    Description

    Condition

    Value
    (Approx.)

    E

    F

    +

    1
    (P)

    CAN-L

    Input/Output

    2
    (L)

    CAN-H

    Input/Output

    4
    (Y)

    Ground

    Ignition power supply

    Input

    13
    (R)

    Ground

    Torque sensor power
    supply

    Output

    14
    (Y)

    15
    (B)

    Ground

    Ground

    Signal name

    Torque sensor sub

    Torque sensor ground

    Input/Output

    Ignition switch: ON

    Battery voltage

    Ignition switch: OFF

    0V

    Ignition switch: ON

    5V

    Ignition switch: OFF

    0V
    Steering wheel: Not
    steering (There is no
    steering force)

    2.5 V

    I

    Engine running

    Steering wheel: steering

    1.6 V – 3.4 V
    (The value is changed
    according to steering
    left or right)

    J

    0V

    K

    Always

    Ignition switch: ON
    16
    (W)

    Ground

    Torque sensor main

    Ground

    Battery power supply

    18
    (B)

    Ground

    19
    (−)
    20
    (B)

    Steering wheel: Not
    steering (There is no
    steering force)

    2.5 V

    Steering wheel: steering

    1.6 V – 3.4 V
    (The value is changed
    according to steering
    left or right)

    Input
    Engine running

    17
    (R)

    H

    Ignition switch: ON
    Input

    Input

    STC

    Input

    Always

    Battery voltage

    Ground

    Always

    0V

    Motor

    Motor

    L

    M

    N

    P

    Fail-Safe

    INFOID:0000000009485779

    • If any malfunction occurs in the system and control unit detects the malfunction, EPS warning lamp on combination meter turns ON to indicate system malfunction.
    • When EPS warning lamp is ON, the system enters into a manual steering state. (Steering wheel turning
    force becomes heavy.)
    • Under abnormal vehicle speed signal conditions, vehicle speed is judged as constant.
    Revision: April 2013

    O

    STC-9

    2014 Note

    EPS CONTROL UNIT
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    Protection Function

    INFOID:0000000009485780

    EPS control unit decreases the output signal to EPS motor while extremely using the power steering function
    (e.g., full steering) consecutively for protecting EPS motor and EPS control unit (Overload protection control).
    While activating overload protection control, the assist torque gradually decreases, and the steering wheel
    turning force becomes heavy. The normal assist torque reactivates by no steering.

    DTC Inspection Priority Chart

    INFOID:0000000009485781

    When multiple DTCs are detected simultaneously, check one by one depending on the following priority list.
    Priority

    Priority order item (DTC)

    1

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    2

    C1609 CAN VHCL SPEED, C1610 CAN ENG RPM

    3

    C1601 BATTERY VOLT

    4

    Other than the above

    DTC Index

    INFOID:0000000009485782

    DTC

    Items (CONSULT screen terms)

    Reference

    C1601

    BATTERY VOLT

    STC-18, «DTC Logic»

    C1604

    TORQUE SENSOR

    STC-21, «DTC Logic»

    C1606

    EPS MOTOR

    STC-23, «DTC Logic»

    C1607

    EEPROM

    STC-25, «DTC Logic»

    C1608

    CONTROL UNIT

    STC-25, «DTC Logic»

    C1609

    CAN VHCL SPEED

    STC-26, «DTC Logic»

    C1610

    CAN ENG RPM

    STC-27, «DTC Logic»

    U1000

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    STC-28, «DTC Logic»

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-10

    2014 Note

    EPS SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    EPS SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009016071

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    STC

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AAGWA0033GB

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-11

    2014 Note

    EPS SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAGIA0066GB

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-12

    2014 Note

    EPS SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    STC

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AAGIA0067GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-13

    2014 Note

    EPS SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AAGIA0068GB

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009485783

    B

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.INTERVIEW FROM THE CUSTOMER

    C

    Clarify customer complaints before inspection. First of all, perform an interview utilizing STC-16, «Diagnostic
    Work Sheet» and reproduce symptoms to understand them fully. Ask customer about his/her complaints carefully. Check symptoms by driving vehicle with customer, if necessary.
    CAUTION:
    Customers are not professional. Never make assumptions like “maybe the customer means that…,” or
    “maybe the customer mentioned this symptom”.

    D

    E

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK SYMPTOM

    F

    Reproduce the symptom that is indicated by the customer, based on the information from the customer
    obtained by interview. Also check that the symptom is not caused by protection function. Refer to STC-10,
    STC
    «Protection Function».
    CAUTION:
    When the symptom is caused by normal operation, fully inspect each portion and obtain the understanding of customer that the symptom is not caused by a malfunction.
    H
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    I

    With CONSULT
    Perform self-diagnosis for “EPS”.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Record or print self-diagnosis results. GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    J

    K

    4.RECHECK SYMPTOM

    With CONSULT
    1. Erase self-diagnostic results for “EPS”.
    2. Perform DTC confirmation procedures for the malfunctioning system.
    NOTE:
    If some DTCs are detected at the same time, determine the order for performing the diagnosis based on STC10, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart».
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Check harness and connectors based on the information obtained by interview. Refer to GI-41,
    «Intermittent Incident».

    L

    M

    N

    5.REPAIR OR REPLACE MALFUNCTIONING COMPONENT

    O

    • Repair or replace malfunctioning component.
    • Reconnect part or connector after repairing or replacing.
    • When DTC is detected, erase self-diagnostic results for “EPS”.

    P

    >> GO TO 7.

    6.IDENTIFY MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM BY SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    Estimate malfunctioning system based on symptom diagnosis and perform inspection.
    Can the malfunctioning system be identified?
    Revision: April 2013

    STC-15

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Check harness and connectors based on the information obtained by interview. Refer to GI-41,
    «Intermittent Incident».

    7.FINAL CHECK

    With CONSULT
    1. Check the reference value for EPS control unit.
    2. Recheck the symptom and check that symptom is not reproduced on the same conditions.
    Is the symptom reproduced?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnostic Work Sheet

    INFOID:0000000009485784

    Description
    • In general, customers have their own criteria for a problem. Therefore, it is important to understand the
    symptom and status well enough by asking the customer about his/her concerns carefully. To systemize all
    the information for the diagnosis, prepare the interview sheet referring to the interview points.
    • In some cases, multiple conditions that appear simultaneously may cause a DTC to be detected.

    Interview sheet sample
    Interview sheet
    Customer
    name

    MR/MS

    Storage date

    Registration
    number

    Initial year
    registration

    Vehicle type

    VIN

    Engine

    Mileage

    km (Mile)

    †The steering wheel position (center) is in the wrong position.
    †Warning lamp turns on.
    Symptom

    †Noise

    †Vibration

    †Others
    (

    )

    First occurrence

    †Recently

    Frequency of occurrence

    †Always

    †Others (

    )

    †Under a certain conditions of

    †Sometimes (time(s)/day)

    †Irrelevant
    Climate conditions

    Weather

    †Fine

    Temperature

    †Hot

    Relative humidity

    †High

    †Cloud
    †Warm

    †Rain
    †Cool

    †Moderate

    †Snow
    †Cold

    †Others (
    †Temperature [Approx.

    °C (°F)]

    †Low

    Road conditions

    †Urban area
    †Suburb area
    †High way
    †Mountain road (uphill or down hill)
    †Rough road

    Operation conditions, etc.

    †Irrelevant
    †When engine starts
    †During idling
    †During driving
    †During acceleration
    †At constant speed driving
    †During deceleration
    †During cornering (right curve or left curve)
    †During steering

    Revision: April 2013

    )

    STC-16

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Interview sheet
    Customer
    name
    Storage date

    MR/MS

    Registration
    number

    Initial year
    registration

    Vehicle type

    VIN

    Engine

    Mileage

    A

    km (Mile)

    Other conditions

    B

    C

    Memo

    D

    E

    F

    STC

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-17

    2014 Note

    C1601 BATTERY POWER SUPPLY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    C1601 BATTERY POWER SUPPLY
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009578758

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1601

    Display item

    Malfunction detected condition
    When a power supply voltage to the EPS control unit
    is maintained at 17.5 V or more or at less than 9V
    continuously for five second or more.

    BATTERY VOLT

    Possible cause




    Harness or connector
    EPS control unit
    Fuse
    Power supply system
    Battery

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
    wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DTC REPRODUCTION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1601” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578759

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to STC-11, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect EPS control unit harness connector.
    Check continuity between EPS control unit harness connector terminal and ground.
    EPS control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    E23

    18

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    4. Connect EPS control unit harness connector.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    2.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (1)

    1.

    Check voltage between EPS control unit harness connector terminal and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-18

    2014 Note

    C1601 BATTERY POWER SUPPLY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A

    EPS control unit

    2.
    3.

    Connector

    Terminal

    M53

    4

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 0 V

    B

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    CAUTION:
    Never start the engine.
    Check voltage between EPS control unit harness connector and ground.
    EPS control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M53

    4

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    C

    D

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (2)

    F

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check the 10A fuse (No. 5).
    STC
    Check the harness for open or short between EPS control unit harness connector M53 terminal 4 and the
    10A fuse (No. 5).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    H
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for ignition power supply circuit. Refer to PG-22, «Wiring Diagram
    — Ignition Power Supply —».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning component.
    I
    CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (3)

    4.
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check voltage between EPS control unit harness connector terminal and ground.
    EPS control unit

    3.
    4.

    Connector

    Terminal

    E23

    17

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    J

    K

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    CAUTION:
    Never start the engine.
    Check voltage between EPS control unit harness connector and ground.

    L

    M
    EPS control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    E23

    17

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    O

    5.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (4)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check the 60A fusible link (J).
    Check the harness for open or short between EPS control unit harness connector E23 terminal 17 and the
    60A fusible link (J).
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for power supply circuit. Refer to PG-10, «Wiring Diagram — Battery Power Supply —».
    Revision: April 2013

    STC-19

    2014 Note

    P

    C1601 BATTERY POWER SUPPLY
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning component.

    6.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect torque sensor harness connector.
    Check terminal for deformation, disconnection, looseness, and so on. If any malfunction is found, repair or
    replace terminal.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning component.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-20

    2014 Note

    C1604 TORQUE SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1604 TORQUE SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009578760

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    C1604

    B

    Display item
    TORQUE SENSOR

    Malfunction detected condition
    When torque sensor output signal is malfunctioning.

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connector
    • Torque sensor
    • EPS control unit

    C

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    If “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
    wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.

    E

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2.DTC REPRODUCTION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1604” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to STC-21, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    STC

    H

    INFOID:0000000009578761

    I

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to STC-11, «Wiring Diagram».

    J

    1.CHECK TORQUE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    K

    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF to ON.
    CAUTION:
    Never start the engine.
    Check voltage between EPS control unit harness connector terminal and ground.
    CAUTION:
    Steering wheel in neutral position. (There is no steering force.)
    EPS control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M54

    13

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 5 V

    L

    M

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for battery power supply circuit. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK TORQUE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    P

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between EPS control unit harness connector terminal and ground.
    CAUTION:
    Steering wheel in neutral position. (There is no steering force.)

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-21

    O

    2014 Note

    C1604 TORQUE SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    EPS control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    M54

    15

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.

    3.CHECK TORQUE SENSOR SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch OFF to ON.
    Check voltage between EPS control unit harness connector terminal and ground.
    CAUTION:
    Steering wheel in neutral position. (There is no steering force.)
    EPS control unit
    Connector

    Terminal
    16

    M54

    3.
    4.

    14

    Voltage

    Ground

    Approx. 2.5 V

    Start the engine.
    Check voltage between EPS control unit harness connector terminal and ground while turning the steering wheel.
    EPS control unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    Voltage

    Ground

    1.6 V – 3.4 V
    (The value is changed according to
    steering left or right)

    16
    M54

    14

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Torque sensor is malfunctioning. Replace steering column assembly. Refer to ST-9, «Removal
    and Installation».

    4.CHECK CONNECTOR

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect EPS control unit harness connector.
    Check terminal for deformation, disconnection, looseness, and so on. If any malfunction is found, repair or
    replace terminal.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning component.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-22

    2014 Note

    C1606 EPS MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1606 EPS MOTOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009578762

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    C1606

    B

    Display item

    Malfunction detected condition
    When the motor driver malfunction of EPS control
    unit or EPS motor malfunction is detected.

    EPS MOTOR

    Possible cause
    • Harness or connector
    • EPS motor
    • EPS control unit

    C

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    D

    If “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
    wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.

    E

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2.DTC REPRODUCTION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1606” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to STC-23, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    STC

    H

    INFOID:0000000009578763

    I

    1.CHECK EPS MOTOR
    Check the EPS motor. Refer to STC-23, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> EPS motor is malfunction. Replace steering column assembly. Refer to ST-9, «Removal and
    Installation».

    2.CHECK CONNECTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect EPS motor harness connector.
    Check terminal for deformation, disconnection, looseness, and so on. If any malfunction is found, repair or
    replace terminal.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning component.

    Component Inspection

    EPS motor

    M

    N

    P

    Resistance (Approx.)

    Terminal
    20

    0.1 Ω or less

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    L

    O

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect EPS motor harness connector.
    Check resistance between EPS motor connector terminals.

    19

    K

    INFOID:0000000009578764

    1.CHECK EPS MOTOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    STC-23

    2014 Note

    C1606 EPS MOTOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> EPS motor is malfunctioning. Replace steering column assembly. Refer to ST-9, «Removal and
    Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-24

    2014 Note

    C1607, C1608 EPS CONTROL UNIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1607, C1608 EPS CONTROL UNIT

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009578765

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    C1607
    C1608

    B

    Display item

    Malfunction detected condition

    EEPROM

    When the memory (EEPROM) system malfunction is
    detected in EPS control unit.

    CONTROL UNIT

    When the internal malfunction is detected in EPS
    control unit.

    Possible cause

    C
    EPS control unit

    D

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    E

    If “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
    wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
    F

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DTC REPRODUCTION PROCEDURE

    STC

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1607” or “C1608” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to STC-25, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    I
    INFOID:0000000009578766

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    J

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Erase self-diagnosis results for “EPS”.
    3. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1607” or “C1608” detected?
    YES >> Replace EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Check EPS control unit pin terminals for damage or loose connection with harness connector. If
    any item are damaged, repair or replace malfunctioning component.

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-25

    2014 Note

    C1609 VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1609 VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009578767

    EPS control unit receives the vehicle speed signal from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN
    communication line.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009578768

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1609

    Display item

    CAN VHCL SPEED

    Malfunction detected condition
    • Malfunction is detected in vehicle speed signal that
    is output from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) via CAN communication.
    • ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) input
    signal error is detected.

    Possible cause




    Harness or connector
    CAN communication line
    EPS control unit
    ABS malfunction
    Vehicle speed signal error

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
    wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DTC REPRODUCTION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1609” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to STC-26, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578769

    1.PERFORM ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT) SELF-DIAGNOSIS
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “ABS” self-diagnosis.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check the DTC.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    With CONSULT
    Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1609” detected?
    YES >> Replace EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Check EPS control unit pin terminals for damage or loose connection with harness connector. If
    any item are damaged, repair or replace malfunctioning component.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-26

    2014 Note

    C1610 ENGINE STATUS SIGNAL
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    C1610 ENGINE STATUS SIGNAL

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009578770

    EPS control unit receives the engine status signal from ECM via CAN communication line.

    DTC Logic

    B
    INFOID:0000000009578771

    C

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    C1610

    Display item

    CAN ENG RPM

    Malfunction detected condition
    • Malfunction is detected in engine status signal
    that is output from ECM via CAN communication.
    • ECM input signal error is detected.

    Possible cause




    Harness or connector
    CAN communication line
    EPS control unit
    ECM
    Engine status signal error

    D

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    F

    If “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
    wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
    STC
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DTC REPRODUCTION PROCEDURE

    H

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1610” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to STC-27, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009578772

    K

    1.PERFORM ECM SELF-DIAGNOSIS
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “ENGINE” self-diagnosis. Refer to EC-53, «CONSULT Function».
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check the DTC. Refer to EC-76, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    L

    M

    2.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    With CONSULT
    Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “C1610” detected?
    YES >> Replace EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Check EPS control unit pin terminals for damage or loose connection with harness connector. If
    any item are damaged, repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-27

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009578773

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
    control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
    communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
    Each control unit communicate data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009578774

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    U1000

    Display item
    CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    Malfunction detected condition
    EPS control unit is not transmitting/receiving CAN communication signal for 2
    seconds or more.

    Possible cause
    • CAN communication error
    • EPS control unit

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PRECONDITIONING

    If “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
    wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.DTC REPRODUCTION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is DTC “U1000” detected?
    YES >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to STC-28, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578775

    Proceed to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-28

    2014 Note

    EPS WARNING LAMP
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    EPS WARNING LAMP

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578776

    1.CHECK THE ILLUMINATION OF THE EPS WARNING LAMP

    B

    Check that the EPS warning lamp turns ON when ignition switch turns ON. Then, EPS warning lamp turns
    OFF after the engine is started.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis. Refer to STC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    INFOID:0000000009578777

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    E

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check the DTC. Refer to STC-10, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    STC

    2.CHECK EPS WARNING LAMP SIGNAL

    With CONSULT
    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    CAUTION:
    Never start the engine.
    2. Select “DATA MONITOR” of “EPS” and select “WARNING LAMP”.
    3. Check that the EPS warning lamp is turned ON.
    4. Start the engine.
    CAUTION:
    Never drive the vehicle.
    5. Check that the EPS warning lamp is turned OFF.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Perform the trouble diagnosis for combination meter power supply circuit. Refer to MWI-39,
    «COMBINATION METER : Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> Replace the EPS control unit. Refer to STC-37, «Removal and Installation».
    1.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-29

    2014 Note

    EPS WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    EPS WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN ON
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009485801

    EPS warning lamp does not turn ON when turning ignition switch ON from OFF. (Check the illumination of the
    EPS warning lamp.)

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009485802

    1.CHECK EPS WARNING LAMP
    Perform the trouble diagnosis of EPS warning lamp. Refer to STC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check that there is no malfunction in each harness connector pin terminal or disconnection.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the specific malfunctioning part.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-30

    2014 Note

    EPS WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN OFF
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    EPS WARNING LAMP DOES NOT TURN OFF
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009485803

    EPS warning lamp does not turn OFF several seconds after engine started.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    B
    INFOID:0000000009485804

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    C

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform “EPS” self-diagnosis.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check the DTC. Refer to STC-10, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    D

    E

    2.CHECK EPS WARNING LAMP

    Perform the trouble diagnosis of EPS warning lamp. Refer to STC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the specific malfunctioning part.

    F

    STC

    3.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT

    Perform the trouble diagnosis of EPS control unit power supply and ground. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check that there is no malfunction in each harness connector pin terminal or disconnection.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the specific malfunctioning part.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-31

    2014 Note

    STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE IS HEAVY OR LIGHT
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE IS HEAVY OR LIGHT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009485805

    Steering wheel turning force is heavy or light.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009485806

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform EPS self-diagnosis.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check the DTC. Refer to STC-10, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK THE ILLUMINATION OF THE EPS WARNING LAMP
    Check that the EPS warning lamp turns ON when ignition switch turns ON. Then, EPS warning lamp turns
    OFF after the engine is started.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis of EPS warning lamp. Refer to STC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    3.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (1)

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    CAUTION:
    Never drive the vehicle.
    2. Select ASSIST LEVEL in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    Dose the item in DATA MONITOR indicate 100%?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.
    1.

    4.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (2)

    With CONSULT
    Select BATTERY VOLT in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    Dose the item in DATA MONITOR indicate 10 V or more?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis of EPS control unit power supply and ground. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    5.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (3)

    With CONSULT
    Select ASSIST LEVEL in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    Stop the EPS system until the item in DATA MONITOR becomes 100%.
    NOTE:
    While stopping the EPS system, do not turn steering wheel.
    3. Check that the symptom continues.
    Dose the symptom continue?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> The assist torque decreases because of protection function. This is not malfunction. Inspection
    End.
    1.
    2.

    6.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (4)
    1.

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-32

    2014 Note

    STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE IS HEAVY OR LIGHT
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Never drive the vehicle.
    2. Turn steering wheel from full left stop to full right stop.
    3. Select TORQUE SENSOR in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    Monitor item

    TORQUE SENSOR

    Condition

    A

    B

    Display value

    Steering wheel: Not steering (There is no steering
    force)

    Approx. 0 Nm

    Steering wheel: Right turn

    Positive value (Nm)

    Steering wheel: Left turn

    Negative value (Nm)

    C

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    7.CHECK EPS MOTOR

    E

    Perform the trouble diagnosis of EPS motor. Refer to STC-23, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the specific malfunctioning part.

    F

    8.CHECK STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE

    STC

    Check the steering wheel turning force. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check the steering wheel turning force for mechanical malfunction. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-33

    2014 Note

    UNBALANCE STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE AND RETURN BETWEEN
    RIGHT AND LEFT
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    UNBALANCE STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE AND RETURN BETWEEN RIGHT AND LEFT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009485807

    Unbalance steering wheel turning force and return between right and left.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009485808

    1.CHECK THE ILLUMINATION OF THE EPS WARNING LAMP
    Check the EPS warning lamp while engine is running.
    Does the EPS warning lamp turn OFF?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Refer to STC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    2.CHECK WHEEL ALIGNMENT

    1. Check the wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-8, «Adjustment».
    2. Perform EPS self-diagnosis.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Adjustment of wheel alignment. Refer to FSU-8, «Adjustment».

    3.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    CAUTION:
    Never drive the vehicle.
    2. Turn steering wheel from full left stop to full right stop.
    3. Select DATA MONITOR of EPS and select TORQUE SENSOR.
    4. Perform the torque sensor inspection.
    1.

    Monitor item

    TORQUE SENSOR

    Condition

    Display value

    Steering wheel: Not steering (There is no steering
    force)

    Approx. 0 Nm

    Steering wheel: Right turn

    Positive value (Nm)

    Steering wheel: Left turn

    Negative value (Nm)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.CHECK EPS MOTOR

    Perform the trouble diagnosis of EPS motor. Refer to STC-23, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the specific malfunctioning part.

    5.CHECK STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE

    Check the steering wheel turning force. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check the steering wheel turning force for mechanical malfunction. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-34

    2014 Note

    UNBALANCE STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE (TORQUE VARIATION)
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    UNBALANCE STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE (TORQUE VARIATION)
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009485809

    A

    B

    Unbalance steering wheel turning force (torque variation).

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009485810

    C

    1.PERFORM SELF-DIAGNOSIS
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
    2. Perform EPS self-diagnosis.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check the DTC. Refer to STC-10, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    D

    E

    2.CHECK THE ILLUMINATION OF THE EPS WARNING LAMP

    F

    Check the EPS warning lamp while the engine is started.
    Does the EPS warning lamp turn OFF?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Refer to STC-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    STC

    3.CHECK STEERING COLUMN AND STEERING GEAR

    H

    Check the steering column assembly and steering gear assembly.
    • Steering column assembly. Refer to ST-9, «Exploded View».
    • Steering gear assembly. Refer to ST-14, «Exploded View».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the specific malfunctioning part.

    I

    J

    4.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (1)

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    CAUTION:
    Never drive the vehicle.
    2. Turn steering wheel from full left stop to full right stop.
    3. Select ASSIST LEVEL in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    Dose the item in DATA MONITOR maintain 100%?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    K

    1.

    L

    M

    5.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (2)

    With CONSULT
    Select BATTERY VOLT in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    Does the item in DATA MONITOR indicate 10 V or more?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Perform trouble diagnosis of EPS control unit power supply and ground. Refer to STC-18, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    6.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (3)

    With CONSULT
    Select ASSIST LEVEL in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    Stop the EPS system until the item in DATA MONITOR becomes 100%.
    NOTE:
    While stopping the EPS system, do not turn steering wheel.
    3. Check that the symptom continues.
    1.
    2.

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-35

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    UNBALANCE STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE (TORQUE VARIATION)
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Dose the symptom continue?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> The assist torque decreases because of protection function. This is not malfunction. Inspection
    End.

    7.CHECK EPS CONTROL UNIT SIGNAL (4)

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    CAUTION:
    Never drive the vehicle.
    2. Turn steering wheel from full left stop to full right stop.
    3. Select TORQUE SENSOR in DATA MONITOR in EPS.
    4. Perform the torque sensor inspection.
    1.

    Monitor item

    TORQUE SENSOR

    Condition

    Display value

    Steering wheel: Not steering (There is no steering
    force)

    Approx. 0 Nm

    Steering wheel: Right turn

    Positive value (Nm)

    Steering wheel: Left turn

    Negative value (Nm)

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    8.CHECK EPS MOTOR

    Perform the trouble diagnosis of EPS motor. Refer to STC-23, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the specific malfunctioning part.

    9.CHECK STEERING WHEEL TURNING FORCE

    Check the steering wheel turning force. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Check the steering wheel turning force for mechanical malfunction. Refer to ST-5, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-36

    2014 Note

    EPS CONTROL UNIT
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    EPS CONTROL UNIT
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009016081

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    STC

    AWGIA0295ZZ

    1.

    Steering column

    2.

    Bracket plate

    3.

    H

    EPS control unit

    Front

    I

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009016082

    CAUTION:
    • Do not allow EPS control unit to get wet with water, moisture or any other liquid. Also, protect the
    EPS control unit from extreme temperatures.
    • Do not disassemble or remodel EPS control unit, EPS motor, torque sensor, harness and connectors.

    J

    K

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.
    5.

    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View»
    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect harness connectors from EPS control unit.
    CAUTION:
    Hold and pull the connector housing, do not pull on harness when disconnecting connectors.
    Also, do not grip, collapse or apply excessive force to the connector.
    Remove screws and EPS control unit from steering column.
    Remove bolts and bracket plate from steering column if necessary.

    L

    M

    N

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that the harness connector, terminals and the EPS control unit are not visibly damaged before
    installing the EPS control unit.
    • Check that the harness connector, terminals and the EPS control unit are free of foreign materials
    before installing.
    • Replace the EPS control unit if it has been dropped or sustained an impact.
    After installing steering column, perform self-diagnosis with CONSULT to ensure correct operation. Refer to
    STC-6, «CONSULT Function».

    Revision: April 2013

    STC-37

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    ENGINE

    SECTION

    STR

    STARTING SYSTEM

    A

    STR

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …….. 13

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2

    Work Flow (With GR8-1200 NI) ………………………….13
    Work Flow (Without GR8-1200 NI) ……………………..16

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3
    Commercial Service Tools …………………………………. 3

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4
    STARTING SYSTEM …………………………………………… 4
    STARTING SYSTEM : Component Parts Location
    …… 4
    STARTING SYSTEM : Component Description …… 5

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 6
    System Description …………………………………………… 6

    WIRING DIAGRAM ………………………………… 7
    STARTING SYSTEM ……………………………………. 7
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………… 7

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 13

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 19
    B TERMINAL CIRCUIT ………………………………. 19
    Description ………………………………………………………19
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..19

    S CONNECTOR CIRCUIT …………………………… 21
    Description ………………………………………………………21
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..21

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 22

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    STARTING SYSTEM ………………………………….. 22
    Symptom Table ……………………………………………….22

    K

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 23
    STARTER MOTOR ……………………………………. 23
    Exploded View …………………………………………………23
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..23

    L

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………… 24

    M

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 24

    N

    Starter Motor ……………………………………………………24
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009452287

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009385556

    STR

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (—) Model GR8-1200 NI
    Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station

    Tests batteries, starting and charging systems
    and charges batteries.
    Operating instructions, refer to diagnostic station instruction manual.

    C

    D

    E
    AWIIA1239ZZ

    F

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009385557

    G

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    H

    I
    PIIB1407E

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-3

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    STARTING SYSTEM
    STARTING SYSTEM : Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009385560

    AWBIA1588ZZ

    Vehicle front
    A.

    Engine front side

    B.

    Transmission LH side

    D.

    Instrument panel LH side (view with
    the instrument panel removed)

    E.

    Pedal assemblies LH side

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-4

    C.

    Engine room LH side

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    STARTING SYSTEM : Component Description
    No.

    Component part

    INFOID:0000000009385561

    A
    Description

    Starter motor

    The starter motor plunger closes and the motor is supplied with battery
    power, which in turn cranks the engine, when the S terminal is supplied
    with electric power.

    STR

    1.

    2.

    Transmission range switch (CVT Models)

    Supplies power to the starter relay and starter control relay (inside
    IPDM E/R) when the selector lever is shifted into the P or N position.

    C

    3.

    IPDM E/R

    CPU inside IPDM E/R operates the starter relay when the ignition
    switch is in the start position.

    4.

    BCM

    BCM controls the starter relay inside the IPDM E/R.

    5.

    Clutch interlock switch (M/T Models)

    Clutch interlock switch supplies power to the coil side of the starter relay when the clutch pedal is depressed to crank the engine.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-5

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009385565

    System Diagram

    ALBIA1145GB

    The starter motor plunger closes and provides a closed circuit between the battery and starter motor. The
    starter motor is grounded to the cylinder block. With power and ground supplied, the starter motor operates.

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-6

    2014 Note

    STARTING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    STARTING SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009385566

    STR

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AABWA0822GB

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-7

    2014 Note

    STARTING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AABIA1098GB

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-8

    2014 Note

    STARTING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    STR

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AABIA1099GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-9

    2014 Note

    STARTING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AABIA1100GB

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-10

    2014 Note

    STARTING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    STR

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    AABIA1101GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-11

    2014 Note

    STARTING SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AABIA1102GB

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-12

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow (With GR8-1200 NI)

    INFOID:0000000009446820

    STR

    STARTING SYSTEM DIAGNOSIS WITH GR8-1200 NI
    To test the starting system, use the following special service tool:
    • GR8-1200 NI Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station
    NOTE:
    Refer to the diagnostic station Instruction Manual for proper starting system diagnosis procedures.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-13

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    AWBIA1200GB

    DETAILED FLOW
    NOTE:
    To ensure a complete and thorough diagnosis, the battery, starter motor and generator test segments must be
    done as a set from start to finish.

    1.DIAGNOSIS WITH MULTITASKING BATTERY AND ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSTIC STATION GR8-1200 NI
    Revision: April 2013

    STR-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Perform the starting system test with Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station GR8-1200 NI. For
    details and operating instructions, refer to diagnostic station Instruction Manual.
    A
    Test result
    CRANKING NORMAL>>GO TO 2.
    LOW VOLTAGE>>GO TO 5.
    STR
    CHARGE BATTERY>>Perform the slow battery charging procedure. (Initial rate of charge is 10A for 12
    hours.) Perform battery test again. Refer to diagnostic station instruction manual.
    REPLACE BATTERY>>Before replacing battery, clean the battery cable clamps and battery posts. Perform
    C
    battery test again. Refer to diagnostic station instruction manual. If second test result is
    “REPLACE BATTERY”, then do so. Perform battery test again to confirm repair.

    2.CRANKING CHECK

    D

    Check that the starter motor operates properly.
    Does the engine crank normally?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    E

    3.ENGINE START CHECK

    Check that the engine starts.
    Does the engine start?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Perform further diagnosis of engine mechanical or engine control system. Refer to EM and EC
    sections. Once resolved, perform battery test again.

    4.STARTER MOTOR ACTIVATION

    F

    G

    H

    Check that the starter motor operates.
    Does the starter motor turn?
    YES >> Check ring gear and starter motor drive pinion. Once resolved, perform battery test again.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    5.COMPARISON BETWEEN ENGINE COOLANT AND CRANKING VOLTAGE

    I

    J

    Compare the engine coolant temperature and verify the cranking voltage is within specifications.
    Minimum Specification of Cranking Voltage Referencing Coolant Temperature

    Engine coolant temperature [°C (°F)]

    Voltage [V]

    −30 to −20 (−22 to −4)

    8.6

    −19 to −10 (−2 to 14)

    9.1

    −9 to 0 (16 to 32)

    9.5

    More than 1 (More than 34)

    9.9

    K

    L

    Is the voltage less than the specified value?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    M

    6.STARTER OPERATION

    N

    Check the starter operation.
    Does the starter motor turn smoothly?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    O

    7.“B” TERMINAL CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    P

    Check “B” terminal circuit. Refer to STR-19, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is “B” terminal circuit normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    8.“S” CONNECTOR CIRCUIT INSPECTION

    Check “S” connector circuit. Refer to STR-21, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Revision: April 2013

    STR-15

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Is “S” connector circuit normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    9.ENGINE ROTATION STATUS
    Check that the engine can be rotated by hand.
    Does the engine turn freely by hand?
    YES >> Replace starter motor.
    NO
    >> Perform further diagnosis of engine mechanical or powertrain mechanism. Once resolved, perform battery test again using Multitasking battery and electrical diagnostic station GR8-1200 NI.
    Refer to the diagnostic station Instruction Manual for proper testing procedures.

    Work Flow (Without GR8-1200 NI)

    INFOID:0000000009446821

    OVERALL SEQUENCE
    NOTE:

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-16

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    If any malfunction is found, immediately disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal.
    A

    STR

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    AWBIA1303GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    O

    1.CHECK ENGINE START
    Crank the engine and check that the engine starts.
    Does the engine start?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    P

    2.CHECK THAT THE STARTER MOTOR STOPS
    Check that the starter motor stops after starting the engine.
    Does the starter motor stop?
    Revision: April 2013

    STR-17

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace starter motor. Refer to STR-23, «Removal and Installation».

    3.CHECK THAT THE ENGINE TURNS WHEN CRANKING
    Check that the engine turns when cranking.
    Does engine turn when cranking?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    4.CHECK THE ENGINE SPEED WHEN CRANKING

    Check that the engine speed is not low when cranking.
    Does engine turn normally?
    YES >> Check ignition/fuel system.
    NO
    >> Check charge condition, corrosion and connection condition of the battery.

    5.CHECK STARTER MOTOR ACTIVATION

    Check that the starter motor runs at cranking.
    Does starter motor turn?
    YES >> Replace starter motor. Refer to STR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    6.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT

    Check the following conditions:
    • Fuse and fusible link
    • Charge condition, corrosion and connection of the battery.
    Are these inspection results normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    7.CHECK STARTING SYSTEM WIRING

    Check the following:
    • “B” terminal circuit. Refer to STR-19, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    • “S” terminal circuit. Refer to STR-21, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Are the inspection results normal?
    YES >> Replace starter motor. Refer to STR-23, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair as needed.

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-18

    2014 Note

    B TERMINAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    B TERMINAL CIRCUIT
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009446823

    STR

    INFOID:0000000009446824

    C

    Terminal “B” is constantly supplied with battery power.

    Diagnosis Procedure
    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to STR-7, «Wiring Diagram».

    D

    CAUTION:
    Perform diagnosis under the condition that the engine cannot start by the following procedure.
    1. Remove fuel pump fuse.
    2. Crank or start the engine (where possible) until the fuel pressure is released.

    E

    1.CHECK “B” TERMINAL CIRCUIT

    F

    1.
    2.
    3.

    G

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Check that starter motor ”B” terminal connection is clean and tight.
    Check voltage between starter motor ”B” terminal and ground.
    Terminals
    (+)
    Starter motor “B” terminal

    Terminal

    F27

    B

    (-)

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    H

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Check harness between battery and starter motor for open circuit.

    J

    1.
    2.

    K

    2.CHECK BATTERY CABLE CONNECTION STATUS (VOLTAGE DROP TEST)
    Shift selector lever to ”P” (Park) or ”N” (Neutral) position.
    Check voltage between battery positive terminal and starter motor ”B” terminal.
    Terminals
    (-)
    (+)

    Starter motor
    “B“ terminal

    Terminal

    Battery positive terminal

    F27

    B

    Condition

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    When the ignition switch is in START position

    Less than 0.5V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Check harness between the battery and starter motor for continuity.

    O

    Shift selector lever to ”P” (Park) or ”N” (Neutral) position.
    Check voltage between starter motor case and battery negative terminal.
    Terminals
    (+)

    (-)

    Starter motor case

    Battery negative terminal

    Condition

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    When the ignition switch is in
    START position

    Less than 0.2V

    Is the inspection result normal?

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-19

    M

    N

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT STATUS (VOLTAGE DROP TEST)
    1.
    2.

    L

    2014 Note

    P

    B TERMINAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> “B” terminal circuit is OK. Further inspection is necessary. Refer to STR-13, «Work Flow (With
    GR8-1200 NI)» or STR-16, «Work Flow (Without GR8-1200 NI)».
    NO
    >> Check the starter motor case to engine mounting for high resistance.

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-20

    2014 Note

    S CONNECTOR CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    S CONNECTOR CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009446825

    The starter motor magnetic switch is supplied with power when the ignition switch is turned to the START posi- STR
    tion while the selector lever is in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009446826

    C

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to STR-7, «Wiring Diagram».
    D

    CAUTION:
    Perform diagnosis under the condition that engine cannot start by the following procedure.
    1. Remove fuel pump fuse.
    2. Crank or start the engine (where possible) until the fuel pressure is released.

    E

    1.CHECK “S” CONNECTOR CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    F

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect starter motor connector.
    Shift selector lever to “P” (Park) or “N” (Neutral) position.
    Check voltage between starter motor harness connector and ground.
    (+)

    (-)

    Connector

    Terminal

    F28

    S

    Ground

    G

    Condition

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    When the ignition switch is in START position

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> “S” circuit is OK. Further inspection is necessary. Refer to STR-13, «Work Flow (With GR8-1200
    NI)» or STR-16, «Work Flow (Without GR8-1200 NI)».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY (OPEN CIRCUIT)
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between starter motor harness connector and the IPDM E/R harness connector.
    Starter motor harness connector

    3.

    IPDM E/R harness connector

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F28

    S

    E43

    6

    Continuity

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    Yes

    Check continuity between starter motor terminal S and ground.

    M

    Connector

    Terminal

    Continuity

    F28

    S

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Further inspection is necessary. Refer to STR-13, «Work Flow (With GR8-1200 NI)» or STR-16,
    «Work Flow (Without GR8-1200 NI)».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the harness or connectors.

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-21

    2014 Note

    STARTING SYSTEM
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    STARTING SYSTEM
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009385574

    Symptom
    No normal cranking
    Starter motor does not rotate

    Revision: April 2013

    Reference
    Refer to STR-13, «Work Flow (With GR8-1200 NI)» or STR-16,
    «Work Flow (Without GR8-1200 NI)».

    STR-22

    2014 Note

    STARTER MOTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    STARTER MOTOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009385575

    STR

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H
    AWGIA0291ZZ

    1.

    Cylinder block

    2.

    Starter motor

    A.

    Mounting hole for CVT

    B.

    Mounting hole for M/T

    C.

    “B” terminal harness

    D.

    “S” terminal harness

    I

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009385576

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    Remove the radiator core support upper. DLK-122, «RADIATOR CORE SUPPORT UPPER : Removal
    and Installation».
    Remove “S” terminal nut and “S” terminal harness.
    Remove “B” terminal nut and disconnect “B” terminal harness.
    Remove the starter motor bolts.
    Remove the starter motor.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful to not damage surrounding parts when removing starter motor from the vehicle.

    INSTALLATION

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-23

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Starter Motor

    INFOID:0000000009385578

    Manufacturer

    Mitsubishi

    Model number*

    M000T32175ZC

    Type

    Reduction gear type

    System voltage

    12V
    Terminal voltage

    No-load

    11V

    Current

    Less than 95A

    Revolution

    More than 3,000 rpm

    *: Always check with the Parts Department for the latest parts information.

    Revision: April 2013

    STR-24

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION & DRIVELINE

    SECTION

    TM

    TRANSAXLE & TRANSMISSION

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    CONTENTS
    5MT: RS5F91R

    GEAR OIL ………………………………………………… 16

    F

    Inspection ……………………………………………………….16
    Draining ………………………………………………………….16
    Refilling …………………………………………………………..16

    G

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 7
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 7
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 7
    General Precautions …………………………………………. 7
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 7

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 17

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 9

    POSITION SWITCH …………………………………… 18

    SIDE OIL SEAL …………………………………………. 17

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..18
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….18

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 9
    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 9
    Commercial Service Tools ……………………………….. 11

    Sectional View ………………………………………………… 12
    System Description …………………………………………. 12

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 14
    POSITION SWITCH ……………………………………..14
    BACK-UP LAMP SWITCH …………………………………. 14
    BACK-UP LAMP SWITCH : Component Inspection ……………………………………………………………….. 14
    PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH ……….. 14
    PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH :
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 14

    Exploded View …………………………………………………19
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..19
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….20

    AIR BREATHER HOSE ……………………………… 21
    Exploded View …………………………………………………21
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..21

    5TH MAIN GEAR ASSEMBLY ……………………. 22
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..22
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….22

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …… 23

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY ………………………….. 23
    Exploded View …………………………………………………23
    Removal and Installation …………………………………..23
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….24

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………… 15

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY … 25

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS
    (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………….15

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY ………………………….. 25

    NVH Troubleshooting Chart ……………………………… 15

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ……………………. 16

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    CONTROL LINKAGE …………………………………. 19

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ……………………….. 12
    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION …………………..12

    H

    Removal and Installation …………………………………..17
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….17

    TM-1

    Exploded View …………………………………………………25
    Disassembly ……………………………………………………29
    Assembly ………………………………………………………..35
    Inspection ……………………………………………………….43

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    INPUT SHAFT AND GEAR …………………………. 44
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 44
    Disassembly ………………………………………………….. 44
    Assembly ………………………………………………………. 44
    Inspection ……………………………………………………… 44

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR ……………………………. 46
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 46
    Disassembly ………………………………………………….. 46
    Assembly ………………………………………………………. 48
    Inspection ……………………………………………………… 49

    FINAL DRIVE …………………………………………….. 51
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 51
    Disassembly ………………………………………………….. 51
    Assembly ………………………………………………………. 51
    Inspection ……………………………………………………… 51

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………….. 53
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………………… 53
    General Specifications …………………………………….. 53

    CVT: RE0F11A
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………… 54
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………. 54
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» ……………………………………………………….. 54
    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover… 54
    Precaution for TCM and Transaxle Assembly Replacement ……………………………………………………… 54
    Precaution for G Sensor Removal/Installation or
    Replacement …………………………………………………. 54
    General Precautions ……………………………………….. 55
    On Board Diagnosis (OBD) System of CVT and
    Engine ………………………………………………………….. 55
    Removal and Installation Procedure for CVT Unit
    Connector ……………………………………………………… 56

    PREPARATION ……………………………………. 58
    PREPARATION …………………………………………. 58

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Primary Speed Sensor ………………………………………………………………… 61
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Secondary Speed
    Sensor …………………………………………………………… 61
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Output Speed Sensor… 62
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor ……………………………………………………. 62
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Secondary Pressure
    Sensor …………………………………………………………… 62
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve …………………………………………………… 63
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Low Brake Solenoid
    Valve …………………………………………………………….. 63
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : High Clutch & Reverse Brake Solenoid Valve ……………………………… 63
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Torque Converter
    Clutch Solenoid Valve ……………………………………… 63
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Line Pressure Solenoid Valve ……………………………………………………… 64
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : G Sensor ……………….. 64
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Overdrive Control
    Switch …………………………………………………………… 64
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : OD OFF Indicator
    Lamp …………………………………………………………….. 64
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Shift Position Indicator …………………………………………………………………. 65
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Malfunction Indicator
    Lamp (MIL) …………………………………………………….. 66
    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM ………………………………………. 66
    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM : Component Parts Location ……………………………………………………………….. 66

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION …………………. 67
    TRANSAXLE ……………………………………………………. 67
    TRANSAXLE : Cross-Sectional View ………………… 67
    TRANSAXLE : Transaxle Mechanism ……………….. 67
    TRANSAXLE : Operation Status ……………………….. 69
    TRANSAXLE : Oil Pressure System ………………….. 70
    TRANSAXLE : Component Description ……………… 70
    FLUID COOLER & FLUID WARMER SYSTEM …….. 71
    FLUID COOLER & FLUID WARMER SYSTEM :
    System Description …………………………………………. 71

    Special Service Tools ……………………………………… 58
    Commercial Service Tools ……………………………….. 58

    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM ………………………………………. 72
    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM : System Description ……… 72

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………. 59

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………… 73

    COMPONENT PARTS ………………………………… 59

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM ………………………………….. 73
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description … 73
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Schematic ………………. 76
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail-safe …………………. 77
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Protection Control ……. 80

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM ………………………………….. 59
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location ……………………………………………………………. 59
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : TCM ……………………… 60
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : ROM Assembly ………. 60
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Transmission Range
    Switch …………………………………………………………… 61

    LINE PRESSURE CONTROL …………………………….. 80
    LINE PRESSURE CONTROL : System Description ……………………………………………………………….. 81
    SHIFT CONTROL ……………………………………………… 81

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-2

    2014 Note

    SHIFT CONTROL : System Description …………….. 82
    SELECT CONTROL ………………………………………….. 83
    SELECT CONTROL : System Description ………….. 84
    LOCK-UP CONTROL ………………………………………… 84
    LOCK-UP CONTROL : System Description ………… 85

    STALL TEST …………………………………………… 130
    Work Procedure …………………………………………….. 130

    LINE PRESSURE TEST ……………………………. 131
    Work Procedure …………………………………………….. 131

    Description …………………………………………………….. 89
    Function of OBD ……………………………………………… 89

    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 132
    Adjustment ……………………………………………………. 132

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 99

    U0073 COMMUNICATION BUS A OFF ……… 133 TM
    Description ……………………………………………………. 133
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 133
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 133
    Description ……………………………………………………. 134
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 134
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 134

    F

    U0140 LOST COMMUNICATION (BCM) …….. 135

    G

    Description ……………………………………………………. 135
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 135
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 135
    Description ……………………………………………………. 136
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 136
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 136

    U0155 LOST COMMUNICATION (IPC) ………. 137
    Description ……………………………………………………. 137
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 137
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 137

    U0300 CAN COMMUNICATION DATA ………. 138
    Description ……………………………………………………. 138
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 138
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 138

    Wiring Diagram …………………………………………….. 113

    CVT SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM ………………………. 120
    Wiring Diagram …………………………………………….. 120

    H

    U0141 LOST COMMUNICATION (BCM A) …. 136

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………… 113
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM ………………………….. 113

    E

    U0100 LOST COMMUNICATION (ECM A) …. 134

    TCM …………………………………………………………..99
    Reference Value …………………………………………….. 99
    Fail-safe ………………………………………………………. 107
    Protection Control …………………………………………. 109
    DTC Inspection Priority Chart …………………………. 110
    DTC Index ……………………………………………………. 111

    C

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ………………….. 133

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM) ………………………..90
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION ………………………………. 90
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : 1 Trip Detection Diagnosis and 2 Trip Detection Diagnosis ……………… 90
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : DTC and DTC of
    1st Trip ………………………………………………………….. 90
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ………………………………………………… 90
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Counter System …… 90
    CONSULT Function ………………………………………… 92

    B

    CVT POSITION ……………………………………….. 132

    IDLE NEUTRAL CONTROL ……………………………….. 85
    IDLE NEUTRAL CONTROL : System Description…. 86

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ……89

    A

    I

    J

    K

    L

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ……………………. 139
    M

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW …… 123

    Description ……………………………………………………. 139
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 139
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 139

    Flowchart of Trouble Diagnosis ……………………….. 123
    Question sheet ……………………………………………… 124

    U1117 LOST COMMUNICATION (ABS) …….. 140

    N

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
    TCM ………………………………………………………… 126

    Description ……………………………………………………. 140
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 140
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 140

    O

    Description …………………………………………………… 126
    Procedure …………………………………………………….. 126

    P062F EEPROM ………………………………………. 141

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………… 123

    Description ……………………………………………………. 141
    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 141
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 141

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY …………………………. 127
    Description …………………………………………………… 127
    Procedure …………………………………………………….. 127

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A . 142

    CALIBRATION OF G SENSOR ………………….. 129
    Description …………………………………………………… 129
    Procedure …………………………………………………….. 129

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-3

    DTC Logic …………………………………………………….. 142
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 142
    Component Inspection (Transmission Range
    Switch) …………………………………………………………. 146

    2014 Note

    P

    P0706 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A . 148
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..148
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………148
    Component Inspection (Transmission Range
    Switch) ………………………………………………………….150

    P0711 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A …………………………………….. 151
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..151
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………151
    Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature
    Sensor) …………………………………………………………152

    P0712 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A …………………………………….. 153

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 171
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 171

    P0847 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE
    SEN/SW B ……………………………………………….. 173
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 173
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 173

    P0848 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE
    SEN/SW B ……………………………………………….. 175
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 175
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 175

    P0863 TCM COMMUNICATION ………………….. 177
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 177
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 177

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..153
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………153
    Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature
    Sensor) …………………………………………………………153

    P0890 TCM ………………………………………………. 178

    P0713 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A …………………………………….. 155

    P0962 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A.. 180

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..155
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………155
    Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature
    Sensor) …………………………………………………………156

    P0715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR A ……………… 157
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..157
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………157

    P0720 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR ……………… 160
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..160
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………160

    P0740 TORQUE CONVERTER ………………….. 163
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..163
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………164
    Component Inspection (Torque Converter Clutch
    Solenoid Valve) ……………………………………………..164

    P0743 TORQUE CONVERTER ………………….. 165
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..165
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………166
    Component Inspection (Torque Converter Clutch
    Solenoid Valve) ……………………………………………..166

    P0744 TORQUE CONVERTER ………………….. 167
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..167
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………168
    Component Inspection (Torque Converter Clutch
    Solenoid Valve) ……………………………………………..168

    P0746 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A. 169
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………..169
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………170
    Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid
    Valve) …………………………………………………………..170

    P0846 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE
    SEN/SW B ……………………………………………….. 171
    Revision: April 2013

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 178
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 178
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 180
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 180
    Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid
    Valve) ………………………………………………………….. 180

    P0963 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A.. 182
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 182
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 182
    Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid
    Valve) ………………………………………………………….. 182

    P0965 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B.. 184
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 184
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 184

    P0966 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B.. 185
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 185
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 185
    Component Inspection (Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve) …………………………………………………… 185

    P0967 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B.. 187
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 187
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 187
    Component Inspection (Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve) …………………………………………………… 187

    P0998 SHIFT SOLENOID F ……………………….. 189
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 189
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 189
    Component Inspection (Low Brake Solenoid
    Valve) ………………………………………………………….. 189

    P0999 SHIFT SOLENOID F ……………………….. 191
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 191
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 191
    Component Inspection (Low Brake Solenoid
    Valve) ………………………………………………………….. 191

    P099B SHIFT SOLENOID G ………………………. 193

    TM-4

    2014 Note

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 193
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 193
    Component Inspection (High Clutch & Reverse
    Brake Solenoid Valve) ……………………………………. 193

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM …………………………. 219

    P099C SHIFT SOLENOID G ………………………. 195

    CVT FLUID ……………………………………………… 224

    B

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 195
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 195
    Component Inspection (High Clutch & Reverse
    Brake Solenoid Valve) ……………………………………. 195

    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 224
    Replacement ………………………………………………… 224
    Adjustment ……………………………………………………. 225

    C

    P1586 G SENSOR …………………………………….. 197
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 197
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 197

    Symptom Table …………………………………………….. 219

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………. 224

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………. 227
    CVT SHIFT SELECTOR ……………………………. 227 TM
    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 227
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 227
    Disassembly and Assembly …………………………….. 228
    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 228

    P1588 G SENSOR …………………………………….. 200
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 200
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 200

    P2765 CLUTCH B SPEED SENSOR …………… 202

    CONTROL CABLE …………………………………… 230

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 202
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 202

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 230
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 230
    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………… 232

    P2857 CLUTCH A PRESSURE ………………….. 205

    KEY INTERLOCK CABLE ………………………… 233

    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 205
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 205

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 233
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 233
    Inspection …………………………………………………….. 234

    P2858 CLUTCH B PRESSURE ………………….. 206
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 206
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 206

    P285A CLUTCH B PRESSURE ………………….. 209
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 209
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 210

    MAIN POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ………………………………………………………… 211
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 211

    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM ………………………………. 217

    J

    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 236

    G SENSOR ……………………………………………… 237
    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 237
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 237
    Adjustment ……………………………………………………. 237

    K

    L

    OIL PAN …………………………………………………. 238
    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 238
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 238
    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………… 239

    PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR ……………………… 240
    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 240
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 240
    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………… 240

    SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR ……………….. 241
    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 241
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 241
    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………… 241

    OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR ……………………….. 242

    Component Function Check ……………………………. 217
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 217

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 242
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 242
    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………… 242

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ………………………. 219

    DIFFERENTIAL SIDE OIL SEAL ……………….. 243

    Revision: April 2013

    H

    AIR BREATHER HOSE ……………………………. 236

    SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR CIRCUIT ……… 216
    Component Parts Function Inspection ……………… 216
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 216

    G

    I

    OD OFF INDICATOR LAMP ………………………. 215
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 215
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 215

    F

    Exploded View ………………………………………………. 235
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 235
    Adjustment ……………………………………………………. 235

    OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH ………………. 213
    Component Function Check ……………………………. 213
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 213
    Component Inspection (Overdrive Control Switch)
    .. 214

    E

    TCM ……………………………………………………….. 235

    P2859 CLUTCH A PRESSURE ………………….. 207
    DTC Logic ……………………………………………………. 207
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………… 208

    A

    TM-5

    2014 Note

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….243
    Removal and Installation …………………………………243
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………243

    WATER HOSE …………………………………………. 245
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….245
    Removal and Installation …………………………………245
    Inspection ……………………………………………………..247

    FLUID COOLER HOSE …………………………….. 248
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….248
    Removal and Installation …………………………………248
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………248

    PLUG ……………………………………………………… 249
    Description …………………………………………………….249
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….249
    Removal and Installation …………………………………249
    Inspection and Adjustment ………………………………249

    Revision: April 2013

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION … 250
    TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY …………………….. 250
    Exploded View ……………………………………………… 250
    Removal and Installation ………………………………… 250
    Inspection and Adjustment ……………………………… 252

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………… 254
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………………. 254
    General Specification …………………………………….. 254
    Shift Characteristics ………………………………………. 254
    Stall Speed …………………………………………………… 254
    Line Pressure ……………………………………………….. 255
    Torque Converter ………………………………………….. 255
    Heater Thermostat ………………………………………… 255

    TM-6

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009578891

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along C
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    TM
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    E
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    F
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.
    G

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS

    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    General Precautions

    INFOID:0000000009417578

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse CSC (Concentric Slave Cylinder). CSC slides back to the original position every time
    when removing transaxle assembly. At this time, dust on the sliding parts may damage the seal of
    CSC and may cause clutch fluid leakage. Refer to CL-16, «Removal and Installation».
    • Do not reuse transaxle gear oil, once it has been drained.
    • Check oil level or replace gear oil with vehicle on level surface.
    • During removal or installation, keep inside of transaxle clear of dust or dirt.
    • Check for the correct installation alignment prior to removal or disassembly. If matching marks are
    required, be certain they do not interfere with the function of the parts marked.
    • In principle, tighten bolts or nuts gradually in several steps working diagonally from inside to outside. If tightening sequence is specified, use it.
    • Do not damage sliding surfaces and mating surfaces.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009417579

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-7

    2014 Note

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    < PRECAUTION >
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-8

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009417580

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    KV32500QAA
    ( — )
    Drift set

    Installing differential side oil seal
    1.

    Drift
    a: 54.3 mm (2.138 in) dia.
    b: 45 mm (1.77 in) dia.
    c: 26.6 mm (1.047 in) dia.
    2.

    Drift
    d: 54 mm (2.13 in) dia.
    e: 48.6 mm (1.913 in) dia.
    f: 26.6 mm (1.047 in) dia

    JPDIC0730ZZ

    KV32300QAC
    ( — )
    Puller

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    Removing 5th main gear

    G

    H
    SCIA1781J

    KV32300QAD
    ( — )
    Puller

    I

    Removing 5th main gear

    J

    K

    SCIA1782J

    ST35300000
    ( — )
    Drift

    • Removing and installing input shaft rear
    bearing
    • Removing and installing mainshaft rear
    bearing
    a: 45 mm (1.77 in) dia.
    b: 59 mm (2.32 in) dia.

    L

    M

    ZZA0969D

    KV111011S0
    ( — )
    Valve seat remover

    Removing mainshaft front bearing

    N

    O

    P

    ZZA0872D

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-9

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < PREPARATION >
    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    ST33400001
    ( — )
    Drift

    Installing mainshaft front bearing
    a: 60 mm (2.36 in) dia.
    b: 47 mm (1.85 in) dia.

    ZZA0814D

    KV40100900
    ( — )
    Drift

    Installing input shaft front bearing
    a: 52 mm (2.05 in) dia.
    b: 39.5 mm (1.555 in) dia.

    NT084

    KV32300QAE
    ( — )
    Drift

    Installing differential side bearing outer race
    a: 61.5 mm (2.421 in) dia.

    JPDIC0635ZZ

    ST33052000
    ( — )
    Drift

    Removing differential side bearing
    a: 22 mm (0.87 in) dia.
    b: 28mm (1.10 in) dia.

    ZZA0969D

    KV40104920
    ( — )
    Drift

    Installing differential side bearing
    a: 21.7 mm (0.854 in) dia.
    b: 44.7 mm (1.760 in) dia.

    ZZA0969D


    (J-46534)
    Trim tool set

    Removing trim components

    AWJIA0483ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-10

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < PREPARATION >

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009417581

    A

    Tool name

    Description

    Socket

    Removing and installing drain plug
    a: 8 mm (0.31 in)
    b: 5 mm (0.20 in)

    B

    C

    TM

    PCIB1776E

    Drift

    Removing input shaft front bearing
    a: 38 mm (1.50 in) dia.

    E

    F
    S-NT063

    Drift

    Installing bushing
    a: 14.5 mm (0.571 in) dia.

    G

    H

    S-NT063

    Puller

    • Removing 5th-reverse synchronizer hub
    • Removing differential side bearing

    I

    J

    K
    NT077

    Bearing remover

    Removing bushing

    L

    M
    S-NT134

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    N

    O

    P

    PIIB1407E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-11

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    Sectional View

    INFOID:0000000009417582

    JPDIC0580ZZ

    1.

    Clutch housing

    2.

    1st-2nd synchronizer hub assembly

    3.

    3rd-4th synchronizer hub assembly

    4.

    5th input gear

    5.

    5th-reverse synchronizer hub assembly

    6.

    5th-reverse baulk ring

    7.

    5th main gear

    8.

    4th main gear

    9.

    3rd main gear

    10. 2nd main gear

    11. 2nd double-cone synchronizer

    12. 1st double-cone synchronizer

    13. 1st main gear

    14. Differential side bearing

    15. Differential

    16. Final gear

    17. Mainshaft

    18. Input shaft

    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009417583

    DOUBLE-CONE SYNCHRONIZER
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-12

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Double-cone synchronizers are adopted for 1st and 2nd gears to
    reduce operating force of the shift selector.
    (1)

    : Outer baulk ring

    (2)

    : 2nd main gear

    (3)

    : Synchronizer cone

    (4)

    : Inner baulk ring

    (5)

    : 1st main gear

    (6)

    : 1st-2nd coupling sleeve

    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    A

    B

    C
    SCIA7117E

    TM

    REVERSE GEAR NOISE PREVENTION FUNCTION (REVERSE BRAKE)
    Description
    Soon after the clutch is disengaged, the input shaft is still rotating due to inertia. This may cause a gear noise
    when the shift selector is moved to reverse position. The reverse gear noise prevention function stops the
    rotation of the input shaft and enables smooth gear shifting when the reverse gear is selected.
    Operation Principle
    1. When the shift selector is moved to reverse position, 5th-reverse
    coupling sleeve (1) slides in the reverse direction. ( )
    (5)

    2.
    3.
    4.

    E

    F

    G

    : 5th input gear

    Synchronizer levers (2) with support point (A) at 5th-reverse
    synchronizer hub (3) presses 5th-reverse baulk ring (4). ( )
    Friction that is generated at 5-reverse baulk ring presses synchronizer lever on 5th-reverse coupling sleeve. ( )
    5th-reverse coupling sleeve that is pressed by synchronizer
    lever stops the rotation of input shaft.

    H

    I
    JPDIC0415ZZ

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-13

    2014 Note

    POSITION SWITCH
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    POSITION SWITCH
    BACK-UP LAMP SWITCH
    BACK-UP LAMP SWITCH : Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417584

    1.CHECK BACK-UP LAMP SWITCH
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect position switch connector. Refer to TM-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Check continuity between position switch terminals.
    Terminals
    1

    2

    Condition

    Continuity

    Reverse gear position

    Yes

    Except reverse gear position

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace position switch. Refer to TM-18, «Removal and
    Installation».

    PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
    PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH : Component Inspection

    MCIA0157E

    INFOID:0000000009417585

    1.CHECK PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect position switch connector. Refer to TM-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Check continuity between position switch terminals.
    Terminals
    2

    3

    Condition

    Continuity

    Neutral gear position

    Yes

    Except neutral gear position

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace position switch. Refer to TM-18, «Removal and
    Installation».
    JPDIC0092ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-14

    2014 Note

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    NOISE, VIBRATION AND HARSHNESS (NVH) TROUBLESHOOTING
    NVH Troubleshooting Chart

    INFOID:0000000009417586

    TM-25

    TM-20

    Reference page

    TM-25

    TM-16

    Use the chart below to find the cause of the symptom. The numbers indicate the order of the inspection. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    3

    1

    Hard to shift or will not shift

    1

    1

    Jumps out of gear

    2

    2

    GEAR (Worn or damaged)

    BEARING (Worn or damaged)

    SHIFT FORK (Worn)

    SHIFT CONTROL LINKAGE (Worn)

    O-RING (Worn or damaged)

    3

    3

    INSERT SPRING (Damaged)

    Oil leakage

    GASKET (Damaged)

    2

    OIL (Oil level is high)

    1

    BAULK RING (Worn or damaged)

    Symptoms

    OIL (Wrong oil)

    Noise

    OIL (Oil level is low)

    SUSPECTED PARTS
    (Possible cause)

    OIL SEAL (Worn or damaged)

    F

    3

    3

    G

    H

    I

    J

    2
    2
    1

    2

    K

    2

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-15

    2014 Note

    GEAR OIL
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    GEAR OIL
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417587

    GEAR OIL LEAKS
    Make sure that gear oil is not leaking from transaxle or around it.

    GEAR OIL LEVEL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    Remove filler plug (1) and gasket from transaxle case.
    Check the gear oil level from filler plug hole as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not start engine while checking gear oil level.
    Install a new gasket on filler plug and then install filler plug to
    transaxle case.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    Tighten filler plug to the specified torque. Refer to TM-25,
    «Exploded View».
    SCIA7119E

    Draining
    1.
    2.
    3.

    4.

    INFOID:0000000009417588

    Start engine and let it run to warm up transaxle.
    Stop engine. Remove drain plug (1) and gasket, using suitable
    tool and then drain gear oil.
    Install a new gasket on drain plug (1) and install drain plug to
    clutch housing, using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    Tighten drain plug (1) to the specified torque. Refer to TM-25,
    «Exploded View».

    PCIB1504E

    Refilling
    1.
    2.

    Remove filler plug (1) and gasket from transaxle case.
    Fill with new gear oil until gear oil level reaches the specified
    limit at filler plug hole as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not start engine while checking gear oil level.
    Oil capacity
    and viscosity

    3.

    4.

    INFOID:0000000009417589

    : Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    Install a new gasket on filler plug and then install filler plug to
    transaxle case.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    Tighten filler plug to the specified torque. Refer to TM-25, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-16

    SCIA7119E

    2014 Note

    SIDE OIL SEAL
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    SIDE OIL SEAL
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417590

    B

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove front drive shaft from transaxle assembly. Refer to FAX-19, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove differential side oil seal (1) using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage transaxle case and clutch housing.

    C

    TM

    E

    F
    JPDIC0118ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Dimension (L1)
    Dimension (L2)
    Tool number

    2.

    G

    Install differential side oil seal (1) to transaxle case side (B) and
    clutch housing side (C) using Tool.

    H

    : 5.7 – 6.3 mm (0.224 – 0.248 in)
    : 2.4 – 3.0 mm (0.094 – 0.118 in)
    : KV32500QAA (

    I

    )

    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse differential side oil seal.
    • Do not tilt differential side oil seal.
    • Do not damage clutch housing and transaxle case.
    Install the front drive shaft. Refer to FAX-19, «Removal and Installation».

    Inspection

    J
    JPDIC0401ZZ

    K
    INFOID:0000000009417591

    L

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check the gear oil level and for gear oil leaks. Refer to TM-16, «Inspection».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-17

    2014 Note

    POSITION SWITCH
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    POSITION SWITCH
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417592

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Drain gear oil. Refer to TM-16, «Draining».
    Disconnect the harness connector (A) from position switch.
    Remove position switch from transaxle case.

    JPDIC0733ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    2.
    3.
    4.

    Apply recommended sealant to threads of position switch.
    CAUTION:
    • Use Genuine Silicone RTV or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and
    Sealants».
    • Remove old sealant and gear oil adhering to threads.
    Install position switch to transaxle case.
    Tighten position switch to the specified torque. Refer to TM-25, «Exploded View».
    Refill gear oil. Refer to TM-16, «Refilling».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417593

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Check continuity between position switch terminals. Refer to TM-14, «BACK-UP LAMP SWITCH : Component Inspection» (Back-up lamp switch) and TM-14, «PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH : Component Inspection» (PNP switch).
    • Check the gear oil level and for gear oil leaks. Refer to TM-16, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-18

    2014 Note

    CONTROL LINKAGE
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CONTROL LINKAGE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417594

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    JPDIC0789GB

    1.

    Shifter lever A

    2.

    Selector lever

    3.

    Selector cable

    4.

    Shifter cable

    5.

    Cable mounting bracket

    6.

    Tapping bolt

    7.

    Bracket

    8.

    Grommet

    9.

    Shift selector assembly

    10. Shift selector

    H

    11. Shift selector handle

    Removal and Installation

    I
    INFOID:0000000009417595

    REMOVAL

    J

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    K

    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    Move the shift selector to the neutral position.
    Remove the battery tray. Refer to PG-70, «Removal and Installation (Battery Tray)».
    Pull out and disconnect cables from shifter lever A and selector lever, using a suitable tool.
    While pressing the lock of the selector cable in the direction of
    the arrows shown, remove the selector cable from the cable
    mounting bracket.
    While pressing the lock of the shifter cable in the direction of the
    arrows shown, remove the shifter cable from the cable mounting
    bracket.
    Remove cable mounting bracket from clutch housing.
    Pull the shift selector handle upward to remove.
    Remove center console assembly. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and
    Installation».
    Pull out and disconnect each cable from the shift selector
    assembly, using a suitable tool.

    L

    M

    N
    JPDIC0793ZZ

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-19

    2014 Note

    CONTROL LINKAGE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    a. While pressing the lock of the selector cable in the direction of
    the arrows shown, remove the selector cable from the shift
    selector assembly.
    b. While pressing the lock of the shifter cable in the direction of the
    arrows shown, remove the shifter cable from the shift selector
    assembly.
    10. Remove the shift selector assembly.
    11. Remove center muffler, exhaust front tube, and heat plate. Refer
    to EX-5, «Exploded View».
    12. Remove the bracket from the vehicle.
    13. Remove the grommet and then remove the shifter cable and
    selector cable from the vehicle.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    JPDIC0793ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Install each cable without causing interference with other parts. Do not allow cable to bend less than
    120 mm (4.72 in), or exceed 180 degree twist.
    • Install boot of each cable without causing interference with other parts. Do not exceed 90 degree
    twist.
    • Fit boot to center console assembly and the groove on shift selector handle.
    • To install the shift selector handle, press it onto the shift selector.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse shift selector handle.
    • Be careful with orientation of shift selector handle.
    • Bolt hole is not threaded on new clutch housing. Self-tapping bolt is used to attach lock plate to clutch housing.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse self-tapping bolt.
    • Insert each cable until it reaches the cable mounting bracket and shift selector assembly.
    • Insert each cable until it reaches the shifter lever A and the selector lever.
    • Move the shift selector to the neutral position.

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417596

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Shift Selector Handle
    Check that the shift selector handle is installed in the right position.
    Shifter Cable and Selector Cable
    • Pull each cable in the removal direction to check that it does not disconnect from the cable mounting
    bracket.
    • Pull each cable in the removal direction to check that it does not disconnect from the shift selector assembly.
    • Pull grommet in the removal direction to check that it does not disconnect from the vehicle.
    Shift Selector Assembly and Shift Selector
    • Check that there is no unusual noise, binding, bending, looseness, and interference when the shift selector
    is moved to each position. If there is a malfunction, then repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    • Check that the shift selector smoothly returns to the neutral position after moving the shift selector from 1st
    to 2nd gear and releasing it. If there is a malfunction, then repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
    • Check that the shift selector smoothly returns to the neutral position after moving the shift selector from 5th
    to the reverse gear position and releasing it. If there is a malfunction, then repair or replace the malfunctioning part.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-20

    2014 Note

    AIR BREATHER HOSE
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    AIR BREATHER HOSE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417597

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    JPDIC0788ZZ

    1.

    Cap

    2.

    Air breather hose

    3.

    2-way connector

    Removal and Installation

    H
    INFOID:0000000009417598

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    I

    Remove air cleaner case. Refer to EM-26, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove air breather hose from the 2-way connector.
    CAUTION:
    When removing air breather hose, be sure to hold 2-way connector securely.
    Remove cap from air breather hose.

    J

    K

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Install air breather hose. Do not bend hose tightly, which may result in pinching or clogging.
    • Insert the air breather hose to the base of the 2-way connector.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-21

    2014 Note

    5TH MAIN GEAR ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    5TH MAIN GEAR ASSEMBLY
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009417599

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    3.
    4.
    5.

    Move the shift selector to the 3rd gear position.
    Disconnect the shifter cable and the selector cable from shifter lever A and selector lever. Refer to TM-19,
    «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Do not move shifter lever A and selector lever to disconnect each cable.
    Drain gear oil. Refer to TM-16, «Draining».
    Remove fender protector (LH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the harness clamp (A) from rear housing (1).

    JPDIC0734ZZ

    6.

    7.

    Remove rear housing and O-ring.
    CAUTION:
    Remove in direction of input shaft ( ) as shown. Rear
    housing gear oil channel is inserted to input shaft center
    hole.
    Remove 5th main gear assembly. Refer to step 5 through 8 of
    “Disassembly of TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY”. Refer to TM-29,
    «Disassembly».

    SCIA1709J

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Shift into 3rd with shifter lever to install the 5th main gear assembly, referring to Step 36 to 39 of “Assembly
    of TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY” Refer to TM-35, «Assembly».
    • Install O-ring and the rear housing to the transaxle case and tighten the bolts to the specified torque. Refer
    to TM-25, «Exploded View».
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    • Do not pinch O-ring when installing rear housing.
    • Refill gear oil. Refer to TM-16, «Refilling».

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417600

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Check the operation of the control linkage. Refer to TM-20, «Inspection».
    • Check the gear oil level and for oil leaks. Refer to TM-16, «Inspection».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-22

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417601

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    JPDIC0478ZZ

    1.

    : Refer to «INSTALLATION» in TM-23, «Removal and Installation» for the locations and tightening torque.

    Removal and Installation

    I
    INFOID:0000000009417602

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high pressure
    coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly turn it a quarter turn to
    allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by turning it all the way.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse CSC (Concentric Slave Cylinder). The CSC slides back to the original position every time
    the transaxle assembly is removed. This action may allow dust or contaminants to gather on the sliding parts and damage a seal of CSC causing clutch fluid leakage.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    H

    Transaxle assembly

    Remove the engine and transaxle assembly. Refer to EM-86, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the reverse lamp switch harness connector.
    Remove the bolts that fasten the transaxle assembly and engine assembly.
    Remove transaxle assembly from the engine assembly.
    Remove engine mounting bracket (LH). Refer to EM-85, «Exploded View».
    Remove CSC (Concentric Slave Cylinder). Refer to CL-16, «Removal and Installation».

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    INSTALLATION

    P

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Secure transaxle assembly to a suitable jack.
    • The transaxle assembly must not interfere with the wire harnesses and clutch tube.
    • When installing transaxle assembly, do not bring input shaft into contact with clutch cover.
    • Bolt hole is not threaded on new clutch housing. Self-tapping bolt is used to attach lock plate to
    clutch housing.
    Revision: April 2013

    J

    TM-23

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Do not reuse self-tapping bolt.
    • Tighten transaxle assembly bolts to the specified torque. The illustration is the view from the engine.
    Bolt symbol

    A

    B

    Transaxle to
    engine

    Insertion direction
    Quantity

    2

    Bolt length
    ( ) mm (in)

    C
    Engine to transaxle

    3
    55 (2.17)

    Tightening torque
    N·m (kg-m, ft-lb)

    D

    2

    1

    49 (1.93)

    69 (2.72)
    JPDIC0813ZZ

    48.0 (4.9, 35)

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417603

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Check the operation of the control linkage. Refer to TM-20, «Inspection».
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leaks.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leaks
    at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leaks at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leaks of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Item

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    CVT Models

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    M/T Models

    Level/Leaks

    Leaks

    Level/Leaks

    Other oils and fluids*

    Level

    Leaks

    Level

    Fuel

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Leaks

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid

    Exhaust gas
    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-24

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY

    A

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417604

    B

    CASE AND HOUSING
    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M
    AWDIA0945GB

    1.

    Differential side oil seal

    2.

    Clutch housing

    3.

    Dowel pin

    4.

    Magnet

    5.

    Drain plug

    6.

    Gasket

    7.

    Oil channel

    8.

    Plug

    9.

    2-way connector

    10. Oil gutter

    11. Air breather inner tube

    12. Filler plug

    13. Transaxle case

    14. O-ring

    15. Rear housing

    N

    O

    16. Position switch

    P

    : Apply Genuine Silicone RTV or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».

    INPUT SHAFT AND GEAR

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-25

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    JPDIC0820GB

    1.

    Input shaft front bearing

    2.

    Input shaft

    3.

    4.

    Input shaft rear bearing

    5.

    Adapter plate

    6.

    Bushing

    7.

    5th input gear

    8.

    5th-reverse baulk ring

    9.

    Synchronizer lever

    10. 5th-reverse synchronizer hub

    11. 5th-reverse coupling sleeve

    13. Retaining pin

    14. Reverse gear

    Snap ring

    12. Lock washer

    : Apply gear oil.
    : Replace the parts as a set.

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-26

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H
    JPDIC0531GB

    1.

    Mainshaft front bearing

    2.

    Mainshaft

    3.

    1st main gear

    4.

    1st inner baulk ring

    5.

    1st synchronizer cone

    6.

    1st outer baulk ring

    7.

    1st-2nd synchronizer hub

    8.

    1st-2nd coupling sleeve

    9.

    Spring

    10. Insert key

    11. 2nd outer baulk ring

    12. 2nd synchronizer cone

    13. 2nd inner baulk ring

    14. Snap ring

    15. Thrust washer

    16. 2nd main gear

    17. 3rd main gear

    18. 3rd baulk ring

    19. 3rd-4th synchronizer hub

    20. 3rd-4th coupling sleeve

    21. 4th baulk ring

    22. 4th main gear

    23. Spacer

    24. Mainshaft rear bearing

    I

    J

    K

    25. 5th main gear
    : Apply gear oil.

    L

    : Replace the parts as a set.

    SHIFT FORK AND FORK ROD

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-27

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    AWBIA1480ZZ

    1.

    Retaining pin

    2.

    1st-2nd shift fork

    3.

    Bushing

    4.

    1st-2nd fork rod

    5.

    Lock pin

    6.

    5th-reverse fork rod

    7.

    5th-reverse shift fork

    8.

    Check ball

    9.

    3rd-4th shift fork

    10. 3rd-4th fork rod

    11. Control shaft

    12. O-ring

    13. Selector

    14. Check ball plug

    15. Bushing

    16. Spring

    17. Gear catch

    : Apply gear oil.
    : Apply Genuine Silicone RTV or equivalent. Refer to GI-22, «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».
    : Replace the parts as a set.

    FINAL DRIVE

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-28

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    JPDIC0481ZZ

    1.

    Differential side bearing outer race

    2.

    Differential side bearing

    3.

    Final drive

    : Replace the parts as a set.

    G

    Disassembly
    1.
    2.
    3.

    INFOID:0000000009417605

    H

    Remove drain plug and gasket from clutch housing using suitable tool, and drain gear oil.
    Remove filler plug and gasket from transaxle case.
    Remove rear housing and O-ring.
    CAUTION:
    Remove in direction of input shaft ( ) as shown. Rear
    housing oil channel is inserted to input shaft center hole.

    I

    J

    K

    SCIA1709J

    4.

    Move the shifter lever A (1) to the 3rd gear position.
    NOTE:
    • If it is not moved to the 3rd gear position, transaxle case cannot be removed from clutch housing.
    • The 3rd gear position means that shifter lever A is fully rotated
    clockwise and it is returned approximately 10 degrees.

    L

    M

    N

    O
    PCIB1524E

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-29

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    5. Remove 5th-reverse shift fork (1) and 5th-reverse coupling
    sleeve.
    a. Remove retaining pin from 5th-reverse shift fork, using a suitable tool (A).
    b. Press 5th-reverse shift fork, shift to 5th, and then engage it with
    3rd gear.
    c. Remove bolt (B).
    d. Remove nut (C) and lock washer.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse nut.
    JPDIC0532ZZ
    • Do not use an impact wrench for removal. Gears may be
    damaged.
    e. Remove 5th-reverse shift fork and 5th-reverse coupling sleeve from 5th-reverse synchronizer hub.
    6. Remove 5th-reverse synchronizer hub from input shaft, using a
    suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Set claw of suitable tool to the wider side of the hub when
    setting the suitable tool in 5th-reverse synchronizer hub.
    7. Remove synchronizer levers, 5th-reverse baulk ring, 5th input
    gear, bushing, and adapter plate from input shaft.

    PCIB1526E

    8.

    Remove 5th main gear from mainshaft, using Tools.
    Tool number

    (A): KV32300QAC ( —
    (B): KV32300QAD ( —

    )
    )

    PCIB1527E

    9.

    Remove position switch from transaxle case.

    PCIB1627E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-30

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    10. Remove transaxle case bolts ( ).
    11. Remove transaxle case from clutch housing.

    A

    B

    C
    JPDIC0610ZZ

    TM

    12. Remove spacer (1) and 4th main gear (2) from mainshaft.

    E

    F

    G
    PCIB1529E

    13. Remove 5th-reverse fork rod (1).
    a.
    b.

    H

    Pull 5th-reverse fork rod up until it contacts claw ( ) of reverse
    gear (2).
    Press gear portion of reverse gear down, and then remove 5threverse fork rod from clutch housing.

    I

    J

    PCIB1530E

    14. Remove 3rd-4th fork rod assembly (1), 3rd-4th coupling sleeve
    (2), and input shaft assembly (3).
    a. Remove 4th baulk ring, insert keys, and springs from mainshaft.
    b. Pull gear of reverse gear (4) up.
    c. Pull 1st-2nd fork rod (5) up, and then maintain the neutral position.
    d. Remove 3rd-4th fork rod assembly, 3rd-4th coupling sleeve, and
    input shaft assembly from clutch housing at the same time.
    15. Remove retaining pin from 3rd-4th shift fork, using a pin punch.
    16. Remove 3rd-4th shift fork from 3rd-4th shift fork rod.
    17. Remove lock pins (

    K

    L

    M

    N
    PCIB1531E

    ) from clutch housing.

    O

    P

    JPDIC0534ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-31

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    18. Remove 1st-2nd fork rod assembly (1) and mainshaft assembly
    (2) from clutch housing at the same time.
    19. Remove retaining pin from 1st-2nd shift fork, using suitable tool.
    20. Remove 1st-2nd shift fork from 1st-2nd shift fork rod.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    PCIB1532E

    21. Remove retaining pin from reverse gear, using suitable tool.
    22. Remove reverse gear from clutch housing.

    MCIB0033E

    23. Remove final drive (1) from clutch housing.
    24. Remove magnet and dowel pins (2) from clutch housing.

    PCIB1533E

    25. Remove plug (1) from clutch housing (2).
    • (C): Plug
    • (D): 15 mm (0.59 in)
    • (E): 45 mm (1.77 in)
    • (F): 95 mm (3.74 in) or more
    • (G): 4 mm (0.16 in)
    a. Install suitable tool (A) and (B) to the holes of clutch housing as
    shown.
    b. While pressing the suitable tool (A) and (B) in the direction of the
    arrows shown, remove plug from clutch housing.

    AWDIA0946ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-32

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    26. Remove input shaft front bearing from clutch housing, using suitable tool.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    A

    B

    C
    MCIB0044E

    TM

    27. Cut oil channel tube at the base.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse oil channel.
    NOTE:
    Oil channel will be removed with the mainshaft front bearing.
    28. Remove mainshaft front bearing and oil channel from clutch
    housing, using Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : KV111011S0 (

    E

    F

    )
    G

    H

    PCIB1536E

    I

    29. Remove bushings (1) from clutch housing, using suitable tool.
    J

    K

    L
    PCIB1537E

    30. Remove differential side oil seals (1) from clutch housing and
    transaxle case, using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage transaxle case and clutch housing.

    M

    N

    O

    PCIB1534E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-33

    2014 Note

    P

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    31. Remove differential side bearing outer races (1) from clutch
    housing and transaxle case, using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage transaxle case and clutch housing.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    JPDIC0484ZZ

    32. Pull 2-way connector (1) straight out to remove it from air
    breather inner tube (2).
    33. Remove air breather inner tube from transaxle case.

    PCIB1541E

    34. Remove bushings (1) from transaxle case, using suitable tool.
    35. Remove retaining pin ( ) from selector, using suitable tool.
    36. Remove selector from control shaft.
    37. Remove oil gutter from transaxle case.

    PCIB1538E

    38. Remove bolt ( ), and then remove bushing, spring, and gear
    catch from transaxle case.
    39. Remove check ball plug from transaxle case.

    JPDIC0533ZZ

    40. Remove bolts ( ), and then remove control shaft (1) from transaxle case.
    41. Remove O-ring from control shaft.

    PCIB1540E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-34

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    42. Expand snap rings (1) and remove input shaft rear bearing and
    mainshaft rear bearing from transaxle case, using Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : ST35300000 (

    A

    )

    B

    43. Remove snap rings from transaxle case.
    44. Remove check balls (2) from transaxle case.

    C

    PCIB1535E

    Assembly
    1.

    TM

    INFOID:0000000009417606

    E

    Install snap rings (1) along transaxle case groove so that notch
    mates with housing as shown.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse snap rings.
    • Check snap ring installation direction.
    • Be sure to align notch with housing.

    F

    G

    H
    PCIB1547E

    2.

    Expand snap rings (1) and install input shaft rear bearing and
    mainshaft rear bearing to transaxle case, using Tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Check that snap ring is correctly installed within bearing
    groove.
    Tool number

    3.

    : ST35300000 (

    I

    J

    )

    Install check balls (2) to transaxle case.

    K
    PCIB1548E

    4.

    5.

    Install bushings (1) until they reach transaxle case, using suitable tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse bushings.
    Apply gear oil to O-ring, and then install it to control shaft.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-ring.

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JPDIC0636ZZ

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-35

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    6.

    Install control shaft (1) to transaxle case, and tighten bolts (
    to the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    Replace control shaft and selector as a set.

    )

    PCIB1540E

    7.

    Install selector to control shaft, and then install retaining pin (
    to selector, using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful with the orientation of selector.
    • Replace control shaft and selector as a set.
    • Do not reuse retaining pin.

    )

    SCIA1726J

    8.

    9.

    Install gear catch, spring, and bushing to transaxle case, and
    then tighten bolt ( ) to the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    Replace gear catch, spring, and bushing as a set.
    Install oil gutter to transaxle case.

    JPDIC0533ZZ

    10. Install air breather inner tube (2) to transaxle case.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage air breather inner tube.
    NOTE:
    It is easier to install when air breather inner tube end is wrapped
    and narrowed by tape. Remove tape after installation.
    11. Insert 2-way connector (1) straight, and then install it to air
    breather inner tube.
    CAUTION:
    Check air breather inner tube for twists after installing.
    PCIB1541E

    12. Install differential side oil seals (1) to clutch housing and transaxle case, using Tool.
    (B)

    : Transaxle case side

    (C)

    : Clutch housing side

    Dimension (L1)
    Dimension (L2)
    Tool number
    Revision: April 2013

    : 5.7 – 6.3 mm (0.224 – 0.248 in)
    : 2.4 – 3.0 mm (0.094 – 0.118 in)
    : KV32500QAA (

    )

    JPDIC0401ZZ

    TM-36

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse differential side oil seal.
    • Do not tilt differential side oil seal.
    • Do not damage clutch housing and transaxle case.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    A

    B

    13. Install differential side bearing outer races until they reach clutch
    housing and transaxle case, using Tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Replace differential side bearing outer race and differential
    side bearing as a set.
    Tool number

    : KV32300QAE (

    C

    )

    TM

    E
    PCIB1549E

    14. Install bushings (1) until they reach clutch housing, using suitable tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse bushings.
    15. Install oil channel to clutch housing.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse oil channel.

    F

    G

    H
    JPDIC0637ZZ

    I

    16. Install mainshaft front bearing so that it becomes even with
    clutch housing surface, using Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : ST33400001 (

    J

    )

    K

    L
    PCIB1544E

    17. Install input shaft front bearing so that it becomes even with
    clutch housing surface, using Tool (A).
    Tool number

    : KV40100900 (

    M

    )
    N

    18. Install pinion gear, pinion shaft, and plug to clutch housing.

    O
    PCIB1545E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-37

    2014 Note

    P

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    19. Install final drive (1) to clutch housing.
    20. Install dowel pins (2) and magnet to clutch housing.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse dowel pins.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    PCIB1533E

    21. Install reverse gear to clutch housing, and then install retaining
    pin to clutch housing, using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse retaining pin.
    22. Install 1st-2nd shift fork to 1st-2nd fork rod, and then install
    retaining pin to 1st-2nd shift fork.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse retaining pin.
    • Replace 1st-2nd fork rod and 1st-2nd shift fork as a set.
    MCIB0033E

    23. Set 1st-2nd fork rod assembly (1) onto mainshaft assembly (2),
    and then install them to clutch housing.

    PCIB1532E

    24. Install lock pins ( ) to clutch housing.
    25. Install 3rd-4th shift fork to 3rd-4th fork rod, and then install
    retaining pin to 3rd-4th shift fork.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse retaining pin.
    • Replace 3rd-4th fork rod and 3rd-4th shift fork as a set.

    JPDIC0534ZZ

    26. Install 3rd-4th fork rod assembly (1), 3rd-4th coupling sleeve (2),
    and input shaft assembly (3) to clutch housing.
    a. Pull 1st-2nd fork rod (4) up, and then maintain the neutral position.
    b. Set 3rd-4th fork rod assembly onto 3rd-4th coupling sleeve, and
    then install them together with input shaft assembly to clutch
    housing.
    CAUTION:
    • Set lock pin (3rd-4th fork rod side) onto 1st-2nd fork rod
    groove and then install 3rd-4th fork rod assembly.
    PCIB1628E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-38

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Be careful with the orientation of 3rd-4th coupling sleeve.
    (A)

    : 4th main gear side

    (B)

    : 3rd main gear side

    A

    B

    • Install 3rd input gear of input shaft assembly so that it is
    set under reverse main gear of 3rd-4th coupling sleeve.
    • Replace 3rd-4th coupling sleeve and 3rd-4th synchronizer
    hub as a set.

    C

    PCIB1551E

    c.
    d.
    e.

    Install springs and insert keys to 3rd-4th synchronizer hub.
    Apply gear oil to 4th baulk ring.
    Install 4th baulk ring.

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    MCIB0061E

    H

    27. Install 5th-reverse fork rod (1) to clutch housing.
    CAUTION:
    Replace 5th-reverse fork rod and 5th-reverse shift fork as a
    set.
    a. Pull gear of reverse gear (2) up.
    b. Temporarily install 5th-reverse fork rod to clutch housing.

    I

    J

    PCIB1629E

    c.

    Press gear of reverse gear (1) down and then install 5th-reverse
    fork rod (2) to clutch housing.
    CAUTION:
    Set levers of 5th-reverse fork rod so as to align with reverse
    gear groove ( ).

    K

    L

    M

    N
    PCIB1552E

    O

    28. Install 4th main gear (2) and spacer (1) to mainshaft.
    CAUTION:
    Install spacer so that spacer protrusion faces rear side of
    transaxle.
    29. Press 3rd-4th shift fork down and then shift 3rd-4th coupling
    sleeve to 3rd gear side.

    P

    PCIB1529E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-39

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    30. Move the shifter lever A (1) to the 3rd gear position.
    NOTE:
    • If it is not moved to the 3rd gear position, transaxle case cannot be installed to clutch housing.
    • The 3rd gear position means that shifter lever A is fully rotated
    clockwise and it is returned approximately 10 degrees.
    31. Apply recommended sealant to transaxle case mating surface of
    clutch housing.
    CAUTION:
    • Use Genuine Silicone RTV or equivalent. Refer to GI-22,
    «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».
    • Do not allow old Silicone RTV, moisture, oil, or foreign
    matter to remain on mating surface.
    • Check that mating surface is not damaged.
    • Apply a continuous bead of Silicone RTV to the mating surface.

    PCIB1524E

    32. Install transaxle case to clutch housing. If it is difficult to install,
    slightly rotate shifter lever A counterclockwise, and then install.
    (1)

    : Selector

    (2)

    : Shift fork

    CAUTION:
    • Do not damage Silicone RTV bead with transaxle case or
    other objects during installation.
    • Be careful to align the lever of 5th-reverse fork rod with
    reverse gear groove.
    PCIB1553E

    33. Rotate input shaft so that bearing and shaft fit each other, and
    then tighten transaxle bolts ( ) to the specified torque.
    34. Apply recommended sealant to position switch thread and check
    ball plug thread. Install to transaxle case and tighten to specified
    torque.
    CAUTION:
    • Use Genuine Silicone RTV or equivalent. Refer to GI-22,
    «Recommended Chemical Products and Sealants».
    • Do not allow old Silicone RTV, moisture, oil, or foreign
    matter to remain on thread.
    35. Apply gear oil to mainshaft spline.
    36. Install 5th main gear (1) to mainshaft, using a suitable bolt (A)
    [M10 x 1.0] and a suitable nut (B).

    JPDIC0610ZZ

    PCIB1554E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-40

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    37. Install adapter plate (1), bushing (2), and 5th input gear (3) to
    input shaft.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful with the orientation of adapter plate.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    A

    B

    : Transaxle case side

    C
    PCIB1555E

    TM

    38. Install 5th-reverse synchronizer hub, 5th-reverse coupling sleeve, and 5th-reverse shift fork.
    a. Apply gear oil to 5th-reverse baulk ring.
    b. Install 5th-reverse baulk ring (1) to 5th input gear.

    E

    : 5th-reverse synchronizer hub side

    c.

    d.

    CAUTION:
    Be careful with the orientation of 5th-reverse baulk ring.
    Install synchronizer levers (2) to 5th-reverse synchronizer hub
    (3).
    CAUTION:
    • Replace 5th-reverse synchronizer hub and 5th-reverse
    coupling sleeve as a set.
    • Be careful with the orientation of synchronizer lever.
    Install 5th-reverse synchronizer hub assembly and lock washer to input shaft.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful with the orientation of 5th-reverse synchronizer hub.

    F

    G

    JPDIC0421ZZ

    H

    I

    J

    : 5th input gear side

    K

    PCIB1556E

    • Do not allow synchronizer lever (1) to overlap 5th-reverse
    baulk ring protrusion (A).
    (2)

    : 5th-reverse baulk ring

    (3)

    : 5th-reverse synchronizer hub

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JPDIC0408ZZ

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-41

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    e. Set 5th-reverse shift fork (1) to 5th-reverse coupling sleeve, and
    then install them to 5th-reverse fork rod and input shaft.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse nut.
    (A)

    : Suitable tool

    (B)

    : Bolt

    (C)

    : Nut

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    JPDIC0532ZZ

    CAUTION:
    • Be careful with the orientation of 5th-reverse coupling
    sleeve.
    : 5th input gear side

    • Replace 5th-reverse synchronizer hub and 5th-reverse
    coupling sleeve as a set.
    • Replace 5th-reverse shift fork and 5th-reverse fork rod as
    a set.
    JPDIC0409ZZ

    f.

    Check that the shifter lever A is in the 3rd position. Press 5threverse shift fork (1) and move shifter lever A to 5th gear.
    (A)

    : Suitable tool

    g.
    h.

    Tighten bolt (B) to the specified torque.
    Tighten nut (C) to the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse nut.
    i. Install retaining pin to 5th-reverse shift fork, using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse retaining pin.
    39. Move shifter lever A (1) to the neutral position.
    40. Install O-ring to rear housing.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse O-ring.

    JPDIC0532ZZ

    SCIA7130E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-42

    2014 Note

    TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    41. Install rear housing to transaxle case, and tighten bolts ( ) to
    the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    • Do not pinch O-ring when installing rear housing.
    42. Install drain plug.
    a. Install gasket to drain plug.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    b. Install drain plug to clutch housing, using suitable tool.
    c. Tighten drain plug to the specified torque.
    43. Install filler plug.
    a. Install gasket to filler plug, and then install filler plug to transaxle case.
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse gasket.
    b. Tighten filler plug to the specified torque.
    CAUTION:
    Fill with gear oil before tightening filler plug to the specified torque.

    Inspection

    A

    B

    C
    PCIB1558E

    TM

    E

    F
    INFOID:0000000009417607

    G

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Check contact surface and sliding surface of fork rod and shift fork
    for excessive wear, uneven wear, and damage. Replace if necessary.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    PCIB1571E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-43

    2014 Note

    INPUT SHAFT AND GEAR
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    INPUT SHAFT AND GEAR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417608

    JPDIC0820GB

    1.

    Input shaft front bearing

    2.

    Input shaft

    3.

    4.

    Input shaft rear bearing

    5.

    Adapter plate

    6.

    Bushing

    7.

    5th input gear

    8.

    5th-reverse baulk ring

    9.

    Synchronizer lever

    10. 5th-reverse synchronizer hub

    11. 5th-reverse coupling sleeve

    13. Retaining pin

    14. Reverse gear

    Snap ring

    12. Lock washer

    : Apply gear oil.
    : Replace the parts as a set.

    Disassembly

    INFOID:0000000009417609

    Refer to TM-29, «Disassembly» for disassembly procedure.

    Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009417610

    Refer to TM-35, «Assembly» for assembly procedure.

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417611

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Input Shaft and Gear

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-44

    2014 Note

    INPUT SHAFT AND GEAR
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Check the following items and replace if necessary.
    • Damage, peeling, uneven wear, and distortion of shaft.
    • Excessive wear, damage, and peeling of gear.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    A

    B

    C
    PCIB0987J

    TM

    Synchronizer
    Check for the following and replace if necessary.
    • Contact surface breakage, damage, and unusual wear of coupling
    sleeve, synchronizer hub, and synchronizer lever.
    • Coupling sleeve and synchronizer hub move smoothly.

    E

    F

    G
    SCIA1753J

    H

    • Breakage, damage, and excessive wear of baulk ring cam surface
    and synchronizer lever contact surface.

    I

    J

    K
    SCIA0608J

    Bearing
    Check bearing for damage and rough rotation. Replace if necessary.

    L

    M

    N

    MTF0041D

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-45

    2014 Note

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417612

    JPDIC0531GB

    1.

    Mainshaft front bearing

    4.

    1st inner baulk ring

    5.

    1st synchronizer cone

    6.

    1st outer baulk ring

    7.

    1st-2nd synchronizer hub

    8.

    1st-2nd coupling sleeve

    9.

    Spring

    10. Insert key

    2.

    Mainshaft

    3.

    11. 2nd outer baulk ring

    1st main gear

    12. 2nd synchronizer cone

    13. 2nd inner baulk ring

    14. Snap ring

    15. Thrust washer

    16. 2nd main gear

    17. 3rd main gear

    18. 3rd baulk ring

    19. 3rd-4th synchronizer hub

    20. 3rd-4th coupling sleeve

    21. 4th baulk ring

    22. 4th main gear

    23. Spacer

    24. Mainshaft rear bearing

    25. 5th main gear
    : Apply gear oil.
    : Replace the parts as a set.

    Disassembly

    INFOID:0000000009417613

    CAUTION:
    • Secure mainshaft in a vise using blocks of wood to prevent damage, and then remove gears and
    snap rings.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-46

    2014 Note

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • For removal of snap ring, set snap ring pliers and flat pliers at
    both sides of snap ring. While expanding snap ring with snap
    ring pliers, remove snap ring with flat pliers.
    • Mark gear component direction for assembly without damaging component contact locations.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    A

    B

    C
    SCIA1755J

    TM

    1.
    2.

    Remove 3rd-4th synchronizer hub and 3rd baulk ring.
    Remove snap ring (1) and thrust washer (2).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse snap ring.

    E

    F

    G

    PCIB1559E

    3.

    H

    Remove 3rd main gear (1) and thrust washer (2).
    I

    J

    K
    PCIB1560E

    4.

    Remove snap ring (1) and thrust washer (2).
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse snap ring.

    L

    M

    N

    PCIB1561E

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-47

    2014 Note

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    5. Remove 2nd main gear (1) and thrust washer (2).

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    PCIB1562E

    6.
    7.
    8.

    Remove snap ring (1), and then remove 2nd inner baulk ring,
    2nd synchronizer cone, and 2nd outer baulk ring.
    Remove 1st-2nd coupling sleeve, insert keys, springs, and 1st2nd synchronizer hub.
    Remove 1st outer baulk ring, 1st synchronizer cone, 1st inner
    baulk ring, and 1st main gear (2).

    JPDIC0541ZZ

    Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009417614

    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse snap ring.
    • For installation of snap ring, set snap ring pliers and flat pliers
    at both sides of snap ring. While expanding snap ring with
    snap ring pliers, remove snap ring with flat pliers.
    • Check that snap ring is securely installed to the groove.
    • Apply gear oil to 1st outer baulk ring, 1st synchronizer cone,
    1st inner baulk ring, 2nd outer baulk ring, 2nd synchronizer
    cone, 2nd inner baulk ring, and 3rd baulk ring.
    • Replace 1st outer baulk ring, 1st synchronizer cone, and 1st
    inner baulk ring as a set.
    • Replace 2nd outer baulk ring, 2nd synchronizer cone, and 2nd
    inner baulk ring as a set.

    SCIA1755J

    • Be careful with the orientation of 1st-2nd synchronizer hub.
    (A)

    : 1st main gear side

    (B)

    : 2nd main gear side

    • Replace 1st-2nd synchronizer hub and 1st-2nd coupling
    sleeve as a set.

    PCIB1566E

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-48

    2014 Note

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Be careful with the orientation of 1st-2nd coupling sleeve.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]
    A

    (A)

    : 2nd main gear side

    (B)

    : 1st main gear side

    B

    C
    PCIB1567E

    TM

    • Be careful with the orientation of 3rd-4th synchronizer hub.
    (A)

    : 4th main gear side

    (B)

    : 3rd main gear side

    E

    • Replace 3rd-4th synchronizer hub and 3rd-4th coupling
    sleeve as a set.

    F

    G
    PCIB1565E

    H

    • Be careful with the orientation of insert key (1) and spring (2).

    I

    J

    PCIB1564E

    Inspection

    K

    INFOID:0000000009417615

    L

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Mainshaft and Gear
    Check the following items and replace if necessary.
    • Damage, peeling, uneven wear, and distortion of shaft.
    • Excessive wear, damage, and peeling of gear.

    M

    N

    O

    P
    SCIA1762J

    Synchronizer
    Check the following items and replace if necessary.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-49

    2014 Note

    MAINSHAFT AND GEAR
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    • Contact surface breakage, damage, and unusual wear of coupling
    sleeve, synchronizer hub, insert key, and spring.
    • Coupling sleeve and synchronizer hub move smoothly.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    SCIA1753J

    • Breakage, damage, and excessive wear of baulk ring cam surface
    and insert contact surface.

    SCIA0608J

    Bearing
    Check bearing for damage and rough rotation. Replace if necessary.

    MTF0041D

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-50

    2014 Note

    FINAL DRIVE
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >

    FINAL DRIVE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009417616

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    JPDIC0481ZZ

    1.

    Differential side bearing outer race

    2.

    Differential side bearing

    3.

    Final drive

    H

    : Replace the parts as a set.

    Disassembly

    INFOID:0000000009417617

    I

    • Remove differential side bearings, using Tool (A) and suitable tool.
    Tool number

    : ST33052000 (

    )

    J

    K

    L
    PCIB1568E

    Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009417618

    • Install differential side bearings, using Tool (A).
    CAUTION:
    Replace differential side bearing outer race and differential
    side bearing as a set.
    Tool number

    : KV40104920 (

    M

    N

    )

    O

    P
    PCIB1570E

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009417619

    INSPECTION AFTER DISASSEMBLY
    Gear and Final Drive

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-51

    2014 Note

    FINAL DRIVE
    < UNIT DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY >
    Check the sliding surfaces for wear, crack, or damage. Replace if necessary.

    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    Bearing
    Check bearing for damage and rough rotation. Replace if necessary.

    SPD715

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-52

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [5MT: RS5F91R]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    General Specifications

    INFOID:0000000009417620

    Transaxle type

    RS5F91R

    Engine type

    HR16DE

    Model code number

    C

    3AM0C

    Number of speed

    3VB0B

    TM

    5

    Synchromesh type

    B

    Warner

    Shift pattern

    E

    F
    SCIA0821E

    Gear ratio

    1st

    3.7273

    2nd

    2.0476

    3rd

    1.3929

    4th

    1.0294

    5th

    0.8205

    Reverse

    3.5455

    Final gear
    Number of
    teeth

    Input gear

    Main gear

    4.0667

    Final gear

    11

    2nd

    21

    3rd

    28

    4th

    34

    5th

    39

    Reverse

    11

    1st

    41

    2nd

    43

    3rd

    39

    4th

    35

    5th

    32

    Reverse

    39

    Final gear/Pinion

    Gear oil capacity (Reference)

    61/15

    (US pt, Imp pt)

    Reverse brake

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    59/14

    Approx. 2.67 (5-5/8, 4-3/4)

    P

    Installed
    1st and 2nd

    Speedometer drive gear

    Not installed

    TM-53

    O

    13/9

    Double-cone synchronizer

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    26

    Side gear/Pinion mate gear

    Remarks

    H

    4.2143

    1st

    Reverse idler gear

    G

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009578896

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009019825

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc to prevent damage to
    windshield.

    PIIB3706J

    Precaution for TCM and Transaxle Assembly Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009019826

    CAUTION:
    • To replace TCM, refer to TM-126, «Description».
    • To replace transaxle assembly, refer to TM-127, «Description».

    Precaution for G Sensor Removal/Installation or Replacement

    INFOID:0000000009019827

    CAUTION:
    To remove/install or replace G sensor, refer to TM-129, «Description».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-54

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < PRECAUTION >

    General Precautions

    INFOID:0000000009019828

    A

    • Turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable
    from the negative terminal before connecting or disconnecting the CVT assembly harness connector. Because battery
    voltage is applied to TCM even if ignition switch is turned
    OFF.

    B

    C

    TM
    SEF289H

    E

    • When connecting or disconnecting pin connectors into or
    from TCM, do not damage pin terminals (bend or break).
    Check that there are not any bends or breaks on TCM pin terminal, when connecting pin connectors.

    F

    G

    AAT470A

    • Perform TCM input/output signal inspection and check
    whether TCM functions normally or not before replacing TCM.
    Refer to TM-99, «Reference Value».

    H

    I

    J

    K
    MEF040DA

    • Perform “DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code) CONFIRMATION
    PROCEDURE”.
    If the repair is completed DTC should not be displayed in the
    “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE”.

    L

    M

    N

    O
    JSBIA1315ZZ

    • Always use the specified brand of CVT fluid. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use lint-free paper not cloth rags during work.
    • Dispose of the waste oil using the methods prescribed by law, ordinance, etc. after replacing the CVT fluid.

    On Board Diagnosis (OBD) System of CVT and Engine

    INFOID:0000000009019829

    The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) to warn the
    driver of a malfunction causing emission deterioration.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-55

    2014 Note

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < PRECAUTION >
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal
    before any repair or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid
    valves, etc. will cause the MIL to light up.
    • Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
    cause the MIL to light up due to an open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease,
    dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
    • Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. Interference of the harness with a
    bracket, etc. may cause the MIL to light up due to a short circuit.
    • Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
    may cause the MIL to light up due to a malfunction of the EGR system or fuel injection system, etc.
    • Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the TCM and
    ECM before returning the vehicle to the customer.

    Removal and Installation Procedure for CVT Unit Connector

    INFOID:0000000009019830

    REMOVAL
    • Rotate bayonet ring (A) counterclockwise. Pull out CVT unit harness connector (B) upward and remove it.

    JSDIA1162ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    1.
    2.

    Align marking (A) on CVT unit harness connector terminal with
    marking (B) on bayonet ring. Insert CVT unit harness connector.
    Rotate bayonet ring clockwise.

    JPDIA0294ZZ

    3.

    Rotate bayonet ring clockwise until marking (A) on CVT unit harness connector terminal body is aligned with the slit (B) on bayonet ring as shown in the figure (correctly fitting condition).

    JPDIA0295ZZ

    CAUTION:

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-56

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Securely align marking (A) on CVT unit harness connector terminal body with bayonet ring slit (B). Then, be careful not to make a half fit condition as shown in the figure.
    • Do not mistake the slit of bayonet ring for other dent portion.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    A

    B

    C
    JPDIA0296ZZ

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-57

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION
    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009019831

    Tool number
    Tool name
    1.
    2.

    Description

    KV311039S0
    Charging pipe set
    KV31103920*
    O-ring

    CVT fluid changing and adjustment

    JSDIA1844ZZ

    KV38107900
    Protector
    a: φ 32 mm

    Installing drive shaft

    PDIA1183J

    *: The O-ring as an unit part is set as a SST.

    Commercial Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009019832

    Tool number
    Tool name

    Description

    31197EU50A
    Drive plate location guide
    a: φ 25 mm

    Installing transaxle assembly

    JPDIA0676ZZ

    Drift
    a: φ 56 mm
    b: φ 50 mm

    Installing differential side oil seal

    NT115

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-58

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION

    A

    COMPONENT PARTS
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM

    B

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009019833

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    ALDIA0436ZZ

    O
    1.

    ECM

    2.

    IPDM E/R

    3.

    TCM

    4.

    Transmission range switch

    5.

    Primary speed sensor

    6.

    CVT control unit

    7.

    Control valve

    Secondary speed sensor

    8.

    Output speed sensor

    9.

    10. G sensor

    11.

    BCM

    12. Sport mode switch

    13. Combination meter

    14. Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL)

    16. Shift position indicator

    17. ABS actuator and electric unit (control
    unit)

    P

    15. Sport mode indicator lamp

    COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-59

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Component

    Function

    IPDM E/R

    The TCM receives the A/C compressor feedback signal via CAN communications from the IPDM E/R.

    TCM

    TM-60, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : TCM»

    Transmission range switch

    TM-61, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Transmission Range Switch»

    Primary speed sensor

    TM-61, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Primary Speed Sensor»

    CVT unit

    Control
    valve

    ROM assembly*

    TM-60, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : ROM Assembly»

    CVT fluid temperature sensor*

    TM-62, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor»

    Secondary pressure sensor*

    TM-62, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Secondary Pressure Sensor»

    Primary pressure solenoid valve*

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve»

    Low brake solenoid valve*

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Low Brake Solenoid Valve»

    High clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve*

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : High Clutch & Reverse Brake Solenoid
    Valve»

    Torque converter clutch solenoid valve*

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve»

    Line pressure solenoid valve*

    TM-64, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Line Pressure Solenoid Valve»

    Output speed sensor

    TM-62, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Output Speed Sensor»

    Secondary speed sensor

    TM-61, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Secondary Speed Sensor»

    G sensor

    TM-64, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : G Sensor»

    Overdrive control switch

    TM-64, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Overdrive Control Switch»

    Combination meter

    The TCM receives the overdrive cntrol switch signal via CAN communications
    from the combination meter.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    The TCM receives the following signals via CAN communications from the ABS
    actuator and electric unit (control unit).
    • Vehicle speed signal
    • VDC operation signal
    • VDC malfunction signal

    ECM

    • For purposes including improving the feeling when shifting and preventing
    drops in engine speed, control signals are exchanged between the ECM and
    TCM, and real-time cooperative control is performed according to the vehicle
    driving conditions. (Engine and CVT integrated control)
    — Engine and CVT integrated control signal
    • The TCM receives the following signals via CAN communications from the
    ECM.
    — Engine speed signal
    — Accelerator pedal position signal
    — Closed throttle position signal
    • TCM sends and receives the following signals with ECM through CAN communication to perform D position N idle control.
    — N idle instruction signal

    BCM

    The TCM receives the following signals via CAN communications from the
    BCM.
    • Stop lamp switch signal
    • Turn indicator signal

    *: These components are included in control valve assembly.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : TCM

    INFOID:0000000009019834

    • The vehicle driving status is judged based on the signals from the sensors, switches, and other control units,
    and the optimal transaxle control is performed.
    • For TCM control items, refer to TM-73, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description».

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : ROM Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009019835

    • The ROM assembly is installed to control valve.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-60

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • The ROM assembly stores the calibration data (characteristic value) of each solenoid valve. TCM enables
    accurate hydraulic control by obtaining the calibration data.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Transmission Range Switch

    INFOID:0000000009019836

    B

    • The transmission range switch is installed to upper part of transaxle case.
    • The transmission range switch detects the selector lever position.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Primary Speed Sensor

    A

    INFOID:0000000009019837

    C

    • The primary speed sensor is installed to side cover of transaxle.
    • The primary speed sensor detects primary pulley speed.
    • The primary speed sensor generates the ON-OFF pulse (short waveform) in proportion to the rotating body TM
    speed which is “The higher the rotating body speed is, the faster the change cycle is”. The TCM judges the
    rotating speed from the changing cycle of this pulse signal.
    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    JSDIA1824GB

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Secondary Speed Sensor

    J

    INFOID:0000000009019838

    • The secondary speed sensor is installed to side cover of transaxle.
    • The secondary speed sensor detects secondary pulley speed.
    • The secondary speed sensor generates the ON-OFF pulse (short waveform) in proportion to the rotating
    body speed which is “The higher the rotating body speed is, the faster the change cycle is”. The TCM judges
    the rotating speed from the changing cycle of this pulse signal.

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JSDIA1824GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-61

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Output Speed Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009019839

    • The output speed sensor is installed to the back side of transaxle case.
    • The output speed sensor detects final gear speed. TCM evaluates the vehicle speed from the final gear revolution.
    • The output speed sensor generates the ON-OFF pulse (short waveform) in proportion to the rotating body
    speed which is “The higher the rotating body speed is, the faster the change cycle is”. The TCM judges the
    rotating speed from the changing cycle of this pulse signal.

    JSDIA1824GB

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009019840

    • The CVT fluid temperature sensor is installed to control valve.
    • The CVT fluid temperature sensor detects CVT fluid temperature in oil pan.
    • The fluid temperature sensor uses a thermistor, and changes the signal voltage by converting changes in the
    CVT fluid temperature to a resistance value. TCM evaluates the CVT fluid temperature from the signal voltage value.

    JSDIA1825GB

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Secondary Pressure Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009019841

    • The secondary pressure sensor is installed to control valve.
    • The secondary pressure sensor detects the pressure applied to the secondary pulley.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-62

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • When pressure is applied to the ceramic device in the secondary pressure sensor, the ceramic device is
    deformed, resulting in voltage change. TCM evaluates the secondary pressure from its voltage change. Voltage is increased along with pressure increase.

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    JSDIA1831GB

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve

    INFOID:0000000009019842

    • The primary pressure solenoid valve is installed to control valve.
    • The primary pressure solenoid valve controls the primary pressure control valve. For information about the
    primary pressure control valve, refer to TM-70, «TRANSAXLE : Component Description».
    • The primary pressure solenoid valve uses the linear solenoid valve [N/H (normal high) type].
    NOTE:
    • The principle of the linear solenoid valve utilizes the fact that the force pressing on the valve spool installed
    inside the coil increases nearly in proportion to the current. This allows it to produce a fluid pressure that is
    proportional to this pressing force.
    • The N/H (normal high) produces hydraulic control when the coil is not energized.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Low Brake Solenoid Valve

    INFOID:0000000009019843

    • The low brake solenoid valve is installed to control valve.
    • The low brake solenoid valve adjusts the tightening pressure of the low brake.
    • The low brake solenoid valve uses the linear solenoid valve [N/L (normal low) type].
    NOTE:
    • The principle of the linear solenoid valve utilizes the fact that the force pressing on the valve spool installed
    inside the coil increases nearly in proportion to the current. This allows it to produce a fluid pressure that is
    proportional to this pressing force.
    • The N/L (normal low) type does not produce hydraulic control when the coil is not energized.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : High Clutch & Reverse Brake Solenoid Valve

    INFOID:0000000009019844

    • The high clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve is installed to control valve.
    • The high clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve adjusts the tightening pressure of the high clutch and reverse
    brake.
    • The high clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve uses the linear solenoid valve [N/H (normal high) type].
    NOTE:
    • The principle of the linear solenoid valve utilizes the fact that the force pressing on the valve spool installed
    inside the coil increases nearly in proportion to the current. This allows it to produce a fluid pressure that is
    proportional to this pressing force.
    • The N/H (normal high) produces hydraulic control when the coil is not energized.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve

    INFOID:0000000009019845

    • The torque converter clutch solenoid valve is installed to control valve.
    • The torque converter clutch solenoid valve controls the torque converter clutch control valve. For information
    about the torque converter clutch control valve, refer to TM-70, «TRANSAXLE : Component Description».
    • The torque converter clutch solenoid valve utilizes a linear solenoid valve [N/L (normal low) type].
    NOTE:
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-63

    F

    2014 Note

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • The principle of the linear solenoid valve utilizes the fact that the force pressing on the valve spool installed
    inside the coil increases nearly in proportion to the current. This allows it to produce a fluid pressure that is
    proportional to this pressing force.
    • The N/L (normal low) type does not produce hydraulic control when the coil is not energized.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Line Pressure Solenoid Valve

    INFOID:0000000009019846

    • The line pressure solenoid valve is installed to control valve.
    • The line pressure solenoid valve controls the pressure regulator valve. For information about the pressure
    regulator valve, refer to TM-70, «TRANSAXLE : Component Description».
    • The line pressure solenoid valve uses the linear solenoid valve [N/H (normal high) type].
    NOTE:
    • The principle of the linear solenoid valve utilizes the fact that the force pressing on the valve spool installed
    inside the coil increases nearly in proportion to the current. This allows it to produce a fluid pressure that is
    proportional to this pressing force.
    • The N/H (normal high) produces hydraulic control when the coil is not energized.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : G Sensor

    INFOID:0000000009019847

    • G sensor is installed to floor under instrument lower cover.
    • G sensor detects front/rear G and inclination applied to the vehicle.
    • G sensor converts front/rear G and inclination applied to the vehicle to voltage signal. TCM evaluates front/
    rear G and inclination angle of the vehicle from the voltage signal.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Overdrive Control Switch

    INFOID:0000000009019848

    • The overdrive control switch is installed to the selector lever knob.
    • When the OD OFF indicator lamp on the combination meter is OFF and the overdrive control switch is
    pressed, the overdrive is cancelled and the OD OFF indicator lamp is ON.
    • When the OD OFF indicator lamp on the combination meter is ON and the overdrive control switch is
    pressed, the overdrive is active and the OD OFF indicator lamp is OFF.

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : OD OFF Indicator Lamp

    INFOID:0000000009019849

    DESIGN/PURPOSE
    The O/D OFF indicator notifies the driver that the shift control of
    transmaxle is in O/D OFF.

    JPNIA1891ZZ

    BULB CHECK
    Approximately 2 seconds after ignition switch ON.

    OPERATION AT COMBNATION METER CNA COMMUNICATION CUT-OFF OR UNUSUAL SIGNAL
    For actions on CAN communications blackout in the combnation meter, refer to MWI-19, «Fail-safe».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-64

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    A

    B

    C
    JSDIA3606GB

    TM

    SIGNAL PATH
    • When a overdrive control switch signal is input to the combination meter, the combination meter transmits
    the overdrive control switch signal to the TCM via CAN communication.
    • When all of the following conditions are satisfied, the TCM transmits a O/D OFF indicator signal to the combination meter via CAN communication. The combination meter turns ON the O/D OFF indicator lamp on the
    combination meter, according to the signal.
    — TCM receives overdrive control switch signal via CAN communication from combination meter.
    — Selector lever: D position

    E

    F

    LIGHTING CONDITION
    When all of the following conditions are satisfied.
    • Ignition switch: ON
    • Selector lever: D position
    • Overdrive control switch is pressed when the O/D OFF indicator lamp is OFF.

    G

    H

    SHUTOFF CONDITION
    When any of the conditions listed below is satisfied.
    • Ignition switch: Other than ON
    • Overdrive control switch is pressed when the O/D OFF indicator lamp is ON.
    • Selector lever is shifted to other than D position when the O/D OFF indicator lamp is ON.

    I

    TIMING CHART

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N
    JSDIA3607GB

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Shift Position Indicator

    INFOID:0000000009019850

    TCM transmits shift position signal to combination meter via CAN communication. The actual shift position is
    displayed on combination meter according to the signal.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-65

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    COMPONENT PARTS
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)

    INFOID:0000000009019851

    The malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is located on the combination
    meter.
    The MIL will illuminate when the ignition switch is turned ON without
    the engine running. This is a bulb check.
    When the engine is started, the MIL should turn off. If the MIL
    remains illuminated, the on board diagnostic system has detected an
    engine system malfunction.
    For details, refer to EC-24, «WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS
    : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)».
    JSBIA1315ZZ

    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM : Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009019852

    ALDIA0267ZZ

    1.

    Stop lamp switch

    4.

    Shift lock solenoid

    2.

    Shift lock release lever

    3.

    Park position switch

    COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
    Component

    Function

    Stop lamp switch

    Stop lamp switch turns ON when brake pedal is depressed.

    Shift lock release lever

    Manually releases the shift lock.

    Park position switch

    Detects that the selector lever is in “P” position.

    Shift lock solenoid

    Operates according to the signal from the stop lamp switch and moves the lock lever.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-66

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION

    A

    TRANSAXLE
    TRANSAXLE : Cross-Sectional View

    INFOID:0000000009019853

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    JSDIA1777ZZ

    1.

    Converter housing

    2.

    Oil pump

    3.

    Counter drive gear

    4.

    Control valve

    5.

    Oil pan

    6.

    Primary pulley

    7.

    Steel belt

    8.

    Secondary pulley

    9.

    Planetary gear (auxiliary gearbox)

    10.

    Side cover

    11.

    Transaxle case

    12.

    Differential case

    13.

    Final gear

    14.

    Reduction gear

    15.

    Counter driven gear

    16.

    Drive sprocket

    17.

    Oil pump chain

    18.

    Torque converter

    19.

    Driven sprocket

    TRANSAXLE : Transaxle Mechanism

    O

    P

    INFOID:0000000009019854

    BELT & PULLEY
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-67

    N

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    Mechanism
    It is composed of a pair of pulleys (the groove width is changed freely in the axial direction) and the steel belt
    (the steel plates are placed continuously and the belt is guided with the multilayer steel rings on both sides).
    The groove width changes according to wrapping radius of steel belt and pulley from low status to overdrive
    status continuously with non-step. It is controlled with the oil pressures of primary pulley and secondary pulley.
    Steel belt
    It is composed of multiple steel plates (A) and two steel rings (B)
    stacked to a several number. The feature of this steel belt transmits
    power with compression of the steel plate in contrast with transmission of power in pulling with a rubber belt. Friction force is required
    with the pulley slope to transmit power from the steel plate. The force
    is generated with the following mechanism:
    Oil pressure applies to the secondary pulley to nip the plate. ⇒The
    plate is pushed and extended outward. ⇒The steel ring shows withstands. ⇒Pulling force is generated on the steel ring. ⇒The plate of
    the primary pulley is nipped between the pulley. ⇒Friction force is
    generated between the steel belt and the pulley.
    JSDIA1966ZZ
    Therefore, responsibilities are divided by the steel plate that transmits the power with compression and the steel ring that maintains necessary friction force. In this way, the
    tension of the steel ring is distributed on the entire surface and stress variation is limited, resulting in good
    durability.
    Pulley
    The primary pulley (input shaft side) and the secondary pulley (output shaft side) have the shaft with slope
    (fixed cone surface), movable sheave (movable cone surface that can move in the axial direction) and oil pressure chamber at the back of the movable sheave.

    JSDIA1779GB

    Pulley gear shifting operation

    • Pulley gear shifting operation
    The movable sheave slides on the shaft to change the groove width of the pulley. Input signals of engine
    load (accelerator pedal opening), engine revolution and gear ratio (vehicle speed) change the operation
    pressures of the primary pulley and the secondary pulley, and controls the pulley groove width. Along with
    change of the pulley groove width, the belt contact radius is changed. This allows continuous and stepless

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-68

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    gear shifting from low to overdrive. “The contact radius ratio of each pulley in contact with the belt x auxiliary
    gearbox gear ratio” is the gear ratio.

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F
    JSDIA2573GB

    AUXILIARY GEARBOX MECHANISM

    G

    1st, 2nd and reverse gears are changed with the planetary gear mechanism.

    TRANSAXLE : Operation Status

    INFOID:0000000009019855

    ×: Engaged or applied.

    Slector lever position

    Parking
    mechanism

    Counter
    gear set

    P

    ×

    ×

    Low brake

    High clutch

    Reverse
    brake

    ×

    Primary
    pulley

    Secondary
    pulley

    Steel belt

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Reduction
    gear set

    R

    ×

    ×

    N

    ×

    D

    ×

    × (1GR)

    × (2GR)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    L

    ×

    × (1GR)

    × (2GR)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-69

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    TRANSAXLE : Oil Pressure System

    INFOID:0000000009019856

    Oil pressure required for operation of the transaxle transmission mechanism is generated by oil pump, oil
    pressure control valve, solenoid valve, etc.

    JSDIA1826GB

    TRANSAXLE : Component Description

    INFOID:0000000009019857

    Part name

    Function

    Torque converter

    It is composed of the cover converter, turbine assembly, stator, pump impeller assembly, etc. It increases the engine torque and transmits the power to the transaxle.

    Oil pump

    Through the oil pump drive chain, it uses the vane oil pump driven by the engine. It generates necessary oil pressure to circulate fluid and to operate the clutch and brake.

    Counter gear set

    The power from the torque converter is transmitted to the primary pulley through the
    counter drive gear and the counter driven gear.

    Belt & pulley (Continuously variable transmission)

    It is composed of the primary pulley, secondary pulley, steel belt, etc. and the mechanism performs shifting, changes the gear ratio and transmits the power with oil pressure
    from the control valve.

    Auxiliary gearbox (stepped transmission)

    It is composed of the planetary gear, multi-disc clutch, multi-disc brake, etc. and the
    mechanism performs shifting (1-2 gear shifting and reverse) with oil pressure from the
    control valve.

    Reduction gear set

    Conveys power from the transmission mechanism to the reduction gear and the final
    gear.

    Parking mechanism

    When the shift lever is changed to P position, the mechanism fixes the parking gear (integrated with the reduction gear) and the fixes the output shaft.

    Control valve

    Controls oil pressure from the oil pump to the pressure suitable for the line pressure
    control system, shift control system, lock-up control system and lubrication system.

    Pressure regulator valve

    Adjusts the discharge pressure from the oil pump to the optimum pressure (line pressure) corresponding to the driving condition.

    Torque converter regulator valve

    Adjusts the feed pressure to the torque converter to the optimum pressure corresponding to the driving condition.

    Pilot valve

    Adjusts line pressure and produces a constant pressure (pilot pressure) necessary for
    activating each solenoid valve.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-70

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Part name

    Function

    Manual valve

    Distributes the clutch and brake operation pressures (pilot pressure) corresponding to
    each shift position.

    High clutch/reverse brake switching valve

    Switches the circuit for the high clutch and the reverse brake.

    Torque converter clutch control valve

    It is operated with the torque converter clutch solenoid valve and it adjusts the tightening pressure and non-tightening pressure of the torque converter clutch piston of the
    torque converter.

    Primary pressure control valve

    It is operated with the primary pressure solenoid valve and adjusts the feed pressure to
    the primary pulley.

    Primary pressure solenoid valve

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve»

    Low brake solenoid valve

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Low Brake Solenoid Valve»

    High clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : High Clutch & Reverse Brake Solenoid Valve»

    Torque converter clutch solenoid valve

    TM-63, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve»

    Line pressure solenoid valve

    E

    TM-64, «CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Line Pressure Solenoid Valve»

    FLUID COOLER & FLUID WARMER SYSTEM
    FLUID COOLER & FLUID WARMER SYSTEM : System Description

    F
    INFOID:0000000009019858

    CVT FLUID COOLER SCHEMATIC

    G

    CVT fluid cooler air-cooling type
    H

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSDIA4497GB

    CVT fluid cooler water-cooling type
    M

    N

    O

    P

    JSDIA2943GB

    COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
    CVT Oil Warmer

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-71

    2014 Note

    STRUCTURE AND OPERATION
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • The CVT oil warmer (1) is installed on the front part of transaxle
    assembly.
    • When engine is started while engine and CVT are cold, engine
    coolant temperature rises more quickly than CVT fluid temperature. CVT oil warmer is provided with two circuits for CVT and
    engine coolant respectively so that warmed engine coolant warms
    CVT quickly. This helps shorten CVT warming up time, improving
    fuel economy.
    • A cooling effect is obtained when CVT fluid temperature is high.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    JSDIA2586ZZ

    CVT Fluid Cooler (Water-cooling)
    • The CVT fluid cooler (water-cooling) is installed in the radiator side tank (right side).
    • CVT fluid is cooled by engine coolant.
    CVT Fluid Cooler (Air-cooling)
    • The CVT fluid cooler (air-cooling) is installed to vehicle front.
    • The CVT fluid cooler (air-cooling) prevents CVT fluid temperature from an abnormal increase while driving
    the vehicle. When flowing into the CVT fluid cooler (air-cooling), CVT fluid is cooled by driving blast while
    driving the vehicle.
    Heater Thermostat
    • The heater thermostat (1) is installed on the front part of transaxle
    assembly.
    • The heater thermostat open and close with set temperature.

    JSDIA2585ZZ

    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009019868

    The selector lever cannot be shifted from “P” position to any other position unless the ignition switch is in the
    ON position and the brake pedal is depressed.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-72

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009019859

    B

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    JSDIA2803GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-73

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL TABLE
    Sensor (or signal)
    • Engine and CVT integrated control
    signal
    • Engine speed signal
    • Accelerator pedal position signal
    • Closed throttle position signal
    • Stop lamp switch signal
    • Secondary pressure sensor
    • CVT fluid temperature sensor
    • Primary speed sensor
    • Secondary speed sensor
    • Output speed sensor
    • Transmission range switch signal
    • Overdrive control switch signal
    • Vehicle speed signal (ABS)
    • ABS operation signal
    • A/C compressor feedback signal
    • G sensor
    • N idle instruction signal
    • Turn indicator signal

    TCM function

    Actuator

    • Line pressure control (TM-81, «LINE
    PRESSURE CONTROL : System Description»)
    • Shift control (TM-82, «SHIFT CONTROL :
    System Description»)
    • Select control (TM-84, «SELECT CONTROL : System Description»)
    • Lock-up control (TM-85, «LOCK-UP CONTROL : System Description»)
    • Idle neutral control (TM-86, «IDLE NEUTRAL CONTROL : System Description»)
    • Fail-safe mode (TM-107, «Fail-safe»)
    • Self-diagnosis function (TM-92, «CONSULT Function»)
    • Communication function with CONSULT
    (TM-92, «CONSULT Function»)
    • CAN communication control (TM-139,
    «Description»)

    • Line pressure solenoid valve
    • Primary pressure solenoid valve
    • Torque converter clutch solenoid
    valve
    • High clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve
    • Low brake solenoid valve
    • OD OFF indicator lamp
    • Shift position indicator

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    • CVT detects the vehicle driving status from switches, sensors and signals, and controls the vehicle so that
    the optimum shift position and shift timing may always be achieved. It also controls the vehicle to reduce
    shift and lockup shock, etc.
    • Receives input signals from switches and sensors.
    • Sends the output signal necessary for operation of solenoid valves, and evaluates the line pressure, shift
    timing, lockup operation, engine brake performance, etc.
    • If a malfunction occurs on the electric system, activate the fail-safe mode only to drive the vehicle.

    LIST OF CONTROL ITEMS AND INPUT/OUTPUT
    Shift control

    Line pressure
    control

    Select control

    Lock-up control

    Fail-safe function *

    Engine torque signal
    (CAN communication)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Engine speed signal
    (CAN communication)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Accelerator pedal position signal
    (CAN communication)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Closed throttle position signal
    (CAN communication)

    ×

    ×

    Stop lamp switch signal
    (CAN communication)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Secondary pressure sensor

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Primary speed sensor

    ×

    ×

    Secondary speed sensor

    ×

    ×

    Output speed sensor

    ×

    Transmission range switch

    ×

    Overdrive control switch
    (CAN communication)

    ×

    Control Item

    Input

    CVT fluid temperature sensor

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-74

    ×
    ×
    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Shift control

    Line pressure
    control

    Select control

    Line pressure solenoid valve

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Primary pressure solenoid valve

    ×

    Control Item

    Fail-safe function *

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    Low brake solenoid valve

    ×

    ×

    ×

    OD OFF indicator lamp
    (CAN communication)

    B

    ×

    High clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve

    Shift position indicator
    (CAN communication)

    A

    ×
    ×

    Torque converter clutch solenoid
    valve
    Output

    Lock-up control

    C

    TM

    ×
    ×

    E

    ·*: If these input/output signals show errors, TCM activates the fail-safe function.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-75

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Schematic

    INFOID:0000000009019860

    JSDIA2911GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-76

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JSDIA2912GB

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Fail-safe

    K

    INFOID:0000000009019861

    TCM has a fail-safe mode. The mode functions so that operation can be continued even if the signal circuit of
    the main electronically controlled input/output parts is damaged.
    If the vehicle shows following behaviors including “poor acceleration”, a malfunction of the applicable system
    is detected by TCM and the vehicle may be in a fail-safe mode. At this time, check the DTC code and perform
    inspection and repair according to the malfunction diagnosis procedures.

    L

    M

    Fail-safe function
    DTC

    Vehicle behavior

    P062F

    Not changed from normal driving

    P0705

    • Shift position indicator on combination meter is not displayed.
    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    • Shift position indicator on combination meter is not displayed.
    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    P0706

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    Conditions of vehicle

    TM-77

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    DTC

    P0711

    P0712

    P0713

    Vehicle behavior

    Conditions of vehicle

    Acceleration is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. ≥
    10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: −35°C (−
    31°F) ≤Temp. < 10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. < −
    35°C (−31°F)

    Acceleration is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. ≥
    10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: −35°C (−
    31°F) ≤Temp. < 10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. < −
    35°C (−31°F)

    Acceleration is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. ≥
    10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: −35°C (−
    31°F) ≤Temp. < 10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. < −
    35°C (−31°F)

    P0715





    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Vehicle speed is not increased
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0720




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0740

    Lock-up is not performed

    P0743

    Lock-up is not performed

    P0744

    Lock-up is not performed

    P0746





    P0846

    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow

    P0847

    Acceleration is slow

    P0848

    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow

    P0863

    Not changed from normal driving

    P0890




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0962




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0963




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Vehicle speed is not increased
    Lock-up is not performed

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-78

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    DTC

    Vehicle behavior

    Conditions of vehicle




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0967




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0998

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    P0965

    P0966

    P0999

    P099B

    P099C

    B

    C

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Wire disconnection

    • Vehicle speed is not increased
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Voltage shorting

    Start is slow

    TM

    E

    F

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Wire disconnection

    • Vehicle speed is not increased
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Voltage shorting

    G

    H

    P1586

    Idle neutral control is not performed

    P1588

    Idle neutral control is not performed

    P2765





    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Vehicle speed is not increased
    Lock-up is not performed

    I

    J

    P2857

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    P2858

    • Vehicle speed is not increased
    • Lock-up is not performed

    K

    P2859

    Vehicle speed is not increased

    P285A

    Start is slow

    U0073




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    U0100




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    U0140

    Not changed from normal driving

    U0141

    Not changed from normal driving

    U0155

    Not changed from normal driving

    U0300




    U1000

    Not changed from normal driving

    U1114

    Not changed from normal driving

    U1117

    Not changed from normal driving

    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    Revision: April 2013

    A

    TM-79

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM : Protection Control

    INFOID:0000000009019862

    The TCM becomes the protection control status temporarily to protect the safety when the safety of TCM and
    transmission is lost. It automatically returns to the normal status if the safety is secured.
    The TCM has the following protection control.

    CONTROL FOR WHEEL SPIN
    Control

    When a wheel spin is detected, the engine output and gear ratio are limited and the line pressure is increased.
    At the 1GR, the clutch pressure is increased.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    If the accelerator is kept depressing during wheel spin, the engine revolution and vehicle speed are limited to
    a certain degree. From the 1GR, upshift to a certain gear ratio is only allowed.

    Normal return condition

    Wheel spin convergence returns the control to the normal control.

    CONTROL WHEN FLUID TEMPERATURE IS HIGH
    Control

    When the CVT fluid temperature is high, the gear shift permission maximum revolution and the maximum
    torque are reduced than usual to prevent increase of the oil temperature.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    Power performance may be lowered, compared to normal control.

    Normal return condition

    The control returns to the normal control when CVT fluid temperature is lowered.

    TORQUE IS REDUCED WHEN DRIVING WITH THE REVERSE GEAR
    Control

    Engine output is controlled according to a vehicle speed while reversing the vehicle.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    Power performance may be lowered while reversing the vehicle.

    Normal return condition

    Torque returns to normal by positioning the selector lever in a range other than “R” position.

    REVERSE PROHIBIT CONTROL
    Control

    The reverse brake is controlled to avoid becoming engaged when the selector lever is set in “R” position while
    driving in forward direction at more than the specified speed.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    If the selector lever is put at “R” position when driving with the forward gear, the gear becomes neutral, not
    reverse.

    Normal return condition

    The control returns to normal control when the vehicle is driven at low speeds. (The reverse brake becomes
    engaged.)

    LINE PRESSURE CONTROL

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-80

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    LINE PRESSURE CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009019863

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    JSDIA1864GB

    J

    DESCRIPTION
    Highly accurate line pressure control (secondary pressure control) reduces friction for improvement of fuel
    economy.

    K

    Normal Oil Pressure Control
    Appropriate line pressure and secondary pressure suitable for driving condition are determined based on the
    accelerator pedal position, engine speed, primary pulley (input) speed, secondary pulley (output) speed, vehicle speed, input torque, stop lamp switch signal, transmission range switch signal, lock-up signal, power voltage, target shift ratio, oil temperature and oil pressure.

    L

    Secondary Pressure Feedback Control
    In normal oil pressure control and oil pressure control in shifting, highly accurate secondary pressure is determined by detecting the secondary pressure using a oil pressure sensor and by feedback control.

    SHIFT CONTROL

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-81

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SHIFT CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009019864

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSDIA2632GB

    DESCRIPTION
    To select the gear ratio that can give the driving force to meet driver’s intent or vehicle situation, the vehicle
    driving condition such as vehicle speed or accelerator pedal position is detected and the most appropriate
    gear ratio is selected and the shifting method before reaching the speed is determined. The information is
    output to the primary pressure solenoid valve to control the line pressure input/output to the primary pulley, to
    determine the primary pulley (movable pulley) position and to control the gear position.
    D Position (Normal)

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-82

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Gear shifting is performed in all shifting ranges from the lowest to the
    highest gear ratio.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    A

    B

    C
    SCIA1953E

    TM

    D Position (OD OFF)
    The gear ratio is generally high by limiting the shifting range on the
    high side, and this always generates a large driving power.

    E

    F

    G
    SCIA8229E

    L Position
    By limiting the shifting range only to the lowest of the gear ratio, a
    large driving force and engine brake are obtained.

    H

    I

    J

    K
    SCIA8240E

    Hill Climbing And Descending Control
    If a downhill is detected with the accelerator pedal is released, the system performs downshift to increase the
    engine brake force so that vehicle may not be accelerated more than necessary. If a climbing hill is detected,
    the system improves the acceleration performance in re-acceleration by limiting the gear shift range on the
    high side.
    NOTE:
    For engine brake control on a downhill, the control can be stopped with CONSULT.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P
    JSDIA2060GB

    Control In Acceleration
    From change of the vehicle speed or accelerator pedal position, the acceleration request level of the driver or
    driving scene is evaluated. In start or acceleration during driving, the gear shift characteristics with linearity of
    revolution increase and vehicle speed increase are gained to improve the acceleration feel.

    SELECT CONTROL
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-83

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SELECT CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009019865

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSDIA1862GB

    DESCRIPTION
    Based on accelerator pedal angle, engine speed, primary pulley speed, and the secondary pulley speed, the
    optimum operating pressure is set to reduce impact of a selector lever operation while shifting from “N” (“P”) to
    “D” (“R”) position.

    LOCK-UP CONTROL

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-84

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    LOCK-UP CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009019866

    A

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM
    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    JSDIA1865GB

    J

    DESCRIPTION
    • Controls for improvement of the transmission efficiency by engaging the torque converter clutch in the
    torque converter and eliminating slip of the converter. Achieves comfortable driving with slip control of the
    torque converter clutch.
    • The oil pressure feed circuit for the torque converter clutch piston chamber is connected to the torque converter clutch control valve. The torque converter clutch control valve is switched by the torque converter
    clutch solenoid valve with the signal from TCM. This controls the oil pressure circuit, which is supplied to the
    torque converter clutch piston chamber, to the release side or engagement side.
    • If the CVT fluid temperature is low or the vehicle is in fail-safe mode due to malfunction, lock-up control is
    prohibited.
    Lock-up engagement
    In lock-up engagement, the torque converter clutch solenoid valve makes the torque converter clutch control
    valve locked up to generate the lock-up apply pressure. This pushes the torque converter clutch piston for
    engagement.
    Lock-up release condition
    In lock-up release, the torque converter clutch solenoid valve makes the torque converter clutch control valve
    non-locked up to drain the lock-up apply pressure. This does not engage the torque converter clutch piston.

    IDLE NEUTRAL CONTROL

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    TM-85

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    IDLE NEUTRAL CONTROL : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009019867

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    JSDIA2535GB

    DESCRIPTION
    If a driver has no intention of starting the vehicle in D position, TCM operates the low brake solenoid valve and
    controls the oil pressure of the low brake to be low pressure. Therefore, the low brake is in the release (slip)
    status and the power transmission route of transaxle is the same status as the N position. In this way, the transaxle is in idling status and load to the engine can be reduced to improve fuel economy.
    NOTE:

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-86

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Provides idle neutral control when stop/start operation is not performed.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    JPDIA1215GB

    Idle Neutral Control Start Condition
    Idle neutral control is started when all of the following conditions are fulfilled. However, during idle neutral control, idle neutral control is stopped when any of the following conditions is not met or idle neutral control continues 30 seconds.
    Driving environment

    : Flat road or road with mild gradient

    Selector lever position

    : “D” position

    Vehicle speed

    : 0 km/h (0 MPH)

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.0/8

    Brake pedal

    : Depressed

    L

    M

    N

    Engine speed

    : Idle speed

    Turn signal lamp/hazard signal lamp

    : Not activated

    O

    NOTE:
    Stops or prohibits the idle neutral control when the TCM and ECM detect that the vehicle is in one of the following conditions.
    • Engine coolant temperature and CVT fluid temperature are the specified temperature or more, or the specified temperature or less.
    • When a transaxle malfunction occurs.
    • When the vehicle detects DTC and is in the fail-safe mode.
    Idle Neutral Control Resume Condition

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    TM-87

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    When the idle neutral control finishes, if the vehicle is driven at more than the specified speed and the idle
    neutral control start conditions are satisfied, the idle neutral control starts again. If the vehicle has a malfunction, the idle neutral control does not start.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-88

    2014 Note

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019870

    This is an on board diagnosis system which records diagnosis information related to the exhaust gases. It
    detects malfunctions related to sensors and actuators. The malfunctions are indicated by means of the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) and are stored as DTC in the ECU memory. The diagnosis information can be
    checked using a diagnosis tool (GST: Generic Scan Tool).

    Function of OBD

    B

    C

    INFOID:0000000009019871

    The GST is connected to the diagnosis connector on the vehicle and communicates with the on-board control
    units to perform diagnosis. The diagnosis connector is the same as for CONSULT. Refer to GI-49, «Descrip- TM
    tion».
    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-89

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION
    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : 1 Trip Detection Diagnosis and 2 Trip Detection Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009019872

    NOTE:
    “Start the engine and turn OFF the ignition switch after warm-up.” This is defined as 1 trip.

    1 TRIP DETECTION DIAGNOSIS
    When initial malfunction is detected, TCM memorizes DTC. In these diagnoses, some illuminate MIL and
    some do not. Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index».

    2 TRIP DETECTION DIAGNOSIS
    When initial malfunction is detected, TCM memorizes DTC of the 1st trip. MIL does not light at this stage. <1
    trip>
    If the same malfunction is detected again in next driving, TCM memorizes DTC. When DTC is memorized, MIL
    lights. <2 trip>
    “Trip” of the “2 trip detection diagnosis” indicates the driving mode that executes self-diagnosis during driving.
    ×: Check possible

    DTC at the 1st trip
    Item

    DTC

    —: Check not possible

    MIL

    Display at the
    1st trip

    Display at the
    2nd trip

    Display at the
    1st trip

    Display at the
    2nd trip

    Illumination at
    the 1st trip

    Illumination at
    the 2nd trip

    1 trip detection diagnosis
    (Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index»)

    ×

    ×

    2 trip detection diagnosis
    (Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index»)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : DTC and DTC of 1st Trip

    INFOID:0000000009019873

    2 TRIP DETECTION DIAGNOSIS THAT ILLUMINATES MIL
    • The DTC number of the 1st trip is the same as the DTC number.
    • When a malfunction is detected at the 1st trip, TCM memorizes DTC of the 1st trip. MIL does not light at this
    stage. If the same malfunction is not detected at the 2nd trip (conforming to necessary driving conditions),
    DTC at the 1st trip is erased from TCM. If the same malfunction is detected at the 2nd trip, TCM memorizes
    DTC and MIL lights at the same time.
    • The DTC of the 1st trip is specified in Service $01 of SAE J1979/ISO 15031-5. Since detection of DTC at the
    1st trip does not illuminate MIL, warning for a problem is not given to a driver.
    • For procedure to delete DTC and 1st trip DTC from TCM, refer to TM-92, «CONSULT Function».
    • If DTC of the 1st trip is detected, it is necessary to check the cause according to the “Diagnosis flow”. Refer
    to TM-123, «Flowchart of Trouble Diagnosis».

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)

    INFOID:0000000009019874

    • TCM not only detects DTC, but also sends the MIL signal to ECM through CAN communication. ECM sends
    the MIL signal to the combination meter through CAN communication according to the signal, and illuminates MIL.
    • For malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) description, refer to EC-24, «WARNING LAMPS/INDICATOR LAMPS :
    Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)».

    DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Counter System

    INFOID:0000000009019875

    RELATION BETWEEN DTC AT 1ST TRIP/DTC/MIL AND DRIVING CONDITIONS (FOR 2 TRIP DETECTION DIAGNOSIS THAT ILLUMINATES MIL)



    When initial malfunction is detected, TCM memorizes DTC of the 1st trip. MIL does not light at this stage.
    If the same malfunction is detected at the 2nd trip, TCM memorizes DTC and MIL lights at the same time.
    Then, MIL goes after driving the vehicle for 3 trips under “Driving condition B” without malfunction.
    DTC is displayed until 40 trips of “Driving condition A” are satisfied without detecting the same malfunction.
    DTC is erased when 40 trips are satisfied.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-90

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • When the self-diagnosis result is acceptable at the 2nd trip (conforming to driving condition B), DTC of the
    1st trip is erased.

    A

    COUNTER SYSTEM LIST
    Item

    Driving condition

    Trip

    MIL (OFF)

    B

    3

    DTC (clear)

    A

    40

    DTC at 1st trip (clear)

    B

    1

    B

    C

    DRIVING CONDITION

    TM

    Driving condition A
    Driving condition A is the driving condition that provides warm-up.
    In specific, count-up is performed when all of the following conditions are satisfied.
    • Engine speed is 400 rpm or more.
    • After start of the engine, the water temperature increased by 20 °C (36 °F) or more.
    • Water temperature was 70 °C (158 °F) or more.
    • The ignition switch was changed from ON to OFF.
    NOTE:
    • If the same malfunction is detected regardless of the driving condition, reset the A counter.
    • When the above is satisfied without detecting the same malfunction, count up the A counter.
    • When MIL goes off due to the malfunction and the A counter reaches 40, the DTC is erased.

    E

    F

    G

    Driving condition B
    Driving condition B is the driving condition that performs all diagnoses once.
    In specific, count-up is performed when all of the following conditions are satisfied.
    • Engine speed is 400 rpm or more.
    • Water temperature was 70 °C (158 °F) or more.
    • In closed loop control, vehicle speed of 70 – 120 km/h (43 – 75 MPH) continued for 60 seconds or more.
    • In closed loop control, vehicle speed of 30 – 60 km/h (19 – 37 MPH) continued for 10 seconds or more.
    • In closed loop control, vehicle speed of 4 km/h (2 MPH) or less and idle determination ON continued for 12
    seconds or more.
    • After start of the engine, 22 minutes or more have passed.
    • The condition that the vehicle speed is 10km/h (6 MPH) or more continued for 10 seconds or more in total.
    • The ignition switch was changed from ON to OFF.
    NOTE:
    • If the same malfunction is detected regardless of the driving condition, reset the B counter.
    • When the above is satisfied without detecting the same malfunction, count up the B counter.
    • When the B counter reaches 3 without malfunction, MIL goes off.
    • When the B counter is counted once without detecting the same malfunction after TCM memorizes DTC of
    the 1st trip, DTC of the 1st trip is erased.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-91

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    TIME CHART

    JSDIA1868GB

    CONSULT Function

    INFOID:0000000009019876

    APPLICATION ITEMS
    Conditions

    Function

    Work Support

    This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately.

    Self Diagnostic Results

    Retrieve DTC from ECU and display diagnostic items.

    Data Monitor

    Monitor the input/output signal of the control unit in real time.

    CAN Diagnosis

    This mode displays a network diagnosis result about CAN by a diagram.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-92

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Conditions

    Function

    A

    CAN Diagnosis Support Monitor

    It monitors the status of CAN communication.

    ECU Identification

    Display the ECU identification number (part number etc.) of the selected system.

    CALIB DATA

    The calibration data status of TCM can be checked.

    B

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS
    C

    Display Item List
    Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index».

    DTC at 1st trip and method to read DTC
    TM
    • DTC (P0705, P0711, P0720, etc.) is specified by SAE J2012/ISO 15031-6.
    • DTC and DTC at 1st trip are displayed on “Self Diagnostic results” of CONSULT.
    When DTC is currently detected, “CRNT” is displayed. If “PAST” is displayed, it shows a malfunction
    occurred in the past.The trip number of drive without malfunction of concerned DTC can be confirmed with E
    “IGN counter” inside “FFD”.
    • When the DTC at the 1st trip is detected, the “timing” is displayed as “1t”.
    F
    DTC deletion method
    NOTE:
    • If the battery terminal is disconnected, the TCM memory is erased. (The disconnection time varies from several seconds to several hours.
    G
    • If the ignition switch is left ON after repair, turn OFF the ignition switch and wait for 10 seconds or more.
    Then, turn the ignition ON again. (Engine stop)
    1. Touch “TRANSMISSION” of CONSULT.
    H
    2. Touch “Self Diagnostic Result”.
    3. Touch “Erase”. (DTC memorized in TCM is erased.)
    IGN counter
    The ignition counter is displayed in “FFD” and the number of times of satisfied “Driving condition A” is displayed after normal recovery of DTC. Refer to TM-90, «DIAGNOSIS DESCRIPTION : Counter System».
    • If malfunction (DTC) is currently detected, “0” is displayed.
    • After normal recovery, every time “Driving condition A” is satisfied, the display value increases from 1 → 2 →
    3…38 → 39.
    • When MIL turns OFF due to the malfunction and the counter reaches 40, the DTC is erased.
    NOTE:
    The counter display of “40” cannot be checked.

    I

    J

    K

    DATA MONITOR
    NOTE:
    The following table includes information (items) inapplicable to this vehicle. For information (items) applicable
    to this vehicle, refer to CONSULT display items.
    ×: Application

    : Optional selection

    L

    M

    Monitor item selection
    Monitored item

    VSP SENSOR

    (Unit)

    (km/h or mph)

    MAIN SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT SIGNALS

    Remarks

    N

    ×

    Displays the vehicle speed calculated from the CVT output shaft speed.

    ESTM VSP SIG

    (km/h or mph)

    ×

    Displays the vehicle speed signal (ABS) received
    through CAN communication.

    PRI SPEED SEN

    (rpm)

    ×

    Displays the primary pulley speed calculated from the
    pulse signal of the primary speed sensor.

    SEC REV SENSOR

    (rpm)

    ×

    Displays the secondary pulley speed calculated from the
    pulse signal of the secondary speed sensor.

    VHCL/S SE (REV)

    (rpm)

    ×

    Displays the CVT output shaft speed calculated from the
    pulse signal of the output speed sensor.

    ENG SPEED SIG

    (rpm)

    ×

    Displays the engine speed received through CAN communication.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-93

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor item selection
    Monitored item

    (Unit)

    MAIN SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT SIGNALS

    Remarks

    LINE PRESSURE SEN

    (V)

    ×

    Displays the signal voltage of the line pressure sensor.

    ATF TEMP SEN

    (V)

    ×

    Displays the signal voltage of the CVT fluid temperature
    sensor.

    G SENSOR

    (V)

    ×

    Displays the signal voltage of the G sensor.

    VIGN SEN

    (V)

    ×

    Displays the battery voltage applied to TCM.

    VEHICLE SPEED

    (km/h or mph)

    INPUT REV

    (rpm)

    PRI SPEED

    (rpm)

    SEC SPEED

    (rpm)

    Displays the secondary pulley speed recognized by
    TCM.

    OUTPUT REV

    (rpm)

    Displays the output shaft speed of CVT recognized by
    TCM.

    ENG SPEED

    (rpm)

    ×

    Displays the engine speed recognized by TCM.

    SLIP REV

    (rpm)

    ×

    Displays the speed difference between the input shaft
    speed of CVT and the engine speed.

    TOTAL GEAR RATIO

    ×

    Displays the total CVT gear ratio calculated from input
    shaft speed/output shaft speed of CVT.

    PULLEY GEAR RATIO

    ×

    Displays the pulley gear ratio calculated from primary
    pulley speed/secondary pulley speed.

    ×

    Displays the vehicle speed recognized by TCM.
    Displays the input shaft speed of CVT recognized by
    TCM.

    ×

    Displays the primary pulley speed recognized by TCM.

    Displays the gear position of the auxiliary gearbox recognized by TCM.

    AUX GEARBOX

    Displays the acceleration and deceleration speed of the
    vehicle calculated from vehicle speed change.

    G SPEED

    (G)

    ACCEL POSI SEN 1

    (deg)

    ×

    VENG TRQ

    (Nm)

    ×

    PRI TRQ

    (Nm)

    ×

    Displays the estimated throttle position received through
    CAN communication.
    Display the engine torque recognized by TCM.
    Display the input shaft torque of CVT.

    TRQ RTO

    Display the torque ratio of torque converter.

    LINE PRESSURE

    (MPa)

    ×

    Displays the secondary pressure (line pressure) calculated from the signal voltage of the secondary pressure
    sensor.

    FLUID TEMP

    (°C or °F)

    ×

    Displays the CVT fluid temperature calculated from the
    signal voltage of the CVT fluid temperature sensor.

    DSR REV

    (rpm)

    Displays the target primary pulley speed calculated from
    processing of gear shift control.

    TRGT GEAR RATIO

    Displays the target gear ratio from the input shaft to the
    output shaft of CVT calculated from processing of gear
    shift control.

    TGT PLLY GR RATIO

    Displays the target gear ratio of the pulley from processing of gear shift control.

    TRGT AUX GEARBOX

    Displays the target gear of the auxiliary gearbox calculated from processing of gear shift control.

    LU PRS

    Revision: April 2013

    Displays the target oil pressure of the torque converter
    clutch solenoid valve calculated from oil pressure processing of gear shift control.

    (MPa)

    TM-94

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor item selection
    Monitored item

    (Unit)

    MAIN SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT SIGNALS

    A

    Remarks

    B

    LINE PRS

    (MPa)

    Displays the target oil pressure of the line pressure solenoid valve calculated from oil pressure processing of
    gear shift control.

    TRGT PRI PRESSURE

    (MPa)

    Displays the target oil pressure of the primary pressure
    solenoid valve calculated from oil pressure processing of
    gear shift control.

    C

    TRGT HC/RB PRESS

    (MPa)

    Displays the target oil pressure of the high clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve calculated from oil pressure
    processing of gear shift control.

    TM

    TRGT LB PRESSURE

    (MPa)

    Displays the target oil pressure of the low brake solenoid
    valve calculated from oil pressure processing of gear
    shift control.

    ISOLT1

    (A)

    ×

    Displays the command current from TCM to the torque
    converter clutch solenoid valve.

    ISOLT2

    (A)

    ×

    Displays the command current from TCM to the line
    pressure solenoid valve.

    PRI SOLENOID

    (A)

    ×

    Displays the command current from TCM to the primary
    pressure solenoid valve.

    HC/RB SOLENOID

    (A)

    ×

    Displays the command current from TCM to the high
    clutch& reverse brake solenoid valve.
    Displays the command current from TCM to the low
    brake solenoid valve.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    L/B SOLENOID

    (A)

    ×

    (A)

    ×

    ×

    Monitors the command current from TCM to the torque
    converter clutch solenoid valve and displays the monitored value.

    I

    SOLMON1

    SOLMON2

    (A)

    ×

    ×

    Monitors the command current from TCM to the line
    pressure solenoid valve and displays the monitored value.

    J

    PRI SOL MON

    (A)

    ×

    ×

    Monitors the command current from TCM to the primary
    pressure solenoid valve and displays the monitored value.

    HC/RB SOL MON

    (A)

    ×

    ×

    Monitors the command current from TCM to the high
    clutch& reverse brake solenoid valve and displays the
    monitored value.

    L/B SOL MON

    (A)

    ×

    ×

    Monitors the current command from TCM to the low
    brake solenoid valve and displays the monitored value.

    D POSITION SW

    (On/Off)

    ×

    Displays the operation status of the transmission range
    switch (D position).

    N POSITION SW

    (On/Off)

    ×

    Displays the operation status of the transmission range
    switch (N position).

    R POSITION SW

    (On/Off)

    ×

    Displays the operation status of the transmission range
    switch (R position).

    ×

    Displays the operation status of the transmission range
    switch (P position).

    ×

    Displays the reception status of the stop lamp switch signal received through CAN communication.

    ×

    Displays the operation status of the transmission range
    switch (L position).

    P POSITION SW

    (On/Off)

    BRAKESW

    (On/Off)

    L POSITION SW

    (On/Off)

    IDLE SW

    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Displays the reception status of the closed throttle position signal received through CAN communication.

    SPORT MODE SW

    (On/Off)

    ×

    ×

    Displays the reception status of the overdrive control
    switch signal received through CAN communication.

    Revision: April 2013

    ×

    TM-95

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor item selection
    Monitored item

    (Unit)

    MAIN SIGNALS

    ECU INPUT SIGNALS

    Remarks

    STRDWNSW

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays the operation status of the paddle shifter
    (down switch).
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    STRUPSW

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays the operation status of the paddle shifter (up
    switch).
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    DOWNLVR

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays the operation status of the selector lever
    (down switch).
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    UPLVR

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays the operation status of the selector lever (up
    switch).
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    NONMMODE

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays if the selector lever position is not at the manual shift gate.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    MMODE

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays if the selector lever position is at the manual
    shift gate.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    INDLRNG

    (On/Off)

    Displays the transmission status of the shift position (L
    position) signal transmitted through CAN communication.

    INDDRNG

    (On/Off)

    Displays the transmission status of the shift position (D
    position) signal transmitted through CAN communication.

    INGNRNG

    (On/Off)

    Displays the transmission status of the shift position (N
    position) signal transmitted through CAN communication.

    INGRRNG

    (On/Off)

    Displays the transmission status of the shift position (R
    position) signal transmitted through CAN communication.

    INGPRNG

    (On/Off)

    Displays the transmission status of the shift position (P
    position) signal transmitted through CAN communication.

    CVT LAMP

    (On/Off)

    Displays the transmission status of the OD OFF indicator
    lamp signal transmitted through CAN communication.

    SPORT MODE IND

    (On/Off)

    Displays the transmission status of the OD OFF indicator
    lamp signal transmitted through CAN communication.

    MMODE IND

    (On/Off)

    • Displays the transmission status of the manual mode
    signal transmitted through CAN communication.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    VDC ON

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays the reception status of the VDC (ESP) operation signal received through CAN communication.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    TCS ON

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays the reception status of the TCS operation signal received through CAN communication.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    ABS FAIL SIGNAL

    (On/Off)

    ×

    Displays the reception status of the ABS malfunction signal received through CAN communication.

    ABS ON

    (On/Off)

    ×

    Displays the reception status of the ABS operation signal
    received through CAN communication.

    4WD FAIL SIGNAL

    (On/Off)

    ×

    • Displays the reception status of the 4WD malfunction
    signal received through CAN communication.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-96

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Monitor item selection
    Monitored item

    (Unit)

    4WD OPERATION SIG

    4WD-TCS SIGNAL

    MAIN SIGNALS

    (On/Off)

    (On/Off)

    ECU INPUT SIGNALS

    A

    Remarks

    B

    ×

    • Displays the reception status of the 4WD operation
    signal received through CAN communication.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    C

    ×

    • Displays the reception status of the engine torque
    down request signal received through CAN communication.
    • It is displayed although not equipped.

    RANGE

    ×

    Displays the gear position recognized by TCM.

    M GEAR POS

    ×

    Display the target gear of manual mode

    G SEN SLOPE

    (%)

    Displays the gradient angle calculated from the G sensor
    signal voltage.

    ENGBRKLVL

    (On/Off)

    Displays the setting of “ENGINE BRAKE ADJ” in “Work
    Support”.

    PVIGN VOLT

    (V)

    ×

    E

    F

    Displays the backup voltage of TCM.
    Displays the target gear ratio of the auxiliary gearbox calculated from processing of gear shift control.

    TRGT AUX GR RATIO

    TM

    G SEN CALIBRATION

    (YET/DONE)

    Displays the status of “G SENSOR CALIBRATION” in
    “Work Support”.

    N IDLE STATUS

    (On/Off)

    Displays idle neutral status.

    CVT-B

    • Displays CVT fluid temperature count.
    • This monitor item does not use.

    CVT-A

    • Displays CVT fluid temperature count.
    • This monitor item does not use.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    WORK SUPPORT
    Item name

    Description

    ENGINE BRAKE ADJ.

    Although there is no malfunction on the transaxle and the CVT system, if a customer
    make a complaint like “I do not feel comfortable with automatic operation of the engine
    brake on downhill”, the engine brake may be cancelled with “engine brake adjustment”.

    CONFORM CVTF DETERIORTN

    Check the degradation level of the CVT fluid under severe conditions.

    G SENSOR CALIBRATION

    Compensate the G sensor.

    ERASE CALIBRATION DATA

    Erase the calibration data memorized by TCM.

    ERASE LEARNING VALUE

    Erase the learning value memorized by TCM.

    ERASE MEMORY DATA

    Perform “erasing of the calibration data” and “erasing of the learned value” at the same
    time.

    CLUTCH POINT LEARNING*

    Allow learning of the clutch engagement point of the auxiliary gearbox for TCM.

    K

    L

    M

    *: “Clutch point learning” can be selected, but do not use it.

    N

    O

    Engine brake adjustment
    ENGINE BRAKE LEVEL
    ON

    : Turn ON the engine brake control.

    OFF

    : Turn OFF the engine brake control.

    P

    Check the degradation level of the CVT fluid.
    CVTF degradation level data

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-97

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (TCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    210,000 or more

    : Replacement of the CVT fluid is required.

    Less than 210,000

    : Replacement of the CVT fluid is not required.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-98

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION

    A

    TCM
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009019877

    B

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR STANDARD VALUE
    • In CONSULT, electric shift timing or lock-up timing, i.e. operation timing of each solenoid valve, is displayed. C
    Therefore, if there is an obvious difference between the shift timing estimated from a shift shock (or engine
    speed variations) and that shown on the CONSULT, the mechanism parts (including the hydraulic circuit)
    excluding the solenoids and sensors may be malfunctioning. In this case, check the mechanical parts followTM
    ing the appropriate diagnosis procedure.
    • Shift point (gear position) displayed on CONSULT slightly differs from shift pattern described in Service Manual. This is due to the following reasons.
    — Actual shift pattern may vary slightly within specified tolerances.
    E
    — While shift pattern described in Service Manual indicates start of each shift, CONSULT shows gear position
    at end of shift.
    — The solenoid display (ON/OFF) on CONSULT is changed at the start of gear shifting. In contrast, the gear
    F
    position display is changed at the time when gear shifting calculated in the control unit is completed.
    NOTE:
    The following table includes information (items) inapplicable to this vehicle. For information (items) applicable
    to this vehicle, refer to CONSULT display items.
    G
    Monitor item

    Condition

    Value/Status (Approx.)

    VSP SENSOR

    While driving

    Almost same as the speedometer display.

    ESTM VSP SIG

    While driving

    Almost same as the speedometer display.

    PRI SPEED SEN

    In driving (lock-up ON)

    A value obtained from dividing engine
    speed by counter gear ratio

    Auxiliary gearbox: 1GR

    Approximately twice the “VHCL/S SE
    (REV)”

    Auxiliary gearbox: 2GR

    Almost same as the “VHCL/S SE (REV)”

    Auxiliary gearbox: 1GR

    Approximately half of the “SEC REV SENSOR”

    Auxiliary gearbox: 2GR

    Almost same as the “SEC REV SENSOR”

    ENG SPEED SIG

    Engine running

    Almost same reading as tachometer

    LINE PRESSURE SEN

    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    0.88 – 0.92 V

    CVT fluid: Approx. 20°C (68°F)

    2.01 – 2.05 V

    CVT fluid: Approx. 50°C (122°F)

    1.45 – 1.50 V

    CVT fluid: Approx. 80°C (176°F)

    0.90 – 0.94 V

    SEC REV SENSOR

    VHCL/S SE (REV)

    ATF TEMP SEN

    Vehicle is level
    Ignition switch: ON

    VEHICLE SPEED

    While driving

    Almost same as the speedometer display.

    INPUT REV

    In driving (lock-up ON)

    Almost same as the engine speed.

    PRI SPEED

    In driving (lock-up ON)

    A value obtained from dividing engine
    speed by counter gear ratio

    K

    2.5 V

    N

    10 – 16 V

    Auxiliary gearbox: 1GR

    Approximately twice the “OUTPUT REV”

    Auxiliary gearbox: 2GR

    Almost same as “OUTPUT REV”

    Auxiliary gearbox: 1GR

    Approximately half of “SEC SPEED”

    Auxiliary gearbox: 2GR

    Almost same as “SEC SPEED”

    ENG SPEED

    Engine running

    Almost same reading as tachometer

    SLIP REV

    While driving

    Engine speed − Input speed

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    M

    G SENSOR

    OUTPUT REV

    I

    L

    VIGN SEN

    SEC SPEED

    H

    TM-99

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor item
    TOTAL GEAR RATIO

    PULLEY GEAR RATIO

    AUX GEARBOX

    Condition
    Auxiliary gearbox: 1GR

    Counter gear ratio ×Pulley ratio Auxiliary
    gearbox gear ratio

    Auxiliary gearbox: 2GR

    Counter gear ratio ×Pulley ratio

    In driving (forward)

    2.20 − 0.55

    In driving (reverse)

    2.20

    Vehicle started with selector lever in “L” position

    1st

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more

    2nd

    In gear shifting of auxiliary gearbox
    Vehicle stopped
    G SPEED

    ACCEL POSI SEN 1

    Value/Status (Approx.)

    1st ⇔ 2nd
    0.00 G

    During acceleration

    The value changes to the positive side
    along with acceleration.

    During deceleration

    The value changes to the positive side
    along with deceleration.

    Accelerator pedal released

    0.00 deg

    Accelerator pedal fully depressed

    80.00 deg

    VENG TRQ

    While driving

    The value changes along with acceleration/
    deceleration.

    PRI TRQ

    While driving

    The value changes along with acceleration/
    deceleration.

    TRQ RTO

    While driving

    The value changes along with acceleration/
    deceleration.

    LINE PRESSURE

    Selector lever: “P” position

    FLUID TEMP

    Ignition switch ON.

    Displays the CVT fluid temperature.

    DSR REV

    While driving

    It varies along with the driving condition.

    TRGT GEAR RATIO

    While driving

    It varies along with the driving condition.

    TGT PLLY GR RATIO

    TRGT AUX GEARBOX

    In driving (forward)

    2.20 − 0.55

    In driving (reverse)

    2.20

    Vehicle started with selector lever in “L” position

    1st

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more

    2nd

    In gear shifting of auxiliary gearbox

    LU PRS

    LINE PRS

    TRGT PRI PRESSURE

    Revision: April 2013

    0.575 MPa

    Display gear position after gear shifting

    • Engine started
    • Vehicle is stopped.

    −0.500 MPa

    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more

    0.450 MPa

    • After engine warm up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    0.500 MPa

    • After engine warming up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • Depress the accelerator pedal fully

    4.930 – 5.430 MPa

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    0.325 MPa

    TM-100

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor item

    Condition
    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    TRGT HC/RB PRESS

    TRGT LB PRESSURE

    ISOLT1

    ISOLT2

    PRI SOLENOID

    HC/RB SOLENOID

    L/B SOLENOID

    SOLMON1

    SOLMON2

    PRI SOL MON

    Revision: April 2013

    Value/Status (Approx.)

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more

    0.400 MPa

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    0.325 MPa

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more

    B

    C

    TM
    0.000 MPa

    E

    • Engine started
    • Vehicle is stopped.

    0.000 A

    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more

    0.500 A

    F

    • After engine warm up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    0.800 – 0.900 A

    • After engine warming up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • Depress the accelerator pedal fully

    0.350 – 0.400 A

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    0.850 – 0.900 A

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    1.000 A

    G

    H

    I

    J

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more

    0.800 – 0.850 A

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    0.200 – 0.250 A

    K

    L

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more

    0.000 A

    • Engine started
    • Vehicle is stopped.

    0.000 A

    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more

    0.500 A

    M

    N

    O

    • After engine warm up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    0.800 – 0.900 A

    • After engine warming up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • Depress the accelerator pedal fully

    0.350 – 0.400 A

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    0.850 – 0.900 A

    TM-101

    A

    0.000 MPa

    P

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor item

    Condition
    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    HC/RB SOL MON

    L/B SOL MON

    D POSITION SW

    N POSITION SW

    R POSITION SW

    P POSITION SW

    BRAKESW

    L POSITION SW

    IDLE SW

    SPORT MODE SW

    Value/Status (Approx.)
    1.000 A

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more

    0.800 – 0.850 A

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    0.200 – 0.250 A

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more
    Selector lever: “D” position

    0.000 A

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “N” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “R” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “P” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Brake pedal is depressed

    On

    Brake pedal is released

    Off

    Selector lever: “L” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Accelerator pedal is released

    On

    Accelerator pedal is fully depressed

    Off

    Press the overdrive control switch

    On

    Release the overdrive control switch

    Off

    STRDWNSW

    Always

    Off

    STRUPSW

    Always

    Off

    DOWNLVR

    Always

    Off

    UPLVR

    Always

    Off

    NONMMODE

    Always

    Off

    MMODE

    Always

    Off

    Selector lever: “L” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “D” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “N” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “R” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “P” position

    On

    INDLRNG

    INDDRNG

    INDNRNG

    INDRRNG

    INDPRNG

    CVT LAMP

    Revision: April 2013

    Other than the above

    Off

    In overdrive OFF

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    TM-102

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor item
    SPORT MODE IND
    MMODE IND

    Condition

    Value/Status (Approx.)

    In overdrive OFF

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Always

    Off

    VDC ON

    Always

    Off

    TCS ON

    Always

    Off

    When ABS malfunction signal is received

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    ABS is activated

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    4WD FAIL SIGNAL

    Always

    Off

    4WD OPERATION SIG

    Always

    Off

    4WD-TCS SIGNAL

    Always

    Off

    Selector lever: “P” and “N” positions

    N/P

    ABS FAIL SIGNAL

    ABS ON

    RANGE

    M GEAR POS

    Selector lever: “R” position

    R

    Selector lever: “D” position (OD OFF indicator
    lamp OFF)

    D

    Selector lever: “D” position (OD OFF indicator
    lamp ON)

    S

    Selector lever: “L” position

    L

    Always

    1

    Flat road

    PVIGN VOLT

    G SEN CALIBRATION

    N IDLE STATUS

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    Uphill gradient

    The value changes to the positive side
    along with uphill gradient. (Maximum
    40.45%)

    Downhill gradient

    The value changes to the negative side
    along with downhill gradient. (Minimum −
    40.45%)

    When the engine brake level of “ENGINE
    BRAKE ADJ”. in “Work Support” is ON

    On

    When the engine brake level of “ENGINE
    BRAKE ADJ”. in “Work Support” is OFF

    Off

    Ignition switch: ON

    Release the accelerator pedal after the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or more
    When G sensor calibration is completed
    When G sensor calibration is not completed

    L

    M
    1.00

    N
    DONE
    YET

    When idle neutral control is operated

    On

    When idle neutral control is not operated

    Off

    CVT-A*

    O

    P

    *: These monitor items do not use.

    TERMINAL LAYOUT

    TM-103

    J

    1.80

    CVT-B*

    Revision: April 2013

    I

    K

    10 – 16 V

    Vehicle started with selector lever in “L” position
    TRGT AUX GR RATIO

    B

    0%

    G SEN SLOPE

    ENGBRKLVL

    A

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    JSDIA2713ZZ

    INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL STANDARD
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)

    Description

    +

    2
    (R/B)

    Ground

    L range switch

    Input

    4
    (W/B)

    Ground

    D range switch

    Input

    Signal

    5
    (L/B)

    Ground

    N range switch

    Input

    6
    (O)

    Ground

    R range switch

    Input

    7
    (Y)

    Ground

    P range switch

    Input

    11
    (LG)

    Ground

    Sensor ground

    Input

    Ground

    CVT fluid temperature sensor

    12
    (G/W)

    Condition

    Input/
    Output

    Output

    Selector lever: “L” position
    Other than the above
    Selector lever: “D” position
    Other than the above
    Ignition
    switch
    ON

    Selector lever: “N” position
    Other than the above
    Selector lever: “R” position
    Other than the above
    Selector lever: “P” position
    Other than the above
    Always

    Ignition
    switch
    ON
    Ignition
    switch
    ON

    Value (Approx.)

    10 − 16 V
    0V
    10 − 16 V
    0V
    10 − 16 V
    0V
    10 − 16 V
    0V
    10 − 16 V
    0V
    0V

    CVT fluid: Approx. 20°C

    2.01 – 2.05 V

    CVT fluid: Approx. 50°C

    1.45 – 1.50 V

    CVT fluid: Approx. 80°C

    0.90 – 0.94 V

    14
    (G/R)

    Ground

    15*
    (V)

    16
    (L/R)

    Ground

    Secondary pressure sensor

    Input

    21
    (R/W)

    ROM ASSY
    (CHIP SELECT)

    22
    (V)

    ROM ASSY
    (DATA I/O)

    23
    (P/L)

    CAN-L

    Input/
    Output

    G sensor

    Input

    When the vehicle stops on
    a flat road


    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    2.5 V


    0.88 – 0.92 V

    200 Hz

    24
    (BR)

    Ground

    Output speed sensor

    Input

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    JSDIA1904GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-104

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)

    Description

    +

    Signal

    Input/
    Output

    26
    (O/W)

    Ground

    Sensor power supply

    Output

    Condition

    Value (Approx.)

    Ignition switch: ON

    5.0 V

    Ignition switch: OFF

    0V

    A

    B

    C
    • After engine warming up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    30
    (BR/B)

    Ground

    Line pressure solenoid valve

    TM

    JSDIA1897GB

    Output

    • After engine warming up
    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • Depress the accelerator pedal fully

    E

    F

    G
    JSDIA1898GB

    31
    (L/W)
    33
    (L/G)


    ROM ASSY
    (CLOCK)
    CAN-H

    Input/
    Output

    H

    700 Hz

    34
    (W)

    Ground

    Secondary speed
    sensor

    Input

    I

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    J

    JSDIA1905GB

    K

    1,100 Hz

    35
    (LG/R)

    Ground

    Primary speed sensor

    Input

    L

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    M
    JSDIA1906GB

    N
    In driving at “L” position

    O
    37
    (BR/W)

    Ground

    High clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve

    JSDIA1897GB

    Output

    P
    Release the accelerator pedal after
    the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or
    less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or
    more
    JSDIA1899GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-105

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)
    +

    Description

    Signal

    Input/
    Output

    Condition

    Value (Approx.)

    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or
    less
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH) or
    more
    38
    (G)

    Ground

    Torque converter
    clutch solenoid
    valve

    JSDIA1900GB

    Output

    • Engine started
    • Vehicle is stopped

    JSDIA1901GB

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    39
    (G/B)

    Ground

    Low brake solenoid
    valve

    JSDIA1902GB

    Output
    Release the accelerator pedal after
    the following conditions are satisfied
    • Selector lever: “D” position
    • Accelerator pedal position: 1/8 or
    less
    • Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 MPH) or
    more

    JSDIA1903GB

    40
    (Y/B)

    Ground

    Primary pressure
    solenoid valve

    Output

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    JSDIA1897GB

    41
    (B)

    Ground

    Ground

    Output

    Always

    0V

    42
    (B)

    Ground

    Ground

    Output

    Always

    0V

    45
    (LG)

    Ground

    Battery power supply (memory backup)

    Input

    Always

    10 − 16 V

    46
    (LG)

    Ground

    Battery power supply (memory backup)

    Input

    Always

    10 − 16 V

    47
    (R/W)

    Ground

    Ignition power supply

    Input

    Revision: April 2013

    Ignition switch: ON

    10 − 16 V

    Ignition switch: OFF

    0V

    TM-106

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal No.
    (Wire color)

    Description

    +

    Signal

    Input/
    Output

    48
    (R)

    Ground

    Ignition power supply

    Input

    Condition

    Value (Approx.)

    Ignition switch: ON

    10 − 16 V

    Ignition switch: OFF

    0V

    A

    B

    *: This harness is not used.

    C

    Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009019878

    TCM has a fail-safe mode. The mode functions so that operation can be continued even if the signal circuit of TM
    the main electronically controlled input/output parts is damaged.
    If the vehicle shows following behaviors including “poor acceleration”, a malfunction of the applicable system
    is detected by TCM and the vehicle may be in a fail-safe mode. At this time, check the DTC code and perform
    E
    inspection and repair according to the malfunction diagnosis procedures.

    Fail-safe function
    DTC

    Vehicle behavior

    P062F

    Not changed from normal driving

    P0705

    • Shift position indicator on combination meter is not displayed.
    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    • Shift position indicator on combination meter is not displayed.
    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    P0706

    P0711

    P0712

    P0713

    P0715

    F

    Conditions of vehicle

    G

    H

    I

    J

    Acceleration is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. ≥
    10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: −35°C (−
    31°F) ≤Temp. < 10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. < −
    35°C (−31°F)

    Acceleration is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. ≥
    10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: −35°C (−
    31°F) ≤Temp. < 10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. < −
    35°C (−31°F)

    Acceleration is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. ≥
    10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: −35°C (−
    31°F) ≤Temp. < 10°C (50°F)

    • Selector shock is large
    • Start is slow

    Engine coolant temperature when engine start: Temp. < −
    35°C (−31°F)





    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Vehicle speed is not increased
    Lock-up is not performed

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-107

    2014 Note

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    DTC

    Vehicle behavior

    Conditions of vehicle

    P0720




    P0740

    Lock-up is not performed

    P0743

    Lock-up is not performed

    P0744

    Lock-up is not performed

    P0746





    P0846

    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow

    P0847

    Acceleration is slow

    P0848

    • Start is slow
    • Acceleration is slow

    P0863

    Not changed from normal driving

    P0890




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0962




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0963




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0965




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0966




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0967




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    P0998

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    P0999

    P099B

    P099C

    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Vehicle speed is not increased
    Lock-up is not performed

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Wire disconnection

    • Vehicle speed is not increased
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Voltage shorting

    Start is slow

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Wire disconnection

    • Vehicle speed is not increased
    • Lock-up is not performed

    Voltage shorting

    P1586

    Idle neutral control is not performed

    P1588

    Idle neutral control is not performed

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-108

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    DTC

    P2765

    Vehicle behavior




    Conditions of vehicle

    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Vehicle speed is not increased
    Lock-up is not performed

    A

    B

    P2857

    • Start is slow
    • Lock-up is not performed

    P2858

    • Vehicle speed is not increased
    • Lock-up is not performed

    P2859

    Vehicle speed is not increased

    P285A

    Start is slow

    U0073




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    U0100




    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    U0140

    Not changed from normal driving

    U0141

    Not changed from normal driving

    U0155

    Not changed from normal driving

    U0300




    C

    Selector shock is large
    Start is slow
    Acceleration is slow
    Lock-up is not performed

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    U1000

    Not changed from normal driving

    U1114

    Not changed from normal driving

    U1117

    Not changed from normal driving

    Protection Control

    J
    INFOID:0000000009019879

    The TCM becomes the protection control status temporarily to protect the safety when the safety of TCM and
    transmission is lost. It automatically returns to the normal status if the safety is secured.
    The TCM has the following protection control.

    CONTROL FOR WHEEL SPIN
    Control

    When a wheel spin is detected, the engine output and gear ratio are limited and the line pressure is increased.
    At the 1GR, the clutch pressure is increased.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    If the accelerator is kept depressing during wheel spin, the engine revolution and vehicle speed are limited to
    a certain degree. From the 1GR, upshift to a certain gear ratio is only allowed.

    Normal return condition

    Wheel spin convergence returns the control to the normal control.

    CONTROL WHEN FLUID TEMPERATURE IS HIGH
    When the CVT fluid temperature is high, the gear shift permission maximum revolution and the maximum
    torque are reduced than usual to prevent increase of the oil temperature.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    Power performance may be lowered, compared to normal control.

    Normal return condition

    The control returns to the normal control when CVT fluid temperature is lowered.

    TORQUE IS REDUCED WHEN DRIVING WITH THE REVERSE GEAR

    TM-109

    L

    M

    N

    O

    Control

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    2014 Note

    P

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Control

    Engine output is controlled according to a vehicle speed while reversing the vehicle.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    Power performance may be lowered while reversing the vehicle.

    Normal return condition

    Torque returns to normal by positioning the selector lever in a range other than “R” position.

    REVERSE PROHIBIT CONTROL
    Control

    The reverse brake is controlled to avoid becoming engaged when the selector lever is set in “R” position while
    driving in forward direction at more than the specified speed.

    Vehicle behavior in
    control

    If the selector lever is put at “R” position when driving with the forward gear, the gear becomes neutral, not
    reverse.

    Normal return condition

    The control returns to normal control when the vehicle is driven at low speeds. (The reverse brake becomes
    engaged.)

    DTC Inspection Priority Chart

    INFOID:0000000009019880

    If multiple malfunction codes are detected at the same time, check each code according to the DTC check priority list below.
    Priority

    1

    2

    3

    Revision: April 2013

    DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)

    Reference

    P0863 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    TM-177

    U0073 COMM BUS A OFF

    TM-133

    U0100 LOST COMM (ECM A)

    TM-134

    U0140 LOST COMM (BCM)

    TM-135

    U0141 LOST COMM (BCM A)

    TM-136

    U0155 LOST COMM (IPC)

    TM-137

    U0300 CAN COMM DATA

    TM-138

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRC

    TM-139

    U1117 LOST COMM (ABS)

    TM-140

    P0740 TORQUE CONVERTER

    TM-163

    P0743 TORQUE CONVERTER

    TM-165

    P0962 PC SOLENOID A

    TM-180

    P0963 PC SOLENOID A

    TM-182

    P0966 PC SOLENOID B

    TM-185

    P0967 PC SOLENOID B

    TM-187

    P0998 SHIFT SOLENOID F

    TM-189

    P0999 SHIFT SOLENOID F

    TM-191

    P099B SHIFT SOLENOID G

    TM-193

    P099C SHIFT SOLENOID G

    TM-195

    P0890 TCM

    TM-178

    TM-110

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Priority

    DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)

    4

    5

    6

    7

    Reference

    P062F EEPROM

    TM-141

    P0705 T/M RANGE SENSOR A

    TM-142

    P0706 T/M RANGE SENSOR A

    TM-148

    P0711 FLUID TEMP SENSOR A

    TM-151

    P0712 FLUID TEMP SENSOR A

    TM-153

    P0713 FLUID TEMP SENSOR A

    TM-155

    P0715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR A

    TM-157

    P0847 FLUID PRESS SEN/SW B

    TM-173

    P0848 FLUID PRESS SEN/SW B

    TM-175

    P1586 G SENSOR

    TM-197

    P1588 G SENSOR

    TM-200

    P2765 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR

    TM-202

    P0720 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR

    TM-160

    P0746 PC SOLENOID A

    TM-169

    P2857 CLUTCH B PRESSURE

    TM-205

    P2858 CLUTCH A PRESSURE

    TM-206

    P2859 CLUTCH A PRESSURE

    TM-207

    P285A CLUTCH B PRESSURE

    TM-209

    P0744 TORQUE CONVERTER

    TM-167

    P0846 FLUID PRESS SEN/SW B

    TM-171

    P0965 PC SOLENOID B

    TM-184

    DTC Index

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    INFOID:0000000009019881

    NOTE:
    • If multiple malfunction codes are detected at the same time, check each code according to the “DTC check
    priority list”. TM-110, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart».
    • The ignition counter is displayed in “FFD”. Refer to TM-92, «CONSULT Function».
    DTC*1, *2

    Items
    (CONSULT screen terms)

    Trip

    MIL

    Reference

    EEPROM

    1

    ON

    TM-141

    P0705

    T/M RANGE SENSOR A

    2

    ON

    TM-142

    P0706

    P0706

    T/M RANGE SENSOR A

    2

    ON

    TM-148

    P0711

    P0711

    FLUID TEMP SENSOR A

    2

    ON

    TM-151

    P0712

    P0712

    FLUID TEMP SENSOR A

    2

    ON

    TM-153

    P0713

    P0713

    FLUID TEMP SENSOR A

    2

    ON

    TM-155

    P0715

    P0715

    INPUT SPEED SENSOR A

    2

    ON

    TM-157

    P0720

    P0720

    OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR

    2

    ON

    TM-160

    P0740

    P0740

    TORQUE CONVERTER

    2

    ON

    TM-163

    P0743

    P0743

    TORQUE CONVERTER

    2

    ON

    TM-165

    P0744

    P0744

    TORQUE CONVERTER

    2

    ON

    TM-167

    P0746

    P0746

    PC SOLENOID A

    2

    ON

    TM-169

    P0846

    P0846

    FLUID PRESS SEN/SW B

    2

    ON

    TM-171

    P0847

    P0847

    FLUID PRESS SEN/SW B

    2

    ON

    TM-173

    P0848

    P0848

    FLUID PRESS SEN/SW B

    2

    ON

    TM-175

    GST

    CONSULT
    (TRANSMISSION)

    P062F

    P062F

    P0705

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-111

    2014 Note

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    DTC*1, *2

    Items
    (CONSULT screen terms)

    Trip

    MIL

    Reference

    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)

    1

    ON

    TM-177

    P0890

    TCM

    1

    ON

    TM-178

    P0962

    P0962

    PC SOLENOID A

    2

    ON

    TM-180

    P0963

    P0963

    PC SOLENOID A

    2

    ON

    TM-182

    P0965

    P0965

    PC SOLENOID B

    2

    ON

    TM-184

    P0966

    P0966

    PC SOLENOID B

    2

    ON

    TM-185

    P0967

    P0967

    PC SOLENOID B

    2

    ON

    TM-187

    P0998

    P0998

    SHIFT SOLENOID F

    2

    ON

    TM-189

    P0999

    P0999

    SHIFT SOLENOID F

    2

    ON

    TM-191

    P099B

    P099B

    SHIFT SOLENOID G

    2

    ON

    TM-193

    P099C

    P099C

    SHIFT SOLENOID G

    2

    ON

    TM-195

    P1586

    G SENSOR

    1

    TM-197

    P1588

    G SENSOR

    1

    TM-200

    P2765

    P2765

    OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR

    2

    ON

    TM-202

    P2857

    P2857

    CLUTCH A PRESSURE

    2

    ON

    TM-205

    P2858

    P2858

    CLUTCH B PRESSURE

    2

    ON

    TM-206

    P2859

    P2859

    CLUTCH A PRESSURE

    2

    ON

    TM-207

    P285A

    P285A

    CLUTCH B PRESSURE

    2

    ON

    TM-209

    U0073

    U0073

    COMM BUS A OFF

    1

    ON

    TM-133

    U0100

    U0100

    LOST COMM (ECM A)

    1

    ON

    TM-134

    U0140

    LOST COMM (BCM)

    1

    TM-135

    U0141

    LOST COMM (BCM A)

    1

    TM-136

    U0155

    LOST COMM (IPC)

    1

    TM-137

    U0300

    CAN COMM DATA

    1

    TM-138

    U1000

    CAN COMM CIRC

    1

    TM-139

    U1117

    LOST COMM (ABS)

    1

    TM-140

    GST

    CONSULT
    (TRANSMISSION)

    P0863

    P0863

    P0890

    *1: These numbers are specified by SAE J2012/ISO 15031-6.
    *2: The DTC number of the 1st trip is the same as the DTC number.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-112

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009019882

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    ABDWA0678GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-113

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABDWA0679GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-114

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABDIA1055GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-115

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABDIA1056GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-116

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABDIA1057GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-117

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABDIA1058GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-118

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABDIA1059GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-119

    2014 Note

    CVT SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    CVT SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009019883

    ABDWA0680GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-120

    2014 Note

    CVT SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O
    ABDIA1060GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-121

    2014 Note

    CVT SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    ABDIA1061GB

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-122

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION

    A

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Flowchart of Trouble Diagnosis

    INFOID:0000000009019884

    NOTE:
    “DTC” includes DTC at the 1st trip.

    B

    C

    1.OBTAIN INFORMATION ABOUT SYMPTOM

    Refer to TM-124, «Question sheet» and interview the customer to obtain the malfunction information (conditions and environment when the malfunction occurred) as much as possible when the customer brings in the TM
    vehicle.
    >> GO TO 2.

    E

    2.CHECK DTC
    1.
    2.

    Before checking the malfunction, check whether any DTC exists.
    If DTC exists, perform the following operations.
    Records the DTCs. (Print out using CONSULT and affix to the Work Order Sheet.)
    Erase DTCs.
    Check the relation between the cause found by DTC and the malfunction information from customer. TM219, «Symptom Table» can be used effectively.
    3. Check the relevant information including STI, etc.
    Do malfunction information and DTC exist?
    Malfunction information and DTC exist.>>GO TO 3.
    Malfunction information exists but no DTC.>>GO TO 4.
    No malfunction information, but DTC exists.>>GO TO 5.

    3.REPRODUCE MALFUCTION SYSTEM

    Check the malfunction described by the customer on the vehicle.
    Check if the behavior is fail safe or normal operation. Refer toTM-107, «Fail-safe».
    Interview sheet can be used effectively when reproduce malfunction conditions. Refer to TM-124, «Question
    sheet».
    Verify the relationship between the symptom and the conditions in which the malfunction described by the customer occurs.
    >> GO TO 5.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    4.REPRODUCE MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
    Check the malfunction described by the customer on the vehicle.
    Check if the behavior is fail safe or normal operation. Refer toTM-107, «Fail-safe».
    Interview sheet can be used effectively when reproduce malfunction conditions.TM-124, «Question sheet».
    Verify the relationship between the symptom and the conditions in which the malfunction described by the customer occurs.

    M

    N

    >> GO TO 6.

    5.PERFORM “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE”

    O

    Perform “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” of the appropriate DTC to check if DTC is detected again.
    Refer to TM-110, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart» when multiple DTCs are detected, and then determine the
    order for performing the diagnosis.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Follow GI-41, «Intermittent Incident» to check.

    6.IDENTIFY MALFUNCTIONING SYSTEM WITH “DIAGNOSIS CHART BY SYMPTOM”
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-123

    2014 Note

    P

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Use TM-219, «Symptom Table» from the symptom inspection result in step 4. Then identify where to start performing the diagnosis based on possible causes and symptoms.
    >> GO TO 8.

    7.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
    Repair or replace the detected malfunctioning parts.
    Reconnect parts or connector after repairing or replacing, and then erase DTC if necessary.
    >> GO TO 8.

    8.FINAL CHECK

    Perform “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” again to make sure that the repair is correctly performed.
    Check that malfunctions are not reproduced when obtaining the malfunction information from the customer,
    referring to the symptom inspection result in step 3 or 4.
    Is DTC or malfunction symptom reproduced?
    YES-1 (DTC is reproduced.)>>GO TO 5.
    YES-2 (Malfunction is reproduced.)>>GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Before delivering the vehicle to the customer, make sure that DTC is erased.

    Question sheet

    INFOID:0000000009019885

    DESCRIPTION
    There are many operating conditions that may cause a malfunction
    of the transmission parts. By understanding those conditions properly, a quick and exact diagnosis can be achieved.
    In general, perception of a problem varies depending on individuals.
    Ask the customer about his/her concerns carefully. It is important to
    understand the phenomenon or status. To systemize all the information for the diagnosis, prepare the question sheet referring to the
    question points.
    In some cases, multiple conditions that appear simultaneously may
    cause a DTC to be detected.
    SEF907L

    Worksheet Sample
    Question sheet
    Customer’s
    name
    Storage date
    Symptom

    MR/MS
    Year

    Month
    day

    Registration
    number

    Initial year
    registration

    Vehicle type

    Chassis No.

    Engine

    Mileage

    † Vehicle does not start. († R position
    † Upshifting does not occur.

    † D position

    Year

    Month
    day

    km
    † L position

    † M position)

    † Downshifting does not occur.

    † Lock-up malfunction
    † Shift point is too high.
    † Shift shock († N⇒D
    † Slip († N⇒D
    † Noise

    † Shift point is too low.
    † Lock-up

    † Lock-up

    † R, D, L and M position)

    † R, D, L and M position)

    † Vibration

    When selector lever position is shifted, shift pattern does not change.
    † Other
    (

    )

    First occurrence

    † Recently (as from month

    Frequency of occurrence

    † Always

    Revision: April 2013

    of year

    )

    † Under certain conditions

    TM-124

    † Sometimes (

    time(s)/day)

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Question sheet
    Customer’s
    name

    MR/MS
    Year

    Storage date
    Climate conditions

    Month
    day

    Registration
    number

    Initial year
    registration

    Vehicle type

    Chassis No.

    Engine

    Mileage

    Year

    Month
    day

    B
    km

    Irrelevant
    Weather

    † Clear

    Temperature

    † Hot

    Relative humidity

    † High

    Transaxle condition

    Road conditions
    Operating condition, etc.

    A

    C
    † Cloud
    † Warm

    † Rain
    † Cool † Cold

    † Moderate

    † In cold-start
    †Engine speed:

    † Snow

    † Others

    † Temperature (Approx.

    )
    °C)

    TM

    † Low

    † During warm-up (approx.
    rpm

    °C)

    † After warm-up

    E

    † Urban area
    † Suburb area
    † Highway
    † Mountainous road (uphill or downhill)
    Irrelevant
    † When engine starts
    † During idling
    † During driving
    † During acceleration
    † At constant speed driving
    † During deceleration
    † During cornering (RH curve or LH curve)

    F

    G

    Other conditions

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-125

    2014 Note

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TCM
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019886

    When replacing the TCM, perform the following work.
    CHECK LOADING OF CALIBRATION DATA

    • The TCM acquires calibration data (individual characteristic value) of each solenoid that is stored in the
    ROM assembly (in the control valve). This enables the TCM to perform accurate control. After the TCM is
    replaced, check that the TCM has correctly loaded the calibration data.
    CALIBRATION OF G SENSOR

    • TCM stores calibration data (inherent characteristic value) of G sensor to provide accurate control. Therefore, it is required to perform calibration of G sensor after the replacement of TCM.
    CAUTION:
    When replacing TCM and transaxle assembly as a set, replace transaxle assembly first and then
    replace TCM.
    If the TCM is replaced in advance, perform “ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TRANSAXLE
    ASSEMBLY” after “G sensor calibration”.

    Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019887

    1.CHECK WORK CONTENTS
    Replacing only the TCM>>GO TO 2.
    Replacing the TCM after the transaxle assembly is replaced>>GO TO 2.
    Replacing the transaxle assembly after the TCM is replaced>>GO TO 5.

    2.LOADING OF CALIBRATION DATA
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Shift the selector lever to the “P” position.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check that “P” is displayed on shift position indicator on combination meter.
    NOTE:
    Displayed approximately 4 – 5 seconds after the selector lever is moved to the “P” position.
    Does the shift position indicator display “P”?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    3.PERFORM G SENSOR CALIBRATION

    Refer to TM-129, «Procedure».
    >> WORK END

    4.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEM
    Check the following items:
    • Harness between the TCM and the ROM assembly inside the transaxle assembly is open or shorted.
    • Disconnected, loose, bent, collapsed, or otherwise abnormal connector housing terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    5.PERFORM G SENSOR CALIBRATION

    Refer to TM-129, «Procedure».
    >> Perform “ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY” after “CALIBRATION OF G SENSOR”. Refer to TM-127, «Procedure».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-126

    2014 Note

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    Description

    A

    INFOID:0000000009019888

    When replacing the transaxle, perform the following work.

    B

    ERASING THE CALIBRATION DATA

    • The TCM acquires calibration data (individual characteristic value) of each solenoid that is stored in the
    ROM assembly (in the control valve). This enables the TCM to perform accurate control. For this reason,
    after the transaxle assembly is replaced, it is necessary to erase the calibration data that is stored in the
    TCM and load new calibration data.

    C

    TM

    ERASING THE LEARNED VALUE DATA

    • TCM learns indicated pressure for appropriate control of the transaxle assembly and records the learned
    values. For this reason, the leaned values stored in TCM must be erased after replacing a transaxle assembly.

    E

    ERASING CVT FLUID DEGRADATION LEVEL DATA

    • TCM records the degradation level of the CVT fluid calculated from the vehicle driving status. Therefore, if
    the transaxle assembly is replaced, it is necessary to erase the CVT fluid degradation level data recorded by
    TCM.

    Procedure

    F

    INFOID:0000000009019889

    G

    1.INITIALIZE TCM
    With CONSULT
    1. Set parking brake.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Select “Work Support” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    4. Select “ERASE MEMORY DATA”.
    5. While maintaining the conditions below, touch “Start”.
    Vehicle stop status
    With engine stopped
    Selector lever: “R” position
    Accelerator pedal: Depressed
    NOTE:
    Select “Start” and complete within approximately 20 seconds.
    Is “COMPLETED” displayed?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for a minimum of 10 seconds then perform the work again.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    2.CHECK AFTER TCM IS INITIALIZED

    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF with the selector lever in “R” position and wait for 10 seconds or more.
    Turn ignition switch ON with the selector lever in “R” position.
    CAUTION:
    Never start the engine.
    3. Select “Special function” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    4. Select “CALIB DATA”.
    5. Check that indicated value of “CALIB DATA” is equal to the value shown in the following table.
    1.
    2.

    Item name

    Display value

    Item name

    00

    MAP NO HC/RB

    00

    UNIT CLB ID2

    00

    MAP NO L/B

    00

    UNIT CLB ID3

    00

    OFFSET2 LU

    0

    UNIT CLB ID4

    00

    OFFSET2 PL

    0

    UNIT CLB ID5

    00

    OFFSET2 PRI

    0

    UNIT CLB ID6

    00

    OFFSET2 H/R

    0

    TM-127

    N

    O

    Display value

    UNIT CLB ID1

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    P

    2014 Note

    ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Item name

    Display value

    Item name

    Display value

    UNIT CLB ID7

    00

    OFFSET2 L/B

    0

    UNIT CLB ID8

    00

    INIT OFFSET H/R A

    0

    UNIT CLB ID9

    00

    INIT OFFSET H/R B

    0

    UNIT CLB ID10

    00

    INIT OFFSET H/R C

    0

    UNIT CLB ID11

    00

    INIT OFFSET H/R D

    0

    GAIN LU

    256

    INIT OFFSET H/R E

    0

    GAIN PL

    256

    INIT OFFSET H/R F

    0

    GAIN PRI

    256

    INIT OFSET LB A

    0

    GAIN HC/RB

    256

    INIT OFSET LB B

    0

    GAIN L/B

    256

    INIT OFSET LB C

    0

    0

    INIT OFSET LB D

    0

    OFFSET LU
    OFFSET PL

    0

    INIT OFSET LB E

    0

    OFFSET PRI

    0

    INIT OFSET LB F

    0

    OFFSET HC/RB

    0

    LB INITIALIZE LEARN

    −1

    OFFSET L/B

    0

    HC INITIALIZE LEARN

    −1

    MAP NO LU

    00

    LB INITIALIZE TEMP

    FF

    MAP NO PL

    00

    LB INITIALIZE TEMP

    FF

    MAP NO PRI

    00

    Is the indicated value of “CALIB DATA” equal to the value shown in the table?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 1.

    3.LOADING OF CALIBRATION DATA
    1.
    2.

    Shift the selector lever to the “P” position.
    Check that “P” is displayed on shift position indicator on combination meter.
    NOTE:
    Displayed approximately 4 – 5 seconds after the selector lever is moved to the “P” position.
    Does shift position indicator display “P”?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    4.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEMS

    Check the following items:
    • Harness between the TCM and the ROM assembly inside the transaxle assembly is open or shorted.
    • Disconnected, loose, bent, collapsed, or otherwise abnormal connector housing terminals
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 1.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunctioning parts.

    5.ERASE THE CVT FLUID DEGRADATION LEVEL DATA
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Select “WORK SUPPORT” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “CONFORM CVTF DETERIORTN”.
    Touch “Clear”.
    >> WORK END

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-128

    2014 Note

    CALIBRATION OF G SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    CALIBRATION OF G SENSOR

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019890

    TCM stores calibration data (inherent characteristic value) of G sensor to provide accurate control. Therefore,
    it is required to perform calibration of G sensor after the following work is performed.
    • Removal/installation or replacement of G sensor
    • Replacement of TCM

    Procedure

    C

    INFOID:0000000009019891

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE CALIBRATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    B

    TM

    Park the vehicle on a level surface.
    Adjust air pressure of all tires to the specified pressure. WT-9, «Tire Air Pressure».
    E

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM CALIBRATION

    F

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    CAUTION:
    Never start engine.
    2. Select “Work Support” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    3. Select “G SENSOR CALIBRATION”.
    4. Touch “Start”.
    CAUTION:
    Never swing the vehicle during “G sensor calibration”.
    Is “COMPLETED” displayed?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Perform steps 1 and 2 again.

    G

    H

    I

    3.PERFORM THE SELF-DIAGNOSIS

    J

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
    2. Turn ignition switch ON.
    3. Select “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Is “P1586” or “P1588” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-111, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> Calibration end

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-129

    2014 Note

    STALL TEST
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    STALL TEST
    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019894

    INSPECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.

    Check the engine oil level. Replenish if necessary.
    Check for leak of the CVT fluid. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».
    Drive for about 10 minutes to warm up the vehicle so that the CVT fluid temperature is 50 to 80°C (122 to
    176°F).
    Be sure to apply the parking brake and block the tires.
    Start the engine, depress the brake pedal and put the selector lever to the D position.
    While depressing the brake pedal, depress the accelerator pedal gradually.
    Read the stall speed quickly. Then, release your foot from the accelerator pedal quickly.
    CAUTION:
    Do not depress the accelerator pedal for 5 seconds or more during the test.
    Stall speed

    : Refer to TM-254, «Stall Speed».

    8.
    9.

    Place the selector lever in the N position.
    Cool the CVT fluid.
    CAUTION:
    Run the engine with the idle speed for at least 1 minute.
    10. Put the selector lever to the R position and perform Step 6 to Step 9 again.

    NARROWING-DOWN MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
    Selector lever position

    Stall speed

    Possible cause

    D

    R

    H

    O

    • Low brake

    O

    H

    • Reverse brake

    L

    L

    • Engine
    • Torque converter one way clutch

    H




    H

    Line pressure is low.
    Primary pulley
    Secondary pulley
    Steel belt

    O: Within the stall speed standard value
    H: Stall speed is higher than the standard value.
    L: Stall speed is lower than the standard value.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-130

    2014 Note

    LINE PRESSURE TEST
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    LINE PRESSURE TEST

    A

    Work Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019895

    INSPECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    B

    Check the engine oil level. Replenish if necessary. Refer to LU-7, «Inspection».
    Check for CVT fluid leaks. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».
    Drive for about 10 minutes to warm up the vehicle so that the CVT fluid temperature is 50 to 80°C (122 to C
    176°F).
    Stop the vehicle, apply the parking brake and block the tires.
    TM
    Start the engine.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “LINE PRESSURE”.
    E
    Measure the line pressure at both idle and the stall speed.
    CAUTION:
    Keep brake pedal pressed all the way down during measurement.
    F
    Line pressure

    : TM-255, «Line Pressure»
    G

    NARROWING-DOWN MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
    Judgment

    Idle speed

    Possible cause

    Low for all positions
    (“P”, “R”, “N”, “D”, “L”)

    Possible causes include malfunctions in the pressure supply system and low oil pump output.
    For example:
    • Oil pump wear
    • Damage of chain and sprocket
    • Pressure regulator valve or plug sticking or spring fatigue
    • Oil strainer ⇒ oil pump ⇒ pressure regulator valve passage oil leak
    • Engine idle speed too low

    Only low for a specific
    position

    Possible causes include an oil pressure leak in a passage or device related to the position after
    the pressure is distributed by the manual valve.

    High

    Possible causes include a sensor malfunction or malfunction in the line pressure adjustment
    function.
    For example:
    • Accelerator pedal position signal malfunction
    • CVT fluid temperature sensor malfunction
    • Line pressure solenoid malfunction (sticking in OFF state, filter clog, cut line)
    • Pressure regulator valve or plug sticking

    Line pressure does not
    rise higher than the line
    pressure for idle.

    Possible causes include a sensor malfunction or malfunction in the pressure adjustment function.
    For example:
    • TCM malfunction
    • Line pressure solenoid malfunction (shorting, sticking in ON state)
    • Pressure regulator valve or plug sticking

    The pressure rises, but
    does not enter the
    standard position.

    Possible causes include malfunctions in the pressure supply system and malfunction in the pressure adjustment function.
    For example:
    • Oil pump wear
    • Line pressure solenoid malfunction (sticking, filter clog)
    • Pressure regulator valve or plug sticking

    Only low for a specific
    position

    Possible causes include an oil pressure leak in a passage or device related to the position after
    the pressure is distributed by the manual valve.

    Stall speed

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-131

    2014 Note

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    CVT POSITION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    CVT POSITION
    Inspection
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    6.
    7.

    8.
    9.

    INFOID:0000000009020197

    Turn ON the ignition switch with the shift selector in the «P» position.
    Press the shift selector handle button with the brake pedal depressed, and confirm that the shift selector
    can be moved from the «P» position. Also confirm that shift selector will not move from the «P» position
    without depressing the brake pedal.
    Move the shift selector and check for “excessive effort,” “sticking,” “noise” or “rattle”.
    Confirm that shift selector stops at each position with the feel of engagement when it is moved through all
    the positions. Check whether or not the actual position the shift selector is in matches the position shown
    by the transaxle body.
    The method of operating the shift selector to individual positions
    correctly should be as shown.
    • (A): Press shift selector button to operate shift selector, while
    depressing the brake pedal.
    • (B): Press shift selector button to operate shift selector.
    • (C): Shift selector can be operated without pressing shift
    selector button.
    When the shift selector handle button is pressed without applying forward/backward force to the shift selector at “P”, “R”, “N”
    and “D” positions, there should be no “sticking” of the button.
    WCIA0620E
    Confirm the back-up lamps illuminate only when shift selector is
    placed in the “R” position. Confirm the back-up lamps do not illuminate when the shift selector is pushed toward the “R” position side when shift selector is in the “P” or “N”
    position.
    Check that the engine can be started only when the shift selector is in the “P” and “N” positions.
    Check that the transaxle is locked when the shift selector is in the «P» position.

    Adjustment
    1.
    2.
    3.

    INFOID:0000000009020198

    Move the shift selector to the “P” position.
    CAUTION:
    Rotate the wheels at least a quarter turn and be certain the transaxle is locked in the «P» position.
    Remove nut (A) and set manual lever (B) to the “P” position.
    CAUTION:
    Do not apply force to the manual lever.
    Tighten nuts to the specified torque. Refer to TM-230, «Exploded
    View».
    CAUTION:
    Do not move the manual lever when tightening.

    JSDIA1875ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-132

    2014 Note

    U0073 COMMUNICATION BUS A OFF
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS

    A

    U0073 COMMUNICATION BUS A OFF
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019896

    B

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links C
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
    TM

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019897

    E

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    U0073

    Control Module Communication Bus A Off

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    TCM communication blockage lasts for 2 secHarness or connector
    onds or more when turning ON the ignition
    (CAN communication line is error)
    switch. (Communication not established.)

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    H

    I

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U0073” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-133, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009019898

    L

    For the diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».
    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-133

    2014 Note

    U0100 LOST COMMUNICATION (ECM A)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U0100 LOST COMMUNICATION (ECM A)
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019899

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019900

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    U0100

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Lost Communication With
    ECM/PCM A

    DTC detection condition
    When the ignition switch is ON, TCM is unable to receive the CAN communications
    signal from ECM continuously for 2 seconds or more.

    Possible causes
    • ECM
    • Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is open or
    shorted)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U0100” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-134, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019901

    For the diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-134

    2014 Note

    U0140 LOST COMMUNICATION (BCM)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U0140 LOST COMMUNICATION (BCM)

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019902

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019903

    B

    C

    TM

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    U0140

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Lost Communication With
    Body Control Module

    DTC detection condition
    When the ignition switch is ON, TCM is unable
    to receive the CAN communications signal
    from BCM continuously for 2 seconds or more.

    Possible causes
    • BCM
    • Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is open or
    shorted)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    E

    F

    G

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    I

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U0140” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-135, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009019904

    L

    For the diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».
    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-135

    2014 Note

    U0141 LOST COMMUNICATION (BCM A)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U0141 LOST COMMUNICATION (BCM A)
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019905

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019906

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    U0141

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Lost Communication With
    Body Control Module A

    DTC detection condition
    When the ignition switch is turned ON, TCM
    continues no reception of the CAN communication signal from IPDM E/R for 2 seconds or
    more.

    Possible causes
    • IPDM E/R
    • Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is open or
    shorted)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U0141” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-133, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019907

    For the diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-136

    2014 Note

    U0155 LOST COMMUNICATION (IPC)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U0155 LOST COMMUNICATION (IPC)

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019908

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019909

    B

    C

    TM

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    U0155

    Lost Communication With Instrument Panel Cluster (IPC)
    Control Module

    When the ignition switch is ON, TCM is unable
    to receive the CAN communications signal
    from the combination meter continuously for 2
    seconds or more.

    Possible causes
    • Combination meter
    • Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is open or
    shorted)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    E

    F

    G

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    I

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U0155” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-137, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009019910

    L

    For the diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».
    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-137

    2014 Note

    U0300 CAN COMMUNICATION DATA
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U0300 CAN COMMUNICATION DATA
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019911

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019912

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    U0300

    Internal Control Module Software Incompatibility

    When the ignition switch is ON, the data
    length transmitted from each control unit is
    shorter than the specified length and the status continues for 2 seconds or more.

    Possible causes

    Control unit other than TCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U0300” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-138, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019913

    1.CONTROL UNIT CHECK
    Check the number of control units replaced before “U0300” is detected.
    Is one control unit replaced?
    YES >> The specification of the control unit replaced may be incorrect. Check the part number and the
    specification.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CONTROL UNIT CHECK

    With CONSULT
    1. Remove one of the control unit replaced.
    2. Assemble the old control unit before replacement.
    3. Turn ignition switch ON, and wait for 2 seconds or more.
    4. Select “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Is “U0300”detected?
    YES >> Turn OFF the ignition switch and check other control units in the same manner.
    NO
    >> The specification of the control unit removed may be incorrect. Check the part number and the
    specification.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-138

    2014 Note

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019914

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019915

    B

    C

    TM

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    U1000

    Trouble diagnosis name
    CAN Communication Line

    DTC detection condition
    When the ignition switch is ON, TCM cannot
    send the CAN communication signal continuously for 2 seconds or more.

    Possible causes
    Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is open or
    shorted)

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    G

    If another “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    I

    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 5 seconds.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U1000” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-139, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    J

    K
    INFOID:0000000009019916

    L

    For the diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-139

    2014 Note

    U1117 LOST COMMUNICATION (ABS)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    U1117 LOST COMMUNICATION (ABS)
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019917

    CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real-time application. It is an on-vehicle multiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent malfunction detection ability.
    Many electronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links
    with other control units during operation (not independently). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2 communication lines (CAN-H line, CAN-L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission
    with less wiring. Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019918

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    U1117

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Lost Communication With
    ABS

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    When the ignition switch is ON, TCM is unable
    to receive the CAN communications signal
    from ABS actuator and electric unit (control
    unit) continuously for 2 seconds or more.

    • ABS actuator and electric unit (control
    unit)
    • Harness or connector
    (CAN communication line is open or
    shorted)

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “U1117” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-133, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019919

    For the diagnosis procedure, refer to LAN-15, «Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-140

    2014 Note

    P062F EEPROM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P062F EEPROM

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009019920

    TCM compares the calculated value stored in the flash ROM with the value stored in TCM. If the calculated
    value does not agree with the stored value, TCM judges this as a malfunction.

    DTC Logic

    B

    INFOID:0000000009019921

    C

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P062F

    Trouble diagnosis name
    Internal Control Module EEPROM Error

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    Flash ROM error is detected when turning ON
    the ignition switch.

    • TCM (flash ROM)
    • Harness or connector
    [TCM power supply (back-up) circuit is
    open or shorted]

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    H

    1. Start the engine.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “P062F” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-141, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009019922

    1.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDNT

    K

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the TCM. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-141

    2014 Note

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019923

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0705

    Transmission Range Sensor
    A Circuit (PRNDL Input)

    DTC detection condition
    Two or more range signals simultaneously
    stay ON continuously for 5 seconds under the
    following diagnosis condition 1 and 2:
    • Diagnosis condition 1 (continued for 5 seconds or more)
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    • Diagnosis condition 2 (continued for 2 seconds or more)
    — Vehicle speed: Less than 3 km/h (2 MPH)
    — Accelerator pedal position: 0.6/8 or less
    — Idle switch: ON
    — Stop lamp switch: ON

    Possible causes

    • Harness or connector
    (Short circuit between transmission
    range switch and TCM)
    • Transmission range switch

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK
    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.

    Start the engine.
    Maintain the following conditions.
    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.0/8

    Brake pedal

    : Depressed

    Vehicle speed

    : 0 km/h (0 MPH)

    3.

    Shift the selector lever through entire positions from “P” to “L”. (Hold the selector lever at each position for
    10 seconds or more.)
    4. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0705” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-142, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019924

    1.CHECK TCM INPUT SIGNALS
    With CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “D POSITION SW”, “N POSITION SW”, “R POSITION SW”, “P POSITION SW” and “L POSITION
    SW”.
    4. Shift the selector lever through entire positions from “P” to “L” and check ON/OFF of each monitor item.

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Monitor item
    D POSITION SW

    Test condition

    Condition

    Selector lever: “D” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-142

    2014 Note

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Monitor item

    Test condition

    N POSITION SW

    R POSITION SW

    P POSITION SW

    L POSITION SW

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Condition

    Selector lever: “N” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “R” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “P” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    Selector lever: “L” position

    On

    Other than the above

    Off

    A

    B

    C

    TM

    Without CONSULT
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Shift the selector lever from “P” to “L” and check voltage between TCM harness connector terminals and
    ground.

    E

    F

    +

    TCM
    Connector

    Voltage

    G

    Terminal
    Selector lever: “ L” position

    2

    Other than the above
    Selector lever: “D” position

    4

    F44

    Condition

    5

    6

    7

    Other than the above
    Ground

    Selector lever: “N” position
    Other than the above
    Selector lever: “R” position
    Other than the above
    Selector lever: “P” position
    Other than the above

    Battery voltage

    H

    Approx. 0 V
    Battery voltage
    Approx. 0 V

    I

    Battery voltage
    Approx. 0 V

    J

    Battery voltage
    Approx. 0 V
    Battery voltage

    K

    Approx. 0 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO-1 [“D POSITION SW” is “ON” when selector is not in “D” position. (Or connector terminal 4
    voltage.)]>>GO TO 2.
    NO-2 [“N POSITION SW” is “ON” when selector is not in “N” position. (Or connector terminal 5
    voltage.)]>>GO TO 4.
    NO-3 [“R POSITION SW” is “ON” when selector is not in “R” position. (Or connector terminal 6
    voltage.)]>>GO TO 6.
    NO-4 [“P POSITION SW” is “ON” when selector is not in “P” position. (Or connector terminal 7
    voltage.)]>>GO TO 8.
    NO-5 [“L POSITION SW” is “ON” when selector is not in “L” position. (Or connector terminal 2
    voltage.)]>>GO TO 10.

    is at power
    is at power

    is at power

    TM-143

    N

    is at power
    O

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals.

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    is at power

    2.CHECK D POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART 1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    P

    2014 Note

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    TCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal
    2

    F44

    5

    4

    Not existed

    6
    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK D POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART 2)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect transmission position switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    +
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    4

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    4.CHECK N POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART 1)

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals.
    TCM

    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal
    2

    F44

    4

    5

    Not existed

    6
    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    5.CHECK N POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART 2)

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect transmission position switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    +
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    5

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-144

    2014 Note

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    6.CHECK P POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART 1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    A

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals.
    TCM

    Connector

    B

    Continuity

    Terminal

    C

    2
    F44

    4

    7

    Not existed

    5

    TM

    6

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    E

    7.CHECK P POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART 2)

    F

    1.
    2.
    3.

    G

    Disconnect transmission position switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    +
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    7

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    H

    Ground

    0V

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    J

    8.CHECK R POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals.

    L

    TCM
    Connector

    K

    Continuity

    Terminal
    2

    F44

    6

    4
    5

    M
    Not existed

    N

    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    O

    9.CHECK R POSITION SW CIRCUIT (PART 2)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    P

    Disconnect transmission position switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-145

    2014 Note

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    +
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    6

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    10.CHECK L POSITION SWITCH CIRCUIT (PART 1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals.
    TCM

    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal
    4

    F44

    5

    2

    Not existed

    6
    7

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 11.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    11.CHECK L POSITION SWITCH CIRCUIT (PART 2)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect transmission position switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    +
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    2

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 12.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    12.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH

    Check transmission range switch. Refer to TM-146, «Component Inspection (Transmission Range Switch)».
    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Transmission Range Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009019925

    1.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH
    Check continuity between transmission range switch connector terminals.
    Transmission range switch
    Terminal
    7 – 10

    Revision: April 2013

    Condition

    Continuity

    Manual lever: “P” and “N” positions
    Other than the above

    Existed
    Not existed

    TM-146

    2014 Note

    P0705 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Transmission range switch
    Terminal
    4–5

    4–8

    4–9

    4–2

    4–6

    Condition

    Continuity

    Manual lever: “P” position

    A

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “R” position

    B

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “N position

    C

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “D” position

    Existed

    Other than the above

    TM

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “L” position

    Existed

    Other than the above

    E

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of transmission range switch. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM250, «Removal and Installation».

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-147

    2014 Note

    P0706 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0706 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019926

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0706

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Transmission Range Sensor
    A Circuit Range/Performance

    All range signals stay OFF continuously for 30
    seconds under the following diagnosis condition 1 and 2:
    • Diagnosis condition 1 (continued for 30 seconds or more)
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    • Diagnosis condition 2 (continued for 2 seconds or more)
    — Vehicle speed: Less than 3 km/h (2 MPH)
    — Accelerator pedal position: 0.6/8 or less
    — Idle switch: ON
    — Stop lamp switch: ON

    Possible causes

    • Harness or connector
    (Open circuit between ignition switch
    and transmission range switch/open
    circuit between transmission range
    switch and TCM)
    • Transmission range switch
    • Control cable

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    Start the engine.
    Maintain the following conditions.
    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.0/8

    Brake pedal

    : Depressed

    Vehicle speed

    : 0 km/h (0 MPH)

    3.

    Shift the selector lever through entire positions from “P” to “L”. (Hold the selector lever at each position for
    35 seconds or more.)
    4. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0706” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-148, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019927

    1.ADJUSTMENT OF CONTROL CABLE
    Adjust control cable. Refer to TM-228, «Inspection».
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Select “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    3. Touch “Erase”.
    4. Perform «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE». Refer to TM-148, «DTC Logic».
    Is “P0706” detected?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-148

    2014 Note

    P0706 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    3.CHECK POWER CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    A

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect transmission range switch connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between transmission range switch harness connector terminal and ground.

    B

    +
    Transmission range switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    F52

    4

    Voltage

    Ground

    10 – 16 V

    C

    TM

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 7.

    E

    4.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH AND TCM (PART 1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between transmission range switch harness connector terminals and TCM harness connector terminals.

    Transmission range switch
    Connector

    F52

    Terminal

    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    2

    4

    5

    7

    6

    F44

    Continuity

    6

    8

    6

    9

    5

    I

    Existed

    J

    K

    5.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH AND TCM (PART 2)
    Check continuity between transmission range switch harness connector terminals and ground.

    Connector

    Terminal

    G

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Transmission range switch

    F

    L

    Continuity

    M

    2
    5
    F52

    6

    Ground

    N

    Not existed

    8
    9

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    P

    6.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH

    Check transmission range switch. Refer to TM-150, «Component Inspection (Transmission Range Switch)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-149

    2014 Note

    P0706 TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    7.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN IPDM E/R AND TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and transmission range switch.
    IPDM E/R

    Transmission range switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    21

    F52

    4

    Continuity
    Existed

    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 8.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    8.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEMS

    Check the following items:
    • Open circuit or short circuit in harness between ignition switch and IPDM E/R. Refer to PG-22, «Wiring Diagram — Ignition Power Supply —».
    • Short circuit in harness between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal 21 and transmission range switch
    harness connector terminal 4.
    • 10A fuse (No. 49, IPDM E/R). Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    • IPDM E/R
    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Transmission Range Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009019928

    1.CHECK TRANSMISSION RANGE SWITCH
    Check continuity between transmission range switch connector terminals.
    Transmission range switch
    Terminal
    7 – 10

    4–5

    4–8

    4–9

    4–2

    4–6

    Condition

    Continuity

    Manual lever: “P” and “N” positions

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “P” position

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “R” position

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “N position

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “D” position

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Manual lever: “L” position

    Existed

    Other than the above

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of transmission range switch. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-150

    2014 Note

    P0711 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0711 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    DTC Logic

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019929

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0711

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Transmission Fluid Temperature Sensor A Circuit Range/
    Performance

    Under the following diagnosis conditions, CVT
    fluid temperature recognized by TCM does not
    change for 10 minutes or more in a temperature range.
    • Diagnosis condition
    — Selector lever: “D” position
    — Vehicle speed: 10 km/h (7 MPH) or more
    — Engine speed: 450 rpm or more
    — Accelerator pedal position: 1.0/8 or more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    — CVT fluid temperature: Less than 10°C
    NOTE:
    Every time the CVT fluid temperature increases, reset the detection time and start the diagnosis again.

    Possible causes

    C

    TM

    CVT fluid temperature sensor

    E

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    H

    I

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for a total of 10 minutes or more.
    Selector lever

    J

    K

    : “D” position

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 1.0/8 or more

    Vehicle speed

    : 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more

    L

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0711” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-166, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    M

    INFOID:0000000009019930

    1.CHECK CVT FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT unit connector.
    Check CVT fluid temperature sensor. Refer to TM-152, «Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature
    Sensor)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-151

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    P0711 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor)

    INFOID:0000000009019931

    1.CHECK CVT FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminals.
    CVT unit

    Condition

    Terminal

    12 – 18

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°C)

    6.5 kΩ

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°C)

    2.2 kΩ

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°C)

    0.87 kΩ

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of CVT fluid temperature sensor. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to
    TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-152

    2014 Note

    P0712 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0712 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    DTC Logic

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019932

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0712

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Transmission Fluid Temperature Sensor A Circuit Low

    Possible causes

    The CVT fluid temperature identified by the
    TCM is 180°C (356°F) or more continuously
    • Harness or connector
    for 5 seconds or more under the following di(CVT fluid temperature sensor circuit is
    agnosis conditions:
    shorted to ground)
    • Diagnosis conditions
    • CVT fluid temperature sensor
    — Ignition switch: ON
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    C

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    F

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1. Start the engine and wait for 10 seconds or more.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0712” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-153, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    H

    I
    INFOID:0000000009019933

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.

    J

    K

    L

    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    12

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part.

    N

    2.CHECK CVT FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    Check CVT fluid temperature sensor. Refer to TM-153, «Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor)

    INFOID:0000000009019934

    1.CHECK CVT FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminals.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-153

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    P0712 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    CVT unit

    Condition

    Terminal

    12 – 18

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°C)

    6.5 kΩ

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°C)

    2.2 kΩ

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°C)

    0.87 kΩ

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of CVT fluid temperature sensor. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to
    TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-154

    2014 Note

    P0713 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0713 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    DTC Logic

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019935

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0713

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    The CVT fluid temperature identified by the
    TCM is −40°C (−40°F) or less continuously for
    5 seconds or more under the following diagno- • Harness or connector
    sis conditions:
    (CVT fluid temperature sensor circuit is
    • Diagnosis conditions
    open or shorted to power supply)
    — Ignition switch: ON
    • CVT fluid temperature sensor
    — Vehicle speed: More than 10 km/h (7 MPH)
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Transmission Fluid Temperature Sensor A Circuit High

    C

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    1.
    2.

    H

    Start the engine.
    Maintain the following condition for 10 seconds or more.
    Vehicle speed

    I

    : 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more

    3. Stop the vehicle.
    4. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0713” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-153, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    J

    K

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019936

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT (PART 1)

    L

    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals and CVT unit harness connector terminals.
    TCM
    Connector
    F44

    CVT unit
    Terminal
    12
    11

    Connector
    F46

    Continuity

    Terminal
    12

    N

    Existed

    18

    O

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part.

    P

    2.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT (PART 2)
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-155

    2014 Note

    P0713 TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    +
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    12

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part.

    3.CHECK CVT FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    Check CVT fluid temperature sensor. Refer to TM-156, «Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (CVT Fluid Temperature Sensor)

    INFOID:0000000009019937

    1.CHECK CVT FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminals.
    CVT unit

    Condition

    Terminal

    12 – 18

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°C)

    6.5 kΩ

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°C)

    2.2 kΩ

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°C)

    0.87 kΩ

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of CVT fluid temperature sensor. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to
    TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-156

    2014 Note

    P0715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR A

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019938

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition
    The primary speed sensor value is less than
    150 rpm continuously for 5 seconds or more
    under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Secondary pulley speed: 1,000 rpm or more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Input/Turbine Speed Sensor A
    Circuit

    P0715

    The primary speed sensor value is 240 rpm or
    less continuously for 500 msec or more under
    the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — 10-msec-ago primary pulley speed: 1,000
    rpm or more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Possible causes

    C

    • Harness or connector
    (Primary speed sensor circuit is open
    or shorted)
    • Primary speed sensor

    TM

    E

    F

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    G

    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    H

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    I

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “L” POSITION

    Vehicle speed

    : 40 km/h (25 MPH) or more

    K

    L

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0715” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-157, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    M

    INFOID:0000000009019939

    N

    1.CHECK PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR POWER CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    O

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect primary speed sensor connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between primary speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.

    P

    +
    Primary speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F50

    3

    Voltage

    Ground

    10 – 16 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-157

    2014 Note

    P0715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    2.CHECK PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between primary speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.
    Primary speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F50

    1

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR AND TCM (PART 1)

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between primary speed sensor harness connector terminal and TCM harness connector
    terminal.
    Primary speed sensor

    TCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F50

    2

    F44

    35

    Continuity
    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    4.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR AND TCM (PART 2)

    Check continuity between primary speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.
    Primary speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F50

    2

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    5.CHECK TCM INPUT SIGNALS

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect all of disconnected connectors.
    Lift the vehicle.
    Start the engine.
    Check frequency of primary speed sensor.
    +

    TCM
    Connector

    Condition

    Frequency
    (Approx.)

    Terminal
    1,100 Hz

    F44

    35

    Ground

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    JSDIA1906GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-158

    2014 Note

    P0715 INPUT SPEED SENSOR A
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace primary speed sensor. TM-240, «Removal and Installation».

    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    A

    6.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN IPDM E/R AND PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal and primary speed sensor harness connector terminal.
    IPDM E/R

    Primary speed sensor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    21

    F50

    3

    B

    C
    Continuity
    Existed

    TM

    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    E

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEMS

    Check the following items:
    • Open circuit or short circuit in harness between ignition switch and IPDM E/R. Refer to PG-22, «Wiring Diagram — Ignition Power Supply —».
    • Short circuit in harness between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal 21 and primary speed sensor harness connector terminal 3.
    • 10A fuse (No.49, IPDM E/R). Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    • IPDM E/R
    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-159

    2014 Note

    P0720 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0720 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019940

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0720

    Output Speed Sensor Circuit

    DTC detection condition
    The output speed sensor value is less than
    150 rpm continuously for 10 seconds or more
    under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: “D”, “L” or “R” position
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — When the “D” position switch, “L” position
    switch or “R” position switch is ON, the output speed has not experienced 250 rpm or
    more.
    — After shifting the selector lever, the input
    speed has experienced less than 300 rpm.
    — Secondary pulley speed: 1,500 rpm or more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Possible causes

    • Harness or connector
    (Output speed sensor circuit is open or
    shorted)
    • Output speed sensor

    The output speed sensor value is 90 rpm or
    less continuously for 500 msec or more under
    the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — 10-msec-ago output speed: 730 rpm or
    more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK
    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    Vehicle speed

    : 55 km/h (34 MPH) or more

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0720” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-160, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019941

    1.CHECK OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR POWER CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect output speed sensor connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between output speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-160

    2014 Note

    P0720 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    A

    +

    Voltage

    Ground

    10 – 16 V

    Output speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F41

    3

    B

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    C

    2.CHECK OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT

    TM

    Check continuity between output speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.
    Output speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F41

    1

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    E

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR AND TCM (PART 1)

    G

    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between output speed sensor harness connector terminal and TCM harness connector
    terminal.
    Output speed sensor

    I

    TCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F41

    2

    F44

    24

    Continuity
    Existed

    J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    K

    Check continuity between output speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.

    L

    4.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR AND TCM (PART 2)
    Output speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F41

    2

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    N

    5.CHECK TCM INPUT SIGNALS
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    O

    Connect all of disconnected connectors.
    Lift the vehicle.
    Start the engine.
    Check frequency of output speed sensor.

    Revision: April 2013

    P

    TM-161

    2014 Note

    P0720 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    +

    TCM
    Connector

    Condition

    Frequency
    (Approx.)

    Terminal
    200 Hz

    F44

    24

    Ground

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    JSDIA1904GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace output speed sensor. Refer to TM-242, «Removal and Installation».

    6.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN IPDM E/R AND OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal and output speed sensor harness connector terminal.
    IPDM E/R

    Output speed sensor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    21

    F41

    3

    Continuity
    Existed

    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEMS

    Check the following items:
    • Open circuit or short circuit in harness between ignition switch and IPDM E/R. Refer to PG-22, «Wiring Diagram — Ignition Power Supply —».
    • Short circuit in harness between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal 21 and output speed sensor harness
    connector terminal 3.
    • 10A fuse (No.49, IPDM E/R). Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    • IPDM E/R
    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-162

    2014 Note

    P0740 TORQUE CONVERTER
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0740 TORQUE CONVERTER

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019942

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0740

    Torque Converter Clutch Circuit/Open

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    The TCM torque converter clutch solenoid
    valve current monitor reading is 200 mA or
    less continuously for 5 seconds or more under
    • Harness or connector
    the following diagnosis conditions:
    (Torque converter clutch solenoid
    • Diagnosis conditions
    valve circuit is open or shorted to pow- Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    er supply)
    more
    • Torque converter clutch solenoid valve
    — GND short diagnosis of the solenoid valve
    circuit is not satisfied.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION (PART 1)

    G

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION (PART 2)

    I

    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine.
    2. Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    3. Select “FLUID TEMP”.
    4. Confirm that the CVT fluid temperature is in the following range.
    FLUID TEMP

    J

    K

    : 10°C (50°F) or more

    With GST
    Start the engine.
    Set the CVT fluid to 10°C (50°F) or more.
    NOTE:
    When the ambient temperature is 20°C (68°F), the CVT fluid usually increases to 50 to 80°C (122 to
    176°F) with driving in an urban area for approximately 10 minutes.
    Is the CVT fluid 10°C (50°F) or more?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> 1. Warm the transaxle.
    2. GO TO 3.

    1.
    2.

    3.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.

    M

    N

    O

    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.

    P

    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    Vehicle speed

    : 40 km/h (25 MPH) or more

    3. Stop the vehicle.
    4. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0740” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-164, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END
    Revision: April 2013

    L

    TM-163

    2014 Note

    P0740 TORQUE CONVERTER
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019943

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and CVT unit harness connector terminal.
    TCM

    CVT unit

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    38

    F46

    8

    Continuity
    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE

    Check torque converter clutch solenoid valve. Refer to TM-164, «Component Inspection (Torque Converter
    Clutch Solenoid Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019944

    1.CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    8

    Ground

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    6.1 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.9 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    7.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of torque converter clutch solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly.
    Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-164

    2014 Note

    P0743 TORQUE CONVERTER
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0743 TORQUE CONVERTER

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019945

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0743

    Torque Converter Clutch Circuit Electrical

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    The TCM torque converter clutch solenoid
    valve current monitor reading is 200 mA or
    less continuously for 480 msec or more under
    • Harness or connector
    the following diagnosis conditions:
    (Torque converter clutch solenoid
    • Diagnosis conditions
    valve circuit is shorted to ground)
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    • Torque converter clutch solenoid valve
    more
    — GND short circuit diagnosis occurs in the
    solenoid valve drive circuit.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION (PART 1)

    G

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    H

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION (PART 2)

    I

    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine.
    2. Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    3. Select “FLUID TEMP”.
    4. Confirm that the CVT fluid temperature is in the following range.
    FLUID TEMP

    J

    K

    : 10°C (50°F) or more

    With GST
    Start the engine.
    Set the CVT fluid to 10°C (58°F) or more.
    NOTE:
    When the ambient temperature is 20°C (68°F), the CVT fluid usually increases to 50 to 80°C (122 to
    176°F) with driving in an urban area for approximately 10 minutes.
    Is the CVT fluid 10°C (58°F) or more?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> 1. Warm the transaxle.
    2. GO TO 3.

    1.
    2.

    3.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.

    M

    N

    O

    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 5 seconds or more.

    P

    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    Vehicle speed

    : 40 km/h (25 MPH) or more

    3. Stop the vehicle.
    4. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0743” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-166, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END
    Revision: April 2013

    L

    TM-165

    2014 Note

    P0743 TORQUE CONVERTER
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019946

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    TCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    38

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE

    Check torque converter clutch solenoid valve. Refer to TM-166, «Component Inspection (Torque Converter
    Clutch Solenoid Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019947

    1.CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    8

    Ground

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    6.1 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.9 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    7.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of torque converter clutch solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly.
    Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-166

    2014 Note

    P0744 TORQUE CONVERTER
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0744 TORQUE CONVERTER

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019948

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0744

    DTC detection condition

    Torque converter clutch circuit
    intermittent

    Possible causes

    The torque converter slip speed is at or above
    a set value (40 rpm + (Vehicle speed / 2) continuously for 30 seconds or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: “D” position
    • Torque converter clutch solenoid valve
    — Accelerator pedal position: 1.0/8 or more
    • Control valve assembly
    — Vehicle speed: 10 km/h (6 MPH) or more
    • Torque converter
    — Engine speed: 450 rpm or more
    — CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F) ≤ CVT
    fluid temperature ≤ 180°C (356°F)
    — Lockup command is being given (except for
    slip lockup).
    — LU PRS: More than 0.2 MPa
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    H

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    I

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION 1

    >> GO TO 2.

    J

    2.PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION 2
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “FLUID TEMP”.
    Confirm that the CVT fluid temperature is in the range below.
    FLUID TEMP

    K

    L

    : 20°C (68°F) or more

    With GST
    Start the engine.
    Set the CVT fluid to 20°C (68°F) or more.
    NOTE:
    When the ambient temperature is 20°C (68°F), the CVT fluid usually increases to 50 to 80°C (122 to
    176°F) with driving in an urban area for approximately 10 minutes.
    Is the CVT fluid 20°C (68°F) or more?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> 1. Warm the transaxle.
    2. GO TO 3.

    1.
    2.

    3.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.

    N

    O

    P

    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 40 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 1.0/8 or more

    Vehicle speed

    : 40 km/h (25 MPH) or more

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    TM-167

    2014 Note

    P0744 TORQUE CONVERTER
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    3. Stop the vehicle.
    4. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0744” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-168, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019949

    1.CHECK LINE PRESSURE
    Perform line pressure test. Refer to TM-131, «Work Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunction items.

    2.CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT unit connector.
    Check torque converter clutch solenoid valve. Refer to TM-168, «Component Inspection (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunction items.

    3.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the malfunction items.

    Component Inspection (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019950

    1.CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    8

    Ground

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    6.1 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.9 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    7.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of torque converter clutch solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly.
    Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-168

    2014 Note

    P0746 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0746 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    DTC Logic

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019951

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0746

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Pressure Control Solenoid A
    Performance/Stuck Off

    The detecting condition A or detection condition B is detected twice or more (1 second or
    more later after detection of the first) in the
    same DC under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — After the ignition switch is ON, 500 msec or
    more have passed.
    — Selector lever: Other than “P” and “N” positions
    — Idle is not being detected.
    — Engine speed: 600 rpm or more
    — Primary pulley speed: 500 rpm or more
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — Acceleration/deceleration speed: −0.05 G
    or more
    — The primary pulley speed experienced 306
    rpm or more and the secondary pulley
    speed experienced 230 rpm or more at
    least once.
    — The output speed is 107 rpm or less or the
    secondary pulley speed exceeds 61 rpm.
    • Detection condition A
    — Status with the shifting ratio of the primary
    pulley speed/secondary pulley ratio exceeding 2.55 is 200 msec or more continuously.
    • Detection condition B
    — Status with the shifting ratio of the primary
    pulley speed/secondary pulley ratio exceeding 3.35 is 100 msec or more continuously.

    Possible causes

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    • Line pressure solenoid valve
    • Control valve assembly

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    NOTE:
    DC stands for «DRIVING CYCLE» and indicates a series of driving cycle of «Ignition switch OFF → ON → driving → OFF».

    L

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    M

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK
    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    N

    O

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    P

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.1/8 or more

    Vehicle speed

    : 40 km/h (25 MPH) or more

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-169

    2014 Note

    P0746 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0746”detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-170, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019952

    1.CHECK LINE PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT unit connector.
    Check line pressure solenoid valve. Refer to TM-170, «Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid
    Valve)»
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK LINE PRESSURE

    Perform line pressure test. Refer to TM-131, «Work Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019953

    1.CHECK LINE PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    1

    Ground

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of line pressure solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-170

    2014 Note

    P0846 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0846 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019954

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0846

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Transmission Fluid Pressure
    Sensor/Switch B Circuit
    Range/Performance

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    The detection conditions continuously for 5
    seconds or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: “D” position
    — The primary pulley speed experienced 306
    rpm or more and the secondary pulley
    speed experienced 230 rpm or more at
    least once.
    — Wheel spin is not being detected.
    — The rate of change in pulley ratio: Between
    −0.09 and +0.09 inclusive
    • Secondary pressure sensor
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    • Control valve assembly
    more
    — GND short diagnosis of the solenoid valve
    circuit is not satisfied.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    • Detection conditions
    — After the value of “Actual secondary pressure − Target secondary pressure” exceeds
    0.675 MPa:
    • The rate of change in vehicle speed [km/h
    (MPH)]: Between −49 (−30) and +49 (+30)
    inclusive
    • The rate of change in accelerator pedal angle: Between −1.3/8 and +1.3/8 inclusive

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    K

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK
    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    L

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    M

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Start the engine.
    Shift the selector lever to “D” position.
    Drive the vehicle at a constant velocity of 40 km/h (25 MPH) at lease for 10 seconds.
    CAUTION:
    At the same time, the accelerator pedal angle must be maintained constant.
    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0846”detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-171, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    N

    O

    P
    INFOID:0000000009019955

    1.CHECK TCM INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Start the engine.
    Check voltage between TCM connector terminal and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-171

    2014 Note

    P0846 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    +

    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    16

    Ground

    Condition

    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    Voltage

    0.88 – 0.92 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of secondary pressure sensor value. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to
    TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-172

    2014 Note

    P0847 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0847 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    DTC Logic

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019956

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Transmission Fluid Pressure
    Sensor/Switch B Circuit Low

    P0847

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    The secondary pressure sensor voltage is
    0.09 V or less continuously for 5 seconds or
    • Harness or connector
    more under the following diagnosis condi(Secondary pressure sensor circuit is
    tions:
    open or shorted to ground)
    • Diagnosis conditions
    • Secondary pressure sensor
    — CVT fluid temperature: −20°C (−4°F) or
    • Control valve assembly
    more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    C

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    H

    With CONSULT
    1. Start the engine.
    2. Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    3. Select “FLUID TEMP”.
    4. Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    FLUID TEMP

    I

    J

    : −19°C (−2.2°F) or more

    5.

    Check the first trip DTC.
    With GST
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 10 seconds.
    CAUTION:
    When the ambient temperature is −20°C (−4°F) or less and the engine is cold, warm up the engine
    for approximately 5 minutes.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0847”detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-173, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    Connector

    CVT unit
    Terminal

    Connector

    11
    F44

    16

    Terminal

    F46

    14

    Existed

    22

    Is the inspection result normal?

    TM-173

    O

    P

    Continuity

    18

    26

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    N

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals and CVT unit harness connector terminals.
    TCM

    L

    INFOID:0000000009019957

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT (PART 1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    K

    2014 Note

    P0847 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT (PART 2)
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals and ground.
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal
    16

    F44

    26

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK TCM INPUT SIGNALS

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Connect all connectors removed.
    Start the engine.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    +

    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    16

    Ground

    Condition

    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    Voltage

    0.88 – 0.92 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> There is malfunction of secondary pressure sensor. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-174

    2014 Note

    P0848 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0848 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    DTC Logic

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019958

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0848

    DTC detection condition

    Transmission Fluid Pressure
    Sensor/Switch B Circuit Low

    Possible causes

    The secondary pressure sensor voltage is 4.7
    V or more continuously for 5 seconds or more
    • Harness or connector
    under the following diagnosis conditions:
    (Secondary pressure sensor circuit is
    • Diagnosis conditions
    shorted to power supply)
    — CVT fluid temperature: −20°C (−4°F) or
    • Secondary pressure sensor
    more
    — Secondary pressure target value: 5.7 MPa • Control valve assembly
    or less
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    C

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, the ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    H

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “FLUID TEMP”.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.

    I

    J

    : −19°C (−2.2°F) or more

    FLUID TEMP

    5.

    Check the first trip DTC.
    With GST
    1. Start the engine and wait for at least 10 seconds.
    CAUTION:
    When the ambient temperature is −20°C (−4°F) or less and the engine is cold, warm up the engine
    for approximately 5 minutes.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0848”detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-175, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019959

    K

    L

    M

    N

    1.CHECK SECONDARY PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    O

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT unit connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between CVT unit harness connector terminal and ground.

    P

    +

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    5.0 V

    CVT unit
    Connector

    Terminal

    F46

    22

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-175

    2014 Note

    P0848 TRANSMISSION FLUID PRESSURE SEN/SW B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK SECONDARY PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals.
    TCM
    Connector

    Continuity

    Terminal

    F46

    22

    Other than 22

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK TCM INPUT SIGNALS

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Connect all connectors removed.
    Start the engine.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    +
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F46

    22

    Condition

    Voltage

    Ground

    • Selector lever: “N” position
    • At idle

    0.88 – 0.92 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of secondary pressure sensor. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-176

    2014 Note

    P0863 TCM COMMUNICATION
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0863 TCM COMMUNICATION

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019960

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC
    P0863

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name
    TCM Communication Circuit

    DTC detection condition
    An error is detected at the initial CAN diagnosis of TCM.

    Possible causes

    C

    TCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    TM

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    E

    F

    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “P0863” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-177, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    G

    H
    INFOID:0000000009019961

    1.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDNT

    I

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace TCM. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-177

    2014 Note

    P0890 TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0890 TCM
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019962

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0890

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    Transmission control module
    power relay sense circuit low

    The battery voltage supplied to the TCM is
    less than 8.4 V continuously for 200 msec or
    more under the following diagnosis condition:
    • Diagnosis condition
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    • Harness or connector
    (TCM power supply (back-up) circuit is
    open or shorted.)
    • TCM

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the DTC.
    Is “P0890” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-178, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019963

    1.CHECK TCM POWER SUPPLY (BACK-UP) CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminals and ground.
    +
    TCM
    Connector
    F44

    Voltage

    Ground

    10 – 16 V

    Terminal
    45
    46

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    2.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT

    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace TCM. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEMS

    Check the following items:
    • Open circuit or short circuit in harness between battery positive terminal and TCM connectors terminals 45,
    and 46.
    • 10A fuse (No.25, fuse and fusible link block). Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-178

    2014 Note

    P0890 TCM
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-179

    2014 Note

    P0962 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0962 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019964

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0962

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    Pressure Control Solenoid A
    Control Circuit Low

    The line pressure solenoid valve current is
    200 mA or less continuously for 200 msec or
    more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid output current: 750 mA or more
    — GND short diagnosis of the solenoid drive
    circuit is satisfied.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    • Harness or connector
    (Line pressure solenoid valve circuit is
    shorted to ground)
    • Line pressure solenoid valve

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0962” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-180, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019965

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    30

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK LINE PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE

    Check line pressure solenoid valve. Refer to TM-180, «Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid
    Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019966

    1.CHECK LINE PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-180

    2014 Note

    P0962 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    1

    Ground

    A

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    B

    C
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of line pressure solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM250, «Removal and Installation».
    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-181

    2014 Note

    P0963 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0963 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019967

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0963

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    Pressure Control Solenoid A
    Control Circuit High

    The line pressure solenoid valve current is
    200 mA or less continuously for 200 msec or
    more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid output current: 750 mA or more
    — GND short diagnosis of the solenoid drive
    circuit is not satisfied.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    • Harness or connector
    (Line pressure solenoid valve circuit is
    open or shorted to power supply)
    • Line pressure solenoid valve

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0963” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-182, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019968

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and CVT unit harness connector terminal.
    TCM

    CVT unit

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    30

    F46

    1

    Continuity
    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK LINE PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE

    Check line pressure solenoid valve. Refer to TM-182, «Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid
    Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Line Pressure Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019969

    1.CHECK LINE PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-182

    2014 Note

    P0963 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID A
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    1

    Ground

    A

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    B

    C
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of line pressure solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM250, «Removal and Installation».
    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-183

    2014 Note

    P0965 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0965 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019970

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P0965

    DTC detection condition
    The detection conditions continuously for 5
    seconds or more under the following diagnosis
    conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: Other than “P” and “N” positions
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — Engine speed: More than 500 rpm
    • Detection condition A
    — Actual primary pulley ratio: 2.0 – 2.4
    — Target primary pulley ratio: Less than 1.2
    • Detection condition B
    — Actual primary pulley ratio: 0.35 – 0.75
    — Target primary pulley ratio: More than 1.55

    Pressure control solenoid B
    control circuit range performance

    Possible causes

    Primary pressure solenoid valve

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to perform “TM-184, «Diagnosis Procedure»” and then perform “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE”.
    • Never perform “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE” before the repairs. Doing so may result in a secondary malfunction.
    • Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 20 seconds or more.
    Vehicle speed

    : 20 km/h (13 MPH) or more

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0965”detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-184, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019971

    1.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-184

    2014 Note

    P0966 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0966 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019972

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0966

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition
    The primary pressure solenoid valve current is
    200 mA or less continuously for 480 msec or
    more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    more
    — GND short circuit diagnosis occurs in the
    solenoid valve drive circuit.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Pressure control solenoid B
    control circuit low

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    (Primary pressure solenoid valve circuit shorted to ground)
    • Primary pressure solenoid valve

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    H

    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0966” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-185, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    Diagnosis Procedure

    J
    INFOID:0000000009019973

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    40

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    N

    2.CHECK PRIMARY PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE

    O

    Check primary pressure solenoid valve. Refer to TM-185, «Component Inspection (Primary Pressure Solenoid
    Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019974

    1.CHECK PRIMARY PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-185

    2014 Note

    P

    P0966 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    2

    Ground

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of primary pressure solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to
    TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-186

    2014 Note

    P0967 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0967 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B
    DTC Logic

    A
    INFOID:0000000009019975

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0967

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition
    The primary pressure solenoid valve current is
    200 mA or less continuously for 200 msec or
    more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    more
    — GND short diagnosis of the solenoid valve
    circuit is not satisfied.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Pressure control solenoid B
    control circuit high

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    (Primary pressure solenoid valve circuit open or shorted to power supply)
    • Primary pressure solenoid valve

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    H

    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0967” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-187, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    J

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019976

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and CVT unit harness connector terminal.
    TCM

    CVT unit

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    40

    F46

    2

    Continuity

    M

    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    N

    2.CHECK PRIMARY PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE

    O

    Check primary pressure solenoid valve. Refer to TM-187, «Component Inspection (Primary Pressure Solenoid
    Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Primary Pressure Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019977

    1.CHECK PRIMARY PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-187

    2014 Note

    P

    P0967 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID B
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    2

    Ground

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of primary pressure solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to
    TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-188

    2014 Note

    P0998 SHIFT SOLENOID F
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0998 SHIFT SOLENOID F

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019978

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0998

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Shift solenoid F control circuit
    low

    The TCM low brake solenoid valve current
    monitor reading is 200 mA or less continuously for 480 msec or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    more
    — GND short circuit diagnosis occurs in the
    solenoid valve drive circuit.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    (Low brake solenoid valve circuit shorted to ground)
    • Low brake solenoid valve

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    >> GO TO 2.

    H

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1. Start the engine.
    2. Shift the selector lever to “D” position and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    3. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0998” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-189, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J

    INFOID:0000000009019979

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.

    K

    L

    M

    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    39

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    O

    2.CHECK LOW BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE

    Check low brake solenoid valve. Refer to TM-189, «Component Inspection (Low Brake Solenoid Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Low Brake Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019980

    1.CHECK LOW BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-189

    2014 Note

    P

    P0998 SHIFT SOLENOID F
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    6

    Ground

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of low brake solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250,
    «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-190

    2014 Note

    P0999 SHIFT SOLENOID F
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P0999 SHIFT SOLENOID F

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019981

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P0999

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Shift solenoid F control circuit
    high

    The TCM low brake solenoid valve current
    monitor reading is 200 mA or less continuously for 200 msec or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    more
    — GND short diagnosis of the solenoid valve
    circuit is not satisfied.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    (Low brake solenoid valve circuit is
    open or shorted to power supply)
    • Low brake solenoid valve

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    >> GO TO 2.

    H

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1. Start the engine.
    2. Shift the selector lever to “D” position and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    3. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P0999” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-191, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J

    INFOID:0000000009019982

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and CVT unit harness connector terminal.
    TCM

    L

    M

    CVT unit

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    39

    F46

    6

    Continuity
    Existed

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    O

    2.CHECK LOW BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE

    Check low brake solenoid valve. Refer to TM-191, «Component Inspection (Low Brake Solenoid Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (Low Brake Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019983

    1.CHECK LOW BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE
    Revision: April 2013

    K

    TM-191

    2014 Note

    P

    P0999 SHIFT SOLENOID F
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    6

    Ground

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    Condition
    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of low brake solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250,
    «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-192

    2014 Note

    P099B SHIFT SOLENOID G
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P099B SHIFT SOLENOID G

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019984

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P099B

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Shift solenoid G control circuit
    low

    The TCM high clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve current monitor reading is 200 mA or
    less continuously for 200 msec or more under
    the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    more
    — GND short circuit diagnosis occurs in the
    solenoid valve drive circuit.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    (High& clutch reverse brake solenoid
    valve circuit shorted to ground)
    • High clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    >> GO TO 2.

    H

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more.
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P099B” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-193, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    I

    J
    INFOID:0000000009019985

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    37

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    M

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK HIGH CLUTCH & REVERSE BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE

    O

    Check high clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve. Refer to TM-193, «Component Inspection (High Clutch &
    Reverse Brake Solenoid Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (High Clutch & Reverse Brake Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019986

    1.CHECK HIGH CLUTCH & REVERSE BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-193

    2014 Note

    P

    P099B SHIFT SOLENOID G
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    7

    Ground

    Condition

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of high & reverse brake solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer
    to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-194

    2014 Note

    P099C SHIFT SOLENOID G
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P099C SHIFT SOLENOID G

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019987

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P099C

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    Shift solenoid G control circuit
    high

    The TCM high clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve current monitor reading is 200 mA or
    less continuously for 200 msec or more under
    the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Solenoid valve output current: 750 mA or
    more
    — GND short diagnosis of the solenoid valve
    circuit is not satisfied.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Possible causes

    C
    • Harness or connector
    (High clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve circuit is open or shorted to power supply)
    • High clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve

    TM

    E

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    F

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    G

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    >> GO TO 2.

    H

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1. Start the engine and wait for 5 seconds or more
    2. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P099C” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-195, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    I

    J

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019988

    1.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND CVT UNIT

    K

    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector and CVT unit connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and CVT unit harness connector terminal.
    TCM

    CVT unit

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    37

    F46

    7

    M

    Continuity
    Existed

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    2.CHECK HIGH CLUTCH & REVERSE BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE

    O

    Check high clutch & reverse brake solenoid valve. Refer to TM-195, «Component Inspection (High Clutch &
    Reverse Brake Solenoid Valve)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Component Inspection (High Clutch & Reverse Brake Solenoid Valve)

    INFOID:0000000009019989

    1.CHECK HIGH CLUTCH & REVERSE BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-195

    2014 Note

    P

    P099C SHIFT SOLENOID G
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Check resistance between CVT unit connector terminal and ground.
    CVT unit
    Terminal

    7

    Ground

    Condition

    Resistance
    (Approx.)

    CVT fluid temperature: 20°C (68°F)

    5.3 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 50°C (122°F)

    6.0 Ω

    CVT fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)

    6.7 Ω

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> There is a malfunction of high & reverse brake solenoid valve. Replace transaxle assembly. Refer
    to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-196

    2014 Note

    P1586 G SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1586 G SENSOR

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019990

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P1586

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    G Sensor Circuit Electrical

    DTC detection condition

    Possible causes

    C

    When the following diagnosis conditions are
    satisfied and the detection conditions are satisfied twice in the same DC:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — While driving
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    • Detection condition
    — The G sensor detection voltage is 0.7 V or
    • Harness or connector
    less continuously for 5 seconds or more.
    (G sensor circuit)
    When the following diagnosis conditions are
    • G sensor
    satisfied and the detection conditions are satisfied twice in the same DC:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — While driving
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    • Detection condition
    — The G sensor detection voltage is 3.2 V or
    more continuously for 5 seconds or more.

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    NOTE:
    DC stands for «DRIVING CYCLE» and indicates a series of driving cycle of «Ignition switch OFF → ON → driving → OFF».

    H

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE

    I

    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    J

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    K

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION

    L

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle for 10 seconds or more.
    Stop the vehicle.
    CAUTION:
    Never stop the engine.
    4. Repeat step 2 through 3.
    5. Check the DTC.
    Is “P1586” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-197, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    M

    N

    O

    INFOID:0000000009019991

    1.CHECK G SENSOR SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT
    Park the vehicle on a level surface.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-197

    2014 Note

    P

    P1586 G SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    4. Select “G SEN SLOPE”.
    5. Swing the vehicle and check if value varies between −40.45% and 40.45%.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    Standard

    Flat road
    G SEN SLOPE

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    0%

    Uphill

    Positive value (Maximum 40.45%)
    Negative value (Minimum −40.45%)

    Downhill

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    2.G SENSOR CALIBRATION (PART 1)
    1.
    2.

    With CONSULT
    Select “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Touch “Erase”.
    >> Perform «G SENSOR CALIBRATION». Refer to TM-129, «Procedure».

    3.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect G sensor connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between G sensor harness connector terminal and ground.
    +
    G sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    M83

    3

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Ground

    5.0 V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 8.

    4.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND G SENSOR (PART 1)

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals and G sensor harness connector terminals.
    TCM
    Connector

    G sensor
    Terminal

    Connector

    11

    F44

    14

    M83

    Terminal
    2

    Continuity

    Existed

    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    5.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN TCM AND G SENSOR (PART 2)

    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals and ground.
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    14

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-198

    2014 Note

    P1586 G SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    A

    6.CHECK G SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove G sensor. TM-237, «Removal and Installation».
    Connect the all connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and
    ground.

    B

    C

    : Direction of gravitational force

    TM
    +

    TCM
    Connector

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    E

    Terminal

    F44

    14

    Ground

    Vertical (−1G) (A)

    1.17 V

    Horizontal (B)

    2.5 V

    Vertical (1G) (C)

    3.83 V

    SCIA8343J

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Replace G sensor.TM-237, «Removal and Installation».

    G

    7.G SENSOR CALIBRATION (PART 2)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    With CONSULT
    Install G sensor. TM-237, «Removal and Installation».
    Select “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Touch “Erase”.

    I

    >> Perform «G SENSOR CALIBRATION». Refer to TM-129, «Procedure».

    J

    8.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (PART 1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and G sensor harness connector terminal.
    TCM

    L

    G sensor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    26

    M83

    3

    Continuity
    Existed

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 9.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    N

    9.CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (PART 2)
    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminal and ground.
    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    F44

    26

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    O

    P

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    K

    TM-199

    2014 Note

    P1588 G SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P1588 G SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019992

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P1588

    Trouble diagnosis name

    DTC detection condition

    G Sensor Circuit Range/Performance

    When the following diagnosis conditions are
    satisfied and the detection conditions are satisfied twice in the same DC:
    • Diagnosis condition (1 second or more)
    — The rate of change in G sensor detection
    value (mV): Between −15 and +15 inclusive
    • Detection condition
    — The rate of change in acceleration/deceleration stays +0.0273 G or more/−0.0273 or
    less at least for 5 seconds or more.

    Possible causes

    G sensor

    NOTE:
    DC stands for «DRIVING CYCLE» and indicates a series of driving cycle of «Ignition switch OFF → ON → driving → OFF».

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK
    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “G SPEED”.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    G SPEED

    : 0.05 G or more

    6.

    Stop the vehicle.
    CAUTION:
    Never stop the engine.
    7. Repeat steps 4 through 6.
    8. Check the DTC.
    Is “P1588” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-200, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019993

    1.CHECK G SENSOR SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    With CONSULT
    Park the vehicle on a level surface.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “G SEN SLOPE”.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-200

    2014 Note

    P1588 G SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    5. Swing the vehicle and check if value varies between −40.45% and 40.45%.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    A

    Monitor item

    Condition

    Standard

    Flat road
    G SEN SLOPE

    0%

    Uphill

    B

    Positive value (Maximum 40.45%)
    Negative value (Minimum −40.45%)

    Downhill

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    C

    2.G SENSOR CALIBRATION (PART 1)
    1.
    2.

    TM

    With CONSULT
    Select “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Touch “Erase”.

    E

    >> Perform «G SENSOR CALIBRATION». Refer to TM-129, «Procedure».

    F

    3.CHECK G SENSOR
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove G sensor. TM-237, «Removal and Installation».
    Connect the all connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminal and
    ground.

    G

    H

    : Direction of gravitational force

    I
    +

    TCM
    Connector

    F44

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Condition

    J

    Terminal

    14

    Ground

    Vertical (−1G) (A)

    1.17 V

    Horizontal (B)

    2.5 V

    Vertical (1G) (C)

    3.83 V

    SCIA8343J

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Replace G sensor.TM-237, «Removal and Installation».

    L

    4.G SENSOR CALIBRATION (PART 2)

    M

    With CONSULT
    1. Install G sensor. TM-237, «Removal and Installation».
    2. Select “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    3. Touch “Erase”.

    N

    >> Perform «G SENSOR CALIBRATION». Refer to TM-129, «Procedure».

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-201

    2014 Note

    P2765 CLUTCH B SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2765 CLUTCH B SPEED SENSOR
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019994

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P2765

    Input/Turbine Speed Sensor B
    Circuit

    DTC detection condition
    The secondary speed sensor value is less
    than 150 rpm continuously for 5 seconds or
    more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Primary pulley speed: 1,000 rpm or more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    The secondary pulley speed sensor value is
    240 rpm or less continuously for 500 msec or
    more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis condition
    — 10-msec-ago secondary pulley speed:
    1,000 rpm or more
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Possible causes

    • Harness or connector
    (Secondary speed sensor circuit is
    open or shorted)
    • Secondary speed sensor

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK
    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    Vehicle speed

    : 55 km/h (34 MPH) or more

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P2765” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-202, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019995

    1.CHECK SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR POWER CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect secondary speed sensor connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between secondary speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.
    +

    Voltage

    Ground

    10 – 16 V

    Secondary speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F48

    3

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-202

    2014 Note

    P2765 CLUTCH B SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 6.

    A

    2.CHECK SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between of primary speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.
    Secondary speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F48

    1

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    B

    C

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    TM

    3.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR AND TCM (PART 1)
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check continuity between secondary speed sensor harness connector terminal and TCM harness connector terminal.
    Secondary speed sensor

    TCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    F48

    2

    F44

    34

    E

    F

    G

    Continuity
    Existed

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    4.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR AND TCM (PART 2)

    I

    Check continuity between secondary speed sensor harness connector terminal and ground.
    J
    Secondary speed sensor
    Connector

    Terminal

    F48

    2

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    K

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    L

    5.CHECK TCM INPUT SIGNALS
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Connect all of disconnected connectors.
    Lift the vehicle.
    Start the engine.
    Check frequency of secondary speed sensor.

    M

    N

    +

    TCM
    Connector

    Condition

    Frequency
    (Approx.)

    O

    Terminal
    700 Hz

    F44

    34

    Ground

    P

    • Selector lever: “L” position
    • Vehicle speed: 20 km/h (12 MPH)

    JSDIA1905GB

    Is the inspection result normal?
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-203

    2014 Note

    P2765 CLUTCH B SPEED SENSOR
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace secondary speed sensor. TM-241, «Removal and Installation».

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    6.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN IPDM E/R AND SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR
    1.
    2.

    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal and secondary speed sensor harness
    connector terminal.
    IPDM E/R

    Secondary speed sensor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    21

    F48

    3

    Continuity
    Existed

    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 7.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    7.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEMS

    Check the following items:
    • Open circuit or short circuit in harness between ignition switch and IPDM E/R. Refer to PG-22, «Wiring Diagram — Ignition Power Supply —».
    • Short circuit in harness between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal 21 and secondary speed sensor harness connector terminal 3.
    • 10A fuse (No.49, IPDM E/R). Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    • IPDM E/R
    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-204

    2014 Note

    P2857 CLUTCH A PRESSURE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2857 CLUTCH A PRESSURE

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019996

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P2857

    DTC detection condition
    The auxiliary gearbox gear ratio is 2.232 or
    more for the auxiliary gearbox 1GR ratio continuously for 5 seconds or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: Other than “P”, “R” and “N”
    positions
    — Accelerator pedal position: 0.7/8 or more
    — Engine speed: More than 550 rpm
    — Output speed: More than 300 rpm
    — Secondary pulley speed: More than 300
    rpm
    — Command for the 1GR of auxiliary gearbox
    is in progress.
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Clutch A pressure engagement performance

    Possible causes

    C

    TM

    • Low brake solenoid valve
    • Control valve assembly

    E

    F

    G

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to perform “TM-205, «Diagnosis Procedure»” and then perform “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE”.
    • Never perform «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» before the repairs. Doing so may result in a secondary malfunction.
    • Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.

    M

    Selector lever

    : “L” POSITION

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.7/8 or more

    Vehicle speed

    : 10 km/h (6 MPH) or more

    N

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P2857” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-205, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    O

    INFOID:0000000009019997

    1.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-205

    2014 Note

    P

    P2858 CLUTCH B PRESSURE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2858 CLUTCH B PRESSURE
    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009019998

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    Trouble diagnosis name

    P2858

    DTC detection condition
    The auxiliary gearbox gear ratio is 2.232 or
    more for the auxiliary gearbox 2GR ratio continuously for 5 seconds or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: Other than “P”, “R” and “N”
    positions
    — Accelerator pedal position: 0.7/8 or more
    — Engine speed: More than 550 rpm
    — Output speed: More than 300 rpm
    — Secondary pulley speed: More than 300
    rpm
    — Command for the 2GR of auxiliary gearbox
    is in progress.
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    Clutch B pressure engagement performance

    Possible causes

    • High clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve
    • Control valve assembly

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to perform “TM-206, «Diagnosis Procedure»” and then perform “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE”.
    • Never perform «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» before the repairs. Doing so may result in a secondary malfunction.
    • Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “D” POSITION

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.7/8 or more

    Vehicle speed

    : 45 km/h (28 MPH) or more

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P2858” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-206, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009019999

    1.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-206

    2014 Note

    P2859 CLUTCH A PRESSURE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P2859 CLUTCH A PRESSURE

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009020000

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P2859

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Clutch A pressuren disengagement performance

    DTC detection condition
    The detection conditions continuously for 200
    msec or more under the following diagnosis
    conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: Other than “P”, “R” and “N”
    positions
    — Vehicle speed: 10 km/h (6 MPH) or more
    — Engine speed: More than 550 rpm
    — Output speed: More than 300 rpm
    — Secondary pulley speed: More than 300
    rpm
    — A lapse of 500 msec or more after the stop
    lamp switch is turned from ON to OFF.
    — Command for the 2GR of auxiliary gearbox
    is in progress.
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    • Detection conditions
    — Acceleration/deceleration: Less than −0.05
    G
    — Actual auxiliary gearbox gear ratio − Auxiliary gearbox 2GR ratio ≥ 50%

    Possible causes

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    • Low brake solenoid valve
    • Control valve assembly

    H

    The auxiliary gearbox gear ratio is ±10% or
    less for the auxiliary gearbox 1GR ratio continuously for 500 msec or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: Other than “P”, “R” and “N”
    positions
    — Accelerator pedal position: 0.7/8 or more
    — Engine speed: More than 550 rpm
    — Secondary pulley speed: More than 300
    rpm
    — Output speed: More than 300 rpm
    — Command for the 2GR of auxiliary gearbox
    is in progress.
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    DTC COFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to perform «TM-208, «Diagnosis Procedure»» and then perform «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE».
    • Never perform «TC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» before the repairs. Doing so may result in a secondary malfunction.
    • Be careful of the driving speed.

    N

    O

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    1.

    Start the engine.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-207

    2014 Note

    P

    P2859 CLUTCH A PRESSURE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    2. Drive the vehicle.
    3. Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.
    Selector lever

    : “D” position

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.7/8 or more

    Vehicle speed

    : 45 km/h (28 MPH) or more

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    4. Stop the vehicle
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P2859” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-208, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009020001

    1.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-208

    2014 Note

    P285A CLUTCH B PRESSURE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    P285A CLUTCH B PRESSURE

    A

    DTC Logic

    INFOID:0000000009020002

    DTC DETECTION LOGIC
    DTC

    P285A

    B

    Trouble diagnosis name

    Clutch B pressure disengagement performance

    DTC detection condition
    The detection conditions continuously for 200
    msec or more under the following diagnosis
    conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: Other than “P”, “R” and “N”
    positions
    — Vehicle speed: 10 km/h (6 MPH) or more
    — Engine speed: More than 550 rpm
    — Output speed: More than 300 rpm
    — Secondary pulley speed: More than 300
    rpm
    — Command for the 1GR of auxiliary gearbox
    is in progress.
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V
    • Detection conditions
    — Acceleration/deceleration: Less than −0.05
    G
    — Actual auxiliary gearbox gear ratio − Auxiliary gearbox 1GR ratio ≥ 50%

    Possible causes

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    • High clutch & reverse brake solenoid
    valve
    • Control valve assembly

    The auxiliary gearbox gear ratio is ±10% or
    less for the auxiliary gearbox 2GR ratio continuously for 500 msec or more under the following diagnosis conditions:
    • Diagnosis conditions
    — Selector lever: Other than “P”, “R” and “N”
    positions
    — Accelerator pedal position: 0.7/8 or more
    — Engine speed: More than 550 rpm
    — Secondary pulley speed: More than 300
    rpm
    — Output speed: More than 300 rpm
    — Command for the 1GR of auxiliary gearbox
    is in progress.
    — Auxiliary gearbox shifting is not in progress.
    — TCM power supply voltage: More than 11 V

    I

    J

    K

    L

    DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
    CAUTION:
    • Be sure to perform “TM-210, «Diagnosis Procedure»” and then perform “DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE”.
    • Never perform «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» before the repairs. Doing so may result in a secondary malfunction.
    • Be careful of the driving speed.

    1.PREPARATION BEFORE WORK

    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK DTC DETECTION
    Start the engine.
    Drive the vehicle.
    Maintain the following conditions for 10 seconds or more.

    Revision: April 2013

    M

    N

    O

    If another «DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE» occurs just before, turn ignition switch OFF and wait for at
    least 10 seconds, then perform the next test.

    1.
    2.
    3.

    H

    TM-209

    2014 Note

    P

    P285A CLUTCH B PRESSURE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Selector lever

    : “L” POSITION

    Accelerator pedal position

    : 0.7/8 or more

    Vehicle speed

    : 10 km/h (6 MPH) or more

    4. Stop the vehicle.
    5. Check the first trip DTC.
    Is “P285A” detected?
    YES >> Go to TM-210, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> INSPECTION END

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009020003

    1.CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
    Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace transaxle assembly. Refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-210

    2014 Note

    MAIN POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    MAIN POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    A
    INFOID:0000000009020004

    1.CHECK TCM POWER CIRCUIT (PART 1)

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect TCM connector.
    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminals and ground.
    +

    Voltage

    TM

    Ground

    10 – 16 V

    E

    TCM
    Connector

    Terminal
    45

    F44

    46

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    F

    2.CHECK TCM POWER CIRCUIT (PART 2)

    G

    Check voltage between TCM harness connector terminals and ground.
    +

    H

    TCM
    Connector

    Condition

    Voltage

    Terminal
    47

    F44

    Ground
    48

    Ignition switch ON

    10 – 16 V

    Ignition switch OFF

    Approx. 0 V

    Ignition switch ON

    10 – 16 V

    Ignition switch OFF

    Approx. 0 V

    I

    J

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    K

    3.CHECK TCM GROUND CIRCUIT

    L

    Check continuity between TCM harness connector terminals and ground.
    TCM
    Connector
    F44

    Terminal
    41
    42

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    M

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    O

    4.DETECT MALFUNCTION ITEMS (PART 1)

    Check the following items:
    • Open circuit or short circuit in harness between battery positive terminal and TCM connectors terminals 45,
    and 46.
    • 10A fuse (No.33, fuse and fusible link block). Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-211

    2014 Note

    P

    MAIN POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    5.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN IPDM E/R AND TCM
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R connector.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal and TCM harness connector terminals.
    IPDM E/R

    TCM

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    E45

    21

    F44

    Terminal
    47

    Continuity

    Existed

    48

    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    6.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING ITEMS (PART 2)

    Check the following items:
    • Open circuit or short circuit in harness between ignition switch and IPDM E/R. Refer to PG-22, «Wiring Diagram — Ignition Power Supply —».
    • Short circuit in harness between IPDM E/R harness connector terminal 21 and TCM harness connector terminal 47, and 48.
    • 10A fuse (No.49, IPDM E/R). Refer to PG-39, «IPDM E/R Terminal Arrangement».
    • IPDM E/R
    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-212

    2014 Note

    OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009020005

    1.CHECK OD OFF INDICATOR LAMP FUNCTION

    B

    Check OD OFF indicator lamp turns ON for approx. 2 seconds when ignition switch turns ON.
    Is the inspection results normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Go to TM-215, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    2.CHECK OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH FUNCTION

    TM

    1. Shift the selector lever to “D” position.
    2. Check that OD OFF indicator lamp turns ON/OFF when overdrive control switch is operated.
    Is the inspection results normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Go to TM-213, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    INFOID:0000000009020006

    1.CHECK OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    G

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT shift selector connector.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between CVT shift selector harness connector terminals.

    H

    CVT shift selector
    Connector
    M38

    +

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    I

    2

    5V

    J

    Terminal
    1

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    K

    2.CHECK OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH
    Check overdrive control switch. Refer to TM-214, «Component Inspection (Overdrive Control Switch)».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    Check continuity between CVT shift selector harness connector terminal and ground.
    CVT shift selector
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    2

    Continuity

    Ground

    Existed

    O

    P

    4.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN COMBINATION METER AND CVT SHIFT SELECTOR (PART 1)
    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination meter connector.
    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector terminal and CVT shift selector harness
    connector terminal.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-213

    M

    N

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    1.
    2.
    3.

    L

    2014 Note

    OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Combination meter

    CVT shift selector

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    8

    M38

    1

    Continuity
    Existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    5.CHECK CIRCUIT BETWEEN COMBINATION METER AND CVT SHIFT SELECTOR (PART 2)
    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector terminal and ground.
    Combination meter
    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    8

    Continuity

    Ground

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 6.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.

    6.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Connect all of disconnected connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “METER/M&A”.
    Select “O/D OFF SW”.
    Check that “O/D OFF SW” turns ON/OFF when overdrive control switch is operated. Refer to MWI-17,
    «Reference Value».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check intermittent incident. Refer to GI-41, «Intermittent Incident».
    NO
    >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».

    Component Inspection (Overdrive Control Switch)

    INFOID:0000000009020007

    1.CHECK OVERDRIVE CONTROL SWITCH
    Check continuity between wires of selector lever knob (1)
    Condition

    Continuity

    Overdrive control switch is depressed

    Existed

    Overdrive control switch is depressed

    Not existed

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Replace
    selector lever knob. Refer to TM-227,
    «Removal and Installation».
    JSDIA1969ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-214

    2014 Note

    OD OFF INDICATOR LAMP
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    OD OFF INDICATOR LAMP

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009020008

    1.CHECK OD OFF INDICATOR LAMP FUNCTION

    B

    Check OD OFF indicator lamp turns ON for approx. 2 seconds when ignition switch turns ON.
    Is the inspection results normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Go to TM-215, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009020009

    TM

    1.CHECK DTC (TCM)
    E

    With CONSULT
    1. Turn ignition switch ON.
    2. Check “Self Diagnostic Results” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check DTC detected item. Refer to TM-111, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2.CHECK DTC (COMBINATION METER)

    G

    With CONSULT
    Check “Self Diagnostic Results” in “METER/M&A”.
    Is any DTC detected?
    YES >> Check DTC detected item. Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    H

    I

    3.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL

    With CONSULT
    Shift the selector lever to “D” position.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “METER/M&A”.
    Select “O/D OFF IND”.
    Check that “O/D OFF IND” turns ON/OFF when overdrive control switch is operated. Refer to MWI-17,
    «Reference Value».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    J

    K

    L

    4.CHECK TCM INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL

    With CONSULT
    1. Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    2. Select “SPORT MODE SW”.
    3. Check that “SPORT MODE SW” turns ON/OFF when overdrive control switch is operated. Refer to TM99, «Reference Value».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Check overdrive control switch. Refer to TM-213, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-215

    2014 Note

    SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR CIRCUIT
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR CIRCUIT
    Component Parts Function Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009020010

    1.CHECK SHIFT POSITION INDICATOR
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Start the engine.
    Shift selector lever.
    Check that the selector lever position and the shift position indicator on the combination meter are identical.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO
    >> Go to TM-216, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009020011

    1.CHECK TCM INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL
    With CONSULT
    Start the engine.
    Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    Select “RANGE”.
    Shift selector lever.
    Check that selector lever position, “RANGE” on CONSULT screen, and shift position indicator display on
    combination meter are identical.
    Is the check result normal?
    YES >> INSPECTION END
    NO-1 (“RANGE” is changed but is not displayed on shift position indicator.>>Check “Self Diagnostic Result”
    in “TRANSMISSION”.
    NO-2 (“RANGE” and shift position indicator are different.)>>Check “Self Diagnostic Result” in “TRANSMISSION”.
    NO-3 (Specific“RANGE” is not displayed on shift position indicator.)>>Check “Self Diagnostic Result” in
    “METER/M&A”.

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-216

    2014 Note

    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009020012

    1.CHECK SHIFT LOCK OPERATION (BRAKE PEDAL RELEASED)

    B

    1. Ignition switch ON.
    2. Attempt to shift selector lever to any position other than “P” position with brake pedal released.
    Can the selector lever be shifted?
    YES >> Go to TM-217, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    C

    2.CHECK SHIFT LOCK OPERATION (BRAKE PEDAL APPLIED)

    TM

    Attempt to shift the selector lever to any position other than “P” position with brake pedal applied.
    Can the selector lever be shifted?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Go to TM-217, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    F

    INFOID:0000000009020013

    1.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
    1.
    2.

    G

    Ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between stop lamp switch connector E13 terminal 4 and ground.

    H

    Stop lamp switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E13

    4

    Ground

    Brake pedal

    Voltage

    Applied

    Battery voltage

    Released

    0V

    Ground

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    J

    2.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR

    K

    Check voltage between CVT shift selector connector M38 terminal 6 and ground.
    CVT shift selector
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    6

    I

    Ground

    Brake pedal

    Ground

    Applied

    Shift selector

    Voltage

    Park

    Battery voltage

    Others

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    L

    M

    N

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    O

    Ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect CVT shift selector connector.
    Check continuity between CVT shift selector connector M38 terminal 6 and ground.

    P
    CVT shift selector
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    6

    Ground

    Continuity

    Ground

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace CVT shift selector. Refer to TM-227, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace ground circuit.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-217

    2014 Note

    SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    4.CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER CIRCUIT
    Check voltage between stop lamp switch connector E13 terminal 3 and ground.
    Stop lamp switch
    Connector

    Terminal

    E13

    3

    Ground

    Voltage

    Ground

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace stop lamp switch.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace power circuit.

    5.CHECK CVT SHIFT SELECTOR POWER CIRCUIT

    Check voltage between CVT shift selector connector M38 terminal 5 and ground.
    CVT shift selector
    Connector

    Terminal

    M38

    5

    Ground

    Brake pedal

    Voltage

    Ground

    Applied

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace CVT shift selector. Refer to TM-227, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace power circuit.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-218

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS

    A

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009020014

    B

    The diagnosis item number indicates the order of check. Start checking in the order from 1.
    Symptom diagnosis chart 1-1

    C

    Check under on board condition (repair
    and part replacement)

    Replace the transaxle assembly.

    Engine stall occurs in “D”, “L”,
    or “R” position and the vehicle
    does not start.
    Driving is
    not possible.

    Acceleration at start is not sufficient in “D”, “L”, or “R” position.

    1

    1

    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    CVT fluid temperature sensor (P0711, P0712, P0713)

    Low brake solenoid valve
    (P173A, P173B, P17B4, P17B5)

    High clutch &reverse brake solenoid valve
    (P1739, P173C, P17B7, P17B8)

    Lock-up solenoid valve
    (P0740, P0743, P0744)

    Line pressure solenoid valve (P0746, P0962, P0963)

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    1

    1

    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    2

    K

    L
    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    1

    2

    2

    1

    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    M

    The engine speed increases
    suddenly in “D”, “L”, or “R” position during driving.
    Engine brake is suddenly applied in “D” or “R” position during driving.

    TM

    TM-111

    1

    Primary pressure solenoid valve (P17BA, P17BB)

    Overdrive control switch
    TM-213

    1

    Secondary pressure sensor (P0846, P0847, P0848)

    TCM
    TM-99

    1

    Transmission position switch (P0705, P0706)

    Control cable
    TM-228

    1

    Output speed sensor (P0720)

    Line pressure is out of the standard value.
    TM-130

    The engine speed increases in
    “D”, “L”, or “R” position, but the
    vehicle cannot start.

    Secondary speed sensor (P2765)

    Incorrect adjustment of CVT fluid level
    TM-225

    1

    Symptom

    Primary speed sensor (P0715)

    Engine system
    EC-107

    Electric system

    1

    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    1

    N
    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-219

    2014 Note

    The engine races when the
    auxiliary gearbox is shifted
    from 1GR ⇔ 2GR.

    Engine braking is not effective
    in “L” position.

    Shifting is
    not possible.
    Shifting does not occur with
    OD OFF.

    During driving in “D” position,
    slippage occurs in lockup or
    lockup is not possible.

    Revision: April 2013
    2

    1
    1
    1

    1
    1

    1

    TM-220

    Line pressure is out of the standard value.
    Control cable
    TCM
    Overdrive control switch

    TM-130
    TM-228
    TM-99
    TM-213

    1

    1
    1

    1
    1

    Engine stall occurs immediately before stop at deceleration in
    “D” or “L” position.

    1
    1

    1
    1
    2

    1

    1

    1
    2
    1

    1
    1
    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1
    1

    CVT fluid temperature sensor (P0711, P0712, P0713)

    Low brake solenoid valve
    (P173A, P173B, P17B4, P17B5)

    Lock-up solenoid valve
    (P0740, P0743, P0744)

    Line pressure solenoid valve (P0746, P0962, P0963)

    Primary pressure solenoid valve (P17BA, P17BB)

    Check under on board condition (repair
    and part replacement)

    Secondary pressure sensor (P0846, P0847, P0848)

    Transmission position switch (P0705, P0706)

    Output speed sensor (P0720)

    Secondary speed sensor (P2765)

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    High clutch &reverse brake solenoid valve
    (P1739, P173C, P17B7, P17B8)

    TM-111

    Incorrect adjustment of CVT fluid level

    TM-225

    Primary speed sensor (P0715)

    Engine system

    Symptom

    EC-107

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    Replace the transaxle assembly.

    Electric system

    1

    1

    1

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom diagnosis chart 1-2

    Replace the transaxle assembly.

    A

    Power transmission

    Driving is
    not possible.

    Shifting is
    not possible.

    The engine speed increases in
    “D”, “L”, or “R” position, but the
    vehicle cannot start.

    1

    Engine stall occurs in “D”, “L”,
    or “R” position and the vehicle
    does not start.

    1

    Acceleration at start is not sufficient in “D”, “L”, or “R” position.

    1

    The engine speed increases
    suddenly in “D”, “L”, or “R” position during driving.

    1

    Engine brake is suddenly applied in “D” or “R” position during driving.

    1

    The engine races when the
    auxiliary gearbox is shifted
    from 1GR ⇔ 2GR.

    1

    1

    Engine braking is not effective
    in “L” position.

    1

    2

    1

    1

    Parking mechanism

    Final gear, differential gear

    Reduction gear

    Planetary gear

    Counter gear

    Bearings

    Reverse brake

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    1
    (In “R”)

    1
    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    1

    1

    TM

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    F

    1

    G

    1
    (In “R”)

    H

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    1
    (In “R”)

    I

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    1
    (In “R”)

    J

    2

    1

    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    1

    C

    E

    TM-250

    High clutch

    Low brake

    Pulley, steel belt

    B

    Torque converter

    Oil pump

    Symptom

    Valve body, control valve

    Oil pressure control

    K

    L

    Shifting does not occur with
    OD OFF.
    Engine stall occurs immediately before stop at deceleration in “D” or “L” position.

    1

    1

    M

    During driving in “D” position,
    slippage occurs in lockup or
    lockup is not possible.

    1

    1

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-221

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom diagnosis chart 2-1

    Check under on board condition (repair
    and part replacement)

    Replace the transaxle assembly.

    2

    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    CVT fluid temperature sensor (P0711, P0712, P0713)

    1

    Lock-up solenoid valve
    (P0740, P0743, P0744)

    Line pressure solenoid valve (P0746, P0962, P0963)

    Primary pressure solenoid valve (P17BA, P17BB)

    1

    2

    1

    2

    1

    1

    1

    TM-111

    Overdrive control switch
    TM-213

    1

    Low brake solenoid valve
    (P173A, P173B, P17B4, P17B5)

    Shock is large when the lever
    is shifted from “N” → “D” and
    “N” → “R” positions.

    Secondary pressure sensor (P0846, P0847, P0848)

    TCM
    TM-99

    2

    Shock in lockup is large during driving in “D” or “L” position.
    Shock vibration
    Noise

    Transmission position switch (P0705, P0706)

    Control cable
    TM-228

    1

    2

    High clutch &reverse brake solenoid valve
    (P1739, P173C, P17B7, P17B8)

    Shock is large when the auxiliary gearbox is shifted from
    1GR → 2GR.

    Output speed sensor (P0720)

    Line pressure is out of the standard value.
    TM-130

    Shock at start is large in “D”,
    “L”, or “R” position.

    Secondary speed sensor (P2765)

    Incorrect adjustment of CVT fluid level
    TM-225

    Symptom

    Primary speed sensor (P0715)

    Engine system
    EC-107

    Electric system

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    Shock is large when the lever
    is shifted from “D” → “L” position.
    Vibration occurs in “D”, “L”, or
    “R” position during driving.

    1

    Noise occurs during driving.
    Noise occurs in idling.

    Other

    1

    1

    2

    1
    1

    1

    Starter operates in “D”, “L”, or
    “R” position.

    1

    1

    1

    Starter does not operate in
    “P” or “N” position.

    1

    1

    1

    Engine stall occurs in “D”, “L”,
    or “R” position during stop.

    1

    1

    1

    1

    Engine stall occurs in “P” or
    “N” position during stop.

    1

    1

    1

    1

    Parking lock does not operate in “P” position.

    1

    1

    Parking lock cannot be cancelled when the selector lever is shifted from “P” position
    to other position.

    1

    1

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-222

    2014 Note

    CVT CONTROL SYSTEM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom diagnosis chart 2-2

    Replace the transaxle assembly.

    A

    Power transmission

    Shock vibration
    Noise

    Parking mechanism

    Final gear, differential gear

    Reduction gear

    Planetary gear

    Counter gear

    Bearings

    Reverse brake

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    Shock at start is large in “D”,
    “L”, or “R” position.

    1

    Shock is large when the auxiliary gearbox is shifted from
    1GR → 2GR.

    1

    Shock in lockup is large during driving in “D” or “L” position.

    1

    Shock is large when the lever
    is shifted from “N” → “D” and
    “N” → “R” positions.

    1

    1
    (“N” →
    “D”)

    Shock is large when the lever
    is shifted from “D” → “L” position.

    1

    1

    1

    Vibration occurs in “D”, “L”, or
    “R” position during driving.

    1

    1

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    1
    (In “D” or
    “L”)

    Noise occurs during driving.

    1

    1

    Noise occurs in idling.

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1
    (In “R”)

    2

    2

    2

    TM

    F

    2

    G

    1

    H

    1

    1

    C

    E

    TM-250

    High clutch

    Low brake

    Pulley, steel belt

    B

    Torque converter

    Oil pump

    Symptom

    Valve body, control valve

    Oil pressure control

    1

    1
    (“N” →
    “D”)

    I

    J
    1
    (In “R”)

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    1

    K

    L

    Starter operates in “D”, “L”, or
    “R” position.
    Starter does not operate in “P”
    or “N” position.
    Engine stall occurs in “D”, “L”,
    or “R” position during stop.
    Other

    M
    1

    1

    N

    Engine stall occurs in “P” or
    “N” position during stop.
    Parking lock does not operate
    in “P” position.

    1

    O

    Parking lock cannot be cancelled when the selector lever
    is shifted from “P” position to
    other position.

    1

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-223

    2014 Note

    CVT FLUID
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    CVT FLUID
    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009020015

    FLUID LEAKAGE
    • Check transaxle surrounding area (oil seal and plug etc.)for fluid
    leakage.
    • If anything is found, repair or replace damaged parts and adjust
    CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».

    SMA146B

    Replacement
    CVT fluid
    Fluid capacity

    INFOID:0000000009019892

    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».
    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».

    CAUTION:
    • Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN
    CVT Fluid NS-3 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the (NISSAN new vehicle limited) warranty.
    • Always use shop paper. Never use shop cloth.
    • Replace a drain plug gasket with new ones at the final stage of the operation when installing.
    • Use caution when looking into the drain hole as there is a risk of dripping fluid entering the eye.
    • After replacement, always perform CVT fluid leakage check.
    1. Select “Data Monitor” in “TRANSMISSION” using CONSULT.
    2. Select “FLUID TEMP” and confirm that the CVT fluid temperature is 40°C (104°F) or less.
    3. Check that the selector lever is in the “P” position, then completely engage the parking brake.
    4. Lift up the vehicle.
    5. Remove the drain plug and overflow tube and drain the CVT fluid from the oil pan. TM-238, «Removal and
    Installation».
    6. Install the charging pipe set (KV311039S0) (A) into the drain
    hole.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten the charging pipe by hand.
    7. Install the ATF changer hose (B) to the charging pipe.
    CAUTION:
    Press the ATF changer hose all the way onto the charging
    pipe until it stops.
    8. Fill approximately 3 liter (2-5/8 lmp qt) of the CVT fluid.
    9. Remove the ATF changer hose and charging pipe, then install
    JSDIA1876ZZ
    the drain plug.
    NOTE:
    Perform this work quickly because CVT fluid leaks.
    10. Lift down the vehicle.
    11. Start the engine.
    12. While depressing the brake pedal, shift the selector lever to the entire position from “P” to “L”, and shift it
    to the “P” position.
    NOTE:
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-224

    2014 Note

    CVT FLUID
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    Hold the lever at each position for 5 seconds.
    A
    13. Check that the CONSULT “Data monitor” in “FLUID TEMP” is 35°C (95°F) to 45°C (113°F).
    14. Stop the engine.
    15. Lift up the vehicle.
    B
    16. Remove the drain plug, and then drain CVT fluid from oil pan.
    17. Repeat steps 6 to 16 (one time).
    18. Install the overflow tube. Refer to TM-238, «Removal and Installation».
    C
    CAUTION:
    Be sure to tighten to the specified torque. If it is not tightened to the specified torque, the tube may
    be damaged.
    TM
    19. Install the charging pipe set (KV311039S0) (A) into the drain
    hole.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten the charging pipe by hand.
    E
    20. Install the ATF changer hose (B) to the charging pipe.
    CAUTION:
    Press the ATF changer hose all the way onto the charging
    F
    pipe until it stops.
    21. Fill approximately 3 liter (2-5/8 lmp qt) of the CVT fluid.
    22. Remove the ATF changer hose and charging pipe, then install
    G
    JSDIA1876ZZ
    the drain plug.
    NOTE:
    Perform this work quickly because CVT fluid leaks.
    H
    23. Lift down the vehicle.
    24. Start the engine.
    25. While depressing the brake pedal, shift the selector lever to the entire position from “P” to “L”, and shift it
    I
    to the “P” position.
    NOTE:
    Hold the lever at each position for 5 seconds.
    J
    26. Check that the CONSULT “Data monitor” in “FLUID TEMP” is 35°C (95°F) to 45°C (113°F).
    27. Lift up the vehicle.
    28. Remove the drain plug and confirm that the CVT fluid is drained from the overflow tube.
    K
    CAUTION:
    Perform this work with the vehicle idling.
    NOTE:
    L
    If the CVT fluid is not drained, refer to “Adjustment” and refill with the CVT fluid.
    29. When the flow of CVT fluid slows to a drip, tighten the drain plug to the specified torque. TM-238,
    «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    M
    Never reuse drain plug gasket.
    30. Lift down the vehicle.
    31. Select “Work Support” in “TRANSMISSION” using CONSULT.
    N
    32. Select “CONFORM CVTF DETERIORTN”.
    33. Select “Erase”.
    O
    34. Stop the engine.

    Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009019893

    P

    CVT fluid
    Fluid capacity

    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».
    : Refer to TM-254, «General Specification».

    CAUTION:
    • Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN
    CVT Fluid NS-3 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the (NISSAN new vehicle limited) warranty.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-225

    2014 Note

    CVT FLUID
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    • During adjustment of the CVT fluid level, check CONSULT so that the oil temperature may be maintained from 35 to 45°C (95 to 113°F).
    • Use caution when looking into the drain hole as there is a risk of dripping fluid entering the eye.
    1. Check that the selector lever is in the “P” position, then completely engage the parking brake.
    2. Start the engine.
    3. Adjust the CVT fluid temperature to be approximately 40°C (104°F).
    NOTE:
    The CVT fluid is largely affected by temperature. Therefore be sure to use CONSULT and check the
    “FLUID TEMP” under “TRANSMISSION” in “Data Monitor” while adjusting.
    4. While depressing the brake pedal, shift the selector lever to the entire position from “P” to “L”, and shift it
    to the “P” position.
    NOTE:
    Hold the lever at each position for 5 seconds.
    5. Lift up the vehicle.
    6. Check that there is no CVT fluid leakage.
    7. Remove the drain plug. Refer to TM-238, «Removal and Installation».
    8.

    9.

    10.
    11.

    12.
    13.
    14.
    15.

    Install the charging pipe set (KV311039S0) (A) into the drain
    plug hole.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten the charging pipe by hand.
    Install the ATF changer hose (B) to the charging pipe.
    CAUTION:
    Press the ATF changer hose all the way onto the charging
    pipe until it stops.
    Fill approximately 0.5 liter (1/2 lmp qt) of the CVT fluid.
    Remove the ATF changer hose from the charging pipe, and
    check that the CVT fluid drains out from the charging pipe. If it
    does not drain out, perform charging again.
    CAUTION:
    Perform this work with the vehicle idling.
    When the flow of CVT fluid slows to a drip, remove the charging pipe from the oil pan.
    Tighten the drain plug to the specified torque. Refer to TM-238, «Removal and Installation».
    CAUTION:
    Never reuse drain plug gasket.
    Lift down the vehicle.
    Stop the engine.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-226

    JSDIA1876ZZ

    2014 Note

    CVT SHIFT SELECTOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    CVT SHIFT SELECTOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020016

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    ALDIA0263GB

    1.

    Shift selector handle

    2.

    Lock pin

    4.

    Position indication panel

    5.

    Shift selector assembly

    3.

    Shift selector handle cover

    Removal and Installation

    K
    INFOID:0000000009020017

    CAUTION:
    Always apply the parking brake before performing removal and installation.

    L

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    Move the shift selector to the “N” position.
    Remove the shift selector handle. Refer to TM-228, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    Remove the center console. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from shift selector.
    Move the shift selector to the “P” position.
    Remove the key interlock cable from the shift selector assembly. Refer to TM-233, «Exploded View».
    Remove the control cable from the shift selector assembly. Refer to TM-230, «Exploded View».
    Remove the shift selector assembly.

    M

    N

    O

    P

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    TM-227

    2014 Note

    CVT SHIFT SELECTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • When connecting the control cable (1) to the shift selector assembly (2), face the grooved surface of the rib (A) up and insert the
    control cable until it stops.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    JSDIA1624ZZ

    Disassembly and Assembly

    INFOID:0000000009020018

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Slide the shift selector handle cover (1) down.
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the shift selector handle cover.
    Pull out the lock pin (2).
    Pull the shift selector handle (3) and shift selector handle cover
    upward to remove.
    Remove the position lamp.

    JSDIA1796ZZ

    5.

    Disengage the hooks (A) (4 locations), and lift up the position
    indication panel (1) to separate it from the shift selector assembly (2).
    CAUTION:
    Do not damage the shift selector assembly.

    ALDIA0264ZZ

    ASSEMBLY
    Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
    • Follow the procedure below to install the shift selector handle.
    1. Install the lock pin (2) onto the shift selector handle (3).
    2. Install the shift selector handle cover (1) onto the shift selector
    handle.
    3. Press the shift selector handle onto the shift selector until it
    clicks.
    CAUTION:
    • When pressing the shift selector handle onto the shift
    selector, do not press the shift selector handle button.
    • Do not strike the shift selector handle to install it.
    JSDIA1796ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009020019

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-228

    2014 Note

    CVT SHIFT SELECTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check CVT position. Refer to TM-132, «Inspection».

    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    A

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-229

    2014 Note

    CONTROL CABLE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    CONTROL CABLE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020020

    JSDIA1921GB

    1.

    Bracket B

    2.

    Lock plate

    3.

    Transaxle assembly

    4.

    Bracket A

    5.

    Control cable

    6.

    CVT shift selector assembly

    A:

    Manual lever

    B:

    Grommet

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020021

    CAUTION:
    Always apply the parking brake before performing removal and installation.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    Remove the battery negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    Remove the TCM and bracket. Refer to TM-235, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the battery tray and bracket.
    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the center console. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the control cable from the shift selector assembly.
    Disengage the pawls (B) of the grommet (A), and pull downward
    to remove.
    Remove the control cable nut from the manual lever.

    JSDIA1809ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-230

    2014 Note

    CONTROL CABLE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    10. Remove the lock plate (1).

    A

    B

    C
    JSDIA1812ZZ

    TM

    11. Lift up the heat plate.
    12. Remove the control cable (1) from the bracket (2).

    E
    Front

    F

    G
    JPDIA0107ZZ

    13. Remove the control cable from the vehicle.
    14. Remove bracket.

    H

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • From below the vehicle, press the grommet (A) into place until the
    pawls (B) make a click sound.
    CAUTION:
    Check that pulling down on the grommet does not disconnect
    it.

    I

    J

    K

    L
    JSDIA1809ZZ

    • Pay attention to the following when connecting the control cable to the shift selector.
    1. When connecting the control cable (1) to the shift selector
    assembly (2), face the grooved surface of the rib (A) up and
    insert the control cable until it stops.

    M

    N

    O

    P
    JSDIA1624ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-231

    2014 Note

    CONTROL CABLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    2. Install the socket (A) onto the shift selector assembly.
    CAUTION:
    • Insert the socket into the shift selector assembly, then
    push it firmly in place.
    • Check that pulling on the socket does not disconnect it.

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    JSDIA1810ZZ

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020022

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check CVT position. Refer to TM-132, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Adjust CVT position. Refer to TM-132, «Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-232

    2014 Note

    KEY INTERLOCK CABLE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    KEY INTERLOCK CABLE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020023

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    ALDIA0262ZZ

    1.

    Shift selector assembly

    2.

    Key interlock cable

    B:

    Lock plate

    C:

    Clip

    A:

    Key cylinder

    Removal and Installation

    J

    INFOID:0000000009020024

    K

    REMOVAL
    CAUTION:
    Always apply the parking brake before performing removal and installation.
    1. Move the shift selector to the “N” position.
    2. Remove the shift selector handle. Refer to TM-228, «Disassembly and Assembly».
    3. Remove the instrumental lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    4. Remove steering column covers. Refer to IP-17, «Removal and Installation».
    5. Remove the center console. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    6. Move the shift selector to the “P” position.
    7. Press the pawls (B) of the key interlock cable slider (A) while
    sliding it in the direction of the casing cap (C), and separate the
    adjusting holder (D) and slider.
    (E)

    L

    M

    N

    O

    :Key interlock rod

    P

    JSDIA1797ZZ

    8.

    Remove the key interlock cable from the shift selector assembly.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-233

    2014 Note

    KEY INTERLOCK CABLE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    9.

    Lift lock plate (A) in the direction of the arrow (
    in the direction of the arrow ( D).
    (1)

    :Key interlock cable

    (B)

    :Key cylinder

    C) and remove

    10. Remove the key interlock cable from the key cylinder.
    11. Disengage the clips and remove the key interlock cable from the
    vehicle.
    JSDIA1798ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    • Temporarily install the adjust holder (A) to the key interlock rod (B).
    • Install the casing cap (C) to the cable bracket (D) on the shift
    selector assembly.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not bend or twist key interlock cable excessively when
    installing.
    • After installing key interlock cable to cable bracket (D) on
    shift selector assembly, make sure casing caps (C) is firmly
    secured in cable bracket (D) on shift selector assembly.
    • If casing cap (C) is loose [less than 39.2 N (4.0 kg, 8.8 lb)
    removing force], replace key interlock cable.

    JSDIA1799ZZ

    • Slide the slider (A) toward the key interlock rod (D) while pressing
    the pull lock (B) down to securely connect the adjust holder (C)
    with the key interlock rod (D).
    CAUTION:
    • Do not press tabs when holding slider (A).
    • Do not apply any side to side force to key interlock rod (D)
    when sliding slider (A).

    JSDIA1800ZZ

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009020025

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Check the CVT operation. If a malfunction is found, adjust the CVT position. Refer to TM-228, «Inspection».
    • Make sure the key can be removed only when the shift selector is in the “P” position.
    • Make sure the ignition switch will not turn to LOCK position when the shift selector is not in the “P” position.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-234

    2014 Note

    TCM
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    TCM

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020026

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    AWBIA1482ZZ

    1.

    TCM

    2.

    Bracket

    3.

    Clip

    H

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020027

    I

    CAUTION:
    When replacing TCM, note the “CVTF DETERIORATION DATE” value displayed on CONSULT “CONFORM CVTF DETERIORTN” in MAINTENANCE BOOKLET, before starting the operation.
    NOTE:
    When replacing the TCM and transaxle assembly as a set, replace the transaxle assembly first and then
    replace the TCM. Refer to TM-126, «Description».

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the battery. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the TCM.
    Remove the TCM and bracket as an assembly.
    Remove the TCM from the bracket (if necessary).

    J

    K

    L

    M

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020028

    N

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Perform «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TCM». Refer to TM-126, «Description».

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-235

    2014 Note

    AIR BREATHER HOSE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    AIR BREATHER HOSE
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020029

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove air duct (inlet). Refer to EM-26, «Exploded View».
    Remove air breather hose from transaxle assembly.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Check that air breather hose is not collapsed or blocked due to folding or bending when installed.
    • Be sure to insert air breather hose (1) fully until it reaches the
    base of the transaxle tube (A).

    JSDIA1978ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-236

    2014 Note

    G SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    G SENSOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020030

    B

    C

    TM

    JSDIA1922GB

    1.

    G sensor

    E

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020031

    CAUTION:
    • Do not drop or strike G sensor, because it may be damaged by impact.
    • Do not use a power tool.

    F

    G

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    H

    Disconnect the battery negative terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Exploded View».
    Remove center console. Refer to IP-18, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from G sensor.
    Remove G sensor.

    I

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    J

    Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020032

    K

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Perform “G SENSOR CALIBRATION”. Refer to TM-129, «Description».

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-237

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    OIL PAN
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020033

    JSDIA1879GB

    1.

    Transaxle assembly

    2.

    Oil pan gasket

    3.

    Magnet

    4.

    Oil pan

    5.

    Overflow tube

    6.

    Drain plug gasket

    7.

    Drain plug

    8.

    Oil pan fitting bolt

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020034

    REMOVAL
    1.

    2.
    3.

    Remove the drain plug and overflow tube, and then drain the CVT fluid.
    WARNING:
    CVT fluid can splash when draining, use safety glasses to protect eyes.
    Remove the drain plug gasket from the drain plug.
    Remove the oil pan bolts (
    oil pan gasket.

    ), and then remove the oil pan and

    : Front

    4.

    Remove the magnets from the oil pan.

    JSDIA1874ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse oil pan gasket and drain plug gasket.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-238

    2014 Note

    OIL PAN
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Do not reuse oil pan bolts.
    • Completely remove all moisture, oil and old gasket, etc. from the oil pan gasket mating surface of
    transaxle case and oil pan.
    • When installing the overflow tube, be sure to tighten to the specified torque. If it is not tightened to
    the specified torque, the tube may be damaged.
    • When the oil pan is installed, temporarily tighten oil pan bolts, then
    tighten the oil pan bolts to specification in the order shown.

    A

    B

    C

    : Front

    TM

    E
    JSDIA1884ZZ

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020035

    F

    INSPECTION AFTER REMOVAL
    Check oil pan for foreign material.
    • If a large amount of worn material is found, clutch plate may be worn.
    • If iron powder is found, bearings, gears, or clutch plates may be worn.
    • If aluminum powder is found, bushing may be worn, or chips or burrs of aluminum casting parts may enter.
    Check points where wear is found in all cases.

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    G

    H

    Check for CVT fluid leakage. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».
    I

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check the CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-239

    2014 Note

    PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PRIMARY SPEED SENSOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020036

    JSDIA1880GB

    1.

    Transaxle assembly
    Front

    2.

    O-ring

    3.

    Primary speed sensor

    : Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020037

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Partially remove fender protector (LH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from primary speed sensor.
    Remove the primary speed sensor.
    Remove the O-ring from the primary speed sensor.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    • Apply Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 to the O-ring.

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020038

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for CVT fluid leakage. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Adjust the CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-240

    2014 Note

    SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    SECONDARY SPEED SENSOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020039

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G
    JSDIA1881GB

    1.

    Transaxle assembly
    Front

    2.

    O-ring

    3.

    Secondary speed sensor

    H

    : Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020040

    I

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Remove battery tray. Refer to PG-70, «Removal and Installation (Battery Tray)».
    Remove IPDM/ER. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from secondary speed sensor.
    Remove the secondary speed sensor.
    Remove the O-ring from the secondary speed sensor.

    J

    K

    INSTALLATION

    L

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    • Apply Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 to the O-ring.

    Inspection and Adjustment

    M
    INFOID:0000000009020041

    N

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for CVT fluid leakage. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION

    O

    Adjust the CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-241

    2014 Note

    OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020042

    JSDIA1882GB

    1.

    Transaxle assembly
    Front

    2.

    Output speed sensor

    3.

    O-ring

    Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020043

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the harness connector from output speed sensor.
    NOTE:
    Lift up the vehicle and perform the work from rear of the transaxle assembly.
    Remove the output speed sensor.
    Remove the O-ring from the output speed sensor.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-ring.
    • Apply Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 to the O-ring.

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020044

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for CVT fluid leakage. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check the CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-242

    2014 Note

    DIFFERENTIAL SIDE OIL SEAL
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    DIFFERENTIAL SIDE OIL SEAL

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020045

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F
    JSDIA1888ZZ

    1.

    Transaxle assembly

    2.

    Front

    Differential side oil seal (left side)

    3.

    Differential side oil seal (right side)

    Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3

    H

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020046

    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the front drive shaft from the transaxle assembly. Refer to FAX-19, «Removal and Installation»
    Remove the differential side oil seal using suitable tool.
    CAUTION:
    When removing the differential side oil seal, be careful not to scratch the oil seal mating surfaces
    of the transaxle case and converter housing.

    INSTALLATION
    Drive the differential side oil seal into the transaxle case side (A)
    and converter housing side (B) using suitable tool to the specified dimension.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to scratch the lip of the differential side oil seal
    when press-fitting it.
    • Do not reuse differential side oil seal.
    • Apply Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 to the differential side
    oil seal lip and around the oil seal.

    2.

    : 1.8 ± 0.5 mm (0.071 ± 0.020 in).
    : 1.8 ± 0.5 mm (0.071 ± 0.020 in).

    O
    JSDIA1836ZZ

    P
    INFOID:0000000009020047

    Check for CVT fluid leakage. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION

    TM-243

    K

    N

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    M

    Install the front drive shaft. Refer to FAX-19, «Removal and Installation».

    Inspection and Adjustment

    I

    L

    1.

    Dimension (C)
    Dimension (D)

    G

    2014 Note

    DIFFERENTIAL SIDE OIL SEAL
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Adjust the CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-244

    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    2014 Note

    WATER HOSE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    WATER HOSE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020048

    B

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    JSDIA4111GB

    1.

    Hose clamp

    2.

    Water hose A

    3.

    Clip

    4.

    Bracket A

    5.

    Bracket B

    6.

    CVT oil warner

    7.

    Water hose B

    8.

    Water bypass pipe

    9.

    Hose clamp

    10. Water hose C
    A.

    J

    11. Water outlet

    K

    To heater core
    : Always replace after every disassembly.

    L

    : N·m (kg-m, in-lb)

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020049

    M

    REMOVAL
    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly push down and
    turn it a quarter turn to allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by pushing it down
    and turning it all the way.
    CAUTION:
    Perform these steps after the engine coolant temperature has cooled sufficiently.
    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    1. Remove the hose clamp and pull out the water hose A.
    2. Remove the hose clamp and pull out the water hose B.
    3. Remove the hose clamp and pull out the water hose C.
    4. Pull out the heater hose and remove the water bypass pipe.
    5. Remove the heater thermostat assembly.
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-245

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    WATER HOSE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    6. Remove the bracket.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse hose clamps.
    • Do not reuse clips.
    • When installing bracket A to the transaxle assembly.
    — Face arrow (A) of bracket A toward the front of the vehicle.
    : Front

    — Set baffle (B) of bracket A to rib (C) of transaxle.

    JSDIA4112ZZ

    • When installing the bracket B to the transaxle assembly.
    — Face arrow (A) of bracket A towards the top of vehicle.
    : Front

    — Insert baffle (B) into the boss hole (C) of transaxle.

    JSDIA4113ZZ

    • Refer to the following when installing water hoses.
    Water hose (1)
    Water hose A

    Water hose B

    Water hose C

    Installation side
    tube (2)

    Direction of paint
    mark

    Water outlet

    Upward

    CVT oil warmer

    Frontward

    CVT oil warmer

    Frontward

    Water bypass pipe

    Rightward (Align
    with the mark of
    the water bypass pipe side)

    Water bypass pipe

    Water outlet

    Hose insertion depth
    (L)

    (A): 27 mm (1.06 in)
    (End reaches the 2stage bulge.)
    JSDIA2459ZZ

    Upward

    • Refer to the following when installing hose clamp.
    CAUTION:
    Hose clamp should not interfere with the bulge of fluid cooler tube.

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-246

    2014 Note

    WATER HOSE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Water hose (1)

    Water hose A

    Water hose B

    Installation side
    tube (2)

    Dieection of tab

    Water outlet

    Upward

    CVT oil warmer

    Frontward

    CVT oil warmer

    Leftward

    Water bypass pipe

    Rightward

    Water bypass pipe

    Upward and 45°
    frontward

    Water outlet

    Upward and 45°
    frontward

    Water hose C

    A

    Hose clamp (3)
    Clamping position

    B

    5 — 7 mm (0.20 — 0.28
    in) (A) from hose end

    C
    JSDIA2424ZZ

    TM

    Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009020050

    E

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Start the engine and check visually that there is no leakage of engine coolant.

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-247

    2014 Note

    FLUID COOLER HOSE
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FLUID COOLER HOSE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009300274

    ALDIA0228ZZ

    1.

    CVT oil cooler

    2.

    Hoses

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009300275

    NOTE:
    When removing components such as hoses, tubes/lines, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove the front bumper fascia. Refer to EXT-16, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect oil cooler hoses.
    Remove oil cooler bolts.
    Remove oil cooler assembly.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    After installation be sure to check the CVT fluid and add the specified CVT fluid as necessary. Refer to TM224, «Inspection».
    CAUTION:
    Do not reuse hose clamps.

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009300276

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for CVT fluid leakage. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Adjust the CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-248

    2014 Note

    PLUG
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    PLUG

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009020051

    Replace the O-ring if oil leakage or exudes from the plug.

    B

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020052

    C

    TM

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    JSDIA1889GB

    1.

    Plug

    4.

    Plug

    2.

    O-ring

    3.

    L

    O-ring

    Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020053

    REMOVAL

    M

    N

    Remove the plugs and O-rings.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 to O-rings.

    O

    P

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020054

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check for CVT fluid leakage. Refer to TM-224, «Inspection».

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    Adjust the CVT fluid level. Refer to TM-225, «Adjustment».
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-249

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009020055

    JSDIA1890ZZ

    1.
    A

    Transaxle assembly
    : For the tightening torque, refer to TM-250, «Removal and Installation».

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009020056

    WARNING:
    Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could occur from high-pressure
    engine coolant escaping from the radiator. Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Slowly push down and
    turn it a quarter turn to allow built-up pressure to escape. Carefully remove the cap by pushing it down
    and turning it all the way.
    CAUTION:
    • Perform these steps after the coolant temperature has cooled sufficiently.
    NOTE:
    • When removing components such as hoses, tubes/line, etc., cap or plug openings to prevent fluid from spilling.
    • When replacing the TCM and transaxle assembly as a set, replace the transaxle assembly first and then
    replace the TCM. Refer to TM-126, «Description».

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove the engine and transaxle assembly. Refer to EM-86, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors and harnesses.
    • For CVT unit harness connector.
    • Transmission position switch harness connector

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-250

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
    [CVT: RE0F11A]
    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • Primary speed sensor harness connector
    • Secondary speed sensor harness connector
    • Output speed sensor harness connector
    • Ground
    3. Rotate the crankshaft and remove the nuts that secure the drive plate to the torque converter from the stator motor mount.
    CAUTION:
    When turning crankshaft, turn it clockwise as viewed from the front of the engine.
    4.

    A

    B

    C

    Remove the bolts (engine to transaxle) that fasten the transaxle
    assembly and engine assembly.
    TM

    E

    F
    JSDIA1839ZZ

    Bolt position
    Direction of insertion
    Quantity
    Nominal length [mm (in)]

    A

    B

    Transaxle assembly ⇒
    Engine assembly

    D

    G

    Engine assembly ⇒ Transaxle assembly

    2

    2

    1

    3

    40 (1.57)

    44 (1.73)

    69 (2.72)

    49 (1.93)

    Tightening torque
    N·m (kg-m, ft-lb)

    5.

    C

    48.0 (4.9, 35)

    H

    I

    Remove transaxle assembly from vehicle.
    CAUTION:
    • Secure torque converter to prevent it from dropping.
    • Secure transaxle assembly to a suitable jack.

    J

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not reuse O-rings.
    • Apply Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 to the O-rings.
    • When installing the transaxle assembly onto the engine assembly,
    check the engagement of the dowel pins ( ).

    K

    L

    M

    N

    JSDIA1184ZZ

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-251

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    • When using suitable tool (A) for alignment, install it to the alignment stud bolt used to align the torque converter to the drive plate.

    JPDIA0683ZZ

    • Rotate the crankshaft so that the alignment hole (A) of drive plate
    aligns with the position of the torque converter alignment stud bolt.
    CAUTION:
    • Rotate the crankshaft clockwise (as viewed from the front of
    the engine).
    • Be careful that torque converter stud bolts are aligned to the
    drive plate holes. Otherwise the stud bolts contact the drive
    plate.
    • Insert the alignment stud bolt of torque converter into the alignment hole of the drive plate, aligning the drive plate holes with the
    torque converter stud bolts.
    JPDIA0684ZZ
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to strike the drive plate with the torque converter stud bolts.
    • When installing the torque converter nuts, temporarily tighten the nuts. Then, after installing the engine and
    transaxle assembly bolts tighten the nuts to the specified torque.
    Tightening torque

    : 51 N·m (5.2 kg-m, 38 ft-lb)

    CAUTION:
    • Rotate the crankshaft clockwise (as viewed from the front of the engine).
    • Check the tightening torque for the crankshaft pulley bolts after the bolts fastening the drive plate
    and torque converter have been tightened and the crankshaft pulley bolts have been secured.
    Refer to EM-51, «Removal and Installation».
    • Install the transaxle assembly and engine assembly bolts according to the following standards.

    JSDIA1839ZZ

    Bolt position
    Direction of insertion
    Quantity
    Nominal length [mm (in)]

    A

    B

    Transaxle assembly ⇒
    Engine assembly

    C

    D

    Engine assembly ⇒ Transaxle assembly

    2

    2

    1

    3

    40 (1.57)

    44 (1.73)

    69 (2.72)

    49 (1.93)

    Tightening torque
    N·m (kg-m, ft-lb)

    48.0 (4.9, 35)

    Inspection and Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009020057

    INSPECTION BEFORE INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    TM-252

    2014 Note

    TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < UNIT REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Check the distance (A) between the converter housing and torque
    converter.
    (B)

    : Scale

    (C)

    : Straightedge

    Dimension (A)

    A

    B

    : TM-255, «Torque Converter»
    C
    JSDIA1840ZZ

    TM

    INSPECTION AFTER INSTALLATION
    Check the following items:
    • For CVT position, refer to TM-228, «Inspection».
    • Before starting engine, check oil/fluid levels including engine coolant and engine oil. If less than required
    quantity, fill to the specified level. Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    • Use procedure below to check for fuel leakage.
    • Turn ignition switch ON (with engine stopped). With fuel pressure applied to fuel piping, check for fuel leakage at connection points.
    • Start engine. With engine speed increased, check again for fuel leakage at connection points.
    • Run engine to check for unusual noise and vibration.
    NOTE:
    If hydraulic pressure inside timing chain tensioner drops after removal and installation, slack in the guide
    may generate a pounding noise during and just after engine start. However, this is normal. Noise will stop
    after hydraulic pressure rises.
    • Warm up engine thoroughly to make sure there is no leakage of fuel, exhaust gas, or any oils/fluids including
    engine oil and engine coolant.
    • Bleed air from passages in lines and hoses, such as in cooling system.
    • After cooling down engine, again check oil/fluid levels including engine oil and engine coolant. Refill to specified level, if necessary.
    • Summary of the inspection items:
    Item

    Before starting engine

    Engine running

    After engine stopped

    Engine coolant

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    Engine oil

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    A/T and CVT Models

    Leakage

    Level/Leakage

    Leakage

    M/T Models

    Level/Leakage

    Leakage

    Level/Leakage

    Level

    Leakage

    Level

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Leakage

    Transmission/
    transaxle fluid
    Other oils and fluids*
    Fuel
    Exhaust gas

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    *Power steering fluid, brake fluid, etc.

    ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLATION
    • Adjust the CVT fluid level. TM-225, «Adjustment».
    • Perform «ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY». Refer to TM-127,
    «Description».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-253

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    General Specification

    INFOID:0000000009020058

    Engine model

    HR16DE

    Drive type

    2WD
    Transaxle model

    RE0F11A

    Stall torque ratio

    1.91 : 1

    Pulley ratio

    Transaxle

    Auxiliary gearbox gear
    ratio

    Forward

    2.200 – 0.550

    Reverse

    2.200

    1GR

    1.821

    2GR

    1.000

    Reverse

    1.714

    Counter gear

    0.967

    Final drive

    3.882
    Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3*1

    Recommended fluid
    Fluid capacity (Approx.)
    Remarks

    6.9 liter (6-1/8 Imp qt)*2

    7.1 liter (6-1/4 Imp qt)*2

    Not applicable

    Applicable

    CVT fluid cooler (air-cooling)

    CAUTION:
    • Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3. Do not mix with other fluid.
    • Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 will damage
    the CVT, which is not covered by the (NISSAN new vehicle limited) warranty.
    *1: Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».
    *2: The CVT fluid capacity is the reference value.

    Shift Characteristics

    INFOID:0000000009020059

    Unit: rpm

    Throttle position

    2/8

    8/8

    Engine speed

    Shift pattern

    At 40 km/h (25 MPH)

    At 60 km/h (37 MPH)

    “D” position (Overdrive control OFF)

    1,400 – 2,700

    1,500 – 3,100

    “D” position (Overdrive control ON)

    1,500 – 2,700

    2,400 – 3,200

    “L” position

    3,000 – 3,800

    3,800 – 4,600

    “D” position (Overdrive control OFF)

    3,900 – 4,700

    4,500 – 5,300

    “D” position (Overdrive control ON)

    3,600 – 4,400

    4,300 – 5,100

    “L” position

    3,600 – 4,400

    4,300 – 5,100

    CAUTION:
    Lock-up is engaged at the vehicle speed of approximately 10 km/h (11 MPH) to 90 km/h (56 MPH).

    Stall Speed

    INFOID:0000000009020060

    Unit: rpm

    Stall speed

    Revision: April 2013

    2,420 – 2,870

    TM-254

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    [CVT: RE0F11A]

    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    Line Pressure

    INFOID:0000000009020061

    A
    Unit: MPa (bar, kg/cm2, psi)

    Shift selector position
    “P” and “N”
    “R” and “D”

    Engine speed

    Line pressure

    B

    At idle

    0.40 (4, 4.1, 58)

    At idle

    0.40 (4, 4.1, 58) – 1.39 (13.9, 14.2, 201.6)

    At stall

    4.20 (42, 42.8, 609) – 4.70 (47, 47.9, 681.5)

    Torque Converter

    C

    INFOID:0000000009020062

    TM
    Distance (A) between the converter housing and torque converter

    16.2 mm

    Heater Thermostat

    INFOID:0000000009020063

    E

    Standard

    Valve lift

    More than 5.0 mm (0.197 in)

    F

    Reference value

    Valve opening temperature

    71°C (160°F)

    Minimum valve lift

    G

    5.0 mm/85°C (0.197 in/203°F)

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    TM-255

    2014 Note

    VENTILATION, HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER

    SECTION

    VTL

    VENTILATION SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Special Service Tool …………………………………………. 3
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 3

    SIDE VENTILATOR GRILLE ……………………………….. 5
    SIDE VENTILATOR GRILLE : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………. 6
    SIDE DEFROSTER GRILLE ………………………………… 6
    SIDE DEFROSTER GRILLE : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………. 6
    CENTER VENTILATOR DUCT …………………………….. 6
    CENTER VENTILATOR DUCT : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………. 6

    F

    G

    H

    VTL

    CENTER DEFROSTER DUCT ……………………………… 6
    CENTER DEFROSTER DUCT : Removal and Installation …………………………………………………………. 6

    J

    SIDE DEFROSTER DUCT …………………………………… 7
    SIDE DEFROSTER DUCT : Removal and Installation ………………………………………………………………. 7

    K

    DUCT AND GRILLE …………………………………….. 5

    FOOT DUCT ………………………………………………………. 7
    FOOT DUCT : Removal and Installation ……………… 7

    L

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 5

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR ………………………….. 8

    CENTER VENTILATOR GRILLE ………………………….. 5
    CENTER VENTILATOR GRILLE : Removal and
    Installation ……………………………………………………….. 5

    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 8
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 8

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4
    VENTILATION SYSTEM ………………………………. 4
    System Description …………………………………………… 4

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 5

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    VTL-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009643745

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009435052

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    VTL-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009429691

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    C

    D

    E
    AWJIA0483ZZ

    F

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009429692

    G

    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description

    ( — )
    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    H

    VTL

    PIIB1407E

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    VTL-3

    2014 Note

    VENTILATION SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    VENTILATION SYSTEM
    System Description

    INFOID:0000000009429695

    OUTLINE
    The ventilation system is controlled by the front air control.

    AIR FLOW
    Front

    AWIIA1690ZZ

    ×: Applicable

    AIR OUTLET
    MODE/DEF setting

    Revision: April 2013

    Ventilator

    Foot (3)

    Defroster (4)

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Center (1)

    Side (2)

    ×

    VTL-4

    2014 Note

    DUCT AND GRILLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

    A

    DUCT AND GRILLE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014885

    B

    FRONT
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    VTL

    J

    K
    AWIIA1679ZZ

    L

    1.

    Center defroster duct

    2.

    Side defroster duct (LH)

    3.

    Center ventilator duct

    4.

    Side ventilator grille (LH)

    5.

    Side defroster grille LH

    6.

    Heating and cooling unit assembly

    7.

    Foot duct (LH)

    8.

    Foot duct (RH)

    9.

    Center ventilator grille (LH)

    10.

    Cluster lid C

    11.

    Center ventilator grille (RH)

    12.

    Side defroster grille RH

    13.

    Instrument panel assembly

    14.

    Side ventilator grille (RH)

    15.

    Side defroster duct (RH)

    M

    CENTER VENTILATOR GRILLE

    N

    CENTER VENTILATOR GRILLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405603

    O

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-14, «Exploded View».
    Release pawls and remove the center ventilator grille from cluster lid C.

    P

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    SIDE VENTILATOR GRILLE

    Revision: April 2013

    VTL-5

    2014 Note

    DUCT AND GRILLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    SIDE VENTILATOR GRILLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405604

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove instrument panel assembly. Refer to IP-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove center ventilator duct. Refer to VTL-6, «CENTER VENTILATOR DUCT : Removal and Installation».
    Remove screw and the side ventilator grille.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    SIDE DEFROSTER GRILLE

    SIDE DEFROSTER GRILLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405606

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove front pillar finisher. Refer to INT-19, «FRONT PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Release side defroster grille pawls using a suitable tool and
    remove.
    : Pawl

    AWJIA1098ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • Visually check the pawls for deformation and damage during installation. Replace with a new component if necessary.
    • When installing side defroster grille, check that all pawls are securely placed into instrument panel
    assembly.

    CENTER VENTILATOR DUCT

    CENTER VENTILATOR DUCT : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405607

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove instrument panel assembly. Refer to IP-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove side defroster ducts. Refer to VTL-7, «SIDE DEFROSTER DUCT : Removal and Installation».
    Remove center defroster duct. Refer to VTL-6, «CENTER DEFROSTER DUCT : Removal and Installation».
    Remove screw and center ventilator duct from instrument panel assembly.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    CENTER DEFROSTER DUCT

    CENTER DEFROSTER DUCT : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405608

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove instrument panel assembly. Refer to IP-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove screws and center defroster duct from instrument panel assembly.

    INSTALLATION
    Revision: April 2013

    VTL-6

    2014 Note

    DUCT AND GRILLE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    SIDE DEFROSTER DUCT

    A

    SIDE DEFROSTER DUCT : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405609

    B

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove instrument panel assembly. Refer to IP-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove screws and side defroster duct from instrument panel assembly.

    C

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    D

    FOOT DUCT

    FOOT DUCT : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009405610

    E

    FOOT DUCT
    Removal

    1.
    2.

    F

    Remove instrument panel assembly. Refer to IP-15, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove screws and foot duct (LH/RH) from heating and cooling unit assembly.

    G

    Installation
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    H

    VTL

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    VTL-7

    2014 Note

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT BLOWER MOTOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009014886

    AWIIA1465ZZ

    1.

    Heating and cooling unit assembly

    2.

    Front blower motor

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Front blower motor resistor
    INFOID:0000000009405612

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.
    9.

    Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-69, «Removal and Installation (Battery)».
    Remove instrument lower panel LH. Refer to IP-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove knee bolster. Refer to IP-14, «Exploded View».
    Remove the accelerator pedal assembly. Refer to ACC-3, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove the brake pedal assembly. Refer to BR-19, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connectors from the front blower motor.
    Disconnect the harness connector from the thermo control amp.
    Remove the front blower motor screw (A).
    Press the flange holding hook, turn the front blower motor counterclockwise and remove.

    JMIIA1741ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    VTL-8

    2014 Note

    DRIVER INFORMATION & MULTIMEDIA

    SECTION

    WCS

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS

    F

    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3

    BUZZER : CONSULT Function (BCM — BUZZER)….13

    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 14

    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3

    COMBINATION METER …………………………….. 14

    G

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 4

    Reference Value ………………………………………………14
    Fail-safe ………………………………………………………….16
    DTC Index ………………………………………………………17

    H

    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 4

    BCM …………………………………………………………. 18

    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 4
    Combination Meter ……………………………………………. 4

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 5
    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM ………………………………… 5
    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM : System Description
    …… 5
    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM : Fail-safe ……………….. 6
    LIGHT REMINDER WARNING CHIME ………………….. 6
    LIGHT REMINDER WARNING CHIME : Light Reminder Warning ………………………………………………… 6
    PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CHIME …… 7
    PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CHIME
    : Parking Brake Release Warning Chime ……………… 7
    SEAT BELT WARNING CHIME ……………………………. 8
    SEAT BELT WARNING CHIME : Seat belt Warning ………………………………………………………………….. 8

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION
    METER) ……………………………………………………… 9
    On Board Diagnosis Function …………………………….. 9
    CONSULT Function ………………………………………… 10

    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………18

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 19
    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM ……………………….. 19
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..19

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 24

    K

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….24

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 26

    L

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT …. 26
    COMBINATION METER ……………………………………..26
    COMBINATION METER : Diagnosis Procedure ….26

    M

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM …………………………………27
    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………………………………….27

    WCS

    METER BUZZER CIRCUIT …………………………. 28

    O

    Component Function Check ………………………………28
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….28

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….12
    COMMON ITEM ………………………………………………… 12
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) …………………………………………….. 12

    Description ………………………………………………………29
    Component Function Check …………………………….29
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….29
    Component Inspection ………………………………………30

    Revision: April 2013

    J

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW ……. 24

    SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT ………………………………………………………… 29

    BUZZER …………………………………………………………… 12

    I

    WCS-1

    2014 Note

    P

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT …………………………………………………………. 31
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 31
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 31
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 32

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………….. 33
    THE PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING
    CONTINUES SOUNDING, OR DOES NOT
    SOUND …………………………………………………….. 33
    Description …………………………………………………….. 33

    Revision: April 2013

    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 33

    THE SEAT BELT REMINDER WARNING
    CONTINUES SOUNDING, OR DOES NOT
    SOUND …………………………………………………….. 34
    Description …………………………………………………….. 34
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 34

    THE LIGHT REMINDER WARNING DOES
    NOT SOUND ……………………………………………… 35
    Description …………………………………………………….. 35
    Diagnosis Procedure ……………………………………….. 35

    WCS-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009541255

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-3

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009541191

    AWNIA3060ZZ

    No.

    Component

    Function

    1.

    Parking brake switch

    Transmits the parking brake switch signal to the combination meter.

    2.

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Transmits the vehicle speed signal to the combination meter via CAN communication.
    Refer to BRC-6, «Component Parts Location» for detailed installation location.

    BCM

    Based on the signals received from various units and switches, transmits the buzzer output signal to the combination meter via CAN communication.
    Refer to BCS-4, «BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Component Parts Location» for detailed installation location.

    4.

    Combination meter

    • Receives a buzzer output signal from the BCM with CAN communication line and
    sounds the buzzer.
    • Controls the following with the vehicle speed signal received from ABS actuator
    and electric unit (control unit) via CAN communication and the signals from
    switches.
    — Seat belt reminder warning chime
    — Parking brake release warning chime
    — Light reminder warning

    5.

    Seat belt buckle switch LH

    Transmits a seat belt buckle switch signal LH to the combination meter.

    3.

    Combination Meter

    INFOID:0000000009541192

    The combination meter has a built-in buzzer 1 and sounds the following warnings, according to signals from each switch and unit.
    • Light reminder warning
    • Parking brake release warning chime
    • Seat belt warning

    AWNIA3061ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-4

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM

    A

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM
    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009541193

    B

    System Diagram
    C

    D

    E

    F

    AWNIA2651GB

    G

    COMBINATION METER INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL (CAN COMMUNICATION SIGNAL)
    H

    Input signal
    Signal name

    Transmit unit

    Vehicle speed signal

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Buzzer output signal

    BCM

    I

    J

    Output signal
    Signal name
    Vehicle speed signal

    Reception unit

    K

    BCM

    BCM INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL (CAN COMMUNICATION SIGNAL)

    L

    Input signal
    Signal name
    Vehicle speed signal

    Transmit unit

    M

    Combination meter

    Output signal
    Signal name
    Buzzer output signal

    WCS
    Reception unit
    Combination meter

    O

    DESCRIPTION
    Combination Meter
    The combination meter sounds the alarm buzzer installed in the combination meter when receiving the buzzer
    output signal transmitted from each unit.
    BCM
    BCM receives signals from various units and transmits a buzzer output signal to the combination meter via
    CAN communication if it judges that the warning buzzer should be activated.

    WARNING CHIME FUNCTION LIST
    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-5

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Warning functions

    Refer to

    Light reminder warning

    WCS-6, «LIGHT REMINDER WARNING CHIME : Light Reminder Warning»

    Parking brake release warning chime

    WCS-7, «PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CHIME :
    Parking Brake Release Warning Chime»

    Seat belt warning

    WCS-8, «SEAT BELT WARNING CHIME : Seat belt Warning»

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM : Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009641654

    The combination meter activates the fail-safe control if CAN communication with each unit is malfunctioning.
    Function

    Specifications

    Buzzer

    The buzzer turns OFF by suspending communication.

    LIGHT REMINDER WARNING CHIME
    LIGHT REMINDER WARNING CHIME : Light Reminder Warning

    INFOID:0000000009541199

    AWNIA2539GB

    WARNING CHIME OPERATION CONDITIONS
    If all of the following conditions are fulfilled.
    Operation conditions
    Ignition switch

    OFF or ACC position

    Combination switch (Lighting switch)

    1st or 2nd position

    Driver side door

    Open [front door switch LH ON]

    WARNING CHIME CANCEL CONDITIONS
    Warning is canceled if any of the following conditions is fulfilled.
    Operation conditions
    Ignition switch

    ON

    Combination switch (Lighting switch)

    OFF or AUTO position

    Driver side door

    Close [front door switch LH OFF]

    SIGNAL PATH
    1.

    BCM requires warning chime output to combination meter when it judges light reminder warning chime is
    necessary from signals below.
    Signal name

    Ignition switch signal

    Revision: April 2013

    Signal source

    WCS-6

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Signal name

    Signal source

    Combination switch signal

    Combination switch (Lighting switch)

    Driver door switch signal

    Front door switch LH

    2.

    A
    BCM

    B

    BCM

    Combination meter sounds integrated buzzer, following the warning chime output requirement (below signal) from BCM.
    Signal name

    C

    Signal source

    Buzzer output signal

    BCM

    D

    Combination meter

    PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CHIME
    PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CHIME : Parking Brake Release Warning
    Chime

    E

    INFOID:0000000009541201

    F

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    G

    H

    I
    JSNIA2422GB

    WARNING OPERATION CONDITIONS

    J

    If all of the following conditions are fulfilled.
    Operation conditions

    K

    Ignition switch

    ON

    Parking brake

    During the operation (parking brake switch ON)

    Vehicle speed

    Approximately 7 km/h (4.3 MPH) or more

    L

    WARNING CANCEL CONDITIONS
    Warning is canceled if any of the following conditions are fulfilled.

    M

    Operation conditions
    Ignition switch

    OFF

    Parking brake

    Release condition (parking brake switch OFF)

    Vehicle speed

    Approximately 3 km/h (1.9 MPH) or less

    WCS

    O

    SIGNAL PATH
    Combination meter sounds integrated buzzer when it judges that parking brake release warning chime is necessary from signals below.
    Signal name
    Ignition switch signal

    Revision: April 2013

    Signal source

    WCS-7

    2014 Note

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Signal name

    Signal source

    Parking brake switch signal

    Parking brake switch

    Vehicle speed signal

    ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)

    Combination meter
    Combination meter

    SEAT BELT WARNING CHIME
    SEAT BELT WARNING CHIME : Seat belt Warning

    INFOID:0000000009541203

    SYSTEM DIAGRAM

    AWNIA2652GB

    WARNING OPERATION CONDITIONS
    If all of the following conditions are fulfilled.
    Operation conditions
    Ignition switch

    ON

    Driver seat belt

    Unfastened [seat belt buckle switch LH ON]

    WARNING CANCEL CONDITIONS
    Warning is canceled if any of the following conditions is fulfilled.
    Operation conditions
    Ignition switch

    OFF

    Driver seat belt

    Fastened (seat belt buckle switch LH OFF)

    6 seconds after the start of warning sound

    SIGNAL PATH
    1.

    BCM requires warning chime output to combination meter when it judges seat belt warning chime is necessary from signals below.
    Signal name

    Signal source

    Ignition switch signal
    Seat belt buckle switch signal LH

    2.


    Seat belt buckle switch LH

    Combination meter

    BCM

    Combination meter sounds integrated buzzer, following the warning chime output requirement (below signal) from BCM.
    Signal name

    Buzzer output signal

    Revision: April 2013

    Signal source
    BCM

    Combination meter

    WCS-8

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    On Board Diagnosis Function

    A
    INFOID:0000000009641732

    ON BOARD DIAGNOSIS ITEM

    B

    Information display, speedometer and tachometer can be checked in self-diagnosis mode.

    STARTING COMBINATION METER SELF-DIAGNOSIS MODE

    C

    METHOD OF STARTING

    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Turn ignition switch ON, and switch the trip meter to “trip A” or “trip B”.
    Turn ignition switch to OFF.
    While pressing the meter control switch (1), turn the ignition
    switch ON.
    Make sure that the trip meter displays “0000.0”.
    Press the meter control switch (1) at least 3 times. (Within 7 seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON).

    D

    E

    F

    G
    JSNIA3904ZZ

    H

    6.

    The combination meter is turned to self-diagnosis mode.
    • All segments of the information display and shift position indicator (A) for CVT models are displayed.

    I

    J

    K
    JSNIA3900ZZ

    NOTE:
    • Check combination meter power supply and ground circuit when the self-diagnosis mode of the combination
    meter does not start. replace combination meter if power supply and ground circuit are normal.
    • If any of the segments are not displayed, replace combination meter.
    7.

    L

    M

    Each meter activates by pressing the meter control switch.
    WCS

    O

    P

    AWNIA2440ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-9

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    NOTE:
    • If any of the meters or gauges is not activated, replace combination meter.
    • The figure is reference.

    CONSULT Function

    INFOID:0000000009641733

    APPLICATION ITEMS
    CONSULT can display each diagnostic item using the diagnostic test modes shown.
    METER/M&A Diagnosis mode

    Description

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT

    The combination meter self-diagnosis results.

    Data Monitor

    Displays combination meter input/output data in real time.

    Warning History

    Lighting history of the warning lamp and indicator lamp can be checked.

    SELF DIAG RESULT
    Refer to MWI-20, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR
    Display Item List
    X: Applicable

    Display item [Unit]

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    Description

    SPEED METER
    [km/h] or [mph]

    X

    Displays the value of vehicle speed signal.

    SPEED OUTPUT
    [km/h] or [mph]

    X

    Displays the value of vehicle speed signal, which is transmitted to each unit with
    CAN communication.

    ODO OUTPUT
    [km/h or mph]

    Displays odometer signal value transmitted to other units via CAN communication.

    TACHO METER
    [rpm]

    X

    Displays the value of engine speed signal, which is input from ECM.

    FUEL METER
    [L]

    X

    Displays the fuel level.

    W TEMP METER
    [°C] or [°F]

    X

    Displays the value of engine coolant temperature signal, which is input from ECM.

    ABS W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of ABS warning indicator

    BRAKE W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of brake warning indicator.

    DOOR W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of door warning indicator.

    HI-BEAM IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of high beam indicator.

    TURN IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of turn indicator.

    LIGHT IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of light indicator.

    OIL W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of engine oil pressure warning indicator.

    MIL
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of malfunction indicator.

    CRUISE IND
    [Off]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of CRUISE indicator.

    O/D OFF IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of O/D OFF indicator.

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-10

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (COMBINATION METER)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Display item [Unit]

    MAIN
    SIGNALS

    Description

    FUEL W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of low-fuel warning indicator.

    O/D OFF SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of O/D OFF switch.

    REAR DEF SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of rear window defogger switch.

    BRAKE SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of brake switch.

    EPS W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of EPS indicator.

    CHAGE W/L
    [Off]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of charge warning indicator.

    SHIFT IND
    [P, R, N, D, L]

    Displays shift selector position.

    FUEL CAP W/L
    [Off]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of loose fuel cap warning message.

    PKB SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Status of parking brake switch.

    BUCKLE SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Status of seat belt buckle switch (LH).

    BRAKE OIL SW
    [ON/OFF]

    Status of brake fluid level switch.

    DISTANCE
    [km] or [Mi]

    Displays distance to empty.

    BUZZER
    [ON/OFF]

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    X

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of buzzer.

    FR FOG IND
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of front fog lamp indicator.

    KEY G/Y W/L
    [ON/OFF]

    Displays [ON/OFF] condition of Intelligent Key warning lamp.

    J

    K

    NOTE:
    Some items are not available according to vehicle specification.

    L

    WARNING HISTORY
    Display item
    W/L ON HISTORY

    Description

    M

    Lighting history of warning lamp and indicator lamp can be checked.

    W/L ON HISTORY
    • Stores histories when warning/indicator lamp is turned on.
    WCS
    • “W/L ON HISTORY” indicates the “TIME” when the warning/ indicator lamp is turned on.
    • The “TIME” above is:
    — 0: The condition that the warning/indicator lamp has been turned on 1 or more times after starting the engine
    O
    and waiting for 30 seconds.
    — 1 — 39: The number of times the engine was restarted after the 0 condition.
    — NO W/L ON HISTORY: Stores NO (0) turning on history of warning/indicator lamp.
    NOTE:
    P
    • W/L ON HISTORY is not stored for approximately 30 seconds after the engine starts.
    • Brake warning lamp does not store any history when the parking brake is applied or the brake fluid level gets
    low.

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-11

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009641652

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-12

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    BUZZER : CONSULT Function (BCM — BUZZER)

    INFOID:0000000009641653

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]
    PUSH -SW [On/Off]

    B

    Description
    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    UNLK SEN -DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of door unlock sensor.

    VEH SPEED 1 [km/h]

    Indicates vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    TAIL LAMP SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of combination switch.

    FR FOG SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front fog lamp switch.

    DOOR SW-DR [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of front door switch LH.

    CDL LOCK SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of lock signal from door lock and unlock switch.

    C

    D

    E

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item
    LIGHT WARN ALM

    Description

    F

    This test is able to check light warning chime operation [On/Off].

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-13

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    COMBINATION METER
    Reference Value

    INFOID:0000000009641717

    VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL
    Monitor Item

    Data monitor

    Display content

    Condition

    Reference value in normal operation

    SPEED METER
    [km/h or mph]

    Speed meter
    operation

    While driving

    Vehicle speed matches speed meter

    SPEED OUTPUT
    [km/h or mph]

    Vehicle speed

    While driving

    The speed output signal value via CAN
    communication is approx. value of vehicle speed.

    ODO OUTPUT
    [km/h or mph]

    ODO meter operation

    Driving

    Distance driven

    TACHO METER
    [rpm]

    Tacho meter
    operation

    Engine running

    The tacho meter is approx. value of engine speed via CAN communication.

    FUEL METER
    [L]

    Fuel level

    Ignition ON

    Fuel level is approx. value of fuel
    gauge.

    W TEMP METER
    [°C] or [°F]

    Engine coolant
    temperature

    Engine running

    Input value of engine coolant temperature signal via CAN communication.

    ABS W/L

    ABS warning
    lamp

    When ABS warning lamp is ON

    On

    When ABS warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    BRAKE W/L

    Brake warning
    lamp

    When Brake warning lamp is ON

    On*

    When Brake warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    DOOR W/L

    Door open
    warning lamp

    When Door warning lamp is ON

    On

    When Door warning lamp is OFF

    Off

    HI-BEAM IND

    HI-Beam indicator lamp

    When High-beam indicator lamp is ON

    On

    When High-beam indicator lamp is OFF

    Off

    TURN IND

    Turn signal indicator

    When Turn signal indicator lamp is ON

    On

    When Turn signal indicator lamp is OFF

    Off

    LIGHT IND

    Light indicator

    When Tail lamp indicator lamp is ON

    On

    When Tail lamp indicator lamp is OFF

    Off

    FR FOG IND

    Front fog lamp
    indicator

    Front fog lamp indicator lamp ON

    On

    Front fog lamp indicator lamp OFF

    Off

    When engine oil pressure warning lamp is
    ON

    On

    OIL W/L

    Engine oil pressure warning
    light

    When engine oil pressure warning lamp is
    OFF

    Off

    When Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is
    ON

    On

    When Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is
    OFF

    Off

    Cruise indicator
    lamp

    When cruise indicator lamp is ON.

    ON

    When cruise indicator lamp is OFF.

    Off

    O/D OFF indicator

    When O/D OFF indicator lamp is OFF.

    Off

    When O/D OFF indicator lamp is ON.

    On

    MIL

    CRUISE IND
    O/D OFF IND

    Revision: April 2013

    MIL warning
    lamp

    WCS-14

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Monitor Item

    Data monitor

    Display content

    O/D OFF SW

    O/D OFF
    switch
    Rear defogger
    switch

    REAR DEF SW

    Condition

    Reference value in normal operation

    When O/D OFF switch is pressed to OFF.

    Off

    When O/D OFF switch is pressed to ON.

    On

    When rear defogger switch is pressed to
    ON

    On

    When rear defogger is pressed to Off

    Off

    When brake pedal is applied

    On

    When brake pedal is released

    Off
    On

    BRAKE SW

    Brake switch

    FUEL W/L

    Low fuel warning

    When low fuel warning is ON
    When low fuel warning is Off

    Off

    EPS W/L

    EPS warning
    lamp

    EPS warning lamp ON

    On

    EPS warning lamp OFF

    Off

    CHAGE W/L

    Charge warning lamp

    Engine running

    Off

    SHIFT IND

    Shift position
    indicator

    The position of the shift position selector.

    FUEL CAP W/L

    Loose fuel cap
    warning

    Loose fuel filler cap warning is On

    On

    Loose fuel filler cap warning is Off

    Off

    PKB SW

    Parking brake
    switch

    When parking brake is active

    On

    When parking brake is inactive

    Off

    BUCKLE SW

    Seat belt buckle switch LH

    When seat belt buckle is unfastened (LH).

    On

    When seat belt buckle is fastened (LH).

    Off

    BRAKE OIL SW

    Brake fluid level
    switch

    When brake fluid level switch ON

    On

    When brake fluid level switch OFF

    Off

    DISTANCE

    Distance to
    empty

    BUZZER

    Buzzer operation

    While driving

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    [P, R, N, D, L]

    G

    H

    I

    J

    [km/h or mph]

    When Buzzer is ON

    On

    When Buzzer is OFF

    Off

    K

    *: Displays “Off” if the brake warning lamp is illuminated when the valve check starts, the parking brake switch
    is turned ON or the brake fluid level switch is turned ON.

    L

    TERMINAL LAYOUT
    M

    WCS

    O
    JSNIA5390ZZ

    PHYSICAL VALUES
    Terminal
    No.

    Wire
    color

    1

    L

    2

    P

    P
    Condition
    Ignition
    switch

    Operation or condition

    Reference value (V)
    (Approx.)

    CAN-H

    CAN-L

    Item

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-15

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Terminal
    No.

    Wire
    color

    3

    SB

    4

    Condition
    Ignition
    switch

    Operation or condition

    Reference value (V)
    (Approx.)

    2P/R

    LG

    8P/R

    6

    W

    Fuel level sensor signal (+)

    7

    V

    Air bag

    8

    P

    O/D OFF switch

    ON

    9

    V

    Seat belt buckle switch LH

    ON

    10

    SB

    Parking Brake switch

    ON

    11

    BR

    Brake fluid level switch

    ON

    15

    R

    18

    R/Y

    21

    B

    22

    B

    23

    B

    24

    Item

    Refer to MWI-42, «Component Inspection».

    O/D OFF switch pressed

    0

    O/D OFF switch released

    Battery voltage

    Unfastened (ON)

    0

    Fastened (OFF)

    Battery voltage

    Parking brake is inactive
    Parking brake is active

    0
    Battery voltage

    Brake fluid level low
    Brake fluid level normal

    0
    Battery voltage

    Ignition switch ON or ACC

    Battery voltage

    Security

    Ground

    0

    GR

    Fuel level sensor ground (-)

    ON

    0

    27

    R/W

    Battery power supply

    OFF

    Battery voltage

    28

    GR

    Ignition switch ON or START

    ON

    Battery voltage

    38

    Y

    Generator

    Generator voltage low

    ON

    Generator voltage normal

    0
    Battery voltage

    Fail-safe

    INFOID:0000000009641718

    The combination meter activates the fail-safe control if CAN communication with each unit is malfunctioning.
    Function

    Specifications

    Speedometer

    Reset to zero by suspending communication.

    Tachometer
    Illumination control

    When suspending communication, changes to nighttime mode.

    Shift position indicator

    When suspending communication, not indicate.
    Current fuel consumption
    Trip computer

    Information display

    Average fuel consumption
    Distance to empty

    Buzzer

    Revision: April 2013

    • When reception time of an abnormal signal is 2 seconds or
    less, the last received datum is used for calculation to indicate the result.
    • When reception time of an abnormal signal is more than two
    seconds, the last result calculated during normal condition is
    indicated.

    Engine coolant temperature gauge

    Reset to zero by suspending communication.

    Odo/trip meter

    An indicated value is maintained at communications blackout.
    The buzzer turns OFF by suspending communication.

    WCS-16

    2014 Note

    COMBINATION METER
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
    Function

    Specifications

    A

    ABS warning lamp
    Malfunction indicator lamp (MIL)
    EPS warning lamp

    The lamp turns ON by suspending communication.

    B

    Brake warning lamp
    High beam indicator lamp

    C

    Turn signal indicator lamp
    Warning lamp/indicator lamp

    Door warning lamp
    Light indicator lamp

    D

    Engine oil pressure warning lamp

    The lamp turns OFF by suspending communication.

    Key warning lamp

    E

    O/D OFF indicator lamp
    Shift P warning lamp
    Engine start operation indicator lamp

    DTC Index

    F
    INFOID:0000000009641719

    G
    Display contents of CONSULT

    Diagnostic item is detected when…

    Refer to

    CAN COMM CIRCUIT
    [U1000]

    When combination meter is not transmitting or receiving CAN communication signal for
    2 seconds or more.

    MWI-34

    CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
    [U1010]

    When detecting error during the initial diagnosis of the CAN controller of combination
    meter.

    MWI-35

    VEHICLE SPEED
    [B2205]

    The abnormal vehicle speed signal is input from the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit) for 2 seconds or more.

    MWI-36

    ENGINE SPEED
    [B2267]

    If ECM continuously transmits abnormal engine speed signals for 2 seconds or more.

    MWI-37

    WATER TEMP
    [B2268]

    If ECM continuously transmits abnormal engine coolant temperature signals for 60 seconds or more.

    MWI-38

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-17

    2014 Note

    BCM
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    BCM
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009014787

    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-18

    2014 Note

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009014788

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O

    P

    AANWA0863GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-19

    2014 Note

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1730GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-20

    2014 Note

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O
    AANIA1731GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-21

    2014 Note

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AANIA1732GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-22

    2014 Note

    WARNING CHIME SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O
    ABNIA4579GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-23

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009014789

    OVERALL SEQUENCE

    JSNIA4485GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1.OBTAIN INFORMATION ABOUT SYMPTOM
    Interview the customer to obtain as much information as possible about the conditions and environment under
    which the malfunction occurred.
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK SYMPTOM
    • Check the symptom based on the information obtained from the customer.
    • Check if any other malfunctions are present.
    >> GO TO 3.

    3.CHECK CONSULT SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS
    1.

    Connect CONSULT and perform self-diagnosis. Refer to WCS-17, «DTC Index».

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-24

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORK FLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    2. When DTC is detected, follow the instructions below:
    Record DTC and Freeze Frame Data.
    Are self-diagnosis results normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4.
    NO
    >> GO TO 5.

    A

    B

    4.NARROW DOWN MALFUNCTIONING PARTS BY SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    Perform symptom diagnosis and narrow down the malfunctioning parts.

    C

    >> GO TO 5.

    5.REPAIR OR REPLACE MALFUNCTIONING PARTS

    D

    Repair or replace malfunctioning parts.
    NOTE:
    If DTC is displayed, erase DTC after repairing or replacing malfunctioning parts.

    E

    >> GO TO 6.

    6.FINAL CHECK

    F

    Check that the warning buzzer in the combination meter operates normally.
    Does it operate normally?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 1.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-25

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    COMBINATION METER
    COMBINATION METER : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009549388

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to MWI-22, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK FUSE
    Check that the following fuses are not blown.
    Power source

    Fuse No.

    Battery

    8

    Ignition switch ON or START

    3

    Ignition switch ACC or ON

    18

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.

    2.POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT CHECK

    1.
    2.

    Disconnect combination meter connector.
    Check voltage between combination meter harness connector M24, terminals 27, 28, 15 and ground.
    Terminals
    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    Ignition switch position
    (–)

    27
    M24

    28

    OFF

    ACC

    ON

    START

    Battery voltage

    Battery voltage

    Battery
    voltage

    Battery voltage

    0V

    0V

    Battery
    voltage

    Battery voltage

    0V

    Battery voltage

    Battery
    voltage

    0V

    Ground

    15

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    3.GROUND

    1.
    2.
    3.

    CIRCUIT CHECK

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination meter connector.
    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector M24, terminals 21, 22, 23 and ground.
    Terminals
    (+)
    Connector

    Terminal

    (–)

    Continuity

    21
    M24

    22

    Ground

    Yes

    23

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-26

    2014 Note

    POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM

    A

    BODY CONTROL SYSTEM : Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009725669

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to BCS-48, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1.CHECK FUSES AND FUSIBLE LINK
    Check that the following fuses and fusible link are not blown.
    Terminal No.

    D

    Signal name

    57

    Fuses and fusible link No.

    70

    E

    12 (10A)

    Battery power supply

    G (40A)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the blown fuse or fusible link after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    G

    Disconnect BCM connector M99.
    Check voltage between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    H
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    Voltage

    Battery voltage

    I

    57

    M99

    Ground

    70

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    J

    3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT

    K

    Check continuity between BCM connector M99 and ground.
    L

    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M99

    67

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    WCS

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-27

    2014 Note

    METER BUZZER CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    METER BUZZER CIRCUIT
    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009541214

    1.CHECK OPERATION OF METER BUZZER
    1. Select BUZZER of BCM(BUZZER) on CONSULT.
    2. Perform LIGHT WARN ALM of Active Test.
    Does meter buzzer beep?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL

    Select the DATA MONITOR for the METER/MA and check the BUZZER monitor value.
    BUZZER
    Under the condition of buzzer input

    : On

    Except above

    : Off

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541215

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WCS-19, «Wiring Diagram».

    1.CHECK POWER SUPPLY OF COMBINATION METER
    Check power supply of combination meter. Refer to WCS-26, «COMBINATION METER : Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Repair power supply circuit of combination meter.

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-28

    2014 Note

    SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009541216

    Transmits a seat belt buckle switch LH signal to the combination meter.

    B

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009541217

    1. CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL

    C

    Select DATA MONITOR for METER/M&A and check the SEAT BELT W/L monitor value.
    Monitor Item
    BUCKLE SW

    Condition

    Status

    When seat belt LH (driver seat) is fastened

    OFF

    When seat belt LH (driver seat) is unfastened

    ON

    D

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Refer to WCS-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541218

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WCS-19, «Wiring Diagram».
    H

    1.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between combination meter harness connector M24 terminal 9 and ground.
    Combination meter
    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    9

    Condition

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    When seat belt LH (driver seat) is fastened

    12 V

    When seat belt LH (driver seat) is unfastened

    0V

    Ground

    I

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    M
    Disconnect combination meter harness connector M24 and seat belt buckle switch LH (driver seat) harness connector B16.
    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector M24 terminal 9 and seat belt buckle
    WCS
    switch LH (driver seat) harness connector B13 terminal 1.
    Combination meter

    4.

    K

    L

    2.CHECK SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    J

    Seat belt buckle switch LH (driver seat)

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    9

    B13

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between combination meter harness connector M24 terminal 9 and ground.
    Combination meter
    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    9

    P

    Ground

    Continuity

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-29

    O

    2014 Note

    SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    3.CHECK SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between seat belt buckle switch LH (driver seat) harness connector B13 terminal 2 and
    ground.
    Seat belt buckle switch LH (driver seat)
    Connector

    Terminal

    B13

    2

    Ground

    Continuity

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check the seat belt buckle switch LH. Refer to SR-24, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009541219

    1. CHECK SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH LH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect the seat belt buckle switch LH (driver seat).
    Check continuity between the seat belt buckle switch LH (driver seat) terminals 1 and 2.
    Terminal
    1

    Condition
    2

    Continuity

    When seat belt is fastened

    No

    When seat belt is unfastened

    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace the seat belt buckle switch LH. Refer to SR-24, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-30

    2014 Note

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009643757

    1.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH OPERATION

    B

    Check that brake warning lamp in combination meter turns ON/OFF when parking brake is actuated.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Proceed to diagnosis procedure. Refer to WCS-31, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    C

    Diagnosis Procedure

    D

    INFOID:0000000009643758

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WCS-19, «Wiring Diagram».

    E

    1.CONNECTOR INSPECTION

    F

    1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
    2. Disconnect combination meter and parking brake switch connectors.
    3. Check connectors and terminals for deformation, disconnection, looseness or damage.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Repair or replace as necessary.

    G

    H

    2.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH

    Check parking brake switch. Refer to WCS-32, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace parking brake switch. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».

    I

    3.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    J

    With CONSULT.
    Connect combination meter connector and parking brake switch connectors.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    In DATA MONITOR select PARK BRAKE SW and check parking brake switch signal.
    Condition

    DATA MONITOR

    Actuate parking brake

    On

    Release parking brake

    Off

    K

    L

    M

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Refer to WCS-24, «Work Flow».
    NO
    >> GO TO 4.

    WCS

    4.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination meter and parking brake switch connectors.
    Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 terminal 10 and parking brake switch connector M17 terminal 1.
    Combination meter

    4.

    Parking brake switch

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    10

    M17

    1

    Continuity
    Yes

    Check continuity between combination meter connector and ground.

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-31

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    Combination meter
    Connector

    Terminal

    M24

    10

    Continuity

    Ground

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace malfunctioning components.

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009643759

    1.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect parking brake switch connector.
    Check continuity between parking brake switch terminal 1 and ground.

    Parking brake switch terminal

    1

    Ground

    Condition

    Continuity

    Parking brake actuated

    Yes

    Parking brake released

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> Replace parking brake switch. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-32

    2014 Note

    THE PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CONTINUES SOUNDING, OR
    DOES NOT SOUND
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    THE PARKING BRAKE RELEASE WARNING CONTINUES SOUNDING, OR
    DOES NOT SOUND
    Description

    B

    INFOID:0000000009541244

    • The parking brake warning buzzer sounds continuously during vehicle travel though the parking brake is
    released.
    • The parking brake warning buzzer does not sound at all even though driving the vehicle with the parking
    brake applied.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    C

    D

    INFOID:0000000009541245

    1.CHECK PARKING BRAKE WARNING LAMP
    1.
    2.

    A

    E

    Start the engine.
    Check the operation of the brake warning lamp by operating the parking brake.
    F
    Combination meter
    Brake warning lamp

    Condition

    Status

    When parking brake is applied

    ON

    When parking brake is released

    OFF

    G

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    H

    2.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH

    I

    Check the parking brake switch. Refer to WCS-32, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Replace parking brake switch. Refer to PB-6, «Exploded View».

    J

    3.CHECK PARKING BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    Check the parking brake switch signal circuit. Refer to BRC-58, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-33

    2014 Note

    THE SEAT BELT REMINDER WARNING CONTINUES SOUNDING, OR DOES
    NOT SOUND
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    THE SEAT BELT REMINDER WARNING CONTINUES SOUNDING, OR
    DOES NOT SOUND
    Description

    INFOID:0000000009541246

    • Seat belt reminder warning does not sound.
    • Seat belt reminder warning sounds continuously.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541247

    1.CHECK SEAT BELT WARNING LAMP
    1.
    2.

    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check operation of seat belt warning lamp in combination meter.
    Combination meter
    Seat belt warning lamp

    Condition

    Status

    When seat belt LH (driver seat) is fastened

    OFF

    When seat belt LH (driver seat) is unfastened

    ON

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2.CHECK SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH LH SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    Check the seat belt buckle switch LH signal circuit. Refer to WCS-29, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair harness or connector.

    3.CHECK SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH LH

    Check seat belt buckle switch LH. Refer to WCS-30, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace seat belt buckle LH. Refer to SR-24, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-34

    2014 Note

    THE LIGHT REMINDER WARNING DOES NOT SOUND
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    THE LIGHT REMINDER WARNING DOES NOT SOUND
    Description

    A
    INFOID:0000000009541248

    Light reminder warning chime does not sound even though headlamps are illuminated.

    Diagnosis Procedure

    B
    INFOID:0000000009541249

    1.CHECK COMBINATION METER INPUT SIGNAL

    C

    Select the Data Monitor for the METER/M&A and check the BUZZER monitor value.
    Monitor Item
    BUZZER

    Condition

    Status

    Under the condition of buzzer input

    ON

    Except above

    OFF

    D

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-48, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    F

    2.CHECK DRIVER SIDE DOOR SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    Check the driver side door switch signal circuit. Refer to DLK-84, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness or connector.

    G

    H

    3.CHECK DRIVER SIDE DOOR SWITCH

    Check the driver side door switch. Refer to DLK-85, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace the BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Replace driver side door switch. Refer to DLK-158, «Removal and Installation».

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    WCS

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WCS-35

    2014 Note

    SUSPENSION

    SECTION

    WT

    ROAD WHEELS & TIRES

    A

    B

    C

    D

    WT

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 2
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 2
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 2
    Service Notice and Precautions for Road Wheel …… 2

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 3
    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 3
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 3

    WHEEL AND TIRE ……………………………………… 5
    Adjustment ………………………………………………………. 5

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ……………. 8

    G

    WHEEL AND TIRE ……………………………………… 8
    Exploded View …………………………………………………. 8
    Removal and Installation …………………………………… 8

    H

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………. 9

    I

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE …………………….. 4

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ………………………………………………………… 9

    WHEEL ………………………………………………………. 4

    Wheel …………………………………………………………….. 9
    Tire Air Pressure ………………………………………………. 9

    Inspection ………………………………………………………… 4

    F

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-1

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION
    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    INFOID:0000000009445894

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Service Notice and Precautions for Road Wheel

    INFOID:0000000009443478

    • Genuine NISSAN aluminum wheel is designed for each type of vehicle. Use it on the specified vehicle only.
    • Use Genuine NISSAN parts for the road wheels, valve caps and wheel nuts.
    • Always use them after adjusting the wheel balance. For the balance weights, use Genuine NISSAN aluminum wheel weights.
    • Use caution when handling the aluminum wheels, because they can be easily scratched. When removing
    dirt, do not use any abrasives, a wire brush, or other items that may scratch the coating. Use a neutral detergent if a detergent is needed.
    • After driving on roads scattered with anti-icing salts, wash off the wheels completely.
    • When installing road wheels onto the vehicle, always wipe off any dirt or foreign substances to prevent them
    from being trapped between the contact surfaces of wheel.
    • Do not apply oil to nut and bolt threads.
    • When tightening the valve cap there is a risk of damaging the valve cap if a tool is used. Tighten by hand.

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-2

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009443480

    Tool name

    Description

    Power tool

    Loosening nuts, screws and bolts

    B

    C

    D

    WT
    PIIB1407E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-3

    2014 Note

    WHEEL
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
    WHEEL
    Inspection
    1.
    2.
    a.
    b.
    c.

    INFOID:0000000009641735

    Check tires for wear and improper inflation.
    Check wheels for deformation, cracks and other damage. If deformed, remove wheel and check wheel
    runout.
    Remove tire from wheel and mount wheel on a balancer machine.
    Set dial indicator as shown.
    Check runout, if runout value exceeds the limit, replace wheel.
    Limit
    Axial Runout (A)
    Radial Runout (B)

    Refer to WT-9, «Wheel».
    Refer to WT-9, «Wheel».

    SEIA0737E

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-4

    2014 Note

    WHEEL AND TIRE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >

    WHEEL AND TIRE

    A

    Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009641736

    BALANCING WHEELS (ADHESIVE WEIGHT TYPE)

    B

    Preparation Before Adjustment
    Remove inner and outer balance weights from the wheel and tire. Using releasing agent, remove double-faced
    adhesive tape from the wheel and tire.
    CAUTION:
    • Be careful not to scratch the wheel and tire during removal.
    • After removing double-faced adhesive tape, wipe clean all traces of releasing agent from the wheel
    and tire.

    C

    D

    Wheel Balance Adjustment
    CAUTION:
    WT
    • DO NOT use center hole cone-type clamping machines to hold the wheel during tire removal/installation or balancing or damage to the wheel paint, cladding or chrome may result. Use only rim-type or
    universal lug-type clamping machines to hold the wheel during servicing.
    • If a balancer machine has an adhesive weight mode setting, select the adhesive weight mode setting and F
    skip Step 2 below. If a balancer machine only has the clip-on (rim flange) weight mode setting, follow Step 2
    to calculate the correct size adhesive weight.
    G
    1. Set wheel and tire on balancer machine using the center hole as a guide. Start the balancer machine.
    2. For balancer machines that only have a clip-on (rim flange) weight mode setting, follow this step to calculate the correct size adhesive weight to use. When inner and outer imbalance values are shown on the
    balancer machine indicator, multiply outer imbalance value by 5/3 (1.67) to determine balance weight that H
    should be used. Select the outer balance weight with a value closest to the calculated value above and
    install in to the designated outer position of or at the designated angle in relation to the wheel and tire.
    a. Indicated imbalance value × 5/3 (1.67) = balance weight to be
    I
    installed
    Calculation example:
    23 g (0.81 oz) × 5/3 (1.67) = 38.33 g (1.35 oz) ⇒ 40 g (1.41 oz)
    J
    balance weight (closer to calculated balance weight value)
    NOTE:
    Note that balance weight value must be closer to the calculated
    balance weight value.
    K
    Example:
    37.4 ⇒ 35 g (1.23 oz)
    37.5 ⇒ 40 g (1.41 oz)
    L
    SMA054D

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-5

    2014 Note

    WHEEL AND TIRE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    3. Install balance weight in the position shown.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not install the inner balance weight before installing
    the outer balance weight.
    • Before installing the balance weight, be sure to clean the
    mating surface of the wheel and tire.
    • When installing balance weight (1) to wheel and tire, set it into
    the grooved area (A) on the inner wall of the wheel and tire as
    shown so that the balance weight center (B) is aligned with the
    balancer machine indication position (angle) (C).
    CAUTION:
    • Always use Genuine NISSAN adhesive balance weights.
    • Balance weights are non-reusable; always replace with
    new ones.
    • Do not install more than three sheets of balance
    weights.

    JPEIC0040ZZ

    4.

    5.
    6.

    7.
    8.

    If calculated balance weight value exceeds 50 g (1.76 oz), install
    two balance weight sheets in line with each other as shown.
    CAUTION:
    Do not install one balance weight sheet on top of another.
    Start balancer machine again.
    Install balance weight on inner side of wheel and tire in the balancer machine indication position (angle).
    CAUTION:
    Do not install more than two balance weights.
    Start balancer machine. Make sure that inner and outer residual
    imbalance values are 5 g (0.17 oz) each or below.
    If either residual imbalance value exceeds 5 g (0.17 oz), repeat installation procedures.
    Wheel balance

    Maximum allowable imbalance

    Dynamic (At flange)

    PEIA0033E

    Static (At flange)

    Refer to WT-9, «Wheel».

    TIRE ROTATION
    • Follow the maintenance schedule for tire rotation service intervals.
    Refer to MA-7, «FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance» (FOR
    MEXICO), or MA-9, «EXCEPT FOR MEXICO : Periodic Maintenance» (EXCEPT FOR MEXICO).
    • Rotate the wheel and tires front to back in the pattern as shown.
    • When installing the wheel, tighten wheel nuts to the specified
    torque.
    WARNING:
    • After rotating the tires, check and adjust the tire pressure.
    • Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven
    for 1,000 km (600 mi) (also in case of a flat tire, etc.).
    • Do not include the spare tire when rotating the tires.

    SMA829C

    CAUTION:
    • When installing wheels, tighten them diagonally by dividing the work two to three times in order to
    prevent the wheels from developing any distortion.
    Revision: April 2013

    WT-6

    2014 Note

    WHEEL AND TIRE
    < PERIODIC MAINTENANCE >
    • Be careful not to tighten the wheel nuts to a torque exceeding specification to prevent strain on the
    disc rotor.
    • Use Genuine NISSAN wheel nuts.
    Wheel nut tightening
    torque

    : WT-8, «Exploded View»

    A

    B

    C

    D

    WT

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-7

    2014 Note

    WHEEL AND TIRE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    WHEEL AND TIRE
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009446829

    JSGIA0969GB

    1.

    Wheel and tire

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009446830

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Remove wheel nuts using power tool.
    Remove wheel and tire.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-8

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Wheel

    INFOID:0000000009443523

    B

    ALUMINUM WHEEL
    Item
    Axial runout

    Runout

    Less than 0.3 mm (0.012 in)

    Radial runout

    Allowable imbalance

    C

    Limit

    Dynamic (At flange)

    D

    Less than 5 g (0.17 oz) (one side)

    Static (At flange)

    Less than 10 g (0.35 oz)

    Tire Air Pressure

    WT
    INFOID:0000000009443524

    Unit: kPa (kg/cm2, psi)

    Tire size
    P195/55R16 86H
    P185/65R15 88H
    T125/70D15

    F

    Cold tire pressure
    Front

    Rear

    Spare

    230 (2.3, 33)

    230 (2.3, 33)

    420 (4.2, 60)

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    L

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WT-9

    2014 Note

    DRIVER CONTROLS

    SECTION

    WW

    WIPER & WASHER

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    CONTENTS
    PRECAUTION ……………………………………….. 3
    PRECAUTIONS …………………………………………… 3
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
    (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER» …………………………………………………………. 3
    Procedure without Cowl Top Cover ………………….. 3
    Precaution for Work ………………………………………….. 3

    COMMON ITEM …………………………………………………14
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM COMMON ITEM) ……………………………………………..14
    WIPER ………………………………………………………………14
    WIPER : CONSULT Function (BCM — WIPER) …….15

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R) ………………. 16

    PREPARATION …………………………………….. 5

    Diagnosis Description ……………………………………….16
    CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R) ………………………..17

    PREPARATION …………………………………………… 5

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ………….. 20

    Special Service Tools ………………………………………… 5
    Commercial Service Tool …………………………………… 5

    BCM, IPDM E/R …………………………………………. 20

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ………………………… 6
    COMPONENT PARTS …………………………………. 6
    Component Parts Location …………………………………. 6
    Component Description …………………………………….. 6

    SYSTEM …………………………………………………….. 8
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM ………………. 8
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Diagram …………………………………………………….. 8
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Description ………………………………………………… 8
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : Circuit
    Diagram …………………………………………………………. 10
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : FailSafe ………………………………………………………………. 11
    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM ………………. 11
    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System
    Diagram …………………………………………………………. 11
    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System
    Description …………………………………………………….. 11
    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : Circuit
    Diagram …………………………………………………………. 13

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM) ……………………….14
    Revision: April 2013

    List of ECU Reference ………………………………………20

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    WIRING DIAGRAM ……………………………….. 21
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM …….. 21

    K

    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..21

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM ………. 25 WW
    Wiring Diagram ………………………………………………..25

    BASIC INSPECTION …………………………….. 30
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW …….. 30

    M

    Work Flow ……………………………………………………….30

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ……………………. 32

    N

    WIPER AND WASHER FUSE ……………………… 32
    Description ………………………………………………………32
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..32

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR LO CIRCUIT ………….. 33
    Component Function Check ………………………………33
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..33

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR HI CIRCUIT …………… 35
    Component Function Check ………………………………35
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………..35

    WW-1

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    FRONT WIPER AUTO STOP SIGNAL CIRCUIT …………………………………………………………. 37
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 37
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 37

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT … 39
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 39

    WASHER NOZZLE : Adjustment ………………………. 56
    WASHER TUBE ……………………………………………….. 56
    WASHER TUBE : Removal and Installation ……….. 56
    WASHER TUBE : Inspection ……………………………. 57

    FRONT WIPER ARM ………………………………….. 58

    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 40

    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 58
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 58
    Adjustment …………………………………………………….. 59

    WASHER SWITCH …………………………………….. 41

    FRONT WIPER BLADE ………………………………. 60

    WASHER MOTOR CIRCUIT ……………………….. 40

    Description …………………………………………………….. 41
    Component Inspection …………………………………….. 41

    REAR WIPER MOTOR CIRCUIT …………………. 43
    Component Function Check …………………………….. 43
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 43

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 60

    FRONT WIPER DRIVE ASSEMBLY …………….. 61
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 61
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 61
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 62
    Disassembly and Assembly ……………………………… 62

    REAR WIPER AUTO STOP SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    … 45

    WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH …………………. 63

    Component Function Check …………………………….. 45
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 45

    REAR WIPER ARM ……………………………………. 64

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ……………………….. 46
    WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    … 46
    Symptom Table ……………………………………………… 46

    FRONT WIPER DOES NOT OPERATE ………… 49
    Description …………………………………………………….. 49
    Diagnosis Procedure ………………………………………. 49

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION ……………. 51
    Description …………………………………………………….. 51

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION …………… 52
    WASHER TANK ………………………………………… 52
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 52
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 52

    FRONT WASHER MOTOR ………………………….. 54
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 54
    Removal and Installation …………………………………. 54

    FRONT WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE ……….. 55
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 55
    WASHER NOZZLE …………………………………………… 55
    WASHER NOZZLE : Removal and Installation …… 55

    Revision: April 2013

    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 63
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 64
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 64
    Adjustment …………………………………………………….. 65

    REAR WIPER BLADE ………………………………… 66
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 66

    REAR WIPER MOTOR ……………………………….. 67
    Exploded View ……………………………………………….. 67
    Removal and Installation ………………………………….. 67

    REAR WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE …………. 68
    Component Parts Location ………………………………. 68
    WASHER NOZZLE ……………………………………………. 68
    WASHER NOZZLE : Removal and Installation ……. 68
    WASHER NOZZLE : Adjustment ………………………. 68
    WASHER TUBE ……………………………………………….. 69
    WASHER TUBE : Removal and Installation ……….. 69

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) …………………………………………………. 71
    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS
    (SDS) ……………………………………………………….. 71
    Specifications …………………………………………………. 71

    WW-2

    2014 Note

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >

    PRECAUTION

    A

    PRECAUTIONS
    Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) «AIR BAG» and «SEAT BELT
    PRE-TENSIONER»

    B

    INFOID:0000000009578755

    The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
    with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
    types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
    this Service Manual.
    WARNING:
    • To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
    the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
    an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
    • Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
    injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
    Module, see the SR section.
    • Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
    Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or harness connectors.

    PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
    WARNING:
    • When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Ignition ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
    hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
    serious injury.
    • When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
    battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.

    Procedure without Cowl Top Cover

    INFOID:0000000009578757

    When performing the procedure after removing cowl top cover, cover
    the lower end of windshield with urethane, etc. to prevent damage to
    the windshield.

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M
    PIIB3706J

    Precaution for Work

    INFOID:0000000009578756

    • When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
    may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
    • When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
    with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
    • Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
    • Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
    • If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
    • Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
    • After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
    • Follow the steps below to clean components:
    — Water soluble dirt:
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Oily dirt:
    Revision: April 2013

    WW-3

    2014 Note

    N

    O

    P

    PRECAUTIONS
    < PRECAUTION >
    • Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
    area.
    • Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
    • Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
    — Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
    — For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-4

    2014 Note

    PREPARATION
    < PREPARATION >

    PREPARATION

    A

    PREPARATION
    Special Service Tools

    INFOID:0000000009578779

    B

    The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.

    Tool number
    (Kent-Moore No.)
    Tool name

    Description


    (J-46534)
    Trim Tool Set

    Removing trim components

    C

    D

    E
    AWJIA0483ZZ

    F

    Commercial Service Tool

    INFOID:0000000009645416

    Tool name

    Description

    Washer nozzle adjuster

    Adjusting washer nozzle

    G

    H

    I
    JSLIA0149ZZ

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-5

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
    COMPONENT PARTS
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009541130

    AWLIA2151ZZ

    A.

    Front and rear washer motor B.
    (view with RF fender protector removed)

    D.

    Rear wiper motor

    Front wiper motor
    (view with cowl top removed)

    Component Description

    Revision: April 2013

    C.

    Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)

    INFOID:0000000009541131

    WW-6

    2014 Note

    COMPONENT PARTS
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    No.

    Component

    Function

    A

    1.

    BCM

    • Monitors combination switch status by performing the combination switch reading function.
    • Sends front wiper relay and front wiper high relay ON signals to IPDM E/R.

    2.

    IPDM E/R

    • Controls front wiper relay and front wiper high relay.
    • Performs the auto stop control of the front wiper.

    B

    3.

    Front and rear washer motor

    • Washer fluid sprayed according to washer switch states.
    • Combination switch operates front washer or rear washer by changing voltage polarity to be supplied to washer pump.

    C

    4.

    Front wiper motor

    • Drives windshield wipers in HI or LO mode.
    • Sends wiper stop signal to IPDM E/R.

    Combination switch
    (Wiper and washer switch)

    • Provides input for wiper and washer control to BCM.
    • Refer to WW-8, «FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Description» for more information.

    D

    5.

    6.

    Rear wiper motor

    • BCM controls rear wiper operation.
    • Sends wiper stop signal to BCM.

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-7

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    SYSTEM
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009541132

    AWLIA2154GB

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Description

    INFOID:0000000009541133

    FRONT WIPER CONTROL (BASIC)
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    BCM detects the combination switch position by the combination switch reading function.
    BCM transmits the front wiper request signal to the IPDM E/R using CAN communication.
    IPDM E/R controls the integrated front wiper relay and front wiper high relay based on the status of the
    front wiper request signal.
    IPDM E/R provides power to operate the front wiper motor.

    LOW SPEED OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Ignition switch ON.
    Front wiper switch in LO or MIST position.
    BCM reads the combination switch position and transmits the front wiper request signal (LO) to IPDM E/R
    using CAN communication.
    IPDM E/R turns ON the front wiper relay.

    HIGH SPEED OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Ignition switch ON.
    Front wiper switch in HI.
    BCM reads the combination switch position and transmits the front wiper request signal (HI) to IPDM E/R
    using CAN communication.
    IPDM E/R turns ON the front wiper relay and the front wiper high relay.

    INTERMITTENT OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Ignition switch ON.
    Front wiper switch INT.
    BCM reads the combination switch position. BCM calculates the delay interval based on the table below
    and then transmits the front wiper request signal (INT) to IPDM E/R using CAN communication.
    IPDM E/R turns ON the front wiper relay only once.
    BCM detects stop position of the front wiper motor based on the front wiper stop position signal received
    from the IPDM E/R.
    BCM transmits the front wiper request signal (INT) again after the delay interval.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-8

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    A

    B

    C
    JPLIA0094GB

    D
    Intermittent switch position

    Length of delay

    Delay interval (s)

    7

    0.4

    6

    1

    5

    Short

    2

    4
    3

    E

    3

    Long

    F

    5

    2

    10

    1

    16

    G

    AUTO STOP OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Front wiper switch is turned OFF.
    BCM monitors wiper switch position by combination switch reading position function.
    BCM stops transmitting the front wiper request signal to the IPDM E/R.
    IPDM E/R detects the front wiper auto stop signal from the position of the front wiper motor (stop position/
    except stop position).
    When the front wiper request signal is stopped, IPDM E/R turns ON the front wiper relay until the front
    wiper motor returns to the stop position.
    IPDM E/R turns the front wiper relay OFF when the front wiper motor has reached the stop position.

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    JPLIA0095GB

    MIST OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Ignition switch ON.
    Front washer switch in OFF position.
    Front wiper switch in MIST position.
    BCM reads the combination switch position and transmits the front wiper request signal (LO) to IPDM E/R
    using CAN communication.
    IPDM E/R turns ON the front wiper relay.
    The front wiper operates once after the front washer operation.

    WIPER/WASHER OPERATION
    1.

    Ignition switch ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-9

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    2. Front washer switch ON.
    3. The front washer switch provides ground for the front and rear washer motor.
    4. BCM reads the combination switch position and transmits the front wiper request signal (LO) to IPDM E/R
    using CAN communication.
    5. BCM transmits the front wiper request signal (LO) to IPDM E/R using CAN communication.
    6. IPDM E/R turns ON the front wiper relay.
    7. The front wiper operates.
    NOTE:
    BCM transmits the front wiper request signal (LO) so that the front wiper operates approximately 3 times after
    front washer switch OFF is detected.

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : Circuit Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009567476

    ALLIA1298GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-10

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : Fail-Safe

    INFOID:0000000009541134

    A

    FAIL−SAFE OPERATION
    IPDM E/R performs the fail-safe function when the front wiper auto stop circuit is malfunctioning. Refer to
    PCS-18, «Fail-safe».

    B

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Diagram

    C

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM

    INFOID:0000000009567483

    D

    E

    F

    G
    AWLIA2158GB

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : System Description

    H
    INFOID:0000000009567484

    OUTLINE

    I

    The rear wiper is controlled by each function of BCM.
    Control by BCM

    J

    • Combination switch reading function
    • Rear wiper control function

    REAR WIPER BASIC OPERATION

    K

    • BCM detects the combination switch condition by the combination switch reading function.
    • BCM controls the rear wiper to start or stop.

    REAR WIPER ON OPERATION

    WW

    • BCM supplies power to the rear wiper motor according to the rear wiper ON operating condition.
    Rear wiper ON operating condition

    — Ignition switch ON
    — Rear wiper switch ON

    M

    REAR WIPER INT OPERATION

    N

    • BCM supplies power to the rear wiper motor according to the INT operating condition.
    Rear wiper INT operating condition


    Ignition switch ON
    Rear wiper switch INT
    BCM controls the rear wiper to operate once.
    BCM detects the rear wiper motor stopping position.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-11

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    • BCM supplies power to the rear wiper motor after an intermittent from the stop of the rear wiper motor.

    JPLIA0165GB

    REAR WIPER AUTO STOP OPERATION
    • BCM stops supplying power to the rear wiper motor when the rear wiper switch is turned OFF.
    • BCM reads an auto stop signal from the rear wiper motor to detect a rear wiper motor position.
    • When the rear wiper motor is at other than the stopping position, BCM continues to supply power to the rear
    wiper motor until it returns to the stopping position.

    JPLIA0166GB

    NOTE:
    BCM stops supplying power to the rear wiper motor when the ignition switch is turned OFF.

    REAR WIPER OPERATION LINKED WITH WASHER
    • BCM supplies power to the rear wiper motor according to the washer linked operating condition of rear
    wiper. When the rear washer switch is turned OFF, BCM controls rear wiper to operate approximately three
    times.
    Washer linked operating condition of rear wiper

    — Ignition switch ON
    — Rear washer switch ON (0.4 second or more)
    • Front and rear washer motor becomes grounded through the combination switch (wiper and washer switch)
    when the rear washer switch is turned ON.

    REAR WIPER DROP WIPE OPERATION
    • BCM controls the rear wiper to operate once according to the rear wiper drop wipe operating condition.
    Rear wiper drop wipe operating condition

    Ignition switch ON
    Rear wiper switch OFF
    Rear washer switch OFF
    BCM controls the rear wiper so that it operates once time approximately three seconds later after the washer
    interlocking operation of the rear wiper.

    REAR WIPER FAIL−SAFE OPERATION
    BCM performs the fail-safe function when the rear wiper auto stop circuit is malfunctioning. Refer to BCS-44,
    «Fail-safe».

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-12

    2014 Note

    SYSTEM
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM : Circuit Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009567486

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    ALLIA1300GB

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-13

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    COMMON ITEM
    COMMON ITEM : CONSULT Function (BCM — COMMON ITEM)

    INFOID:0000000009567679

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with BCM.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    ECU identification

    The BCM part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The BCM self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The BCM input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Active Test

    The BCM activates outputs to test components.

    Work support

    The settings for BCM functions can be changed.

    Configuration

    • The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
    • The vehicle specification can be written when replacing BCM.

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    SYSTEM APPLICATION
    BCM can perform the following functions.

    Work support

    ×

    ×

    REAR DEFOGGER

    ×

    ×

    BUZZER

    ×

    ×

    Interior room lamp timer

    INT LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Exterior lamp

    HEAD LAMP

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Wiper and washer

    WIPER

    ×

    ×

    ×

    Turn signal and hazard warning lamps

    FLASHER

    ×

    ×

    Air conditioner

    AIR CONDITIONER

    ×

    Intelligent Key system

    INTELLIGENT KEY

    Combination switch

    COMB SW

    BCM

    BCM

    Immobilizer

    IMMU

    Interior room lamp battery saver

    BATTERY SAVER

    Vehicle security system

    Door lock

    DOOR LOCK

    Rear window defogger
    Warning chime

    ×

    ×

    ×

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    Active Test

    ×

    Sub System

    Configuration

    Data Monitor

    ×

    System

    ECU identification

    Self Diagnostic Result

    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×
    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    ×

    THEFT ALM

    ×

    ×

    ×

    RAP system

    RETAINED PWR

    ×

    Signal buffer system

    SIGNAL BUFFER

    ×

    ×

    WIPER

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-14

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BCM)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    WIPER : CONSULT Function (BCM — WIPER)

    INFOID:0000000009567680

    A

    DATA MONITOR
    Monitor Item [Unit]

    B

    Description

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch.

    VEH SPEED 1 [km/h]

    Indicates vehicle speed signal received from ABS on CAN communication line.

    FR WIPER HI [On/Off]
    FR WIPER LOW [On/Off]
    FR WASHER SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of wiper operation of combination switch.

    C

    D

    FR WIPER INT [On/Off]
    FR WIPER STOP [On/Off]

    Indicates front wiper auto stop signal received from IPDM E/R on CAN communication
    line.

    INT VOLUME [1 − 7]

    Indicates condition of intermittent wiper operation of combination switch.

    RR WIPER ON [On/Off]
    RR WIPER INT [On/Off]

    E

    F

    Indicates condition of rear wiper operation of combination switch.

    RR WASHER SW [On/Off]
    RR WIPER STOP [On/Off]

    G

    Indicates rear wiper motor auto stop input from rear wiper motor.

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test Item

    H

    Description

    FR WIPER

    This test is able to check front wiper operation [INT/Lo/Hi/Off].

    RR WIPER

    This test is able to check rear wiper operation [On/Off].

    I

    WORK SUPPORT
    Support Item
    WIPER SPEED SETTING

    Setting

    J

    Description

    On

    Front wiper intermittent time linked with vehicle speed and wiper dial position.

    Off*

    Front wiper intermittent time linked with wiper dial position.

    K

    * : Initial setting

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-15

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    Diagnosis Description

    INFOID:0000000009567681

    AUTO ACTIVE TEST
    Description
    In auto active test, the IPDM E/R sends a drive signal to the following systems to check their operation.
    • Front wiper (LO, HI)
    • Parking lamp
    • License plate lamp
    • Tail lamp
    • Front fog lamp
    • Headlamp (LO, HI)
    • A/C compressor (magnet clutch)
    • Cooling fan
    Operation Procedure
    NOTE:
    Never perform auto active test in the following conditions.
    • Passenger door is open
    • CONSULT is connected
    1. Close the hood and lift the wiper arms from the windshield. (Prevent windshield damage due to wiper
    operation)
    NOTE:
    When auto active test is performed with hood opened, sprinkle water on windshield beforehand.
    2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    3. Turn the ignition switch ON, and within 20 seconds, press the driver door switch 10 times. Then turn the
    ignition switch OFF.
    4. Turn the ignition switch ON within 10 seconds. After that the horn sounds once and the auto active test
    starts.
    5. After a series of the following operations is repeated 3 times, auto active test is completed.
    NOTE:
    • When auto active test has to be cancelled halfway through test, turn the ignition switch OFF.
    • When auto active test is not activated, door switch may be the cause. Check door switch. Refer to DLK-84,
    «Component Function Check».
    Inspection in Auto Active Test
    When auto active test is actuated, the following operation sequence is repeated 3 times.
    Operation sequence

    Inspection location

    Operation

    1

    Front wiper

    LO for 5 seconds → HI for 5 seconds

    2




    10 seconds

    3

    Headlamp

    LO for 10 seconds →HI ON ⇔ OFF 5 times

    4

    A/C compressor (magnet clutch)

    ON ⇔ OFF 5 times

    5

    Cooling fan

    LO for 5 seconds → MID for 3 seconds → HI for 2 seconds

    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Tail lamp
    Front fog lamp

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-16

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Concept of Auto Active Test
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    JMMIA0812GB

    • IPDM E/R starts the auto active test with the door switch signals transmitted by BCM via CAN communication. Therefore, the CAN communication line between IPDM E/R and BCM is considered normal if the auto
    active test starts successfully.
    • The auto active test facilitates troubleshooting if any systems controlled by IPDM E/R cannot be operated.

    F

    G

    Diagnosis Chart in Auto Active Test
    Symptom





    Inspection contents

    Any of the following components do not operate
    Parking lamp
    License plate lamp
    Tail lamp
    Front fog lamp
    Headlamp (HI, LO)
    Front wiper (HI, LO)

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the applicable system operate?

    Possible cause
    YES

    BCM signal input circuit

    NO

    • Lamp or motor
    • Lamp or motor ground circuit
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and applicable system
    • IPDM E/R

    YES

    • BCM signal input circuit
    • CAN communication signal between BCM and ECM
    • CAN communication signal between ECM and IPDM E/R

    NO

    • Magnet clutch
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and magnet clutch
    • IPDM E/R

    YES

    • ECM signal input circuit
    • CAN communication signal between ECM and IPDM E/R

    NO

    • Cooling fan motor
    • Harness or connector between
    IPDM E/R and cooling fan motor
    • IPDM E/R

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the magnet clutch operate?

    A/C compressor does not operate

    Perform auto active test.
    Does the cooling fan operate?

    Cooling fan does not operate

    CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R)

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    INFOID:0000000009567682

    P

    APPLICATION ITEM
    CONSULT performs the following functions via CAN communication with IPDM E/R.
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    Ecu Identification

    The IPDM E/R part number is displayed.

    Self Diagnostic Result

    The IPDM E/R self diagnostic results are displayed.

    Data Monitor

    The IPDM E/R input/output data is displayed in real time.

    Revision: April 2013

    H

    WW-17

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Direct Diagnostic Mode

    Description

    Active Test

    The IPDM E/R activates outputs to test components.

    CAN Diag Support Mntr

    The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.

    ECU IDENTIFICATION
    The IPDM E/R part number is displayed.

    SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
    Refer to PCS-20, «DTC Index».

    DATA MONITOR
    Main
    Signals

    Description

    MOTOR FAN REQ [%]

    ×

    Indicates cooling fan speed signal received from ECM on CAN communication
    line

    AC COMP REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates A/C compressor request signal received from ECM on CAN communication line

    TAIL&CLR REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates position light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HL LO REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates low beam request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    HL HI REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates high beam request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    FR FOG REQ [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates front fog light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    FR WIP REQ [Stop/1LOW/Low/Hi]

    ×

    Indicates front wiper request signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    WIP AUTO STOP [STOP P/ACT P]

    ×

    Indicates condition of front wiper auto stop signal

    WIP PROT [Off/BLOCK]

    ×

    Indicates condition of front wiper fail-safe operation

    Monitor Item [Unit]

    Indicates ignition switch ON signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    IGN RLY1 -REQ [On/Off]
    IGN RLY [On/Off]

    ×

    Indicates condition of ignition relay

    PUSH SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of push-button ignition switch

    INTER/NP SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of CVT shift position

    ST RLY CONT [On/Off]

    Indicates starter relay status signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    IHBT RLY -REQ [On/Off]

    Indicates starter control relay signal received from BCM on CAN communication
    line

    ST/INHI RLY [Off/ ST /INHI]

    Indicates condition of starter relay and starter control relay

    DETENT SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of CVT shift selector (park position switch)

    DTRL REQ [Off]

    Indicates daytime light request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HOOD SW [On/Off]

    Indicates condition of hood switch

    THFT HRN REQ [On/Off]

    Indicates theft warning horn request signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    HORN CHIRP [On/Off]

    Indicates horn reminder signal received from BCM on CAN communication line

    ACTIVE TEST
    Test item

    Description

    HORN

    This test is able to check horn operation [On].

    FRONT WIPER

    This test is able to check wiper motor operation [Hi/Lo/Off].

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-18

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (IPDM E/R)
    < SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
    Test item

    Description

    MOTOR FAN

    This test is able to check cooling fan operation [4/3/2/1].

    EXTERNAL LAMPS

    This test is able to check external lamp operation [Fog/Hi/Lo/TAIL/Off].

    A

    CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR

    B

    Refer to LAN-12, «CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor».
    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-19

    2014 Note

    BCM, IPDM E/R
    < ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >

    ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
    BCM, IPDM E/R
    List of ECU Reference

    INFOID:0000000009541143

    ECU

    Reference
    BCS-28, «Reference Value»

    BCM

    BCS-44, «Fail-safe»
    BCS-46, «DTC Inspection Priority Chart»
    BCS-46, «DTC Index»
    PCS-13, «Reference Value»

    IPDM E/R

    PCS-18, «Fail-safe»
    PCS-20, «DTC Index»

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-20

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    WIRING DIAGRAM

    A

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    INFOID:0000000009541144

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    AALWA0632GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-21

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1385GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-22

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1386GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-23

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1387GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-24

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    Wiring Diagram

    A
    INFOID:0000000009578851

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AALWA0633GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-25

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1388GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-26

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O
    AALIA1389GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-27

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >

    AALIA1390GB

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-28

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
    < WIRING DIAGRAM >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O
    ABLIA4881GB

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-29

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >

    BASIC INSPECTION
    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    Work Flow

    INFOID:0000000009541145

    WORK FLOW

    AWLIA1887GB

    DETAILED FLOW

    1. REVIEW CUSTOMER COMPLAINT
    Review customer complaint. Try to obtain detailed information about the conditions when the symptom occurs.
    >> GO TO 2

    2. VERIFY THE SYMPTOM
    Verify the symptom by performing an operational check. Refer to WW-8, «FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
    SYSTEM : System Description».
    >> GO TO 3

    3.PERFORM TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS BY SYMPTOM
    Diagnose the vehicle by performing the appropriate trouble diagnosis. Refer to WW-46, «Symptom Table».
    >> GO TO 4

    4. REPAIR OR REPLACE MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
    Repair or replace the specific parts.
    >> GO TO 5

    5. FINAL CHECK

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-30

    2014 Note

    DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
    < BASIC INSPECTION >
    Perform a final inspection of the system.
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Inspection End.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-31

    2014 Note

    WIPER AND WASHER FUSE
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
    WIPER AND WASHER FUSE
    Description
    Component

    INFOID:0000000009541146

    Capacity

    Fuse No.

    Location

    Front wiper motor

    30 A

    39

    IPDM E/R

    Front and rear washer motor

    10 A

    6

    Fuse block (J/B)

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541147

    1. CHECK FUSES
    Check that the following fuses are not blown.
    Component

    Capacity

    Fuse No.

    Location

    Front wiper motor

    30 A

    39

    IPDM E/R

    Front and rear washer motor

    10 A

    6

    Fuse block (J/B)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> Inspection End.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-32

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR LO CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR LO CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009541148

    1.CHECK FRONT WIPER LO OPERATION

    B

    IPDM E/R AUTO ACTIVE TEST
    Start IPDM E/R auto active test. Refer to PCS-9, «Diagnosis Description».
    Check that the front wiper operates on LO operation.
    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    1. Select FR WIPER of BCM (WIPER) active test item.
    2. Check front wiper operation.
    1.
    2.

    LO
    OFF

    C

    D

    : Front wiper (LO) operation
    : Front wiper OFF

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Front wiper motor LO circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to WW-33, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541149

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-21, «Wiring Diagram».
    H

    1. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not blown.

    I

    Component

    Capacity

    Fuse No.

    Location

    Front wiper motor

    30 A

    39

    IPDM E/R

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2

    J

    K

    2. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR (LO) OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Select FR WIPER of BCM (WIPER) active test item.
    While performing the active test, check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    WW

    M
    Terminals
    (+)

    (-)

    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    17

    Ground

    FRONT WIPER

    Voltage (Approx.)

    LO

    Battery voltage

    OFF

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R and front wiper motor.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and front wiper motor harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-33

    O

    P

    3. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR (LO) OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR LO CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    IPDM E/R

    Front wiper motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    17

    E1

    3

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front wiper motor. Refer to WW-61, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-34

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR HI CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR HI CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009541150

    1.CHECK FRONT WIPER HI OPERATION

    B

    IPDM E/R AUTO ACTIVE TEST
    Start IPDM E/R auto active test. Refer to PCS-9, «Diagnosis Description».
    Check that the front wiper operates on HI operation.
    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    1. Select FR WIPER of BCM (WIPER) active test item.
    2. Check front wiper operation.
    1.
    2.

    HI
    OFF

    C

    D

    : Front wiper (HI) operation
    : Front wiper OFF

    E

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Front wiper motor HI circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to WW-35, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541151

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-21, «Wiring Diagram».
    H

    1. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not blown.

    I

    Component

    Capacity

    Fuse No.

    Location

    Front wiper motor

    30 A

    39

    IPDM E/R

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2

    J

    K

    2. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR (HI) OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Select FR WIPER of BCM (WIPER) active test item.
    While performing the active test, check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    WW

    M
    Terminals
    (+)

    (-)

    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    18

    Ground

    FRONT WIPER

    Voltage (Approx.)

    HI

    Battery voltage

    OFF

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 3
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R and front wiper motor.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and front wiper motor harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-35

    O

    P

    3. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR (HI) OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR HI CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    IPDM E/R

    Front wiper motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E45

    18

    E1

    5

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front wiper motor. Refer to WW-61, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-36

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER AUTO STOP SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT WIPER AUTO STOP SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009541152

    1. CHECK FRONT WIPER (AUTO STOP) SIGNAL

    B

    1.
    2.
    3.

    C

    Select FR WIPER STOP of BCM (WIPER) data monitor item.
    Operate the front wiper.
    Check that FR WIPER STOP changes from ON to OFF according to the wiper position.
    Data monitor

    Condition

    FR WIPER STOP

    Front wiper motor

    Status

    Stop position

    ON

    Except stop position

    OFF

    D

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Front wiper auto stop signal circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to WW-37, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541153

    F

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-21, «Wiring Diagram».

    G

    1. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR (AUTO STOP) OUTPUT VOLTAGE

    H

    1.
    2.

    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.
    I

    Terminals
    (+)

    (-)

    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E46

    74

    Ground

    FRONT WIPER

    Voltage (Approx.)

    Except stop position

    Battery voltage

    Stop position

    0V

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Check for intermittent failure.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2

    J

    K

    WW

    2. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR (AUTO STOP) SHORT CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    M

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect IPDM E/R and front wiper motor.
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground.

    N
    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    Terminal

    E46

    74

    Ground

    Continuity

    O

    No

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Repair or replace harness.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    P

    3. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR (AUTO STOP) CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
    Check continuity between IPDM E/R harness connector and front wiper motor harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-37

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER AUTO STOP SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    IPDM E/R

    Front wiper motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    E46

    74

    E1

    4

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front wiper motor. Refer to WW-61, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-38

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT WIPER MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT

    A

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541154

    B

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-21, «Wiring Diagram».
    C

    1. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect front wiper motor.
    Check continuity between front wiper motor harness connector and ground.
    Front wiper motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E1

    2

    Ground

    D

    Continuity

    E

    Yes

    F

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Front wiper motor ground circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-39

    2014 Note

    WASHER MOTOR CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    WASHER MOTOR CIRCUIT
    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541155

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-21, «Wiring Diagram», WW-25, «Wiring Diagram».

    1. CHECK FRONT AND REAR WASHER MOTOR FUSE
    1.
    2.

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Check that the following fuse is not blown.
    Component

    Capacity

    Fuse No.

    Location

    Front and rear washer motor

    10A

    6

    Fuse block (J/B)

    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 2.

    2. CHECK FRONT AND REAR WASHER MOTOR POWER SUPPLY

    1.
    2.
    3.

    Disconnect front and rear washer motor.
    Turn ignition switch ON.
    Check voltage between front and rear washer motor harness connector and ground.

    Front washer operation

    Terminals
    (+)

    (-)

    Front and rear washer motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E2

    1

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Washer switch

    OFF

    0

    ON

    Battery voltage

    Rear washer operation

    Terminals
    (+)

    (-)

    Front and rear washer motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    E2

    2

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)

    Washer switch

    OFF

    0

    ON

    Battery voltage

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front and rear washer motor. Refer to WW-54, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 3.

    3. CHECK WASHER SWITCH

    Check washer switch. Refer to WW-41, «Component Inspection».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Repair harness between front and rear washer motor and washer switch.
    NO
    >> Replace washer switch. Refer to WW-63, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-40

    2014 Note

    WASHER SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    WASHER SWITCH

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009541156

    • Washer switch is integrated with the combination switch.
    • Combination switch (wiper and washer switch) switches polarity between front washer operating and rear
    washer operating to supply power and ground to the front and rear washer motor.

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    ALLIA0350GB

    Component Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009541157

    H

    1. CHECK FRONT WASHER SWITCH
    1.
    2.
    3.

    G

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect combination switch (wiper and washer switch).
    Check continuity between the combination switch (wiper and washer switch) terminals.

    I

    A: Terminal 4

    J

    B: Terminal 6
    C: Terminal 3

    K
    D: Terminal 1

    WW

    JPLIA0164GB

    Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)

    Condition

    Continuity

    Front washer switch ON

    Yes

    M

    Terminal
    1

    6

    3

    4

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2.
    NO
    >> Replace combination switch (wiper and washer switch). Refer to WW-63, «Removal and Installation».

    2. CHECK REAR WASHER SWITCH
    1.

    O

    P

    Check continuity between the combination switch (wiper and washer switch) terminals.

    Revision: April 2013

    N

    WW-41

    2014 Note

    WASHER SWITCH
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    A: Terminal 4
    B: Terminal 6
    C: Terminal 3

    D: Terminal 1
    JPLIA0164GB

    Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)

    Condition

    Continuity

    Rear washer switch ON

    Yes

    Terminal
    1

    4

    6

    3

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Wiper and washer switch is normal.
    NO
    >> Replace combination switch (wiper and washer switch). Refer to WW-63, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-42

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER MOTOR CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR WIPER MOTOR CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578887

    1. CHECK REAR WIPER ON OPERATION
    1.
    2.

    B

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Select «RR WIPER» of BCM active test item.
    While operating the test item, check rear wiper operation.
    ON
    OFF

    C

    : Rear wiper ON operation
    : Stop the rear wiper.

    D

    Is rear wiper operation normal?
    YES >> Rear wiper motor circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to WW-43, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    E

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578888

    F

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-25, «Wiring Diagram».
    G

    1. CHECK REAR WIPER MOTOR OUTPUT VOLTAGE
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    H

    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect rear wiper motor.
    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    Select «RR WIPER» of BCM active test item.
    While operating the test item, check voltage between BCM harness connector and ground.

    J

    Terminals

    Test item

    (+)
    BCM

    (−)

    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    54

    I

    Ground

    Voltage
    (Approx.)
    REAR WIPER
    ON

    Battery voltage

    OFF

    0V

    Is the measurement value normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> GO TO 3

    K

    WW

    M

    2. CHECK REAR WIPER MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
    1.
    2.

    N

    Turn the ignition switch OFF.
    Check continuity between rear wiper motor harness connector and ground.
    Rear wiper motor
    Connector

    Terminal

    D502

    4

    Ground

    Continuity
    Yes

    P

    Does continuity exist?
    YES >> Replace rear wiper motor. Refer to WW-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    3. CHECK REAR WIPER MOTOR OPEN CIRCUIT
    1.

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and rear wiper motor harness connector.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-43

    O

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER MOTOR CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
    BCM

    Rear wiper motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    54

    D502

    2

    Continuity
    Yes

    Does continuity exist?
    YES >> GO TO 4
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    4. CHECK REAR WIPER MOTOR SHORT CIRCUIT
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    54

    Ground

    Continuity
    No

    Does continuity exist?
    YES >> Repair or replace harness.
    NO
    >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-44

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER AUTO STOP SIGNAL CIRCUIT
    < DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >

    REAR WIPER AUTO STOP SIGNAL CIRCUIT

    A

    Component Function Check

    INFOID:0000000009578889

    1. CHECK REAR WIPER (AUTO STOP) OPERATION
    1.
    2.
    3.

    B

    CONSULT DATA MONITOR
    Select «WIPER» of BCM data monitor item.
    Operate the rear wiper.
    Check that «RR WIPER STOP» changes to «ON» and «OFF» linked with the wiper operation.
    Monitor item

    Condition

    RR WIPER STOP

    Rear wiper motor

    C

    Monitor status

    Stop position

    ON

    Except stop position

    OFF

    D

    E

    Is the status of item normal?
    YES >> Rear wiper auto stop signal circuit is normal.
    NO
    >> Refer to WW-45, «Diagnosis Procedure».

    F

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009578890

    G

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-25, «Wiring Diagram».
    H

    1. CHECK REAR WIPER MOTOR AUTO STOP CIRCUITS FOR OPEN
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Turn ignition switch OFF.
    Disconnect BCM and rear wiper motor.
    Check continuity between BCM harness connector terminals and rear wiper motor harness connector terminals.

    I

    J
    BCM

    Rear wiper motor

    Connector

    Terminal

    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    44

    D502

    3

    Continuity
    Yes

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 2
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    K

    WW

    2. CHECK AUTO STOP CIRCUITS FOR SHORT TO GROUND
    M

    Check continuity between BCM harness connector terminals and ground.
    BCM
    Connector

    Terminal

    M100

    44

    Ground

    Continuity

    N

    No

    Is inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-45

    2014 Note

    WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
    WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    Symptom Table

    INFOID:0000000009541158

    CAUTION:
    Perform the self-diagnosis with CONSULT before performing the diagnosis by symptom. Perform the
    diagnosis by DTC if DTC is detected.
    Symptom

    HI only

    Possible malfunction

    Reference

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    • IPDM E/R
    • Harness between IPDM E/R and front wiper
    motor
    • Front wiper motor

    Front wiper motor (HI) circuit
    Refer to WW-35, «Component
    Function Check».

    Front wiper request signal (IPDM E/R)

    Front wiper does not operate in…

    LO and INT

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    • IPDM E/R
    • Harness between IPDM E/R and front wiper
    motor
    • Front wiper motor

    Front wiper motor (LO) circuit
    Refer to WW-33, «Component
    Function Check».

    Front wiper request signal (IPDM E/R)

    INT only

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Front wiper request signal (IPDM E/R)

    Any mode


    Front wiper auto stop signal (IPDM E/R)

    Front wiper does not
    stop in…

    Revision: April 2013

    Any mode

    Check FR WIP REQ in DATA
    MONITOR of IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-10, «CONSULT
    Function (IPDM E/R)».

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • BCM

    WW-46

    Check FR WIP REQ in DATA
    MONITOR of IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-10, «CONSULT
    Function (IPDM E/R)».
    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».
    Check FR WIP REQ in DATA
    MONITOR of IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-10, «CONSULT
    Function (IPDM E/R)».
    Refer to WW-49, «Diagnosis
    Procedure».
    Refer to WW-37, «Component
    Function Check».
    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    2014 Note

    WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom

    Front wiper operates abnormally because…

    Possible malfunction

    Reference

    Intermittent adjustments cannot be made.

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    Wiper/washer will not
    operate together.

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    • IPDM E/R
    • Harness between IPDM E/R and front wiper
    motor
    • Front wiper motor

    Front wiper auto stop signal
    circuit
    Refer to WW-37, «Component
    Function Check».

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    • BCM
    • Harness between rear wiper motor and
    BCM
    • Harness between rear wiper motor and
    ground
    • Rear wiper motor

    Rear wiper motor circuit
    Refer to WW-43, «Diagnosis
    Procedure».

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • BCM

    Rear wiper motor circuit
    Refer to WW-43, «Diagnosis
    Procedure».

    WW

    ON only

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    M

    INT only

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • BCM
    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between rear wiper motor and
    BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    Wipers will not return to
    stop position (repeatedly operates for 10
    seconds and then
    stops for 20 seconds.
    Wipers then stop operating).

    ON only

    INT only
    Rear wiper does not operate.

    ON and INT

    Rear wiper does not
    stop.

    Wiper is not linked to
    the washer operation.

    BCM
    Rear wiper does not operate normally.

    Rear wiper does not return to the Stop position
    (Stops after a five-second operation).
    Rear wiper stops after
    operating for five seconds when ignition
    switch is turned ON.

    Revision: April 2013

    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    N

    O

    P
    • BCM
    • Harness between rear wiper motor and
    BCM
    • Rear wiper motor

    WW-47

    Rear wiper auto stop signal
    circuit
    Refer to WW-45, «Diagnosis
    Procedure».

    2014 Note

    WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM SYMPTOMS
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    Symptom

    Front and rear washer
    motor does not operate.

    Revision: April 2013

    Front and rear washer
    motor does not operate
    when the washing
    windshield.

    Possible malfunction

    Reference

    • Combination switch (wiper and washer
    switch)
    • Harness between combination switch (wiper and washer switch) and BCM
    • BCM

    Combination switch (wiper
    and washer switch)
    Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom
    Table».

    • Harness between rear combination switch
    (wiper and washer switch) and front and
    rear washer motor.
    • Front and rear washer motor

    Front and rear washer motor
    circuit
    Refer to WW-40, «Diagnosis
    Procedure».

    WW-48

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    FRONT WIPER DOES NOT OPERATE

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009541159

    The front wiper does not operate under any operation conditions.

    B

    Diagnosis Procedure

    INFOID:0000000009541160

    C

    Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to WW-21, «Wiring Diagram».
    D

    1. CHECK WIPER RELAY OPERATION
    IPDM E/R AUTO ACTIVE TEST
    Start IPDM E/R auto active test. Refer to PCS-10, «CONSULT Function (IPDM E/R)».
    Check that the front wiper operates on LO and HI operation.
    CONSULT ACTIVE TEST
    1. Select FR WIPER of BCM (WIPER) active test item.
    2. Check front wiper operation.

    E

    1.
    2.

    LO
    HI
    OFF

    F

    : Front wiper LO operation
    : Front wiper HI operation
    : Front wiper stop

    G

    H

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 5
    NO
    >> GO TO 2

    2. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR FUSE

    I

    Refer to WW-32, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the fuse blown?
    YES >> Replace the fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
    NO
    >> GO TO 3

    J

    3. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT

    K

    Refer to WW-39, «Diagnosis Procedure».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> GO TO 4
    NO
    >> Repair or replace harness.

    WW

    4. CHECK FRONT WIPER MOTOR OUTPUT VOLTAGE

    M

    1.
    2.
    3.

    N

    Turn the ignition switch ON.
    With CONSULT, select FRONT WIPER of IPDM E/R ACTIVE TEST item.
    Check voltage between IPDM E/R harness connector and ground while wipers are operating.
    Terminals
    (+)

    (−)

    IPDM E/R
    Connector

    FRONT WIPER

    Voltage (Approx.)

    LO

    Battery voltage

    OFF

    0V

    HI

    Battery voltage

    OFF

    0V

    Terminal
    17

    Ground

    E45
    18

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace front wiper motor. Refer to WW-61, «Removal and Installation».
    Revision: April 2013

    WW-49

    2014 Note

    O

    P

    FRONT WIPER DOES NOT OPERATE
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
    NO
    >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».

    5. CHECK FRONT WIPER REQUEST SIGNAL INPUT
    1.
    2.
    3.

    With CONSULT, select FR WIP REQ in DATA MONITOR of IPDM E/R.
    Switch the front wiper switch to HI and LO.
    Check the status of FR WIP REQ while operating the switch.
    Data monitor

    FR WIP REQ

    Condition

    Status

    Front wiper switch OFF

    STOP

    Front wiper switch LO

    LOW

    Front wiper switch HI

    HI

    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace IPDM E/R. Refer to PCS-30, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> GO TO 6

    6. CHECK COMBINATION SWITCH (WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH)

    Check combination switch (wiper and washer switch). Refer to BCS-66, «Symptom Table».
    Is the inspection result normal?
    YES >> Replace BCM. Refer to BCS-67, «Removal and Installation».
    NO
    >> Repair or replace the applicable parts.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-50

    2014 Note

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
    < SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >

    NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION

    A

    Description

    INFOID:0000000009541161

    FRONT WIPER PROTECTION FUNCTION

    B

    IPDM E/R detects front wiper stop position by a front wiper stop position signal.
    When a front wiper stop position signal is in the conditions listed below, IPDM E/R stops power supply to wiper
    after repeating a front wiper 10 seconds activation and 20 seconds stop.

    C

    Ignition switch
    ON

    Front wiper switch

    Front wiper stop position signal

    OFF

    The front wiper stop position signal (stop position) cannot be input for 10 seconds.

    ON

    The front wiper stop position signal does not change for 10 seconds.

    NOTE:
    This operation status can be confirmed on the IPDM E/R “Data Monitor” that displays “BLOCK” for the item
    “WIP PROT” while the wiper is stopped.

    REAR WIPER MOTOR PROTECTION FUNCTION
    • BCM may stop rear wiper to protect the rear wiper motor when the rear wiper is stopped for 5 seconds or
    more due to a snowfall.
    • Rear wiper operates normally one minute after the obstacles are removed with rear wiper OFF.

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-51

    2014 Note

    WASHER TANK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
    WASHER TANK
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009578899

    ALLIA1318ZZ

    1.

    Washer tank cap

    A.

    Front washer motor seal

    2.

    Washer tank

    3.

    Front washer motor

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009578900

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove washer tank clip (A) using a suitable tool.

    ALKIA3175ZZ

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-52

    2014 Note

    WASHER TANK
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4. Release the front washer tube (2) and rear washer tube (1) from
    washer tank (3).
    5. Release the harness (4) from the washer tank (3).

    A

    B

    C
    ALLIA1305ZZ

    6.
    7.

    D

    Disconnect the harness connector from the washer pump.
    Remove bolts (A) and washer tank (1).

    E

    F

    G
    ALLIA1303ZZ

    H

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    • After installation, add water to the top of the washer tank inlet to check that no leaks exist.
    • Fill washer tank with specified amount of fluid. Refer to WW-71, «Specifications».

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-53

    2014 Note

    FRONT WASHER MOTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT WASHER MOTOR
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009606283

    ALLIA1318ZZ

    1.

    Washer tank cap

    A.

    Front washer motor seal

    2.

    Washer tank

    3.

    Front washer motor

    Front

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606284

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.

    Remove front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the front washer motor.
    Remove front washer tube and rear washer tube from front washer motor.
    Remove front washer motor from washer tank.
    Remove front washer motor seal from washer tank.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Do not rotate or damage the front washer motor seal when installing the front washer motor.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-54

    2014 Note

    FRONT WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009606306

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    ALLIA1306ZZ

    1.

    Front washer nozzle (RH)

    2.

    Front washer tube

    3.

    Front washer motor

    4.

    Washer tank

    5.

    Front washer nozzle (LH)

    A.

    To rear washer

    B.

    Washer pump seal

    J

    Clip

    K

    WASHER NOZZLE
    WASHER NOZZLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606285

    WW

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove cowl top cover. Refer to EXT-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect front washer tube from front washer nozzle (1).
    Place cowl top cover (2) up side down and release front washer
    nozzle pawl (A) using a suitable tool to remove.

    M

    N

    O

    P
    AWLIA2161ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    After installation, adjust the nozzle spray pattern. Refer to WW-56, «WASHER NOZZLE : Adjustment».
    Revision: April 2013

    WW-55

    2014 Note

    FRONT WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    WASHER NOZZLE : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009606286

    ALLIA1307ZZ

    1.

    Windshield glass

    2.

    Black printed area line

    3.

    Front washer nozzle (LH/RH)
    215.7 mm (8.49 in)

    A.

    Center line

    B.

    509.7 mm (20.07 in)

    C.

    D.

    614.5 mm (24.19 in)

    E.

    329.1 mm (12.96 in)

    F.

    41.0 mm (1.61 in)

    G.

    379.6 mm (14.94 in)

    H.

    161.1 mm (6.34 in)

    J.

    58.6 mm (2.31 in)

    K.

    58.0 mm (2.28 in)

    M.

    142.0 mm (5.59 in)

    N.

    365.9 mm (14.41 in)

    O.

    54.7 mm (2.15 in)

    P.

    492.5 mm (19.39 in)

    Q.

    652.2 mm (25.68 in)

    R.

    174.3 mm (6.86 in)

    S.

    520.7 mm (20.50 in)

    If washer nozzle (1) spray pattern is not within specification, adjust
    using a suitable tool (A).

    JMLIA1327ZZ

    WASHER TUBE
    WASHER TUBE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606287

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove front washer tube from washer pump.
    Remove cowl top cover. Refer to EXT-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Release the clips that retain the front washer tube to the vehicle body using a suitable tool and remove.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-56

    2014 Note

    FRONT WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    A

    WASHER TUBE : Inspection

    INFOID:0000000009606329

    B

    INSPECTION
    Check that air can pass through the nozzle (1) by blowing into the
    nozzle and that air cannot flow in the opposite direction.
    O: Air can flow
    X: Air cannot flow

    C

    D

    E
    JMLIA1326ZZ

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-57

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER ARM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT WIPER ARM
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009606288

    ALLIA1310ZZ

    1.

    Wiper arm cap (LH/RH)

    2.

    Wiper arm (LH)

    3.

    Wiper blade (LH)

    4.

    Wiper arm (RH)

    5.

    Wiper blade (RH)

    6.

    Front wiper drive

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606289

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Open hood.
    Operate wiper to move it to the auto stop position.
    Remove wiper arm cap.
    Remove wiper arm nut and wiper arm.

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Clean wiper arm mount as shown. This will reduce the possibility
    of wiper arm looseness.

    ELH0717D

    2.
    3.

    Operate wiper motor to move the wiper to the auto stop position.
    Adjust the front wiper blade position. Refer to WW-59, «Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-58

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER ARM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    4. Install front wiper arm and front wiper arm nut.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten front wiper arm nut to specification. Refer to WW-58, «Exploded View».
    5. Install front wiper arm cap.
    6. Check that wiper blades stop at the specified position. Refer to WW-59, «Adjustment».

    Adjustment

    A

    B
    INFOID:0000000009606290

    C

    WIPER BLADE POSITION ADJUSTMENT

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K
    ALLIA1309ZZ

    WW
    1.

    Wiper blade (RH)

    2.

    Front fender (RH)

    3.

    Windshield glass

    4.

    Cowl top cover

    5.

    Wiper blade (LH)

    C.

    28.0 ± 7.5 mm (1.10 ± 0.30 in)

    D.

    60.7 ± 7.5 mm (2.39 ± 0.30 in)

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-59

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER BLADE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT WIPER BLADE
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606291

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Lift up wiper arm and set to the position where wiper arm can be locked back.
    Push the release tab (A) of the front wiper blade (1), then move
    the front wiper blade down the front wiper arm (2) to remove.
    CAUTION:
    Be careful not to drop the wiper arm onto the windshield
    glass.

    JMLIA1044ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    Insert the front wiper blade onto the front wiper arm until it clicks into place.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-60

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER DRIVE ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    FRONT WIPER DRIVE ASSEMBLY

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009606292

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    ALLIA1310ZZ

    1.

    Wiper arm cap (LH/RH)

    2.

    Wiper arm (LH)

    3.

    Wiper blade (LH)

    4.

    Wiper arm (RH)

    5.

    Wiper blade (RH)

    6.

    Front wiper drive assembly

    Removal and Installation

    J

    INFOID:0000000009606293

    K

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Remove cowl top cover. Refer to EXT-23, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from front wiper motor.
    Remove bolts and front wiper drive assembly.

    WW

    INSTALLATION

    M

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Tighten front wiper drive assembly bolts to specification. Refer to WW-61, «Exploded View».

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-61

    2014 Note

    FRONT WIPER DRIVE ASSEMBLY
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009606294

    ALLIA1311ZZ

    1.

    Wiper linkage 2

    4.

    Front wiper drive

    2.

    Wiper linkage 1

    Disassembly and Assembly

    3.

    Front wiper motor

    INFOID:0000000009606295

    DISASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.

    3.

    Remove front wiper drive assembly. Refer to WW-61, «Removal and Installation».
    Remove wiper linkage 1 and 2 from the front wiper drive.
    CAUTION:
    Do not bend the linkage or damage the plastic part of the ball joint when removing the wiper linkage.
    Remove screws and wiper motor from front wiper drive.

    ASSEMBLY
    1.
    2.

    3.
    4.

    Install wiper motor screws and wiper motor to front wiper drive.
    Install wiper linkage 2 to the front wiper drive.
    CAUTION:
    • Do not drop wiper motor or cause it to come into contact with other parts.
    • Be careful of the grease condition at the wiper motor and wiper linkage joint (retainer). Apply a
    suitable multi−purpose grease if necessary.
    Install wiper linkage 1 to the wiper motor and the front wiper drive.
    Install front wiper drive assembly. Refer to WW-61, «Removal and Installation».

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-62

    2014 Note

    WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH

    A

    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009578916

    The wiper and washer switch is part of the combination switch. Refer to EXL-112, «Removal and Installation».

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-63

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER ARM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR WIPER ARM
    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009606296

    ALLIA1312ZZ

    1.

    Rear wiper motor

    2.

    Rear wiper arm seal

    4.

    Rear wiper arm

    5.

    Rear wiper blade

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Rear wiper arm cover

    INFOID:0000000009606297

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.

    Operate the rear wiper to move it to the auto stop position.
    Remove rear wiper arm cover.
    Remove nut and rear wiper arm.

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Clean the rear wiper arm as shown. This will reduce the possibility of wiper arm looseness.

    SKIA0082J

    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.

    Adjust the rear wiper blade position. Refer to WW-65, «Adjustment».
    Install the rear wiper arm and nut.
    Install the rear wiper arm cover.
    Check that the rear wiper blade stops at the specified position. Refer to WW-65, «Adjustment».

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-64

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER ARM
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009606298

    A

    WIPER BLADE POSITION ADJUSTMENT
    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    ALLIA1313ZZ

    1.

    Back door window glass

    A.

    30.7 ± 7.5 mm (1.21 ± 0.30 in)

    2.

    Back door

    3.

    G

    Rear wiper blade

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-65

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER BLADE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR WIPER BLADE
    Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606299

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.

    Lift the rear wiper arm and blade assembly away from the back window glass.
    Push the release tab (A) of the rear wiper blade (1), then move
    the rear wiper blade down the rear wiper arm (2) to remove.

    JMLIA1044ZZ

    INSTALLATION
    1.

    Insert the rear wiper blade onto the rear wiper arm until it clicks into place.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-66

    2014 Note

    REAR WIPER MOTOR
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR WIPER MOTOR

    A

    Exploded View

    INFOID:0000000009606300

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I
    ALLIA1312ZZ

    1.

    Rear wiper motor

    2.

    Rear wiper arm seal

    4.

    Rear wiper arm

    5.

    Rear wiper blade

    Removal and Installation

    3.

    Rear wiper arm cover

    J

    INFOID:0000000009606301

    K

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.

    Remove rear wiper arm. Refer to WW-64, «Removal and Installation».
    WW
    Remove back door inner finisher. Refer to INT-34, «BACK DOOR INNER FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the harness connector from the rear wiper motor.
    M
    Remove bolts and rear wiper motor.

    INSTALLATION

    N

    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-67

    2014 Note

    REAR WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >

    REAR WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE
    Component Parts Location

    INFOID:0000000009606337

    ALLIA1321ZZ

    1.

    Grommet

    2.

    Rear washer nozzle

    4.

    Front washer motor

    5.

    Washer tank

    3.

    Rear washer tube
    Clip

    WASHER NOZZLE
    WASHER NOZZLE : Removal and Installation

    INFOID:0000000009606302

    REMOVAL
    1.

    Disconnect the rear washer tube grommet (1) from the back
    door.

    ALKIA3188ZZ

    2.
    3.

    Disconnect the rear washer tube from the rear washer nozzle.
    Remove the rear washer nozzle.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
    CAUTION:
    Adjust the rear washer nozzle spray pattern. Refer to WW-68, «WASHER NOZZLE : Adjustment».

    WASHER NOZZLE : Adjustment

    INFOID:0000000009606303

    WASHER NOZZLE SPRAY PATTERN

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-68

    2014 Note

    REAR WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    A

    B

    C

    D

    E

    F

    ALLIA1314ZZ

    1.

    Rear washer nozzle

    2.

    Back door window glass

    3.

    Black printed area line

    A.

    30.8 mm (1.21 in)

    B.

    23.6 mm (0.93 in)

    C.

    21.1 mm (0.83 in)

    G

    If washer nozzle (1) spray pattern is not within specification, adjust
    using a suitable tool (A).
    H

    I

    J
    JMLIA1327ZZ

    WASHER TUBE
    WASHER TUBE : Removal and Installation

    K
    INFOID:0000000009606304

    REMOVAL
    1.
    2.
    3.
    4.
    5.
    6.
    7.
    8.

    WW

    Remove front under cover. Refer to EXT-25, «FRONT UNDER COVER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove fender protector (RH). Refer to EXT-24, «Removal and Installation».
    Disconnect the rear washer tube from the washer pump.
    Remove dash side finisher (RH). Refer to INT-22, «DASH SIDE FINISHER : Removal and Installation».
    Remove front and rear kicking plate (RH). Refer to INT-20, «KICKING PLATE : Removal and Installation».
    Remove center pillar lower finisher (RH). Refer to INT-23, «CENTER PILLAR LOWER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».
    Remove rear seat back (RH). Refer to SE-19, «SEATBACK : Removal and Installation».
    Remove luggage side upper finisher (RH). Refer to INT-33, «LUGGAGE SIDE UPPER FINISHER :
    Removal and Installation».

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-69

    2014 Note

    REAR WASHER NOZZLE AND TUBE
    < REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
    9. Disconnect the rear washer tube grommet (1) from the back
    door.

    ALKIA3188ZZ

    10. Disconnect the rear washer tube from the rear washer nozzle.
    11. Release the clips using a suitable tool and remove the rear washer tube.

    INSTALLATION
    Installation is in the reverse order of removal.

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-70

    2014 Note

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    < SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

    A

    SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
    Specifications

    INFOID:0000000009578817

    B

    WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID
    C

    Windshield washer fluid capacity

    2.5

    Windshield washer fluid specification

    (2 5/8 US qt, 2 1/4 Imp qt)

    Refer to MA-12, «Fluids and Lubricants».

    D

    E

    F

    G

    H

    I

    J

    K

    WW

    M

    N

    O

    P

    Revision: April 2013

    WW-71

    2014 Note

    Ниссан Ноут 2 ремонт

    Руководство по эксплуатации Ниссан Ноут 2 с 2016 года рестайлинг в кузове Е12 с двигателем 1.2 литра HR12DE передний или полный привод

    Характеристики Ниссан Ноут 2

    Тип привода    Передний — полный
    Тип кузова    Хэтчбек
    Тип трансмиссии    Вариатор
    Объем двигателя, куб.см    1198
    Клиренс (высота дорожного просвета), мм    150
    Габариты кузова (Д x Ш x В), мм    4100 x 1695 x 1525
    Габариты салона (Д x Ш x В), мм    2065 x 1390 x 1255
    Колесная база, мм    2600
    Минимальный радиус разворота, м    4.7
    Ширина передней колеи, мм    1480
    Ширина задней колеи, мм    1485
    Масса, кг    1040
    Общий вес автомобиля, кг    1315
    Расход топлива в смешанном цикле, л/100 км    4,3
    Передняя подвеска Независимая, амортизационная стойка типа МакФерсон
    Задняя подвеска    Полузависимая, торсионная балка
    Передние тормоза    Дисковые вентилируемые
    Задние тормоза    Барабанные

    Двигатель HR12DE
    Максимальная мощность, л.с. (кВт) при об./мин.    79 (58) / 6000
    Максимальный крутящий момент, Н*м (кг*м) при об./мин.    106 (11) / 4400
    Тип двигателя    Рядный, 3-цилиндровый, DOHC
    Доп. информация о двигателе    электронная система впрыска топлива
    Используемое топливо    Бензин Regular (АИ-92, АИ-95)
    Степень сжатия    10.2
    Диаметр цилиндра, мм    78
    Ход поршня, мм    83.6
    Экологический тип двигателя    снижение токсичных выбросов на 75% по нормативу 2005 года
    Удельная мощность, кг/л.с.    13.16

    Лампы Ниссан Ноут 2 Е12

    Ближний дальний HB5
    поворотники 3457 AK
    габариты W5W
    ПТФ H8

    Задние поворотники WY21W
    Габариты/стоп сигнал W21/5W
    Задний ход W21W
    номерной знак W5W

    Заправочные объемы Ниссан Ноут

    Топливный бак 41 л
    моторное масло 3.5 л 5W30
    Система охлаждения 7.3 л
    Свечи PLZKAR6A-11

    Автор Ниссан
    формат PDF

    Руководство Ниссан Ноут 2

    The front-wheel drive Nissan Note, created by the famous Japanese manufacturer, successfully combines the highest quality standards and innovative technologies, thanks to which thousands of car enthusiasts around the world prefer these machines, being sure that they will not find a more reliable partner on the road. Indeed, Nissan Note cars are distinguished by predictable and stable work, good build, unpretentious character and elegant design, reflecting the personality of its owner. The only condition for uninterrupted operation and impeccable appearance of the car – compliance with the standards of operation, conducting preventive checks and, if necessary, repair. For all those interested in the stable operation of their car drivers, as well as employees of service stations and car services, there is an irreplaceable repair manual for the Nissan Note, which also focuses on the topics of competent operation and maintenance of these machines.

    The workshop manual Nissan Note in detail are the most optimal solutions of diagnostic and repair tasks of any complexity, and implement them in practice not be difficult, not only due to the clear instructions, but also because of the quality figures.

    CONTENTS

    • Accelerator Control System
    • Audio, Visual & Navigation System
    • Body Control System
    • Body Repair
    • Brake Control System
    • Charging System
    • Clutch
    • Cruise Control System
    • Defogger
    • Door & Lock
    • EM
    • Engine Control System
    • Engine Cooling System
    • Engine Lubrication System
    • Exhaust System
    • Exterior Lighting System
    • Exterior
    • Front Axle
    • Front Suspension
    • Fuel System
    • General Information
    • Glass & Window System
    • Heater & Air Conditioning Control System
    • Heater & Air Conditioning System
    • Horn
    • Instrument Panel
    • Interior Lighting System
    • Interior
    • LAN System
    • Maintenance
    • Meter, Warning Lamp & Indicator
    • Mirrors
    • Parking Brake System
    • Power Control System
    • Power Outlet
    • Power Supply, Ground & Circuit Elements
    • Power Window Control System
    • Rear Axle
    • Rear Suspension
    • Road Wheels & Tires
    • Seat Belt
    • Seat
    • Security Control System
    • SRS Airbag Control System
    • SRS Airbag
    • Starting System
    • Steering Control System
    • Steering System
    • Transaxle & Transmission
    • Ventilation System
    • Warning Chime System
    • Wiper & Washer

    Language: English
    Format: PDF
    Pages: 739

    Nissan Note E12 2016 Service Repair Manual

    Electronic Service Manual Nissan Note E11.

    Мультимедийное руководство на английском языке по техническому обслуживанию и ремонту автомобиля Nissan Note серии E11.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: Nissan
    • Год издания: 2006
    • Страниц:
    • Формат:
    • Размер: 60,5 Mb

    Service Manual Nissan Note E12.

    Руководство на английском языке по техническому обслуживанию и ремонту автомобиля Nissan Note серии E12.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: Nissan
    • Год издания: 2013
    • Страниц:
    • Формат: PDF
    • Размер: 60,0 Mb

    Инструкция по эксплуатации Nissan Note с 2005 г.

    Сборник руководств по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию автомобиля Nissan Note с 2005 года выпуска.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: Nissan Europe
    • Год издания: 2006/2010
    • Страниц: 264/229
    • Формат: PDF
    • Размер: 12,9 Mb

    Ремонт без проблем Nissan Note с 2005 г.

    Руководство по эксплуатации, техническому обслуживанию и ремонту автомобиля Nissan Note с 2005 года выпуска с бензиновыми двигателями объемом 1,4/1,6 л.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: Третий Рим
    • Год издания: 2011
    • Страниц: 651
    • Формат: PDF
    • Размер: 77,8 Mb

    Руководство по эксплуатации Nissan Note с 2005 г.

    Руководство по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию автомобиля Nissan Note с 2005 года выпуска.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: MoToR
    • Год издания:
    • Страниц: 274
    • Формат:
    • Размер:

    Руководство по эксплуатации, ТО и ремонту Nissan Note с 2005 г.

    Руководство по эксплуатации, техническому обслуживанию и ремонту автомобиля Nissan Note серии E11 с 2005 года выпуска с бензиновыми двигателями объемом 1,4/1,6 л.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: Автонавигатор
    • Год издания:
    • Страниц: 447
    • Формат: PDF
    • Размер: 26,7 Mb

    Устройство, ТО и ремонт Nissan Note 2005-2009 г.

    Руководство по техническому обслуживанию и ремонту автомобиля Nissan Note серии E11 2005-2009 годов выпуска.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: Автонавигатор
    • Год издания:
    • Страниц: 448
    • Формат:
    • Размер:

    Руководство по эксплуатации и ремонту автомобиля Nissan Note с 2013 года выпуска с бензиновыми и дизельными двигателями.

    • Автор:
    • Издательство: Монолит
    • Год издания:
    • Страниц: 468
    • Формат: PDF
    • Размер:

    Доп информация

    Понравилась статья? Поделить с друзьями:
  • Fubag inmig 200 syn инструкция по эксплуатации на русском
  • Хлоргексидин для растений инструкция по применению цена
  • Шкатулка из картонной коробки своими руками пошаговая инструкция
  • Генератор карвер 3900 инструкция по эксплуатации
  • Электрорубанок интерскол р 110 1100м инструкция